Skip to main content

Full text of "Smithsonian miscellaneous collections"

See other formats


GAM I) W¥¥ WEIS WO GGe Vy WAVIGhAL 
Sy ee thee wil sta 

: Argentinas: Pe eeunee “WS 
Pcie wvayVO ioe orc cae at 


= 


ree eee”, ver WV YU UaY v Ww 
vulyets wy W whi eine “\ 
uS Saag we onan NY) vey WW We 
iWyvy yyy a i 

Weed 

Ww 


SE CES 


IIIT vriry rarity : 
f wi Meee Ny Way vo 

no en WW veani aaa ene 
ive wit ‘ ww 

, cer 
NV Fy eis WW See 

gee Ne YW 


cx 


eee 


Law 


"NAN UN 9 he 
UMA Svea 


yy 


iy EO 


< 
UE 


2 Se EE 
§ CCC 


reareas 


< 


Wi) vi CN ay 
NY ey 


aes 


Wer cay 
: 


mis ain. 


i v v v ' / ¥ : ye Wits ’ v Wy | i VY ud} es Vy wiv. | 
eee “i yY’vuy | 

is vs ie i iaaeesa in 
NMA WYNYYS UN Uy y Wii Yyvosuns Sy MMW 
Tne suo OO Rh aad oc oe 


eee... 


— 


Department of the interior. ‘ \ 


é 


é 


Books are issued to and returned by employés, between the hours 
of 11 a. m. and 2 p. m. on all days except Sundays. o 

The Library is open to employés, for reference, from 9 a. m. till ails 
4 p.m. ’ 


8 8 8 ee, 


LIBRARY RULES. 


1. The employés of the Department of the Interior only are authorized to 
borrow books from the Library. 4] - 
2. Before being allowed to draw books employés will be required to file with 
the Librarian a certificate of identity from the Chief Clerk of the Department, 
or of the Bureau or Office in which employed. 
3. No book will be taken from the Library until its title and the name of the 
borrower shall have been registered by the Librarian. 
4. Of works of single volumes only one at a time may be borrowed ; of works 
of two or more volumes two may be taken. 
5. The period of a loan of books is for two weeks, and borrowers are strictly 
prohibited from lending books thus drawn to other persons, whether of the 
Department or not. 
6. Borrowers wishing to retain books for a longer period than two weeks, ' 
may at the close of the second week renew the loan for an additional twow 7 
weeks. ‘ 
7. The loan of a book will be renewed but once. 
8. Books classed as ‘‘ Works of Reference” or marked in the Catalogue with 
an (*), cannot be taken from the Library. 
9. When a book has been injured while in the possession of a borrower, it 
must be replaced by a perfect copy. ‘ 

10. Application for and return of books must be made in person, except in 
cases of sickness or absence from the city. 

11. Books retrned will not be reissued until they have been examined and 
replaced upon the shelves. 4 

12. When a book has been retained by a borrower beyond two weeks without 
renewal, its price will be certified to the Disbursing Officer of the Department, 
and deducted from the salary of the person withholding it. 

13. Writing on the leaves or covers of books, and the folding or turning down 
of their leaves are strictly prohibited ; violation of this rule will debar employés 
from further privileges of the Library. : 

14. In selecting books from the shelves, care must be used in handling them, 
replacing those not drawn on the shelves from which they were taken; the num- 
ber of the shelf may be ascertained from the label above. - 

15. Employés, on quitting the service of the Department, must return all rie 
books in their possession belonging to the Library. Final payment of thei 
salaries will be withheld by the Disbursiug Officer until he is satisfied that all 
books charged against them at the Library have been returned. 

16. New books can be drawn for one week only, and not renewed. 

17. Current periodicals can be drawn for three days onky, and not renewed. : cry 

18. For infringements of any of the above rules the Librarian is authorized 
to suspend or refuse the issue of books to the culpable persons. 


y order of the Secretary : 
GEO. A. HOWARD, 
14520 b—1 m Chief Clerk. 


— 


BA Ps ‘ ’ ’ 
id o ¢ 
ANY 


yh oy 
- ‘ 
i hie 


Peat dia te ha oe 
Te ee ae 


ay oda eh 
Mf ic \ 
nN 


q 


% 
! 
, 


‘ 


a \ 
» 
7 as Ye eh ia 


SMITHSONIAN 


MISCELLANEOUS COLLECTIONS, 


23 


VOL. XX XIII. 


“EVERY MAN 18 A VALUABLE MENEER OF SOCIETY WHO BY HIS OBSERVATIONS, RESEAKCHES, 


AND EXPERIMENTS PROCURES KNOWLEDGE FOR MEN.”’—SMITHGON. 


WASHINGTON: 
PUBLISHED BY THE SMITHSONIAN INSTITUTION. 


1888. 


ADVERTISEMENT. 


The present series, entitled “Smithsonian Miscellaneous Collec- 
tions,” is intended to embrace all the publications issued directly 
by the Smithsonian Institution in octavo form; those in quarto 
constituting the “Smithsonian Contributions to Knowledge.” The 
quarto series includes memoirs, embracing the records of extended 
original investigations and researches, resulting in what are be- 
lieved to be new truths, and constituting positive additions to the 
sum of human knowledge. The octavo series is designed to contain 
reports on the present state of our knowledge of particular branches: 
of science ; instructions for collecting and digesting facts and mate- 
rials for research; lists and synopses of species of the organic and 
inorganic world ; museum catalogues; reports of explorations; aids 
to bibliographical investigations, ete., generally prepared at the ex- 
press request of the Institution, and at its expense. 

The assignment of a work to one or the other of the two series 
will sometimes depend upon whether the required illustrations can 
be presented more conveniently in the quarto or the octavo form. 

In the Smithsonian Contributions to Knowledge, as well as in 
the present series, each article is separately paged and indexed, and 
the actual date of its publication is that given on its special title 
page, and not that of the volunre in which it is placed. In many 
cases works have been published and largely distributed, years 
before their combination into volumes. 


S. P. LANGLEY, 
Secretary S. I, 


vid 


AALS 7 “8 Fal 
: 
ba! . ’ f i 
aga . 
; ‘ 6 ‘ 
m we K's 
‘ 
i “ +4 : 
us 
' Fricc "i 
ra ‘ 
{ 
” 
j ; 7 Asay le f e4 y 
f 4 -. . : ' : ‘ A ' Wail 
wh) 
Yay é + : 
dit ‘ 
ale | ia id ALi 
r ! 
; 
. ; ' 
wi ty thy 
Ps ‘ 
‘ 
pe ' 
j b 
ean iy ny ’ 
\ 
) r “ 
' 7 
1: vee \ a 
1 ) + 
yp +31 Glie ‘ e ’ 4 
J 
Rae re * y 
! 4 4 
Aew 
‘ 
{ he Pau eo 
/ 4 ‘ 
. va 
= . ‘ 
/ 
+ 
vA Vie 
Ey 
* 
: 
A! ’ 
e 
: t 
- 
‘ i 
J - 
wien 
“ j 
: we 
Nas , 
mAs iy 


TABLE OF CONTENTS. 


ArticLte I. (543.) BUuLiLEetiIn oF THE PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY 
or Wasuinctron. Vol. VI. For the year 1883. 
Pp. 220. 


ARTICLE II. (592.) BULLETIN OF THE PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY 
oF Wasuineton. Vol. VII. For the year 1884. 
Pp. 194. 


ARTICLE II]. (636.) BuLLETIN OF THE PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY 
oF WasuinGcron. Vol. VIII. For the year 1885. 
Pp. 115. = 


ArtTicLE ITV. (661.) BuLLEeriIn oF THE PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY 
or WasHinetTon. Vol. IX. For the year 1886, 
Pp. 115. And Vol. X. For the year 1887. Pp. 
2638. 


NOTE. 


With this volume—(containing the last five volumes of the “ Bul- 
letins of the Philosophical Society of Washington”)—is terminated 
the reissue of these proceedings in the series of MiscELLANEOUS 
CoLLEctions. It may be stated that volumes 1, 2, and 3 of these 
“ Bulletins” formed Vol. XX of the Miscellaneous Collections. 
Volumes 4 and 5 were included in Vol. X XV of the Miscellaneous 
Collections. And, lastly, volumes 6, 7, 8, 9, and 10—together 
with the Memorial Proceedings in honor of Prof. Baird, and a 
full Index of the whole ten volumes—constitute the present Vol. 
XXXII of the Miscellaneous Collections. 


(5) 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY 


or 


WASHINGTON. 


VOLE 


Containing the Minutes of the Society for the year 1883, and the 
Minutes of the Mathematical Section from its organiza- 
tion, March 2gth, to the close of the year. 


PUBLISHED BY THE CO-OPERATION OF THE SMITHSONIAN INSTITUTION. 


WASHINGTON: 
1884. 


CONTENTS. 


Page 

a ISIE ep ae a Sa a i ed reine VII 
Standing Rules of the Society____-__.__----- Ca A BE a eink Ce a aL IX 
prams Euules. of, the General, Committee. 25 -- | 2 Le XII 
ulecaur tne. aplication ef the. Bulletin. 22 22) J XIII 
Wihecersiclectedu Mecem pers Tooe cua a a ORT 
G@iucersrelcctedsWecembely OO ste saaa ae eae ee ee oe ee XV 
msHomeviembers,corrected,to) December i, 1863-52 2 ee EVI 
AnnngNenOru Ot the: Dreasuren: 2 = = Sos ee ee RITE 
mnaual Addressiof the President, J. W..Powell_.=.-<-—...-...c...=. | EXV 
Hollennreiathe GeneraleVMeetine 2 2. oe eA ee ee I 
Experiments in binary arithmetic, H. Farquhar___.-_-_--------... 3 
Refraction in a triaxial ellipsoid, ( 77¢/e only,) S. M. Burnett-_-__~ 4 
Monochromatic aberration in aphakia, ( 7zt/e only,) W. Harkness-_- 5 

Whe matare of matter,.( Z72z/e ovtty,) H. H. Bates\s-W-- ~ 2: 5 
Prevention of malarial diseases, A. F. A. King_-__-___--_.-_-.- 5 
Response of climate to variations of solar radiation, G. K. Gilbert. 10 
Thermal belts of North Carolina, J. W. Chickering-_____-.-_-____ II 
Geology of the Hawaiian Islands, C. E. Dutton _______._---_-__- 13 
Substance, matter, motion, and force, ( Zz¢/e only,) M. H. Doolittle. 14 
Formulas for the computation of Easter, E. B. Elliott___-__..____- 15 
Florida expedition for observing transit of Venus, J. R. Eastman. 21 
Determining the temperature of the air, C. Abbe_-__.______--___- 24 
Determination of specific gravity of solids, C. E. Munroe____-_____ 26 
ieelomyotbintteras., W., CO. Merino 2.) 8a ec 28 
Topographical indications of a fault, H. F. Walling______-_--__. 30 

Ore deposition by replacement, S. F.|Emmons___.---.-......--. 32 
Glagavon tm. Alaska. WoT. Dall 222 oe a ea Se a eis 3 

The Eucalyptus on the Roman Campagna, ( Zi¢/e only,) F.B. Hough 36 
Elyemometrc observations, Hi. A. Hazen-2-. 0+ s-.-. 222-8. 36 
Dreams in their relation with psychology, E. Farquhar__------.-. 37 
Recent experiments on serpent venom, (7Z7¢/e only,) R. Fletcher___ 38 
Further experiments in binary arithmetic, H. Farquhar_-----_-_-- 38 
Medallienmecicalphistory.6 We duce =.= 8 —— sae en ene oec aay 39 


III 


Iv 


CONTENTS. 


Bulletin of the General Meeting—Continued. 


Note on the rings of Saturn, W. B. Taylor_-_....-—_ --.-.----== 
Focal lines in astigmatism, ( 72¢/e only,) S. M. Burnett------ ----— 
Thermometer exposure, Hi a. Flazen "22-2 eee 
Ichthyological results of the Albatross, ( 7z¢/e only,) T. N. Gill---- 
Fallacies: concerning, the deaf, AUG. Bell 2222 2) 2S Sane e eee ae 
Seismographic record from Japan, ( Zz¢/e only,) E. Smith_--------- 
The volcanic problem stated, C. E. Dutton... --2== ee ee ee 
Drainage system and loess of eastern Iowa, W J McGee --------- 
Cambrian system in the United States and Canada, C. D. Walcott - 
Distribution of surplus money of the United States, J. J. Knox.-__- 


An initial meridian and universal time, R. D. Cutts___.-_-._----__ 


Bulletin of the. Mathematical Sectione=_. 1222222 Sa 


Rules ofs the Secon as. 2 ae eee ee ee ee ee 


Inaugural Address of the Chairman, A. Hall_-_----__-_--_-_____ 
A quasi general differentiation, ( 77¢/e only,) A. S. Christie____-__- 
Alignment curves on any surface, C. H. Kummell-__. -----.___-_- 
Determination of the mass of a planet, A. Hall ---______________ 
Infinite and infinitesimal quantities, M. H. Doolittle ___-__.-_____ 
Graphic tables for computing heights, ( 72¢/e only,) G. K. Gilbert__ 
Computation of lunar perturbations, G. W. Hill_---.---------___ 
Units of force and energy, ( Z7#e only,) E. B. Elliott ___-__-.__ pe 
Theory of errors tested by target shooting, C. H. Kummell___-___ 
A special case in maxima and minima, B. Alvord ._____--___.---- 
A financial problem, E.B. Elhotty 22 (225522 ee 
A form of least-square computation, H. Farquhar -_-________-___- 


Note on problem discussed by Mr. Alvord, H. Farquhar -__-___-_. 


The rejection of doubtful observations, M. H. Doolittle--_-__ -__- 
Special treatment of observation-equations, R. S. Woodward_____. 
Contact of jplanetcurves,"A.,S; (Christie ae eee abs 
Committees on papers.- 4 JUS oi a oo ee 
Corrigenda to Vol. ‘V..2-- ee a ee 
6:1; [a re ee Ui tie sy pew ay CUES 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


CONSTITUTION, RULES, 


LIST OF 


OFFICERS AND MEMBERS, 


TREASURER’S REPORT. 


CONSTITUTION 


OF 


THE PHILOSOPHICAL SOGIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ArtTIcLE I. The name of this Society shall be Tor PHILosoput- 
CAL Society oF WASHINGTON. 


ArticuE II. The officers of the Society shall be a President, 
four Vice-Presidents, a Treasurer, and two Secretaries. 


Artic.E III. There shall be a General Committee, consisting of 
the officers of the Society and nine other members. 


ArticLe IV. The officers of the Society and the other members 
of the General Committee shall be elected annually by ballot ; they 
shall hold office until their successors are elected, and shall have 
power to fill vacancies. 


ArrtIcLE V. It shall be the duty of the General Committee to 
make rules for the government of the Society, and to transact all 
its business. 


ArtTIcLE VI. This constitution shall not be amended except by 
a three-fourths vote of those present at an annual meeting for the 
election of officers, and after notice of the proposed change shall 
have been given in writing at a stated meeting of the Society at 
least four weeks previously. 


Vii 


ats, 


°o. = 


; ‘ Rh “e 
u) ely 7 
( f PENS et a 
. yee re: 
Me ea ee 
Peg. sick ck a nce 
ey Y f é ae Uns ; ey as 
i m vb f Vis 4 oy 
12>, a 
ma 
k 
» { 


eae 
T we 
F 
; 
, 
t 
‘ «4 
hey 
on. s 
A 
' 
y 
: 
"i 
; 
\ 
1 
ad 
? 


STANDING RULES 


FOR THE GOVERNMENT OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


1. The Stated Meetings of the Society shall be held at 8 .0’clock 
P. M. on every alternate Saturday; the place of meeting to be 
designated by the General Committee. 


2. Notice of the time and plaee of meeting shall be sent to each 
member by one of the Secretaries. 
When necessary, Special Meetings may be called by the President. 


3. The Annual Meeting for the election of officers shall be the 
last stated meeting in the month of December. 


The order of proceedings (which shall be announced by the 
Chair) shall be as follows: 


First, the reading of the minutes of the last Annual Meeting. 

Second, the presentation of the annual reports of the Secretaries, 
including the announcement of the names of members elected since 
the last annual meeting. 

Third, the presentation of the annual report of the Treasurer. 

Fourth, the announcement of the names of members who, having 
complied with Section 13 of the Standing Rules, are entitled to vote 
on the election of officers. 

Fifth, the election of President. 

Sixth, the election of four Vice-Presidents. 

Seventh, the election of Treasurer. 

Eighth, the election of two Secretaries. 

Ninth, the election of nine members of the General Committee. 

Tenth, the consideration of Amendments to the Constitution of 
the Society, if any such shall have been proposed in accordance 
with Article VI of the Constitution. 

Eleventh, the reading of the rough minutes of the meeting. 

im 


x PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


4, Elections of officers are to be held as follows: 

In each case nominations shall be made by means of an informal 
ballot, the result of which shall be announced by the Secretary; 
after which the first formal ballot shall be taken. 

In the ballot for Vice-Presidents, Secretaries, and Members of the 
General Committee, each voter shall write on one ballot as many 
names as there are officers to be elected, viz., four on the first ballot 
for Vice-Presidents, two on the first for Secretaries, and nine on the 
first for Members of the General Committee; and on each subse- 
quent ballot as many names as there are persons yet to be elected ; 
and those persons who receive a majority of the votes cast shall be 
declared elected. 

If in any case the informal ballot result in giving a majority for 
any one, it may be declared formal by a majority vote. 


5. The Stated Meetings, with the exception of the annual meet- 
ing, shall be devoted to the consideration and discussion of scientific 
subjects. 

The Stated Meeting next preceding the Annual Meeting shall 
be set apart for the delivery of the President’s Annual Address. 


6. Sections representing special branches of science may be 
formed by the General Committee upon the written recommenda- 
tion of twenty members of the Society.* 


7. Persons interested in science, who are not residents of the Dis- 
trict of Columbia, may be present at any meeting of the Society, — 
except the annual meeting, upon invitation of a member. 


8. Similar invitations to residents of the Distriet of Columbia, 
not members of the Society, must be submitted through one of the 
Secretaries to the General Committee for approval. 


9. Invitations to attend during three months the meetings of the 
Society and participate in the discussion of papers, may, by a vote 
of nine members of the General Committee, be issued to persons 
nominated by two members. 


10. Communications intended for publication under the auspices 


* Under this rule the Mathematical Section was organized March 29, 1883. 
Its rules and proceedings follow the Bulletin of the General Meeting. 


STANDING RULES. XI 


of the Society shall be submitted in writing to the General Com- 
mittee for approval. 


11.* Any paper read before a Section may be repeated, either 
entire or by abstract, before a general meeting of the Society, if 
such repetition is recommended by the General Committee of the 
Society. 


12. New members may be proposed in writing by three members 
of the Society for election by the General Committee; but no per- 
son shall be admitted to the privileges of membership unless he 
signifies his acceptance thereof in writing within two months after 
notification of his election. 


13. Each member shall pay annually to the Treasurer the sum 
of five dollars, and no member whose dues are unpaid shall vote at 
the annual meeting for the election of officers, or be entitled to a 
copy of the Bulletin. 

In the absence of the Treasurer, the Secretary is authorized to 
receive the dues of members. 

The names of those two years in arrears shall be dropped from 
the list of members. 

Notice of resignation of membership shall be given in writing to 
the General Committee through the President or one of the Secre- 
taries. 


14. The fiscal year shall terminate with the Annual Meeting. 


15. {Members who are absent from the District of Columbia for 
more than twelve months may be excused from payment of the 
annual assessments. They can, however, resume their membership 
by giving notice to the President of their wish to do so. 


16. Any member not in arrears may, by the payment of one 
hundred dollars at any one time, become a life member, and be 
relieved from all further annual dues and other assessments. 

All moneys received in payment of life membership shall be 
invested as portions of a permanent fund, which shall be directed 
solely to the furtherance of such special scientific work as may be 
ordered by the General Committee. 


* Adopted, May 19, 1883. ¢ Amended, Nov. 10, 1883. 


STANDING RULES 


OF THE 


GENERAL COMMITTEE OF THE PHILOSOPHICAL 
SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


1. The President, Vice-Presidents, and Secretaries of the Society 
shall hold like offices in the General Committee. 


2. The President shall have power to call special meetings of the 
Committee, and to appoint Sub-Committees. 


3. The Sub-Committees shall prepare business for the General 
Committee, and perform such other duties as may be entrusted to 
them. 


4, There shall be two Standing Sub-Committees; one on Com- 
munications for the Stated Meetings of the Society, and another on 
Publications. 


5. The General Committee shall meet at half-past seven o’clock 
on the evening of each Stated Meeting, and by adjournment at 
other times. 


6. For all purposes except for the amendment of the Standing 
Rules of the Committee or of the Society, and the election of mem- 
bers, six members of the Committee shall constitute a quorum. 


7. The names of proposed new members recommended in con- 
formity with Section 11 of the Standing Rules of the Society, may 
be presented at any meeting of the General Committee, but shall 
lie over for at least four weeks before final action, and the concur- 
rence of twelve members of the Committee shall be necessary to 
election. 

The Secretary of the General Committee shall keep a chronologi- 
cal register of the elections and acceptances of members. 


8. These Standing Rules, and those for the government of the 
Society, shall be modified only with the consent of a majority of 


the members of the General Committee. 
xii 


ey eS 


FOR THE 


PUBLICATION OF THE. BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


1. The President’s annual address shall be published in full. 


2. The annual reports of the Secretaries and of the Treasurer 
shall be published in full. 


3. When directed by the General Committee, any communication 
may be published in full. 


4. Abstracts of papers and remarks on the same will be. pub- 
lished, when presented to the Secretary by the author in writing 
within two weeks of the evening of their delivery, and approved by 
the Committee on Publications. Brief abstracts prepared by one 
of the Secretaries and approved by the Committee on Publications 
may also be published. 


5.* If the author of any paper read before a Section of the 
Society desires its publication, either in full or by abstract, it shall 
be referred to a committee to be appointed as the Section may 
determine. 

The report of this committee shall be forwarded to the Publica- 
tion Committee by the Secretary of the Section, together with any 
action of the section taken thereon. 


6. Communications which have been published elsewhere, so as 
to be generally accessible, will appear in the Bulletin by title only, 
but with a reference to the place of publication, if made known in 
season to the Committee on Publications. 


* Adopted May 19, 1883. 
2a ili 


OFFICERS 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON, 


ELECTED DECEMBER 16, 1882. 


Presedentzs o2es te J. W. POWELL. 


Vice-Presidents..____-- J. C. WELLING, J. E. HILGARD, 
C. H. CRANE, J. S. BILLINGS. 


Treasurer _...~- eons LEVELAND ABBE. 


Secvetartes. Pane ae G. K. GILBERT, HENRY FARQUHAR. 


MEMBERS AT LARGE OF THE GENERAL COMMITTEE, 


W. be DATE, C. E. Dutton, 
J. R. EASTMAN, EB. BE Luror 
R. FLETCHER, Wm. HARKNESS, 
D. L. HunTINGTON, GARRICK MALLERY,* 


C. A. SCHOTT. 


STANDING COMMITTEES. 


On Communications + 


J. S. BILLINGs, Chairman, G. K. GILBERT, HENRY FARQUHAR. 


On Publications : 


G. K. GILBERT, Chairman, HENRY FARQUHAR, | CLEVELAND ABBE, 
S. F. Bairp.+ 


* Mr. Mallery was elected Vice-President October 13 to fill the vacancy occasioned by 
the death of Mr. Crane. Mr. C. V. Riley was at the same time added to the General 
Committee to fill its number. 

+ As Secretary of the Smithsonian Institution. ’ 

X1V 


OFPERICHRS 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON 


ELECTED DECEMBER 22, 1883. 


GhEStO Chia ae ha Os. WELLING: 

Vice- Presidents ___-_- J. S. BILLINGs. GARRICK MALLERY. 
J. E. Hivcarp. ASAPH HALL. 

TT EQLSUR ETA Ae ae wes, —.CLEVELAND ABBE. 

MSEC CLOT TES ae we HENRY FARQUHAR. G. K. GILBERT. 


MEMBERS AT LARGE OF THE GENERAL COMMITTEE. 


H. H. BATEs. E.. B. ELLIortT. 
W. H. DALL. ROBERT FLETCHER. 
C. E. DuTTon. WILLIAM HARKNESS. 
J. R. EAstTMan, J. J. Knox. 

C..V. RILEy. 


STANDING COMMITTEES. 


On Communications 


J. S. BILLInGs, Chairman. HENRY FARQUHAR. G. K. GILBERT. 
On Publications : 


G. K. GILBERT, Chairman. CLEVELAND ABBE. HENRY FARQUHAR. 


S. F. Barrp.* 
* As Secretary of the Smithsonian Institution. 


xV 


LIST OF MEMBERS 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Corrected to December 31, 1883. 


The names of founders are printed in Sma CapPiraLs. 
(d) indicates deceased. 


(a) indicates absent from the District of Columbia and excused from payment of dues 


until announcing his return. 
(r) indicates resigned. 


NAME. P. O. ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. 


Abbe, Cleveland.. ...| Army Signal Office. 2017 1St. N. W... 


Abert, Sylvanus Thayer.. sbidoa cugeteduens Engineer’s Office, War Department. | 1875, Jan. 30 
1724 Penn. Ave. N. W. 
Adams, ITenry.........0-000 Hincsenstarentent TOOT ES. ee cecsscesneveus eadesen versed heeesceentd 1881, Feb. 5 
Aldis, Asa Owen.......... Wecsaeneenntomegenas THUG ET GE IN, Wiesssctacccu eet 1873, Mar. 1 
PATTET UAMIGSS.: peedareasessesecenseseessve ...| Army Signal Office. 1707 G St. N. W..} 1882, Feb. 25 
Alvord, Benjamin ...........::00ceeee SOL LZO TG tieg Ne) NV ches enteednpaesunteneebenoance mated 1872, Mar. 23 
ANTISELL, 'THOMAS........ ..| Patent Office. 1311 Q St. N. W........... 1871, Mar. 13 
Avery, Robert Stanton........ .| Coast and Geodetie Survey Office. | 1879, Oct. 11 
320 A St. S. E. 
Babcock, Orville Elias............... ..| 2024 G St. N. W .| 1871, June 9 
Bailey, Theodorus (A) svtwosesasnnaxcacabect| Sexccess tnescescusanchnnes;aeseeasensnvay pater ye mpenet emer 1873, Mar. 1 
BatrD, SPENCER FULLERTON......-..00000 Smithsonian Institution. 1445 Mass. 1871, Mar. 13 
ve 
Ba Or sHv ans key resasscdesenaccosesansesSenssmend SZGC: Nisha, Wisseccecssenensuecesserenesscenecneane 1881, May 14 . 
Baker, Marcus....... ...| 347 Hill St., Los Angeles, Cal........ ...| 1876, Mar. 11 
Bancroft, George SOB ED SiC Wiscssccecudecstesncrscusttectocnaeee 1875, Jan. 16 
IBRRNES) 0 OSEPH IK) (0)iccesceasas son serescact| \senusousvaxaesceconsuaaputerseeesecehe<sitasesseeeEaary 1871, Mar. 13 
Bates, Henry UG DANhitesssc carenccturerets Patent Office. The Portland........ a 1871, Nov. 4 
Beardslee, Lester Anthony (@)........ Navy Department .........cccsecsenesceecesere 1875, Feb. 27 
Bell, Alexander Graham..........ssse00 Scott Circle, 1500 R. I. Ave...........scceees 1879, Mar. 29 
Bell, Chichester Alexander ose) S22NI COMM AAV? ING Wis tvcnceucenuns toed seens ..| 1881, Oct. 8 
Benér, STEPHEN VINCENT......-.-sceeeeee ed Say War Department. | 1871, Mar. 13 
1717 t. 
BABSON A PRIME <ciardeascacnauceuessscudccanccdss Senos Institution. 1444 N St. | 1875, Jan. 16 
BILLINGS, JOHN SHAW....ccccceceecseeceesses ae Office, U.S. A. 3026 N | 1871, Mar. 13 
. t. N. W. 
Birney, William.........scesecceeses secseesss}| 456 Louisiana Ave. 1901 Harewood |} 1879, Mar. 29 
Ave., Le Droit Park. 
Birnie, Rogers (@)..é.....cssscscovees «..| Cold Spring, Putnam Co., N. Y........ «| 1876, Mar. 11 
Bodfish, Sumner Homer. Geological Survey. 605 F St. N. W..... 1883, Mar. 24 
Browne, John Mills ............00 Mee Director, U.S.N. The Port- | 1883, Nov. 24 
an 
Burchard, Horatio Chapin............. ..| Director of the Mint. Riggs House..| 1879, May 10 
Burgess, Edward Sanford..........0.0 .| High School. 1214 aa St. N. W.. 1883, Mar. 24 
Burnett, Swan Moses.,........sssseceseees 12151 St. N. W.. wUbsachse duésveneesescavenst WLS Qe terete 


XVI 


DATE OF 
ADMISSION. 


1871, Oct. 29 


LIST OF MEMBERS. XVII 
a DATE OF 
NAME. / P. O. ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. iMevumteanai: 
Busey, Samuel Clagett............ssesse POZO STING) Wisscwencsssess 1874, Jan. 17 


4 The PORTION Oc sst.cacseucqacsoune eededessuucaicn 


CAPRON, HORACE........0s.00+s & 
Case, Augustus Ludlow (a, ---| Navy Department. Bristol, be ae 
Casey, THomas LINCOLN.......... aemeanieee Sa ey RP OTPA of Engineers. 1419 
Caziarc, Louis Vasmet............s0s00 Army Signal Office. 1415 G St. N.W... 
CHASE AV OATMON LOR TUAND) ((2) sesces devace)ssvese cen ssseneceecesvedereseenccseucecdstecbatoctescee Saack 
Chamberlin, Thomas Crowder........ Geological BUM OV cucaasonserseuscap senveniereee 
Chickering, John White, Jr............ Deaf Mute College, Kendall Green... 
Christie, Alexander Smyth............. Coast and eevee Survey Office. 
513 6th St. N. W. 
Clapp, William ea (Gy Reasccswaxuvree TAG CORCOTAT Statclersacceisaclecce caxseseasess 
Clark, Edward... aepeantnactad vecnet sy ge dai Office, Capitol. 417 4th St. 
Clark, Ezra Westcote............ssee-csess Revenue Marine Bureau, Treasury 
Department. Woodley Road. 
Clarke, Frank Wigglesworth........... Geological Survey. 1425 Q St. N.W... 
CorFIN, JOHN HUNTINGTON CRANE...... TSOE TSENG IW sieccncsactt vows chdswavateddtonessea 
Collins, Frederick (d)..........e000. ennane| Gadbansesbaasaenborekeressenanesoesseneacchowucanine oa 
Comstock, John Henry (a)... ..-| Cornell University, Ithaca, ie Naveen 
Coues, 11) SNARE eee .-| Smithsonian Inst. 1726 N. St. N. W... 
RAE ENSAMIN HAN EULE (GQ) c.asavavecee| savasvisacssaesssseecawssaccscstees esscsdsibecasenckesacve 
Craig, RODeFt....ccnessecscascces Keene -..| Army Signal Office. 1008 I St. N. W.. 
Craig, SUDO MNAS (Gc. scestpccesarss ---| Johns Hopkins pis Baltimore, Md.. 
RORIAIN ay CHUAGS TE SULUEN EW?) (12) ass vanssentoues| sch aceuseeccamascarcdcacceasccccedevadesceaasnsnucstteualees 
Curtis, JOSIAH (A)...csccsersrencesenes 
Cutts, Richard Dominicus (d)..... Kecexdbachasevascesees aouscedasnatsetebe 
Dati, Witt1am HEALFY... HPO, : Nap WV avcexes 
UES CHALLE JEL OILY (12) sor0occascasnssoal acrdedece veasasiocecsersebecncuascacasccsomettecceacctestace 
Davis, Charles Henry..............sseess Navy Department. 1705 Rhode Island 
Ave. N. W. 
Dean, Richard Crain (@)..............000 Navy Yard; New. York sccscoves sostecnsecesece! 
De Caindry, William Augustin........ Commissary General’s Office. 924 
19th St. N. W. 
De Land, Theodore Louis............... Treasury Dept. 126 7th St. N. E........ 
GRU ERE NOONE T) ncn onanoeicnt assgposes osebes] eves Oessecesvascaeves seaevevas en cabedaserenueseagecaseacsen , 
Doolittle, Myrick Hascall............... Coast and peadetia Survey Office. 
19251 St. N. W 
OTE GE PECTIC WILLIS (2) sscoustecsossns|ssvaseversstactascatccnsstccosacchaccuvecsesevusseccdsessves 
Dunwoody, Henry Harrison Chase..| Army Signal Office. 1803 G St. N. W.. 
Dutton, Clarence Edward................ Geological Survey. 23 Lafayette 
Square. 
Toa PATEK ANDER De(()tssereseccecocecesss|scciccervee abs ebtrasvarstcess suas eacasensuceaumueewecneeds 
Eastman, John Robie ...............cc0e08 Naval Observatory. 930 18th St. N.W.. 
EESTI SCA MON MEYER BE (2) ia, ss/ceciscancbaxeai close staccacsiseus trodes iacncaswedeaneecdurbucesiccvacdictces 
AUC MOMIA Gt savcecssroces venceseensccse sconce bureau of Education, Interior Dept. 
712 East Capitol St. 
SLATER SARS WATE (GQ) 2cccctscvcsccscssccees|ecescivoeceperectcorsdeeceectest 
Exiot, GEorcE Henry (7) 
Enniott, EZEKIEL BROWN..............0065 Office of Government Actuary, Treas- 


ury Department. 1210GSt.N. W. 


Emmons, Samuel Franklin . .-| Geological Survey. 915 16th St. N.W. 


Endlich, Frederic Miller i). Smithsonian Institution....... Eretteevsncesd 

Ewing, Charles (a). ach cavcbaswen|peaancipetabetaceaatparcasudacoe sudaeudnectienteres onctcy 

Puy LIA Se PAULO (CL) secs emecesinsescicenssetenees Lancaster, ODIO“, scssecaascsteatssqucsed res 

Marquh ar, EGward........-10:-0c-s-ssecsccas Patent Office Library. 1915 H St. N.W. 

MarguharvGnry,,, s.c.tsscecseseseressaeszene Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 
Brooks Station, D. C. 

OGTOL WMA svcseeesavsecene=sesatecnnncns Army Signal Office. 471 C St. N. W... 

Bleteher, RODE t-i..:ss.-0scncssosvaccassatee Surgeon Genl’s Office, U.S.A. 1326 
LSt. N. W. 

Flint, Albert Stowell.................cssse0 aval Se eneny: 1209 Rhode Island 

J ve 

Flint, James! Miltom.........cccccceseseocse Smithsonian Inst. Riggs House....... 

Foote, Enisua (d)......... 

Mostar; VONMVGAY (Gd) ii iicieseccsescccsestlossecvase 

French, Henry ike gg (7) 

Fristoe, IQUE Ce tiecsscseusscscsssvexs TABSS IN SG. IN Wivcncex cates set vaasecbevsteeace mie 


1871, Mar. 13 
1872, Nov. 16 
1871, Mar. 13 


1882, Feb. 25 
1871, Mar. 13 
1883, Mar. 24 
1874, Apr. 11 
1880, Dec. 4 


1882, Feb. 25 
1877, Feb. 24 


1882, Mar. 25 


1874, Apr. 11 
1871, Mar. 13 


.| 1879, Oct. 21 


1880, Feb, 14 
1874, Jan. 17 
1871, Mar. 13 
1873, Jan. 4 
1879, Nov. 22 
1871, Mar. 13 
1874, Mar. 28 


.| 1871, Apr. 29 


1871, Mar. 13 
1874, Jan. 17 
1880, June 19 


1872, Apr. 23 
1881, Apr. 30 


1880, Dec. 18 
1879, Feb. 15 
1876, Feb. 12 


1874, Jan. 17 
1873, Dec. 20 
1872, Jan. 27 


1871, Mar. 13 


1871, May 27 
1871, Mar. 13 
1874, May 8 


1871, June 
1871, Mar. 8 
1871, Mar. 13 


1883, Apr. 7 
1873, Mar. 1 
1874, Jan. 17 
1874, Jan. 17 


1876, Feb. 12 
1881, May 14 


1872, Nov. 16 
1873, Apr. 10 


1882, Mar. 25 


1881, Mar. 19 
1871, Mar. 13 
1873, Jan. 18 
1882, Mar. 25 
1873, Mar. 29 


1709 Rhode Island Ave. N. W. 


Hill, George William.................0..| Nautical Almanac Office. 314 Ind. 


XVIII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 
NAME. P. O. ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. Pegi 
Gale, Leonard Dunneil vy Sdighesacadasdclanswoassunbe neanct aren sp cnecntonetecuce qavceesenercesteerene 1874, Jan. 17 
Gallaudet, Edward Miner.. -| Deaf Mute’ College, ‘Kendall Green.. 1875, Feb. 27 
Gannett, Henry Renahasvandennedens .| Geological Survey. 1881 Harewood 1874, Apr. 11 
Ave., Le Droit Park. 
Gardiner, James Terry (@)........ State Library, Albany, N. W... ..| 1874, Jan. 17 
Garnett, Alexander Young P. (7).. 1878, Mar. 16 
Gihon, Albert Leary.........ccccccccesses pag he at ea a 2019 Hillyer Place} 1880, Dec. 18 
Gilbert, Grove Karl..............sscsesseere Geological Survey. 1424 Corcoran St..| 1873, June 7 
Gaitu, THEODORE NICHOLAS........ «...| Smithsonian Inst. 321-323 414 St. N.W.| 1871, Mar. 13 
Godding, William Whitney.............] Government Asylum for the Insane...| 1879, Mar. 29 
Goode, George BrowD............sseceer oe Museum. 1620 Mass. Ave. 1874, Jan. 31 
Goodfellow, Edward..........s.sseeesssees Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. | 1875, Dec. 18 
1330 19th St. N. W. 2 
FOOAdTOLIOW MI OUEY AT) ---sexsscessgenscnsos| snceancseccceenceanten y cunestsaaeyeneasbusctbetecactesneres 1871, Nov. 4 
Gore, James Howard... ....| Columbian College. 1305 Q St. N. W..| 1880, Mar. 14 
GrAVOS, IO WArdlOZIOl (Q)istccssesescceue|ssavasuestep reccevaee esubasesevonscnetunacosbanctneeuaacaed 1874, Apr. 11 
Graves, Walter Hayden (a) Denver, Colorado... ceria: 1878, May 25 
Greely, AGOlPHUS WHSHIN SCOT (@) cs secsesesuassssessoceveesncecuenstanccacessseqcececretesrees 1880, June 19 
Green, Bernard Richardson............ 788 INGEN. Weds anes seseceeeee| 1879, Feb. 15 
Green, Francis Mathews (@)............ Navy Department............ 1875, Nov. 9 
GREENE, BENJAMIN FRANKLIN (@)...... West Lebanon, N. H 1871, Mar. 13 
Greene, Francis Vinton .............0000 min: : Commissioners! Office. 1915 1875, Apr. 10 
Gunnell, Francis M.......:ssesseeseeseess aed Director, U.S. N. 600 20th | 1879. Feb. 1 
Hains, Peter Conover (a). .| 1824 Jefferson Place.....cccccvccsssesessosece 1879, Feb. 15 
PATE MAGAPH octacscecncadaees .| Naval Observatory. 2715 N .| 1871, Mar. 13 
HANSCOM, Leaiahil (i)! sevesssessvcceascescoce| cncsessicssusenaceresthpsae seen srcceestcaeu ses tans eenseden 1873, Dee. 20 
FLARKNESS) WILDEAM:. ccvcevescwoeccssus svesse Naval Observatory. 1415 G St. N. W.. 1871, Mar. 13 
Hassler, Ferdinand Augustus (q)....| Tustin City, Los Angeles Co., Cal....... 1880, May 8 
HaypEN, FERDINAND VANDEVEER (@)..| Geological Survey. 1803 Arch ’St., Phil-| 1871, Mar. 13 
adelphia, Penn. 
Hazen, Henry Allen..........ccccsceesseees Army Signal Office. 1416 Corcoran St.| 1882, Mar. 25 
Hazen, William Babcock.. Army Signal Office. 1601 K St. N.W.. 1881, Feb a 
YEN Ry, JOSEPH (G) o5.-cccecackonganccses cr seed | tsewacccsevest abasncnenetad yack Wasentanaene seesneeeeeaNee .| 1871, Mar. 13 
Henshaw, Henry Wetherbee... Bureau of Ethnology. P.O. Box 585. 1874, Apr. 11 
HInearp, JULIUS ERASMUB...ssscesscseeses Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. | 1871, Mar. 13 


1879, Feb. 1 


Ave. N. W. 
Holden, Edward Singleton (a)......... Madison, WisComsi.........-ccccssseseseesee 1873, June 21 
Holmes, William Henry.............0008 Geological Survey. 1100 OS St. NW 1879, Mar. 29 
Hough, Franklin Benjamin (@)....... Seriguibore: Department. Lowville, 1879, Mar. 29 
Howell, Edwin Eugene (q).............. Rochester, Ni Wicivecccvccsssocswuevcdunestasnee 1874, Jan. 31 
HUMPHREYS, ANDREW ATKINSON (4) .....|..ccssscscccccssertescnssccenscesessncascneveessece Saveees 1871, Mar. 13 
Jackson, Henry Arundel Lambe (@) War Department............ss0 Nencctanveabon 1875, Jan. 30 
James, Owen (a) apes Hyde Park, Penn. c 1880, Jan. 3 
Jeffers; William Nicolson (77) .xt csvset] swescaccasceecesseaatensocacaccnn .| 1877, Feb. 24 
JENKINS, THORNTON ALEXANDER. ZVI Pentiy AV.) INs) Wiessncscscersccveencussean 1871, Mar. 13 
Johnson, Arnold Burges..........sseeeees Light House Board, Treasury Dept. 1878, Jan. 19 

501 Maple Ave., Le Droit Park ' 
Johnson, Joseph Taber............0.s000 926 17th St. Ne Wessssccesessececsveresseee Rhoaane 1879, Mar. 29 
Johnston, William Waring...........-.. 1603 K. St. N. Woi.sccssesstsosscoce sovecess senses 1873, Jan. 21 
Kampf, Perdinand(d) sin ciicccccscctosves|sccruavencensenn eatorrencees sdiadvesdedavters bet ainta ptesaet 1875, Dec. 18 
Keithy Rewel (a)ivciticcstctccucscectosnescers}veveteccatermnaturesyerssccsce 1871, Oct. 29 
Kerr, Washington serrnthers: daccnucke Raleigh, N. © -| 1883, Apr. 7 
Kidder, Jerome Henry.... : he ee Institution. 1816 N St. 1880, May 8 
Kilbourne, Charles Evans............... ian Signal Of Office. Lexington House.| 1880, June 19 
King, Albert Freeman Africanus....| 726 13th St, N. Was.seceesseeeees sees e-.| 1875, Jan. 16 
King, Clarence (7) .cisceciicseccevacsaecncoce vecsehconaen cpadepececnsauspne cenbeuanUnesobGceteryeeh iene 1879, May 10 
Knox, John Jay.............. Treasury Dept. 1127 10th St. N. W... 1874, May 8 
Kummell, bane. Hugo........00.---..| Coast and GES Survey Office. 1882, Mar. 25 

608 Q St. N. W 
WANE; JONATHAN HLOMER (GB) .sccvescssnsoe] sucons sendctucs coucek sponse devena dcauvesdaesusnnverBigiraeen 1871, Mar. 13 
Lawver, Winfield Peter...............000 Mint Bureau, Treasury Department. 1881, Feb. 19 


1912 I St. N. W. 


LIST OF MEMBERS. XIX 


DATE OF 
NAME. P. O. ADDRESS anp*REsivENce. fGen 
Bee, William ..........0sc0seceseee PANT PEUTIPAVE: PINs CVs caracccccantaceeecsccnee 1874, Jan. 17 
Lefavour, Edward Brown : Bo ee ge Survey Office. | 1882, Dec. 16 
11 9. EB. 
Lincoln, Nathan RADATUE Joos cae cswaneceany 1514 H St. N. W ...| 1871, May 27 
Lockwood, BELEN NEY AEs (23) stare eitseanciowaa del deta scasnden, oteeuetavasnaadcescsswretscecsue-scentennas-tp> 1871, Oct. 29 
Loomis, Ben JenkS..cccseccceccseseseeees Nautical Almanac Office. 1413 Col- | 1880, Feb. 14 
lege Hill Terrace N. W. 
Dull; Hdward Phelps <.........ccssssesssss. NEV) DGPATLOOMts.cccccke.saccetessesesesssbee 1875, Dec. 4 
Lyford, Pater LO YS (© Bilata (fs nuruc vece st siacn era lemarracctaswantpabersedes suaccvseraauncnxereseat spnctavesss 1873, Jan. 18 
MacCauley, Henry Clay (@).........+++ Helena, Montana... ..<siecsseccosevessseseeses 1880, Jan.. 3 
MCGee, W. J... .cccscccecancosssrseccencversese Geological Survey. 512 13th St. N. W.| 1883, Nov. 10 
McGuire, Frederick Bauders 1306 F St. N. W. 614 E St. N. W 1879, Feb. 15 
Mack, Oscar A. Dy ret we ceercnicutaneetepaves| weanasunceutet-ssus Sgsesavcanecscuss<staccedsccestevcsetuns 1872, Jan. 27 
McMurtrie, William (a) ........... pes MOM AUO DATE WML. co rcsssccsensancvevdsstdesdeesess 1876, Feb. 26 
Mallery, Garrick ...2.2...:ccces.cccsveeneeses Bureau of Ethnology. P.O. Box 585. | 1875, Jan. 30 
1323 N St. N. W. 
MARV Le PORE DUS SACL ED (GB) :ccssccaesces | snwcte eosseersccumaysececescccsanccedocccesédetesseasvesceos 1878, May 25 
ManrInG Are bibald! FODCLtSOML (C2) ..;|terseveesose sasaas se cacs essessiasnusssaesscenvsssdepanenacess 1874, Jan. 31 
Mason, Otis Tufton...............0..seccecee Columbian College. 1305 Q St. N.W...| 1875, Jan. 30 
MEEK, 'Freipine BRADFORD (GD) ssc secvaa| acct cores acunt ected neescscaccceecdacessnavatiianaeedadetes 1871, Mar. 13 
Meigs, Montgomery (@).......::.-++se+++ War Department. Rock Island, Tl... 1877, Mar. 24 
Meias, MonrGomeRY CUNNINGHAM.....| 1239 Vermont Ave. N. W......ccc:eseceeetere 1871, Mar. 13 
Milner, James William (d)... es aes ..| 1874, Jan. 31 
Morgan, Ethelbert Carroll.. 918 ESt. N. W .| 1883, Oct. 13 
Morris, Martin Ferdinand (a : , ..| 1877, Feb. 24 
Mussey, Reuben Delavan ....... | P.O. Box 618. 508 5th St. N. ..| 1881, Dec. 3 
Myer, ALBERT J. (d)........004.- Sascebes seest een ..| 1871, Mar. 13 
Myers, William (@)).........:000.ss-sesasse0e “War Department.. Washist/onstbbanedeebhooseusladeees 1871, June 23 
NEWCOMB, SIMON.......:cccssccccccccsceccecees Navy Deparianent,. Stoddart Bireets 1871, Mar. 13 
Nichols, Charles Henry (a). ere ...| 1872, May 4 
Nicuotson, WALTER Lams... "322 T St. N. W... 1871, Mar. 13 
Nordhoff, Charles...........00.s:cssceeesseee Alpine, Bergen Co., N. J... .| 1879, May 10 
Osborne, John Walter..............s00e0 212 a Delaware Ave. N. ae iidae binwshacs ten seeses 1878, Dec. 7 
Oris, GEORGE ALEXANDER (@)............/.. biceeueaanda seer cura LO GMS MMeAICG It 
(PARRES ODHN GEUBEs scesccsvcseoscooseeness Engineer Bureau, War Department. | 1871, Mar. 13 
16 Lafayette Square. 
PAIGE EMIS scveccsskersacssscsshesdvoscauen= 2 Lafayette Square.......2-ccccccsssseeseccees 1871, Mar. 13 
Parry, Charles Christopher es: Pree Burlington, Iowa 1871, May 13 
HERE ERGH CAEITIO OILOGK (2) siecccassns|ccorccezesedtesiontsss sovceaceceétav ces cesuevssecncsestescone]| LOU) INOVSLG 
Paul, Henry Martyn................s.secooses Naval Observatory. 917 RSt. N. W...| 1877, May 19 
Peale, Albert Charles.............sccessees 7] Gotan Survey. 1210 Mass. Ave. | 1874, Apr. 11 
PEALE, TITIAN RAMSAY (@)........cseceees Philadelphia, Penn 1871, Mar. 13 
PETROS  SENUAMUN) (G) ci .bonesepccase ccactes|bsasstasteycseustesseustedeveasoavssesers 1871, Mar. 13 
Peirce, Charles Sanders (a).. Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. | 1873, Mar. 1 
Baltimore, Md. 
Pilling, James Constantine............. Geological Survey. 918 M St. N. W...] 1881, Feb. 19 
Poe, Orlando Metealfe............. 34 Congress St. West, Detroit, Mich...| 1873, Oct. 4 
Pope, Benjamin Franklin Surgeon General’s Office, WSs A 1882, Dec. 16 
2029 P St. N. W. 
BOVCOR DAV IG) SUX OW CM) savtensincs cos sebass]sxcpsesnasevarev cores ssecnasss ese daecescassucvisue sswsneces 1874, Apr. 11 
Powell, John Wesley..........s.seseceeeree Geological Survey. 910M St. N. W...| 1874, Jan. 17 
Prentiss, Daniel Webster................ LDZA OU ETAAING, Wiccaccocas cece caavlenwexee dates at 1880, Jan. 3 
Pritchett, Henry Smith (a)............. Washington University, St. Louis, Mo.| 1879, Mar. 29 
Rathbone, Henry Reed (a).... Buca event dicate tocamnensdpawtileceiscusseasvess sec escecwswaves|| SLOG4y CGM La 
Rathbun, pilihiard joie cecscccese arts ae Institution. 1622 Mass. 
Ave. N. W. 1882, Oct. 7 
Renshawe, John Henry................+. Geological S cages 1221 O St. N. W...| 1883, Feb. 24 
Richey, Stephen UMN cr cctcsccesestsvescs TADG INGO AVG. ING Wisscisustassevavsveveasveds 1882, Oct. 7 
Ridgway, Robert (@)............6 aeeneetees Smithsonian Inst. Lee Va. Av. N.W.| 1874, Jan. 31 
Riley, Charles Valentine................. Agricultural Dept. 1700 13th St. N.W.| 1878, Nov. 9 
Riley, John Campbell (d)... Sat aaa eraeaits aida saalv wala gas enisounastenradeed Sel MESURE “ko 
Ritter, William Francis McKnight. ‘Nautical Almanac Office. 16 Grant | 1879, Oct. 21 
ace. 
et aa aisiniaice Raymond |OLU7ZSTISty NG Wenn... ccn-soccscnscaressccesvesteeee| LOV2, Mar. 19 
erry 
VOOM OLS fl ON (2) s.c-crsccetcdverscessoee eiaildatasbevedacobecdusshacenacecsvenes supeesdesczactestateddcd 1872, Nov. 16 
Rogers, Joseph Addison (a) .. +] Naval ODSeCrvatory....cscscsnereccdvecvncenssses 1872, Mar. 9 
Russell, Israel Cook..........00000 ..| Geological Survey. 1424 Corcoran St..! 1882, Mar. 25 


xx PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF ‘WASHINGTON. 


. ? DatE OF 
NAME. P. O. ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. pee 
ISHN OMI AS. yc cvecdsctsdnansseaunepracsen Army Signal Office. 904 M St. N. W...| 1883, Feb. 10 
Salmon, Daniel Elmer.............sss000 Agricultural Dept. 11211 St. N. W..... 1883, Nov. 24 
Sampson, William Thomas.............. Naval Observatory ........ ASF censcerccop reo 1883, Mar. 24 
SAnng) BENJAMIN FRANKLIN: (2): .0ctees|ssovesconsssesasnssrssepadeucnopssnnesiscnstaesadaneessens 1871, Mar. 13 
Saville, James Hamilton..........:...0 a D oe (La. Ave.) N. W. 1315 M St. | 1871,“Apr. 29 
ScHAEFFER, GEORGE CHRISTIAN (d)...... ideledccatlh Supe dncasheraaaes oa 1871, Mar. 13 
Scuort, CHARLES ANTHONY.......2.-e0c00+ Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. | 1871, Mar. 13 
212 1st St. S. E. 
Searle, Henry Robinson ().........000:|ssccssssssecssssseeeee eae lauavsheducsnarsnenneapeeedoasnaaes 1877, Dec. 21 
Seymour, George Dudloyi(a)is..2<sccscclaeeaccechscasucatssevsurscnesecscsdesacceuccureeeseaetareces 1881, Dec. 3 


Shellabarger, Samuel. Room 23 Corcoran Building. 81217th | 1875, Apr. 10 


St. N. W. 
SHOErMAN KIO cccccacseasansccnaxsacs 1319 K St. N. W... ; ...| 1874, Jan. 17 
SHERMAN, WILLIAM TECUMSEH (7) ......|----seseeeeeeeeeses todatuat dated vasnsaseGaranaee 1871, Mar. 13 
Shufeldt, Robert Wilson..............6 Sueeen Sen's Office, U.S.A. 1619 | 1881, Nov. 5 
Sicard, Montgomery (@) .....s.ssceseeeee Ordnance Bureau, Navy Department. | 1877, Feb. 24 
Sigsbee, Charles Dwight.................. Hydrographic Office, Navy Depart- | 1879, Mar. 1 
ment. 3319 U St. N. W. 
Skinner, John Oscar......ccccrqecssoecsens B7BOU HY Sis tIN Wisc cece csavcans cote xcacencesbaubeeey 1883, Mar. 24 
Smiley, Charles Wesley ............000 .| U. S. Fish Commission, 1443 Mass. | 1882, Oct. 7 
Ave. 1207 11th St. N. W. 
Sraiths WAV (0) ror cscassnvsesenwecssascsenss Navy Department............ Ppcorkecno rience 1876, Dee. 2 
SSED RUE LEU WAIL cre sesexecsvavavaenssvessseetvasen Coast and Geodetic Survey Office ...... 1880, Oet. 23 
Spofford, Ainsworth Rand........ dashes Ley. of Congress. 1621 Mass. Ave. | 1872, Jan. 27 
Stearns, John (a) -sessesssweseseees ieee Daath ine Oe ee 1874, Mar. 28 
Stome, Ormond (@).........sceccessesscsseees Leander McCormick Observatory, | 1874, Mar. 28 
University of Virginia. 
Taylor, Frederick William...............| Smithsonian Institution.........0-sesee0 1881, Feb. 19 
TaYLor, WILLIAM BOWER..........2.0ee000 Smithsonian Inst. 306 CSt. N. W...... 1871, Mar. 13 
Thompson, Almon Harris. sec| GrOOLO PICA SULVCY.<ccatcccossecccveccdocartsenns 1875, Apr. 10 
Tilden, William Calvin (a) ..| Army Medical Museum ..........sccseceee+s 1871, Apr. 29 
Todd, David Peck (a) _ Amherst, Mass......... .-.| 1878, Nov. 23 
Toner, Joseph Meredith.... ...| 615 Louisiana Ave. 1873, June 7 
True, Frederick William........ ...... National Museum. 1882, Oct. 7 
pyre WV al ica Iie (GR) see es andas soc anzche|ep@entcseeaceencosacevensioucsceresnaensevsthussaweus ...| 1878, Nov. 23 
Upton, Jacob Kendrick (7) ..............[sssessseossesccssessnnse secccnnescescsesencesssecessussessns 1878, Feb. 2 
Upton, William Wirt................ceeee 2d Comptroller’s Office, Treasury | 1882, Mar. 25 
Dept. 810 12th St. N. W. ’ 
Upton, Winslow (@)........ Sedmesanes soseee eae alana Office. 1441 Chapin St. | 1880, Dee. 4 
Vasey, George (7) ....cccccsssssosssecescsese| senseseeesscceses atise ase vecke Sveswaentedeieccertakeaerat 1875, June 5 
Walcott, Charles Doolittle............... Geolaaical Survey. 1116 N. Y. Ave. | 1883, Oct. 13 
Waldo, Wrath vcccscsrersepcassdacaves-cnosennva Army Signal Office. 1427 Chapin St. | 1881, Dec. 3 
Walker, Francis Amasa (@).........0+ Mass. Inst. of Technology, Boston, | 1872, Jan. 27 
ass. 
Walling, Henry Francis............sss00 Geological SUIVeY.....sscsesesee: sereceseeres 1883, Feb. 24 
Ward, Paes PAUISUEA raawevsesukesaccssaresnse Gaoler eal Survey. 1464 R. I. Ave. | 1876, Noy. 18 
Webster, Albert LOWrY.............++s+++ Johns Hopkins University, Balti- | 1882, Mar. 25 
more, 
Welling, James Clarke... 1302 Connecticut AVE.........0.0-scsesesseees 1872, Nov. 16 
Wheeler, George M. (a).. Engineer Bureau, War Department...| 1873, June 7 
WHEELER, Junius B. (a)....... ...| West Point, New York .| 1871, Mar. 13 
White, Charles Abiathar.................. Geological Survey. LeDroit Park......| 1876, Dec. 16 
White, Zebulon Lewis (@)............+++ Providence, Rhode Island.............s000 1880, June 19 
Williams, Albert, Jr...... Sete cnsstarepaarat Goploxion! Survey. 23 Lafayette | 1883, Feb. 24 
quare. 

Wilson, Allen D. (@) .......ceceeceereeceeees Newport, R. I......... tagessaseeeacsss ences sonees 1874, ee il 
Wilson, James Ormond.............-.+++ eran Rahoot Building. 1439 Mass. | 1873, Mar. 1 
Ave. N. W. 

Winlock, William Crawford............ Naval Observatory. 733 20th St. N.W...| 1880, Dec. 4 
Wolcott, Christopher Columbus (7)..}......02 .-++0 jesesendeeassessscoverecnasatenccanscacesans 1875, Feb. 27 
Wood, Joseph (a) Gua dustanecebecensuc chanted Asst. Engineer B. & P. R. R............0088 1875, Jan. 16 


Wood, Willtam Maxwell (qa) ..........6 Navy Department ...........csccssessecsassonns| 1871, Dec. 2 


LIST OF MEMBERS. xXxI 


; 5 : DATE oF 
NAME. P. O. AppRESsS AND RESIDENCE. erento 
WoopwakbD, JOSEPH JANVIER............4+ Army Med. Museum. 620 F St. N.W..| 1871, Mar. 13 
Woodward, Robert Simpson............ Naval Observatory. 1125 17th St. N.W.| 1883, Nov. 24 
WODU WORE, COMM AER yard ()..c. 5. clnaseorscesscccnsbaneesteudescscccucccscecasccctencevescaces 1874, Jan. 31 
SPMMEL OP NOECOCSI (i )acsccsncieusstetsases|sasaveestaasectanh siesstsopisehasaiicusscces scuncwesausp snes ce 1871, Apr. 29 
Yarrow, Harry Crécy .........cserececceee SUARLTEMUSEPING [Wis bet vececeascevpooesunteusaseee 1874, Jan. 31 
Zumbrock, Anton........ euaeeaudcacestescnes Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. | 1875, Jan. 30 
455 C St. N. W. 
é 
ADOT OL FOUMMENS...cscnrese) cosesecvessusceesesecaceers 44 

i MEMbETS Mecgased........sseceesecesseeeseeees 36 

ts ee absent 55 

“ “ 

“ ita 


XXII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ANNUAL REPORT OF THE TREASURER. 


WaAsHINGTON Crry, December 31, 1883. 
To the Philosophical Society of Washington : 


I have the honor to present herewith my annual statement as 
Treasurer for the year ending December 31st, and to express my 
regret that owing to absence from the city I was not able to present 
this report at the proper time on the occasion of the recent annual 
meeting, December 22d. 

By the kindness of Messrs. Riggs & Co. the Society has been 
enabled to invest in another $1,000 United States 4 per cent. bond, 
but in this case a few weeks in advance of the regular winter accu- 
mulation of its revenue. The balance shown by Riggs’ books 
against the Society is, therefore, with their assent, and in fact at 
their suggestion, and will pr obably be met during J anuary 

The total invested fund of the Society is, therefore, 32, 500, of 
which $1,000 is at 42 per cent. and $1,500 at 4 per cent. 

The further assets of the Society consist of unpaid annual dues 
to the amount of $185 for 1883 and $90 for 1882. ‘The total active 
membership remains at about one hundred and fifty, and the prob- 
able income for the next year may be estimated at $900, nearly all 
of which will be needed to pay current expenses and the bills for 
printing Volume VI. 

Early in the year one hundred and fifty-five copies of Volume IV 
and two hundred and eighty-five of Volume V were distributed to 
the active members and to about fifty domestic and eighty-five for- 
eign recipients. 

The list of recipients is a slightly amended copy of that printed 
in Volume IV of the Bulletin of the Society. Occasional copies of 
the earlier volumes have been distributed to those whose sets had 
accidentally become imperfect, or were otherwise entitled to them. 

As custodian of the library and property, I have the honor to 
report that the Society occasionally receives scientific publications 
by way of exchange with similar organizations. The accession cata- 
logue of the library now includes a hundred and two numbers or 
titles, being an increase of thirty-one during the year. 

By order of the General Council, the "Treasurer was in 1881 
instructed to initiate the keeping of a record book containing a 
sketch of the life and services of the individual members of the 
Society ; this record volume is now prepared, and a notice will be 
sent to each member asking for the necessary data. 

Very respectfully, 
CLEVELAND ABBE, 
Treasurer. 


XXIII 


TREASURER’S REPORT. 


OUR OOP OMG | wean oss eee ee pipe Ses e1O CSSO6PI t= - a= — = [e190 
The yi ee a leet gc saa tae ae OD ® sBs1Y UO yesp-19A0 
LOgoe Pi + GSec aa aaa sean sodInos ][V Woy s}d1999xy 
00 $06 | oe s}dia9ax1 [JO], 
OOPOS? se alras ae *yua0 sad F ye ‘puog ‘Ss ‘GQ OoOS¥¢ aug 
00 Sb -- ‘yua0 sad %¥ ye ‘puoqg “Ss "AQ COO'I¢ aUO 
00 obg¢ 2 ZIA ‘SpUN} Po}saaul UO }So19]UT 
00 of ~--£eg1 ‘gz aaquis.eq _poyisodap pur 
00 Sg ---£991 ‘o1 1aqwasaq, poysodap pur 
00 Sor |---£ggr ‘Lz saqmaaon paytsodap pur : 
00 $6 ---£9Q1 ‘Sr 1aquiaaon poyisodap pur . 
COrGLA wa |p Eger ‘1 Avy poytsodap pur ——-- 
GOOONS 455 ae €ggr ‘Li yorey poysodap pur CAC eCelall aa tee pare aoe ‘yuoo sad 
00 oS ----€eer ‘br Areniqaq paytsodap pur b ‘Ss ‘pooo'rg¢ “on w ss3ry | 6L | Z S$ 29q 
Go:cer>-|*>-"= £ggi ‘9g Areniqa,y poysodap pue So § ---- Areyaroag aaqn "yD | gl | 9 Qe ‘AON 
60; Se= =e €ggr ‘1 Areniqa,z poysodap pur oS It ~~ saajurid ‘raplamjoq 2 ppnf{ | ZZ | oz oun{ 
oo Sfi¢g |---zggr ‘fz saquis90q7 paytsodap pure ol oF ~~ qomsvaly, ‘aqqy purpaasg,y | o£ | ¥ gz Judy 
: pealsdoi sonp yenuuy |} go dir |-~ saaqutad ‘xapiaajaqy 3» ppnf{ | SZ | £ Iz judy 
LOVER Ao To ZQQI *Qz ‘99 WOAJ ADAO potiies sduL[vg || oS SF ~~ sxoquud ‘rapraajaq 2 ppn{ | SZ | z Iz judy 
> SMOT[OJ sv s}diadaa Aq ytparD oo o9f = | ~~ saaquid ‘1ayramjoqy 9 ppnf{ | PL | 1 I yorey 
"Egg 
‘ Qal\< 
12}, ‘yunowy *90INOS JeYM UII] ‘yunowy ‘pred woya OJ, @ 2 ‘aed 
a ae 
“SLAIDOaY “SHUN LIGNAdXY 
"ag ERR aah ay] 40f ‘4aansva4y, ‘2qgQP puvjanay ypin sunorIv Ur UOjSuLmsygy fo Ajar205 pvrrydosojiyg YJ ‘Ad 


Oe”, 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. 


XXV 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF’ THE PRESIDENT, 
J. W. Powe tt, 
Delivered December 8, 1883. 


THE THREE METHODS OF EVOLUTION. 


In the early history of research attention was chiefly given to 
phenomena of co-existence. In late years the phenomena of sequence 
have received the larger share of attention. The investigation of 
the phenomena of sequence has led to.the invention of a number of 
hypotheses. In the past history of scientific research three of these 
have each led to a long series of important discoveries. These are 
the nebular hypothesis, the atomic hypothesis, and the hypothesis 
of the development of life. The nebular theory is an hypothesis 
of astronomic evolution; the atomic theory has gradually assumed 
the shape of an hypothesis of chemical evolution; and the develop- 
ment theory has been elaborated and re-stated as the hypothesis of 
biologic evolution. The time has come when in all fruitful research 
evolution in some form is postulated by each investigator in his own 
field. Yet many scientific men, though admitting the doctrines of 
evolution in their own special fields, ofttimes reject them elsewhere; 
and there is some disagreement even among the greatest thinkers 
as to the extent to which the hypotheses of evolution can be carried, 
but all postulate evolution in some form and to some degree. 

An attempt will be made in this address to point out what is be- 
lieved to be the fact—that there are three grand classes of phe- 
nomena, constituting three kingdoms of matter and representing 
three stages of evolution; or, stated in another way, that there has 
been an evolution of the methods of evolution, so that the methods 
discovered in the first stage have been superseded by those discov- 
red in the second, and these superseded by the methods of the third 
stage. It is proposed to indicate and, as clearly as possible within 
the limits of an address, to define, in terms of matter and motion, 
the three kingdoms of matter and the three methods of evolution. — 
As precedent to the general statement it will be well, therefore, 
briefly to consider the kinematic hypothesis. 


XXVII 


XXVIII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


THE KINEMATIC HYPOTHESIS. 


That motion is persistent is the kinematic hypothesis. In the 
early history of research many modes or varieties of motion were 
directly observed. To account for these motions they were said to 
be caused by forces, and Force was sometimes defined as that which 
produces motion. Something, therefore, was conceived to exist— 
not matter, not motion—an existence that would produce motion. 
Then arose the question, What is Force—this antecedent of Motion? 
The researches inaugurated from this standpoint led again and 
again to the discovery that the antecedent of motion is some other 
motion, and one after another of the so-called “forces” were thus 
resolved into motions, until at last only gravity and affinity, and 
perhaps magnetism, remain as unexplained antecedents of motion. 
But gravity, affinity, and magnetism are included under one term, 
“ attraction,” by those who hold that there is yet a force—something 
other than motion which produces motion. Attraction, then, is left. 
Sometimes these same philosophers speak of “ attraction and repul- 
sion.” If, then, all forces the actions of which are thoroughly 
known are resolved into antecedent motions, it is indeed an induc- 
tive hypothesis worthy of consideration that the antecedents of the 
phenomena of attraction and repulsion may also be regarded as 
modes of motion. 

But this hypothesis is reached by another method. It is known 
that motions may be transmuted from one kind or mode into an- 
other.. Affinity can be transmuted into motion, and motion into 
affinity. If we wish to obtain the mode of motion called electricity, 
we may derive it from mechanical motion through friction, or we 
may derive it through affinity in the voltaic cell. If we combine a 
gramme of hydrogen with oxygen, 34,000 units of heat—a mode of 
motion—are developed. If a gramme of hydrogen be combined 
with iodine, 3,600 units of heat—a mode of motion—are absorbed. 
But why introduce single illustrations? A large part of all the 
powers used by man in the industries of the world are derived from 
affinity. Affinity, therefore, is the equivalent of motion. By a 
similar process it is shown that gravity can be transmuted into mo- 
tion and motion into gravity, and the trasmutation of magnetism 
into motion and of motion into magnetism is well known. 

It is thus seen that while motion may be derived from the so- 
called forces, gravity, affinity, and magnetism, these so-called force 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XxXIX 


may also be derived from motion. In all other cases where a mode 
of motion is transmuted, it is but changed into another mode. It 
is therefore an inductive hypothesis that gravity, affinity, and mag- 
netism are also modes of motion. 

This hypothesis is reached by yet another inductive process. 
There is a vast multiplicity of properties which bodies present to 
the mind through touch, taste, smell, hearing, and sight—properties 
at first explained as occult. During the progress of scientific re- 
search, one after another of these properties has been resolved into 
motion, until at last two remain unexplained—rigidity and elasticity. 
By those who hold with most tenacity to older explanations of such 
phenomena, these two remaining properties are attributed to attrac- 
tion and repulsion; but those who have fallen into the current of 
modern thought believe that they can be explained as the results of 
the composed motion of the constituent parts of the bodies which 
exhibit them, together with molecular impact. That some such ex- 
planation will eventually be fully established is highly probable as 
an inductive hypothesis. 

When these various methods of induction are combined they 
lead to an hypothesis of the highest character,and we may reasonably 
expect that all forces will ultimately be resolved into motions. The 
term force will still be of value in science, to be used in each case as 
denoting the antecedent motion. 


Intimately related to the kinematic hypothesis is the hypothesis 
of an ether, which has also been reached by a variety of inductive 
methods, 7. e. from converging lines of research. In fact, the kine- 
matic hypothesis and the ethereal hypothesis are identical, the first 
being stated in terms of motion, the second in terms of matter. 

Intimately related to the ethereal hypothesis is the nebular hypo- 
thesis, also reached through a series of converging lines of induc- 
tion. 

Every fact that lends probability to one lends probability to all. 
Thus each strengthens the other. It must be understood that how- 
ever probable they may be, they are yet hypotheses, and for their 
complete demonstration the mode of action must be specifically 
pointed out in each case. 

The ethereal hypothesis furnishes the original homogeneous matter 
in motion from which the various aggregates have been segregated. 
The nebular hypothesis takes up this matter while it is yet in a 

3 a 


XXX PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


molecular condition and derives from it the more compounded ag- 
gregates and their motions, in obedience to the law of the persis- 
tence of motion, which is the kinematic hypothesis. Thus there are 
bodies of men engaged in researches relating to molecular physics, 
other bodies of men in researches relating to molecular physics and 
astronomy, and others in molecular physics and chemistry, all of 
whose researches converge in the kinematic hypothesis. It is there- 
fore reached by a consilience of many inductive methods. 


In the statement thus made concerning the kinematic theory 
there is no attempt to assemble the data on which it rests. Such 
task could not be performed in an address, as volumes would be 
~ needed for their presentation. An attempt has been made simply 
to characterize the processes of inductive reasoning by which the 
hypothesis is reached. 

If the kinematic hypothesis should be demonstrated, it would be 
a veritable explanation. The dynamic hypothesis is no explana- 
tion. To exhibit this fact it must be briefly analyzed. 

Philosophy is the science of opinion, and the philosopher has for 
the subject-matter of his science the origin and nature of opinions, 
and he discovers that they may be broadly grouped in three classes— 
mythic, metaphysic, and scientific. Mythic opinion arises from the 
attempt to explain the simple in terms of the compound—that is, 
to explain biotic and physical phenomena by their crude analogies 
to human activities. Early man, discovering that his own activi- 
ties arose from design and will, supposed that there was design and 
will in all function and motion. Through this method of explana- 
tion have arisen the mythologies of the world. 

But in the early civilization of the Aryan race a multitude of 
mythic systems were thrown together and studied by the same body 
of men, originally for the purpose of deriving therefrom the com- 
mon truth. The resulting comparison and investigation led to the 
conclusion that they were all false, and in lieu thereof a new system 
of explanation was invented. These earlier philosophers of the 
cities of the Mediterranean, while engaged in the comparison of 
mythologies, were also engaged in the comparison of languages, and 
they discovered many profoundly interesting facts of linguistic 
structure, and the intimate relations between language and thought 
by which the form of thought itself is moulded. These great 
facts appearing at the same time that mythic philosophy was dis- 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XXXI 


solving into idle tales, led to the origin of a new philosophic 
method. The men of that day supposed that the truth is in the 
word, and that a verbal explanation could be constructed ; that the 
philosophy of the universe could be based on language; and to 
them verbal statement was explanation, final and absolute, and be- 
ing was but ideal. 

But metaphysic philosophy was displaced by the increase of 
knowledge—the development of scientific philosophy. In this sys- 
tem the phenomena of co-existence and sequence are objectively 
discerned and classified. 

This bare statement of the three methods can be made more lucid 
by an illustration. Unsupported bodies above the earth fall, and 
such phenomena are seen so often as to challenge every man’s atten- 
tion. Early man, whose mind was controlled by mythic opinions, 
subjectively knew that if he wished to move a body he must push 
or pull it, and to him there was no other method of originating 
motion. 

Some years ago I was with a small body of Wintun Indians on 
Pitt River, the chief tributary of the Sacramento, engaged in the 
study of mythology. I had gone among the rocks for the purpose 
of awakening echoes, that I might elicit from my dusky philosophers 
an explanation thereof. Unexpectedly I fell upon an explanation 
of gravity. We had climbed a high crag, and I sat at the summit 
of the cliff with my feet overhanging the brink. An Indian near 
me, who could speak but imperfect English, seemed solicitous for 
my safety, and said: “ You better get out; hollow pull you down.” 
I had previously been intent on watching the operations of his mind 
for the purpose above mentioned, and this expression seemed to me 
strange; and it started a line of investigation which I eagerly pur- 
sued. I soon discovered that he interpreted the fall of bodies by 
purely subjective analogies. He who stands on a rock but slightly 
elevated above the earth feels no fear, but if standing a thousand 
feet above the base of the cliff, he attempts to look over, fear curdles 
his blood, and he seems to be pulled over. As he climbs a lofty 
pine, at every increase of altitude there is an increase of fear, and 
he seems to be pulled down by a stronger force. When he rests 
upon the solid earth he feels no “ pull,” but when elevated above it 
he interprets. his subjective feelings as an objective pull. Vacuity 
is personified and believed to be an actor. 

In the early winter of 1882 I was with a party of Indians in the 


XXXIT PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Grand Cafion of the Colorado. Some of the young men were 
amusing themselves by trying to throw stones across a lateral gorge. 
No one could accomplish the feat, though they could throw stones 
even farther, as they believed, along the level land. Chuar, the 
chief, explained this to me by informing me that the cafion pulled 
the stones down. The apparent proximity of the opposite wall was 
believed to be actual, and vacuity was personified and believed to 
exert a force. ; 

: Metaphysic explanations of gravity are found. By that method 
an absolute up and down is predicated, and bodies have a tendency 
to fall down. This is an explanation in words, the words expressing 
no meaning but believed to be themselves thoughts. It is per- 
haps the earliest form of the metaphysic explanation of gravity. 
But with the progress of knowledge the absolute disappears, and 
positions are found to be but relative ; there is no absolute up and 
down; and other facts with regard to gravity are discovered. And 
finally the metaphysician says bodies attract. Now the term fall, 
as used by the early metaphysicians, was the name of a motion 
observed, and it was held to be a complete explanation as long as 
up and down was supposed to be absolute, not relative; and the 
explanation was abandoned as insufficient when the ideas of abso- 
lute up and down were abandoned. But the word attraction does 
not involve this error. It is simply a name for the phenomenon, 
without the manifestly fallacious implication of “‘up and down.” 
And it is a good name for the specific phenomenon to which it is 
applied. But it must not connotate any other idea; in so far as 
it does, it is vitiated. Yet the metaphysician will suppose that by 
using the term “attraction” he explains gravity. The scientific 
philosopher uses the term purely as the name of the phenomenon, 
and does not suppose that thereby the phenomenon is explained ; 
and having named it, he still seeks for its explanation—that is, he 
still seeks to resolve that which is manifestly a complex phenom- 
enon, exhibited in the relations of positions of bodies, into its most 
simple elements. Whenever this is done he will say that attraction, 
or gravity—they being synonyms for the same phenomenon—is 
explained. 

The kinematist uses “attraction” asasynonym for “ gravitation.” 
The dynamist uses “attraction” as a verbal explanation of Gravi- 
tation. The mythic philosopher uses the term to connotate the still 
further idea that bodies exert a “ pull” on one another; and this 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XX XIII 


latter concept is no less mythic than that of the Indian who believes 
that the vacuity between them exerts the pull. 

It is fortunate for science that every discovery and every induc- 
tive hypothesis is rigidly criticised, as this leads to the careful 
examination of the verity of facts discerned and of the legitimacy 
of hypotheses derived therefrom. Against the kinematic theory of 
force much good rhetoric has been hurled, which may be somewhat 
imitated in the following manner : 

Here is a quotation from Bagehot, with an interpolation of my 
own: “This easy hypothesis of. special creation [occult force] has 
been tried so often, and has broken down so very often, that 
in no case probably do any great number of careful inquirers very 
firmly believe it. They may accept it provisionally, as the best 
hypothesis at present, but they feel about it as they cannot help 
feeling as to an army which has always been beaten; however 
strong it seems they think it will be beaten again.” 

The venerable gentlemen who constitute the elder school tell us 
that motion is not persistent; that energy constitutes a class of 
things including two groups, the forces on the one hand and the 
motions on the other; that the total amount of energy is persistent, 
but that the total amount of motion is changeable. And by their 
definition force is that which produces motion, 7. e. force can create 
or destroy motion. But manifestly where there is more motion there 
must be less force, therefore force can destroy itself; and when there 
is more force and less motion, force can create itself. 

The moon that passes through the sky of the gentlemen of the 
old school is moon from the eastern to the western horizon. Then 
the dragon, which exists not, destroys the moon and thus creates 
itself, and passing through the cave from west to east it mounts to 
their horizon, and in the twinkling of an eye commits suicide by 
creating a moon. It is not strange that the thaumaturgics of such 
philosophy should lend signal aid to its rhetoric. 


The use of hypothesis in science is not only legitimate but an 
absolute necessity. The science of psychology, as distinguished 
from metaphysic speculation, points out this fact: that all increase 
of knowledge is dependent upon hypothesis. Objective impressions 
made by the phenomena of the universe upon the organ of the mind 
are discerned only by the aid of comparison, and are added to 
knowledge only by being combined with previously discerned phe- 


é 


XXXIV PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


nomena. Phenomena imperfectly discerned are such as are com- 
bined by superficial analogies; phenomena clearly discerned are 
such as are combined by essential homologies. With all discern- 
ment, therefore, there is comparison, and comparison is reflection 
and reflection is reason. Now, scientific research is not random 
observation and comparison, but designed discernment and classifi- 
tion ; it is research for a purpose, and the purpose is the explanation 
of imperfectly discerned phenomena. Phenomena not understood, 
because imperfectly discerned and classified, are made the subject of 
examination by first inventing a hypothetic explanation of the 
same. With this, the investigator proceeds to more careful obser- 
vation and comparison, devising new methods of discrimination 
and of testing conclusions. Under the impetus of this hypothetic 
explanation, discernment and comparison proceed, and additions to 
knowledge are made thereby, and it matters not whether the hypo- 
thesis bé confirmed or overthrown. 

On this rock much research is wrecked. When an hypothesis 
gains such control over the mind that phenomena are subjectively 
discerned, that they are seen only in the light of the preconceived 
idea, then research but adds to vain speculation. A mind con- 
trolled by an hypothesis is to that extent insane; the rational mind 
is controlled only by the facts, and contradicted hypotheses vanish 
in their light. 

There is another rock on which research is wrecked—the belief 
which ofttimes takes possession of the mind that the unknown is 
unknowable, that human research can penetrate into the secrets of 
the universe no farther. It is the despondency of unrewarded 
mental toil. 

Yet another rock on which research is wrecked is the definition 
of the unknown. Phenomena appear, but whence is not discovered, 
and resort is had to verbal statement, and the verbal statement oft 
repeated comes to be held as a fact itself. This is the vice of all 
metaphysics, by which words are held to be things—spectral imagin- 
ings that haunt the minds of introverted thinkers as devils possess 
the imaginations of the depraved. 

In the midst of the sea of the unknown stand the three rocks: the 
controlling hypothesis, the unknowable unknown, and the verbal 
definition, and in the waters about them are buried many wrecks. 


% 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XXxXV 


COMBINATION OF MATTER. 


When the various bodies known to mind are resolved into their 
constituent parts to the utmost of art and knowledge, such parts 
are found to be so minute as almost to disappear in the perspective 
toward the infinitesimal. The molecular bodies thus dimly discerned 
‘are combined and re-combined, until substances are produced that 
come distinctly within the cognizance of our senses, so that we are 
able to observe their forms and motions. These molar bodies 
are again combined, until at last bodies of such magnitude are pro- 
duced that they are but dimly discerned in the perspective toward 
the infinite—stellar systems that appear not to the eye, but only to 
the mind’s eye. 


INORGANIC COMBINATION. 


Matter is primarily combined by chemical affinity. The sub 
stances thus produced appear in three states: gaseous, fluid, and 
solid, but are not clearly demarcated. That chemically combined 
matter which is found in the solid state is further combined by crys- 
tallization and lithifaction. It may be that these methods are parts 
of the same process, and further, that they are one with chemical 
affinity ; at any rate it is impossible clearly to demarcate them. 

- They are also influenced by gravity, and to a large extent act under 
its control. Thus it is that gravity, and affinity with its concomi- 
tants, unite in molecularly combining matter into inorganic sub- 
stances. Again, these bodies are mechanically combined into geo- 
logic formations, bodies of water, and bodies of air, and such com- 
binations result from gravity. Finally they are all combined into 
an aggregate, the earth itself, solid, fluid, and gaseous. This also 
results from gravity. 

In the succession of combinations thus briefly reviewed, the first 
natural aggregate reached is the earth. Below that we have chemi- 
cal and mechanical substances, which do not constitute integers, but 
only integral parts. The earth itself is a whole—an aggregation, 
as the term is here used. 

Again, the earth is one of the bodies of the solar system, which 
is a combination of worlds. This aggregation, also, is controlled by 
gravity. Other higher astronomic aggregates may exist. 


ORGANIC COMBINATION. 


Portions of the matter combined by affinity and gravity are seg- 


LIBRARY 
} SEP 6 J888 


1 LW we see SND DWIID 


XXXVI PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


regated to be combined by vitality, giving organic bodies or aggre- 
gates, as plants and animals. These bodies do not permanently re- 
main such, as the matter of which they are composed sooner or later 
returns to the condition of combination due solely to affinity and 
gravity. They live and die. 


SUPERORGANIC COMBINATION. 


There are certain biotic bodies whose activities are combined. 
The first step in combination is the biologic differentiation of the 
sexes, giving a group of co-operative individuals for the activities 
of reproduction—male and female, parent and child. This initial 
combination is crudely developed into still larger combinations of 
co-operative individuals among the lower animals. With mankind 
it is developed to a much higher degree, resulting in a great variety 
of co-operative activities. 


There is found, then, a variety of methods of combination, in- 
cluded under three classes: physical, due to affinity and gravity; 
biotic, due to vital organization; and anthropic, due to related actiy- 
ities. Physical combinations result in the production of substances 
and aggregates, and the existence of a physical body is preserved 
by preserving identity of form and identity of constituent matter. 
Biotic combination also produces substances and aggregates, and 
the existence of a biotic body is continued by the preservation of 
identity of form, but not of identity of constituent matter. In an- 
thropic combination, substances and aggregates, as the terms are 
here used, are not produced, but biotic aggregates are interrelated 
in their activities through the agency of mind. 

In physical aggregates the relation of parts is that of interde- 
pendence, so that the constitution and form of each part are de- 
pendent on the constitution and form of every other part. This 
interdependence may be better comprehended by means of an illus- 
tration. In the aggregate the earth, the interdependence is exhib- 
ited in the relations existing between the incompletely aggregated 
bodies of minerals, known as geologic formations; the incompletely 
aggregated bodies of water, known as seas, lakes, streams, and 
clouds; and the incompletely aggregated bodies of air, known as 
winds. Air-currents gather the waters from the seas and pour them 
upon the lands. Rains and rivers disintegrate the rocks and carry 
them to the sea. Currents in the sea distribute the detritus over 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XXXVII 


the bottom. By the loading of areas of sea-bottom they are de- 
pressed, and by the degradation of land-areas they are unloaded 
and rise. Change in the geography of the land effects a change in 
wind-currents and in bodies of water, and a change in the latter 
effects a change in sedimentation. In like manner, throughout all 
physical nature, an interdependence of parts is exhibited. Part 
acts on part. 

In biotic aggregates the same interdependence of parts is shown. 
Any change affecting the digestive apparatus affects the circulatory 
apparatus, and these again are influenced by the respiratory appara- 
tus. But in addition to this interdependence of parts, there is also 
an organization of parts—that is, special functions are performed 
by the several parts, and each is the organ of its function. And 
this organization is of such a nature that each works for the others. 
The digestive apparatus digests for itself and all the organs, the 
heart propels for all the body, the eye sees for all the body, the ear 
hears for all the body, the hand touches for all the body. Thus the 
organic parts act on and for one another. 

In activital combination, aggregates, as the term is here used, do 
not appear, but the same interdependence is observed. By associa- 
tion the sanitary state of the husband affects that of the wife, and 
the condition of the mother affects the child; and on through the 
different combinations of animals and men this interdependence is 
observed. The relation of organization also exists by the differen- 
tiation of industries. The husband brings food to the wife and 
children, and the wife prepares the food. And this differentiation of 
industries, or “division of labor” as it is termed in political science, 
is carried on to an elaborate condition in civilized life. Then men 
are related to one another as constituent members of society ; one 
commands and another obeys. Then men are related to one another 
through language; one speaks, another hears; one writes, another 
reads. Then men are related to one another through opinions; 
having common opinions, they form common designs and act for 
common purposes. It will thus be seen that superorganic or an- 
thropic combination arises trom the establishment of four classes of 
relations, corresponding to the four classes of activities represented 
by arts, institutions, languages, and opinions. The arts are human 
activities directed to the utilization of the materials of nature and 
the control of its powers, for the purpose of securing happiness. In- 
. stitutions are human activities arranged for the purpose of securing 


~ 
XXXVIII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


peace and establishing justice, and thereby increasing happiness 
Languages are activities devised for the purpose of communicating 
thought, and thereby securing happiness. Opinions arise from 
psychic activities, the purpose of which is to learn the truth, that 
happiness may ensue. 

In physical, biotic, and anthropic combinations the parts control 
one another. It will therefore be convenient to speak of three 
‘kingdoms of matter: the mineral or physical kingdom, the organic 
or biotic kingdom, and the anthropic or activital kingdom. 


MODES OF MOTION. 


All bodies, however combined, are discovered to be in motion. 

Among the bodies of the mineral kingdom, a variety of modes 
of molecular motion are exhibited, having various distinguishing 
characteristics. These are heat and light, electricity and magnetism, 
then sound and that motion in gases by which through impact they 
retain their rarefied state. Again, a variety of molar motions are 
observed in gases, liquids, and solids; and finally stellar motions 
are observed in astronomic systems. 

In the biotic kingdom plants and animals exhibit many varieties 
of organic motions, called functions. These are superadded to the 
physical motions, which appear alike in the physical and biotic 
kingdoms. Physical bodies exhibit motions; biotic bodies exhibit 
motions and functions, the latter being highly organized motions. 

In the anthropic kingdom there is a complexity of motions arising 
from biotic functions, which are arranged and combined so as to 
produce activities. These activities are represented by arts, institu- 
tions, languages, and opinions. 

Thus there are three great classes of motions corresponding to the 
three great classes of combinations, namely, physical motions ; biotic 
motions, or functions; and anthropic motions, or activities. 


THE RELATION OF MOTION TO COMBINATION. 


It will at once be seen that anthropic combination,is such by 
virtue of human activities. Activital combination is manifestly 
composed motion. 

Again, biotic aggregates are such by virtue of continuous combi- 
nation and dissolution. Within proper limits a biotic body may be 
compared to a river; it is a form through which matter passes. In 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XXXIX 


plants some of this passing matter becomes fixed for a time, but 
eventually returns from the biotic to the mineral kingdom. Among 
animals this passage of physical matter through the biotic form is 
more rapid. The organic functions, also, of these bodies are but 
arranged or organized motions. Life is motion—the specific motion 
called function. 

Again, among the aggregations of the physical kingdom, stellar 
systems are aggregates by virtue of motion. The combination ob- 
served is due to composed motion. Of the mechanical combina- 
tions, that exhibited in the atmosphere is such by virtue of motion— 
that is, the gaseous state is preserved by the interference of molecu- ° 
lar motions, and the bodies into which it is imperfectly differen- 
tiated, 7. ¢., currents of air, are such by virtue of motion. Again, 
the imperfectly aggfegated bodies of water are such by virtue of 
motion. This is seen to be true of the clouds floating in the air, 
and of rivers rolling to the seas. Lakes with outlets are bodies of 
water in motion, forever fed from the clouds, forever discharging 
into the sea; and mediterranean seas without outlet are perpetually 
receiving and discharging their waters; and so far as the sea is 
differentiated into currents, these are bodies imperfectly aggregated 
by motion. 

There yet remain certain molecular combinations of inorganic 
substances, due to affinity and gravity, the nature of which is not 
so immediately perceived. Now, as all societies and other anthropic 
combinations are such by virtue of their motions, known as activi- 
ties, and as all biotic bodies are such by virtue of their functions, 
and as all stellar combinations are such by virtue of stellar motion, 
and as finally all mechanical combinations are such by virtue of 
motion, it is at once suggested as an inductive hypothesis that those 
combinations the nature of which is yet unknown are also such by 
virtue of motion. It is an hypothesis worthy of consideration, that 
affinity and gravity are also due to motion. It has even been sup- 
posed by some that chemical and barologic methods of combination 
are but diverse modes of the same process; that affinity and gravity 
constitute but one method of combination, and that we call it 
affinity when the combination involves minute bodies, below our 
sense perceptions, and gravity when larger bodies are involved. 

An attempt has thus been made to define the three kingdoms of 
matter in terms of matter and motion, showing that there are three 


XL PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON 


methods of combination, and that the parts combined are related 
by three corresponding methods, and that in each kingdom motions 
of a distinctive class are discovered. The constitution of physical 
bodies is due to composed motion; the constitution of biotic bodies 
is due to composed transmutations of motion; anthropic combina- 
tions are due to related activities. 

In order that there be evolution, there must be change in com- 
bination of matter and in mode of motion. The sole property of 
matter is motion, and motion itself is change of position. But this 
change of position results in change of combination, and change of 
combination results in change of mode of motion. These changes 
must now be set forth. 


CHANGE OF COMBINATION. 


If the mind could discern and classify all the bodies of the uni- 
verse at any one moment, only space conditions would enter therein ; 
but bodies change from time to time, so that there are sequences of 
combination. Substances and aggregates of matter are such by rea- 
son of an arrangement in position of their constituent parts. Sub- 
stances and bodies change in external relations and in internal rela- 
tions. Change in external relations is change of position in relation 
to external things. Change in internal relations is the change in 
relative arrangement of constituent parts. And this change of posi- 
tion is always motion, the first and only property of matter. 

Chemical, crystalline, and lithical combinations are decomposed 
and otherwise re-composed, mechanical combinations are broken 
up and otherwise re-arranged, and stellar aggregates are believed 
to have been gradually formed. With physical bodies internal 
change is the direct result of external change. This is their dis- 
tinctive characteristic, that all their changes of constitution result 
directly from agencies without themselves. 

Biotic bodies exhibit the same changes as mineral bodies, and 
also a series peculiar to themselves. First, biotic substances are 
segregated from the mineral kingdom—. e., mineral substances are 
changed into biotic substances. Second, biotic bodies begin, grow, 
decline, and die. This is a progressive change of structure. Third, 
the structure of biotic bodies is preserved by continuous change in 
their constituent matter. Form and structure are preserved while 
the matter is forever changing. Life is a determined, systematic 
sequence of transmutations of motion, transformations of matter, and 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLI 


transfigurations of body. Life is change. Fourth, as the individ- 
uals are not persistent, the method of aggregation continues by the 
processes of reproduction of like forms. But these like forms are 
made unlike—. e., changed—by two processes. In the biotic repro- 
duction of the higher forms the bisexual method prevails, so that 
each individual is the offspring of two parents, like both so far as 
they are alike, but differing from the one or the other so far as they 
are unlike. Fifth, the individual has its constitution determined 
by its parents, but subject to changes which may be brought about 
by external relations differing from those to which the parents were 
subjected ; and within limits these are transmitted to offspring. 
Thus it is seen that biotic changes are caused by external and in- 
ternal agencies. 

This may be put in another form. In mineral bodies the same 
matter is changed in structure. In biotic bodies the same or nearly 
the same structure remains and the constituent matter changes; yet 
there is a slow change in structure from birth to death, and a still 
further change in structure from generation to generation; but 
there is more rapid change of constituent matter. Anthropic ag- 
gregates arise, not by a combination of matter, but by a combina- 
tion of the activities of biotic bodies. These biotic bodies them- 
selves change, as individuals disappear and new ones take their 
places. Thus family group succeeds family group, and generations 
of people succeed generations of people. In the same manner arts 
change. Old arts are abandoned and new arts appear. Various 
societies cease to exist and new societies are organized. ‘The organ- 
ization due to the differentiation of operations steadily increases by 
the division of labor; and the grouping of bodies of men into states, 
i. €., tribes and nations, is in constant flux. So, languages change— 
they grow and die. And opinions change with each individual and 
from generation to generation. All these changes are determined 
by the will of the individual units who are actors—that is, activi- 
ties change because the actors so desire. Anthropic change is due 
to psychic agencies. 


CHANGE OF MOTION. 


That motion is persistent is a fundamental axiom. But while it 
does not change in quantity it changes in quality in diverse ways. 
First, motion may be changed in direction. Simple motion is the 
motion of a body in a straight line, and change of such motion of 


XLII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


the lowest order is change in direction, and this is accomplished by 
the combination of two or more motions having different directions. 
Then motion may be transmitted from one body to another. The 
molecular motions—heat, light, electricity, sound, ete—are motions 
propagated by transmission from molecule to molecule. In the 
kinematic hypothesis of gravity it is held that atomic motion is 
transmitted from atoms to combined and aggregated bodies by im- 
pact; and here we reach another method of change—that by trans- 
mutation. One mode of motion may be transmuted into another, 
as molar motion into heat, and heat into electricity. 

By the combination of matter motion iscomposed. Mineral sub- 
stances and aggregates exhibit this composition of diverse modes of 
motion. Biotic bodies exhibit composition of modes of motion, and 
also composition of transmutations of motion, ‘and it is this latter 
characteristic which distinguishes biotic from physical motion. 
Activital combinations exhibit a composition of modes of motion, 
and a composition of the transmutations of motion, and a compo- 
sition by co-operative action. It is the last characteristic which 
distinguishes activital motion from biotic. 

The changes of motion exhibited in the mineral kingdom are 
changes in direction by combination, changes in relative quantity 
by transmission, changes in mode of motion through transmutation, 
and changes in the combination of modes of motion. 

In the biotic kingdom the same changes are found as in the min- 
eral kingdom, but to them are added changes in the composition of 
transmutations of motion. 

In the anthropic kingdom all the changes in the other kingdoms 
appear, together with changes in the composition of activities. 


EVOLUTION DEFINED. 


As matter is indestructible, when one combination or aggregation 
is dissolved some other must appear, and vice versa. Existing 
bodies must have antecedents. In tracing backward the history of 
bodies, lines of sequences are followed. Many such are known, and 
the first important characteristic to. be noted of them is they are 
orderly. ike bodies have like antecedents. From this results one 
of the highest inductions of science, namely, that from consequents 
antecedents can be restored, and from antecedents consequents can 
be predicted. The second important characteristic of these sequences 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. xXLiUt 


of change is that many are in a definite direction, which is gradually 
becoming known. This general course of change is denominated 
Evolution, and the term must be defined. 

Evolution is progress in systemization. It must be noted that 
not all changes are progressive; some are retrogressive. It is only 
progressive change that is here called evolution; retrogressive change 
is dissolution. As the term is here used, a System is an assemblage 
of interdependent parts, each arranged in subordination to the 
whole so as to constitute an integer. Evolution may therefore be 
defined in another way. It is progress in differentiation by the 
establishment of unlike parts, and in the integration of these parts 
by the establishment of interdependence. Dissolution is retrogres- 
sion by the lapsing of integration through the destruction of inter- 
dependence, and the lapsing of differentiation through the loss of 
heterogeneity in parts. 


EVOLUTION IN THE PHYSICAL KINGDOM. 


Under the kinematic hypothesis, which embraces the ethereal and 
nebular hypotheses, portions of discrete matter have been segregated 
to be combined and aggregated. The process precedent to evolu- 
tion, then, is combination and aggregation, by which substauces 
and integers are produced. 

Whatever may be the fate of the explanation of the origin of 
substances and aggregates through the kinematic and concomitant 
hypotheses, the fact remains that such bodies exist, and the evolu- 
tion of matter, as it is hereafter dealt with, starts from this point. 
Given substances and aggregates as they are known to exist in 
nature, and given changes which they are known to undergo, it is 
proposed to point out by what methods evolution is attained. 

The terms substance and aggregate have been used as distin- 
guishing two orders of combination. It should be noted that they 
cannot be clearly demarcated. Substances are composed of homo- 
geneous, non-interdependent parts, but this homogeneity is never 
absolute, and some slight degree of interdependence may always be 
discovered. Aggregates, on the other hand, are composed of hetero- 
geneous, interdependent parts, but degrees of heterogeneity and 
interdependence appear. Combination is the bringing together of 
dissociated matter; and it is in the combinations, separations, and 
re-combinations of matter that evolution appears. 


> 
XLIV PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


In mineral bodies combinations proceed by molecular, molar, and 
stellar methods. It has been shown that the changes in these bodies 
are due to external conditions or forces. If a given body be in 
harmony with external conditions no change occurs in its constitu- 
tion, but if it be out of harmony the impinging agencies effect such 
modifications as will produce harmony. This may be done by a 
change in the body as a substance or aggregate, or by its separation 
and re-combination in some more harmonious form. The evolution 
of mineral bodies is thus accomplished by direct adaptation to 
external conditions. 

If it is permitted hypothetically to conceive of a universe of 
ethereal matter—i. e., matter composed of discrete atoms in motion, 
such atoms would remain in an attenuated condition by atomic im- 
pact. In matter thus constituted, motion could be transmitted from 
atom to atom, but no new mode of motion would result therefrom. 
The mass of matter thus constituted would be absolutely homoge- 
neous. But if by some method several such atoms should be com- 
bined, so as to move together as a common body, and so that 
their interspaces could not be penetrated by other atoms, the motion 
of an impinging atom would not only be transmitted to the larger 
body, but it would also be transmuted into another mode or kind of 
motion. If other such molecules were formed by the segregation of 
atoms from the homogeneous mass, the new kind of motion would 
be set up in all the matter thus segregated, and the motions of these 
bodies would react one upon another. If, again, some of these 
molecules were segregated, to be combined in larger bodies, with or 
without such a diminution of interspaces as to prevent the inter- 
penetration of atoms, a third mode of motion would be established ; 
and if diverse methods of aggregation should occur, diverse modes 
of motion would be established thereby; and in all combining and 
re-combining, aggregating and re-aggregating, new modes and com- 
plexities would arise. 

It is a well-known law that a moving body passes in the direction 
of the least resistance. Diverse modes of motion may exist in a 
body, due to the complexities of its organization. Im the trans- 
mission of motion to such a body from another by impact, the 
motion transmitted is transmuted into that mode which gives it 
the least resistance. This is illustrated on every hand. When 
a smaller body impinges against a larger, the inequality between 
the two may be so great that molar motion is not set up in the 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLV 


larger body, but the whole of the imparted motion is transmuted 
into heat or some other melecular motion. 

This law, that motion passes in the direction of least résistance, 
is the equivalent of the law of adaptation in the evolution of mat- 
ter. When evolution is considered from the standpoint of matter, 
it is convenient to use the term Adaptation ; when considered from 
the standpoint of motion, it is more convenient to use the term Least 
Resistance. 


EVOLUTION IN THE BIOTIC KINGDOM. 


In biotic bodies it has been seen that change is the result of in- 
ternal as well as external conditions. As external conditions, or the 
environment, are changing, these bodies change to a limited extent, 
in the same manner as do mineral bodies; but there is also a change 
brought about indirectly by the environment, through certain in- 
ternal changes in the constitution of biotic bodies. Through this 
internal constitution individuals are changed in time—one genera- 
tion dies and another succeeds. 

There is yet another method of change in biotic bodies, which 
steadily increases from the lowest to the highest—that is, the change 
in their constituent matter. While structure changes slowly from 
birth through growth and decadence to death, the constituent matter 
changes with much greater rapidity. In this change the minute 
elements of structure change much more rapidly than the larger 
into which they are compounded ; so that every part of the organ 
must be supplied with new material to replace that which is steadily 
becoming effete and passing away. Now the rate of this change in 
any integral part of an organism is dependent upon the activity of 
the organ. Exercise increases the rate of change in the constituent 
matter of a biotic organ, and thus the slow change in its structure, 
which proceeds from life to death, is accelerated. This accelerated 
change results in increased differentiation of the organ, and it thereby 
becomes more and more efficient in the performance of its function. 
This change, therefore, results from exercise. Organs that are ex- 
ercised increase in efficiency, by non-exercise they decrease in effi- 
ciency. This change in the organization of any one individual is 
but slight, but as the slight changes pass from one generation to’ 
another, continuous exercise of one set of organs greatly modifies 
them; continuous neglect of exercise in another set modifies them 


also, until at last they are atrophied. Thus by exercise and non- 
4a 


XLVI PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


exercise important structural changes are produced when conjoined 
with the changes due to heredity. 

All these changes result in progress, from the fact that those indi- 
viduals whose change is in a direction out of harmony with the en- 
vironment ultimately perish, while those whose change is in a direc- 
tion in harmony with the environment survive. This method of 
adaptation or evolution in biology is called “ the survival of the 
fittest.” 

The rate of evolution by survival is greatly accelerated by another 
condition. Each pair of biotic bodies reproduce a large number of 
new bodies, so that reproduction from generation to generation is in 
a high geometric ratio. The earth having become occupied with 
all the biotic beings that can derive sustentation therefrom, but a 
small fraction of the beings produced in a generation can live. Few 
survive, many succumb. Survival by adaptation is therefore made 
more efficient by competition. 

There are other changes in the biotic kingdom brought about by 
adaptation. The multiplicity of biotic beings, causing over-popula- 
tion, has crowded them into every conceivable habitat—in the air, 
on the land, and in the water; and living beings have become 
adapted thereto by the development of wings, legs, fins, and correl- 
ative organs. Thus by exercise organs have been developed, and 
by non-exercise other organs have been atrophied, until living be- 
ings have become specialized for a vast diversity of habitats—for 
life on the mountain and in the valley, in the light and in the dark, 
in the cold and in the heat, in humid regions and in arid re- 
gions. Living beings have also been adapted to various kinds of 
food and to various methods of acquisition—in fine, to a great 
variety of conditions. 

This specialization by development, through exercise and non- 
exercise, must be clearly distinguished from the processes of evolu- 
tion. The heterogeneous living beings thus produced are but multi- 
plied and diverse forms, animals and plants alike being as often de- 
graded as evolved in the processes of specialization. Degradation 
is especially to be noticed in parasitic animals and others adapted 
to extremely abnormal habitats ; but it should be understood that 
a form thus produced may, in the process of its production and sub- 
sequent existence, make progressive change in the system of its 
structure by the methods of evolution already characterized. 

Specialization is greatly accelerated by a peculiar method. As 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLVII 


all the highes animals are physically discrete, psychic relations 
must be established, in order that they may meet for the act of re- 
production. These psychic relations gradually develop into choice, 
or sexual selection, and by methods which have been clearly pointed 
out by biologists the minute increments of change that result there- 
from eventually accumulate into strong variations, always adapted 
to the conditions of the environment. Thus the survival of the 
fittest is accelerated by sexual selection. 


EVOLUTION IN THE ANTHROPIC KINGDOM. 


If attention is directed exclusively to animal life, we notice that 
evolution has proceeded pari passu with specialization. Of the 
forms that have been specialized from time to time some have be- 
come extinct, some have been degraded, and some have been evolved 
in varying degree. One form, not the most specialized, made the 
greatest progress in evolution, until an organism was developed of 
so high a grade that this species became more independent of en- 
vironment than any other, and, by reason of its superiority, spread 
widely throughout the land portion of the globe. This superior 
animal was early man, when he first inhabited all the continents 
and the great islands. The production of this superior, 7. e. more 
highly systematized organism, was the antecedent to the inauguration 
of new methods of evolution. 

It has been shown that the great efficiency of the biotic method 
of evolution by survival depends upon competition for existence in 
enormously overcrowded population. Man, having acquired superi- 
ority to other animals, passed beyond the stage when he had to 
compete with them for existence upon the earth and into the stage 
where he could utilize plants and animals alike for his own pur- 
poses. They could no longer crowd him out, and to that extent 
the law of the survival of the fittest in the struggle for existence 
was annulled in its application to man. - He artificially multiplies 
such of the lower animals as are most useful to him, and domesti- 
cates them, that they may be more thoroughly under his control, 
and modifies them, that they may be more useful, and uses such as 
he will for beasts of burden; and the wild beasts he destroys from 
the face of the earth. In like manner he cultivates useful plants, 
and destroys such as are worthless to him. He does not compete 
with other biotic species, but utilizes them for his wélfare. Yet 


XLVIII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


the law of the survival of the fittest applies in so far as it is not 
dependent upon competition, and slow evolution may still result 
therefrom. But at this stage new methods spring up of such great 
efficiency that the method by the survival of the fittest may be 
neglected because of its insignificance. 

In anthropic combinations the units are men, and men at this 
stage are no longer passive objects, but active subjects; and instead 
of man being passively adapted to the environment, he adapts the 
environment to himself through his activities. This is the essential 
characteristic of anthropic evolution. Adaptation becomes active 
instead of passive. In this change certain parts of the human or- 
ganism are increasingly exercised from generation to generation. 
This steadily increasing exercise results in steadily increasing 
development, and the progress of the unit—man—in this higher 
organization depends upon development through exercise. But the 
progress by exercise depends upon the evolution of activities. 

Man is an animal, and may be studied as such; and this branch 
of science belongs to biology. But man is more than an animal, 
Though an animal in biotic function, he is man in his anthropic 
activities ; for by them men are combined—1. e., interrelated—so that 
they are not discrete beings, but each acts on, for, and with, his 
fellow-man in the pursuit of happiness. Human activities, thus 
combined and organized, transcend the activities of the lower ani- 
mals to such a degree as to produce a new kingdom of matter. The 
nature of these activities must here be set forth. 

The first grand class is composed of those which affect the exter- 
nal world, and by them men are interrelated through their desires. 
These activities are the Arts. The arts have been evolved by human 
invention, and man has been impelled thereto by his endeavor to 
supply his wants. In the course of the evolution of the arts, man 
has progressively obtained control over the materials and powers of 
nature. All the arts of all the human period are the inventions of 
men. But invention has proceeded by minute increments of growth. 
A vast multiplicity of arts have been devised, of which compara- 
tively few survive in the highest civilization. As the inventions 
have been made, the best in the average has been chosen. Man has 
therefore exercised choice. The evolution of the arts has thus been 
by the method of invention and choice, in the endeavor to gratify 
desire, and by them man has adapted the environment to himself. 

Second. There is a grand class of activities through which men 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLIX 


are interrelated in respect to their conduct. These activities result 
in Institutions. Through them men are associated for a variety of 
purposes. Every institution is an organization of a number of in- 
dividuals, who work together for a common purpose, as, for exam- 
ple, to prosecute some industrial enterprise, to co-operate in the 
pursuit of pleasure, to promote some system of opinions, or to wor- 
ship together under the forms of some religion. All such institu- 
tions constitute a class denominated Operative Institutions. A second 
class are the institutions which man has organized for the direct reg- 
ulation of conduct. These are States and their subordinate units, 
with their special organs of government, and rules for the regulation 
of conduct, called Laws. 

Institutions have been developed from extreme simplicity to ex- 
treme complexity. They are all the inventions of mankind, and 
their evolution has been by minute increments of growth. Their 
invention has been wrought out that men might live together in 
peace and render one another assistance; and gradually, by the 
consideration of particulars of conduct as they have arisen from 
time to time, men have sought to establish justice, that they might 
thereby secure peace. Of the vast multiplicity of institutions— 
forms of state, forms of government, and provisions of law—which 
have been invented, but few remain in the highest civilization, and 
these few have been selected’ by men. Men have thus exercised 
choice. Institutions, therefore, have been developed by invention 
and the choice of the just in the endeavor to secure peace. 

Third. There is another fundamental group of activities through 
which men are interrelated in respect to their thoughts. These are 
the activities of mental intercommunication, and result in Lan- 
guages. Languages, also, are inventions by minute increments of 
growth. Many languages have been invented, and in each language 
many words and many methods of combining linguistic devices have 
been invented. In the languages of the most civilized peoples, but 
few of these survive; and there are spoken by all the peoples of the 
earth but few languages in comparison to the many that existed in 
the early history of mankind; and the method of survival, when 
analyzed, is found also to be choice. Men have chosen the economic 
in the expression of thought. Languages, therefore, have devel- 
oped by invention and choice in the struggle for expression. 

Fourth. There is a grand class of activities by which men are 
interrelated in respect to their designs. Men arrive at Opinions, and 


L PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


these have always reacted upon languages, institutions, and arts, and 
largely led them in their courses of progress. Because of their opin- 
ions, men are willing to work together, and thus have common designs. 
There have been many opinions and many systems of philosophy. Of 
all that have existed, but few remain in the highest civilization. A 
careful analysis of the facts relating to the growth of opinions re- 
veals this truth, that opinions also are invented, and that the final 
survival of the few has been due to the human act of choice in the 
selection of the truth. Opinions, therefore, have been developed by 
invention and choice in the struggle to know. 

Fifth. Opinions are formed as the direct activities of the Mind. 
Languages, institutions, and arts have arisen through the action of 
the mind and the exercise of other corporeal functions. All these 
activities, therefore, are dependent upon the mind. On the other 
hand, these objective activities react upon the mind, so that mental 
operations are controlled thereby. Through the exercise of the 
mind in the prosecution of activities it is developed. These 
mental activities are perception and comparison, or reflection, as it 
is more usually called. The subjective evolution of the mind is 
therefore the product of the objective evolution of activities. 

These five great classes of activities are interdependent in such a 
manner that one is not possible without the others; they arise to- 
gether, and their history proceeds by a constant interchange of 
effects. All the five classes of activities react upon man as an ani- 
mal in such a manner that his biotic history subsequent to his 
differentiation from the lower animals is chiefly dependent thereon. 
The evolution of man as a being superior to the beast is therefore 
due to the organization of activities. 

It has been shown that man does not compete with the lower 
animals for existence. In like manner, man does not compete with 
man for existence; for by the development of activities men are 
interdependent in such a manner that the welfare of one depends 
upon the welfare of others ; andas men discover that welfare must 
necessarily be mutual, egoism is transmutted into altruism, and 
moral sentiments are developed which become the guiding princi- 
ples of mankind. So morality repeals the law of the survival of 
the fittest in the struggle for existence, and man is thus immeasur- 
ably superior to the beast. In animal evolution many are sacrificed 
for the benefit of the few. Among mankind the welfare of one 
depends upon the welfare of all, because interdependence has 
been established. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LI 


It has thus been shown that there are three stages in the combina- 
tion of matter and motion, and that each stage is characterized by 
a clearly distinct method of evolution. These may be defined as 
follows : 

First, physical evolution is the result of direct adaptation to en- 
vironment, under the law that motion is in the direction of least 
resistance. 

Second, biotic evolution is the result of indirect adaptation to the 
environment by the survival of the fittest in the struggle for exis- 
tence. 

Third, anthropic evolution is the result of the exercise of human 
faculties in activities designed to increase happiness, and through 
which the environment is adapted to man. 

These may be briefly denominated: evolution by adaptation, 
evolution by survival of the fittest, and evolution by endeavor. 


Civilized men have always recognized to some extent the laws of 
human evolution,—that activities are teleologically developed, and 
that happiness is increased thereby. In the early history of man- 
kind the nature of teleologic endeavor was so strongly impressed 
upon the mind that the theory was carried far beyond the truth, so 
that all biotic function and physical motion were interpreted as 
teleologic activity. When this error was discovered, and the laws 
of physical and biotic evolution established, vast realms of phe- 
nomena were found to have been entirely misunderstood and falsely 
explained, and teleologic postulates have finally fallen into disrepute. 
Men say there is progress in the universe by reason of the very laws 
of nature, and we must let them alone. Thus, reaction from the 
ancient false philosophy of teleology has carried men beyond the 
truth, until they have lost faith in all human endeavor; and they 
teach the doctrine that man can do nothing for himself, that he 
owes what he is to physical and biotic agencies, and that his inter- 
ests are committed to powers over which he has no control. 

Such a philosophy is gradually gaining ground among thinkers 
and writers, and should it prevail to such an extent as to control 
the actions of mankind, modern civilization would lapse into a con- 
dition no whit superior to that of the millions of India, who for 
many centuries have been buried in the metaphysical speculations 
of the philosophy of ontology. When man loses faith in himself, 
and worships nature, and subjects himself to the government of the 


LII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


laws of physical nature, he lapses into stagnation, where mental and 
moral miasm is bred. All that makes man superior to the beast is 
the result of his own endeavor to secure happiness. 

Man, so far as he is superior to the beast, is the master of his 
own destiny, and not the creature of the environment. He adapts 
the natural environment to his wants, and thus creates an environ- 
ment for himself. Thus it is that we do not discover a biotically 
aquatic variety of man, yet he dwells upon the sea and derives 
sustentation from the animals thereof by means of his arts. gA 
biotically arboreal variety of man is not discovered, but the forest 
are used in his arts and the fruits of the forests for his susten- 
tation. An aérial variety of man is not discovered, but he uses 
the winds to propel his machinery and to drive his sails; and, in- 
deed, he can ride upon the air with wings of his own invention. 
A boreal variety of man is not discovered, but he can dwell among 
the everlasting snows by providing architectural shelter, artificial 
warmth and bodily protection. 

Under the influences of the desert a few plants secure a constitu- 
tion by which the moisture imbibed during brief and intermittent 
rains is not evaporated; they become incrusted with a non-porous 
glaze, or contract themselves into the smallest space and exist with- 
out life until the rain comes again. Man lives in the desert by 
guiding a river thereon and fertilizing the sands with its waters, and 
the desert is covered with fields and gardens and homes. LEvery- 
where he rises superior to physical nature. The angry sea may not 
lash him with its waves, for on the billows he builds a palace, and 
journeys from land to land. When the storm rises it is signaled 
from afar,and he gathers his loved ones under the shelter of his 
home, and they listen to the melody of the rain upon the roof. 
When the winds of winter blow he kindles fossil sunshine on his 
hearth, and sings the song of the Ingleside. When night covers 
the earth with darkness he illumines his path with lightning light. 
For disease he discovers antidote, for pain nepenthe, and he gains 
health and long life by sanitation; and ever is he utilizing the 
materials of nature, and ever controlling its powers. By his arts, 
institutions, languages, and philosophies he has organized a new 
kingdom of matter, over which he rules. The beasts of the field, 
the birds of the air, the denizens of the waters, the winds, the 
waves, the rivers, the seas, the mountains, the valleys, are his 
subjects; the powers of nature are his servants, and the granite 
earth his throne. 


BULLEWIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON, 


GENERAL MEETING. 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


GENERAL MEETING. 


227TH MEETING. JANUARY 13, 18838. 
The President in the Chair. 


Twenty-six members present. 


Mr. H. FarquHar completed a communication begun at the 
224th meeting on 


EXPERIMENTS IN BINARY ARITHMETIC, 


in which he showed that simple addition involved carrying on sev- 
eral distinct mental operations almost simultaneously and a capital 
of more than fifty propositions committed to memory. Believing 
that the difficulty in mastering, and the mental strain and liability 
to error in conducting, this most important of mathematical pro- 
cesses could be proved to be unnecessarily great, he had compared 
the time occupied in adding a few dozen numbers of six or eight 
figures each with that required when these numbers were expressed in 
powers of 2, the mental work being, in the latter case, reduced to 
counting similar marks and halving their sums. He had found it 
best to give different forms to the marks denoting neighboring powers, 
so as to avoid confusion of columns, and had combined two or more 
of them into one written figure for brevity of expression. About 
seventy combinations of various shapes had been tried, but very few 
of them found economical. In the best notation, however, the addi- 
tion required only three-fourths the time taken with the ordinary 
figures. Had the computer practised as many weeks with the new 
notation as years with the old, the difference would have been much 
more marked; as it was in fact when one unskilled in arithmetic, 
to whom the binary notation had just been taught, tried the two 
additions. The gain in accuracy, with this observer, was even 
3 


> 
4 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


more striking than the gain in speed. There could be very little 
doubt, therefore, that a fair degree of skill in arithmetic with a 
binary notation could be acquired by many to whom it is impossible 
under the present system. , 

The only practicable division of arcs and angles, and the most 
natural division of all things, is by continued bisections. This is 
shown by the ratio of value in our coins, weights, and capacity 
measures ; by any table of prices; and by the prevalent subdivision 
of lowest nominal units, as of the carpenter’s inch into eighths and 
sixteenths, and of percentages into quarters, etc., in stock quotations, 
where convenience of calculation by our present arithmetic seems 
almost gratuitously sacrificed. The American coinage is inconye- 
nient in practice, because of the awkward fractional ratio 22, which 
it introduces between successive pieces; and there would be the 
same difficulty in a decimal system of weights or of measures, should 
it be imposed upon us. We have thus another powerful reason for 
endeavoring to introduce a binary arithmetic. 

In the remarks which followed, Mr. E. B. E:uiorr expressed the 
hope that Congress would adopt the metric system of weights and 
measures for international purposes. It would be better to secure 
what advantage could be gained from uniformity and consistency, 
even though the basis of consistency was an arithmetic not ideally 
the best attainable. Such a course would not prevent, but might 
pave the way for a better arithmetic. 

Mr. W. B. Taytor said the world was losing so much by the 
employment of the denary arithmetic that he thought even a single 
generation might find economy in substituting the octonary. The 
introduction of decimal measures, while it would aid the computer, 
would injure the remainder of the community. The paper of Mr. 
Farquhar had an especial value, in that it proved the ability of 
binary systems to compete with the established system in rapidity 
of computation. 

Other remarks were made by Messrs. Harkness, Mussry, Pow- 
ELL, and GILBERT. 


The next communication was by Mr. 8. M. Burnert on 


REFRACTION IN THE PRINCIPAL MERIDIANS,OF A TRIAXIAL ELLIP- 
SOID; REGULAR ASTIGMATISM AND CYLINDRICAL LENSES ; 


and he was followed by Mr. W. Harkness on 


GENERAL MEETING. 5 
THE MONOCHROMATIC ABERRATION OF THE HUMAN EYE IN 
APHAKTIA. 


These two papers are complementary, and are published in the 
Archives of Ophthalmology, Vol. XII, No. 1. 


228TH MEETING. JANUARY 27, 1883. 
The President in the Chair. 
Thirty-seven members present. 
The Auditing Committee, appointed at the Annual Meeting, re- 
ported through its chairman, Mr. Antisell, that it had examined 


the accounts of the Treasurer for 1882, and found them correct. 
The report was accepted. 


The communication of the evening was by Mr. H. H. Bares on 


THE NATURE OF MATTER, 


and was discussed by Mr. W. B. Taytor and Mr. Powe tt. 
This paper is published in the Popular Science Monthly for 
April, 1883. 


229TH MEETING. FEBRUARY 10, 1883. 
The President in the Chair. 
Forty-two members and visitors present. 


It was announced that reports of the scientific proceedings would 
hereafter be furnished to Science. 

Mr. W. H. Datu announced that an opportunity would be 
afforded members to contribute to the Balfour Memorial Fund. 


A communication was then read by Mr. A. F. A. Kine on 


THE PREVENTION OF MALARIAL DISEASES, ILLUSTRATING, inter alia, 
THE CONSERVATIVE FUNCTION OF AGUE. 
[Abstract. ] 


The various theories thus far presented in explanation of the 


- 


6 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


phenomena of malaria were unsatisfactory and insusceptible of 
scientific demonstration. 

' According to the best medical authorities the most generally 
admitted facts upon which the present orthodox theory of malaria 
rests were as follows: 1. Malaria affects by preference low and 
moist localities. 2. It is almost never developed at a lower tem- 
perature than 60° F. 3. Its evolution or active agency is checked 
by a temperature of 32° F. 4. It is most abundant and most 
virulent as we approach the equator and the sea-coast. 5. It has 
an affinity for dense foliage, which has the power of accumu- 
lating it, when lying in the course of winds blowing from malarious 
localities. 6. Forests or even woods have the power of obstructing 
and preventing its transmission under these circumstances. 7. By 
atmospheric currents it is capable of being transported to consider- 
able distances—probably as far as five miles. 8. It may be devel- 
oped in previously healthy places by turning up of the soil, as in 
making excavations for the foundations of houses, tracks for rail- 
roads, and beds for canals. 9. In certain countries it seems to be 
attracted and absorbed by bodies of water lying in the course of 
such winds as waft it from the miasmatic source. 10. Experience 
alone can enable us to decide as to the presence or absence of 
malaria in any given locality. 11. In proportion as countries, 
previously malarious, are cleared up and thickly settled, periodical 
fevers disappear, in many instances to be replaced by typhoid 
fever (?) 12. Malaria usually keeps near the surface of the earth. 
It is said to “hug the ground,” or “love the ground.” 13. It is 
most dangerous when the sun is down, and seems almost inert 
during the day. 14. The danger of exposure after sunset is greatly 
increased by the person exposed sleeping in the night air. 15, Of 
all human races the white is most sensitive to marsh fevers, the 
black least so. 16. In malarial districts the use of fire, both in- 
doors and to those who sleep out, affords a comparative security 
against malarial disease. 17. The air of cities in some way renders 
the poison innocuous; for, though a malarial disease may be raging 
outside, it does not penetrate far into their interior. 18. Malarial 
diseases are most prevalent towards the latter part of summer and 
in the autumn. 19. Malaria is arrested not only by trees, but also 
by walls, fences, hills, rows of houses, canvas curtains, gauze veils, 
mosquito nets, and probably by fishing nets. 20. Malaria spares 
no age, but it affects infants much less frequently than adults. 


GENERAL MEETING. 7 


These generally admitted facts were insusceptible of scientific 
explanation by the marsh fever hypothesis of Lanscisci; but were 
capable of explanation by the theory that marsh fevers are pro. 
duced by the bites of proboscidian insects, notably in this and in 
some other countries by mosquito bites. 

A review of the natural history, habits, and geographical distri- 
bution of the mosquito was next presented in explanation of the 
twenty statements above quoted. 

In discussing statement 15, it was maintained that the compara- 
tive immunity of the black races was largely due to color, the dark 
complexion of the skin being another illustrative instance of “ pro- 
tective coloring ” so often observed in other animals, and by which, 
in this instance, the negro was protected from the sight, and conse- 
quently from the dite of the mosquito; a similar protection being 
further secured by the offensive odor and greasiness of his cutaneous 
secretions, aided by artificial inunction of the body with grease, 
paint, pitch, &c., which last probably constituted the initial step in 
the evolution of dress. Hence malarial melanosis was considered 
to be the designed natural termination of ague—its conservative 
function—destined to modify the individual by defensive adaptation 
against the mosquito, whose penetrating proboscis, like an inoculat- 
ing needle, infected the body with malarial poison, no matter 
whether this last was mosquital saliva, the Bacillus malarie of 
Klebs and Crudelli, or some other element as yet unknown. 

The spleen, whose function is not yet settled by physiologists, 
was regarded as the chief pigment-forming organ, and was designed 
for this purpose in the economy of the organism. Generally con- 
sidered a superfluous organ, capable of removal without any great 
interference with the functions of the organism, it was naturally 
designed to meet the emergency of variation in skin-color to secure 
“ protective coloring ” against fever-producing proboscidian insects, 
as before indicated. The natural process, however, required expo- 
sure of the naked body to the sun during the chill stage, in order 
to secure deposit of the newly formed pigment in the skin. Nature 
had not anticipated the artificial appendage of dress, and the organ- 
ism had not inherited from ancestral progenitors any provision for 
so unexpected an addition. Chills do not occur at night, but only 
between the rise and setting of the sun; sunlight during the chill 
stage being a necessary requirement, in order that nature’s design 
of cutaneous chromatogenesis may be consummated. Other racial 


8 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


differences between the whites and blacks—such as even cerebral 
capacity and variations in the skeleton—might be susceptible of 
explanation by blood changes resulting from malaria. The marrow 
of bones was also a pigment-forming tissue, and the aching of bones 
during ague, especially in so-called “ break-bone” fever, suggested 
congestion and modified nutrition in the osseous structures, such as 
might eventually lead to modification in the skeleton. The inhabi- 
tants of oriental countries especially were more vigorous and intel- 
ligent if they lived in elevated regions, than were others inhabiting 
mosquito-infected lowlands and sea coasts. 

In further support of the mosquital origin of malarial fevers 
numerous noted medical authorities were cited, showing that, in 
all parts of the world where these diseases prevail, immunity was 
secured by protecting the body from mosquito bites. The geo- 
graphical distribution and seasonal evolution of mosquitoes and 
other proboscidian insects were shown partially to agree with the 
times and places in which malarial diseases prevail; though from 
lack of information conclusive evidence on this point was yet 
wanting. There was, however, a general admission on the part of 
medical authorities that swarms of these insects in almost any 
locality were a pretty sure sign of malignancy. 

On the other hand numerous instances were adduced from “ Nar- 
ratives”’ and “ Travels” in which the bodies of persons had been 
covered with pustules, “ resembling small-pox,” from mosquito bites 
without any subsequent occurrence of fever having been recorded 
by the narrating authors. 

This opposing evidence was inconclusive, (1) because the authors 
cited were not in search of medical information; (2) because the 
period of incubation, being often long and uncertain, fever may 
have occurred after the mosquito bites had been forgotten; (3) 
the insect proboscis (like a vaccine lancet unarmed with virus) 
might be uncontaminated with fever poison, or fever germs; and 
(A) successful inoculations of specific germ poisons are not usually 
followed by immediate local suppuration at the point of puncture, 
but only after a certain period of incubation, the immediate local 
inflammation being rather preventive of subsequent blood infection. 

The possible spread of yellow-fever contagion by the inoculating 
proboscis of the mosquito carrying infecting matter drawn from 
the blood of yellow-fever patients to unaffected persons was sug- 
gested. In epidemics, the spread of the disease stopped as soon as 
a freezing temperature paralyzed the mosquito, &c. 


~ 


GENERAL MEETING. 9 


The spread of spotted-fever, typhus-fever, in jails, ships, &c., was 
referred to the inoculating instrument of ‘fleas, &c.—these insects 
usually prevailing among filthy people thickly crowded together. 

That malarial diseases were ever produced solely by the inhala- 
tion of supposed poisonous vapors was held to be untenable. Ex- 
perimenters, who had demonstrated the existence of specific poisons 
for special fevers, had equally proven that the mode by which such 
poisons, when obtained, could be introduced into the body for the 
artificial production of disease, was by inoculation through the skin, 
These experiments were imitations of insect inoculation. The pro- 
boscis of the mosquito was Nature’s inoculating needle. 

The modus operandi of the eucalyptus tree in preventing malarial 
diseases was ascribed tentatively to the tree being destruetive to, or 
interfering directly or indirectly with, the propagation and develop- 
ment of mosquitoes. 

From the foregoing conceptions as to the origin of malarial dis- 
ease, the following prophylactic measures were deducible: 


1st. Personal protection from all winged insects, especially during 
evening and night, by gauze curtains, veils, window-blinds, or 
clothing impenetrable by the proboscis of inoculating insects; and 
further, personal protection both from these and all creeping insects, 
especially during epidemics, endemics, and in crowded jails, ships, 
&c., by daily inunction of the whole body with some terebinthinate, 
camphorated, or eucalyptalized ointment or liniment. 


2d. Domiciliary protection (a) exteriorly, by screens of trees, walls, 
fences, &c., interposed at some distance between dwellings and the 
supposed sources of malaria, or mosquito nurseries ; and with fires 
or lamps arranged as traps for the attraction and destruction of 
such winged insects as may encroach nearer. A further protection 
(6) in the interior of dwellings being secured by the use of smoke 
(as of tobacco or prethrum) or of some volatile aromatic substance, 
as of camphor, assafcetida, garlic, &c., which may be offensive to 
proboscidian intruders. 


3. Municipal protection by groves of trees (pines, cedars, or eucal- 
yptus) planted between cities and the sources of malaria and mos- 
quitoes, together with cordons of electric or other lights, between 
said grove and the marsh, the lights to be arranged as fly-traps for 
the retention and destruction of such winged insects as may be thus 


secured. 
5 


> 
10 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON, 


With relation to the city of Washington, it was suggested that 
the Washington monument would afford a good opportunity (by 
placing illuminated fly-traps at different elevations on its exterior) 
for ascertaining the height at which mosquitoes fly, or are brought 
by the wind from the adjacent Potomac flats. The proposed re- 
clamation of the flats could scarcely do more than mitigate malarial 
disease, so long as our summer and autumn southern breezes come, 
laden with mosquitoes, from the miles of unreclaimed swamps 
farther down the river, as at Four-mile Run and other nearer local- 
ities. 

Mr. Bruuincs remarked that, since ague did not invariably 
result from insect bites, the most that could be claimed was that 
they accomplished an accidental inoculation with malarial poison. 

The subject was also discussed by Messrs. DoouirrLe, ToNER, 
and ANTISELL. 


The meeting closed with an exhibition by Mr. C. E. Durron of 
a series of oil paintings illustrative of the Hawaiian Islands. 


230TH MEETING. Fresruary 24, 1883. 
Vice-President Briiines in the Chair. 
Thirty members and visitors present. 


The Chair announced the election of Mr. Taomas RussELtL to 
membership. 


The first communication was by Mr. G. K. GitBErt on 


THE RESPONSE OF TERRESTRIAL CLIMATE TO SECULAR VARIATIONS 
IN SOLAR RADIATION. 


[ Abstract. ] 


Secular variations of climate may theoretically be catised (1) by 
the internal heat of the earth and (2) by changes in the constitu- 
tion or volume of the atmosphere. They have unquestionably been 
wrought (3) by changes in the limits and configuration of ocean 
bottoms and land surfaces, (4) by changes in the movements of the 
earth with reference to celestial bodies, and (5) by variations of 


GENERAL MEETING. ng 


solar radiation. Attention will here be restricted to the last-men- 
tioned cause. 

An augmentation of the strength of solar radiation (a) will cause 
a general rise in the temperature of the atmosphere, (0) will heighten 
the contrast between warm and cold regions, thereby stimulating 
oceanic and atmospheric circulation, and (ce) will heighten the con- 
trast between wet and dry regions, making the wet wetter and the 
dry drier. (d) It will also diminish glaciation. This has been dis- 
puted by some writers, but is sustained by a quantitative discussion. 
A computation, based on the annual curves of precipitation and tem- 
perature at St. Bernard, close to the glaciers of the Alps, shows that 
a general rise in the temperature of the air, while it will increase the 
total precipitation, will slightly diminish the snow-fall ; that it will 
very greatly increase the rate of melting. The ratio of snow-fall 
to evaporation is reduced one-half by 6° C rise of temperature ; 
the ratio of snow-fall to melting is reduced one-half by a rise of 
13°; and, assuming that evaporation actually dissipates twice as 
much snow as does melting, the ratio of snow-fall to snow dissipa- 
tion (or the tendency to glaciation) is reduced one-half by 42° rise 
of temperature.* 

(e) Increase of solar radiation will also, through its general 
effects, influence the distribution of winds, and thus produce sec- 
ondary effects of a local nature. 

Mr. Dawu remarked that ice was rendered more plastic and 
fluent by the presence of water; so that the movement of ice and 
the consequent. extent of glaciers are favored by rain. If Mr. 
Gilbert by the term “ glaciation” referred to the extent of glaciers, 
some limitation of his conclusions might be necessary. 

Other remarks were made by Messrs. ANTISELL, DooxiTrLe, H. 
FarquuHar, and Exv.iort. 


The next communication was by Mr. J. W. CHIcKERING on 
THE THERMAL BELTS OF NORTH CAROLINA. 
[ Abstract. ] 


In the agricultural volume of the Patent Office Report for 1861 
is an article written by Mr. Silas McDowell, of Franklin, Macon 
county, N. C., bearing this title. He was a man of much intelli- 


* The computation is given in full in “ Science’’ for March 16, 1883. 


19 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


gence, an enthusiastic student in geology and botany, a companion 
and guide of several botanists in their early explorations of the 
southern Appalachians, and a farmer by profession. He died in 
1882, at the ripe old age of 87. 

He states that in the valley of the Little Tennessee river, in 
Macon county, lying about 2,000 feet above tide water, when the 
thermometer in the morning indicates a temperature of about 26°, 
the frost line extends about 300 feet in vertical height, but that then 
comes a belt extending about 400 feet in vertical height up the 
mountain side, within which no frost is seen, delicate plants remain- 
ing untouched. Above this, frost again appears. So sharp is the 
dividing line that sometimes one-half of a shrub may be frost 
killed, while the other half is unaffected. 

A small river, having its source in a high plateau 1,900 feet above 
this, runs down into this valley, breaking through three mountain 
barriers, and consequently making three short valleys, including 
the plateau, rising one above the other, each of which has its own 
vernal zone, traversing the hillsides that enclose it, and each 
beginning at a lesser elevation above the valley, as the valleys 
mount higher in the atmosphere, so that around the plateau, a 
beautiful level height, containing 6,000 acres of land, aud lying 
3,900 feet above tide water, the lower edge of the thermal belt is 
not more than 100 feet above the common level of the plateau. 

Not only does vegetation within this zone remain untouched by 
frost, so that the Isabella, the most tender of all the native grapes, 
has not failed to produce abundant crops in twenty-six consecutive 
years, but mildew, blight, and rust, which often attack vines in the 
lower valleys, are here unknown, while the same purity and dry- 
ness of the air which favor the grape, make this a refuge for the 
consumptive, as diseases of the lungs have never been known to 
originate among the inhabitants. 

Mr. McDowell adds: “The thermal belt must exist in all coun- 
tries that are traversed by high mountains and deep valleys, and 
the only reason why its visible manifestations are peculiar to our 
southern Alleghanies, is the fact that their precocious spring vegeta- 
tion is sometimes killed by frost, while the same thing does not 
happen in the mountains further north.” 

These statements are corroborated by similar testimony respect- 
ing another such belt along the Tryon mountain range in Polk 
county, N. C.; the specific claim being that such a belt is found 


GENERAL MEETING. eo 


for eight miles in length, extending from 1,200 feet to 2,200 feet 
above tide water, within which the leaves of plants, shrubs, and 
flowers remain untouched by frost until the latter part of Decem- 
ber, and after a snow storm not a particle of snow remains within 
the belt, while the tops and sides of the mountains above and the 
valleys below will be covered. 

The verification of these alleged facts would be matters of interest 
in their economical and sanitary aspects, and would supply data 
for some interesting researches respecting the nocturnal stratifica- 
tion of the atmosphere. 

It is earnestly to be hoped that at some time we may have reli- 
able and continuous thermometrical observations at these and simi- 
lar stations, to determine the existence, extent, and temperature of 
such belts. 

Remarks were made on this communication by Mr. ALvorD. 


Mr. C. E. Dutron then made a communication on the 


GEOLOGY OF THE HAWAIIAN ISLANDS. 


[ Abstract. ] 


On the slopes of Mauna Loa are sea beaches, terraces, coral 
sands, and other evidences of shore action at various levels. The 
highest that can be positively announced has an altitude of 2,800 
feet above the ocean. It can be traced a large part of the way 
around the island, being discernible even when covered by more 
recent lava. It does not now lie horizontal, but descends from 
2,800 to 400 feet, while on the adjoining island, Maui, there is 
evidence of submergence. On the farther (western) side of Maui, 
and on other islands beyond, there is again evidence of upheaval. 

All the lavas of the islands are basaltic. Those of Mauna Loa 
and Kilauea are abnormally basic and are related to certain lavas 
of New Zealand, called by Mr. Judd “ ultra-basalts.” ‘The New 
Zealand rock consists chiefly of olivine; that of Mauna Loa is 
sometimes more than half olivine, and contains much magnetite 
and hematite. A Greenland lava, classed also as ultra-basalt, 
contains the only known native iron of telluric origin. As this 
suggests the iron meteorites, so the basalts of New Zealand and 
Mauna Loa suggest the stony meteorites. 

The volume of the eruptions of Mauna Loa is enormous; that of 
1855 would nearly build Vesuvius, and two of prehistoric date 


> 
14 PHILUSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


were greater still. The lava has a high liquidity and flows forty 
to fifty-five miles, spreading at the base of the cone into a broad 
sheet. There are no explosive phenomena and no fragmental pro- 
ducts. The slope of the mountain is 4° along the major and 7° 
along the minor axis. Kilauea has a few cinder cones on its flanks. 
-Mauna Kea consists chiefly of them, and has an average slope of 
#4° 011°. 

Kilauea is always active, maintaining lakes of liquid fire.’ Over 
one of these a crust is formed, black, but flexible, which after a 
while breaks up and suddenly sinks, the process being repeated at 
intervals of 14 to 2+ hours. The great interior pit described by 
observers from 1823 to 1841 is now filled. 

Mauna Loa is not active more than one-third or one-fourth of 
the time, but compensates by the magnificence of its phenomena. 
Great fountains of lava are projected hundreds of feet into the air. 

Mr. Dutton’s communication was interrupted by the arrival of 
the hour for adjournment. In response to a question by Mr. Tay- 
LOR, he stated that the crust over a lava lake acquired a thickness 
of five or six inches before breaking up. 

Mr. ANTISELL inquired whether there is any basalt on the 
islands, and Mr. Dutton explained that they are composed exclu- 
sively of that material. 


231st MEETING. Marcx 10, 1883, 
Vice-President WELLING in the Chair. 


Thirty-four members and visitors present. 


The Chair announced that Messrs. ALBERT WILLIAMS, Jr., 
JoHn Henry ReEnNsHAWE, and Henry Francis Wauuine had 
been elected to membership. 

Mr. M. H. Doo.irt_e read a communication on 

SUBSTANCE, MATTER, MOTION, AND FORCE, 
which was discussed by Messrs. W. B. Tayitor, Evtiorr, HarK- 
NEss, and WELLING. 


Mr. E. B. ELLIoTr then communicated 


GENERAL MEETING. 15 
FORMULAS FOR THE COMPUTATION OF EASTER. 


In the calendar the vernal equinox is considered as invariably 
occurring on the 21st of March. 

The Paschal full moon is the full moon which (according to the 
calendar) occurs on or first after the 21st of March. 

Easter Sunday in any year is the first Sunday which occurs after 
the Paschal full moon; that is, first after the full moon which, 
according to the calendar, occurs on or first after March 21st. 


To find the date of Easter Sunday for any year, A. D., New Style. 
Let ¢ denote the complete hundreds of years in the number de- 
noting any year, and y the number of remaining years. Thus in 
the year 1883, c = 18 and y = 83, the number for the entire year, 
18838, being denoted by 100 ¢ + y. 
In the following formulas w, as a subscript after a division, de- 
notes that only the whole number of the quotient is to be retained, 
and r,as a subscript, denotes that only the remainder after the 


division. is to be retained; thus( 7) =4: and (=) we 
4 Ww 4 r 


nm (the golden number Jess one) 


= (8), = Ct), = C9, = GYD, 


=n LCs), + (i), J, 


This number (7) pertains to a lunar cycle of 19 years. 


8 
a” = (4) 
s=é—8— (4) -(‘# 25 Ww 
iy 3 Ww 
Inspection of the formula for s will show that, for any year from 
1700 A. D. New Style to 1899 A. D., both inclusive, the value of 
sis zero (0). For any year Old Style the value of s is the con- 
stant number 22. - 
23 
q= (a ma = =) ; also, 
r 
23 +s—11 *) 


I 
Pa 
WwW 
= 


> 
16 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The value of A may be shown to be zero (0) for any year from 
1700 A. D. to 1899 A. D., both inclusive, during New Style, and 
for all years during Old Style. 

p =q—h=the interval in days from March 21st to the date 
of the Paschal full moon, or the number of days to be added to 
March 21st to find the date of the Paschal full moon. 

If p = zero (0), the Paschal full moon accordingly falls on the 
21st of March. 


n—(1+2(5),-1-(G),+ Go). ) 


ZL denotes the number (in alphabetical order) of the Dominical 
or Sunday letter. Thus, the number corresponding to the Domini- 
cal letter A is 1, to B is 2, to C is 3, to D is 4, to E is 5, to F is 6, 
and to G is 7 or 0 (zero). 


c ; ; , 
The term (a5) gives a correction to the Gregorian value when 
Ww 


the year exceeds 4000 A. D.; for any year less than 4000 the 
value of this corrective term is obviously zero (0). 


(? ae rime 3+6p+L 
a ee 
7 r 7 r 
t denotes the number of days which elapse after the date of the 
Paschal full moon to the date of Easter Sunday. 
Easter Sunday = March (21 +1+p+#—1) 
= March (21 + p + 2) 
== April (p+t— 10) 


To find the date of Easter Sunday for any year, A. D., Old Style. 
aif Feat c.f 100g = 2) 
eae ( ie a9 ( r 


19 19 
The formula for n is the same as in New Style. 


(Gee ae = (ets (ae 
q=p= 2 ), =), = 


Ee Gascon 5 
7 ys 


pain (C=HEY), = (EYP) 


rE 


GENERAL MEETING. 17 
Faster Sunday = March (21 +1+p+t—1) 


= March (21+ p-+ 2) 
= April (p+t—10) ° 


Exampte 1.—Required the day of the month on which Easter Sunday 
falls in the year 1883 A. D., New Style. 


( a “) = (73), i, (45), 


(=) J dter = 1: 5 (5) Eonar 25 
r 1 


19 19 
exes, 
197, 19 oe 
n=—5+7=2 
20 n = 40 


19» = 20n—n= 88 


ae et == die 


3 


=10-4—(=;~) =10-4-6=0 
23+8s+19n (23 + 0+ 38 
q= ( jhe ea 


30 = 30 | 
ie (35), + i9—1 (), (),=0+28x0x0=0+40=0 


p=q—h=1—-0=1 


2G), aoa (a). ) 


ny 


( 


= (a) _ Ge 84) a0 


‘Easter Sunday = March (21+1+p+t—1) 
= March (22 + 1 + 2) 
= March 25 


18 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Examp_e 2.—Required the date of Easter Sunday for the year 1884 
A. D., New Style. 


20 n = 60 
20 —n=19n =)57 
a 
ie 23+0+57\ | 
a= ( 30 ), =20 
20 20 3 
n= (5), —™ (38), (7a), 


=0+9x0x0=0+4+0=0 
p=q—h=20—0=—20 


z—( 1+? Cie ae: (a). ) 


it 
SS 
fe 704-5 a 35 Ms: 

im1- (74>) = (4°), =2 
Easter Sunday = March (21 + 1+ 20 + 2) 

= March 44 

= April (44 — 31) 

= April 13 


EXAMPLE 3.—Required date of Easter Sunday for the year 3966 
A. D., New Style. 


39 | 66 
2x 19 = 38] 57 = 3x19 : 
ile 
Bey _ (SX1+9 
n= ( 19 Ha 19 ) =u 
20 n = 280 


19 n = 20n — n= 266 


GENERAL MEETING. 19 


Peco ase (=) - ( Pe ae (“3 J.) 


3 


= s1—9—(">*) Sage oo 13 19 
Ww 


at (tet =") = (2+ = “\ = 28 


28 ee ER 14 
=h (55), + 2 — 28 (55), cae 


=04+1x*1x1=04+1=1 
p=q—h=28—-1=27 


z-(1+2(@), "= (9). @).) 


7 
14+2x38—3—2+0 
3—pt+L 3—27+2 
Easter Sunday = March (21 + 1 + 27 + 6) 
= March 55 


= April (55 — 31 =) 24 


EXAMPLE 4.—Required the date of the Paschal full moon (March 
21+ p), and the date of Easter Sunday (March 21 + p +t or 
March 21 + 1+ p+ (¢—1) for the year 2152 A. D., New Style. 


2152 ; 
(Fx), =5=" 
Poe 95 
<— a 
23= 23 


—— 


19+ s+ 23 = 119 


r= (M*%) = (9) ao 


h=1+0X0X0= 1 
p= q—h= 28 


> 
20 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Paschal full moon = March (21 + 28 =) 49 
== April (49 — 31 =) 18 


Le -( +2(3), is ae (a). ) 


= 


= (2H ¢=I= 8) G2) ot 


7 
ESE eh (——') | 
ir 
Easter Sunday = March (21 -+1-+ 28+4 =) 54 
= April (64 — 31 =) 23 


The Julian or Old Style Calendar was established by the Council 
of Nice A. D. 325; the first year of the Gregorian or reformed 
calendar was A. D. 1582, and the first year in which the reformed 
calendar was adopted in England was A. D. 1752. 

In Russia, and in other countries where the religion of the Greek 
Church now obtains, the New Style of reckoning has not been 
adopted, but the Old Style is still in force. 

In Alaska, Old Style was employed until after the cession of that 
country by Russia to the United States in the year 1869. 


EXAMPLE 5.—Find the date of Easter Sunday for the year 1582 
A. D., Old Style. 


15 |\ 682 
5 +15 | =75 
90—1) 157.° @ 

101 

“AT +7=24=19+45 

m= 5 

19n = (20—1)n=100—5 = 95 =3 %30 +5 
_ (19m4+15) (5415) _ - 
a= ( ee el 30), = 20 


p-(4e =) 


x 


(H=7=*) = = (77) =0 


GENERAL MEETING. 21 


2 
Easter Sunday = March (22 + 20+ 4=) 46 
== April (46 — 31 =) 15 


232p MEETING. Marca 24, 1883. 


Vice-President WELLING in the Chair. 


Forty-three members and visitors present. 


The first communication was by Mr. J. R. Eastman on 


THE FLORIDA EXPEDITION FOR OBSERVATION OF THE TRANSIT 
OF VENUS. 


[ Abstract. ] 


The observing station of the Florida expedition was upon Way 
Key, the largest of the group of islands known as Cedar Keys. 

The principal instruments employed were a portable transit, a 
five-inch equatorial telescope, and a photoheliograph. The first 
two require no description. The photoheliograph consisted of an 
objective of five inches aperture and about forty feet focus, a helio- 
stat for throwing the sun’s rays on the objective, and a plate holder 
at the focus of the objective. The accessory apparatus consisted 
of a measuring rod, permanently mounted, for accurately measuring 
the distance from the objective to the photograph plate; a movable 
slide with a slit of adjustable width, for exposing the plates; and a - 
circuit connecting with a chronograph, so arranged that when the 
exposing slide was moved to expose the plate, and when the center 
of the slit was opposite the center of the plate-holder, the circuit 
was broken and the record made on the chronograph. A black 
disk was painted on one side of the slide, and so placed that when 
the slide was at rest at one end of its course and the image of the 
sun was adjusted concentric with this disk, it would fall on the 
center of the plate-holder when the slide was moved. The adjust- 
ments having been completed the exposing of the plates was a sim- 
ple matter. The image of the sun was thrown by the heliostat 
upon the black disk and centered, the sensitive plate was fixed in 


> 
22 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


the plate-holder, the operator moved the exposing slide, and the 
time of exposure was recorded on the chronograph. 

For observing contacts I used an eye piece, magnifying 216 diam- 
eters, attached to a Herschel solar prism, and a sliding shade-glass 
with a density varying uniformly from end to end. The time of 
my signals was taken by assistant astronomer Lieut. J. A. Norris, 
U.S. N., from a chronometer; while, with an observing key, I also 
made a record on the chronograph as a check. 

About 40 seconds before the computed time of first contact a 
narrow stratus cloud passed on to the southeastern edge of the sun 
and shut out all the light. The cloud remained about 3 minutes, 
and when it passed off, the notch in the sun’s limb was plainly 
marked. Two photographs were taken to test the apparatus and 
the plates, and then the time before second contact was devoted to 
an examination of the limbs of Venus and the sun. Both were 
perfectly steady. In observations of the sun for the last twenty 
years I never saw it better. At about 13 minutes after first contact 
the outline of the entire disk of Venus could be seen, and seemed 
perfectly circular. About 2 minutes later a faint, thin rim of 
yellowish light appeared around the limb yet outside the sun. This 
rim was at first broadest near the sun’s limb, but soon the width of 
the light became uniform throughout. The light was wholly ex- 
terior to the limb of Venus; that is, the black limb of Venus on 
the sun and the dark limb outside formed a perfectly circular disk, 
with the rim of light or halo, outside the portion off the sun. As 
the time of second contact approached, Lieutenant Norris again 
took up his station at the chronometer. As the limbs neared geo- 
metrical contact, the cusps of sunlight began to close around Venus 
more rapidly; and the perfect definition of the limbs and the steady, 
deliberate, but uniformly increasing motion of the cusps, convinced 
me instantly that the phenomena attending the contact would be 
far more simple than I had ever imagined. I had only to look 
steadily to see the cusps steadily but rapidly extend themselves into 
the thinnest visible thread of light around the following limb of 
Venus and remain there without a tremor or pulsatiom At the 
moment the cusps joined I gave the signal and also made the 
record on the chronograph. Still keeping my eye at the telescope, 
I saw nothing to note save the gradually increasing line of light 
between the limbs of the two bodies. The disk of Venus on the 
sun was black. 


GENERAL MEETING. 23 


A re-examination was then made of all the photographic appara- 
tus, and about 10 minutes after the second contact the principal 
photographic work was commenced; and this was continued with 
slight interruption until about 10 minutes before third contact ; 
150 dry plates and 30 wet ones being exposed. One of the inter- 
ruptions was for the purpose of making measurements of the 
diameter of Venus, which was done with a double-image micrometer 
attached to the 5-inch telescope. ; 

On going to the telescope to observe the last contacts, I found the 
limbs of Venus and the sun as steady as in the morning, and though 
there was now some haze over the sun it did no harm. The third 
contact was observed with great accuracy, nothing occurring to 
obstruct or complicate the very simple and definite phenomena, 
which were in the reverse order of those seen at second contact. 
The rim of light appeared around Venus as soon as the limb was 
visible beyond the sun, and was seen for nearly 10 minutes. The 
complete outline of Venus was visible for 2 minutes longer. No 
phenomena worthy of note were seen between third and fourth con- 
tacts. The lapping of the limb of Venus over that of the sun 
gradually but steadily decreased until the final separation, which 
was observed with great accuracy for such a phenomenon. Soon 
after the last contact the entire apparatus was again carefully 
examined and the necessary observations made to determine the 
errors of the chronometers. 

In the observations of interior contacts there was no trace of any 
tremor or fluctuation of the light in the cusps as they closed around 
the limb of Venus; and it is almost needless to say that there was 
no trace of a shadow or a black drop or ligament between the 
limbs at second and third contacts. The probable error for the 
second and third contacts was estimated at 0”.3; for fourth con- 
tact, 0’.5. 

Observers of transits of Venus and Mercury have written so 
much in regard to the obstacles encountered from the apparition of 
the shadow, or black drop, between the limbs of the two bodies at 
second and third contacts, and so full has been the testimony in 
favor of the existence and the almost necessary occurrence of this 
phenomenon, that at the transit of Mercury, in 1878, many ob- 
servers claimed, as evidence of their skill, that they did see it; 
while others, less fortunate, apologized for not seeing it. Observers 
of the black drop were so generally confined to those with imperfect 


> 
24 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


apparatus or to those unaccustomed to observation of the sun’s 
limb or disk that the true nature of the obstacle was pretty well 
understood before it was carefully investigated. It is now quite 
well settled that the “black drop” is due to bad eyes, imperfect 
apparatus, or the inexperience of the observer. With good eyes 
and proper apparatus a good observer never should see the black 
drop. When it is seen there is something wrong; it is a spurious 
phenomenon. 


_ One of the negatives was exhibited to the Society. 


In reply to a question by Mr. E. J. Farquaar, Mr. Eastman 
said the halo about Venus was believed to be due to the atmosphere 
of the planet. 


The next communication was by Mr. CLEVELAND ABBE on 


DETERMINING THE TEMPERATURE OF THE AIR. 


He stated that the question now to be considered is not where to 
place a thermometer so as to obtain the temperature most proper 
for the use of the meteorologist, but is rather the purely physical 
question of how to determine the temperature of the air at any 
given location. He described the methods and defects of the for- 
mer and present meteorological methods of exposure, viz: (1) Ther- 
mometers hung in the open air. (2) Those’ placed in shady loca- 
tions. (3) The Glaisher screen. (4) The Stevenson screen and 
the double louvre screens in general. (5) The double metallié cylin- 
drical shelters of Jelinek and Wild. (6) The silver thimble screen 
of Regnault. (7) The whirling thermometer of Saussure, Arago, 
Bravais, and the French observers (exhibiting Babinet’s arrange- 
ment as made by Casella.) (8) Joule’s method, depending on a 
balance in the temperature and density of two columns of the air. 

He then gave a description of the method devised by him in 
1865 and used for a short time at Poulkova; this consisted in con- 
structing a very perfect louvre screen, within which were established 
black bulb and bright or silvered bulb thermometers having very 
diverse coefficients of radiation and conduction. These thermom- 
eters were in air, not in vacuo, as this latter arrangement was proper 
only for the determination of the direct solar radiation, as in the 
Arago-Davy method, whereas in the present case the temperature 
of the air and the radiation from terrestrial objects were the special 
objects of study. 


GENERAL MEETING. 25 


The air temperature (t,) was found from the indications of the 

bright and black bulbs (t, and t,) by the empirical formula 
t= t, + C (tr —t) 

where C is a small coefficient, to be determined experimentally, 
and is nearly constant. This arrangement of bright and black 
bulbs can be used by meteorologists and physicists without a 
screen, and even in the sunlight, if the theory of the action of the 
bright and black bulbs is perfectly understood. A similar for- 
mula will give the temperature (T) of a single radiating body whose 
effect is equal to the total effect that is shown by the black bulb: 


T=t,+C (,—t..) 

He then stated that the theoretical basis of this method has quite 
recently been further elucidated by Professor Ferrel, who has shown 
that the approximate nature of the relation between the above con- 
stant C, the radiating, absorbing, and conducting powers of the 

_thermometers, and the velocity of the wind is given by the following 
equation : 


Br, 
1+ = pr 
B’/+B 
ae eT y 
p Dea 
1 


where r, and r, are the radiating (and absorbing) powers of the 
blackened and silvered bulbs, respectively, v is the velocity of the 
wind or currents flowing past the bulbs, and B B’ B” are constant 
coefficients depending on the size, conductivity, and specific heat 
of the substance of the bulbs. 

In reply to a question of Mr. GiLBert, he stated that the differ- 
ence between the bright and black bulbs had rarely exceeded a 
few tenths of a degree in the delicate shelter made of oiled paper, 
as used by him at Poulkova, the maximum occurring February 22, 
1866, at 10 a. m., when, the louvre box being in the full sunshine, 
the bright bulb was at 14°.9 Cent. and the black bulb at 14°.3, 
showing that the latter had been slightly warmed by the warm sides 
of the box. 

In reply to a question of Mr. Harxness, the author explained, 
that although it was conducive to accuracy that these thermometers 
should be placed within a shelter, yet this was not necessary; if 


we take advantage of the more accurate method of determining 
6 


~ 
26 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


the co-efficient constant C, as given by Prof. Ferrel’s theory, 
the two thermometers placed anywhere within doors or without 
would still give data for determining temperatures of the loca- 
tion; it should be borne in mind that the temperature thus ob- 
tained belongs specifically to the air in contact with the themome- 
ters and is not an average value for any extensive portion of the 
atmosphere. As it is an advantage to conduct observations under 
uniform conditions, it is recommended that a pair of bright and 
black bulb thermometers be attached to the whirling table, whereby 
the effect of a current of air may be on the one hand determined 
and on the other hand kept as ‘uniform as possible. 

Mr. Harxness said that the object practically sought by meteo- 
rologists was to learn the average temperature of a considerable 
body of air, but their efforts were thwarted by the irregularity and 
inconstancy of the distribution of temperature. So long as the air 
in contact with the thermometer is not precisely representative of 
the air of the vicinage it was useless to refine methods of observa- 
tion, unless by that refinement errors of a constant nature were 
eliminated. For the determination of mean monthly or annual 
temperatures he considered the reading of the nearest half degree 
as sufficient, and regarded the reading of the tenths of a degree as 
a useless refinement. . 

The advantage of reading to tenths was further discussed by 
Messrs. ABBE, DooxirrLeE, and Kummetyt. Mr. KumMMeE.y 
pointed out that where a difference of temperature is observed as 
an indication of the moisture of the air, the tenths are worthy of 
record. 


The following communication by Prof. Coartes E. Munrog, 
of Annapolis, Md., was then read by the Secretary : 


DETERMINATION OF THE SPECIFIC GRAVITY OF SOLIDS BY THE 
COMMON HYDROMETER. 


Having occasion some time since to devise methods for the ex- 
amination of coal on board ship, I was obliged, as my first con- 
sideration, to work with such materials and apparatus as are usually 
found in ships’ stores, and then to arrange the methods so that they 
could be used under the restricted conditions which prevail. The 
unsteadiness of the ship makes balance methods for the determina- 
tion of specific gravities difficult, even when a suitable balance is at 


GENERAL MEETING. 27 


hand, while hydrometers may be steadied so that the instrument 
may be read with a reasonable degree of precision, as is shown in 
its constant use in the determination of the degree of saturation of 
the water in the steam-boiler, and in other instances. 

To use the hydrometer for the determination’ of the specific 
gravities of solids I take advantage of the fact that, when a body 
floats in a liquid in which it is wholly immersed, the specific gravi- 
ties of the liquid and the solid are the same, and we have simply to 
determine the value for one of them. 

The process is carried out by taking a dense solution, dropping 
in it the solid to be determined, (which must be light enough to 
float on the surface,) and then diluting slowly with water until the 
solid floats immersed, stirring the mixture constantly. The solid 
is now removed and the hydrometer inserted and read. For the 
determination of the specific gravities of the bituminous coals and 
lignites a thick solution of cane sugar was used, while for the 
heavier anthracite concentrated sulphuric acid, diluted with dilute 
sulphuric acid, was employed. The increase in temperature in the 
latter case causes no appreciable error if the reading is quickly 
taken. The following results were obtained by the method des- 
cribed, the specific gravity of each specimen having first been de- 
termined by Jolly’s balance: 


By Jolly’s balance. By mixture. 


PTI LOLA CLE Mots sure eee eS 1.5640 1,560 
Bituminous ‘coal’ 22 bs 2 pat eureh 1,3008 1,310 
Bituminous) coals sxe) (yee woes 153000 1,300 
(AIS (CIDE ne SIS oa AE ne 1,2790 1,285 
Canney coala@ipniform) 222-2 ==. 22 b 1,1550 1,155 
Cannelicoali acest eee ie el a 1,1292 1,120 
VRSp SES) Leela — 1,0909 1,090 


Mr. Durron remarked that the same principle had recently been 
successfully applied to the separation of the component minerals of 
crystalline rocks. A sample is powdered and then placed in a very 
heavy liquid (a solution of mercuric iodide and potassium iodide), 
the density of which is gradually diminished, until the particles of 
the heaviest mineral sink to the bottom. A repetition of the process 
eliminates each mineral in turn. 


28 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 
233p MEETING. ApRIL 7, 1883. 
Mr. Wa. H. Datu in the Chair. 


Thirty-six members and visitors present. 


The Chair announced that Messrs. EnwARD SANDFORD BURGESS 
and SUMNER Homer BoprisH had been elected members. 


The General Committee reported to the Society that “a Mathe- 
matical Section had been organized by the election of Mr. AsaPH 
HA. as Chairman and Mr. Henry Farquuar as Secretary. All 
members of the Society who are interested in mathematics are in- 
vited to attend and take part in its meetings, announcements of 
which will be sent to those who notify the Secretary of a desire for 
them.” 


The first communication was by Prof. W. C. Kerr on 


THE GEOLOGY OF HATTERAS AND THE NEIGHBORING COAST. 
[ Abstract. ] 


The notable projection of Hatteras, beyond the general line of 
trend of the Atlantic coast, has, of course, a geological origin. 
The study of the changes now taking place, and of the phenomena 
which have left their recent traces on the surface, readily furnish 
the data for the solution of the problem. Nearly one-half of this 
eastern inter-sound region of North Carolina is water surface, and 
the land surface lies for the most part below ten feet (much of it 
below five.) 

A large part of this low-lying surface is covered with beds of 
peat, which thicken towards the centre on the divides or swells be- 
tween the bays and sounds, rising, in some cases, to ten and fifteen 
feet, and in the Dismal Swamp on the northern border of the State 
to twenty-two feet. These beds of peat are in process of forming 
by the decay of plants growing on the surface, chiefly cypress and 
juniper. Many tiers of the undecayed logs of these timbers are 
piled upon one another through the whole thickness of the deposit, 
which is soft and yielding, so that a fence-rail may be thrust down 
beyond its length. Vast tracts of such peat swamps (and of marsh 
and savanna on which only water grasses and small shrubs and 
scrub pines grow and decay) are found throughout this coast region. 
Here we have the first stage in the formation of a coal bed. Another 
notable fact is that many of the rivers which empty into the sounds 


GENERAL MEETING. 29 


increase in depth of channel at a distance from their mouths; 
while the sounds are 12 to 15 and 20 to 22 feet deep, the rivers are 
often 30 and 40 feet and upwards. This can only be accounted for 
by supposing a subsidence of the region to be in progress, the 
sounds and open bays being silted up by the deposits brought down 
by the floods of the Roanoake and other large rivers, while no 
particle of sediment can reach the sheltered depths of the narrow 
windings of the upper reaches of these minor streams. This theory 
of subsidence is abundantly confirmed by the disappearance under 
water of large tracts of swamp bordering the rivers, as the Chowan, 
within the observation of men now living, and by the existence 
of rooted stumps of cypress and juniper in the bottom of the bays 
and sounds, even to the depth of 15 and 20 feet, and also by the 
vertical and crumbling shores of the sounds, undermined and 
eroded by the advancing waves. 

The Atlantic ocean is walled off from this region by a narrow 
fringe of sand islands, or dunes, blown shoreward by the wind and 
thrown up into reefs and hillocks like snow-drifts 50, 80, and even 
more than 100 feet high. The movement of these sand.waves 
being inland, the sounds are silting up next the sea, and are in 
many places converted into marshes 3 to 5 miles wide. The reef is 
increasing in continuity and breadth, most of the inlets above Hat- 
teras that were open 300 years ago being closed and obliterated. 
An inspection of the form of the curves of the submarine contours 
off Hatteras and adjoining coasts will show that the action of the 
tides and ocean currents, the Gulf stream and Arctic current meet- 
ing at this point, accumulate upon Hatteras the river silt which 
reaches the sea by way of the Chesapeake as well as that of the 
rivers which discharge their burdens through the inlets about this 
point and southwards. Which amounts to this—that Hatteras may 
be described as a sort of delta, whose materials are derived from the 
drainage of more than 100,000 square miles of the Atlantic slope. 

A subsidence of about 20 feet would bring the sea again 
over the entire Sound region and carry the shore 75 miles inland, 
bringing Hatteras to coincide with Cape Lookout. A sand reef, 
like that north of Hatteras, marks the line of the ancient shore, 
when these conditions obtained. A depression of fifty feet would 
move the shore 100 miles west of Hatteras and carry the point of 
meeting of the conflicting ocean currents and waves to Cape Fear. 
A subsidence of 500 feet, as in the glacial period, would carry 


30 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Hatteras more than 200 miles west of its present position. This 
horizon is marked by an immense sand reef, still retaining its wind 
and wave marks, and rising to a height of more than 500 feet above 
tide, the reef itself being at least 100 feet deep and many miles in 
length. The sea must have remained at this level for a very long 
period. 

But Hatteras is not a modern phenomenon. It is at least as old 
as the cretaceous; the quaternary as well as the tertiary of this 
coast region of North Carolina are laid down upon an eroded 
surface of cretaceous rock, while the artesian borings, at Charleston, 
reach this formation at 700 feet, and at the mouth of the Chesa- 
peake they do not seem to have touched it at 1,000 feet. 

Mr. Warp remarked that, in traversing the Jericho canal of the 
Dismal Swamp in a row boat, he had observed an outward flow at 
both ends of the canal, showing that, by continuous water passage, 
a divide was crossed between Lake Drummond and the James river. 

He criticised the doctrine taught in text-books and popular writ- 
ings that the preservation of leaves in a fossil state is due ordinarily 
to river action and delta formation. More favorable conditions 
are to be found in swamps. 

Other remarks were made by Messrs. Durron and Hove. 


The second communication was by Mr. H. F. Waiine on 


TOPOGRAPHICAL INDICATIONS OF A FAULT NEAR HARPER'S FERRY. 
[ Abstract. ] 


A description was given of a break in the continuity of the Blue 
Ridge, where its disconnected portions, extending side by side for a 
few miles, are cut by the Potomac river, near Harper’s Ferry, the 
gorges so formed presenting a striking feature of the scenery. 

The two ridges, here about 12,000 feet apart, stretch for hundreds 
of miles in nearly parallel directions, one to the south and the 
other to the north; the latter being known in Pennsylvania as the 
South Mountain. ‘The strike of the rocks is parallel to the ridges, 
about N. 30° E., and the prevailing dip is eastward; averaging not 
more than 30°. The ridges are composed of hard sand-rock; 
the adjacent region, of lime-stone and other, rocks more easily dis- 
integrated or dissolved. 

Supposing the sand-rock of the Blue Ridge and South Mountains 
to have been originally a continuous formation, it will be readily 


GENERAL MEETING. 31 


seen that a vertical fault in easterly dipping strata, having its 
direction somewhat nearer the meridian than the present strike 
and its downthrow on the west side of the fault, would produce a 
lateral discontinuity like that here observed, the upthrown part of 
any stratum cropping out on the east of the downthrown part at a 
distance depending upon the amount of the vertical displacement. 

All this would depend upon whether the sand rocks were origi- 
nally continuous in the two ridges—a question which was left for 
the geologists to decide. The writer, however, took occasion to 
suggest that great longitudinal faults might be formed near coast 
lines when the gradual overloading of the balanced crust by depo- 
sitions of sediment produced a strain too great to be relieved by flex- 
ure. A rupture would then occur, the strata going:down on the 
overloaded side of the fault and up on the other until equilibrium of 
pressure upon the yielding magma below was restored by lateral 
displacement of the magma. The fault so formed would present a 
diminished resistance to dislocation, and if the action which origi- 
nated it should continue, it would be likely to increase in dimensions 
both in length and in the amount of vertical displacement. This 
action might even continue after the emergence of the region above 
the surface of the water, provided a more rapid denudation of the 
landward than of the seaward side of the fault took place, in which 
case a continued disturbance of equilibrium would be accompanied 
by vertical yielding, increasing the amount of dislocation, and by sub- 
terranean movements of the supporting magma, whereby a restora- 
tion of material would be effected from overloaded to denuded areas. 

Moreover, the hypothesis of a constant restoration of disturbed 
equilibrium makes it easier to understand why the folding of strata 
should grow steeper, even to a folding under, as the axis of a moun- 
tain chain is approached. A diagram exhibiting the so-called 
“fan-like structure of the Alps,” enlarged from a figure by Rogers, 
(see Rogers’ Report on the Geology of Pennsylvania, Vol. II, p. 
902,) was shown in illustration. The gradual subterranean move- 
ments inward under a mountain chain, as the upper portions were 
removed and the remainder elevated, would carry the strata along 
on a support of diminishing width until they were folded upward 
and backward. 

The gradual increase towards the east in the amount of corrugation 
and steepness of dips, together with the supposed reversed folding by 
which the rocks of the eastern part of the Appalachian region seem to 


_ 
32 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


dip under older rocks, still further east appear, therefore, to favor the 
notion that the paleozoic rocks of the Appalachian region and the 
eastern part of the Mississippi basin were derived from the erosion 
of highlands formerly existing east of the Appalachian chain, now, 
perhaps, submerged in the Atlantic ocean. The downthrow of a 
fault, if formed in the manner supposed in the region under con- 
sideration, would accordingly be on its western side, as suggested 
above. 


The third communication was by Mr. S. F. Emmons on 
, ORE DEPOSITION BY REPLACEMENT. 


[ Abstract. ] 


After a few introductory remarks upon the relatively unsatis- 
factory condition of that branch of geology which treats of ore de- 
posits, considering the early date at which it was taken up, the 
speaker briefly reviews the existing theories and classifications, and 
shows that they are mainly based on the idea that each ore deposit 
is the filling of some pre-existing cavity or opening in the rock in 
which it is now found ; that so-called fissure veins, for instance, were 
once actually open cracks, and that irregular deposits in limestone 
have been made by the filling up of open caves, such as so fre- 
quently occur in these rocks. The result of his studies of the so- 
called “carbonate deposits” of Leadville, Colorado, has been to 
show that they are not the filling up of pre-existing cavities; the 
caves there have been formed since the ore was deposited, as is 
proved by their crossing indiscriminately ore bodies and limestone. 
‘They belong to a class of deposits for which he proposes the name 
metamorphic deposits, or those which have been formed by a meta- 
somatic interchange between the vein and original rock material. 
In Leadville the principal deposits are an actual replacement of 
the limestone itself at or near the contact of this stratum with an 
overlying sheet of porphyry. This replacement action has in places 
proceeded so far that the entire stratum of ore-bearing limestone or 
dolomite, originally 150 to 200 feet thick, has been cHanged into 
vein material, which consists of silica and metallic minerals. This 
vein material was brought in solution by percolating waters, which 
had taken it up during their circulation through the adjoining and 
generally overlying eruptive rocks. A more detailed description 
of the phenomena of these deposits will be found in his paper en- 


GENERAL MEETING. 33 


titled ““ Abstract of a Report on the Geology of Leadville,” in the 
Second Annual Report of the Director of the United States Geo- 
logical Survey. 

While the speaker’s studies have thus far been mainly confined to 
limestone deposits, he has reason to believe that essentially the same 
process has produced a large proportion of ore deposits in crystal- 
line and eruptive rocks, and that to the class of metamorphic de- 
posits belong most of the so-called fissure veins of the Rocky Moun- 
tain region. That is, that they are not the filling in of pre-existent 
open fissures by vein materials foreign to the adjoining rocks, but 
simply a metamorphic change of these rocks themselves along 
channels of easy access to percolating waters; and according to the 
character of the material held in solution by these waters, these 
rocks have been more or less changed into quartz and metallic min- 
erals, to a greater or less width, as the case may be. Numerous 
instances of such veins will be found in the forthcoming Census 
Report upon the Statistics and Technology of the Precious Metals, 
by Mr. G. F. Becker and the speaker. 


234TH MEETING. Aprit 21, 1883. 
Vice-President Britiincs in the Chair. 


Forty members present. 


The Chair announced that Messrs. WASHINGTON CARRUTHERS 
Kerr and SAMUEL FRANKLIN Emmons had been elected members. 


Mr. W. H. Datu addressed the Society on 
GLACIATION IN ALASKA, 


illustrating his remarks by maps of the territory and of the glacial 
areas of the St. Elias Alps and Kachekmak Bay, Cook’s Inlet, the 
latter being from surveys made by him under the direction of the 
U.S. Coast Survey. 

He called attention in the first place to the wide differences in 
the character of the masses of ice resulting from the consolidation 
of snow by gravity (which would usually be classed as glaciers), 
as observed by him during nine years’ exploration in Alaska. 

These might be classed under several heads: as plateau-ice, filling 


34 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


large areas of depression and without motion as a whole, but when 
sufficiently accumulated overflowing the edges of its basin in various 
directions; as valley-ice, filling wide valleys of gentle incline both 
as to their axes and their lateral slopes, producing masses of ice 
moving in a definite direction but without lateral and sometimes 
even without terminal moraines; as ice-cascades, formed in sharp nar- 
row ravines of very steep inclination, usually without well-defined 
surface moraines; as typical glaciers, showing névé and lateral and 
terminal moraines; and lastly, as effete or fossil glaciers, whose 
sources have become exhausted, whose motion has therefore ceased, 
and whose lower portions have become smothered by the accumu- 
lation of non-conducting débris. The very existence of one of these 
last has remained unknown for half a century, though the plateau 
underwhich it is buried has been described and mapped by explorers. 

Another form under which ice appears in Alaska is that of solid 
motionless layers, sometimes of great thickness, interstratified with 
sand, clay, etc. A deposit probably of this character is described 
by Nordenskiéld, on the Asiatic coast, near Bering Strait. In 
Alaska this formation, in which ice plays the part of a stratified 
rock, extends from Kotzebue sound, where the greatest known 
thickness of the ice-layer, about three hundred feet, has been noted, 
around the Arctic coast, probably to the eastern boundary.- In 
Kotzebue Sound the ice is surmounted by about forty feet of clay 
containing the remains of fossil horses, buffaloes (Bos latifrons, etc.), 
mountain sheep, and other mammals.. Farther north the ice is 
covered with a much thinner coat of mineral matter or soil, usually 
not exceeding two or.three feet in thickness, and rarely rises more 
than twelve or fifteen feet above high water mark on the sea coast. 
Its continuity is broken between Kotzebue Sound and Icy Cape by 
rocky hills composed chiefly of carboniferous limestones, which 
bear no glaciers and do not seem to have been glaciated. The 
absence of bowlders and erratics over all this area has. been noted 
by Franklin, Beechey, and all others who have explored it. The 
remarkable extent and character of the formation was unknown 
previous to the speaker’s investigations, though the“ice cliffs of 
Kotzebue Sound had attracted attention from the time of their first 
discovery. 

Mr. Datu desired especially to emphasize the distinction between 
these strata of pure ice and the “frozen soil” so often alluded to 
by arctic explorers. The absence of frozen soil in the alluvium 


GENERAL MEETING. 85 


of the Yukon Valley, far north of Kotzebue Sound, was noted, as 
well as the fact that this valley has, for some unexplained reason, 
a mean temperature considerably above the normal, so that its 
forests extend well beyond the Arctic circle. 

The distribution of glaciers, properly so-called, in Alaska, as far 
as our present knowledge goes, is confined to the region of the 
Alaskan range and the ranges parallel with it south of the Yukon 
Valley, but particularly to the coast mountains bordering on the Gulf 
of Alaska and the Alexander Archipelago, of which the Saint 
Elias Alps form the most conspicuous uplift. 

The distribution of stratified ice is all north of the Yukon Val- 
ley, which divides the two regions. Hence, for the glacial epoch, 
it may be presumed that the one is the equivalent of the other, and 
the fact that Arctic Alaska is marked by stratified ice, rather than 
glaciers such as those of Greenland, must be due to local geological 
and climatic peculiarities existing at the time. On the Asiatic 
coast, especially at Holy Cross Bay, in nearly the same latitude and 
with not very different topographic conditions, glaciers are abun- 
dant at the present time. 

On the mainland, facing the Alexander Archipelago, especially 
toward Lynn Canal, Icy Strait and the Stikine region, local glaciers 
are abundant, and traces of others, now dissolved, may be found 
on the lowlands of most of the islands. That these were always 
local, though doubtless very extensive, and that they were the pro- 
geny of the topography instead of being its parent, is obvious to 
anyone who has seen the coasts of Maine or Norway, which have 
been submitted to general glaciation, and will compare their 
rounded, worn, and moutonnée aspect with that of the sharp cliffs, 
beetling crags, narrow valleys, and scanty lowlands of the Alaskan 
islands. 

The speaker concluded, from his observations, that the extent of 
the Alaskan glaciers is greatly diminished from its former state, 
and is probably still diminishing; that the southern portion of the 
Territory is probably nearly or quite stationary, while the northern 
part is undergoing elevation; and that, from the nature of the case, 
the area of stratified ice cannot be expected to increase or di- 
minish materially without changes in geological or climatic con- 
ditions too great to be anticipated. 

Mr. Atvorp remarked that on Point Barrow frozen ground had 
been penetrated to a depth of thirteen feet. 


36 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


In reply to a question by Mr. AntiseLt, Mr. Dawu said that 
little was known of the humidity of the interior of Alaska; 23 
inches of precipitation, nearly all in snow, had been observed in a 
single year at one point and 12 inches at another. 


Mr. F. B. Hovueu then read a paper on 


THE CULTIVATION OF THE EUCALYPTUS ON THE ROMAN 
CAMPAGNA, 


which was discussed by Messrs. E. B. Etuiorr and H. FarquHar. 
It is published in the American Journal of Forestry for June, 1883. 


235TH MEETING. May 5, 1888. 
Vice-President Briir1nes in the Chair. 
Twenty-seven members and visitors present. 


The Chair announced the election to membership of Messrs. 
Wixi1AM THomas SAMPSON, JOHN OscAR SKINNER, and THomaAs 
CROWDER CHAMBERLIN. 


The first communication was by Mr. H. A. Hazen on 


HYGROMETRIC OBSERVATIONS. 
[ Abstract. ] 


After describing the various devices by which the moisture of. 
the air has been measured, and especially the novel and valuable 
apparatus of Crova, the speaker illustrated the difficulty of the 
subject by contrasting synchronous determinations made at four 
points within a radius of two miles, and then described some ex- 
periments tending to show the inaccuracy of the wet and dry bulb 
hygrometer, as ordinarily observed. The value of the wet bulb 
reading is enhanced by blowing on the bulb with a bellows, or 
otherwise subjecting it to a brisk current of air. . 

Mr. Harkness remarked first, that Mr. Hazen’s experiments 
appeared to prove the insufficiency of Regnault’s formula, for they 
showed the difference between the indications of the wet bulb and 
dry bulb to be a function not only of the humidity, but of the 
velocity of wind; second, that height of station above the ground 


GENERAL MEETING. 37 


was a condition to which too little attention had been given; and 
third, that there seemed a possibility of obtaining a slightly erro- 
neous vapor tension with Crova’s apparatus. 


Mr. E. J. Farquuar then read a paper on 


DREAMS IN THEIR RELATION WITH PSYCHOLOGY. 
[ Abstract. ] 


Several theories of dreams were considered and none found en- 
tirely sufficient; not because a new and complete one was to be 
proposed, but because all seemed a little too partial and limiting in 
their scope. After touching on the relation of dreams to sleep and 
to waking, as intermediate between them, discrediting many recorded 
experiments on the ground of their being vitiated by a special pur- 
pose latent in the mind, and pointing out that the usual supposition 
of our being often waked by the intensity of a dream appears to 
put cause for effect, since it must be the fact of waking that effects 
the dream, perhaps by slow degrees—the character of mental opera- 
tions in dreams was discussed. Dissent was expressed from the 
opinion that the dreaming state is devoid of such originating power 
as belongs to the waking; this position was maintained by showing 
_ first, the extreme vividness and lastingness of impression often per- 
taining to dreams, apart from any features of horror; then the 
coherence, far from being unknown among them, yet of a peculiar 
kind ; and, finally, the true significance occasionally appearing in 
them, generally by figurative shape, amounting sometimes to a real 
enlightenment of the mind. Regarding the faculties or aspects of 
mind most apt to display themselves in dreams, it was held that all 
were liable to the exercise in turn, though some of the higher ones, 
especially the moral sense and judgment, less than others; since these 
expressed a rarer and more distinctive force evolved and laid up by 
and for our relations with actual life, while other powers whose 
exercise is less of an expenditure from the most important vitalities 
of mind were freer at the time—the principles of conservation and 
struggle for existence being thought to apply among the mental 
elements. Thus, to a certain degree, the mind may be seen more 
clearly in its true character by means of dreams than awake, 
though in very partial views at a time. Unconscious mental action 
was reviewed in this connection, and it was held that not only the 
lower processes, called reflex, but many of the highest functions 


38 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


largely partake of this attribute. A great number of other points 
in regard to dreams were merely named as illustrating the fertility 
of the subject. 


236TH MEETING. May 19, 1883. 
Vice-President HrtGarp in the Chair. 
Forty members and visitors present. 


It was announced from the General Committee that the following 
rules had been adopted : 


I. If the author of any paper read before a section of the Society 
desires its publication, either in full or by abstract, it shall be re- 
ferred to a committee, to be appointed as the section may determine. 

The report of this committee shall be forwarded to the Publica- 
tion Committee by the secretary of the section, together with any 
action of the section taken thereon. 


II. Any paper read before a section may be repeated, either en- 
tire or by abstract, before a general meeting of the Society, if such 
repetition is recommended by the General Committee of the So- 
ciety. 


Mr. Ropert FLETCHER made a communication entitled 
RECENT EXPERIMENTS ON SERPENT VENOM. 


It is published in the American Journal of the Medical Sciences 
for July, 1883. 


Mr. H. FarquuAr then made a communication on 
FURTHER EXPERIMENTS IN BINARY ARITHMETIC, 


showing that the relation between the vertical and horizontal di- 
mensions of the characters used in the binary notation is a factor 
in determining its economic value. He presented, also, the results 
of a series of comparative tests showing that the binary notation 
enables some persons, after brief practice, to perform addition more 
rapidly than with denary notation, while with others it requires a 
longer time. The latter class includes practiced computers, gene- 
rally, and the former those less accustomed to the use of figures. 


GENERAL MEETING. 39 


Mr. DoorirrLe remarked that the most instructive results would 
be obtained by experimenting with young persons; and the subject 
was further discussed by Messrs. W. B. Taytor, E. B. Exxiott, 
and C. A. Scuort. 


237TH MEETING. JUNE 2, 1883. 


Vice-President HinGarp, and afterward Mr. HarKkwness, in the 
Chair. 


Twenty-two members present. 


It was announced that the next meeting would be held October 
13th. 


Mr. W. Lee made a communication, with illustrations, entitled 


SKETCHES FROM MEDALLIC MEDICAL HISTORY. 
; [ Abstract. ] 


The paper was prefaced by remarks on the value of coin and 
medal collecting as a profitable means of instruction, and by a recog- 
nition of the danger to which collectors are exposed of develop- 
ing a mania for collecting odd and curious things which cease to 
be instructive. An extended interest in numismatics commenced 
to show itself in this country in 1858, at which time there were 
probably not as many as one hundred coin collectors in the United 
States. The interest has grown rapidly, however, until now there 
must be on the books of the United States Mint the names of at 
least one thousand collectors who receive yearly the issue of 
the mint, with a special proof polish. In New York alone, during 
the year 1882, there were thirty-nine collections sold at public 
auction, the amount realized being '$68,441.36. The largest of 
these was the Bushnell collection, which realized $13,900.47. Sev- 
eral of our large cities have numismatic societies, some of which 
are designated as numismatic and archeological societies; and a 
number of periodicals devoted simply to the interest of numis- 
matics obtain a satisfactory circulation. . 

The modes of striking off coins and medals were given somewhat 
in detail, and attention was then called to the important part which 
medals struck in honor of medical men and to commemorate im- 


40 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


portant events bearing directly upon the history of medicine have 
played throughout the history of the world. The illustrations of 
the paper included a hundred and fifty examples of the medals 
themselves, in regular sequence, from the days of Roman and’ 
Greek medicine down almost to the date of the paper itself, an 
interesting commemoration of events and individuals marking 
epochs in the history of medicine. These medals were taken up 
seriatim, references were made to the lives of individuals and the 
scientific work done by them, and descriptions were given of the 
occasions which called for the striking of medals. 

The paper closed with an expression of hope that the Society 
might be stimulated at the sight of so many handsome and perma- 
nent memorials of the men and times of the past, to attempt to 
preserve the features of its first president, Joseph Henry, in a 
similar enduring form. 

The bibliography of the subject was discussed at some length, 
and the following works were referred to: 


MeEap, Richardi.—Dissertatio de Nummis quibusdam a Smyrnaeis 
in medicorum honorem percussis. Naples, 1752. 


Rupo.put, C. A.—Index numismatum in virorum de rebus_ medi- 
cis vel physicis meritorum memoriam percussorum. Berlin, 
Ist edition 1823, 2d edition 1825, 12mo., XII, 131 pp, 3d 
edition 1828, 4th edition 1829. (This work (2d edition) 
comprises the description of 523 medals struck in honor of 
350 scientific and medical men.) 

RENAULDIN, Leop. Jos.—LEtudes historiques et critiques sur les 
Médicins Numismatistes, contenant leur biographie et l’an- 
alyse de leurs écrits. Paris, 1851, 8°, XVI, 574 pp. (This 
work contains the names of 61 physicians). 

CHEREAU (A).—Les mereaux et les getons de l’ancienne faculté de 
médecine de Paris. L’Union Médicale. Paris, 1873, 3 
Series, XV, pp. 309, 321. 

PFEIFFER, (L) und RuLtanp (C).—Pestilentia in Nummis. Ges- 
chichte der grossen Volkskrankheiten in numismatischen 
Documenten. Ein beitrag zur Geschichte der Medicin und 
der Cultur. Tubingen, 1882, 8 X, 189 PP. Mit zwei 
Tafeln Abbildungen in lichtdruck. 

Wrornu, Warwick.—Asklepios and the Ceins of Pergamon. From 
the Numismatic Chronicle and Journal of the Numismatic 
Society. London, 1882, Part I, Third Series, No. 5, pages 
1 to 51, plates 3. 

Moeusen, J. C. G.—The exact title of this author’s work is not 
known to the writer of the paper; it was written in German, 


GENERAL MEETING. 41 


and embodies a description of a collection of medals in 
Berlin struck in honor of physicians, giving 200 medals 
struck after the 15th century. 


GROTEFEND, C. L.—Die Stempel der Rémischen Augenirzte. 
Hannover, 1867. 


Mr. T. N. Gixiu then made a communication on 


ANALOGUES IN ZO0O-GEOGRAPHY. 


238TH MEETING. OcToBER 138, 1883. 


The Society, in accordance with the notice of adjournment at 
the June meeting, resumed its sessions. 


The President in the Chair. 
Forty-four members and visitors present. 


It was announced that during the vacation the Society had lost 
by death Surgeon General C. H. Cranz, one of its Vice-Presidents ; 
Admiral B. F. Sanps, one of its founders; and Dr. Jostan CurRTIs. 

It was further announced from the General Committee that Mr. 
Garrick MALLERY had been appointed Vice-President to fill the 
vacancy occasioned by the death of Mr. Crane, and that Mr. 
C. V. Rizey had been added to the General Committee to complete 
its number, 


Mr. Wii.14m B. Taytor read a paper entitled 


NOTE ON THE RINGS OF SATURN. 
[ Abstract. ] 


After an historic sketch of the varying and apparently incon- 
gruous observations by astronomers on the markings and aspects of 
the Saturnian rings, down to those of Schiaparelli of the Milan 
Observatory, (published in June last,) Mr. TayLor remarked that 
since the mathematical discussion by Prof. J. Clerk Maxwell, in 
1857,* both the rigid and the fluid ring theories have been aban- 
doned ; and the discrete or meteoric constitution of the rings is now 
accepted by all physical astronomers as conclusively established. 


* On the Stability of the Motion of Saturn’s Rings. 4to. 71 pp. and 1 plate. 
Cambridge, Eng., 1859. 
7 


42 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Reference was then made to the startling announcement by Otto 
Struve, in 1851, that a careful comparison of the earlier with the 
later measurements showed that during the two hundred years of 
observation the rings had been widening, and the inner edge steadily 
approaching the body of the planet.* Considering the necessarily 
vast antiquity of the Saturnian system, such a change during the 
brief interval of human existence seems @ priori almost infinitely 
improbable. The hypothesis of some that a meteoric ring has been 
drawn in by Saturn’s attraction, within comparatively recent ages, 
seems entirely negatived by the circular symmetry of the system. 
It is not surprising, therefore, that Struve’s inference has been re- 
ceived with an almost universal incredulity by the astronomical 
world. Robert Main, of the Greenwich Observatory, from a dis- 
cussion of his own measurements taken in the winter of 1852-3, 
and in 1854, disputed the accuracy of Struve’s measures ; and con- 
cluded that “no change has taken place in the system since the 
time of Huyghens.”+ And Prof. F. Kaiser, in a paper on “The 
Hypothesis of Otto Struve respecting the gradual increase of 
Saturn’s Ring,” etc., arrives at the same conclusion, and believes 
“there exists no reason whatever for supposing that the compound 
ring of Saturn is gradually increasing in breadth.” { 

There seems to be little doubt of some unintentional exaggeration 
in Struve’s tabulated results, which range from 4”.6:6”.5 for the 
ratio of ring breadth to space between ring and ball, in the time of 
Huyghens, 1657, to 7”.4:3”.7 for the ratio of breadth to space, by 
his own observation in 1851. Nevertheless it is a noteworthy fact 
that all the early drawings of Saturn made in the seventeenth cen- 
tury (many of which are figured by Huyghens in his Systema Sat- 
urnium, 1659) plainly exhibit the width of the ring as sensibly 
less than the dark space within; while all modern observers would 
agree that the bright ring is now wider than the dark space, in 
about the ratio of 8:2; or were we to take the average of the esti- 


* Recueil des Mémoires présentés [etc.] par les Astronomes de Poulkoya. 4to. 
St. Petersburg, 1853. Vol. I, pp. 349-385. ‘Sur les Dimensions des Anneaux 
de Saturne.” (Memoir read before Acad. Sci.) A brief abstract Of the memoir 
is given in the Monthly Notices, R. A. S., November 12, 1852. Vol. XIII, pp. 
22-24. \ 

+ Monthly Notices, R. A. S., December 14, 1855. ~ Vol. XVI, pp. 30-36. 

t Mem. Acad. Sci., Amsterdam, 1858. A translation of the memoir is given 
in the Monthly Notices, R. A. S., January 11, 1856. Vol. XVI, pp. 66-72. 


GENERAL MEETING. 43 


mates of the last century, it would probably not vary far from 
5”.25:5”.75; while the general average for the present century 
would probably be about 6”.5:4”.5. There seems, therefore, to be 
a real difference, not accounted for by inferiority of earlier instru- 
ments and estimates, nor by the existing uncertainties of modern 
measurements. The question will probably be definitely settled in 
less than a century. Meanwhile there is a need of some explana- 
tion of the apparently systematic and progressive divergence first 
pointed out by Struve; and we naturally ask, What indications 
are afforded by theory ? 

The elder Herschel, in 1789, (at the Saturnian equinox, when the 
edge of the ring was presented to view,) from supposed observation 
of protuberances moving on the line, believed that he had detected 
a rotation, whose period he estimated at 10h. 32m. 15s., for the 
outer edge of the ring.* The correctness of this interpretation was 
controverted by Schroeter, from observations at Lilienthal, on the 
next passage of Saturn’s equatorial node in 1803; as it was after- 
ward questioned by Prof. G. P. Bond, of Harvard Observatory, 
from observations in 1848.+ It is scarcely doubtful that Herschel’s 
period was derived from an entire misconception of the nature of 
the ring—which he firmly held to be solid—and that it possesses no 
scientific value whatever. A. Secchi, from certain recurrent irreg- 
ularities of phase observed at Rome in 1854, 1855, and 1856, in- 
ferred a rotation period of 14h. 23m. This is doubtless a nearer 
approximation (for the outer edge of the ring) than Herschel’s es- 
timate. It is not probable, however, that the period of any portion 
of the ring will be determined by observation. 

Accepting the meteoric theory of the rings as now established, 
we may by Kepler’s law compute with confidence the period of 
rotation of any part of the ring; and we thus find— 


From the period of the inner Satellite (AZ@mas)_._. 22h. 373m.— 
The period/of ‘otter edge ofiring -L 2 JL kee sisi} obs | eet) bene 

os dividing. stripe js s oe eee eer eDED. 20), 

ge inner edge of bright ring _-_-_-___ Tog sk 20 

oe inner edge of dusky ring _--_-_--.-- 5h. 45 m. 
Mean period of ring (supposed solid) about _--_-_ Ioh. 50 m. 


‘The period of the planet Saturn is . > ‘ 10h. 14m. 


* Phil. Trans. Roy. Soc. 1790: Vol. LXXX, p. 479; and 1792: Vol. 
LXXXII, p. 6. 
j Gould’s Astronomical Journal. 1850. Vol. I, pp. 20, 21. 


44 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Thus regarding each constituent element of the ring as having 
its own independent rotation, (a condition absolutely essential to 
the stability of the system,) we may consider that from the compli. 
cated and variable perturbations by the exterior satellites, no one 
particle can revolve in a circular orbit, and hence that in a space 
so crowded there must be a considerable amount of interference, 
The collisions at intersecting orbits may result in heat or in disin- 
tegration; but in any event they must tend to a degradation of 
motion, and hence to a slightly shortened mean radius-vector and a 
shortened period. 

Theoretically then such an effect as that indicated by Struve 
would seem inevitable, whether as a matter of fact it has been 
sufficient in a couple of centuries to be detected or not. And this 
involves a modified conception as to the earlier condition of the 
Saturnian rings. To suppose a fine web of nebulous matter con- 
tinuously spun out from Saturn’s equator, with an unchanging 
balance of centrifugal and centripetal forces during the long ages 
while the planet was slowly contracting to one-half its radius, is 
certainly no easy task or plausible theory. If, however, we are 
now beholding but a stage of transitional development of the ring, 
we shall have to imagine its primitive radius considerably larger, 
and its width as probably very much narrower—so narrow indeed 
as to have a planetary or satellitic status, revolving in a single 
definite period—possibly that of Mimas the nearest satellite. Such 
a ring would present a condition of comparatively great stability ; 
and it may have been that only the secular recurrence of rare and 
remarkable conjunctions commenced upon it the work of disturbance 
and disintegration. 

When Galileo, the first to see the strange appendages to Saturn, 
(though without being able to distinguish the anse as parts of a 
ring,) observed, in 1612, that they had entirely disappeared, he 
wrote in some dismay, “ Has Saturn possibly devoured his own 
children?” * So may perhaps the future astronomer, seeing but an 
airy trace of the historic ring, repeat the saying, Saturn has indeed 
devoured his offspring; not indeed completely, for*a part will © 
probably still remain ; nor with violent catastrophe, for the scattered 
fragments falling by their eccentricity will be absorbed as gently as 
are the meteors daily falling on our earth. 


* Third letter to Marc Velser, December 1, 1612. Ofjere di Galileo. 4toi 4 
vols. Padua, 1744: Vol. II, p. 123. 


GENERAL MEETING. 45 


A subsidiary point deserving of notice is the certainty that the 
inner portions of the bright ring (and still more those of the dusky 
ring) are revolving in periods three or four hours shorter than that 
of Saturn himself. When Professor Hall made his brilliant discov- 
ery of the satellites of Mars, and announced that the inner satellite 
(Phobos) was found to have the short period of 7h. 38m. (or less 
than one-third of that of Mars) the fact was at once proclaimed by 
some as incompatible with the “nebular hypothesis.” Everybody 
knows that the rotation periods of the’sun and planets do not con- 
form to the third law of Kepler. Our own moon has an actual 
velocity in its orbit more than double that of our terrestrial equator. 
And had the moon a little less than one-third its present distance, 
(that is, were its radius-vector less than 70,000 miles,) its angular 
velocity would exceed that of the earth, or its period would be less 
than 24 hours. Or, stated in another way, our earth, if expanded 
to the orbit of the moon, (under the most favorable disposition of 
form and of homogenous density,) would occupy considerably more 
than a year in completing its rotation. The supposed nebular diff- 
culty is therefore just as pertinent to our own satellite as to those 
of Saturn or of Mars. The obvious solution is, that all the planets 
(without exception) have lost a very large amount of rotatory 
energy ; and this may be largely or chiefly ascribed to the retarding 
effects of internal friction resulting from solar tides. And, given 
time enough, the rotation of every planet should be finally reduced 
to the lunar condition of a precise accord of its diurnal and annual 
periods. On any hypothesis whatever, it is certain that the rotations 
of the planets are very much slower (notwithstanding too the 
acceleration due to contraction) than they originally were. This 
fact certainly offers no objection to the nebular hypothesis. 


“ Mr. Durron questioned the validity of Ennis’ hypothesis, that 
the rotation of a nebular mass could be initiated by purely internal 
movements. 


Other remarks were made by Mr. FrisBy. 
Mr. S. M. Burnett then made a communication on 
THE CHARACTER OF THE FOCAL LINES IN ASTIGMATISM, 


showing that the two lines which limit the focal interval of Sturm 
have been erroneously assumed to be straight. There is only one 


_ 
46 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


special case of the triaxial ellipsoid in which they are straight. 
In all other cases they are curved. 

The full text of this paper may be found in the Archives of 
Ophthalmology, Vol. XII, Nos. 3 and 4. 


Mr. H. A. Hazen followed with a communication on 
THERMOMETER EXPOSURE. 
[ Abstract. ] 


Without entering upon the question, Where in any locality shall 
the air temperature be observed, it is proposed to discuss the even 
more important question, What shall be the environment of a 
thermometer that it may give the true temperature. ‘The practice 
has been very various: in England the Stevenson shelter is re- 
garded as a standard: this is a double-louvred frame, wholly of 
wood, 18 x 10 x 18 inches, and placed about 4 feet above grass. In 
Russia we find a large wooden outside shelter of single louvres 
open to the north, inside of which is placed a metallic screen, the 
whole being exposed 12 or 13 feet above grass. In any exposure we 
should seek, first, to allow the freest possible access of the outer air, 
and second, to screen the thermometer from direct sun heat, from 
precipitation, and from radiation, whether (a) from surrounding 
objects by day or (6) to the sky at night. 

It is important that we adopt some ready means of accurately 
determining the air temperature which may answer as a standard 
of comparison. This we have in the swung thermometer, which, 
by its free motion through a large body of air shaded from direct 
sunlight in the daytime, is calculated to give good results. 

Experiments have been tried with a so-called “ Pattern” shelter 
constructed of wood,.of single louvres, inclined 30° to the hor- 
izontal, thus giving a good air circulation. The size is 4x3x3 
feet, and it is erected at a height of 13 feet above a tin roof. In 
order to determine the Jeast admissible size for a shelter, thermom- 
eters were placed in the Pattern 5 inches apart and running in an 
east and west direction, and these were observed morning and after- 
noon. It has been found that with a hot sun and still air the heat 
from the louvres rapidly diminishes with distance and becomes in- 
sensible at 15 inches. Comparisons have also been made for several 
weeks between the: Russian and Pattern shelters; and the means 
of 100 sets of continuous observations on a still day, and again on 
a windy day, are shown n the following table: 


‘ 


GENERAL MEETING. 47 


Dry ther- Wet ther- Relative humidity ; 
mometer. mometer. per cent. 
Russian. Pattern. R. BE: I P 
StU alr See ACTS isha 64°.0 62°.7 52.4 S10 
Light south wind-_ 77 .2 “Wien 62.0 61.0 3087) 134.5 


These results show directly the advantage of a good circulation 
of air, and that after shielding from the sun and radiation to the 
sky with a shelter at least 3 feet long, we may neglect other consid- 
erations. 

Experiments are still in progress to determine the proper height 
above sod or roof, the proper exposure for a north window, and so 
forth. 

Mr. ANTISELL, referring to the general theme rather than to 
the special subject of the paper, took occasion to note that the 
practice of conducting meteorologic observations on the tops of 
highshouses, while it may well subserve the special purposes of the 
Signal Service, renders their work of materially less value to the 
medical profession. There is so much change, especially of the 
moisture element, in the first few feet from the ground upward that 
no observations can be depended upon as reporting the conditions 
of the phenomena of disease unless they are made in the layer 
actually occupied by man. 

Mr. Taytor asked whether there might not be an error arising 
from the set given to the glass of the bulb by the pressure of the 
mercury of a whirled thermometer. 

Mr. HazeEN replied that he had tested the effect of pressure ap- 
plied to the bulb with the finger, and found that the set produced 
was of very brief duration. He had also tested the thermic effect 
of the friction on the atmosphere incurred by rapid whirling, and 
found it inappreciable with a velocity of about fourteen miles an 
hour. On whirling a black bulb thermometer, he observed a change 
of several tenths of a degree, which appeared clearly referable to 
the greater coefficient of friction of the surface roughened by lamp- 
black. 

Mr. Granam BExt remarked that if we eliminate radiation and 
learn the absolute temperature of the air at the point of observa- 
tion, our knowledge is still limited to that point only, whereas for 
meteorologic purposes it is important to ascertain the average tem- 
perature of a body of air. He suggested the possibility of utilizing 
for this purpose a measurement of the velocity of sound, which 


48 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


velocity is dependent on atmospheric temperature and independent 
of barometric pressure. 

Mr. Durron thought that the extreme delicacy of this observa- 
tion would involve an uncertainty greater than the one which now 
inheres in the determination. 


239TH MEETING. OcTOBER 27, 1883. 
The President in the Chair. 
Forty-seven members and guests present. 


The Chair announced the death of two members since the last 
meeting—LrEonARD Dunnett GALE and Exisua Foore. : 

Announcement was also made of the election to membership of 
Cuar.es DootirrLe WALCOTT. 


Mr. T. N. Griu made a communication on 
ICHTHYOLOGICAL RESULTS OF THE VOYAGE OF THE ALBATROSS. 


Mr. ALEXANDER GRAHAM BELL made the following communi- 
cation on 


FALLACIES CONCERNING THE DEAF, AND THE INFLUENCE OF SUCH 
FALLACIES IN PREVENTING THE AMELIORATION 
OF THEIR CONDITION. 


It is difficult to form an adequate conception of the prevalence 
of deafness in the community. There is hardly a man in the 
couniry who has not in his circle of friends and acquaintances at 
least one deaf person with whom he finds it difficult to converse 
excepting by means of a hearing-tube or trumpet. Now is it not 
an extraordinary fact that these deaf friends are nearly all adults? 
Where are the little children who are similarly afflicted? Have 
any of us seen a child with a hearing-tube or trumpet? If not, 
why not? The fact is that very young children who are hard of 
hearing, or who cannot hear at all, do not naturally speak, and this 
fact has given origin to the term “ deaf-mute,” by which it is cus- 
tomary to designate a person who is deaf from childhood. 

“But are there no deaf children,” you may ask, “ excepting 
those whom we term deaf-mutes?”’ No; none. In the tenth census 


GENERAL MEETING. 49 


of the United States (1880) persons who became deaf under the 
age of sixteen years were returned as “deaf and dumb.” Such 
facts as these give support to the fallacy that deafness, unaccom- 
panied by any other natural defect, is confined to adult life, and is 
specially characteristic of advancing old age. 

So constant is the association of defective speech with defective 
hearing in childhood that if one of your children whom you have 
left at home, hearing perfectly and talking perfectly, should, from 
some accident, lose his hearing, he would also naturally lose his 
speech. Why is this, and why are those who are born deaf always 
also dumb ? 


Fallacies Concerning the Dumbness of Deaf Children. 


The most ingenious and fallacious arguments have been advanced 
in explanation. George Sibscota,* in 1670, claimed that the nerves 
of the tongue and larynx were connected with the nerves of the 
ear, ‘and from this Communion of the vessels proceeds the sympathy 
between the Ear, the Tongue and Larynx, and the very affection of 
those parts are easily communicated one with the other. Hence it 
is that the pulling of the Membrane of the Ear causeth a dry Cough 
in the party; and that is the reason most deaf men * * * are 
Dumb, or else speak with great difficulty ; that is, are not capable of 
framing true words or of articulate pronunciation by reason, of the 
want of that convenient influx of the animal spirits; and for this 
cause also, it is that those who are thick of Hearing have a kind of 
hoarce speech.” 

The value of Sibscota’s reasoning may be judged of by the 
further information he gives us concerning the uses of the Eusta- 
chian tube. “ By this it is,” he says, “that Smoakers, puffing up 
their Bheeks, having taken in the fume of Tobacco, send it out at 
their Ears. Therefore the opinion of Alemaeon is not ridiculous, 
who held that she-Goats did breathe thorough their Ears,” &c., &e. 

It is easy for us to laugh at the fallacies of the past, but are we 
ourselves any less liable to error on that account? The majority 
of people at the present day believe that those who are born deaf 
are also dumb because of defective vocal organs. Now let us examine 


* J have been informed that Sibscota’s work, “The Deaf and Dumb Man’s 
Discourse,” from which the above extracts are taken, is in reality a translation of 
another work by Anthony Densing, published in 1656. 


50 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


this proposition. It is a more ridiculous and absurd fallacy than 
that of Sibscota and more easily disposed of. 

The hypothesis that congenitally deaf children do not naturally 
speak because their vocal organs are defective involves the assump- 
tion that were their vocal organs perfect such children would natu- 
rally speak. But why should they speak a language they have 
never heard? Do we speak any language that we have not heard? 
Are our vocal organs defective because we do not talk Chinese? It 
is a fallacy. The deaf have as perfect vocal organs as our own, 
and do not naturally speak because they do not hear. I have my- 
self examined the vocal organs of more than 400 deaf-mutes with- 
out discovering any other peculiarities than those to be found 
among hearing and speaking children. The deaf children of Italy 
and Germany are almost universally taught to speak, and why 
should we not teach ours? Wherever determined efforts have been 
made in this country success has followed and articulation schools 
have been established. 


Fallacy Concerning the Intelligence of Deaf Children. 


The use of the word “ mute” engenders another fallacy concerning 
the mental condition of deaf children. There are two classes of 
persons who do not naturally speak—those who are dumb on account 
of defective hearing and those who are dumb on account of defec- 
tive minds. All idiots are dumb. 

Deaf children are gathered into institutions and schools that 
have been established for their benefit away from the general observ- 
vation of the public, and even in adult life they hold themselves 
aloof from hearing people; while idiots and feeble-minded persons 
are not so generally withdrawn from their families. Hence the 
greater number of “ mutes” who are accessible to public observation 
are dumb on account of defective minds, and not of defective hear- 
ing. No wonder, therefore, that the two classes are often con- 
founded together. It is the hard task of every principal of an 
institution for the deaf and dumb to turn idiots and feeble-minded 
children away from his school—children who hear perfectly, but 
cannot speak. Although it is evidently fallacious to argue that, 
because all deaf infants are dumb, and all idiots are dumb; there- 
fore all deaf infants are idiots: still this kind of reasoning is un- 
consciously indulged in by a large proportion of our population ; 
and the majority of those who for the first time visit an institution 


GENERAL MEETING. 51 


for the deaf and dumb express unfeigned astonishment at the bright- 
ness and intelligence displayed by the pupils. 


Why Hearing Children who become Deaf also become Dumb. 


I have stated above that children who are born deaf do not natu- 
rally speak because they cannot hear. For the same reason chil- 
dren who lose their hearing after having learned to speak naturally 
tend to lose their speech. They acquired speech through the ear 
by imitating the utterances of their friends and relatives, and when 
they become deaf they gradually forget the true pronunciation of 
the words they know, and have naturally no means of learning the 
pronunciation of new words; heace their speech tends to become 
more and more defective until they finally cease to use spoken 
words at all. 

Adults who become deaf do not usually have defective speech, 
for in their case the habit of speaking has been so fully formed 
that the mere practice of the vocal organs in talking to friends 
prevents loss of distinctness. We can learn, however, from the 
case of Alexander Selkirk how important is constant practice of 
the vocal organs. This man, after about one year’s solitary resi- 
dence upon an island, was found to have nearly forgotten his mother 
tongue; and we find that deaf adults who shrink from society and 
use their vocal organs only on rare occasions acquire peculiarities 
of utterance that are characteristic of persons in their condition, 
although the general intelligibility of their speech is not affected. 


Fallacies Regarding the Nature of Speech. 


The fallacies I have already alluded to respecting the difference 
between those who become deaf in’ childhood and those who become 
deaf in adult life have their origin in a fallacy concerning the nature 
of speech itself. To most people, who do not reflect upon the sub- 
ject, it appears that speech is acquired by a natural process similar 
to that by which we acquire our teeth. Ata certain age the teeth 
make their appearance, and at another age we begin to talk. To 
unreflecting minds it appears that we grow into speech; that speech 
is a natural product of the vocal organs, produced without instruc- 
tion and education ; and this leads directly to the fallacy that where 
speech is wanting or imperfect the vocal organs are defective. 

I have already stated that this cause has been assigned in expla- 


52 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


nation of the dumbness of children who are deaf. The idea gives 
rise also to the popular notion that stammering and other defects of 
speech are diseases to be “cured,” and the attempt has been made 
to do so, even by heroic treatment. It is not so very long ago that 
slices have been cut from the tongue of a stammerer, in the vain 
hope of “curing” what was, after all, but a bad habit of speech. 
I have myself known of cases where the uvula has been excised to 
correct the same defect. The dumbness of the deaf and the defect- 
ive speech of the hearing are some of the penalties we pay for ac- 
quiring speech ignorantly, by mere imitation. If parents realized 
that stammering and other defects of speech were caused by igno- 
rance of the actions of the vocal organs, and not necessarily through 
any defect of the meuth, they would have their children taught the 
use of the vocal organs by articulation teachers, instead of patron- 
izing the widely-advertised specialty physicians, who pretend by 
secret means to “cure” what is not a disease. Speech is naturally 
acquired by imitation, and through the same agency defects of 
speech are propagated. A child copies the defective utterance of 
his father. A school-fellow mocks a stammering companion, and 
becomes himself similarly affected. In the one case the fallacy that 
the supposed disease is hereditary prevents attempts at instruction 
and correction, and in the other the idea that the affliction is the 
judgment of God in the way of punishment discourages the afflicted 
person and renders him utterly hopeless of any escape excepting by 
a miracle. 

A practical illustration of the fact that defective speech is prop- 
agated by imitation is shown in my own case. When I was a boy 
my father was a teacher of elocution, and had living with him at 
one time one or two pupils who stammered. While under the care 
of my father, these boys spoke clearly and well, without any ap- 
parent defect, but, owing to his being called away for a protracted 
period of time, his pupils relapsed, and the boys commenced to 
stammer as badly as at first. Upon my father’s return he found a 
house full of stammerers. His own sons were stammering too! I 
can well remember the process of instruction through which I 
went before the defect was corrected in my own case, 


Ignorance the Real Difficulty in the Way of Teaching Deaf Children 
to Speak. 


Speech is the mechanical result of certain adjustments of the 


GENERAL MEETING. 53 


vocal organs, and if we can teach deaf children the correct adjust- 
ments of the perfect organs they possess, they will speak. The diffi- 
culty lies with us. We learn to speak by imitating the sounds we 
hear, in utter ignorance of the action of the organs that accompa- 
nies the sounds. I find myself addressing an audience composed of 
scientific men, including many of the most eminent persons in the 
country, and I wonder how many there are in this room who could 
give an intelligible account of the movements of their vocal organs 
in uttering the simplest sentence? We must study the mechanism 
of speech, and when we know what are the correct adjustments of 
the organs concerned, ingenuity and skill will find the means of 
teaching perfect articulation to the deaf. 


The Old Fallacy—“ Without Speech, no Reason.” 


I have already stated that children who are born deaf are also 
always dumb. How, then, can they think? It is difficult for us to 
realize the possibility of a train of thought being carried on with- 
out words; but what words can a deaf child know, who has never 
heard the sounds of speech ? 

When we think, we think in words, though we may not actually 
utter sounds. Let us eliminate from our consciousness the train of 
words, and what remains? I do not venture to answer the ques- 
tion ; but it is this, and this alone, that belongs to the thoughts of 
a deaf child. 

It is hardly to be wondered at, therefore, that the fallacy should 
have arisen in the past that there could be no thought without 
speech ; and this fallacy prevented for hundreds of years any attempt 
at the education of the deaf. Before the end of the last century 
deaf-mutes were classed among the idiots and insane; they had no 
civil rights, could hold no property ; they were irresponsible beings. 
Even those interested in the religious welfare of the world consigned 
their souls to the wrong place, for “faith comes by hearing,” and 
how could a deaf child be saved? I say that for hundreds of years 
the old fallacy, that “without speech there could be no reason,” 
hindered and prevented any attempt at the amelioration of the con- 
dition of the deaf. But, strange to say, it was this very fallacy that 
first led to their education. It was attempted, by a miracle to teach 
them to speak. 

In Bede’s History of the Anglo-Saxon church we read “ How Bish- 
opp John cured a dumme man with blessing him.” 


54 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


“ And when one weeke of Lent was past, the next sounday he 
willed the poore man to come unto him; when he was come, he 
bydd him put out his tounge and show it unto him, and taking him 
by the chinne, made the signe of the holy crosse upon his tounge, 
and when he had so signed and blessed it, he commaunded him to 
plucke it in again, and speake saying, speake, me one word, say 
gea, gea, which in the english tounge is a worde of affirmation and 
consent in such signification as yea, yea.* Incontinent the stringes 
of his tounge were loosed, and he said that which was commanded 
him to say. The bishopp added certain letters by name, and bid 
him say A; he said A; say B, he said B, and when he had said 
and recited after the bishopp.the whole cross rewe he put upon him 
sillables and hole wordes to be pronounced. Unto which when he 
answered in all pointes orderly, he commaunded him to speake long 
sentences, and so he did; and ceased not all that day and night 
following, so longe as he could hold up his head from sleepe (as 
they make report that were present) to speake and declare his secret 
thoughtes and purposes, which before that day he could never utter 
to any man.”’} 

Now, stripped of the miraculous, this is simply a case of articula- 
tion teaching. In the other countries of Europe the first attempts at 
the education of the deaf were also made by teaching them to speak, 
and as the early teachers were monks of the Roman Catholic 
Church, it is probable that these schools resulted from the attempts 
to perform the miracle of healing the dumb. <A large proportion 
of the deaf and dumb who were thus brought together were success- 
fully taught to articulate. 

But now comes a marvel: It was found by the old monks that 
their pupils came to understand the utterances of others by watch- 
ing the mouth. Such a statement appears more marvelous to those 
who understand the mechanism of speech than to those who are 
ignorant of it; and there is a general tendency to consider this ac- 
complishment as among the fictitious embellishments of the old nar- 
ratives. But the experience of modern teachers confirms the fact. 
John Bulwer, who is said to have been the earliest English writer 
upon the subject of the instruction of the deaf and dumb, published 


* It will be remembered that the original of this was in Latin, and that “the 
english tounge’? here means what we now call the Anglo Saxon. 
+ American Annals of the Deaf and Dumb, vol. I, p. 33 (1848). 


GENERAL MEETING. 55 


in the year 1648 a treatise entitled “ Philocophus; or, the Deaf and 
Dumbe Man’s Friend. Exhibiting the Philosophicall verity of that 
subtile Art, which may inable one with an observant Hie, to Heare 
what any man speaks by the moving of his lips. Upon the same 
Ground, with the advantage.of an Historicall Exemplification, ap- 
parently proving, That a Man Borne Deafe and Dumbe may be 
taught to Heare the sound of words with his Hie, and thence learn 
to speak with his tongue.” 


Articulation Teaching in America. 


In Europe at the present time deaf children are much more com- 
monly taught to speak and undérstand speech than in this country. 

In the majority of our schools and institutions articulation and 
speech-reading are taught to only a favored few, and in these schools 
no use is made of articulation as a means of communication. A 
considerable number of the deaf children in our institutions could 
once hear and speak, and those pupils who retain some knowledge 
of spoken language have their vocal organs exercised for an hour 
or so a day in an articulation class under a special articulation 
teacher, but this is not enough exercise to retain the speech. I have 
seen a boy who became deaf at 12 years of age, and who had previ- 
ously attended one of our public schools, go into an institution for 
the deaf and dumb talking as readily as you or I and come out a 
deaf mute. 

Few, if any, attempts are made to teach articulation to those who 
have not naturally spoken, except at the special request of parents 
who desire that the experiment shall be tried with their children. 

I have seen a congenital deaf mute, who also had a sister deaf and 
dumb, who was taught to speak in adult life, and I found upon ex- 
periment that he could understand by ear the words and sentences 
that he had been taught to articulate when they were spoken in an 
ordinary tone of voice about a foot behind his head, yet this young 
man had been educated at one of our best institutions without ac- 
quiring articulation, and as a consequence he grew up a deaf mute 
and married a deaf mute. He informed me himself that he could 
hear the people talking in the workshop where he was employed, 
but did not understand what they said. 

As a matter of personal observation I am convinced that a large 
proportion of the congenitally deaf are only hard of hearing, and 
this belief is supported by the fact that it used to be the custom in 


56 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


some of our institutions to summon the pupils from the play-ground 
by the ringing of a bell! Does this not indicate that a large num- 
ber of the pupils could hear the ringing of the bell, and that they 
told the others who could not hear atall? Such pupils could have 
been taught to speak at home by their friendsif artificial assistance 
had been given to their hearing. There was no necessity for their 
ever becoming deaf and dumb. 

It is only within the last fifteen years or thereabouts that schools 
have been established in the United States where all the deaf chil- 
dren admitted are taught articulation and speech-reading, but such 
schools are rapidly increasing in number. Still, it is not generally 
known that the experimental stage has passed, and that all deaf 
mutes can be taught intelligible speech. This is now done in Italy 
and Germany, and the international conventions of teachers of the 
deaf and dumb held recently at Milan and Brussels have decided 
in favor of articulation for the deaf. 

I have stated before that the difficulties in the way of teaching 
articulation are external to the deaf. They lie with us and in our 
general ignorance of the mechanism of speech. A teacher who does 
not himself understand the mechanism of speech is hardly competent 
to produce the best results. So dense is the general ignorance upon 
this subject that it is probable that of the 50,000,000 of people in 
this country the number of persons who are familiar with all that 
is known concerning the mechanism of speech might be numbered 
on the two hands. Considering this, the success obtained in our 
articulation schools is gratifying and wonderful. 


Upon the Art of Understanding Speech by the Eye. 


It has been found in the articulation schools of this country that 
deaf children can acquire the art of understanding by eye the utter- 
ances of their friends and relatives, and this fact has led some 
teachers to suppose that speech is as clearly visible to the eye as it 
is to the ear, and this fallacy tends to hinder the acquisition of the 
art by their pupils. 

When we examine the visibility of the elementary sounds of our 
language we find that the majority can not be clearly distinguished 
by the eye. How then, you may ask, can a deaf child who cannot 
distinguish the elements understand words which are combinations 
of these elements? 

When the lips are closed we cannot see what is going on inside 


GENERAL MEETING. Be 


the mouth. The elementary sounds of our language, represented 
by the letters P, B, and M, involve a closure of the lips. Hence 
the differences of adjustment that originate the differences of sound 
are interior and cannot be seen. But while the deaf child may not 
be able to say definitely whether the sound you utter is P, B, or M, 
he knows certainly that it must be one of these three, for no other 
sounds involve a closure of the lips. And so with the other ele- 
ments of our language. While he may not be able to tell definitely 
the particular element to which you give utterance, he can gener- 
ally refer it to a group of sounds that present the same appearance 
to the eye. In the same manner he may not be able to tell the pre- 
cise word that you utter, but he can refer it to a group of words 
having the sameappearance. For instance, the words “ pat,” “bat,” 
and “mat” have the same appearance to the eye. While he can- 
not tell which of these words you mean when it is uttered singly, 
he readily distinguishes it in a sentence by the context. For in- 
stance, were you to say that you had wiped your feet upon a “ mat,” 
the word could not be “ pat” and it could not be “ bat.” 

Here we come to the key to the art of understanding speech by 
the eye—Context. But this involves, as a prerequisite, a compe- 
tent knowledge of the English language; and we may particularly 
distinguish those children who have acquired the art from those 
who have not, by their superior attainments in this respect. We 
can, therefore, see why children who have become deaf after hav- 
ing learned to speak, naturally acquire this power to a greater ex- 
tent than those who are born deaf. 

There are many cases of congenitally deaf children who have ac- 
quired this art as perfectly as those who have become deaf from 
disease; but in every case such children have been thoroughly 
familiar with the English language, at least in its written form. 


Fallacies Regarding Speech-reading. 


The fallacy that speech is as clearly visible to the eye as it is 
audible to the ear hinders the acquisition of the art by causing the 
teacher to articulate slowly and word by word, even opening the 
mouth to its widest extent to make the actions of the organs more 
visible. When we realize that context is the key to speech-read- 
ing, theory asserts that ordinary conversational speech should be 
more intelligible than slow and labored articulation. This is amply 
proved by the experience of the most accomplished speech-readers. 

8 


58 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


I have been told by one who has acquired this art that when intro- 
duced to strangers their speech is more readily understood if they 
are not aware they are speaking to one who cannot hear. The 
moment they are told they commence to speak slowly and open 
their mouths to an unnatural extent, thus rendering their articula- 
tion partially unintelligible. The change brought about by the 
knowledge that the listener could not hear was sometimes sudden and 
great. 

Ihave lately made an examination of the visibility of all the 
words in our language contained in a small pocket dictionary, and 
the result has assured me that there are glorious possibilities in the 
way of teaching speech-reading to the deaf, if teachers will give 
special attention to the subject. 

One of the results of my investigation has been that the ambigui- 
ties of speech are confined to the little words, chiefly to monosylla- 
bles. The longer words are nearly all clearly intelligible. The 
reason is obvious, for the greater number of elements there are in a 
word the less likelihood is there that another word can be found 
that presents exactly the same outline to the eye. 

We need never be afraid, therefore, of using long words to a deaf 
child, if they are within his comprehension. We are apt to have 
the idea that short words will be simpler, and we sometimes try to 
compose sentences consisting as much as possible of monosyllabic 
words, under the impression that such words are easy for the pupil 
to pronounce and read from the mouth. It is more common, there- 
fore, to present such sentences to beginners than to more advanced 
pupils. Now, I do not mean to say that these sentences may not be 
easier for a child to pronounce, but the words used are the most 
ambiguous to the eye. Such a simple word as “ man,” for instance, 
is homophenous with no less than thirteen other words. 

A few years ago I dictated a string of words to some pupils, with 
the object of testing whether they judged by context or were able 
to distinguish words clearly by the eye. The results are instruct- 
ive. Among the words dictated occurred the following: “ Hit— 
rate— ferry — aren’t —hat— four — that — reason — high — knit— 
donned—co.” I told the pupils not to mind whether they under- 
stood what I said or not, but simply to write down what they thought 
the words looked like, and what do you think they wrote? Upon 
examining their slates I found that nearly every child had written 
the following sentence: “It rained very hard, and for that reason 


GENERAL MEETING. 59 


I did not go.” I told the pupils to be very careful to observe 
whether they could distinguish any difference between the words I 
uttered and the words they wrote. I therefore went over the whole 
string of words again, articulating them one by one very distinctly. 
No difference whatever was detected. 

The mother of one of my pupils was present, aa was greatly as- 
tonished to see her daughter writing down words so different from 
those I had pronounced. She said that she could not have believed 
that her daughter could have been so stupid; but her surprise was 
increased when she found that the other children had written the 
same sentence. I told her that there was no difference in appear- 
ance between the words I had uttered and the words they had writ- 
ten. She desired to test the matter herself with her own child. 
She asked her daughter to repeat after her the words I had written, 
but the result was the same. The last part of the sentence she re- 
peated at least a dozen times, without shaking her daughter’s con- 
fidence in the belief that the words she had uttered were precisely 
the same as those spoken by her mother. To one who could hear, 
it was a startling revelation to observe the confidence of the child 
in the accuracy of her replies. 

“ Repeat after me,” said the mother, as she pronounced the words 
singly and with deliberate distinctness : “high ;” answer, “I; “ knit,” 
ans., “did ;” “donned,” ans., “not;” “co,” ans., “go.” “Are you 
sure you have pronounced the words exactly as I have said them ?” 
Ans. “Yes; perfectly certain.” ‘Try again.” “ Knit,” answer, 
“did ;” “donned,” answer “not.” ‘Are you sure I said that?” 
Ans. “Yes; absolutely sure.” “ Try again,” and here the mother 
mouthed the word “donned,” ans., “not.” The mother was con- 
vinced, and she left the room with the remark that she felt that she 
had been very cruel to her child through ignorance of the fact that 
words that were very different to her ear looked alike to her child, 
and could not possibly be distinguished, excepting by context. 

I have seen a teacher attempting to impart instruction to a deaf 
child by word of mouth. She would speak word by word, and the 
pupil would repeat after her. Upon one occasion the pupil gave 
utterance to a very different word from that which had been spoken 
by the teacher. The latter repeated the word a number of times, 
opening her mouth to the widest extent, and the boy each time re- 
peated the incorrect expression. The teacher grew annoyed at the 
supposed stupidity of the pupil, and the pupil grew sulky, and was 


60 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


discouraged in his attempt to read from the mouth; whereas, in 
reality, it was not the stupidity of the boy that was in the way of 
his progress, but the ignorance of the teacher, who did not know 


that the words that were so different to her ear were absolutely alike 
to his eye. 


Some teachers, in their anxiety to teach speech-reading to their 
pupils, have the idea that they should refrain from every other 
mode of communication, so that their pupils may be forced to ob- 
serve the movements of the mouth, and the mouth alone. For in- 
stance, it is easy to write an ambiguous word or to spell it by a 
manual alphabet, but some teachers refrain from doing so, under 
the impression that this practice leads the pupil to depend upon 
the hand instead of the mouth. 

Again, deaf persons gather an idea of the emotion that actuates 
a speaker by the expression of his countenance. In fact facial 
expression is to the eye what the modulation of the voice is to the 
ear. It gives life to the inaudible utterances of the mouth; but 
there are some teachers who are so afraid that their pupils may 
come to depend upon the face instead of the mouth, that they think 
they should assume an impassive countenance from which nothing 
could be inferred. 


Requisites to the Art of Speech-reading. 


If we examine the visibility of speech and the causes of its in- 
telligibility, we shall find that there are three qualifications that 
must be possessed by a deaf child in order that he may understand 
readily the utterances of his friends. Omit any one of these quali- 
fications and good speech-reading is an impossibility : 

I. The eye must be trained to recognize readily those movements 
of the vocal organs that are visible. Has this ever been done? 
Have not pupils been required to grapple with all the difficulties of 
speech-reading at once, and to observe not only the movements of 
the vocal organs, but to find out the meaning of what is said? 

II. I have already explained that certain words have the same 
appearance to the eye, and it is necessary, if the pupil is to under- 
stand general conversation, that he shall know the words that look 
alike, so that a given series of movements of the vocal organs shall 
suggest to his mind not a single word, but a group of words, from 
which selection is to be made by context.” 

An illustration will explain what 1 mean. There are many 


GENERAL MEETING. 61 


words which have the same sound to the ear, but different signifi- 
cations. For instance, were I to ask you to spell the word “ rane,” 
you could not tell whether I meant “rain,” “rein,” or “reign.” 
These words sound alike, but they lead to no confusion, for they 
are readily distinguished by context. In the same way “homo- 
phenous words,” or words that have the same appearance to the 
eye, are readily distinguished by context. 

As a general rule when a teacher finds that her pupil does not 
understand a given word, she supposes the non-comprehension to 
be due to an untrained eye, and this leads to the patient repetition 
of the word with widely opened mouth, to make the action of the 
organs more visible. This, unintentionally, enables the pupil to 
acquire a knowledge of homophenous words; for, when he fails to 
understand in the first instance, he is requested to try again. He 
then guesses at the meaning. He thinks of all the words that past 
experience has taught him looked something like the word pro- 
posed, and after a series of guesses generally succeeds in his at- 
tempt to unravel the meaning. 

In this way success comes at last, not in consequence of the pupil 
seeing more than he saw at first, but in consequence of knowledge 
gained by experience of failure. He learns what words present the 
same appearance to the eye. Let teachers find out the words that 
look alike, and teach them in groups to their pupils. In this way 
instruction will take the place of painful experience. 

Ill. The third requisite to good speech-reading is familiarity 
with the English language. Familiarity with our language, either 
in its written or spoken form, is absolutely essential in order that 
a deaf person may make use of context in his attempt to decipher 
our speech. It is a mental problem that the deaf child has to 
solve and not solely a problem of vision. The eyes of the con- 
genitally deaf, if there is any difference at all, are rather stronger 
and better than the eyes of those who become deaf from disease; 
and yet, as a class, the congenitally deaf acquire the art of speech- 
reading with much more difficulty than those who could speak be- 
fore they became deaf. The reason is, that, as a class, the former 
have not a vernacular knowledge of our language even in its writ- 
ten form, while the latter have. Children who become deaf in 
infancy from disease are at as great a disadvantage in this respect 
as the congenitally deaf, and for the same reason. 

I shall inquire more particularly into the cause of this lack of 


62 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


familiarity with the English language, and I shall show that it 
results from a wide-spread fallacy regarding the nature of language 
and the means by which our language should be taught. In the 
meantime I shall simply direct attention to the fact that those who 
are deaf from infancy do not, as a general rule, become familiar 
with the English language even in its written form. 

It is obvious that if we talk to deaf children by word of mouth, 
and refrain from explaining, by writing or some other clearly visi- 
ble means, the words that are ambiguous, those pupils who are 
already familiar with the language have very great advantages 
over the others. They have a fund of words from which to draw, 
they can guess at the ambiguous word and substitute other words 
within their knowledge so as finally to arrive at the correct mean- 
ing. But young children who have been deaf from infancy and 
who never, therefore, have known our language, are not qualified 
at once for this species of guess-work. They know no words ex- 
cepting those we teach them, and haye, therefore, no fund to draw 
upon in case of perplexity. If we commence the education of 
such children by speech-reading alone they are plunged into dif- 
ficulties to which they have not the key. 

To such children it becomes a matter of absolute necessity that 
our language should be presented to them in an unambiguous form. 
With such pupils, writing should be the main reliance, and speech- 
reading can only be satisfactorily acquired by the constant accom- 
paniment of writing, or its equivalent—a manual alphabet. I have 
no hesitation in saying that the attempt to carry on the general 
education of young children who are deaf from infancy by means 
of articulation and speech-reading alone, without the habitual use 
of English in a more clearly visible form, would tend to retard their 
mental development. Ido not mean to say that this is ever actu- 
ally done, but I know there is a tendency among teachers of articu- 
lation to rely too much upon the general intelligibility of their 
speech. Let them realize that the intelligibility is almost entirely _ 
due to context, and they will rely more upon writing and less upon 
the mouth in their instructions to young congenitally deaf children. 

After a probationary period, pupils who could speak before they 
became deaf become so expert in speech-reading that the regular 
instruction of the school-room can be carried on through its means 
without detriment to the pupil’s progress. The exceptional cases 
of congenitally deaf persons who have become expert in this art 


9 


GENERAL MEETING. 63 


assures us that, with all who are deaf from infancy, we can cer- 
tainly achieve the same results if only we can give them a sufficient 
knowledge of our language, at least in its written form. In the 
early stages of the education of the congenitally deaf it appears to 
me that written English should be made the vernacular of the 
school-room, and that all words or sentences written should also be 
spoken by the teacher and read by the pupils from the mouth. 
When the English language has become vernacular there is no 
reason why instruction should not also be given by word of mouth 
alone (as in the case of those who could speak before they became 
deaf’) without interfering with mental development. 

Before leaving this subject I would say that it is of importance 
to remember that speaking and understanding speech by the eye 
are two very different things. We can all of us speak very readily, 
but I fancy it would puzzle most of us to be called upon to tell what 
a speaker says by watching his mouth. The congenitally deaf can 
certainly be taught to speak intelligibly even by persons unfamiliar 
with the mechanism of articulation. Such pupils should therefore 
be taught to articulate, and their vocal organs should be continually 
exercised in the school-room by causing them to speak as well as to 
write. The congenitally deaf can be taught to articulate even be- 
fore they are familiar with English, but I do not think they can 
acquire the power of understanding ordinary conversational speech 
by watching the mouth, at least to any great extent, until after they 
have become familiar with our language. 


Gesture Language. 


I have already stated that the old fallacy, “ without speech there 
can be no reason,” prevented for hundreds of years any attempt at 
the education of the deaf and dumb, and now I come to the mem- 
orable experiment that forever exploded the fallacy. Towards the 
latter end of the last century the Abbe de l’Epee, during the course 
of his ministration in Paris, entered a room in which two girls were 
sewing. He addressed some remarks to them, but received no reply. 
These girls were deaf and dumb. At once the kind heart of the 
good Abbe was touched, and he determined to devote his life to the 
amelioration of the condition of the deaf and dumb. 

He gathered together quite a number of deaf children, who made 
their home with{him. He spent his time in their society and de- 
voted to their comfort all that he possessed, reducing himself even 


64 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON, 


to poverty for their sake. He soon observed that these children 
were communicating with one another, but not by speech. They 
were inventing a language of their own, unlike any of the spoken 
languages of the earth—a language of gestures. These children 
were reasoning by means of this language; they were thinking in 
gestures instead of in words, and the idea occurred to the Abbe de 
l’Epee that the old dogma that had for so many hundred years pre- 
vented the education of the deaf was a fallacy. Here was nature 
developing an instrument of reason with which speech had nothing 
to do. Why should he not study this gesture language and assist 
these children in their attempts to perfect a means of communica- 
tion of this kind, and why should he not use this means of com- 
munication so as to lead their minds to higher and ever higher 
thoughts? He did so and succeeded in developing the “sign lan- 
guage” that is now so extensively employed in this country in 
the education of the deaf. The experiment at once attracted at- 
tention. Kings and Emperors visited the humble abode of the 
Abbe de l’Epee and were astonished by what they saw. He con- 
versed with his pupils in the gesture language, and he taught them 
through its means the meaning of written French, so that they were 
enabled to communicate with hearing persons by writing. 


The Fallacy that a Gesture Language is the only Form of Language 
that is Natural to the Congenitally Deaf. 


The old fallacy was done away with, but a new one immediately 
took its place, which has been introduced into our country with the 
language of signs, and is now the main: obstacle to the acquisition 
of English by the congenitally deaf. The fallacy to which I allude 
is that this gesture language is the only language that is natural to 
the congenitally deaf, and that therefore such children must acquire 
this language as their vernacular before learning the English lan- 
guage, and must be taught the meaning of the latter through its 
means. To my mind such a statement consists of a succession of 
fallacies, each one resting on the preceding. The proposition that 
the sign language is the only language that is natural to congeni- 
tally deaf children is like the proposition that the English language 
is the only language that is natural to hearing children. It is nat- 
ural only in the same sense that English is natural to an American 
child. It is the language of the people by whom he is surrounded. 
A congenitally deaf child who for the first time enters an insti- 


GENERAL MEETING. 65 


tution for the deaf and dumb finds the pupils and teachers em- 
ploying a gesture language which he does not understand; but in 
time he comes to understand it, and learns by imitation to use it, 
just as an American child in Germany comes in time to understand 
and speak German. 

Although congenitally deaf children, when they enter an institu- 
tion, do not understard or use the sign language as there employed, 
they each know and use a gesture language of some kind, which 
they employ at home in communicating with their friends and rela- 
tives. Hence it is argued that if the “sign language” employed in 
our institutions is not the only one, a gesture language of some kind 
is necessarily the vernacular of the congenitally deaf child. The 
scope of the statement is thus widened, and the proposition we have 
now to consider may be thus expressed: Gesture language, in the 
wider sense, is the only forin of language that is natural to those 
who are congenitally deaf. 

It is a matter of great importance to the 34,000 deaf-mutes of 
this country, and to their friends and relatives, as well as to all 
persons who are interested in the amelioration of the condition of 
the deaf and dumb, that we examine this proposition with care and 
decide whether it is a fallacy or not. To my mind it is a fallacy 
based upon another concerning the nature of language itself, namely, 
that there is such a thing as a natural language. Such an idea has 
led to errors in the past, and will ever continue todoso. Wehave 
all read of the monarch of ancient times, who is recorded to have 
shut up a number of little children by themselves, and to have 
given orders to their attendants to hold no communication with 
them, so that he might observe what language they would naturally 
speak as they grew up. It is recorded that the first word uttered 
was a Greek word, from which it was argued that the Greek lan- 
guage was the natural language of mankind. 

In the seventeenth century the ingenious Van Helmont was im- 
bued with the idea that the Hebrew language was of divine origin, 
from which he argued that Hebrew was the natural language of 
mankind, and that the shapes of the Hebrew letters had some nat- 
ural relation to the sounds they represented ; that they pictured, in 
fact, the positions of the vocal organs in forming the sounds. The 
latter idea led him to employ the characters as a means of teaching 
articulation to a deaf-mute; but the former idea led him to teach 
his deaf-mute Hebrew, instead of his native tongue. 


66 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


When we examine the languages of the world that are naturally 
acquired by hearing children, we fail to discover any natural con- 
nection between the sounds of the words and the things they repre- 
sent ; everything is arbitrary and conventional. 


Origin and Mode of Growth of a Gesture Language. 


Now, let us examine for a moment the nature of a gesture lan- 
guage and the manner in which it comes into existence. You are, 
we shall suppose, a farmer, and your little deaf boy comes run- 
ning into the house in great excitement, anxious to tell you some- 
thing he has observed. How does he do so? 

We shall imagine a case. He commences by placing his hands 
above his head, bowing Jow, and marching about the room, after 
which he points out of the window. 

You shake your head; you have not the remotest idea what he 
means. 

His face assumes an anxious look, and down he goes upon his 
hands and knees, and scrambles over the floor, touching the carpet 
with his mouth from time to time, and then again points out of the 
window. 

Still you do not comprehend. 

A look of perplexity crosses his face. What can he do to make 
you understand? At last his face lights up, as a new thought comes 
into his mind, and he touches the bridge of his nose and again points 
out of the window. 

But, alas! alas! you cannot understand. 

The little fellow is perplexed and troubled. At last, in despair, 
he takes hold of your coat and pulls you out of the door, around 
the corner, and you find your cow in the turnip patch. 

Now you begin to understand what it was he meant to say; he 
had tried to picture the cow, and to imitate its actions. The 
hands held above the head had indicated the horns ; the scrambling 
on the floor on his hands and knees had imitated the action of a 
four-footed animal, and his mouth to the carpet meant the cow 
eating the turnips. 

But how about the bridge of his nose? 4. 

You will probably observe that the cow to which he referred had 
some white spot or other mark upon the nose, and the gesture of the 
child had not indicated a cow in general, but your black cow 
“ Bessie,” with the white spot on her nose, in particular. 


GENERAL MEETING. 67 


Having advanced thus far in the comprehension of his meaning, 
do you think that the child will take the trouble to go through this 
same pantomime the next time he wishes to tell you about your 
cow? No. He may commence such a pantomime, but before he 
gets half through you understand what he means, and he never 
completes it. A process of abbreviation commences, until finally a 
touch on the bridge of his nose alone becomes the name of your 
black cow “ Bessie,” and the simple holding of his hands above his 
head conveys to your mind the idea of a cow in general. 

By a natural process of abbreviation the child arrives at a sim- 
ple gesture or sign for every object or thing in which he is inter- 
ested. 

But there are many thoughts he desires to express which are ab- 
stract in their nature. How, for instance, can he indicate by any 
sign the color of an object? Suppose, by way of illustration, that 
he desired to communicate to you the idea that he had seen in the 
road a cow that was perfectly white? 

I shall try to depict the conversation between yourself and your 
deaf boy as it might actually have occurred. 

THE Boy. The boy points to the road, touches his teeth, and holds 
his hands above his head. 

You gather from this a vague idea of some connection between 
that road, the boy's teeth, and a cow. 

Here is a problem: What did he mean? It is pretty clear that 
he had seen a cow in the road, but what connection had his teeth 
with that? Perhaps the cow’s teeth were peculiar. You think you 
had better get him to explain, so— 

THE FATHER. You touch your teeth with an interrogative and 
puzzled look. 

Tue Boy. The boy responds by showing you his shirt sleeve and 
pointing to the road. ; 

Can he mean that there was any connection between his shirt 
sleeve and the cow. To clear this point— 

THE FATHER. You touch his shirt sleeve and raise your hands 
above your head with a look of interrogation. 

Tur Boy. The boy nods vigorously, raises his hands above his 
head, and makes his sign for “snow,” followed by other signs for 
objects that are white. 

After he has presented a sufficient number of such signs, you per- 
ceive that the one thing common to them all was their color—they 


68 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


were white. And thus you gain the idea that the cow was white. 

Do you suppose he goes through this process every time he desires 
to communicate the idea of white? No; he remembers the object 
which had conveyed to your mind the idea that that cow was white, 
and the sign for this object is ever after used as an adjective, quali- 
fying the object the whiteness of which he desires to indicate. Of 
course you cannot predicate what this particular sign may be. I 
have seen children who have conveyed the idea by touching their 
teeth; others who expressed it by an undulatory downward move- 
ment of the hand, expressive of the way in which a snow-flake falls 
to the ground. 

It will thus be understood that a deaf child first commences to 
express his ideas by pantomime, and that by a process of abbrevia- 
tion pantomimic gestures come to be used in a conventional manner. 
Pantomime is no more entitled to the name of language than a 
picture is, although many ideas can be conveyed through its means. 
In proportion as it becomes more conventional and arbitrary it be- 
comes more and more worthy of the name of language. 


The Sign-Language of Our Institutions. 


Now, when the deaf children who lived with the Abbe de l’Epee 
were first brought together, each of them used a gesture-language 
he had invented for himself as a means of communicating with his 
friends at home. Thus there were as many gesture-languages as 
there were children. The only element common to these languages 
was probably the pantomime from which they had allsprung. But 
now what happened? Association and the necessity of intercom- 
munication led to the adoption of common signs. Each child pre- 
sented his gestures to his fellows, and by a process of selection those 
signs that appeared to the majority to be most fitting survived, and 
were adopted by the wltole; and the synonymous signs, which were 
not so well fitted, were either forgotten by disuse or used in a new 
meaning to express other ideas. 

I do not wonder at the interest displayed in this growth by the 
Abbe de L’Epee and his contemporaries. To my mind it was the 
most interesting and instructive spectacle that has ever been pre- 
sented to the mind of man—the gradual evolution of an organized 
language from simple pantomime. 

When, in 1817, the first school for the deaf and dumb was opened 
in America, the sign-language as used in the school of the Abbe de 

“ 


GENERAL MEETING. ‘69 


]’Epee (then under the charge of his successor, the Abbe Sicard) 
was imported from France, and became the medium of instruction. 
The teachers trained in this school naturally became the principals 
of other institutions established upon its model, and thus the sign- 
language has been diffused over the length and breadth of our Jand. 

I heartily agree with all that experienced teachers of the deaf 
have urged concerning the beauty and great interest of this gesture 
language. It is indeed interesting to observe how pantomimic ges- 
tures have been abbreviated to simple signs expressive of concrete 
ideas; how these have been compounded or have changed their 
meaning to indicate abstract thoughts; and how the sequence of 
the sign-words has to a certain extent become obligatory, thus 
forming a sort of gesture syntax or grammar. 

The original stock or stocks from which our languages are derived 
must have disappeared from earth ages before historic times; but 
in the gesture speech of the deaf we have a language whose history 
can be traced ab origine, and it has appeared to me that this fact 
should give it a unique and independent value. In the year 1878, 
in a paper read before the Anthropological Society of London, I 
advocated the study of the gesture language by men of science ; 
for it seemed to me that the study of the mode in which the sign 
language has arisen from pantomime might throw a flood of light 
upon the origin and mode of growth of all languages. 

You may ask why it is that, with my high appreciation of this 
language as a language, I should advocate its entire abolition in 
our institutions for the deaf. 

IT admit all that has been urged by experienced teachers con- 
cerning the ease with which a deaf child acquires this language, 
and its perfect adaptability for the purpose of developing his mind ; 
but after all it is not the language of the millions of people among 
whom his lot in life is cast. It is to them a foreign tongue, and 
the more he becomes habituated to its use the more he becomes a 
stranger in his own country. 

This is not denied by teachers of the deaf and dumb, but the 
argument is made, as I have stated above, that it is the only lan- 
guage that is natural to congenitally deaf children, or that at all 
events, some form of gesture language must necessarily be their 
vernacular, and be employed to teach our English tongue. 


70 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The Fallacy that a Gesture Language is the only form of Language 
in which a Congenitally Deaf Child can Think. 


Now what do we mean by a language being “ natural” or not? 
I cannot believe that in this 19th century any one really entertains 
the fallacy that there is a natural language per se. So I presume 
that that language is considered natural to a person in which he 
thinks. Under this meaning the proposition assumes this shape: 
The sign language taught in our institutions, or a gesture language 
of some kind, is the only form of language in which a congenitally 
deaf child can think; that is, it is the only language of which the 
elements can be associated directly with the ideas they express. 

In this form the fallacy is easily exploded, for in the course of 
the last one hundred years so many experiments have been made 
in the education of the deaf that we now know with absolute cer- 
tainty that deaf children can be taught to associate written words 
directly with the ideas they represent; and when they are taught 
to spell these words by a manual alphabet, the movements of the 
fingers become so natural a method of giving vent to their thoughts 
that even in sleep their fingers move when they dream. 

Not only has written English been made the vernacular of con- 
genitally deaf children, but the same result has been achieved with 
written French, German, Spanish, Dutch, and other languages. 

Congenitally deaf children who have been taught articulation 
move their mouths in their sleep and give utterance to words when 
they dream. 

Laura Bridgman, the blind deaf-mute, was taught by the late 
Dr. Howe to gather ideas through the sense of touch. English 
words printed in raised letters were presented to her sense of touch 
in connection with the objects which they represented, and she 
associated the impressions produced upon the ends of her fingers 
with the objects themselves. The English language in a tangible 
form became her vernacular. 

All these facts assure us that any form of language may become 
natural to a deaf child by usage, so long as it is presented to the 
senses he possesses. There is only one way that language is natu- 
rally acquired, and that is by usage and imitation. Any form of 
language that can be clearly appreciated by the senses the deaf 
child possesses, will become his vernacular if it is used by those 
about him. 


GENERAL MEETING. 71 


Why the Deaf employ a Gesture Language. 


A gesture language is employed by a deaf child at home, not 
because it is the only language that is natural to one in his con- 
dition, but because his friends neglect to use in his presence any 
other form of language that can be appreciated by his senses. 
Speech is addressed to his ear; but his ear is dead, and the motions 
of the mouth cannot be fully interpreted without previous familiarity 
with the language. On account, therefore, of the neglect of parents 
and friends to present to his eye any clearly visible form of lan- 
guage, the deaf child is forced to invent such a means of communi- 
cation, which his friends then adopt by imitation. I venture to 
express the opinion that no gesture language would be developed 
at home by a deaf child if his parents and friends habitually em- 
ployed, in his presence, the English language in a clearly visible 
form. He would come to understand it by usage, and use it by 
imitation. 

An old writer, George Dalgarno, in 1680, expressed the opinion, 
in which I fully concur, that “there might be successful addresses 
made to a dumb child even in its cradle, risw cognoscere matrem, if 
the mother or nurse had but as nimble a hand as usually they have 
a tongue.” 

When deaf children enter an institution they find the other 
pupils and the teachers using a form of gesture language which 
they do not understand. For the first time in their lives they find 
a language used by those about them that is addressed to the senses 
they possess. After a longer or shorter time they discard the lan- 
guage that they had themselves devised, and acquire, by imitation, 
the sign language of the institution. 


Harmful Results of the Sign Language. 


After a few months residence in the institution, the children re- 
turn to their friends in the holidays using easily and fluently a lan- 
guage that is foreign to them, while of the English language they 
know no more than the average school boy does of French or Ger- 
man after the same period of instruction. The only language they 
can employ in talking to their friends is the crude gesture language 
of their own invention, which they had long before discarded at 
school ; and they perpetually contrast the difficulty and slowness of 
comprehension of their friends with the ease with which their school 
fellows and teachers could understand what they mean. They have 


72 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


learned by experience how sweet a thing it is to communicate freely 
with other minds, and they are continually hampered and annoyed 
by the difficulty they meet with in conversing with their own parents 
and friends. ; 

Can it be wondered at, therefore, that such a child soon tires of 
home? He longs for the school play-ground, and the deaf com- 
panions with whom he can converse so easily. Little by little the 
ties of blood and relationship are weakened, and the institution be- 
comes his home. 

Nor are these all the harmful effects that are directly traceable 
to the habitual use in school, as a means of communication, of a 
language foreign to the mass of the people. Disastrous results are 
traceable inwards in the operation of his mind, and outwards in his 
relation to the external world in adult life. He has learned to 
think in the gesture-language, and his most perfected English ex- 
pressions are only translations of his sign speech. 

As a general rule, when his education is completed, his knowl- 
edge of the English language is like the knowledge of French or 
German possessed by the average hearing child on leaving school. 
He cannot read an ordinary book intelligently without frequent re- 
course to a dictionary. He can understand a good deal of what he 
sees in the newspapers, especially if it concerns what interests him 
personally, and he can generally manage to make people under- 
stand what he wishes by writing, but he writes in broken English, 
as a foreigner would speak. 

Let us consider for a moment the condition of a person whose 
vernacular is different from that of the people by whom he is sur- 
rounded. Place one of our American school boys just graduated 
from school in the heart of Germany. He finds that his knowledge 
of German is not sufficient to enable him to communicate freely 
with the people. He thinks in English, and has to go through a 
mental process of translation before he can understand what is said, 
or can himself say what he means. Constant communication with 
the people involves constant effort and a mental strain. Under 
such circumstances what a pleasure it is for him to meet with a per- 
son who can speak the English tongue. What a felief to be able 
to converse freely once more in his own vernacular. Words arise 
so spontaneously in the mind that the thought seems to evoke the 
proper expression. 

But mark the result: the more he associates with English- 


GENERAL MEETING. 73 


speaking people the less desire does he have to converse in German. 
The practice of the English language prevents progress in the 
aquisition of German. I have known of English people who have 
lived for twenty years in Germany without acquiring the language. 

If our American school boy desires to become familiar with the 
German language, he must resolutely avoid the society of English- 
speaking people. He then finds that the mental effort involved in 
conversation becomes less and less, until, finally, he learns to think 
in German, and his difficulties cease. 

Now consider the case of a deaf boy just graduated from an 
institution where the sign language has been employed as.a means 
of communication. His vernacular is different from that of the 
people by whom he is surrounded. He thinks in the gesture lan- 
guage and has to go through a mental process of translation before 
he can understand what is said or written to him in English, and 
before he can himself speak or write in English what he desires to 
say. He finds himself in America, in the same condition as that 
of the American boy in Germany. If he avoids association with 
those who use the sign language, and courts the society of hearing 
persons, the mental effort involved in conversation becomes less and 
less, and finally he learns to think in English and his difficulties 
cease. 

But such a course involves great determination and perseverance 
on the part of the deaf boy, and few, indeed, are those who succeed. 

Not only do the other deaf-mutes in his locality have the same 
vernacular as his own, but they were his school fellows, and they 
have a common recollection of pleasant years of childhood spent 
in each other’s society. Can it be wondered at, therefore, that the 
vast majority of the deaf graduates of our institutions keep up 
acquaintance with one another in adult life? The more they com- 
municate with one another the less desire they have to associate 
with hearing persons, and the practice of the gesture language 
forms an obstacle to further progress in the acquisition of the 
English language. 

These two causes (a) previous exclusive acquaintance with one 
another in the same school, and (6) a common knowledge of a form 
of language specially adapted for the communication of the deaf 
with the deaf, operate to attract together into the large cities large 
numbers of deaf persons, who form a sort of deaf community or 


society, having very little intercourse with the outside world. 
9 


74 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 

They work at trades or businesses in these towns, and their 
leisure hours are spent almost exclusively in each other’s society. 
Under such circumstances can we be surprised that the majority of 
these deaf persons marry deaf persons, and that we have as 
a result a small but necessarily increasing number of cases of 
hereditary deafness due to this cause. Such unions do not gene- 
rally result.in the production of deaf offspring, because the deaf- 
ness of the parents in a large proportion of cases is of accidental 
origin, and accidental deafness is no more likely to be inherited 
than the accidental loss of a limb. Still I would submit that the 
constant. selection of the deaf by the deaf in marriage is fraught 
with danger to the community. 


Why the English Language should be Substituted for the Sign 
Language as a Vernacular. 


If we examine the position in adult life of deaf children who 
have been taught to speak, or who have acquired the English lan- 
guage as a vernacular, whether in its written or spoken forms, we 
find an entirely different set of tendencies coming into play, especi- 
ally if these persons have not been forced in childhood to make the 
acquaintance of large numbers of other deaf children, by social 
imprisonment for years together in the same school or institution 
apart from the hearing world. 

Their vernacular use of the English language renders it easy for 
them to communicate with hearing persons by writing, or by word 
of mouth if they have been taught to articulate; and hearing per- 
sons can easily communicate with them by writing, or by word or 
mouth if they have been taught the use of the eye as a substitute 
for the ear. The restraints placed upon their intercourse with the 
world by their lack of hearing leads them to seek the society of 
books, and thus they tend to rise mentally to an ever higher and 
higher plane. A cultivated mind delights in the society of edu- 
cated people, and their knowledge of passing events derived from 
newspapers forms an additional bond of union between them and 
the hearing world. 

If they have formed in childhood fow deaf acquaintances, they 
meet in after life hundreds of hearing persons for every deaf acquain- 
tance, and if they marry, the chances are immensely in favor of 
their marrying hearing persons. 

There is nothing in the deaf-mute societies in the large cities to 


GENERAL MEETING. 75 


attract them, and much to repel them; for the more highly edu- 
cated deaf-mutes in these societies speak what is to them a foreign 
language; while the greater number of the deaf-mutes to be found 
there are so ignorant that self-respect forbids them from mingling 
with them. 

Thus the extent of their knowledge of the English language is 
the main determining cause of the congregation or separation of 
the deaf in adult life. A good vernacular knowledge of the Eng- 
lish language operates to effect their absorption into society at 
large, and to weaken the bonds that tend to bring them together ; 
whereas, a poor knowledge of the language of the country they 
live in causes them to be repelled by society and attracted by one 
another ; and these attractive and repulsive tendencies are increased 
and intensified if they have been taught at school a language for- 
eign to society and specially adapted for intercommunication among 
themselves. I say, then, let us banish the sign language from our 
schools. Let the teachers be careful in their intercourse with their 
pupils to use English and English alone. They can write, they can 
speak by word of mouth, they can spell the English words by a 
manual alphabet, and by any or all of these methods they can 
teach English to their pupils as a native tongue. 


Conclusion. 


In conclusion allow me to say: 

1. That those whom we term “ deaf-mutes” have no other natural 
defect than that of hearing. They are simply persons who are 
deaf from childhood and many of them are only “ hard-of-hearing.” 

2. Deaf children are dumb, not on account of lack of hearing, 
but of lack of instruction. No one teaches them to speak. 

3. A gesture language is developed by a deaf child at home, 
not because it is the only form of language that is natural to one 
in his condition, but because his parents and friends neglect to use 
the English language in his presence in a clearly visible form. 

4, (a) The sign language of our institutions is an artificial and 
conventional language derived from pantomime. 

(b) So far from being natural either to deaf or hearing persons, 
it is not understood by deaf children on their entrance to an insti- 
tution. Nor do hearing persons become sufficiently familiar with 
the language to be thoroughly qualified as teachers until after one 
or more years’ residence in an institution for the deaf and dumb. 


76 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


(ce) The practice of the sign Janguage hinders the aquisition of 
the English language. 

(d) It makes deaf-mutes associate together in adult life, and 
avoid the society of hearing people. 

(e) It thus causes the intermarriage of deaf-mutes and the 
propagation of their physical defect. 

5. Written words can be associated directly with the ideas they 
express, without the intervention of signs, and written English can 
be taught to deaf children by usage so as to become their ver- 
nacular. 

6. A language can only be made vernacular by constant use as 
a means of communication, without translation. 

7. Deaf children who are familiar with the English language in 
either its written or spoken forms can be taught to understand the 
utterances of their friends by watching the mouth. 

8. The requisites to the art of speech-reading are: 

(a) An eye trained to distinguish quickly those movements of 
the vocal organs that are visible (independently of the meaning of 
what is uttered.) 

(6b) A knowledge of homophenes ;* that is, a knowledge of those 
words that present the same appearance to the eye; and 

(ec) Sufficient familiarity with the English language to enable 
the speech-reader to judge by context which word of a homophe- 
nous group is the word intended by the speaker. 


If we look back upon the history of the education of the deaf, 
we see progress hindered at every stage by fallacies. Let us strive, 
by discussion and thought, to remove these fallacies from our minds 
so that we may see the deaf child in the condition that nature has 
given him to us. If we do this, I think we shall recognize the fact 
that the afflictions of his life are mainly due to ourselves, and we 
can remove them. 

Nature has been kind to the deaf child, man cruel. Nature has 
inflicted upon the deaf child but one defect—imperfect hearing ; 
man’s neglect has made him dumb and forced him to invent a 
language which has separated him from the hearing world. 

Let us, then, remove the afflictions that we ourselves have caused. 


* This word was suggested to me some years ago by Mr. Homer, lately Prin- 
cipal of the Providence (R. I.) School for Deaf-Mutes, and has now been per- 
manently adopted. 


GENERAL MEETING. ie 


1. Let us teach deaf children to think in English, by using 
English in their presence in a clearly visible form. 

2. Let us teach them to speak by giving them instruction in the 
use of their vocal organs. 

3. Let us teach them the use of the eye as a substitute for the 
ear in understanding the utterances of their friends. 

4, Let us give them-instruction in the ordinary branches of edu- 
cation by means of the English language. 

5. And last, but not least, let us banish the sign language from 
our schools. 

If it were our object to fit deaf children to live together in adult 
life and hold communication with the outside world as we hold 
communication with other nationalities than our own, then no bet- 
ter plan could be devised than to assist the development of a special 
language suitable for intercommunication among the deaf. 

But if, on the other hand, it is our object to destroy the barriers 
that separate them from the outside world and take away the isola- 
tion of their lives, then I hold that our energies should be devoted 
to the acquisition of the English language as a vernacular in its 
spoken and written forms. With such an object in -view we should 
bring the deaf together as little as possible and only for the pur- 
pose of instruction. After school hours we should separate the deaf 
children from one another to prevent the development of a.special 
language and scatter them among hearing children and their friends 
in the outside world. 


The subject being presented to the Society for discussion, Mr. 
E. M. GauuavupeEt spoke, in substance, as follows: 


I have listened with great interest to the remarks of Mr. Bell 
this evening, and am ready to agree in many particulars with the 
views he has so well presented. 

I am, however, compelled to differ with him at several points; 
and as these involve matters of vital importance in the treatment 
of the deaf, I will beg the indulgence of the Society for a short 
time, while I attempt to show to what extent some of Mr. Bell’s 
views are erroneous. 

In proving the generally received opinion that the vocal organs 
of persons deaf from infancy are defective, to be a fallacy, Mr. 
Bell declared that difficulties encountered by such persons in 
acquiring speech are wholly external to themselves, and that all 


78 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


persons so situated can, with proper instruction, be taught to speak 
and to understand the motions of the lips of others. 

That this is a grave error has been proved by the experience of 
more than a century of oral teaching in Germany. 

The late Moritz Hill, of Wessenfels, Prussia, a man of the widest 
experience and highest standing among the oral teachers of Europe, 
expressed to me the opinion a few years since that out of one hun- 
dred deaf-mutes, including the semi-mute and semi-deaf, only 
“eleven could converse readily with strangers on ordinary subjects” 
on leaving school. Of course a much larger number would be able 
to converse with their teachers, family, and intimate friends on 
common-place subjects; but it would be found that very many 
could never attain to any ready command of speech. 

The explanation of this lies in the fact that a child, deaf from 
infancy, in order to succeed with speech and lip-reading must pos- 
sess a certain quickness of vision, a power of perception, and a 
control over the muscles of the vocal organs, by no means common 
to all such children. 

Mr. Bell’s view has been held by many instructors with more 
or less tenacity, and this fact is explained by a readiness on their 
part to argue from the particular to the general. Having 
attained marked success with certain individuals, they draw, in their 
enthusiasm, the mistaken conclusion that success is possible in the 
case of every other deaf child, overlooking the fact that many 
things, besides the mere deafness of the child, may affect the result. 
Experience has demonstrated that in attempting to teach the 
deaf to speak, failure in many cases must be anticipated. 

Mr. Bell is mistaken in supposing ignorance as to the mech- 
anism of the vocal organs to be a prominent cause of failure to 
impart speech to the deaf. It is no doubt true that among per- 
sons unfamiliar with the training of the deaf, few have made the 
mechanism of speech a study ; but in Germany, Italy, and France, 
not to speak of our own country, many are to be found who may 
be said to have mastered this subject. The results of their labors 
have been made available to instructors of the deaf, and all the 
best oral schools are profiting thereby. . 

Mr. Bell is also mistaken when he says that “in a majority of 
our schools and institutions articulation and speech-reading are 
taught to only a favored few, and in these schools no use of articu- 
lation is made as a means of communication,” and that “ few, if 


lod 


GENERAL MEETING. 19 


any, attempts are made to teach articulation to those who have not 
naturally spoken.” In most of the larger institutions for the deaf 
in this country, every pupil is afforded an opportunity to acquire 
speech, and instruction in this is discontinued only when success 
seems plainly unattainable. 

It is a great error to suppose it to be true of a deaf person edu- 
cated on what Mr. Bell calls the sign-method, that, “as a general . 
rule, when his education is completed, his knowledge of the English 
language is like the knowledge of French or German _ possessed 
by the average hearing child on leaving school,” or to say that 
“he cannot read an ordinary book intelligently without frequent 
recourse to a dictionary.” On the contrary, a majority of persons 
thus educated have a good knowledge of their vernacular, are 
able to use it readily as a means of communication with hear- 
ing persons, and are able to read intelligently without frequent 
recourse to the dictionary. 

When Mr. Bell has become familiar with the peculiarities of 
the deaf by personal contact with a large number of this class 
of persons, I am confident he will not repeat his assertion that 
“nature has inflicted upon the deaf child but one defect—imperfect 
hearing.” For he will then have discovered, what has long been 
known to teachers of experience, that deaf children, in addition to 
their principal disability, are often found to be lacking in mental 
capacity, or in the imitative faculty, in the power of visual or tactile 
perception, and in other respects; all of which deficiencies, though 
they do not amount even to feeble-mindedness, much less to idiocy, 
do operate against the attainment of success in speech, as well as 
in other things which go to complete the education of such chil- 
dren. . 

Passing over several points of relatively small importance, in 
regard to which I believe Mr. Bell’s views to be subject to criti- 
cism, I come to his characterization as a fallacy of the opinion 
held by many “that the language of gestures is the only language 
natural to the child born deaf or who has become deaf in infancy.” 

I think that in order to sustain his view that this is a fallacy 
Professor Bell gives a strained and very unusual meaning to the 
words “natural language.” If, as he explains, a natural language 
is any one that a child may happen to be first taught by those with 
whom he is associated, then I should have no controversy with him. 
But I understand a natural language to be one that is mainly spon- 
taneous, and not at all one that is borne in upon a child from without. 


80 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Moritz Hill, to whom I have already alluded, speaks of the lan- 
guage of signs as “one of the two universally intelligible innate 
forms of expression granted by God to mankind,” the other being 
speech. Now it is hardly necessary to urge that speech is the form 
of expression natural to hearing persons, and I think a little re- 
flection will satisfy most persons that with the deaf the language of 
signs is the only truly natural mode of expressing their thoughts. 

Mr. Bell urges that the use of signs in the education of the deaf 
is a hinderance rather than a help, and that it would be better 
to banish them altogether. To this view I must give my earnest 
dissent. 

I might, of course, cite the opinions of very many successful in- 
structors of the deaf, who have followed only the sign method, to 
sustain my position, but I prefer to call in again the testimony of 
Moritz Hill, a man whose whole life was devoted to the instruction 
of the deaf by the oral method. In an exhaustive work on the 
education of the deaf,* Hill says, speaking of those who pretend 
that in the “ German method” every species of pantomimic language 
is proscribed : 4 

“Such an idea must be attributed to malevolence or to unpardon- 
able levity. This pretence is contrary to nature and repugnant to 
the rules of educational science. 

“Tf this system were put into execution the moral life, the in- 
tellectual development of the deaf and dumb, would be inhumanly 
hampered. It would be acting contrary to nature to forbid the 
deaf-mute a means of expression employed by even hearing and 
speaking persons. * * * It is nonsense to dream of depriving 
him of this means until he is in a position to express himself orally. 
* * % Even in teaching itself we cannot lay aside the lan- 
guage of gestures (with the exception of that which consists in 
artificial signs and in the manual alphabet—two elements proscribed 
by the German school), the language which the deaf-mute brings 
with him to school, and which ought to serve as a basis for his edu- 
cation. To banish the language of natural signs from the school- 
room and limit ourselves to articulation is like employing a gold 
key which does not fit the lock of the door we would open and 
refusing to use the iron one made for it. * * * At the best, it 
would be drilling the deaf-mute, but not moulding him intellectually 
or morally.” 


* Der gegenwiArtige Zustand des Taubstummen Bildungswesens in Deutsch- 
land; von Hill, Inspector der Taubstummen Anstalt zu Wetssenfels; Ritter des 
St. Olafs, &c. Weimar, H. Béhlau, 1866. 


GENERAL MEETING. 81 


Hill then follows with thirteen carefully formulated reasons why 
the use of signs is important and even indispensable in the educa- 
tion of the deaf. 

Mr. Bell is in error when he supposes that in the so-called sign- 
schools verbal language is only imparted through the intervention 
of the sign-language. In many well-ordered schools of this class, 
language is taught without the use of signs, and in such schools 
the language of signs is kept in its proper position of subordination. 
It goes without saying that in schools for the deaf there may be an 
injudicious and excessive use of signs. This is always to be guarded 
against, and when it is, I am convinced that no harm, but great 
good, results from the use of signs in teaching the deaf. 

Furthermore, it is well known that the attempt to banish signs 
from a school for the deaf rarely succeeds. Miss Sarah Porter, for 
three years an instructor in the Clarke Institution at Northamp- 
ton, Mass., an oral school in which most excellent results have been 
attained, shows candor as well as judgment when she says, in a re- 
cent article in the American Annals of the Deaf and Dumb, “ Every 
oral teacher knows that fighting signs is like fighting original sin. 
Put deaf children together and they will make signs secretly if not 
openly in their intercourse with each other.” 

It is not true as a matter of fact that the use of signs necessarily 
prevents the deaf from acquiring an idiomatic use of verbal lan- 
guage and from thinking in such language. Large numbers of 
them who have never been taught orally have come into sucha 
use of verbal language, and while it is granted that many edu- 
cated under the sign system do not use verbal language freely and 
correctly, the same is found to be true of very many who have 
been educated entirely in oral schools. 

In one important particular the language of signs performs a 
most valuable service for the deaf, and one of which nothing has 
yet been found to take the place. Through signs large numbers of 
deaf persons can be addressed, their minds and hearts being moved 
as those of hearing persons are by public speaking in its various 
forms. 

Having seen the good effects on the deaf of the discreet use of 
the sign-language through a period of many years, I am confident 
that its banishment from all schools for the deaf would work great 
injury to this class of persons intellectually, socially, and morally. 


82 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The Hon. Garpiner G. Hupsarp being present, was invited by 
the chair to participate in the discussion. He said he had been 
connected with the Clark Institution for many years. The deaf 
pupils in that school are taught entirely by articulation. 

From recent inquiries which had been made to ascertain how 
far the graduates had profited by instruction in articulation, it ap- 
peared that in almost in every instance they could carry on conver- 
sation with others sufficiently to engage in many kinds of business 
from which they would have been excluded if they had only used 
signs. 

It was true, as Mr. Gallaudet said, the congenitally deaf were fre- 
quenty able to articulate more distinctly than those who lost their 
hearing at an early age, but this arises from the fact that the dis- 
ease that caused the deafness affected the organs of articulation to 
a greater or less degree; but the congenitally deaf do not make as 
rapid progress in their studies as those who had once spoken, for 
these have a knowledge of language which the former could ob- 
tain only by long protracted study. 

Mr. Hubbard believed that the pupils at the Clark Institution 
made at least as rapid progress in all their studies as those taught 
by signs; while, at the same time, they acquired the power of read- 
ing from the lips and speaking, in which those taught by signs were 
deficient. 

When the first application was made to the Legislature of Mas- 
sachusetts for the incorporation of the Clark Institution, Mr. Dud- 
ley, of Northampton, chairman of the committee to whom the peti- 
tion was referred, had a congenitally deaf child under instruction 
at Hartford. The petitioners were opposed by the professors from 
the asylum, as they believed an articulating school would retard 
the education of the deaf, as it was impractical to teach the deaf 
by articulation, that system having been tried and proved a failure, 
and the new method was stigmatized as one of the visionary theories 
of Dr. Howe, (the principal of the Perkins Institute for the Blind, 
and the teacher of Laura Bridgeman, the blind deaf mute,) who 
was associated with the petitioners in the hearing. 

The application was rejected through the influence of these pro- 
fessors and of Mr. Dudley, who ‘ knew, from experience with his 
own child, that it was impossible to teach the congenitally deaf to 
talk.’ 

Two years after, our application was renewed and with better 
success. 


GENERAL MEETING. 83 


Mr. Hubbard in the meantime, with the aid of Miss Rogers, had 
opened a small school where the deaf were taught to speak. This 
school was visited and examined by the committee, and the progress 
made was so great that Mr. Dudley became a warm convert, con- 
vinced that the impossible was possible, and the application was 
granted, although again opposed by the gentlemen from Hartford. 
The school was opened at Northampton, and has been in operation 
for nearly fifteen years, and teaching by articulation has ceased to 
be a visionary theory. 

Many of the warmest friends of the Institution now are, like Mr. 
Gallaudet, connected with institutions where signs are used. In 
almost every institution for the deaf classes are now taught to articu- 
late, though articulation is not used as the instrument for instruc- 
tion. 

Mr. Gallaudet had taken exception to the remark of Mr. Bell, that 
idiots were born dumb, and said that in every school for idiots there 
were many feeble-minded children who could talk readily ; but Mr. 
Bell used the word idiot not as simply a feeble-minded person, but 
according to its ordinary meaning, “a human being destitute of 
reason or the ordinary intellectual powers of man.” 

It has always been the policy at Northampton to prevent, as far 
as possible, marriages of deaf with deaf, for the records show that 
the children of such intermarriages are often deaf; and even where 
a congenitally deaf person marries a hearing person, the children 
sometimes are deaf. 

The tendency of the intermarriage of the deaf would be to raise 
a deaf race in our midst. 

About one in 1,500 of the population are deaf; but if these in- 
termarriages should take place and a deaf race be created, the propor- 
tion would rapidly increase. The object of all friends of the deaf 
should be to prevent the deaf from congregating, and to induce 
them to associate with hearing people. In bringing the deaf to- 
gether in institutions, where they are taught by signs, the tendency 
is to make the deaf deafer and the dumb more dumb. 

It was originally intended to have only a family or small school 
at Northampton, but it was soon found that signs could not be ex- 
cluded from the play-ground, as the young children could not com- 
municate in any other way. The plan was changed, the number of 
pupils was largely increased, and a preparatory department estab- 
lished, in which signs were tolerated on the play-ground. On 


84. PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


the removal of the pupils to the higher departments, the use 
of signs is forbidden, and they are rarely used on the play-ground 
or between the pupils, either in or out of school hours. 

In the later years of instruction they acquire great facility in 
articulation and reading from the lips, though there is almost always 
some difficulty for a stranger to understand them. 

Mr. Gallaudet had referred to the International Convention of 
deaf-mute teachers and their friends, at Milan, three yearsago. Mr. 
Hubbard was present at the convention held this year at Brussels, 
and was there informed that a delegate had been sent from France 
to attend the convention at Milan and investigate the method of in- 
struction in Italy, where articulation was used, for the purpose of 
deciding whether the instruction in the French schools should con- 
tinue to be by signs, or instruction by articulation be substituted 
for signs. 

The preference of the delegate had been for signs, but on witness- 
ing the results obtained in the Italian schools and hearing the dis- 
cussion, he was led to advise that the instruction in the French 
schools hereafter be by articulation, instead of signs, and such a 
change has, Mr. Hubbard understands, been made in most of the 
schools of France. 

Mr. Hubbard learned from the reports at Brussels that almost all 
the European schools were taught by articulation, and that this means 
of instruction was being rapidly substituted for the sign language 
in England as well as in France. 


Mr. BELL, in reply to the remarks of Mr. Gallaudet, said: 


There are signs and signs. There is the same distinction between 
pantomime and the sign-language that there is between a picture 
and the Egyptian hieroglyphics. 

Pictures are naturally understood by all the world, but it would 
be illogical to argue from this that a picture-language, like that de- 
veloped by the ancient Egyptians, must also be universally intelli- 
gible. Pantomime is understood by all the world, but who among 
us can understand the sign-language of the deaf and dumb without 
much instruction and practice? 

No one can deny that pantomime and dramatic action can be 
used, and with perfect propriety, to illustrate English expressions 
so as actually to facilitate the acquisition of our language by the 
deaf; but the abbreviated and conventionalized pantomime, known 


GENERAL MEETING. : 85 


as the “sign-language,” is used in place of the English language, 
and becomes itself the vernacular of the deaf child. 

Judging from the quotations given by Dr. Gallaudet, Moritz 
Hill himself makes a clear distinction between pantomime and the 
sign-language, retaining the former and proscribing the latter. 
“Every species of pantomimic language is not proscribed,” he 
says. ‘Natural signs,” or “signs employed by hearing and speak- 
ing persons,” are retained, while “ artificial signs ” are proscribed. 

All the arguments that have been advanced regarding pantomime 
and a pantomime language are equally applicable to pictures and 
a picture-language. For instance, we may say that a picture- 
language is more natural than any of the spoken languages of the 
world, because pictures are naturally understood by all mankind. 
We may even arrive, by a further process of generalization, at the 
idea that picture-language, in the wider sense, really constitutes 
the only form of language that is natural at all, for all the other 
languages of the world appear to be entirely arbitrary and conyen- 
tional. If we pursue the parallel we shall arrive at the conclusion 
that a picture-language of some kind must necessarily become the 
vernacular of our pupils, through which the other more conventional 
languages may be explained and taught. 

It is immaterial whether such statements are fallacious or not, so 
long as we do not apply them to educational purposes. But let us see 
how they work in practice. The exhibition of a picture undoubtedly 
adds interest to the fairy tale or story that we tell a child. It 
illustrates the language we use, and it may be of invaluable 
assistance to him in realizing our meaning. But is that any reason 
why we should teach him Egyptian hieroglyphics? Granting the 
premises: Is the conclusion sound that we should therefore teach 
him English by means of hieroglyphics ? 

If such conclusions are illogical, then the fundamental ideas 
upon which our whole system of education by signs is based are 
also fallacious and unsound. 

One word in conclusion regarding speech. 

The main cause of the fallacies that fog our conception of the 
condition of the deaf child is his lack of speech. A deaf person 
who speaks is regarded by the public more as a foreigner than as a 
deaf mute. Speech, however imperfect, breaks through the barriers 
of prejudice that separate him from the world, and he is recognized 
as one of ourselves. 


86 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Mr. Gallaudet under-estimates the value of speech to a deaf 
child. He seems to think that speech is of little or no use, unless 
it is as perfect as our own. The fact is that the value of speech 
to a deaf child must be measured by its intelligibility rather than 
by its perfection. 

It is astonishing how imperfect speech may be and yet be intelli- 
gible. We may substitute a mere indefinite murmur of the voice for 
all our vowel sounds, without loss of intelligibility. (Here Mr. Bell 
spoke a few sentences in this way, and was perfectly understood.) 
Here at once we get rid of the most difficult elements we are called 
upon to teach. If now we examine the relative frequency of the con- 
sonantal elements, we shall find that 75 per cent. of the consonants 
we use are formed by the point of the tongue, and that the majority 
of the remainder are formed by the lips. The consonants that are 
difficult to teach are chiefly formed by the top or back part of 
the tongue; but, on account of their comparative rarity of occur- 
rence, they may be very imperfectly articulated without loss of 
intelligibility. Hence I see no reason why, in spite of the general 
ignorance of teachers respecting the mechanism of speech, we 
may not hope to teach all deaf children an intelligible pronuncia- 
tion. 

Let teachers appreciate the value of intelligible speech to a deaf 
child, and they will make the attempt to give it to him. At the 
present time, lack of appreciation operates to prevent the attempt 
from being made upon a large scale. Skilled teachers of articula- 
tion will become more numerous as the demand for their service 
increases, and their ingenuity, intelligently applied, will increase 
the perfection of the artificial speech obtained. 

In the meantime, do not let us discard speech from the difficulty 
of obtaining it in perfection. Do not let us be misled by the idea that 
intelligible but defective speech is of no use, and must necessarily 
be painful and disagreeable to all who hear it. Those who have 
seen the tears of joy shed by a mother over the first utterances of 
her deaf child will tell you a different tale. None but a parent can 
fully appreciate how sweet and pleasant may be the imperfect articu- 
lation of a deaf child. 


240TH MEETING. NovemBeEr 10, 1883. 
The President in the chair. 
Forty-eight members present. 


GENERAL MEETING. 87 


Announcement was made of the election to membership of 
ETHELBERT CARROLL MoraGan. 

It was announced from the General Committee that invitation had 
been extended to the members of the Anthropological and Biologi- 
cal Societies to attend the meeting of December 8th, for the pur- 
pose of listening to the annual address of the President. 


Mr. Epwin Smita exhibited a 
SEISMOGRAPHIC RECORD OBTAINED IN JAPAN, 


describing the apparatus by which it was made, and giving a brief 
account of the seismographic investigations of Professor J. A. 
Ewing. 

Remarks were made by Mr. ANTISELL. 


Mr. C. E. Dutton made a communication, entitled 


THE VOLCANIC PROBLEM STATED. 
[ Abstract. ] 


It is sufficiently obvious that the volcano is a heat problem, or a 
thermo-dynamic problem. All volcanic activity is attended with 
manifestations of great energy. This energy is due to the elastic 
force of considerable quantities of water occluded in red-hot or 
yellow-hot lavas. The problem is to find a satisfactory explanation 
of the origin of the heat, the origin of the occluded water, and their 
modes of reaction. 5 

In attempting this solution, various explanations have been con- 
jectured. The first to be noticed, and the one which, in various 
forms, has met with the most favor from geologists and physicists, 
is that the source of heat is primordial—«. e., it is the remains of a 
large amount of heat contained by the entire earth-mass in its sup- 
posed primordial condition, according to the nebular hypothesis ; 
that water has penetrated from above, either from the ocean or from 
lakes ; and that the contact of cold water with the hot magmas within 
the earth is a summary explanation of the phenomena. This view 
is supported by the following considerations: Ist, the contact of 
water with intensely hot bodies and the resulting generation of 
great explosive force is matter of the commonest experience; 2d, 
the outer rocks and strata are known to be full of fissures, and the 
ocean bottom and lake bottoms are, therefore, presumably very 
leaky ; 3d, nearly all active volcanoes are situated either within, or 


88 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


in the neighborhood of, large bodies of water; 4th, volcanoes near 
the sea often deliver salts which may reasonably be supposed _ to be 
the same as those contained in the ocean; 5th, the analogy of gey- 
sers gives us a series of phenomena which seem to be, in many respects, 
quite parallel, and which have been satisfactorily explained in a 
similar way. 

To this view of the origin,and causation of voleanic activity there 
are some objections. There is difficulty in understanding how water 
obtains access to hot magmas. No doubt the rocks are full of 
fissures, but we cannot, by any means, confidently infer that these 
fissures extend sufficiently deep to afford free or even capillary pas- 
sages to melted magmas beneath. We should more legitimately 
infer that the heat increases gradually with the depth. At adepth 
of a few miles the rocks presumably have a temperature which, 
though high, is still below fusion, and at such temperatures it is well 
known that all the siliceous or rocky materials we are acquainted 
with are viscous. Remembering the immense statical pressure due 
to a thickness of a single mile of rocks, all fissures at such depths 
would be closed, as if the rocks were wax or butter. 

2d. Although the contact of cold water with intensely hot masses 
will surely produce a violent explosion, we are not at liberty to admit 
offhand that cold water does obtain such contact in the volcanoes. 
On the contrary, as it penetrates it takes up the heat of the rocks 
through which it passes. But water is believed by all physicists to 
have what is technically termed a critical temperature, i. ¢., a tem- 
perature at which it can exist only in the form of vapor however 
great the pressure, and this temperature is computed theoretically 
to be about 772° F., which is far below that of melted rock. If 
therefore, water could reach the liquid lavas below, it would reach 
them only in the form of vapor. There is indeed no difficulty in 
supposing that the vapor of water may, under great statical pres- 
sure, be forced into the rocks, passing between inter-molecular spaces. 
This is but one aspect of the phenomena of the diffusion and occlu- 
sion of gases in solids, and we know that water-vapor in large quan- 
tities is readily occluded by lava. But this is evidently no explan- 
ation of the explosive action. It isin the broadest possible con- 
trast with the gross conception of the sudden access,of cold water 
to hot bodies. The presumption is, under the process here sug- 
gested, that the vapor of water might penetrate slowly into regions 
of great heat until the hot magmas were saturated, and then the 


GENERAL MEETING. 89 


process would come to a standstill. But there would be no voleano 
in this case, for the supposed condition is evidently statical and 
stable. For the pressure which is supposed to force the vapor in is 
that due to the hydrostatic pressure of a column of water. The 
pressure which keeps it from blowing out is that due to an equally 
high or even higher column of rock, the density of which is at least 
two and a half times greater. 
od. The analogy of the geyser thus fails to become a true ho- 
mology, or an epitome of the voleano. For the geyser is due to the 
access of cold water to a cavity walled by hot rocks and its vapor- 
ization ; the volcano, if due to the penetration of water, is due to pen- 
etration in the form of vapor in the first instance; and the difference 
is radical. 
4th. The proximity of voleanoes to large bodies of water does 
not necessarily imply a logical and causal relation, and is not nec- 
essarily the true law of distribution. Another and perhaps a more 
rational law of distribution may be given. As a matter of fact all 
active volcanoes are not situated near seas or lakes, though in truth 
the exceptions are at the present time few, as for instance, Sangay, 
in the eastern Cordilleras- of Peru, and the volcanoes of Central 
Asia. It seems as if Darwin had acutely divined the true associa- 
tion, viz: that volcanoes are situated in areas which are undergoing 
elevation. So far as we know this rule is without exception, but 
there are many cases where the verification of the elevation is want- 
ing. So far, however, as the test has hitherto been applied it has 
approved the rule. This is especially conspicuous in the western 
half of our own country when applied to the late Tertiary and Post 
Tertiary volcanoes, and it is true, so far as known, of the Andes, 
Java, Phillippines, and Mediterranean, and I have recently been 
able to verify it in the case of the Hawaiian volcanoes. It happens 
that elevations, as well as subsidences, are much more frequent and 
extensive near coast lines than in continental interiors, whence the 
proximity of volcanoes to the sea becomes a secondary rather than 
a primary relation. But elevations also occur in continental in- 
teriors, though less frequently. And when they do occur, we find 
associated phenomena of volcanism as abundant and forcible as in 
littoral regions. This has been the case in the great Tertiary ele- 
vation of the Rocky Mountains, of the Alps, and of the Himalayan 
plateau. Darwin’s law of the distribution of volcanoes is as thor- 
oughly sustained by geological history as by modern instances; 
10 


90 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


while the other law, though largely predominant at the present 
period, shows a few conspicuous failures at the present time, but a 
very large number of them in times past. 

Another hypothesis to account for volcanic energy supposes the 
interior of the earth to consist of unoxidized elements, which grad- 
ually become oxidized by the penetration of oxygen from the at- 
mosphere. 

The objections to this hypothesis are as follows: On the assump- 
tion that the earth acquires no oxygen from space, the primitive 
atmosphere would have been many thousand times greater than at 
present ; but the geological record argues strongly in favor of an 
atmosphere which may indeed have varied in quantity and compo- 
sition, but nowhere near so greatly as the hypothesis implies. Any 
such extravagant difference would have recorded itself legibly in 
the strata. Furthermore, on this view, the end of all volcanic ac- 
tivity is close at hand. Only three pounds of oxygen to the square 
inch of terrestrial surface are left. A few hundred or thousand 
centuries and the last volcanic beacon is extinguished, and with it 
all organic life. 

But suppose the earth gathers up oxygen in its march through 
space. This may be true, but we can make any supposition on this 
point which pleases our fancy and feel sure that no prudent scien- 
tific man will dispute it. 

A third hypothesis is that of the late Robert Mallet, which as- 
sumes the earth to be contracting interiorly by asecular loss of prim- 
itive heat. As the interior cools and shrinks, the external shell is 
crushed and crumpled together, and this mechanical crushing is a 
sufficient source of heat. 

To this hypothesis there are many answers. The most direct one 
is that the very facts which are relied upon to prove that there is - 
any interior cooling at all now going on also prove that the amount 
hitherto has been excedingly small, and has been limited as yet to 
a thin external shell, not exceeding 150 miles in thickness, while 
the great interior is about as hot as ever; but, by the terms of the 
hypothesis, if the interior has not cooled there has been no interior 
contraction. The hypothesis is refuted by taking its own premises 
and pushing them to their inevitable conclusions. 

There is a fourth hypothesis, which cuts the Gordian knot in- 
stead of untying it. It assumes, as the result of causes unexplained, 
heat is generated locally within the earth, and such local movements 


GENERAL MEETING. of. 


of heat are the cause of voleanism. This is an arbitrary postulate, 
which, by its own terms, precludes discussion. Nevertheless it is 
the one which I believe agrees best, and perhaps perfectly, with ob- 
served facts. It undoubtedly sweeps away the difficulties which 
encumber all other hypotheses, but unfortunately it is an appeal to 
mystery, and therefore substitutes a single difficulty as great as, if 
not greater, than all the other difficulties put together. 

There is a fifth hypothesis, which takes account of the fact that 
many bodies which are solid under great pressure are immediately 
liquefied when the pressure is removed, heat being neither lost nor 
gained. The removal of pressure by denudation of the surface 
above the seat of lavas may thus determine volcanic action. The 
reply to this is that voleanoes do not always, nor even generally, 
occur where such denudation and consequent relief of pressure, are 
in progress. The true law of the distribution of volcanoes appears 
to be the one given by the late Charles Darwin, viz., that they occur 
in areas which are undergoing elevation. 

There are several broad facts, or categories of facts, which a true 
theory of the volcano must cover, and which will be recited 
briefly. 

1. Lavas, in their subterranean seat, could not possibly have been 
in a highly elastic explosive condition from the earliest epochs of 
the earth’s evolution, and only waiting a convenient season to break 
forth. We have no alternative but to regard them as being inert 
and inexplosive in their primitive condition, and as having acquired 
explosive energy just before the epoch of eruption. To assume that 
they have always been in the condition they present while pouring 
forth, and that the opening of a fissure has been the accident which 
determined the eruption, is reasoning ina circle. It is the energy 
of the lavas which causes the fissure, and not the fissure which 
causes the lavas to extrude. The lavas extrude themselves by vir- 
tue of their acquired elastic force. The theory must explain how 
materials which antecedently were inert, passive, incapable of erup- 
tion, may become active, dynamical, eruptible. 

2. Another broad fact, closely related to the foregoing, is the in- 
termittent action of volcanoes. These vents do not discharge all 
their available products at once, but by repeated spasms of activity, 
separated by longer intervals of repose. If these fiery explosive 
liquids had lain so long in the earth, chock-full of energy and only 
awaiting the opening of a passage-way, how happens it that when 


92 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


a vent is once opened they do not all rush forth ‘at once, and con- 
tinue to outpour until the reservoir is completely exhausted, and 
why does not the vent thereafter close up forever? Ina word, why 
should a volcano dole out its products in driblets, instead of send- 
ing forth one stupendous belch, equal to all the driblets combined ? 
The answer here proposed is that it is because lavas, in their primi- 
tive condition, do not have sufficient potential energy, in the form 
of elastic force, to break open the covering which keeps them in; 
but they gradually acquire that energy in a portion of the reser- 
voirs at a time, and when a sufficient portion of them has acquired 
it the covering is ruptured, and the whole of this energetic portion 
is extravasated. The vent then closes, and the process is repeated 
upon a second installment. The agency which thus progressively 
develops this force is the missing factor, and when we discover it 
we shall discover the secret of the volcano. 

The third general fact to be taken account of is the enormous 
quantity of heat given off by volcanoes through long periods of 
time without any sign of exhaustion. The quantity of heat brought 
up by the lavas themselves is but a fraction of the whole amount 
dissipated. Kilauea wastes many times more heat by quiet radia- 
tion from the surfaces of its lava lakes and by steaming and by 
numberless modes of escape than by actual eruption of lavas. 
Mauna Loa also dissipates the greater part of its heat in the same 
way, and the same fact is wholly or partially true of all other active 
or intermittent volcanoes. And yet for very long periods, for thou- 
sands of centuries, these great volcanoes show no sign of heat-exhaus- 
tion; on the contrary, such indications as we have suggest the con- 
clusion that the earth beneath them is hotter than before. 

A fourth general fact is that volcanoes are located in areas which 
have recently been or are now undergoing elevation. 

All these facts suggest the action of some cause generating heat 
within the earth. This cause, if such it be, is for the present wholly 
mysterious and unknown. 


Mr. PowELL, referring to the relation between volcanic eruption 
and elevation, said that the typical, secular sequence of geologic 
events was, first, elevation, resulting in, second, degredation, accom- 
panied by, third, extravasation, followed sooner or later by, fourth, 
subsidence, resulting in, fifth, sedimentation. There are numerous 
regions in which this circle of events ha8 been recorded, and in 
some places it has been repeated two or three times. 


GENERAL MEETING. 93 


Mr. F. W. CuarkeE suggested that the difficulty in the way ofa 
_ chemical explanation of volcanic phenomena was due to our ignor- 
ance of chemical force under high pressures. Spring has lately 
shown that chemical union could be brought about by pressure 
alone. Hence, water coming in contact with molten rock matter 
in the interior of the earth might be prevented from dissociating. 
If, however, dissociation takes place, we may conceive that water 
may play the following ‘part in volcanic explosions. Gradually 
filtering through the surface rocks to the hot lava, it would undergo 
slow decomposition, and great quantities of mixed oxygen and hy- 
drogen would thus slowly accumulate. Now let a process of cool- 
ing begin. Soon the temperature at which oxygen and hydrogen 
unite would be reached, and explosive union would occur. This 
may account for volcanic explosions, at least in part. By sucha 
process, potential energy is gradually stored up, to be later, sud- 
denly or instantaneously, released. This hypothesis does not ac- 
count for volcanic heat, but presupposes its existence. 

Mr. Waite, referring to Mr. Powell’s remarks on the instability 
of continental areas, said that the prevalent doctrine of the perma- 
nence of oceans, and the gradual development of the continents, 
was not sustained by paleontology. Continents were needed some- 
where to develop the land plants and land mammals which ap- 
peared during the emergence of the known continents. 

Mr. Harkness pointed out that Mr. White was postulating un- 
known continents to support the Darwinian hypothesis, to which 
Mr. White assented. 

Mr. Powe. added, that in detailing the great cycle of geologic 
events, he should have included metamorphism as a sixth term, re- 
sulting from burial by sediment; and Mr. Durron remarked that 
he had included this consideration in a paragraph contained in his 
written manuscript, but not read. 


Mr. McG&e made a communication on 


THE DRAINAGE SYSTEM AND THE DISTRIBUTION OF THE LOESS OF 
EASTERN IOWA. 


[ Abstract. ] 
The most conspicuous geographic feature of eastern Iowa is 


the remarkable parallelism among its water-ways. Yet the region 
comprises two essentially distinct geologic tracts; and the coincidence 


94 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


in direction of drainage in these is fortuitous: 1. The Wisconsin 
Driftless Region so far extends into the northeastern corner of Iowa 
as to include all of the triangular area bounded on the southwest 
by the elevated Niagara escarpment extending from the extreme 
eastward projection of the state northwestwardly to the Minnesota 
line, fifty miles west of the Mississippi. Within this tract, the drain- 
age was originally determined by general surface slope and by rock- 
structure, and the present topography, which is varied and pictu- 
resque, was developed by sub-zrial erosion. 2. Within the far more 
extensive tract formed by the glacial drift and its derivatives, the 
surface is a gently undulating plain, over which the general relief 
is inconspicuous, and the local topography faintly defined though 
singularly uniform and symmetric in character ; and here the par- 
allelism in drainage is prevalent and characteristic. There are, in- 
deed, both local and general exceptions to this parallelism, which 
exemplify a variety of types of aberrant behavior of the streams; 
but while these impair the geographic symmetry of the drainage 
system, they add much more largely to its geologic significance: 
Putting together the instances of accordant, and neglecting the in- 
stances of aberrant extension of water-lines, a normal direction of 
drainage for the whole of the drift-formed tract might be empiric- 
ally determined; which normal direction is represented by a sym- 
metric series of slightly divergent and slightly curved lines, concave 
to the northeastward, radiating from a point north of the state in 
a general southeasterly direction, toward the Mississippi. Probably 
nowhere else on the surface of the globe does so symmetric a normal 
drainage system exist, and assuredly nowhere else does the sum of 
directions of stream-flow over so considerable an area present so few 
examples of departure from the normal. 

The broader topographic features of eastern Iowa are dependant 
upon geologic structure. The dip of the rocks is to the southwest, 
and the outcrops of the several formations represented form suc- 
cessive approximately parallel zones (trending northwest and south. 
east), of which those of the Niagara and Hamilton are widest. Now 
the Niagara rocks resisted well the planation of the pre-quaternary 
eons, and their eastern margin is accordingly defined by a promi- 
nent escarpment varying from 1,000 to 1,350 feet in“altitude, from 
which there is a steep northeasterly slope to the Mississippi, and a 
gentle inclination, corresponding to the dip of the strata, in the op- 
posite direction. The Hamilton rocks, on the other hand, have so 


GENERAL MEETING. 95 


yielded to erosion that their area is topographically represented 
by a broad, shallow trough, of which the altitude is only from 
600 to 1,000 feet, and of which the sides rise and culminate in the 
Niagara escarpment on: the east and in the Mississippi-Missouri 
water-shed on the west. There is, however, a subordinate general 
topographic feature which is independent of geologic structure. A 
wide, gentle, indefinitely outlined depression extends directly across 
the great eastward projection (the “ Cromwell’s Nose’’) of Iowa and 
diagonally across the Upper Silurian, Devonian, and Carboniferous 
rocks alike, in the line of the general course of the Mississippi, from 
near the’ mouth of the Turkey to the mouth of the Iowa. Itis 
manifestly of great antiquity. 

Thus, in its general topography, eastern Iowa is characterized, 
primarily, by an elevated escarpment near its eastern border, by a 
broad depression intersecting its western portion diagonally, and 
by a general southwesterly slope extending over most of its area; 
and secondarily, by an indefinite ancient valley cutting off its eastern 
projection. And its general drainage system is almost absolutely 
independent of this general topography ; for not only do the prin- 
cipal streams flow at right angles to the prevailing slope and cut 
through the elevated escarpment when it lies in their way, but, with 
the single exception of the Cedar, they preserve their courses directly 
across the ancient valley. 

In their relation to minor topographic features the rivers of 
eastern Iowa conform to two diametrically opposite laws: 1. for 
two-thirds or three-fourths of their combined length they flow in 
the axes of the ill-defined, shallow valleys which characterize the 
drift-plain ; and, 2, for the remaining portion of their courses they 
flow in narrow gorges which they have excavated for themselves in 
the axes of the elongated ridges that constitute the leading features 
in the local topography of the region. Moreover, they have in 
many instances, at the same time gone out of their direct courses, 
and deserted valleys already prepared for them, to attain the anoma- 
lous positions assumed under the second law of association. And let 
it be noted that in every such case the gorges have demonstrably 
been carved by the streams themselves through the quaternary and 
older formations alike; that the pre-existent valleys which they 
avoided have not been appreciably eroded since the quaternary ; 
and that there has been no localized orographic movement in the 
region since long antecedent to the quaternary. 


96 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The principal tributaries entering the rivers frorh the right simi- 
larly conform to two antagonistic laws in their relation to topog- 
raphy: 1. Most of them flow throughout their courses in directions 
coincident with local and general slopes, and avoid elevations in 
their vicinity ; and, 2. Many of them originate with directions ap- 
proaching those normal to their localities, but curve more and more 
to the left toward their mouths, until they flow directly against the 
general slope, and enter the rivers at large angles; and all such 
streams have high north banks which they closely hug, and low 
south banks which they avoid. 

So the drainage system of eastern Iowa is essentially independent 
of the more general topographic features, though affected by local 
topography ; and the relations of the waterways to local topography 
are largely anomalous, and without parallel elsewhere. 

Though essentially continuous stratigraphically, and of unques- 
tionable genetic unity, the loess of eastern Iowa is variable in many 
characters, and may be separated into three geographic divisions; 
viz: 1, the Driftless Region division; 2, the Riparian division ; 
and, 3, the Southern division. That of the first division forms the 
surface throughout the Driftless Region, as it exists in Iowa, and 
everywhere overlaps the eastern border of the drift; it is generally 
rather coarse, heterogeneous, and non-calcareous, and yields depau- 
perate fossils of characteristic species; it reposes upon or gradu- 
ates into a thin stratum of water-worn erratic materials, which, in 
turn, rests upon either the residuary clays of the Driftless Region 
or the margin of the drift-sheet ; its western border is exceedingly 
sinuous, affects the greatest altitudes, and invariably overlooks the 
contiguous drift-plain; and, in capping the elevated Niagara escarp- 
ment, it forms the highest land within hundreds of miles, except in 
northerly directions. The loess of the Riparian division occurs 
chiefly in the elongated ridgesso common and so intimately asso- 
ciated with the waterways in eastern-central Iowa; it is often fos- 
siliferous, and its characters are generally typical; it usually grad- 
uates downward into stratified sands or gravels, which may or may 
not merge into drift; and it invariably seeks the highest summits in 
the region;—for the ridges in which the rivers have carved their 
cafions are always loess-topped; wherever streams avoid low-lying 
valleys for high-lying plateaus, the plateaus are of loess exteriorly; 
and the high northern banks of the aberrant tributaries are gen- 
erally loess-capped. The loess of the Southern division prevails 


GENERAL MEETING. 97 


over southeastern Iowa; it abounds in characteristic fossils (which 
may or may not be depauperate), in loess-kindchen, and in calcare- 
ous tubes; it is fine, homogeneous, and vertically cleft; it generally 
graduates into the subjacent drift so imperceptably that neither 
geographic nor stratigraphic separation of the formations, by other 
than a purely arbitrary line, is possible; and it occurs indiscrimi- 
nately at all levels. 

So, in its distribution, the loess of eastern Iowa is intimately con- 
nected with the Driftless Region, with the drainage, and with the 
topographic configuration ; but in its disposition to seek the greatest 
altitudes in the north, and to merge into the drift in the south, its 
behavior is as anomalous as is that of the rivers of the same region. 


Mr. PowrEL. remarked that these peculiarities of drainage were 
different from those observed in the drainage systems of mountain 
regions and demanded a different explanation, which was not yet 
forthcoming. It was probable, however, that not enough allowance 
was made for the differential effects of general degradation subse- 
quent to the determination of the drainage. 

Mr. GILBERT, after defining antecedent and super-imposed drain- 
age, said that Mr. McGee’s description definitely negatived the hy- 
pothesis of antecedent drainage, and rendered the hypothesis of 
super-imposed drainage in the ordinary sense equally untenable. 
The most plausible alternative is the hypothesis suggested by Mr. 
McGee in one of his earlier papers, that the drainage was super- 
imposed by the ice-sheet, the distribution of loess having been de- 
termined at the same time and by the same causes. 

Mr. WHITE regretted that Mr. McGee’s special investigations 
did not include the portion of Iowa draining to the Missouri. The 
details of drainage in that region are equally interesting, and, in 
his opinion, do not admit of the explanation mentioned by Mr. 
Gilbert. The direction of the rivers diverges at right angles from 
that of the Mississippi tributaries, and their valleys are excavated 
from loess except along their upper courses. 

Mr. Powe 1 said that on the Illinois side of the Mississippi River 
many of the features described in the paper are repeated. The loess 
hills follow the river courses, and in the opposite directions over- 
Jook plains. The explanation of the phenomena is problematic, 
but the theory advocated by Mr. Gilbert does not appear sufficient. 


98 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


241st MEETING. NovemBeErR 24, 1883. 
Vice-President Brii1nes in the Chair. 
Fifty-three members and guests present. 


It was announced by the Chair that the next meeting would be 
held in the Lecture Hall of the National Museum, that the mem- 
bers of the Anthropological and Biological Societies were invited 
to be present, and that the members of all three societies were re- 
quested to invite their friends. 

Opportunity was afforded for the introduction of amendments to 
the Constitution, but none were offered. 


Mr. C. D. WAtcorr made a communication on 


THE CAMBRIAN SYSTEM IN THE UNITED STATES AND CANADA. 
[Abstract. ] 


Defining the Paleozoic period as has been doné by Geikie in his 
Text-Book of Geology, it will include all the older sedimentary for- 
mations containing organic remains, up to the top of the Permian. 
Upon the paleontologic evidence it may be divided into an “ older 
and newer division, the former (from the base of the Cambrian to 
the top of the Silurian system) distinguished more especially by the 
abundance of its graptolitic, trilobitic, and brachiopodous fauna, 
and by the absence of vertebrate remains ; the latter (from the top 
of the Silurian system to the top of the Permian system) by the 
number and variety of its fishes and amphibians, the disappearance 
of graptolites and trilobites, and the abundance of its cryptogamic 
terrestrial flora.” The two divisions may be still further subdivided ; 
the upper into the Carboniferous and Devonian, the lower into the 
Silurian above and the Cambrian beneath. It is the Cambrian 
division we now have to consider. 

Stratigraphically it is difficult to fix any definite upper limit to 
the Cambrian system, owing to local causes having affected the con- 
ditions of sedimentation and consequent extinction or continuance of 
the fauna. Upon the evidence of the section in New York State on 
the western side of Lake Champlain, the Potsdam sandstone closes 
the period stratigraphically and paleontologically, the Calciferous 
formation forming little more than a closing deposit of the Potsdam; 
and the large Chazy fauna appearing suddenly in the overlying lime- 
stone is entirely distinct from that of the Potsdam. In central 


GENERAL MEETING. 99 


Nevada the section passes through limestones marked by the presence 
of a typical Potsdam fauna and on up to one that has the general 
facies of that of the Trenton Lower Silurian fauna. Midway of 
these passage beds occur layers of rock that carry representatives 
of both the Cambrian and Silurian faunas. Above this band the 
Cambrian fauna gradually disappears, and below it soon predomi- 
nates to the exclusion of the Silurian types. In this section we have 
an illustration of the gradual extinction of an older fauna as a new 
one is introduced, the sedimentation continuing and no physical dis- 
turbance occurring to change the conditions necessary for the pres- 
ence of animal life. It is the ideal section uniting the faunas of two 
periods, and if we had the blanks filled in between all the groups, 
as the blank between the Potsdam and Chazy in New York is filled 
in by the Nevada section, the Paleozoic would be a record of con- 
tinuous connected organic life from the base of the Cambrian to 
the summit of the Permian. 

It is convenient for stratigraphic geologic work to separate the 
Paleozoic series into subdivisions, and, as this is almost necessarily 
done on paleontologic evidence, I would separate the Cambrian as 
one characterized by what Barrande has named the first fauna.* 
Applying this to the Nevada section already mentioned, the line 
between the Cambrian and Silurian would be drawn where the 
types of the second fauna begin to predominate. With this defini- 
tion of the Cambrian system, the strata referred to it in the United 
States and Canada will be briefly noticed. 

In the Grand Cafion of the Colorado the top of the Cambrian is 
the Tonto formation, a series of sandy calcareous strata 1,000 feet 
in thickness. The contained fauna is closely allied to that of the 
Potsdam sandstone and continues up to the summit of the forma- 
tion, the overlying Devonian rocks resting directly above strata 
containing Lingulepis, Iphidea, Conocephalites, Dicellocephalus, etc. 
The Tonto rests uncomfortably on strata that were extensively 
eroded prior its deposition. This lower series comprises over 11,000 
feet of unmetamorphosed shales, limestones, and sandstones, with 
1,000 feet of interbedded lavas. It forms the Grand Cajion and 
Chu-ar’ groups of Powell and is characterized by the presence of a 
few fossils that enable us to refer it to the Cambrian but not to de- 
fine its stratigraphic horizon. That is done on the evidence of the 
position it occupies with reference to the Tonto. 


* The paleontologic evidence and discussion will appear in a future paper. 


100 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The relations of the Grand Caiion section are shown in the first 
column of the page of sections. 

The Potsdam sandstone in Wisconsin occupies the same relative 
stratigraphic position as the Tonto formation, except that the break 
above the Tonto and between it and the Devonian is filled in by 
the Calciferous and other Silurian formations. As has already 
been said, the faunas of the Potsdam and Tonto are very much the 
same in general character. The Potsdam formation here overlies 
unconformably a series of strata that are directly comparable with 
the Grand Cafion and Chu-ar’ series. The Keweenawan series, 
according to Chamberlin, has about 10,000 feet of sedimentary 
strata distributed through 30,000 feet of eruptive rocks. In all 
this great mass no decisive evidence of organic life has been dis- 
covered, but knowing that the series is unconformably overlain by 
the Potsdam formation and that it in turn rests unconformably on 
the Archean, as does the Grand Cajion series, we feel justified in 
correlating the Grand Cajion and Wisconsin sections and they are 
united in the first column of the page of sections. 

The upper part of the Nevada section has already been men- 
tioned. Below the Potsdam horizon there occurs a distinct fauna, 
characterized by a considerable development of the trilobitic genus 
Olenellus, a genus that in the embryonic development of several of 
its species proves that it is derived from the Paradowides family 
and is consequently of later date. This section is readily correlated 
with that of the Georgian group of Vermont, as there we have the 
Potsdam sandstone above the Olenellus horizon, and in the down- 
ward section both stop at nearly the same relative horizon. The 
position of the Georgian formation in Nevada and Vermont, in 
relation to the Potsdam, leads to the view that it represents a por- 
tion of the period of erosion between the Tonto formation and the 
Grand Cafion series and also the Potsdam formation and the 
Keweenawan series. 

The upper portion of the Tennessee Cambrian, the Knox shale, 
is correlated with the Potsdam sandstone, and so is the Knox sand- 
stone. The Chilhowee sandstone and Ocoee conglomerate and 
slates cannot be directly connected with the Georgian horizon, 
since the paleontologic data are insufficient. From their position 
beneath the Knox shale with its Potsdam fauna they are extended 
downward past the Georgian and into the Paradoxidian or St. Johns 
horizon. Their total thickness (Geology of Tennessee, pp. 158, 
159) is nearly 15,000 feet. 


101 


GENERAL MEETING 


ON SECTION 


ma] 


‘ 


SECTION (7 oer e 


T. = Tonto. 


Ep ers = $ 
~ ~~. 
4A : 
rn 6 
; K 
ths z | 
3 { See |S i 
x ' “Te (=z 
rt + H i ai : m hile ie ome iz occu 
z =I { ( ty 
? B 4 
' ‘ ' yy 
: i : = x 
ii Se —St. J; 
ate ene awn e--} ---—--- a 
S 
& 
a 
ae 
! ; z 


TYPICAL CAMBRIAN SECTIONS. 


qe we = = - - - 


G. C, = Grand Cafion. P. = Potsdam. G. = Georgian. St. J. = St. Johns. 
Maximum thickness of Cambrian = 50,000 + feet. 


POTSDAM 


GEORGIAN 


CAMBRIAN 


ACADIAN 


K. = Keweenawan. 


102 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


There is still another group, the St. Johus or Acadian, that ‘occu- 
pies an horizon below the Georgian and may fill in a portion of the 
period of erosion between the pre-Potsdam and Keweenawan and 
the Tonto and Grand Caiion series, or it may represent some of the 
upper portions of the Grand Cafion and Keweenawan series. In 
the geologic sections it is placed beneath the Georgian and as above 
or passing down into the lower groups. For the present both it 
and the Paradoxidian argillites of Braintree must be left in doubt 
with regard to their relations to the lower Cambrian of Wisconsin 
and northern Arizona. 

Of the Canadian survey sections, the one on the north side of the 
Straits of Belle Isle is most interesting as it gives the Georgian 
horizon, but unfortunately an interval of ten miles in width is occu- 
pied by the straits before the section is again continued. In this 
interval the Potsdam group is lost, but farther along the coast 
there occurs, below limestones referred to the Calciferous horizon, 
a mass of sandstone that may be assigned to the Potsdam forma- 
tion—giving, in connection with the Olenellus or Georgian horizon, 
a section not unlike that of Central Nevada. 

No other section that has been determined in the British Provinces 
throws much light on the stratigraphic succession of the Cambrian 
rocks. At Point Levis a curious mingling of the Cambrian and 
Silurian faunas has been said to occur, but this is rather to be at- 
tributed to error in the interpretation of the stratigraphy in a much 
disturbed area than to a break in the sequence of organic remains, 
elsewhere so uniform. I prefer to accept the interpretation given 
by M. Jules Marcou, who says (The Taconic and Lower Silurian 
Rocks of Vermont and Canada, Proc. Bos. Soc. Nat. Hist., Vol. 
VIII, p. 252, 1862,) that the primordial or Cambrian types are 
associated together and occur in a belt of limestone that contains 
no traces of the second or Silurian fauna. 

The accompanying table of sections gives a general outline of the 
Cambrian. Numerous local sections of the Potsdam series are not 
mentioned, as they do not add materially to the general informa- 
tion in regard to the system in its vertical range. 

The geographic range is great, extending as it does from New- 
foundland to Montana on the northern line, and thence south to 
Nevada, Texas, and Alabama. 


GENERAL MEETING. 103 


Mr. Joun JAy Knox made a communication on 


THE DISTRIBUTION OF THE SURPLUS MONEY OF THE UNITED STATES 
AMONG THE STATES. 


[ Abstract. ] 


President Jackson, in his message to Congress in 1829, referred 
to the difficulty in adjusting the tariff, so that the revenues of the 
Government should be but slightly in excess of its expenditures. 
He considered the appropriation of money for internal improve- 
ments, by Congress, as unconstitutional, but suggested that, if the 
anticipated surplus in the Treasury should be distributed among 
the States, according to their ratio of representation, such improve- 
ments could then be made by the States themselves. If necessary 
it would be expedient to propose to the States an amendment to the 
Constitution, authorizing such legislation. 

In his message for the following year he again suggested the 
same proposition. 

The receipts from sales of public lands for the three years, 1834, 
1835, and 1836, were $44,492,381—slightly less than the total re- 
ceipts from this source for the thirty-eight years previous, from 
1796 to 1834. On January 1, 1835, the country was virtually out 
of debt, and the receipts of the Government largely exceeded the 
previous estimates of the Secretary. The amount of surplus on 
January 1, 1835, was $8,892,858, and at the same date in 1836 
$26,749,803. On January 1, 1857,it amounted to more than forty- 
two millions. 

In 1834-5-6, the public money, which had heretofore been de- 
posited in the Bank of the United States, was deposited in favorite 
State banks by order of General Jackson. The deposit of the 
revenues in these banks was followed by financial distress, and dur- 
ing the year 1834, and previous thereto, propositions were made in 
the public press for distribution of the surplus revenue among the 
States as a measure of relief. These propositions were first in the 
form of a distribution of the revenue from public land; then a 
a distribution of the lands themselves; and finally a distribution 
of the surplus. During the session of 1835, a select committee was 
appointed in the Senate, which reported a resolution to amend the 
Constitution so that the money remaining in the Treasury at the 
end of each year, until the first of January, 1843, should annually 
be distributed among the States and Territories. Both General 


104 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Jackson and Secretary Woodbury were opposed fo this proposition, 
as the withdrawal of public moneys would deprive the State banks 
of the deposits, and would be likely to increase the financial troubles. 
A bill to distribute the surplus was, however, introduced in the-« 
Senate, and passed by a vote of 25 to 20. It was evident that this 
bill could not pass the House, as a majority of its members con- 
sidered the bill, in the form of a distribution, as unconstitutional. 
The friends of the measure in the Senate determined to change its 
form so as to remove the difficulty. A bill then pending in the 
Senate was so amended as to change the proposition for distribu- 
tion to a proposition for deposit with the States, and in this form it 
passed the Senate, and subsequently the House by a large majority, 
155 to 38. 

This act of June 23, 1836, provided for the deposit with the 
treasurers of the several States of 37 millions ($37,468,859) in four 
instalments during the year 1837—the Secretary of the Treasury 
to receive certificates of deposit therefor signed by competent au- 
thority, in such form as he should prescribe, which certificates | 
should express the usual legal obligation, and pledge the faith of | 
the State for the safe keeping and repayment of the deposit, from : 
time to time, whenever the same should be required. ‘The first three 
installments were deposited. Before the last installment, payable 
on the Ist day of October, was transferred, a series of financial dis- 
asters culminated in the crisis of 1837, and there was no surplus to 
deposit. Further legislation was deemed necessary in this emer- 
gency, and an extra session of Congress was called by President 
Van Buren. During this session, on September 11, 1837, a bill was 
reported from the Finance Committee of the Senate, providing that 
the transfer of the fourth installment should be indefinitely post- 
poned. The opposition to this bill was persistent, and there was a 
long debate, which was participated in by Webster, Clay, Calhoun, 
Buchanan, Benton, Silas Wright, Caleb Cushing, and others of the 
Senate; and in the House by Adams, Fillmore and Sibley of New 
York, Bell of Tennessee, Wise of Virginia, and many others. 

A bill was finally passed, providing for the postponement of the 
deposit of the fourth installment until January 1, 1839. It passed 
the House by a vote of 119 to 117, and contained ‘an amendment 
proposed by Mr. Buchanan, providing that the deposits should not 
be subject to the requisition of the Secretary of the Treasury, but 
should remain until called for by Congress. On the 1st of Jan- 


GENERAL MEETING. 105 


uary, 1839, there were no funds in the Treasury available for the 
payment of the fourth installment, and since that date there has 
never been a surplus in the Treasury above the debts and estimated 
expenditures of the Government. 

The amount of the three installments was $28,101,645, and the 
amount placed in the Treasury of each State has since been carried 
among “unavailable funds of the general Treasury,” as may be 
seen by reference to the annual reports of the Treasurer of the 
United States. 

The fourth installment, amounting to $9,367,215, has never been 
transferred or deposited, and recently the State of Virginia, through 
the action of its Legislature, and the State of Arkansas, through 
the action of its treasurer and one of its United States Senators, 
has applied to the Secretary of the Treasury for the payment of 
this last instalment. 

It is generally believed that the moneys deposited by the Gov- 
ernment with the different States were, for the most part, wasted or 
employed in works of internal improvement which were unneces- 
sary. The data for a full investigation of this subject are not at 
hand, but it is known that the States of Massachusetts, Connecticut, 
New York, New Jersey, Pennsylvania, Delaware, Maryland, North 
Carolina, Illinois, Indiana, Kentucky, Ohio, and Missouri appro- 
priated a considerable portion of the income from this fund to the 
support of public schools; and that in many of these States the 
income from the whole fund has been from the commencement, and 
still is, devoted to the education of the people. 

A bill was introduced by Senator Logan, during the first session 
of the last Congress, providing that the entire income derived from 
the internal-revenue tax on the manufacture and sale of distilled 
spirits shall be appropriated and expended for the education of all 
children living in the United States, as shown by the census of 1880 
and each succeeding census. The bill also provides that the States 
shall be required, before receiving the benefits of the act, to make 
school attendance obligatory upon all children between the ages of 
seven and twelve years, for at least six months in each year. 


Mr. ALVoRD inquired as to the present status of the Smithsonian 
fund, amounting to about half a million of dollars, which was in- 
vested in the bonds of the State of Arkansas. 


Mr. Knox said that the Government has assumed the Arkansas 
11 


106 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


bonds formerly held by the Smithsonian Institution, and that the 
Government also held quite a large amount of the bonds of the 
States of Virginia and Arkansas in the Indian Trust Fund. If 
legislation should be obtained authorizing the payment of the fourth 
nstalment to these States, such legislation should provide that the 
payment be made in the bonds now held by the Government. 

Mr. ALvorp said that the history of agricultural college grants 
was not thus far very encouraging. It would have been better if 
Congress had provided that the agricultural colleges should never 
be united with other colleges. The union was apt to lead to con- 
fusion and controversies, and lower the standard and prestige of 
both. Witness the case of Dartmouth College. In this reference 
Mr. Mussey concurred. 

The Hon. HucnH McCutxoveu, being invited by the Chair to 
participate in the discussion, said that in Indiana the application of 
the money deposited by the United States had occasioned a long de- 
bate, which had resulted in its division. One half, by means of a 
system of commissioners, was loaned to individuals on Jand and 
mortgage; the other half was put into stock of the State Bank, 
with which the speaker was at that time connected. In a financial 
crisis the first half was practically lost, probably less than one- 
twentieth part being recovered; but the loss was fortunately made 
good by the bank stock, upon which dividends were regularly paid, 
and by which the investment was eventually doubled. Since the 
closing of the bank, this money has constituted the school fund of 
Indiana. 


Mr. R. D. Currs made a communication on 


THE ACTION OF THE INTERNATIONAL GEODETIC ASSOCIATION AS TO 
AN INITIAL MERIDIAN AND UNIVERSAL TIME. 


[ Abstract. ] 


The International Geodetic Association of Europe, formed for 
the purpose of connecting the systems of triangulation executed by 
the different States of Europe, and hence for the measurement of 
arcs, and for the discussion of all questions of science comprised 
within the term Geodesy, has been in active existence for many 
years. The meeting in 1882 was held at The Hague, and before 
adjournment it was decided that the seventh conference should meet 
at Rome, in October, 1883. 


GENERAL MEETING. 107 


In the meantime, all governments in diplomatic relations with 
the United States were invited by the President, in accordance with 
the act of Congress, August 3, 1883, to send delegates to Washing- 
ton for the purpose of fixing upon a meridian proper to be em- 
ployed as a common zero of longitude and standard of time, reck- 
oning throughout the globe. More than twenty of these countries 
had signified, before October last, their acceptance of the invitation, 
but these did not include many of the principal governments of 
Europe. The delay in forwarding their definitive replies was due to 
their desire to have the advice, before committing themselves, of the 
Eurpean Geodetic Association. Hence it was at the request of 
many of these governments that the Association took up the subject 
of the unification of longitudes, and of the introduction of a uni- 
versal time. 

So soon as it was decided to take such action, General Ibanez, of 
Spain, the then President of the Association, addressed a letter to 
the Superintendent of the Coast and Geodetic Survey, urging him 
in strong terms to send a delegate to the meeting at Rome. So short 
a notice was given, however, that the delegate selected had to start 
at once, reaching Rome only on the morning of the first day’s ses- 
sion, October 15th. 

After a full discussion of the different views presented, the fol- 
lowing resolutions were almost unanimously passed on October 24th. 
It must be borne in mind that they are merely of an advisory 
character, ‘sanctioned and urged, nevertheless, by the highest scien- 
tific authority. It is the function of the convention to be held at 
Washington next year to take official and decisive action on the 
subject in all its details. 


Resolutions of the International Geodetic Commission in relation to 
the Unification of Longitudes and of Time. 


The seventh general conference of the International Geodetic Asso- 
ciation, held at Rome, and at which representatives of Great Britain, 
together with the directors of the principal astronomical and nau- 
tical almanacs, and a delegate from the Coast and Geodetic Survey 
of the United States, have taken part, after having deliberated 
upon the unification of longitude by the adoption of a single initial 
meridian, and upon the unification of time by the adoption of a 
universal hour, have agreed upon the following resolutions : 


108 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


I. The unification of longitude and of time is desirable, as much 
in the interest of science as in that of navigation, of commerce, 
and of international communication. The scientific and practical 
utility of this reform far outweighs the sacrifice of labor and the 
difficulties of adaptation which it would entail. It should, there- 
fore, be recommended to the Governments of all the States in- 
terested, to be organized and confirmed by an International Conven- 
tion, to the end that hereafter one and the same system of longitudes 
shall be employed in all the institutes and geodetic bureaus, for 
the general geographic and hydrographic charts, as well as in the 
astronomical and nautical almanacs, with the exception of those 
made to preserve a local meridian, as, for instance, the almanacs for 
transits, or those which are needed to indicate the local time, such 
as the establishment of the port, &c. 

II. Notwithstanding the great advantages which the general in- 
troduction of the decimal division of a quarter of the circle in the 
expressions of the geographical and geodetic co-ordinates, and in 
the corresponding time expressions, is destined to realize for the 
sciences and their applications, it is proper, through considerations 
eminently practical, to pass it by in considering the great measure 
of unification proposed in the first resolution. 

However, with a view to satisfying, at the same time, very serious 
scientific considerations, the Conference recommends, on this occa- 
sion, the extension by the multiplication and perfection of the nec- 
essary tables, of the application of the decimal division of the quad- 
rant, at least, for the great operations of numerical calculations, for 
which it presents incontestable advantages, even if it is wished to 
preserve the old sexagesimal division for observations, for charts, 
navigation, &c. 

III. The Conference proposes to the Governments to select for the 
initial meridian that of Greenwich, defined by a point midway be- 
tween the two pillars of the meridian instrument of the Observa- 
tory of Greenwich, for the reason that that meridian fulfils, as a 
point of departure for longitudes, all the conditions demanded by 
science; and because being at present the best known of all, it 
presents the greatest probability of being generally accepted. 

IV. It is advisable to count all longitudes, starting from the 
meridian of Greenwich, in the direction from west to east only. 

V. The Conference recognizes for certain scientific wants and for 
the internal service in the chief administrations of routes of com- 


GENERAL MEETING. 109 


munication, such as the railroads, steamship lines, telegraphic and 
post routes, the utility of adopting a universal time, along with 
local or national time, which will necessarily continue to be em- 
ployed in civil life. 

VI. The Conference recommends, as the point of departure of 
universal time and of cosmopolitan date, the mean noon of Green- 
wich which coincides with the instant of midnight, or with the 
commencement of the civil day, under the meridian situated 12 
hours or 180 degrees from Greenwich. 

It is agreed to count the universal time from 0° to 24°. 

VII. It is desirable that the States which, for the purpose of 
adopting the unification of longitudes and of time, find it necessary 
to change their meridians, should introduce the new system of lon- 
gitudes and of hours as soon as possible. 

It is equally advisable that the new system should be introduced 
without delay in teaching. 

VIII. The Conference hopes that if the entire world should agree 
upon the unification of longitudes and of time by accepting the 
meridian of Greenwich as the point of departure, Great Britian will 
find in this fact an additional motive to make, on its part, a new step 
in favor of the unification of weights and measures, by acceding to 
the Convention du Metre of the 20th May, 1875. 

IX. These resolutions will be brought to the knowledge of the 
Governments and recommended to their favorable consideration, 
with the expression of a hope that an International Convention, 
confirming the unification of longitudes and of time, shall be 
concluded as soon as possible, by means of a special conference, 
such as the Government of the United States has proposed. 


Mr. HriuGarp said that while the report of the Association did 
not conform in some of its details to the desires and interests of this 
country, nevertheless our principal object had been gained by the 
endorsement of the Association for the International Conference on 
the subject of standard time, to be held in Washington. 

The selection of the meridian of Greenwich as the starting point 
for longitudes, was more convenient for us than for Europeans; 
Europeans alone are liable to the confusion arising from the 
numerical identity of meridians east and west of Greenwich. It 
will be impossible, however, for us to agree to the rule which counts 
all longitudes from west to east. 


110 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Mr. Exurorr opposed the establishment of noon as the initial 
hour of the day. It seemed to be proposed in the interest of astron- 
omers, who work at night, and would not be submitted to by the 
people at large. 

He exhibited a map showing a grouping of the railroads of the 
country under the recently adopted time schedule. 

Mr. Curts said that the resolutions of the Geodetic Association 
do not appertain to civil time. The “universal time” they advo- 
cate is for the use only of astronomers and great transportation 
corporations. 

Other remarks were made by Mr. Newcoms. 


2425 MEETING. DEcEMBER 8, 1883. 


By permission of the Secretary of the Smithsonian Institution, 
the Society occupied for the evening the Lecture Hall of the 
National Museum. 


The President called Vice-President MaLitery to the Chair. 
There were present about three hundred members and guests. 


By invitation, the Presidents of the Biological and Anthropo- 
logical Societies occupied seats on the platform. 


The President of the Society, Mr. J. W. PowE i, delivered the 
annual address, taking for his subject 


THE THREE METHODS OF EVOLUTION. 


[The address is printed on pages XXVII-LU, ante. ] 

The Chair invited the members of the Society and their friends 
to remain for a period after adjournment, for the purpose of social 
intercourse. 

The Society then adjourned. 


GENERAL MEETING. Mt 


243D MEETING. DECEMBER 22, 1883. 
THE THIRTEENTH ANNUAL MEETING. 
The President in the chair. 


Thirty-four members present. 


The minutes of the 226th, 241st, and 242d meetings were read. 

The Chair announced the death, since the last meeting, of 
General R. D. Curts. 

The Chair announced the election to membership of Messrs. 
Rosert SImPsON WOODWARD, DANIEL ELMER SALMON, and JOHN 
Mirus Browne. 

The Secretary’s report on the membership of the Society was 
read. During the year the Society received seventeen new mem- 
bers, lost eight by death, and lost three by resignation. 

The Treasurer not being present, the Chair appointed Mr. Henry 
Farquhar Treasurer pro tempore. 

The officers for the ensuing year were then elected by ballot. (The 
list is printed on page Xv.) 

On motion of Mr. JENKINS, the vote for President was made 
unanimous. 

The Chair appointed Messrs. C. A. White, S. Newcomb, and H.C. 
Yarrow a committee to audit the annual report of the Treasurer. 

The Society then adjourned. 


Poh Cita parr : 
Vex! Ceres ; aN” be i 


% ty Pane | fi ie if heed 


He a vied 


wert, dang abdhiied ts 


a ge tee Haro, bine’ 


SU tC ue ie us Rovian OR 
hy a ; wy PM ng 
a racen he OnE A : pr yan Mr Are R ),ieg 
{ iq | . ai b AW) Wie: | vet » A i nkth of 
ji rr Whar, ie s ¥ ; 
i Say Ae edela|ea it ate hae a ul ‘Us: Bitar 


a ets i) none Aes chs Weny 13 RE dats RS) SES 


on t j / v ) 
: ta tee H ACER tle Tae Gee a r fey dad 3 
ine a. cteka Sh ee Fe er ee Da er Ske WP UML, oa ERM te CT, 
i : y eh a ite oes RS r Viele 
ver : Srey da Sa Se MOVE CAST Thetey koh 
ee 
a ay 
J ' 
\ i To. 
) ay 
j 4 
d 00 MG 
( 0 
| a 
i a eee 
ae 
4) 
’ ; bn 8) 
* 
A 
; oO 
\ 
h 
y 
{ 
7 
' 
} : 
5 
\ 
5 
+ ‘ 
i 
: \ 
i ; 
. a ry 
Be es A 
i A 
0 
i ) 
ey ‘ y 
‘i f 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


113 


MITA LIE: 


STANDING RULES 


OF THE 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


Adopted March 24, 1883. 


1. The object of this Section is the consideration and discussion 
of papers relating to pure or applied mathematics. 


2. The special officers of the Section shall be a Chairman and a 
Secretary, who shall be elected at the first meeting of the Section 
in each year, and discharge the duties usually attaching to those 
offices. 


3. To bring a paper regularly before the Section it must be sub- 
mitted to the Standing Committee on Communications for the 
stated meetings of the Society, with the statement that it is for the 
Mathematical Section. 


4, Meetings shall be called by the Standing Committee on Com- 
munications whenever the extent or importance of the papers sub- 
mitted and approved appear to justify it. 


5. All members of the Philosophical Society who wish to do so 
may take part. in the meetings of this Section. 


6. To every member who shal! have notified the Secretary of 
the General Committee of his desire to receive them, announcements 
of the meetings of the Section shall be sent by mail. 


7. The Section shall have power to adopt such rules of pro- 
cedure as it may find expedient. 


LIST OF MEMBERS 


WHO RECEIVE ANNOUNCEMENT OF MEETINGS OF THE 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


ABBE, C. 
ALVORD, B. 
AVERY, R. S. 


BABCOCK, O. E. 
BAKER, M. 
Bates, H. H. 
BILuin¢s, J. S. 
Burcess, E. S. 
CHRISTIE, A. S. 
CorFin, J. H. C. 
DELAND, T. L. 


Doo.itTt_e, M. H. 


EASTMAN, J. R. 
EL.LiotTt, E. B. 
FARQUHAR, H. 
FLINT, A. S. 

GILBERT, G. K. 


NeEwcoms, S. 


GorE, J. H. 
GREEN, B. R. 
HALL, A. 
HARKNESS, W. 
Hazen, H. A. 
HILGARD, J. E. 
AIEL; Gwe 
Kine, A. F. A. 
KuUMMELL, C. H. 
LEFAVOUR, E. B. 


PEIRCE, C. S. 


RITTER, W. F. M’K. 


SMILEY, C. W. 
TayLor, W. B. 
Upton, W. W. 
WALLING, H. F._ 
WINLOCK, W. C. 


116 


INAUGWRAL ADDRESS 


OF THE 


CHAIRMAN OF THE MATHEMATICAL SECTION, 
By AsApH HALL. 


GENTLEMEN OF THE MATHEMATICAL SECTION: 


I thank you for the honor you have conferred on me by my 
election as Chairman of this Section, and the best return that I can 
make is to do my utmost to render our meetings as interesting and 
successful as possible. 

Although my duties have been such that I have not been able to 
take a very active part in the proceedings of the Philosophical So- 
ciety, it is easy to understand how a need has been felt for a more 
full and frequent discussion of mathematical questions. Mathe- 
matics has indeed been called the queen of the sciences, but the 
rigor and dryness of its methods make it distasteful to many. 
The fact seems to be that as any branch of knowledge advances 
and finally is reduced to law, it loses in a large degree its attractive- 
ness and popularity. Then, it is only with the indefinite outlines 
and the obscure boundaries of this science that most people like to 
deal; and this may be natural and right, since nearly all advance- 
ment originates in speculation and doubt, which lead to investiga- 
tion, and which, by a variety of motives, spur men on to labor. 
But the science of mathematics, though old, is yet young and vigo- 
rous. We have now six journals of the highest rank, which are 
devoted almost exclusively to pure mathematics—two in Germany, 
two in France, one in England, and, I am glad to say, one in our 
own country. These journals are devoted to the discussion of the 
highest conceptions of space and number, treating chiefly of the 
laws and forms of analytical expressions, and generally they touch 
lightly on any practical application of the science. Such discus- 
sions prepare the way, however, for better and more general prac- 
tical methods, and in our own country they have, I think, another 
value. For one, I can hardly accept the doctrine, advocated in 
some quarters, that the American scientific man of the future should 


117 


118 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


be distinguished by his facility in getting a patent on his discovery, 
in forming joint stock companies and watering stock, and in sud- 
denly becoming rich at the expense of his fellow-men. Such a 
career may be a natural result of our present system of sociology, 
but it does not seem to be in harmony with scientific thought and 
research, and our social need is for men of a different character. 
Far nobler is the life of one who devotes himself to the study of 
the most abstract forms of science; winning for us, if haply he 
may, another forward step up the hill of knowledge. 

But when we come to the field of applied mathematics we soon 
learn how necessary are the studies of the pure mathematician. 
Nearly all the researches in natural philosophy, where the action of 
forces is concerned, require the formation and solution of differen- 
tial equations, and hence the theory of such equations becomes 
important, and in some cases almost essential, for the advancement 
of physical investigations. It is not, of course, to be supposed that 
experiment and observation are to be done away with or neglected, 
or that mere skill in differentiating, integrating, and solving equa- 
tions can supply the place of correct thinking. In fact, we may be 
sure that Leibnitz was mistaken when he declared that the inven- 
tion of the differential calculus had made known that royal road to 
knowledge for which the king had inquired in vain of Euclid. But 
still it remains true that this calculus forms the most powerful 
engine we have for the solution of questions in natural philosophy. 
It enables us to adopt the old maxim, “ divide et impera.” If we 
can reduce the problem to its elements, and can form its true differ- 
ential equation, the rest of the work is purely mathematical. Un- 
fortunately, the differential equations that occur in the problems of 
nature are very different from those given in our text-books, and 
their exact solution is in most cases impossible. Here we must rely 
chiefly on that happy device of the variation of constants, by means 
of which the solution of simpler forms is extended to the more 
complex. 

One of the great advantages of putting a question in a mathemati- 
cal form is the precision with which it can bestated. If we are right, 
the truth of our assertion will be the sooner acknowledged, and if 
we are wrong, our error can be the more easily detected. Fre- 
quently it has seemed to me that disputes would be avoided in the 
meetings of our scientific societies if men would take the trouble to 
put their assertion into a formula and write it on the blackboard ; 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 119 


and certainly there would be a clearness and meaning that are so. 
often wanting. Thus, if any one asserts that when a planet comes 
to its perihelion it ought to fall into the sun, the law of gravitation 
being true, he is not worth listening to unless he will put his asser- 
tion into a formula; and when he is able to do this he will probably 
find out his own error. There will be so much gain by simply re- 
ducing the problem to its elements and giving it a correct form. 
Again, where scientific statements may be true, there will be a gain 
in giving them, when possible, a mathematical expression. Thus, 
when we are told that the fixed star 1830 Groombridge is running 
away, disobedient to the law of gravitation, how much better it 
would be if we could see on the blackboard the mathematical proof 
of this assertion, so that we could judge for ourselves on what 
assumption it is based. The subject of impulsive forces is one that 
we hear disputes about in our own society, and it seems to be a fair 
field for a mathematical exposition. How often do we see such 
phrases as “energy,” “potential energy,” “kinetic energy,” “ con- 
servation of energy,” “work,” “ virial,” &c. Could not some one 
of our members give us a clear account of these terms, show us how 
they are connected with the general equations of mechanics, what 
new ideas they contain, and on what limitations they may be based ? 
As the application of mathematics is extended, sounding phrases 
are sure to come into use, and it is well to test them and know what 
they mean. 

In the discussions of this Section, while all are invited to be 
critical, I trust that we shall all be kind and good tempered. We 
come together for discussion and mutual improvement, and while 
error is not to be spared we must be charitable to each other’s faults. 


2 66 


8 Wem SR Shaina ee ie sos) 
BC. Gxt iaee heal teabatiet Litanech RRA BT, took 
ot AN 5 she ie iiebes haat haabhe ny omg. tgs Te Po Ga: 
Ree | ho LGA y Wel Meee Qe aee: Machen! Pai Thy} 
te ey CW) ARR Mn SE epee ave tine esd asesintotd et ry sien 


Le aa PERT Ath (heme ARNE RD TET) Ws EMI uaa Tv ‘lair an 


Sia EAR sia Re gC 9 lan on Sonat eR ean 1 dat i. 
mie te Ae eee PRE ORR ARAL GD ee Movin bit ay? phd 98 
! Mi : } ‘ ‘ iy eee oe itch Cie te 
' 


} ; , uh Pye Pecan ere ike ita ate LG athe my f ‘at Pee m 

haa ie ; * vt if cei ams LA NAAR ARE idefpaeaginn BRA weil ree epee sec 08 
. . 1 eS pds OR itr cia citi 8 Sol ere ee “te ita el 

aD ARTS Ue VO NS COE ; ein ‘sadhe'Y wt. Ms Poet hy aA 

ea “ye bode, pest cut ialantan a: 8 be Bu retrained pane reste ati iit Ant pin 


ur : vi _— " ' : : ay 
en BE SCIEN RTT) CEU SRS OER 
NS ‘ 2 
ms 
‘ 
at 
, 
“i 4 ; 
he 
/ 
Le) 
7 t ‘ ? ’ r 
7 r e) i 4 ‘ \ * #4 ae 
sta ie, WY SOU AES ek at andl i | Robe ihe 
; ‘ 
; 
A 
i 
+, 
| 
i 
« 
\ 
7 ‘ 
get rt 
a, 
f mM 
M 
‘ . y aki 
; 
y ’ } *.- 
‘ 
a? ~~ 
i hed 
i 
P 
rh * 
Nie vee > sat, yt 
| 
a j 
ity { : AEDs 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


A communication signed by Mr. J. E. Hilgard and nineteen 
other members of the Philosophical Society, asking that a Section 
in Mathematical Science be formed, as provided in Paragraph 6 of 
the Standing Rules of the Society, was presented to the General 
Committee at its regular meeting January 27, 1883. The propo- 
sition was agreed to, and Mr. Hilgard was empowered to call a 
special meeting for the purpose of organizing such a section; the 
call being extended to all members of the Society. 


ist PRELIMINARY MEETING. FEBRUARY 17, 1883. 


Twelve members met in the library of the Army Medical Mu- 
seum, in answer to the first call. 

Mr. Hiiearp not being present, Mr. E. B. Evurorr was called 
to the Chair. 

An informal discussion followed, which brought out a unanimous 
sentiment in favor of forming the Section. 

With some differences of opinion as to details, it was agreed to 
postpone formal action, and the meeting adjourned subject to call. 


2p PRELIMINARY MEETING. Marcu 5, 1883. 


Mr. Hiiearp in the Chair. 
Fifteen members present. 


A plan of organization was adopted, and referred to the Gene- 
ral. Committee of the Society for consideration. 


12 121 


122° PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 
Ist Reauitar MEETING. * Marce# 29, 1883. 


Fourteen members present. 


In the absence of Mr. HitGarp, who had presided over the 
meeting for organization, Mr. G. W. H1xu was called to the Chair. 


The standing rules for the government of the Section, as adopted 
at the last meeting of the General Committee of the Society, were 
read. 

The Section then proceeded to elect officers for the year 1883. 
On motion of Mr. Wrytock the rules of the Society at its An- 
nual Meeting were followed. 

Mr. AsapH Haut was chosen Chairman and Mr. H. FarquHar 
Secretary. 

A letter from Mr. Marcus Baker, dated Los Angeles, Cal., was 
read by Mr. Curistiz. It expressed a strong interest in the Sec- 
tion, recommending that it should be conducted as nearly as possi- 
ble on the plan devised by the. late Prof. Henry for the Society 
itself, by which business and science are kept apart. A free use of 
pencil and’ paper at the meetings, and seats around a table, were 
further suggested. The letter closed by advocating the foundation 
of a new mathematical journal. 


Mr. CuristTis£ then made a communication on 


A QUASI GENERAL DIFFERENTIATION, 


The paper was discussed by Messrs. KumMMELL, Ex.iort, Hint, 
and DooxitrLEe. The author reserves it from publication to await 
further research. 


A resolution was passed, requesting the committee in charge of 
the matter to call meetings of the Section on Wednesday evenings. 


2p MEETING. ApRIL 11, 1883. 
The Chairman, Mr. Hatt, presided. 
Present, ten members and two invited guests. 


It was announced that the Editor of “Science” would publish 
brief reports of the meetings of the Section. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 128 


The Chairman read an inaugural address, [given in full on pp. 
117 to 119 ante.] 


Mr. C. H. KuMMELL then began a paper on 
ALIGNMENT CURVES, 


which was not finished at the time of adjournment. 


38D MEETING. APRIL 26, 1888. 
The Chairman presided. 


Present, sixteen members and one invited guest. 


Mr. KuMMELL completed his paper, begun at the second meet- 
ing, on 


ALIGNMENT CURVES ON ANY SURFACE, WITH SPECIAL APPLICATION 
TO THE ELLIPSOID. 


[ Abstract. ] 


The attempt to put a number of points in line on a curved sur- 
face whose normals are supposed to be given (abstraction is made 
of deviations of the plumb-line and lateral refraction) gives rise to 
various curves, which I call alignment curves. There are two 
classes—alignment curves with two given termini and those with a 
starting point only. There are three distinct curves of the first 
class, viz.: 1. The normal section, if the surveyor directs his assist- 
ant to place staffs in line from one end of the line. 2. A curve 
described if the surveyor would align a point near him, then move 
up to this point, thence align another point, etc., until the terminus 
is reached. This process is that used in chaining, or more roughly 
by a pedestrian going towards a point, and is characterized by 
requiring only foresights. I call it prodrthode (xpo, 6p@cs, 6dds).* 
3. A curve resulting if a backsight is also taken. This curve is 
therefore defined by the condition that the normal plane at any 
point of it which passes through one end also passes through the 
other. I call it diorthode (0:4, épOds, bdds), because it may be con- 


* This and other names of curves were coined by my friend, Mr. Wm. R. 
Galt, of Norfolk, Va. 


124: PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


sidered straight all through at any of its points. This curve may 
be considered the ideal curve of a primary base line. Various 
names have been given to it when on the terrestrial spheroid. Dr. 
Bremiker, who appears to have first considered it (in his Studien 
ueber hoehere Geodesie, 1869), proposed the name “ Feldlinie”; 
that is, field line. He thinks it should be adopted as the geodetic 
line, because both linear and angular measurements conform to it. 
Clarke, Zachariz, and Helmert have also mentioned it, the latter, 
however, only in a note, where he remarks that it deserves no con- 
sideration in geodesy. 

To the second class belong two curves: 1. A curve described as 
follows: The surveyor at the starting point takes his directions 
from a staff at short distance and directs his assistant to place 
a staff in the prolongation. Repeating this operation from the 
first staff, from the second staff, etc., he describes a curve which 
is well known to be the shortest curve between any of its points. 
It is usually called the geodetic line. However, since this name 
would apply at least equally well to the three curves already con- 
sidered, I propose the name brachisthode (fpaytoros). The proper- 
ties of this curve need not be considered here, such mathematicians 
as Gauss, Hansen, Bessel, and others, having perfected its theory. 
Helmert, in his “ Hoehere Geodesie,” makes this curve the basis of 
nearly all geodetic computations. The brachisthodic process on a 
plane evidently results in a straight line, and on a sphere in a great 
circle. If, on these surfaces, it is in starting directed to a distant 
point, that point will be reached (disregarding errors of observation). 
Not so on other curved surfaces; there, in general, the first element 
of the brachisthode is not in direction to any of its points at a finite 
distance. 2. The loxodrome being a curve which has a constant 
inclination to a given direction, may, perhaps, be mentioned as be- 
longing to this class. 

The general equations of the two-end curves on any surface may 
be developed as follows: 

Let the equation of the surface be: 


u=f (2%, y, 2) = 0 (1) 
then if (€, 7, £) is any point in the normal at the surface point 
(x, y, 2), we have its equations: 


ae a @) 
(i) (%) (z) 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 125 


and the equation of a normal plane at the surface point (2, y, z) 
and passing through (2,, 7, 2,), (not necessarily a surface point, but 
considered so here), is: 


0=[ ¢—»(%)-¢-9(&) |Lo-»(Z)-@-9() ] 
—[o-»(z)-«-9(%) |Le—9(@)-«-9(@) ] 
=[%—y) €—2)-@—2G—-y)] (=) 
+[@—)G—-) —%—» €-a1() 


du 
+ [@—2) €-2) -@-DE-a1(F) © 
If in this we replace the surface point (2, y, z) by the surface 
point (2,, y,, z,) and (, 7, ¢) by the surface point (a, y, z) we obtain: 
du 
= (G.— 9) @— 2) —@—«) y-wi(F) 
du 
+ia— 4) — %)—-G—n) @—4)] aa) 


“-FLG@,— %,) G—2)— (Ce 2) (x 7 2,)] (37) (4) 


which, if combined with the equation of the surface, gives the nor- 
mal section at (2, y,, 2,) through (2,, y,, 2). 

If, however, we replace in (3) (&, y, £) by the surface point 
(a, y, 2) we obtain: 


0=[(y— y) @{— 2~)—(@, — 2) (y—y)] 3) 
+{[@-9M-y) -—G-NG-4] (iz) 


+ —2) @—2)-@-)@—29) (7) 6) 


and this, combined with the equation of the surface, gives the dior- 
thodic curve. 

As we move along the diorthode, (5) may be considered a plane 
which turns about the chord (1, 2) as an axis, so as to be always 
normal to the surface. It follows that the normals at any point of 
the diorthede are constrained to pass through the chord. They will 
thus generate a ruled surface, whose equation is not (5) however. 


126 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The equation of this ruled surface is obtained by eliminating 2, y, z 
from (1), (2), and (5). It is important to remark that the dior- 
thode does not consist of parts which are diorthodes with respect to 
their termini, otherwise the normals would at the same time pass 
through two chords from the same point and the curve would be a 
plane curve. Dr. Bremiker had erroneously supposed that the 
diorthode was touched by the normal planes. This is only the case 
at the termini. He has been criticized by Dr. Bruns of Pulkowa 
and by Helmert, but neither critic has shown the existence of a curve 
possessing this property, namely, the prodrthode, in which the nor- 
mal plane at any of its points passes through the consecutive point 
and the forward terminus, but not in general through the starting 
point. If then in (5) we replace (,, y,,2,) by («+ dz, y+ dy, 
z+ dz) we have: 


0=[y.—y) de— (e,— 2) ay (FZ) 
+[@—2)dy— (de ($2) 


+ [(a,— x) dz — (z,— z) dx] (3 ai 
Gi 


aaa s>2) 7) 1@ 
+[@-9 (SE) =< a -»(¢ a) |e 


du U 
+[@- (F) -% —» (Z) Je 6) 
By means of the equation of the surface (1) and its differential 
equation 
d d x 
o= (34) de + (FH) ay + (FE yd) 


any one of the variables with its differential can be eliminated. 
The resulting differential equation being integrated so as to contain 
the starting point (2, y,, 2), will be the equation of a projection of 
the prodrthode on a coérdinate plane. 

The proérthode being differently related to its ends, will be dif 
ferent furward and backward, while the diorthode is the same for- 
ward and backward. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 127 


The following diagram will illustrate the relative course of these 
curves: 


“normal section 


tteiete dioTthode 


Bee proorthode 
te brachisthode 


Any surface of the second degree may be represented by 
z—a\? yp 2 
= 0 = |—— v—_|  — 8 
u=o= (**) 404% a (8) 
The origin is taken at one of its real vertices, so that (a, 0, 0) is 
its centre. The equation of the diorthode is then by (5), if we 
write %,— ©, = AX; J, — J, = AY; 4-444 


0=[y— 9) (4-2) —@—2)(U—- DIG 


C—O 


+[e%—2)m%—-Y)—-Y—-YNa-AI | 
+[@%—2)4-)-&@-%) GA- «“)] = 


Zz 
= (y, X, — YL, + YX — Ay) ”q 


“—a 
+ & % — 4% + 24y — ydz) — 
+ (a, 2 — 2, % + waz — zhx) = 
1 
ns ale 2)n sa (2 1) 
eta 
+ (2, % — % Yo) a 


2 Z 
+ (4, % — 2, 2, + pdz) z + (YX = Yy % — VIG (9) 

The equations of the chord (1, 2) may be written: 
brat RL Se Pea AR (10) 


Every point of the chord, therefore, satisfies (9), and since that 


128 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


represents a surface of the second degree, it must be a hyperboloid 
of one sheet, for this and its varieties are the only ruled surfaces of 
that order. In the general form (9) it has a center in finite space. 
It is then the elliptic hyperboloid ; but if a = p (ora = qor p = q), 
it has its center at an infinite distance, and it is a parabolic hyperbo- 
loid. In this case the base surface a satis 


Ss ae = (11) 


which is a surface of ei of the Sec degree. 

If a = p= q, then (9) becomes a plane and the base surface a 
sphere. (9) is evidently satisfied by the center (a, 0, 0), therefore 
the intersecting surface always passes through the center of the 
base surface. 

I consider now the ellipsoid : 


0= 


2 


x? 2 
0O=C+R+5-1 (12) 
We have then the intersecting surface of the diorthode: 


# y 
0 = %%— 4% + Ay — ydz) + (a, 2% — %, % + Az — 2A) pr 


@ 
+ (Ys %, — I, % + Yaw — wAy) = (13) 
Let (0, y,, 2) be the eae wnire ane chord CL, 2) pierces the yz - plane 
(aw, 0, 2,) “ “ ae. * 
(z,, ws 0) éc “cc “ce cc “cc xy ‘a “ce 
then we can easily verify the relations: 
ts A WRIT WL eRe aan hig AO ba 
Sipe AX I ear Ax (14) 
Jee hp Ge re 
Ae Ay Pig aye Ay (14,) 
g, = HAS . y, = AAs (14,) 


and if we assume: 


a i 


a, =1— ;@42=1-— 


> (15,) 

B b ) 

ee hy yal (15,) 
e 
Bb 


(15,) 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 129 
(13) will take sia of the following annuals forms : 


0=42%,—- 4) = {+ Ac (2,— f 2) Fe + Ay (@, — ~ 720) (13"} 


0 = ay (2, — a2) + az(a,— fine tar, — ree (13%) 


The following relations will be much referred to: 


Y2 ey ah Yx 1 
(teat ete (16) 
Ea il Sie ie I iiaale SG eee 7 
x, Yx e, ae %, ; UP z, x, ce x, ‘ 
Z,.—2 r 4 
x y toe yy, eae yx (17) 
2 Bm ae a 
0=42, ¥, Ze Ys 2, &, (18) 
Replacing in these Ax, Ay, Az; Y,, 25) 3 Zar Uys Ye 
Des A ii yak 
by Gr Ger i wr Borie 5 Ses Bar Fo (19) 
2 fy 2 2 2 2 2 
Nn 2 “a i B a, 
we have: 0 = ae Be =a oh “ip aa (16' 
By Sar i — is — 8, a Tic im a," a a,” wd Pa 
By ieee A OR, “leat oti 
a,” ae 8, ee B, os dy” (eu) 
a, ie nes Vv 
0 Saw 7 tn a,” = ay” a? ie (18") 


and these relations also will be found correct. 


Because in the equation of the diorthodic surface the terms in 
x,y, 2 are wanting, there must be lines, perpendicular to the co- 
ordinate planes, lying wholly in the surface. To determine those 
perpendicular to the zy- plane, I place = 0 the term in ee de- 

pendent on z and that in (13") independent of 2, or 


Ay 
> A 


Be 2 
O= — yar art n— 7. &) 


to % vy 
= — part ;— 2) by (16) and (16! 


4 
O = ayz, - a+ az(2, — 20) Fs 


: iG as 2) y by (16) and (16') 


=> 


130 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Substituting the value of y from the first into ‘the second equation 
we have: 


Ys MEM ee) nt 
0— Be +sS ie — =) (7-2) 


0= a Ts —2,)a+ St «) (4 —_— ) by (17,) and (17,') 


By lo a 
v, x x. 
=i fe y ot) a a eas — ores 
(Ft) ets ews | 2 


Corresponding to the hi a we have: 
tc Y, Ly — 2, ' Y, %y—, 
et MAY RI 
and Se to the second : 
Cay 
Y= me _ de “x, (- ni)! az, Be za =i by ly cig 

Denoting hat constants by %,, 2%, Ys Yq» respectively, we have 
then the equations of a pair of generatrices of the hyperboloid (13) 
perpendicular to the zy - plane: 


xis me by (17,) 


x Zz 

eas y= i= y (20,) 
&. Yx 

t= Ba My; Y= G2 (20,") 

Similarly the pair of generatrices perpendicular to the yz - plane: 
Yx %,. 
a > er ba 20, 

yee es ae (20,) 
Ys 2 

aire (Visca Taq (20,") 

and that perpendicular to the za - plane 

Z @ 

ait Va a tila io (20,) 
&. x, 

= za rire? a te (20,*) 


Now the second line of each pair intersects the chord, as may be 
proved thus: The equations of the chord (1, 2) are any two of the 
following three equations: 


LE 6 
pte ete (21,) 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 131 


at ones (21,) 
A 21 
ange be ye 

1 : 
Now B+ bist a ai + Am ale = 0 


and (21,) or (21,) can always be satisfied for some value of z; 
therefore (20,’) intersects the chord. In the same manner it may 
be proved that (20,’) and (20,*) intersect the chord. It follows, 
then, that (20,), (20,), and (20,) cannot intersect the chord, and 
hence belong to the same system of generation. 

The equations of a pair of lines intersecting in a given point of 
the hyperboloid and belonging to different systems of generation 
can be easily found by the condition that one of them must inter- 
sect (20) and the other (20). I omit this, but give a remarkable 
symmetrical form of the equation of the hyperboloid : 
0=(e@—%,) (y—4,) (2-4) — (@— &) (Y — Ya) @—%) (22) 

TF @(Y,2,— Ya%y) + y (2,2, Ta 2, X,) = 2(2, Yq aah x, Y,) 

— xy (2, —%) — y2(%, — 2.) — 2e(Y, —Y,), because 2,4, 2, = %, Y,% 
by (18) and (18'). 

It is immediately evident that this equation is satisfied by equa- 
tions (20). Itis not uninteresting to prove that it also satisfies (21), 
or that it contains the chord, since it shows the remarkable plia- 
bility of these forms by virtue of the relations (16), (17), (18), 
fo"), (177), (18°). 

The points (2, Yes 2,)s (®er Yor 2v)» (Lp Yor 2) (Lvs Yar 20)» (ys Yar Za)» 
(&,, Y,, 2,) form a warped hexagon, which lies wholly in the hyper- 
boloid, and its sides may be considered six intersecting edges of a 
characteristic parallelopipedon. These edges are: 


1 1 1 
A= 5%, —2,)3 B= > y.—9.); C= > @—4,) 3) 
and the co-ordinates of its center are: 
1 1 1 
t= 5 (% + %)3 Yor va iy “U3 Se OY (2, + %) (24) 


and these must be those of the center of the hyperboloid also. 
Transferring the origin of co-ordinates to this center, we have 
the equation of the hyperboloid regarding (23) : 


0= (@— A) (y— B) (@— C)—(@+ A) V+ B+) (25) 


132 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


From this equation we soon find by familiar processes the 
lengths and directions of the principal axes. 

As to the question, Which of the alignment curves should be 
used in geodesy? I observe that between two intervisible points on 
the terrestrial spheroid the difference between the course of these 
curves is so extremely minute that they are practically identical ; 
we can use then that method of tracing which is most convenient. 
For the distance of non-intervisible stations I consider the brachis- 
thode the geodetic line as heretofore, because 1st, the diorthode be- 
comes impracticable; and 2d, it cannot be divided into portions 
which are themselves diorthodes. As Assistant Wm. Eimbeck, of 
the United States Coast and Geodetic Survey, suggested to me, the 
diorthode proper cannot even be traced between very distant 
stations, which are intervisible only from very elevated positions, 
such as high peaks or the usual wooden structures. Thisled me to 
consider a new class of alignment curves—the apparent horizon 
alignment curves. The a. h. pro-orthode would be the locus of all 
points for which the tangent cuts the normal at the forward end; 
while the a. h. diorthode is a curve, at any point of which a tangent 
to the surface, which passes through the normal at one end, also 
passes through that at the other end. The equation (3) being 
adapted to these changed conditions will furnish also the equations 
of these curves; and I have thus found that the a. h. diorthode on 
an ellipsoid has an intersecting surface of the fourth order. 


Messrs. HARKNEsS and DooLirrLE made remarks on this paper. 


Mr. Asapu HAtt then made a communication on 


THE DETERMINATION OF THE MASS OF A PLANET FROM OBSERVA- 
TIONS OF TWO SATELLITES. 


[ Abstract. ] 


M. Struve recommends that the position angle and distance of one 
satellite from another satellite be measured, instead of referring the 
place of each to the center of the primary planet; and a series of 
such measurements on satellites of Jupiter has been begun under 
his direction at Pulkowa. ‘These observations are found to occupy 
one-third the time, and are considered two or three timés as accurate 
as those where the planet is used. The most important advantage 
of the new method is its freedom from the unknown constant errors 
attending the old, due to the great difference in size and bright- 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 133 


ness of the objects measured. The price to be paid for this ad- 
vantage is a greatly increased complexity in the computation; for 
the elements of both orbits now enter into each equation of con- 
dition, and there are therefore twelve normal equations instead 
of six to solve. The comparative difficulty may be estimated by 
the number of auxiliary quantities that must be computed in the 
solution of 2 equations, namely : 


Zn (n+1) (n+), 


which amounts to 77 for n = 6, and to 442 for n = 12; a value 
nearly six times as great. But it is worth while to bear in mind 
that the twelve equations, by giving the elements and mean distance 
. of each satellite, give two values of the planet’s mass. 

Mr. Harkness called attention to the advantage of substituting 
an accidental error, be it even a large one, for an unknown constant 
error. 

Mr. Taytor criticised the designations usually given to the 
apsides of satellites orbits as being particular when they should be 
general. He suggested the terms peri-apsis and apo-apsis, or aphapsis. 

Remarks were also made by Messrs. KUMMELL and HI Lt. 


Before adjournment the Chairman replied to some questions as 
to the new object glass for the Imperial Observatory at Pulkowa; 
and gave a short explanation of the difficulty of calculating the 
true anomaly in elliptic orbits, 


4TH MEETING. May 9, 1883. 
The Chairman presided. 
Present: twelve members and one guest. 
The report of a committee appointed by the General Committee 
of the Society to consider matters pertaining to Sections was read. 
Mr. DooxitrLeE read a paper entitled 


INFINITE AND INFINITESIMAL QUANTITIES. 
[ Abstract. ] 


An infinitesimal may be defined as the result of infinite division ; 


134 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


but the term infinite division probably does not represent the same 
conception to all mathematicians. If we suppose a quantity divided 
into a number of parts, and each of these parts subdivided, and 
similar subdivisions to go on forever, each requiring finite time, we 
have a conception to which the name infinite division may be given 
with some appropriateness, but which might better be called eternal 
division. Such division never reaches a result. But if we suppose 
the time of each subdivision to be proportional to the magnitude of 
each part, the entire process is completed in finite time, although 
no limit can be given to the number of subdivisions. If a point 
be supposed to have passed with constant velocity over a given 
distance, there was a time when it had passed over half the distance ; 
afterward a time when the remaining distance was one-fourth of the 
original distance; the number of such successive halvings is cer- 
tainly unlimited; and the result is that there is no remaining dis- 
tance. This is division infinite but not eternal, and the result seems 
to be zero. 

As a point is defined to be position without magnitude, so may an 
infinitesimal be defined to be quantitative relation without magnitude, 
The terms infinitesimal, differential, nothing, and zero, are not 


synonyms. They have the same logical denotation but differ in 


connotation. Mathematicians usually speak of “the value” or 
“the true value” of a vanishing fraction, as though any quantity 
whatever were not a true value. The term serial value is proposed 
as conducive to clearness of thought. A differential coefficient is 
the serial value of a vanishing fraction; and a differential or infi- 
nitesimal may be further defined as zero in serial relation to con- 
tinuously diminishing quantity. 

The term infinitesimal is however frequently employed like other 
terms to denote the symbol of its exact signification. We speak of 
drawing and erasing lines, meaning the visible symbols of Euclidean 
lines. Even in our purely mental processes we give the name 
points to the imagined small volumes that symbolize positions with- 
out magnitude. In like manner the term infinitesimal is employed 
to denote the imagined small quantity in approximate relation that 
symbolizes a relation which becomes exact only when magnitude 
disappears. e 

A line is infinite relatively to a point, but infinitesimal, 2. e., zero, 
relatively to a surface or volume. Every quantity is finite rela- 
tively to other quantities of its own order—zero relatively to orders 


I, OE ee 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 135 


above and infinite relatively to orders below. A volume is inte- 
grated from surfaces, a surface from lines, and a line from points. 
Each integral is infinite relatively to the magnitudes from which 
it is integrated. As momentum is integrated from motion-genera- 
ting force, it is infinite relatively thereto. Momentum may also be 
dissipated by infinitesimal decrements; and it is possible that mo- 
mentum is always thus dissipated and re-integrated whenever 
motion is communicated from one body to another; but the prin- 
ciples of mathematics are equally consistent with the hypothesis 
that actual contact sometimes occurs, in which case motion is di- 
rectly. and instantaneously transmitted without dissipation or re- 
integration. Granting that infinitesimal time requires infinite force, 
momentum satisfies that condition. 

This paper gave rise to considerable discussion, in which Messrs. 
Taytor, Hitt, KuMMELL, and Leravour maintained the legiti- 
macy of the notion of infinitesimals as real elements out of which 
quantity is built up; Messrs. E:xiorr, DooLitrrye, and FarquHaR 
took the opposite ground, preferring the Newtonian view of the 
Calculus; while Mr. Curistixn, while preferring the infinitesimal 
method, maintained that no evaluation of continuous quantity, in 
terms of units as it must necessarily be, could ever be precise or 
entirely satisfactory, to however small a compass the uncertainty be 
reduced. Mr. CurisTIE also pointed out some paradoxes to which 
the usual definitions of curves and tangents appeared to lead. 


Mr. Exiorr then exhibited some tables to serve as a perpetual 
calendar, and gave a full explanation how by means of them the 
day of the week corresponding to that of the month for any year, 
New or Old Style, B. C. or A. D., could be found. 


5tH MEETING. May 23, 1883. 
The Chairman presided. 
Twenty members and guests present. 


The appointment of the committee called for under the new 
Standing Rule relating to papers read before Sections of the 
Society was considered. Mr. Tayntor moved that the committee 
consist of the Chairman and Secretary and a third member to be 


136 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


appointed by the Chair. After some diScussion by Messrs. 
HARKNEss and ELuiorT it was so ordered, with the additional 
provision that this appointment be made for each paper separately. 


Mr. G. W. Hitt made a communication on 
PLANETARY PERTURBATIONS OF THE MOON, 


which was yet unfinished when he yielded the floor to Mr. G. K. 
GILBERT, who made a communication on 


GRAPHIC TABLES FOR COMPUTING ALTITUDES FROM BAROMETRIC 
DATA. 


This paper will appear in the Bulletins of the U. S. Geological 
Survey. 


6TH MEETING. JUNE 6, 1883. 
The Chairman presided. 
Present, sixteen members and guests. 
Mr. G. W. Hit concluded his paper on 


CERTAIN POSSIBLE ABBREVIATIONS IN THE COMPUTATION OF THE 
LONG-PERIOD PERTURBATIONS OF THE MOON’S MOTION 
DUE TO THE DIRECT ACTION OF THE PLANETS. 


[ Abstract. ] 


Hansen has characterized the calculation of these inequalities as 
extremely difficult. However, it seems to me that if the shortest 
methods are followed there is no ground for such an assertion. The 
work may be divided into two portions independent of each other. 
In one the object is to develop, in periodic series, certain functions 
of the moon’s coordinates, which in number do not exceed five. 
This portion is the same whatever planet may be considered to act, 
and hence may be done once for all. In the other portion we seek 
the coefficients of certain terms in the periodic development of 
certain functions, five also in number, which involve the codrdinates 
of the earth and planet only. And this part ofthe work is very 
similar to that in which the perturbations of the earth by the 
planet in question are the things sought. And as the multiples of 
the mean motions of these two bodies, which enter into the expres- 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. Tz 


sion of the argument of the inequalities under consideration, are 
necessarily quite large, approximate values of the coefficients may 
be obtained by semi-convergent series similar to the well-known 
theorem of Stirling. This matter was first elaborated by Cauchy,* 
but in the method as left by him we are directed to compute special 
values of the successive derivatives of the functions to be developed. 
Now it unfortunately happens that these functions are enormously 
complicated by successive differentiation, so that it is almost impos- 
sible to write at length their second derivatives. Manifestly then, 
it would be a great saving of labor to substitute for the computation 
of special values of these derivatives a computation of a certain 
number of special values of the original function, distributed in 
such a way that the maximum advantage may be obtained. This 
modification has given rise to an elegant piece of analysis. 

It will be noticed that in this method it is necessary to substitute 
in the formule, from the outset, the numerical values of the elements 
of the orbits of the earth and planet. There seems to be no objec- 
tion to this on the practical side, as for the computation of the 
inequalities sought no partial derivatives of R, with respect to 
these elements, are required. 

The paper is printed in full in the American Journal of Mathe- 
matics, Vol. VI. 


Mr. E. B. Evutorr made a communication on 


UNITS OF FORCE AND ENERGY, INCLUDING ELECTRIC UNITS. 


SeventH MEETING. NOVEMBER 21, 1883. 
The Chairman presided. 


Thirteen members present. 


* Mémoire sur les approximations des fonctions de trés-grands nombres, and 

, Rapport sur un Mémoire de M. Le Verrier, qui a pour objet la détermination 

dune grande inégalité du moyen mouvement de la planéte Pallas. Comptes 

Rendus de Académie des Sciences de Paris. Tom. XX, pp. 691-726, 767-786, 
825-847. 


138 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Mr. C. H. KuMMELL read a communication ertitled 


THE THEORY OF ERRORS PRACTICALLY TESTED BY TARGET- 
SHOOTING. 


[ Abstract. ] 


Sir John Herschel treats a special case in which shots of equal 
probability are in circles. According to Liagre’s theory target 
shooting is compounded of two distinct operations, viz., sighting 
and leveling, each of which is liable to errors, independently fol- 
lowing the ordinary linear law of error. Some reasons for the in- 
dependence of these operations are that for sighting the direction 
of the wind, which does not affect the leveling, must be regarded; 
and that, on the other hand, leveling only is affected by the range. 
The consequences of Liagre’s theory will now be developed. 

Let x = error of sighting and ¢, its mean error; 

y = error of leveling and «, its mean error ; 
then it follows that 


x 
d — 52 
wi e 26x" — probability to hit anywhere at distance z from 
sighting axis. (1) 
d a 
we gree probability to hit anywhere at distance y from 
y g | 
leveling axis. (1,) 
ded Se 
— - — 2 
’ —— ates 3 “Go probability to hit the point (2, y). (2) 
FE y7 
This probability is the same for any point on the ellipse: 
Pr 2 9? 1 
3 a a= where © = oy Ce 0 e”) (3) 
x Ag 


This I shall call, then, an equal probability ellipse; its semi-axes 
are: 


ae fy 
A oe : (4) 
and r = mean semi-diameter (which is equal to its conjugate). 


r 


€ 
Assume ar and : pee ae (5) 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 139 


then every point on the equal probability ellipse (3) corresponds 
to a point (#,, y,) on the circle: #7 + y7 = 7", (6) 
which is the reduced equal probability circle. 
Counting directions from the right of the x - axis, let 


a = direction of (x,y) (7) 
i= ia “ (@,,Y,), or reduced direction of (z,y) (8) 
h wots y fy O &x oo fy 9 
peewee ee sri sais (9) 
also = = 7 COS a, (10,) 
Bee ca 
y= 7 sin a, (10,) 


€ € s 
whence dz = ~ cosa, dr — ~r sin a,da, 


S é 
een a ae 
dy = — sin a,dr + — r cos a,da, 


Transforming, then, (2) to the new variables, 7 and a,, we must 
replace: 


dedvan e,.¢,rdrda, 
e? 
and thus obtain 
rdrda, — kad 
Ont & 2c — probability to hit a point of which (r, a,) 
is the reduced point. (11) 


Vg. 


A» 


FAN 
an 


Fig. 1 exhibits 24 shots of equal probability, on an equal proba- 
bility ellipse, and their reduced positions evenly distributed over 
the reduced circle. 


140 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The probability to hit anywhere on the perimeter of an equal 
probability ellipse of mean semi-diameter, 7, is found by integrating 
(11), with respect to a,, through a circumference. It is 


re 
r € . 


Let n, = number of shots on area of equal probability ellipse of 
semi-diameter 7, and n = total number; then 


n ar Afi co =f ue MB 
T= f- we 22@=1—e 26” op Bo 2 —tt = 2e7 (18) 
0 o 
Let r =p; if n,=3n, thon} =e 22.5. p= 7/212 (14) 
The ellipse : 
2 2 
+ 4=212 (15) 
x y 


is then an even chance ellipse, which is hit or missed with equal 
probability. Eliminating <« between (13) and 14), we obtain: 


(55)"= (@)" as 


These formule agree with Herschel’s in form, and have, also, the 
same signification, in case the precisions of sighting and leveling are 
equal, for in that case the ellipses (3) and (15) become circles and 
r, p their radii, respectively. Herschel employs these formule for 


determining the skill of a marksman, which he defines to be =-, 


from the number of shots that have fallen on a circle of radius r. 
Correspondingly, we should have to count the shots that have 
fallen on an equal probability ellipse, the axes of which have the 


unknown ratio —., which, as yet, we have no method of finding; 
€ = 


therefore formule (14) and (17) cannot be employed in their gen- 
eral signification. If, nevertheless, we count the shots on a circle 
of radius r and compute a value for p and ¢, we shall come as near 
to their true values as the problem requires, especially if the precis- 
ions of sighting and leveling are not very different. This can be 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 141 


shown analytically by proving that the probability of hitting the 
area of the circle 


x _- y? — ia 
differs from that of hitting the equal probability ellipse 
ger Ss ea 
es a mee 


by terms of the fourth order, with respect to the difference between 
the mean errors of sighting and leveling. 

In computing p by (17) the radius (or mean semi-diameter) 7 is 
left arbitrary ; it is, however, not at all indifferent; for if we take 
it very small or very large it will give very unreliable values of p. 


There must then be a certain magnitude of r giving the most re- 
- 


re 
: ue : rdr — ss 
liable value of p, anditis that which makes P, = —-é 22 4 
‘ ie aay r 
maximum. This gives the condition: 0 = zrworse 


Thus the most favorable value of r for determining p is the 
2 


2 
mean error « and the ellipse on =1 (18) 
= My 


is the ellipse of the most probable shot. 
Placing 7 = ¢ in (13), we have 


I 
pe 2 OR06E8.... 
n 


I 
.n, = ( —e z) n = 0.39847 ...n=0.4n nearly (19) 
The most probable shot is, therefore, the distance of the (0.4n)th 
shot from the center nearly; also the mean of the (0.4n + m)th, 
and the (0.4n — m)th shot should, if m is not too large, give a fair 
value of the most probable shot. 
Solving (13) for «, we have also 


Cee 
2! n (20) 
n—N, 


From the definition of e, and es it is obvious that 


psa gf a 


142 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


which formule afford a comparison between the precisions of 
sighting and leveling. We have then 


el: =] 24 gf 
c= Jit = ory . as 
This formula, although laborious for practical use, is the most 
rigorous measure of skill in shooting, and there is no need of other 
formule except when shots are lost. In that case it requires an 
important modification, whereby it loses in rigor if the number of 
lost shots is considerable. Assuming the precisions of sighting 
and leveling equal, then the reduced distance r in (12) will be the 
actual distance s of a shot; and if the target is circular, of limiting 
radius R, we have 
nD R j & 


[s*], Ser oF fi ee 


o 


Bays . eG 
=n} — 2 ze <A bah =)! 


ke? 
Now by (18) fe G. ft 


therefore [2], # on, gee (n — Np ) R 
"R 
and wis Le ota (n Tee )e (23) 
2n 2 


This formula reverts, of course, to (22), ifn =n # and it makes 


the most probable sum of the squares of the lost shots 
ny oe ae R 
[s iM 5 (n n eh 
R R 


and since ( a Ni is the smallest possible actual value of 


this quantity ; this expression for it is quite plausible. 
The targets used by the National Rifle Association are rectan- 
gular. (At long range they are 12 feet wide and 6 feet high). 


ae 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 143 


Let a (= 6 feet) be the limiting value of « and b (= 3 feet) that 
for y, then we have, if n,, is the number of hitting shots 


a * b , 
dz a dy ST Se 
Eagles Te re NGI ease aN Ga 


% dz eee 9 z 72 
i => — 2 x = — dt ir 
The integral P#, f ie ‘ =) é , and 


similarly Pi,, is tabulated in Chauvenet’s Method of Least Squares 
(Table IX, appendix, to the argument ¢), and is therefore known. * 


We have further: 


ny a can b yy 
[a] Pals oe f is ee é 2e2? £ dy _ a ze? 
; Say 8/20 ane ey 20 
a x2 
oe 
= nPt, [Sse = 6 +), ss dives 
= ne, Pt, (Pt, — tP't,) (25,) 


2 
9 fete 


= 
Here P’t, denotes —+* fy mies e and can also be taken from 


Chauvenet’s table, £6 100 X difference. Similarly, 


1 
[y"] = ne,'Pt, (Ph — hP) (25,) 
By virtue of (24) we have also 
[a7] Nay 
ep Abi es / 
- P%. (25,’) 
nol 07) 
Talia 
hte ae (25,') 
wll 2, ) 


and these formule may be used to compute «, and «, by an obvious 


ab 
2 
approximative process. They show that «,* > a as it should 


‘ab 


144 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 
be; but it may, or rather must, happen sometinies that the most 


n n 
probable increase of the sum of 2? and y’ or [2*]_ + [y] consistent 
Nap Nes; 


with (25’) is << (n —n,,) 6’,b being the smaller limit. Such a re- 
sult cannot be accepted, being contradictory to the fact that there 
are n—n,, shots at a greater distance than 6. The following 
method gives plausible results in that case. Assume 


[y7], + = yy) 8? 
(4 ee (25,”) 


as first approximate value in (25,’), and if ¢,<(<,) adopt (<,) as 
final value of «,: but if ¢,>(¢,), then proceed in approximating to 
e, by (25,’). The solution of (25,’) gives, as heretofore, the best 
value of ¢,. Among the target records of the international shoot- 
ing match of 1874, at Creedmoor, there are 9 with lost shots, 5 of 
which give too small an increase of sum of squares, and this means 
that from the record of the hitting shots it would not appear prob- 
able that so many shots were lost. 

Instead of the squares, we may, however, employ first powers of 
distances; and I shall develop the requisite formule for a circular 
target and equal precisions. 


Nap 


n R ee s? 
We have [s], k= nf 8 pid e 22 
> 


0 


iss 2 
an(— 27 ae NF Re | 


oe ~_ Be si by (13) 


ry, * (n ay ils 
eee )n a (26) 
if N p=, this becomes ¢ = ae . ; (27) 
a | Soe 
The quantity ae rad VE (28) 


: 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 145 


which may be called the average shot, has been recently introduced 
by the United States Ordnance Department, under the name 
“radius of the circle of shots,” in place of the extremely defective 
quantity, the mean absolute deviation, the insufficiency of which 
was pointed out by Henry Metcalfe, Captain of Ordnance, in the 
Report of the Chief of Ordnance of 1882. Thus the adopted 
method of discussion of the precision of firearms, as used by that 
department, is in agreement with Liagre’s theory, only the shots 
are not referred to the true center, but to the “center of shots,” 
viz.: their center of gravity. 

We have, now, the following three quantities, each of which may 
be used as a measure of precision, sighting and leveling being 
equally good. 

1, the even chance shot, p. 

2, the most probable shot, <, (or mean error of sighting and lev- 
eling). 

3, the average shot, 7,, also called radius of the circle of shots; 
and they are related to each other as follows: 


p 2 
2a > ONG pe 


The preceding formule I regard as complete, for practical discus- 
sion of target records, provided there is no evidence for a constant 
vitiating cause. If, for example, during a shooting match the wind 
is blowing constantly in the same direction, the effect of this might 
be partially revealed by computing for the whole match the quan- 
tity : 

= 8 

If the sign of this quantity is consistent with the observed direc- 
_ tion of the wind, it might, perhaps, be proper to refer the shots to 
a new center, to the right or left of the true center, by this quan- 
tity. In that case we have, however, 

he | ne? 
‘ - fa" : —1 i 

In leveling there may be a somewhat constant individual habit 
of holding too high or too low, which, however, ought not to be 
eliminated in a fair discussion of a match, although it would be of 
interest to compute the quantity 

Ly] 


Oo 
n 
for each marksman and for a whole team. 


146 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Much less proper, it would seem to me, to regard the position of 
the axes unknown, and to compute their most probable position. If 
center and axes are to be determined, 2’ y’ denote the co-ordinates 
of ashot from a random origin and position of axes, and w the 
angle of turning the latter into their most probable direction ; then 
the most probable co-ordinates of a shot are: 


e=2,+2 cosw+ysinw; y=y,+y cosw — x sinw. 
Imposing the conditions of a minimum for [27] and [y’], we find 


v, = — =; (LeJeosw+ fy] sin w) 
(33) 
y= — = (iy cos w — [2’] sin w) 


[?yJ—— (ef 


tan 2u = ——_,; —*_______ (34) 
[2] ——{e'P — [y+ — FP 


These formule have, however, their proper place in the theory of 
Andre’s “ Fehler-ellipse.” 

Fig. 2 exhibits an ideal distribution of 45 shots. Each ring con- 
tains 6 shots, leaving 3 shots between the outer ring and infinity. 
The dotted circle is that of the most probable shot, and the dashed 
one that of the even chance shot. 


The following table refers to the combined target record of the 
Irish team at 800 yards range, in the international shooting match 
of 1874, at Creedmoor : 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


147 


Irish Team at 800 yards: ¢ = 1.8095 ft.; 90 shots, 88 hits. 


No. of shots on > 
circle. 3 
Radit. a 
Theory.| Actual. rs 
Feet. 
0.5 63 | 5 +L1.3 
1.0 2226 || 22 +0.8 
1.5 43-3 | 47 Pa ot 
2.0 62.0 | 58 +4.0 
RA ay CR 1.5 
Leveling limit__| 3-0 83.5 | 83 -+0.5 
35 || 87-5 | 87-+-?| +0.5? 
4.0 89.2 | 87-1? ? 
4.5 89.8 | 88+? ? 


No. of shots on 
ring. 


Theory.| Actual. 


6.3 
16.5 
20.5 


18.7 


13-5 


Discrepancy. 


a 
bo 


| 
ie) 
tn 


A target of 50 pistol shots at 50 yards range shows similar dis- 
cordance between theory and practice, which, on an average, may 
be taken less than 5 per cent. 


148 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Target of pistol shots at 50 yards range: ¢ = 0.167 ft.; 50 shots, 


NO Misses. 
| No. of shots on | No. of shots on 
circle. ring. 
Radii. ||- Diserep'y:"|—--_, | Dares: 
Theory. | Actual. Theory. | Actual. 
5 | i es 
22. i 
0.5 1.5 I +0.5 1.5 I +0.5 
1.0 5.9 8 —2.1 4.4 7 —2.6 
el 12.2 14 18 6.3 6 +0.3 
2.0 19.7 23 —3.3 72 9 —I.5 
2.5 27.0 28 —1I.0 ise} 5 +2.3 
3-0 Nn 3a 33 +0.7 6.7 5 +17 
3-5 || 39-6 37 +2.6 5-9 4 +1.9 
4.0 43-2 41 2.2 3.6 4 —0.4 : 
4.5 46.0 46 0.0 2.8 5 —2.2 
5.0 47.8 47 +08 | 1.8 I +08 | 
5.5 48.8 49 —0,2 1.0 2 —1.0 
6.0 49.4 50 —o.6 0.6 I —0.4 
49-4 50 


Mr. ELiiorr gave an example of remarkably close agreement 
between the distribution of errors by theory and by observation of the 
chest measurements of 1,516 United States soldiers, reported by Dr. 
Bulkley at the Berlin Statistical Congress. In five groups the 
greatest difference was four-tenths per cent. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 149 


Er1egHtH MEETING. DrEcEMBER 5, 1883. 
The Chairman presided. 


Fourteen members and guests present. 


Mr. ALvorpD discussed 
A SPECIAL CASE IN MAXIMA AND MINIMA, 


the problem being to find the radius of the sphere that will displace 
the maximum quantity of liquid from a conical wine glass full of 
water. 

The differential co-efficient, when put equal to zero, is in the form 
of two factors. Equating each to zero, one gives the radius of the 
maximum sought; the other gives a still larger radius, which proves 
to be the radius of the sphere just tangent to the centre of the base 
of the cone, and to the sides of the cone, extended upwards. This 
gives the minimum displacement equal to zero. Calling a the 
radius of the base, 6 the height, and ¢ the slant height of the cone, 
theradius of the sphere producing maximum displacement equals 

abe 


Ce — aa fe)? 


ment equals 


the radius corresponding to minimum displace- 


C— a. 

When the radius is still greater, the sphere does not reach the 
surface of the liquid, but displaces an imaginary quantity of the 
same. An analytical expression for this case was sought in vain; 
the result above is simple, and no square root of a negative 
quantity appears. By some deyice in the mode of investigation, 
this imaginary case might appear, as in the question to obtain the 
radical axis of two circles, discussed by Salmon. 

Mr. KuMMELL suggested that the close relation between the 
circle x” + y’ = FR’ and the equilateral hyperbola 2? — y’?= R’, each 
of which could be regarded as an imaginary branch of the other, 
might help us to understand many of such difficulties. He showed 
that the radical axis of two circles not intersecting was the com- 
mon chord of two equilateral hyperbolas whose major axes were. 
those diameters of the circles which lie in the same straight line. 


Mr. EvLLiottr read a communication on 
A FINANCIAL PROBLEM, 


in which he gave formule for calculating the advantage of in- 


150 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


vestment in United States Government bonds, at Six or at four per 
cent., and making use of the banking privileges thus available, 
over investment at a higher rate without such privileges. The 
restrictions caused by the high premium on Government bonds, the 
bank tax, and the necessary specie reserve were all allowed for. 

This paper was discussed by Messrs. Harkness, DE Lanp, 
SmILEy, and others. 


Mr. H. Farquuar presented the following 


FORM OF LEAST-SQUARE COMPUTATION. 


Suppose four unknown constants, A, B, C and D, are to be cal- ° 


culated from equations of condition of the form 
aA + 6B+cC+dD=y. 
Arrange columns in order (1) a’, (2) ab, (3) ae, (4) ad, (5) ay, 
(6) b?, (7) be, (8) bd, (9) by, (10) e*, (11) ed, (12) ey, (18) d’, (14) dy 
Add up first five columns and place under (2) to (5) the quotients 
of their sums divided by 2(1). 


Put the product x) 3(2) under (6), + a ) ¥(3) under (7), 0,32 3(4) 


under (8), A, +(5) under (9), Fer +(3) under (10), sae) under 


(12): en 2(5) under (12), co 5(4) under (13), and aD 2(5) under 


(14), reversing the sign in every case. 
Then add up (6) to (9), placing under the sums of (7) to (9) 
their quotients divided by 2’(6). 
(7 
Put the product ae +’(7) under (10), 76, 2’(8) under (11), 
27) 


¥6) 29) ends (12, mB, 2’(8) under (13), and re 2”(9) under 


(14), reversing each sign. 
yw itil Ds 1, 
Add (10) to (12), putting quotients ach and ech under 
the sums. - 
rig 2”(11 
Put the product dy 2”(11) under (18) and m0) 2”(12) un- 


der (14), reversing the signs. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. - PHL 


wi 


214 
Add (13) and (14); when vrs =D. 


2”(12 a ChE) 
Then, under (12), enter eee ae Fag? = ( 


> 9 Dx Dy le 
Next, under (9), enter 6) re ~ Ee = B. 
20) | 3ta) 208) 22) 
Be) eat) pe ek 


Nores.—[1] The sign of summation is distinguished by an ad- 
ditional stroke for every additional quantity introduced under the 
column added up. 

[2] These additional quantities, under the columns of squares, 
(6), (10), and (13), will evidently all be negative. 

[3] This form may be extended to any number of unknown 
quantities, by insertion of ae, etc., between (4) and (5), be, etc., 
between (8) and (9), and so on. Modifications where there is a 
smaller number of unknown constants, and where one of them has 
the coefficient always unity, will be obvious. 

[4] One of the quantities a, }, etc., will, in many computations, 
be zero when another one is significant, and vice-versa ; as when one 
unknown quantity changes in the course of a series of observations. 
In this case we may save some columns by arranging our equation 
thus: a, A, + a, A, + 0B + etc. =y (where a, a, = 0, always). 
Here two sums are found under columns (1) to (5), two quotients 
under (2) to (5), and two additional quantities placed under each of 
the other columns before they are summed up. The remainder of 
the work then proceeds as before, except that the Jast step will be 
duplicate. 

[5] It will be found advisable always to make 4a, 2%, etc., as 
nearly zero as possible, so that the products will be smaller and 
there will be less danger of error. 

[6] The computation is to be checked by applying A, B, etc., 
and finding the residuals of y. Then 2 (a Ay), ¥(a 4b), etc., should 
all be zero. 

[7] Where but two unknown quantities are to be found, one of 
them with the constant coefficient unity (as A + b) B =), other 
methods will usually be preferable. Two of these will be given. 

I. If the values of 6 are symmetrical, so that b = 2? + b',,2+0’,, 
& + 0’,, etc., here all that is necessary to find B is to subtract the 


Lastly, under (5), enter D— B=. 


152 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON: 


value of y for every # — b’ from that for #0’, to multiply the 

remainders by 0’, to find 2 (b’ay) and divide it by 2 5 (b”), when 

the quotient will be B. If A should be wanted also—as is very 
AY 

often not the case—then 2y must also be found, and A = = — 6B, 

where n equals the number of equations. 

If. In all cases we may obtain the required values by taking the 
difference of 6 and of y from the mean of the column, multiplying 
the residual by the former difference, thus forming columns of 

2b\?2 rb » 
(0 _ =) and (0 _ =) (y _ a4 adding these and dividing 
the second sum by the first. That is, 


210-FZ)0-2)} 
SY y 
|e ea iS Ue te 1 Wheit"A co =o) 
y (0 idl =) 1 ie 
{(@-= 
Ninto MEETING. DECEMBER 19, 1883. 


The Chairman presided. 


Sixteen members and guests present. 


Mr. H. Farquuar furnished a 
NOTE ON THE PROBLEM DISCUSSED BY MR. ALVORD, 


in which he showed that the volume of a spherical segment of 


height h, zi? (Rk — zh), being real for all values of h, both positive 


and negative, was to be interpreted for h<0 or h>2H as the vol- 
ume of the segment of the equilateral hyperboloid of two sheets 
whose axes equal #; this volume being taken with a negative sign. 
It was positive for negative values of hf, since it must become zero 
when h = 0 by negative increments; hence the minimum of the 
function when A = 0 in such problems as the ene discussed. 


Mr. Doo.itrLE read a communication on 
THE REJECTION OF DOUBTFUL OBSERVATIONS. ° 
[ Abstract. ] 


For the purposes of this discussion we may divide errors into 


ee, ee a 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 153 


two‘grand classes, and name them, from their consequences, instruc- 
tive errors and uninstructive errors. The latter class includes blun- 
ders in recording, pointing on wrong objects, &c. The former con- 
sists of errors that indicate error in other observations. 

I once tried the experiment of dropping a short straight piece of 
wire five hundred times upon a sheet of ruled paper and counting 
the number of intersections of the wire with a ruled line. When 
the end of the wire touched or nearly touched a line, and inter- 
section was doubtful, I counted it as half an intersection. I re- 
corded the number of intersections in groups of fifty trials, as fol- 
lows: 23, 26, 28.5, 24, 31.5, 28, 27, 14, 25, 28.5. These numbers 
may be regarded as observations from which may be deduced the 
probable ratio of the length of the wire to the distance between 
two consecutive lines; and it seems impossible to account for the 
remarkable smallness of the eighth number by any supposition of 
uninstructive error. It is almost certain that a ratio deduced from 
it alone is largely in error; but it indicates that the other nine 
observations are somewhat in error, and that its error is needed to 
counterbalance theirs. If we retain it, and regard the mean of all 
as the most probable truth, we infer that this observation is 11.55 
units in error. If we reject it, and take the mean of the other nine 
as the most probable truth, we infer that this observation is 12 5-6 
units in error. It should be remembered that the rejection of an 
observation does not sweep from existence the fact of its occurrence; 
but merely increases its already large estimate of error. Because 
an error of 11.55 units is so large as to be very improbable, shall 
we therefore infer that an error of 12 5-6 units is more probable? 

It seems very clear to me that the larger an instructive error is 
the more instructive it is, and the more important is it that the 
observation containing it should not be rejected. The mean of all 
the ten above-described observations being regarded as the most 
probable truth, any one of the other nine could be better spared 
than the eighth. On the other hand, the larger an uninstructive 
error is, the more important it is that the observation should be 
rejected. Whenever an observation is intelligently rejected, there 
is a comparison of two antecedent probabilities, viz.: that of the 
occurrence of an instructive error of the magnitude involved and 
that of the occurrence of an uninstructive error of the same mag- 
nitude. When an error is evidently so large that it cannot possibly 


belong to the instructive class, the antecedent probability of such 
14 


154 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


an instructive error is 0; the antecedent probability of an unin- 
structive error is always greater than 0; and the observation should 
certainly be rejected. But since the theory of least squares allows 
no limit whatever to the possible magnitude of instructive errors, 
such rejection involves the admission that the method of least 
squares is not applicable to the case. When an observation involves 
a merely suspicious error, which is neither so large that instructive- 
ness is impossible nor so small as to pass without question, it would 
seem reasonable that the observation should be weighted according 
to the relative magnitudes of the two antecedent probabilities 
which I have mentioned; but this can never be determined with 
any approach to mathematical precision. 

In order to make this matter clear, let us suppose for example 
that ninety-nine observations of equal weight and known to be free 
from uninstructive error are separately written on as many cards; 
that the number 25 is arbitrarily written on a similar card; that 
these hundred cards are thoroughly shuffled; and that ten cards 
being then drawn at random, the following numbers appear on 
them: 15, 18, 14, 25, 17, 16, 15, 18, 16, 17. Let it be required to 
determine from these data, according to the theory of least squares, 
the probability that the number 25 on the fourth card drawn is the 
record of an observation. Here the antecedent probability of an 
uninstructive error is by hypothesis equal to 1-10. 

I commence by assuming a value of the required probability, 
and weight the doubtful observation accordingly. I then proceed 
in the ordinary method and determine an approximation to the 
antecedent probability of the occurrence of a genuine observation 


giving the value 25 by integrating <= fe — © dt between the 


limits corresponding to 24.5 and 25.5, since the observations are 
taken to the nearest unit. This integral is the antecedent proba- 
bility of an instructive error of the given magnitude, tainted with 
the incorrectness of the assumption with which I began. Call this 
P 
to +P 
it agrees with my original assumption, the problem is solved. If it 
does not agree, I have data for a better assumption according to the 
well-known method of trial and error. After a few repetitions of 
the process, as I have found by experiment, an assumption can be 
made that will be verified by agreement with the result. 


integral p. Then is the resulting required probability. If 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 155 


In practical problems the antecedent probability of blunders and 
other uninstructive errors is never known, and is only matter of 
exceedingly vague conjecture. Perhaps if a very large number of 
observations were examined, and the proportion of evidently unin- 
structive errors ascertained, a somewhat intelligent estimate might 
be made of the proportion of those that exist but are not evident; 
and data of some little value might be gathered toward a scientific 
method of weighting. But Ihave no faith that the result would 
be any where near worth the labor. At present, the best that a 
computer can do is to reject entirely, or retain entirely, or assign 
a simple weight, such as 3, 3, or #, in sheer desperation, and with 
the feeling that his judgment is nearly or quite worthless. It would 
be utter folly to assign weights upon a centesimal scale; and it 
would also be utter folly to conjecture an antecedent probability 
and proceed according to the method just set forth. 

It is well known that the method of least squares gives very un- 
trustworthy information in regard to the antecedent probability of 
large instructive errors. In regard to the other antecedent proba- 
bility required for an intelligent solution of the problem, it gives 
no information whatever. So far as I can understand Prof. 
Peirce’s method of arriving at a criterion, he takes two probabili- 
ties, both functions of probabilities of instructive error, and balances 
them against each other. This procedure reminds me of what 
sometimes haj.pens in war, when two detachments of the same 
army meet in the dark and fire into each other, each supposing the 
other to belong to the common enemy. Prof. Peirce also seems to 
me to violate the fundamental principle of the science of probabili- 
ties, that probabilities must be independent in order that their 
product shall equal concurrent probability. 

If a computer resorts to the criterion when he feels that his own 
judgment is worthless, and only then, the criterion is harmless ; 
since it is of no importance whether a decision is made by a worth. 
less judgment or a worthless criterion. 

In the discussion that followed, Mr. A. HAuu gave a brief account 
of the literature of the criteria which have been proposed for the 
rejection of doubtful observations. In addition to the criterion 
proposed by Prof. Peirce,,which had been discussed by Mr. Doolit- 
tle, that of Mr. E. J. Stone was mentioned; and also the proofs 
of a criterion given by Chauvenet and Watson. The advocacy of 
of Peirce’s criterion by Gould, Winlock, Bache, Coffin, and Schott 


156 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


was noticed, and also its criticism by Airy, Sténe, and Glaisher, 
together with Glaisher’s approval of De Morgan’s method of 
treating observations. In conclusion, Mr. HAut said: 

The general result of what has been done in this matter appears 
to be as as follows: 

Every one can devise a criterion that suits himself, but it will not 
please other people. 

Now there seems to be a good reason underlying this. The 
attempt to establish an arbitrary and general criterion for the dis- 
cussion and rejection of observations is an attempt to eliminate 
from this work the knowledge and judgment of the investigator. 
Such an attempt ought to fail, and it certainly will fail at length, 
no matter by what personal influence it may be supported. It is 
true that no proof has been given of the principle of the arith- 
metical mean for a finite number of observations, such as the prac- 
tical cases that always come before us; but we assume this principle 
as leading to the most probable result. When we depart from this 
principle, it must be done, I think, for reasons that are peculiar to 
each case, and there can be no better guide than the judgment of 
the investigator. It may be said that if the criteria that have 
been proposed be carefully managed they will do little harm, since 
the result of the arithmetical mean will be altered very little; and 
in fact this is their chief recommendation. But by diminishing 
the value of the real probable error the criteria give to the observ- 
ations a fictitious accuracy and a weight they do not deserve. 

The paper was also discussed by Messrs. Hit, Exuiorr, Far- 
QUHAR, WoopWARD, and others, including Mr. JAmMEs Maryn, a 
visitor—all agreeing, on essential points, with Mr. Doolittle’s view. 


Mr. R. S. WoopwAkrp then discussed 
THE SPECIAL TREATMENT OF CERTAIN FORMS OF 
OBSERVATION-EQUATIONS. 
[ Abstract. ] 


In a set of observation-equations whose type is 
z+ (t—t,) y—n =v with weight p, 
in which ¢, is an arbitrary constant, the same for éach equation, 
and in which the residuals, v, are supposed to arise solely from 
errors in the observed quantities, n, it will be best to make 


pea 
2 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 157 


This value of ¢, makes the co-efficient of y in the first normal 
equation and the co-efficient of z, in the second normal equation, 
zero, and hence gives directly 


[pn] 


yornv a 
_ [pt —t,)n] 
~ [pé—47] 


The weight of this value of x, is a maximum; 7. e., the value of 


pt] 


x, corresponding to ¢, = 7 P| has a greater weight than the value of 


x, corresponding to any other value of t,. 

The probable error of the function x, + yy is given by the simple 
formula. 

V ot wre, 

in which ¢,, and «, are the probable errors of x, and y, respectively. 

The investigation shows that, when several standards of length 
are to be intercompared two and two, in order to obtain the length 
of some one of them, it will be conducive to accuracy to have the 
mean temperatures of the several sets of comparisons equal. 

Remarks were made upon this communication by Mr. KuMMELL. 


Mr. Avex. S. CHRISTIE made a communication on 


CONTACT OF PLANE CURVES.* 
[ Abstract. ] 

Let 0 = fiz, y), 1), 0 = ¢(@, y), (2), and y = ¢(2), (8) be the 
equations of plane curves. Transferring the origin to (¢, 7), where 
= $(&), writing f, ¢ for f(§, 7), ¢(§, 7), respectively, and u, for 

1 of 1 og 


dee? Yn for — I =e , we have 


y" o2 *o 
from (1), ae (ES iy 73 (oru,)), (1’), from (2), 


2 3 30 a dy 
leap} oak 2(a'v,), (2'), and from (3), y= # z pty ge 
S| 

Br age + &e. ve 


* Throughout this paper, d, for lack of sorts, is put for round d, and denotes 
partial differentiation. 


158 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Writing (8’) in the form y= zw, + 2’w, + aw, + &e. (3”) 


and assuming y” = 2”(y,) + c ay (¥,) + &e. (4) 
Where (»,) obviously equals w,”, and (,), (,), &., are functions 
v— y—l 
of &,7 to be determined, we have, from (4), vy ; _ =z vw) 
v2 
t+ar.vt1.(4)+ae .»+2.(,)+ &e. (5) 
from (3”), = e®.1lwta'.2w,+2?.3w, + &e. | (6) 


d cae 
from (3”, 5),» y’. 2 =2"((,)yw,) +e (yew) y+1.u,) 
+2 (Gay +) ofl. uy +) 2 2.0) + &e. 
d ; < 
from (4,6), y”. - = 2(,) w, +2 fe (¢,)» . 2w, ot (,)y . 1w,)) 


se OES i Sey a ney att 1w,) + &e. 

" 0O=(%). »—-0.w+,).0-—1.y, 
0=0,).2—0.u,+().¥—1.u,+0,).0—2.u, 
0=6,).383—0.4,+().22—1.u,+ ©) .¥—-2.4, 

+(%).0—3.%, ° 


O=().m—0.u,4,+%).(m—1)¥—1.u, 


+ (»,).(m — 2)» —2.w,—,+() . (m— 3) »— 38. u,_-, 
+...+(%,).0—m.u, 


159 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


ee (TI—m)—a * 


in ({T—w) —9 ‘ 


(2) 


‘n* (Z—wW) —«z° 


Sere fa +7 = (zg = Ww) 


‘m*(Z—w)—a -°- 


im (g—w)— 9 °° 


¢ "2" Z— «(e— w) 


‘ c_my), * Z—4(F— w) 


oe) | 


‘ 


¢ ‘n° 1 —nz 
€ m*T—a« 
‘ mI —0 


x 


“m*T—a(T—w) ‘t+ "n° QO— au 


u 


~ "a —T—a(Z—w) * M*Q—A(T— wW) 


"n° T—a(@e—w) '-"n+ 9 —a(g—w) 


< in? 9 — ae 


© in 9 = 42 


‘ m*Q—« 
a % 
. ny 


—dARY OM DDTOY AA 


160 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


which determines the coefficients in (4). (*) Putting w,, for 


1 é” Tie rs v+l 
rl, al, de Oy? We have yy gr * ¥ (atu) = 2 ((%) ty) +2 ((%) ty 


+ (%) Uv) + & ces (CO) Uy + Oy) thy + (2) Mv) + &e., and this in 
(1’) gives an equation of the form 
0=2A,+21A,+27A,+ 2A, + Ke. (8) 
viz: 0 = 2° [(0,) Mo} + 2 [(09) to + (01) Moo + (Lo) Mor] 
+ 2° [ (0p) Ugo + (01) Myo + (Oz) Moo Ao) Mar + Ai) Mort (2) Mop] 
4° [(0p) Usp + (01) May + (02) Myo + (95) Moo A Lo) Mort Ay) Mh 
+ Ag) tor HF (20) he + C21) Moz + (8p) Mos] + Ke. (8’) 
for the abscissae of points common to (1) and (3). Similarly for 
the abscissae of points common to (2) and (3) we get an equation 
of the form 
0O=2 Bote B, +7 B,+2 B, + &e. (9) 
viz: 0 = 2° [(O4) % J + 2 (00g) Mo + (1) Yo + Go) Mm] + &e. 8’) 
Let (2) contain at least p parameters, enabling us to pass (2) 
through p of the intersections of (1) with (8). When this is done 
we have the equation 0 = 2° (A,— B,) +. 2' (A, — B,) +2’ (A,—B,) 
+ &c. (10) true for the p values of x corresponding to the p points 
common to (1), (2), (3). Let the » common points move to the 
origin, (10) must have p roots equal zero, that is, 0 = A, — 
B, 0= A, =— By, 0 = A, — B, . 2.0 = A,_, — Bo eee 
If we suppose (3) the parabolic representative of (1), 2 in (8) 
becomes indeterminate, and hence besides 0 = A, we have also 
C= A 0= A, Ge. 
that is, 0 ng with 


dy 6 
[ = t+ Zt5, 
| va Ley a FS «Ae (ay ee 
2.08" deatin Bide on, 2 NOs) On 
Oh ck AG Od 1d’ Of 1 dyof 


= 327 QaziP + Nae de, 1 Baeo, G2) 


1 (2) 5 2 Bae ii Feet H(z oe 
| boa \ag) ago TBI de dB an? TBI Nae) oy 
L  &e. &e. _ &e. 


* Putting x = 1 in (3/7) and (4), we obtain the multinomial theorem in the form 


(204 -+ Wy + Ws + &Ke.)¥ = (%) + (%) +e (%) + Ke. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 161 
I i: f 
equations fully determining ae : et : Ae , &c., in terms of the 


partial derivatives of f. 
Again, suppose (3) the parabolic representative of (2), then 
0 = B,, with 0 = B,, 0 = B,, &c., and consequently by (11) 0 = A,, 


with O= A,,0=A,,...090=A,—,, or the first p—1 of the 
equations (12) are satisfied indifferently whether the = ; = re 


—1 
aS therein contained be derived from (1) or (2); that is, we 
have arrived at Lagrange’s conditions for contact of the (p — 1) 
order, as a consequence of p - punctual contact; and it follows at 
once that the distance between two curves:in the neighborhood 
of ap - tuple common point is of the p™ order when the distance 
along the curves from the p- tuple point is of the 1st order.* 


Note. 


The abstracts of communications to the Mathematical Section 
have each been examined by a special committee, consisting of the 
Chairman, the Secretary, and a third member appointed by the 
Chairman. These third members were as follows: 


Title. Author. Third Member. 

Alignment Curves on any Surface___-- C. H. Kummeitt. A. S. CHRISTIE. 
The Mass of a Planet from Observa- 

tions of two Satellites__________- A HAGE: W. B. Tay or. 
Infinites and Infinitesimals____.---___ M. H. DoouitTLe. G. W. HILL. 
Planetary Perturbations of the Moon__G. W. HILL. EK. B. ELLIoTr. 
The Law of Error practically tested 

bys Larget-Shooting.. 2. =. 2-2. C. H. Kummett. A. S. CHRISTIE. 
Form of Least-Square Computation.__.H. FARQUHAR. R. S. WoopwarbD. 


Rejection of Doubtful Observations.._.M. H. DooLiItTLe. W. C. WINLOCK. 
Special Treatment of certain forms of 

Observation-Equations ----------R. S. Woopwarp. W. C. WINLOCK. 
Contact of Plane Curves _____..._____A. S. CHRISTIE. C. H. KUMMELL. 


* This paper will be continued. 


vy Pate a ' ' 
ts) LV oe Le he ae 
, Men ae Wan cata, iy BI 
; ti ve if Pity 
thas RES et it Are 
‘eat 
oF ) LPS PDR a EST LETS 
ae ’ 
. ‘ 
% « . 
\ fy ‘ i vesaul 
ae AY 
: ‘ 
hi 4 
1 1a, sendy 


2 
, . 
* ' 
; 
y 4 ys q 
2 Par 
4 
, ‘¢ 
y 
v7 ? 
; 
. ¢ 


CORRIGENDA, 


Vol. V, p. 86, line 2. For “ abused ”’ read absurd. 
es A, 6.7... Bor tens ” read earth. 


- 
‘ 
' 
e} 
b 
‘ 
' 
‘ 
j 
» 
ie 
ry 
' 
6, 
. } 
: : ote 
v 
: 
. 
‘ 
; . 
' 
( : 1} 
' by A : | 
r y ac ‘ ape! 
4 , A FAP 
h i, f Phy 4 i 
saa ay a 
! Pt Oe Ld delay 
. 1, iy ‘ eb i r 
is ’ t My 
; ay 


Ra PAWL, Ge tt 


PY Dew 


Page, 
Abbe, Cleveland: communication on Deter- 
mining the temperature of the air......... 24 
— —: report as Treasurel.......cccccccseeeeeeeees ripe. bl 
Address of the Chairman of the Mathemat- 
LES CCULON . sancccarscevocenscnaceradcupancanecesascenee 
— — — President.... 


Action of the International Geodetic Asso- 
ciation as to an initial meridian and uni- 


Versal time .......c0..eee00 Bich ceisecsescesacse nireseie 
Activital evolution... 
Agricultural college ratte, basebsveiscsueswcsncadvedacs 100 
Ague, The conservative function of.............. 5 
Air, Determining the temperature of the, 24, 46, 47 
PICA GIACTATION 101 |. cccccenveccssssccersssoprssoeten SS 
—, Humidity of... SsunuedshansenasRavedasavee assess iO 


Alignment curves on any Saniece, with 
special application to the ellipsoid.......... 
Alvord, Benjamin: communication on a 
special case in maxima and minima....... 149 
— —: remarks on agricultural college grants 106 


123 


— — — — glaciation in Alaska............0..008 . 35 
— — — — Smithsonian funds invested in 
ARK ANESS DONS. ....s0ccesccsasesesoeee escpasneovnane 105 
Analogues in z00-geoyraphy........seeceeeee rie 41 
Announcement of death of B. F.Sands......... 41 
— — — — O. H. Crane............ccessecceceeeee whem 4, 
— — — — Elisha Foote.......c...cce. cscceosceeeees . 48 
— — — — Josiah Curtis 20.0... cece ceeeeeeeeees 41 
— — — — LD. Gale... cece cccsseesceeeeo eens . 48 
tirerle—ieen) ie ED, ULES. .csvscsevviecssccscconses cesses wih 
—-— election to membership of Albert 
BEMIS SS Pca bavdencyouciusscesss'sastesss) caavasecsess 14 
—-_---- C. D. Walcott... 
—-—-- D. E. Salmon 
—----- E. C. Morgan 
—---- BL Ses UNE CSS -cutacvavacccesecesenr, 2S 
—-—---- TG OWA ci, scnespataasaae ye 
---- J. H. Renshawe.......... 14 
—---- J. M. Browne 111 
--—--- ASOUBKINN ESN vascsccwesns 36 
—--—- Re S. WOOGWArG vvccsesecccscoons 14 
--—--- Set MIMI OM Gus eccencessnscessrss) (00 
—--—--- SE ES OGISI Ge. crt es astascscsessce BAZO 
—--- MGs Chamberlin... .csseeteuee 100 
—---- - Thomas Russell .. 10 
—-—-—-_—— — W. C. EN 33 
—----- W. T. Sampson.... 36 
— — filling of vacant offices.............00sssccsses 41 
— — invitation to Anthropological and Bio- 
POPICALSOCIObIOS..c0%:ssscesovsccasvazpedevsieonves 87, 98 


Page. 
Announcement of new rules concerning pa- 
pers read before Sections..........cecseeseeaee . 38 


— — organization of Mathematical Section.. 28 
— — summer vacation.. ms) 09 


Anthropic evolution...... Artultecsarecub ser) EVAL 
Antisell, Thomas: Gatien mone heakan Ha- 
WALA AS PULLS es cse teduanodssscohecucseskeacenenves 14 
— —: remarks on meteorologic stations...... 47 
— —: report of Auditing Committee............ 5 
Aphapsis ........ “trenece evessbcibysnentbleserdsessevuencosce 133 
Appalachian region, Geology of........ jackiegestes 31 
Arithmetic, Binary 
ATKANSHS| DONCG ecacessecesssncntsecinviete dri ce ersesrass 
Articulation by the corfgenitally deaf... 76, 78, 84 
Astronomy (see Mars, Perturbation, Saturn, 
Venus.) 
AtiTA@ TLOM say sesceaseucacsareesesess XXvViii, ¥xxii, xxxix 
Auditing Committee, Appointment of........... 111 
— —, Report of............. Gareuseseerchesssanereaatanyvs a 8 
Baker, Marcus: letter to Mathematical Sec- 
UL OM oes sepesescecedecerseccrseoyscatescceanseaenants asd ees . 122 
Balfour memorial TunG)c.<.--..<scssnsvesaescsrsecsscos 5 


Bates, H. H.: communication on the nature 
OP MAPA UGIeeret tecee svartosvecusesesecascesereeccd ony atsabe 5 
Beaches, Ancient, of the Hawaiian Islands.. 13 
Bede, : cited on the miraculous cure of 
CUI MONS ce elsoees cache adstescotsacdepcssdnecencessene . St 
Bell, A. G.: communication on Fallacies con- 
cerning the deaf, and the influence of 
such fallacies in preventing the amelio- 


ration of their condition.................... . 48, 84 
— — —: remarks on determining the tem- 
PeratureiOl He BL A scccoxesccasedcccnsascensaersess 47 


Bibliography of medallic medical history... 40 
Billings, J. S.: remarks on the prevention of 


MALATIG CISC RROR cccssacecscaviy) Coan svcnacad-ceunsae 10 
BADPALTY: ATICAMOUICs wcsccesscannecsseveudeccacnctenceussn 3, 38 
BiGtiC! CVOlUtLOMs.--usceuwsntauctsasesseencescesenscasdentes xlv 
Black bulb thermometer...........+ Redon enthneees 6) 120 


Black drop, The, a spurious phenomenon..... 23 
Bodfish, S. H., Election to membership of.... 28 


IBrachisthOdes LNGk, ncc-sosnssoesscevsvecrenceesssmassae 124 
Browne, J. M., Election to membership of..... 111 
Bulletin of the General Meeting............ce00 Sr 
— — — Mathematical Section .............. Corer 113 


—, Rules for the publication of the ............ xiii 

Bulwer, John: cited on the instruction of 
deaf-mutes ...........0s0006 Be Seance aceepmaneatctcs 5+ 

Burgess, E. S., Election to membership of., 28 


163 


164 


Page. 
Burnett, S. M.: communication on Refraction 
in the principal meridians of a triaxial 
ellipsoid ; regular astigmatism and cylin- 


drical lenses......... Se kaanihaVacasessatsenaatitha sh bee . 4 
_—-- The character of the focal 

lines in astigmatism ..... sone scouenen awaceeeee tans 45 
Calendar, Perpetual ............scscccccssecenssenecceees 135 
Cambrian system, The, in the United States’. 

PVE OMMNACA sc scscavccuvssenesiversstdscsesdascseaaeeate - 98 
Cape Hatteras, Geology Of..c.....ce-ccecceseeeeceenes 28 


Certain possible abbreviations in the com- 
putation of the long-period perturbations 
of the moon’s motion due to the direct 
action of the planets........ ......+ Dewekuctnsess 136 
Chamberlin,T. C., Election to membershipof, 36 
Character of the focal lines in astigmatism., 45 
Chemistry (See Explosive Eruption, Specijic 
Gravity.) 


Chickering, J. W.: communication on The 
thermal belts of North Carolina..........4 rel 
Christie, A. 8.: communication on A quasi 
general differentiation. ............:0-ssccecerees 122 
--—-- Contact of plane curves......... 157 
— — —: remarks on infinitesimals.............. 135 
Clarke, F. W.: remarks on volcanic ex- 
PIGSIOUS revvactadussnascwasVencstesecencterserastee tees 93 
Climate, Response of, to variations in solar 
ALA DION oe stevecacs coer een tacteceestenesacresasense asain 10 
Coal, Origin of........ meenintescssecennd ioe sapetenereresses - 28 
Committee, Auditing, Appointment of.......... 111 
—— —— EUODOE U Of ccc cseveccesss3 ssenadvavevrssssdorersesenpces 5 
—, General, Constitution and duties of the.. vii 
ix, xX, xi 
— —, Members of the ......... cece ceeeee coer xiv, XV 
— on Communications, Constitution and 
GUTIOSTOL UNG .srsecteeccecx ecsacnessees seseeeceeeantes xii 
— — —, Members of the ...........c eee eeeees Xiv, XV 
— — Publications, Constitution and duties 
OT TAG: vy, Se St eeveiet es cecheeancne vancutoteceammee xii, xiii 
— — —, Members of the..............2cceeeeee AP. h ae.a 4 
Committees on Mathematical Papers...... 135, 161 
Computation, Least-square..........cccesseseeeeene 150 
— of lunar perturbations 
GONSUIGUTION! 3.0 c0.cceccesecvet coupeusencaecustuectace castes 
Contact of plane’ CUrVvesi.scccsuveccctssecrcsesvucceecute 
Correlation of Cambrian groups .............c000 98 
GOFTISONG A. sce cccecsvencstedesacssacssesanepdes sarasnseesresee 162 
Crane, CoH Deathioris cisswrcccasccerseteatenes . Xiy, 41 
Criteria for the rejection of observations...... 155 
Crova'sihy grom eters: secessessasceys fecneeeatweterecesee 36 
Cultivation of the eucalyptus on the Roman 
CaMPAR DA sseiacosscasssducecasteasceterousautsecst cere 36 
Curtis; Josiah Death Ofi-c.r..ctanesereserereetee acces 41 
Curves; Alignmenti.oc3i.c2:cie vccthecstacesestese scares 123 
—, Contact of....... =cotecrer ceeercrt: otrecree Besereneenee 157 


Cutts, R. D.: communication on The action 
of the International Geodetic Association 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
as to an initial meridian and universal 
time ..... panecuavahapd pasddss'sseccunvcacnceuneaauenaeen soae) oO 

me a my DORE Off .ccs cdececsoccscsocnecanscentensnuteets 111 
Dalgarno, George: cited on communication 
With MUGS. 06.05 <cnseccascsusesscesssnassieeemeenneee 71 
Dall, W. H., Announcement by.............00seee08 5 
—-—-—: communication on glaciation in 
AlagSkG sivcccevese acvae cid saadedaces oseapeeanee bgeananes Bess 


— — —: remarks on glaciers and solar heat, 11 
Darwin's theory of the distribution of vol- 


CATLOCS {civic cacssenscenastachenceceeataeee anes asa 89, 91 
Deaf, Fallacies concerning the.............08 heaved Ga 
Denudation and volcanism...........cssccseceee ee 


Deposition of ore by replacement ............ 32 
Determination of the mass of a planet from 

observations of two satellites ................. 132 
— — — specific gravity of solids by the 


common hydrometer........... isecasdeesteaatenae 26 
Determining the temperature of the air, 24, 46, 47 
Differentials: defined ........<..001sccnsncsdrancvaeeeees . 134 
Differentiation, A quasi general................00 . 122 
Diorthode, The............ svudvenssencphensdueeeenanee -. 123 
Dismal Swamp........... seeabsbusoseanceduenaeheeeanne . 28, 30 
Distribution of the surplus money of the 

United States among the States.......... - 103 
— — volcanoes.......... Seusdaassessaenadecpatsdeateaeee 87 
Doolittle, M. H.: communication on Infinite 

and infinitesimal quantities.. ............0000 133 
—--—-- Substance, matter, motion, and 

FOL COs sscisire sce oesewns ducewsdsacuscastectestntreeenaeee 14 
---- The rejection of doubtful ob- 

SOLVAtlONS!... .casdeccaccs ssdcnssvevaceastseeeeneee dereos AOD 
— — —: remarks on binary arithmetic........ 39 
Doubtful observations, Rejection of.......... eos 152 
Drainage, system, The, and the distribution 

of the loess in eastern Iowa..............02000 93 


Dreams in their relation with psychology.... 37 
Driftless region, Loess of the.............sse0000 96 
Dumbness, Fallacies concerning 
Dunes)of, North Carolina :..2..scessccsesdesteteeeeten 
Dutton, C. E.: communication entitled The 
volcanic problem stated...........s00ss008 ccnseeaenn 
— — — —on the Geology of the Hawaiian 
Tan dS s.scsctuss.cccecsshvcsccercsencusedeneentacenenenme Pa 
— — —: exhibition of views of the Hawaiian 
Tslan ds, vccccccscstcceeevesteves ceamte Prreerrr cers: = LO) 
— — —: remarks on determining the tem- 
perature! of the air.:.:;.cvssieveneleereeeeae ausse ee 
—--—--—-— Ennis’ hypothesis 
—--—--—-— the separation of minerals by 
GONSIY’ ...:ccecescacvaccuecoscccescescenteeeesseeenenne <7 a 
Dynamic hypothesis, The, controverted..... xxx 


Easter, Formulas for the computation of...... 15 

Eastman, J. R.: communication on The Flor- 
ida expedition for observation of the 
transit Of VeNUS........0ccesesees od evonse edu ea 


INDEX. 165 
Page. Page. 
Education of deaf mutes........... Soaveanesite 77, 82,86 | Gallaudet, E. M.: remarks on fallacies con- 
Elevation and subsidence...............es0eeeeeee 31, 92 cerning the deaf...............00 eat deeapeeyeen Soy if 
eM ITPAU ASIC Avie eccuks scaaweasdegsuntane cbutvesocencsvanseoeesy . 385 | Geikie, Archibald: cited on the division of 
— in the Hawaiian Islands............sssssesesesseee 13 Paleozoic time...........00.00 eaebece oa casecheceoey 98 
Elliott, E. B.: communication entitled Form- General committee (See Committee). 
ulas for the computation of Easter........ - 15 | — Meeting, Bulletin of the........ Lasoca a AoE 1 
-—---- A financial problem................. 149 | Geodesy (See Alignment). 
— — — —on Units of force and energy, in- Geodeticline, The, ...::..cscassssescsvasesesstesdosesse . 124 
Cluding electric UNItS!....ccccc.scesesseceancsseees 137 | Geology of Hatteras and the neighboring 
— — —: exhibition of perpetual calendar..... 135 CO AS Ube sane vo se nen hana yeGuenseee canbiesubucdish «sedauntngeh 28 
— — —: remaris on infinitesimals............. — — the Hawaiian Islands...............sceccsssseee 13 
—-—-—-—— the metric system...............006 — (see also Cambrian, Drainage, Fault, Glaci- 
—-—-— unification of time ation, Ore, Volcanic). 
Ellipsoid, Alignment curves on the Gesture language of the deaf.. 63, 66, 71, 75, 79, 84 
Emmons, S. F.: communication on Ore dep- Gilbert, G. K.: communication on Graphic 


osition by replaceMeNnt............ssessesecseees . a2 
— — —, Election to membership of............. 33 
REMMI COIN, Of secsasctciccsseuctossscssensccucsteaepaces 138 
MPMPTUIOMIOL LAVA ccccestscasscccnesescscestscenccsssesaresves 87 
Evolution defined............ Mospsentterdsgescie xlii 
—, The three methods of................00 xxvii 
Experiments in binary arithmetic............. 3, 38 
Explosive eruption discussed.............sseee 93 
Exposure of thermometers .............:csecsseee 24, 46 


Fallacies concerning the deaf, and the influ- 
ence of such fallacies in preventing the 


amelioration of their condition........ Sanches 48 
Fan structure of MOUNtAINS............0:0seeeeees « 31 
Farquhar, Edward: communication on 

Dreams in their relation with psychol- 

ORY, oneness pavsuaseure once cteten eee operas eeeer ee Eee 37 
—, Henry: communication on Experiments 

in binary arithmetic......... Sactneaenesncesceceae 3 
— — — —A form of least-square computa- 

(C0) EE oaa RUPEE eepedssbpatictcuubevnwcsvabescnsarsasestien 150 
— — — — Further experiments in binary 

SEMI MEIDIELN Gl west cerooscuinenscsacven seas Bae sacesauatavets 38 
— —: election as Secretary of Mathematical 

BREA RNASTA ratios ra suntede secede sveadadsCucevebicevacacueess 122 
— —: remarks on infinitesimals................... 135 
Fault near Harper’s Ferry .....cscc--ssescee cosscees 30 
Ferrel’s temperature formula..............cccce0 ne 
Finance (See Distribution). 

TIAL PrOblEM Ai ccscescccsedcvesessvssvceettevercee 149 
Fletcher, Robert: communication on Recent 

experiments on serpent venom..........04. - 38 
Florida expedition for observation of the 

BYOUEMHOL \WONUS. 1.:.c.cecccovss uevevvocsestcoeesacs 21 
Foote, Elisha, Death of........ pssbetuadve Movuteossccee 48 
PICO sscctcscuewssccinesas savatkbuucasecenpevers xxviii, xxxiii 
Form of least-square computation......... watch oe 150 
Formulas for the computation of Easter ...... 15 
Fossil leaves, Method of preservation of...... 30 
Frozen soil of the arctic regions.............. . 34, 35 


Further experiments in binary arithmetic... 38 


PMNs TD CAD Of escccsccccossncscvsccccecscesscadaled 48 


tables for computing altitudes from bar- 


OMEGVIC | Matacic. cnsccetssssenvseseuscssadshsed cuaeynusé 136 
--- The response of terrestrial 
climate to secular variations in solar 
PACULAUION ccesesteecase asada <astan=aaeeae peteccoee ceeeece 10 
— — —: remarks on the drainage system of 
OBSEOLN TO Wasi. ccs ecssconcactavanus totpesccusciecevaes 97 
Gill, T. N.: communication on Analogues in 
ZOO- FSO LTRDIY :.cavanacvssnnccverdedaseasscdsascnenctes 41 


—-—-— Ichthyological results of the 
voyage of the Albatross 
Glaciation and solar heat.........css00 secoscssssess 


VN AES ICR... tssecnwtuevescsysesabe 

Glaciers classified........ sarensbesased esnundattcat a t= tn 

Graphic tables for computing altitudes from 
DALOME LIC A RUS crrcsscanesncensewdecusuavecsunererts 136 

Gravitation, Explanations of......... SAonrire Ap.6.o.41l 

Hall, Asaph: address as Chairman of the 


Mathematical Section ...........ssecssescsccsesees 117 
— —: communication on The determination 

of the mass of a planet from observations 

of two'sntellitess: sito. ccccoccndscesseccees Sieteconl 3) 
— —:election as Chairman of the Mathe- 

DIAHCANSSCHTON Ges eececce vets cecccssentaeecreue 122 
— —: remarks on criteria for the rejection 

of doubtful observations.................ceeeeeees 155 
Harkness, William: communication on The 

monochromatic aberration of the human 


bo 


eye in aphakia.............. Saremeerare ocak Saeeenecea 4 
——: remarks on accidental and constant 
OQITOLS is vnctuvevsusudedscdedvecuccecveacescnrs ssnsececsvodes 133 
— — — — determining the temperature of 
PHO BUG <j sccacsavbsncccttbeassecesccscudiendescesaacecsacats 26 
— — — — hygrometric observyations............ 36 
— — — —the postulation of continents to 
support hypotheses...... pakss fpesrtaneesepwanensses 
Harper’s Ferry; Fault near.............sssscsesceess « 30 
Hatteras, Geology of Cape........ edatetechstaeceessess 28 
Hawaiian Islands, Geology of the................ 13 
— —, VieWwS Of the......cccccccccccccersccnecscseses cones 10 
Hazen, H. A.: communication on Hygromet- 
TICLODSSY VALIONS oi ddccccavansenses ssi -ncren=b baecsess 36 


166 


Page. 

Hazen, H. A.: communication on Thermo- 
Meter CXPOSULC....seeeereee Gonsceass see! aeeaeipse 46, 47 
Hilgard, J. E.: organization of the Mathe- 
Matical Section .....cccecseccccerereeeeesreerereenee 
— — —: remarks on the unification of longi- 
tudes and time 
Hill, G. W.: communication on Certain possi- 
ble abbreviations in the computation of 
the long-period perturbations of the 
moon’s motion due to the direct action 


109 


Prrererirrri i 


of the planets........ eccadied eet. Ae enrnacn seo) 180 
— — —: remarks on infinitesimals ..........++ 135 
—, Moritz: cited on natural language............ 80 
— — — — the education of deaf mutes........ 78 
---- value of sign language to the 
Geaf ... cscs suostcceeccarstscecastueccesesons edanses 80, 85 
FLOMOPhe neS......sseceeessneeccecseneeceeececeeeeraneees 57, 76 
Hough, F. B.: communication on the culti- 
vation of the Eucalyptus on the Roman 
Cam pagna ......+« Sc abaucs'scnadsabendee@uasuveecuesuvnnse 36 
Hubbard, G. G.: remarks on fallacies con- 
cerning the deaf........sssscseseseeeeees Sees 82 
Humidity observations..........-sss0 Ststecserswesets 36 
— of Alaska...... did ibaeseaeuastbate casenseneccen>neseneose 36 
Hydrometer determination of the specific 
GIAVIty Of SOLIGS......cceeeeeereeeceseeereeeserenee 26 
Hygrometer observations.... 36 
Hypothesis, Utility of, in science ........... xxxiii 
Ichthyological results of the voyage of the 
AIDAtrOSs ...ccosccscnssessccvsvcescsccnscecccsenscescanse 48 


Idiots, Dumbness Of.......scesseeeereereereeeeeceeees 
Illinois, Loess hills of 
Inaugural address of the Chairman of the 


Mathematical Section. ..........-ccseseeseeeeeeees 117 
Infinite and infinitesimal quantities ............ 133 
Initial meridian, Universal...........sseesseeeessees 106 
Intermarriage of deaf mutes............... 74, 76, 83 
Intermittence Of VOICANOES......ceececeeeceeeeeereeee 91 
International Geodetic Association ........--.+ 106 
Invitation to Anthropological and Biological 

SOCTCHICS..v.cccsscvcccssancosseccoescccnsassasscnsesacess 87 
Iowa, Loess of eastern........ socuenenseesde secre pmenne 92 
Kerr, W. C.: communication On the geology 

of Hatteras and the neighboring coast.. 28 
— — —, Election to membership Of.......+++++ 33 
Kinematic hypothesis, The..........ss0+sesees xxviii 


King, A. F. A.: communication on The pre- 
vention of malarial diseases, illustrating, 
inter alia, the conservative function of 
AZUL... cccreceeernevner sushanSeavevacteconsnssnstenccsessen 5 

Knox, J. J.: communication on The distri- 
bution of the surplus money of the 
United States among the States.............. 

Kotzebue Sound ice CLiffs.........seseseeeeee eucaes 34 

Kummell, C. H.: communication on Align- 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page 
ment curves on any gurface, with spec- 
ial application to the ellipsoid................ 123 
The theory of errors practi- 
cally tested by target shooting.......... sseee OS 
— — —: remarks on consequences of the re- 
lation of the circle to the equilateral hy- 


perbola... ade wsse isa devas Ugh 
—---- ‘infinitesimals..2.< ee 135 
—-—--—- refinement in the determina- 
tion of the temperature of the air........... 26 
Lavas of the Hawaiian Islands............++e+eeee 13 
Lee, William: communication entitled 
Sketches from medallic medical history 39 
Leadville Ore CepOSits......sceccsssecesee seceeessnees 32 
Least-Square COMPUtAtiON .........ceseeceeereeren ere 150 
Lefavour, E. B.: remarks on infinitesimals... 135 
Liagre’s theory.............c.ccsssenasasevssusnnshmseenseaen 139 
List Of members :cessesastscceseacceesuasnaaee Ae sy 
Loess of eastern Iowa 93 
Longitudes, Unification Of ........ccereceeseeeee cone LOG 
McCullough, Hugh: remarks on money de- 
posited by the United States with the 
State of Im diam ars ciictsscacttscescesetendeawemecee 106 
McDowell, Silas: cited on thermal belts of 
North) Carolinas: 22s. sccccocneeceeeceaahepueane 11, 12 
McGee, W J: communication on The drain- 
age system and the distribution of the 
loess of eastern TOWa.........csceeesecees pececets 93 
Malarial diseases, Prevention Of...........0.ss00+ 5 
Mallery, Garrick: election as Vice-president 41 
Mallet's theory of volCanisM..........sssceeeeeeeees 90 
Marriage of deaf mutes... oss cheap pee 
Mass of planets, Deteiiinstias ats asa es crt, » 132 
Mathematical Section, Address by Chair- 
AVIAN OL; LHC secseneessaccsuctersuccsaewaee wabuseihae 117 
— —, Bulletin of the..........cecccceeeseee acta 113, 121 


— —, Committee of the.... 
—, Members of the.... 


— —, Officers of the....... na 

— —, Organization Of the........0.....sccccseses 28, 121 

— =, Rules Of....sssccosccctivencseser aeeneaea +. 11551385 * 

Mathematics (see Arithmetic, Formulas, Math- 
ematical Section.).....0. acaceudedes Seine bRaaneetern 

Matter, Combination of..............04 


Maxima and minima........ 
Medallic medical history.. 


Members, List of. : 

— of the Mathematical Section.............2.0000+ 

Meridian, Universal initial............... iecanaeee 

Metamorphic deposits....... pags seesensnenscsecreonecs 

Metamorphism and subsidence ........-.c.0se0e 

Meteorology (see Climate, Humidity, Hygro- 
meter, Temperature, Thermal, Thermome- 
ter.) 


INDEX. 167 
Page Page. 

Metric system discussed......ccc.cccccsecseeeee essere 4 | Riley, C. V., Election of, as member of the 
Minerals, Separation of, by density...... nawiaeda 26 General Com miitheescencc.sesecssccs afuocesesrvese 41 
Mad es/Of MOtION seaiaiisessecavcssdse-secuere aad RMT #| Hines of Saturn. secs st. bay tesa coe tes 41 
Moon’s motion, Pertubations of the.............. 136 | Rules for the publication of the Bulletin sucess xiii 
Morgan, E. C., Election to membership of ... 87 | —, New, on papers read before section......... 38 
Mosquito, Inoculation by the........csseeeeeeeeeeee 7 | —, Standing, of the General Committee....... xii 
Motion, Modes Oftsccccisccccecsnccccccdennes + XXxvili, xli | — — — — Mathematical Section.................. 115 


Munroe, C. E.: communication on the De- 
termination of the specific gravity of 


solids by the common hydrometer......... 26 
Mutes, Fallacies concerning.............. aeavauy 49, 78 
Natural language ............. SShceeccoareecee 64, 70, '75, 79 
VAG, LG, Of) MALLOY sss cccssccccteatesvodcevenssstece 5 


Nebular hypothesis and volcanic eruption... 87 
— — not discredited by Saturnian and Mar- 


IPPON OO See ciegcucuscacusceccsuscaspectsrs cueactioneste 
North Carolina, Geology of.... 
Es Thormal belts Of ......cesresscscssosees 
Notation, New arithmetic................ccesseeeeee- 
Note on the rings of Saturn............. eesaneausess aed 
Observation-equations..............sssseeseeseteeceeees 156 
Observations, Rejection of doubtful.............. 152 
Officers of the Mathematical Section ...... 28, 122 
Seeaimeesvom—= OCT OGY vcsconscexees sussue evseccssconsecsenas xiv, XV 
Ore deposition by replacement..............seeee 32 
Peat beds of North Carolina.............csssssesssees 
RIAD SMS ic svacaisovess avcics casbccsenakcatsvicsee. 
Periods, Saturnian............. 
EBEPOLU Al CalON GAT. ccccsasscesdecacersecesvavesesseotsce 
Pertubations, LUNAL...........ccssesesssesrseresensnes 
Physical evolution........ pewakosseavine- Wicaeestecacsres xliii 
BAIOEUT ONAN SUAGE cass alecestossccreosonseccscseceve snes . 84 


Porter, Sarah: cited on the use of signs by 


deaf-mute children 81 
Powell, J. W.: address as President XXV 
—-—-—: remarks on the drainage system 

SEP OMSTONIM, LGW soxcasasebocsecen-ic ostceteslaeoaseate 97 
—--—-—-—— loess of western IIlinois..... 97 
—_--- volcanic eruption................ 92, 93 
President’s annual addresg,,............0..ccesesees XXV 
Prevention of malarial disease............ssecee00 5 
IPEOOTUNOUGs TN Oscccck secs ccsecaconccvesocesstecdesiecsesce 123 
Quasi general differentiation, A....... diseenascencs 122 
Recent experiments on serpent venom........ 38 
Rejection of doubtful observations.............. 152 


Renshawe, J. H., Election (o membership of, 14 
Replacement in ore deposition 
Report of the Treasurer................ 


Response, The, of terrestrial climate to ya- 
riations in solar radiation.......0....cceesces 10 


Ficlets SRP pee ee eee mae ng ix 
Russell, Thomas, Election to membership of, 10 


Salmon, D. E., Election to membership of.... 111 
Sampson, W. T. , Election to membership of, 36 


Sands, B. F., Death Ofmisatatescveasercenees : 41 
Saturn’s rings 41 
“Science” to report the scientific proceed- 
INES Of the Society eyo ete ncccvceeeeek. 5, 122 
Seismographic record obtained in Japan...... 38 
Shelters for thermometers.........ccsesscssceceoeee 46 
Sibscota, George : cited on the cause of dumb- 
DOSS) sccsJencnssncsee sonsanhoveccetedseshasdeavessuccacstorers 49 
Sign language of the deaf...... 63, 66, 71, 75, 79, 84 
Sketches from medallic medical history...... 39 


Skinner, J. O., Election to membership of.... 36 
Smith, Edwin: communication on a Seismo- 


graphic record obtained in Japan.......... 87 
Smithsonian investment .........cccccsssssceesaceres 105 
Solar radiation in its relation to climate ...... 10 
Sound velocity as a measure of air tempera- 

CULE sressispacctanehsussersntscdivessessstcuecsensnteeecit 47 
Speech and thouphit.cacs ccscssecsseseccsssceussce 53, 81 
— reading by the eye............ 56, 60, 70, 76, 78, 84 
Special case, A, in maxima and minima....... 149 
— treatment of certain forms of observation- 

BQUALIONS soca .iicensasssusaceeecelcasrs asacveseseicessoce 156 
Specific gravities, Determination of.............. 26 


Standard time.. a Scneerbwccbeseenansacesrect OG 
Standing rules (See Bake. 
Substance, matter, motion, and force............ 14 


Surplus money, Distribution of ..............s000 103 
Survival of the fittest, not the law of an- 

thropic evolution ..............cccccseeeeses xl vii, lii 
Taylor, W. B.: communication entitled Note 

On tite TINS OL SAUUTNss.cesses ceessecest sees cotics 41 
— — —: remarks on binary arithmetic........ 4 
—-—- designation of apsides............ 133 
--— eT MNEICO SIMA Sy eacevsucsseoneccasess.ce LOD 
-- thermometric obseryation...... 47 
War ret Shootin. ctagvasessuecdack easckesseeesenec eee 139 
Temperature of the air..................002. 24, 46, 47 
The theory of errors practically tested by 

CALE Ob SHOOBING: oso ca.ccc-cuccwccaccesascaeonascearte 138 
The thermal belts of North Carolina............ 11 
Thermometer CXpOSure...........0.ccccccceccecees 24, 26 
Mhourht and speeches vsssotuecrete eee 53, 81 
Three methods, The, of evolution............. xxvii 


Topographical indications of a fault near 
Harpor's OLTy scc.cecscetaseetivesece ecdscccseeses 30 


ee 


168 


Page 

Transit of Venus..........0.+ seupnysb Wey speeeiaessmetnpent 21 

Treasurer’s annual report...........ecereseereeeeees xxij 
— accounts for 1882, Report of Auditing 

COMMIttSe ON the......diecscccovcccedevaccssncsves 5 

Unification of longitudes and time.............+. 106 
Units of force and energy, including electric 


units 
Universal time.... 


Velocity of sound as a measure of air tem- 


PEVRUUTEG \. cvess,sier sete edsa0e6 47 
Venus, Transit of. 21 
Volcanic problem, The, stated.........sccsccsseseee 87 


Walcott, C. D.: communication on The Cam- 
brian system in the United States and 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page 
Cop Sey: oF talus eee anes MMR. cctl Eh ees 98 
— — —, Election to membership Of............. 48 


Walling, H. F.: communication on Topo- 
graphical indications of a fault near Har- 


PON'S POLTY: .iocssecasscacessadonseesbapnastsnueadnaeene 30 
— — —, Election to membership of............ 14 
Ward, L. F.: remarks on Dismal Swamp...... 30 
Water, a factor in voleanie eruption.............. 87 
White, C. A.: remarks on the drainage sys- 

teams iOf Towa so.<st.iesvaceecnsreand Srrenitoy 97 


——-—--—-— instability of continents.... 93 

Williams, Albert, Jr., Election to member- 
BIR’ Of... onecesesoseecntvssnavasasosiarasesangeaenneen . i4 

Woodward, R. S.: communication on the 
Special treatment of certain forms of ob- 
servation-equations 

— — —, Election to membership of...... 


15€ 
lll 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY 


OF 


WASHINGTON, 


VOL. VII. 


Containing the Minutes of the Society and of the Mathematical 


Section for the year 1884. 


PUBLISHED BY THE CO-OPERATION OF THE SMITHSONIAN INSTITUTION. 


WASHINGTON: 


A 1885. 


CONTENTS. 


Constituijonyis see se ets so ee Seb Se ote oe ee eka 
prepeing rulesiof the Sotieiye? soak eal c peieleen ete scien 
Standing Rules of the General Committee.___. ---_. --...-.------. 
Rules for the Publication of the Bulletin .--.-..-~..2..-s-......- 
Oiticersvelected December, TeSBeean clk oe es es ae 
Onicerselected December) 1884 2 oe ey oe 
List of Members, corrected to December 81, 1884- ----_. --..-----_- 
MOU LO Ty CL AaTy ee es tence es nee LL en Sl a eB al 
ennual Repork of the Secretaries... v.22. tte tees 
Annual Report.of the Treasurer. .+s+- ot. 43-40-25 enone 
Annual Address of the President, J. C. Welling-__.-_------.------ 


Pulletin-or the General Mecting 20.0555 soo oe bcs anne bun nos 
The Rochester (Minnesota) tornado, J. R. Eastman -__-_-_-..-.-- 
Recent advances in our knowledge of the limpets, W. H. Dall. 
The existing glaciers of the High Sierra of California, I. C. 

1) |S SN Ea anys ea A oar RRR ER Of MO RO 
The mica mines of North Carolina, W. C. Kerr --__-._-----_- 
Recent advances in economic entomology, C. V. Riley ------ 
Why the eyes of animals shine in the dark, 8. M. Burnett --- 
Some eccentricities of ocean currents, A. B. Johnson_..__- --_- 
The periodic law of chemical elements, F. W. Clarke__----~- 


Sieeun-plows,:H.A, DaZepi nooo 2 em ee ee ctenien mee cn ee 
The application of physical methods to intellectual science, R. 
ORS TUN Gas oa ch cerca mentees Nr cal li een ia a 


Deposits of volcanic dust in the Great Basin, I. C. Russell .__- 
Some physical and economic features of the upper Missouri sys- 


Heme PGeSteritin, WAC ne cece oe ee ee NU 
The diversion of water courses by the rotation of the earth, G. 
DESL G Ell cYohey MRE AE Se oN SSI RS SEE ORS BOSS NE he ee ee oe 
The relations between northers and magnetic disturbances at 
Havana, -G. BE. Curtis, (Mile only) —-siee-2-0- a2 tone mene 


Composite photography applied to craniology, J. 8. Billings. 
Fisheries exhibitions, G. B. Goode, (Title only) ---.-.---.--- 
Music and the chemical elements, M. H. Doolittle___________ 
Review of the theoretical discussion in Prof. P. G. Tait’s ‘‘ En- 

cyclopedia Britannica’’ article on mechanics, H. Farquhar- 
Anew meteorite, sch. Wastmansnes oe oc el 
Certain appendages of the mollusca, W. H. Dall, (Title only) - 

III 


Page. 
Vil 
Ix 
XII 


EV CONTENTS. 


The voleanie sand which fell at Unalashka, October 20, 1883, 
and some considerations concerning its composition, J. S. 


AO SWC Oa de a ecg a ye ey Ee ee ee a 33 
The methods of modern petrography, G. H. William -___-_- 86 
What is a glacier? (Symposium) .--- ----- ---------------=-- 37 
The physical basis of phenomena, H. H. Bates ------ -----— 40 
The strata exposed in the east shaft of the water-works exten- 

BvOn ee EVO DUISON) 222 one ee eee oe ee ee 69 
Plan for the subject bibliography of North American geologic 

literature, G. K. Gilbert and J. W. Powell_.------ -----_-- phil 
Are there separate centres for light- form- and color-percep- 

tion’? “So Ri Burnett sass Sa Se ee ee ee 72 
Was the earthquake of September 19th felt in the District of 

Columbia ?~Ts Robinsont3=— 2 2 a2 ee 73 
Natural naturalists, Washington Matthews -__-__.---------- 73 
Resolutions on the death of Dr. Woodward -_-- ------------- 75 
The voleanoes and lava fields of New Mexico, C. E. Dutton ~~ 76 
Electric lighting, E. B. Elliott, (Title only) -----. ----—.- --- 80 
Thermometer exposure, H! ‘A. Hazen*l2 _L2 ---2 2-2 eae 80 
Presentation of the:annualaddress-2_ 222 SoU Sek See ee 81 

Axnual Meating 2202) eS ee ee eS eet ee ee 81 

Bulletin of the Mathematical Section” -.2- i 2- LS 2S sees 83 
Standing’ Rules of the Seetion=—— “2. Se ee ee 85 
Officers of ‘the: Sections. a eee 86 
Curves similar to their evolutes, C. H. Kummell -_----~----- 87 
The problem of the knight’s tour, G. K. Gilbert --_-------__- 88 
Empirical formule for the diminution of amplitude of a freely- 

oscillating pendulum, H. Farquhar ~__~__---_~. ------ -__- 89 
A concrete problem in hydrostatics, G. K. Gilbert_.-__-____- 92 . 
The formule for computing the position of a satellite, A. Hall- 98 
A formula for the length of a seconds-pendulum, G. W. Hill, 

( Pitlerortty) oa eee ee a 101 
A form of the multinomial theorem, A.S. Christie, (Title only). 101 
Discussion of a concrete problem in hydrostatics proposed by 

Mr. G. K. Gilbert, R. S. Woodward, (Title only) ---------- 101 
The quadric transformation of elliptic integrals, combined with 

the algorithm of the arithmetico-geometric mean, C. H. 

Kunimell) 42 ees ee eee eee ee 101, 102 
A case of discontinuity in elliptic orbits, W. B. Taylor____..§.§ 122 
The verification of predictions, M. H. Doolittle.-.------.---- 122 
Memorial to Gen. ‘Alvord (Set Ses ol eee ee 
Committees on mathematical communications_.._-_--.-------- 129 

Index 22223 a ne ee he en 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


CONSTITUTION, RULES, 


LIST OF 
OFFICERS AND MEMBERS, 
AND REPORTS OF 


SECRETARIES AND TREASURER. 


CONSTITUTION 


OF 


THE PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ArricLE I. The name of this Society shall be Tor PHILOSOPHI- 
CAL Society OF WASHINGTON. 


ArricLeE II. The officers of the Society shall be a President, 
four Vice-Presidents, a Treasurer, and two Secretaries. 


ArvicLE III, There shall be a General Committee, consisting of 
the officers of the Society and nine other members. 


ArticLe IV. The officers of the Society and the other members 
of the General Committee shall be elected annually by ballot ; they 
shall hold office until their successors are elected, and shall have 
power to fill vacancies. 


Artic, V. It shall be the duty of the General Committee to 
make rules for the government of the Society, and to transact all 
its business. 


ArticLe VI. This constitution shall not be amended except by 

a three-fourths vote of those present at an annual meeting for the 

election of officers, and after notice of the proposed change shall 

have been given in writing at a stated meeting of the Society at 
least four weeks previously. P 
Vil 


SPANDING ROLES 


FOR THE GOVERNMENT OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


1. The Stated Meetings of the Society shall be held at 8 o’clock 
P.M. on every alternate Saturday; the place of meeting to be 
designated by the General Committee. 


2. Notice of the time and place of meeting shall be sent to each 
member by one of the Secretaries. 
When necessary, Special Meetings may be called by the President. 


3. The Annual Meeting for the election of officers shall be the 
last stated meeting in the month of December. 


The order of proceedings (which shalk be announced by the 
Chair) shall be as follows: 
First, the reading of the minutes of the last Annual Meeting. 


Second, the presentation of the annual reports of the Secretaries, 
including the announcement of the names of members elected since 
the last annual meeting. 


Third, the presentation of the annual report of the Treasurer. 
Fourth, the announcement of the names of members who, having 


complied with Section 13 of the Standing Rules, are entitled to vote 
on the election of officers. 


Fifth, the election of President. 

Sixth, the election of four Vice-Presidents. 

Seventh, the election of Treasurer. 

Eighth, the election of two Secretaries. 

Ninth, the election of nine members of the General Committee. 


Tenth, the consideration of Amendments to the Constitution of 
the Society, if any such shall have been proposed in accordance 
with Article VI of the Constitution. 

Eleventh, the reading of the rough minutes of the meeting. 

Lx 


x PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


4, Elections of officers are to be held as follows: .* 

In each case nominations shall be made by means of an informal 
ballot, the result of which shall be announced by the Secretary ; 
after which the first formal ballot shall be taken. 

In the ballot for Vice-Presidents, Secretaries, and Members of the 
General Committee, each voter shall write on one ballot as many 
names as there are officers to be elected, viz., four on the first ballot 
for Vice-Presidents, two on the first for Secretaries, and nine on the 
first for Members of the General Committee; and on each subse- 
quent ballot as many names as there are persons yet to be elected; 
and those persons who receive a majority of the votes cast shall be 
declared elected. 

If in any case the informal ballot result in giving a majority for 
any one, it may be declared formal by a majority vote. 


5. The Stated Meetings, with the exception of the annual meet- 
ing, shall be devoted to the consideration and discussion of scientific 
subjects. 

The Stated Meeting next preceding the Annual Meeting shall 
be set apart for the delivery of the President’s Annual Address. 


6. Sections representing special branches of science may he 
formed by the General Committee upon the written recommenda- 
tion of twenty members of the Society. 


7. Persons interested in science, who are not residents of the Dis- 
trict of Columbia, may be present at any meeting of the Society, 
except the annual meeting, upon invitation of a member. 


8. Similar invitations to residents of the District of Columbia, 
not members of the Society, must be submitted through one of the 
Secretaries to the General Committee for approval. 


9. Invitations to attend during three months the meetings of the 
Society and participate in the discussion of papers, may, by a vote 
of nine members of the General Committee, be issued to persons 
nominated by two members. 


10. Communications intended for publication under the auspices 
of the Society shall be submitted in writing to the General Com- 
mittee for approval. 


STANDING RULES. dH 


11. Any paper read before a Section may be repeated, either 
entire or by abstract, before a general meeting of the Society, if 
such repetition is recommended by the General Committee of the 
Society. 


12. New members may be proposed in writing by three members 
of the Society for election by the General Committee; but no per- 
son shall be admitted to the privileges of membership unless he 
signifies his acceptance thereof in writing within two months after 
notification of his election. 


13. Each member shall pay annually to the Treasurer the sum 
of five dollars, and no member whose dues are unpaid shall vote at 
the annual meeting for the election of officers, or be entitled to a 
copy of the Bulletin. 

In the absence of the Treasurer, the Secretary is authorized to 
receive the dues of members. 

The names of those two years in arrears shall be apllae from 
the list of members. 

Notice of resignation of membership shall be given in writing to 
the General Committee through the President or one of the Secre- 
taries. 


14. The fiscal year shall terminate with the Annual Meeting. 


15. Members who are absent from the District of Columbia for 
more than twelve months may be excused from payment of the 
annual assessments. They can, however, resume their membership 
by giving notice to the President of their wish to do so. 


16. Any member not in arrears may, by the payment of one 
hundred dollars at any one time, become a life member, and be 
relieved from all further annual dues and other assessments. 

All moneys received in payment of life membership shall be 
invested as portions of a permanent fund, which shall be directed 
solely to the furtherance of such special scientific work as may be 
ordered by the General Committee. 


STANDING RULES * 


OF THE 


GENERAL COMMITTEE OF THE PHILOSOPHICAL 
SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


1. The President, Vice-Presidents, and Secretaries of the Society 
shall hold like offices in the General Committee. 


2. The President shall have power to call special meetings of the 
Committee, and to appoint Sub-Committees. 


3. The Sub-Committees shall prepare business for the General 
Committee, and perform such other duties as may be entrusted to 
them. 


A. There shall be two Standing Sub-Committees; one on Com- 
munications for the Stated Meetings of the Society, and another on 
Publications. 


5. The General Committee shall meet at half-past seven o’clock 
on the evening of each Stated Meeting, and by adjournment at 
other times. 


6. For all purposes except for the amendment of the Standing 
Rules of the Committee or of the Society, and the election of mem- 
bers, six members of the Committee shall constitute a quorum. 


7. The names of proposed new members recommended in con- 
formity with Section 11 of the Standing Rules of the Society, may 
be presented at any meeting of the General Committee, but shall 
lie over for at least four weeks before final action, and the concur- 
rence of twelve members of the Committee shall be necessary to 
election. 

The Secretary of the General Committee shall keep a chronologi- 
cal register of the elections and acceptances of members. 


8. These Standing Rules, and those for the government of the 
Society, shall be modified only with the consent of a majority of 
the members of the General Committee. 

Xii 


Lists @ AN Dry = 


FOR THE 


PUBLICATION OF THE BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


1. The President’s annual address shall be published in full. 


2. The annual reports of the Secretaries and of the Treasurer 
shall be published in full. 


3. When directed by the General Committee, any communication 
may be published in full. 


4, Abstracts of papers and remarks on the same will be pub- 
lished, when presented to the Secretary by the author in writing 
within two weeks of the evening of their delivery, and approved by 
the Committee on Publications. Brief abstracts prepared by one 
of the Secretaries and approved by the Committee on Publications 
may also be published. 


5. If the author of any paper read before a Section of the 
Society desires its publication, either in full or by abstract, it shall 
be referred to a committee to be appointed as the Section may 
determine. 

The report of this committee shall be forwarded to the Publica- 
tion Committee by the Secretary of the Section, together with any 
action of the Section taken thereon. 


6. Communications which have been published elsewhere, so as 
to be generally accessible, will appear in the Bulletin by title only, 
but with a reference to the place of publication, if made known in 
season to the Committee on Publications. 

xiii 


OFFICERS 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON 


ELECTED DECEMBER 22, 1883. 


DP ESULCRRE nee neta J. C. WELLING. 

Vice-Presidents...----J. S. BILLINGs. GARRICK MALLERY. 
J. E. HiLecarp. AsAPH HALL, 

Treasurer_..-------- CLEVELAND ABBE. 

SECPELATIES (Ieee HENRY FARQUHAR. G. K. GILBERT, 


MEMBERS AT LARGE OF THE GENERAL COMMITTEE. 


HH. HBATES! HOB PECIor et. 


W. H. DALL. ROBERT FLETCHER: 


C. E. DuTTon. WILLIAM HARKNESS. 


J. R. EASTMAN. J. J. Knox. * 


Co. Vis ARULEY: 


STANDING COMMITTEES. 


On Communications + 


J. S. BrLiincs, Chairman. HENRY FARQUHAR. G. K. GILBERT. 


On Publications: 


G. K. GILBERT, Chairman. CLEVELAND ABBE. HENRY FARQUHAR. 


5. Ff BAIRD 


* Mr. Knox resigned May 10, 1884, and the General Committee elected Mr. F. W. Clarke 
to the vacancy. 
+ As Secretary of the Smithsonian Institution. 


WXNIV 


OP Pith Re 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON 


ELECTED DECEMBER 20, 1884. 


PY EMUEN base fen ae AsAPH HALL. ® 
Vice- Presidents ...---.-J. S. BILLINGs. GARRICK MALLERY. 


WILLIAM HARKNEss. J. E. HILGARD. 


Tregsurep ns nye ROBERT FLETCHER. 


UNF [1 Oa a G. K. GILrert. HENRY FARQUHAR. 


MEMBERS AT LARGE OF THE GENERAL COMMITTEE. 


Marcus BAKER. H. H. Bares. 
B. OW. CLARKE: Wi EL DALL. 
C. E. Dutton. J. R. EastMan. 
E; B. ELLiorr. H. M. PAUvL. 


C. V. RILEY. : 
STANDING COMMITTEES. 
On Commnuications : 


J. S. BILLincs, Chairman. G. K. GILBERT. HENRY FARQUHAR. 


On Publications : 


G. K. GILBERT, Chairman. RoBerRT FLETCHER. HENRY FARQUHAR. 


S. F. Batrv.* 


*As Secretary of the Smithsonian Institution. 
xv 


LIST OF MEMBERS 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Corrected to December 20, 1884. 


The names of founders are printed in Smaun Capirats. 
(d) indicates deceased. 


(a) indicates absent from the District of Columbia and excused from payment of dues 
until announcing his return. 


(r) indicates resigned. 


Darr or 

NAME. P. O. ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. Annee 
Abbe, Clevelan Gite. smcauessenstoe-tesoss-ten Army Signal Office. 20171 St. N. W...| 1871, Oct. 29 
Abert, Sylvanus Thayer..........csssee 1724 Penn. Ave. N. W 1875, Jan. 30 
Adams, Henry...... sel GOTMEL SG. NCW) .csncsssse, 1881, Feh. 5 
Aldis, Asa Owen ..| 1765 Mass. Ave... ae --| 1873, Mar. 1 
Allen; Jamesi...c:tccsstes ..| Army Signal Office | 1882, Feb. 25 
Alvord, POU] AUNT (G2) les evacsoen ssetvoensete| nares scence snes senessas recen<-eeeeaieeaenuenenad --| 1872, Mar. 23 
ANTISELL, HEH OMAR sects escenducsunccents ......| Patent Office. 1311 QSt. N. W.. ---| 1871, Mar. 13 
Avery, Robert Stanton.....sssesssese | Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. | 1879; Oct. 11 

320 A St. S. E. 
Babeock, Orville LIAS) ccccvecccertces|cacsccccsecsesvesscevsecenussupeve Spraoacitececcec eon te 1871, June 9 
Bailey, Theodorus (QD) kes wancrosete stncenee] Sasser setnesescansennsnsecccessenccesassuscsccesceseassoeee 1873, Mar. 1 
Barb, SPENCER FULLERTON........+.200+- pion ina Institution. 1445 Mass. | 1871, Mar. 13 
ve. N. W. 

Belcer, Harkey, caateeadieentsvenevaresmmedsn SIGIC. Sts Na WW ivecuiteccena ten ceandeasccnepenneacen 1881, May 14 


Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. | 1876, Mar. 11 


Baker, Marcus... 
1205 Rhode Island Ave. 


Bancroft, George... ®................| 1623 H St. N. W., or Newport, R. I...... 1875, Jan. 16 
Barnard, William Stebbins...........--J Agricultural Department. 917 N.Y. | 1884, Mar. 1 
Ave. N. W., or Canton, Ill. 
BARNEY POSE PH: KK. (G)soveccoucte>scosvanests| cneepevescsetrabdauensanadsatnd-sncecna-sucesahe teseaaddu-ae 1871, Mar. 13 
Bates, Henry Hobatrt...........seeseeeeree Patent Office. The Portland.............. 1871, Nov. 4 
Bean, Tarleton Hoffman..............+++. National Museum. 1411 R. I. Ave...... 1884, Apr. 26 
Beardslee, Lester Anthony (@)........ Captain U. 8. N., Navy Department....| 1875, Feb. 27 
Bell, Alexander Graham.. v.....ccsese0 Scott Circle. 1500 R. I. Ave.....sssseceees- 1879, Mar. 29 
Bell, Chichester Alexander............. TOBM OONWWAW Ga. 20 s-ccsncunonpeakesuvecenenacers 1881, Oct. 8 
Benér, STEPHEN VINCENT.......cc0cce00 Ordnance Office, War Department. | 1871, Mar.13 
1717 I St. N. W. 
ISASSCLS PESING screen ssnsscvve sssaesinasessce ai Seuiebagaian Institution. 1444 N St. | 1875, Jan. 16 
BILLINGS, JOHN SHAW......+.ssceesseseceenes press leeod Office, U.S. A. 3027 N | 1871, Mar. 13 
Birney; William... .cccc..csesssconcssscense 456 Louisiana Ave. 1901 Harewood | 1879, Mar. 29 
Ave., Le Droit Park. 
Birnie, Rogers: (@)....c0s.sceccosssscccnsecse Cold Spring, Putnam Co., N. Y........00 1876, Mar. 11 
Blair, Henry IW SVI10i(C) setacnsccsenssnctss| ssseacnsatosnscnvsceebscvenesevancnvesscsehnansasssenudedved 1884, Feh. 2 
Bodfish, Sumner Homer...e.ccsseseseseee Geological Survey. 605 F St. N. W.....| 1888, Mar. 24 
Boutelle, CHATICSIOCIS icc ccssseseueccesencs Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 1884, Feb. 16 
1513 20th St. N. W. 
Bowles, Francis Tiffany...........sseses 1823 Jefferson PlACOniccc, .sosseccascaseubennay 1884, Mar. 29 
Brown, Stimson Joseph .........20ee0004 *| Naval Observatory. 2133 K St. N.W... 1884, Apr. 12 
Browne, John Mills .............cs000..0e0. ceo Director, U.S.N. The Port- | 1883, Novy. 24 
and. ; 
Burchard, Horatio Chapin .............. Director of the Mint. Riggs House...! 1879, May 10 


Ve 


LIST OF MEMBERS. 


XVII 


DaTE OF 
NAME. P. O. ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. inuneeran: 
Burgess, Edward Sandford............. High School. 81012th St. N. W......+.. 1883, Mar. 24 
Burnett, Swan MOSES......ccsseceeeeesereee AUD isto NW cawaetessecess| xewese sevesesecscesee] 1879, Mar. 29 
Busey, Samuel Clagett .......sseeeeee POD UISU UN Wet. -wet es ccsncelacGgasess Parr 1874, Jan. 17 
CAPRON, HORACE......0..seeeseeeees evene cantar MRMOREOrEB BU tenes scien tstcceet mas attce eases 1871, Mar. 13 
Case, Augustus Ludlow (@)..........+. Bristol, R. I......... ieete Grr eroeeecr erEenn etch 1872, Nov. 16 
Casey, THOMAS LINCOLN....ccsso-cseecceeee aes Cores of Engineers. 1419 K St. | 1871, Mar. 13 
IN. . 
Caziare, Louis Vasmer (@)........++- -..| War Department.......... meuacutaecabenaetencd 1882, Feb. 25 
CHASE, SALMON PORTLAND (G).......00-- [ecccsersccessencscen sense eneees 1871, Mar. 13 
Chamberlin, Thomas Crowderv......... Geological Survey........... 1883, Mar. 24 
Chickering, John White, Jr... ..-.| Deaf Mute College, Kends 1874, Apr 11 
Christie, Alexander Smyth............. Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. | 1880, Dec. 4 
628 Mass. Ave. N. W. 
Clapp, William Henry (@)........eeccsee Ft. Davis, Tex. 1416 Corcoran St. | 1882, Feb. 25 
Washington. 
QOlarikk, HGWard oc -cc.ccsvscssseccosuss paehers Or ree Office, Capitol. 417 4th | 1877, Feb. 24 
Clark, Ezra Westcote..............+0 eeeees Revenue Marine Bureau, Treasury | 1882, Mor. 25 
Department. Woodley Road. 
Clarke, Frank Wigglesworth........... Geological Survey. 1425 Q St. N. W...] 1874, Apr. 11 
Corrin, JouN Hunrineron ORANE...... LOOISDIS GIN Ea Wiet uatesstteces conc teers ...| 1871, Mar. 13 
ABGUIAS EE REO OLLCI: ((3)),.- 5 -scbencsscdccceost! Ustenspevtwecteneapeabenescesscnsene 1879, Oct. 21 
Comstock, John Henry (@).........0008 Cornell University, Ithaca, N. Y......... 1880, Feb. 14 
Coues, Elliott..............cc0e-es Smithsonian Inst. 1726 N. St. N. W...| 1874, Jan. 17 
RATA MESENTAMEN, HA NEULL ()scsee serves [asccse seocvep terre rec ncnetecescocasesccbudcsdbesats cased 1871, Mar. 13 
Craigs, RODELE......ccccase-ee-rene Army Signal Office. 1008 I St. N. W...] 1873, Jan. 4 
Craig, THOMAS ()........2..ccccseseeeserres Johns Hopkins Uniy., Baltimore, Md..| 1879, Nov. 22 
Crane, CHARLES HENRY (d).......00.20008 eee acute a be hcedes secuuscspyevedesaacsethecm ieee 1871, Mar. 13 
Curtis, George Edwatrd..........ecsese Army Signal Office. 1416 Corcoran St..| 1884, Jan. 5 
Curtis, Josiah (d)........ Rote meab ar ecobel| Wibecassrasauemubasetere sys Cee M eas cae aviszsouuieeckuanven 1874, Mar. 28 
Cutts, Richard Dominicus (d)..... saps! ten -@eshaapusesivedacconanegceadsvatuurisstetrsysassececceen 1871, Apr. 29 
Dah, WILLIAM HEALEY ....c0.sescesseosens Care Smithsonian Institution. 1119 | 1871, Mar. 13 
12th St. N. W. 
Davis, Charles Henry ().........ccseseee[ee addins saewdauadtann:sacarses- en panceaalabestidsdedecsaet 1874, Jan. 17 
Davis, Charles Henry..........ccssessseee ae eee aceite 1705 Rhode Island | 1880, June 19 
ve. N. W. 
Dean, Richard Orain (@)......cessecesees Naval Hospital, New York............ce.0. 1872, Apr. 23 
De Caindry, William Augustin........ Commissary General’s Office. 924 | 1881, Apr. 30 
19th St. N. W. 
De Land, Theodore Louis............0+ Treasury Dept. 126 7th St. N. E......... 1880, Dee. 18 
Dewey, Frederick Perkins..............) National Museum. 1007 G St. N. W.....] 1884, Apr. 25 
NOVO OOLGONT icc shenecescas cstess <ccensusee erackelc Guan settee Mec ccc tueate tee dc ose lecpeal 1879, Feb. 15 
Diller, Joseph SUAS. +.....cccesesnacsonesee. GeolozicaliSarvey.cccste essere uee 1884, Mar. 1 
Doolittle, Myrick Hascall ............. Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. | 1876, Feb. 12 
1925 I St. N. W. 
Dorr, Frederic William (d)............0:).s.cc00 asbobesnctaca sh ves hae meane user sae ech Ce staan 1874, Jan. 17 
Dunwoody, Henry Harrison Chase(a)| Army Signal Office. 3012 Dumbarton | 1873, Dec. 20 
St., Georgetown. 
Dutton, Clarence Edward................ Geological Survey 1872, Jan. 27 
Nir eaRe AN ORCA EeaDp Eva (E2) sees tisev'ceas arunce rca seal nocd soceentenste Seescscpsateoencd oe lubuse saxon 1871, Mar. 13 
Earll, Robert Edward ......sessssos- ssc National Museums oo a eae 1884, Apr. 26 
‘Eastman, John Robie..... .| Naval Observatory. ..| 1871, May 27 
BATON, AMOS) BEEBE) (@) i. iis sscess sscassees| svoeres-sveneteacssedsae Reeanacnedeaekanseeshdcccanassees 1871, Mar. 13 
Eaton, John........ Sonbec sdsenecen bod eee Bureau of Education, Interior Dept. | 1874, May 8 
712 East Capitol St. 
Wimbeck, William..........ccccsscssesscsese Coast and Geodetie Survey Office....... 1884, Feb. 2 
Eldredge, Stewart (@).......:c.0-sseseee olkohamas Japan’ <0 . 3 aoe it 1871, June 9 
| ES eroy Ces Gr olay Leh oh & Ooh ah U7) eee ey Me Mn RY Se PR RID IN SY tA 1871, Mar. 13 
ExtiotT, EZEKIEL BROWN....c.....ceceeees Government Actuary, Treasury De- | 1871, Mar. 13 
partment. 1210G St. N. W. 
Emmons, Samuel Franklin............ Gesoctral Survey. 23 Lafayette | 1883, Apr. 7 
ace, 
Endlich, Frederi¢ Miller (q)........... Smithsonian Institution. Lake Val- | 1873, Mar. 1 


ley, New Mexico. 
EP VIIN ES 16S IMM (2) caste none See touuds cy var scallcnaas eansdesce Rew ies eek com cieac iets oecar ecules a eege 
PE yan Ee ANE TL (Ch) scans ocsnnascaccusites texcts|( UA CASLEM ONO ycsas <cbescasductivsucy cou tuesd 
Farquhar, Edward...........0.....00....! Patent Office Library. 1915 HSt. N.W.. 


1G" 


1874, Jan. 17 
1874, Jan. 17 


1876, Feb. 12 


XVIII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Date or 


NAME. P. O. ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. | ADMISSION. 


1881, May 14 


1872, Nov. 16 
1873, Apr. 10 


Farquhar, Henry........--::..-s1:+.+seeee| Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 
Brooks Station, D. C. 
Army Signal Office. 471 C St. N. W... 
.| Surgeon Genl’s Office, U.S. A. 1326. 
L St. N. W. 


Ferrel, William ... 
Fletcher, Robert 


Flint, Albert Stowell ...............-s.ss00 Naval Observatory. 1450 Chapin St., | 1882, Mar. 25 
College Hill. 
Mints AMES WUULONs..cc0sccensttocnsconer ove Dept. U.S.S. Albatross........... 1881, Mar. 19 
WOOMESRESLISHAL (2) ccnccsacsteveccssecesesacecn| coscesuuepevounecstesccs-cbisesnzecensebaen aausenccawilnessy 1871, Mar. 13 
Woster, Jolin Gray.) (G)viccecsvee dennce «scase) seopossendoaucalsuhuncassonsanadaesectedscbsenedecaceant cunces 1873, Jan. 18 
French, Henry Flagg (7)..........ss01]resccsseoeseccesesccesea recess coeeseces Corteeeerectccocccc 1882, Mar. 25 
Pristoe, EXGward 1. 5..6-Mes..ccccseeconcceos 1434 N St. N. W....... pisvansueveaneoskeneees pesuas 1873, Mar. 29 
Galeq Meonard DUNMEI (Gd) cece facwnssehel tcenmcpeeaasanusanrdnanaecuctassedasncssen:nusaaccduasepes ..| 1874, Jan. 17 
Gallaudet, Edward Miner............+0+: Deaf Mute College, Kendall Green... 1875, Feb. 27 
Gannett, HONEY: iccscaccecncdeccosones sane Geological Survey. 1881 Harewood 1874, Apr. 11 
Ave., Le Droit Park. 
Gardiner, James Terry (@) .............. State Survey, Al Dany, No Visssteccsscansues 1874, Jan. 17 
Garnett, Alexander Moun  (PAN(0:) fa catll edeseepsenseescecns cu stnes ces -chisdsehucesseuneneceestad 1878, Mar. 16 
Gihon, Albert JiGA IY: secstseasory snes aoveree Naval Hospital, 2019 Hillyer Place 1880, Dee. 18 
Gilbert, Grove Karl...........ccsesss- esses GeologicalSurvey. 1424 Corcoran St...) 1873, June 7 
GILL, THEODORE NICHOLAS........00.0000 Smithsonian Institution.................00 1871, Mar. 13 
Godding, William Whitney............. Government Asylum for the Insane..| 1879, Mar. 29 
Goode, George Brown...... Rcavontawaaeeen Wie Museum. 1620 Mass. Ave. | 1874, Jan. 31 
Goodfellow, Edward........cscccces ssoves- Coast and Geodetic Survey Office......] 1875, Dec. 18 
Goodfellow, Henry (r) ..| 1871, Nov. 4 


Gore, James Howard........ 6: “Columbian Univ. 1305 Q'St. N. V ..| 1880, Mar. 14 
.| Asst. Treasurer U.S ..| 1874, Apr. 11 


Graves, Edward Oziel (a)... 


Graves, Walter Hayden (a)... he tacestentera Denver, Colorad0......cccsscseceee cones ....| 1878, May 25 
Greely, Adolphus Washington........ Army Signal cute: EGOS OL Stie creases 1880, June 19 
Green, Bernard Richardson............ 1738 N St. N. W...... ashe ceauvareahenreucceccones 1879, Feb. 15 
Green, Francis Mathews (@).........0.. Navy De Punteay seer 1875, Nov. 9 
GREENE, BENJAMIN FRANKLIN (4)...... West Lebanon, N. H 1871, Mar. 13 
Greene, Francis Vinton............cese0 District Commissioners! Office, 1915 | 1875, Apr. 10 
Gregory, John Milton.......... Beas sanecen MLO CAML DHL ROG wancsacccanctssade on sunceseasemannae 1884, Mar. 29 
Gunnell, Francis M........0.cccseseeesee- Peon eres U. S. N. 600 20th | 1879, Feb. 1 
GENE We 


.| 1879, Feb. 15 


Hains, Peter Conover..................+...] 1924 Jefferson Place.. 
1871, Mar. 13 


UAT PASAPH <5 occccascattantssuccets ....| Naval Observatory. 2715 N St. N. W.. 
Naval Observatory. 2715 N St. N. W.. 


Hall, "Asaph, tea eaces tedecesccsee 1880, Dee. 20 
Hanscom, Nesaei big (G)seceuscercccnvondecardenpiecceecuance totbemeylcnensnarssnnceeers er rekegeneeeMae tenet 1873, Dec. 20 
HARKNESS, WILLIAM... ....| Naval Observatory. 1415 G St. N. W..| 1871, Mar.13 
Hassler, Ferdinand Augustus (a) ...| Santa Ana, Los Angeles Co., Cal.......... 1880, May 8 
Haypen, FERDINAND VANDEVEER (a)..] Geological Survey. 1803 Arch St., Phil-| 1871, Mar. 13 


adelphia, Penn. 
Hazen, Henry Allem...............seesssees P. O. Box No. 427. 1416 Corcoran St... 
Hazeu, William Babcock.. Army Signal Office. 1601 K. St. N. W.. 


1882, Mar. 25 
1881, Feb. 5 


Heap, David Porter............. .| Light House Board,Treasury Depart- | 1884, Mar. 15 
ment. 1618 Rhode Island Ave. 

ELENRY, DOSER (G) vscsten cancncsessseseessnads|scecuacsnnenecssus-cheecacuspannrcestas/neustavessssecyeeren 1871, Mar. 13 

Henshaw, Henry Wetherbee........... Bureau of Ethnology, P. 0. Box 585... .| 1874, Apr. 11 

Hinearp, JULTUS ERASMUS...csseseseceeess Coast and Geodetic Survey fice. 1871, Mar. 13 


1709 Rhode Island Ave. N. W. 


Hill, George William...................., Nautical Almanac Office. 314 Ind. | 1879, Feb. 1 


Ave. N. W. 
Hitchcock, Romy ...| P. O. Box 630.. won:eei'sss cessccneaaes csvech| LOGa mean 
Holden, wai é Giddlotan (a)... ...| Madison, Wisconsin... .| 1873, June 21 
Holmes, William Henry... .....| Geological Survey. 1100 O St. N. ‘W... 1879, Mar. 29 
Hough, Franklin Benjamin (a)... ..| Agricultural Dept. Lowville, N. Y..... 1879, Mar. 29 
Howell, Edwin Eugene (@).........s008+ MOGHESTOP ANG Wieccscccccscenelecces wedep esas 1874, Jan. 31 
Humpurers, ANDREW ATKINSON (@)...|...cccocosssecorsecceresesccecccccsseese= scenes scons senses .13 


Jackson, Henry Arundel Earhe (a)| War oi . 30 
James, Owen (@) ceacccnuvseeedssavsese-seseesm |, SCLANLONS Pa... uate 3 
Jeffers, William Nicolson (r)... LU sbavacnd | ovtaceveceseteh sescaeaesccnevenvatensaness yisecenua . 24 
JENKINS, THornton ALEXANDER....... 2115 Penn. Ave. N ve 


LIST OF MEMBERS. XIX 


5 a DATE oF 
NAME, P. O. AppRESS AND RESIDENCE. Merete. 
Johnson, Arnold Burges..........esee Light House Board, Treasury Dept. | 1878, Jan. 19 
501 Maple Ave., Le Droit Park. 

Johnson, Joseph Taber......... nebascine: GDB UE Sly NG AW sess scacsescoinossaseonccssdituss 1879, Mar. 29 
Johnson, Willard Drake...........+ss000 Geological Survey. 501 Maple Ave., | 1884, Feb. 16 
; Le Droit Park. 

Johnston, William Waring..............] 1603 K St, N. W....iscssssccssscssees seseeeensees 1873, Jan. 21 
see N ARS METAL IT ENTD CN) ) ee teciasenesteu ass cack (suesenedtianenaticuncacebepselvaacastsp seb sedsvnercersausnranr 

Kauffmann, Samuel Hays.............+ ae 

Keith, Keuel Eeaeaacelkacasieceostincraneuerecssep 2219 I St... Maeeteneesesseckn rt onvepscsewaycne=<=sennneres 1871, Oct. 29 
Kerr, ‘Mark Brickell.......... 812 2lst St. N. W.. 1884, Feb ue 
Kerr, Washington Caruthe 1883, Apr. 
Kidder, Jerome Henry............. aa F ..| 1880, May 3 
Kilbourne, Charles Evans (a) War Department........ 1880, June 19 
King, Albert Freeman Africanus...| 726 13th St. N. W.. 1875, Jan. 16 
Rasiya AML OVACE: (15) tocasccstenscnncntnad seeccu|isseact xeneavancpocsvaneaspas dsccsvessveces serssascctecfseds 1879, May 10 
Kero Xe) OLIN SAY (CE) ixsectcevanveoncctssonad ace "Nat. Bk. ol alae Se New York City..... 1874, May 8 
Kummell, Charles Hugo. Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. | 1882, Mar. 25 

608 Q St. N. W. 


1871, Mar. 13 
1884, Feb. 16 


1881, Feb. 19 


Lane, JONATHAN HomER mm AC). CAs cuss conan flsusceneewansune’ uicet eevee cpvawes ennstveve sv ast casercaceces 
Lawrence, William... nected seee First Comptroller's Office, Treasury 


: Department. 1344 Vermont Ave. 
Lawver, Winfield Peter..................| Mint Bureau, Treasury Department. 
1912 I St. N. W. 


TUE SAW TL UEAYIN ceccess sucsncmeeenesce tej) Zt Penns Ave. Ni OW... cccsneccazescvascaccsess 1874, Jan. 17 
Lefavour, Edward Brown.... .| Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 1882, Dec. 16 
905 O St. N. W. 
Lincoln, Nathan Smith.................... TSVAC EE Ste NW accaveceucvespsccevccccccnscatesees 1871, May 27 
Mie ee R PEL CRIT Elicl (15) vsseacvasscpeecces| (nseeaese esecccsanevessercasadecdiecavacdvs ciassecsecated 1871, Oct. 29 
Loomis, Eben Jenks.........c.cccsssessese Nautical Almanac Office. 1413 Col- 1880, Feb. 14 
lege Hill Terrace N. W. 
Lull, Edward Phelps (a)..............006 74 Cedar St., Roxbury, Mass...............] 1875, Dee. 4 
PEON SCP ILE CATT) (9%); .ccoscaccceseccus| <ntssnes ctenrencosnaccenatanesevenceros Seeecpeer ci scoscsee | LOIS, Jan. 18 
MacCauley, Henry Clay (a)............ P. O. Box 953, Minneapolis, Minn...... 1880, Jan. 3 
yay CELA beso atetens cL dcatuancccoazececosves Geological Survey. 1424 Corcoran St.| 1883, Nov. 10 
McGuire, Frederick Bauders.......... 1306 F St. N. W. 614 E. St. N. W......... 1879, Feb. 15 
Mack, Osear A. (d)........ ° ..| 1872, Jan. 27 
MeMurtrie, William ( ..| Champaign, IIl........ ..| 1876, Feb. 26 
Maher, James Arran..... ..| Geological Survey. ‘91 ESt. N. W...... 1884, Feb. 16 
Ma lery Garvie kc. sccsccsccssatessssaccvree Bureau of Ethnology, P.O. Box 585. | 1875, Jan. 30 
1323 N St. N. W. 
Marcon, John Belknap........sseceeeeee Geplorical Survey rc: ccvevenc--ncstssesccesavere 1884, Mar. 29 
Marvin, Joseph Badger (q).............. Internal Revenue Bureau........... ..| 1878, May 25 
Marvin, RUA ELODOXUSOILG)..cal|vecessaey seus ansnactntcsredaccdesd/ccesesneaescccounesnerses 1874, Jan. 31 
Mason, (OBIE T WEtOM..., cecsesessncscon ae National Museum. 1305 Q St. N. W.. 1875, Jan. 30 
Matthews, Washington..........cccescees Surgeon General’s Office, U. S. A...... 1884, June 7 
Meek, Firtptna BRADFORD (d)......... AMeA ove dosweneavelie atastect Rovasastonvarsaaecs mca § 1871, Mar. 13 
Meigs, Montgomery (Q)............. Senche U.S. Engineer Office, Keokuk, Iowa..} 1877, Mar. 24 
Metres, MontcoMERY CUNNINGHAM...... 1239 Vermont Ave. N. W............seeseeeee 1871, Mar. 13 
Merrill, George Perkins................ National Museum ..............e.002006 ....| 1884, Apr. 26 
oes 1874, Jan. 31 


Milner, James William (d). 
Morgan, Ethelbert Carroll.. 


“} 918 E St. N. W..... ‘| 1883; Oct. 13 


Morris, Martin WUGTIOLUFIAN A) (93) isa pusecs| decsvnedcacs cocud cow'saeees evtivdsdtc ccdndaecencccosteesdeeee 1877, Feb. 24 
DUM OCH OLN vasscvascosercascst srcetaceces Smithsonian Inst on. 1441 Chapin |} 1884, Apr. 26 
- St., College Hill. 
Mussey, Reuben Delavan................ P. 0. Box 618. 508 5th St. N. Wu... 1881, Dee. 3 
Myer, Auzert J. a Beeneeeaeeccnat ceatrateaausactaLospeetiencestscadevasavecsctusssacas 1871, Mar. 13 
Myers, William (a) War Department..................00.ssse0reaee 1871, June 23 
INTE WW COME: SIMON. -..200snesnesrsstvessaccadense INA VY DUG DREtMGD sence. <---<cuescavesnececuaces 1871, Mar. 13 
Nichols, Charles Henry (2). Bloomingdale, N. Y scscesee-| 1872, May 4 
Nicuotson, WALTER LAmp... 1322 1 St. N. W » Mar. 13 
Nordhoff, Ae RAMI a) nee 1c ee pe ete 9, May 10 
SES gL | nc a I i Mar. 1 
Ogden, Herbert Gouverneur........... Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. | 1784, Feb. 2 
1324 19th St. N. W. 
Osborne, John Walter...........s01.sseee, 212 Delaware Ave. N. Eu.........cccccesceeeee 1878, Dec. 7 


xX PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


NAME. P. O. Appress AND RESIDENCE. 


Oris, GEoRGE ALEXANDER (@)...... 


PARKE, JOHN GRUBB....cccssssccoeee « wanes Engineer Bureau, War Department. 
16 Lafayette Square. 

PARKER, PETER i s.assdectactstscossvesdessnee =| 2iduata retibe | SOManolssssaecestebessescenrs ced 

Parry, Charles Christopher (q)........ Davenport, Iowa......... ees 

Patterson) (Carlile: Pollogk (@).2.ic...clelacusapeencesseceacescks ssonan ava seuverseweetenearsanteeee 

Paul, Henry Martyn... cccsssssee Racanauesve Naval Observatory. 109 1st St. N. EB... 


Peale, Albert Charles 


Geological Survey. 1010 Mass. Ave. 
N. W 


Peae, TrT1AN RAMSAY (@).......+. Philadelphia, Penn........... ...| 1871, Mar. 13 
PEIR GE NBDENTAMIN (GQ). csuceccscesvetaccesse:| >sanstucsnebenspanesnucsiue strech epan cautndueeniecste ...| 1871, Mar. 13 
Peirce, Charles Sanders (@)..........00 Coast and Geodetic Survey Office....... 1873, Mar. 1 
Pilling, James Constantine.............. Geological Survey. 918 M St. N. W..] 1881, Feb. 19 
Poe, Orlando Metcalfe (@)..........see00 34 Congress St. West, Detroit, Mich...] 1873, Oct. 4 
Poindexter, William Mundy........... 701 15th St. N. W. 806 17th St. N. W..| 1884, Dee. 20 
Pope, Benjamin Franklin ............... Surgeon General’s Office, U. S. A. | 1882, Dea. 16 
1309 20th St. N. W. 
Porter, David: Dixon()i...ceccsensce couse | teeavoatesbesdecer wescchets dusts cess suesccacuuesssereneeeery 1874, Apr. 11 
Powell, John Wesley.......... ahseeveestee Geological Survey. 910 M St. N .| 1874, Jan. 17 
Prentiss, Daniel Webster.......... cpacagd 1224 9th St. N. W.. ..| 1880, Jan. 3 
Pritchett, Henry Smith (q)..............) Washington University, St. “Louis, Mo. 1879, Mar. 29 
Rathbone, Henry. Reed (@) i. ..<cc5sascqe|escvcousens (aecese odessecus scot varisvnese dav abs cevcaceseone] | RODHG ROEDER 
Rathbun, Richard........ décneas doamseatiees Smithsonian Institution 1622 Mass. | 1882, Oct. 7 
Ave. N. W 
Ray, Patrick Henry........ oe Army Signal Office... ..| 1884, Jan. 5 
Renshawe, John Henry.. ..| Geological Survey. 1221 O St. N. W... 1883, Feb. 24 
Richey, Stephen Olin.........scsce.ssess- 732 17th St... te 1882, Oct. 7 
Ricksecker, Eugene........ ..| Geological Survey. 1505 Q St. N. W... 1884, Feb. 16 
Ridgway, Robert (a)..... -] Smithsonian Inst. 1214 Va. Av. 8. W.. 1874, Jan. 31 
Riley, Charles Valentine. : ra Department. 1700 13th | 1878, Nov. 9 
t. N. W. 
Riley, John Campbell (2) sarcacentasesses| sesteacucsteseos eat becacasestvecesesicvscersnerarhessteetaene 1877, May 19 
Ritter, William Francis McKnight.. antics Almanac Office. 16 Grant | 1879, Oct. 21 
ace. 
Robinson, Thomas.........csccseeseee ....| Howard University. 6th St. N. W., | 1884, Jan. 19 
cor. Lincoln. 
Rodgers, Christopher Raymond | 1723 I St. N. W..........sssscccssessseessceeseseee] 1872, Mar, 9- 
Perry (a). 
Rodgers, ohn (GY Ncwsdecsectececscns Seuesse| égeeeteecseh saaeubeopassessonsvacestusvansmneeecnesipatate 1872, Nov. 16 
Rogers, Joseph Addison (q)... Naval ODSCrVAtOTy..c..sse-assasenscnesesenreee 1872, Mar. 9 
Russell, Israel! Cook: ...0.ccc0s.2 Geological Survey. 1424 Corcoran St.} 1882, Mar. 25 
Russell, Thomas......ssssccssssssssssseeese! Army Signal Office. 1116 M. St. N. W.} 1883, Feb. 10 
Salmon, Daniel Elmer.............sscse Agricultural Dept. 1006 N St. N. W...| 1883, Nov. 24 
Sampson, William Thomas (@)......... Torpedo Station, Newport, R. I........... 1883, Mar. 24 
Sanps, BENJAMIN FRANKLIN (Qyikchssncs|scpesuecvcasscestens se suhaavannsassclacensohceescnnaswetanees 1871, Mar. 13 
Saville, James Hamilton................. 342 DSt. N. W. 1815 MSt. N. W......... 1871, Apr. 29 
ScHAEFKER, GEORGE) CHRISTIAN (G)o05..|iccasnsusccereccevecciresastssos-scasscscnscdecossussocneste 1871, Mar. 13 
SCHOTT, CHARLES ANTHONY....csccseeseeees Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. | 1871, Mar. 13 
212 Ist St. S. E. 
Searle; Henry RObINSON! (@).i.ccacecsuce| ccuseavacatvesatatestenascceusscsnssuaonsussun cous pneneneee 1877, Dec. 21 
Seymour /Georee Wadley (77) cscs averes| coecsatncscunsceraccesestsseuscoasse Greanearsesseaceas satan 1881, Dee. 3 
Shellabarger, Samuel............ een i ae Building. 81217th | 1875, Apr. 10 
St. N. . 
BNOrmans WOUN.sccenccesducsese sereeciss 1819 K St. N. W......0008 .| 1874, Jan. 17 
SHERMAN, VV WANE LE CUMSEHY( 9") turces| ceverstvessaveeneccrecvucsdsecte 1871, Mar. 13 
Shufeldt, Robert Wilson (@)............ Surgeon Genl’s Office, U. 1881, Nov. 5 
144 Smithsonian Institution. 
Sicard, Montgomery (@).....s+0+0 Sorte? Ordnance Bureau, Navy Department.| 1877, Feb. 24 
Sigsbee, Charles Dwight..........0 wee] Naval apace Annapolis, Midiettacees 1879, Mar. 1 
Skinner, DOHNMOSCAM ca: ssseaucpesss anaes THZOTO isiiuaNenWissesescessatecacesaeenates sssseeees| 1883, Mar. 24 
Smiley, Charles Wesley.......:.....ses+ U. S. Fish Commission, “1443 Mass. 1882, Oct. 7 
Ave. 943 Mass. Ave. 
SMU A VIG weceeesacveepewssveeuevecsceesbuae 1350) CONCOPAWIS tionc-scessnecesnsnsasavecarmeeres 1876, Dee. 2 
SMibN, MGW). .steeccstuecvsecedddvecuarts cos Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 1880, Oct. 23 


2024 Hillyer Place. 
Library of Congress. 
Ne Wis 


Spofford, Ainsworth Rand............... 1621 Mass. Ave. 


DaTE oF 
ADMISSION. 


....| 1871, Mar. 13 


1871, Mar. 
1871, Mar. 


13 


1872, Jan. 


LIST OF MEMBERS. 


XXI 


2 ki : Date or 
NAME. P. O. ApprEess AND RESIDENCE. AD Mie erOK 
Btearns, JOD (@)ic.cccadececcacasncaret sscuse Boston, Mass... scvesesaccconsee| L974, Mar. 28 
Stearns, Robert Edwards Carter...... a ean Institution. “1296 Mass. | 1884, Novy. -22 
ve 
Stone, Ormond (@).........-seceeseseeecees Leander McCormick Observatory, | 1874, Mar. 28 
University of Virginia. 
Taylor, Frederick William (q)......... Smithsonian Institution. Lake Val- | 1881, Feb. 19 
‘ley, New Mex. 
Tayior, WILLIAM BoWER.......... Seuees Smithsonian Inst. 306 C St. N. W...... 1871, Mar. 13 
Thompson, Almon Harris ...... Me OOLOPICAL SUL MOY Ici ccstssaces scuers ccessenceens 1875, Apr. 10 
Thompson, Gilbert... eseceserseees.| GEOlogieal Sh 1448 Q St. N. W... 1884, Feb. 16 
Tilden, William Calvin (a). aalsae ...| New York City.... eeeee| 1871, Apr. 29 
Todd, David Peck (q)....... .| Lawrence Observ., “Amherst, “Mass... 1878, Nov. 23 
Toner, Joseph Meredith 5 -| 1873, June 7 
True, Frederick William.. ‘ 1882, Oct. 7 
Twining, WVU sat ir (G) Aivccceasvecesccese . 1878, Nov. 23 
Upton, Jacob Kendrick (7)... 3 1878, Feb. 2 
Upton, William Wirt............ssseeees 2d_Comptrolle:’s Office, Treasury | 1882, Mar. 25 
Dept. 1746 M St. N. W. 
Upton, Winslow (@).........sccccesereeerees Brown University, Providence, R. I...} 1880, Dec. 4 
IE Va CMTECON Ti) acennhcsselavasessecianaretrel| oserccseusddasena <nccetearcnsvche vee voesrsesacncsen swcuees 1875, June 5 
Walcott, Charles Doolittle Geological Survey, Nat. Museum........ 1883, Oct. 13 
Waldo, Frank (q).. Army $ Signal Office. Ft. Myer, Va..... 1881, Dee. 3 
Walker, Francis Amasa (a)... Pesdueahaupees se Inst. of Technology, Boston, | 1872, Jan. 27 
ass. 
Walling, Henry Francis es ...| Geological Survey, Cambridge, Mass..| 1883, Feb. 24 
Ward, Lester Frank... Seay aetna Geological Survey. 1464 R. I. Ave. | 1876, Nov. 18 
Webster, Albert Lowry (@)..........000 ee Brighton, Staten Island, | 1882, Mar. 25 
Welling, James Clarke.............. 0000. 1302 Connecticut Ave...........:.scessssscoes 1872, Nov. 16 
Wheeler, George M. (@).......000+ ..| Engineer Bureau, War Department...| 1873, June 7 
WHEELER, JUNIUS B. (@) .......00. WAM OUT SIN GIG sce tae, dessus racstcveraamentcecseees 1871, Mar. 13 
White, Charles Abiathar.......... ...| Geological Survey. Le Droit Park.....! 1876, Dee. 16 
White, Charles Henry.......... By LTA Gp She UN WN scehce catsuceaseatitocescsstusccs: 1884, Mar. 1 
White, Zebulon Lewis (a)... ...| Providence, Rhode Island.................. 1880, Junelgy 
Williams, PNUDOME UE spareessonests)icswescexe Cee Survey. 23 Lafayette | 1883, Feb. 24 
quare 
Wilson, Allen D. () Be stnvceswaceee| eccneacnacssdtveva vera: sadtas cons sWactmerdetessaree tcc tins 1874, Apr. 0 
Wilson, James Ormond......... cee seeeee ere ees eee 1439 Mass. | 1873, Mar. 
Ave. i : 
Winlock, William Crawford............ Naval Observatory. 723 20th St. N.W.| 1880, Dec. 4 
Molcoit- Christopher Columbus (7x) coc. cccsscdcccssteccsevescecsusesenes seascescescseacerse 1875, Feb. 27 
Wood, Joseph ) ieap pcecte ence serk eueeeeeted Supt. Motive Power, Penn. Co., Fort | 1875, Jan. 16 
Wayne, Ind. 3 
Wood, William Maxwell (@) ........... Navy /DepantmMent..cic.ccs.cossassevecesonseees 1871, Dec. 2 
Woodruff, Thomas Maher............... ae. Signal Office. 2020 Hillyer | 1884, Apr. 12 
ace. 
Woopwakp, JosepH JANVIER (d)......... 1871, Mar. 13 
Woodward, Robert Simpson............ | 1883, Nov. 24 
Woodworth, John Maynard (d) 1874, Jan. 31 
Ryauerr UNTO TG B Galh(A) cia sectesbcrawscsbees|iscanovdoseewececameasatvaces 1871, Apr. 29 
Yarrow, Harry Crécy....... Pee eevee MO LAME MLE USING IV) ssecunschcud cot cedseeseteicekeesd 1874, Jan. 31 
Yeates, William Smith.............0..0.. abhseutan Institution. 401 G St. | 1884, Apr. 29 
Mim Proc. “ATION ...tstncatervecescdeecutes Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. | 1875, Jan. 30 
455 C St. N. W. 
Number of founders........-.-+--. 
members deceased . 
° ce absent.. 
oi S resigned ... ae 
ss + QUEL Citses-cascseveberacine eaceava 


Total mumber CHrOWEA i. ..cccccsezecccess 292 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


XXII 


[dy 


82 ‘FI 62 ‘GT ‘I 81 ‘Ff 
08 ‘91 *e |) 9L.% 61 “¢ 
1e ‘LIL ‘€ Lee 02 ‘9 
SL ‘F Bl ‘F 13 ‘L 
92 ‘ZI 13 ‘ST 0€ ‘OL ‘Z 
82 ‘FL 82 ‘FL 18 ‘LI 
62 ‘ST ‘T Ce) hat 81 ‘F 
0g ‘9L ‘3 | OL % 61 ‘¢ 


9% ‘ZI 9% “SL 63 ‘ST 

1B ‘EL 1 ‘EL 0 ‘OL % 
63 ‘FL 82 ‘FI Leelee 
“oI “Aleniqey | ‘Arvnuve 


LOGL 
“9061 
tt seseeeeecesnaneessassee eee QT 


“FO6L 
S061 
+ Z06T 


“O06T 
“6681 


se OQT 
sresteaes eee sreeet essen eens QO 


*SIvo A 


‘Iaquisseq |'10queAoN 


‘poysttqnd pasapio pur ‘bggr ‘Z ounf aaywwo0 [eiaua5 oy) 0} payruiqns 


“LLOITTY ° 


qd ‘A ‘UN Ad Gauvaaug 


ZI stteeeeeeceeensaeneesananes pQGT 


12 ‘ST “0061 
83 FL eee **°°°°E68T 
63 ‘ST : eee 868L 
8% 'G ses tuseaneneeeneessoseseess pRB T 
iid ‘OL nes een pep se apnea meaeen eA ORG Th 
9% ‘SL ; “COST 
13 SOT eenee eeeeee “PRL 
83 SL apashezeNnshice.derserexc ete n ey 
6% ‘CL RapeseRaes sinha Recrrenexs eon 


sieteeeees QEOT 


“6881 
“S881 

6% ‘ST cesses euesuessensesenaenes) QT 

€Z 6 «ee - 

¥6 ‘OL : 

G3 ‘IL ees 

“1840300 *sIRd 


‘anasnjour ‘go —Lobs 07 Spt gy1 worl ,, suosvas ,, posanas ay Surinp sSuyeapy Surpjoy 4of SA VQNOLVS wvusayy ayy SUmMLoys 
‘ALHIOOS ‘IVOIHdOSOTIHd AHL JO ASN AHL WOA UVANATVO 


SECRETARIES’ REPORT. XXIII 


( 


ANNUAL REPORT OF THE SECRETARIES. 


WasuHineton City, December 20, 1884. 
To the Philosophical Society of Washington : 


_ We have the honor to present the following statistical data | 
for 1884. 


At the beginning of the year the number of active members 
was : : : - : ‘ : : : pe hod 
This number has been increased by the addition of 35 new 
members and by the return of 5 absent members. It has 
been diminished by the departure of 13 members and by 
the death of 5. There have been no resignations. The 


net increase of active members has thus been 22 
And the active membership is now : ; : Te ema W 65) 
The roll of new members is: 
W.S. BarnarD. WILLIAM LAWRENCE. 
T. H. BEAN. J. A. MAHER. 
H. W. Buarr. J. B. Marcovu. 
C. O. BoUTELLE. WASHINGTON MATTHEWS. 
F. T. Bow.ugs. G. P. MERRILL. 
S. J. Brown. JoHN Murpocu. 
G. E. Curtis. Basti Norris. 
F. P. DEwery. | H. G. O@pEN. 
Je. DIGEER. 12s Eel yay 
R. E. Ear. W. M. PoInDEXTER. 
WILLIAM EIMBECK, EUGENE RICKSECKER. 
AsaPH HALL, Jr. THOMAS ROBINSON. 
J. M. Greqory. : R. E. C. STEARNS. 
DS Rev eirAP: GILBERT THOMPSON. 
Romyn Hitcucock. C. H. WHITE. 
W. D. JoHnson. T. M. WoopRvurFF. 
S. H. KaAuFFMANN. W.S. YEATES. 
M. B. Kerr. 
The names of deceased members are: 
BENJAMIN ALVORD. O. E. Bascock. H. W. Buiarr- 
CHARLES EWING. J. J. WOODWARD. 


There have been 15 general meetings for the presentation and 
discussion of papers (not including the public meeting of Dec. 6); 
the average attendance has been 42. There have been six meetings 
of the Mathematical Section ; average attendance 15. 

In the general meeting 32 communications have been presented ; 
in the mathematical section 11. Altogether 43 communications 
have been made by 32 members and one guest. The number of 
members who have participated in the discussions is 38. The total 
number who have contributed to the scientific proceedings is 50, or ° 
29 per cent. of the present active membership. 

Very Respectfully, G. K. GinBert, 
H. Farquuar, 
Seerctaries. 


XXIV PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ANNUAL REPORT OF THE TREASURER. 
Wasuineton Crry, December 31, 1884. 
To the Philosophical Society of Washington : 
_ Ihave the honor to present herewith my annual statement as 
Treasurer for the year ending December 20th, 1884. 

The revenue of the Society has amounted to $855.00 and the ex- 
penditures have been $671.96, leaving a balance of $183.04 on hand ; 
the details of this account are given in the accompanying table. 

The investments of the funds of the Society have not changed 
and consist, therefore, of $1,000 in a U.S. Bond at 43 per cent. 
and $1,500 in U.S. Bonds at 4 per cent. 

The receipts during the past year wits be classified as follows : 


Interest on invested fund : ‘ ; - . $95 
5 Dues for 1882 : : ; $25 
EG eee 1883, 5 ; ; 80 
196: “43 See: 4 630 
5): 2 10 
149 745 
The dues remaining unpaid are about as follows: 
For 1882, : 2 $15 
* 1883, 10 2 : : : 50 
: 1884, 7 ae f : : 235 
60 300 


Early in February 500 copies of Volume VI of the Bulletin were 
received from the printer, and 148 copies have been distributed to 
active members, also 67 copies have been sent to domestic and 75 
to foreign recipients ; occasional copies of other volumes have also 
been sent to complete broken sets. The stock of publications now 
on hand is about as follows: 


Bulletin, Volume L , : Zé . 91 copies. 
1 Re ; : 1 | Re 
= fa ack . i oo a het eaae 
. ee S's ; : ; 3s RE les 
tk Ni - ; , (AUN ae 
cc 6s VI. 915 5 “ce 
W. B. Taylor, Memoir of Joseph Henry, ist Ed. . 64 copies. 
2d Kid. . 303% 
aa, Welling, Address on life of Joseph as ae 
W. B. Taylor, Address as President «(Ota 


In return for the distribution of Bulletins 4 Society has re- 
ceived about seventy-five publications from other organizations or 
individuals and the Accessions Catalogue of the Library now 
includes 177 titles. 

Very respectfully your obedient servant, 
CLEVELAND ABBR, Treasurer. 


XXV 


GPE Slee |ea tates Sa et oe os tig oe [80 
1G @L ~-T--==-—-!--= egey “oaq Jo YJVIp-19A0 ssary 
Cet. 
00 G6 
00 0g _,b #8 009 T 
00 StS ip 3 000" 1% JO 3s010}UT 
tS = z Ainaqa 7, poytsodep 
‘Suruid Teroads roy quourdkedory 
Bi 00 sg “"-“"F88I ‘0S toqueooqgd puvy ul ysup 
fa 00 OTL 
2 Se 
x 00 06 “~ 5) ‘QTL, Qut,ooq ” ” 
oa 00 &6 “—— » ‘T ysnsny ” ” 
n 00 ¢ ee ee | Somame 4 (IW i ” ” 
73 00 02 a ej Oateeeeme)118 ” ” 
a 00 OOL SS pts [udy ” ” 
5 OOS S| aes 6 4” 9 
R 00 ¢FzS |-“F881 ‘GZ Auenaqe,, peytsodep pur 
a : poAlooal sonp [enuuy 
2 (“mo709 ‘Tq'e1& 9fnup-aa0 aa) 
a Waar emmnnn|~om--m=——-|-09 ‘Te ‘Q0q] ULOL} IAAO POLLIvO 9OUV[e 
: SALOTIOF sv sydieoor Aq 4IperoO 
‘[BqOI, ‘yunouly “OO.INOS IBY A WLOLT 


*‘SLAIMODY 


6h 182 
FO S8T 
GF 869 
89 OL 
00 1 
09 18 
0g 

Gt LI 
18-9 
10 61F 
00 OL 
GL 0Z 
GG 68 
88 8 
06 Lz$ 
“‘qunoUuly 


“"7> >=" purty wo souvleg 
ee ae eo [POL 


--£,o0g sv ‘dxo ‘y10qi19 “yO 
-----==-goq1uel ‘eT Mey “A “VW 
"7 stojuprd ‘roTOaNjoqy 3 x» ppue 
“--- “quopIselg “SUITIO AA ‘OL 
Soe 9 ‘reqnbaey “EL 


~-L0ag sv -dxo “touTLD “WO 
10 IF ” v8 
00 8% ” ” 
00 OST 


00 d0cg'std ‘oproagogy p ppar 
ASST itoyiuvl ‘te_MBy “AW 
‘svar, sv ‘dxo ‘eqqy puvpeas[p 
Za ‘TopTOMIOCT 9 ppne 


” ‘W94TL) “SE “OD 
rN 209 sv sosuodxo ‘aeqnbaey “A 


‘pred uoya og, 


“SHUN LIGNAIXY 


=p | 


ano | ra NI od HID DO OO AS CO) 2 Selig 


jo) 
S) 
a) 
iS 


AV 


"AQ “F88L ‘0% 29g Sumpua unali ay2 vol ‘waunsnany, ‘aqqy punjaaayy yzun zunovon ua Uopburysnyy fo hgavoog yoorydosojnyd a4J, 


"ud 


"Pe ' 
7 it \ 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON, 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. 


XXVII 


fei M Fe es 


Mv 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT, 
JAMES C. WELLING. 
Delivered December 6, 1884. 


THE ATOMIC PHILOSOPHY, PHYSICAL AND META- 
_ PHYSICAL. 


Every nation under the sun has a philosophy of some kind, but 
the philosophy we profess draws the lines of its historic traditions, 
if not its “increasing purpose,” from the home of our Aryan an- 
cestors in Greece. It was here that the typical forms of our litera- 
ture were invented, that the art of sculpture was carried to its 
climax, and that the architecture of the lintel came to a transfigu- 
ration in the Theseum and the Parthenon. And as if all these 
glories were not enough, it is the further good fortune of the 
Greeks to have at least opened up the great leading problems of 
human enquiry, in physics, in psychology, and in ethics; and to 
have so opened them up at the starting point of the world’s Torch- 
race, that the light shed on these questions more than twenty-five 
centuries ago is still a matter of curious retrospection to this 
generation of ours on whom the ends of the world are come. 

It is to one of the oldest of the formal physical philosophies ever 
framed by the mind of man for the explanation of the mechanical 
structure of the Universe that I purpose to call your attention to- 
night—a theory the most comprehensive in its scope, and, at the 
same time, the most searching in its subtility, which has been 
handed down to us by all antiquity—a theory which in its ingenuity 
represents the synthetic power of the Greek mind at the highest stage 
of its physical speculation—a theory which the literature of Rome 
has preserved in the amber of Cicero’s philosophical disquisition, 
and embalmed in the immortal verse of Lucretius—a theory, in fine, 
which has survived the old dialectic in which it was first conceived, 
because it has come to a new birth in the forms of modern science. 
I refer to what is known in history as the Atomic Philosophy of the 


Greeks. 
p.@.G 0. ¢ 


XXX PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The fundamental principle of the ancient physical philosophy— 
its point of departure and its ever re-entering point of return—is 
found in the famous well-worn maxim of metaphysics, that out of 
nothing nothing comes, and that what 7s can never be annihilated. 
It was in the name of this maxim and under the shadow of its 
authority that the Greek physical philosophers sought to shelter 
their whole right of free enquiry from the charge of impiety, and 
if to us the dictum seems the merest truism, it was not so regarded 
at the dawn of natural philosophy. Sometimes used as a logical 
club with which to brain a stolid and incurious indifferentism, and 
sometimes waved as a red flag in the face of polytheistic supersti- 
tion, it meets us perpetually in all the oldest records of ancient 
philosophical speculation—in the formal elaborations of Aristotle,* 
in the lucubrations of Boéthius,} and in the verse of poets as remote 
from each other in style and creed as Lucretius, the lively Epicu- 
rean,{ and Persius, the sternest of Stoic moralists.§ This maxim 
stirred the philosophical mind of antiquity to its lowest depth, 
because it was then the type and symbol of a whole method of phi- 
losophizing—a method regarded by many as not a little presump- 
tuous, much as the Copernican theory of the Universe was regarded 
in the sixteenth century, or much as the Formula of Evolution is 
regarded to-day outside of scientific circles. 

It was because the maxim seemed to so many the challenge of a 
vain wisdom and of a false philosophy that the early champions of 
physical philosophy sometimes felt themselves called to vindicate 
the truth of this truism by an appeal to formal argument. The 
necessity for such an appeal measures the scientific ineptitude of 
the average mind at that early age. ‘“ If what emerges into sensible 
perception,” argues Epicurus with the utmost gravity, “can be con- 
ceived as coming from nothing, then everything might come of any- 
thing, and that, too, without any need of germs; and if what dis- 
appears from sensible perception was really destroyed into nothing, 
then all things might perish without anything being left into which 


* Aristotle: De Generatione et Corruptione, I, iii, 5, (Didot’s ed., vol. 2, 
p: 437.) 

+ Boéthius: De Consolatione Philosophie, Lib. V, Prosa 1. 

} Lucretius: De Rerum Natura, I, 161-227. 


2 Persius: Sativa, iii, 84. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XXXI 


sk 


they were resolved.” * Such was the rude flint-flake with which, 
as their only weapon of logic, the early Nimrods of philosophy in 
Greece defended their right to philosophize in the paleolithic stage 
of natural enquiry. 

As the next step in this metaphysical logic we find a distinction 
drawn by the ancient Greek philosophers between things as they 
are in substrate and things as they appear, disappear, and reappear 
in time—between the noumenal and the phenomenal world, as we 
would say to-day in the Kantian phraseology. It was the favorite 
doctrine of the Eleatic school of philosophers that we get a true 
conception of things only when, abstracting from their individ- 
uality, their partitiveness and their changing forms, we find the 
ultimate root and unity of all being in a simple, indivisible, and 
unchangeable substrate, which is the true object of knowledge, be- 
cause it is the true basis of all reality. This concept increased in 
clearness as it passed through the minds of Xenophanes, Parmeni- 
des, and Empedocles, until, in the generalizations of the last-named 
philosopher, the ultimate substrate of things was resolved into four 
elementary substances—earth, air, fire, and water; each uncreated 
and imperishable, each equal in quantity, each composed, within 
itself, of parts that are qualitatively the same, and each forever in- 
commutable with the others; yet each and all capable of every 
variety and degree of mixture in the manifold combinations of 
things as they appear in the sensible world. 

On the other hand, it was held by Heraclitus that this funda- 
mental substrate or unity of things is a mere figment of the phil- 
osophical imagination, and that it is only as things are conceived 
to be in perpetual flux that the forms of our knowledge can be 
brought into correspondence with the forms of actual being. That 
is, to the doctrine of the unchanging substrate of things Heraclitus 
opposed the doctrine of the perpetual flux of things. 

It remained to effect a synthesis and reconciliation between these 
opposing views of the Eleatic and Heraclitic philosophies of nature, 
while at the same time saving the fundamental dogma of all natural 
philosophizing, that out of nothing nothing comes. Such a basis of 
pacification was found in the terms of the Atomic Philosophy, in the 
doctrine that the changing forms, positions, motions, and phases of 


* Diog. Laért.: Lives of the Philosophers, swb voce ‘‘ Epicurus.”’ 


XXXIT PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


things are to be conceived as a perpetual flux, resulting from the 
changing permutations and combinations of the indestructible atoms 
composing the eternal substrate of nature. And ‘thus it was that 
the doctrine of ultimate atoms, incessantly modified in the forms of 
their combination, but remaining forever the same in substance, 
became the legitimate deduction and the crowning corollary of the 
primal eldest maxim of physical philosophy. Aristotle expressly 
gives this genesis of the Atomic Philosophy of Greece in its reduc- 
tion by Anaxagoras. After saying that Anaxagoras hypothesized 
an infinity of atoms, to explain the myriad varieties of nature, be- 
cause he wished to avoid the reproach of getting something out of 
nothing, Aristotle adds: “ From the fact that contraries are made out 
of each other, they must needs have previously existed in each other ; 
for if everything that becomes must needs come either from some- 
thing or from nothing, and if this latter alternative is impossible, 
(about which all who treat of nature are agreed in opinion,) then 
it only remains to infer that everything which becomes must have 
come from the things in which it pre-existed, though, on account of 
the smallness of their bulks, made out of things imperceptible to 
us.” * 

The Atomic Philosophy of the Greeks was, therefore, not a mere 
exhalation of the imagination, but a logical inference from the 
starting point and major premise of their natural metaphysics. The 
doctrine of ultimate atoms in nature was, indeed, the necessary com- 
plement and reconciliation of the conception that all things are in 
elemental stir, and that yet in this elemental stir there is no crea- 
tion of anything out of nothing and no annihilation of anything, 
but only composition, decomposition, and recomposition. 

It need not surprise us, therefore, to find that the doctrine of 
ultimate atoms in nature is a universal- form of thought among 
thinking men of all the most advanced races in antiquity. Into 
the hidden historic springs of the Atomic Philosophy, as formu- 
lated by the Greeks, it is not here proposed to enquire. Whether its 


* Aristotle: Naturalis Auscultatio, I, iv, 2, (Didot’s ed., vol. 2, p. 252.) 
Compare, also, Lucretius, De Rer. Nat., I, 543-545: 
—— ‘ Quoniam supra docui nil posse creari 


‘De nilo, neque quod genitum est ad nil revocari, 
Esse immortali primordia corpore debent.”’ = 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XXXIII 


germs were derived from Egypt, or from India, or from Pheenicia, 
or whether it was an original birth of the Hellenic mind, is a mat- 
ter of curious historic interest which hardly admits, perhaps, of 
precise and positive determination, though certain it is that India 
had an Atomic Philosophy before the Greeks. However possible or 
probable it may be that the early Greek philosophers borrowed 
some of their lore under this head, as we know they did under 
others, from the Egyptian priests; or whatever truth there may be 
in the tradition, reported by Posidonius,* (Cicero’s teacher in phi- 
losophy,) that one Moschus, a Phcenician, imparted the doctrine to 
Pythagoras, it is very certain that the Greek philosophers have 
made the doctrine their own by the logical development they gave 
to it, and by the hereditament in it which they have bequeathed to © 
the subsequent generations of men moving along the lines of human 
progress. It has been more than suspected that the doctrine dates 
in Greece from the age of Pythagoras, by reason of certain spe- 
cific ideas, which we can read in the spectrum analysis of the most 
distant times by the light of modern anthropological science. Cer- 
tain definite lines of thought are to be found in the psychology of 
every epoch, and these lines betray the mental constitution of the 
epoch as surely as the vapors of the elements absorb rays of the 
same refrangibilities that they radiate. In the days of Pythago- 
ras we discover certain psychical ideas which are seen to have 
been the natural reflex of the great fundamental dogma out of 
which the Atomic Philosophy sprang. I refer to the doctrine of 
metempsychosis and of its correlate, the pre-existence of souls. 
If it be assumed that the human soul is something generically 
different from the body, and is not generated by it, then it necessa- 
rily follows, according to the maxim De nihilo nihil fit, that the 
- soul pre-existed somewhere before the atoms of the body were put 
together, and from the other branch of the maxim, that it must 
continue to exist somewhere after the body is dissolved. The doc- 
trine of the transmigration of souls is not, therefore, a mere vagary 
of the ethnical imagination, but the natural offspring of that form 
of Pythagorean dualism which distinguished the soul, as not only 
generically, but genetically distinct from the body. Hence, the 


*Strabo: Geog., Lib. xv1. Cf. Sextus Empiricus: Adversus Mathematicos, 
Lib. 9, 
17 


XXXIV PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


doctrine reappears under one form or another in every dualistic 
conception of matter and mind—now in the purple light of Plato’s 
imperial fancy, and now in the pallid shades of that metaphysical 
theology which, in the days of Origen and St. Augustine, arrayed 
the doctors of the Church into opposing schools on the great ques- 
tion of Traducianism or Creationism. 

In whatever way the Atomic Philosophy was begotten in’ the 
Greek mind, we know that on its emergence it was subjected to 
the solvents of philosophical criticism, and underwent a variety 
of transformations. So soon as we come within the lines of 
definite history we find a bifurcation of ideas between such typical 
teachers as Anaxagoras on the one hand, and Leucippus and 
Democritus on the other. This dissidence of opinions had regard 
to the nature and the constitution of the ultimate atoms which 
compose the substance of matter. The doctrine of Anaxagoras 
was qualitative; the doctrine of Democritus was quantitative. 
Anaxagoras held that the atoms which compose the physical Uni- 
verse in its fleeting forms, and at the same time in its enduring 
substance, are eternally differentiated in kinds, and that it was by 
the collocation and adhesion of like parts—of bony atoms to make 
bone, of fleshy atoms to make flesh, of stony atoms to make stones 
—that the actual varieties of body in the Universe were built up. 
This is the famous doctrine of Homeomeria which fares so ill in 
the spiritual philosophy of Plato, and which fares no better in the 
materialistic philosophy of Lucretius. Aristotle tells us that 
Anaxagoras was driven to adopt this hypothesis in order to relieve 
the doctrine of atoms at the points where the heaviest stress and 
tightest pinch seemed to be laid upon it by the dogma De nthilo 
nihil fit; for how else, said Anaxagoras, could we account for the 
existing varieties of matter unless there be an original and eternal 
variety in its constituent elements? 

Democritus simplified the theory of atoms by giving to it a purely 
mechanical reduction. Conceiving atoms to be invisible by reason 
of their smallness, he at the same time conceived them to be indi- 
visible, not as mathematically considered, but as physically consid- 
ered; and while holding them to be infinite in number and infinite 
in their-shapes, he at the same time held that they differed not at 
all in inherent quality, but simply in their shapes, sizes,,situations, 
and motions, and that hence it was by the different combination of 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XXXV 


atoms differing in these mechanical aspects that all the varieties of 
bodies and souls were integrated, disintegrated, and reintegrated. * 
The different impressions produced on the human senses by differ- 
ent bodies, according to their various mechanical constitutions, 
were regarded by him as purely subjective—the mechanical results 
of different concussions made on the senses by the different effluxes 
of things,t and, therefore, no more requiring any qualitative differ- 
ences to explain the phenomena of sensation than to explain the 
phenomena of being. Weight and hardness were treated by De- 
mocritus as primary qualities of bodies resulting from the greater 
or less degrees in which their constituent atoms are compacted, as 
compared with the interstitial voids or vacua. The secondary 
qualities of bodies are simply the impressions they make on the 
human senses, depending, as has just been said, on the varying 
shapes, sizes, and arrangements of the atoms composing all the 
varieties of material substance. 

Anaxagoras had made his theory of atoms a pendant to dualism, 
conceiving, as he did, that souls, both animal and rational, are eter- 
nally pre-existent before the birth, and post-existent after the disso- 
lution, of the bodies in which they temporarily resided. { Democ- 
ritus made the animal soul and the rational soul only two more dis- 
tinct varieties in the mechanical collocation of atoms varying in 
shape, size, situation, and motion; and, therefore, he had no place 
in his theory for the transmigration of souls considered as entities 
distinct from bodies. Souls and bodies were equally the results of 
a concourse of atoms obeying in their movements the law of a me- 
chanical necessity. That is, to the dualism which preceded him 
Democritus opposed a pure and simple monism. Yet between the 
materialism of Democritus and the dualism of Anaxagoras there is 
not much to choose; for the misty spiritualism of the latter did not 

* Aristotle: De Generat. et Corrup., I, i, 4, (Didot’s ed., vol. 2, p. 482;) 
also Arist.: Metaphysics, VII, ii, 2, (Didot’s ed., vol. 2, p. 559,) and the 
Nat. Auscul., I, v, 1, (Didot’s ed., vol. 2, p. 254.) 


t Action from a distance, as of the magnet on iron, was also explained by 
Democritus on the hypothesis of ‘‘effluxes.”” Zeller: Philosophieder Griechen, 
Erster Theil, p. 704. 


{ Cudworth: Intellectual System of the Universe, vol. I, chap. 1, (Andover 
ed,) p. 95. : 


XXXVI PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


carry with it any clear conception of personal identity, and hence 
Lucretius justly argued that the doctrine of a future life, as held 
by many in his day, was stripped of all significance if the chain of 
personal consciousness is broken at death.* 

And to this fundamental antithesis of ideas lying at the bottom 
of these two forms of the Greek Atomic Philosophy another anti- 
thesis must be added in the Stratonical Hylozoism, which, assuming 
in matter an atomic structure partly material and partly vital, pro- 
ceeded to account for the genesis of animated bodies on the super- 
added assumption of a plastic energy working in nature to the pro- 
duction of every living thing. In a word, Strato’s matter, instinct 
with life, and waiting only for the first chance to be stuck together 
in the composition of plants and animals, seems to have been the 
metaphysical anticipation of our modern protoplasm.f ? 

It was in opposition alike to the physics of Anaxagoras, Democ- 
ritus, and Strato, that Plato reared his splendid fabric of idealism, 
while Aristotle, for his part, rejected the philosophy of atoms alto- 
gether, and installed in its place for centuries the doctrine of Form 
and Quality, and Substance and Entelechy, whatever that may mean. 
“Tf,” he says, “there be no other substance beyond the substances 
existing in nature, then Physics is the first science; but if there be 
a certain substance which is immoyable, then this is before body, 
and Philosophy is the first science.” | That single sentence re- 
capitulates the whole verbal philosophy of the Middle Ages. Plato 
was so hostile to the hypothesis of Democritus that he never once 
names that philosopher in all his writings, though it is the Abderite 
physicist to whom he intends a disparaging allusion when in the 
Timeus he impales on the shafts of his irony “a certain philosopher 
of an indefinite and ignorant mind.” Aristotle names him often 
enough, either separately or in conjunction with Leucippus, and 
treats the Atomic Philosophy with respect as an ‘invention framed 
to explain the transformation and birth of things—explaining birth 
and dissolution by the decomposition and recomposition of atoms, 


* Lucret.: De Rerum Natura, Lib. iii, 851. 


+ Cicero aptly defines the antithesis of ideas between Democritus and 
Strato. Sce Academ. Prior., Lib. II, xxxviii, 121. Also, De Nat. Deor., 
Lib. I, xiii, 35. 


{ Arist.: Bet, Lipe'V 1; 0% ef. Dib.) X, ‘vil, 9: 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XXXVII 


and explaining transformations by the arrangement and position 
of atoms.” * . 

But it is in the physical philosophy of Epicurus, as that philo- 
sophy has been expounded and expanded by Lucretius, that we can 
discover the fullest and clearest exposition of the doctrine of atoms, 
considered as a key to the structure of the Universe. We here have 
the doctrine formulated into a theodicy of naturism, a theory of 
psychology, a cosmogony, and an anthropology. According to 
Epicurus, in his Lucretian rendering, atoms are minute material 
particles, indivisible, not by reason of their smallness, but of their 
solidity which makes them indestructible and unchangeable in their 
constitution ; they have size, weight, and shape, yet are forever in- 
visible to the eye; in shape, some of the atoms are different from 
the others, but, while the number of the different shapes is finite, 
the number of atoms of each shape is infinite; every atom must 
have at least three cacumina (yovias), that is, infinitesimally small 
bounding points which are incapable of existing apart from the 
atom, but must be conceived to coexist with it in order to give 
definition to it and to enclose its “solid singleness;” some of the 
atoms are hook-shaped, some only slightly jagged, some smooth, 
&c.; atoms are in incessant motion, racing through space in all 
directions under the stress of their weight, according to the fa- 
voring conditions of a vacuum more or less complete, yet so that 
the sum of their motions results in the supreme repose of gross 
matter, except when a thing exhibits the motion of translation in 
space—a form of motion which is molar and not atomic; atoms 
move besides at an enormous uniform speed, in parallel lines, up 
and down, so far as there can be any up and down in a universe 
equally boundless in all directions, and except so far as some of the 
atoms have originally a shape which makes them capable of slight 
deflections from parallel straight lines—that elinamen principiorum 
which was invented by Epicurus to explain the phenomena of so- 


* Arist.: De Generat. et Corrup., I, ii, 4 (Didot’s ed., vol. 2, p. 484.) 


t Epicurus derived the motion of atoms from their weight, which gives 
movement i7 vacuo. Democritus derived the motion of atoms from an im- 
pulse given to them in the beginning. So says Cicero (De Fato, 20, 46), 
but for the contrary opinion, ¢f. Zeller: Philos. der Griechen, Erster Theil, 
702, 714. 


XX XVIII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


called voluntary motion in animals and free-will in men, while at 
the same time explaining how it is that this free-will is eternally 
encased in the rigid parallel lines of the other atoms. In this way 
Epicurus supposed himself to have added a useful supplementary 
hypothesis to the original hypothesis of Democritus, who binding 
nature fast in fate had not left free the human will, because he had 
omitted to provide for that third mode of motion in atoms which 
is required to explain the possibility and genesis of voluntary mo- 
tion and self determination. 

Such is a brief and imperfect exposition of the Atomic Philoso- 
phy of the Greeks—a form of physical speculation the most elabo- 
rate, the most ingenious, and, to use a Latinism of Dr. Johnson, 
the most concinnous which has come down to us from all antiquity. 
The Epicurean physics are as much superior to the Aristotelian 
and the Stoical physics as the ethics of the Lyceum and of the Porch 
are superior to the ethics of the Sty; and yet it now remains to be 
said that in all this operose system of metaphysico-physical atoms 
there is not an atom of scientific truth, in the modern sense of that 
word. The whole speculation is a mirage, caused by unequal 
refractions in the Greek intellect—by the volatility of the Greek 
fancy passing through a dense, practical ignorance with regard to 
everything but surface views in nature. Or, to borrow one of Plato’s 
favorite figures, it was a “ wind-egg,” begotten of metaphysic con- 
ceit, and differing from the other “wind-eggs” of that time in the 
greater symmetry of its shell rather than in the greater fecundation 
of its contents. It had the form, but not the power of scientific 
truth. If there be such a thing as atoms they must needs be chem- 
ical conceptions, and the very word “ chemistry” had not yet come 
into the Greek language, because the rationale of such a science 
had not even dawned on the horizon of the Greek intellect by the 
faintest reflection from below. 

Much explanation, which does not explain, has been wasted 
to account for the incapacity of the Greek mind in physical 
philosophy. The learned historian of the Inductive Sciences, 
Dr. William Whewell, ascribes this incapacity to the alleged 
fact that though this sprightly race had in their possession an 
abundance of facts, and were acute observers and critics, their 
ideas “ were not distinct and appropriate to the facts.”* It would 


* William Whewell: History of the Inductive Sciences, vol. I, p. 87. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XXXIX 


hardly be possible to frame an explanation more pointless. If there 
has ever been a hypothesis framed with more “distinct ideas” than 
that of the Greek atomists, I am not acquainted with it, and it is 
precisely because it was so “appropriate” to the surface facts of the 
Greek observation that it was so illusory. It was fitted to these 
facts with a concinnitas that is most admirable from a psychological 
point of view. It was invented to fit them, and its whole raison 
d’étre was that it did fit them, so far as ideas and words could make 
it fit. For this purpose it was revised, modified, contracted, en- 
larged, supplemented, until it seemed to fit every sinuosity of the 
facts of nature, as far as the facts of nature were open to the appre- 
hension of the Greeks in the 5th century before Christ. The hy- 
pothesis was strong just where it seems weak to Dr. Whewell, and 
it is precisely because it was so ideally strong that it was so physic- 
ally weak, and it is precisely because it fitted the facts so well that it 
was a delusion andasnare. Men rested in it with a sense of satisfac- 
tion which simulated the rest of a mind turning on the poles of truth. 
It satisfied the highest cravings of Greek physical enquiry in the 
then contemporaneous stage of mental evolution in Greece. The 
Greek mind of that age had not reached a stage of development 
which required anything more than metaphysical hypotheses for the 
explanation of physical facts, because it had not reached a stage 
of evolution which capacitated it to frame hypotheses in physics capa- 
ble of anything more than metaphysical verification. And hence 
it was in the ingenuity of a plausible hypothesis, and in the nicety 
with which it fitted the superficial facts that the subtle and artistic 
mind of the Greeks found the sole interest and zest which a physi- 
cal hypothesis had for them or could have. “Ancient logic,” says 
Prof. Jowett, “was always mistaking the truth of the form for the 
truth of the matter.”* The conscious incapacity of the Greeks 
for physical science was so great that we find the best class of minds 
among them absolutely revolting at the very idea of such a science. 
Socrates, for instance, had no patience with it. Plato represents 
him in the Phedo as at the same time deploring misology—the 
hatred of formal ideas—and yet, in almost the same breath, confess- 
ing himself a misologist in the presence of mechanical conceptions 
of nature. He liked the doctrines of Anaxagoras well enough, so 


* Jowett’s Plato, vol. I, p. 376. 


XL PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


far as they moved in mind, but he detested them, to use the words 
put in his mouth by Plato, so far as they moved in “air, and ether, 
and water, and such like inconsequences ;” * and, detesting them, he 
falls back upon a purely anthropomorphic conception of the Uni- 
verse—anthropomorphic because it is avowedly anthropocentric, 
with Socrates for its centre. The whole passage is a most instruct- 
ive page in comparative psychology, now that we can read it in 
the light of modern anthropological science. 

It is no part of my present purpose to carry the history of the 
Atomic Philosophy into Roman speculation. The Romans took all 
their ideas in mental, moral, and physical philosophy at second-hand 
from the Greeks.f Strong in the practical arts of war and polity, 
they were content to be in literature imitators and in philosophy 
eclectics. Equally inept for the deft metaphysical analysis of the 
Greeks and for their fine artistic synthesis, the Romans none the 
less contributed, on the practical side of life, to the definite exposi- 
tion of the contents of all the philosophical systems of the Greeks. 
Hence we could ill spare the ponderous banter of Cicero when he 
mocks at the weak points of the Atomic Philosophy, and still less 
could we spare that reasoned elaboration of its strong points which 
has made the De Rerum Natura of Lucretius the most systematic, 
the most complete, the most earnest, and the most realistic of all 
the reductions which the Atomic Philosophy has ever received. But 
after allowing for all his skill in the episodical handling of the rival 
systems of Heraclitus, Empedocles, and Anaxagoras, for his power 
of description, for the vivacity of his narrative, for the force and 
often the beauty of his illustrations and analogies, it must still be 
conceded that there is much more of original poetry than of original 
philosophy in these glowing hexameters of the Epicurean philoso- 
pher-poet. 


In a history of the Atomic Philosophy we can leap the chasm of 
the Middle Ages at a single bound. The physical philosophers of 


* Phedo, 347; Jowett’s Plato, vol. I, p. 427. 

{ For evidence as to the imbecility of the Roman mind in physical phi- 
losophy, see the 2nd Book of Cicero’s ‘‘ Prior Academics,’’ which is a long 
wail over the want of truth, or of tests of truth, in physical speculation. 

tDe Natura Deorum, I, 18, 54, 66, 69, 73, 120; ef. De Fate, I, x, xi, 
xx; De Finibus, I, vi--vii; Tuse. Disput. I, xi, 22; xviii, 42. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLI 


that time were not discussing the concourse of atoms, fortuitous or 
otherwise, but were carefully pondering, with Doctors Divine and 
Angclical, Subtile and Irrefragable, the difference between Ens and 
Essentia, between materia quomodolibet accepta and materia signata, 
between quidditas per se and hecceitas per se, between ultima entitas 
entis and ultima actualitas forme. As we plod our weary way 
through the Quodlibeta of these venerable doctors, we can but envy 
the angels one of the faculties ascribed to them by St. Thomas 
Aquinas—that of being able to pass from point to point without 
passing through intermediate spaces. 

Bacon,* as he stood at the threshold of the new dispensation of 
physical science, had made a plea for the forgotten philosophy of 
Democritus, but when the metaphysical philosophy of Europe came 
to a new Avatar in the brain of Descartes, we find that thinker 
denying a discrete conception of matter, and arguing for the con- 
trary conception of continuous extension, of the identification 
of extension with substance, and, hence, of the infinite divisi- 
bility of matter. He says: “It is easy to demonstrate that 
there cannot be atoms; that is, parts of bodies or of matter which 
are of an indivisible nature, as some philosophers have imagined, 
since, however small we may suppose these parts, inasmuch as they 
must needs have extension, we conceive that there is not one of 
them which cannot still be divided into two or more still smaller 
parts; whence it follows that it is divisible.” | It will here be seen 
that Descartes falls into a confusion of ideas with regard to the 
atoms of the ancient philosophers. They did not conceive that the 
atom was indivisible because of its smallness, but because of the 
indestructible solidity which made it incapable of being cut, or 
broken, or bent, and which also made it impervious to heat or hu- 
midity. { 


*See, especially, Cogitationes de Natura Rerum, and De Principiis atque 
Originibus, &e. Works, (Ellis & Spedding’s ed., London,) vol. III, pp. 15, 
82, et seq.; cf. Advancement of Learning, Book II, vii, 7, (Ellis & Sped- 
ding’s ed.,) vol. ITI, p. 358. 

} For a formal criticism on Democritus’ theory of atoms see Principes de 
la Philosophie, Cfuvres de Descartes, (Cousin,) tome III, p. 516, and cf. 
Aristotle: De Generatione et Corruptione, I, ii, 11-21, where this criticism is 
anticipated and surpassed. 

$‘‘ Corpora individua propter soliditatem,’’ Cic., De Fin., I, vi, 17; ef. 
Lucret., I, lines 532-5. 


XLII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


And this supposed conflict between the infinite divisibility of 
matter, mathematically considered, and the actual ihdivisibility of 
atoms, physically considered, is a pure logomachy resulting from 
what the lawyers would call a misjoinder of parties and a misjoinder 
of issues. The mathematician, contending for the infinite divisi- 
bility of matter, proceeds from the idea of space to a fact in nature, 
while the atomist, contending for the actual indivisibility of the 
atom, proceeds from an assumed fact in nature to the idea of space, 
- and so, as has been said, the duellists cross swords in the air over 
the head of a phantom standing between them, and never succeed 
in touching each other.* 

From this time onward, for many years, the opinions of philoso- 
phers concerning the nature or reality of atoms seem to have 
floated in a state of uncertainty between the views of the ancients 
and the views of Descartes. For instance, we find Henry More, 
the platonizing metaphysician of England, in the 17th century, 
adventuring the following dogmatic definition of matter: “I have 
taken the boldness to assert that matter consists of indiscerptible 
parts, understanding by indiscerptible parts particles that have, 
indeed, real extension, but so little that they cannot have less and 
be anything at all, and, therefore, cannot be actually divided. The 
parts that constitute an indiscerptible part are real, but divisible 
only intellectually, it being of the very essence of whatever is to 
have parts or extension in some measure or other, for, to take away 
all extension is to reduce a thing only to a mathematical point.” 

For the physical atom of Greek metaphysics, Leibnitz, itis known, 
substituted the monad or formal atom, considered as the continent 
and complex of an infinite number of essences. Leibnitz tells us 
that so soon as he had thrown off the yoke of Aristotle he plunged 
into the vacuum and atomic hurly-burly of Democritus, but that he 
could find no rest there, because he could not account for the gene- 
sis of mind in man on any mechanical theory of purely physical 
atoms. Hence the invention of the Leibnitzian Monadology and 
Pre-established Harmony—a form of metaphysical philosophizing 
which reflects the mental evolution and intellectual environment 


*See Westminster Review, vol. 59, p. 178, cf. Samuel Brown: Lectures 
on the Atomic Theory, Edinburgh, 1858. 


+ Quoted in Munro’s Lucretius, vol. 2, p. 158. 


. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLIII 


of the 17th century, as exactly as the metaphysical speculations of 
Anaxagoras and Democritus and Epicurus represent the mental 
evolution and intellectual environment of the Greeks two thousand 
years before. The atom of Leibnitz instead of being an indivisible 
and sempiternal “solid singleness”’ is a created monad, a “manu- 
factured article,” deriving its perpetuity and power from the im- 
manent and perpetual “fulgurations of Divinity.”* It is the 
curious destiny of the atomic philosophy, let me here say, in paren- 
thesis, that it has subtended three very distinct orders of meta-_ 
physic—the polytheistic metaphysic of Greece and Rome, the 
theistic metaphysic of the Renaissance period, and the scientific 
metaphysic of our own day. 

According to Leibnitz separate classes of monads have separate 
qualities. Different degrees of aggregation in monads, differing in 
kind, make the varieties of matter. The natural mutations of 
monads proceed from an intestine force which is the principle or 
change in matter. In all simple substance there is a plurality of 
relations and affections, so that a residuum of relations and affec- 
tions remains after every transfer of affections and relations in the 
production of material changes. These material changes proceed 
according to the law of continuity, for all change of the created 
monad is only the modulus of its perdurancy.| The monad is 
inconceivable, except as a creation of Divinity. When created, it 
is destructible only by the decree of Omnipotence.t Monads 
work no changes in each other’s inner constitution, and therefore 
act on each other according to a Divine Pre-established Harmony, 
which makes each monad the mirror of the Universe, and the con- 
tinuous register of all physical changes, past, present, and future. 
Hence the order of the movement and the continuity of the pro- 
cess which have resulted in the formation of the only world pos- 
sible and the best world possible. It will be seen that we are here 


*« Dieu seul est Vunité primitive ou la substance simple originaire, dont 
toutes les monades créées ou dérivatives sont des productions, et naissent, pour 
ainsi dire, par des fulgurations continuelles de la Divinité, de moment & mo- 
ment.”? (Monadologie, prin. 47). Leib. : Opera Phil., Lat. Gal. Germ. om- 
nia. Berlin, 1840, p. 708. 


} Leibnitii Principia Philosophie, More Geometrico demonstrata, p. 38. 
jt Ibid., pp. 71, 74. 


XLIV PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


far enough away from the Epicurean atoms, but we are still work- 
ing with the atoms of pure metaphysics. ° 

It is equally in accordance with the chronological order of time, 
and the logical order of scientific ideas, that we should next turn 
to Newton. And of Newton, the greatest name in all physical 
philosophy, it need only be said that in his work on Optics he re- 
turned to a conception of atoms, which, except that it proceeds on 
the assumption of a Deity and of final cause, is substantially identi- 
cal with that of Leucippus, Democritus, and Epicurus. He says: 
“All these things considered [that is, the chemical facts he had 
just recited], it seems probable to me that God in the beginning 
formed matter in solid, massy, hard, impenetrable, movable parti- 
cles, of such sizes and figures, and with such other properties and 
in such proportion to space as most conduced to the end for which 
He formed them; and that these primitive particles, being solids, 
are incomparably harder than any porous bodies compounded,of 
them, even so very hard as never to wear or break in pieces—no 
ordinary power being able to divide what God himself made one 
in the first creation.” This definition reminds us of Lucretius. 

In continuation Newton adds: “ While the particles continue 
entire they may compose bodies of one and the same nature and 
texture in all ages; but should they wear away or break in pieces, 
the nature of things depending on them would be changed. Water 
and earth composed of old worn particles would not be of the same 
nature and texture now with water and earth composed of entire 
particles in the beginning. And, therefore, that nature may be 
lasting, the changes of corporeal things are to be placed only in the 
various separations and new associations, and motions of these 
permanent particles.” 

The very form of this last-cited statement carries us back to 
the cradle of the Atomic Philosophy.* But it is not so much 
the form of Newton’s statement which excites our admiration 
as the connection of thought in which it stands. The whole of 


* Anpdzpttos 03 xar Asdutrxog momjoaytss ta oyypata, THY Adhotwow 
nar chy yéveow & tobtwy motodat, Oraxptozt yey zat ovyxplost yéveow zat 
giopdy, taZ2¢ OF zat Hose adhoiwor. Aristotle: Izy: Tsvecsws zat 


Phopas, 1, 2,4. (CDidot’s ed., vol. 2., p. 454.) 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLV 


the “3st Query,” under which this passage occurs in the book of | 
“‘Opticks,”’ is occupied with certain chemical analyses which Newton 
had made in his laboratory. Newton, we know, was an alchemist, 
and spent laborious days and nights in trying to discover the secret 
by which base metals might be rendered noble; but I can hardly 
concur with Prof. Jevons when he says that Newton’s “lofty powers 
of deductive investigation were wholly useless” in the conduct of 
these experiments.* There is some gold at the bottom of even 
his alchemical crucible. He was the first to put the conception of 
atoms in their rightful logical connection with the phenomena of 
practical chemistry. 

It would here be in order to follow Joseph Boscovich in his pro- 
found theory of the constitution of matter, if in doing so we might 
not fall into the danger of drifting too far from the atom considered 
as a minim of corporeal singleness. With him the atom is a point 
of attractive and repulsive forces rather than an ultimate physical 
element; and as it was really the atom of chemical physics which 
Democritus posited in his mind without knowing it, thus setting ap 
the altar of science to an “unknown god,” it is time that we 
should hasten towards the epoch when Chemistry came to rend the 
vail from the face of this Isis whom the Greek atomists had so long 
and so ignorantly worshipped. 

It is in the writings of the Hon. Robert Boyle, pleasantly de- 
scribed by his Irish biographer, with a somewhat Irish collocation 
of ideas, as “ Father of Chemistry and brother of the Earl of Cork,” 
that we find the period of transition, when the old order of meta- 
physical atoms is changing to give place to the new order of 
physical atoms as weighed and measured by modern chemistry. In 
his essay on “ The Intestine Motions of the Particles of Quiescent 
Bodies,” } as also in his essays on Fluidity and Firmness, he threw 
out some positive ideas on the old atomic philosophy. He sup- 
poses it to be of Phcenician derivation, and even tries to effect a 
reconciliation between that philosophy and the Cartesian notion of 
continuous substance by drawing on the maieria subtilis of the 
French philosopher (which was conceived to pass constantly, like a 


*Jevons: Principles of Science, vol. II, p. 188. 
t Opticks, Book III, Query 31. 
t Robert Boyle’s Works, vol. I, p. 444. 


XLVI PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


stream, through the pores of the solidest matter) as a very good 
analagon for the racing atoms of Epicurus. : 

It is, however, in his essay entitled an “Attempt to make chemi- 
ical experiments useful to illustrate the notions of the corpuscular 
philosophy,” * that he approaches this discussion with a bold front. 
He there says: “ The corpuscular doctrine, rejecting the substantial 
forms of the schools, and making bodies to differ but in magnitude, 
figure, motion, or rest, and situation of their component particles, 
which may be always infinitely varied, seems much more favorable 
to the chemical doctrine of the possibility of working wonderful 
changes and even transformations in mixed bodies. . . . As 
many chemical experiments may be happily explicated by the cor- 
puscularian notions, so many of the corpuscularian notions may be 
commodiously either illustrated or confirmed by chemical experi- 
ments.” + 

It will be seen at once, in the very dialect and purport of such 
language, that we have reached, even in Boyle, a turning point of 

,the whole Atomic Philosophy. His words import that we are to use 
“the corpuscularian notions” to explicate chemical experiments, 
and that, in turn, the corpuscularian notions may find a new and 
solid basis in chemical experimentation. Men have changed their 
whole Welt-Anschauung, as compared with that of the Greeks in 
the days of Epicurus, before such processes of thought and such 
instruments or methods of enquiry become possible. It is only as 
the thoughts of men are widened with the process of the suns that 
they take in, or can take in, those wider horizons and deeper vistas 
of truth which are opened to the human mind by the ascending 
hierarchies of the physical sciences. We have now passed the 
border-line which separates the metaphysico-physical atoms of Epi- 
curus from the physico-metaphysical atoms of modern chemical 
science. 

I can afford to pass over this part of my story sicco pede, for 
we shall henceforth have to deal only with the atoms required by 
the hypotheses of positive and experimental science to explain the 
actual facts and processes of nature, not as those facts and processes 
lie on the surface of things, but as extorted from the very bosom 


* Robert Boyle’s Works, vol. I, p. 354. 
f Ibid., pp. 358, 359. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLVII 


of nature by the racks and thumbscrews of physical enquiry. In- 
stead of taking our atoms as they were distilled and attenuated by 
the refining brains of an Anaxagoras, a Democritus, an Epicurus, 
or a Leibnitz, we can now take them as weighed and measured by 
the quantitative, qualitative, or volumetric analysis of modern 
chemistry, in ways that Anaxagoras or Democritus or Epicurus 
or Leibnitz never dreamed of in their philosophy. The distance 
between the 5th century before Christ and the year 1800 is meas- 
ured as well by John Dalton as by John Howard. John Dalton 
and John Howard would have each been impossible in the days 
of Democritus—the one as much so as the other. John Howard 
plunged into the reek of European prisons at the impulse of a 
Christian philanthropy unknown to the Greek, with all his love of 
the Good, the Beautiful, and the True. John Dalton plunged into 
the reek of the Lancashire marshes,” at the impulse of an abstract 
science unknown to the Greek with all his love of dialectics, of art, 
and of xsthetic culture. John Howard, to use the fine phrase of 
Burke, taught men who love mercy to “ take the gauge and dimen- 
sion” of human misery. John Dalton taught men who love truth 
in disinterested studies to take the gauge and dimension of the ele- 
ments which compose the physical Universe. Who was this John 
Dalton that stands in such typical relation with the scientific 
thought of our century? 

Given, a man “meditative and ratiocinative;” a meteorologist, 
curious in all eudiometrical research, and, therefore, perpetually 
experimenting on the constitution of mixed gases; a teacher of 
arithmetic, so given to mental numeration that on his first visit to 
London he counts all the carriages he sees while wending his way 
to the Friends’ Meeting House on a Sunday; a chemist, who took 
the diffusion and absorption of elastic fluids as his special province 
of investigation; a theorist, who never theorized without an exper- 
iment, and an experimenter who never experimented without a 
theory, and you have John Dalton, the father and founder = the 
Modern Atomic Philosophy. 

As early as the year 1802, in some experimental combinations of 
oxygen with nitrous gas, Dalton discovered that “the elements of 
oxygen combined with a certain portion of nitrous gas, or with 
twice that portion, but with no intermediate quantity.” Though he 


9 


* He obtained his inflammable gas from these marshes. 


XLVIITI PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


called attention at the time to “the theory of the process,” he does 
not seem to have apprehended the generality of the principle of 
definite and multiple proportions till a few years later, when the 
doctrine dawned on him in the course of some investigations into 
the constitution of olefiant gas and carburetted hydrogen gas.* 

Richter, before him, had ascertained the quantity of any base 
required to saturate one hundred measures of sulphuric acid, and 
had formed a table exhibiting the proportions of the acids and 
alkaline bases constituting neutral] salts, but Dalton took this table 
and translated it into the relative weights of the ultimate atoms 
composing these saline compounds. 

The doctrine of atomic weights had thus already become a work- 
ing hypothesis in chemistry, no longer an idle speculation, and we 
soon find Berzelius writing to Dalton that “multiple proportions 
are a mystery without it.” { 

From this time onward the history of chemistry has been studded 
with fresh confirmations of the new atomic logic, while ever and 
anon prophetic glints of truth, implicit in every true physical 
hypothesis, have leaped into the light of ocular demonstration 
with each advancing stage in chemical science. Time would fail 
to tell the beads of the atomic rosary. The doctrine of fixed, 
multiple, and volumetric combinations, as formulated by Avo- 
gadro in 1813;§ the determination of the proportions in which 
bodies combine according to the number and disposition respect- 
ively of their molecules, as announced by Ampére in 1814, with 
special reference to the clear-cut distinction between molecules 
and their integrant atoms, (already presaged before Ampére by 
Laurent and Gerhardt;) || the relation between the atomic weights 
of bodies and their specific heats, conjectured by Dalton and estab- 
lished by Dulong and Petit in 1819;9] the law of isomorphism, an- 
nounced by Mitscherlich at the close of the same year, from which 
it appeared that “a similar atomic constitution determines not only 


*Henry: Memoirs of the Life and Scientific Researches of John Dalton, 
p- 80. 

+ Ibid., p. 85. 

t Ibid., p. 100. 

2 Wurtz: The Atomic Theory, p. 36. 

|| Annales de Chimie, vol. 90, p. 48. 

q Wurtz: The Atomic Theory, p. 52. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLIX 


the analogy of chemical properties, but also the similarity of physi- 
cal forms;”* the discoveries in electrolysis, with their bearing on 
atomicity, as published by Faraday in 1834, in the Seventh Series or 
his Experimental Researches ; + the labors of Berzelius in clarify- 
ing the atomic weights of the elements; the “law of Octavyes,” an- 
nounced by Newlands in 1865, according to which the elements were 
divided into groups, having numbers differing by seven, or some 
multiple of seven ;{ the enlarged Periodic System of the elements, 
as published by Mendelejeff in 1869, with the prognostication of 
undiscovered metals required to make the system complete—among 
them a metal which the Russian chemist proceeded to namé “ekaalu- 
minium” in advance of its discovery ;§ the discovery of the missing 
metal in 1875, by Lecoq de Boisbaudran, who found it in a blende 
from the mines of Pierrefitte, in the Pyrenees, and gave to it the 
name of “Gallium,” without knowing that he had lighted on the 
“missing link” of Mendelejeff; || the extension of this periodic 
system by Lothar Meyer, with his Curve of the Elements, showing 
that the ductility, fusibility, and volatility of bodies are functions 
of their comparative atomic weights; the periodic system, as re- 
vised and extended during this very year, by Prof. Carnelley, in the 
light of the experimental boiling and melting points and heats of 
formation of the halogen compounds of the elements,§] (chlorides, 
bromides, and iodides;) Carnelley’s tables of color relations in 
chemical compounds as indicating the influence of atomic weights ;** 
and, lastly, Carnelley’s new reduction of the periodic system of the 
elements considered in the light of their occurrence in nature, with 
the helpful inferences to be drawn from it ***—these, and such like 
discoveries as these, following in the wake of the modern atomic 


-* Experimental Researches in Electricity, vol. I, pp. 230-258. 
+ Wurtz: The Atomic Theory, p. 58. 
t+ Newlands: The Discovery of the Periodic Law, &c., p. 14. 
3 Annalen der Chemie und Pharmacie, Supplement Band 8, p. 133 et seq. 
|| Comptes Rendus, t. LX X XI, p. 493. How fully Mendelejeff recognized 


in gallium the characters wanted to fill the gap in his periodic system, see 
Comptes Rendus, same volume, p. 969. 


{| Philosophical Magazine for July, 1884. 
** Phil. Mag. for August, 1884. 
*** Phil. Mag. for September, 1884 

18 


L PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


theory, have abundantly vindicated its value as an instrument of 
chemical research, while conspiring to vindicate its truth by giving 
to its votaries that ability of prediction which is the crucial test of 
science. The theory, besides, has sometimes “snatched a grace 
beyond the reach of art” by working retroactively to the purifica- 
tion of chemical method from errors and defects incident to the 
most careful manipulations of the practical chemist. 

Standing in the presence of chemical science, as now constituted, 
Baron Liebig has expressed the opinion that we can scarcely con- 
ceive how it could have been developed without the Daltonian 
hypothesis. And yet the atom of Dalton, considered in its rela- 
tion to our natural senses, is just as incapable of visible and tangi- 
ble demonstration as the atom of Democritus. For this reason it 
is known that Faraday could never fully reconcile himself to the 
modern doctrine of atoms.* But, in fact, there is a genetic and a 
generic difference between the ancient and the modern conception. 
The former is the offspring of the philosophical imagination 
toying with analogy. The latter is the offspring of the philosophi- 
cal imagination gendering with the homologies of reason. The atom 
of Democritus sprang into thought under the plastic forms by 
which he figured to himself at will the invisible relations and 
constitution of matter. The atom of Dalton sprang into thought 
from a rigid mathematical mind figuring to itself certain de- 
terminate relations which had become visible in elastic fluids. 
The atom of Democritus was, by the terms of its genesis, incapable 
of verification. The atom of Dalton was, by the terms of its 
genesis, capable of verification, if true, in all the gases of nature. 
Metaphysic thought born of the analogical reason can never con- 
clusively prove its legitimacy. Metaphysic thought born of the - 
homological reason can always prove its legitimacy, and, until it 
does, has no rights of heirship in the kingdom of science. The 
essential quality of a metaphysico-physical hypothesis is that it 
should be plausible; the essential quality of a physico-metaphysical 
hypothesis is that itshould be apodictic. The former is “magistral 
and peremptory;” the latter is “ingenuous and faithful.” The 
former is contrived in such sort as to be “soonest believed,” the 


* Faraday: Experimental Researches in Electricity, vol. 2, p. 284. But 
ef. vol. I, p. 249. . 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LI 


latter is contrived in such sort as to be “easiliest examined,” to 
cite the words of Bacon.* 

The Atomic Philosophy may, therefore, be said to offer a good 
type of all that is valid in physical metaphysics, and of all that is 
invalid in metaphysical physics. As the child in the infantile stage 
of his development dwells delightedly amid fays and talismans, 
because his metaphysic is stronger than his physics, so the savage 
man, artless child of nature, is easily pleased with the rattle of 
some lying legend, or tickled with the straw of some preposterous 
myth—the more preposterous the better. A cultivated race 
whose imagination is creative and artistic, but whose reason has 
not yet been developed by the processes of a rigorous logic, will 
demand, as has been already said, an artful and curious felicity in 
their physical theories—but they will demand nothing more, be- 
cause when this demand is met, their highest. intellectual demand 
has been met. It isnot until “the heir of all the ages” has learned 
to change the organon and method of his physical enquiries, and to 
put his reason over his imagination, by making imagination the 
hand-maid of reason, that Science is born. Long before this stage 
has been reached the children of Science may come to the birth, but 
there is not strength to deliver, because the true maieutic of science— 
experimentation with rational hypothesis, and rational hypothesis 
with experimentation—has not yet come to the teeming mind of 
philosophy. The goddess Experimentation is the Lucina of Science. 
The free surrender of all metaphysical conceptions to the hands of 
this Lucina, with the distinct knowledge that she will strangle them 
if they are not well formed, is the birth-pang of the scientific spirit. 
Until this stage of mental evolution is reached we shall have as 
many theories of the Universe as we have stages of culture, for 
every stage of culture will have a physics of its own, because it has 
a metaphysic of its own. Hence, the endless varieties of cosmol- 
ogy—the Hottentot physics, the Indian physics, the Stoical physics, 
the Epicurean physics, the Leibnitzian physics, the Cartesian phys- 
ics, and such like—all the coinage of the metaphysical imagination. 
Grote enumerates as many as twelve distinct physical philosophies 
which divided speculative opinion in Greece during the century 
and a half between Thales and the Peloponnesian war. 


* The Advancement of Learning, Book I, v, 9. 


LII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


It is the mission of science to bring the physics of the world into 
unity by reading the phenomena of the world in the dry light of 
reason, and by continuing to spell and parse the hieroglyphs of 
Nature until the rational processes of our logic are brought into 
demonstrated correspondence with the actual processes of Nature. 
Science still keeps metaphysic in her service. But instead of 
weaving whole fabrics from the metaphysical loom and devising 
ingenious tissues which only reveal the nakedness of reason, Science 
in passing from the known to the unknown employs metaphysic 
as the gossamer spider employs the single thread on which she 
sways and balances her movements between two solid points. The 
thread is tied to something solid as the condition of reaching some- 
thing solid after her aerial flight. So the man of science, work- 
ing in and under the limitations of physics, works on the lines 
of metaphysic thought when he frames the tentative hypotheses 
with which he returns again to the patient, practical study of 
nature.* 

The scientific man reads the Universe backward by the inductive 
syllogism, because Nature has proceeded forward in her evolutions, 
according to an unbroken chain of antecedent causes. The physi- 
cal Universe is indeed a fasciculus of natural syllogisms colligated 
into the compactest unity, and so holding all things, forces, and 
functions under the bonds of logic. The scientific man, at any 
given stage of his enquiry, has before him only the conclusions or 
at best only the minor premises and the conclusions of this world- 
process. And he knows that these conclusions of the natural syllo- 
gistic process have been reached through a perpetual flux in the 
universal complex of things, forces, and functions—a flux which 
dates from the beginning of star-mist and nebula, or from the 
beginning of that more elementary fluid out of which star-mist and 
nebula were generated, according to the scientific metaphysic of the 
present day. Is it any wonder, then, that many of the major 

premises of Nature’s physical syllogisms should still be wrapt in 
impenetrable mystery to us, as many of the major premises which 


* Bacon’s oft-quoted contrast between metaphysicians, who, he says, spin 
‘‘Jaborious cobwebs of learning,’’ like spiders, and physical philosophers, 
who ‘work according to the stuff, and are limited thereby,”’ seems hardly fair 


to the spider. Advancement of Learning, Book J, iv, 5. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LIII 


we have spelled out were wrapt in an impenetrable mystery to the 
Greeks in the 5th century before Christ? 

As there is a needs be that much of metaphysic thought must 
be blended with the psychological processes which lead to every 
passage from the known to the unknown; so every great discovery 
of the physical philosopher tends to widen the metaphysical horizon 
within which he works. The world was never so full of metaphysic 
as it is to-day, when physical science is transforming the minds of 
men not so much by the secular boons it is dropping in the lap of 
modern civilization as by its underlying doctrines; and these doc- 
trines are often the mere metaphysical reflex or obverse of the 
physical truths they subtend. The psychological processes of every 
age are conditioned by its logical method, and its logical method is 
justified to itself by its metaphysic—by those necessary conceptions 
and fundamental relations which it takes to be architectonic of the 
Universe. What, for instance, can be more metaphysical than the 
latest conception of our highest physical science—the conception of 
vortex atoms moving in an imaginary frictionless fluid where the 
origin and the end of the motion are equally inconceivable? Or, 
take Mr. Darwin’s doctrine of hypothetical gemmules “ inheriting 
innumerable qualities from ancestral sources, circulating in the 
blood and propagating themselves, generation after generation, still 
in the state of gemmules, but failing to develop themselves into 
cells because other antagonistic gemmules are prepotent and over- 
master them in the struggle for points of attachment” *—in what 
respect is this doctrine one whit less metaphysical than St. Augus- 
tine’s doctrine of original and hereditary sin? Or, when the late 
Prof. Clifford tells us that “the Universe consists entirely of mind- 
stuff;” that “ matter is a mental picture,in which mind-stuff is the 
thing represented,” and that “ reason, intelligence, and volition are 
properties of a complex which is made up of elements themselves 
not rational, not intelligent, not conscious”—how does his “ mind- 
stuff” differ from the “ mind-stuff” of Pythagoras, + except in the 


* Galton: Hereditary Genius, p. 367; cf. Darwin: Animals and Plants 
under Domestication, (London,) vol. 2, p. 402. For a criticism on this 
physiological doctrine, see Encyclopedia Britannica, (‘‘Atoms,’’) vol. 3, 
p. 42. 

+ For the ‘‘mind-stuff’’ of Pythagoras, see Cicero, De Nat. Deorum, I, 
xi, 27. For the ‘‘mind-stuff’”’ of Clifford, see ‘‘ Mind,’’ January, 1878, p. 66. 


LIV PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


greater ingenuity and method of the metaphysic art with which 
it is conceived ? 7 

If within the limits of this discussion I had the time, and if, 
under the limitations of my knowledge, I had the ability, to carry 
this enquiry into the realm of molecular physics and dynamics, 
where such star-eyed mystagogues as a Clausius or a Rankine, a 
Clerk-Maxwell or a Sir William Thompson have borne the thyrsus 
of science before us, it would be easy to show that, under their guid- 
ance, we have escaped the pitiless parallel lines of the Epicurean 
atoms only to find ourselves inextricably implicated in the knotted- 
ness and linkedness of the vortex rings of atoms as they execute 
their infinite evolutions and invyolutions, vibrating now in one period 
and now in another behind that vail of matter where they can be 
descried only by the shadowy lines they reveal to the spectroscopic 
imagination. “It is the mode of motion,” says Clerk-Maxwell, 
“which constitutes the vortex rings, and which furnishes us with 
examples of that permanence and continuity of existence which we 
are accustomed to attribute to matter itself. The primitive fluid, 
the only true matter, entirely eludes our perceptions when it is not 
endued with the mode of motion which converts certain portions of 
it into vortex rings, and thus renders it molecular.” * 

Of these vortex rings we must say, in the dialect of the schools, 
cognoscendo ignorantur, sed ignorando cognoscuntur. Withheld from 
positive conception, yet necessitated to scientific thought and spec- 
ulation by the exigencies of the knowledge we can conceive posi- 
tively, they afford a good illustration of the physical metaphysic 
which has wafted the scientific mind of the present generation into 
an empyrean as much higher than the empyrean of Plato as the 
spectroscopic vision of modern science is more far-reaching than the 
highest flight of metaphysic wit among all the physical atomizers 
who ever lived or dreamed in Greece. Every chemical atom, says 
Sir John Herschel, is forever solving differential equations, which, 
if written out in full, might belt the earth. ‘An atom of pure 
iron,” says Jevons, “is probably a vastly more complicated system 
than that of the planets and their satellites.” 

Between metaphysical physics and physical metaphysics there is 
a world-wide difference. The invisible ether posited behind the 


* Encyclopedia Britannica, sub voce ‘‘Atom.”’ 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LV 


vail of matter by the East Indian philosophy of the Upanishads, or 
by the visionary dialectic of Cleanthes, was posited there by meta- 
physical physics. The invisible fluid posited by modern science 
behind the vail of matter is posited there by physical metaphysics. 
The vortices of Democritus as well as the vortices of Descartes 
are the creations of metaphysical physics. The vortices of Helm- 
holtz and of Sir William Thompson are the creations of physical 
metaphysics. The fixed and crystalline sphere of the old Ptole- 
maic astronomers was an invention of metaphysical physics. The 
solid ether which transmits to us the light of the stellar Universe, 
and which, as Sir John Herschell remarks, is the modern “ realiza- 
tion of the ancient idea of the crystalline orb,” is the invention 
of physical metaphysics. When Lucretius finds in the iridescent 
hues of the peacock’s tail, as it shimmers in the sun, a fresh type 
and instance of Nature’s prodigality in the display of atoms, he 
does but yield another contingent to the barren store of his meta- 
physical physics. When Dr. John Tyndall finds in the iridescences 
of the common soap bubble a proof that stellar space is a plenum 
filled with a material substance that is capable of transmitting 
motion with a rapidity that would girdle the equatorial’ earth eight 
times in a second, he does but yield another contingent to the fertile 
store of his physical metaphysics. When Dr. George Cheyne, of 
Scotland, expressed the opinion in the last century, that “all ani- 
mals, of what kind soever, were originally and actually created at 
once by the hand of Almighty God, it being impossible (he said) to 
account for their production by any laws of mechanism ;” and 
when he further held that “every individual animal has, in minimis, 
actually included in its loins all those who shall descend from it, 
and every one of these again has all its offspring lodged in its loins, 
and so on ad infinitum,” and that “all this infinite number of ani- 
malcules may be lodged in the bigness of a pin’s head,’’* he preached 
a biological doctrine which sounds in the terms of metaphysical 
physics. When Mr. Darwin in his provisional theory of Pangenesis 
assumes the existence of the gemmules which inherit innumerable 
qualities from ancestral sources, and which prelude as gemmules 
that struggle for existence which antedates and therefore condition- 
ates the terms of the human struggle witnessed in society, commerce, 
and national life, he expounds a biological doctrine which sounds 
just as clearly in the terms of physical metaphysics. When old 


* J. Brown: Locke and Sydenham, p. 270. 


LVI PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Heraclitus proclaimed that the Universe with all it contains sprang 
into being from elemental heat, and was destined to be resolved 
again into the elemental heat from which it sprang, and thus in a 
ceaseless round to continue the cycle of being, he taught a doctrine 
of conservation and correlation of energy which had its root in 
metaphysical physics. When Dr. John Tyndall declares that “all 
our philosophy, all our poetry, all our science, all our art—Plato, 
Shakespeare, Newton, and Raphael—are potentially in the fires 
of the sun,” and so tucks away the genius of a Darwin in the folds 
of a nebular blastema, he teaches a doctrine of equivalence which 
has its root in physical metaphysics. 

It will thus be seen that under the dominion of Science the world 
has use for as much metaphysic as ever before, but only for a meta- 
physic radically different from the old metaphysic in its point of 
departure as also in the tests of its validity, and, therefore, radi- 
cally different in the tenure by which it is held. The votaries of 
the old metaphysical physics proceeded from what was unknown to 
explicate and explain the known appearances of things, and rested 
content in explanations which seemed to consist with those appear- 
ances. The votaries of the modern physical metaphysics proceed 
from what is known to explicate and explain what is unknown in 
the deeper relations of things, and rest content in explanations only 
so long as, and so far as, they seem consistent with experimental 
proofs or with the broadest homologies of the deductive reason. 

When the law of simple multiples in chemical combinations was 
given to the world by Dalton, and was expressed by him in atomic 
language, he had really made a great departure from the physical 
methods of Democritus, though it is curious to observe that there is 
a perfect identity between the metaphysical ideas underlying his 
logic and the metaphysical ideas of his Greek predecessor. The 
method of each proceeds on the assumption of the indestructibility 
of matter, and it is from this platform that the English chemist 
reaches out his hand to the Greek philosopher in token of a com- 
mon metaphysic. “No new creation or destruction of matter,” 
wrote Dalton, in his celebrated paper on “ Chemical Synthesis,” “is 
within the reach of chemical agency. We might as well attempt 
to introduce a new planet into the solar system, or to annihilate 
one already in existence, as to create or destroy a particleof hydro- 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LVII 


gen.” * Democritus knew nothing of hydrogen, but he saw as 
clearly and said as plainly as Dalton that the antecedent premise 
of all physical philosophy must be found in the metaphysical maxim 
that “out of nothing nothing comes, and that nothing which is can 
ever be annihilated.” 

And this maxim, with which the old Greek philosophy began, is 
about all of solid and sound that remains to us from the physical 
philosophizing of the ancients. It is true, as Mr. Balfour Stewart 
remarks, that the ancients had in some way grasped the idea of the 
essential unrest and energy of things; that they had the idea ot 
small particles or atoms as the constituent elements of matter, and 
divined the existence of an ethereal medium extending through all 
space; but there is no evidence at all to support the statement 
that any one or all of these doctrines proceeded from even a ru- 
dimental conception of “the most profound and deeply seated ot 
the principles of the material universe.” 

There is, however, one respect in which it may be justly said that 
Democritus stands at the head of the long line of natural philoso- 
phers who since his day have been explicating for us the structure 
of the physical universe. He was the first who ever attempted a 
purely mechanical solution of the problem of physical being. It is 
the singular glory of the atomic philosophers that alone, among the 
jarring schools of Greece, they saw that a science of the Universe 
was possible only on the assumption that the phenomena of the 
physical universe are bound together by necessary law, and this 
law mechanical in the modes of its operation. They had no science, 
it is true, in the modern sense of the word, but it is no small dis- 
tinction which they have won in standing at the head of an intel- 
lectual succession which embraces in its ranks a Copernicus and a 
Galileo, a Newton and a Laplace, a Dalton and a Faraday. { 

* Henry: Memoirs, &c., of Dalton, p. 88. 

{ Diog. Laert., sub voce ‘‘ Democritus,” where it is particularly recorded 
that he assumed as his point of departure the maxim ‘Out of nothing 
nothing comes,’’ &c. 

t‘‘ Was die Atomiker von ihren Vorgangern unterscheidet, ist nur die 
Strenge und Folgerichtigkeit mit der sie den Gedanken einer rein material- 
istischen und mechanischen Naturerklérung durchgefithrt haben; diese kann 
ihnen aber um so weniger zum Nachtheil gedeutet werden, da sie damit nur 
die Schliisse gezogen haben welche durch die ganze bisherige Entwicklung 


gefordert, und wozu in den Annahmen ihrer Vorginger die Vordersatze ge- 
geben waren.’”’ Zeller: Philos. d. Griechen, Erster Theil, 765. 


LVIII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


With two short lessons cited to point the moral of this long story, 
and I have done. The first of these moralities shall” be a warning | 
against the folly of the old atomists in attempting to philosophize 
beyond the conditions of their knowledge. They reared imposing 
fabrics in astronomy, in physics, in psychology, and in anthropology, 
but they built without laying their foundation in any deep knowl- 
edge of nature, and laid the successive courses of their system- 
building in the untempered mortar of an incoherent logic. And 
the moral needs to be pointed as much for the admonition of modern 
scientific workers, with their cheap and easy cosmologies, as for the 
reproach of the old physiologers of Greece. One of our poets has 
sung: 

From an old English parsonage 
Down by the sea, 

There came in the twilight 
A message to me. 

Its quaint Saxon legend, 
Deeply engraven, 

Hath, as it seems to me, 
Teaching from heaven; 

And all through the hours 
The quiet words ring, 

Like a low inspiration, 
“Doe the nerte thyuge.” 


The message is as full of inspiration for guidance in physical 
philosophizing as for guidance in moral conduct. Tantwm series 
juncturaque pollet. 

The only other morality which time permits to be pointed at the 
end of this review is a warning against intellectual impatience— 
not that intellectual impatience rebuked by the maxim just cited, 
and which seeks to leap at a single bound the limitations of knowl- 
edge in any given age—but the intellectual impatience which cayils 
at the short-comings of the men who dug the first ditches and 
planted the first hedges around the vineyards of science. They 
were humble pioneers, but they opened the way into that land of 
Beulah where the men of science sit to-day beneath their own 
vines and fig-trees, with none to make them afraid. Even after 
John Dalton had come to place the key of the new Atomic Philoso- 
phy in the hands of men, it was a saying of Mitscherlich that it 
took fourteen years to discover and establish a single fact in 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LIX 


chemistry. Let us not wonder, then, that it took more than two 
thousand years to perfect the doctrine of atoms as a clew to the 
“mystery of matter.” Democritus invented a mechanical key 
of wonderful ingenuity, but it would not unlock anything that 
could not be unlocked without. it. Newton divined that the 
key must be fitted to the two great wards of chemical attrac- 
tion and chemical repulsion, but still the key would not turn in the 
udamantine lock of Nature. Dalton found that the secret of the 
combination must be sought in wards nicely graduated according to 
certain fixed, definite, and multiple numbers, and, since his day, 
door after door in the chemist’s “chamber of imagery” has seemed 
to swing open at the touch of this talisman. And even, if in the 
next two thousand years, or in the next twenty years, the theory of 
John Dalton should be absorbed in some deeper truth, there will 
still be room in the pantheon of science for the memorial bust of 
the plain Manchester arithmetician, so long as men recall how far 
that little candle, which he lighted with inflammable gas obtained 
in the rudest way from the ponds of Lancashire, has thrown its 
quickening beams across the whole tract of modern chemistry. 


ie 


nye A AY ee iy 
a vat eae, oy 
ue Waal | 
ust Wariate, teem i 
} 4 i And 


a Ng d Le iy 
a2 Aah Ast 
PACS EAE ATEN A 


sf) 


: PhP ht tb, 

Ay ba th ay 

Wed Me Dina 
SSD RN 


0 


4 


” 
NS a 


oe ‘on ed a RP a, : Mh ee 
it . Rs fea hey er b i ‘AS a 4 is 


Yi Pid beni 
{ Chan hi 
“" P PA tay SEC sy ad Pa ; : * 
Lh Aa CARRS SEL De DNAS ah ANE ee 
; f PAU te CeO enn Bene ‘ny 


tag 
ae 


: cacy who 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


GENERAL MEETING. 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


GENERAL MEETING. 


244TH MEETING. JANUARY 5, 1884, 
The President in the Chair. 


Twenty-eight members and guests present. 


The Chair announced the death, since the last meeting, of 
General A. A. HumpHreys, one of the founders of the Society. 


Mr. J. R. EAstMAan made a communication on 
THE ROCHESTER (MINNESOTA) TORNADO, 


describing the ground as it appeared a few days after the storm, 
and showing that the phenomena did not indicate cyclonic motion. 
All disturbed objects were thrown in essentially the same direction, 
and were pressed down rather than lifted. 

Mr. Exxiorr related that twenty-five years previous he had 
crossed a storm-track consisting of a double line of fallen timber, 
with an interval in which the timber was standing. Mr. Eastman 
thought this phenomenon should be referred to two separate 
cyclones, possibly moving as companions. 

Mr. Dauu described storm tracks in the Escanaba region in 
which the trunks of prostrate trees pointed uniformly in one 
direction, the path of destruction being definitely limited at the 
margins. 

Mr. E. Farquaar suggested that a highly inclined storm axis 
might account for the uniformity in the direction of the wind in 
the zone of destruction. 


3 


A PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Mr. W. H. Datu read a paper on 


RECENT ADVANCES IN OUR KNOWLEDGE OF THE LIMPETS, 


summarizing the researches of Spengel on the sensory organs or 
osphradia; Cunningham on the renal organ and renopericardial 
pore in Patella and Patina; Fraissé on the eye in Patina, Fissurella 
and Haliotis, and the speaker on the presence of an intromittent. 
male organ in Cocculina. He stated that among the Acmeide and 
Patellide the type of eye differs, and while in Patina it is of a very 
rudimentary character, in other genera it might be well developed, 
as, for instance, in Ancistromesus, which has as well developed eyes 
as Fissurella. He also alluded to the gradual progress in classifi- 
cation afforded by anatomical investigation during the past few 
years, and observed that nearly all the known forms except Propili- 
dium and Scutellina were amenable to classification; our ignorance 
of the branchize in the former, and the dentition in the latter, 
operating to prevent a final classification in these two cases, until 
more is known. Those authors who study the embryology and 
histology usually from a single species, generally ignore the wide 
differences of adult anatomy between the genera of Limpets, and 
sow their generalizations on a basis of classification which is little 
in advance of that of Lamarck and his immediate successors. 


Professor C. H. Hircucock being present was invited by the 
Chair to address the Society, and responded briefly. 


The President of the Society then pronounced a brief eulogy on 
General Humphreys, characterizing him as a man who had left 
behind him an honorable name as well for his distinguished 
achievements in science and in war as for the virtues and graces 
which adorned his private life. Mingling among his fellow-men 
with the utmost unobtrusiveness, and as gentle in spirit as he was 
brave in conduct, he brought the highest intelligence as well as the 
highest conscientiousness to the discharge of all the duties—scien- 
tific, military, and administrative—with which he filled his long 
and useful life: a life fitly closed by the serenity and peace of his 
beautiful death, Ki 


GENERAL MEETING. 5 


245TH MEETING. JANUARY 19, 1884. 
The President in the Chair. 


Forty-five members and guests present. 


The Chair read a letter from the Biological Society of Washing- 
ton inviting the members of the Philosophical Society to attend 
its meeting of January 25th, for the purpose of listening to the 
annual address of its President, Dr. C. A. White. 

Announcement was made of the election to membership of 
Messrs. GEORGE Epwarp Curtis and Patrick Henry Ray. 


Mr. I. C. RusseLt made a communication on 


THE EXISTING GLACIERS OF THE HIGH SIERRA OF CALIFORNIA. 


[Abstract. ] 


During the summer of 1883 I had an opportunity of tracing to 
their sources some of the ancient glaciers of the High Sierra in 
the region between Mono Lake and the Yosemite Valley. 

From the glacial records seen during a number of excursions 
into the mountains it was evident that the High Sierra had formerly 
been so deeply covered with ice that only the culminating peaks 
and ridges escaped the general glaciation. From the vast névé of 
the mountain tops flowed long winding rivers of ice, both to the 
eastward and westward through the cafions and valleys. In nearly 
all cases the glaciers occupied drainage lines of pre-glacial date, 
which they modified and enlarged, but, with the exception of the 
cirques about the higher peaks and crests, they failed to originate 
any of the more prominent topographical features of the range. 
The glaciers of the Sierra Nevada were not connected with a north- 
ern ice-sheet, but were of local origin and of the same type as the 
Swiss glaciers of the present day, but of far greater magnitude. If 
the cafions and valleys of the Sierra are traced upward, it is almost 
invariably found that they head in cirques or amphitheaters, in 
some of which small glaciers still linger—perhaps remnants of the 
mighty ice-rivers that formerly flowed from the same fountains. 

The first glacier visited by the writer was on the northern side of 
Mt. Dana, at an elevation of about 11,500 feet above the sea, and 


at the head of a deep cafion which drains into Leevining creek, 
19 


6 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


one of the tributaries of Mono Lake. The Mt. Dana glacier is approx- 
imately 2,500 feet long and of somewhat greater breadth. Although 
small, and in fact but a “ pocket edition” of what may be seen on 
a far grander scale in many mountains, yet it is a veritable glacier, 
with nearly all the features that characterize such ice-bodies 
in other countries. The distinction between the snow-ice of the 
névé and the more solid blue or greenish-blue ice of the glacier 
proper is clearly marked—as was observed to be the case also 
in a number of neighboring glaciers. An irregular open fissure 
crosses the head of the névé, corresponding to the “ bergschrund ” 
of the Swiss glaciers, while a number of parallel fractures on the 
border of the glacier at the foot of the snow-field form marginal 
crevasses with walls of solid blue ice. Near the terminus of the 
glacier alternating sheets of porous, white ice, and of more compact 
bluish ice were observed, which produce a distinct laminated or 
ribboned structure. Dirt-bands were plainly visible, sweeping 
in undulating lines across the surface of the glacier; and similar 
bands are a conspicuous feature in nearly all the ice-bodies seen in the 
High Sierra. About the foot of the Mt. Dana glacier a true terminal 
moraine is now in process of formation. The fall of stones and 
dirt from the ice onto the moraine was noticed many times during 
our visits. Some of the rounded stones from beneath the ice are 
battered and scratched and have evidently received these markings 
within the past few years. 

On the northern side of Mt. Lyell another glacier was visited, 
which is the source of the Tuolumne river. The Mt. Lyell glacier is 
somewhat larger than the one on Mt. Dana, and, like it, exhibits 
characteristic glacial phenomena. A protrusion of compact, banded 
ice from beneath a snow-field at the head of an amphitheatre was 
here again observed, as well as the presence of moraines, crevasses, 
dirt-bands, ete. On the lower portion of this glacier were observed 
“ice-pyramids”’ of the form represented in the figure on the follow- 
ing page. 

At the northern base of a pyramid there invariably occurs a 
stone or a mass of dirt, that is depressed below the general surface 
of the glacier, as is indicated in the sketch. The pyramid invariably 
points toward the noon-day sun. IJts mass is composed of porous 
and banded ice, like that forming the general surface of the glacier, 
but its northern face is sheeted with compact, bluish ice. The 


GENERAL MEETING. ‘i 


northern face is also concave, as represented in the sketch, and 
usually conforms to some extent with the shape of the stone at its 
base. 


Fie. 1. An Ice-Pyramid. 


On another glacier, discovered at the head of Parker creek, one 
of the tributaries of Mono Lake, all the glacial phenomena: men- 
tioned above are well displayed, and, in addition, “ glacier-tables ” 
were observed in considerable numbers. The following figure repre- 
sents several of the glacier-tables of the Parker creek glacier, 
grouped for convenience of illustration : 


a 


= = if) 
mars { 4 

GE 
Tos 


Fig. 2. Glacier-Tables. 


8 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The largest perched-block now being carried along by this glacier 
measures 34 by 28 by 10 feet, and is supported on & column of ice 
five or six feet thick, eight feet high on its northern side, and six 
feet high on its southern. Many masses of rock larger than the 
one measured were seen in the terminal moraine that circles about 
the foot of the glacier. ; 

The motion of these glaciers was not observed, but that it exists 
is manifest from the nature of the crevasses and the curvature of 
the dirt-bands. The rate of flow of a glacier on Mt. McClure was 
measured several years since by Mr. Muir, who found it to be 47 
inches in 46 days (from August 21st tc October 6th, 1872).* 

Six glaciers are known to the writer within the southern rim of 
the hydrographic basin of Mono Lake, and about twice this num- 
ber were seen about Mt. Conness, Mt. McClure, Mt. Lyell, Mt. 
Ritter, and the Minarets. 

Many of the glaciers mentioned above have been previously re- 
ported in popular articles by Mr. John Muir, but the fact that they 
are true glaciers haying been denied by eminent geologists, it is de- 
sirable to have a more accurate description of them. 


[The communication was illustrated by photographic lantern 
views. Its subject-matter will be more fully presented in the Fifth 
Annual Report of the United States Geological Survey. ] 


Mr. Girpert THompson described certain glaciers on Mount 
Shasta believed to be new to science. Their discovery increases 
the number of known glaciers on the flanks of Shasta to seven. 

Mr. Houmes described modern glaciers of the Rocky Mountains 
observed by himself. Those of the Wind River Mountains are 
from one-fourth mile to one mile in length. He illustrated by a 
sketch the position of three small glaciers in the gorges of Mount 
Moran, in the Teton Range, at an altitude of 10,000 feet. 

Mr. PowEtu remarked that the chief interest of these small 
modern glaciers lies in the fact that they illustrate the process by 
which the drift has been distributed, and aid in completing the 
theory of the ancient glaciation of the country. 

Mr. Marx B. Kerr mentioned the occurrence of a probable 
glacier in the Salmon Mountains, a division of the Coast Range. 


e 


* American Journal of Science, Vol. V, p. 69; 1878. 


GENERAL MEETING. 9 


Mr. Harkness set forth the apparent difficulty of discrimina- 
ting between a névé and a glacier proper, and requested that some 
geologist would define the term “glacier.” 

Mr. Emmons said that a true glacier is an ice river, conform- 
ing in shape to the more or less restricted channel in which it 
flows, and this characteristic might form a base of distinction be- 
tween the true glacier and the névé-field, the latter being com- 
parable to the lake which forms the source of a mountain stream. 
Thus the névé would become a glacier only when from a broad and 
shallow ice-field it had become compressed into a narrower and 
deeper mass, between confining walls. 

Other remarks were made by Messrs. E. FARQUHAR, GILBERT, 
Datu, and ELiiort. 


Professor W. C. KERR made a communication on 
THE MICA MINES OF NORTH CAROLINA. 


[Abstract. ] 


The profitable mines are restricted to a plateau limited eastward 
by the Blue Ridge and westward by the Smoky Range. These 
were anciently worked on a very extensive scale. Few other modern 
mining operations have been so profitably conducted as those at the 
points occupied by the early miners. The ancient work was per- 
formed with blunt-pointed tools—doubtless of stone—and was con- 
fined to the partially decomposed portions of the granite veins, but 
large pits were nevertheless excavated. One of these measures 
150 by 75 feet, and, despite a partial filling with débris, retains a 
depth of 35 feet. Facts connected with the arboreal vegetation 
show that some, and perhaps all of these openings were aban- 
doned as much as five hundred years ago. The modern industry 
began in 1868, and, although it has assumed considerable import- 
ance, is not yet conducted in a systematic way. 

The character of the mica and its associated minerals were dis- 
cussed and illustrated by specimens. 


10 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


246TH MEETING. FEBRUARY 2, 1884, 
The President in the Chair. 
Forty-eight members and guests present. 


The Chair announced the election to membership of Mr, Taomas 
ROBINSON. 


Mr. C. V. Ritry made a communication on 
RECENT ADVANCES IN ECONOMIC ENTOMOLOGY. 


The paper set forth the part which insects play in the economy 
of nature, and particularly their influence on American agriculture. 
The earlier writers on applied entomology in the United States, as 
Peck, Harris, Fitch, Walsh, LeBaron, Glover, did some excellent 
work in their studies of the habits and life-histories of injurious 
species, but the most important results followed when such studies 
were combined with field work and experiment by competent persons 
and upon scientific principles. A number of the remedies proposed 
in the agricultural press are foolish and based on misleading em- 
piricism. Economic entomology as a science is of comparatively 
recent date. It implies full knowledge of the particular injurious 
species to be dealt with and of its enemies, of its relations to other 
animals and to wild and cultivated plants. In short, the whole 
environment of the species must be considered, especially from the 
standpoint of the farmer’s wants. The habits of birds, more par- 
ticularly, and the bearings of meteorology and of the develop- 
ment of minute parasitic organisms must be considered. Experi- 
ments with insecticides and appliances will then be intelligent 
and successful in proportion as the facts of chemistry, dynamics, 
and mechanics are utilized. 

The complicated nature of the problem was illustrated by the 
life-history of Phylloxera vastatriz Planchon, and the difficulties 
often encountered in acquiring the facts were illustrated by the late 
work on Aletia xylina (Say). 

The chief insecticides considered for general use and applicable 
above ground were tobacco, white hellebore, soap, arsenical com- 
pounds, petroleum, and pyrethrum; those for use under ground, 
naphthaline, sulpho-carbonate of potassium, and bisulphide of car- 


GENERAL MEETING. 11 


bon. The most advantageous and improved methods of utilizing 
each were indicated. Recent experiment showed that kerosene 
emulsions, such as had been recommended lately in the author’s 
official reports, are superior to bisulphide of carbon when used 
under ground against the Grape Phylloxera, and the discovery is 
deemed of great importance, especially to the French people and 
those on our Pacific slope. Contrary to general belief, pyrethrum 
powder was shown to have a peculiar and toxic effect on higher 
animals as well as on the lower forms of life. Its deadly influence 
on lower organisms led the author to strongly recommend its use 
as a disinfectant, and to express the belief that it will yet come to 
be used in medicine. Dr. H. A. Hagen’s recommendation of the 
use of yeast ferment was touched upon. It has proved of little or 
no practical avail, and some of the publications on the subject were 
characterized as unscientific. The use of malodorous substances 
as repellants, which was much relied on in the early days of econ- 
omic entomology and strongly recommended by the two Downings, 
has latcly been agitated as a new principle for the prevention of 
insect attack by Prof. J. A. Lintner. The principle can be applied 
in exceptional cases to advantage, but experiment gives little hope 
of its utility against most of our worst field insects. Prof. S. A. 
Forbes is engaged in interesting researches, having for object the 
utilization of micro-organisms, but with more promise for pure than 
applied science. 

Of recent progress in mechanical appliances, the paper dealt 
with those lately perfected under the author’s direction by Dr. W. 
S. Barnard, one of his assistants. This part of the subject was 
illustrated by models and by plates from the forthcoming fourth 
report of the United States Entomological Commission. 

The paper concluded with the following plea for applied science: 
“Matters of fact do not tend to provoke thought and discussion; 
and I must confess to some misgivings in bringing these practical 
considerations before a body which reflects some of the highest and 
purest science and philosophy of the nation. From the days of 
Archimedes down to the present day there has existed a disposition 
to decry applied science and to sneer at the practical man. Yet I 
often think that science, no matter in what fine-sounding name we 
clothe her, or how high above the average understanding we stilt 
her, is, after all, but common sense employed in discovering the 


12 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


hidden secrets of the universe and in turning them to man’s wants, 
whether sensual or intellectual. Between the unbalanced vapor- 
ings of the pseudo-scientific theorizer and the uninformed empiric 
who stumbles upon a discovery, there is the firm middle ground of 
logical induction and deduction, and true science can neither be 
exalted by its inapplicability, nor degraded by its subserviency to 
man’s material welfare. The best results follow when the pure and 
the applied go hand-in-hand—when theory and practice are wedded. 
Erstwhile the naturalist was honored in proportion as he dealt 
with the dry bones of his science. Pedantry and taxonomy over- 
shadowed biologic research. To-day, largely through Charles Dar- 
win’s influence, we recognize the necessity of drawing our inspira- 
tion more directly from the vital manifestations of nature in our - 
attempt to solve some of the many far-reaching problems which 
modern science presents. The fields of biology, morphology, physi- 
ology and psychology are more inviting than formerly. Nor is 
the lustre that glorifies the names of Stevenson, Watts, Faraday, 
Franklin, Morse, Henry, Siemens, and a host of yet living investi- 
gators dimmed because they made science useful. Goethe makes 
Wagner say: 


‘‘Ach wenn man so in sein Museum gebannt ist 
Und sieht die Welt kaum einen Feiertag 
Kaum durch ein Fernglas, nur yon Weiten 
Wie soll man sie durch Ueberredung leiten?’ 


“Tf to-day, right here in Washington, there is great activity in 
the field of original research; if the nation is encouraging it in a 
manner we may well be proud of, the fact is due in no small degree 
to the efforts of those, many of them members of this Society, who 
have made practical ends a means, rather than to those who would 
make science more exclusive, and who are indifferent to practical 
ends or popular sympathy. Such, at least, is my apology for the 
nature of this paper.” 


In response to an inquiry by Mr. White, Mr. Rrury said that 
the ox-eye daisy. had been subjected to a thorough test under his 
supervision and the result had shown that it has none of the insect- 
icide qualities of pyrethrum. 


os 


GENERAL MEETING. 13 


Mr. S. M. Burnett made a communication entitled 


WHY THE EYES OF ANIMALS SHINE IN THE DARK.* 
[Abstract. ] 


Erroneous opinions have been held and expressed, not only by 
the non-scientific, but also by some persons holding high positions 
in the scientific world, in regard to the phenomena of luminosity of 
the eyes of animals, and particularly of cats, when they are in ob- 
scurity. It is not due, as has been commonly supposed, to phosphor- 
escence, but to light reflected from the bottom of the eye, which 
light is diffused on account of the hypermetropic condition that is 
the rule in the lower animals. 


In response to a question by Mr. White, Mr. Burnerr said that 
human eyes affected by hypermetropia do not yield similar results, 
partly because the human pupil is too small and partly because the 
bottom of the human eye is not so strongly reflecting a surface as 
that of most animals. 

Mr. Harkness remarked that in determining the degree of di- 
vergence of rays emitted by an eye, from an image situated upon 
its retina, it is necessary to consider the magnitude of that image 
as well as its distance from the focal plane of the lens. The diver- 
gence of the rays coming from any one point of the image is deter- 
mined by the interval which separates the retina from the focal 
plane of the lens, while the divergence of the rays coming from 
any two points of the image depends principally upon the size of the 
image itself. The total divergence is the sum of the divergences 
produced by these two causes, and the neglect of that due to the 
size of the image will probably account for the discrepancy between 
the observed angle of divergence and that computed by Dr. Burnett. 

It also seems desirable to bear in mind the distinction between 
fluorescent and phosphoresent light ; the former disappears as soon 
as the incident waves are cut off; the latter does not. 


* This paper is published in full in the Pop. Sci. Monthly for April, 1884; 
Vol. XXIV, pp. 813-818. 


14 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Mr. A. B. Jonson made a communication on 


SOME ECCENTRICITIES OF OCEAN CURRENTS, 


[Abstract. ] 


The records of the Light House Board show that no less than 
eleven buoys of various patterns have gone adrift from the waters 
of the United States and been found at distant points where ocean 
currents have carried them. Many of these were not so fully iden- 
tified that their precise original station could be indicated. In the 
case of a few, it has been determined that they were swept from 
the harbor and bay of New York by the outgoing ice in the winter 
of 1880-81 when nineteen buoys were carried to sea. 


1. In the spring of 1871, a buoy was picked up on the west coast 
of Ireland. 


2. In March, 1871, the Norwegian vessel Vance picked up a buoy 
in lat. 42° 22’, long. 26° 38’. 

3. In February, 1881, a buoy went ashore on one of the cays 
near Turk’s island. This was recognized as a New York buoy. 

4. May 17, 1881, the steamer William Dickinson passed a whist- 
ling buoy in lat. 29° 46’, long. 77° 38. 

5. In March, 1881, a buoy of the largest size, likewise referred 
to New York, was found near Bermuda. 


6. In February, 1882, a Sandy Hook buoy was found near Ber- 
muda. 


7. In February or March, 1882, a buoy was washed ashore at 
Pendeen Cove, Penzance Bay, England. 


8. In the spring of 1882, the Swedish bark Abraham Lincoln 
picked up a buoy in lat. 32° 30’, long. 28° 40’. 

9. October 22, 1883, a buoy was picked up on the east side of 
Teneriffe in lat. 28° 21’, long. 16° 15’. 


10. October, 1883, a second buoy was picked up fifteen miles 
from the east coast of Teneriffe. 


11. August 20, 1883, the British bark Jane Richardson picked 
up a buoy in lat. 24° 11’, long. 32° 48’, 


GENERAL MEETING. 15 


All were identified as the property of the United States by letters 
cast in the plates. 

The charted currents of the ocean readily explain the courses 
and account for the positions of many of these buoys, but others 
appear anomalous. 


Mr. JENKINS cited an instance of a bell-buoy, carried away from 
the coast of the United States in 1850, which was seen and heard 
while adrift and finally stranded on the southwest coast of Ireland. 

Mr. WELLING suggested that the phenomena might not be refer- 
able to ocean currents exclusively, but in part to wind currents. 
Mr. Jonnson judged from the forms of the buoys that their move- 
ments would be controlled more by currents than by winds. 

Mr. H. Farquuar and Mr. JENKINS were of opinion that the 
buoy picked up off Florida might have been carried there by the 
southward coast-current. Mr. Dawu concurred, but thought it also 
possible that it had made the entire circuit of the Sargasso sea. 

Mr. Daut, referring to Mr. WELLING’s suggestion, said that 
wind and current worked together, and their effects could not be 
discriminated. The wind does not blow prevailingly in any direc- 
tion without coercing currents to correspondence. 


247TH MEETING. FEBRUARY 16, 1884. 
The President in the Chair. 
Fifty-four members and guests present. 


The Auditing Committee reported through its Chairman, Mr. C. 
A. Wuirs, that it had examined the accounts of the Treasurer for 
1883, finding the same properly vouched in respect to expenditures 
and receipts. On motion of Mr. Durron, the report was accepted. 

The Chair announced the election to membership of Mr. Henry 
Wayne Buair and Mr. Hersert GoUVERNEUR OGDEN. 


Mr. F. W. CLARKE made a communication on 


THE PERIODIC LAW OF CHEMICAL ELEMENTS. 


After giving an account of the law as worked out by Newlands, 
Mendelejeff, and Lothar Meyer, he exhibited an enlarged copy of 


16 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Meyer’s atomic volume curve, drawn with the latest values for both 
atomic weight and specific gravity. On the same,sheet was also 
drawn a similar curve, illustrating the connection between atomic 
weight and melting point, and it was shown that in the latter the 
highest portions correspond to the lowest depressions in the atomic 
volume curve. The opinion was expressed, in view of the regu- 
larities exhibited by these curves, that the elements had originated 
by some method of evolution, and that a future transmutation of 
one element into another was not improbable. 


In reply to a question by Mr. Farquhar, Mr. CLARKE said that 
search was being made for similar evidence of system in the spectra 
of the elements, but that the subject was rendered difficult by 
reason of the fact that not all the lines of the spectra fall within 
the range of visibility. 

' Mr. ANTISELL remarked that while the determination of the 
atomic weights of the elements was one of the most important 
labors which the modern chemist could be occupied with until a 
final constant numerical result should be arrived at, and until the 
other properties of matter which appear to have some definite 
relation with the atomic weight were rigidly investigated, there was 
necessity for continued effort to search into those hidden relations; 
but if by such investigation it was believed that we could arrive at 
any certainty about atoms, their form and structure, or about matter 
itself, we should be much disappointed. Situated as we are on a 
cold planet, we are precluded from ever arriving, by the study of 
matter from a standpoint merely terrestrial, at any ideas of the 
ultimate nature of atom or molecule, or whether there be really 
any such thing as “elements” or one form of matter wholly dis- 
tinct from another. ‘To arrive at a knowledge of matter, pure and 
simple, we must have ready means for dissociating all compound 
matter, and we have at our command at present no such methods 
or apparatus on this globe. Subjection to intense heat is required, 
and our most glowing furnaces and the are light itself is insufficient 
for the purpose. It calls for the exhibition of such heat as is pro- 
duced in the sun and its atmosphere to reduce our elements, as we 
term them, to the more simple condition of matter as it exists under 
solar temperature, and the present spectroscope and its.future im- 
provements by which such dissociation is to be studied. The 


GENERAL MEETING. fu § 


investigations of Huggins and Lockyer and other spectroscop- 
ists have revealed to us the presence of several of our so-called 
elements in the solar atmosphere; but constant observation has 
raised in the minds of these observers grave doubts whether the 
spectral lines of the elements, as obtained by observation of them 
in our atmosphere, are universally of such or whether only con- 
ditionally so, that is true only in our cold atmosphere. Doubts 
have arisen as to the spectral lines of elements being permanent 
characters of their essential nature, seeing that the spectral lines 
of an element, which at one time resemble those of copper, are 
found to be interchangeable and attached to a different element, as 
calcium, and that there are elements which possess the character of 
giving multiple spectra, as carbon, for example, which, under these 
solar temperatures, yields no less than three distinct and charac- 
teristic spectra. 

In view of these apparently contradictory and confusing results, 
obtained by the examination of matter found in the solar atmos- 
phere, which are so different from those obtained from matter in 
our own atmosphere, it behooves us to be very cautious in asserting 
the existence of any distinct elements so called, or whether there be 
only one matter under various cosmical conditions. 

Other remarks were made by Messrs. DooLiTrLE and WHITE. 


Mr. H. A. Hazen made a communication on 
THE SUN-—GLOWS, 


opposing the theory that they are due to dust, either cosmic or vol- 
canic, and advocating a theory involving electrical action in con- 
nection with frost particles.* 


A general discussion followed, in which Messrs. ELurorr, PAvut, 
Rosinson, Hauy, Durron, GILBert, and E. Farquyar, partici- 
pated. 

Mr. Exxiorr advocated the electrical origin of the glows, basing 
his argument on the simultaneousness of the phenomena through- 
out the planet, on the transparency of the glow as shown by obser- 
vations on Lyre, and on the extraordinary abundance of sun 
spots for the past few weeks. 


* This paper is published in full in the American Journal of Science for 
March, 1884; Vol. XX VII, pp. 201-212. 
c 


18 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


248TH Mrerinc. Marcu 1, 1884. 
The President in the Chair. 
Forty-two members present. 


The Chair announced that Messrs. CHARLES Oris BouTELLE, 
GitBert THompson, WILLARD DRAKE JOHNSON, and EUGENE 
RicKsECKER had been elected to membership. 

It was announced from the General Committee that standard 
time would hereafter be recognized in the opening and closing of 
the meetings. 


Mr. R. D. Mussty read a paper entitled 


THE APPLICATION OF PHYSICAL METHODS TO INTELLECTUAE 
SCIENCE. 


The aim of the paper was to show in how far those methods 
which had been successfully employed in the investigation of the 
phenomena of nature, and which were denominated the Physical 
Sciences, were applicable to those sciences, the subject-matter of 
which were mental operations and their results, and which, for dis- 
tinction, might be named the Intellectual Sciences. Some illustra- 
tions were given of the application of these methods to the study 
of the law; and the paper concluded with the remark that its 
writer desired it to be regarded as a suggestion rather than a solu- 
tion of the problem stated: “How far and in what way physical 
methods and physical sciences help thinkers to say Therefore.” 


Remarks were made by Mr. Roprnson. 
Mr. I. C. Russe_i made a communication on 


DEPOSITS OF VOLCANIC DUST IN THE GREAT BASIN. 


[ Abstract. ] 


In contrast with the aridity of the Great Basin at the present 
time, geologists have shown that during the Quaternary it was 
crowded with lakes. In studying the sedimentary deposits of one 
of these fossil lakes, named Lahontan by Mr. King, I found strata 


GENERAL MEETING. 19 


of white, unconsolidated, dust-like material, which is undistin- 
guishable in general appearance from pure diatomaceous earth. 
Beds of this material, varying in thickness from a fraction of an 
inch to four or five feet, were observed at a number of localities 
in the sides of the cafions that have been carved in lacustrine 
strata of Lahontan age by the Humboldt, Truckee, Carson, and 
Walker rivers. Deposits identical with those of the Lahontan 
sections were observed at a number of localities among the moun- 
tains of Nevada and California at an elevation of several hundred 
feet above the former level of Lake Lahontan and at a distance of 
forty or fifty miles from its borders, thus showing that the deposits 
were both sub-aerial and sub-aqueous in their mode of accumu- 
lation. Further exploration revealed the fact.that similar beds 
occur abundantly in Mono Lake Valley, where they may be seen 
to pass into well-characterized fragmental deposits of pumice and 
obsidian, thus suggesting that the finer material was also of volcanic 
origin. Experiment confirmed this hypothesis. Under the micro- 
scope the dust from a number of widely separated localities was 
found to consist almost wholly of angular flakes of transparent 
glass, with scarcely a trace of crystallized matter. When a sam- 
ple of pumice from near Mono Lake was reduced to a fine powder, 
it was found to present the same physical and optical properties 
as the dust in question, with which it also agreed closely in chem- 
ical composition, as shown by analyses made by Dr. Chatard, of 
the Geological Survey. 

The Mono Craters, from which this dust is supposed to have been 
erupted, form a group of cones about fifteen miles in length, situ- 
ated in the southeastern part of the Mono Lake Valley, California. 
These extinct volcanoes are composed almost entirely of pumice 
and obsidian, in the condition both of coulées and lapilli, the latter 
constituting cones of great symmetry and beauty, the grandest of 
which have an elevation of nearly three thousand feet above Mono 
Lake. Some of these craters were in eruption during Quaternary 
times, while others were active after the ancient lakes and glaciers 
of the region had passed away. Many times during their history 
vast quantities of lapilli and dust were thrown out. As the 
volcanic dust interstratified with the sediments of Lake Lahontan 
is undistinguishable from that deposited in the Mono Basin, there 
is little room for doubting that they had a common origin. The 


20 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


greatest distance from the Mono Craters at which the dust was 
observed, was in the Humboldt Cajion, about two hundred miles 
northward of the point of eruption. 

At three localities in the Lahontan Basin the bones of extinct 
mammals were found closely associated with the deposits described 
above, thus furnishing the suggestion that the showers of fine vol- 
canic dust were, at least to some extent, fatal to animal life. 


Mr. ANTISELL said it was useless to look for the source of vol- 
canic dust in existing volcanoes on the land. Pumice in the 
character of fine particles, as exhibited, is exclusively the product 
of submarine eruption. Other remarks were made by Mr. Harx- 
NESS. 


Mr. Lester F. Warp read a paper entitled 


SOME PHYSICAL AND ECONOMIC FEATURES OF THE UPPER MIS- 
SOURI SYSTEM, 


in which he described the process by which the valleys of the Lower 
Yellowstone and Upper Missouri are formed, and pointed out the 
importance and the feasibility of utilizing the water of these rivers 
for purposes of irrigation.* 


Mr. GILBERT said that Mr. Ward’s description of the process 
by which the Missouri constructs its flood plain was verified by a 
nearly identical group of phenomena observed by himself on the 
lower course of the Colorado. Mr. Exxiorr concurred with the 
speaker’s view that the system of irrigation should be inaugurated 
by national action rather than local. Mr. Ritry was of opinion 
that the proposed plan of irrigation was entirely feasible, and said 
that the final solution of the grasshopper problem lay in the culti- 
vation of the northern plains. 

Mr. BurcHarp said that while the political advantage of a con- 
tinuous belt of settlement uniting the Atlantic and Pacific States 
was undeniable, he questioned the advisability of increasing at 
present our agricultural production. 


* This paper was subsequently separated into its two natural divisions, 
and the part relating to the ‘‘ physical features ’’ was published with illus- 
trations in the ‘‘ Popular Science Monthly ’’ for September, 1884 (Vol. XXV, 
pp. 594-605), while that relating to the ‘‘economic features’”’ appeared in 
‘‘Science”’ for August 29, 1884 (Vol. IV, pp. 166-168). 


GENERAL MEETING. 21 


249TH MEETING. Marcu 15, 1884, 
The President in the Chair. 
Fifty members present. 


The Chair announced the election to membership of Messrs. 
Mark BrickKELL Kerr, SAMUEL Hays KAUFMANN, JOSEPH 
Sizas DILLER, CHARLES Henry WuHits, and WILLIAM Lavw- 


RENCE. P 


Mr. G. K. Gitpert made a communication on 


THE DIVERSION OF WATER COURSES BY THE ROTATION OF THE 
EARTH. 


[Abstract. ] 


It being admitted that the rivers of the northern hemisphere are, 
by the rotation of the earth, pressed against their right banks, and 
those of the southern hemisphere: against their left banks, it re- 
mains to determine whether this pressure is quantitatively sufficient 
to appreciably modify the courses of rivers. Opinion is divided, 
and the results of observation have been largely negative. Those 
who regard the cause as insufficient to produce observable results 
have approached the subject from two points of view, which are 
illustrated by the discussions of Messrs. Bertrand and Buff. The 
former computes that a river flowing in N. lat. 45° with a velocity 
of three metres per second exerts a pressure on its right bank of 
s3ss0 Of its weight, and regards this pressure as too small for con- 
sideration. The latter points out that the deflecting force, by com- 
bining with gravitation, gives the stream’s surface a slight inclina- 
tion toward the left bank, thereby increasing the depth of water 
near the right bank, and consequently increasing the velocity of 
the current at the right. This increment of velocity has a certain 
erosive effect, but it is regarded as less than that assignable to wind 
waves on the same water surface, so that the prevailing winds have 
a more important influence than the rotation of the earth. 

The object of the paper is to consider the theoretical effect from 
anew point of view. The form of cross-section of a stream flow- 
ing in a straight channel depends on the loading and unloading of 
detritus, anti is essentially stable, its character being naturally 


22 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


restored if accidentally or artificially modified. The distribution 
of velocities within this cross-section is symmetrie, the swiftest 
threads of the current being in the center and the slowest adjacent 
to the banks. If now curvature be introduced in the course of 
the channel, centrifugal force is developed. This centrifugal force 
is measured by the square of the velocity, and is therefore much 
greater for the swift central threads of the current than for the 
slow lateral threads. The central threads, tending the more strongly 
toward the outer bank, displace the slower threads at that bank, 
and the symmetry of the distribution of velocities is thus destroyed. 
As pointed out by Thomson and others, this redistribution of velo- 
cities determines the erosion of the outer bank and the simultaneous 
deposition of detritus along the inner bank. 

It has been shown by Ferrel that the deflecting power of the 
rotation of the earth upon a body moving on the surface is equiva- 
lent to the centrifugal force which would be developed if the body 


followed a circular course with radius of curvature (p) equal to 
v 


2n cos. # | 
angular velocity of the earth’s rotation, and % the polar distance of 
the locality. 

The effect of rotation on a stream being equivalent to a centri- 
fugal force is identical in kind with the effect of curvature of 
channel,* and this identity renders a quasi-quantitative comparison 
possible. Humphreys and Abbott found during flood a mean 
velocity of the Mississippi river at Columbus of 8.4 feet per second. 
The value of p corresponding to this velocity and the polar dis- 
tance of the locality is about 20 miles. The actual bends of the 
channel in the same region, which depend for their features on the 
velocity and volume of the river at flood stage, have a radius of 


In this expression v is the velocity of the body, n the 


* The author has since seen reason to modify this statement. The two 
effects are not strictly identical in kind, because the effect of rotation varies 
with the first power of the velocity, while the effect of curvature of channel 
varies with the second power. For this reason the selective power of curva- 
ture is, for the same deflective force, double the selective power of rotation. 
The introduction of this consideration would modify the numerical results 
derived from the Mississippi river, but would not impair the qualitative 
conclusion. A modified treatment of the subject will be found"in the Ameri- 
ean Journal of Science for June, 1884; Vol. XXVII, pp. 427-482. 


GENERAL MEETING. a8 


curvature of about 13 miles. Centrifugal force being a simple in- 
verse function of radius of curvature, it follows that the deflective 
force by which the river is impelled toward its right bank by virtue 
of rotation is proportioned to the force by which it is impelled 
toward its outer bank on acute bends in the ratio of 13 to 20. That 
is to say, in this particular instance -the rotational deflective force 
is 73 per cent. of the deflective force from curvature of channel. 

The process of lateral corrasion isso complex that it is impossible 
to convert this result into terms of erosion and consequent deflec- 
tion of stream channel, but a consideration of the manner in which 
the two deflective forces are combined sufficiently indicates that that 
due to rotation cannot be ignored. Wherever the stream bends 
toward the left the centrifugal force developed by the curvature is 
augmented by the rotational force; wherever the stream turns to- 
ward the right the centrifugal force is diminished by the amount of 
the rotational force; so that the tendency of the swiftest threads of 
current to approach the outer bank must be notably greater in one 
set of bends than in the other. } 

If this analysis of the subject is legitimate, the rotation of the 
earth ought surcly to modify the courses of rivers to such extent 
that the modifications are observable phenomena. Exception should 
however be made of two important cases: first, rivers which are 
rapidly deepening their channels are by that fact held rigidly to 
their original courses, and are not deflected either by rotation or 
by any other cause; second, those parts of rivers whose function 
is deposition instead of erosion, should theoretically, under the 
influence of rotation, built their alluvial plains higher on the right 
hand side than on the left, and having established an inclination 
of the alluvial plain toward the left, should thereafter meander 
over the plain with ‘equal facility in all directions. It is only in 
the. middle courses of streams, where the work performed by the 
water is chiefly that of transportation, that the discovery of the 
effects of rotation should be expected. 


Mr. Warp remarked that in the regions especially discussed the 
river courses are, in general, southerly, while the prevailing winds 
are westerly, so that the influence of the winds is opposed to what- 
ever influence may be exerted by rotation. Mr. ABBE said that 
the tendency of driftwood toward certain river banks, cited by 


24 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


von Baer, had been plausibly explained as due to prevailing winds, 
but such action is purely or chiefly superficial, andsa less important 
factor in erosion than the behavior of thé main current, which is 
comparatively little influenced by winds. Nevertheless, he was 
surprised that the rotational influence admitted of so large a quan- 
titative expression. 

Mr. Dawu said that the northward-flowing rivers entering the 
Arctic ocean afforded at their mouths no evidence of the effect of 
rotation. The summer winds of Arctic regions are from the north- 
east and east, and these produce on the north coast of America a 
shore-current, which drifts the beach sand and shingle westward, 
and deflects the river-mouths in the same direction. All the rivers 
from the Mackenzie to Point Barrow illustrate this tendency. On 
the coast of Siberia the fresh water discharged by the large rivers 
has been observed to turn eastward, although the winds would 
tend to throw it the opposite way. The Arctic ocean is there 
deeper; and it is believed that its principal currents are controlled 
by the northeasterly set of the general currents of the North 
Atlantic. 

Mr. Rogprnson spoke of the indirect influence of wind on river 
channels, through drifting sand. "Mr. Hazen pointed out that the 
influence of wind might be eliminated from the problem by study- 
ing the streams running east or west. Mr. BourreLLe suggested 
that the course of the Mississippi did not indicate any result of 
rotational influence. Mr. E. FarquHar inquired whether the 
behavior of the Gulf Stream and other ocean currents was in accord- 
ance with the theory of rotational influence; and Mr. Dau re- 
sponded that in the discussion of ocean currents this cause had lately 
dropped out of sight, the determination of courses being ascribed 
to the winds. 

Mr. Mussey inquired whether the acuteness of continental 
masses toward the south admitted of an explanation based on the 
effect of terrestrial rotation; and Mr. Durron responded by saying 
that the mass of speculation in regard to the recurrence of certain 
forms of continental outline had never really accomplished more 
than the statement of the fact. The fact itself is an accident, 
dependent on the volume of the ocean and the general laws govern- 
ing the formation of mountain chains. If the ocean were five 
hundred feet deeper, or five hundred feet shallower, the forms of 


GENERAL MEETiNG. 25 


continents would be so far different that all the existing resem- 
blances would disappear... The pointed extremities of some conti- 
nents are merely expressions of the fact that mountain chains are 
more or less linear, and do not hold the same height throughout 
their whole extent. 


Mr. G. E. Curtis read a paper on 


THE RELATIONS BETWEEN NORTHERS AND MAGNETIC DISTURB- 
ANCES AT HAVANA, 


upon which remarks were made by Messrs. ABBE and COFFIN. 
[It will be published by the Army Signal Office as Signal Service 
Note No. XIII.] 


Mr. GiLBERT recurred to the subject of Mr. Russell’s paper of 
the preceding meeting, and dissented from the view advanced by 
Mr. Antisell in regard to the origin of pumice. Mr. ANTISELL 
announced that he would discuss the matter more fully at some 
future meeting. 


250TH MEETING. Marcu 29, 1884. 
Vice-President MALLERY in the Chair. 
Forty-two members present. : 


The Chair announced the election to membership of Messrs. 
Basit Norris and WILLIAM STEBBINS BARNARD. 


Mr. J. S. Bruurnes spoke briefly on 
COMPOSITE PHOTOGRAPHY APPLIED TO CRANIOLOGY, 


exhibiting several composite photographs of skulls. Adult male 
skulls of the same race were selected for composition and were 
photographed in sets of from 7 to 18—front, side, and back views 
being separately taken. The composition was directly from the 
skulls and not from the photographs, 

Incidental mention was made of the uncertainty of measure- 
ments of cranial capacity by means of shot. Not only did differ- 


26 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ent observers obtain widely different determinations from the same 
skull, but the same observer was not able to obtainrclosely approxi- 
mate results in successive determinations. 


Mr. G. Brown GoopE made a communication on 
FISHERIES EXHIBITIONS, 


giving a list of all international exhibitions and describing es- 
pecially those of Berlin (1880) and London (1883). The adminis- 
trative systems of these two national exhibits were contrasted, and 
the social and economic results of the London exhibit were ex- 
plained. [The substance of the paper will be published in the ex- 
ecutive report on the London and Berlin exhibitions. ] 


Mr. M. H. DoortrrLeE began a communication on 
MUSIC AND THE CHEMICAL ELEMENTS, 


but was unable to complete it before the hour for adjournment. 
The remaining portion was postponed until the next meeting. 


By unanimous consent adjournment was deferred for a few 
minutes in order to afford Mr. Antisell an opportunity to reply to 
a criticism made at the previous meeting in regard to his views on 
. the origin of pumice. 


251st MBErTING. APRIL 12, 1884, 
The President in the Chair. 
Forty-one members and guests present. 


Announcement was made of the election to membership of 
James ARRAN Maner, Joun BeLtknap Marcou, Joun MILton 
Grercory, Francis Trrrany Bow es, and Witit1AmM EIMBECK. 


GENERAL MEETING. 27 
Mr. M. H. DoouirrLe made a communication on 


MUSIC AND THE CHEMICAL ELEMENTS. 


[Abstract. ] 


The mathematical theory of music requires the satisfaction of 


: Sane, sag 
the equation 2* = (5) nearly ; in which, for equal temperament, 


x = the number of equal intervals in the octave, and y = the 
number of these intervals that correspond to a nearly perfect fifth ; 
and, for untempered music, x = the number of approximately 
equal intervals in the octave, and y = the number corresponding 
to a perfect fifth. 

The above equation gives 


log 3 
Ey _ 176091 Type 
| art bg a nearly = 301080 7 ly; 
and by the method of continued fractions we obtain the succession 
7 24 31 


f i ti Ta coe Spr bee 
GF approximations > 5 777) pa" ) dio. 
For scales appropriate to major thirds, but disregarding fifths, 
we may substitute 2 for S in the above equations, and obtain 
HOE ts WO ae 
th t >) ==» oy 
Py OPPPOREMBORE ia). 5a! ea 
vibration ratio 7 : 4 (called by Ellis the subminor seventh), we may 


&c. For the chord having the 


Paes ; : Abi 
obtain in like manner the approximations % oF &e. 


Ue ahaa: : ; 
Since Cham Cy the first two series of approximate fractions 


include a common scale of twelve intervals to the octave, of which 
seven intervals give the fifth, and four give the major third. The 
first and the third of these series include a scale of five intervals 
to the octave, of which three constitute the major third, and four 
constitute the subminor seventh. There is some reason to believe 
that this is the scale of Japanese music, with the intervals 
Tea Ole ueeiney: We ; S : 

ca a c CAM aids a Five-tone scales have universally prevailed 
in early music; but it is questionable whether the vibration ratios 


28 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


have in any case involved the prime number seven. It would be 
interesting to know what scale best represents the songs of wild 
birds. 

There is much reason to believe that simple mathematical princi- 
ples underlie the phenomena of chemistry. It is not, a priori, 
absurd to suppose that matter in some way conforms to the prop- 
erties of the primes 2, 3, and 5; in which case such derivative 
numbers might be expected prominently to appear as prominently 


: : : ay Silents 
occur in the science of music. The fraction 75 might reasonably 


be expected. 

If all the keys of a piano should be arranged seven consecutive 
keys in a line, the next seven in the next line, and so on, the columns 
give successions of fifths. It has been shown that if the chemical 
elements are arranged in the order of their atomic weights in lines 
of seven, the columns contain elements remarkably similar to each 
other. We seem to have a chemical scale remarkably analogous 
to the ordinary musical scale. If the piano keys be arranged in 
lines of twelve, the columns give octaves; but nothing is devel- 
oped from a similar arrangement of the chemical elements, whence 
it may be inferred that the observed analogies are accidental, and 
have no true logical basis. 

If the intervals of the chemical scale could be supposed to cor- 
respond to the seven intervals of the diatonic scale, the non-appear- 
ance of the twelve-fold relation would be accounted for; but, while 
the diatonic scale may have some claim to be called natural, it is 
not directly established by algebraic investigation of the relations 
of prime numbers. Until the discovery of chemical flats and 
sharps, there will be insufficient reason to regard the present chem- 
ical scale as diatonic. 


Mr. Leravour illustrated the connection between tone and 
wave-length by means of a logarithmic spiral of base 2, the har- 
monic notes having radii vectores equal to multiples of the principal 
note. 

Mr. Exvxriorr said he had learned from Mr. Poole that he had 
endeavored, in his euharmonic organ, to produce perfect chords in 
all keys without temperament. | 

Mr. KumMMELL remarked that in modern music the,intervals of 
the major and minor thirds are the most important, because with- 


GENERAL MEETING. 29 


out them there is no harmony. This is also apparent from the well- 
known rule in thorough-bass that a third with its fundamental 
note is to be treated as a complete chord. Now it happens, in 
dividing the octave by equal temperament into 12 equal parts, 
that a major third is nearly 4 and the minor third nearly 3 of 
these, and thus we obtain not only tolerable fifths, but also tolerable 
, thirds, and the requirement of thirds for harmony is approximately 
fulfilled. They are still better fulfilled, of course, if we divide the 
octave into 41 or 58 parts, as Mr. Doolittle has shown. As to the 
seventh harmonic, Poole and Helmholtz rightly hold that it should 
be and is used by instruments which can temper. It is obviously 
the fourth element of the chord of the dominant G, B, D, F, the F 
being the seventh harmonic to the G two octaves below (nearly 
so in equal tempcrament and exactly in natural harmony), and 
this chord in modern music forms the opposing harmony to the 
tonic chord C, E, G, in major, and C, E flat, G, in minor. Instru- 
ments with fixed tones like the piano-forte have to use equal tem- 
perament, and thus virtually reject all natural harmony except the 
octave. This defect is generally inappreciable in very slow move- 
ments, but may be noticed by a very cultivated ear. 

Other remarks were made by Messrs. CLARKE, Mussry, and 
HARKNESS. 


Mr. H. FarquHar read a 


REVIEW OF THE THEORETICAL DISCUSSION IN PROF. P. G. TAIT’S 
“ PNCYCLOPZDIA BRITANNICA” ARTICLE ON MECHANICS. 


[ Abstract. ] 

This article covers seventy-four quarto pages in the last edition 
of the Encyclopedia, and gives a thorough mathematical treatment 
of the subject. No innovations calling for comment—unless an 
extended use of the “fluxional” notation for derivative functions 
be so regarded—appear until near the end, where two and a half 
pages are devoted to a disproof of the objective reality of force, 
and an advocacy of the disuse of the term in scientific writing. 
The character of the publication, and the eminence of the author 
in mathematics and physics, entitle his arguments to a careful 
examination. 


30 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


In the first place, Prof. Tait infers that force can have no such 
reality as matter has, because it is to be reckoned positively and 
negatively—an action being opposed by reaction—while matter or 
mass is signless. This suggests two comments: (1), the author 
never questions the objective reality of space and time, of which 
realities it is an essential feature that to every direction or interval 
A-B, an equal direction or interval B—A, of opposite sign, corres- 
ponds; (2), the idea of a negative mass is not a self-contradictory 
one, and was once generally accepted. The element phlogiston was 
given up not because of any absurdity in ascribing levity to ma- 
terial substance, but because a form of matter with positive mass 
(oxygen), capable of explaining all the phenomena, had been actually 
separated and identified. 

Prof. Tait’s next criterion of objective reality is quantitative 
indestructibility, an attribute shared by time, space and matter, to 
which he adds energy. But the evidence of the indestructibility 
of energy is not of the same nature as that of the indestructibility 
of matter; for the latter in all its forms may be localized, and its 
density or elasticity measured; while the former, when stored up 

r “potential,” cannot be shown to possess any of the properties of 
energy kinetic, or any existence in space, or any objective character 
whatever. Prof. Tait admits this difficulty virtually, and awaits 
for its solution the discovery of some evidence “as yet unexplained, 
or rather unimagined.” All strains and other actions of a clock- 
weight on its supports are obviously precisely the same—or impalp- 
ably somewhat stronger—with the weight wound up an inch, as with 
it wound up a yard; and the existence of a greater “potential 
energy” in the latter case is to be found not in the clock, but in 
the mind, which requires this expression as a form in which to put 
its conviction that a certain greater amount of work can be obtained. 
Even though it be admitted that there are no other intelligible 
terms in which this conviction can be stated, it is clear that the 
indestructibility of energy is an ideal and subjective truth, and 
cannot, therefore, be relied on as evidence of a reality distinctively 
“objective.” 

A third point made by Prof. Tait against force is that its nume- 
rical expression is that of two ratios: “the space-rate of the trans- 
formation of energy” and “the time-rate of the generation of 
momentum.” These results are obtained by simple division, in an 


GENERAL MEETING. ol 


equation which expresses the fact that the work done by a body in 
falling the distance A is just that required to lift it through A against 
gravity. The fallacy involved in treating the numerical expression 
for force as force itself, has been well exposed by Mr. W. R. Browne 
(in a criticism of the same article, L. E. D. Phil. Mag. for Novem- 
ber, 1883); and the assumption that ratios are necessarily non- 
existent is even more fallacious. Were it trustworthy, Prof. Tait’s 
deductions would not be the only ones admissible. His equations 
would lead quite as conclusively to proofs of the non-objectivity 
of space and time (the former becoming the rate of work-units, 
the latter of motion-units, per unit of force), and so to a confirma- 
tion of the celebrated German view, that that which is universal 
and necessary in thought, belongs to the Subject; or they might 
even give mass in the form of a ratio, and hence suggest the non- 
objectivity of matter. 

Not the least of the Professor’s objections against force, it would 
appear, is that it is “sense-suggested.” It isa mere truism to say 
that no other suggestor is possible, within the domain of science, 
It is, perhaps, better worth while to call attention to the indubitable 
fact that the real, if not the avowed, ground of the objection 
against “action at a distance,” entertained by many physicists, is 
that such action is not directly suggested by sense-impressions. This 
is what they must mean by calling it “occult;” actions as our con- 
sciousness knows them, and as we can produce them, being gene- 
rally characterized by proximity undistinguishable from actual 
contact. Further, if there is any reproach in this epithet, energy 
is quite as open to it as any function of energy can be. In fact, 
our senses directly report work, in the form of nerve-disturbance, 
and nothing else. Force is no more truly an inference from nerve- 
reports testifying of energy exerted, than is matter. In fact, the 
‘inference of the independent existence of matter is the less direct — 
and more questionable of the two. The view advocated by Mr. 
Browne, following Boscovich, that matter is but “an assemblage 
of central forces, which vary with distance and not with time” or 
with direction, is one of great simplicity as well as suitability to 
analytic treatment, and one of which no disproof is possible. 


The paper was discussed by Messrs. DooLirTLe and Exiorr. 


co 
bo 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


252p MEETING. Aprit 26, 1884. 


Mr. Harkness in the Chair. © 
Thirty-eight members and guests present. 


Announcement was made of the election to membership of 
Messrs. Davip Porter Hrear and Toomas MAYHEW WoopRrvrFr. 


Mr. J. R. EASTMAN made a communication on 


A NEW METEORITE. 


[Abstract.] 


A mass of meteoric iron weighing 113 pounds was accccidently 
discovered in the making of an excavation at Grand Rapids, Mich- 
igan, and was examined by the speaker in 1883. One face shows 
evidence of fracture, and the greater part of the remaining surface, 
of fusion. A very small sample submitted to Mr. F. W. Taylor 
for chemical examination had a specific gravity of 7.53 and a com- 
position : 


Tron i ; r d 94.54 
Nickel : : : ! 3.81 
Cobalt : i i 3 .40 
Insoluble (about) ‘ : 12 


The stone is supposed by its holders to consist of gold and silver, 
and to be the buried treasure of a miser. This delusion has caused 
it to form the subject of a lawsuit. 


The communication was discussed by Messrs. Bates and F. W. 
CLARKE. 


Mr. W. H. Datu read a paper on 


CERTAIN APPENDAGES OF THE MOLLUSCA.* 


* Published in the American Naturalist, Vol. XVIII, pp. 776-778. 


GENERAL MEETING. 33 
Mr. J. S. DILLER made a communication on 


THE VOLCANIC SAND WHICH FELL AT UNALASHKA OCTOBER 20, 
1888, AND SOME CONSIDERATIONS CONCERNING ITS 
COMPOSITION. 


[Abstract. ] 


The sand is composed chiefly of crystal fragments of feldspar, 
augite, hornblende, and magnetite, with a considerable proportion 
of microlitic groundmass and a very few splinters of volcanic glass. 
Its mineralogical composition is that of a hornblende andesite; but 
the chemical analysis by Mr. Chatard shows it to contain only 
52.48 per cent. of silica,—which is much more basic than the average 
for that group. The character of the minerals, as well as the gen- 
eral composition of the sand, indicated so clearly that the crater 
from which it must have issued was erupting hornblende-andesite, 
that I was led to seek an explanation for its paucity in silica. 

With this purpose in view, a number of volcanic sands and dusts 
from various parts of the world were examined and compared with 
the lavas to which they belong. First and most important among 
these is a sand from Shastina, a crater named by Captain Dutton, 
upon the northwestern flank of Mt. Shasta, in northern California. 
This sand, like that from Unalashka, is composed chiefly of crystal 
fragments of feldspar, augite, hornblende, and magnetite, with 
fragments of microlitic groundmass. Besides these, there are many 
pieces of hypersthene crystals and pumiceous glass. The sand con- 
tains 60.92 per cent. of silica, while the hornblende-andesite lava 
(rich in hypersthene) of Shastina, to which the sand belongs, con- 
tains 64.10 per cent. of silica. 

From these and other examples it may be stated as generally 
true that volcanic sand is composed essentially of crystalline frag- 
ments, and contains less silica than the lava to which it belongs. 

With volcanic dust, however, the case is different. Microscopical 
examination shows that it is composed chiefly of volcanic glass 
particles; and as far as chemical analyses have been made, they 
indicate that volcanic dust is more silicious than the lava to which 
it belongs. 

That volcanic sand should be crystalline and basic, and the 
accompanying dust vitreous and acidic, as compared with the lava 

9 


34 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


to which they belong, is not merely determined by accidental cir- 
cumstances, but has its inception in the magma before the eruption 
takes place. By the process of crystallization magmas are fre- 
quently divided into a crystalline solid portion, and an amorphous 
more or less fluent portion. Basic minerals are the first to crys- 
tallize, so that as the process advances the amorphous remnant of 
the magma becomes more and more silicious. The crystals are 
generally thoroughly intermingled with the amorphous magma, and 
in the latter are accumulated nearly all of the absorbed gases 
under great tension, so that when the pressure is relieved it may 
be blown to fine silicious dust, which may be carried by the wind 
many miles from its source, while the solid crystalline portion will 
contribute chiefly to the formation of sand, and be precipitated 
comparatively near the crater from which it issued. 

In cases where no previous crystallization has taken place in the 
magma before it comes to violent eruption, the voleanic dust then 
formed will have about the same chemical composition as the lava 
to which it belongs. Myr. Russell has recently described an inter- 
esting case of this kind in the western part of the Great Basin. 
It appears to be generally true that if other conditions are favor- 
able the difference in chemical composition between volcanic sand 
and dust is directly proportional to the amount of crystallization 
in the magma before its ejection. 

The basic character of the Unalashka sand may be explained by 
supposing that the silicious portion of the magma was carried away 
in the form of dust. ‘ 

The source of this sand is supposed by the collector, Mr. Apple- 
gate, the Signal Service Observer at Unalashka, to have been the 
new crater formed last autumn, near the Island of Bogosloff, about 
sixty miles away. 


Mr. Durron spoke in commendation and amplification of Mr. 
Diller’s contribution to geologic philosophy. Mr. Datu described 
the geographic relations of the volcano from which the Unalashkan 
dust was presumably derived, showing the improbability of the 
eruption having been directly observed. He spoke also of the dis- 
tribution of the Aleutian volcanoes and the lithologic characters 
of their ejectamenta. - 

There ensued a general discussion of the nature and properties 


GENERAL MEETING. 35 


of volcanic dust and of the theory which ascribes recent meteo- 
rologic phenomena to the dust ejected by Krakatoa. In this Messrs. 
Duron, Pau, W. B. Taytor, Drier, Ropinson, and Warp 
participated. Mr. Durron pointed out that their process of for- 
mation tends to give volcanic dust particles a quasi-definite size, 
and probably does not produce a large amount of dust fine enough 
for indefinite suspension. The greatest distance to which volcanic 
dust has been definitely ascertained to travel is eight hundred miles. 

Mr. Paut argued from the violence of the Krakatoan explosion 
its competence to charge the atmosphere at very great altitudes, 
and considered the fineness of the dust a sufficient explanation of 
its indefinite suspension. 

Mr. Taytor said the phenomenon to be accounted for was 
specially remarkable, first, for the unusual elevation of the finely- 
divided smoke or dust extending far above the highest cirrus clouds, 
or probably to twenty or thirty miles above the earth’s surface (as 
shown by its twilight duration); secondly, for its wide diffusion 
(covering a large fraction of the terrestrial atmosphere); and 
thirdly, for the long continuance of its suspension in the air (ex- 
tending over many months). Mr. Lockyer and Mr. Preece had 
suggested an electrical condition of the matter as favoring both its 
extraordinary diffusion and its equally extraordinary suspension. 
This hypothesis seemed to the speaker very plausible. Electricity 
is a phenomenon of volcanic eruption, and dust particles charged 
with electricity in the same sense with the earth would be repelled 
not only by one another, but by the earth. At thirty miles above 
the ground the air is not only very rare, but is practically anhydrous, 
and the discharge of electricity is impossible. 

Mr. DILLER, in response to a question by Mr. Paul, said that the 
microscope reveals no limit to the fineness of Krakatoan dust. The 
higher the magnifying power applied, the greater the number of 
particles visible; and this relation extends to the limits afforded by 
the capacity of the instrument. To more powerful microscopes, 
yet finer particles would presumably be visible. 


36 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


253p MEETING. , May 10, 1884. 
The President in the Chair. 


Fifty-four members and guests present. 


Announcement was made of the election to membership of 
Messrs. JonN Murpocu, Romyn Hircucock, WiLiiam SMITH 
Yeates, GrorGE Perkins MERRILL, and FREDERIC PERKINS 
DEWEY. 


It was announced that a vacancy in the General Committee, 
occasioned by the resignation of Mr. J. J. Knox, had been filled 
by the election of Mr. F. W. CLarkeE. 


By invitation, Mr. G. H. Witiras, of Baltimore, Maryland, 
addressed the Society on 


THE METHODS OF MODERN PETROGRAPHY, 


first, defining the field of petrography, and second, discussing the 
methods of petrographic investigation. These methods dre: (1), 
chemical; (2), mechanical; (3), optical; (4), thermal. The chem- 
ical methods are quantitative and qualitative. The mechanical 
methods include the separation of the constituent minerals of rocks 
by precipitation in heavy solutions and by the use of electro-mag- 
nets. The optical methods include the preparation of thin sections, 
their examination by transmitted ordinary light, and their exam- 
ination by polarized light, for the determination of crystallographic 
system, pleochroism, and angles of extinction. The thermal methods 
are chiefly synthetic, consisting in the artificial production of min- 
eral aggregates for the purpose of determining the processes of their 
natural production. By the regulation of temperatures in fusion 
and refrigeration all varieties and all structures of basic rocks are 
reproduced. Acidic rocks have not been thus reproduced, and it 
is believed that great pressure is a condition of their genesis. 


Mr. Durrton spoke of the bearing of modern petrographic in- 
vestigations on some of the greater problems of geology. 


GENERAL .MEETING. 37 
There followed a symposium on the question 
WHAT IS A GLACIER? 


[ Abstract. ] 


Mr. I. C. Russevu: In framing a definition of a glacier it is 
evident that we must include both alpine and continental types, 
and also take account of the secondary phenomena that are com- 
monly present. With this preamble we may define a glacier as an 
ice-body, originating from the consolidation of snow in regions 
where the secular accumulation exceeds the loss by melting and 
evaporation, 7. ¢., above the snow-line, and flowing to regions where 
loss exceeds supply, 7. e., below the snow-line. 

Accompanying these primary conditions, many secondary phe- 
nomena dependent upon environment, as crevasses, moraines, lami- 
nation, dirt-bands, glacier-tables, ice-pyramids, etc., may or may 
not be present. 

Mr. 8. F. Emmons: The glacier is a river of ice, possessed, like 
the aqueous river, of movement and of plasticity. In virtue of 
the latter quality it adapts itself, though more slowly, to the form 
of the bed in which it flows. The névé field is the reservoir, from 
which it derives not only its supply of ice, but the impulse which 
gives it its first movement. The névé is formed by the snows which 
accumulate in relatively wide basins above the snow-line from 
year to year, living through the heat of summer. Its mass may be 
more or less compact, according as it is thicker or thinner, and it 
may have a certain movement, which will be greater or less, accord- 
ing to the greater or less inclination of the basin; but until it moves 
from its wide and shallow bed into a narrower and deeper one, and 
thus gives outward proof of the plasticity of the ice of which it is 
composed, it does not become a glacier. It may be crevassed. 
Often a long crevasse at its upper edge gives definite proof of its 
movement; and this movement may cause a cracking or crevassing 
in other points, resulting from the unevenness of its bed. It may 
or may not carry blocks of rock on its surface, but these would be 
rare, and never in the well-defined moraine ridges that are formed 
upon the glacier proper. Not, however, until its form had essen- 
tially changed to fit the bed in which it flows should it be considered 
to ee a glacier proper. 


38 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Mr. W J McGee: The phenomena of glacier ice and névé ice 
appear to belong to a graduating series; and in eonsequence the 
two phases can only be arbitrarily discriminated. Any classifica- 
tion depending upon coincidence of the loci of apparent transition 
from the first phase to the second with oct of sudden constriction 
or abrupt acclivity in the valley is artificial and incompetent, 
since such coincidence is fortuitous; the classification depending 
upon the ability of the second phase to sustain bowlders upon its 
surface is superficial and incompetent (provided such ability be due 
to density of the ice), since the sub-surface density of the névé, 
being determined by its age and the pressure of the superincumbent 
mass, must, in some portions, equal the surface density of the gla- 
cier; and the classification depending upon rate of motion is equally 
incompetent, since motion is common to the entire ice-mass, and. 
abruptly varies only where conditions of glacier-bed are suddenly 
variant. Arbitrary diagnostic characters may and should be, how- 
ever, agreed upon by consense among glacialists. Perhaps the 
most satisfactory line of demarkation detectable is the snow-line, 
above which superficial débris is buried by precipitation, and below 
which it is exposed by ablation. 

Mr. W. H. Datu: It is proper to discriminate masses of ice 
moving in a definite direction from the immense fields of ice which 
are practically stationary. The term “glacier” should be restricted 
to the former. A glacier is a mass of ice with definite lateral 
limits, with motion in a definite direction, and originating from 
the compacting of snow by pressure. Moraines are not diagnostic; 
and the definition should not include those masses of arctic ice 
which, by reason of their low temperature, are fixed in position. 

Mr. T. C. CoaAmBerytin: Nomenclature is a matter of conveni- 
ence. When subjects rise into familiar thought and frequent 
reference brevity of expression calls for specific names. But terms 
arising thus from a natural demand are not closely discriminative. 
Hard and fast lines of demarcation do not prevail in nature, but 
rather gradations of character. Were it otherwise names of sharply- 
defined application could be more freely used. The terms névé and 
glacier doubtless originated to satisfy the convenience of guides and 
travelers, and were without strict scientific application. In attempt- 
ing to give them scientific definition, I think we shall,fail of satis- 
faction by making them structural terms. The better distinction 


GENERAL MEETING. 39 


is genetic. There is an area of growth and an area of waste to 
every glacier, and the distinct recognition of the two in quaternary 
glaciers is likely to rise to some importance. Superficially the area 
of growth coincides with the névé; the area of waste is that of the 
‘glacier proper. From every annual snow-fall there remains, at the 
time of maximum summer melting, a remnant that feeds the gla- 
cier. This is the névé for that year. The area may be greater or 
less in different seasons. The névé-field is accurately shown only 
on the day of maximum waste. 

A contribution of much value, bearing upon the property of ice 
which permits glacier motion, has recently been made by Petterson, 
who has demonstrated, by refined experimentation, that ice, es- 
pecially if impure, shrinks as it approaches the melting point and 
becomes plastic. © 

Mr. C. E. Durron desired to reiterate the remarks of Mr. 
Chamberlin to the effect that definitions can rarely or never be 
made rigorous. Glaciers, no doubt, vary in their characteristics like 
almost all other groups of phenomena. There is little difficulty in 
recognizing a glacier when all those features which characterize it 
are present, and when the conditions are of the ordinary nature. 
But exceptional cases arise. The lower parts are sometimes want- 
ing and the névé alone remains, or the portion where the névé 
passes into the glacial stream may constitute the termination. In 
the latter case those who desire to be extremely precise in their 
phraseology might hesitate. It should seem best, whenever an 
occurrence is modified or defective, to use the term “glacier,” with 
a qualification which shall express the particular circumstancs. 

Remarks were also made by Messrs. GILBERT and ELLiort. 


254TH MEETING. May 24, 1884. 
The President in the Chair. 
Twenty-six members and guests present. 


It was announced from the General Committee that after the 
255th meeting, June 7, the Society would take a vacation until 
October 11. 


40 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


A request on behalf of the coming Electrical Exhibition at Phil- 
adelphia for instruments and books was communicated to the Society. 


Mr. H. H. Bares read the following paper on 
THE PHYSICAL BASIS OF PHENOMENA. 


If there is anything entirely disheartening, it is to see the few 
landmarks of human achievement disappear before the shifting 
current of opinion, as headlands disappear under the ceaseless 
buffeting of the ocean. It is no doubt a matter of poignant regret 
to the cherisher of ardent theological convictions to see the bulwarks 
of faith slowly undermined by controversy. So, also, to him who 
has built his convictions on supposed demonstrable and irrefragable 
fact, to find nothing unassailable, not even the axioms and postu- 
lates conceded for ages as first principles, on which the fabric of 
science was reared, nor the sublime inductions of Galileo and 
Newton, on which the modern philosophy called natural—the only 
fruitful philosophy which man has produced—has been founded. 

But the course of criticism shows that there are no first princi- 
ples. Nothing is unquestionable. Even the mathematic joins 
hands with the metaphysic. I propose briefly to examine the fun- 
damental grounds of mechanical philosophy, in view of the wide 
divergence of basal hypotheses in recent years, and especially on 
account of the importance conferred upon certain speculations by 
their admission into works of standard reference and authority.* 

To do this aright it isnecessary to go behind the mere sub-science 
of mechanics to the essence and substance of things, as did the 
eighteenth-century philosophers succeeding Newton. The obser- 
vational data which have accumulated since that time by the splen- 
did efforts of the molecular physicists enable us to review and recast, 
with some promise, the primary dogmas regarding the physical basis 
of phenomena. It is legitimate to frame hypotheses on subjects 
which are still unfathomed, but which confessedly do not belong to 
the domain of the unknowable. The distinguished example of the 
authors of the vortex atom would alone justify such a conclusion. 

No entirely satisfactory hypothesis of the atom has yet been 


* Encyclopedia Britannica, 9th Ed., Articles ‘‘ Mechanics,’’ ‘‘ Measure- 
ment,’’ etc. 


GENERAL MEETING. 41 


found. I do not design to discuss the vortex atom here at length; 
for, although it is the most successful form of the Cartesian doctrine 
of vortical substance, it has not been perfected, and is generally 
regarded rather as an example of remarkable speculative and math- 
ematical ingenuity, than as a discovery, corresponding with any 
facts of objective physics. It has insuperable difficulties, some of 
which have been pointed out by Clifford, and others by Clerk- 
Maxwell. Moreover, unparticled or continuous substance, the 
necessary postulate in this hypothesis, is something we not only 
have no experience of, but find full of inconsistencies with ex- 
perience, when we gain a clear conception of what it implies. Such 
a conception fulfills Hegel’s paradox that being and non-being are 
the same, since it forbids all mobility, all differentiation, as was 
perceived by the followers of Democritus. It simply affords an 
inviting basis for analytical discussion, on account of the elimina- 
tion of the very conditions of objective existence which make the 
mathematical difficulty. 

There are some postulates regarding substance which we may 
probably be permitted to assume at the outset. We may postulate 
its objectivity, and also its discontinuity. I have no space to review _ 
here the time-worn controversy between continuous and discontin- 
uous substance. The arguments, which are exhaustive from the 
metaphysical side, are as old at least as Democritus and Anaxa- 
goras. Suffice it to say that modern experiential philosophy has 
decided the battle experimentally in favor of the discontinuity of 
matter. The dispute only lingers in the region of the atom, where 
observation cannot penetrate or has not penetrated. The inability 
to conceive which attaches to all non-experiential affairs is encoun- 
tered here, coupled with the too great facility of conceiving what 
is superficially observed, but will not bear analysis. Thus our first 
impressions of substance are in favor of its continuity. It is only 
after much reflection that we get the idea of necessary discontinu- 
ity, as bound up with the exhibition of existing phenomena. But 
the wonderful development of the Cartesian mathematics, in con- 
junction with the infinitesimal calculus, and its great facility in 
dealing with geometrical continuities, has tacitly revived the Car- 
tesian idea regarding the nature of matter, as synonymous with 
space relations, which never reached intelligible development at the 
hands of its author, and wholly declined and disappeared after the 


42 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


establishment of the Newtonian philosophy, and the discovery of 
the discrete character of substance. 

In point of fact, experience would point to extreme porosity or 
discreteness as characteristic of substance, rather than to its oppo- 
site—perfect continuity. The infinite divisibility of space has 
nothing in the world to do with the question, though this is a con- 
fusion often fallen into. On the contrary, there is an infinite dis- 
tinction between the infinitesimal discrete units of substance, occu- 
pying extension by their interactivity, and the passive infinitesimal 
resolvability of space continuity. This is the antipodean difference 
between the Epicurean and the Cartesian conceptions; the former 
admitting of the operations of force, the free exhibition of motion, 
the organization of material phenomena, which are phenomena of 
mobility; the latter constituting a plenum, with only ideal divisions, 
and phenomenally as necessarily barren a negation as space itself. 

Substance is purely experiential. In its essence it is still incom- 
prehensible, because experience has not yet reached down to those 
recesses. We know nothing of substance except by its manifesta- 
tions. These manifestations are cognized by us through sense im- 
pressions, weighed, compared, adjusted, and analyzed in the mys- 
terious alembic of the mind. First impressions have enormous 
predominance, and are intensified by heredity of cerebral predis- 
position and function. 

We cognize substance only in bulk by direct perception, and 
these vast aggregations stand in thought for matter. A drop of 
water contains incomparably more molecules than the ocean con- 
tains drops; a grain of sand more particles than the earth contains 
grains; and it is this vast mesh of complicated forces that forms 
the integrated concept of matter to our apprehension. The child, 
before he can walk, encounters obstacles to movement, reaction to 
his every muscular effort, of equal measure to his own; and thus 
his first and profoundest convictions of objective existence are asso- 
ciated with resistance, opposition, repulsion. This impression of 
matter is so early that it remains with us as its most natural and 
obvious characteristic. 

The idea of weight is also one of the earliest experiences. This 
idea would not be conceivable to a denizen of the deep sea, for 
our first ancestor who emerged from the water gained theexperience 
at the cost of great struggle and enterprise. By the natural devel- 


GENERAL MEETING. 43 


opment of muscle and function the child rears itself very early 
against the constant pull of our pedestal, triumphs over it with 
new-found energies, dances on tiptoe, and spurns the ground, but 
is soon content to draw the battle, to wander around a few weary 
years on equal terms, at length to call in the aid of a stick or 
crutch, and, finally, to resign the unequal contest, and sink, van- 
quished and satisfied, to rest in its bosom. Weight thus seemed a 
natural characteristic of matter until identified and generalized by 
Newton as a universal and especially a reciprocal property. This’ 
generalization transferred the property, in conception, from the 
naturally heavy body to a cause outside thereof, namely, the earth 
itself. Here the human mind relucted, for, unlike repulsion, attrac- 
tion is not an observational fact. All forms of tension, stress, 
constraint—by whatever name called—are attended in the child’s 
experience with an intermediary connection. ‘The string is neces- 
sary to pull the cart, and the action of the magnet upon the iron 
particles is viewed with astonishment and awe. The sense of mys- 
tery does not proceed so far in his case as to contemplate the equally 
mysterious power which makes his string differ from a rope of sand. 
The most profound attention of the human mind has not yet 
fathomed this mystery. 

Inertia or mass is a less obvious property, being in early obser- 
vation and in common apprehension bound up with weight. It 
was not recognized in philosophy till Galileo’s time, nor is it now 
by the common perception, except after training. A lady makes 
no scruple of asking to have a loaded car or train or vessel stopped 
at a given point on the instant, and reinvested with motion any 
number of times; and would-be inventors often contrive theoretical 
machines having numerous heavy reciprocating parts timed to 
. velocities impossible of execution. With beings under other con- 
ditions it is wholly different. The sword-fish, e. y., can have no 
conception of gravity, as he has no perception of it, but his appre- 
hension of inertia is finely cultivated, through the muscular sense, 
in setting up and modifying the rapid movements in which his © 
existence delights, as well as through his vivid realization of mo- 
mentum, in the piercing of a whale or a vessel, by which his 
function is so powerfully exhibited. When once realized by human 
perception, however, inertia becomes identified with substance as 
its most primary characteristic. 


44 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The old scholastic property of impenetrability, also, is one of 
the superficial notions of experience, gained in the same way as 
that of repulsion. It seems to pertain to solids—the typical mat- 
ter—with approximate accuracy, though calcined plaster of Paris 
and water, e. g., will occupy a good share of each other’s volume, 
and still form a highly porous solid. But a quart receiver full of 
hydrogen can have a quart of carbonic acid gas deftly introduced 
into it as into a void space; and so can a quart of water, at ordinary 
temperature and pressure, according to Gmelin, without increase of 
volume, although water is the type of material continuity. As to 
impenetrability in the molecule we can predicate nothing. The 
evolution of heat in chemical combinations indicates penetration of 
volume, with reorganization of the molecule in less space; and there 
is no reason, except a scholastic one, why two or more molecules, 
or even atoms, should not occupy the same place, as admitted by 
the highest authority—James Clerk-Maxwell. 

Dimension is also a common notion, derived similarly from supe- 
ficial and early experience. Solids alone have figure and assign- 
able dimension, though liquids have fixed volume, and gases variable 
volume, in inverse ratio to constraint; but even solids are of vary- 
ing and fluctuating dimensions, according to temperature, density, 
etc. Solidity and liquidity are, it is well known, but mere transi- 
tory conditions of material aggregation, for all matter is capable, 
by sufficient accession of molecular motion, of assuming that hyper- 
bolic or expansive condition which we call gaseous, and in this 
state dimension and impenetrability are meaningless terms. Con- 
cerning dimension as a necessary attribute of the unit of mass, 
Clerk-Maxwell says (Encyclopedia Britannica, 9th Ed., Vol. 3, p. 
37): “Many persons cannot get rid of the opinion that all matter 
is extended in length, breadth, and depth. This is a prejudice 
* * %* rising from our experience of bodies consisting of im- 
mense multitudes of atoms.’ That there is no necessary relation 
between mass and volume as there is, e. g., between mass and weight 
is shown to common experience by the notably different masses of 
a buck-shot and a pith-ball of the same dimensions, or of a cannon- 
ball and a child’s hydrogen balloon. A pellet of iridium equiva- 
lent in mass to the pith-ball might be microscopic, and, by extreme 
supposition, infinitesimal. We are not forced, however, to deny to 


GENERAL MEETING. 45 


the unit of mass finite magnitude, as this would be an experiential 
fact when ascertained. 

The remaining so-called properties of matter are too obviously 
transitory, accidental, or derivative to require attention. Color, 
luminosity, opacity, transparency, sapidity, sonority, odor, texture, 
temperature, diathermancy, plasticity, hardness, brittleness, density, 
compressibility, conductivity, malleability, fusibility, solubility, and 
many others, are too clearly but conditions of aggregation, or else 
mere subjective states due to the way the complicated interactions 
of the primary qualities affect our senses. What are the primary 
qualities ? 

Here is where the modern method of philosophy flags, by the 
disappearance one by one of the experimental means of approach, 
as we eliminate the non-essentials. But though the substance is 
thus elusory, we cannot yet believe it to be illusory. 

Chemical and molecular physics have already gone marvellously 
beyond the ordinary range of sense-perception, by strictly scientific 
methods. Not only is the discrete character of matter established, 
but many data of the differentia and organization of the molecule 
are discovered. Here is a vast field of science in itself. From the 
ideal molecule, or simple couple, up through the 70 actual organized 
molecules of our provisional elements, then the chemical molecules 
of their combinations in vast numbers, discovered and undiscovered, 
and, lastly, the enormously complex organic molecule in infinite 
variety, the domain transcends in area for classification that of 
biologic science. The simple molecule has not yet been discovered, 
much less the molecular constituent, the atom, or the indivisible. 
It is evident, however, that the properties of matter which are 
essential, not differential, must reside in the atom. The philoso- 
phers succeeding Newton treated the atom and the elementary 
molecule as one, from lack of sufficient chemical knowledge. We 
are on a higher plane of information, but their method is not nec- 
essarily vitiated by such lack of distinction. 

We cannot, as before said, attribute @ priori to the atom dimen- 
sion or figure, though we postulate it to aid conception. As the 
atom is an absolute unit, there is incongruity in finally assigning to 
it such relative attributes, which are but matters of comparison 
and degree. There are properties, however, which are inseparable 
from an absolute essence. These are the properties by which the 


46 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON, 


essence is manifested to us. We know them provisionally as forces, 
in the Newtonian nomenclature. Had gaseous matter neither 
weight nor mass, we could not know of its existence. But these 
attributes are so constant in matter that we estimate its quantity 
in terms of them and have no other exact terms. Weight is the 
statical measure; mass the dynamical measure. And since weight 
and mass correspond for all substances, under all transformations, 
we judge that the correspondence identifies them alike with the 
essence. They cannot be the mere result of organization. They 
must belong to the ultimate atom. 

At this point it would seem proper to attend to a question of defi- 
nition. Definitions are essential to clearness, on the one hand, and 
a source of entanglement on the other, if we fall into the scholastic 
error of regarding a mere word as the coextensive symbol of an 
idea. Words are evolved during the imperfection of ideas, and 
language is still a most imperfect medium of expression. Hence, 
logic is not a science in the sense that mathematics is. I have used 
the term force. This is a word of much ambiguity of meaning. 
We may use it as a convenient mathematical expression fur a mere 
rate of change of momentum, or we may go farther and define it, 
as that which changes a body’s state of rest or of uniform motion 
in a straight line; either of which uses restricts it to only a portion 
of phenomena, and ignores the whole science of statics, dealing with 
forces in equilibrium and the phenomena of balanced stress. If we 
give it a more general signification, as that which changes or tends 
to change, or conserve, the state of motion of particles, or systems 
of such, either in quantity or direction, we embrace statics as well 
as kinematics, and get a measurably philosophical definition, if we 
bear in mind the proviso that we do not thereby postulate force as 
an entity apart from substance. 

And since the compound variable space and time condition which 
we call motion (of which rest is but a phase) is the sensible result- 
ant of the interaction of such discrete substance by constant rear- 
rangement where readjustment is free, or the potential resultant 
where confined, we may admit that the observed tension and per- 
sistence, of whatever form, is that which effects the phenomenon 
(though masked by infinite variety and composition), and always 
across the discontinuity: not as separate entities, but as modes of 

manifestation of the interacting and pervasive substance itself and 


GENERAL MEETING. 47 


its only manifestations. This we call force—the inscrutable agent 
of phenomena—and this I take to be the true Newtonian concep- 
tion, as evinced by his maturest conclusions, expressed in query 31 
appended to his Optics. (B. 3, 2d Ed., 1717.) 

So far as weight goes, it was generalized by Newton to be a 
reciprocal force or stress, operative without limit on the law which 
inheres in radial space relations—the inverse square of the dis- 
tance. The term operative means effective upon mass, namely, 
bridging the discontinuity. Gravity is the typical attractive foree— 
vis centripeta. The relation is mutual by the law of action and 
reaction, and amounts to a universal tension among particles, con- 
trolling all matter everywhere into orderly movements and relations. 
This is what we postulate from observation, on the Newtonian plan 
of naming simply what we see. The notion, however, of action at 
a distance has encountered a metaphysical difficulty in many minds, 
from the preconception derived from ordinary experience that all 
affections or stresses must proceed through an intermediary connec- 
tion, deemed continuous. Even Newton made concession to this 
prejudice in his oft-quoted letter to Bentley. That there is really 
no such continuity in any mode of connection known is demonstra- 
ble, and the notion itself that the fancied continuity of some rare 
effluvium could in any way aid the mechanics of the problem is 
chimerical. Clerk-Maxwell, moreover, has shown (Nature, Vol. 7, 
p- 324; Encyclopedia Britannica, Vol. 3, p. 63) that action at a 
distance is as necessarily implied in repulsion as in attraction, so 
that theories of repulsion do not aid conception. Ability or ina- 
bility to conceive, furthermore, is not held even by the metaphysi-: 
cians to be a criterion of objective truth. Such truths exist inde- 
pendent of the conceiving mind. The conceiving organ was evolved 
by experience, and conception develops with attention. The first 
law of motion was wholly inconceivable to the contemporaries of 
Galileo, and we find such instances even now. Thus, while plain 
truths are inconceivable until established, some utter absurdities 
have been deemed conceivable, as, for instance, vacuity of two 
dimensions. State of mind, then, is no measure of external truth.* 


* In this connection, to illustrate how entirely a matter of opinion or pre- 
judice or culture is this notion of conceivability, I quote from a letter 


48 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The second force or manifestation of the atom, inertia,—or mass,— | 
unlike gravity, is not unlimited in range of agtion. As to this 
property matter is discrete. Mass has both a locus and a limit 
(being apparently dependent for dimension on multiplicity), and 
amounts to that incomprehensible property by which conservation 
of motion is maintained. Under gravity, quantity of motion varies 
according to relations of contiguity, but under inertia motion is 
conserved in direction and quantity, is modified in direction and 
quantity by interaction of mass with gravity, and is redistributed 
by interaction with repulsive force upon an indefinitely near ap- 
proach of particles, upon conservative principles. Its discreteness 
gives matter its numerical and finite character, and admits of that 
interplay which constitutes phenomena.* Its reality and primary 


written by Faraday to Dr. Playfair, in response to some inquiries of the 
latter about his atomic opinions: 


* * * “T believe in matter and its atoms as freely as most people—at 
least, I think so. As to the little solid particles which are by some supposed 
to exist independent of the forces of matter, and which in different sub- 
stances are imagined to have different amounts of these forces associated 
with or conferred upon them, * * * as I cannot form any idea of them 
apart from the forces, so I neither admit nor deny them. They do not 
afford me the least help in my endeavor to form an idea of a particle of 
matter. On the contrary, they greatly embarrass me; for, after taking an 
account of all the properties of matter, and allowing in my consideration for 
them, then these nuclei remain on the mind, and I cannot tell what to do 
with them. The notion of a solid nucleus without properties is a natural 
figure or stepping-stone to the mind at its first entrance on the consideration 
of natural phenomena; but when it has become instructed, the like notion 
of a solid nucleus apart from the repulsion, which gives our only notion of 
solidity, or the gravity, which gives our notion of weight, is to me too dif- 
ficult for comprehension; and so the notion becomes to me hypothetical, 
and, what is more, a very clumsy hypothesis.’’ (Playfair’s works, Vol. 4, 


p- 84.) 


Here we see a difficulty opposite to that usually encountered, for, while 
many people profess an infirmity of conception of the forces apart from the 
imaginary vehicle, Faraday finds the vehicle of no use as a carrier of the 
properties, but a positive impediment. 


* This property has a multiplicity of names in the Newtonian nomencla- 
ture, according to the varying aspect of its function. Thus, in the aspect 
of persistence of mass in state of rest or of motion uniform in direction 


GENERAL MEETING. 49 


character, when once apprehended, have proved more acceptable 
to the imagination than has the conception of central force, 
and under appulsion hypotheses (with the aid of that other readily 
accepted property, repulsion, and certain highly artificial hypo- 
thetical media), it has been made to do duty in providing so-called 
explandtions of gravity, under its form of vis viva. 

It has always seemed to me that the mode of approach adopted 
by Boscovich was the most philosophical and rigorous of any. He 
viewed matter for the purposes of mathematical treatment and for 
investigation of its essentials, as divested of accidental and fugitive 
properties; and as the analytical calculus had not then become so 
developed as to wholly fascinate the attention of geometers with ab-, 
stract and ideal relations, he proceeded from prime physical data. 
He thus identified matter by those apparently general and charac- 
teristic properties recognized by Newton as the basis of mechanical 
philosophy in conjunction with the laws of motion. These proper- 
ties are, as before said, gravity, inertia, and repulsion; or, as char- 
acterized by function, attraction, conservation, distribution. In 
this view matter consists of certain loci of central forces, mutually 
attractive by the first property according to a variable law in the 
duplicate inverse ratio of distance without limit, but restricted in 
manifestation as to the second property to the infinitesimal locus, 
thereby excluding unitary dimension. Contemplating matter un- 
der this aspect alone, a dilemma arose. For gravity waxing by 
the law of inverse squares of the distance up to the focus or origin 
involves the consideration of infinite force and apparently of infi- 
nite velocity in the limit,in the supposable case of rectilinear ap- 


and quantity, i. e., of resistance to change of state except in conformity 
with motion impressed, the property is called vis imsita, which may be vis 
insita activa (momentum), or vis insita passiva (vis inertie of mass.) In 
its aspect of acquirement of a new state of motion by interaction with other 
forces or masses, Newton called the new state thus superposed vis impressa ; 
which, when the operation of acquirement has ceased, becomes again vis 
insita. In its aspect of persistence of mass towards uniform direction of 
motion under the constant deflective stress of vector central force, it is 
called vis centrifuga. And in its active form, conditioned by motion ac- 
quired, its capacity for furnishing motion from its store, either for impressing 
motion upon other mass, with consequent loss, or for supplying the poten- 
tial fund under the drain of adverse central force, is called vis viva (energy.) 
> 


50 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


proach, at which point the equations become unexplainable. While 
Euler and La Place differ in their interpretations of the result, 
Boscovich sought to solve the apparent absurdity and inconceiva- 
bility by the invention of his ingenious and complex system of 
alternate spheres of attraction and repulsion, or change of sign, 
on a very near approach, with infinite repulsion at the focus, which 
so loaded down and vitiated his hypothesis as to cause its rejection. 
This result was similar to that of Le Sage’s speculations and those 
of the Ptolemaic astronomers, each thus working out the falsity of 
his respective scheme by superadded complications to readjust the 
theory to the progress of criticism or of observed fact. 

By attributing finite magnitude to the atomic mass, however, 
Boscovich’s difficulty disappears, as I had the honor of pointing 
out before this Society some ten years ago. This may be deemed a 
violent hypothesis in regard to a positive discrete simple absolute, 
as the atom is presumed to be, but parallel difficulties inhere in any 
other finite supposition, as, e. g., a sphere of repulsion. Under my 
provisional assumption, the way out follows from an elementary 
proposition of Newton’s, and it does not demand the gratuitous 
change of law or of continuity involved in the resort of Boscovich. 
The movement of a gravitating particle under stress of a center of 
gravitative force would be in all respects as the great 18th century 
mathematicians have demonstrated, until the margin of the par- 
ticle reached the attracting center, where, if we suppose the attrac- 
tive virtue to prevade the particle equally throughout a certain 
finite volume of mass, however minute, as gravity does the mass of 
a sphere, the maximum of attractive force would be attained ; for, 
as Newton has shown, homogeneous spheres are controlled under 
gravity by a law of force varying directly as the mass and inversely 
as the squares of the distance between their center of mass and the 
attracting center, at all points beyond the surface, and directly as 
the distance between the said centers within the surface; so that, 
after passing the surface, the attractive center must proceed on- 
wards to the gravitating center of mass (relatively), not by a force 
increasing to infinity, but by a force decreasing to zero, after pass- 
ing the maximum, since it is balanced at the center by opposing 
stresses.** 


* Let M be an exaggerated particle of mass and C'a fixed center of gravi- 
tation external thereto. Newton proved that for all positions outside of a 


GENERAL MEETING. yl. 


A similar law of attraction prevails between two gravitative par- 
ticles when both are similarly endowed with finite spherical volume 
and mass, excluding the idea of impenetrability (which is not a 
necessary attribute of mass), the Newtonian law being the product 


of the masses divided by the product of the distances (7) ” for 


outside positions. 


gravitating homogeneous spherical mass the stress is precisely as though the 
whole mass thereof were concentrated at the center of said sphere, and 
varies directly as the mass and inversely as the square of the distance be- 
tween the said center and the fixed center of gravitation; 7. ¢., G ~~ M 
d? 


The maximum of gravitating force will here be at the surface, where d is 
minimum. He also proved that at all points within a homogeneous gravi- 
tating spherical concentric shell a gravitating particle is uniformly affected 
by balanced attractions. Hence, the stress for any smaller concentric sphere is 
g Sat m m being the smaller spherical mass and 7 the reduced radius. 
mes 

But since homogeneous and similar masses are as the volumes, and similar 
volumes are as the cubes of the homologous dimensions, 


m Sem 7. i oagre S IR er SR 
Ye 


The maximum of gravitating force is here also at the surface, where r is 
maximum. 


*I write the formula this way because it is possible that we have been in 
error all along in regarding the denominator as a radial space relation, as 


Mm 


implied when we write it a In discussing the deflection of the particle 


under gravity, Newton, for mathematical simplicity, treated it as governed 
by a fixed attracting central force, and in testing various relations found that 
the radial space relation gave the true path of the planetary bodies under 
the immense preponderating influence of the sun’s mass. The fixed center 
of attraction is, however, a mathematical, not a physical, condition, and can 
only be realized by making M =o, when we get a form of expression 
which does not give a law of force. I think it possible that the relation is 
a mere reciprocal distance relation, since the stress is mutual for the masses 
and each is equally distant from the other. The inverse form of the relation, 
moreover, may arise from our subjective way of viewing distance, as meas- 
ured outwardly from ourselves, since we have to go from here to yonder. 
It is possible to look upon the relation as really one of contiguity or near- 


ness, and by placing = = ¢ we get the cosmical law of gravitation as 


Meme. This, however, would not be a useful formula, since we are not ac- 
customed to expressions which attain maximum value with minimum mag- 
nitude. 


52 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


For positions of encroachment the law is more complicated, and 
forms an interesting field for mathematical discussion. Where three 
or more atoms are superimposed the problem becomes too complex 
for discussion. It is noted, however, that such compound atom, if 
quiescent from extreme abstraction of heat, would be in a condition 
of elastic equilibrium, ready to respond like a bell to the slightest 
disturbances. In all these cases of interpenetration the law of stress 
would be finite and diminishing, and if the line of encounter should 
chance to be a right line through their centers (a condition infi- 
nitely rare in actual occurrence), they would continue on or repeat 
according to energy of approach; while upon any other lines of 
approach orbital relations would supervene, in modified curves of 
the second order, either hyperbolic, parabolic, or elliptic, according 
to velocity, and with or without partial penetration, according to 
nearness of approach. 

Boscovich, however, did not adopt this solution, although within 
his reach. The problem of the action of a gravitative particle as 
controlled by an attractive center has several aspects of statement, 
which may be confined to four, for practical investigation. In the 
first, where the particle is assumed to be without mass, no discus- 
sion is possible, for the two suppositious points instantly assume the 
same locality, and end the relation. In the second, where the par- 
ticle is endowed with inertia but not magnitude (and the attractive 
locus fixed by postulate), the element of motion enters, but infinite 
terms appear in the equations in the limit, forbidding interpretation. 
Thirdly, when we attribute finite magnitude to the gravitative par- 
ticle for gravitative pervasion, as in actual spherical masses, no in- 
finite terms appear, and we get an intelligible mathematical discus- 
sion, with planetary results for exterior positions, and pendulum 
results for interior positions, as I have heretofore demonstrated ; 
and lastly, when both the gravitating Joct are invested with similar 
attributes of volume and of mass (excluding extraneous notions of 
ordinary collision and repulsion from the problem), the results are 
similar to those of the third hypothesis. I do not introduce any 
of the mathematical discussions here, as the dynamics of the par- 
ticle have been fully treated by mathematicians, though I am not 
aware that any of them have pursued it to physical conclusions. 

It is not likely, however, that there is any matter so simple as 
this modified Boscovichian atom; that is, which can be identified. 


GENERAL MEETING. 5d 


All the matter we know of is already compounded and highly or- 
ganized. The ideal simple molecule would consist of a single pair 
of such atoms, bound to each other in orbital relations of more or 
less eccentricity, including the extreme rectilineal form of simple 
pendulum-like oscillation through one another’s centers; and it is 
a most significant fact that spectroscopic observation of all incan- 
descent matter shows atomic matter to be in this state of transverse 
or orbital oscillation with inconceivable but synchronous rapidity 
without regard to range, according to the pendulum law of stress 
varying directly as the range of oscillation, discovered by Galileo. 
Any theory of the simple molecule must take cognizance of this 
observed fact. Another cognate fact is that the law of elastic 
cohesion manifest in all elastic tensile action—“ ut tensio sic vis” — 
is a parallel law of stress, as illustrated in the spring balance weigh- 
ing scale, the spring dynamometer, the isochronous spring governor, 
etc., and is a function of molecular and ultimately of atomic force 
and distance. 
If the atom is really thus characterized, the repulsion or resistant 
property experienced in matter becomes worthy of investigation, 
since it drops,out as the primitive affection or disaffection postulated 
by Boscovich. I have shown that it is not necessary to oscillatory 
motion. We must admit that the notion of rebound or recoil, in 
the ordinary sense, between simple atoms possesses difficulties. No 
less does the idea of plasticity or destruction of momenta. Con- 
sider what is involved in the hypothesis of two absolutely hard, 
rigid, unparticled, homogeneous spherical bodies of any magnitude 
at all, if possessed of mass, meeting on a rectilineal central line of 
motion. We know what would happen in case of ordinary spherical 
elastic masses or aggregations of molecules. Such merely undergo, 
first, apparent contact, then compression, deformation, strain, accu- 
mulation of stress, retardation of velocity, momentary arrest, accel- 
eration on new lines of departure, relief of strain, recovery of form, 
redistribution of momenta, and final resumption of uniform veloci- 
ties, with relative motion inverted and aggregate energy of motion 
unimpaired, unless permanent distortion and heat have absorbed a 
portion. All this complex action is involved in the term elasticity. 
None of this could take place with simple undifferentiated particles, 
unless we invent for them a mystic atmosphere or cushion of repul- 


sive capacity surrounding the locus, as Boscovich was forced to do 
22 


54 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


by logical conclusions. Without this, contact would be absolute 
and instantaneous at first impact. As hardness,involves impen- 
etrability, absolute destruction of motion on the instant must ensue; 
that is, motion and no motion at consecutive instants of time; a 
discontinuity unknown to experience, and known to be inconsistent 
with the nature of motion and of time. This argument from breach 
of continuity is due to Leibnitz. Conversion into heat motion is 
excluded, heat being a mode of motion of the entire atom. More- 
over, the destroyed motion has to be recreated instantaneously in 
new directions, for destruction of energy cannot be postulated. 
This geometrically angular motion is also unknown to experience, 
for all deflected bodies pass by continuity from motion in one direc- 
tion into a new direction, and, so far as we can see, must do so. 
These discontinuities in translatory relations are therefore put aside, 
not because they are inconceivable, but as illogical and non-experi- 
ential. Simple repulsion by contact without occult intervention is 
a false suggestion, and we find that we get the pseudo-conception 
from our false observation of what occurs in the collision of sensible 
masses, somewhat as we make a false observation and generalization 
about material continuity, or about tension, from a superficial per- 
ception of matter; thus creating concepts from supposed experi- 
ence which can have no true objective counterparts. I shall recur 
later to a possible derivative basis for repulsion. 

It is remarkable that to Newton we owe the final establishment 
of the majority of those fundamental and universal truths which by 
simplicity and generality seem to touch the absolute; that is, more 
than to any and all other philosophers combined. Thus, of the six 
ultimate generalizations, four were formulated and placed on an 
impregnable basis by Newton: the three laws of motion and the 
law of gravitation. All of these were inconceivable when first pro- 
mulgated, were hotly controverted on the metaphysical plan, were 
finally established experientially, and are now generally accepted 
as axiomatic by the modern mind, except for sporadic reversions 
which appear now and then to deny their actuality and reassert 
their inconceivability. The remaining two universal inductions 
are the collective group of axioms formulating the relations of ex- 
tension—the only enduring remnant of the Greek philosophy—and 
the law of the conservation and unity of energy, unperceived in 
Newton’s time in its generality, though taught as a dogma by the 


-_— 


GENERAL MEETING. 00 


Cartesians. These also are still held to be inconceivable by certain 
disciples of metaphysical methods and axiomatic by others. Suen 
mental attitudes should lead us to believe that simplicity has been 
arrived at in all these cases and the boundaries of explainable 
knowledge reached, where inconceivability necessarily begins. 

It has been said that paradox is born either of confusion of 
thought, or of knowledge, or confusion of statement arising out of 
the imperfection or subtlety of the verbal vehicle of thought. Thus, 
as Clerk-Maxwell points out, the celebrated arguments of Zeno of 
Elea, establishing the inconceivability of motion, represented in 
the paradox of Achilles and the tortoise, were unanswerable and un- 
answered until Aristotle showed, some half century later, that du- 
ration is continuous and incommensurable by numerical methods 
in the same sense that extension is. The old logical dilemma of the 
irresistible force encountering the immovable body was insoluble to 
the Greek mind, both from lack of physical knowledge and lack of 
verbal clearness of statement. The acute sophist knew not the 
nature of force, the constitution of bodies, the conservation, trans- 
formation, and dissipation of energy, and consequently knew not 
the refuge and escape from the dilemma contained in the percep- 
tion of the conversion of molar energy into heat energy, expansion, 
and dissipation. The resources of verbal subtlety and of inner 
consciousness failed, as they always do. Something of the same 
difficulty remains in modern problems, where observation and strict 
verification are, from the nature of the problem, inapplicable, or 
where the confusion arises from the still-existing imperfection of 
language, or, again, where generalizations, both clearly made 
out and clearly formulated, have not passed into the instinctive 
popular apprehension. The modern dilemma of the inconceiva- 
bility of infinite or finite space is, I take it, due to the metaphysical 
form of the statement. For when we reflect that the ideas of im- 
mensity and of infinitesimal resolvability are but abstract generali- 
zations of the merely relative continuities, extension, distance, and 
dimension, which are in their turn but abstractions of the sense- 
perceptions, form, translation, and volume, the statement becomes 
intelligible and entirely conceivable, and I think, though with 
deference, saves geometry; that is, the universality of that system 
of inductive postulates regarding the relations of extension and 
inferences therefrom, known as geometry to the Greek philosophy, 


56 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


but now named Euclidean by certain analysts whose so-called 
geometry is symbolic. Geometry is therefore able*to deal with all 
aspects of extension, without regard to limit, in spite of some in- 
firmity in the Greek method, for scale cannot affect the generality 
of extension relations, and abstract unconditioned space is not an 
entity but a mere negation, concerning which relative propositions 
are unintelligible. A false philosophy regarding space is at the 
root of all modern heresies concerning geometry and mensuration, 
founded in misapprehension of the Euclidean inductions or gene- 
ralizations.* 

The first law of motion is but the formulated recognition of in- 
ertia, which is only manifest in conjunction with motion, actively 
or passively. It was known to Galileo, and laid down by Descartes 
as a law in his Principia. It is a cosmical truth, bound up with 
the absolute nature of mass and the true relations of extension, 
which correlates the whole fabric of dynamical knowledge with 
rectilinear geometry, curvilinear motion being demonstrably not a 
simple state of conservation under inertia, but a resultant of mul- 
tiple forces. The simple action of mass under the first law of 
motion, if undisturbed, furnishes the absolute unreturning recti- 
lineal path which overthrows all speculation about possible ideal 
spaces. I here recall a book written by a learned American of 
Philadelphia—learned, that is, according to the mediaeval stand- 
ard of the colleges—and published only during the past year, en- 


* There are two opposite though similar forms of error in the assumptions 
regarding space. The first is that space is a specific or perhaps generic en- 
tity or objectivity per se, possessed of conditions and attributes, like sub- 
stance, such as dimension (in several), differentia in locality, figure, as cur- 
vature, etc. (hence necessarily finite), and only uncognizable by us simply 
for lack of perceptive faculties to correspond. This is the fundamental 
error, as it seems to me, of Riemann and Lobatschewsky. The second is 
that of the older Cartesians, who viewed space as but the mere attribute or 
synonym of substance, and inconceivable apart from it, so that bodies sep- 
arated by void space would be absolutely in contact without regard to dis- 
tance. Both of these speculations are purely metaphysical, and non-exper- 
iential, the latter resulting from the old scholastic method of syllogistic de- 
duction from primary postulates of verbal definition, and the former from 
similar inferences from the forms of the analytical logic of symbols, the use 
of which is still in the scholastic stage. Like Zeno’s paradox, these merely 
intellectual difficulties should be removable by intellectual processes. 


GENERAL MEETING. 57 


titled “An Examination of the Philosophy of the Unknowable, as 
expounded by Herbert Spencer,” wherein he naively lays down the 
first law of motion as unintelligible except by appulsion. Motion, 
he says, in the absence of propulsion is inconceivable. I have no 
space here to reproduce the explanation evolved out of consciousness 
_ by this reasoner to account for the action of a ball struck by a bat 
after leaving the bat. It resembles in ingenuity and gratuity some 
of the inventions devised to explain gravity. The notable thing 
about it is that here, at this date, is a mind of good caliber, informed 
in the higher schools of learning, which is still of the mental period 
of Aristotle; a mind which has evidently never apprehended in- 
ertia, nor heard of the great contributions to knowledge made by 
Galileo and Newton, by which philosophy was entirely revolution- 
ized. 

The second law of motion, regarding the independence and co- 
existence of motions, on which we occasionally see comments in 
the metaphysical vein controverting its possibility, has long been 
established experientially, Its early experimental proof is attrib- 
uted to Galileo. Yet I recall a pamphlet written and published 
only during the last year by a learned German at Leipzig, the 
theme of which was that ‘the sun changes its position in space, 
therefore it cannot be regarded as being in a condition of rest.” 
This, he concludes, overthrows the entire fabric of Copernicus, be- 
cause the planetary orbits in such case cannot be closed. 

The third law of motion is but formulated reciprocal stress, in 
its modes of compulsion and repulsion, through which mass acts on 
mass to redistribute motion by what appears to be necessary law. 
The stress is necessarily reciprocal, since there is no point d’appui, 
or fixed fulcrum, in the universe. 

We have thus been brought to the boundary of the absolute, 
where all is inconceivable until found out, and where the simple 
data are unexplainable. All examination seems to continue to 
point to mass and weight as the ineffable simple insignia of sub- 
stance standing on this limit. We must accept something as ele- 
mentary fact; what shall we find more elementary? Repulsion is 
still debatable; for, if we make an issue between repulsion and 
compulsion as contradictory primary attributes of the same essence, _ 
or untenable in conjunction for artificiality, by far the greater dif- 
ficulties attach to the former, some of which I have already alluded 


58 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


to. The profound mind of Boscovich was forced to accept repul- 
sion as a primal quality, but in deference to the physical hypotheses 
of his time, he overloaded it with complication. This has been 
weighed in the balance of philosophical judgment and found want- 
ing. I have intimated that there are possible grounds for surmising 
that it may not be a simple property of the atom, but a mere mode 
of distribution of energy dependent on composition of motion of 
atomic mass after change of sign, 7. ¢., a mode of vis impressa after 
exhaustion of the space relation; for, mathematically, the hyperbolic 
lines of approach and recession of two atoms under the high proper 
motion characteristic of the atom, and on lines not directly central, 
would be similar, at sensible distances, in their asymptotes (which 
would be the practical paths), whether the deflection were due to 
attractive or repulsive stress, though acceleration and retardation 
at the passage of the infinitesimal focus would be inverted.* 


* It is well known that for any finite system of two particles controlled 
by gravity the lines of movement are closed curves of the second order, of 
more or less eccentricity, about the common center of gravity, which, for 
equal masses, would be midway. For an infinite system under the same 
conditions the orbits are parabolic, but for a system to which the particles 
enter by extraneous motion the lines of movement are hyperbolic, thus: 


WIG. bs 


Now, under repulsion, the lines of motion are seen to be similar, A B, D E, 
Fig. 2, being asymptotes of the hyperbolas representing the two paths at 
sensible distances : - 


GENERAL MEETING. 59 

It therefore seems to me immaterial to result which of the two 
modes of passing the infinitesimal focus is the true one. In either 
case the distance at passage is infinitesimal, and the force may be 
as near infinity as the facts require it to be assigned. The normal 
or rectilineal enzounter is here excluded from supposition. In that 
case, under repulsive stress, as postulated by Boscovich, the recoil 
would be rectilineal and opposite, without breach of continuity. 
Under attractive stress, with finite volume of the atomic mass, 
penetration would ensue as before shown; but without dimension 
or repulsion we have an insoluble condition, although the occur- 
rence would be infinitely rare. Only one pair of elements is here 
considered. In all real encounters, whether of masses or molecules, 
the effect is a vast resultant, but should not be different in kind 
from that of the elements; that is, hyperbolic or expansive between 
alien systems under motion. As the number of elements ordinarily 
engaged could not be represented by any numerical places of arabic 
notation for which we have names, we see the hopelessness of stat- 
ing the problem mathematically. I therefore do not presume to 


Hr, 2. 


This encounter represents only one element of the molecule, of which 
myriads are engaged at every recoil of molecules, not to speak of solids. 
It is thus seen that the mesh constituting the molecule is ordinarily impen- 
_ etrable to other meshes. If the curve F G be allowed to represent the out- 
line of the molecule, the limb of the solid to which it belongs, say a buck- 
shot, will be represented by the Sierra Nevada, or the Andes, and its diam- 
eter would be measurably represented by that of the earth, as approximately 
shown by Sir Wm. Thompson in the case of a drop of water. 


60 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


offer this as an explanation of repulsion, and I confess that to me 
repulsion is in its mechanism incomprehensible. *We know the re- 
sult experimentally, and that is resistance to penetration, and reac- 
tion at insensible distances on an undefined boundary which begins 
prior to contact and increases in a high exponential ratio as approx- 
imation progresses. The contact boundary of any solid—even the 
smoothest and hardest—resembles the astronomical limb of Jupiter 
in geometrical indefiniteness. The contact transmitter in the tele- 
phone, the whole range of whose phenomena occurs under pressure 
and so-called contact of varying degrees, illustrates how relative a 
thing is contact. Under high velocities the distinction between 
solids, liquids, and even zriform bodies entirely disappears in re- 
spect to repulsive reaction, though this is the most sensible distine- 
tion between them under low velocities. 

We may, therefore, adopt the conclusion that if any of the ap- 
parently simple properties of the atom are to be thrown out as de- 
rivative and secondary, presumption points to repulsion as the com- 
plex one. We could possibly account for phenomena in a universe 
bound together by purely tensile stress, but most of the sensible 
phenomena of solids—cohesion, affinity, tenacity, etc., including 
nearly all of statics—remain hopelessly unattackable problems un- 
der a hypothesis of pure repulsion, like that of Le Sage, or Pres- 
ton. It is to be noted that the kinetists who freely postulate repul- 
sion and appulsion, without analysis, as a primordial fact, but re- 
luct against compulsion or tension, are forced to the invention of 
the most complicated and gratuitous mechanism and media to ex- 
plain the phenomenon of gravity, and then without attainment of 
result. Le Sage’s atom is too complicated, even without his suppo- 
sitious or extra-mundane operative machinery; and the vortex 
atom is but a mere analytical expression for an unproducible con- 
dition in a figmentary mathematical plenum. 

The thesis that conservation is the characteristic by which we 
identify objective existence will not bear the test of examination 
It is only in the most recent times that such a quality has heen 
known or imagined, and its establishment, both as to matter and 
energy, is justly viewed as the triumph of modern philosophy. The 
evocation of matter from nothing and its relegation to nothing. 
even by the finite will of a wizard, was ever a common and universal 
notion, which did not at all impair the belief in its present reality 


GENERAL MEETING. 61 


and substantiality. We have only to go to Apuleius for this, and 
it is doubtful if even now the notion of the indestructibility of mat- 
ter is anything but a scientific conviction, for do we not see num- 
bers of our contemporary fellow-citizens meeting together frequently 
in our midst to witness feats of materialization out of nonentity by 
powers akin to those of the sorcerer, without an idea of incongruity ? 
Nor has the essentially modern doctrine of the conservation of en- 
ergy anything to do with the belief in its reality. Few people ap- 
prehend it even now. No philosopher understood it a hundred 
years ago. Its verity rests on a sufficiently general inductive basis, 
from the refined and exhaustive experiments of Joule, and the the- 
oretical conclusions of Mayer and Clausius, and it is accepted in 
the same sense that the law of gravitation is accepted. But the 
duality of matter and energy to the exclusion of force is a verbal 
shift, the assumption of which removes no difficulty. Matter, the 
object, remains unexplained; and energy, the phenomenon, becomes 
segregated and unintelligible. Energy, in fact, is but mass in phe- 
nomenal manifestation, being a product of triple factors, two of 
which—translation and speed—are not things, but variable and 
evanescent conditions, and, taken together, constitute motion. Mass 
is the absolute or persistent factor, but the evanescent character 
of the variable component—motion—would render the entire phe- 
nomenon—energy—apparitional, were it not for the distance re- 
lation involved in motion, which, under the same inscrutable agency 
which modifies and saps the motion renders it potential upon change 
of sign. This agency, the dynamical source of the-manifestation, 
being central to mass and likewise persistent and constant, renders 
the positive and negative potentialities of movement constantly 
equal, and the actual and potential energies consequently comple- 
mentary, from which energy gets its character of conservation. 
Energy cannot therefore be that other reality of existence (be- 
sides matter), since force is clearly the one reality at the bottom of 
the manifestation of both, to whose persistence and resistance to 
change, except through transformation, the conservation of both is 
due. This one reality is, in its triple aspect of causation, (1) at- 
traction—the source and modifier of motion; (2) inertia—the con- 
server of motion; and (3) repulsion—the distributer of motion; 
or, more correctly, in its aspect of quality: (1) vis centripeta-—the 
power of mutual control across distance; (2) vis insita—the power 


¥ 


62 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


of persistence in state of motion impressed; and (3) the distributive 
power of imparting and acquiring motion by trangfer, at minimum 
distance, which may be called vis partitiva, the result of which is 
Newton’s vis impressa. Matter thus comes into the world of phe- 
nomena by the simple presence of other matter, permitting the 
exhibition of these comparisons and interactions, involving the 
conditions of contiguity, distance, position, translation, direction, 
succession or sequence, and time-rate for the continuous increments, 
decrements, successions, and uniformities, all bound up in the com- 
pound variable continuity—motion. With motion and distance 
comes the dependent phenomenon—energy—active and potential, 
which should be a constant, the numerical units of mass being con- 
stant throughout immensity, provided the sum of the motions, 
potential and actual, be constant. This the dynamical theory de- 
duces from the fact of central force (for without force potential 
motion is ridiculous), and the thesis of the conservation of energy 
is a dynamical truth or nothing. It is therefore all the more ex- 
traordinary that certain kinetists, who reluct against central force, 
should have selected, out of all the manifestations of the universe, 
the variable and conditional product—energy—to be the one reality 
or objectivity, aside from the undefined hypostasis—matter—as a 
primordial simple fact at the basis of phenomena. It has been 
mathematically demonstrated by Mr. Walter R. Browne (London 
Edinburgh and Dublin Philosophical Magazine, January, 1883, p. 
35) that the conservation of energy is true if the material system 
is a system of central forces, and is not true if the system is any- 
thing but a system of central forces. In fact, the ordinary theo- 
retical proof of the principle of the conservation of energy assumes 
the forces acting to be central forces, 7. e., reciprocal stresses between 
units of mass, as recognized by Clausius in his Mechanical Theory 
of Heat. Moreover, the entire body of kinetists, who have aimed 
to supersede gravity or central force, have freely assumed an extra- 
mundane supply of motion and energy without regard to conser- 
vation, and it is notable that every hypothesis for this purpose yet 
broached involves the constant expenditure of work without re- 
covery, and postulates the accession of energy in infinite influx 
from some occult source, of which only a small portion relatively 
is available or manifest in observable phenomena, thus yiolating all 
three of the canons of philosophical ascription—true cause, sufficient 


GENERAL MEETING. 63 


cause, and least cause. Such is the power of conception of the un- 
known in endeavor to explain the inconceivable known. 

If the dynamic hypothesis of perpetual transformation of energy 
could be established as a universal induction, with as much gen- 
erality, e. g., as the statement of the law of gravitation, it would 
establish and confirm that law, by Mr. Browne’s demonstration, as 
something more than a law, to wit, the necessary constitution of 
matter as a system of central forces and nothing more, substan- 
tially as conceived by Newton and elaborated by Boscovich. At 
present it is but a dynamic induction, but the theory of gravity is 
no more. Our appliances are material, and we can deal with mo- 
lar forces, but only indirectly and inferentially with those which 
are atomic. Conservation is indubitably true of energy in the me- 
chanical and molar sense, under the laws of dynamics and the per- 
sistence of force. It is, also, experimentally true, so far as we can 
trace it, of those less understood forms of energy which are mole- 
cular or atomic, the establishment of which was the great glory of 
Benjamin Thompson, Clausius, and Joule as to heat, and of a mul- 
titude of observers as to electrical energy. We infer it as a gen- 
eral truth of these energies (formerly known as imponderables, 
since they are not manifestations of matter in the concrete), from 
the fact of their convertibility with other modes of energy which 
are undoubtedly dynamical, and also from the intimate connection 
of electrical energy with one of the specific exhibitions of central 
atomic force—magnetism. Such clews create a warrantable pre- 
sumption that the phenomena in question will all ultimately be 
classified among the modes of atomic mass and motion, inductively 
as well as hypothetically. Possibly in the investigation of these 
evanescent modes of energy the missing simple particle may come 
to light. Provisionally, we are entitled to rank them among the 
mechanical modes of energy, as products of the same material 
forces, assuming, until the contrary is proved, that some form of 
matter is concerned in manifestations so correlated by conservation 
with undoubted material activities. 

In including the imponderables within the general dynamical 
law of conservation, we have to take account of the phenomenon 
of dissipation, first pointed out by Sir William Thompson. It is 
true that heat (as well as electrical energy) is strictly correlated 
with and interconvertible with energy of mass motion, as before 


64 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


stated, but in its final form energy seems to take leave of matter 
altogether, so far as our perceptions can followit, and disappear 
as a material phenomenon (though liable to reappear wherever 
matter is encountered whose particles are deficient in a like 
species of atomic motion with that which disappeared; which fact 
indicates that atomic mass is still a factor, with its inherent prop- 
erty of persistence and transference). The earth and all upon it 
is radiating heat energy away into space at the constant rate of 
500° F. of absolute temperature, more or less; the sun and the 
visible stars at the rate of many millions of degrees. Much energy 
also passes off in the luminous form. Of electrical and actinic 
energies we know less, and of some we doubtless know nothing. 
This amounts to a constant drain of the dynamical supply of 
energy. These final forms, the radiant energies, have a remark- 
able specific high cosmical velocity of their own, which is a func- 
tion of something not material, or at least not molar. It is sup- 
posable that, in addition to the dynamical source of motion from 
central forces, and the contraction of systems in dimension which 
supplies dissipation, there may be an inherent and primordial store 
of atomic motion. The high proper motion of some of the stars, 
beyond what can be accounted for on dynamical principles, and the 
inexhaustible and enormous supply of radiant energy from the 
visible stars, have afforded grounds for such a surmise, but these 
speculations do not belong to the domain of mechanics. 

And here we must bear in mind that the dynamical theory, in plac- 
ing these assumed agencies and modes of interaction in causal relation 
to phenomenal motion, by no means predicates or can predicate any- 
thing concerning absolute motion or its cause. The lack of this dis- 
tinction may have proved a stumbling block to some in comprehend- 
ing the idea of force. Were it not for the observed dissipation of 
energy no system could become contracted in dimensions a particle 
by the interactions of material forces, nor is there now any known 
way by which the material system can be expanded in dimensions 
except by the accession of motion from extra-mundane sources, 
which there is no scientific mode of ascertaining. The sum of mo- 
tions under the action of forces remains the same, and any change 
would imply creation or annihilation, which is not ascribable to a 
material agency. Primordial dimension remains as inscrutable 
a fact as ever, and primordial motion an unsolved problem. 


GENERAL MEETING. 65 


In conclusion, I know nothing of force except as a manifestation 
of matter, and nothing of matter except through its manifesta- 
tions. It is substance that interacts with substance, so far as we 
know, always reciprocally, and force is but the convenient transla- 
tion of the terminology invented by Newton to designate these 
several species or modes of action, in the word vis, with its appro- 
priate adjective. He was arraigned by the Cartesians (and virtu- 
ally is by their modern representatives) as the reintroducer of oc- 
cult qualities into philosophy, but his statement was “hypotheses 
non fingo,’ and to a similar charge brought against him by Leib- 
nitz he pertinently replied that it was a misuse of words to call 
those things occult qualities whose causes are occult though the 
qualities themselves be manifest. 

I have adopted gravity as the type of central inherent force— 
vis centripeta—but I would not thereby be understood as excluding 
from the category of material forces any and all other modes of 
tensile or constraining force which may be hereafter made out as 
specific, by the elucidation of such phenomena as affinity, cohesion, 
tenacity, elasticity, ductility, viscosity, capillarity, polarity, mag- 
netism, etc., now so little understood, any more than I would ex- 
clude any form or mode of energy which may be observed, from 
the category of material phenomena. The Newtonian doctrine of 
force would not be impaired by such discovery, and its strength 
lies in the fact that it as readily includes static phenomena—that 
despair of the kinetist, who has no imaginable hypothesis by which 
to range them under a form of motion—as it does kinematical phe- 
nomena. Statical force (Newton’s vis mortua) cannot be ignored 
in a theory of force. The straw that breaks the camel’s back— 
the very lightning that crashes through the sky—are familiar ex- 
amples of its power made manifest. Its reality may be exemplified 
by suspending two heavy balls of equal weight at equal heights— 
one by an elastic cord, and the other by a tense string. The dif- 
ference of effort required to displace the two vertically upwards, 
which can be measured, makes sensible the difference between the 
two forms of balanced statical forces. In the one case the antago- 
nizing force is suddenly withdrawn, and in the other gradually. 
Wherever strain exists—and it is everywhere—there force. is as 
certainly present as when it becomes manifested in a stress relieved 
by motion and measurable in terms of energy. 


66 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Let us, then, give up the standard of a priori conceivability, 
in view of its many historical failures, and adopé as possible that 
which is provisionally ascertained. The “ego” and the “cogito”— 
Cartesian starting points—have proved barren and irrelevant in 
Philosophy. True Philosophy is concerned with objectivity. The 
data of consciousness, mainly acquired in infancy or in the womb, 
are blind guides. Many an ego, whose brain was his cosmos, has 
run through his brief subjectivity, but the order of nature endures. 
The same facts are continually observed, verified, recorded, and 
rectified, but the observers change. Their intelligent observations 
add to the sum of knowledge. This is all the proof we need of 
objectivity, and all we will get. The insoluble difficulties of Phi- 
losophy have disappeared one by one since the happy thought of 
eliminating them by observation entered. The immortals are those 
who have successfully applied this method. It is only where ob- 
servation fails that the insolubility lingers. Beyond the sphere of 
the knowable it will continue, in spite of introspection. How mas- 
terful is fact in the presence of the most intricate mental subtle- 
ties. The ball leaves the bat, in spite of the inconceivability. 
Galileo’s plummet dropped from the moving mast strikes the deck 
and not the water, in spite of the inconceivability. The Earth re- 
turns in its orbit, to the second, in spite of the sun’s rapid fall 
through space, and of the inconceivability. Two opposed horses 
can pull no more than one, in spite of the inconceivability. The 
guinea and the feather dropped in the exhausted receiver strike 
the plate together, in spite of the inconceivability. The isochro- 
nous pendulum swings through the widest arc in the same time as 
through the smallest, in spite of the inconceivability. The minute 
hand overtakes the hour hand, in spite of the inconceivability. The 
magnet draws the iron with undiminished force through all pos- 
sible interpositions, in spite of the inconceivability. Could an ex- 
ception be found, the perpetual-motion “crank” would work a 
greater inconceivability, by the instant contrivance of a power- 
generating machine. 

We need not aspire, therefore, to remove any of the inconceiva- 
bilities of the external world. We must accept them as natural to 
the finite comprehension, as necessary to faculties which act by 
comparison, and above all as evidences of objectivity. On the 
other hand we should avoid that opposite error of the introspective 


GENERAL MEETING. 67 


school, of deeming that probable, or in any way connected with 
fact, which merely seems conceivable. I have shown that while 
thesimplest truths have generally proved inconceivable until found 
out and established by genius, the greatest absurdities have had 
ready currency without a doubt of their conceivability. This all 
mythology shows. Such rubbish as “a thing cannot act where it 
is not,’ and “a body cannot move where it is not,” or “a cause 
cannot precede its effect” —mere metaphysical assertions or subtle- 
ties in face of everyday fact—were stumbling blocks for ages. 
Such assumptions formed the basis of deduction in lieu of observa- 
tion, and blocked the possibility of advance. And even yet, rigid 
deduction from the most hare-brained premiss, if the chain of de- 
duction is sufficiently intricate, seems to possess fascinations over a 
verifiable induction, with many minds. 

And now, if any ask, “cui bono” to the scientist, these philosophical 
inquiries and intricacies when he has the vast field of unexplored data 
still before him to occupy him, I answer, the queries of Philosophy 
are not only the main-spring and final cause of science (her first 
fruitful daughter and handmaid), but they, consciously or uncon- 
sciously, dominate the methods and results of science herself. 
Each investigator, even though in the domain of the most abstract of 
the sciences, postulates more philosophy than he is aware of; and with 
so much the more danger to final accomplishment if he assumes his 
philosophical basis without examination. It is the errors of giant 
minds that are dangerous, by their ponderosity. The infallibility 
of the master, Aristotle, seemed to make investigation useless, 
until the rise of parallel giants, like Galileo and Copernicus, stim- 
ulated a new conflict of opinion. And Descartes, though harm- 
less from all his productions within the metaphysical domain, is 
dangerous by his very eminence and originality in science, 
which gives vogue and currency to his monumental errors. 
Although acquainted with the true law of motion, his scheme 
of matter evolved from consciousness would forbid all exhibi- 
tion thereof. A grand geometer, he erected a scaffold for 
scaling immensity, and with unparalleled penetration perceived 
how a purely ideal logic, if general, would represent truth in a 
wholly dissimilar realm of deduction, if equally general. Sirange 
to say, this grand and useful discovery has become the engine, in 
nihilistic hands, for overthrowing all the positive knowledge we 


68 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


possess—the achievements of two thousand years of human effort. 
Not only geometry—all that has survived to us of philosophical 
value from the antique world—but the basis of positive dynamics, 
as handed down from Galileo and Newton and Boscovich and 
Dalton, are apparently undermined, for all that gives them intel- 
lectual value—their certainty—unless an effort be made in the 
neglected field of philosophy. With strange inconsistency these 
advocates par excellence of the experiential origin of knowledge 
are found in the same breath promulgating as possible truth mat- 
ters not only non-experiential, but not representable in ideas de- 
rived from or verifiable by experience, and avowedly originating 
not from inductive generalizations—the only source of knowledge— 
but in purely deductive processes in the old scholastic way, from 
logical premises of bald assumption. In a similar way, in the 
hands of the Greek sophist, language, a good servant, became a 
vicious master, and made a chaos of all ethical achievement. A 
remnant of knowledge, fortunately expressed, not in verbal, but 
diagrammatic logic—geometry—was left, but only to fall now by 
the hands of similar iconoclasts, armed with more potent destruc- 
tiveness, in its full flower and fruit of twenty centuries of unmo- 
lested growth. 

It is time, therefore, to get back to Baconian ground, and while 
using for its legitimate purposes the magnificent modern machinery 
of analytical investigation in the field of abstract continuity—ex- 
tension, motion, duration—not attempt to conjure with it as a source 
of objective revelation, which no mere machinery can be. <A scaf- 
fold of » dimensions is as useless to the geometer as to the archi- 
tect. To assume matter as continuous, simply because of the posses- 
sion of a potent engine for the investigation of continuities, is to re- 
peat the practice of certain quack specialists, who are prone to diag- 
nose nearly every form of disease as a variety of their own peculiar 
specialty. And to interview the symbols of a mathematical logic 
for the prime definition of a fundamental objectivity, like force, is 
to revert to a barren source of knowledge, by an obsolete process 
in philosophy, and bar all progress in anything but abstract tech- 
nique. 


The paper was discussed by Mr. W. B. Taytor and Mr. Kum- 
MELL. 


GENERAL MEETING. 69 
Mr. T. Roprnson made a communication on 


THE STRATA EXPOSED IN THE EAST SHAFT OF THE WATER-WORKS 
EXTENSION. 


[ Abstract. ] 


The shaft (23’ square in the clear) was begun in the bottom of 
an old sand-pit at a level of 131.5’ above tide. This sand-pit was 
excavated in the side of a hill; and recent cuttings have exposed 
the strata from the hill-top to the level of the top of the shaft. 
Thus we have a vertical section of 188.5’, extending from 171.5’ 
above tide (or 40’ above the top of the shaft) to 17’ below tide. 


1. About 6” of surface soil. 


2. A layer of gravel in red clay, about 4’ thick, containing isolated 
bowlders from a foot to two feet in their longest diameters. 


3. About 24’ of a mixed material, consisting mainly of sand and 
kaolin. The two are sometimes uniformly mixed; at other 
times they lie in separate masses of two or three feet in 
thickness at one point, and run down to as many inches 
at another. In short, the whole bed is a sort of “ pell-mell” 
of sand and clay. 


4, A bed of sand, about 10’ thick, generally sharp and clean, but 
varying from coarse to fine grains, and streaked with iron 
oxides, with pebbles near bottom of stratum. 


5. A thin stratum of clay, about 2’ thick, varying in color from blue 
to red, and containing in spots fragments of lignite. 


6. 2.5’ of sharp, coarse, clean sand. 


7. 32.5’ of red clay, mottled with blue and gray, showing no lami- 
nation. — 


8. 5’ of sandy clay, mottled as above. Between this stratum and the 
clay above, there was no dividing line; the two beds blended 
gradually along their line of union. 


9. A bed of gray, clayey sand, 6’ thick. In this bed occurred, on 
one side of the shaft, some masses of sandstone, somewhat 
more ferruginous than the surrounding sand, and on the 
ofier side a tongue of clean, red clay. 


79 


11. 


12. 


13. 


14. 


15. 


16. 


Avs 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY 


. A bed of sand with its upper 


surface horizontal, having a 
thickness of about 1’ at one 
side of the shaft and 4’ on the 
other. 

A stratum, about 2’ thick, of 
sandy mud, containing lignite. 
The lamine of this bed were 
horizontal, while its upper sur- 
face fell from north to south 
at the rate of about one in 
eight. 

6’ of sand containing nodules of 
iron pyrites, isolated masses 
of lignite, and pockets of red 
clay. 


A bed of fine, clean sand, con- 
taining here and there a little 
clay. This bed was 9 thick, 
and gradually gave way to the 
succeeding bed. 


A bed of sandy kaolin, 6’ thick, 
very wet and difficult to work. 
It was a regular mortar-bed 
in consistence. 


A layer, 2” to 4” thick, of hard, 


ferruginous conglomerate. 


¥ of blue-grey clay, hard, com- 
pact, and possessing a very 
unctuous feel. This bed con- 
tained a bunch of rootlets, the 
first trace of organic remains 
below the lignite of No. 11. 


A bed of clayey sand, streaked 
with red, blue, and grey, 7’ 
thick, and gradually running 
into the subjacent stratum. 


OF WASHINGTON. 


4 F 
a 


88 


k 


BER BsQs 


24 


Fig. 3. Geological Section at Water-Works’ Shaft. 


18. 


19. 


20. 


21. 
22. 


23. 


24. 


25 


GENERAL MEETING. 71 


A bed of clean, white, sharp sand, about 2’ thick. (These last 
nine feet were difficult to work. The material could not be 
shovelled, and was too sandy to pump.) 


A layer of red sand about 1’ thick, containing on one side of 
the shaft a clayey sediment with lignite, and on the other a 
ferruginous conglomerate. 


5’ of blue-black, hard clay, running into a sandy sediment, 
and this, in turn, into the next stratum. 


3.5’ of clean, white sand. 

2’ of dark green, compacted sand, containing pebbles and 
lignite. 

1.5’ of fine, sharp sand, almost apple-green in color. Beneath 
this lay the irregular surface of No. 24. 


Dark, coarse-grained, soft, chloritic rock. This rock could be 
easily removed by the pick to a depth of three feet, where 
blasting was begun at about twenty-six feet above mean 
tide. The rock grew harder as the depth increased for about 
ten feet, when it became a chloritic gneiss, and in general 
remained of that nature through about thirty feet to the 
bottom of the tunnel grade, or seventeen feet below mean 
tide. 


5TH MEETING. JUNE 7, 1884. 
Vice-President Briur1nqs in the Chair. 


Thirty-five members and guests present. 


Mr. G. K. GruBeErt presented a 


PLAN FOR THE SUBJECT BIBLIOGRAPHY OF NORTH AMERICAN 


GEOLOGIC LITERATURE. 


Mr. J. W. Powe. presented a slightly different plan for the 


same purpose. 


of 


These plans proposed to establish at the outset a limited number 
divisions of the subject-matter of the literature and to simul- 


taneously prepare a bibliography of each. 


i2 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Mr. J. 8S. Briurgs criticised the plans at length and advocated 
that which has been adopted for the indexing of the Library of 
the Army Medical Museum. 

Other remarks were made by Messrs. ANTISELL, Norris, GOODE, 
E. Farquuar, F. W. CLARKE, Harkness, TONER and WARD. 


The meeting announced for October 11 was informally ad- 
journed, to enable members to attend a meeting of the Anthropo- 
logical Society, and listen to an address by Dr. E. B. Tylor, of 
Oxford, England. 


256TH MEETING. OcToBER 25, 1884, 
The President in the Chair. 
Forty members and guests present. 


The Chair announced the death, since the last meeting, of Dr. 
JOSEPH JANVIER WoopwWaRD, a former President of the Society, 
Gen. ORVILLE Extas Bascock, and Gen. BENJAMIN ALVORD. 


Announcement was also made of the election to membership 
of Messrs. WASHINGTON MarrHews, STiMson JOSEPH Brown, 
TARLETON HorrMaNn BEAN, and Ropert Epwarp EARLL. 


Mr. S. M. Burnerr read a paper entitled— 


ARE THERE SEPARATE CENTRES FOR LIGHT-, FORM-, AND 
COLOR-PERCEPTION ? 


controverting the theory which gives an affirmative answer to 
the question, and maintaining, first, that there is no white-light 
sensation that cannot be resolved into its constituent elements of 
color sensation; and, second, that the sense of form is an expres- 
sion of the idea of extension as represented by the dimensions 
of the area of the retina impressed. The idea of form is not 
a purely visual sensation, but is based also on information derived 
from other sources. 


[The paper is published in the Archives of Medicime, Vol. XII, 
No. 2, October, 1884. ] 


GENERAL MEETING. Tey 


Mr. T. Roprnson read a paper entitled— 


WAS THE EARTHQUAKE OF SEPTEMBER 19TH FELT IN THE 
DISTRICT OF COLUMBIA? 


[Abstract. ] 


At 3.20 p. m. of September 19 I noticed a peculiar vibration of 
the floor, table, and chair. I saw my ink shaking and heard the 
door of the room rattling. The table and chair rocked in a north 
and south direction. The sounds made by the door were at regular 
intervals of something less than a secondeach. My room is on the 
second floor of the Howard University building. 

Immediately after the occurrence I inquired if other persons had 
noticed anything unusual at that time. One had heard a rum- 
bling, another had felt the shock, and a third had both felt and 
heard it. The miners in the water-works’ tunnel also heard a rum- 
bling noise at about the same hour. 

From the motion of my table and chair and the continued thump- 
ings of the door I judge that the shock passed in the direction of 
the meridian, and continued from ten to fifteen seconds. 

There was no local cause for the phenomenon, and I concluded 
that it was in some way connected with the earthquake that oc- 
curred in the West at about the same time. 


Mr. Pav remarked that the direction of the motion communi- 
cated to buildings by a slight earthquake shock is not a reliable 
index of the direction of the earth tremor. The azimuth, ampli- 
tude, and period of vibration of the buildings are functions of their 
structure rather than of the azimuth, amplitude, and period of the 
earth vibration. 

Other remarks were made by Mr. H. A. Hazen and Mr. Evxiort. 


Mr. J. S. Bruiryes exhibited a collection of microscopes illus- 
trating-the evolution of the mechanical stage. The collection will 
be sent by the Army Medical Museum to the New Orleans Ex- 
hibition. 

Mr. Bruuines read a paper by Mr. WAsHiInGTON MATTHEWS on 

NATURAL NATURALISTS. 
[Abstract. ] 


It is easy to understand that a savage may be well versed in the 
knowledge of animals and plants which contribute to his wants, 


74 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


but it is a matter of surprise that with equal care he acquires and 
disseminates information about creatures which hesdoes not use. I 
have never yet failed to get from an Indian a good and satisfactory 
name for any species of mammal, bird or reptile inhabiting his 
country; and I have found their knowledge of plants equally com- 
prehensive, It is true that not all Indians are equally well in- 
formed in this respect, but, as a class, they are incomparably supe- 
rior to the average white man or to the white man who has not 
made zoology or botany a subject of study. 

There is a prevalent impression that Indians are unable to gen- 
eralize; and a paragraph goes the rounds of ethnological treatises 
to the effect that the Chatas have no general term for oak tree, 
but only specific names for the white oak, the black oak, the red 
oak, etc. This impression is entirely erroneous. The Indian is as 
good a generalizer and classifier as his Caucasian brother. His 
system of classification does not fully coincide with that of the white 
naturalist, because his system of philosophy leads him to base his 
groups upon a different series of resemblances, but his arrangement 
is nevertheless the result of a process of generalization. 


Mr. Warp remarked that his own experience fully sustained the 
statements of the paper in regard to the botanical ignorance of 
white men, but less fully in regard to the accuracy of Indian ob- 
servations. “ When collecting plants in Utah, he had found that 
Piute boys and girls gave names to nearly all his specimens, dis- 
criminating allied species; but in collating the Indian botanical 
names recorded by others, he had been led to suspect that certain 
discrepancies arose from failure to recognize the same species in 
different stages of development. 

Mr. Mason said it is a canon of anthropology that things seem 
marvellous to us only when we do not understand them, every 
human phenomenon being governed by law. Our ignorance in re- 
gard to wild animals and plants is to be explained by the fact that 
our activities do not bring us into close relation with them, whereas 
the savage is dependent on them for sustenance. The market- 
women who bring herbs to Washington have names for them all, 
and ignorant mechanics handle technical terms of their craft with 
great familiarity. . 

Mr. Durron said that his own acquaintance with the Navajos 


GENERAL MEETING. 15 


made him prone to believe that they diagnose species of plants, but 
he questioned their powers of generalization. 

In illustration of Mr. Mason’s remark that familiarity is con- 
ditioned by contact, he related that rural rambles had made him 
when a boy so familiar with the fauna and flora of his district that 
he knew a name for every prominent species. As a man, he had 
been occupied with other and different matters, and had lost this 
familiarity. 

Mr. WELLING admitted that the Indian was an acute observer, 
but questioned the propriety of calling him a naturalist. As illus- 
trated by the paper, his methods of interpretation are metaphysical, 
not scientific. . 

Other remarks were made by Mr. H1ucarp. 


257TH MEETING. NovEeMBER 8, 1884. 
Vice-President BrLuines in the Chair. 


Forty-eight members and guests present. 


Mr. Biiur1nes, on behalf of the General Committee, reported the 
following resolutions: 


Resolved, That this Society receives with deep regret the an- 
nouncement of the the death, on the 17th of August last, of Dr. 
JOSEPH JANVIER WoopWARD, an ex-president of this Society and 
one of its original founders. 

Resolved, That this untimely death has deprived science of one 
of its most energetic, patient, and skilful workers and this Society 
of one of its most efficient and distinguished members. 

Resolved, That in our sorrow for this affliction we have some 
consolation in the knowledge that his long and great suffering is at 
last ended and that the fruits of his unceasing labors for the last 
twenty-five years remain for the benefit of the world and as an en- 
during monument to his memory. 

Resolved, That a copy of these resolutions, duly authenticated, 
be forwarded to his bereaved family. 


In presenting these resolutions, Mr. Brtu1nes spoke briefly of 
Dr. Woodward’s work and his characteristics as a scientific man, 


76 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


eulogizing his accuracy of observation, his delicacy of manipula- 
tion, his conservatism as a theorist and as a critic of new ideas; 
and alluding to his delight in teaching and his interest in, and 
affection for, the Philosophical Society. 

Mr. PowE tu spoke of his remarkable acumen and his conspicu- 
ous mental integrity. Mr. Gruon spoke of his boyhood ; Mr. Toner 
of his ability as a practitioner; and Mr. E. Farquuar of the im- 
pression of great force conveyed by his presence and conversation. 

The resolutions were unanimously adopted. 


Mr. C. E. Durron made a communication on 
THE VOLCANOES AND LAVA FIELDS OF NEW MEXICO, 


his remarks being illustrated by photographic lantern views, and 
by a map exhibiting the boundaries of the region usually termed 
the Plateau country. 

[Abstract. ] 


Beginning at the north, the boundary of the Plateau country 
runs along the southern base of the Uinta Range to the junction 
of the latter with the Wasatch ; following the eastern base of the 
Wasatch southward it strikes off towards the southwestern corner 
of Utah; thence turning due south it crosses the Colorado river, 
and gradually shifts its course to the southeastward, preserving this 
direction for nearly 400 miles and far into New Mexico; here it 
rapidly turns north northeastward, reaching into the Valley of the 
Rio Grande, and follows the western bank of that river nearly or 
quite into Southern Colorado ; here the course of the boundary is 
somewhat indeterminate, but is, in a general way, first northwest- 
ward, then northward to the place of beginning. The western and 
southern border of the Plateau province is usually sharply defined ; 
the plateaus end generally in great cliffs suddenly terminating the 
horizontal strata, and the profiles drop down upon the rough, irreg- 
ular topography of a type peculiar to the Great Basin. The 
eastern border of the Plateau province is by no means so definite ; 
the features peculiar to it pass rather by gradual transition into 
those characterizing the Rocky Mountains of Colorado. 

Among the many geological features of this wonderful region, 
the volcanic masses are not the least interesting. Volcanic action 
has prevailed there upon a grand scale, and it may be first noted 


GENERAL MEETING. Wi 


that volcanic rocks predominate around the borders of the 

province. The interior spaces, while not wholly devoid of them, 

show but a very small amount. The region of the High Plateaus 

of Utah, which lies upon the western or northwestern border, 

discloses a very large mass of lavas, erupted chiefly during 

tertiary time, and representing almost continuous activity from the 

eocene to the quaternary. Proceeding southward, we are never out 

of sight of eruptive masses, and in the Unkarets, on the border of 
the Grand Cafion, we find many scores of old and young cinder- 

cones and some considerable lava-fields. In the San Francisco _ 
Mountains we also have a vast field of voleanic rocks, and thence 

southeastward they augment in volume and area until at the 

southernmost extension of the Plateau country they become indeed 

immense. Still following the boundary northward into the Valley 

of the Rio Grande they are found abundant, and a singularly 

interesting field is presented in the neighborhood of Mt. Taylor. 

The speaker was engaged during the past summer in the geological 

examination of the Mt. Taylor district, and it is of the striking 

features there presented that he designs especially to speak. 

Mt. Taylor is an old volcano long since extinct. Its altitude is 
about 11,400 feet above the sea. It stands upon a high mesa, from 
the summit of which it rises as an ordinary volcanic cone of con- 
siderable magnitude—much larger than Vesuvius, much smaller 
than tna. Its lavas are rather monotonous in type, so far as ex- 
ternal appearances are concerned, consisting probably of basalts 
and andesites. The mesa upon which it stands is of great extent, 
being 40 miles long and 25 miles wide. It is composed of nearly 
horizontal cretaceous strata, capped everywhere with basalt or an- 
desite, ranging from 200 to 400 feet in thickness. To the north- 
east and to the south of it are similar high mesas, also capped by 
basalt and andesite, but presenting no great volcanic pile like Mt. 
Taylor. The only features which indicate volcanic vents are barely 
noticeable hillocks, which scarcely affect the evenness of the hori- 
zontal surfaces and which are wholly incommensurate, apparently, 
with the vast lava caps upon which they occur. 

These lavas are all of tertiary age. It would be difficult to say 
to what divisions of tertiary time their activity should be assigned, 
but it cannot have been very late tertiary and it is reasonably 
certain that it cannot have been very old tertiary. In a general 


78 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


way their activity is inferred to have prevailed in a period not far 
from middle tertiary time—possibly in the mioeene. The large 
amount of erosion which has occurred since their eruptions ceased 
forbids a much later period, and the still larger amount of tertiary 
erosion which preceded this activity equally forbids a much earlier 
one. . 

Upon the summits of the mesas no recent eruptive rocks occur. 
But in the broad valleys which lie between them and around them 
are lavas of quite another age. These valley lavas are all recent. 
Indeed the most superficial observer is at once impressed with the 
freshness of their aspect, and critical examination confirms the 
view that none of them have any geologic antiquity, while some of 
them are so modern that it seems as if half a dozen centuries were 
a large estimate of the time which separates us from their outflow. 

These recent eruptions are basalts of normal type. The external 
aspects of the fields of young lava resemble those of the Hawaiian 
Islands. The two forms of solidified lava are well presented, viz: 
the viscous or ropy, and the rough clinker fields. 

A striking characteristic of both old and young lavas—those 
upon the mesa summits and those in the valleys below—is the usual 
though not universal absence of cinder cones or piles of fragmental 
matter built up around the orifices from which the lavas were ex- 
truded. The eruptions, with the exception of those of Mt. Taylor, 
belonged to the quiet order which are typified among volcanoes 
now active, by Mauna Loa and Kilauea. 

But the volcanic remnants which appeal most strongly to the im- 
agination of the observer, remain to be described. In the broad 
valleys which separate the lava-capped mesas are seen many con- 
spicuous objects rising as sharp peaks or aiguilles of rock to great 
altitudes. They are very black in color, and contrast powerfully 
with the bright tints of the sedimentary beds around them. These 
peaks, which range in altitude above the valley plains from 
700 or 800 feet to 2,000 feet, consist of columnar basalt. They 
are, in fact, the ancient lavas which congealed in the volcanic 
pipes, while the sedimentary strata which formerly inclosed them 
have been swept away in the great erosion of the country. In that 
long-continued and great denudation these “necks,” by their more 
adamantine character, have resisted the general decayyand remain 
to attest the former extension of the strata over the valleys and the 


GENERAL MEETING. 79 


existence, prior to their denudation, of volcanic extravasations 
which probably covered them wholly or in part. In the mesa walls 
and on their slopes may be seen numerous instances of partially 
excavated necks, while in others the necks are just beginning to be 
exhumed. Im the latter cases remnants of the old cinder-cones 
which were piled up over their summits are still preserved, so that 
natural sections of the whole apparatus are exhibited. There are 
many scores of these necks, and the effects of erosion in unearthing 
them are exhibited in all stages. Wherever the true neck or core 
is disclosed the basalt is seen to be columnar, and the columns are 
often arranged in beautiful fashions. 

No more striking illustration and proof of a great erosion could 
be mentioned than is here disclosed, and the region must become 
a classic one, to be referred to by future geologists as an excellent 
example of some of the grandest laws and’ processes with which 
their science deals. 


Mr. PowE.u spoke of the distribution of eruptions. They are 
apt to occur on the faces of acclivities undergoing erosion, but not 
on acclivities due to displacement. Near a fault they break through 
the uplifted block rather than the thrown. They do not occur in 
the bottoms of cajions. . 

In mapping the Plateaus he had thrown the boundary farther 
north than Captain Dutton, so as to include a large area north of 
the Uinta Mountains. 

The peculiarly favorable conditions under which geology is 
studied in the plateau region enable its features to be comprehended 
without the doubts and the laborious compilation of details else- 
where necessary. It results that while the structure of the Plateau 
country is as well known as that of any equal area in the world, 
the literature of its geology is exceedingly small. 

Other remarks were made by Messrs. WHITE and GILBERT. 


258tH MEETING. NovEMBER 22, 1884. 
The President in the Chair. 


Forty-nine members and guests present. 


80 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Mr. E. B. Exxtiorr made a communication on 
ELECTRIC LIGHTING, . 


which was discussed by Messrs. Hincarp, WELLING, MussEy, 
Pav, and PowE Lt. 


Mr. H. ALLEN HAZEN made a communication on 


THERMOMETER EXPOSURE. 
[Abstract.] 


In recent experiments for determining the relative values of tem- 
peratures in city and country, it has been found that ordinarily, on 
clear days, in the early morning, at 6 feet above ground, in the 
country, temperatures are 4 to 5 degrees lower than in the city, and 
also that the air is always nearly saturated in the country, but not 
as nearly in the city. This is due more to intense radiation from 
grass in the country, this cooling the air to the dew point, than to 
the heating and drying from pavements and walls or chimneys of 
houses. 

To obtain a standard air temperature it is proposed to use bright 
and black bulb thermometers joined together and swung over grass 
ground under an umbrella, with no shade from trees or buildings, 
in the day time. Under such circumstances the two thermometers 
can be brought within 0.5° of each other, and the true air tempera- 
ture may be taken as about as much lower than the bright-bulb as 
that is lower than the black. 

Recent experiments with six different thermometer shelters indi- 
cate a general agreement, except in the case of the Wild shelter. 
The peculiar condition effected by the Wild shelter is inferior ven- 
tilation, and the experiments indicate the practical sufficiency of 
the single-louvred shelter. To determine the humidity with the 
psychrometer in still air, the employment of artificial ventilation 
is recommended. 


Remarks were made by Mr. Pauvt. 


259TH MEETING. DECEMBER 6, 1884. 


By courtesy of the officers of the Columbian University, the 
meeting was held in the lecture hall of the University building. 


GENERAL MEETING. 81 


Members of the Anthropological, Biological, and Chemical Societies 
and their friends were present by invitation. 


Mr. J. W. Powe, by request of the President, occupied the 
Chair. 


Present, one hundred and four members and guests. 


The business of the evening was the presentation of the Annual 
Address of the President, Mr. J. C. Wrexxiine. In introducing 
him to the audience, the Chairman sketched the history of the 
Society, describing the socio-scientific club of which it was the 
offspring, and referring to the younger scientific societies of Wash- 
ington, of which it might be regarded as the parent. 


The President then read an address on 
THE ATOMIC PHILOSOPHY, PHYSICAL AND METAPHYSICAL. 
[Printed in full on pp. Xx1x-LIx.] 


On motion of Mr. Grecory, the Society tendered its President 
a vote of thanks for his efficient administration and instructive 
address. 


260TH MEETING. DECEMBER 20, 1884, 
THE FOURTEENTH ANNUAL MEETING. 


The President in the chair. 


The Chair announced the death, since the last meeting, of Mr. 
Henry WAYNE BLArr. 

The Chair announced the election to membership of Mr. RoBERT 
Epwarps CARTER STEARNS. 

It was announced that the Mathematical Section would, in the 
future, hold its meetings in the mathematical class room of the 
Columbian University, the use of that room having been tendered 
by the officers of the University. 

The order of business was then read, and afterward the minutes 
of the last annual meeting. 


82 ' PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The report of the Secretaries were read and accepted. (Printed 
on page XXIII.) . 

The report of the Treasurer was read, received, and referred to 
an Auditing Committee, consisting of Messrs. H. C. Yarrow, Mar- 
cus Baker, and W. C. Winlock. (The report is printed on pages 
XXIV and xxv.) 

The minutes of the 258th and 259th meetings were read and ap- 
proved. 

The officers of the ensuing year were then elected. (The list is 
printed on page Xv.) 

The rough minutes of the meeting were read, and the meeting 
adjourned. 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


83 


Ss cae oe 


ih Hiv hee Seo) Cele dite Ain? iii eran 


j 


Pe Doak FS 6 RNR ROLE eT ee 
¥ ) , : . | . ! 
‘a . poe bh Se aes Vinee Ol a 
s: iia Jt a Padi ma Mae eas: 
art aoe eee! ie a red tee 
A ; eucoree PER ON eee 
h 4, 
. , a? 
é 
. nite 
if k LH S 
& ‘ 
. - = 4 aad ‘ 
ai MOTs PAO TaAy 
/ 
2 
~ ’ 1 
mate ‘ 
‘ 
‘ 

; ; ‘ ; » H : * 


j 
i 
eit i ‘ 
| j ti tare, 
; " 
; P P ’ oy 
frit: i i if) 6 
a a a. | fe 
; Aw p - of i 


STANDING RULES 


OF THE 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


1. The object of this Section is the consideration and discussion 
of papers relating to pure or applied mathematics. 


2. The special officers of the Section shall be a Chairman and a 
Secretary, who shall be elected at the first meeting of the Section 
in each year, and discharge the duties usually attaching to those 
offices. 


3. To bring a paper regularly before the Section it must be sub- 
mitted to the Standing Committee on Communications for the 
stated meetings of the Society, with the statement that it is for the 
Mathematical Section. 


4. Meetings shall be called by the Standing Committee on Com- 
munications whenever the extent or importance of the papers sub- 
mitted and approved appear to justify it. 


5. All members of the Philosophical Society who wish to do so 
may take part in the meetings of this Section. 


6. To every member who shall have notified the Secretary of the 
General Committee of his desire to receive them, announcements 
of the meetings of the Section shall be sent by mail. 


7. The Section shall have power to adopt such rules of procedure 
as it may find expedient. 


24 85 


OFFICERS 


OF THE 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION FOR 4884. 


Chairman, ASAPH HALL. Secretary, HENRY FARQUHAR. 


LIST OF MEMBERS WHO RECEIVE ANNOUNCEMENT OF THE 


MEETINGS. 
ABBE, C, Hatt A, 
AVERY, R. S. HARKNEsS, W. 
BAKER, M. HAZEN, H. A. 
BaTEs, H. H. : HILGARD, J. E. 
BILLINGS, J. S. HI, G. W. 
BurcEss, E. S. Kine, A. F. A. 
CHRISTIE, A. S. : KuMmMELL, C. H. 
CorFIn, J. H. C. McGEE, W J 
CurtTIs, G. E. NeEewcoms, S. 
DELAND, T. L. PAuL, H. M. 
Doo.iTTLe, M. H. Leravour, E. B. 
EASTMAN, J. R. PEIRCE, C. S. 
EIMBECK, W. RITTER, W. F. M’K. 
ExuiorTtT, E. B. SMILEY, C. W. 
FARQUHAR, H. TAYLOR, W. B. 
FLInt, A. S. Upton, W. W. 
GILBERT, G. K. WALLING, H. F. 
GorgE, J. H. Wintock, W. C. 
GREEN, B. R. WoopwarbD, R. Sw 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


10TH MEETING. JANUARY 30, 1884. 
The Chairman presided. 


Seventeen members and guests present. 


The Section proceeded, under Rule 2, to the election of a Chair- 

man and a Secretary for the year 1884. On motion of Mr. 
_Exxiort, the rules governing the elections of the Society were 
adopted. The officers for 1883—Mr. Haut, as Chairman, and Mr. 
H. Farquuar, as Secretary—were re-elected, after each had briefly 
expressed a desire that the choice might fall on some one else. 

Mr. KumME t read an extract from a letter lately received from 
Mr. Artemas Martin, of Erie, Pennsylvania, in which the forma- 
tion of an American Mathematical Society was recommended. 
After some informal discussion, Mr. WinLock moved the appoint- 
ment of a special committee, with instructions to report on the 
advisability of taking steps for the formation of such a society. 
On motion of Mr. Exxiort, the matter was postponed. 


Mr. KuMMELL then made a communication on 
CURVES SIMILAR TO THEIR EVOLUTES, 


in which he made use of the intrinsic equation, and showed this prop- 
erty to belong to a whole class, of which the logarithmic spiral 
is at one extreme and the cycloids are at the other.* 


* Prof. Benjamin Peirce solved a problem almost identical with this one, 
in Gill’s Mathematical Miscellany for May, 1839, by essentially the same 
methods. This solution, which had not been seen by Mr. Kummell at the 
time of reading his paper, is believed to contain the first use of what has 
since become known as the “intrinsic equation.”’ 


87 


88 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Remarks on this communication were made by Messrs. CHRISTIE 
and HI.t. 


Mr. G. K. Gitpert made a communication on 


THE PROBLEM OF THE KNIGHT'S TOUR. 
[ Abstract. ] 


The ordinary problem, requiring the knight to traverse the chess- 
board and return to his original position in sixty-four moves, is 
susceptible of very numerous solutions, and is not difficult. Its 
interest is increased by extending it so as to include fields of other 
form and size. 

It is readily shown that a perfect tour is impossible on any field 
containing an odd number of squares. 

A symmetric tour is one divisible into two or more similar parts. 
A tour has bilateral symmetry when one-half, being turned face 
downward upon the other, coincides with it. A tour has biradial 
symmetry when one-half, being rotated through 180° about the cen- 
ter of figure, coincides with the other half. A tour has quadri- 
radial symmetry when its fourth part, being rotated through 90° 
about the center of figure, coincides with the adjacent quarter. 

A tour having bilateral symmetry cannot be devised on a field 
containing a number of squares divisible by four. 

A tour having biradial symmetry cannot be devised on a field 
whose number of squares is divisible by two and not by four. 

A tour having quadriradial symmetry cannot be devised on a 
field whose number of squares is divisible by eight. 

It follows that on square fields the tour is impossible if the num- 
ber of spots on a side is odd; bilateral symmetry is never possible ; 
quadri-radial symmetry is possible only when the number of squares 
on a side is the double of an odd number. The only symmetry 
possible on a chess-board is biradial. 

The above conclusions are deductive. It is determined empiri- 
cally that the smallest square field on which the tour can be exe- 
cuted is that with 36 spots. Upon this field the number of possible 
tours with biradial symmetry is twenty-one, of which five have 
also quadriradial symmetry. 


Remarks on this communication were made by Megsrs. ELLIoTT 
and Hau, who called attention to previous work on the subject. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 89 


lita M®rertiIne. FEBRUARY 20, 1884. 
The Chairman presided. 


Eighteen members and guests present. 


Mr. H. Farquaar made a communication on 


EMPIRICAL FORMULZ FOR THE DIMINUTION OF AMPLITUDE OF 
A FREELY—OSCILLATING PENDULUM. 


[Abstract. ] 


The theoretical formule usually employed are obtained by in- 
tegration from an expression for the diminution of the amplitude 
in terms of the amplitude itself. The most important term in this 
expression is one involving the first power of the amplitude, indi- 
cating a resistance proportional to the velocity of the pendulum’s 
motion. A term containing the square of the velocity (or ampli- 
tude) also enters; and, to allow for the friction of the pendulum 
knife-edge on its support, a term independent of the velocity would 
have to be added. Atmospheric resistance to very high velocities 
is found, moreover, to be proportional to a higher power than the 
square of the velocity. There are thus more than three terms the- 
oretically required to express the resistance, and these must be 
calculated, such is the uncertainty of the subject and the complex- 
ity of the conditions on which the different resistances depend, from 
the observations themselves. Since these observations must also 
be depended on for an additional constant (the amplitude at some 
initial time or the time of some standard amplitude), and since 
they are not complete or exact enough to furnish more than three 
constants, or four in a few exceptional cases, it is obvious that a 
good approximation to theory must content us in practice. 

Two convenient methods of representing amplitude in terms of 
time are suggested by imposing arbitrary conditions. First, taking 
three terms to express the diminution (the amplitude being ¢), thus: 

a + be + eg’, 
suppose the square of half the middle co-efficient equal to the 
product of the other two. This expression has then the form: 


= (ep + 6). 


90 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Integrating this value of — D,y, and supplying a constant, we 

have: 

(¢ ae b) (t{—e)=a, 
in which the constants a + be, e and — J, are easy to calculate by 
least squares. 

To show the agreement of this formula with observation, take | 
Mr. Pierce’s “mean swing” at three European stations (U.S. Coast 
Survey Report for 1876, appendix 15, pages 232, 271) and apply 
b = 29'.2, e = —7632°, a = 756847, in see ¢ from t. Hence 
the following table: 


t. g, obs’d. ¢, cale’d. Residuals (1st). Residuals (2d). 


— 2880° 130’ 130’.07 —0’.07 —0'.16 
—2187 110 109 .80 +0.20 +0.13 
—1779 100 100.11 —0.11 —0.04 
—706 80 80 .08 —0.08 +0 .24 
0 70 69 .97 +0 .03 +0 .40 
+1927 50 49 .98 +0 .02 0.00 
+3304 40 * 40.01 —0.01 —0 .66 


The agreement (in column “ residuals, Ist”) is as close as could 
be desired. The equation is that of the equilateral hyperbola, with 
asymptotes parallel to the axes of g andi. This agreement can 
be made still closer by inclining one of the asymptotes, a term 
—c(t—e)* being added. There are thus four constants to com- 
pute; but this form of equation has the advantage of having its 
constants directly deducible by least square reduction. With the 
additional term, a perfect agreement between theory and the most 
precise observations hitherto made can be attained. As an instance, 
the thirty-five observations of amplitude, from over 2° down to 10’, 
given by Prof. Oppolzer in the Proceedings of the Vienna Academy 
for October, 1882, were compared with the formula 


(¢ + 60'.6) (¢ + 10.8) — 0.5 (¢ + 10.8)? = 2178.1 


(the unit of ¢ being an interval of about 5.7) and of the residuals, 
which need not be given in detail, the largest was 0’.8. A similar 
accordance was found in a set of observations extending over six 
hours, the pendulum swinging under less than half an inch of 
atmospheric pressure. (See Mr. Pierce’s report, page 248, last two 
columns combined.) In this formula, 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 91 


D,g=— 5 {(e + 8) — 400+ (9 +1) /@ FO dae} 


ie Se bY 43 ace’ 
aah ht oe gee tte 


The correction to the time of oscillation (4 De 2”) involves 
the logarithm of ¢ — e, and is not very simple in practical applica- 
tion. 

The second convenient method is the one by which the residuals 
in the last column of the table above given were calculated. In 
this the rate of diminution is supposed proportional to g1+”, n be- 
ing a proper fraction. Hence, 


¢ (t—e) =a, and ip 9 =——___,_ =-— 
(2—n) (t-e)n* 2—n 


This formula is very simple, and the table shows its agreement 
with observation to be fair for the larger amplitudes—those of chiet 
importance. In this calculation n = 4, e = —10716°, and a= 
89400. Better results would have been obtained by using a slightly 
smaller value of n, say 0.44; but in practice the nearest tenth or 
reciprocal of a whole number is sufficient. In reducing the obser- 
vations given by Prof. Oppolzer, n was taken equal to 0.28; but 
one of the residuals exceeded 1’, though two others were as high as 
0’.9. The observations at low pressures, above referred to, indi- 
cated a much smaller n. By using the value 0.04, however, the 
agreement of formula and observation was perfect. thus appears 
to be nearly proportional to the square root of the atmospheric 
pressure; but when very small, it may be supposed to vanish, and 
g” replaced by the logarithm of g. In this case e will of course 
be the time of unit-amplitude, instead of that of infinite amplitude 
as in former cases. 

No two observations of the diminution of amplitude of the same 
pendulum will in general be found to be copies of each other, for 
differences in atmospheric conditions and in friction on the support, 
imperceptible otherwise, will manifest themselves in a changed rate 
of diminution. Even in calculating the correction for different 
parts of one extended swing, it is advisable to adopt different values 
of one or other of the constants found. By so varying the quan- 


92 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


tity e, in the formula last given, all disadvantages from its want of 
exact accordance with observation disappear, and the results are 
brought far within the needful limits of accuracy. 


Mr. GILBERT then stated 
A CONCRETE PROBLEM IN HYDROSTATICS, 


suggested by the fact that the shore-line of a quaternary lake in 
the Great Basin is shown by levels to be more than a hundred feet 
higher on elevated land, that once formed islands near its middle 
part, than on the margin of the lake. This inland sea, known.as 
Lake Bonneville, was one hundred and twenty miles across. Among 
the possible explanations of the present difference of level, the 
effect of the removal of a large body of water in changing the form 
of level surfaces in its basin had been suggested, and the problem 
was to find how great an effect was due to this cause. 


In the discussion that followed, Mr. Paut called attention to the 
complexity of the calculation of equipotential surfaces. 

Mr. Woopwarp had formerly made a somewhat similar compu- 
tation to ascertain the deflection of the plumb-line caused by un- 
equal local attraction to eastward and to westward at the eastern 
end of Lake Ontario; from which it appeared to result that the 
effect due to this cause was insignificant in comparison with that 
required by the problem. 

Other remarks were made by Messrs. Dootttri4, Hri1, H. Far- 
QUHAR, and S. J. Brown. 

At the request of the Chairman, a communication promised by 
him was postponed until next meeting. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 93 


1218 MEETING. Marca 5, 1884. 
The Chairman presided. 
‘Fifteen members present. 
Mr. A. Hatt read the following paper on 


THE FORMULZ FOR COMPUTING THE POSITION OF A SATELLITE. 


The method of rectangular co-ordinates in space furnishes a very 
simple and at the same time a general method of treating many 
questions in astronomy. This method was introduced into practical 
astronomy by Lagrange in his memoir on the Transit of Venus, 
June 3, 1769 (Berlin Academy Memoirs, 1766). Whenever we 
have to consider the relations of three points in space, we may take 
the origin of co-ordinates at one of the points, and then forming 
the values of the rectangular co-ordinates of the other points in 
terms of the polar co-ordinates, the sum or difference of two of the 
x co-ordinates being equal to the third x co-ordinate, we have an 
equation between the three polar co-ordinates. Similar relations 
hold for the axes of y and z, and hence result three equations be- 
tween the two angles and the distance that are required to be 
found. This method is extremely useful, and can be applied to a 
great number of questions in parallax, aberration, eclipses, and to 
those that occur in nearly every part of spherical astronomy. A 
great recommendation of this method is its simplicity, and the fact 
that it is so closely connected with first principles that it can be 
applied with the greatest ease. After the equations are formed 
they have only to be transformed by known rules, and the whole 
work is thus reduced to algebraic and trigonometric transformations 
which can be safely made. These advantages are so great that it 
is not surprising that this method of treating astronomical ques- 
tions has come so largely into use, and the generality and elegance 
of the process are in marked contrast with the old methods which 
proceed by spherical trigonometry.. Perhaps a disadvantage of the 
new method is that it is too mechanical, and one is apt to forget or 
never know the meaning of the quantities that areemployed. The 
old geometrical methods have therefore their value in calling to 
mind a more exact knowledge of the quantities that are used in 
the solution of a problem. 


94 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


In the method which Bessel has employed for computing the 
position of a satellite, he has derived his formule by Lagrange’s 
method. Thus if @ and 0 be the apparent right ascension and 
declination of the planet at any instant, a’, 0’ the same quantities 
for the satellite, and if p and p’ be their distances from the earth, 
and if r be the radius vector of the satellite, and a and d its right 
ascension and declination seen from the planet, we have, by the 
method of rectangular co-ordinates, 


p’ cos 0’ cos a’ = p cos 6 cos a+ 7 cos d cos a 

p’ cos O sin o = p cos d0 sin a+rcosd sina (1) 
‘sin & =p sin 0 +rsin d 

p p 


If p and s are the angle of position and distance of the satellite 
with respect to the center of the planet, the spherical triangle 
formed by the pole of the equator, the planet, and the satellite 
gives us the following equations: 


cos s = sin 6 sin ” + cos 0 cos & cos (a — a) 
sin s cos p = cos 0 sin 0’ — sin 6 cos & cos (a — a) (2) 
sin s sin p= cos © sin (a — a) 


If N and J be the longitude of the node of the orbit of the sat- 
ellite on the equator, and its inclination to the equator, and u the 
distance of the satellite from the node counted on its orbit, we have 


cos d sin (a — N) = sin u cos J 
cos d cos (a — NV) = cos u (3) 
sin d ' = sin usin J 


These three sets of equations are fundamental, and are sufficient 
for the complete solution of the problem—Given the orbit of a sat- 
ellite to determine its apparent angle of position and distance. We 
have only to transform these equations, and, in order to ease the 
computation, to introduce, as Bessel has done, certain auxiliary 
quantities which depend on the position of the planet in the heavens, 
and the position of the orbit of the satellite with respect to the 
equator. These auxiliary quantities will of course vary with the 
position of the planet, and also from the slow changes that the node 
and inclination of the orbit undergo, but they can be tabulated 
easily. So far, therefore, as the practical solution of. this question 
is concerned there is not much more to be desired, but it is interest- 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 95 


ing to look at the problem from another point of view, and one 
that will lead us to consider more closely its geometry. 

Imagine a set of rectangular axes in space, the origin being at 
the center of the planet, and denote by X, Y, Zthe points on the 
celestial sphere made by the intersections of these axes. Let S be 
the point where the prolongation of the radius vector of the satel- 
lite strikes the sphere; then we have for the co-ordinates of the 
satellite 


z=r. cos SX 
y= r.cos SY 
z= r. cos SZ 


We can express these cosines by means of six auxiliary quanti- 
ties similar to those that Gauss has used for computing the position 
of a planet. Take the prolongation of the right line drawn from 
the earth to the planet as the axis of Z, the axis of Y in the plane of 
the declination circle that passes through Z, and the axis of X at 
right angles to this plane and in the direction of increasing right 
ascensions. Let O be the pole of the equator and T' the positive 
pole of the orbit of the satellite. Introduce the following notation, 
which is the same as Bessel’s : 

arc TX =f, angle OTX=F 
Re A ete So WR cae 
Ny Ore ar 

Since the are TS = 90°, the spherical triangles STX, STY, and 

STZ give 
cos SX = sin f cos STX 
cos SY = sin gcos STY 
cos SZ = sin h cos STZ 

The distance of the satellite in its orbit from the node being u, 
and the angle OTN being 90°, we have 

STX = 90° — (F + u) 
STY = 90° — (G+ u) 
STZ = 90° — (H+ u) 

And the values of the co-ordinates are therefore: 
z=r.sinfsin(F + wu) 
y =r. singsin(G+ u) (4) 
z=r.sinhsin (H + u) 


96 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


These are the values at which Bessel arrives by the analytical 
method. The ares f, g, A are always less than 180°, and the only 
difficulty is in counting the angles F', G, H. In the purely ana- 
lytical process we merely substitute so as to satisfy the equations, 
and the result is right if we pay attention to the algebraic signs; 
but in the preceding quasi-geometrical method we must be careful 
to count the angles F', G, Hin the direction of increasing right 
ascensions from 0° to 360°. The formule for computing the six 
auxiliary quantities can be found from the spherical triangles 
TOX, TOY, TOZ. In these triangles the angles at O are 

TOX = 180°— (a— NV) 
TOY= 90 —(a—WN) 
TOZ = 90+ (—WN) 
Hence, we have 
cos f = — sin J cos (a — NV) 
sin fsin F= —sin (a— N) 
sin fcos F= cosJ cos (a— WN) 
cos g = cos é cos J + sin ésin Jsin (2 — NV) 
sin gsin G = —sin dcos(a—WN) (6) 
sin g cos G = cos 6 sin J — sin 6 cos J sin (2 — NV) 
cos h = sin 6 cos J — cos d sin J sin (a2— NV) 
sin Asin H = cos 6 cos (2 — NV) 
sin h cos H = sin 6 sin J + cos 6 cos J sin (ec — NV) 

The computation of these formule may be changed by introduc- 
ing other auxiliary quantities, as is commonly done, but nothing is 
gained by such a change if the computer is accustomed to the use 
of addition and subtraction logarithms. 

By means of the spherical triangles we can find a number of 
elegant relations among the quantities f, g,h, F, G, H. But we 
have first 

cos f? + cos g? + cos A? = 1, 
or these are the direction cosines of the line drawn from the planet 
to the pole of the orbit of the satellite. 

The triangle XTY gives 


cos XY = cos XT cos YT + sin XT sin YTveos XTY, 
and we have AY = 90°, XTY = F — G, 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 97 


hence the values of cos XY, cos YZ, cos ZX furnish the equations 
cos (F' — G) = — cotg f cotg g 
cos (G — H) = — cotg g cotgh (6) 
cos (H — F') = — cotg A cotg f 
Again the triangle X7'Y gives 
cos f = sin g cos TYX, 
and from the triangle 7YX 
sin hsin YTZ= sin TYZ, 
but TYX — TYZ= 90°, 
and YTZ= — (G— B), 
hence these equations and similar ones give 


cos h 
sin f sing 


sin (F — G) = 
cos f 
ain (GH) =" ain gain he (7) 


COs g 
sin A sin f 


sin (H — F)= 


By combining equations (6) and (7), we have 
cotang (fF — G) = — a 


cotang (G — H) = — angen’ 


__ 608 h cos f 
COS J 

cos f? = cotg (F' — G@) cotg (H — F) 

cos g’ = cotg (G— H) cotg (F — @) 

cos h? = cotg (H— F) cote (G — H) 


cotang (H — F’) = 


: cos (G@ — H) 
anf == in (F— Gein (= F+) 
, cos (H — F’) 
ang = an yan (PS G) 
. cos (F — G) 


SMI — = se He Pa GSD) 


98 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


These six auxiliary quantities are therefore strictly analogous to 
those which Gauss introduced for computing ‘the position of a 
planet. For controlling the computation, we have 

sin g sin h sin (H —G 

tang J = ; sin f oF , 
an equation in which each of the six auxiliaries enters into the 
value of J. 
If we introduce another auxiliary quantity, and put the ante 
TZO = 180° — k, 

it follows, from the manner adopted for counting an angle of 
position, that 

TZO = 180° — (p — k). 

Denoting the angle between the radius vector and the axis of 

Z by «, the spherical triangle TZS gives 
sin o sin (p — k) = cos(H + u) 
sin ¢ cos(p — k) = sin (H+ u) cos h (8) 
COs ¢ = sin(H+ u) sinh 
But we have also 
p’ sins = rsine 
p’ coss =r cosa + p, 
and by uniting these equations with (8), we can findsand p. This 
method of finding the distance and the angle of position is due to 
Marth, and as it is in constant use by him for the very convenient 
ephemerides of satellites which he publishes, it may be well to con- 
sider it further. If we multiply equations (8) by 7, and then sub- 
stitute the values of 7 sin ¢ and 7 cos ¢ from the last equations, 
we have 
p’ sin s sin (p — k) = 7 cos (H+ u) 
p’ sin s cos (p —k) = rsin (H+ wu) cosh (9) 
p’ COs 8 =rsin (H+ u)sinh+p 

Instead of these exact equations we may use in nearly all known 
cases of satellites the first two equations and put p for p’ and s si 
sins. The equations for use are then 


ssin (p — k) = 7, c08 (H+ u) (10) 


3 cos (p — k) =~ sin (H + w) cos h 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 99 


If we express s and r in seconds of arc, and assume that the orbit 


is circular, = will be the semi-major axis of the apparent ellipse 
described by the satellite, and = cos h will be the semi-minor axis. 


age. Sant 
The quantities PRs cos h, H and & can be tabulated, and equa- 


tions (10) furnish the easy method of computing s and p which is 
employed by Marth (Monthly Notices, Royal Astronomical Society.) 
For computing & we have from the triangle TZO 
snAsink= cos(a—WN)sinJ 
sin h cos k = — sin (2— NV) sinJsind—cosJcosé (11) 
and, also, sinh sin k = — cosf 
sin h cos k = — cosg 
In what precedes it is assumed that the orbit of the satellite is 
known. If this orbit is not known the easiest method of proceed- 
ing seems to be the following: First, we assume the orbit of the 
satellite to be a circle, and from the observed angles of position 
and the observed distances determine the major and minor axes of 
the apparent ellipse described by the satellite around the planet, 
and the angle of position of the minor axis. Generally these 
quantities can be found by a graphical method. The preceding 
angle & is the angle of position of the minor axis, and cos h is found 
from the ratio of the two axes. Then from the triangle TOZ we 
have the equations 


sin J cos (N— a)=sin hsin k 
sin J sin (N — a) = cos h cos Ase sinhsindcosk (12) 
cos J = cos A sin 6 — sin h cos 6 cos k 


With the approximate values of J and NW found from these equa- 
tions we can compute the auxiliary quantities depending on the 
position of the plane of the orbit and the position of the planet, 
and can determine the elements belonging to the plane of the orbit. 
These approximate elements can afterwards be corrected by equa- 
tions of condition or by other methods. 

In work of this kind it is more convenient to have the inclination 
and node of the orbit referred to the equator, and since these ele- 
ments are commonly given with respect to the ecliptic we have to 
transfer them to the equator. If n and i are the node and inclina- 


100 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


tion referred to the ecliptic, « the obliquity of the equator, and w 
the distance from the ecliptic to the equator coynted on the orbit, 
we have the following equations for finding J, N, and w. These 
equations come from the triangle between the equator, the ecliptic, 
and the orbit of the satellite. They are similar to those given in 
the Theoria Mot., Art. 55, 


in Beh w— N nm , &+s 
sin cos = ¢c0s > Sin 
2 2 2 


A _ w—N pe ij 4 
sin 4 J sin 5} = sin > sin —> 
w+ N n e+iz 

cos 2 J cos ——g— = cos 7 C08 —G 
‘ _ wt Nv BF gee) ag 
cos + J sin —9 = sy OG 


For the inverse problem of finding 7, NV, and w from J, N, and 
e, we have from the same triangle 


: n-— w N fife 3 
cos ¢ 2 COs 5) = C08 F COS —Z 

eee Se) , No. Paes 
cos #2 sin 5} = siN 5 C08 —p 
‘ ; n w NN’, J—e 
sin + 2% cos —7 = cos 5 sin —F5 
; sud» Mb erate etal ky era 
sin $7 sin 5} = sin 5 sin 5) 


POSITION OF A SATELLITE. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 101 


TX =f, OTX = F, OT = J, STZ = 90° — (H+ u) 
TY =g, OTY= G, OY = 4, TZO = 180° — k 
TZ = h, OTZ = H, OZ = 90° — 6, TZS = 180° — (p — &) 
NS = u, NOZ = a — N, TOZ= 90°+(a — N), SZO = 360° — p 
TOX = TOY + 90 = 180° — (4 — N) 

WN is the pole of OT, .. NOT = NTO = 90° 

In response to a question, Mr. Hauy said that in computations 
of orbits of double stars, as little reliance should be placed upon 


measures of distance as possible. Variations of angular velocity 
are far safer. 


Mr. G. W. Hit made a communication on 
A FORMULA FOR THE LENGTH OF A SECONDS-PENDULUM, 


which is published in full tn the Astronomical Papers of the 
American Ephemeris, Vol. III, Part 2, Chapter V. 


138tH MEETING. Marcu 26, 1884. 
The Chairman presided. 
Fourteen members present. 
Mr. Atex. §. CHRISTIE made a communication on 
A FORM OF THE MULTINOMIAL THEOREM. 


This communication is reserved by the author. Remarks were 
made by Mr. Hitt. 


Mr. R. 8. WoopwarpD gave a 


DISCUSSION OF A CONCRETE PROBLEM IN HYDROSTATICS 
PROPOSED BY MR. G. K. GILBERT. 


Remarks on this communication were made by Mr. G1LBert. 


Mr. C. H. KumME LL gave the first part of a communication on 
THE QUADRIC TRANSFORMATION OF ELLIPTIC INTEGRALS, 


which was unfinished when the hour of adjournment arrived. 


102 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


14rH MEETING. May 7, 1884. 


The Chairman presided. 


Nine members present. 


In the absence of the Secretary, the minutes were read by Mr. 
CHRISTIE. 


Mr. KumME Lt finished the paper begun by him at last meeting on 


THE QUADRIC TRANSFORMATION OF ELLIPTIC INTEGRALS, 
COMBINED WITH THE ALGORITHM OF THE 
ARITHMETICO-GEOMETRIC MEAN. 


[Abstract. ] 


The algorithm of the arithmetico-geometric mean, so remarkable 
for its symmetry and convenience, was first used by Gauss many 
years before the brilliant era of Abel and Jacobi. The form which 
the theory of elliptic functions assumed under the hands of these 
eminent geometers, though extremely beautiful, might be improved 
from a practical point of view by a combination with the Gaussian 
algorithm. In the attempt to do this, the defects of the usual nota- 
tion became very annoying, and gradually the new, simple, and 
consistent system of notations, as used in the following, resulted : 

I assume for the type of an integral of the first species, 


Y Y 
i adg ig adg 

V a@— sin’ V a cos *9 + 8 sin *9 
oO oO 


4 d 4 d 
V1—/;'sin’g V cos 29 + f sin *9 
oO oO 
For the inverse of this I write u_y = ¢. - (2) 


> 


By (1) we have the modulus 7 = < and the complementary modu- 


lus?=—-. The letters y and # are used throughout as symbols for 


a a 
required. 


c : P 
— and —, respectively, and are expressed in a, 6, and ¢ whenever 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 103 


In the theory of elliptic functions, sin amu, cos amu, A amu 
(Jacobi’s notation) or snu, cn, dnu (Gudermann’s notation), the 
elliptic quadrant K (Jacobi) is the numerical unit of their period. 
Consistency requires the use of the quadrant as a unit for trig- 
onometric functions also. Let _| denote a circular quadrant (ordi- 


narily denoted >) ; then we have, by the notation just explained, 


ma | 


inet NMEA ip 3 
—_S_= ose ch (= K of Jacobi). ( ) 


oO 


The complementary integral then 


a 
d 7 ° 
STFS =! © K of Incobi. (4) 


If n is an integer, then, and only then, (n_|)y =n _|y. (5) 


Thus we should be careful in distinguishing between integrals 
such as 
2 _] a 
? 


i Pe 9 aA ean 
Oy \ rapa tb Se 


According to the system of notation just explained, it is unneces- 
sary to use the Jacobian am or the Gudermannian n, neither of 
which define the functional relation completely, and we write simply 


sin g = sin u_y (= sin amu of Jacobi or 
snu of Gudermann) 


cos = cos u_y (= cos amu of Jacobi or 
enu of Gudermann) 
V1i—7sin’g= Ag= Au_y(= A amu of Jacobi or 
dnu of Gudermann) (6) 


I remark that none of the usual notations indicate the modulus, 
and a grave objection to Gudermann’s is that it is apt to give the 
impression that snw and cnw are not an ordinary sine and cosine. 
I shall now give in this notation a number of well-known relations, 
of which use will be made hereafter. The theorem of addition is, 
if w and v are two integrals to the modulus +, 


104 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


sin (wu + v)_y = sin w_y cos v_y A v_y + sin Vy cos U_y A U_y 
-+1—/’ sin *u_y sin v_y 

cus (wu + V)—y = C08 U_y COS V_y + sin U_y A u_y sin v_y A v_y 
—-1—/’ sin *u_y sin v_y 

A (ut v)-y= Au_yAv_y + 7 sin u_y cos u_y sin v_y cos v_y 


+1—/’ sin *u_y sin v_y (7) 
We have gin (y= 1 
cos(+ _])=0 
a(+_)=8 (8) 
therefore, replacing v by _ |y, we have 
: as COS U—y 
sin (ust |jyj=+ A uay 
ey sin U_y 
eos (ste iy) = ea wes ay 
B 
ST 7 talaga (9) 
Replacing in these u by u + _|y, we have 
sin (w+ 2_ jy) = —sin u_y 
cos (wu - 2_ |y) = — cos u_y 
A(w+2 _b)= Auy (10) 


It follows, replacing in these u by w+ 2_|y, that 4_|]y is the 
complete period of the elliptic sine and cosine and 2 _ }y that of the 
delta. 

Placing u = v, we have the duplication formule: 


sin (2u)_y = 2 sin w_y cos u_y A u_y + 1—?’ sin tu_y 
cos (2u)—y = cos *u_y — sin *u_y A*u_y + 1 — 7’ sin *u_y 
A (2u)-y = A®u_y—7’ sin®u_y cos*u_y + 1—/’ sin *u—y (11) 


Replacing in these u by + wu and solving, we have the dimidia- 
tion formule: 


sin? (+) ~y = 1— cos u_y +1+Au_y 
cos” ($)+= Au_y + cos U—y +1-+Au_,y 


U 


“W(>)y=P+4u_-y+ 7 cosu_y+1+t+au_y (12) 
3 )-7 y 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 105 


Jacobi’s imaginary transformation consists in assuming 


sin 9 = 7 tan ¢ 


or C08 PS coe @ 
Ege SNES 1 
of Seg ley = coe o 4 A -7 (18) 
 d es 
tre Wy: ST in 
then u =| Ag Sam 
0 ° 


or u= vy =i $B | (14) 
therefore, by (13), | 


; : U 1 ‘ 
sin U_y = 2 tan (+) -8 = tan (ut)_g 


1 1 
COS U-y = TF a LS Tae Pn OA SLs 
a (+) te cos (ut)_B 


A uy= ae A (+) aie: Da" (ui)_g (15) 


Using these relations in (7), we obtain the following formule 
for elliptic functions, with complex arguments and complementary 
moduli: 
sin (w+ w)-y=sinu-y Avg +icosu_y A u_ysin v-f cos v_gB 

+ 1—A%*u-_y sin 7v_g 
cos (wu = vi)-y = Cos U_y Cosv_B F isin u_y AU_ysinv_B Av_B 
--1—Au-_y sin *v_g 
A (ut v)-y= Au-_y cosv_pAv_B + y’isin u_y cos U_y sin v_Z 
+1—A*u-_y sin *v_B (16) 
We have sin (_|¢)-g=1 
cos (_|a)-p = 0 
4 (_\s)-=7 17) 


106 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


therefore, replacing in (16) v by _|, we have 


sin(u+ _|gt)-p= Tat 
cos (u + _]e1)-p= + Kile ts! 
7 sin u_y 
A(u _|s1)-p= + 1 cot u_y (18) 
Placing in these u + _|g 7 for u, we have 
sin (wt2_|et)-y= sin wy 
cos (w+ 2_ |g i)-y = — cos u_y 
A(ut2 _|pi)-y=— Auwy (19) 


It follows, replacing in these u byu+2_|g%, that 4_|g7is 
the imaginary period of the elliptic cosine and delta and 2 _|gz 
that of the sine. We have then, if m and » are integers, 


sin (u+4m_|ly+ 24 _|6%)-y =sin u_y 
cos (u+4m_}ly+ 44 _]|p8 t)-y = cos u_y 
A(ut+2m_ly+44_|gt)-y= Auy (20) 


The general problem of transformation may be en thus: 
Assuming 


1 1 77 
Sot —c sing —— sin 2¢" Ue ee et (21) 


then it is required to discover the relations between the given quan- 
tities 9, a, y arid ¢’, a’, 7’. 

Before treating of the special subject of this paper (the quadric 
transformation), a short exposition of some important points of the 
general problem of transformation, slightly modified from Abel 
(see Enneper’s Elliptische Functionen, page 239-246), will be 
given. 


We have, by (21), 
cin g = sin (% of ) y= seine) =sf sin (4 gy) b 2 


where f denotes the unknown relation between sin ¢ and sin ¢’. 


| ‘MATHEMATICAL SECTION. | 107 
But we have, by (20), 
sin (¢’/ + 4m’ _|y +24’ _|p’ %)-/ 
=sin{ Sey t4m_y+2u_dby (8) 


therefore, m |= — m _ly (24) 


# ig aig (25) 


Oe ae, Se OC, 


and S=5a" = 


Anticipating here the definition of the highly important con- 
stant, the nome q, which is such a prominent feature in the brilliant 
researches of Jacobi and Abel, we have 


ls 
q=e * hy ie 
and the nome q’ of the transformed integral is 
_|6 m’ 1 _|p mip 


ee ee Oe ae | = = bee GD) 


Thus it appears that the nomes of the given and transformed 
integrals are in a relation 
q” — d n! 
where n and n’ are integers, and, if n = 1 and n’ = 2, we have the 
quadric transformation. 
Landen’s transformation consists in assuming 


sin (2y’ — ¢) =—sing (28) 


which is Legendre’s convenient form for computing the amplitude 
gy’. Differentiating, we have 


(2d¢’ — dg) cos (2¢’ — ¢) = —cos gy dg 


dy dg’ 


or” ahge  t(as¢-+ccos¢) (29) 


108 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Solving for g, we have 


a sin 2¢’ a tans’ 
baa arn + a cos 2¢’ ~ a’ — U’ tan 79’ (30) 
one 2a sin ¢’ cos ¢’ __ asin ¢’ cos ¢’ (31) 
Pe Ya + 2ac cos 2¢ +e a ag’ 
e+acos2¢’ 1 b’ 
cos ¢ = ret as (da é—z3) (82) 
et ae bv’ 
ag=—(a A¢g +z9) (33) 


where we have placed 


t(ate)=a;t(a—ec) =U; 


_Vac=¢; Va? —c? sin?’ =a ag (34) 
From (82) and (33) follows 
ado’ =} (ad¢-+c cos ¢) (35) 
b’ 

ag TGR Ps core) (36) 

d dy’ 
and (29) becomes rye =7ag (37) 

1 1, 

the integral is 7 %7=a gy (38) 


‘The first and third formula of (34) give the first step in the 
algorithm of the arithmetico-geometric mean, and the first two fol- 
low from (35) and (86) by placing g = 0 = ¢’, 2. e., they are rela- 
tions at the lower limit of the integrals, corresponding to (35) 
and (86). 


/ 


Assuming sin (2¢” — ¢’) = — sin g’ (28’) 
oe’ = 3 (a’ + d); jess } (a’ ee c); eee Vad (34’) 

1 1 / 1 "et 
then we have a ay ety = Tey (38’) 


Proceeding in this manner the amplitudes will very rapidly 
reach a limit ¢‘~), while simultaneously a and ¢ tend to become 
equal to their common limit, the arithmetico-geometric mean of a 
and ec. Gauss, when investigating its functional properties, denotes 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 109 


this by Uf (a, c); elsewhere he uses the notation a‘~) or c(*), which 
is sufficiently distinct for our purpose. 
At the limit we have a(™) a g(*) = e() cos g(”), therefore, 


1 a 
ok shee A od ee ey = bom ight ater e 


dyl=) 1 : 
(=a am) tant (_] + 96 )) (38(@)) 
ie) 


Let e= ‘3 then gy ae aes o" = a. Paki gl) = _](2) and 


1 Dib eras ok J 
im _ly fo ra /= a ea a Fo) ea 
(= Ta tan (J+ am) (39(~)) 
This transformation can be applied also to the more general form: 
Ce 
‘hen f dg ° 40 
= JZ in ¢, 003 ¢, 49) (40) 
0) 


for if, simultaneously to the above algorithm, we express sin ¢, cos ¢, 

A ¢ in terms of sin ¢’, cos ¢’, 4 ¢’, and these again in terms of 

sin yg”, cos g”, A g”, etc., by means of (31), (82), (83), we arrive, 

after a few transformations, at the form 

g(~) 
dg(~) 


~ J eo) cos gi) 
Oo 


I f (>) (sin ¢!™), cos gf@)) (41) 
which is an elementary form if f (sin ¢, cos g, A ¢) is rational 
with respect to sin ¢, cos ¢, A ¢. 

In tracing this process backwards, the quantities may be dis- 
tinguished at the several steps by subprimes, so that we have, at 
the first backward step, 


sin (29 — ¢,) = <t sin 9, = ee sin ¢, (28,) 
é 


a=4(a,+¢);b=3(4,—¢); ¢=Va,¢, (34,) 
Adding, and then also subtracting, sin ¢, from (28,) and dividing 


the difference by the sum, we have the following convenient for- 
mula, also given by Legendre: 


tan (g,—¢) = Stan ? (42) 


110 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 
Solving (34,) for a, 5, ¢,, we have 
a,=a+b;b,=2Vab;¢=a=b 


In order to have again the convenient algorithm of the arith- 
metico-geometric mean, it is preferable to assume 


a, = 4a,= 3 (a+); b, = 4, = ab; 6, = be, = (@—b) (43) 


For the second step assume 


b 
tan (¢, — ¢) = = tan 9, (42,) 
1 
a,=t(a,+ b,); b= a,b; & = 2 (a, — 4) (43,) 
1 1 iL 
We have then ede 2a, (Q)n = Pa, Ce (44,) 


Continuing this process, which diminishes the modulus, and is 
therefore called descending the scale of moduli, while the above is 
called ascending, the a and 6 will rapidly approach their arithmetico- 


geometric mean, @~ = 6, while Fa Pin) tends towards a limit 


which I shall denote ¢. The limiting form of the integral is 


P(e) 
dg(ay _ Yoo 
Bey ibe \ 


and we have 


1 1 1 betel Dea . 
Ly — dq, Pn= ig, Pu)¥. = we tw ew 92 Ge (Yo), (=52 (44(~)) 
1 1 

If g = _|theni¢,= pe,=-+-pr 9m =--- = J 
and we have 
1 1 1 1 il 
A yet neh nee — 1h, (=F) 5m) 


This remarkable value for the complete integral was discovered 
by Gauss by means of a different transformation, known as Gauss’. 
This may be deduced as follows: Assume in place of (44(*)) the 
following series of relations 


1 1 1 
4 y= 1 Gon = EG On= +11 3z ode (= Foe Ge) 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 111 


To discover the relations for the first step we have to determine 
¢, from the equations 


Wn =1@)n = ¢y (46) 


Place in (12) wu =(¢,)y,, then 3 u = (¢,)y, and u_y, = ¢,; (5) -/1 
= ¢,, and consequently 
sin 7¢, = 1 — cos ¢, +1+A¢, 
cos*y, =A¢g,-+ cos ¢¥, +1l+Ag, 
4%, =f) +49,+y77cosg,+1+4¢9, (47) 
From (32) and (33) we derive with due regard to (43) 


a,ay,=3(aa¢ +z) 


b 
g4¢,=t(aae— x2) (48) 
and eliminating ¢g, from (47) by means of (48) there result the 
relations 


’ a 1—Ag 

Se i Gin Taale 
gyi it Senere i, 
me fe 6 (Lag) 
awtg+t+b 

2 — 

ath =a £49) oS) 
whence also 

» ____ asin gy 

ae a, + ¢, sin *¢, 

__ a, cos $, Ag, 

Ne tan feed 
— } 2 


~ a, + ¢ sin *¢, 
This is Gauss’ transformation. For practical use it is far less 


convenient than that given above. 
Instead of (46) we might have assumed — 


m (,)y, = 2 (¢,)y, = 2n <1. gy (mand n integers) (51) 


For any special values of m and n we can express, by means of 


112 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


the addition theorem, the elliptic functions of {m (A)y} -y, in terms 
of those of 6,, and in the same manner those wf {n (¢.n}-n in 
terms of those of ¢g, Since we know ¢ in terms of ¢,, we can elimi- 
nate g, and obtain a relation between @, and ¢, which would be a 
new transformation. However, we need not expect to discover in 
this manner any substitution sufficiently simple for practical use. 

The substitutions given above may of course be applied also to 
the complementary integral, and, since interesting relations will 
be thus discovered, I place the different series of forms together for 
comparison. 


i Se Cl HS Oe aa = Te fi”) 
(= Tal tan # (_] + of) 
= 94, (Pn = Fa (er a ei on |= lim 2 
ar 
== On=— Dy == Wa) 
\ (=5,¢- (52y) 
= 9p 9B == (PDB =, (Par = ve ee moe = (ve) 
(= : Ztan + (_] + ga) 
=9, (e-)6 = rare iA a eee = ay lim 
( aoe 
aly 1 ppd. eel aan 
(= (52p) 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 113 


(= Foyltand (_] + _J) 


1 1 
Ri ra aidedte) (ee afte Mie tat st |e) i al ye iad Fare (53) 
1 1 1 
cage oars (A= a, = Ole Sirieiey 9) ay aa wey # a bo (_I@), 
| (ate ved ona) 
1 1 
a ae _|e ea Be ae aay Karey ch aie stp'a) eee tic =o)! (538) 
We easily deduce the symmetrical relations 
2) (Pa) = Yo Hl) (54) 
Je) (_Je), = _P (55) 


This last equation is well known; it appears here, however, as a 
particular case of a more general relation. The quantity ¢. is the 
argument of the @ functions and ie usually denoted 2; 9,() is 


then denoted by x’ ; Schellbach has 5 for Je) and for _ },(>), 


while Hoiiel, in his Recueil de wie has p and p’, respectively. 
Other relations are 
Ph?) deo Of) deo GK gl") Hay 
Se) TC AP cy 
(ge), 9) oh M2) (Poh ua) HM) glo 


iN = SS = —————: * OO EES OO C 


ea oer Cie ek OO 
The following expressions for the nome q can now be given: 


18 mn 
Pa aay ha 2 (_le), 


ey eng (58) 

The first form is simply Jacobi’s definition; the second gives, 
since 

(_Joo), = 2 tan 4 (_] + _Je) (59) 

q = cot? # (_] + _]o) (60) 

This is one of the best formule for computing gq, especially if the 

modulus does not differ much from unity. The third form may be 


114 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


used if 6 and ¢ are not very different, for in that case the algorithm 
of the arithmetico-geometric mean converges equally fast in both 
directions. If either 6 or c is very near to a, the process may con- 
verge in one direction so slowly that the formula becomes nearly 
inapplicable. 

The fourth form may be transformed to a new formula, which is 
more convenient than any given. In (52g) place ¢ = 2” _], then, 
since ; 


P= 2-1 _J5 gy = I"? _J5 pe BMF _J wee 
on = athe Pn+1 — (2Pie Ws 8 “_2e 8 @ 
we have 


AL oi—1 Qn—2 
ple ae Ses gr aie eer 


i 1 
a eo ae Oe { _Nn41 wae (61) 


Gn +1 
But we have by (28) = sin(2(2h_)Pn+1—_)= i sin | 


or Qaiin? (OP. Dae 1 


Gn 
. | yaa 
Ser C2" Dp \/ (4 ae ) 


If we suppose a, = 6, = 6. within the precision of the compu- 
tation, ¢, will be very small, yet not zero. We have then 


i 1 
pecighec {@" Detite 


1 
= ttan #(_} + (2"_})n 41) 


Qn+1 
HE i Vi 1 + sin (2n Dna s 
ct wae 1 — sin (2? Dn 
Per rn 
Vig: h tye (1 +8) 
Tig yas 


Vityi (142) 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 115 


Oy eet +c) 


ar Qn +1 bn 
V3 (a—3) 

1 2 Van 

aaa ee l VEG (sufficiently near) 

ey pee 

as - U Ete Para (sufficiently near) 
1 ? On : 

= 5 / aves (sufficiently near) (62) 
oo Cn 

therefore we have by (61) 
1 dat 1 2? an 


eee." ve 


Da Deltas 2 
ee 2 Bi L (—*) 


Cn 

2 == 2 —n+1 
1 (an zm)? "=1(2 a? i 

n—1 Cn—1 

: on 

since Cp = + (An_1 — D n_1) =7 
it, ae —n+1 — Be —n+2 

= 1 (2m . =)" =1(="=)" i 


if AS V Gx An—1 


=] (2 on an 1 Ga) ee 
i C n—3 Cn—3 


if a,» = V 4-1 An—2 


G, ¢, 
if a,= Ya, a, (63) 
2 <al 2 
a (2%, . =)? =1 (=) 
Cc Cc 


if=V aa, (64) 


116 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Using (63) in the fourth form of (58) we have 
e a—b z 
io Fa - (65) 


and using (64) we have 
an \* 
a= (ya) 
The nome of the complementary integral is denoted by Jacobi 
and writers that follow him by 7. In our system this would be 
the notation for the nome of the integral ¢’/; ¢/’ that for gy”, ete; 
also gq, that of (¢,)y1.3 q% of (%)y, ete. It is therefore better to 


follow the example of Broch, who denotes the nome of the com- 
plementary integral by p. We have then 


aay 
pik POE ae 25] 


Se OOt) BO ae oth) eee aro T= Pa (sr) (67) 


where aml) = 7/ Gi) g @—1) 


a (7—2) — V at—qnr2 
a (n—3) — V an—2 qn—3 
al! = V a” q 
a =VY aa (68) 


By (55) and the second forms of (58) and (67) we have the 
following relation between p and q 


ip-4lq-4—= PP (69) 

or in Briggian logarithms 
log {log p— log q~4} = log (_| log e)? = 9.6678084 (69) 
or _—_ log{log p-! log q-! } = 0.2698684 (70) 


By means of this relation we can always choose the shortest 
route to either p or g. It is easy to see that the nomes and com- 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. TA 


plementary nomes at the several steps of the modular scale are as 
follows 


—n Die Gist 
m= o ee B= 3H=C GT=RIEHTY 
SSGon) ss ote qQ”) = (71) 
Qn he 2? ay Ee (Aaeee 2 Ud 
Pri=p ape > 1—P-s P—P> Pp —P>P 
9-2 Q-n 
Sar OIC Arata (ets op” = p (72) 


We have then in this transformation the simplest possible case 
of Abel’s theorem (27); and because in ascending we pass to the 
square of the nome, it is called the quadric transformation. 

The ascending transformation is possible in real quantities if 
c¢ > a, for we have M(c, a) = M(a,c). Also if 6 > awe can use 
the descending transformation; and in either case we can, after 
one transformation, proceed in either direction. This may be 
symbolized by the following diagram 


bg a’ > rd 


ae 
In order to exhibit the practical nature of the formule given, I 
shall make the necessary aca area for the integral 


fe ae 
aa V1—sin?75sin’¢ Q 


if ¢ = 70° and also for tho complete integral. . 
Because y = sin 75° is > 7/3 we must use the ascending trans- 
formation. The computation for 70°sin 7° may be conveniently 
arranged as follows: 
26 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


118 


(e2) pe ee a va i oll Se EAE 


? 6 


easy am ‘(19) pus (eq Ag) ' 


‘toryejnduwo0o Jo yuNows ows oy} A[Jowxe seatnbar sseooad siyy Aq o% UIS[~ Jo uoryeyndut0d oyy, 


B0L9IIZO = off WIS 9K) BOT 


CF0SZ66'6 — = («9 BOT — 
£81196 — = a Bo] Soy — 
L6S69F8'S = ((x)% +/+) = By BOT Soy 


9FLECOL'O = (x) +/+) § UBq Soy PP SZ LFSL=(@e)o +1) §F 
88 ‘OC FE 19 = 2 = (=)? 


CE0CZE6'6 = /P 80] = (w)9 SOT 


11892666 = ? 80] 
GILFZ66'6 = / 80 | 66966860 = 


I1F8¢96'6 = C4 — ,,22) Ws Soy oe OL rely £56 
£906696'6 = 2 US SOT Cr FS Gg LO= 4 
96261966 = (4 — 4%) uls Soy P8 SOILG9= 4— 2% 
86862166 = 4 UIs So 00,/00,000L= 4 


0000000'0 = ” Sof | 8G%6¢96'0 = 8 
SSP6F86'6 = 9 50] [=o 


119 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


‘sopnytydure Aq avy} o[duris o10Ul IBY St POYJOU SIT, 


OOLIZEF'O 8 =—- = 08% UST SOT 


GF0GG66'6 — = (~)9 Bo, — 
SP8L1896 — = 2 Soy BOT — 

. SF9FZLO'O = %-A SOT Soy 
PRSCIST I «= = %- Boy o% MIST Jo wolyeynduU0D 
cresoeg, = @aoj 
LGZFEEGS =O — v) Soy ZELOFEO'0 = 9 — 0 
0060806°0 — = 3% 80, — 


Gh0SZ66'6 — = 2 80, — 


“ATIeva puNnoy st [BAdoyUT oyo[uu09 oy} wy} WLOAy puv ouFoM AreyMENMETdUIOD 94} VOY} oynduIOD eA, 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


120 


OOLIZEF'O = = 0% BB Boy 
68F6SCL'6 — = °g So, — 
66119610 =[ 807 
LOE99TS'O — = 0% HS,0), SOT 
68F6EEL'6 — = °¢9 BOT — 
6FLEGS9F =, 218 BOT 
1610G¢9z'¢ =" So] 


S6SFLOF'O = ("4 — BS) ue} Boy 
BST Oy 0, a amy 20] 


ocg90gs'6 = ("4 — 4) wey So] 
96ETSEV'6 = “4 uey Soy 


“69S0L9F'0 = C6 — "d) uv} Soy 
“IZLF6GC'O = ‘4 wey Soy 


S0S61E8'6 = ( 4 — “4) ue} Soy 
IFS68EF'O = 4 Uey Soy 


o% UIs Jo woIyeyndu0~ 


GG T9LZ6T = 


GG 
SP 


09 
88 


FO 
¥8 


FO 
08 


08 


‘6G FG GE 
00.,,00,00002 


TY GE EE 


"6S GF 9G8 = 


‘66 1G 8GF = 
‘66 1G 86F = 


‘YE OOTIG = 
‘ELST VIE = 


"9T 0¢ SOL = 
"6S FG GOT = 


Pp 
“A = (~)d 
Nd we aly 
Md 
"A at "4 
"4 
'd a "dA 
'd 
d— 'd 
d 


6EF6EEL'6 = "9 SOT = 


LFFG6SSL'6 = ‘0 80] 
OSF6EEL'6 = *9 Soy 


FOLIGGL'6 = ‘0 50] 
LGLLEGL'6 = *@ 80[ 


SEE6861L'6 = 'P Boy 


2 


I86F90L'6 = ‘9 50] 


0000000°0 = » Soy 
CIGESIF'6 = 9 SOT 


”@ Bo] 


PZLFLOG'O = *p 


1g98coc'0 = *9 
09L069¢°0 = *P 


€60F669'0 


O6T88960 = 9 
= D 


‘8}BINDOV SSO] BIOJA.1OT} pus ‘esvd sTyy 
Ul IaSMOT St II YSNoy} ‘WAOYS oq MOU TIIM o[Bos Surpusosep oy} Aq [v1SojUI ouMNS oY} JO WOTyVynduUIOD oY, 


121 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


‘smorjouns o1jdi]]9 Jo ArOoYy oY} OUT UBaUT OITJOUIOSS-OoTJOUIYIIIE OY} JO UIYZLOSTB oy} Jo 
WOLJONpoOLzUL oy} Woy sadByUBApE [voTJOvAd oY] MOYs 07 JUoTOYFNs ‘odoy | ‘st YoIexs ojo[duMODUr eAogs oY], 


£89869 0 


G818968°6 = 1—5 So] So] GZZLLEL'0 = 1-5 FO] 
ShEFELS'0 = 1-4 Bo] So] gggTege’Z = 1—a Soy 


eaBy OM ‘((),) Aq sooyo OL 
TLLZZIG6 = b Soy 


I 


$$Z6698'6 Qq—» So OI18LItFL0O =9—2 
00608060 — = = ,@ 80] — 
GLESHGL6 — = *» Bol — 


Trr6sol6 = = *» SOT 


:sny} spuvzs b ourou oy} Jo uo14WeynduI0D EY, 


122 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Mr. Hau. spoke of the importance of the arithmetico-geometric 
mean in astronomy. . 


Mr. W. B. TAytor made a communication on 


A CASE OF DISCONTINUITY IN ELLIPTIC ORBITS * 


around an empty center of gravitative force. Diminution of the 
minor axis of the attracted body’s path (the major axis being con- 
stant) increases the ratio of distance at the two apses without limit, 
the “periapsis” continually approaching the attractive center, 
as long as the minor axis has a value, however small. But when 
this axis is made to vanish, and the motion is directly to the center 
of force, the body, instead of rebounding from it, as continuity 
would require, will pass through it, and describe an equal path on 
the opposite side, the orbit being at once doubled. 


This paper was discussed by Messrs. Bares, Caristir, Haun 
and others, and brought out a wide diversity of view as to the 
demeanor of a heavy point when coincident with an empty attract- 
ing center. 


15TH MEETING. . DECEMBER 38, 1884. 
The Chairman presided. 


Nineteen members and guests present. 
Mr. M. H. DooxrrrLe made a communication on 
THE VERIFICATION OF PREDICTIONS. 


[ Abstract. ] 


Mr. G. K. Gilbert has published (American Meteorological 
Journal, 8°, Detroit ; September, 1884, pp. 166-172) a method of 
estimating the ratio of skill in predictions of occurrences and non- 
occurrences of a simple event. Adopting his notation, we have 


s = the sum or total number of cases, 
o = the number of occurrences, 


p= the number of predictions of occurrences, 


i 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. ro 


e = the number of coincidences or verifications, 


} = the inference-ratio, or that part of the success which is due to 
skill and not to chance, and which may be called the degree 
of logical connection between event and prediction. 


Since success is proportional to each of the two fractions 
c c 
—~(gnd'—s 
0 p 
it may be represented by their product 
é 


op 
ak ; 
The fraction {> Tepresents the ratio of random success, and 


0 : : awh e ¢ 
therefore = verifications out of p predictions are to be ascribed 


to chance and must be subtracted throughout. The remainders, 


0 0 
0 — ‘and p— i, 
8 8 
represent fields which chance leaves for science to conquer; and 
PE ol 


represents the portion of each which science does conquer. Hence 


he We 
fe ee 
7B DP Opa —oya— py 
8 8 


By another method, 


< = the probability that any single occurrence will be predicted 
in some manner. 

P —: 

8s— 


c bee , 
9 = the probability that any single date of non-occurrence 


will correspond to an unsuccessful prediction = the general 
probability of unskillful prediction in any case. 


Subtract from the probability that any single occurrence will be 
predicted in some manner the general probability of unskillful 
prediction, and we have 
= _ e = = the probability that any given occurrence will be 

skillfully predicted. 


124 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


In like manner 


4 = the probability that any single prediction will be fulfilled 


in some manner. 


: = = the general probability of unpredicted occurrence; which, 
in case of prediction, becomes probability of fortuitous ful- 
fillment. 

> ; - = the probability that any single prediction will be 


fulfilled by reason of a logical connection. 

Since the skillful predictions are mingled indistinguishably with 
all the unskillful ones, and are vitiated accordingly, the value of 
the vitiated probability of the skillful prediction of any single 
occurrence may be represented by the product 

: c ¢ o—e (cs — op)? 
re (<- s— ;) x een, ™ op(s — 0)(s — p)’ 
as before. 

Prof. C. 8. Peirce (in Science, 1884, Nov. 14, Vol. IV, page 453) 
deduces the first of these factors as the unqualified value of 2, 
making no allowance for the vitiation, and tacitly assuming that 
an assortment of predictions is the logical equivalent of a jumble 
of the same predictions. He obtains his result by the aid of the 
supposition that part of the predictions are made by an infallible 
prophet, and the others by a man ignorant of the future. If Prof. 
Peirce had called on omnipotence instead of omniscience, and sup- 
posed the predictions to have been obtained from a Djinn careful to 
fulfill a portion of them corresponding to the data, the remainder 
of the occurrences being produced by an unknown Djinn at ran- 
dom, he would have obtained by parallel reasoning the second 


factor, i — se These Djinns represent, respectively, the 
known and unknown forces of nature, and gauge the prophet’s 
knowledge with principal reference to the proportion of predictions 
fulfilled. Prof. Peirce’s test refers principally to the proportion of 
occurrences predicted. THis test eliminates sins of omission; the 
other, sins of commission; and both are necessary to a proper 
estimate of the prophet’s comparative rectitude. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 125 


In the data cited by Mr. Gilbert from Finley’s tornado predic- 
tions, s = 2803, o= 51, p = 100, andc = 28. By Mr. Gilbert’s 
formula, 


a) cs — op 
“= 8(0--p —¢) — op 
he obtains 
t= 216. 
Prof. Peirce obtains 
4= .523. 
I obtain 
4= .142. 


By making s, 0, and 7 constant, and imposing conditions on p and 
¢, we may obtain hypothetical data involving equal skill. Putting 
e = p, I infer that Mr. Finley would have manifested equal skill if 
he had made no false predictions of tornadoes, and, out of the 51, 
had predicted 7.35. Mr. Gilbert’s formula gives 11.18, and Prof 
Peirce’s 26.67. Putting c=o0,I infer that he would also have 
manifested equal skill if he had included all the 51 tornadoes by 
making 323.7 predictions. Mr. Gilbert’s formula gives 221.5, and 
Prof. Peirce’s 1364. 

_ Mr. Finley’s entire success in predicting tornadoes is 


ee = .154; 
op 
and since the portion due to skill = .142, we may infer that .923 
of this success is due to skill, and only .077 to chance. On the 
other hand, of his success in predicting the non-occurrence of tor- 
nadoes, only .147 is due to skill, and .853 is due to chance. 
Prophecy and fulfillment are effects of a common cause. Neither 
causes the other. The problem, broadly stated, requires a nume- 
rical expression for the causal relation between two classes of phe- 
nomena either in co-existence or in sequence, when the presence of 
one corresponds sometimes to the presence and sometimes to the 
absence of the other, and sometimes both are absent. In case of 
sequence it is immaterial which is antecedent. The quantities de- 
noted by o and p should therefore be interchangeable. 
My formula responds properly to every test proposed by Mr. 
Gilbert. The value of 7 increases rapidly with that of c, and 


126 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


slowly with that of s, diminishes with increase of o or p, and varies 
between the limits 0 and 1. Skill in making false predictions is 
indicated by a negative value of cs — op; but the same degree of 
causal relation exists as when equal skill is employed in making 
true predictions ; and a negative value of 7 can never occur. When 


: : 0. : ; 
s = either p or 0,1 = 9? but the apparent indeterminateness van- 


ishes when we consider that 7 is the product of two factors, of which 
one = 0-and the other is indeterminate within limits. And the 
value of 2 is unaltered when predictions of non-occurrences are 
substituted for those of occurrences, and vice versa. In the latter 
case, write s — o for 0,s — p for p, and s—o—p+e fore; and 
the formula reduces to its original form. 

In addition to Mr. Gilbert’s tests, two others may be | 
In the case of predictions all falsely reported, we may write s — p 
for p and o — ¢ for c; and the formula becomes 


4s 4? Lop — ca)? 
~ op (s— 0) (8 —p)’ 


with a proper reversal of signs in the quantity under the exponent 
and no change in the value of 7. 

If occurrences always appear whenever they are not predicted, 
and never appear when they are predicted, we put c= 0 and 
p= s — 0, with the result 

tA; 


or the logical connection is perfect. 

In order that the general formula shall be properly applicable, 
care must be taken that the predictions are fairly homogeneous in 
definiteness of time and space. For illustration: if predictions 
that phenomena will occur in given months are examined indis- 
criminately with those that they will occur on given days, the result 
will be manifestly worthless. 

It has been proposed to extend the problem so as to include three 
or more classes of events of which one must happen and only one 
can happen in any case. It seems clear to me that no single 
numerical expression can be a proper solution of such a problem. 
Suppose the three classes of events, A, B, and C. By the method 
above given A and Not A may be examined; and all instances 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 127 


involving either the prediction or occurrence of A may be excluded 
and B and C separately investigated. Suppose it thus ascertained 
that great skill has been shown in discriminating between A and 
Not A, and little or none in discriminating between B and C. No 
single numerical expression can properly comprehend these heter- 
ogeneous. results. 

Mr. Curtis showed that some of the results given by Mr. Doo- 
little could be independently deduced by another method. 

Mr. GrLBeErT noted as a defect in the formula proposed by Prof. ° 
Peirce, that it did not duly discourage positive predictions of rare 
events; and, while gratified with Mr. Doolittle’s discussion of the 
subject, he expressed a disappointment that no satisfactory decision 
as to the treatment of cases of three or more alternatives had been 
reached by him. 

After some further discussion, a communication by Mr. M. 
BAKER was called, but postponed, on motion of Mr. H. FarquyHar, 
to allow time for the consideration of & testimonial to a late asso- 
ciate, Mr. ALVORD. 

Mr. E. B. Exxiorr read the following tribute, prepared by Mr. 
Baker and himself: 


MEMORIAL. 


The Mathematical Section of the Philosophical Society of Wash- 
ington, having suffered the loss by death, on October 16th, 1884, of 
General BENJAMIN ALVORD, one of its founders and active workers, 
desires to place on record this testimonial to his worth and to the 
loss to this Section and to science by his death. 

Of his worth, one of America’s greatest mathematicians has said 
that he was a scientist of “real originality who had actually ex- 
tended the boundaries of science.” 

The bent of General Alvord’s mind and studies was early 
directed towards a purely geometrical solution of the general prob- 
lem of tangencies, and his reward, which it is our pleasure to 
chronicle, was success. 

Of his mathematical publications, the following is submitted as 
a provisionally complete list : 


128 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


LIST OF MATHEMATICAL PUBLICATIONS BY GENERAL BENJAMIN 
ALVORD. a 


1. The tangencies of circles and of spheres. 
[Jn Smithsonian Contributions to Knowledge. 4°. Wash- 
ington, 1856, Vol. 8, Article 4, 16 pp., 9 plates. ] 
Also issued separately. 


2. On the interpretation of imaginary roots in questions of maxima 
and minima. 

[In The Mathematical Monthly. 4°. New York, 1860, . 

April, Vol. 2, No. 7, pp. 237-240.] 


3. Tangencies. 
[Jn Johnson’s New Universal Cyclopedia. 8°. New York, 
1878, Vol. 4, pp. 723-4. ] 


4. Mortality in each year among the officers of the army for fifty 
years, from 1824 to 1873, as derived from the army 
registers. 

[In Proceedings of the American Association for the Ad- 
vancement of Science, 23d Meeting, Hartford, August, 
1874. 8°. Salem, 1875, pp. 57-59.] 


5. The intersection of circles and the intersection of spheres. 
[Jn American Journal of Mathematics. 4°. Baltimore, 
1882, March, Vol. 5, No. 1, pp. 25-44; 4 plates. ] 


6. Curious fallacy as to the theory of gravitation. 
[Jn Bulletin of the Philosophical Society of Washington. 
8°. Washington, 1883, Vol. 5, pp. 85-88.] 


tok special case in maxima and minima. 
[Jn Bulletin of the Philosophical Society of Washington. 
8°. Washington, 1884, Vol. 6, p. 149.] 


Mr. M. Baker, in moying the adoption of this memorial by the 
Section, said: 

General Alvord’s entire life was that of the soldier, and his 
routine of life work did not call him in the direction of mathemati- 
cal study. Hence whatever he accomplished in mathematics or 
literature was accomplished in military surroundings and with only 
such facilities as barrack and camp life afford. If under these 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 129 


conditions the total of his contributions to science appears small, 
we should bear in mind that any contribution under such circum- 
stances is exceptional. And to have been able, therefore, to make 
even a single contribution to human knowledge is to have done that 
which few men in any generation do and that of which any one of 
us might well be proud. 

General Alvord early became interested in the problem of tan- 
gencies and intersections of circles, and his chief mathematical 
work and fame rests on his complete and purely geometrical solu- 
tion of the various problems relating to this subject. His chief 
writings on this subject consist of the paper on Tangencies, in the 
Smithsonian Contributions in 1856; the article on Tangencies, in 
Johnson’s New Universal Cyclopedia; and the paper on intersec- 
tions, in the American Journal of Mathematics, March, 1882. 

The memorial was adopted, and the Secretary was instructed to 
send a copy of it to the family of the deceased. 


Note. 


The following members have assisted the Chairman and Secre- 
tary in the examination of abstracts of communications to the 
Mathematical Section : 


Title. Author. Third Member. 


The Problem of the Knight’s Tour. G. K. GiLBErt. E. B. Evxiort. 
Formule for Diminution of Ampli- 


sudevror 2 Pendulum. --—..-.2-.-. H. FarQuHar. A. 8S. CHRISTIE. 
The Formule for Computing the 

Position of a Satellite-__.___..-- A. Hatt. C. H. KUMMELL. 
The Quadric Transformation of El- 

Inptic Inteerals 222622 21._5 C.H. Kummetn. G. W. Hit. 


The Verification of Predictions....0M.H.Doouitrytz. M. Baker. 


Th ve ae' 1s 

EN RN ee a ee 

Fhe to ee ay ne a 
: : vid url 


ay ax oad W OP, mrtat rete 
; Ait "” a: * 


‘ % Vie? 


So ee i Oh pe ee 
mt eth tes}. 


y fd tA 


is) S ve pone 147at hae Boia: 


tear xii 
y 


£ 


— 7 


i hoetyesael Via ie 


edit phsa3* ee Shey Got : 
. 7* ' ¥ aA M 
y eer x + Pers eee | AGty Seer) £ 
f f j of Pet 


ES 
fale ee ach orseteieg tet hy bo tidiepene cheese 
; ) PINSES eRe” Ga ChE Rd Ase): 
FE > Kye Fl ee hey cb le peer aang 


Kp La Feat ia te 5 (hi vs \ ‘ { MM 
bees mE SPT RE eC aE Mu } ih 


, 
U 
ir? 
* a fc 
= eE Hay bel Dh aia Fai aie ‘ 
® Ya 
f dix vy otf # 
7) i itt 9 eee * elehaby) / 
‘ wit) be 
4 ? 7 
it ‘ a ty, 


' ‘vs 
RAGES oS aa! p as 
: “4 
Boat AEDT Roth aa lnihys ty te 
. 
‘ 
A 
an 
” / 
yy a? 
ies 
' nie 
’ * soy 
{ = ‘ 
* , sd 
- 
" a i 
E ; 
‘ mh 
; ) at f 
u ) 
ris i i Ad 
AN) 'e up Ms eu 
La ad 


RIDE 3 


Page. 
Abbe, Cleveland: remarks on deflection of 
rivers 
— reportas Treasurer.....:... Sean 


Address of the President... 
ELAS UIT V.OY TN OUTS. cesccceccussccoccnssscscccscsenscsas 
Alvord, Gen. Benjamin, Death of.................. 72 
— Memorial to............ Senoncnstisotecocee cooeanonsreccc 127 
Antisell, Thomas: remarks on the chemical 
elements .......... Rhaauernane daccuasestacacamenceseennts 16 
--— — poasesdsoca 
Annual address.. 
— Meeting..........008 
Application of physical methods to intellec- 
METRIESCICIIC Oitewavasncusass sotcspevstscattocsscoces scseee 18 
Are there aes centres for light- form- 


Aristotle, cited on atoms 


Atomic philosOphy.......scssesesesseesesesessesseeeeee 

—— The, physical and ipiaalsiedl .-Xxix, 81 
Auditing committee, Appointment of....... seen 
= — Report Off.........cccscccoessecsesccccsscsceses ‘ 15 
Babcock, Gen. O. E., Death off...............0.00008 72 
Bacon, cited on atoms......... wageante Secon eedeuiealss xli 


Baker, Marcus: memorial to General Alvord.. 127 
Barnard, W.S., Election to membership of.. 25 
Bates, H. H.: communication on the physi- 


eal basis of phenomena..........cscseeeees oes eel) 
Bean, ‘I’. H., Election to membership of........ 72 
Bibliography of North American geology..... 71 
— — mathematical papers by Benjamin Al- 

RONG esesanvereerancene cnneapadeeneseeeds acces Rosia tach 128 
Billings, J.S.: communication on compos- 

ite photography applied to craniology... 25 
— exhibition of microscopes............... eaeeastes 73 
— remarks on bibliography.............. Gardusteves ae 
— resolutions on the death of Dr. Wood- 

EE ULe wate athe koesctod ste aeunesaacacasd cccsusesveuseccce ako 
Perea EL WCHL Of -, ccnccwnvecvscdoxshcovsdrevseceres 81 
— Election to membership of......... 15 
Bogosloff, Voleanie dust from 34 


Boutelle, C. E., Election to membership of... 18 


— remarks on the deflection of rivers......... 24 
Bowles, F. 'I., Election to membership of..... 26 
Boyle, Robert, cited on atoMS.........c0cceeeeeeee xlvi 
Brown, 8. J., Election to membership of...... 72 
Browne, W. R., cited on matter......... Sereprcet 31 


Page. 

Buoys drifted by ocean currents..... ..........+ 14 
Burchard, H. C.: remarks on the irrigation 

of the upper Missouri valley................+ 20 


Burnett, S. M.: communication on separate 
centres for light- form- and color-percep- 


ELON sssaseedstewsavacecaeck cree an astaas Susataasaisetecsees ssh 72 
——w— Why the eyes of animals shine in 

the (ar eas 4,0 Fe ETI Be aseaeettccoeee aces 13 
Calendar.......... suaaaudsacruaceeveaseusaotenaresdog.aedene xxii 
Case of discontinuity in elliptic orbits......... 122 
Chamberlin, T. C.: communication on What 

15) B SIACTON,?, cs saseeischeoeecuceclpuocgtiabocess cece 38 
Chatard, 'T. M.: analysis of andesite 33 
Chemical elements and musicC..............22+00 27 
——-YPeriodie Tawiofisics,sasecacossdeusasesccsece serceces. 2a 
Cheyne, Dr. George, cited on heredity........ Joely 
Christie, A. S.: communication on a form of 

the multinominal theorem......... aasherdsce 101 
Clarke, F. W.: communication on the peri- 

odic law of chemical elements........... con Ala, 
— election to General Committee........ 36 
Clerk-Maxwell, James, cited on properties 

OL, Matters .s5 RN et eae oes 44, 47 
— — — VOrteX TINES.......0ccecceccsseceeee ebsdasaaabecee liv 
Clifford, Prof., cited on mind-stuff................ liii 
Columbian University affords the Society 

facilities............ nates 


Committee, Auditing... th 
— on communications, Dattes ‘one 


ses eves OD 
— —— Membership Of,.....ccccc..ccccceccecseceee Xiv, XV 
— — publications, Duties of................c008 sees xiii 
— —— Membership Of...............s000-seseee 00s xiv, XV 


Committees, Standing..................0+..Xil, XIV, XV 
Composite Sates applied to craniolo- 


EV cewewien “proneebetec as Pee) 
Concrete pr abteel in viiyarontation, sana seeeeweee 92, 101 
CONSELEUTION hess cwseesesseeconavert sasaaccucce Sovessaetees vii 
Continents; Worms of-tssvecssssccevececs coecacacacenses 24 
Craniology... eke He we 
Curtis, G. Bi: Seokatanicanione on es pole 


tions between northers and magnetic 


disturbances at Havana.. 25 
— election to membership........ 5 
— remarks on the veritiGations ‘of. fences 

tions... creer Sertpameccocnerie 74 
Curves pine to theie evalutens ee desecceast OT 


Dall, W. H.: communication on certain ap- 
pendages of the mollusca............00 mevsesa nae 


131 


132 


Page. 

Dall, W. H.: recent advances in our knowl- 
edge of the limpets.............06 pkinvenseahs aeouey 1k 
— — — What is a glacier ’?....... ploucsiiensessrewatseue 38 
—remarks on Alaskan volcanoes... 34 
— — — deflection Of rivers... .......eeccecesseeceveee 24 
— — — Crifting Of DUOYS......scercerceccecer see cence ys a6 
— — — tOFNAOEB...... ...ccscseececceceecncencees aanealave 3 

Dalton, John, contribution to atomic the- 
GEV edcccuchracscspseusveanvsanencs spavhunsavecce xlvii, 1, lvi 
Darwin, Cited On GEMMULES .....cereecrereeerrees lili 
Death of Gen. Benjamin Kivauas ey GP 82-7 4 
—— Gen, O. E. BabcCock...ccccssssrscsccscccsrsscvsece 72 
—— H. W. Blair.......000 iethaseeue aecanabaten' divalaterigl 
— — Gen. Chas. EWing...........ccsseesceeseees assis Kite 
—— Gen. A. A. Humphreys.......0:0.6 vans .3, 4 
— = Dr. Ji J: WOOAWANGL. cccisssccssissreoccssccecsesee 02 
— — — Resolutions CONCErNiNG.......sereeeeree 75 
Deceased members, List of....... .-Xxiii 
Deflection Of rivers.....ccccccssscesseecceee senatacneaeeh 21 
Deposits of voleanic dustin the Great Basin. 18 
Dewey, F. P., Election to membership of..... 36 


Dilier, J. S.; communication on the voleanic 
sand which fell at Unalashka Oct. 20, 1883, 
and some considerations ee its 
composition.. en sdeeeusadrereey OO 

— Election to metabareiin ‘of deapansaceaadeencuvetamere 

Discontinuity in elliptic orbits...... cee ee 

Discussion of a concrete problem in hydro- 
statics proposed by Mr. G. K. Gilbert..... 101 

Diversion of water-courses by the rotation 


OF the CAarthi....iscccvecsesscvsescosscens Saueeu se oeyesny 21 
Doolittle, M. H.: communication on the 
verification of predictions............se+seeees 122 
— —— music and the chemical elements.... 27 
Dust, Volcamic..........cccccsescecccesesesreceeones seevrsvlOy Oo 
Dutton, C. E.: communication on the volca- 
noes and lava fields of New Mexico........ 76 
— —— What is a glacier ?.,....cccccsscssccccssssneese 39 
— remarks on the forms of continents ........ 24 
— — — — Navajos as scientific observers..... 74 
— — — PeCtrOZraphy.......cceccerseeeesseeceesecseracecee 36 
— — — SUN-ZIOWS.......:.ceeeeeceeeee ceeneee eospies eeckcs 35 
Earll, R. E., Election to membership of....... 72 
Earthquake of Sept. 19.......cccccessssereeeeees Went 73 
Eastman, J. R.: communication on a new 
WNGGOOTTEC sis. iscvaysasveccnchscconse tenses snacauveaesscre 32 
——— the Rochester (Minn.) tornado........ 3 
Eimbeck, William, Election to membership 
Olccctnsccsatidaceeouvteapeste Ravatntny tavavsoaaveusssaese 26 
Election of officers...........ssees0 evedeavasesenedhae 82, 87 
—— new members....xi, 5, 10, 15, 18, 21, 25, 26, 32 
36, 72, 81 
Electric Lighting. .ccsrccsccccscsescsccscccccesecnscnccerse OO 
Elements, Periodic law Of.........:.ss000+ ceanencces 15 
Elliott, E. B.: calendar for the use of the 
society ...... bas cesneeeuse aevadaansis in ceeunente wdaepecceeakid 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page, 
Elliott, E. B.: communication on electric 
Tigtin es cei cepcceesp sere Cassnneee poennt espe euacenesnean 

— memorial to General Alvord..............css008 
— remarks on the etharmonic organ........0. 
—— —— irrigation of the upper Missouri 
WAL Ys icesdivecuacsss ae soseeassy 
— — — BSUD-GIOWS... ccccsccerceccesereeee dusia taxes eapone 
— — — tornadoes.,.........sceeeeeeee paceandeenre Saucueee 
Emmons, S. F.: communication on What is 
&) WlACISL Pics. coc sasestescdoccvensssceseusteranere 

— remarks on glaciers............. porwivossaasnanien 
Empirical formule for the diminution of 
amplitude of a freely-oscillating pendu- 


80 


28 


Henne eee eeeeeereeeenes 


20 
17 
3 


seeeee 


of 


Ewing, Charles, Death of............... dapetneanaee xxiii 

Existing glaciers of the High Sierra of Cali- 
FOVTIIG toes cnaceccnvew sansco advdes vector ds teen iabese 5 

Eyes of animals, why they shine in the 
dark.......... Snersseoeeunnene an waivakaegyl aiseatdeaeiaed 


Faraday cited on the nature of matter........ 5 
Farquhar, Edward: remarks on ocean cur- 
rents... peeumned ancanvesenee, 
a tanneninns seuuseosisedssspaneetelQwiawae heanepaven 3 
———the late Dr. Woodwaraelt podeseontsastate ; 
Farquhar, Henry: communication on em- 
pirical formule for the diminution of 
amplitude of a freely-oscillating pendu- 
lum... mo ays aaeaue 
oe the ihooretiesl ‘disohinslon in Prof. Py 
G. Tait’s Encyclopedia Britannica article 
on mechanics..........-+« eabvalunelee sipplbunebemeetin 
— election as Secretary of the Mathemati- 
cal Section ........... seccsensecucel on beecsiunnWeneneas 87 
— remarks on drifting of buoys........ apeeutasee 15 
— report as Secretary... wicevesubeauneas xxiii 
Ferrel, William, cited on rotational deflee- 


SOOO ee eee tee eeeneeennsee 


we nee anennee coves 


29 


Finley’s tornado predictions 
Fisheries exhibitions............... 
Force, Reality of......:.....-0« be 
Form of the multinominal theorem........ pace) LOL 
Formula for the length of a seconds-pen- 

QUIDM scsenes s cuubkvanwdueeeeepteny 
Formule for computing the position of a 

BALCLILUC. ..<csccsneccnccseotineensesnensennenen 


101 


eee eeeeee ee eeeesenee 


sescenatvieeene 
General Meeting, Bulletin Of.............ccc00.eee0 1,3 
Geological section of water-works shaft......69, 70 
Gihon, A. L.: remarks on the late Dr. J. J. 
Woodward... sCekvonsiadacke tenant 
Gilbert, G. K.: communication on a concrete 
problem in hydrostatics..........seecereeseeee 
— — — the diversion of water-courses by the 
rotation of the earth....... 


cecccees cov eceveccsesas 76 
92 


Senne ren nereeeseseeeees 


0 ee 


———- = 


INDEX. 133 

Page. Page 

Gilbert, G. K.: a plan for the subject biblio- * Kerr, M. B., Election to membership of....... 21 

graphy of North American geologic lite- — TemMarks On SlACICTS,...........ccccsserececssoases ee: 

PU REINO cers pps suse tupnscscncnanaassswanenncideadtsne Beep PRMIPNGS COU... acacscecustestoc sauvaee Ununssyecstsrr «scan 88 
— — — the problem of the knight’s tour...... 88 | Knox, J. J.: resignation from General Com- 

— remarks on the origin of pumice........... - 25 WOUUUCE parcactagncnenscvatuisveasavercncasevemsssen=scavsse! OO 
— — — — upper Missouri valley...............000 20 } Kummell, C. H.: communication on curyes 

—— —— verification of predictions........... . 127 similar to their evolutes ........sscsccccceceeees 87 
—TEPOTh AS SCCTELATY.........0ccsscosccccceveccescsons xxili | ——— the quadric transformation of ellip- 
Glacier tables...............cccrsee peabaneaakenbatercrs se Palen! tic integrals, combined with the algo- 
Glacier, What is a.. se seawonspNanes congress (00 rithm of the arithmetico-geometrical 

Glaciers of the Sonne Baieee Beasasseessenece, AGS INGAN ccccssecestavesvereanadasadesscsnéeseecesceSeactpes -. 102 

— — — High Sierra........ Risser eaaaapehhvaessisihkeiinp 5 | --remarks on musical intervals.............000 - 28 

—— — Rocky Mountains.............. apeeene vane CaaS 

Goode, G. Brown: communication on fish- Lake Bonneville.. aawels Sep. Oe 
SMIGHEXDIDILON Gs ssacvnsneebersarysdcusnenosssenseae 26 | Lawrence, William, Sleciion 5 membee 

Gregory, J. M., Election to Taemiberckiy of... 26 SLI NO dweeensshetetmerersnuttedereactans qt ence averccsascen = (or 

Lefavour, E. B.: remarks on musical seales. 28 

Hall, Asaph: communication on the form- Leibnitz, Cit6d On AGOMS....ccccvasaccocecesdwewsvene xliii 


ule for computing the position of a 
BME SLO UMGO src. cysntocascancotchescosssassnseesassonnsns ssa, 93. 
— election as chairman of the Mathemati- 
GB SOCMON .scecspsaecayesse5ena-nche- cet 87 
— remarks on ae anishmaetioo: ee reneiie 


WaPo ncaay sa cnceniccssnacpeaasiies dan tied peiicncameatigs 122 
Harkness, William: remarks on glaciers..... 9 
— — — the shining of eyes in the dark........ 13 
Hazen, H. A.: communication on the sun- 

SLOW Asaausncnckesaesecceass eiscpanaas spaced peaiuesassase 17 
— — — thermometer exposure... ......ceeeeeee » 80 
— remarks on the deflection of rivers......... 24 
Heap, D. P., Election to membership of........ 32 
High Sierra, Glaciers Of............ccsscccecsccenscenes 5 


Hill, G. W.: communication on a formula 
for the length of a seconds-pendulum.., 101 


SILC MC OCI ENOL: sl casscitecsacrnanssosscadecssssecsys 4 
Hitchcock, Romyn, Election to membership 
(ileeetratacsetercseapsaccssessacscns Sheecarhetoc aber 36 
Holmes, W. H.: remarks on glaciers 8 
Humphreys, A. A., Death Of............ccccesssesssee 3, 4 
ES WVIAC. coi sis scorcotcs exaccssecccscssecseusss See orn 6, 7 
Indians, Observation and generalization by. 73 
Insecticides..........00....000 Sen enatecneeiieacneacccvet setae 10 
Integrals, Transformation of elliptic............ 102 
MICEIITESTC QOUIALI ON: --ccesesee a-tes tec sucslerostegeioed foe 87 


Irrigation of the upper Missouri valley........ 20 


Jenkins, T. A.: remarks on drifting of 
MIELGY Be ewe accarcesacoe eres cesh ccbsenselecebtseswceseneers 15 

Johnson, A. B.: communication on some 
eccentricities of ocean currents.....,....... 14 

Johnson, W. D., Election tomembership of... 18 


Kauffmann, S. H., Election to membership 


Kerr, W. C.: communication on the mica 
mines of None Carolingal. -csnadecnptesensce ato) 


PUMPER, sonccccaansenarnsmesescsuonsteusitens asessasiesdecccee 4 


McGee, W J: communication on What is a 
glacier ?...... axusanideasudcaeksbanasapaneauatus cncesaverare 38 
Maher, J. A.: Election to membership of...... 26. 
Marcou, J. B., Election to membership of.... 26 
Martin, Artemas: letter to Mathematical 


Section... ccdscascscscsonnocasete is sap ussapecevtniecenamen «, St 
Mason, O. T.: remarks on the conditions of 
Observation.......0.sceee ermevoaeas ress teesnest Shanes 74 
Mathematical Section, Bulletin of........ wetaeSoatn 
po = NOD OLS U Olas. an vnans saseais sosskacusecssesor bees é 
— — Officers of......... pisacesanedas 
—='SOCIOLY; PLON OSC Geissanstccussase'scsscnscsaccasersenaasace 
Matthews, Washington: communication on 
Maturall MAGULALISES:...<<cuicacecdecusatondceser ovetee 


— election to membership 
Members, List of 
— — — deceased,... 


Merrill, G. P., Election to membership of.... 36 


MeGtOOVitel, 2025 .i-.00000<ccntseveyacavanae| seauserossesceoteoen 32 
Methods of modern petrography............ mag ss 
Mica mines of North Carolina .............cscc000 9 
More, Henry, cited on nature of matter...... xlii 
Mount Taylor, Geology Of..........-.cscscsrsscesess en i i 
Muir, John, cited on glacierS...............s00ccceee 8 
Murdoch, John, Election to membership of. 36 
Music and the chemical elements.. ............. 27 


Mussey, R. D.: communication on the appli- 
cation of physical methods to intellec- 


GLA SCLON CC sesh cvecnsueusatcavescdsuanenpoceseeees Seg aks 
— remarks on the forms of continents........ « 24 
Natural naturalists.......... besmanaoppyvasinn gienuenneamsecian ee 


Necks, Volcanic 
INE VG: COMED. x ccccevcesagaseses, on 


teccescccvee OF 


oeeeeeereens 


e 
134 PHILOSOPHICAL 

Page. 
NOW MEMDETS.....cccsccrcccrecscccccsncccccesesescecscess xxiii 
— MEtCOTIEC.....0ccceecescccssccccsccrsccccccs coccsesecccces 32 
— Mexico, Volcanoes Of,.........ccessccseecesser coesee 
Newton, cited on atoms 
Norris, Basil, Election to membership of..... 25 
North Carolina, Mica mines Of......cec.seeseseeees 9 
OCEAN CUTLeNtS.........csecccccrccccerecserccsssaceesceees 
Officers, Election of.. 
RUN ASU Olsvouusssiececenaescudcccseseds'sraene sens ea 6 pe '¢ 
— of the Mathematical Section.............. 85, 86, 87 


Ogden, H. G., Election to membership of... 15 


Paul, H. M.: remarks on earthquakes........... 73 
— — — equipotential surfaces.........seeveeee. 92 


— — — SUN-ZlLOWS... ceesee eee SRSECCERC 35 
Peirce, Prof. Benjanien, eited’o on n the intHineio 
OQUALION........crscseccscncvecncnncunseeesess onceee cones 87 
Peirce, C. S., cited on pendulum observa- 
TIOIS.0...c0ccsesecneccscesecscenceeeccconscsansscncessconsce 90 
— — — the verification of predictions....... we. 124 
Pendulum, Formula for diminution of am- 
plitude of oscillation Of......csssecceseseesseere 89 
Periodic law of chemical elements.... 15 
Petrographic Methods.........seseseeeeseeee 36 
Physical basis of phenOMenA...........esee0+e0+0e 40 
— and economic features of the upper Mis- 
SOUL SYStOM.......cceccecccrensscesssesseccacscsceeres 20 
Plan for the subject bibliography of North 
American geologic literature..........s.sc00- 71 
Plateau COUNtTY........+0 Rare eunaeaeenecketnteennesses 76, 79 
Powell, J. W.: communication on a plan for 
the subject bibliography of North Amer- 
ican geologic literature.......... O nanestesievaca 71 
— remarks on the distribution of eruptions. 179 
— — — ZIACICTS........s020ccecerercereteeserenesseesecerees 8 


— —— the history of the society................. 81 
— = ——Jate Dr, WOOGWALG...cccccec-0-4- 
Predictions, Verification of..... ... 

Presidential AdALeSS......0. sesseeee 

Problem of the knight’s tour 
Pumice, Formation of........ Suncaseesen seseeeee20, 25, 26 


Quadric transformation of elliptic integrals, 
combined with the algorithm of the 
arithmetico-geometric MeAN............+. 102 


Ray, P. H., Election to membership of......... 5 
Recent advances in economic entomology... 10 
— —— our knowledge of the limpets........... 4 
Relation between northers and magnetic 

disturbances at Havana.....ccccsccsssescesereree 25 
Report of Secretaries.........ssseseeereeeereers xxiii, 82 
mere TNGASUUOD sc cccunescverosccvecscsanvsessersna xxiv, 15, 82 
Review of the theoretical discussion of Prof. 

P. G. Tait’s Encyclepedia Britannica 

article on mechanics...... 


snoscsccenecccsecscenese 0 


SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 

Ricksecker, Eugene, Election to member- 
ship of........ as Sedacageeceuersl 6, sccussceoaisaetaeentene - 18 

Riley, C. V.: communication on recent ad- 
vances in economic entomology...... newved 10 

— remarks on the irrigation of the upper 
Missouri valley eae 
Rivers, deflection Of.............sscssses ainveaGanainvatten 21 

Robinson, Thomas: communication entitled 

Was the earthquake of Sept. 19 felt in 
the District of Columbia?...............ss.0. 73 

—— on the strata exposed in the east shaft 
of the water-works extension.......... Ronee!) 
— election to Membership..........cseeseceeeeees is 10 
— remarks on the deflection of rivers.......... 24 
Rochester (Minn.) tornad...........cccccccsessee o 
Rotation and rivers...........0..-.0ses 
Rules for the publication of the Bulletin.... xiii 
— of the General Committee......... Sedicey Le 
— — — Mathematical Section............02e20 85 


— — — SOCICtY... .cerecrereee sa badeeabeeeentreeene wade: SE 
Russell, I. C.: communication on deposits 

of volcanic dust in the Great Basin...... 18 
— — — the existing glaciers of the High 

Sierra of California....... 5 
— — — What is a glacier?........... sesegeseosees see BT 
Sand, Volcanic.......:....s0:.sccssscsssesessussesess Percent 
Satellite, Computation of position of a......... 93 
Seales, Musical......... pusvocsncnshaseascaersstec annie nena 27 
Secretaries’ report... ue et 82 
Sierra Nevada Paes snes ceeneuareeeemmnaes 
Some eccentricities of ocean 1 ope Sseaenes poms 
Standing rules of the General Committee..... xii 
— — — — Mathematical Section............... seus uae 
—— — — Society........ 6 sssewencses sess anes teneEmtnena ix 


Stearns, R. E. C., Election to membership of. 81 

Strata exposed in the east shaft of the 
water-works @XteNSiON.......s0:ceccecseeserseeee 69 

Sun-glows ...... aitisin sive Sannes tease eee scuccns aseneoliig OD 


Tait, Prof. P. G., on mechanics; reviewed.... 29 


Taylor, F. W.: analysis of meteorite............ 32 
Taylor, W. B.: communication on a case of 

discontinuity in elliptic orbits.............+.. 122 

— remarks ON SUN-G1]OWS......cceseeee-ceeeeees aaeaneah eee 

Thermometer exposure... weeks sae) OD) 
Thompson, Gilbert, Election me ‘member- 

ship of... necekbndees . 18 

— ponekeat on a vlagtere. a 8 


Toner, J. M.: remarks on nthe Tate ia “Wood: 
ward... 
Tornado a ‘Rochester (Minn. ee 


Treasurer’s report.......seceeseeeee 


Volcanic Gust........ssccscssssessocssssescesereceeseessesel Oy OB 


Verification of predictions... 


ae 


INDEX. 


Page. 


Ward, L. F.: communication on some phys- 
ical and economic features of the upper 
MMIGSOUTE SYSUGIN: scccveseacsceccesescorscsers Raieeine 20 

— remarks on the deflection of rivers 23 

— — — Indians as botanic observers............ 74 

Was the earthquake of Sept. 19 felt in the 
District of Columbia?......... correcccortoeecer cos) at 

Welling, J. C.: eulogy on Gen. Humphreys.. 4 

— presidential address............. peenvevesécaes xxix, 81 


— remarks on drifting of DUOYS.........00.0.008. 15 
— — — the Indian as a scientific observer... 75 
Williams, G. H.: communication on methods 

Of Modern PetrOYraPhyY...wrevscscsresesecceere 36 
ELSES st LACION fracrtccs sre can cis ssctevcrectovscevscedese’? OO) 


135 


Page. 

White, C. H., Election to membership of..... 21 

White, C. A.: report of auditing committee. 15 
Why the eyes of animals shiné in the 

dark..... 

Woodruff, T. M., Election to Ais Nceets 


seeesercceeccerenccsceeevercscees cuncesccccenacscns 13 


of... Creo 32 
Woodward. Dr. a s “Death of. - 72 
— Resolutions on death Ofsscccvcctencsicestaceatacts 75 
Woodward, R. S.: discussion of a concrete 

problem in hydrostatics proposed by 

Mr. G. K. Gilbert...... meacenas serene LOE 
— remarks on deflection of ‘pinnae ches 92 


Yeates, W.S., Election to membership of.... 36 


TO wy SY 


- apne ‘8 vudidiena 


yi ay) 4 ea ud ney 2h + 


t pba 


4 ee bs 
i \ On Cg AD Let eee ether 
ay 4 i o 
i * 
ie a. rh Kost aa ive er: 
* i wiu rah Avant j ie ERB eit 51h Wah regs Us 
wh ‘ alee i Gytbee hee TREE « Pees 
‘ we Peat usher?) Cee T (Ascend gestae aaa 
t Beth Winter ite pid hate 
ty 43 ' te ak a ORV SN | Ne Ln ' Bote CuaPiin.. Ney tye We ye 
7 \ { . ae 
. ad 
‘ ft 7 é 
Da ‘ 
Rf 
. ee t 
+ i 
‘ 
, / 
i 
1 
\ 
i < f 
, ag ' 
' 
+ 
{ 
Pind ys ‘ 
i 
: ‘ : 4 
? i 
iar f 
i * ; ' 
F t 1 ou 7 
: y J _ 
ow) \l F , 
a 1h 
; ) 
‘ $ 
* . 
ar 
= ‘ Ap 0 
f : on 
eat A i : ® : 
* 
1 A 22 y ‘ 
? r \ 
j ‘ é 
by : * fe y r bf fi 
A c 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY 


OF 


WASHINGTON. 


VOL. VIII. 


Containing the Minutes of the Society and of the Mathematical 
Section for the year 1885. 


PUBLISHED BY THE CO-OPERATION OF THE SMITHSONIAN INSTITUTION. 


WASHINGTON : 
1885 


t008 7 


Qi? 1 


Beet, a Sonar i Hh 4) : 
; i 5 * iy ‘s : 4 , As : j my 
i ij 4 ab i ; 1) ee } kh ' ) 
, ; * , 4" 
wn a ths a 4. ‘ 4 \ re | . i BY ta: i 
. ) a 
, ea oar ; ‘ 
nicy 
La 
*. " 
t i 
| Ad Om Gare a 8 
inabiaiultedd att li bee wee eds Wi aati ae 
} ik ee or-4aF Gohiose 
RRA OTD ORIN Ce DONS HO eel OO Sea 
‘ ‘ \ + 
, # 
oe aS 
RL” CUS fel iw Ot 


CONTENTS. 


Page 
MRT WER CRLEYID, 22 De 28 so a ag es a he a i Sn VII 
Beaming Sirles of TnasSOeleby aos as ee IX 
Standing Rules of the General Committee..___.______ _---__ -____- XII 
Hules for the Publication of the Bulletin... _.____ -_-___ _-___. XITE 
Oficers! elected! Mecember, 1884 2222.48. 22 oo se a eo oe XIV 
Oiticers. elected, December, 1885). ah oe XV 
ee WERE HS ea Sh i at i i eee, EVI 
SumenAmecesnod. MOM BOIS. co) 6 SS. 25) oo le ee XXV 
MOnealbaport of the Secretaries: oo6 46. +225 aa. ae. KXVII 
Annual Report of the Treasurers... ....2--___ =.= -_.- XXVIII 
OE Rr eS COS ee eS ae epee eS a=, * ERR 
Annual Address of the President, Asaph Hall -___ -----_-__. ----_. XXXIII 
Protector the General Machine 8 oe eh a ee ee ses 1 
Keport of the Auditing Committee..______. __.-.. . —_--— .. sof 3 

The vital statistics of the Tenth U.S. Census, J. S. Billings, 
PETS ECOPEDN het 25 eke ey SBE See RI tee 4 

Recent experiments on reaction time and the time sense, G. 
Stumleyy tall. (Pirle omle) sso oo oe et 4 

Practical geology versus speculative physics, C. E. Dutton, 
CAPOORME) oi Se a eed sie is ee es we «AYE 


Topaz from Stoneham, Maine, F. W. Clarke and J. 8. Diller, 


y (Title only) ---.--------—- -- .- ---------- ---- ---- -------- 5 
Two remarkable forms of mollusks, W. H. Dall___-.-______- 5 
Geological and physical theories, W. B. Taylor._____-___ -_-- 6 
Methods of verifying weather predictions, C. Abbe__-------_ 8 
Marratrons: Ofiatitude: AVS Ela aa) 5 oa 10 
Mhunderstorms;or 1884, Hi. Aw azen fe ee 10 
The Javal and Schiotz ophthalmometer, 8S. M. Burnett, (Title 

OU) aoe es wie oe Sees oc amen ne ode eo aoe 11 
The difficulty in determining the direction of sound, A. B. 

OU S ON tae eee eee ee eens Pit leatsyl seed Salah 11, 12 
Mythological dry painting of the Navajos, W. Matthews -__. 14 
Comets II and III, 1884, W. C. Winlock ~__.-____-__... .-.. 16 
Problems connected with the physics of the earth’s crust, H. 

BIO ictRe Le eNO) bent a te Se pe rt 17, 18 
Modern ideas of brain mechanism, F. Baker, (Title only)-_---- 17 
The flora of the Laramie group, L. F. Ward, (Title only) ---- ily) 
The measurement of temperature at distant points, T. C. Men- 

LEN a) ee eee 18 
The asteroids, G. L. Ravene, (Title only y) neh Pana VEST Cal te ae 18 


Tit 


IV CONTENTS. 
The mechanism of ‘clicks’? and ‘“clucks,’”’? A. G. Bell, ( Title 

Only) sh aas seen see Soe ees ee ee en oe 

The crumpling of the earth’s crust, W. B. Taylor- .---.-- = 

The columnar structure in the diabase of Orange mountain, 
INiiSy ab, Dd dines ee 

The terraces of the Potomac valley, W J McGee, ( Title only)-_ 
Anthropometric and reaction-time apparatus, J. S. Billings 

and W. Matthews 222 .-2 7 tools vel s (eee eee 

The condensing hygrometer and sling psychrometer, H. A. 

1 £1 “Wea en Soareaie yD MGA RRND MI MORALS Rep BO SET 

A new volt-meter, Cy Mendenhall2{--5 a2 
Flextures of transit instruments, W. Harkness___--_-____- = 

An attempt at a theory of odor, F. W. Clarke --____ -___ -_-- 

The Flood Rock explosion, F. W. Clarke, C. F. Marvin, and 
BM, Paul oo oe es en ee 

The systematic care of pamphlets, G. B. Goode and C. V. Riley 

Germ cultures; J. S. Billings! 22. 22-222 eee 
Presentation of, the annual’address=_2-- 2 == eee 
Annual meeting ’.o- ioe s tee ee ee eee 
Bulletin of the Mathematical Section ~—_- ----__.._- -__- - 2S ee 
Standing Rules of the’ Section — .----. --—__ =22 0s eae 


Officers of the Section... 2-7. oa2- 5 ce Loses eee 
Example illustrating the use of a certain symbol in the calcu- 
lus of affected quantity, E. B. Elliott, (Title only)_-------- 
A collection of formule for the area of a plane triangle, M. 
Baker,)( Title only) 2 22. cone ctn ce oa oe cee or 
Physical observations on Wolf’s comet (1884, III), W. C. 
Winlocko W235 2225 2e et ee 
A slight modification of the Newtonian formula of gravitation, 
WeoBe Daylor = 2 eo eres Socsesss ssl. ae 
An artifice sometimes useful for the adjustment of conditioned 
observations, ‘C.°H. Kummell 222 2 
The theory of Mercury, G. L. Raven6_-_~-_ --_.-. ---- --== as 
A group of circles related to Feuerbach’s circle, M. Baker_-_- 
Distances on any spheroid, C. H. Kummell ---.-_-.-----_--- 
On Grassman’s system of geometry, A. Ziwet_---- ----__ -_-- 
Cause and chance in the concurrence of phenomena, M. H. 


Doolittle, (Wide only) =..--U2 222 22 .cos 22 
The asteroids, G. L. Ravené, (Title only) ».------. -----2 ==. 
Secular perturbations of Polyhymnia by Jupiter, W. F. McK. 

GG? ‘oo oe ao ee eaten sees ee eae eee 
Some practical features of a field time determination with a 

meridian transit, KK. S. Woodward 2) -2_2 2 eee = 
Can the attraction of a finite mass be infinite? C.H. Kum- 

Me] lov 2. ise ew See ao oa eo eee ee eee 


Committees on mathematical communications. -_.-__ --_. -_-- 


Under 2a as a re 


Page. 


18 
18 


19 
24 


25 


25 
26 
27 
27 


28 
29 
30 
30 
30 
33 
35 
36 


387 
387 
387 
39 
41 
41 
45 
52 
53 


54 
54 


54 


BULLETIN 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON, 


CONSTITUTION, RULES, 


LIST OF 


AND REPORTS OF 


SECRETARIES AND TREASURER. 


4 


¥ 


3 Lt id 


ven 


MARL 


CONSTITUTION 


OF 


THE PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON, 


ArticueE I. The name of this Society shall be Tar PHILosoPHti- 
cAL Society OF WASHINGTON. 


AnrticLeE II. The officers of the Society shall be a President, 
four Vice-Presidents, a Treasurer, and two Secretaries. 


ArticLE III. There shall be a General Committee, consisting of 
the officers of the Society and nine other members. 


ArtIcLE IV. The officers of the Society and the other members 
of the General Committee shall be elected annually by ballot ; they 
shall hold office until their successors are elected, and shall have 
power to fill vacancies. 


ArticuE V. It shall be the duty of the General Committee to 
make rules for the government of the Society, and to transact all 
its business. 


ArticLE VI. This constitution shall not be amended except by 
a three-fourths vote of those present at an annual meeting for the 
election of officers, and after notice of the proposed change shall 
have been given in writing at a stated meeting of the Society at 
least four weeks previously. 
Vil 


fey Vic 


Cove rsre V1 ape ee Babes Reha Pe ais Beamer phar oc 8 


¢ . * . a sea 1 ae 
Wal kitioks Dotisork ot Jon fess alte aa 
rhs Dene + Rue stag ig hivauep yi Bethy yin Bawa st 
; is pie ae! | 
BS ii why gay Hy Lee Seabee a3 “UI We EM BAN 


A, Se: Oat ae Ae Milo Ry Dest ae Pere 
Sy ily: 


ty’ 
* t 
. 
y 
% . 
| 
1 « P - 
' h , 
bige: 
o. - 
—_——" 
. ie 
‘ st 
v 7 4 f, 
i! Ws , oe ran a) 
‘ if 


STANDING RULES 


FOR THE GOVERNMENT OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


1. The Stated Meetings of the Society shall be held at 8 o’clock 
P.M. on every alternate Saturday; the place of meeting to be 
designated by the General Committee. 


2. Notice of the time and place of meeting shall be sent to each 
member by one of the Secretaries. 
When necessary, Special Meetings may be called by the President. 


3. The Annual Meeting for the election of officers shall be the 
last stated meeting in the month of December. 


The order of proceedings (which shall be announced by the 
Chair) shall be as follows: 
First, the reading of the minutes of the last Annual Meeting. 


Second, the presentation of the annual reports of the Secretaries, 
including the announcement of the names of members elected since 
the last annual meeting. 


Third, the presentation of the annual report of the Treasurer. 
Fourth, the announcement of the names of members who, having 


complied with Section 14 of the Standing Rules, are entitled to vote 
on the election of officers. 


Fifth, the election of President. 

Sixth, the election of four Vice-Presidents. 

Seventh, the election of Treasurer. 

Highth, the election of two Secretaries. 

Ninth, the election of nine members of the General Committee. 

Tenth, the consideration of Amendments to the Constitution of 
the Society, if any such shall have been proposed in accordance 
with Article VI of the Constitution. 

Eleventh, the reading of the rough minutes of the meeting. 

1X 


x PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


4. Elections of officers are to be held as follows: 


In each case nominations shall be made by means of an informal 
ballot, the result of which shall be announced by the Secretary ; 
after which the first formal ballot shall be taken. 

In the ballot for Vice-Presidents, Secretaries, and Members of the 
General Committee, each voter shall write on one ballot as many 
names as there are officers to be elected, viz., four on the first ballot 
for Vice-Presidents, two on the first for Secretaries, and nine on the 
first for Members of the General Committee; and on each subse- 

uent ballot as many names as there are persons yet to be elected ; 
and those persons who receive a majority of the votes cast shall be 
declared elected. 

If in any case the informal ballot result in giving a majority for 
any one, it may be declared formal by a majority vote. 


5. The Stated Meetings, with the exception of the annual meet- 
ing, shall be devoted to the consideration and discussion of scientific 
subjects. 

The Stated Meeting next preceding the Annual Meeting shall be 
set apart for the delivery of the President’s Annual Address. 


6. Sections representing special branches of science may be 
formed by the General Committee upon the written recommenda- 
tion of twenty members of the Society. 

7. Persons interested in science, who are not residents of the Dis- 
trict of Columbia, may be present at any meeting of the Society, 
Pas the annual meeting, upon invitation of a member. 


8. * On request of a member, the President or either of the Secre- 
taries may, at his discretion, issue to any person a card of Invitation 
to attend a specified meeting. Five cards of invitation to attend a 
meeting may be issued in blank to the reader of a paper at that 
meeting. 

9. Invitations to attend during three months the meetings of the 
Society and participate in the discussion of papers, may, by a vote 
of nine members of the General Committee, be issued to persons 
nominated by two members. 

10. Communications intended for publication under the auspices 
of the Society shall be submitted in writing to the General Com- 


mittee for approval. 
[nn nnn nn UE EE pp RED RROREEIN 


* Amended January 17, 1885. 


STANDING RULES. xI 


11. Any paper read before a Section may be repeated, either 
entire or by abstract, before a general meeting of the Society, if 
such repetition is recommended by the General Committee of the 
Society. 


12. *It is not permitted to report the proceedings of the Society or 
its Sections for publication, except by authority of the General Com- 
mittee. 


13. New members may be proposed in writing by three members 
of the Society for election by the General Committee; but no per- 
son shall be admitted to the privileges of membership unless he 
signifies his acceptance thereof in writing within two months after 
notification of his election. 


14. Each member shall pay annually to the Treasurer the sum 
of five dollars, and no member whose dues are unpaid shall vote at 
the annual meeting for the election of officers, or be entitled to a 
copy of the Bulletin. 

In the absence of the Treasurer, the Secretary is authorized to 
receive the dues of members. 

The names of those’ two years in arrears shall be dropped from 
the list of members. 

Notice of resignation of membership shall be given in writing to 
the General Committee through the President or one of the Secre- 
taries. 


15. The fiscal year shall terminate with the Annual Meeting. 


16. {Any member who is absent from the District of Columbia 
for more than twelve consecutive months may be excused from pay- 
ment of dues during the period of his absence, in which case he 
will not be entitled to receive announcements of meetings or current 
numbers of the Bulletin. 


17. Any member not in arrears may, by the payment of one 
hundred dollars at any one time, become a life member, and be 
relieved from all further annual dues and other assessments. 

All maneys received in payment of life membership shall be 
invested as portions of a permanent fund, which shall be directed 
solely to the furtherance of such special scientific work as may be 
ordered by the General Committee. 


* Adopted January 17, 1885. t Amended December 19, 1885. 


STANDING RULES 


OF THE . 


GENERAL COMMITTEE OF THE PHILOSOPHICAL 
SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


1. The President, Vice-Presidents, and Secretaries of the Society 
shall hold like offices in the General Committee. 


2. The President shall have power to call special meetings of the 
Committee, and to appoint Sub-Committees. . 


3. The Sub-Committees shall prepare business for the General 
Committee, and perform such other duties as may be entrusted to 
them. 


4, There shall be two Standing Sub-Committees; one on Com- 
munications for the Stated Meetings of the Society, and another on 
Publications. 


5. The General Committee shall meet at half-past seven o’clock 
on the evening of each Stated Meeting, and by adjournment at 
other times. 


6. For all purposes except for the amendment of the Standing 
Rules of the Committee or of the Society, and the election of mem- 
bers, six members of the Committee shall constitute a quorum. 


7. The names of proposed new members recommended in con- 
formity with Section 13 of the Standing Rules of the Society, may 
be presented at any meeting of the General Committee, but shall 
lie over for at least four weeks before final action, and the concur- 
rence of twelve members of the Committee shall be necessary to 
election. 

The Secretary of the General Committee shall keep a chronologi- 
cal register of the elections and acceptances of members. 


8. These Standing Rules, and those for the government of the 
Society, shall be modified only with the consent of a majority of 
the members of the General Committee. 

xii 


me Las 


FOR THE 


PUBLICATION OF THE BOLLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


1. The President’s annual address shall be published in full. 


2. The annual reports of the Secretaries and of the Treasurer 
shall be published in full. 


3. When directed by the General Committee, any communication 
may be published in full. 


4, Abstracts of papers and remarks on the same will be pub- 
lished, when presented to the Secretary by the author in writing 
within two weeks of the evening of their delivery, and approved by 
the Committee on Publications. Brief abstracts prepared by one 
of the Secretaries and approved by the Committee on Publications 
may also be published. 


5. If the author of any paper read before a Section of the 
Society desires its publication, either in full or by abstract, it shall 
be referred to a committee to be appointed as the Section may 
determine. 


The report of this committee shall be forwarded to the Publica- 
tion Committee by the Secretary of the Section, together with any 
action of the Section taken thereon. 


6. Communications which have been published elsewhere, so as 
to be generally accessible, will appear in the Bulletin by title only, 
but with a reference to the place of publication, if made known in 
season to the Committee on Publications. bi 

28 xu 


OFPRPICHRS 


OF THE ; 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON 


e 
ELECTED DECEMBER 20, 1884. 


PESTER ae ASAPH HALL. 

Vice-Presidents_..----J. S. BILLINGS. GARRICK MALLERY. 
WILLIAM HaArKNEss. J. E. HILGARD. 

Treasurers ces eee ROBERT FLETCHER. 


SECTELEIIES See eee G. K. GILBERT. HENRY FARQUHAR. 
y 


MEMBERS AT LARGE OF THE GENERAL COMMITTEE. 


MARrcus BAKER. H. H. BATEs. 
F. W. CLARKE. W. H. DALL. 
C. E. DUTTON. ] J. R. EASTMAN. 
E. B. ELLiortT. HM: PAUL: 

GC: Va RILEN. 


! 


STANDING COMMITTEES. 


On Communications : 
J. S. BILLINGs, Chairman. G. K. GILBERT, HENRY FARQUILAR, 
On Publications: 


G. K. GILBERT, Chairman. ROBERT FLETCHER, HENRY FARQUHAR, 


S. F. BAIRD.* 


* As Secretary of the Smithsonian Institution. ‘ 
xIV 


OFPPLOHNRS 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON 


ELECTED DECEMBER 19, 1885. 


Prestdentan ene e |.) Sv DLEEINGS. 

Vice-Presidents..----- WILLIAM HARKNESS. GARRICK MALLERY. 
C. E. DUTTON. J. E. HILcarpb. 

TP COSUT ET ns Sane -- ROBERT FLETCHER. 

MESReLEMeS a EG. Ki iGILBERT: Marcus BAKER. 


MEMBERS AT LARGE OF THE GENERAL COMMITTEE. 


H. H. BATEs. F. W. CLARKE. 
Wiehe ArT, C. E. Dutton. 
J. R. EASTMAN. HENRY FARQUHAR. 
T. C. MENDENHALL. H. M. PAvuL. 

C. V. RILEY. 


STANDING COMMITTEES, 


On Communications + 


WILLIAM HARKNESS, Chairman. G. K. GILBERT. MARcus BAKER. 


On Publications: 
G. K. GILBERT, Chairman. ROBERT FLETCHER. MARcus BAKER. 
S. F. Barrp.* 


* As Secretary of the Smithsonian Institution. 
XV 


LIST OF MEMBERS 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Corrected to January 16, 1886, 


The customary titles of members are here for the first time given. 
Names of gentlemen here indicated as resigned will be omitted from future lists. 


NAME. 


ABBE, Prof. CLEVELAND 


ABERT, Mr.S. T.(Sylvanus Thayer) 
ADAMS, Mr. Cuartus FREDERICK 


Apams, Mr. Henry 
Apis, Hon. A. O. (Asa Owen) 
ANTISELL, Dr. THoMas (Founder) 


Avery, Mr. Roser 8. (Robert 
Stanton) 


BairD, Prof. Spencer I’. (Spencer 
Fullerton) (Founder) 

Baxer, Dr. FRANK 

Baker, Mr. Marcus 


BANCROFT, GEORGE 


BarnarpD, Dr. Wo. 8. (William 
Stebbins) 

Barus, Dr. CaRL 

Bares, Mr. Henry H. (Henry 
Hobart) 

BEARDSLEE, Capt. L. A. (Lester 
Anthony) U. 8. N. (Absent) 

Beut, Mr. A. GRAHAM (Alexander 
Graham) 

Betu, Dr. C. A. (Chichester Alex- 
ander) 

Burner, Gen. 8, V. (Stephen Vin- 
cent) U. 8. A. (Founder) 


ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. 


Army Signal Office. 
2017 Tist. N3 Wea 
810 19th st. N. W. 
Civil Service Commission. 
2017 Gst. N. W. 
1607 H st. N. W. 
1765 Mass. ave. N. W. ° 


‘Patent Office. 


1311 Q st. N. W. 
320 A st. 8S. E. 


Smithsonian Institution. 
1445 Mass. ave. N. W. 

326 OC st. N. W. 

Coast and Geodgtic Survey Office, 
1205 Rhode Island ave, 

1623 H st. N. W., or 
Newport, R. I. 

917 New York ave. N. W., or 
Canton, Ill. 

Geological Survey. 

Patent Office. 
The Portland. 

Navy Department. 


Scott Circle ; 
1500 Rhode Island ave. 
1814 19th st. N. W. 


Ordnance Office, War Dept. 
1717 Ist. N. W. 


XVI 


| Admitted. 


1871 


1875 
1885 


1881 
1873 
1871 


1879 


1871 


1881 
1876 


1875 
1884 


1885 
1871 


1875 
1879 
1881 
1871 


LIST OF MEMBERS. 


XVII 


NAME. 


Berssets, Dr. EMIL 

Briurvas, Dr. JounS. (John Shaw) 
U.S. A. (Founder) 

Birney, Gen. WILLIAM 


Brrnixz, Rogers (Absent) 

BoprisH, Mr. 8. H. (Sumner Ho- 
mer) (Absent) 

BoutELLE, Mr. OC. O. (Charles 
Otis) 

Bow ss, Asst. Nav. Constr. Fran- 
cis T. (Francis Tiffany) U.S. N. 

Browne, Dr. J. Mitus (John 
Mills) U.S. N. 

BurcuHarD, Hon. H. C. (Horatio 
Chapin) (Resigned 

Burazsss, Mr. E. 8. (Edward San- 
ford) 

Burnett, Dr. Swan M. (Swan 
Moses) 

Busry, Dr. SAMuEL C. (Samuel 
Clagett) 


Casry, Col. Toomas Linocoty, U. 
S. A. (Founder) 

Cazrarc, Lieut. L. V. (Louis 
Vasmer) U.S. A. (Absent) 

CHAMBERLIN, Prof. T. C. (Thomas 
Crowder) 

CuatTarD, Dr. Toomas M. (Tho- 
mas Marean) 

CHICKERING, Prof. J. W., Jr. 
(John White) 

CurisTIE£, Mr. Avex. S. (Alexan- 
der Smyth) 

CLARK, Mr. HE. (Edward) 

CLARKE, Prof. F. W. (Frank 
Wigglesworth) 

Corrin, Prof. J. H. C. oe 
Huntington Crane) U. 8. N. 
(Founder) 

Comstock, Prof. J. H. (John 
Henry) (Absent) 

Coves, Prof. E.utiott ~ 


Craia, Lieut. Ropert, U. S. A. 
(Absent) 
Craia, Dr. Toomas (Absent) 


2a 


ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. 


Glenn Dale, Md. 
Surg. General’s Office, U. S. A. 
8027 N st. N. W. 
456 Louisiana ave. 
1901 Harewood ave., Le Droit 
Park. 


Geological Survey. 
605 F st. N. W. 
Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 


Navy Department. 


Navy Department. 
The Portland. 


High School. 
810 12th st. N. W. 
1215 Ist. N. W. 


901 16th st. N. W. 


War Department. 
1419 K st. N. W. 
War Department. 


Geological Survey. 
939 K st. N. W. 
Geological Survey. 
601 18th st. N. W. 
Deaf Mute College, Kendall 
Green. 
Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 
507 6th st. N. W. 
Architect’s Office, Capitol. 
417 4th st. N. W. 
Geological Survey. 
1425 Q st. N. W. 
190) T st: NOW: 


Cornell University, Ithaca, N.Y. 
Smithsonian Institution. 

1726 N st. N. W. 
1008 I st. N. W. 


Johns Hopkins Univ., 
Baltimore, Md. 


Admitted. 


—_ 
fo 2) 
-~I 
on 


1871 
1879 
1876 
1883 
1884 
1884 
1883 
1879 
1883 
1879 
1874 


1871 
1882 
1883 
1885 
1874 
1880 
1877 
1874 
1871 


1880 
1874 
18738 
1879 


XVIII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


NAME. 


Curtis, Mr. Gro. E. (George Ed- 
ward) 


Dati, Mr. Wma. H. (William 
Healey) (ounder) 

Davis, ee H. (Charles 
Henry) U.S. N 

Dean, Dr. Rh. C. (Richard Crain) 
U.S. N. (Absent) 

De Carnpry, Mr. Wm. A. (Will- 
iam Augustin) 

DeLanp, Mr. Tueovore L. (The- 
odore Louis) 

Dewey, Mr. Frep. P. (Frederic 
Perkins) 

Ditter, Mr. J. 8. (Joseph Silas) 


DootirrLE, Mr. M. H. (Myrick 
Hascall) 

Dunwoopy, Lt. H. H. C. (Henry 
Harrison Chase) U.S. A. (Absent) 

Dutton, Capt. C. EH. (Clarence 
Edward) U.S. A. 


Ear, Mr. R. Epwarp (Robert 
Edward) 

EasTMAN, Prof. J. R. (John Ro- 
bie) U. 8.0 N. 

ErmBEcK, Mr. WILLIAM 

ELDREDGE, Dr. Srewart (Absent) 

Exuriott, Mr. EH. B. (Ezekiel 
Brown) (Founder) 

Emmons, Mr. 8. F. (Samuel Frank- 
lin) 

Enpuicu, Dr. F. M. (Frederic 
Miller) (Adsent) 

Ewine, Gen. Huan (Absent) 


Farquuar, Mr. EpwAarp 
Farquyuar, Mr. Henry 

FERREL, Prof. WILLIAM 
Fuiercuer, Dr. RoBEertT 

Fuint, Mr. A. 8. (Albert Stowell) 
ee abe Re J. M. (James Milton) 


Friston, Prof. Epwarp T 


> 
ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. 


Army Signal Office. 
930 18th st. N. W. 


Care Smithsonian Institution. 
1119 12th st. N. W. 
Navy Department. 
1705 Rhode Island ave. 
Naval Hospital, New York city. 


Commissary General’s Office. 

1718 H st. N. W. 
Treasury Department. 

126 7th st. N. E. 
National Museum. 

Lanier Heights. 
Geological Survey. 

1804 16th st. N. W. 


Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 


1925 1 st. N. W 
War Department. 


Geological Survey. 
2222 G st. N. W. 


Smithsonian Institution. 
1386 T st. N. W. 

Naval Observatory. 
1828 Ist. N. W. 


Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 


Yokohama, Japan. 
Gov’t Actuary, Treas. Dept. 
L2TOCG ste N. Wie 
Geological Survey. 
1022 Vermont ave. 
Smithsonian Institution. 
Lake Valley, New Mexico. 
Lancaster, Ohio. 


Patent Office Library. 
1915 H st. N. W. 


Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 


Brooks Station, D. C. 
Army Signal Office. 
ATL Cist: Ns Wie 


Surgeon General's Office, U.S. A. 


The Portland. 
Naval Observatory. . 


1450 Chapin st., College Hill. 


Navy Department. - 
U.S. 5. Albatross. 

Columbian University. 
1434 N st. N.W. 


Admitted. 


LIST OF MEMBERS. 


XIX 


NAME. 


GALLAUDET, President E. M. (Ed- 
ward Miner) 
GanneETT, Mr. HENRY 


Ginon, Dr. ALBERT L. (Albert 
Leary) U.S. N. (Resigned 
GILBERT, Mr. G. K. (Grove Karl) 


Goppine, Dr. W. W. (William 
Whitney) 
Goocu, Dr. F. A. (Frank Austin) 


GoopE, Mr. G. Brown (George 
Brown) 

GooprELLow, Mr. EpwAarD 

Gore, Prof. J. H. (James How- 
ard 

Bee Mr. WALTER H. (Wal- 
ter Hayden) (Absent) 

GrReeLy, Lieut. A. W. (Adol- 
phus Washington) U.S. A. 

GREEN, Mr. BeRNARD KR. (Bern- 
ard Richardson) 

GREEN, Commander F. M. (Fran- 
cis Mathews) U.S. N. (Absent) 

GREENE, Prof. B. F. (Benjamin 
Franklin) (Founder: absent) 

GREENE, Capt. FRANCIs V. (Fran- 
cis Vinton) U.S. A. (Absent) 

Gresory, Dr. Jonn M. (John 
Milton) 

GUNNELL, Francis M., M. D., U. 
ue. 


Hains, Col. Pxrrer C. 
Conover) 


(Peter 


Hains, Mr. Roperr P. (Robert 
Peter) 
Hatt, Prof. Asarpg, U.S. N. 
(Founder) ; 
Hatt, Mr. Asapu, JR. 


Haxwocr, Dr. WILLIAM 
Hampson, Mr. THomMAS 


Harkness, Prof. WiLu1AM, U.S. 
N. (Founder) 


ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. 


Deaf Mute College, Kendall 
Green. 
Geological Survey. 
1881 Harewood ave., Le Droit 
Park. 


Geological Survey. 
1424 Corcoran st. : 
Government Hospital for the In- 
sane. 
Geological Survey. 
825 Vermont ave. 
National Museum. 
1645 TE st. IN. W.- 


Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 


Columbian University. 
1305 Q st. N. W. 
Denver, Colorado. 
Army Signal Office. 
1914 Gst N. W. 
1738 N st. N. W. 
Navy Department. 
West Lebanon, N. H. 
West Point, N. Y. 
15 Grant Place. 


600 20th st., N. W. 


Engineer’s Office, Potomac Riy. 


Improvement, 2136 Pa. ave. 


1824 Jefferson Place. 
Patent Office. 
1714 18th st. N. W. 
Naval Observatory. 
2715 N st. N. W. 
Yale College Observatory, New 
Haven, Conn. 
2715 N st. N. W. 
Geological Survey. 
Geological Survey. 
504 Maple ave., Le Droit 
Park. 
Naval Observatory. 
Cosmos Club, 23 Madison 
Place. 


s 
o 
~» 
Rx} 
= 
g 
Le 
< 


xx PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


NAME. 


Hassuter, Dr. FERDINAND A. 
(Ferdinand Augustus) (Absent) 

Haypen, Dr. F. V. (Ferdinand 
Vandeveer) (Founder: absent) 

Hazen, Prof. H. A. (Henry Allen) 


Hazen, Gen. W. B. (William 
Babcock) U.S. A. 
Heap, Maj. D. P. (David Porter) 


Hensuaw, Mr. H. W. (Henry 
Wetherbee) 

HiteGarp, Mr. J. KE. (Julius Eras- 
mus) ( (Founder) 

Hitt, Mr. G. W. (George Wil- 
liam) 

Hircucock, Mr. Romyn 


Hopexins, Prof. H. L. (Howard 
Lincoln) 

Hoven, Prest. EDWARD SINGLE- 
TON (Absent 

Hoimes, Mr. W. H. (William 
Henry) 

Howe t, Mr. Epwin E. (Edwin 
Eugene) (Absent) 


Ipprnes, Mr. JosrerH P. (Joseph 
Paxson) 


JameEs, Rev. OwEn (Absent) 

JENKINS, Rear Admiral THoRN- 
ton A. (Thornton Alexander) 
WS: oN. (Founder 

JOHNSON, 
Burges) 


B. (Arnold 


Jounson, Dr. JosePH TABER 

Jounson, Mr. WILLARD D. (Will- 
ard Drake) (Absent) 

Jounston, Dr. W. W. (William 
Waring) 


KavurrMann, Mr. 8. H. (Samuel 
Hays) 
Keirn, Mr. R. (Reuel) 


Kerr, Mr. Marx B. (Mark 
Brickell) 
Kipper, Dr. J. H. (Jerome Henry) 


ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. 


Santa Afia, Los Angeles Co., 
Cal. 
Geological Survey. 
1805 Arch st., Phila., Pa. 
P. O. Box No. 427. 
1416 Corcoran st. 
Army Signal Office. 
1601 K st. N. W. 


Light House Board, Treas. Dept. 


1618 Rhode Island ave. 
Bureau of Ethnology. 

13 Iowa Circle. 
L739" st. Ne WV. 


Nautical Almanac Office. 

314 Indiana ave. N. W. 
National Museum, or 

P. O. Box 630. 
Columbian University. 

627 N st. N. W. 
University of California, 

Berkeley, Cal. 

Geological Survey. 

1100 O st. N. W. 
48 Oxford st., Rochester, N. Y. 


Geological Survey. 
1028 Vermont ave. 


Seranton, Pa. 
2115 Penna. ave. N. W. 


Light House Board, Treas. Dept. 
501 Maple ave., Le Droit 
Park. 
926 17th st. N. W. 
Geological Survey. 


1603 K st. N. W. 


1000 M st. N. W. 


Nautical Almanac Office. 
-2219 I st. N. W. 
Geological Survey. 
722 2ist st. N. W. 
Smithsonian Institution. 
1816 N st. N. W. 


Admitted. 


1880 
1871 
1882 
1881 
1884 
1874 
1871 
1879 
1884 
1885 
1873 
1879 
1874 


1885 


1880 
1871 


1878 


1879 
1884 


1878 


1884 
1871 


1880 


| 
| 
/ 


LIST OF MEMBERS. XXI 
3 
NAME. ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. 2 
z 
=< 
Kix~pourne, Lt. C. E. (Charles | War Department. 1880 
Evans) U.S. A. (Absent) 
Kine, Dr. A. F. A. (Albert Free- | 726 18th st. N. W. 1875 
man Africanus) 
Knox, Hon. Jonun Jay (Absent) Prest. Nat. Bank Republic, New | 1874 
York city 
KumMELL, Mr. C. H. (Charles | Coast and Geodetic Survey Office.| 1882 
Hugo) 608 Q st. N. W. 
Lawrence, Mr. WILLIAM 1344 Vermont ave., and 1884 
Bellefontaine, Ohio. 
Lawver, Dr. W. P. (Winfield | Mint Bureau, Treas. Dept. 1881 
Peter) 1912 1st. N. W. 
Lez, Dr. WILLIAM 2111 Penna. ave. N. W. 1874 
1821 Ist. N. W. 
Leravour, Mr. Epwarp B. (Ed- | 905 O st. N. W. 1882 
ward Brown) 
Lincotn, Dr. N.S. (Nathan Smith)) 1514 H st. N. W. 1871 
Loomis, Mr. E. J. (Eben Jenks) | Nautical Almanac Office. 1880 
1413 Stoughton st. N. W. 
Lutt, Capt. E. P. (Edward Phelps)) Navy Department. 1875 
U.S. N. (Absent) 74 Cedar st., Roxbury, Mass. 
McGez, Mr. W J Geological Survey. 1883 
1424 Corcoran st. 
McGuire, Mr. Frep. B. (Freder- | 1416 F st. N. W. 1879 
, ick Bauders) 614 Est. N. W. 
McMurtriz, Prof. WiLL1aAM University of Illinois, Cham- | 1876 
| (Absent) paign, Ill. 
| Mauer, Mr. Jamus A. (James | Geological Survey. 1884 
| Arran) 21 K st. N. W. 
| Mauuery, Col. Garrick, U.S. A.| Bureau of Ethnology. 1875 
| 1323 N st. N. W. 
\Mawn, Mr. B. PickmaAn (Benja- | Department of Agriculture. 1885 
min Pickman) 924 19th st. N. W. 
\Marcou, Mr. J. B. (John Belknap)| Geological Survey. 1884 
| 601 13th st. N. W. 
Marvin, Prof. C. F. (Charles | Army Signal Office. 1885 
Frederick) 1736 13th st. N. W. 
Marvin, Mr. Jos. B. (Joseph | Internal Revenue Bureau. 1878 
| Badger) (Absent) 
Wason, Prof. Or1s T. (Otis Tufton)} National Museum. 1875 
1305 Q st. N. W. 
Tarruews, Dr. W. (Washington) |} Surg. General’s Office, U. S. A. | 1884 
| U.S: A. 
Krtas, Gen. M. C. (Montgomery | 1239 Vermont ave. 1871 
Cunningham) U.S.A. (Founder) 
MenDENHALL, Prof.T. C.(Thomas| Army Signal Office. 1885 
Corwin) 
RRILL, Mr. GEorGE P. (George | National Museum. 1884 
?erkins) 


XXII 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


NAME. 


Morean, Dr. E. C. (Ethelbert 
Carroll) 

Moser, Lt. J. F. (Jefferson Frank- 
hin) 8. N. 

Murpocu, Mr. JoHn 


Mussery, Gen. R. D. (Reuben Del- 
avan) 


Myers, Gen. WitriaAM, U.S. A. 


Newcomp, Prof. Simon, U.S. N. 
(Founder) 

Nicwors, Dr. Cuarves H. (Charles 
Henry) (Absent) 


NicHortson, Mr. W. L. (Walter 
Lamb) (ounder) 

Norpuorr, Mr. CHARLES 

Norris, Dr. Basiu U.S. A. (Ad- 


sent) 
Nort, Judge C. C. (Charles Cooper) 


Oapen, Mr. Hersert G. (Herbert 
Gouverneur) 
OsporneE, Mr. J. W. (John Walter) 


ParkE, Gen. Jonn G. (John 
Grubb) U.S. A. (Founder) 

Parker, Dr. PETER (Iounder) 

Parry, Dr. CHARtEs C. (Charles 
Christopher) (Aésent) 

Pau, Mr. H. M. (Henry Martyn) 


PEALE, Dr. A. C. (Albert Charles) 


Piniine, Mr. Jamzs C. (James 
Constantine) (Resigned) 

Por, Gen. O. M. (Orlando Met- 
calfe) U. S. A. (Absent) 

PoInDEXTER, Mr. W. M. ( William 


Mundy) 

Por, Dr. B. F. (Benjamin Frank- 
lim) U.S.A; 

Powrii, Major J. W. (John 
Wesley) 

Prentiss, Dr. D. W. (Daniel 
Webster) 


PritcueTt, Prof. H. 8. (Henry 
Smith) (Absent) 


ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. 


918 E st. N. W. 


Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 
7 2d st. S. E. 
Smithsonian Institution. 
1441 Chapin st., College Hill. 
P. O. Box 618. 
508 5th st. N. W. 
War Department. 


Navy Department. 
941 M st. N. W. 
Bloomingdale Asylum, Boule- 
vard and 117th st., New 
Mork AN. 
Topographer, P. O. Dept. 
1822" TD stag Ws 
1781 K st. N. W. 
Vancouver, Clarke Co., Wash. 
Ter. 
Court of Claims. 
826 Connecticut ave. N. W. 


Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 
1324 19th st. N. W. 
212 Delaware ave. N. E. 


Engineer Bureau, War Dept. 
16 Lafayette Square. 

2 Lexington Place. 

Davenport, Iowa. 


Naval Observatory. 

109 ist st. N. E. 
Geological Survey. 

1010 Mass. ave. N. W. 


384 Congress st. West, Detroit, 
Mich. 
701 15th st. N. W. 
806 17th st. N. W. 
Surg. General’s Office, U. S. A. 


Geological Survey. 
910 M st. N. W. 
1224 9th st. N. W. 
Director of Observatory, Wash. 
University, St. Louis, Mo. 


| Admitted. 


LIST OF MEMBERS. 


NAME. 


RatuBun, Mr. RicuarD 


Ravené, Mr. Gustave L. (Gus- 
tave Louis) 

Ray, Lieut. P. H. (Patrick Henry) 
WL S., A. 

REeNnsHAWE, Mr. Jno. H. (John 
Henry) 

Ricuey, Dr. 8. O. (Resigned) 

RicksEcKER, Mr. EUGENE 


Rivey, Dr. C. V. (Charles Valen- 
tine) 


Ritter, Mr. W. F. McK. (Will- 
iam Francis McKnight) 
Rosinson, Mr. THomas 


Rogers, Mr. JosepH’ A. (Joseph 
Addison) (Absent) 

Russett, Mr. Israzt C. (Israel 
Cook) 

Russe_u, Mr. Tuomas 


Satmon, Dr. D. E. (Daniel Elmer) 


Sampson, Commander WILLIAM 
Tomas U.S. N. (Absent) ® 
Savitye, Mr. J. H. (James Ham- 

ilton) 
Scuort, Mr. Cuar.es A. (Charles 
Anthony) (Founder) 
SHELLABARGER, Hon. SAMUEL 


SHERMAN, Hon. JouHn 


SHUFELDT, Dr. R. W. (Robert 
Wilson) U. 8. A. (Absent) 

SHumway, Mr. W. A. (Willard 
Adams) (Resigned) 

SicarpD, Capt. Monreomery, U. 
SN. 


SiasBEE, Commander C. D. 
(Charles Dwight) U.S. N. (Ab- 
sent 

Sxinner, Dr. J. O. (John Oscar) 
U.S.A 


SMILEY, Mr. Cuas. W. (Charles 
Wesley) 

SmirH, Chf. Eng. Davin, U. 
S.N. 


ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. 


Smithsonian Institution. 
1622 Mass. ave. 
1417 6th st. N. W. 


Fort Gaston, Cal. 


Geological Survey. 
The Woodmont. 


Geological Survey. 

1323 Q st. N. W. 
Agricultural Department, or 

National Museum. 

1700 18th st. N. W. 
Nautical Almanac Office. 

16 Grant Place. 
Howard University. 

6th st. N. W., cor. Lincoln. 
Naval Observatory. 


Geological Survey. 
1424 Corcoran st. 
Army Signal Office. 
1447 Corcoran st. N. W. 


Agricultural Department. 
1337 15th st. N. W. 
Torpedo Station, Newport, R. I. 


1419 F st. N. W. 
1315 M st. N. W. 

Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 
212 Ist st. S. E. 

Room 23 Corcoran Building. 
812 17th st. N. W. 

U.S. Senate. 
1319 K st. N. W. 

Surg. Genl’s Office, U. S. A., or 
Box 144, Smithsonian Inst. 


Ordnance Bureau, Navy Dept. 
Navy Department. 


Surg. General’s Office, U. S. A. 
1529 Ost. N. W. 

U.S. Fish Commission. 
943 Mass. ave. 

1330 Corcoran st. 


XXIII 


Admitted. 


XXIV 


NAME. 


SmitrH, Mr. Epwin 


SporrorD, Mr. A. R. (Ainsworth 
Rand) 

Srrearns, Mr. Rosert E. C. (Rob- 
ert Edwards Carter) 

Srone, Prof. Ormond (Absent) 


Taytor, Mr. F. W. (Frederick 
William) (Absent) 

Taytor, Mr. W1L1AM B. (William 
Bower) (Founder) 

Tuompson, Prof. A. H. (Almon 
Harris) 

THompson, Mr. GILBERT 


Topp, Prof. Davip P. (David 
Peck) (Absent) 

Toner, Dr. J. M., (Joseph Mere- 
dith) 

True, Mr. FREDERICK W. (Fred- 
erick William) 


Upton, Mr. Wm. W. (William 
Wirt) 
Upton, Prof. Winsiow (Absent) 


Watcott, Mr. C. D. (Charles 
Doolittle) 
Wa po, Prof. Frank (Absent) 


Wa ker, Mr. Francis A. (Fran- 
cis Amasa) (Absent) 

Watuine, Mr. Henry F. (Henry 
Francis) (Absent) 

Warp, Mr. Lester F. (Lester 
Frank) 

Wesster, Mr. ALBERT L. (Albert 
Lowry) (Absent) 

Weep, Mr. Walter H. (Walter 
Harvey) 

Wruitine, Mr. JAmus C. (James 
Clarke) 


WHEELER, Capt. Guo. M., U.S. A. 


WuirE, Dr. C. A. (Charles Abia- 
ther) 

Wuirte, Dr. C. H. (Charles Henry) 
C5. N 

WIi.uiAMs, Mr. ALBERT, Jr. 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. 


Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 


2024 Hillyer Place. 
Library of Congress. 
1621 Mass. Ave. N. W. 
Smithsonian Institution. 
1635 18th st. N. W. 
Leander McCormick Observa- 
tory, University of Vir- 
ginia, Va. 


Lake Valley, New Mexico. 

Smithsonian Institution. 
306 C st. N. W. 

Geological Survey. 


Geological Survey. 
1448 Q st. N. W. 


Lawrence Observatory, Amherst, | 


Mass. 
615 Louisiana ave. 


National Museum. 
1385 N st. N. W. 


1416 F st. N. W. 
1746 M st. N. W. 
au University, Providence, 
ae le 


Geological Survey; National 
Museum. 

Army Signal Office, Fort Myer, 
Va 


Massachusetts Institute of Tech- 
nology, Boston, Mass. 
U.S. Geological Survey, Cam- 

bridge, Mass. 
Geological Survey. 
1464 Rhode Island ave. 
West New Brighton, Staten Isl- 
and, N. Y. 
Geological Survey. 
1413 Rhode Island ave. 
1802 Connecticut ave. 


Lock Box 92. 
Geological Survey. 
312 Mapleave., Le'Droit Park 
Museum of Hygiene, 1744 G st. 
ye av? 


Geological Survey. 


Admitted. 


1882 


1882 
1880 


1883 
1881 
1872 
1883 
1876 
1882 
1885 
1872 


1878 
1876 


1884 
1883 


LIST OF MEMBERS. 


‘si 
3) 
< 


NAME. 


Wits, Mr. BarLey 


Witson, H. M. (Herbert Michael) 

Witson, Mr. J. ORMOND (James 
Ormond) 

Wintock, Mr. WILL1AM C. ( Will- 
iam Crawford) 

Woop, Mr. Josepu (Absent) 


Woop, Lt. W. M. (William Max- 
well) U. S. N. (Absent) 

Woopwarp, Mr. R. S. (Robert 
Simpson) 

Worrtman, Dr. J. L. (Jacob Law- 
son) 

Wrieut, Mr. Gro. M. (George 
Mitchell) 


Yarrow, Dr. H. C. (Harry Crécy) 


Yeates, Mr. W. 8. (William 
Smith) 


Ziwet, Mr. ALEXANDER 


ZuMBROcK, Dr. A. (Anton) 


LIST OF DECEASED MEMBERS. 


Name. 
Benjamin Alvord 
Orville Elias Babcock 
Theodorus Bailey 
Joseph K. Barnes 
Henry Wayne Blair . 


Horace Capron . : A 
Salmon Portland Chase 
Frederick Collins : A 


Benjamin Faneuil Craig. 
Charles Henry Crane 

Josiah Curtis 

Richard Dominicus Cutts 
Charles Henry Davis 4 
Frederick William Dorr . 


an} 
Qo 
ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. = 
= 
Geological Survey. 1885 
2017 N st. N. W. 
Geological Survey. 1885 
1439 Massachusetts ave. N. W. | 1873 
Naval Observatory. 1880 
718 21st st. N. W. 
Supt. Motive Power, Penn Co., | 1875 
Fort Wayne, Ind. 
Navy Department. 1871 
Geological Survey. 1883 
1125 17th st. N. W. 
Army Medical Museum. 1885 
916 14th st. N. W. 
Geological Survey. 1885 
1319 Vermont ave. 
Surgeon General’s Office, U.S. A.| 1874 
814 17th st. N. W. 
Smithsonian Institution. 1884 
1008 E st. S. W. 
Coast and Geodetic Survey Office.| 1885 
1456 Corcoran st. 
455 Cst. N. W. 1875 
Admitted. 
1872 
‘ . - ° 1871 
. ° ay yore 
Founder 
. ° - 1884 
: . Founder | 
‘ . s - Founder 
5 3 : : 1879 
. : 5 . Founder 
. : . : Founder 
1874 
1871 
° : : «. 1874 
. : : : 1874 


XXVI PHILOSOPHICAL 


Name. 
Alexander B. Dyer . 
Amos Beebe Eaton 
Charles Ewing 
Elisha Foote 
John Gray Foster : 
Leonard Dunnell Gale . . 
Isaiah Hanscom 
Joseph Henry 
Franklin Benjamin Hough : 


Andrew Atkinson Humphreys . 


Ferdinand Kampf 
Washington Caruthers Kerr 
Jonathan Homer Lane 
Oscar A. Mack ‘ 
Archibald Robertson Marvine 
Fielding Bradford Meek 
James William Milner 
Albert J. Myer . 

George Alexander Otis 
Carlile Pollock Patterson 
Titian Ramsay Peale 
Benjamin Peirce 

John Campbell Riley 

John Rodgers 

Benjamin Franklin ginal 
George Christian Shaeffer 
Henry Robinson Searle 
William J. Twining 

Joseph Janvier Woodward . 
John Maynard Woodworth 
Mordecai Yarnall . . 


SOCIETY OF 


SUMMARY. 


Active members 
Absent members 


Total 


Deceased members 


WASHINGTON. 


Admitted, 
Founder 
Founder 

1874 
Founder 

P 1873 

: 1874 

1873 
; Founder 

1879 
Founder 

1875 

1883 
Founder 

1872 

1874 
Founder 

1874 
Founder 
- Founder 

5 1871 
- Founder 
Founder 

: 1877 

: 1872 
Founder 
c Founder 

1877 

° 1878 
Founder 

1874 

e 1871 


ad y SECRETARIES’ REPORT. XXVITI 


ANNUAL REPORT OF THE SECRETARIES. 


WASHINGTON, City, December 19, 1885. 
To the Philosophical Society of Washington: 


We have the honor to present the following statistical data 
for 1885. 


At the beginning of the year the number of active members 
was . : . 3 ; ; i : : , hg Bole 
This number has been increased by the addition of 22* new 
members and by the return of 3 absent members. It has 
been diminished by the departure of 6 members, by the 
death of 1, by the resignation of 5, and by the dropping 
of 7 for non-payment of dues. The net increase of active 


members has thus been . : : é y ; f 6 
And the active membership is now... : : ot, ae 

The roll of new members is: 
C. F. ADAMs. H. L. HopexK ins. W. A. SHUMWAY. 
Car BARUS. J. P. Ipprnas. W. iH. WEED. 
T. M. CHATARD. B. P. MANN. BAILEY WILLIS. 
TF. A. Goocu. C. F. Marvin. H. M. WILson. 
Ree EL ANS: : T. C. MENDENHALL. J. L. WoRTMAN. 
WILLIAM HALLOcK. J. KF. Moser. G. M. WRIGHT. 
THOMAS HAMPSON. C. C. Nott. ALEX. ZIWET. 

G. L. RAVENE. 

The names of deceased members (active and absent) are: 

HorAcE CAPRON. F. B. Hove. W. C. KERR. T. R. Peas. 


There have been 16 meetings for the presentation and discussion 
of papers (not including the public meeting of Dec. 5); the average 
attendance has been 48. There have been 6 meetings of the Mathe- 
matical Section ; average attendance 15. 

In the general meetings 32 communications have been presented ; 
in the mathematical section 14. Altogether 46 communications 
have been made by 32 members and one guest. The number of 
members who have participated in the discussions is 41. The total 
number who have contributed to the scientific proceedings is 54, or 
31 per cent. of the present active membership. 

The General Committee has held 17 meetings. Attendance below 
10 on one evening only, and four times as high as 15. Average 
12.2. Corresponding average last year 11.9, and in 1883 10.3, 
when the attendance was below 10 at five meetings. 


Very respectfully, G. K. GILBERT, 
Henry FArRQuHaAR, 
Secretaries. 


*The figures in this report have been brought down to Jan. 16, 1886, so 
as to correspond with the list of members. They differ somewhat from those 
read to the Society at the annual meeting. 


XXVIII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


REPORT OF THE TREASURER. 
Mr. President and Gentlemen: ° 


The report which I have the honor to present to you to-night 
covers the pecuniary transactions of the fiscal year which termi- 
nates with this meeting. 

You will see from the statement which I shall presently read 
that the total receipts by the Treasurer have been $1,224.04, and 
the total disbursements $740.02, leaving a cash balance of $484.02. 
These sums do not, however, represent the net income and expendi- 
ture for the year, since the receipts include a balance transferred 
by the former Treasurer, and the amount collected of unpaid dues 
of previous years. The payments, also, include the sum of $104.12, 
for unpaid debts of 1884, 

All the liabilities of the Society have been discharged to date, 
and the actual income belonging to 1885 has been $1,041.00, which 
includes $205.00 of dues yet outstanding. The disbursements for 
the same period have been $635.90, leaving a net saving for the cur- 
rent year of $405.10. 

The unpaid dues of former years which have been collected, 
amount to $160.00. 

The Government bonds which belong to the Society were at the 
beginning of the year exchanged for new issues of the same 
amounts and denominations. This was done, under authority of 
the General Committee, in order to obtain uniformity in the 
designation of the Society, the former bonds having varied from 
each other in that particular. The bonds consist of: — 


1 $1,000 00 bond, bearing interest at 4 per cent. 
1 500 00 (73 “ “cc 4 79 
il! 1,000 00 a3 6c “ 4} fg 


Total, $2,500 00. 
The assets of the Society are as follows: — 


Cash, with Riggs & Co. 3 : $482 02 
Bonds j ; ; , ! ; 2,500 00 
Unpaid dues. : i : : 295 00. 


Total ; 2 2 ; . $3,279 02 


The market value of the bonds is, of course, considerably in 
excess of their face value; on the other hand, a part of the “un- 
paid dues” will probably not be collected. 

I have in my possession a still ample stock of the Bulletins. 
A copy of Vol. VII was seut directly after its publication in 
February last to every member entitled to receive it, as well as to 
the various societies and scientific journals, at home and abroad, 
with which it has been customary for the Society to exchange 
publications. 


TREASURER’S REPORT, 


“LOMNSDIAT, 


‘AHHOLEATA LUTAOW 
a as Set ae Bt tee) ita Oe te oe tg) eee 


40 #22'1$ 


ST 69 


oe = OD Sp sear aA ‘oousreg 
‘049 ‘YIOM [BOIOTO ‘L1oU0Ty 

-vys ‘osvysod roy ‘soansvory, puv sarieyjor 

99g Jo sasuodxo snoouejoosiu pred yse9 

ae ~"~-syooq jun0d90B8 puv prodded Jo 

qos Mou pu ‘spivo peysod ‘st[1q ‘sano 

“t10 ‘Suryurid snoouryjoostut oy pred yseg ‘GT 09 
a aes ~--=-—== Karo0g oy} Jo ssurjoout 

8[T Uo sduBptez}e soy doytuvl pied yseg et oune 
uljol[Ng oy} JO J [OA 

‘oqo ‘Surpurq ‘Suyurd soz ous pred yseg 
““-—“gunooov saad 4se] Uo onp 

punog "[vq “TopIoMjod a ppne pred ysep “11 your 

— isxoyonoa sod ee ‘syuaurasinqsip Ag "G8ST 


10 F22'TS 
00 GOT Se j 
QOROD ee cee ” FI OOGT » 
OSI quo sod fF 3% QOO'TS UO 
— i spuoq uo 4so109Ur OF a = 
(JOA BF Raat es = ae ~ 988T 9 ” ” 
00 0&4 ~~" S88T on ” ” 
OO<OGIes tere ae P83st ” ” 
QUES GSS pits = ee S880 ” ” 
00 G ~~ G8sk JO sONnp ” » “6L “00d 
00 “---uljol[Ng Jo ops roy ‘i, » “OS “IPL 
FO SIGS "OQ "D Wor poatooor Ysvo oF, “g ‘use 


“S88T 


‘wopburysnyy fo hyor00g) poorydosopryg ay], YM WUNOIDD UL JALNSHALT, 94,7, ‘aq 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


xxx 


02 ‘9 €% ‘6 93 ‘IL 
GS ‘8 G3 SIL 13 ‘SI- 
&% ‘6 96 ‘AL 82 ‘FI 
3 ‘OL 13 ‘SL Go ‘SL ‘TL 
SI ‘F 2 ‘L &3 ‘6 
02 ‘9 £2 ‘6 93 ‘IL 
16 ‘h %% ‘OL 96 ‘ZL 
Go 8 G3 ‘TL 13 “ST 
> 
£2 ‘6 
$3 ‘OL 
SI ‘fF 
GL ‘¢ @ ‘8 #3 ‘OL 
02 ‘9 £3 ‘6 c% SLT 
Zo ‘8 GZ ‘IL 13 ‘ST 
€z ‘6 9% ‘ZL 82 ‘FL 
#% ‘OL LG ‘SL 6 ‘GT ° 
SL ‘F Goan £2 ‘6 
0% ‘9 &z “6 G3 ‘IT 
1% ‘L $3 ‘OL 93 ‘ZI 
Go. ‘8 G3 ‘IL 1G ‘SL 
€2 ‘6 93 ‘ZL 8% “FT 
SL ‘Ft 12k &2 ‘6 
GL ‘¢ Ga ‘8 vB ‘OL 
02 ‘9 &@ ‘6 & ‘IL 
‘ouns “ABI ‘TLady 


“yore 


81 ‘* Pee ees eeeerereeseeee sese "SOG 1Z =) Mf) A | 
GL ‘9 
03 ‘9 
13 ‘L 
0g ‘OL % SOO RR Ree eee eet eee ne ee teeeeeees 061 
1 eT Se . eeeeee . 
8I ‘F " 
61 §g wee eee ewes 
“O06T 6 
“COST 0 

"SGOT + "1681 
0g ‘QT 4 Pace Gees eur caee sig euee canaenese)) aT) 6L ‘¢ IZ ), to ‘OL BASSO Hyp 
81 as wee scoane*s"O6RT 1Z 1 €3 G 9% ‘SL Asnececeseesern= CHOOT 
61 ‘¢ “C6ST Go ‘8 #2 ‘OL 13 ‘EL See ORE 
02 9 COORLEELCOE ited “7 A GZ TL 82 SL eccve pataesassenoheeneriiay 
IZ FH Seeceeeemeeipar 7d ‘OL 9% WAS 6Z ‘GL pas cnaae sacuns reriaeenue(esor ris 
os ‘OL ‘3 “ere CEST 61 ‘¢ “1681 
18 ‘LL ‘g “1681 02 ‘9 “0681 
Sl ‘F “O68 cua “6881 
6L °g 6881 Go se} £Z ‘OL 13 ‘EL errrrer rrr retiree eer "SSSL 
1% Bh Sig ease annoasisanscesseess<2=:S] 000i A OL 9% ‘OL 62 ‘OL “L881 
62 ‘ST cae *L88T Sl ‘F 03 ‘9 &@ ‘6 “"O88T 
0s ‘OL ‘ “9881 61 ‘¢ 12 ‘L ¥ ‘OL “CSS 
TRS eat POD “G88L 02 ‘9 a ‘8 G3 ‘IL “P88 


“Areniqey | “Arvenuve 


“S1IB9X “Taq ula09q | LIQuigAONT 


°19Q0}90 "SIBOX 


*poystiqnd poszapio pur “bggr ‘Z aunf aa}1WUI0D [e19Uey ay} 0} payruqns 


‘LLOITIG "G "W ‘UW AI Gauvdaug 


‘aazsnjruz ‘90 -Lobs 03 S9-bgyr mo04f ,,suosvay ,, pvaanas ayy Suainp sSuyoayy Suyyoy sof SA VQYOLVS wyousayv ay, Sumys 
‘ALHIOOS ‘IVOIHdOSOTIHd AHL AO ASN AHL WOA. UVANAIVO 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON, 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. 


XXXI 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT, 
ASAPH HALL. 
Delivered December 5, 1885. 


AMERICAN SCIENTIFIC SOCIETIES. 


Mr. Chairman and Fellow-Members of the Philosophical Society : 


The termination of the office with which you have honored me 
during the past year brings, in accordance with our custom, the 
duty of addressing you, and I have chosen for my subject American 
Scientific Societies. ‘The Philosophical Society of Washington is the 
first scientific society of which I was a member, and, having still a 
lively recollection of the curiosity and interest with which I watched 
its formation and early progress, I propose to consider briefly the 
history of such societies in our own country, and incidentally, some 
of their benefits. 

Nothing can be more natural than the union of men of similar 
tastes and thought into associations for the investigation and dis- 
cussion of matters that mutually interest them, and thus we see in 
all civilized countries the formation of societies in every branch of 
learning and of art. In the countries of Europe such bodies have 
been a long time in existence, and many of them are still in vigor- 
ous life. Most of these societies owe their establishment to the favor 
of a powerful patron, generally an emperor or a king, who was.wise 
enough to understand that the well-being of his people would be en- 
hanced by the progress of science and art. But whatever may have 
been the motive of their foundation, these academies of scientific men 
have exerted a great influence on the civilization of Europe. Such 
an assertion may seem doubtful to the readers of what is called 
history, but in fact the larger part of our civilization that is good 
and permanent will be found closely connected with the works and 
inventions of scientific men. It is these works that have changed 
our ideas and conception of the world in which we live, and of the 
universe around us. It is these works, also, that slowly but surely 
compel the changes of political and theological theories. History, 
as it is now written, deals mostly with battles and sieges, with the 

3a XXXIII 


XXXIV PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


actions of emperors and kings, the amours of princes, and the in- 
trigues of courtiers and priests. These are the bubbles and froth 
of the social world that have attracted nearly all historical writers, 
but there is a growing feeling that such recitals do not contain the 
substantial parts of history. Who would not wish to know more 
of the social forces that have been at work in Europe and in our 
own country, and which have converted some of the most rugged 
and barren parts of the world into the richest and most prosperous— 
of the ingenious and persevering industry that brings about the 
greatest changes in the customs of men and in the political power 
of nations? These changes come from an increase of command over 
the forces of nature, and in our ability to make these forces work 
for us. Now it is the discovery and study of these forces and their 
modes of action that form a large part-of scientific work; and if we 
turn to the academies of Europe we shall find that they have a 
splendid history. By their encouragement of the labors and writ- 
ings of ingenious men, by just criticism, and by the publication of 
memoirs these academies take a prominent place in the history of 
science. It is in these enduring monuments of the human intellect, 
rather than in brazen statues or marble shafts, that the real glory 
of the race consists, 

The men who settled our country were separated by a great ocean 
and a month’s journey from the civilization and learning of Europe. 
They had ample work to do in building houses and roads, and in 
establishing themselves securely in this new world, However, they 
soon began to set up schools and colleges, so that the elements at 
least of learning might be kept alive. But the inhabitants were 
scattered over a great extent of country, and means of communica- 
tion were poor. Under these circumstances concerted action and 
union into societies were difficult, and a century and a half passed 
away before the formation of a formal scientific society. The first 
society of this kind that I find in our country is the American 
Philosophical Society of Philadelphia, organized in 1769. At that 
time Philadelphia was the largest and the leading city of this 
country, and being in a good degree free of the bitter theological 
quibbles and disputes that embroiled New England communities, it 
was better adapted for the home of a scientific society. It was also 
the residence of Benjamin Franklin, who appears to have taken an 
active part in the formation of the new society, and who became its 
first president. Franklin was a native of Boston, but when seven- 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XXXV 


teen years of age, having written and spoken disrespectfully of what 
he called “religious knaves,” and having thus provoked the enmity 
of influential men in his native town, he sought and found a home 
in a more genial climate. The new society began well. Its first 
_ three presidents were Benjamin Franklin, David Rittenhouse, and 
Thomas Jefferson. This society formulated and published an ex- 
cellent plan of scientific work, including a study of the native inhab- 
itants of the country, an examination of the ancient mounds of the 
Western States, and researches in geology and natural history. In 
1796 it offered several prizes, with premiums ranging from fifty to 
one hundred dollars. The first premium offered was “ for the best 
system of liberal education and literary instruction adapted to the 
genius of the government, and best calculated to promote the gen- 
eral welfare of the United States, comprehending, also, a plan for 
instituting and conducting public schools in this country on princi- 
ples of the most extensive utility.” Premiums were also offered for 
improving the method of computing longitudes from lunar distances, 
for the improvement of ship pumps, for the improvement of stoves 
or fire-places, for the best method to prevent the premature decay 
of peach trees, for a treatise on native American vegetable dyes, 
and for the best improvement of lamps. This society published its 
first volume of memoirs in 1771. Among the first contributors was 
David Rittenhouse, the able and ingenious astronomer, and the first 
volume contains a very full account of the Transit of Venus that 
happened June 3, 1769. We find here, also, some account of im- 
provements in the sextant, which appears to have been independ- 
ently invented by Thomas Godfrey, of Philadelphia, in 1730. 
Franklin was an early contributor to the memoirs, his writings 
generally having a very practical bearing. His first paper is on 
the causes and cure of smoky chimneys, and occupies thirty-six 
quarto pages. It is an interesting paper on an important subject, 
much discussed at that time. A correspondent of Franklin de- 
clares its importance by quoting the lines— 


“A smoky house and a scolding wife 
Are two of the greatest ills in life.’’ 


This was followed by other papers of Franklin on the formation 
of the earth, the‘theory of light and heat and of magnetism, and 
on the manufacture of paper. Franklin thought the interior of the 
earth is a heavy fluid, and he imagined magnetism to be a general 


XXXVI PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


property of the universe, so that one might govern his course from 
star to star by the compass. The succeeding volymes contain sey- 
eral ingenious memoirs by Joseph Priestley, in some of which he 
expounds the theory of phlogiston, which appears to have been 
purely a hypothetical substance for explaining the theory of com- 
bustion. The volume of these memoirs published in 1825 contains 
a letter from Albert Gallatin, Secretary of the Treasury, under 
date of Marcn 25, 1807, and addressed to Mr. F. R. Hassler, of 
Philadelphia, relating to the survey of our coast. There is a long 
and interesting reply by Hassler, who gives.a full account of the 
methods of such a survey, with descriptions of instruments, forms 
for keeping the observations, making maps, and carrying on the 
work generally. Still later these volumes contain the memoirs of 
Joseph Henry on his important researches in electricity and mag- 
netism. ‘These papers were read in January, 1835, and published 
in 1837. The American Philosophical Society has published twenty- 
one volumes of memoirs, which contain papers of enduring interest. 
One feels regret that a society that began so well and which has 
published so much of value should stop the publication of its 
memoirs and seem to flag in its scientific work. Let us hope that 
this may be only a temporary condition. 

The next establishment of a scientific society in our country is 
that of the American Academy of Arts and Sciences in Boston. 
This society was chartered in 1780, James Bowdoin being the first 
president. The Boston society does not appear to have started 
under such favorable auspices as its sister society in Philadelphia, 
but on the other hand it has kept up its scientific work better, and 
is still active and efficient. Perhaps this may be owing to its prox- 
imity to a large and flourishing college, which has now developed 
into a university. The American Academy of Arts and Sciences 
has published fifteen volumes of memoirs. Among its distinguished 
members I cannot omit to mention Nathaniel Bowditch, the self- 
taught mathematician, who was probably the first man in our coun- 
try to really grasp the methods of the Mecanique Celeste. It is one 
of the surprises of our prolific country that it produces so many 
men who, it is said, read the Mecanique Celeste before they graduate 
from college, and it is another surprise to meet these same men in 
after life and be convinced from their own lips that they know but 
little about that great work. But Nathaniel Bowditch mastered it. 

These two societies, that of Philadelphia and that of Boston, are 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XXXVII 


the most widely known and they are among the best of our local 
societies. Many others have been established or revived recently, 
and some of them are doing good work. Among those which have 
taken a high standing by the publication of valuable memoirs is 
the Connecticut Academy of Arts and Sciences. Such societies 
deserve a hearty support, and by their encouragement and direction 
of local talent can render valuable service to science. But these 
societies are too numerous to mention here. 

I cannot, however, pass from the two elder societies without notic- 
ing in the first place the gradual cessation of their memoirs and the 
falling into what are styled “proceedings” for publication. It 
seems to me a matter of regret that this should happen. Such pub- 
lications are apt to degenerate into a dry account of meetings, and 
elections, and deaths and resignations, and lists of members. If this is 
all a society is able to do it may be tolerated for awhile, but it is a 
condition which should be outgrown. I think that keeping up a 
good form for printing memoirs tends to elevate the character of a 
society and to incite members to good works. 

There is another matter in connection with these two elder socie- 
ties which is curious and worthy of mention. Each of them had a 
list of foreign honorary members. It is interesting now after the 
lapse of a century to examine these lists, and to see what kind of 
men were selected for such honors, and also to see how far the 
judgment of the philosophers has been confirmed by time, which 
makes such havoc with the estimates of men. At the time of the 
organization of the American Philosophical Society, Euler was the 
jeading mathematician of Europe. He was then sixty-two years 
old and at the height ofhis reputation. There is hardly a branch 
of mathematics which Euler had not enriched by his ingenious and 
wonderfully prolificlabors. He had worked in the theory of numbers, 
in all parts of the calculus, and had laid the foundations of the cal- 
culus of variations. He wrote a complete treatise on dioptrics, made 
a laborious and valuable investigation of the lunar theory, and ap- 
plied mathematical theories to a very great number of physical 
questions. In 1766 he became blind by his incessant labors, but still 
continued his work. Ido not find the name of Leonard Euler in 
the list of the fifty-five foreign associates of the American Philosoph- 
ical Society. The successor of Euler as the leading mathematician 
of the world was Lagrange. The Mecanique Analytique was not 
published until 1788, but Lagrange had shown his power in a great 


XXXVIII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


number of memoirs on mathematical and astronomical questions. 
The Mecanique Analytique put him at the head ef all living inves- 
tigators in the theory of rational mechanics; and this book 
remains to-day a model worthy the study of every student. In fact 
at the present time, when so many doctors and professors seize the 
great analytical machine and turn out pages of elegant and trifling 
formule, there can be no better experience than to go back to the 
luminous pages of Lagrange. Here is a master whose symbols are 
always in subjection, and who has no need to startle us by mysterious 
phrases. His inventions and improvements are among the most 
valuable in the history of pure and applied mathematics. But the 
name of Lagrange is not on the list of honorary members of the 
American Philosophical Society. Laplace was a younger man than 
Lagrange, but he was fortunate in securing a good position in Paris 
in early life, and he immediately began that wonderful career of 
scientific labors that culminated in the Mecanique Celeste. The first 
volume of this work was published in the year seven, or in 1799. 
It is the methodical arrrangement and condensation of the labors 
of his great predecessors and colleagues of that century, together 
with his own remarkable investigations—a work that placed him at 
the head of the philosophers of his day. But his fame was not of 
the kind to put him on the honorary list of the American Philo- 
sophical Society. It may be worth while to look for one name more, 
that of Legendre, the ingenious and persevering mathematician who 
lived such a quiet and unpretentious life that we are not surprised 
to find his name omitted. I think this example is worthy of notice, 
since it shows that the scales of philosophers donot weigh men much 
more accurately than those of other people. But it would bea 
mistake to suppose that this society differed in this respect very 
much from others of its own time. The matter may be instructive 
in warning us against careless estimates of our cotemporaries, and 
by giving us caution in judging scientific men from their social 
position and rank. It may also throw light on the election to posi- 
tions in our scientific societies of men whose chief recommendation is 
a noisy and uncertain reputation. However these things may be 
one thing is certain: the lords, counts, and gentlemen of the hono- 
rary lists are dead, buried, and forgotten; but the names of the four 
men who could not command this distinction live in. the memories 
of all men of science. 

Omitting for the present any reference to the many scientific socie- 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XXXIX 


ties that have been organized recently I come to our national socie- 
ties. The earliest of these is the American Association for the 
Advancement of Science. The first meeting of this association 
was held in Philadelphia in 1848, and was called to order by Pro- 
fessor William B. Rogers, of Virginia, who had taken a prominent 
part in its formation. Only one volume of memoirs has been pub- 
lished by the American Association, but its annual volume of pro- 
ceedings has been issued with regularity. This association has em- 
braced among its members nearly all the prominent scientific men of 
the country, and it is our most complete national scientific organiza- 
tion. Theplan of its formation seems to have been a good one, and I 
think it has exerted an excellent influence by bringing into acquain- 
tance and sympathy men from different parts of the country. Ia 
recent years its character has become more popular, and under the lead 
of its energetic secretary its membership has reached nearly two thou- 
sand. During its early days this society took an active part in dis- 
cussing the scientific operations carried on by the General Govern- 
ment, and its influence in this direction seems to have been wise. 
With the increase in the number of members such discussions have 
been judiciously avoided, and even the passing of resolutions, so 
common in all American bodies, might perhaps better be omitted. 
In such large bodies there is apt to be so much confusion and dis- 
pute that the resolutions are made extremely vague and meaning- 
less or are manipulated to suit the purpose of afew. There is 
another danger to this society arising from its easy conditions to 
membership and its rapid increase of members. Our country pro- 
duces a large number of men and women who are born with a mis- 
sion. Educated in the schools and colleges, but never attaining 
much distinction as scholars, these people begin in their own phrase 
to think for themselves. The result of this thinking is often some 
discovery in science, and one that contravenes doctrines estab- 
lished by long observation and study. The questions considered 
are generally vast and mysterious, such as the origin of gravitation, 
the nebular hypothesis, and the nature of force. Having made his 
discovery the author wishes of course to present it to the world, and 
what method is more convenient than through a scientific society, 
admission to which is so easy. And if we admit a person to mem- 
bership and take his money how can we refuse to listen to his 
theories. Who that has had the honor of presiding over one of 
the sections of the American Association, in casting his eye over 


XL PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


the audience, has not had brought to mind the description of Dean 
Swift : : 

“The first man I saw was of meagre aspect, with sooty hands and 
face; his hair and beard long, ragged, and singed in several places. 


He had been eight years upon a project for extracting sunbeams 
out of cucumbers, which were to be put into phials hermetically 
sealed, and let out to warm the air in raw and inclement summers, 
He told me he did not doubt in eight years more he should be able 
to supply the governor’s gardens with sunshine at a reasonable rate; 
but he complained that his stock was low, and he entreated me to 
give him something as an encouragement to ingenuity, especially as 
this had been a dear season for cucumbers.” 

Now although this matter has a comical phase, it has also its 
serious and difficult side. No man of science wishes to suppress the 
opinions of others, and ingenious speculations are worthy of atten- 
tion, but he has a right to his own time, and should be freed from 
the trouble of listening to absurd projects. How this can be done 
with such an easy course of admission to membership I do not see. 
There is another hindrance to the successful operation of the Ameri- 
can Association which comes from the great extent of our country 
and the cost and difficulty of attending its meetings. To those who 
have ample time and means at their disposal this hindrance is not, 
perhaps, very great. This vigorous and generous society may need 
a little pruning, but on the whole its influence has been good, and 
every one must wish it a long and honorable life. 

We have another scientific organization of national character in 
the National Academy of Sciences, established in 1863. This is a 
body on a basis quite different from that of the American Associa- 
tion for the Advancement of Science. The National Academy was 
brought into existence during a great civil war, and its members 
were of necessity chosen from one section of the country. It was 
incorporated by act of Congress, and this act limited the number of 
its members to fifty. From the language of the act we may fairly 
infer that the academy was intended to be the adviser of the Gen- 
eral Government in matters of science. During a time of great 
civil commotion, when the powers of the Government were greatly 
extended, such a society would very naturally come into existence; 
but when the strife had subsided it became an object of criticism. 

In filling vacancies in its membership it was difficult always to 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLI 


/ 
select the best man, and sometimes abler men were left out of the 
academy than those who had the right kind of influence to be 
appointed. Scientific men are like other people, and they elect 
their friends and those whom they think will help them. Within 
a few years after the close-of the civil war the limitation of the num- 
ber of members was removed by act of Congress. The National 
Academy has now the power to determine the number of its members, 
and for the present this has been practically fixed at one hundred. 
Whether this number should be increased, and whether its member- 
ship should be more evenly distributed throughout the country are 
questions over which the academy has entire control. Its destiny, 
therefore, is in its own hands, and it is to be hoped, and it is to be ex- 
pected, that its career will be useful and honorable. To act such a 
part as this the academy must maintain a high and independent char- 
acter. Itshould choose for its members the best and ablest scientific 
men of the country, and it must never become the tool of the shrewd 
men who deal out the rich patronage of the Government. That there 
is need for such an independent body to criticise and assist in the 
direction of the scientific work done by public authority seems be- 
yond question. It is assumed, of course, that the General Govern- 
ment is to carry on scientific works of various kinds, a position 
which may be disputed by some, but which appears to be already 
practically conceded. How far the Government should enter on 
such works, and how much should be left to private enterprise, is a 
question of public policy.. But there are certain works which belong 
almost of necessity to the General Government. Thus the survey of 
our coast and harbors, a general geological survey, and a-good map 
of the country seem to belong to the work of the Government. 
These may be justified on the ground of their utility to the pub- 
lic. But there are other scientific works, not so directly con. 
nected with commercial and moneyed interests, that an enlightened 
government may properly undertake. Why should not there be in 
this country a first-class national astronomical observatory, where 
observations may be continued from one age to another with the 
best instruments of the times? Again, do not the elevated plains of 
the West offer an excellent opportunity for the determination of an 
arc of the meridian which may be extended from British America 
to the City of Mexico, and why cannot our General Government 
undertake such a determination? Must everything that is not 
strictly utilitarian be prohibited in the public works of our Repub- 


XLII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


lic? JI do not think so. On the other hand the things that are 
purely commercial may generally be left to themselves. 

But if the Government is to doscientific work it should have the 
aid of men of science. We all know the tendency of public offi- 
cials to fall into habits of routine, and to spin out their work to an 
almost interminable length. There should be, therefore, a body of 
men who can criticise kindly, but boldly and justly, the labors of 
officials, and make them perform their duties as they ought. This, 
I think, should be one of the functions of the National Academy 
of Sciences. But to make this advice influential the Government 
must recognize the scientific men of the country, and give them 
some regular channel of communication through which their opin- 
ions can be made known to the public and to the executive author- 
ities. Thus far in the history of our Government the scientific man 
has generally been regarded as an expert who is to be carefully 
watched, lest he get the better of the officials who are set over him, 
and who sometimes undertake to manage affairs of which they have 
but little knowledge. The jealousy thus engendered is unfortunate. 
The man of science should be treated just as other men are treated, 
and there should be no grumbling at paying him a fair recompense 
for his labor. Our national military and naval academies are costly 
institutions, and fortunate is the young man who has a Congressman 
for an uncle or a cousin; but I have never heard a word from any 
scientific man against the cost of these establishments. So far as I 
know, their universal sentiment is, let us have the best of instruc- 
tion in military and naval science, for this is the cheapest. Our 
public buildings cost vast sums of money, but there is no objec- 
tion to such expenditures if the buildings are well and solidly 
constructed, since here, also, the best is the cheapest. On the 
other hand, is there not something very absurd in the manner 
the politician looks on the small expenditures for science, and 
the lavish ones that are voted for other purposes? Let us take a 
single case. A public vessel is “repaired,” to use an adopted 
euphemism, at one of our navy yards, and the cost of the repairs 
amounts to a million of dollars, or more than double the original 
cost of the ship. There is some astonishment at this, but we are 
told in a confident manner that the ship is greatly improved in 
strength and speed. The trial comes off, and while the ship is going 
along at her utmost speed, with the velocity of nine miles an hour, 
the engine breaks down. Here is a serious collapse, since before 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLIII 


she was repaired the vessel could make eleven miles an hour. The 
head of the Department very properly orders an examination. 
Now, it might occur to superficial persons that those who repaired 
that ship had made mistakes. But the examining board weighs the 
evidence carefully, and it deliberately comes to the conclusion that 
the fault lies wholly with some unknown person who is more than 
three thousand miles away. The matter is mysterious, but the 
result is certain. The Government has been cheated, the money is 
gone, and the local politicians are happy. And the curious thing 
is that the public accepts the report of the examining board as en- 
tirely satisfactory. There is not a whisper of dissent from any news- 
paper in the land. And, after all, it is only half a million dollars, 
and do we not throw away ten times as much every year on rivers 
and harbors? Have we not seen a Senator boasting in his 
speeches that during the last twenty years more of the public money 
has been expended on the mountain streams of his own State than 
that State has paid taxes into the public treasury. 

Now change the case and let us suppose that some scientific man 
by bad management of his own or by failure of an assistant, has 
wasted ten thousand dollars of the public money. Ah, this is quite 
a different matter, and must be looked at from a different stand- 
point. How soon do we hear some smug official complacently re- 
mark that he always knew that scientific men cannot do business. 
And how eagerly the newspapers seize upon the case; how indig- 
nant the editors become, and how the head lines flctre. Is thee 
one law for the public functionary and another for the man of 
science ? 

But it is not right to leave this matter without further considera- 
tion. When we look at the advantageous position occupied by the 
officer of the army or navy we see immediately that this dod¢s not 
come from any personal merit he may have, but from the fact that 
he is recognized by law as an essential part of the Government. 
This position renders him in theory impersonal, and it is assumed 
that he has no private business of his own, but all his interests are 
one with those of the public. He has his member of the Cabinet 
to represent his views. His appropriations never fail, and he has 
no need to summon men from distant parts of the country to push 
his bills through Congress. Now, so long as the scientific man is. 
looked upon merely as an expert and an adventurer, and has no 
regular channel of communication with the Government he will 


XLIV PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


stand ata great disadvantage He may gain’a victory now and 
then, just as militia may sometimes beat regular troops, but the 
final result is pretty sure to be defeat. The position of the man of 
science must, therefore, be recognized by law if he is to be con- 
nected with public works in such a way that he may act freely and 
usefully. Such considerations will bring up the question of how far 
the Government is to proceed in the cultivation of science. 

If we examine the history of a country like England, where we 
have good records for a thousand years, we shall see that there has 
been a steady tendency toward three results. The first of these is 
personal liberty. The slave that was bought and sold has been 
changed to the serf, and the serf to the laborer. These changes 
have gone on with conflicts, and sometimes with retrograde move- 
ments, but on the whole they have proceeded until now, in nearly . 
all civilized countries, personal liberty is secured by law. The sec- 
ond result is the freedom of opinion. To control such an intangible 
thing as the opinions of men is a difficult matter, but it is a business 
which many men delight in, and the contest, though old, is yet a 
living one. When Sir Richard Saltonstall reproached his friends 
in Boston for persecuting Baptists and Quakers, on the ground that 
such persecutions made men hypocrites, the Puritan ministers at 
once replied that hypocrites are much better than profane persons 
like Baptists and Quakers.. But such people have been forced back 
from one position to another, explaining, apologizing, and retreat- 
ing, until now in several countries opinion is nearly free. There 
remain a few able men who pray for more superstition and bigotry, 
but they are the relics of a past time. The third result is the right of 
free exchange, and toward this end we have gained but little, since 
nearly all governments exercise their power in prohibiting among 
men'the free exchange of their products. The general course of 
events is thus to restrict the sphere of government, and to leave to” 
the individual more and more freedom of action. The chief duty 
of government is to see that justice is done between man and man, 
and to this end that the courts are fair and intelligent, and that our 
judges are not owned by rich men and corporations; that the public 
service is honest and efficient, and is not used for personal or polit- 
ical aggrandizement. But, granting all this, it seems to me that 
the Government may properly undertake such great scientific works 
as I have mentioned, with the condition that they be placed under 
proper control and inspection. To the successful accomplishment 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLV 


of these works the man of science must be brought into the public 
service. He must be held responsible, just as other officials are, in 
his account of public money. Such a condition would subject him 
to some limitations that might be irksome at first, since it is pleas- 
ant for many to have at their disposal large sums of money which 
they may use at their pleasure, and almost every one fancies that 
he could do a great deal of good in this way. But such a method 
of handling public money is dangerous, and is apt to lead into 
trouble. 

Supposing that our public scientific works are to be carried on 
by men of science, what part the National Academy of Sciences 
shall act I cannot say, and it is not my province to urge on the 
Government the services of this academy, but here is a body of 
scientific men who have pledged themselves to the public service 
and they should be made to do their duty. And is there not ample 
room for intelligent criticism and suggestion in all the methods 
through which the public money is expended? Take the case of 
public schools, which is a kind of communism jusfified on the 
ground of utility to the State. What shall be the course of educa- 
tion in these schools? There is an unfortunate class of our fellow 
creatures that must be cared for at the public expense, but shall 
benevolent institutions encourage the production of such beings? 
Have we.not read of the English poorhouse where were found the 
grandfather, the father, and the son, all hearty men,—paupers breed- 
ing paupers? Do not some of our charitable institutions give 
plausibility to the saying that the mistakes of the good do more 
harm than the vices of the wicked? In fact, turn to any of the 
modes of public expenditure and examples will be found where 
sober, scientific judgrhent is necessary for the wise conduct of busi- 
ness. 

I come now to consider our own home society, the Philosophical 
Society of Washington. And, speaking cautiously and soberly, is 
it not to-day the best local scientific society in the country? This 
is owing partly and perhaps chiefly to our position at the Capital of 
a great people. Men from all sections come back to us as winter 
approaches, and many of them have interesting information to give. 
No other city of our country offers such advantages for fresh and 
early information of the investigations that are going on in the 
various departments of science. Our libraries in astronomy, math- 
ematics, ue medical science are among the best. As a general 


XLVI PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


library that of Congress must surpass all others in the country. 
These are advantages which make Washington an agreeable resi- 
dence for men of science and literature. 

I think also our society has a good plan of organization, thanks 
to the men who formed it. The general business can be safely con- 
fided to a committee, and in this way the meetings are made more 
interesting. This committee is so large that by a generous rotation 
in office most of the members may see and share, if they wish; the 
governing of the society. We have simple rules and they should 
always be enforced, since no society can afford to be overawed by 
any man, especially a society where we all meet as equals and where 
no favors are to be asked or granted. Our society has been estab- 
lished on a broad basis, to include all brances of learning, and as 
we have members from all the professions our meetings ought not 
to lack in variety of subjects. In such meetings the purpose of a 
paper should be to present the principal points clearly, and the 
author may generally trust to the intelligence of his audience to fill 
in the details. It is the failure to recognize this rule and the lack 
of arrangement that make some papers so long and tedious. 

Our society has its home in a beautiful city, and who’ that has 
seen its wonderful growth during recent years can doubt its future 
splendor and greatness? It is a city cosmopolitan in its character, 
Being the seat of political power, here will come the enterprising 
and adventurous from all parts of the country, with additions from 
other lands. Some of the brightest names in our scientific annals 
are those of foreigners who have made their homes with us. Letus 
welcome all earnest men, remembering that the principles of science 
are universal, and are not confined to any language or country. 

In respect of personal conduct we can have no better example 
than the noble man who was our first President, whose simple and 
devoted life was a model for every scientific man. If we need other 
inducements to devote ourselves to labors that may not give a great 
return of money, or lead to easy and luxurious lives, let us remem- 
ber that we live in a magnificent country, and one that has been 
dedicated as we hope to the liberty and welfare of the human race. 
Each one of us may do a little in adding to her scientific renown, 
which is now only beginning. Let us recall the words of the great 
Athenian: “I would have you day by day fix your.eyes upon the 
greatness of Athens, until you become filled with the love of her; 
and when you are impressed by the spectacle of her glory, reflect 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLVIE 


that this empire has been acquired by men who knew their duty 
and had the courage to do it, who in the hour of conflict had the 
fear of dishonor always present to them, and who, if ever they failed 
in an enterprise, would not allow their virtues to be lost to their 
country, but freely gave their lives to her as the fairest offering 
which they could present at her feast. The sacrifice which they 
collectively made was individually repaid to them; for they received 
again each one for himself a praise which grows not old, and the 
noblest of all sepulchres—I speak not of that in which their remains 
are laid, but of that in which their glory survives, and is proclaimed 
always and on every fitting occasion both in word and deed. For 
the whole earth is the sepulchre of famous men; not only are they 
commemorated by columns and inscriptions in their own country, 
but in foreign lands there dwells also an unwritten memorial of 
them, graven not on stone but in the hearts of men.” 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON, 


GENERAL MEETING. 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


GENERAL MEETING. 


261st MEETING. | JANUARY 3, 1885. 
President Hatt in the Chair. 


The Chair announced the election to membership of Messrs. 
WiiuiAm Munpy PornpextTer and Asapu HALtt, Jr. 


The Auditing Committee, appointed at the annual meeting, sub- 
mitted the following report : 


Wasuineton, D. C., December 27, 1884. 


Mr. President and Gentlemen of the 
Philosophical Society of Washington : 


We, your committee, appointed at the annual meeting, December 
20, 1884, to audit the report of the Treasurer for the year 1884, 
have the honor to submit the following report: 


We have examined the statement of receipts of dues from mem- 
bers, and of interest on bonds, and find the former to be $745, and 
the latter $95, as appears in the Treasurer’s statements of aceounts 
for the year 1884. 

In addition to the foregoing, $15 were repaid to the Treasurer by 
a member for extra printing, thus making the total receipts $855. 

We have examined the vouchers for disbursements for the same 
period, and find them correct. 

We have compared the return checks with the vouchers and with 
the entries in the bank book, and find them correct. 

We have examined the bank book, and found the balance as set 
forth to be correct, said balance, deducting the amount of two checks 
not yet returned, being $183.04, with Messrs. Riggs & Co. 


© 
vo 


4 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The bonds referred to in the statement of assets were exhibited 
to us by the Treasurer, and consist of one $1,000 U.S. bond @ 44 
per cent., one $1,000 U.S. bond @ 4 per cent., and one $500 U.S. 
bond also @ 4 per cent. 

All of which is respectfully submitted. 

H. C. Yarrow, 
Marcus BAKER, 
Witiram C. WINLOCK, 
; Committee. 


On motion, the report was accepted and the committee discharged. 


Mr. J. S. Brnurinas made a communication on 
THE VITAL STATISTICS OF THE TENTH U. 8. CENSUS, 


presenting a brief outline of results soon to be published in Vol. 
XI of the Census Reports. 


Remarks were made by Messrs. Evtrorr, MALLERY, and AsAPH 
HALL. 


262p MEETING. JANUARY 17, 1885. 
The President in the Chair. 


The Chair communicated an invitation to the members of the 
Society to attend the annual meeting of the Biological Society and 
listen to an address by Dr. C. A. WHITE. 


By request, Professor G. Srantey Hat, of the Johns Hopkins 
University, made a communication on 


RECENT EXPERIMENTS ON REACTION TIME, AND THE TIME SENSE, 


reviewing the methods of investigation and the results attained. 


An animated discussion followed by Messrs. Roprnson, HILGARD, 
Newcoms, Bruurnes, Eastman, PAuL, Wintock, AsapH HALL, 
and Professor GEORGE Davipson, of San Francisco. 


Mr. C. E. Durron then began a communication on 
PRACTICAL GEOLOGY versus SPECULATIVE PHYSICS, 


which was unfinished when the hour of adjournment arrived. 


GENERAL MEETING. 5 


2638p MEETING. JANUARY 381, 1885. 
The President in the Chair. 
Fifty-eight members and guests present. 


The Chair communicated an invitation to the members of the 
Society to attend the ninetieth regular meeting of the Anthropo- 
logical Society, and listen to an address by Major J. W. PowE t. 

Mr. C. E. Dutton finished the communication begun by him at 
the last meeting on 


PRACTICAL GEOLOGY Versus SPECULATIVE PHYSICS, 


and the subject was further discussed by Messrs. Doorirrte, 
Mason, CLARKE, Warp, Watcott, Paut, Taytor, M. BaKkeEr, 
and Roprnson. 


2640 MEETING. FEBRUARY, 14, 1885. 
The President in the Chair. 
Thirty-one members present. 


The Chair announced the election to membership of Messrs. CARL 
Barus, Frank Austin Goocn, and Wiii1Am HAuock. 


Messrs. F. W. Cuarke and J. 8. Ditier made a joint communi- 
cation on 
TOPAZ FROM STONEHAM, MAINE, 


describing the alteration of topaz into damourite. [The paper is 
published in the American Journal of Science, 3d series, Vol. 
XXIX, pp. 378-384.] 


Mr. Witu1Am H. DALL made a communication on 
TWO REMARKABLE FORMS OF MOLLUSKS. 


Mr. Datu described the anatomical features of the remarkable 
Chlamydoconcha Oreutti, of San Diego, California,* which is in fact 
a degraded lamellibranch, in which the shell has become internal 
and functionless, and is no longer adjusted by adductor muscles. 

He also described a remarkable feature which he had just dis- 
covered in Milneria minima, a small California bivalve, belonging 


*The main features of this notice appear in Science, No. 76, Vol. IV, p. 
50, 1884. 


6 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


to the Carditide, and living on the backs of Haliotis shells. The 
female has the base of the shell pushed up into a deme in the median 
line, the opening to which is closed by an extension of the mantle. 
In the pocket so formed the young of the species are protected by 
the mother. The only other case among the lamellibranchs of such 
a protective modification is that of Thecalia concamerata, in which 
the same end is reached in a different manner. Both belong to the 
same family. The males of Milneria are without the pocket. Both _ 
sexes adhere by a byssus. 


Mr, W. B. Tayxor read a communication on 
GEOLOGICAL AND PHYSICAL THEORIES, 


in which, controverting the claims of practical or field geology—to 
the exclusion of physical theory—in the solution of physiographic 
problems, he contended that the family ties of planetary relationship 
cannot be disowned by geology. He thought the value of “ exter- 
nal” inductions fully shown by the probable effects of varying 
eccentricity in the earth’s orbit on secular changes of climate, as 
well as by a reference to the general inter-relation between the 
meeting boundaries of astronomical, geological, physical, and chem- 
ical science. On the physical side, he maintained that the sup- 
posed demonstrations of the earth’s comparatively recent consol- 
idation, (as well as of the limit assigned to the sun’s active life,) 
were entirely inconclusive: first, from the admitted uncertainty of 
the data, and secondly, from our ignorance that unknown factors 
might not enter into the problem. He therefore heartily agreed 
with Captain Dutton in recognizing the strong demands of geological 
induction for an incomparably longer chronology than terrestrial 
physics could as yet cipher out.* At the same time, the speaker 
contended that the certainty remained entirely unimpaired of an 
origin and a limit to solar—as well as to planetary—energy ; unless 
we were prepared to accept the absurdity of an infinite potential. 
He also pointed out that the doctrine of “uniformitarianism” does 
not require (as sometimes too readily supposed) an unvyarying 
degree of energy in geological dynamics throughout the distant past; 
but that the contrary was the more probable—if only from the broad 
generalization that all action whatever has its period or periods of 
maximum and minimum. » 


* Mr. Taylor’s paper was a reply to one by Mr. Dutton, of which the 
Society obtained no abstract. See pp. 4 and 5. 


GENERAL MEETING. 7 


On the question whether geology itself gave us “traces of a begin- 
ning, or prospects of an end,” Mr. T. argued that stratigraphical 
geology unmistakably indicated its own genesis in the plutonic char- 
acter of its primeval “Archean,? or Laurentian—pointing to a 
time when the primitive surface was a molten ocean; and that 
when read in the light of palzontology such indication of a begin- 
ning was strengthened into convincing proof. by the receding grada- 
tions of animal and vegetable life, starting in the lower Silurian 
and its underlying Cambrian, with the humblest invertebrate forms 
of molluscan and crustacean life, and the simplest cryptogamous 
thallogens—the marine algze and fucaceze. And in this connection 
he referred to the memorable generalization of Louis Agassiz—that 
the geological successions of animal types correspond remarkably 
with the phases of embryonic development—as one of the most sug- 
gestive contributions ever made to the theory of evolution. 

The speaker then turned to the question of the earth’s interior 
fluidity; and after stating that the celebrated mathematical argu- 
ments of Hopkins from the “precession” value, and of Thomson 
from the hydrographic tides, had both been practically abandoned 
by the latter—though he still persisted in his pre-possessions for a 
solid globe (mainly on the specific-gravity skepticism), Mr. T. said 
he felt no difficulty whatever in accepting the geological evidences of 
a fluid earth enveloped by a flexile, friable egg-shell. With regard 
to the large amount of contraction and corrugation every where 
exhibited by this shell, he admitted that Mr. O. Fisher had conclu- 
sively disproved the sufficiency of Elie de Beaumont’s plausible 
hypothesis that the contraction is due to the secular cooling of the. 
planet. Mr. Fisher had however no better speculation to offer; 
and the answer to the riddle must come ultimately—not from petrol- 
ogy; nor from structural, or stratigraphical, or physiographical 
geology—but from cosmological physics. In conclusion, the speaker 
urged that the same inductions which so clearly establish the birth, 
the childhood, and the manhood of our planet, as inevitably impli- 
cate its decline, decadence, and decease; and he quoted passages 
from Byron’s familiar lines on “ Darkness,” as in the main a scien- 
tific prophecy. 

Mr. Paut spoke of the importance of a recent contribution to the 
subject of the earth’s rigidity by Mr. George H. Darwin. Mr. Gix- 
BERT thought that Darwin’s deduction of high rigidity was vitiated 
by his postulate of homogeneity. 


8 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The President remarked on the great interest of the discussion 
opened by Captain Durron’s communication to a preceding meet- 
ing, and expressed his especial approval of the method in which Mr. 
Warp had approached the subject. 


265TH MEETING. FrEeBRuARY 28, 1885. 


The President in the Chair. 
Fifty members and guests present. 


The Chair announced the election to membership of Messrs. 
Tuomas Corwin MENDENHALL, ALEXANDER ZiweEtT, Howarp 
Lincotn Hopextins, BAILEY WILLIs, JosEPH Paxson IppDINGs, 
and C. F. Marvin. 


Announcement was also made of the death of the Hon. Horace 
CAPRON. 


Mr. C. ABBE made a communication on 
METHODS OF VERIFYING WEATHER PREDICTIONS, 


giving a general account of the rules under which the U. S. Signal 
Office deduces from “indications ” and subsequent observations the 
published percentages of verifications. For purposes of prediction 
and verification the area of the United States is divided into a small 
number of districts. The “indication” for each district refers to the 
subsequent 24 hours, and is compared with the three next following 
weather-maps constructed from the observations, and the degree of 
correspondence for each station in the district is marked on a scale of 
five terms—0, 25, 50, 75, and 100. The published percentages are 
means of these marks. For certain special classes of phenomena— 
such as high-winds, frosts, and cold-waves—in which the indication 
only discriminates the occurrence and non-occurrence of a specific 
event, the formula for percentage of verification is 


v 


n +o 


in which n is the whole number of times the event is predicted, v is 
the number of verifications, or of events coincident with predictions, 
and o is the number of unpredicted events. 

It has been found for a large area in Europe, an area comparable 


GENERAL MEETING. 9 


in size with one of the districts above mentioned, that, on the aver- 
age, a given type of weather—e. g., rain, threatening, fair, hot, 
cloudy, clear—can prevail simultaneously over only 85 per cent. of 
the area. If this law holds for the United States, we can hope for 
no better predictions while the existing system of districts is adhered 
to, for our percentage of verification is now approximately 85. 


Mr. Curtis described the method of verification adopted by the 
Deutsche Seewarte. It differs from that of the U. 8S. Signal 
Service in that the predictions are compared for verification with 
the observations at a single representative station in each district. 
Thus, for northwest Germany, the observations at Hamburg are 
employed. The limits for the prediction of stationary temperature 
are taken as + 1°C., on the basis of an investigation by Hann who 
found that the “change in 24 hours at Hamburg, in two-thirds of 
all cases, averages less than two degrees C.” Mr. Curtis showed 
that, for verifications to be directly comparable with respect to skill 
in prediction, the limits for “stationary” must vary in different dis- 
tricts and at different seasons of they ear. Unless such variations 
are adopted, the verifications should exhibit a uniform geographical 
difference, and an annual period, if the method employed possesses 
any scientific accuracy. As any such change of definition would be 
impracticable, it would seem desirable to base the range allowed for 
“stationary” temperature entirely on physiological considerations, 
leaving the question of comparability for subsequent discussion. 


_ In reply to a question by Mr. Paut, Mr. AxnbE said that the rules 

required that a prediction covering 24 hours should be verified by 
the maps compiled at the 8th and 16th hours, as well as by that 
compiled at the 24th. The desirablity of subdividing the geo- 
graphic sections to which the weather predictions apply was dis- 
cussed by Messrs. GILBERT, PAUL, and ABBE; and Mr. ABBE said 
that if any change was made, it would consist in the abandonment 
of specially defined districts and the substitution of individual States. 


Mr. H. A. Hazen remarked that if the prevailing weather in a 
district treated as a unit actually pertained, on an average, to but 
_ 85 per cent. of the district, then only omniscience could attain to a 
success in weather prediction measured by 85 per cent. of verifica- 
tion. 


10 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 
Mr. A. HAtui made a communication on 
VARIATIONS OF LATITUDE, 


discussing the observations tabulated by Mr. Fergola, and reaching 
the conclusion that the evidence fails to show that latitudes are 
variable. 

[The paper is published in the American Journal of Science, ig 
series, Vol. X XIX, pp. 223-27. ] 


Mr. R. S. Woopwarp said that he had recently undertaken the 
discussion of the subject with somewhat fuller data than those used 
by Mr. Haru. Postulating that the pole was changing its position 
by motion at a uniform rate on the arc of a great circle, he. com- 
puted the direction to be along the meridian 50° west of Green- 
wich, and the rate of motion about 2” per century. His inves- 
tigation was not yet completed, but he inclined to the opinion that 
actual change was indicated by the data used. 

Other remarks were made by Messrs. FARQUHAR, BAKER, and 
PAUL. 


966TH MEETING. Marcu 14, 1885. 
The President in the Chair. 
Fifty-four members and guests present. 


The Chair announced the election to membership of Messrs. 
Rosert Porter HaAtrns and GreorGE MitrcHELL WRIGHT. 


The Chair read a letter from Mr. A. C. Peaz, announcing the 
death, on the 13th of March, of Mr. Trrran Ramsay PEALE, one 
of the founders of the Society. Mr. Peale accompanied Colonel 
Long in his explorations of the Rocky Mountains as naturalist, and 
was afterwards a member of the Wilkes’ exploring expedition. 


Mr. H. ALLEN HAZEN made a communication on 


THUNDERSTORMS OF 1884. 


? 


This paper was a resumé of some of the investigations made by 
the Signal Office, looking to a detailed study of the origin, progress, . 
and development of thunderstorms. Over 13,000 special reports 
were received and studied. An attempt to connect thunderstorm 
frequency with the phases of the moon showed a rather marked 


GENERAL MEETING. 11 


increase during the time of new moon, thus corroborating the result 
previously obtained by Dr. Képpen. 

A comparison of storm frequency with the period of solar rotation 
gave a marked maximum during the rotation. It was shown that 
taking the mean temperature over the whole storm region there was 
a close relation between the occurrence of high temperature and 
storm action, the former preceding the latter by about 24 hours. 

Taking the mean of the meteorological elements on 20 days of 
many storms at many of the stations, it was found that a marked 
low-pressure area was present to the northwest of the storm region, 
there was also a high temperature, while the humidity and weather 
were normal. On 20 days of few storms the reverse was found true, 
namely, a relatively high pressure and low temperature, the humid- 
ity and weather being normal as before. These results were highly 
interesting as bearing upon the conditions favorable to thunderstorm 
action. The detailed study gives promise of large additions to our 
knowledge of these meteors. 

In the ensuing discussing, Messrs. Mussry, Ray, ANTISELL, E. 
Farquuar, Pau, GILBERT, Roprnson, and Hazen spoke of the 
topographic, geographic, and seasonal distribution of thunderstorms 
and of the relation of the precipitation to the electric phenomena. 
Mr. ANTISELL said that moisture is essential to their generation; 
they are a secondary effect of the influence of the sun, not a pri- 
mary. Mr. KE. FarquHar spoke of the concentration of electricity 
by diminution of aqueous surface, when cloud-particles coalesce and 
form raindrops. 


Mr. 8. M. Burnert exhibited and explained 


THE JAVAL AND SCHIOTZ OPHTHALMOMETER. 
Mr. A. B. Jonnson began a communication on 


THE DIFFICULTY IN DETERMINING THE DIRECTION OF SOUND. 


267TH MEETING. Marca 28, 1885. 
The President in the Chair. 
Forty-two members and guests present. 


The Chair announced the election to membership of Messrs. 
GusTAVE Louis Ravenk&, THomas MAREAN CHATARD, HERBERT 


12 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


MicHareLt WILson, WILLARD ADAMS SHUMWAY, and JEFFERSON 
FRANKLIN Moser. - 
Mr. A. B. Jonnson then completed his communication on 


THE DIFFICULTY IN DETERMINING THE DIRECTION OF SOUND, 


illustrating his remarks by a model of the topophone. The follow- 
ing is an abstract of the entire paper. 


Mr. Jounson said the hunter could not locate his game by the 
sound it made, unless the sound was frequently repeated; that the 
plainsmen could not locate each others’ site by shouts, until they 
were frequently repeated; that a child calling its mother in a house 
could not tell which room she was in, or even the floor she was on, 
until her voice was heard several times; that it was hard to tell, 
from its noise alone, whether a street-car was going to the right or 
left, in approaching it at right angles; in fact that it was not easy 
to fix by the ear alone, the location of the source of any sound. 

A dog aroused from sleep by the call of his unseen master fre- 
quently dashes in different directions before hitting the right one. 
Game startled by hearing a hunter’s tread will as readily run into, 
as out of danger. Blind people, despite the highly developed con- 
dition of their remaining senses, do not appear to be more able to 
determine the source of sound, other things being equal, than seeing 
people. It seems to be a question whether people generally do not 
use sight, touch or smell, involuntarily in locating sound. Hence, 
when they are so placed that they must depend on hearing alone, 
and err unusually in doing so, they consider such instances as ab- 
normal. 

After referring to subjective errors in audition, which frequently 
arise, Mr. Jounson spoke of the peculiar class of errors in audition 
into which mariners are apt to fall, often resulting in disaster. The 
collision between the ocean steamers Edam and Lepanto, was. 
referred to, in which the former was sunk, as the latter had erred 
an eighth of the compass circle in fixing her position by the sound of 
her fog signal, and thus ran into her. A lawsuit ensued, in which 
Judge Addison Brown, of the U. S. District Court of New York, 
decided against the plaintiff, holding “that an error of five points, 
in locating a vessel by the sound of her whistle in a fog, is not nec- 
essarily a fault, under the proved aberrations in the course of 
sound.” 


GENERAL MEETING. 13 


Mr. Jounson then read from Judge Brown’s opinion, extracts 
from papers read before the Washington Philosophical Society by 
three of its former Presidents, Henry, Taylor, and Welling, and by 
himself, all as to the difficulty of determining the direction of sound, 
and he congratulated the Society that its conclusions had been 
adopted by the courts. 

As it was evident that the unaided ear could not be relied upon 
to fix the direction from which sound came, Mr. JOHNSON said atten- 
tion should be directed to giving the ear all possible assistance. 
That something of this kind could be done was proved, he thought, 
by Professor Morton’s experimentation with the topophone. This 
instrument had been devised by Professor Mayer of the Stevens 
Institute of Technology. It consisted of an arrangement by which 
two Helmholtz resonators were connected on the deck of a steamer 
with rubber tubes running into the cabin and with bars and rods 
which could be moved from the cabin. The actuating principle of 
the device was the neutralization of the dynamic force of the full 
sound wave by the half sound wave, thus approximating silence, 
and thus indicating automatically, within ten degrees, or less than 
one point of the compass, the direction of the sound. 


Mr. Pau. remarked that the bar connecting the resonators should 
be shorter than the wave length of the sound under observation, 
since otherwise deceptive results would be obtained with the two 
resonators in similar phases of different waves. Mr. TayLor ques- 
tioned the utility of the instrument, though heartily applauding its 
ingenuity. The real difficulty in determining sound direction arises 
from the heterogeneity of the air in point of density and moisture, 
and especially from its indeterminate differences of movement, 
whereby diffractions and refractions are occasioned many times 
greater than those affecting light. The topophone, like the ear, is 
cognizant only of the final direction of the incident beam of sound, 
so to speak, and can tell us nothing of the direction of the source of 
sound. Mr. E. FarquHar remarked that the verdict of the ear in 
regard to direction is usually just; the conditions under which it 
errs are exceptional. He thought there was a rapid adjustment by 
motion of the head, from which the general direction is almost in- 
voluntarily ascertained. Mr. F. Baker said that animals, such as, 
for example, the carnivora, make fewer mistakes than man, and this 
is probably due to their muscular control of the external ear. When 
the ears are Becee up in listening, special tensions may be given 


14 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


to the concha. When man listens intently he adjusts the tensions of 
the membrana tympani. “ 

The possible influence of wind velocity on the pitch of sound was 
discussed by Messrs. PAut, Tayntor, and GILBERT, and other 
remarks were made by Messrs. Kine, Haui, Evuiorr, and H. 
Farquiar. 


Mr. WaAsuinaton Marruews began a communication on 
MYTHOLOGICAL DRY PAINTINGS OF THE NAVAJOS, 


which occupied the remainder of the evening. Its completion was 
deferred. 


268rH MEETING. AprRIL 11, 1885. 
Vice-President Briur1nes in the Chair. 
Forty-six members and guests present. 


Mr. Wasuincton Matruews concluded his paper on 
MYTHOLOGICAL DRY PAINTING OF THE NAVAJOS. 


This paper described an art in use among the medicine men of 
the Navajo Nation, by which they represent various mythological 
conceptions on the sanded floor of the medicine lodge with dry pig- 
ments of five different colors. These dry paintings are from ten to 
twelve feet in diameter, and are quite intricate, containing from five 
to thirteen mythological figures of large size. About a dozen men 
labor from eight to ten hours in making them. When completed, 
they are after some ceremonies completely obliterated, and even the 
sand on which they are drawn is carried out.of the lodge and thrown 
away. The existence of such an art is not generally known and 
the figures are not copied from any visible standard but are retained 
in the memories of the medicine men. 

The paper was illustrated with seven water-color paintings— 
reproductions of the Navajo drawings. Four were pictures of the 
esoteric portion of a Navajo ceremony called dsilyidje-qacal or “song 
in the mountains,” and represented visions or revelations of the 
Indian prophet who instituted these ceremonies. The remaining 
three pictures were from a ceremony known as kledje-qagal or “song 
of the night,’ and represented the revelations of another Navajo 


GENERAL MEETING. 15 


prophet, he who, according to their mythology, instituted the latter 
ceremonies. The symbolism of the pictures was explained, and such 
portions of the myths as directly referred to the pictures were 
related. 

The first picture showed the house of the great snakes. The 
second represented the gods of the domestic plants, with the prin- 
cipal domestic plants of the Indians, corn, bean, pumpkin, and to- 
bacco, indicated by highly conventionalized figures. The third pic- 
ture was of certain goddesses of great height, called the Bitsihi-nez 
or Long-bodies, which the prophet is said to have seen in a house 
made of dewdrops. The fourth drawing depicted the sacred arrows 
used in the dance, which the medicine men pretend to swallow. 
The lecturer explained the trick by which this imposture was car- 
ried out. The fifth picture represented the peculiar myth of the 
tsis-naole or whirling sticks. It represents two logs placed in the 
center of a lake so as to form across. Eight divine beings sat on these 
logs, which were kept constantly whirling by other gods who poked 
the logs with plumed staves. There were twelve apotheosized human 
figures in the picture. The sixth picture showed the kledje qacal as 
it took place in the abodes of the gods when the Navajo*prophet 
first saw it, and is a fair representation of the dance as it is per- 
formed among the Navajos to-day. The seventh painting repre- 
sented a portion of the dance among the gods, at a time when a spell 
had been cast upon them by the angry Coyote-god. 

The figures in the east of the pictures are painted in white, those 
in the south blue, those in the west yellow, those in the north black. 
This is the usual order of Navajo color symbolism; but sometimes 
the white is assigned to the north and the black to the east; instances 
were given where this interchange took place. 

The gods in many cases are shown standing on rafts made of sun- 
beams, such rafts being favorite vessels of the gods when they make 
their aerial journeys. The gods are depicted with round heads, the 
goddesses with quadrangular heads. In the dances, the actors wear 
masks of corresponding shapes to indicate males and females. 

Seven of the pictures were surrounded with symbols of the rain- 
bow deity, which with the Navajos, as with the Greeks, is a goddess. 

The sanded floor on which the pictures are drawn is slightly 
sprinkled with charcoal; this is to convey the idea of a surface of 
clouds, for it is said that in the houses of the gods these pictures 
were drawn on sheets of clouds. 


16 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The speaker closed by referring to the transitory nature of the 
pictures, and showing how it might easily have happened that no 
knowledge of them would ever transpire. 


Mr. Gitpert THompson described pictures on the walls of a 
shallow cave near San Antonio Spring, New Mexico, and exhibited 
copies of the same. The outlines of the pictures are etched on the 
rock, and several different colors are employed, both in the etched 
grooves and on the plane surface of the rock. Mr. MarrHEws 
explained the relations of these drawings to Navajo myths and cere- 
monies. 


In response to questions by Messrs. Bituines, M. Baxer, Pavt, 
and Mauuery, Mr. Marruews said that individual drawings are 
not repeated on the same occasion. The ceremonial dances, most 
of which take place only during the season when the snakes hiber- 
nate, are executed for the benefit of invalids, or for the gratification 
of individuals who by conventional fiction are regarded as ill. They 
are paid for, and they are very expensive luxuries, the gross bill of 
expenses sometimes amounting to the value of $300. The patient 
or his friends select the particular dance to be performed. After 
the completion of the picture, the patient enters the lodge, and is 
seated upon the east figure, while a litany is chanted. Sand from 
one of the painted figures is then applied to his body, sand from the 
arm being applied to his arm, &e. 


Mr. Pavt described a similar art of dry-painting, practiced by the 
Japanese, but for amusement only. Bold designs of great variety 
are executed skillfully and rapidly in-public places, for which the 
artist receives compensation from the by-standers. Wealthy Japan- 
ese also employ persons to dance for them, and, for that matter, to 
fish for them; but the motive appears to be pleasure, and not religion, 
or health. 


Other remarks were made by Mr. JENKINS. 
Mr. W. C. WINLOcK made a communication on 
COMETS II AND III, 1884, 


i!lustrating his subject by models exhibiting each cometary orbit in 
its proper relation to the earth’s orbit, and also by plane diagrams 
and sketches of the comets. 


GENERAL MEETING. i7 


Mr. RAvENE spoke of the perturbations of Barnard’s comet 
occasioned by the attraction of Jupiter, and thought it might have 
been brought into the solar system by that attraction. 


Other remarks were made by Mr. PAvt. 
Mr. H. M. Paut commenced a communication on 


PROBLEMS CONNECTED WITH THE PHYSICS OF THE EARTH’S CRUST. 


Its completion and discussion were deferred to a future meeting. 


269TH MEETING. APRIL 25, 1885. 
The President in the Chair. 
Fifty-three members and guests present. 


Announcement was made of the election to membership of Mr. 
CHARLES FREDERIC ADAMS. 


Mr. Frank BAKER made a communication on 
MODERN IDEAS OF BRAIN MECHANISM. 


Remarks were made by Messrs. E. Farquuar, H. FARQUHAR, 
M. Baker, and DoouirtrLe. 


Mr. L. F. Warp began a communication on 
THE FLORA OF THE LARAMIE GROUP, 


the completion of which was deferred for lack of time. 


270TH MEETING. May 9, 1885. 
The President in the Chair. 
Forty-four members and guests present. 


Announcement was made of the election to membership of Mr. 
Water Harvey WEED. 

Mr. Lester F. Warp completed the reading of his communica- 
tion on 


THE FLORA OF THE LARAMIE GROUP. 


[It will appear in the Sixth Annual Report of the U.S. Geological 
2 


18 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Survey, as a portion of the author’s “Synopsis of the Flora of the 
Laramie Group.’’] R 


Remarks followed by Messrs. GitBERT, ELLIoTT, and WHITE. 
Mr. T. C. MENDENHALL made a communication on 


THE MEASUREMENT OF TEMPERATURE AT DISTANT POINTS. 


Remarks were made by Mr. Ev.iorr. 


Mr. GusTaVE RAVENE gave an abstract of a communication pre- 
pared on 


THE ASTEROIDS. 


Remarks were made by Messrs. TayLtor, H. Farquyar, and 
ELLIort. 


271st MEETING. May 23, 1885 
The President in the Chair. 
Forty-one members and guests present. 


The Chair announced that only one more meeting would be held 
before the summer vacation. 


Mr. A. GRAHAM BELL made a communication on 
THE MECHANISM OF “CLICKS” AND “CLUCKS.” 


Remarks were made by Messrs. M. BAKER, GILBERT, and Ros- 
INSON. 


Mr. H. M. Paut completed his communication on 
THE CONDITION OF THE EARTH’S INTERIOR. 
Mr. W. B. Taytor made a communication on 
THE CRUMPLING OF THE EARTH’S CRUST, 


in which, referring to the plausible hypothesis of contraction by cool- 
ing—which had been so largely accepted, he contended that the 
amount of cooling and contraction since the formation of a consis- 
tent crust had been much less than even the opponents of that 
hypothesis had conceded; while the maximum amounts estimated 
by its adherents would still be wholly inadequate to represent the 


GENERAL MEETING. 19 


actual measure of compression indicated by the average degrees of 
plication of the stratified rocks. Supposing these to represent a 
a reduction from the original circumference of the crust of one-eley- 
enth, this would involve a former excess of volume of about one- 
third. 

The speaker then gave an historical sketch of the growing con- 
viction among physicists that from the tidal retardation of the 
earth’s rotation, the length of the day must have been much shorter 
in remote geological eras than at present—and consequently the ob- 
lateness of the terrestrial ellipsoid considerably greater. Estimating 
that a day of six hours would give an equatorial enlargement of about 
one-tenth (without taking any account of volumetric change by reduc- 
tion of temperature), he thought this morphologic change an adequate 
explanation of the.observed crumpling of the earth’s crust; and 
claimed that the cause assigned is both a true and a sufficient one. 
This larger oblateness would imply an equatorial bulge 396 miles 
greater in radius than the present ; and a corresponding depression 
of the poles 658 miles below their present levels. As in a general 
way confirmatory of this hypothesis, Guyot’s statement was quoted 
that “On the whole, the reliefs begin with the vast, low plains 
around the polar circle, and go on increasing from the shores of the 
Arctic ocean toward the tropical regions;” and that “the ocean 
basins become less deep toward the - = A pci as the lands 
become lower toward the same region.” 

[This paper is printed in full in the American Journal of Science, 
3d Series, Vol. XXX, pp. 249-266.] 


272ND MEETING. JUNE 6, 1885, 
The President in the Chair. 


Twenty-eight members present. 
Mr. J. P. Ipprnes made a communication on 


THE COLUMNAR STRUCTURE IN THE DIABASE OF ORANGE 
MOUNTAIN, N. J. 
[ Abstract. ] 
The paper describes the occurrence and structure of the “ trap” 


rock in the neighborhood of Orange, with special reference to the 
arrangement of the columns in John O’Rourke’s quarry and in the 


20 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Undercliff quarry in Llewellyn Park. The chief interest centers in 
the groups of radiating columns which form the, upper portion of 
the exposures, the lower portion being divided into vertical columns 
or blocks of larger size. That these two portions of the lava sheet 
belong to one and the same mass is shown, not only by the contin- 
uity of the rock of the upper and lower parts, but also by the mutual 
accommodation of the different sets of columns, which taper off and 
curve in one direction along lines of oblique junction ; and by the 
fact that the positions of the columns are not what they should be 
along the supposed lines of contact. 

The columnar structure in volcanic lavas is unquestionably a 
cracking produced by shrinkage upon further cooling, after the 
mass has consolidated into rock. 

Considering the origin and progress of a crack produced by the 
shrinkage of a homogeneous mass, we see that, starting with a plane 
surface over which forces producing contraction are acting uni- 
formly, the contraction produced on the surface of the mass in a 
given time will be greater than that produced at some depth within 
the mass, and that it will decrease gradually from the surface in- 
ward. As the contraction progresses, the limit of tension in the 
direction of the surface will be reached before that in the direction 
of depth, causing a rapture across the direction of the surface, and 
as the limit of tension for the layer next to the surface is reached 
it will rupture in the same direction as the surface layer did, 
and soon. The direction of the crack is at right angles to that 
of greatest contraction, or normal to the line of maximum strain. 
Moreover the condition of the mass at the moment the limit of 
tension along the surface is reached may be graphically repre- 
sented as in figure 1, the contraction being a maximum in the 


-----,---- 


Fig.1. 


top layer and diminishing successively in each layer beneath to that 
with the initial expansion. The distance of this layer from the 
surface being taken as unity, the maximum contraction at the 


GENERAL MEETING. vcd | 


moment of rupture will be equal to twice the tangent of a. In 
other words 2 tan «@ represents the limit of tension, and will be con- 
stant for any given substance. 

As the conductivity of a cooling body is not directly proportional 
to the degree of radiation from its surface, the difference between 
the contraction of successive layers of a rapidly cooling mass will be 
greater than between those of one cooling less rapidly, and what 
may be styled the angle of contraction will be greater in the former 
case than in the latter. And if we assume a certain rate of cooling 
to have caused a single rupture in a given extent of mass (repre- 
sented in fig. 1), then a greater rate of cooling, which would pro- 
duce in the same extent of mass a contraction represented by a 

n 6 
?tan a 

If the forces producing contraction are unequally distributed over 
the surface a 6, figure 2, being a maximum at ¢, the maximum 


greater angle, ?, will cause as many ruptures as the ratio 


Fig. é. 


strain at the beginning will be in the direction of the surface, and 
the cracks will start normal to it; but their progress inward will 
no longer be uniform. At the end of a given time the limit of ten- 
sion reached by a greater force, at f, will be farther from the sur- 
face than that reached by a less force, at g, and the line of maxi- 
mum strain in this portion of the mass will be 9’ f’, to which the 
crack of parting will be normal. At the end of another given time 
the direction of the crack will be again changed, and the same 
action taking place in the other parts of the mass will result in a 
system of diverging cracks. 

So far we have considered the shrinkage in one direction in one 
plane only, that is, parallel to the cooling surface in a plane at right 
angles to it. But a homogeneous mass contracts equally in all 


pa PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


directions, and the contractile force which produces cracks at 
certain distances in a given mass will exert itself equally in all 
directions over a surface uniformly subjected to the cooling forces, 
and will, at the instant of fracture, act towards centres, whose dis- 
tance apart is dependent on the rate of cooling. If the mass is per- 
fectly homogeneous the centres of contraction will be disposed over 
the surface with the greatest uniformity possible, that is, they will 
be equidistant throughout, and the resultant fractures will be in a 
system of hexagons. If from any irregularity in the composition 
or petrographic structure of the rock the contractile force acts un- 
equally in different directions, the form of the polygons will be less 
regular. 

The mutual influence of the forces producing different columns as 
they approach each other is readily understood from the foregoing. 
Take the case of two columns, S, S’, approaching one another (Fig, 
3,) and suppose the progress of the maximum strain to have reached 


a b, a’ b’, the forces producing contraction acting through a and a 
will meet and react on each other before those acting through } 
and 0’, so that the points of maximum strain at any given time will 
have advanced farther along the lines through a and a’ than through 
band b’. The lines of greatest strain will then beed and ¢’ d’, and 
the cracks normal to them will take the directions ¢ e and ¢ é, 
This will continue.-till they become parallel. 

If there were but two columns forming at equal rates they would 
curve symmetrically and continue in parallel directions‘and of con- 
stant width, but if one column progresses more rapidly than the 


GENERAL MEETING. 23 


other they will no longer curve to the same extent, and the slower 
one will curve more than the faster one. 

Now, instead of two single columns, there,are always two groups 
_ approaching one another, and these prevent the continuation of the 
columns beyond the bend, pinching them out and causing them to 
taper off as already observed in the quarry described. 

The difference in the systems of cracks of the lower and upper 
portion of this lava sheet may then be accounted for by a difference 
in the rate of cooling from the lower and upper surfaces, the more 
frequent fractures arising from the more rapid cooling, and the two 
systems proceeding from their initial planes until they blend in one 
another within the mass. 

If for any reason the cooling from one surface should take place 
irregularly and from any point proceed more rapidly than from 
others, it is evident that there would result a set of columns diverg- 
ing from this point as a focus. 

Besides the columnar fracturing, a division of the mass by trans- 
verse cracks, especially near the top of the lava sheet, is more or less 
noticeable. 

There remains to be considered the contraction exerted in all 
other directions through the mass. Since the uniform contraction 
of a homogeneous body acts equally in every direction through it, 
its effect corresponds to the equal shortening of the radii of a sphere 
of such a body. If through any resistance cracking or parting 
occurs it will take the form of concentric spherical shells. 

If for any reason the resistance to the contracting force in a par- 
ticular direction be counteracted by some other force acting in the 
same direction the parting will no longer be spherical, but ellipsoidal, 
as will be seen from Figure 4, where abc represents a section 


through the sphere along the radii of which contraction takes place. 
A uniform resistance in the direction of the radii represented by 


24 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ec, dd’, ete., will produce a parting parallel to the arc of the circle 
cd’ é,etc. If, however, the resistance in a direction parallel to ae 
be neutralized by some force, the resistance along the different radii 
will be diminished by the amount of the vertical component in each 
case, and the resulting fracture will be parallel to the ellipse ¢ 0’. 
The relative tendency to fracture also is represented by the area 
bcd’. 

Such a parting is actually present in the large columns in John 
O’Rourke’s quarry, the major axis of the ellipsoid being vertical, as 
it should he if the weight of the superincumbent mass counteracted 
any resistance to contraction in a vertical direction. 

The wavy form of the columns, large and small, suggests irregu- 
larities in the mass which disturbed the uniform advance of the lines 
of maximum strain and caused them to deviate from parallelism. 

The superficial banding of the large vertical columns by nearly 
horizontal notches or grooves, resembling layers of bricks or rude 
chiseling, appears to be simply a modification of the plane of the 
crack. 

The paper closes with a description of the microscopical charae- 
ter of the Orange rock, which from its identity with many recent 
basalt flows leads the writer to the conclusion that it should be 
classed as a coarse-grained basalt or dolerite, as Prof. E. S. Dna 
has called the similar rocks in the Connecticut valley. 

The occurrence of the rock in question as a surface flow is ren- 
dered highly probable by its glassy nature, and the disposition of 
the columns, which resembles that of many lava sheets in western 
America, as well as of those in central France. G. Poulett Scrope, 
in his work on “ Volcanos” (2d edition, London, 1872), discusses 
the question of the origin and nature of columnar structure in 
lavas and other substances, and by a somewhat different course of 
reasoning arrives at essentially the same conclusions as those reached 
in the present paper. 


Mr. W. J. McGeEsr then made a communication on 
THE TERRACES OF THE POTOMAC VALLEY. 


Remarks were made by Messrs. Warp, Toner, Ropinson and 
Bates. 


~ 


GENERAL MEETING. 25 


273D MEETING OcTOBER 10, 1885. 
The President in the Chair. 


Thirty-nine members and guests present. 


Announcement was made of the death since the last meeting of 
two members of the Society, FRANKLIN BEenyJAMIN HovucH and 
WaAsHINGTON CaRUTHERS Kerr. 


Messrs. J. S. Brnyines and WasHINGTON MArTTHEws made a 
joint communication on 


ANTHROPOMETRIC AND REACTION-TIME APPARATUS. 


They exhibited a set of the anthropometric apparatus, devised 
chiefly by Mr. Francis Galton, and recently employed in the anthro- 
pometric laboratory of the London Health Exhibition. The appara- 
tus test acuteness of hearing, strength of vision, color discrimination, 
the estimation of the aliquot parts of a line, the estimation of a right 
angle, the rapidity of arm movement in striking a blow, the strength 
of certain muscles, the weight, the height (sitting and standing), 
span of arms, and chest capacity. Their peculiar characteristic is 
their simplicity, which permits of their use by the person measured, 
with a minimum of instruction and supervision. There was also 
exhibited a device by Mr. James McKeen Cattell, for the determina- 
tion of the time occupied by various sensations, mental processes 
and muscular actions. 


There followed an informal discussion by Messrs. H. A. Hazen, 
KE. Farquyar, Haru, H. Farquaar, Harkness, Mussrey, Woop- 
WARD and MAson. 


274TH MEETING. OcToBER 24, 1885. 
The President in the Chair. 
Fifty-three members and guests present. 
Mr. H. ALLEN HAZEN made a communication on 
THE CONDENSING HYGROMETER AND SLING PSYCHROMETER. 


[Abstract. ] 


By way of introduction the results of a few experiments were 
given, tending to show the best interval that can be obtained in the 


; 


26 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


graduation of degrees upon a thermometer scale. These were made 
with a common vernier of a mercurial barometer. A mark on the 
vernier was placed at each tenth (by estimation) of intervals of .05”, 
10”, .15”, .20”, .30”, and .40”, marked on the limb, and the vernier 
read for each estimation. Over 1300 readings were made, and these 
showed little difference in the splitting to tenths for the last 5 inter- 
vals above, but .05” seemed too small for accurate work. 

Results and methods of observing the Alluard form of Regnault’s 
condensing hygrometer were given. It was shown that if the ther- 
mometer immersed in the liquid is placed quite near the plate where 
dew is to appear, there is little or no danger of the air as it passess 
into the liquid harmfully affecting the thermometer. The com- 
plaint of some that the dew is deposited in the air, having a tem- 
perature frequently 40 or 50 degrees above the liquid, and hence 
that the thermometer can hardly give a correct dew-point tempera- 
ture was shown to have little weight, since the results, with a slight 
difference between the air and dew-point, at which time the effect 
would be small, are nearly identical with those where the difference 
is large, and the effect would be large. It was shown that the great 
difficulty in nearly all psychrometric work up to the present time 
has been the disregard of a sufficient ventilation of the wet-bulb 
thermometer. The sling psychrometer, with a few precautions in 
its use, furnishes results entirely satisfactory. 

The comparisons so far made between the two instruments have 
shown a remarkable uniformity under all conditions of moisture and 
temperature, and have left little to be determined in order to make 
either apparatus one of precision. A probable effect of compression 
of ice on the wet bulb at temperatures of 0° F., and below, was 
shown to exist, though this may be due to the lack of conduction 
on the part of the ice for the residuum of heat in the bulb. The 
question of the effect of height above sea on the indications of the 
above instruments was touched upon, and it was shown that the 
effect was small and only to be detected by the most refined obser- 
vations. Also, that until we have some law for reducing humidity 
results to sea level, the propriety of introducing such effect into tables 
is questionable. 

Mr. T. C. MenpENHALL exhibited a new volt-meter devised by 
Sir William Thompson. The principal difficulty entountered by 
earlier instruments of this class has arisen from the inconstancy of 
the magnetic force of the terrestrial field. By this instrument ter- 


GENERAL MEETING. DY 


restrial magnetism is eliminated. The force produced by the current 
is opposed by a weight and is thus measured in terms of gravity. 
Mr. MENDENHALL also renewed the discussion of the preceding 
evening on reaction time, reciting the methods and results of his 
own experiments in 1871. 
Remarks on the volt-meter were made by Mr. Ev.tiort, on re- 
action time by Messrs. Pau, Mason, and MatTHews. 


Mr. Wiii1Am HarxkNness made a communication on 
FLEXURES OF TRANSIT INSTRUMENTS, 


pointing out that the flexures induced by the weight of a transit, in 
positions other than vertical, are not eliminated by reversing the 
instrument, and developing equations for the discussion of the errors 
so far as they can be determined by the aid of collimators. 


\ 


275TH MEETING. NovEMBER 7, 1885. 
The President in the Chair. 
Sixty-nine members present. 


Mr. F. W. Ciarke made a communication on 
AN ATTEMPT AT A THEORY OF ODOR, 


in which he accounted for the lack of knowledge as to the con- 
ditions of action of this sense by the difficulty of dissociating it from 
taste; and, while disclaiming any thought of attempting a physio- 
logical explanation of the sense, proposed the following as the essen- 
tial objective conditions : 


1. To be odorous, a substance must be volatile, so that it may 
come into contact with the mucous tissue of the nose, and 

2. It must be chemically unstable, so that it may undergo chemi- 
cal changes in contact with that tissue. 

Mr. Clarke gave some confirmatory instances, from the compounds 
of hydrogen with sulphur, selenium, and tellurium, and from the 
C, H,, O, group of acids (formic, acetic, etc.) 

Mr. ANTISELL called attention to the connection between a low 
boiling-point and simplicity of chemical constitution, and to the 
associated fact that organic substances containing a large number 


28 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


of equivalents of carbon are inodorous. He ascribed the smell of 
prussic acid to arriére-gout rather than true odor. * 

Mr. Brxurncs showed that from the peculiarly exposed condition 
of the olfactory nerve-terminal, it was subject to irritations that 
must be distinguished from odors properly speaking. 


Mr. CLARKE then made a communication on 
“THE FLOOD ROCK EXPLOSION, 


in which he described the arrangements for observing earth tremor 
at stations near New York city, and particularly that at Ward’s 
Island, occupied by Mr. Mendenhall and himself. The tremor was 
felt at that station a full second before any disturbance was seen 
in the surface of the water above Flood Rock. 

Mr. C. F. Marvin, in a communication on the same subject, de- 
scribed the form of seismoscope used, in which a small agitation 
closed an electric circuit, and sounded an alarm. 

Mr. Paut followed with a communication on the same subject. 

Mr. CLARKE quoted some results of observations made at Gen, 
Abbot’s stations, giving a mean velocity for the tremor from Flood 
Rock to Pearsall’s of 2.6, and to Patchogue of 2% miles per second, 
and thus indicating a retarded rate of transmission. 

Mr. Rosrnson suggested that the blasts at the new water-works 
reservoir would afford a good opportunity for measuring the velocity 
of earth tremors. 

Mr. H. Farquyar spoke of the sounds coincident with the flight 
of meteors reported by some observers, as indicating the need of 
caution in accepting observations of sound in this connection. 

Mr. Rogrnson had distinctly heard two sounds after blasts at the 
water-works; one immediately following the tremor, through the 
earth, and a later one through the air. 

Mr. CHATARD had made a similar observation in connection with 
mining blasts. 

Mr. :Durron said that his impression, from eruptions of Hawaiian 
volcanoes, had been otherwise, and that the general testimony with 
regard to earthquakes is that the sound precedes the shock. 


GENERAL MEETING. 29 


276TH MEETING. NovEMBER 21, 1885. 
The President in the Chair. 
Fifty-seven members present. 


Announcement was made of the election to membership of Mr. 
Tuomas Hampson. 

The Chair communicated to the members an invitation from the 
Chemical Society to attend its meeting on December 10th and listen 
to the address of its retiring president, Prof. F. W. CLARKE. 

Mr. G. Brown GoopeE and Mr. C. V. Ritey made communica- 


tions on 
THE SYSTEMATIC CARE OF PAMPHLETS, 


exhibiting the appliances employed by them and illustrating their 
_ methods. . 

Mr. Goope furnishes each pamphlet with a firm, durable cover, 
by which it is protected from injury, and at the same time kept 
separate for convenient use and classification. Photographs, draw- 
ings, newspaper clippings, etc., are preserved in the same manner. 
[A full description of his appliances may be found: in Science, vol. 
VI, p. 337.] 

Mr. Rinry employs inexpensive, flexible covers, occupying less 
space, and stores them in the “ institute pamphlet case.” 

Mr. B. Pickmann Many, being invited to participate in the dis- 
cussion, exhibited his method of binding pamphlets together, a method 
in which four holes are punched at standard intervals in each pam- 
’ phlet and corresponding holes, in flexible hinges to stiff covers, so 
that a convenient volume can be made up by merely inserting and 
tying two cords, and any desired rearrangement or insertions can 
be made, the holes for binding always corresponding. [See Science, 
vol. VI, p. 407, and Library Journal, vol. VIII, p. 6.] 

Mr. Bruurnes described the tin boxes used in the storage of the 
immense file of pamphlets in the library of the Army Medical 
Museum. Mr. Warp and Mr. Toner spoke in approval of the 
substantial covers adopted by Mr. Goode. Messrs. GILBERT, TONER 
and Harxness opposed the binding of several pamphlets together, 
believing that such combination interferes with their use and ready 
classification and reclassification. 

Other remarks were made by Messrs. DALL, Mussry, and Doo- 


LITTLE. 
32 


30 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Mr. J. S. Bruiines made a communication on 


GERM CULTURES, 


exhibiting specimens of cultures of chromogenetic and pathogenetic 
micro-organisms, to illustrate the improvements in methods of 
investigating these organisms which have been made of late years. 

Attention was called to the value of culture upon semi-solid media 
such as peptonized gelatin, agar agar, coagulated blood serum, etc., 
as a means of differentiating micro-organisms, and of obtaining pure 
cultures to be used for experimental purposes; and the applications 
of the method to testing the efficacy of disinfectants, to water 
examinations, &c., were pointed out. 


277TH MEETING. DrEcEMBER 5, 1885. 


By courtesy of the officers of the Columbian University, the 
meeting was held in the law lecture room of the University build- 
ing. Members of the Anthropological, Biological, and Chemical 
Societies and their friends were present by invitation. 


Vice-President BiLLines occupied the Chair. 
Present, one hundred and sixty members and guests. 


The President, Mr. AsApH HALL, read his annual address, taking 
for his subject : 


AMERICAN SCIENTIFIC SOCIETIES. 
[Printed in full on pp. XxxIII-XLVII.] 


A resolution of thanks was moved and unanimously passed. 


278TH MEETING. DECEMBER 19, 1885. 
THE FIFTEENTH ANNUAL MEETING. 
The President in the chair. 
Thirty-eight members present. 


The minutes of the 260th, 276th, and 277th meetings were read 
and approved. 


GENERAL MEETING. 31 


The Chair announced the election to membership of Mr. Jacos 
Lawson WorTMAN. 

The report of the Secretaries was read and accepted. 

The report of the Treasurer was read, received, and referred to 
an auditing committee, consisting of Messrs. J. M. Toner, O. T. 
Mason, and T. C. Mendenhall. 

On motion of Mr. Harkness, the thanks of the Society were 
tendered to the Treasurer and Secretaries for the efficient perform- 
ance of the duties of their offices. 

Officers were then elected for the year 1886. (The list is printed 
on page XV.) 

The rough minutes of the meeting were read, and the Society 
adjourned. 


\ 


ia pike os t one or ial ok xn Mie 


4 a pabhe , 


Meakin Oe bs Bani ON Gp iirairiig anh 9 i: 


f : Pero ir ee Yard 
de eased a a Here ee IR) OEY has aa 


\ i i ‘ { 
Abie diy Sobel agit?) cera es 


’ f 
Poe 


Miser: Stl 
j ! ‘ ane gui bi 
ry ‘4 A a i - AGhVT Ry Peet ith 7 
vn \ ‘i o j dat rae Th EY j , we v4 iW fe a 
cal} viel wide nah} 0e eae ee 

, an ®, Cie Ae 

. . A. foley Re ee aa ee 

: ( 3 f it 1 aye i ima? ALY Lie Wet ee ah, (fh 4} ete ; 

Ms { j y« a 

; ; ; . . ‘ ; Ba 
ea i el holy ai ae eel bY Qo SS ae 


j 
- 

\ 

\ 

i A 
‘ 
P ‘ 
2 x 
\ 
t 
4! 
Un 
‘ 
\ 
i 
‘ 
{ ‘ 
‘ 
‘ 
i 
a“ 
‘ 
‘ 
4 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


33 


STANDING RULES 


OF THE 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


1. The object of this Section is the consideration and discussion 
of papers relating to pure or applied mathematics. 


2. The special officers of the section shall be a Chairman and a 
Secretary, who shall be elected at the first meeting of the Section 
in each year, and discharge the duties usually attaching to those 

offices. 


3. To bring a paper regularly before the Section it must be sub- 
mitted to the Standing Committee on Communications for the 
stated meetings of the Society, with the statement that it is for the 
Mathematical Section. 


4. Meetings shall be called by the Standing Committee on Com- 
munications whenever the extent or importance of the papers sub- 
mitted and approved appear to justify it. 


5. All members of the Philosophical Society who wish to do so 
may take part in the meetings of this Section. 


6. To every member who shall have notified the Secretary of the 
General Committee of his desire to receive them announcements of 
the meetings of the Section shall be sent by mail. 


7. The Section shall have power to adopt such rules of procedure 


as it may find expedient. i 
) 


OFFICERS 


OF THE 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION FOR 1885. 


Chairman, G. W. H1tt. Secretary, Marcus BAKER. 


LIST OF MEMBERS WHO RECEIVE ANNOUNCEMENT OF THE 


ABBE, C. 
AvERY, R. S. 
Baker, M. 
Batss, H. H. 
Biiuines, J. 8. 


Burasss, E. 8. 
CurRisTIE, A. S. 
CoFFin, J. H. C. 


Curtis, G. E. 
DELAnD, T. L. 


Doouitrie, M. H. 


EASTMAN, J. R. 
E1mMBEck, W. 
Exuiott, E. B. 
Farquuar, H. 
Fuint, A. S. 
GILBERT, G. K. 
Gorgz, J. H. 
GREEN, B. R. 
Hatt, A. 


MEETINGS. 


Woopwarp, R. S. 


HALL, Aer 
HARKNEss, W. 
Hazen, H. A. 
Hrncarp, J. E. 
Hit, G. W. 


Hovexins, H. L. 
Kine, A. F. A. 
KuMMELL, C. H. 


Lzeravoour, E. B. 
McGez, W. J. 
NeEwcoms, §. 
PaAvL, H. M. 
Ravens, G. L. 


RitTER, W. F. M’K. 


Rogrnson, T. 
Smitzry, C. W. 
Stone, O. 
Tartor, W. B. 
Urton, W. W. 
WINLocKyW. C. 


36 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


16TH Meretine. JANUARY 7, 1885. 
The Chairman, Prof. AsApH HALL, presided. 
Nineteen members and guests present. 


Election of officers of the Section for the year 1885 was then 
held and resulted in the selection of Mr. G. W. Hrvx as Chairman 
and Mr. Marcus BAKer as Secretary. 


Mr. E. B. Exxiorr then presented a communication entitled 


EXAMPLE ILLUSTRATING THE USE OF A CERTAIN SYMBOL IN THE 
CALCULUS OF AFFECTED QUANTITY. 


The example selected was a demonstration of the Pythagorean 
Theorem by the aid of a new symbol. 


Mr. Marcus Baker presented a communication entitled 


A COLLECTION OF FORMULZ FOR THE AREA OF A PLANE 
TRIANGLE, 


which elicited some criticism of details and of notation. 
[This paper is published in full in the Annals of Mathematics, 
vol. 1, No. 6, and vol. 2, No. 1.] 


Mr. W. C. Wintock (by permission of Rear Admiral S. R. 
Franklin, Superintendent U. S. Naval Observatory) presented a 
communication on 


PHYSICAL OBSERVATIONS OF WOLF’S COMET (1884 III). 
[Abstract. ] 
The first observation of Wolf’s comet that I obtained was with 


the transit circle of the U. 8. Naval Observatory on September 24, 
37 


38 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


1884. The aperture of the instrument is 8 inches and the magni- 
fying power employed 186. . 

On October 13, using the 9-inch equatorial and a power of 182, 
“the comet seemed to bea circular nebulous mass with quite a 
well marked central condensation. The nucleus was not sharply 
defined, but blended gradually into the fainter light surrounding it.” 

Noy. 8. Transit circle. Nucleus quite well defined. Faint but 
not difficult to observe. 

Noy. 12. Transit circle. Nucleus elongated in the preceding fol- 
lowing direction and apparently composed of a number of bright 
points. Faint and difficult to observe. The nebulous envelope 
seems to extend farther on the upper or south side than on the lower 
side. Seeing, very poor. 

Nov. 13 with the 9-inch equatorial and the same power as before 
a sketch (omitted here) was made. The remarks I give sub- 
stantially as in my note-book: Watched the comet carefully for 
about an hour (seeing not very good,—a little fog hanging over the 
river). It is a very slightly oval nebulous object. The central 
part is a little condensed; the nucleus proper more so. Filar 
micrometer measures give for the extent of the outer nebula, meas- 
ured in the direction of a circle of declination, 1’ 52”, and for the 
inner disc 18”. The nucleus is perhaps extended a little in the 
preceding following direction, but I looked in vain for any indica- 
tion of the beaded appearance which I thought I saw last night 
with the transit circle. I might add that using the distance of the 
comet given in Kriiger’s ephemeris these measures would represent 
distances of 47,000 and 7,500 miles, respectively. No tail. 

Noy. 20. Transit circle. Nucleus stellar, 10th magnitude. 

On November 22 another observation was obtained with the 
9-inch equatorial, magnifying power 132 as before. Micrometer 
measures of the outer nebula and the inner dise gave 1’ 30” and 
16”, respectively, differing but little from the measures of the 13th. 
Seeing, fair. The following note was made: I divide the comet 
into three parts, the outer nebula, the inner envelope (or coma I 
presume it might be called), and the nucleus proper. It is almost 
impossible to assign a definite limit to this outer envelope, wavering 
and flickering like a mass of smoke, but the micrometer measures 
will fix it roughly. The inner envelope blends into the outer with- 
out any sharp division, though there is sufficient difference in bright- 
ness to attempt a measurement. The inner envelope condenses in 
turn into the brighter nucleus. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. . 39 


Nov. 24. Transit circle. Nucleus sharp and stellar and about 
10th magnitude. 

Dec. 2. Transit circle. Seeing poor. Extremely faint. Like a 
12.5 magnitude star, surrounded by a large but faint nebula. 

Dec. 8. 9-inch equatorial and power 132. The diameter (in de- 
clination) of the outer envelope, from a micrometer measurement, 
was 2’ 21”, the seeing being noted a little better than on Noy. 22. 
Occasionally I think I see the inner condensed disc, but am not 
sure of it; also think that at times there is an indication of a more 
or less rounded outline to the head on the south preceding side, but 
it is unstable. Cannot be sure of anything like a tail, and indeed 
any definite form other than an irregular circle is, after all, largely 
a matter of imagination. 


The communication gave rise to some comment and discussion 
on the difficulties encountered in making satisfactory observations 
of faint comets and also on the resisting medium in space. 


Mr. Taytor called the attention of the Section to 


A SLIGHT MODIFICATION OF THE NEWTONIAN FORMULA OF 
GRAVITATION 


with which he had been struck in reading Mr. Bates’ paper on “ The 
Physical Basis of Phenomena” recently read before the General 
Meeting. (See vol. vii, p. 51.) 


[Abstract. ] 


There is a widespread fallacy—particularly displayed by those 
kinematists who fancy they have an exceptional insight into the 
“mechanism of gravitation,” that this influence is simply a 
radiant emanation, necessarily observing the geometry of radial 
space relations, having as such emanation the same total energy 
on all concentric spheres whatever their radii, as in the case of 
luminous radiation for example. Of course every well instructed 
astronomer and physicist knows that this is not so. In truth “the 
inverse square” is not geometrical—not a square at all, having no 
relation whatever to surface——kut simply an algebraical second 
power, very much like the familiar “velocity squared” (mv X 1, 
or momentum multiplied by velocity), which forms the measure of 
all kinetic energy and which no one supposes to represent a square. 


40 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Our late colleague, General Alvord, in confutation of this not un- 
usual misconception, made a communication to the Society some 
two or three years ago (as those present doubtless remember) in 
which he showed that as gravitation was known to act equally on 
every particle of matter (7. e. proportionally to the mass) and as 
solid homogeneous spheres subtending any given conical angle from 
a center of reference possess volumes (or masses,—d being constant) 
directly proportional to the cubes of the conical altitudes or radii 
of distance, it follows—if gravity were a radial emanation—its 
effect must obey the law of inverse cubes of distance, contrary to the 
facts of observation. 

The fallacy here criticised springs evidently from the too common 
tendency to regard gravitation simply as a central force or as a 
single influence radial in direction, whereas it is always a duplex 
and reciprocal action; and however insignificant one of the terminal 
elements its presence and measure of distance cannot be neglected 
without completely nullifying all action. Thus m and m’ being 
two masses at any given distance apart, the action in the direction 
and through the distance m/’ m, is as real and positive as that in the 
direction and through the distance m m’. In other words, it would 
seem that the mutuality of the re-action necessarily involved with it 
the idea of reciprocity of the distance relation. Thus, adopting the 
suggestion of Mr. Bates, if we write the formula of the effect as 
(m +- d) X (m’ +d), we have this reciprocity distinctly brought 
out, and obtain at once the Newtonian formula. Thespeaker wished 
to learn from those more conversant than himself with mathemati- 
cal literature whether the suggested modification is new, and also 
whether any mathematical objection appears to its form. 


Mr. Hit remarked that one fault of the notation proposed ap- 
peared to be its want of generality, as it is evidently inapplicable to 
any other force having a higher or different exponent of the space 
function. 

Mr. Dooxtrr.e observed that, admitting the “reciprocity of the 
distance relation,” he yet failed to perceive how this function could 
appear in the formula as a product. Why should we write the dis- 
tance twice taken—as d multiplied by d rather than as d plus d? 

Further remarks were made by Messrs. Etuiorr, Bares, and 
ROBINSON. : 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 41 


17TH MEETING. FEpRuARY 10, 1885. 
The Chairman, Mr, G. W. Hirt, presided. 
Present, eleven members and one guest. 


In the absence of the Secretary the reading of the minutes of the 
last meeting was deferred, and Mr. R.S. Woopwarp designated as 
Secretary pro tem. 


Mr. KuMMELL made a communication on 


AN ARTIFICE SOMETIMES USEFUL FOR THE ADJUSTMENT OF 
CONDITIONED OBSERVATIONS. 


[Abstract.] 


The general process consists in multiplying equations of condition 
by such factors as will extinguish side-coefficients in the normal 
equations for correlates. This was shown to be possible in an infinite 
number of ways. One such way leading to linear equations for the 
multipliers was shown to require for the extinguishment of all the 
side-coefficients the solution of the normals, 7. e., the very work 
which was to be evaded. The method would, however, be advan- 
tageous for the partial extinguishment of large side-coefficients, and 
the normal equations could thus be solved with advantage by Gauss’ 
indirect method. A useful symmetrical rule was given for extin- 
guishing the side-coefficients for a pair of conditions. Illustrations 
of this rule in the adjustment of simple geometrical figures were 
given, beginning with a simple figure of two triangles and extend- 
ing to a complete pentagon. 


Mr. Hixt remarked that Jacobi had proposed a similar method 
for removing side-coefficients. Further remarks were made by Mr. 
Woopwarb. 


The next communication was by Mr. Gustave L. RAVENE on 


THE THEORY OF MERCURY. 
[Abstract. ] 


The method here used of computing the secular variation of the 
elements of an orbit is dueto Gauss. 


42 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The notation employed for the disturbed body is 


a 


t = longitude of perihelion ; 
= longitude of the ascending node; 
= inclination to the ecliptic ; 
= mean distance from the sun; 
= mean annual motion ; 
= eccentricity ; 
eccentric angle = arc sin ¢; 
= radius vector; 
= true anomaly ; 
= eccentric anomaly ; 
m = mass; and the same symbols with accents, =’, 6’, 7’, etc, rep- 
resent corresponding quantities for the disturbing body. 
From the definition of the secular perturbations, according to 
Gauss, the perturbing function may be expressed by 


22 2x 
m’ 1 — e cose E 
V= fa f fA ae de 
0 9O 


in which p is expressed by 


»%K,24 0.3 2 = 
I 


p? =a"? +r — 2dr cos (a, 7). 
We also have 
r =a’ (1— ecose)’ 
a'r cos (a’,r) = a’ cose” {cos m (a cos ¢ — ae) — a cos ¢ Sin « sin r} 
+ a’sin < {a cos g sin e cosz + sinz(a cose — ae)}. 
Putting for brevity 
a’ (1 — ecose)? = pP, 
2 {cos z (a cose — ae) — a cos gsin esin z} = 4, 
2 {sin m(a@ cos ¢ — ae) + @ Cos ¢ SiN € Cos z} pa 
we get 
ey Ai) ae ’ A 
p= (a” + p.) — a (g, cose’ + 8 sin ’). 


The differential equation for the secular variation of the peri- 
helion is 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 43 


mn’ cos ¢ 1—ecose = ’ 
— Tafa {4 aa oh ae, 


If we now put 


and also 


A =—acosz — ae cose cos7 + sin z sin ¢ 
€ cos g 
a(2—e)., : 
CA ld IRI ge ta) forse te 
cos @ 
: , ae ; 
B =—asinz — ae cose sin z — ——— coszsin ¢ 
€ cos 9 
a (2—@é d : 
$ SC) os x sin © cos ¢ + 2a sin = cost 6 


we obtain 


cig : in <” 
< =" Sae{a A, f= a 4B, Se ae } 
_we ry cose f S 


This expression contains the following integrals: 
Qn 


de’ 
= a 
R= {rep +. p,) —@ q, cose’ — a's sin aye 


c?) 


sa sin ¢’ de’ 
BAECs + p) —a@ q, cose’ — a's “sin oy}? 


cos < de’ 
dared Bes + p,) —@ q, cose’ — a's ain oy 
oO 


which must be computed for every value of © obtained by dividing 
the circumference into 7 parts. 


If we put 
a® +p. =; aq =¢ cos Q; a’ s = q sin Q, 
we get . 
{(@” + p,) —@ q, cose’ — a’ 8 sin e\-t 


= {1—q cos (e’ — a}? 
s lp 20," cos (c’ — Q) + oa.” cos 2 (c’ — Q) +--- 


44 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The quantities ay, 4, a, etc., may be computed by Hansen’s for- 
mule given in his work, Auseinandersetzung, etc., 1 Abth., § 61, 
and wes found R, S, and T are found from the Seale 

R= 2a7; S = 2a,, sin Q; T= 2a,, cos Q. 

It would be interesting to know what influence the supposed 
intra-Mercurial planet would have on the other bodies of the 
system, especially on Venus. 

The differential equation of the motion of the ascending node is 

do 365.25 k dV 
dt ~ Ya+m)sini di’ 

The quantity & is the well known Gaussian constant, expressed in 
seconds of arc, and its logarithm is log k = 3.5500065746. 

The value of p’ is expressed by 

ep? =a? -+ a? — 2ad’ cos (a’, a) 
from which we have 


d(p*) ap , a[cos (a, a’)] 
Bis ae ain the di 
But cos (a, a’) = cos cose’ + sine sin <’ cos J, 
cos I = cosi cos?’ -++ sinisin? cos (0 — 0’), 
cot P sin (0 — 0’) — cot sini = — cos (0 — ) cost. 
Differentiating we get 
d® sin’? 


di sn (0—0) (cot i’ cos it + cos (0 — #) sin t) = ¢, 
We also have 
d any noe 
a = — cos?’/sini + cos isin? cos (0 — ”) = t,. 
From these expressions we obtain 
_d(cosa, a’) 
di 
and therefore d(p”) becomes 


= (— cos ¢’ sine + sin ¢’ cose cos I)t, + sin & sin ¢ t,, 


cial = p,cose’ + q, sin &’ 
in which 
p= 2aa’ sin « t,, 


and 
=— 2aa’ (cose cos I t, + sine ¢,). 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 45 


TOMO P cote ; : : 
The expression 7; will in the actual computation be written in 


the form 
do 365.25 k m’ 0 
dt Ya(l+m)sini2= ~~” 
in which 


j CG a Tp. > Sq. 
. , ° , , , 0 Nie 
Using the values 0’ = 14°36’, a’ = 0.200, 7’ = 7°,and m’ = a p9009 


derived by me some time since for the intra-Mercurial planet, the 
perturbation of the node of Venus’ orbit is found to be 


60 = — 3.92120 
in a century. 


Mr. Hix, commenting on this paper, discussed briefly the prob- 
able mass and density of Mercury on grounds of probability and 
analogy, pointing out that its density would on such grounds appear 
to be far less than the ordinarily accepted value. 


18tH MEETING. APRIL 15, 1885. 


In the absence of the Chairman, Mr. DooiTrLe was made Chair- 
man pro tem. 


Present, ten members and one guest. 


Minutes of the sixteenth and seventeenth meetings were read and 
approved. 


Mr. Marcus Baxer then read the following paper on 
A GROUP OF CIRCLES RELATED TO FEUERBACH’S CIRCLE. 


In any plane triangle the middle points of the sides and the feet 
of the perpendiculars drawn from the vertices to the opposite sides 
are six points in the circumference of a circle. This circle also 
bisects the segments of the perpendiculars between orthocenter and 


vertices, thus making nine noteworthy points. These properties 
33 


46 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. . 


were first published in January, 1821, in Gergonnes’ Annales, vol. 
II, in a memoir by Brianchon and Poncelet on the determination 
of an equilateral hyperbola from four given conditions. 

In 1822 Prof. K. W. Feuerbach, of Nurenburg, showed that this 
circle is tangent to the inscribed and three escribed circles. This 
property is known as Feuerbach’s theorem, and the circle is known 
to the Germans as Feuerbach’s circle, In 1828 Steiner showed that 
this circle passed through twelve noteworthy points and was tangent 
to the in and escribed circles. This was done without a knowledge 
of the earlier work by Feuerbach. 

In 1842 Terquem, the editor of the Nowvelles Annales de Mathé- 
matiques, called it the nine-points circle. In some books it has been 
called the six-points circle. In an article, by myself, in the Mathe- 
matical Magazine for January, 1882, I have called it the twelve- 
points circle. 

Of the twelve points considered noteworthy six are in the sides 
of the triangle and six are not. If all the noteworthy points now 
known are to determine its designation, then twelve-points circle ap- 
pears to be a proper designation. If only those points in the sides 
of the triangle should determine the designation then six-points circle 
would appropriately name it. In either case nine-points circle would 
be an imperfect designation, and as the name Feuerbach’s circle was 
the first name it received it seems on the whole best to adhere to it. 
A somewhat analogous case is the seven-points circle known as Bro- 
card’s circle, not named for the number of noteworthy points it 
contains but for its discoverer. The name twelve-points circle may 
therefore be rejected and the name Feurbach’s circle adopted. 

The following proof of the fundamental properties of Feuerbach’s 
circle is offered as being simpler than that usually given: 


PRELIMINARY. 


1. Definition. When we determine upon a right line AB a point 
Csuch that AC = BC = 2 AB the line is said to be bisected. 
This restricts us to one point C. 


Fig oy A C B Ge 


I t ! I 


It will be found convenient in what follows to extend this 
definition so as to include the points C’ and C”, Fig. 1, where 
AC= BC= AC’ = BC” = 3 AB; 1. ¢., by considering a der 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 47 


nite line AB to be bisected when a segment equal to one-half the line is 
laid off from either extremity in either direction. 

2. Theorem. The perpendiculars of a plane 
triangle meet in H, and, being prolonged to 
intersect the circumference in A’, B’, C’, the 
segments HA’, HB’ and HC’ are bisected by 
the sides of the triangle. (See Fig. 2.) 

Proof: AB’D = AHD = angle C. 


Notrre.—Here bisection is used in its ordi- 
nary sense. 


HZ is the orthocenter, and the theorem may be otherwise stated as 
follows: The segments of the perpendiculars included between the 
orthocenter and circum-circle are bisected by the sides of the triangle. 

The point of intersection of the medians is the eidocenter,* which 
we call G, and the well-known theorem that the medians are con- 
current and mutually divided into segments of which the greater is 
twice the less may be otherwise stated thus: T'he segments of the 
medians included between the eidocenter and vertices are bisected by 
the sides of the triangle. 


Note.—Here bisection is used in its extended sense. 


Using bisection in this extended sense it is therefore possible to 
unite these propositions into a single general statement, as follows: 
perpendiculars orthocenter 

The segments of the | at between the ROA ction 


away from 


towards the vertices are bisected 


and circumcircle measured | 
by the sides of the triangle. 
Thus in Fig. 3. ye 
oH=alL=}3 HI; and EP=};} EA; 
BH = §M =} HM; EQ =1 EB; 
7H +N = § FN; ER = 3 EC. 
3. Conceive the triangle ABC (Fig. 4) and 4@ 
its cireumcircle O to be the base of an oblique 
cone withinscribed tetrahedron. Let the ver- k 
tex of this cone be so taken that when the whole is projected 


* This term from etdog, form, and xévtpoy, center, has been ‘suggested by 
Mr. Henry Farquhar as being a more accurate derivation than the term 
centroid often used. It is, moreover, analogous to orthocenter, circum- 
center, etc. 


48 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


upon the plane of the base the projection of the vertex shall fall at 
the orthocenter H. Now let the whole be orthogonally projected 
upon the plane of the base. 


~~ — 


a a 


From this conception it is seen that HA, HB, HC and HA’, 
HB', HC’ are projections of elements of the cone and HO the 
projection of the axis. Let the axis of the cone be bisected by 
planes parallel to the base. There are three such bisecting planes: 
one midway between apex and base, another below the base, and a 
third above the base. Finally let all these sections be orthogonally 
projected upon the plane of the base. 

From these conceptions it follows immediately that— 

(a.) These projections are circles whose diameters are, respect- 
ively, 2, #, 3, the diameter of the circumcircle. 

(b.) The centers of these circles F, F’, F”, all lie in the line HO, 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 49 


joining the circumcenter to the orthocenter, and are points of 
bisection, in the ordinary and extended sense, in such manner that 


i= FO = PO — FF" A FO. 


(c.) The segments of the perpendiculars HA, HB, HC, and HA’, 
HB’, HC’ are all bisected by each of these circles. In the case of 
the first circle F, the segments are bisected in the ordinary sense, 
and since the segments HA’, HB’, and HC’ are also bisected by 
the sides of the triangle this circle passes through the feet of the per- 
pendiculars. 

The points of bisection on the perpendiculars determined by the 
circle F are points of bisection in the ordinary sense. 

The points of bisection on the perpendiculars determined by the 


7 
circle | are points of bisection in the extended sense, and in 


such Wise that the segments cut off from A and A’, B and B’, Cand 


towards 


away from the vertices. 


C’ are measured from the orthocenter | 


(d.) Every line drawn from # to the circumcircle is bisected by 
the three circles F, F’, and #’”’. His therefore a direct center of 
similitude common to the circles O, F, and F” and an inverse 
center of similitude common to all four circles. 


4. The eidocenter is collinear with the circumcenter, orthocenter, 
and Feuerbach center*; for from a known theorem we have 
HB = 2 OM, and therefore HO must divide BM into segments of 
which the greater is twice the less, 7. e., it must pass through the 
eidocenter. 


5. Again conceive the triangle ABC (Fig 5) as the base of an 
oblique cone, etc, as in section 3, except that its vertex is to be con- 
ceived as perpendicularly over the eidocenter instead of over the 
orthocenter, and the whole projected as before. In this case KA, 
EB, EC,and EA’, EB’,EC’ are projections of the elements of the 
cone and EO, coincident with HO from section 4, the projection 
of the axis. 

Let the axis be bisected as before by three planes parallel to the 
base: one midway between apex and base, another below the base, 
and a third above the apex, and the sections so formed projected 
upon the plane of the base. 


* The center of Feuerbach’s circle may be so called for brevity. 


50 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


We then have— . 


(a.) These projections are circles whose diameters are, respect- 
ively, 2, $, and 4, the diameter of the circumcircle. 


(b.) The centers of the circles fF”, F’”, F all lie in EO and there- 
fore in HO joining circumcenter to orthocenter and are points of 
bisection of HO in both the ordinary and extended sense in such 
Wise that Fy Sih "Ol Sa = Bae 

(c.) The segments of the medians EA, EB, EC and EA’, EB’, 
EC’ are all bisected by each of the circles. In the case of the 
third circle F, the segments are bisected in the eatended sense, and 
since the segments of the medians, EA, EB, EC, are also bisected 
in the extended sense by the sides of the triangle the,cirele F bisects 
the sides of the triangle. 

The points of bisection on the medians determined by the circle 
F”’ are bisections in the ordinary sense. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 51 


The points of bisection on the medians determined by the circles 
wt ry 
| yf are points of bisection in the extended sense, and in such 


manner that the segments cut off from A and A’, B and B’, C and 


towards 
away from 


(d.) Every line drawn from £ to the circumcircle is bisected by 
the three circles F’”’, F’”’, F'; E is therefore a direct center of simili- 
tude common to three circles O, F”, F’” and an inverse center of 
similitude common to all four circles. 


OC’ are measured from the eidocenter i the vertices. 


6. If we now compare figures 4 and 6 and consider the three 
circles in each which resulted from projection, we find that circle F, 
and only circle F, is identical in the two figures. 

This identity appears from the fact that their diameters are equal, 
each equaling half the diameter of the circumcircle, and their cen- 
ters coincident. The coincidence of their centers appears from 
drawing the projections of the axes of the cones side by side, thus: 


O F Lik 
_——— From Fig. 4. 
|———— - —- ve From Fig. 6. 
O E F 


From Fig. 4 we find that this circle, Feuerbach’s, passes through 
6 noteworthy points, being 2 points on each perpendicular; and 
from Fig. 6 we find that the same circle passes through 6 other 
noteworthy points, being 2 on each median, or in all Feuerbach’s 
circle passes through 12 noteworthy points. 


7. It is apparent from the foregoing that if we should not bisect 
the axis of the cone but should cut it in any ratio (Fig. 4) by a 
plane parallel to the base then the projection of the section would 
bea circle cutting the perpendiculars in that ratio and its center F, 
would divide HO in that ratio. The medians would not be divided 
in that ratio, but a point in HO exists (ca!l it E,) through which, 
if lines be drawn from the vertices to the opposite sides, these lines 
would be divided in the given ratio. 

The four points O, En, /,, H would in this case, as before, be 
four harmonic points. 

8. Since Feuerbach’s circle bisects the sides of the triangle it is 
the circumcircle of a triangle similar to the original and of half its 


52 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


size. The results here deduced may therefore be considered to be 
results of a comparison of the circumcircles of these two triangles. 
A corresponding study of the relations of the tangent circles (in- 
and escribed) would therefore be expected to yield many more 
properties as there are four times as many circles to be considered. 


Concerning the phrase “bisection in the extended sense,” Mr, 
Dooxirr Lez suggested that the term “sesquisection ” might be advan- 
tageously employed. As to the name “nine-points circle,” Mr. 
KuMmMELL said that it was plainly defective, either “ six-points” 
or “twelve-points ” circle being satisfactory, according to the point 
of view taken, but that nine-points circle was not a correct desig- 
nation from any point of view. Further remarks were made by 
Mr. Exxiorv. 


Mr. C. H. KumMe tt presented a communication entitled 
DISTANCES ON ANY SPHEROID. 


[Abstract. ] 


The present form of solution of the problem to determine the 
shortest distance between two points on a spheroid which are given 
by their latitudes and longitudes is characteristic in making use of 
the Gaussian algorithm of the arithmetico-geometric mean. This 
and a corresponding transformation of the amplitudes give the 
necessary elements for computing in three terms the distance precise 
to the eighth order at lJeast. The form is also remarkable for its 
symmetry and easy extensibility to still higher precision. 

Also the preliminary part of the problem in which the excess of 
the spherical longitude over the spheroidal is determined by succes- 
sive approximations is much facilitated by the introduction of an 
angle 7, which is closely related to ¢, the angle of eccentricity, and 
which varies between 0 and «. It was thus possible to express the 
excess of spherical over spheroidal longitude in one term, precise to 
the 6th order at least. 


[This paper has been published ig full in the Astronomische 
Nachrichten, No. 2671.] ; 


In reply to a question, Mr. KuMMELL said that the®rdinary for- 
mulz for computing distances between intervisible points on the 
terrestrial spheroid are all that can be desired. The formulse here 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 53 


presented, however, are designed for much greater distances and 
for any spheroid, and would serve, if need ever arose, for comput- 
ing the shortest distance between any two points on the terrestrial 
spheroid no matter how remote. 


19TH MEETING. APRIL 29, 1885. 
The Chairman, Mr, G. W. Hitt, presided. 


Present, nineteen members and one guest. 
Minutes of the eighteenth meeting read and approved. 


Mr. A. Zriwer read a paper entitled 
ON GRASSMANN’S SYSTEM OF GEOMETRY. 


This paper will appear in full in the Annals of Mathematics, vol. 
2, Nos. 1 and 2. 


In reply to a question by Mr. Curtis as to whether Grassmann’s 
system could be advantageously substituted for the Cartesian sys- 
tem, Mr. Zrwet expressed the opinion that it could not be so sub- 
stituted in general, but that it might in certain special cases. 

Grassmann has not, said Mr. ZiwET, made applications of his 
method to astronomy, nor indeed does its value consist in its 
adaptability to the solution of special problems. But for present- 
ing general geometrical truths it appears superior to Hamilton’s 
methods, to which it is closely related and with which it might be 
advantageously joined. 

Mr. Haut remarked that he had seen planetary orbits worked 
out after Hamilton’s method by J. Willard Gibbs, but the process 
appeared rather more laborious than the usual Gaussian one. 

The labor of computation of results, Mr. Hitt remarked, was 
practically the same by all methods. By introducing the needful 
symbols the general expressions may be made exceedingly simple, 
but when the numerical work begins it will be found that after par- 
ing off more or less extraneous matter there still remains a central 
kernel or core of computation from which there is no escape by 
any method whatsoever. 

With this view Mr. R.S. Woopwarp heartily concurred, and 
added that the supreme test of the usefulness of such systems as 


54 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Grassmann’s, Hamilton’s, ete., consists in their ability to reveal new 
truths; a test which, according to Mr. Ziwet, Grassmann’s system 
successfully stands. 


Mr. M. H. DooxirtLe presented a communication on 
CAUSE AND CHANCE IN THE CONCURRENCE OF PHENOMENA. 


The author’s views set forth in this communication were stated 
to be preliminary and incomplete, and he therefore reserves them 
to be more fully elaborated before publication. 


20TH MEETING. May 18, 1885. 
The Chairman, Mr. G. W. H111, presided. 
Present, eleven members and three guests. 


Minutes of the nineteenth meeting, read, corrected, and adopted. 
Mr. G. L. RAVENE read a paper entitled 
THE ASTEROIDS. 


This communication elicited a general discussion, participated in 
by Messrs. KumMELL, Rirrer, BAKER, WoopwArD, ELLIorT, 
Pau., and HI. 


Mr. Rirrer then read a paper on 


SECULAR PERTURBATIONS OF POLYHYMNIA BY JUPITER, 
[Abstract. ] 


In the computations of these perturbations Gauss’s method has 
been employed, using the formule adapted to facilitate the appli- 
cation of this method given by Mr. G. W. Hill. 

The eccentricity of Polyhymnia being very large the circum- 
ference, with reference to the eccentric anomaly of Polyhymnia, 
has been divided into twenty-four parts. This is a greater number 
than necessary, but it seemed worth the additional labor required 
to have the forces and the other quantities involved for as large a 
number of points as practicable. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. ae 


The epoch for both systems of elements is 1873, July, 17.0, 
Berlin mean time. 

The ecliptic and mean equinox are for 1873.0. 

The resulting secular variations in one Julian year are the fol- 


lowing: 

Secular variation of the eccentricity, or de== + 1.268; 
. “ ~~ inelination, or oi=— 1.649; 
3 “ ascending node, or 62 = — 61.031; 
is “ ~~ longitude of the perihelion, or dz = + 59.116; 
> “ mean longitude, or 6D = — 83.429; 


The paper was discussed by Messrs. PAuL, H1Lu, and Woop- 
WARD. 


2ist MEETING. May 27, 1885. 


The meeting was called to order at 8:15 by the Chairman, Mr. 
G. W. Hitt. 


Seventeen members present. 


At the request of the Chair Mr. Wintock acted as secretary pro 
tem., Mr. BAKER being absent. 


Mr. R. 8. Woopwarp read a paper on 


SOME PRACTICAL FEATURES OF A FIELD TIME DETERMINATION 
WITH A MERIDIAN TRANSIT. 


[ Abstract. ] 


An important desideratum in all kinds of field work is the 
adoption of those methods which will secure the accuracy essential 
in the results sought with the minimum amount of computation. 
It is in general easier and more conducive to precision to eliminate 
unnecessary factors involved with the quantity sought than to 
determine their values and allow for them by computation. Very 
frequently also a systematic arrangement of observations will secure 
the maximum precision with the minimum of computation. 

In a field time determination for telegraphic longitude’ the essen- 
tial quantity is the error of the time-piece used at some determinate 
epoch, and the unessential factors are the azimuth and collimation 
of the transit and the rate of the time-piece. It is evident that a 


56 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


minimum of computation will be required if the observations can 
be so arranged as to eliminate the effect of these factors in the final 
value of the correction to the time-piece. Although it is usually im- 
possible to eliminate the effect of the azimuth, collimation, and rate 
completely, it is generally possible to make a close approximation 
thereto. To show this fact analytically let 


= the correction to the time-piece at the epoch ¢,; 
= the observed time of a star’s transit; 

= the star’s right ascension; 

= the azimuth of the transit; 

= the collimation of the transit; 

= the rate of the time-piece; 

the azimuth factor ; 

= the collimation factor; 

= the weight of (¢ — 4); 

= the residual error. 


Saif. 3 fen 
| 


Then the type observation-equation will be 
at+ Aat+tCce+t—t)r+ti-—-a=v». (1) 
The normal equation in At, using brackets to indicate summation 
of like quantities, is 
[p]4t+[pA]a+[pCl]e+[pG@—t)]r+ [pG—a1= 0. (2) 
~ This shows that in order to secure the complete elimination of 
the effect of a, c, and r, we must have 


[pA] = 0, [pC] = 0, [p ¢@ — t.)] = 0. (3) 


The last of these conditions can always be fulfilled by making 
fe Lee) 
bij seit re 


It may be shown that the value of A¢ corresponding to ¢, as 
defined by (4) has a maximum weight. A close approximation to 
the first two conditions of (3) can be secured by selecting for obser- 
vation stars of suitable declinations and by reversals of the tele- 


scope. 
If we put 
Load sy ee Lee 
behets) aL se? 
equation (2) gives At = — At, — Ba—jye. (5) 


This shows that in case # and y are small, as supposed above, an 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 57 


approximate value of At is — At,. After some preliminary obser- 
vations at a station it is easy to render a and ¢ small, and their ap- 
proximate values may always be found from the observation equa- 
tions by a brief inspection; so that with such values of a, c, #, and 
y as are nearly always readily attainable At may be derived from 
(5) to the nearest 0°.01. 


We may thus dispense entirely with the other three normal equa- 
tions and reach the same result which would follow from their use. 
The solution may also be checked; for by one or two approxima- 
tions the values of At, a and ¢ which make [pv] = 0 can be readily 
found. 

The practical steps in deriving 4¢ from (5) may be summarized 
as follows: 

1. The mean of the observation-equations for clamp west minus 
the mean of those for clamp east will give an approximate value of 
the collimation c. 


2. The application of this value of ¢ to each observation equation 
will give a corrected value of (¢ — a) for each star. 


3. An approximation to the value or values of the azimuth will 
then result by eliminating At from one or more pairs of the corrected 
observation equations. The azimuth may then be applied to correct 
the values of (¢ — a), reached in step 2. 


4. The approximate values of a and ¢ will now give an approxi- 
mate value of At from (5), and the application of this value of At 
to the values of (t — «), derived in step 3, will give approximate 
values of v. 


5. Form [pv]. If this sum is not zero within 0°*.01 or 0°.02, a 
brief inspection will show what changes in a and ¢ (and _ possibly 
At) will make it zero within those limits. 


By this process of determining the residuals or their approximate 
values as soon as possible in the computation any large errors in 
the values of (£ — a) or the azimuth and collimation factors will be 
easily detected. 


In precise longitude determinations it is customary to have for 
each night’s observations two complete time determinations, one 
immediately preceding and one immediately following the tele- 
graphic comparison of time-pieces. In this case there will be two 
values of A¢. Calling these At’ and At’ and denoting the corres- 


58 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ponding epochs by ¢,/ and,” the rate of the time-piece will be 
given with sufficient accuracy for interpolation by the equation 
At” — at’ 

Mr. Paut thought it an objection to this method that in arrang- 
ing the groups valuable stars might be lost, so that in a limited 
time the accuracy of the results would be impaired by the smaller 
number of observations ; moreover, the method did not furnish the 
computer with a clear idea of the performance of the instrument. 

Mr. Hatz said that he liked the method, and that he thought it 
especially good for time work. He had discovered the method once 
himself, and he knew that it had also been used by Prof. Ormond 
Stone. 

Mr. KumMeE t said that in connection with this subject he had 
investigated the question of the advisability of using stars towards 
the pole for time determinations; that is, he had examined the 
weight co-efficient formule to see at what distance north of the 
zenith a maximum value would be obtained. He found that in 
general the limit of declination was about 60°. 

Mr. Paut thought that every weight-formula should take account 
of the increase of atmospheric disturbance with increase of zenith 
distance. 


T= 


Mr. KumMe t then read the following paper entitled 
CAN THE ATTRACTION OF A FINITE MASS BE INFINITE? 


In Price’s Calculus, vol. III, art. 201, discussing the result for 
the attraction of a thin rectangular plate on a particle external to 
it and in its own plane it is found that if the attracted particle is at 
an angle of the rectangle the attraction is infinite. Price’s method 
of determining the attraction of plates consists in integrating be- 
tween the proper limits the following differentials : 


ax = Se qd ) 
(a? + y')° ‘ 
a’ Y = mor es Es 3 
(a? ue y’)” y 


where X = x — axial component of attraction; 
Y = y — axial component of attraction; 
= mass of attracted particle ; 
6 = density of attracting mass, supposed homogeneous ; 
t = thickness of the plate. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 59 


Referring to the attracted particle as origin let (a,, 6,) be the 
corner nearest and (a,, b,) that farthest from the particle; then 


Ba: “ 
a CaAXL 
vg = mdr SoS ce ob y)? 


Q, 
b, 
= mot y dy ((a, = yy? — (a? + )) 
| b+ (at +52)? b+ (a2 +5) 
= mor] 4 WEA Ee A 
b, + (a? +67)" b+ (a? + b,”)° 


and a similar expression for Y by exchanging the a’s for the b’s. 


(2) 


If in this we place a, = b, = 0 then X= moro. 

This is taken by Price to be infinite; yet, since the thickness t 
must be taken infinitesimal, this is an entirely unfounded conclu- 
sion, 

At first, however, I did not suspect this result, and when Mr. 
Woodward found an infinite attraction of a circular disk on a point 
at its circumference, which result I checked, it seemed to be possible 
that the attraction of a finite mass could be infinite. Yet neither 
Mr. Woodward nor myself was entirely convinced. To settle this 
question I then resolved to determine the attraction of a right 

‘prism and also of a right circular cylinder ona particle at mid- 
height, which, being then moved to the surface and taking the 
height infinitesimal, would give the attraction of a plate on a par- 
ticle in a position at which an infinite attraction had been found. 

For a right rectangular prism we have, 2A being its height, 


By ha h 
dr 
x= a hay: adx Serer! 
° a, ~ 


b, 
2Qhadx 
wed J. WerpetyTr Si 
° a, 


Comparing this with (2), putting 2h = t, we readily see that 
these values are by no means identical, for (2) is of the form 
tf, (a,, @,, b,, b,) while (8) is <f, (a,, a,, 6, b,,7). Here f, is independ- 
ent of z while f, is not. 


60 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Placing a, = b, = o or supposing the attracted particle at the 
edge of the prism we have - 


1 
adx 
X = 2moh ne yee E 
0 0) 


b, Vaptyt h? 


Var tyre 
z2—h 


1 
= auth faol aes 
Verh 


Vap+y, +R 


z2—h 
mo fal Ve rm = | (4) 
Vet 

This form nets clearly that X vanishes with h; therefore the 
attraction of a rectangular plate on a particle at one of its corners 
is not infinite, but, on the contrary, it is infinitesimal. 

Similarly the attraction of a circular plate on a particle at its 
circumference may be found by considering the plate a vanishing 
cylinder. Using cylindrical co-ordinates to a vertical line through 
the attracted particle as axis we have, if p = horizontal radius 
vector, v = vectorial angle, for the attraction of a cylinder, radius 
r, density 0, ona particle at midheight h and distance d from axis 
of cylinder where 


My shah lees ; 
COS V = Qpd 


; 1 “tid BA ESe, ¢ 
and sin v= 9g VIE + 


d+r v h 
Aja mo fp? dp { cos vdv FFA “ a Ht 
d—r —v _ 
d+r 
2h - 
a a7, br ies AGES Biarclil TEIN 
= mo fp de * 2smv. PV OLE 


d—r 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 61 


d+r 
Bey fee oy LCE = Tbe = d=r))] 
Ane Sp ae 
d—r 
Ve—h 
h do (a? — po — i?) (P aay Caen B) 
= 2m0 =i : Lo ee 7 
Ve—F 


where a= 7/7) +H; andb=Y@—r/ +h (5) 


Pe ey ae 
Assume tan ¢ = > \ ——— then ¢ has the limits _| and 


a — p 
a b? 
0. Wehave then p? + ? = Few ae ae where Ag 
Se 
is an elliptic A function to the modulus | jee S Transform- 
ing we have, expressing in A functions 
? 
(1 — d¢’) (a¢’ —-, 
A= amo 1 ab? ay _ 
A¢g ?— hag’ 
0 
ab? te dg = dg (#— iy. dy | 
amd a} at) apt fa a ae 
eh ; 9 Um 49) a9} 
b? | , dg Rh 
= 2md77 | fx-Bs¥ Ag 
Lo 0 
ft] } 
(d + r) dg | 
mae f 4rdh? 


0 (1 + a (d— ry sin *0) Ag | 


= amo | Fe EH (4) (S45) fe 


where fF, E, and J/ denote quadrantal elliptic integrals of the 1st, 
2d, and 3d species, according to Legendre’s notation. If our object 
was to obtain here a formula for convenient computation of the 
attraction the third term could still be expressed in integrals of the 
1st and - species, which have been tabulated by Legendre, 


62 ‘ PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Let us now move the particle to the surface of the cylinder, then 


we have d= 7; a= 7/4r* +17; b =h, and (6) becomes 
ah 
A’ = 2m0 —- (F— E). (6’) 

Mr. Woodward, as already stated, had found an infinite attrac- 
tion of a circular disc on a particle on its circumference by using 
Price’s method. Now, since A’ is surely a finite quantity, we have 
here the manifest absurdity that the attraction of a cylinder on a 
particle on its surface would be’ less than that of a circular disk 
which is only an infinitesimal part of it. 

If we wish to ascertain the attraction of a circular disk of finite 
small thickness we may, of course, use (6’), and since then F’ tends 
to infinity, E may be neglected; therefore 


- d 
A’ _ 2mé ah f = 
are Nats af — sin? 
) 7 ae h=o0 
oy 


= 4m0 
i 
h? h=o 
me 
47? af sin *9 dg 
a* Ag® 
= 4m - 
Th h=o0 
= 0 - 


Since then the attraction is 0 if A = 0 it will be small if h is 
small, and will continuously grow with h. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 63 


The notion of an infinite attraction exerted by a finite mass has 
thus been dispelled in two special cases in which it seemed to have 
been proved, and I add some remarks on its general impossibility. 

The attraction of a mass element on a particle at distance p is 


dx dy dz 
me ——— 
, i 

This is then an infinitesimal of the third order, and the summa- 
tion of its components with respect to a fixed direction requires 
three integrations, which give surely a finite result if p is always 
finite. 

If p is infinitesimal there will be one element of attraction, which, 
instead of being of the third order, is only of the first order of in- 
finitesimals, and this one element being added to the finite sum of 
the other elements has no effect. Hence I conclude that a finite 
mass exerts only a finite attraction on a particle. 


The paper was discussed by Messrs. Hati, HiLy, and Woop- 
warp. Mr. Woopwarp said that he had arrived at a result simi- 
lar to Mr. Kummell’s by a somewhat different route. The fallacy 
in Price’s Calculus arose from neglecting the thickness of the plate. 


Nore. 


The communications and abstracts printed in the proceedings of 
the Mathematical Section have each been examined by a special 
committee consisting of the Chairman, the Secretary, and a third 
member appointed by the Chairman. These third members were 
as follows: 


Title. Author. Third Member. 
Physical observations of Wolf’s comet-W. C. Winlock, — — — 
The Theory of Mercury_---____-_____G. L. Ravené. E. B. Elliott. 
A group of circles related to Feuer- 
ee SG C1TC1O a Marcus Baker. C. H..Kummell. 
Some practical features of a time de- 
FOLIATION soso ne eae —R.S. Woodward. H. Farquhar. 


Can the attraction of a finite mass be 
MOH ILE Me eee ee ko Oe Kummells,. Rt on Woodward: 


nae ie phe Poe ih 


ee 
oa uy i 


PD Exe 


Page. 
Abbe, C.: communication on methods of 
verifying weather predictions...........06 . 8,9 
Adams, C. F., Election to membership of...... 17 
Adjustment of conditioned observations...... 41 
American Academy of Arts and Sciences..xxxvi 
' American Association for the Advancement 


PSHE GIO CO sn sdeasteascansnavasssxeaccaselscssseierast Xxxix 
American Philosophical Society...xxxiv, xxxvii 
American scientific societies.........ccccee. + Xxxili 
Annual address of the President...... .........XxX Xi 
Annual meeting.....cccesseeeees eatserseatcoatiegeacesay = 30 
Anthropological Society, Invitation from...... 5 


Anthropometric and reaction-time apparatus 25 
Antisell, T.: remarks on the nature of odors 27 


— — — thunderstorMms.....ce.sccssssersecseseecesees 11 
Artifice sometimes useful for the adjustment 

of conditioned observations.............eceeee 41 
Attempt at a theory of OdOT............00cceceesceees Q7 
Attraction, Infinite, of a finite mass.............. 58 
Auditing committee, Appointment of........... 31 
BeBILE DOLL Ol ic cascucies suabsvine cydecesns csavecccasacseaes yen; 


Baker, Marcus: communication on a group 
of circles related to Feuerbach’s circle.. 45 
———a collection of formule for the area 


Misa Plane tIANS] O.)-.52ccessencsssacseveocsconeaixs 37 
— elected Secretary of Mathematical Section 387 
—report of auditing committee.............ces 3 
Baker, Frank: communication on modern 
ideas of brain mechanism... Siachenirncesl ae 
— remarks on the recognition a like ieee 
BEATA GES OUT. soescecce ls eeauasnnystaedicsanarn csstecaces 13 
Barus, Carl, Election to membership of....... 5 
Bell, A. G.: communication on the m@than- 
ism of “clicks” and “clucks”’...........0008 18 
Billings, J. S.: communication on anthropo- 
metric and reaction time apparatus....... 25 
——-— germ cultures........ Soe spesuevens daveccaasc see 30 
— — — Vital statistics of the tenth U. S. 
DETUSITS sc nsavvanesaonsalasucansenasenciub ewes senscnkrecssea 4 
— remarks on the olfactory sense organs..... 28 
————— CATS Of PAM Ph ]Ots........cscse-cecscseseceese » 29 
Biological Society, Invitation from ....... 4 
Brown, Addison, cited on ahertetions “of 
UTENNL lst tecceaceccct sv sai'sesisaainoevelibewwes veceeskeameaaly 12 
Bulletin, Rules for pulication of.............0 xiii 
Burnett, S. M.: communication on the Javal 
and Schiotz ophthalmometer.................. 11 


Capron, Horace, Death of............ Budcsbenppaesenstd a 
Cause and chance in the concurrence of phe- 
TVOMI OT Avi revcapseeopuedesadapenncs bencataueees <bcsvodstceh 54 
Chatard, T. M., Election to membership 
(OPisakataneancacsie scouts az Seeeeupeoaeneee eee cree 11 
— remarks on transmission of sounds and 
Carb: TrOMOLS. tens cadvenestteabegstscoseccteee eee 


Chemical Society, Invitation from. .. 
Chlamydoconcha Orcutti... Sabeseces 
Circles related to Feuerbach’s s ee 
Clarke, F. W.: communication on an at- 
tempt at a theory of OdOL.......eeccccceceesceee ruts 
— —— the Flood Rock explosion.............0. 
— — — topaz from Stoneham, Maine............ 5 
Collection of formule for the area of a plane 


triangle (Mitlevonly) ic cccceesce ee 37 
Columnar structure in the diabase of Orange 
Mountain, Ne Jisecticac. coh cee eee dee 19 
Comets II and ITI, 1884 (Title only)............... 16 
Committee, auditing, Appointment of........., 31 
_—— Beport Oliueceatrsee aeasess megsedeuanscanetasyseetess 3 
Ravaagen daceau danscuvespeeapscecesenceeete xii, xiv, XV 
Ss ceknechiveeauascreresterert Xiv, Xv 
— — mathematical communications............ 63 
=== LUD LIGA TL OU Sitrect ersassacseestecevstesvecsareise xiv, XV 
Condensing hygrometer and sling psychro- 
MIE UO vasaeavennicaccyousawesesansncecistassatesesaaateeees - 25 
Condition of the earth’s interior (Title only) 
17, 18 
Conditioned observations...........-.csesseseeeseseee 41 
Connecticut Academy of Arts and Sciences 
Xxxvii 
COMSULEUTIONN. 2 cc-vecccsrecsnsacecseccsscce asaskabbseeeeeas vii 
Crumpling of the earth’s crust............:0.ce000 18 
Curtis, G. E.: remarks on methods of veri- 
fying weather predictionS.............0.0se0008 9 
Dall, W.H.: communication on two remark- 
able'forms of MollUSIKS..<..-.secccucseveensoossse 5 
Deceased memberg.............08 XXV, XXVii, 8, 10, 25 
Diabase, Columnar structure Of.........0..2.see00 19 
Diller, J.S.: communication on topaz from 
Stoneham; Main Os ..c<ssv.saccssscsayscacassscacssese 5 
Distances on any Spheroid.............ccccscrssceres 52 


66 


Page. 
Doolittle, M. H.: communication on cause 
and chance in the concurrence of phe- 


NOMENAL....eseee aveavuvaseweane Wavesosknuecnsersienouecs . 54 
— remarks on bisection and sesquisection... 52 
— —— notation for gravitation formula....... 40 
Dutton, C. E.: communication on practical 

geology versus speculative physics....... «4,0 
— remarks on transmission of sounds and 

Carth trEMOTS.....ccccccceeeceeee pcuseankudaccasnepene . 28 
Earth, Interior of........... feseares mrureyete edgeenstdvans 7 
Earth’s cr ust, Crumpling Of.......s0-+eeees sees 18 


Elliott, E. B.: communication entitled Ex- 
ample illustrating the use of a certain 
symbol in the calculus of affected quan- 
TG Yirve sense Syagavesvessaciey Gattvesueessere Reecaed 

Endowment of research ; 

Example illustrating the use of a certain 
symbol in the calculus of affected quan- 
tity (Title Only)....cccercecccesssccscceesnees Lieake a 37 


Farquhar, E.: remarks on the recognition 

of the direction Of SOUDG......cccesceccsereeees 13 
== —= — THUNGOFSHOLMSsscesccsvecsccssiverssescnsesevera LL. 
Farquhar, H.: remarks on sounds connected 


with meteors and earthquakes 28 
Feuerbach’s Circle............cceeseessecees 45 
Flexures of transit instruments.... 27 
Flood Rock explosion......... waeitetonsusdeessuceyrecd 28 
Flora of the Laramie group (Title only)....... 17 
General Committee, Members Of............. xiv, XV 
— — Rules Of.....sscsceeeeeeeee aocecchdvasheusancaduauseses xii 
— government in its relations to research... xli 
Geometry, Grassmann’s system Of.............++ 53 
Germ Cultures......-scesceeeeee Souebhsaionguyancsaelneenneys 30 
Gooch, F. A., Election to membership of...... 5 


Goode, G. B.: communication on the syste- 
matic care of pamphlets.........0.:ccesseereenee 29 


Grassmann’s system Of ZCEOMECETY......c.ceeceeees 53 
Gravitation, Modification of Newtonian 
PODIUM AsO. clase caccatansveseenssuns ss supemntceate crass 39 


Group of circlesrelated to Feuerbach’scirele 45 


Hann, J., cited on temperature changes at 


Hamburg...... scehopwuehunaavstenecsiascnessccuunnsspeds 9 
Hains, R. P., Election to membership of...... 10 
Hall, Asaph: communication on variations 

OF TAtitUGelice.vsecsesescusmaresesns vonons Rahitacaecaceck 10 


— Presidential address , «-XXXiii 
— remarks on a communication by Mr. Dut- 


GOD. scecccnsecconcssccvssccecacavcesecsvessssscessetaveanases 8 
—— — field-time determinations........e. eee 58 
— — — Hamilton’s geometric system........... 53 


Hall, Asaph, Jr., Election to membership of. 3 

Hall, Prof. G. Stanley: communication on 
recent experiments on reaction time 
and the time SONnSC........eeeeeee aeipirenae siete 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 


Hallock, William, Election to membership of, 
Hampson, Thomas, Election to member- 
SHAD Of ...csccsseosocsseves anvevosroees=esenauiaeapemnineme 
Harkness, William: communication on flex- 
ures of transit instruments...... 
— remarks on care of pamphlets........... aaveani 
Hazen, H. A.: communication on the con- 
densing hygrometer and sling psychro- 
MOLCMs.. ..ccscce oss ocssopnaenseus seseneuen bsaonmonesheaea . 
— —— thunderstorms of 1884........0cccccceseeee 
—remarks on the verification of weather 
PVOMICHONS ss5i. eke. cassteesbaceds dvameenere sane 
Hill, G. W.: elected President of Mathantake 
ical SGeti ON. ...6243 .iccivesenvacsuedsdeatneeeesthaeeee - 
— remarks on adjustment of conditioned 
ODSeYVatlOns.c.tvscccvessusassevensees ad cuscaeeaeeneee P 
—— — geometric systemS..........0.. 
— — — MeYcury.........ceceeeeeeeees a-cwabcaasheeeneneenee 
— — — notation for gravitation formula...... ° 
Hodgkins, H. L., Election to membership of 
Hoaorary members of American Societies 


5 


29 


27 
29 


XXXVii 


Hough, F. B., Death of.... 
HY ZTOMCteT Sis csvecsecsenst succes scsnnnsseeaae oii daveaweny ° 


eRe ee eee eee neewen eee eneeee 


Iddings, J. P.: communication on the col- 
umnar structure in the diabase of Or- 
ange Mountain, IN. J. .cs.sccevcuscvebsenesneacenen 

— Election to membership Of...............e0cee06 : 

Infinite attraction of a finite Mass... r 


Javal and Schiotz ophthalmometer, Exhibi- 
TION OF. 0.005 ccceccdscuscsncsesdecceseneeendeneteeneeeeuee i 
Johnson, A. B.: communication on the diffi- 
culty in determining the direction of 


25 
25 


19 


11 


SOUND, sovces csvect savcadevedan cddphestaamne eae Gate 11, 12 


Kerr, W.'C.,, Deathiofvcisstetetsssteasstnnaienenenetene 
Kummell, C. H.: communication entitled, 
Can the attraction of a finite mass be 
TD AINIbC 7...000.0tsevaverseicesons<wananhteaaehueaeeeneeeeeee 
— ——an artifice sometimes useful for the 
adju@ment of conditioned observations. 
— remarks on distances on any spheroid...... 
— — — Feuerbach’s CIrcle.....cccccsssese eneceeseeee . 
— — — field-time determinations...... 


Latitude, Variations Of......... sss PA 


Listiof MOM DeLBi secsacccare: evacsnsussuatansesisnepeeteeye . Xvi 


Mann, B. P.: remarks on the care of pamph- 


Marvin, C. F., Election to membership of..... 
Mathematical communications, Committees 


— Section, Bulletin Of. cds eocduuce danabe athqa erent 5 
—= — Mombers) Of,.....02.ccucsnavenssseatsavadaanvaenep " 


0 a | 


INDEX. 67 


Page. 
Mathematical Section, Officers of...... ........ 36, 37 
— — Rules of....... pabeanses eeSeueatiecktcuseccnetes aodssant? OD 


Matthews, Washington: communication on 
mythological dry painting of the Nava- 


Helicsraccatrarscestrcccdvadosse dd geues Paccons pier cen co. . 14 
—-—-— anthropometric and reaction time 
BPPATALUG... ..rceereseoes aaadanewes Gabe ded suecWaee seers s 25 
McGee, W. J.: communication on the ter- 
races of the Potomac valley..............009+ . 24 
Measurement of temperature at distant 
Ponts (Ditlet Only)? «.Fis.cccts<sacecseesdaevedace we 238 


Mechanism of clicks and clucks (Title only) 18 
Members, Deceased........0..XXV, XXVii, 8, 10, 25 
— List of......... Beeeantes eeaudedunasevensvese cncpetavecce dasen VI 
Mendenhall, T. C.: baidutiadtion on mea- 
surement of temperature at distant 
ROLE GSneteseasuraserisoeskacstcuuane-eravece=srtckenae caine 18 
— Election to membership of........ sou coduceccee 8 


— exhibition of a volt meter 26 
— remarks on reaction time.............. easj, Ot 
Mercury, Mathematical theory of... we 41 


Methods of verifying weather predictions... 8 


Milneria minima........ Beenepnelesesekraresncatees hewces 5 
Modern ideas of brain mechanism (Title 
SEILY:)acuwdarisacascesthessdcosedecccsadecsstacectecnccedcs Seley 
Mollusks, Two remarkable forms of............. 5 
Moser, J. F., Election to membership of...... 12 
Mountain structure........ areas fhekvascktose nave # (18 


Mythological dry painting of the Navajos.... 14 


National Academy of Sciences................. xl, xly 
Navajos, Painting Dy...........css0 Sasatecuctecedavedn 14 
Newtonian formula of gravitation................ 39 
Nine-points circle...........000 Gvereusansecstyendactecede 46 
Odor, Theory of....... auaavasuasece sicerucxesincrsvscexaucs: AAT 
Officers, Election of......... paunnssbovatdnenaces Sperecr) sy 
— of the Mathematical Section............ 00.0... - 36 
— — — Society........ penuveswaveuadassassestutscacnens Xiv, XV 
Orange: Mountain, N. Ji..:-0...0000000sssssees edeseaces reli kt) 
Painting by the Navajos..........ssssscsee . 14 
EPRBRDOUIOUSS CANO! Of; -coscces acseeessnecccsceseaccoce sesso 29 
Paul, H. M.: communication on the earth’s 
MINLETROL pe ccssecedanssuccsessccsesce facctswesweceecosene 17,18 
— — — the Flood Rock explosion................. 28 
— remarks on the earth’s rigidity............... ap ere 
——— dry painting by the Japanese............ 16 
— — — field time determinations 58 
— — — the topophone...............es000. 13 
BGR Ga A Fi:5 DICALD OF; <cccscevsccecsoscccccccoccccsaseccs 10 
Perturbations of Polyhymnia.............:c00ccc008 54 
Physical observations on Wolf’s comet (1884, 
MEN) See sscsccese ses eacedeasnaueanasnncnsstacecsastotentcseec 37 
Poindexter, W. M., Election to membership 
Sotandattusastatansdutnessasnsentksssssavcconuaviseltadesecssel! | 3 


Page. 

Polyhymnia, Perturbations of......... Reecusveantade 54 
Practical geology versus speculative physics 

(Ditle only): .....ste00 Saanexerecnunee Lactounwetcgee 4,5, 6 

President’s address............ aceacca ee eey iadeeees Xxxili 

PSY. CHYOM CLOTS: sisisvscs ssccesvivdvescnatsencresereosecses 25 

Publications, Committee on............ccc00 «Xiv, XV 


Ravené, G. L.: communication on the aste- 


TOUS wtstecceacecane RubawaweaeCdudenwestacperaveraccabs 18, 54 
——-— the theory of Reroure ducenussisazsueesacae 41 
— Election to membership Of...............00s000 « It 
== NEOMATECS) ONGC OMA Les stuseaneauecdsseesss-ncevecites ony LI 
Reaction time apparatus........cccccccccsscsecsceess 25, 27 
Recent experiments on reaction time and 

the time sense (Title only).............ss0000 4 
Report of Secretaries..............00 Coe ee. 4p Dt) | 
— — Treasurer..............008- -- XXVili, 31 
Research, Endowment Of..........:0c00cesscesecessece xli 
Riley, C. V.: communication on the system- 

atic care of pamphlets............sss0+ sosseese 29 
Ritter, F. W. McK.: communications on see- 

ular perturbations by Jupiter......c...ccceeee 54 


Robinson, T.: remarks on the observation 
Of Carthy tremors; sacs. sasccssceseie ee 


— — — Society ...........c00000 


Secretaries, Report of............ 


..XXVIi, 31 
Secular perturbations of Polyhymnia by Jup- 

iter .. ste Srapeerereretseecocrncrrcris) tie! 
Seismometric observation, iets dusreaanvnasseasseansnene 28 
Shumway, W.A., Election to membership of 12 
Signal service investigations of thunder- 


storms... yeaa ase) LO 
—— rules for ipcpatieationn ‘of puedictiona: rap 8 
SUX POMS CITC Oz sscceccenteccostuswsueccstdesoieeeite - 46 
Slight modification of the Newtonian form- 
Wla/Of SYAVICATION scvsscedesccccsussceceesctyees seosey) (09) 
Sling psychrometer 25 
Smelly SONse- Of sa.ccacshoseres cxcckeaece 27 
Societies, American scientific. .............00. Xxxili 
Some practical features of a field time de- 
termination with a meridian transit...... 55 
Sound, Aberration of............. Deconssieacwesssseusenril cele 
Spheroids DistanCes:Onisc..s.0+caccoancs saseccecsecusee 52 
Standing rules of the General Committee... xii 
— — — — Mathematical Section.............. serce OD 
mae mls MO CLO UY case co east ssacceassiscienacscocdesteneace ix 
Switt; GAN; CLL sc. scccsssvoscsacsvosstcesncesseeee cee xl 
Systematic care of pamphlets................000 « 29 
Taylor,W. B.: communication on the crump- 
ling of the earth’S Crust. ....cccc.ccscncceveee wo 18 
—— — geological and physical theories...... 6 


——-— aslight modification of the Newton- 
ian formula of gravitation... .ccceccceee 08 


68 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
Taylor, W. B.: remarks on the topophone.... 13 
Terraces of the Potomac valley (Title only). 24 


THEO Of MerCury.c.csccssseccnsccoscsess Seeeuaineteress 41 

Thompson, Gilbert, on rock paintings in 
INGW, WIOKIC Oss cccnccascsacanssusasescreece eudvaesvespen wLO 

Thunderstorms of 1884............«+ senanedweusnuceavee 10 


-Time determination with meridian transit.. 55 
Toner, J. M.: remarks on the care of pamph- 


POGS sictavectteracs's Saananceuncenevat cnt evsncadvanksbapentees 29 
Topaz from Stoneham, Maine 5 
SROVOPNONO ivessevcncecencveccdenccres Seceeece este dacececcim dt) 
Transit instruments, Flexures Of..........0.000+ 27 
Trap, Colummnat........ccre donsrsedcabuanecanerearararseasitee 
Treasurer, Report Of.,.......scssee Snesnuanee xxviii, 31 
Twelve-points Circle........c.ccccescceserccsceree sees 46 
Two remarkable forms of mollusks............. 5 


Variations of latitude....rccsccscccssscsscccscenccscess 10 
Velocity of transmission of earth tremors... 28 


Verifying weather predictions..........cccsseeees 8 
Vital statistics of the tenth U.S. census 
(Dita iOnlly)icecessascacssmecesses sesceess 4 
Volt-meter, Exhibition Of...........sscsssseescesees Sco) 
Ward, L. F.: communication on the flora of 
the Laramie group..........ss00+ Sree deotensy LG 
Weather predictions, Verification of.......... 8 


Page, 
Weed, W. H., Electiontjo membership of..... 17 
Willis, Bailey, Election to membership of... 8 
Wilson, H. M., Election to membership of... 11 
Winlock, W. C.: communication on comets 


Thand TIT, TS84. ..0).cccsssqsesqeconcnensuccenieenian 16 
— — — physical observations on Wolf's 

comet (1884, III)......ccs0ocscssssesseeve iueonn conve » af 
— report of auditing committee.................. ii shee 
Woodward, R. S.: cited on infinite attrac- 

LLOV dsp osccutscctuete paneWoashadhouhvedeencsmiaumei 0000009, 62 


— communication on some practical fea- 

tures of a field time determination with 

a meridian transit.......... apeucpetenie sactunbament 55 
— remarks on geometric systems....... ceccesvee OS 
— — — infinite attraction of a finite mass.... 63 
— — — variations of latitude.............seceeeeee «i woe 
Wolf's comet........cscccsses bisesustessteaees au snunrven fades 37 
Wortman, J. S., Election to membership of.. 31 
Wright, G. M., Election to membership of... 10 


Yarrow, H. C.: Report of auditing com- 
HEULULOC ss vecsevensevsatntsvanncuentemaects 


Ziwet, Alexander: communication on Grass- 
mann’s system of geometry........ 
— Election to membership of 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY 


OF 


WASHINGTON. 


VOL. IX. 


Containing the Minutes of the Society and of the Mathematical 


Section for the year 1886. 


PUBLISHED BY THE CO-OPERATION OF THE SMITHSONIAN INSTITUTION. 


WASHINGTON: 
1887. 


‘ ; y 
est } Re ek * Sa al 
yf it | y. Cas ! Tye i, ek aw gt 


re Bee ge te Pe cole ae 
eet me ie Ay 7. . Cuca Al 


‘ 
\ \ ' ; , 
‘ | ae a lpia Lk = 


Orr ae 


Hea: 


CONTENTS. 


Page. 
MO GRISURINNGIO, Shc es ee ees = VEL 
Standing Eules\of the Society. 22 ek Ix 
Standing Rules of the General Committee --_.---_----.------. 2 x 
Rules for the Publication of the Bulletin --__.__-_.--_. ---__.___- XIII 
iresears cleetenlacemiber, teem ce ool Se RIV 
Oicers elected December, 1686-2. = a BE ENG 
1S SA TEES 2s RA SE A PS aL UO eal a XVI 
Wires ce eresed: (Members Ao ee aed 
I se Se ee ae XXVIII 
wannis), eport ef, the Seeretaries).2. 2. 1-2 OX 
flainualcheport of. the, Treasureryc2! 0) yen ee ee ee) RE 
Annual Address of the President, J. S. Billings_---.-.---..__..__- XXXV 
Bulletin‘of the General Meeting 222 ee) os oe et 1 
Report of the Auditing Committee_---___ —..__. _---. -_-_. 3 
Notes on the geology of northern California, J. S. Diller ___- 4 
Notes on the faults of the Great Basin and of the eastern base 
Of, the) Sierra, Nevada, 1... Russelle 2 = be ee 5 
Recent changes of level in the basin of Lake Ontario, G. K. 
Galpert,:( Ticle ore) ceo he eae 8 
Lieutenant Lockwood’s expedition to farthest north, George E. 
ETE AR SSG IES RO PT atl is aN ch 2 SR LN eo His 8 
Two examples of similar inventions in areas widely apart, O. T. 
SO Ste ee a a ee 12 
Historical sketch of deep-sea temperature observations, J. H. 
gg A Ge AM LT | RR esl BS naps Gl Mee ae Ae 14 
Annual profit to banks of national bank note circulation, E. B. 
PETRON ty Renee OVObYy Vem nn oon eee Ret 14 
Quantity of United States subsidiary silver coin existing and 
in circulation, E. B. Elliott, (Title only)-----.---- -------- 14 
The new star in the nebula of Andromeda, Asaph Hall, (Title 
OTe) rach Sarees nee ae ee aren et los aie Geet 14 
The images of stars, Asaph Hall, (Title only) -------------- aes 15 
On the changes of terrestrial level surfaces due to variations in 
distribution of superficial matter, R. S. Woodward, (Title 
OVA) aes ee oe BS Mh 15 
On the observed changes of level surfaces in the Bonneville 
area and their explanation, G. K. Gilbert, ( Title only) --_-. 15 


On the varying altitudes of former level surfaces in the Great 
Lake region and the applicability of proposed explanations, 
Po, Cnsmnberiin,: (isle onlyys <n coho a eta eee LOY LO 
The enlargement of mineral fragments as a factor in rock alter- 
anion, ik. US irvine, (Die O71) 5 on ao es Ss a 16 
iii 


IV CONTENTS. 

The subaerial decay of rocks and the origin of the red clay of 
certain formations, I. C. Russell, (Zvtle only) --.,- ---- ---- 
Recent improvements in microscopic objectives, with demon- 
stration of the resolving power of a new 1-16th inch, Romyn 
iteheock, (Title only), taco ees to ae ae eee 
A phonetic alphabet, Henry Farquhar -_~-~- ---- ---- ---- ---- 
Customs of every-day life, Garrick Mallery_-_-- ----— ------ 
When I first saw the cholera bacillus, R. D. Mussey, ( Title only) 
The distribution of fishes in the oceanic abysses and middle 
strata, G. Brown Goode and T. H. Bean, ( Z%tle only) ------ 
The physical geographical divisions of the southeastern portion 
of the United States and their corresponding topographical 
types, Gilbert. Thompson -2 24-3 225 oan ee ee 
Temperatures at which differences between mercurial and air 
thermometers are greatest, Thomas Russell, (with figure) _-- 
The gilding of thermometer bulbs, J. H. Kidder, (Title only) _ 
Effects of solar radiation upon thermometer bulbs having dif- 
ferent metallic coverings, H. A. Hazen-_ -__-__--__---- .--- 
Organic cells of unknown origin and form found in human 
feeces (two cases), Newton L. Bates -_-_---.--_. ---_---- Es 
On museum. specimens illustrating biology, J. 8. Billings, G. 
Brown Goode, and Frederick A. Lucas_-__- ---.-------- ots 
On geological museums, George P. Merrill, (Title only)------ 

The Charleston earthquake, by— 
T..0.. Mendenhall in 2456 ts tol peed ae ee 
Wd MeGeoiss22. <. esate) A hela ee ee ee 
Charles 'G.'Roékwood laa. 250. 62. 26 See ce eee 
Everett Hayden, (with one plate)_-.-. .... —-—- += --2-— 
1, OM. Paul oo Se eee 
Bowyers and fletchers, 0, T. Mason -- <2. ——_ 2 oS 
onl new and small mountain ranges, G. K. Gilbert, (TZvtle 
ONY) Soi oa a eo ee a se 
Normal barometers, T. Russell/__-- <2... 3 eee 
On the occurrence of copper ores in the Trias of the eastern 
United States, N. H. Darton, (Title only)_--_-__ -_--__-__- 
The latest voleanic eruption in northern California and its 
peculiar lava; J. &. Diller, (Title only).—.- -- - -2 5 2 2o oe 
Presentation of the annual address... -.. -._- =~. —— ses 
“Annual Meetinion 2. 2 2 Sos oo ee ee oe ee Ba 


Bulletin of the Mathematical Section=-- 2. a 


Standing Rules of the Section... 2. + .2-4 soi. das- 2+ bee 
Officers'of the Section. .. 2522. L223 fuss de ee 
List of members who receive announcements of the meetings_ 
Comparison of the Boss and Auwers’ declination standards, 


Henry Narquhar--— = 1222 cio Se ee ee 
On the position and shape of the geoid as dependent on local 
masses, R. S. Woodward, (Title only)_-.--_ --~- - aye -=--—- 


On the use of Somoff’s theorem for the evaluation of the ellip- 
tic integral of the 3d species, C. H. Kummell, (Title only) -- 


Td yee cee rr ae 


53, 


16 


16 
17 
19 
22 


22 


22 


25 
33 


33 
35 


35 
36 


387 
37 
37 
38 
41 
44 


45 
46 


46 


46 
47 
47 
49 
51 
52 
52 


53 
54 


54 
55 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON, 


CONSTITUTION, RULES, 


LISTS OF 


OFFICERS AND MEMBERS, 


AND REPORTS OF 


SECRETARIES AND TREASURER. 


“i I 7 a m f Wy 


TOU 


CONSTITUTION 


OF 


THE PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ArtIcLE I. The name of this Society shall be Taz Pariosoput- 
CAL Society or WASHINGTON. 


ArticLE II. The officers of the Society shall be a President, 
four Vice-Presidents, a Treasurer, and two Secretaries. 


ArticLE III. There shall be a General Committee, consisting of 
the officers of the Society and nine other members. 


ArtIcLE IV. The officers of the Society and the other members 
of the General Committee shall be elected annually by ballot; they 
shall hold office until their successors are elected, and shall have 
power to fill vacancies. 


ArticLE V. It shall be the duty of the General Committee to 
make rules for the government of the Society, and to transact all 
its business. 


ArticLe VI. This constitution shall not be amended except by 
a three-fourths vote of those present at an annual meeting for the 
election of officers, and after notice of the proposed change shall 
have been given in writing at a stated meeting of the Society at 
least four weeks previously. 


vii 


LOLpL RES uA 60 ‘ 


To 9 o¢ 
ahh 


pg 
wt 


STANDING RULES 


FOR THE GOVERNMENT OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


1. The Stated Meetings of the Society shall be held at 8 o’clock 
P. M. on every alternate Saturday; the place of meeting to be 
designated by the General Committee. 


2. Notice of the time and place of meeting shall be sent to each 
member by one of the Secretaries. P 
When necessary, Special Meetings may be called by the President. 


3. The Annual Meeting for the election of officers shall be the 
last stated meeting in the month of December. 


The order of proceedings (which shall be announced by the 
Chair) shall be as follows: 
First, the reading of the minutes of the last Annual Meeting. 


Second, the presentation of the annual reports of the Secretaries, 
including the announcement of the names of members elected since 
the last Annual Meeting. 


Third, the presentation of the annual report of the Treasurer. 


Fourth, the announcement of the names of members who, having 
complied with section 14 of the Standing Rules, are entitled to vote 
on the election of officers. 


Fifth, the election of President. 

Sixth, the election of four Vice-Presidents. 

Seventh, the election of Treasurer. 

Eighth, the election of two Secretaries. 

Ninth, the election of nine members of the General Committee. 

Tenth, the consideration of Amendments to the Constitution of 
the Society, if any such shall have been proposed in accordance 
with Article VI of the Constitution. 

Eleventh, the reading of the rough minutes of the meeting. 

35 ix 


x PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


4. Elections of officers are to be held as follows: 


In each case nominations shall be made by means of an informal 
ballot, the result of which shall be announced by the Secretary ; 
after which the first formal ballot shall be taken. 

In the ballot for Vice-Presidents, Secretaries, and members of the 
General Committee, each voter shall write on one ballot as many 
names as there are officers to be elected, viz., four on the first ballot 
for Vice-Presidents, two on the first for Secretaries, and nine on the 
first for members of the General Committee; and on each subse- 
quent ballot as many names as there are persons yet to be elected; - 
and those persons who receive a majority of the votes cast shall be 
declared elected. 

If in any case the informal ballot result in giving a majority for 
‘any one, it may be declared formal by a majority vote. 


5. The Stated Meetings, with the exception of the Annual Meet- 
ing, shall be devoted to the consideration and discussion of scientific 
subjects. 

The Stated Meeting next preceding the Annual Meeting shall be 
set apart for the delivery of the President’s Annual Address. 


6. Sections representing special branches of science may be 
formed by the General Committee upon the written recommenda- 
tion of twenty members of the Society. 


7. Persons interested in science, who are not residents of the Dis- 
trict of Columbia, may be present at any meeting of the Society, 
except the Annual Meeting, upon invitation of a member. 


8. On request of a member, the President or either of the Secre- 
taries may, at his discretion, issue to any person a card of invitation 
to attend a specified meeting. Five cards of invitation to attend a 
meeting may be issued in blank to the reader of a paper at that 
meeting. 


9. Invitations to attend during three months the meetings of the 
Society and participate in the discussion of papers, may, by a vote 
of nine members of the General Committee, be issued to persons 
nominated by two members. 


10. Communications intended for publication under the auspices 
of the Society shall be submitted in writing to the General Com- 
mittee for approval. 


STANDING RULES. XI 


11. Any paper read before a Section may be repeated, either 
entire or by abstract, before a general meeting of the Society, if 
such repetition is recommended by the General Committee of the 
Sodiety. 


12. It is not permitted to report the proceedings of the Society or 
its Sections for publication, except by authority of the General 
Committee. 


13. * New members may be proposed in writing by three mem- 
bers of the Society for election by the General Committee; but no 
_ person shall be admitted to the privileges of membership unless he 
signifies his acceptance thereof in writing, and pays his dues to the 
‘Treasurer, within two months after notification of his election. 


14, Each member shall pay annually to the Treasurer the sum 
of five dollars, and no member whose dues are unpaid shall vote at 
the Annual Meeting for the election of officers, or be entitled to a 
copy of the Bulletin. 

In the absence of the Treasurer, the Secretary is authorized to 
receive the dues of members. 

The names of those two years in arrears shall be dropped from 
the list of members. 

Notice of resignation of membership shall be given in writing to 
the General Committee through the President or one of the Secre- 
taries. 


15. The fiscal year shall terminate with the Annual Meeting. 


16. Any member who is absent from the District of Columbia 
for more than twelve consecutive months may be excused from pay- 
ment of dues during the period of his absence, in which case he 
will not be entitled to receive announcements of meetings or current 
numbers of the Bulletin. 


17. Any member not in arrears, may, by the payment of one 
hundred dollars at any one time, become a life member, and be 
relieved from all further annual dues and other assessments. 

All moneys received in payment of life membership shall be 
invested as portions of a permanent fund, which shall be directed 
solely to the furtherance of such special scientific work as may be 
ordered by the General Committee. 


*Amended Oct. 9, 1886. 


STANDING RULES 


OF THE 


GENERAL COMMITTEE OF THE PHILOSOPHICAL 
SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


1. The President, Vice-Presidents, and Secretaries of the Society 
shall hold like offices in the General Committee. 


2, The President shall have power to call special meetings of the 
Committee, and to appoint Sub-Committees. 


3. The Sub-Committees shall prepare business for the General 
Committee, and perform such other duties as may be entrusted to 
them. 


4, There shall be two Standing Sub-Committees; one on Com- 
munications for the Stated Meetings of the Society, and another on 
Publications. 


5. The General Committee shall meet at half-past seven o’clock 
on the evening of each Stated Meeting, and by adjournment at 
other times. 


6. For all purposes, except for the amendment of the Standing 
Rules of the Committee or of the Society, and the election of mem- 
bers, six members of the Committee shall constitute a quorum. 


7. The names of proposed new members recommended in con- 
formity with section 13 of the Standing Rules of the Society, may 
be presented at any meeting of the General Committee, but shall 
lie over for at least four weeks before final action, and the concur- 
rence of twelve members of the Committee shall be necessary to 
election. 

The Secretary of the General Committee shall keep a chronologi- 
cal register of the elections and acceptances of members. 


8. These Standing Rules, and those for the government of the 
Society, shall be modified only with the consent of a majority of 


the members of the General Committee. 
xii 


nm ODEs 


FOR THE 


PUBLICATION OF THE BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


1. The President’s Annual Address shall be published in full. 


2. The annual reports of the Secretaries and of the Treasurer 
shall be published in full. 


3. When directed by the General Committee, any communication 
may be published in full. 


4. Abstracts of papers and remarks on the same will be pub- 
lished, when presented to the Secretary by the author in writing 
within two weeks of the evening of their delivery, and approved by 
the Committee on Publications. Brief abstracts prepared by one 
of the Secretaries and approved by the Committee on Publications 
may also be published. 


5. If the author of any paper read before a Section of the 
Society desires its publication, either in full or by abstract, it shall 
be referred to a committee to be appointed as the Section may 
determine. 

The report of this committee shall be forwarded to the Publica- 
tion Committee by the Secretary of the Section, together with any 
action of the Section taken thereon. 


6. Communications which have been published elsewhere, so as 
to be generally accessible, will appear in the Bulletin by title only, 
but with a reference to the place of publication, if made known in 
season to the Committee on Publications. 

X111 


OPFPrTiIiCcCnaRsS 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON 


ELECTED DECEMBER 19, 1885. 


President..-_--.--.---J. S. BILLIna@s. 

Vice-Presidents _-___. WILLIAM HARKNESS. GARRICK MALLERY. 
C. E. Dutton. J. E. Hitearp.* 

Treasurer.-_..------ RoBERT FLETCHER. 

Secretaries ...--.-.-. G. K. GILBERT. Marcus BAKER. 


MEMBERS AT LARGE OF THE GENERAL COMMITTEE. 


H. H. Bares. F. W. CLarke. 
W. H. Datu. G. B. Goon. 
J. R. EastMan. HENRY FARQUHAR. 
T. C. MENDENHALL.t H. M. Patt. 

C. V. RILry. 


STANDING COMMITTEES. 
On Communications: 


Witr1am Harness, Chairman. G. KK. GILBERT. Marcus BAKER. 


On Publications: 


G. K. GiLBert, Chairman. RoBeRT FLETCHER. Marcus BAKER. 
S. F. Barrp.t 


* Resigned membership Nov. 20, 1886. . 

+Resigned Oct. 9, 1886; vacancy filled by election of W. B. Taylor, Oct. 23, 1886. 

t As Secretary of the Smithsonian Institution. : 
x1V 


OFFICERS 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON 


ELECTED DECEMBER 18, 1886. 


EET CSCO nee eS WILLIAM HARKNESS. 

Vice-Presidents ....__.GARRICK MALLERY. C. E. Dutton. 
J. R. EASTMAN. G. K. GILBERT. 

Treasurer._..------. ROBERT FLETCHER. 

Secretarieg....._._.. Marcus BAKER. J. H. K1ippER. 


MEMBERS AT LARGE OF THE GENERAL COMMITTEE. 


H. H. Bares. F. W. CLarkeE. 
W. 4H. Dati. E. B. Evxiort. 
G. B. GoopE. C. V. Ritzer. 

H. M. Pavt. W. C. WINLOcK. 


R. S. Woopwarp. 


STANDING COMMITTEES. 
On Communications : 
J. R. EastMan, Chairman. Marcus Baker. J. H. Kipper. 


On Publications: 


Marcus Baxkzr, Chairman. RoBert FLETCHER. J. H. Krppzr. 
S. F. Barrp. 


LIST OF MEMBERS 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Corrected to December 18, 1886. 


Names of gentlemen here indicated as resigned will be omitted from future lists. 


"& 
NAME. ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. aA 
ns 
fom} 
ABBE, Prof. CLEVELAND Army Signal Office. 1871 
2017 I st. Now. 
ABERT, Mr.8S.T.(Sylvanus Thayer)| 810 19th st. N. W. 1875 
Apams, Mr. CHARLES FREDERICK] Civil Service Commission. 1885 
316 C st. N. W. 
ApaAMs, Mr. Henry 1603 H st. N. W. 1881 
Apts, Hon. A. O. (Asa Owen) 1765 Mass. ave. N. W. 1873 
ANTISELL, Dr. THomas (Founder) | Patent Office. 1871 
1311 Q st. N. W. 
Avery, Mr. Rozert 8. (Robert | 320 A st. S. E. 1879 
Stanton) 
Bairp, Prof. SPENCER F. (Spencer | Smithsonian Institution. 1871 
Fullerton) (Founder) 1445 Mass. ave. N. W. 
Baker, Prof. FRANK 1315 Corcoran st. N. W. 1881 
Baker, Mr. Marcus Geological Survey. 1876 
1125 17th st. N. W. 
BANCROFT, GEORGE 1623 H st. N. W., or, insummer, | 1875 
Newport, R. I. 
Barvs, Dr. Cart Geological Survey. 1885 
Bates, Mr. Henry H. (Henry | Patent Office. 4 1871 
Hobart) The Portland. 
Batzs, Dr. N. L. (Newton Lem- | Navy Department. 1866 
uel) U.S. N. 1233 17th st. N. W. 
Bran, Dr. T. H. (Tarleton Hoff- | National Museum. 1884 
man) 1616 19th st. N. W. 
BEARDSLEE, Capt. L. A. (Lester | Little Falls, N. Y. 1875 
Anthony) U.S. N. (Absent) 

Bett, Mr. A. GRawAM (Alexander} Scott Circle ; 1879 
Graham) 1500 Rhode Island ave. 

BELL, Dr. C. A. (Chichester Alex- | University College. 1881 
ander) (Absent) London, England. 

Benét, Gen. 8. V. (Stephen Vin- | Ordnance Office, War Dept. 1871 
cent) U. 8. A. (Founder) 1717 Ist. N. W. 


xvi 


LIST OF MEMBERS. 


XVII 


NAME. 


BgssExs, Dr. EM1IL 
Bryer, Dr. H. G. (Henry Gustav) 


Brixines, Dr. Joun S.(John Shaw) 
U.S. A. (Founder) 
Birney, Gen. WILLIAM 


Birntiz, Capt. Roarrs, Jr.,U.S. A. 


BoprisH, Mr. S. H. (Sumner Ho- 
mer) (Absent) 

Bow ess, Asst. Nav. Constr. FRAN- 
cis T. (Francis Tiffany) U.S. N. 
(Absent) 

Brown, Prof. 8. J. (Stimson Jo- 
seph) U.S. N. (Absent) 

Browne, Dr. J. Mitis (John 
Mills) U.S. N. 

Bryan, Dr. J. H. (Joseph Ham- 


mond), 

Burgess, Mr. E.S. (Edward Sand- 
ford) 

Burnett, Dr. Swan M. (Swan 
Moses) 

Busey, Dr. SAMuEL C. (Samuel 
Clagett) 


.Casry, Col. Tuomas Lincotxy, U. 


S. A. (Founder: absent) 

Cazrarc, Lieut. L. V. (Louis 
Vasmer) U.S. A. (Absent) 

CHAMBERLIN, Prof. T. C. (Thomas 
Crowder) 

CuHATARD, Dr. THomas M.(Thomas 
Marean) 

Cuickrerine, Prof. J. W., Jr. 
(John White) 

CurisTI£, Mr. ALEx. S. (Alexan- 
der Smyth) 

Cuark, Mr. E. (Edward) 


CuiarkeE, Prof. F. W. (Frank 
Wigglesworth) 

Corrin, Prof. J. H. C: (John 
Huntington Crane) U. 8S. N. 
(Founder) 

Comstock, Prof. J. H. (John 
Henry) (Adsent) 

Cours, Prof. ELLIOTT 


Craia, Lieut. Ropert, U. S. A. 
(Absent) 
9 


ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. 


Glenn Dale, Md. 
Bureau Med. & Surg.,Navy Dept. 
1207 Connecticut ave. 
Surg. General’s Office, U. S. A. 
3027 N st. N. W. 
456 Louisiana ave. 
1901 Harewood ave., 
Le Droit Park. 
Office Chief of Ordnance,U.S. A. 
1341 New Hampshire ave. 
Geological Survey. 
605 F st. N. W. 
Navy Department. 


Naval Academy, 
Annapolis, Md. 
Navy Department. 
The Portland. 
1644 Conecticut ave. 


High School. 
1120 13th st. N. W. 
1734 K st. N. W. 


901 16th st. N. W. 


Army Building, cor. Green and 
Houston sts., New York city. 
Little Rock Barracks, 
Little Rock, Ark. 
Geological Survey. 


Geological Survey. 
Cosmos Club. 
Deaf Mute College, Kendall 
Green. 
Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 
507 6th st. N. W. 
Architect’s Office, Capitol. 
417 4th st. N. W. 
Geological Survey. 
1425 Q st. N. W. 
1901 Ist. N. W. 


Cornell University, Ithaca, N.Y. 
Smithsonian Institution. 


1726 N stoN.: W.. 
War Department. 


Year of 
admission. 


_ 
9 2) 
1 


875 
1886 


1871 
1879 


1876 
1883 
1884 


1884 
1883 
1886 
1883 
1879 
1874 


1871 
1882 
1883 
1885 
1874 
1880 
1877 
1874 
1871 


1880 
1874 
1873 


XVIII 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


NAME. 


Craic, Dr. THomas (Absent) 


Cummines, Prof. G. J. (George 
Jotham) 

Curticr, Mr. CooPpER 

Curtis, Mr. Go. E. (George Ed- 
ward) 


Dati, Mr. Wm. H. (William 
Healey) (Founder) 

Darton, Mr. Netson H. (Nelson 
Horatio) 

Davis, Commander C. H. (Charles 
Henry) U.S. N. 

Dean, Dr. R. C. (Richard Crain) 
U.S. N. (Absent) 


Dz Carnpry, Mr. Wa. A.( William 
Augustin) 

Der LanD, Mr. THEODORE L. (The- 
odore Louis) 

Dewey, Mr. Frep. P. (Frederic 
Perkins) 

DituER, Mr. J. 8. (Joseph Silas) 


DoouittLE, Mr. M. H. (Myrick 
Hascall) 

Dunwoopy, Lt. H. H. C. (Henry 
Harrison Chase) U.S. A. aboot) 

Dutton, Capt. C. E. (Clarence 
Edward) U.S. A. 


Earti, Mr. R. Epwarp (Robert 
Edward) 

EastMan, Prof. J. R. (John Ro- 
bie) U. 8. N. 

ErmpBeck, Mr. WILLIAM 

ELDREDGE, Dr. STEWART (Absent) 

Exuiotr, Mr. E. 8B. (Ezekiel 
Brown) (Founder) 

Emmons, Mr. 8. F. (Samuel Frank- 
lin 

ihren: Dr. F. M. (Frederic 
Miller) (Absent) 

Ewinea, Gen. Hueu (Absent) 


FarquuHar, Mr. EDwarD 
Farquuar, Mr. Henry 


FERREL, Prof. WILLIAM 


_ 
ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. 


Johns Hopkins Univ., 
Baltimore, Md. 
Howard University. 


Agricultural Department. 
Army Signal Office. 
1401 16th st. N. W. 


Care Smithsonian Institution. 


1119 12th st. N. W. 
Geological Survey. 

1101 K st. N. W. 
Navy Department. 

1705 Rhode Island ave. 
Navy Department. 


45 Lafayette Place, New York 


city. 
Commissary General’s Office. 

1713 H st. N. W. 
Treasury Department. 

115 7th st. N. E. 
National Museum. 

Lanier Heights. 
Geological Survey. 

1804 16th st. N. W. 


Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 


1925 I st. N. W. 
War Department. 


Geological Survey. 
2119 H st. N. W. 


Smithsonian Institution. 
1836 T st. N. W. 

Naval Observatory. 
1905 I st. N. W. 


Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 


Yokohama, Japan. 
Gov’t Actuary, Treas. Dept. 
1210 G st. N. W. 
Geological Survey. 
1708 H st. N. W. 
Reading, Pa. 


Lancaster, Ohio. 


Patent Office Library. 
1915 H st. N. W. 


Coast and Geodetic Survéy Office. 


Brooks Station, D. C. 
1641 Broadway, 
Kansas City, Mo. 


Year of 
admission. 


Peter) 


1714 13th st. N. W. 


LIST OF MEMBERS. XIX 
a6 
Name. ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. | 3.2 
ne 
FietcHer, Dr. RoBERT Surgeon General’s Office,U.S. A.| 1873 
The Portland. 
Fuint, Mr. A. 8. (Albert Stowell) | Naval Observatory. 1882 
1330 Riggs st. 
Fuint, Dr. J. M. (James Milton) | Navy Department. 1881 
WSN. U. 8. 5S. Albatross. 
FRIsTox, Prof. Epwarp T Columbian University, cor. 15th | 1873 
and H sts. N. W. 
GALLAUDET, President E. M.(Ed-| Deaf Mute College, Kendall | 1875 
ward Miner) Green. 
GANNETT, Mr. Henry Geological Survey. 1874 
1881 Harewood ave., Le Droit 
Park. 
GILBERT, Mr. G. K. (Grove Karl) | Geological Survey. 1873 
: 1424 Corcoran st. 
Goppine, Dr. W. W. (William | Government Hospital for the In-| 1879 
Whitney) sane. 
wore = F. A. (Frank Austin) | Yale College, New Haven, Conn. | 1885 
Absent 
GoopE, Mr. G. Brown (George | National Museum. 1874 
Brown) Summit ave., Lanier Heights. 
GooDFELLow, Mr. Epwarp Coast and Geodetic Survey Office.| 1875 
1324 19th st. N. W. 
Gorpon, Prof. J. C. (Joseph Clay- | Deaf Mute College, 1886 
baugh) Kendall Green. 
GorE, Prof. J. H. (James How- | Columbian University. 1880 
ard) 1305 Q st. N. W. 
Graves, Mr. WattER H. (Wal- | Denver, Colorado. 1878 
ter Hayden) (Absent) 
GREELY, Lieut. A. W. (Adolphus | Army Signal Office. 1880 
Washington) U.S. A. 1914 G st. N. W. 
GrReEEN, Mr. Bernarp R. (Bern- | Office of Building for State, War | 1879 
ard Richardson) and Navy Depts. 
1738 N st. N. W. 
GREEN, Commander F. M. (Fran- | Navy Department. 1875 
cis Mathews) U.S. N. (Absent) 
GREENE, Prof. B. F. (Benjamin | West Lebanon, N. H. 1871 
Franklin) U. 8. N. (Founder: 
absent) 
GREENE, Francis V. (Francis | 280 Broadway, New York city. | 1875 
Vinton) (Absent) 
Gregory, Dr. Jonn M. (John | 15 Grant Place. 1884 
Milton) 
GUNNELL, Francis M., M. D., | 600 20th st. N. W. 1879 
W. 8. N. 
Hatrns, Col. PETER C. (Peter Con- | Engineer’s Office, Potomac Riv. | 1879 
over) Improvement, 2136 Pa. ave. 
1824 Jefferson Place. 
Hains, Mr. Rongrt P. (Robert | Patent Office. 1885 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


NAME. 


Hatt, Prof. Asarn, U.S. N. 
(founder) 
Hatt, Mr. Asapu, Jr., (Absent) 


Hawpock, Dr. WILLIAM 
Hampson, Mr. THOMAS 


Harxness, Prof. WILLIAM, U.S. 
N. (Founder) 

HassLterR, Dr. FERDINAND A. 
(Ferdinand Augustus) (Absent 

Hayprn, Dr. F. V. (Ferdinan 
Vandeveer) (Founder: absent) 

Hazen, Prof. H. A. (Henry Allen) 


Hazen, Gen. W. B. (William 
Babcock) U.S. A. 
Heap, Major D. P. (David Porter) 


HensHaw, Mr. H. W. (Henry 
Wetherbee) 

Hitearp, Mr. J. E. (Julius Eras- 
mus) (Founder: resigned) 

Hitt, Mr. G. W. (George William) 


Hitt, Mr. Rosert T. (Robert 
Thomas) 

HILLEBRAND, Dr. W. F. (William 
Francis) 

Hircucock, Mr. Romyn 


Hopexins, Prof. H. L. (Howard 
Lincoln) 

HoupeEn, Prest. EDWARD SINGLE- 
TON (Absent) 

Hoxtmes, Mr. W. H. (William 
Henry) 

Hower tt, Mr. Epwin E. (Edwin 
Eugene) (Absent) 


Ipprnes, Mr. Josrpu P. (Joseph 
Paxson) 
Irvin@, Prof. R. D. (Roland Duer) 


JAMES, Rev. OWEN (Absent) 

JENKINS, Rear Admiral THORN- 
ton A. (Thornton Alexander) 
U.S. N. (Founder) 

Jounson, Mr. A. B. (Arnold 
Burges) 


ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. 


Naval Observatory. 
2715 N st. N. W. 

Yale College Observatory, New 
Haven, Conn. 

Geological Survey. 

Geological Survey. 
504 Maple ave., Le Droit 
Park. 

Naval Observatory. 
Cosmos Club. 


Santa Afia, Los Angeles Co., Cal. 


Geological Survey. 

1805 Arch st., Phila., Pa. 
P. O. Box 427. 

1416 Corcoran st. 
Army Signal Office. 

1601 K st. N. W. 


Light House Board, Treas. Dept. 


1618 Rhode Island ave. 
Bureau of Ethnology. 
13 Iowa Circle. 


Nautical Almanac Office. 

314 Indiana ave. N. W. 
National Museum. 

1464 Rhode Island ave. 
Geological Survey. 

506 Maple ave., Le Droit Park. 

National Museum. 

Osaka, Japan. 
Columbian University. 

627 N st. N. W. 
University of California, 

Berkeley, Cal. 
Geological Survey. 

1100 O st. N. W. 
48 Oxford st., Rochester, N. Y. 


Geological Survey. 
1028 Vermont ave. 
Geological Survey. 


Scranton, Pa. 
2115 Penna. ave. N. W. 


Light House Board, Treas. Dept. 


501 Maple ave., Le Droit 
Park. 


Year of 
admission. 


— 
[o-¢) 
ai 
— 


1884 
1885 
1885 
1871 
1880 
1871 
1882 
is81_ 
1884 
1874 
1871 
1879 
1886 
1886 
1884 
1885 
1873 
1879 
1874 


1885 
1886 
1880 
1871 


1878 


1323 N st. N. W. 


LIST OF MEMBERS. XXI 
38 
NAME. ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. 5.2 
he 
~] 
Jounson, Dr, JosePH TABER 926 17th st. N. W. 1879 
Jounson, Mr. WILLARD D. (Will- | Geological Survey. 1884 
ard Drake) (Absent 
Jounston, Dr. W. W. (William | 1603 K st. N. W. 1873 
Waring) 
KaurrmMann, Mr. 8. H. (Samuel | 1000 M st. N. W. 1884 
Ha 
tees Prof. R. (Reuel) Nautical Almanac Office. 1871 
1017 M st. N. W. 
Kewnaston, Prof. C. A. (Carlos | Howard University. 1886 
Albert) 
Kerr, Mr. Marx B. (Mark | Geological Survey. 1884 
Brickell) 722 21st st. N. W. 
Kipper, Dr. J. H. (Jerome Henry)} Smithsénian Institution. 1880 
1816 N st. N. W. 
KiILBourngE, Lieut. C. E. (Charles | War Department. 1880 
Evans) U.S. A. (Absent) 
Kine, Dr. A. F. A. (Albert Free- | 726 13th st. N. W. 1875 
man Africanus) 
Knox, Hon. Joun Jay (Absent) | Prest. Nat. Bank Republic, New| 1874 
York city. 
KumMELL, Mr. C. H. (Charles | Coast and Geodetic Survey Office.| 1882 
Hugo) 608 Q st. N. W. 
LAWRENCE, Mr. WILLIAM Bellefontaine, Ohio. 1884 
Lawver, Dr. W. P. (Winfield | Mint Bureau, Treas. Dept. 1881 
Peter) 1912 I st. N. W. 
Lez, Dr. WILLIAM 2111 Penna. ave. N. W. 1874 
1821 I st. N. W. 
Leravour, Mr. Epwarp B. (Ed- | Cambridge, Mass. 1882 
ward Brown) 
Lincoin, Dr. N.S. (Nathan Smith)| 1514 H st. N. W. 1871 
Loomis, Mr. E. J. (Eben Jenks) | Nautical Almanac Office. 1880 
1413 Stoughton st. N. W. 
LULL, Capt. E. P. (Edward Phelps)) Navy Yard, 1875 
U.S. N. (Absent) Pensacola, Fla. 
McApiz, Mr. A. G. (Alexander | Army Signal Office. 1886 
George) ‘¢ Morleigh’’, Anacostia, D. C. 
McDonatp, Col. MarsHALL U.S. Fish Commission. 1886 
1515 R st. N. W. 
McGez, Mr. W J Geological Survey. 1883 
920 14th st. N. W. 
McGuire, Mr. Frep. B. (Freder-| 1416 F st. N. W. 1879 
ick Bauders) 614 KE st. N. W. 
McMurrriz, Prof. WILL1AM University of Dllinois, Cham- | 1876 
(Absent) paign, Il. 
Mauer, Mr. James A. (James | Geological Survey. 1884 
Arran) 21 Est. N. W. 
MALLERY, Col. Garrick, U.S. A.| Bureau of Ethnology. 1875 


XXII 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


NAME. 


Mann, Mr. B: PickMAN (Benja- 
min Pickman) 
Makrcou, Mr. J. B. (John Belknap) 


Martin, Mr. ARTEMAS 


Marvin, Prof. C. F. 
Frederick) 

Marvin, Mr. Jos. B. (Joseph 
Badger) (Absent) 

Mason, Prof. Oris T. (Otis Tufton) 


(Charles 


Marruews, Dr. W. (Washington) 
U.S. A. 

Metras, Gen. M. C. (Montgomery 
Cunningham) U.S. A. (Founder) 

MENDENBALL, Prof.T. C. (Thomas 
Corwin) (Absent) 

Merriam, Dr. C. Hart (Clinton 
Hart) 

MERRILL, Mr. GroraE P. (George 
Perkins) 

MircHe.u, Prof. Henry 


More@an, Dr. E. CARROLL (Ethel- 
bert Carroll) 

Moser, Lt. J. F. (Jefferson Frank- 
lin) U. 8. N. (Absent) 

Murpocu, Mr. JoHNn 


Newcoms, Prof. Simon, U.S. N. 
(Founder) 

Nicuots, Dr, CHaRrzEs H. (Charles 
Henry) (Absent) 


Nicuotson, Mr. W. L. (Walter 
Lamb) (Jounder) 

Norpuorr, Mr. CHARLES 

Norris, Dr. Basi, U.S. A. 
(Absent) 

Nort, Judge C. C. (Charles Cooper) 


Oaptn, Mr. HerBert G. (Herbert 
Gouverneur) 
OsBorne, Mr. J.W. (John Walter) 


Parke, Gen. Joun G. (John 
Grubb) U. 8. A. (Founder) 

Parker, Dr. PETER (Founder) 

Parry, Dr. CHARLEs C. (Charles 
Christopher) (Absent) 


> 
ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. 


Department of Agriculture. 
1918 Sunderland Place, N. W. 
Geological Survey. 
Cosmos Club. 
Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 
55 C st. 8. E. 
Army Signal Office. 
1736 13th st. N. W. 
Internal Revenue Bureau. 


National Museum. 
1305 Q st. N. W. 
Surg. General’s Office, U. 5S. A. 


1239 Vermont ave. 
Terre Haute, Ind. 


Department of Agriculture. 
1912 Sunderland Place, N. W. 
National Museum. 
1602 19th st. N. W. 
Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 
1331 L st. N. W. 
918 E st. N. W. 


Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 


National Museum. 
1441 Chapin st., College Hill. 


Navy Department. 
941 M st. N. W. 
Bloomingdale Asylum, Boule- 
vard and 117th st., New York, 
Nay. 
Topographer, P. O. Dept. 
2109 G st. N. W. 
1731 K st. N. W. 
Vancouver Barracks, Wash. Ter. 


Court of Claims. 
826 Connecticut ave. N. W. 


Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 
1324 19th st. N. W. 
212 Delaware ave. N. E. 


Engineer Bureau, War Dépt. 
16 Lafayette Square. 

2 Lafayette Square. 

Davenport, Lowa. 


Year of 
admission. 


1885 
1884 
1886 
1885 
1878 
1875 
1884 
1871 
1885 
1886 
1884 
1886 
1883 
1885 
1884 


1871 
1872 


1871 


1879 
1884 


1885 


1884 
1878 
1871 


1871 
1871 


a 


LIST OF MEMBERS. XXIII 
35 
Name. ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. a2 
aE 
<4 
Pav, Mr. H. M. (Henry Martyn) | Naval Observatory. 1877 
109 Ist st. N. E. 
PxEALE, Dr, A. C. (Albert Charles) | Geological Survey. 1874 
1010 Mass. ave. N. W. 
Por, Gen. O. M. (Orlando Met- | 34 West Congress st., Detroit, | 1873 
calfe) U.S. A. (Absent) Mich. 
PoinpEexTER, Mr. W. M. (William | 1505 Pennsylvania ave. 1884 
Mundy) 1227 15th st. N. W. 
Porx, Dr. B. F. (Benjamin Frank- | Surg. General’s Office, U. 8. A. | 1882 
lin) U.S. A. 
Powet.t, Major J. W. (John | Geological Survey. 1874 
Wesley) 910 M st. N. W. 
Prentiss, Dr. D. W. (Daniel | 1101 14th st. N. W. 1880 
Webster) 
Pritcuett, Prof. H. S. (Henry | Director of Observatory, Wash. | 1879 
Smith) (Absent) University, St. Louis, Mo. 
RatTHBuUN, Mr. RicHarpD Smithsonian Institution. 1882 
1622 Mass. ave. 
Bari t Lieut. P. H. (Patrick Henry) | Fort Gaston, Cal. 1884 
ey = 
ac, Mr. Jno. H. (John | Geological Survey. 1883 
Henry) 1512 Kingman Place. 
RicksEecKER, Mr. EuGENE Geological Survey. 1884 
1323 Q st. N. W. 
River, Dr. C. V. (Charles Valen- | Agricultural Department, or 1878 
tine) National Museum. 
1700 13th st. N. W. 
Ritter, Mr. W. F. McK. (William | Nautical Almanac Office. 1879 
Francis McKnight) 16 Grant Place. 
Ropinson, Mr. THoMas Howard University. 1884 
6th st. N. W., cor. Lincoln. 
Rocrrs, Mr. Josrpu A. (Joseph | Naval Observatory. 1872 
Addison) (Absent) 
eau Mr. IsraEt C. (Israel | Geological Survey. 1882 
ook) 
Russe.i, Mr. THomas ’ | Army Signal Office. 1883 
1447 Corcoran st. N. W. 
Satmon, Dr. D. E. (Daniel Elmer) | Agricultural Department. 1883 
12 Iowa Circle. 
Sampson, Commander W. T. (Wil-| Naval Academy, 1883 
liam Thomas) U.S. N. (Absent) Annapolis, Md. 
SavItte, Mr. J. H. (James Ham-| 1419 F st. N. W. 1871 
ilton) 1315 M st. N. W. 
Scnorr, Mr. Coaruzs A. (Charles | Coast and Geodetic Survey Office.| 1871 
Anthony) (Founder) 212 Ist st. S. EH. 
SHELLABARGER, Hon. SAMUEL Room 31 Kellogg Building. 1875 
812 17th st. N. W. 
SHERMAN, Hon. JoHN U.S. Senate. 1874 


SHUFELDT, Dr. R. W. (Robert 
Wilson) U.S. A. (Absent) 


1319 K st. N. W. 


Surg. Gen’l’s Office, U. S. A., or| 1881 


Box 144 Smithsonian Inst. 


XXIV 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


NAME. 


Sr1asBEE, Commander C. D. 
(Charles Dwight) U.S. N. (Ad- 
sent) 

Sxinnepr, Dr. J. O. (John Oscar) 
U. 8. :As 

Smrtey, Mr. Cas. W. (Charles 
Wesley) 

Smita, Chf. Eng. Davin, U. 
Si IN. 

SmitH, Mr. EDWIN 


Snevu, Mr. Merwin M. (Merwin 
Marie) 

SporrorD, Mr. A. R. (Ainsworth 
Rand) 

Srearns, Mr. Ropert E. C. (Rob- 
ert Edwards Carter) 

Strong, Prof. ORMoND (Absent) 


Taytor, Mr. F. W. (Frederick 
William) (Adsent) 

Taytor, Mr. WILLIAM B.( William 
BoweEr) (Founder) 

Tuompson, Prof. A. H. (Almon 
Harris) 

Tuompson, Mr. GILBERT 


Topp, Prof. Davip P. (David 
Peck) (Absent) 

Toner, Dr. J. M., (Joseph Mere- 
dith) 

TrenuoLM, Hon. WILLIAM L. 
(William Lee.) 

Truez, Mr. FREDERICK W. (Fred- 
erick William) 


Urron, Mr. Wm. W. (William 
Wirt) 
Urrton, Prof. WINSLow (Absent) 


Watcort, Mr. C. D. (Charles 
Doolittle) 
Waxpo, Prof. Frank (Absent) 


Waker, Mr. Francis A. (Fran- 
cis Amasa) (Absent) 

Watuine, Mr. Henry F. (Henry 
Francis) (Absent) 

Warp, Mr. Lester F. (Lester 
Frank) 


ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. 


Navy Department. 


Surg. General’s Office, U. S. A. 
1529 O st. N. W. 

U.S. Fish Commission. 
943 Mass. ave. 

Navy Department. 


Coast and Geodetic Survey Office. 
2024 Hillyer Place. 
National Museum. 
715 Mt. Vernon Place. 
Library of Congress. 
1621 Mass. ave. N. W. 
Smithsonian Institution. 
1635 18th st. N. W. 
Leander McCormick Observa- 
tory, University of Virginia, 
a 


Care Smithsonian Institution. 


Smithsonian Institution. 
806 C st. N. W. 
Geological Survey. 


Geological Survey. 
1448 Q st. N. W. 

Amherst College Observatory, 
Amherst, Mass. 

615 Louisiana ave. 


Controller of the Currency. 
1812 N st. N. W. 
National Museum. 
1835 N st. N. W. 


1416 F st. N. W. 
1746 M st. N. W. 


-Brown University, Providence, 


Geological Survey; National 
Museum. 

Army Signal Office, Fort Myer, 
Va. 

Massachusetts Institute of Tech- 
nology, Boston, Mass. 

U.S. Geological Survey, Cam- 
bridge, Mass. 

Geological Survey. 
1464 Rhode Island ave. 


Year of 
admission 


1879 


1883 
1882 
1876 
1880 
1886 
1872 
1884 
1874 


1881 
1871 
1875 
1884 
1878 
1873 
1886 
1882 


1882 
1880 


1883: 
1881 
1872 
1883 


1876. 


LIST OF MEMBERS. 


XXV 


NAME. 


WeEssTER, Mr. ALBERT L. (Albert 
Lowry) (Absent) 


WEED, Mr. WALTER H. (Walter 
Harvey) 

WELLING, Mr. James C. (James 
Clarke) 

WHEELER, Capt. Guo. M. (George 
Montague) U.S. E. 

Wuite, Dr. C. A. (Charles Abia- 
thar) 

Waite, Dr. C. H. (Charles Henry) 
U.S. N. 


Wituts, Mr. BAILEY 


Witson, H. M. (Herbert Michael) 

Witson, Mr. J. ORMoND (James 
Ormond) 

Win tock, Mr. WiLi14M C. (Wil- 
liam Crawford) 

Woop, Mr. Josepy (Absent) 


Woop, Lt. W. M. (William Max- 
well) U.S. N. (Absent) 

Woopwarp, Mr. R. S. (Robert 
Simpson) 

WortMay, Dr. J. L. (Jacob Law- 
son) 

Wrieut, Mr. Gro. M. (George 
Mitchell) (Absent) 


Yarrow, Dr. H. C. (Harry Crécy) 


Yeates, Mr. W. S. (William 
Smith) 


ZiweEtT, Mr. ALEXANDER 


ZuMBROCK, Dr. A. (Anton) 


36 


ADDRESS AND RESIDENCE. 


107 Drexel Building, Broad st., 
New York city; West New 
Brighton, Staten Island, N.Y. 

Geological Survey. 

‘The Grammercy ’’, Vermont 
ave. 

1802.Sonnecticut ave. 


Lock Box 93. 

930 16th st. N. W. 
Geological Survey. 

312 Maple ave., Le Droit Park 
Museum of Hygiene, 1744 G st. 

NeW 


Geological Survey. 

1823 H st. N. W. 
Geological Survey. 
1439 Massachusetts ave. N. W. 


Naval Observatory. 
718 21st st. N. W. 

Supt. Motive Power, Penn. Co., 
Fort Wayne, Ind. 

Navy Department. 


Geological Survey. 
1804 Columbia Road. 
Army Medical Museum. 
1711 13th st. N. W. 
Akron, Ohio. 


Surgeon General’s Office, U.S. A. 
814 17th st. N. W. 
Smithsonian Institution. 
1403 6th st. N. W. 


Coast and Geodetic Survey Uftice. 
140 C st. 8. EH. 


Year of 
admission. 


1882 


1885 


1872 
1873 
1876 
1884 
1885 


1885 
1878 


1880 
1875 
1871 
1888 
1885 
1885 


1874 
1884 


1885 
1875 


XXVI PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


LIST OF DECEASED MEMBERS. 


Name. 


Benjamin Alvord 

Orville Elias Babcock 

Theodorus Bailey 

Joseph K. Barnes 

Henry Wayne Blair 

Horace Capron . . 

Salmon Portland Chase 

Frederick Collins 

Benjamin Faneuil Craig. : : : 
Charles Henry Crane . - : g ° 
Josiah Curtis ; 

Richard Dominicus Cutts 

Charles Henry Davis 

Frederick William Dorr 

Alexander B. Dyer . 

Amos Beebe Eaton 

. Charles Ewing 

Elisha Foote - 

John Gray Foster . 

Leonard Dunnell Gale . 

Isaiah Hanscom 

Joseph Henry 

Franklin Benjamin Hough 

Andrew Atkinson Humphreys 

Ferdinand Kampf 

Washington Caruthers Kerr 

Jonathan Homer Lane f 5 : - : 
Oscar A. Mack . . : . . . 
Archibald Robertson Marvine 
Fielding Bradford Meek : 
James William Milner ; : . 
Albert J. Myer . 

George Alexander Otis 

Carlile Pollock Patterson 

Titian Ramsay Peale 

Benjamin Peirce 

John Campbell Riley 

John Rodgers . 

Benjamin ‘Franklin Sands 

George Christian Shaeffer 

Henry Robinson Searle 

William J. Twining . 

Joseph Janvier Woodward 

John Maynard Woodworth 

Mordecai Yarnall : 


SUMMARY. 
Active members 
Absent members : ; c . 


Total 
Deceased members 


Admitted. 


1872 
1871 
1878 
Founder 
1884 
Founder 
Founder 
1879 
Founder 
Founder 
1874 
1871 
1874 
1874 
Founder 
Founder 
1874 
Founder 
1873 
1874 
1873 
Founder 
1879 
Founder 
1875 
1883 
Founder 
1872 
1874 
Founder 
1874 
Founder 
Founder 
1871 
Founder 
Founder 
1877 
1872 
Founder 
Founder 
1877 
1878 
Tounder 
1874 
1871 


XXVIEI 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


02 9 srecesres= ss GAQT 9% ‘aL hes ee rca abt pea 1) 
we 8 TSI SRE | Sesame 
£2 ‘6 3 ‘OL cObL 
12 OL 63 ‘eT Pesestacy Crnanes ra eaesrass ener 
81 ‘b 
0z ‘9 Htaeeeeeeee Cigar 
Z 4, seeeeeeeeee GT 
az S sssessansenseneraneesseeeseneess TORT 
£3 ‘6 seneere?""00GL 
#3 ‘OL “66ST 
8L ‘F * S68T. 
6L g Se ROT: 
0Z ‘9 etter teeeeee epeceeres OORT 
ae *8 eee re seeeeenee en OB OT 
£3 ‘6 sosseeae eesennesnesonennnee gor 
32 ‘OL cesses GOT seensenstseesnennenesens eee gor 
st seeeeeneeeeee pay soseeneseeen canes eneneneeeT gOT 
02 ‘9 
12 ‘h 
aa 8 Misevl cserarsbescssrasVanicesscu Aig 77 
2 ‘6 tages eee ees nen rag eres OR OT, 0 % 
SI‘ Be Pk reterss % 9 ee 
61 ‘9 ¢ 13 ‘L TA 
03 ‘9 9 Go ‘8 
‘ouns ‘qoivyy =| ‘Arenaqogq | “Arenave *sIvOX *1aquI909q | I9QUIBAON | *19q0700 “SIBOK 


“paystiqnd pasepio pur “bggr ‘Z oun aay [er9Uax) oY) 0} payqns 
“LLOITIQ “G “QA “UJN AT Gauvadug 


‘aagsnaue ‘g0,-Lob6r 02 59,931 most ,,suosvas ,, Josanas ayg Suranp sSuyoayy Suipjoy sof SAVAYALVS wvusayv ays Sumoys 
‘ALGIOOS ‘IVOIHdOSOTIHd AHL AO ASN AHL WO UVANATVO 


ee 


tere h 


ve ? Swen ieA ALORS VATE 


bak nm ery Suh, Sly ah gt 


= 


= 
ty 


5 
. 
7 
Bip bed 


iy 


_e 


eo 


—— 


: ti 
mueratt Satin, 


wt 
up 


Loe, Se 


a 


SECRETARIES’ REPORT ped 6d 


ANNUAL REPORT OF THE SECRETARIES. 
Wasuineron, D. C., December 18, 1886. 


To the Philosophical Society of Washington : 


We have the honor to present the following statistical data for 
1886: 


The last Annual Report brought the record of membership 
down to January 16, 1886. The number of active mem- 
bers wasthen . . . ; : : : } fa HS 
This number has been increased by the addition of 18 new 
members, by the return of 1 absent member, and by the 
reinstatement of 2 members previously dropped. It has 
been diminished by the departure of 9 members, by the 
resignation of 1, and by the dropping of 7 for non-pay- 
ment of dues. There has been no death. The net in- 
crease of active members has thus been . ; : : 4 
And the active membership is now. i ‘ 5 2) ESS 


The roll of new members is: 


N. L. Batss. J. C. Gordon. MarsHALL McDona.Lp. 
H. G. BEYER. Lid NS ae oy ARTEMAS MARTIN. 

J. H. Bryan. W.F. HILLEBRAND. C. H. Merriam. 

G. J. CUMMINGS. R. D. Irvina. Henry MITCHELL. 
CooPER CURTICE. C. A. KENASTON. M. M. SNELL. 

N. H. Darton. A. G. McADIE. W. L. TRENHOLM. 


There have been 14 meetings for the presentation and discussion 
of papers (not including the public meeting of December 4); the 
average attendance has been 47. There have been 2 meetings of 
the Mathematical Section; average attendance 16. 

In the general meetings 39 communications have been presented; 
in the mathematical 8. Altogether 42 communications have been 

@ made by 29 members and candidates for membership and by 2 
guests. The number of members who have participated in the dis- 
cussions is 38. The total number who have contributed to the 
scientific proceedings is 49, or 27 per cent. of the present active 
membership. 

The General Committee has held 15 meetings; average attend- 
ance 12, the smallest attendance at any meeting being 7 and the 


largest 15. 
G. K. GILBert, 


Marcus Baker, 
Secretaries. 


XXX PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


THE REPORT OF THE TREASURER. 


Mr. President and Gentlemen: 


The report which I shall presently have the honor to submit to 
you shows the total receipts and disbursements for the fiscal year 
ending with this meeting. 

The actual income belonging to the year 1886 was $878.00, and 
the expenditures for the same period were $451.50, leaving a net 
surplus of $426.50. 

The unpaid dues of former years which have been collected this 
year, amount to $175.00. 

By a resolution of the General Committee, passed May 22, 1886, 
the Treasurer was authorized to invest six hundred dollars of the 
surplus funds of the Society in six second-mortgage bonds of the 
Cosmos Club of this city. The present high premium on Govern- 
ment bonds reduces the annual interest upon them to about 2? per 
cent. The bonds purchased were obtained at par, and pay an 
interest of five per cent. per annum, the security being an extremely 
valuable piece of city property. 


The assets of the Society consist of: 


2 Government bonds, $1,000 and $500, at 4 per cent., $1,500 00 
1 a bond, 1,000, a Re 1,000 00 
6 Cosmos Club bonds, «5 ss 600 00 
Cash with Riggs & Cosi ite aa) 6 |e cwihel wii doe) ee 
Unpaid:dues cod cee. mad? 7S. nhs See ose 


PROBE cys sto gach Rach rd pputeoecins, «110 grag oi anaes elk ea 


Of the “unpaid dues” it is probable that a part cannot be col- 
lected; on the other hand, the market value of the bonds is in® 
excess of their face value. 

Volume VIII of the Bulletin was duly sent in February to all 
members entitled to receive it, and to the societies and scientific 
journals with which it is the custom of the Philosophical Society to 
exchange its publications. 


XXXI 


TREASURER’S REPORT. 


‘vainsna4y, “SHHOLATA LYALOW 


"O88T ‘ST vaquasag ‘NOLDNIHSV A 


Soo 


20 LEg'Tg 60 L89'T$ 
ICTs ea at i ae ate OD B sHSry YIM ooureg |) 00 OZI 
Zo 86 Tote rens sm s=—-o9g ‘QI [BOIIE[ ‘AIIUOTy 00: Gis = 980 
-vys ‘osvysod 10j JoInsvaly, put solayze100g -19}UI $,0U 9 n- 8 VOT =--} 
Jo sosuodxe snoouvyjaostur 103 pred ysvo Ag 0028t:- = a » 6 O00T » 
cP 8g See are nae ‘048 ‘sprvo [wysod ‘srvpno11o O0209Gs==5 = Sees ‘yuoo sed F 48 QOG'TE UO 
—suyulid snoourjaostut 10g pred ysvo Aq ‘gt ‘00g : Spuoq UO 4sorOJUT IOJ ” ” 
00 009 ==" qQnIO soulsop ‘spuoq 9g 03 pred ysvo Ag OOL08Ls = “9881 ” ” ” 
HOGE be a5 pee Por ea COOgE: Os 9881 i oe 
GI ¥8 souvpus;3e soz s0yruel pred ysvo gq ‘yz Avy || 00 Gp 277 PSST ” » ” 
I 7s a alga PANE Fee ulqelIng oqy COe8 Se 8881 JO sonp 10g ” ” 
JOTITA ‘(OA Surddvim pure ‘Surpurq ‘Sur 00 8 “““Ulja[Ng JO sayvs WIOIJ POATADI YSvd 4, “QT “00q 
“quyad Joy opomyoq » ppne pred ysvo Ag “GT “Ivy || ZO F8PS ~~~SSBI ‘GT ‘20q ‘Puy UO Ysvo oouL[eq of, 
‘9881 ‘988T 
im: 18) ‘uopburysoyy fo hgars0g yoorydosonyg YF, Yn qunovnp we sainspany, 2Y.L "aq 


a 


Fig’ i; : ‘ i _ 
US Uva Sevita be ee. 


r? t aaa 
tg | 7 
Arts: HK : ; 
pee ig -eegee . | 7 | 
3 = iv tes 
were. Soa sis j | pe 
eis ; 
iS 
; 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON, 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. 


XXXIII 


. " 
A 
‘ 
A -_ i" 
* A 
‘® t 
oh , . 
iv A Med z . 
hes 
; ¥ . 
h* j 
y 
I 
ry iA y 
» 
of i a 
Vee | Ne 
i. an wat | 
j ; 
j 
* 
Bre 
* . 
4 
i 
‘ 
" 
f , 
} ‘ 
j 
4 
; 
ord ol fF 
Wee ee 
, 
, 
nik! 
ad { 
i 
+ 1 
t 
+ 4 Si J 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT, 


JOHN S. BILLINGs. 


Delivered December 4, 1886. 


SCIENTIFIC MEN AND THEIR DUTIES. 


Mr. Chairman and Fellow-Members of the Philosophical Society : 


The honor of the presidency of such a society as this—carrying 
with it, as it does, the duty of giving at the close of the term of 
office an address on some subject of general interest, has been aptly 
compared to the little book mentioned in the Revelations of St. 
John—the little book which was “sweet in the mouth but bitter in 
the belly.” I can only thank you for the honor, and ask your in- 
dulgence as to the somewhat discursive remarks which - am about 
to inflict upon you. ‘ 

There is a Spanish proverb to the effect that no man can at the 
same time ring the bell and walk in the procession. For a few mo- 
ments to-night I am to ring the bell, and being thus out of the pro- 
cession I can glance for a moment at that part of it which is nearest, 
At first sight it does not appear to be a very homogeneous or well- 
ordered parade, for the individual members seem to be scattering in 
every direction, and even sometimes to be pulling in opposite ways; 
yet there is, after all, a definite movement of the whole mass in the 
direction of what we call progress. It is not this general movement 
that I shall speak of, but rather of the tendencies of individuals or 
of certain classes; some of the molecular movements, so to speak, 
which are not only curious and interesting of themselves, but which 
have an important bearing upon the mass, and some comprehension 
of which is necessary to a right understanding of the present con- 
dition and future prospects of science in this country. 

The part of the procession of which I speak is made up of that body 
or class of men who are known to the public generally as “scientists,” 
“scientific men,” or “men of science.” As commonly used, all these 
terms have much the same significance ; but there are, nevertheless, 
shades of distinction between them, and in fact we need several other 


XXXV 


XXXVI PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


terms for purposes of classification of the rather heterogeneous mass 
to which they are applied. The word “scientist” is a coinage of the 
newspaper reporter, and, as ordinarily used, is very comprehensive. 
Webster defines a scientist as being “one learned in science, a 
savant ’’—that is, a wise man—and the word is often used in this 
sense. But the suggestion which the word conveys to my mind is 
rather that of one whom the public suppose to be a wise man, 
whether he is so or not, of one who claims to be scientific. I shall, 
therefore, use the term “scientist” in the broadest sense, as including 
scientific men, whether they claim to be such or not, and those who 
claim to be scientific men whether they are so or not. 

By a scientific man I mean a man who uses scientific method 
in the work to which he specially devotes himself; who possesses 
scientific knowledge,—not in all departments, but in certain 
special fields. By scientific knowledge we mean knowledge which 
is definite and which can be accurately expressed. It is true 
that this can rarely be done completely, so that each proposition 
shall precisely indicate its own conditions, but this is the ideal at 
which we aim. There is no man now living who can properly be 
termed a complete savant, or scientist, in Webster’s sense of the 
word. There are a few men who are not only thoroughly scientific 
in their own special departments, but are also men possessed of 
much knowledge upon other subjects and who habitually think 
scientifically upon most matters to which they give consideration ; 
but these men are the first to admit the incompleteness and super- 
ficiality of the knowledge of many subjects which they possess, and 
to embrace the opportunity which such a society as this affords of 
meeting with students of other branches, and of making that 
specially advantageous exchange in which each gives and receives, 
yet retains all that he had at first. 

Almost all men suppose that they think scientifically upon all 
subjects; but, as a matter of fact, the number of persons who are so 
free from personal equation due to heredity, to early associations, to 
emotions of various kinds, or to temporary disorder of the digestive 
or nervous machinery that their mental vision is at all times achro- 
matic and not astigmatic, is very small indeed. 

Every educated, healthy man possesses some scientific knowledge, 
and it is not possible to fix any single test or characteristic which 
will distinguish the scientific from the unscientific man. There are 
scientific tailors, bankers, and politicians, as well as physicists, 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XXXVII 


chemists, and biologists. Kant’s rule, that in each special branch 
of knowledge the amount of science, properly so called, is equal to 
the amount of mathematics it contains, corresponds to the definition 
of pure science as including mathematics and logic, and nothing 
else. It also corresponds to the distinction which most persons, 
consciously or unconsciously, make between the so-called physical, 
and the natural or biological sciences. Most of us, I presume, have 
for the higher mathematics, and for the astronomers and physicists 
who use them, that profound respect which pertains to comparative 
ignorance, and to a belief that capacity for the higher branches 
of abstract analysis is a much rarer mental quality than are those 
required for the average work of the naturalist. I do not, however, 
propose to discuss the hierarchy of the sciences; and the term science 
is now so generally used in the sense of knowledge, more or less 
accurate, of any subject, more especially in the relations of causes 
and effects, that we must use the word in this sense, and leave to 
the future the task of devising terms which will distinguish the 
sciences, properly so called, from those branches of study and occu- 
pation of which the most that can be said is that they have a scien- 
tific side. It isa sad thing that words should thus become polar- 
ized and spoiled, but there seems to be no way of preventing it. 

In a general way we may say that a scientific man exercises the 
intellectual more than the emotional faculties, and is governed by 
his reason rather than by his feelings. Heshould be a man of both 
general and special culture, who has a little accurate information 
on many subjects and much accurate information on some one or 
two subjects, and who, moreover, is aware of his own ignorance and 
is not ashamed to confess it. 

We must admit that many persons who are known as scientists 
do not correspond to this definition. Have you never heard, and 
perhaps assented to, some such statements as these: “Smith is a 
scientist, but he doesn’t seem to have good, common sense,” or “ he 
is a scientific crank ?” 

The unscientific mind has been defined as one which “is willing 
to accept and make statements of which it has no clear conceptions 
to begin with, and of whose truth it is not assured. It is the state 
of mind where opinions are given and accepted without ever being 
subjected to rigid tests.” Accepting this definition, and also the 
implied definition of a scientific mind as being the reverse of this, 
let us for a moment depart from the beaten track which presi- 


XXXVIII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


dential addresses usually follow, and instead of proceeding at once 
to eulogize the scientific mind and to recapitulate the wonderful 
results it has produced, let us consider the unscientific mind a little, 
not in a spirit of lofty condescension and. ill-disguised contempt, 
but sympathetically, and from the best side that we can find. As 
this is the kind of mind which most of us share with our neighbors, 
to a greater or less degree, it may be as well not to take too gloomy 
a view of it. In the first place, the men with unscientific minds 
form the immense majority of the human race. 

Our associations, habits, customs, laws, occupations, and pleasures 
are, if the main, suited to these unscientific minds; whose enjoyment 
of social intercourse, of the every-day occurrences of life, of fiction, 
of art, poetry, and the drama is, perhaps, none the less because 
they give and accept opinions without subjecting them to rigid 
tests. It is because there are a goodly number of men who do this 
that the sermons of clergymen, the advice of lawyers, and the pre- 
scriptions of physicians have a market value. This unscientific 
public has its uses. We can at least claim that we furnish the ma- 
terials for the truly scientific mind to work with and upon; it is out 
of this undifferentiated mass that the scientific mind supposes itself 
to be developed by specialization, and from it that it obtains the 
means of its own existence. The man with the unscientific mind, 
who amuses himself with business enterprises, and who does not 
care in the least about ohms or pangenesis, may, nevertheless, be a 
man who does as much good in the world, is as valuable a citizen, 
and as pleasant a companion as some of the men of scientific minds 
with whom we are acquainted. . 

And in this connection I venture to express my sympathy for two 
classes of men who have in all ages been generally condemned and 
scorned by others, namely, rich men and those who want to be rich. 

I do not know that they need the sympathy, for our wealthy citi- 
zens appear to support with much equanimity the disapprobation 
with which they are visited by lecturers and writers—a condemna- 
tion which seems in all ages to have been bestowed on those who 
have by those who have not. 

So far as those who actually are rich are concerned, we may, I 
suppose, admit that a few of them—those who furnish the money to 
endow universities and professorships, to build laboratories, or to 
furnish in other ways the means of support to scientific men—are 
not wholly bad. Then, also, it is not always a man’s own fault that 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XXXIX 


he is rich; even a scientist may accidentally and against his will 
become rich. 

As to those who are not rich, but who wish to be rich, whose chief 
desire and object is to make money, either to avoid the necessity for 
further labor, or to secure their wives and children from want, or 
for the sake of power and desire to rule, I presume it is unsafe to 
try to offer any apologies for their existence. But when it is 
claimed for any class of men, scientists or others, that they do not 
want these things it is well to remember the remarks made by old 
Sandy Mackay after he had heard a sermon on universal brotherhood: 
“And so the deevil’s dead. Puir auld Nickie; and himso little ap- 
preciated, too. Every gowk laying his sins on auld Nick’s back. 
But I’d no bury him until he began to smell a wee strong like. 
It’s a grewsome thing is premature interment.” 

I have tried to indicate briefly the sense in which the terms “sci- 
entist”’ and “scientific man” are to be used and understood, and 
you see it is not an easy matter. The difficulty is less as regards 
the term “man of science.” By this expression we mean a man who 
belongs to science peculiarly and especially, whose chief object in 
life is scientific investigation, whose thoughts and hopes and desires 
are mainly concentrated upon his search for new knowledge, whose 
thirst for fresh and accurate information is constant and insatiable. 
These are the men who have most advanced science, and whom we 
delight to honor, more especially in these later days, by glowing 
eulogiums of their zeal, energy, and disinterestedness. 

The man of science, as defined by his eulogists, is the beaw idéal 
of a philosopher, a man whose life is dedicated to the advancement 
of knowledge for its own sake, and not for the sake of money or 
fame, or of professional position or advancement. He undertakes 
scientific investigations exclusively or mainly because he loves the 
work itself, and not with any reference to the probable utility of 
the results. Such men delight in mental effort, or in the observa- 
tion of natural phenomena, or in experimental work, or in historical 
research, in giving play to their imagination, in framing hypotheses 
and then in endeavoring to verify or disprove them, but always the 
main incentive is their own personal satisfaction (with which may 
be mingled some desire for personal fame), and not the pleasure or 
the good of others. Carried to an extreme, the eulogy of such men 
and their work is expressed in the toast of the Mathematical Society 
of England: “Pure mathematics; may it never be of use to any 


XL PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 
man!” Now, it is one thing to seek one’s own pleasure, and quite 
another thing to pride one’s self upon doing so. « The men who do 
their scientific work for the love of it do some of the best work, and, 
as a rule, do not pride themselves on it, or feel or express contempt 
for those who seek their pleasure and amusement in other direc- 
tions. It is only from a certain class of eulogists of pure science, so 
called, that we get such specimens of scientific “dudeism” as the toast 
just quoted, opposed to which may be cited the Arab saying that 
“A wise man without works is like a cloud without water.” 

There are other men who devote themselves to scientific work, 
but who prefer to seek information that may be useful; who try to 
advance our knowledge of Nature’s laws in order that man may 
know how to adapt himself and his surroundings to those laws, and 
thus be healthier and happier. They make investigations, like the 
men of pure science—investigations in which they may or may not 
take pleasure, but which they make, even if tedious and disagree- 
able, for the sake of solving some problem of practical importance. 
These are the men who receive from the public the most honor, for 
it is seen that their work benefits others. After all, this is not 
peculiar to the votaries of science. In all countries and all times, 
and among all sorts and conditions of men, it has always been 
agreed that the best life, that which most deserves praise, is that 
which is devoted to the helping others, which is unselfish, not stained 
by envy or jealousy, and which has as its main pleasure and spring 
of action the desire of making other lives more pleasant, of bringing 
light into the dark places, of helping humanity. 

But, on the other hand, the man who makes a profession of doing 
this, and who makes a living by so doing, the professional philan- 
thropist, whether he be scientist or emotionalist, is by no means to 
be judged by his own assertions. Some wise German long ago re- 
marked that “Esel singen schlecht, weil sie zu hoch anstimmen” —that 
is, “asses sing badly because they pitch their voices too high,” and 
it is a criticism which it is well to bear in mind. 

In one of the sermons of Kin O* the preacher tells the story 
of a powerful clam who laughed at the fears of other fish, saying 
that when he shut himself up he felt no anxiety ; but on trying this 
method on one occasion when he again opened his shell he found 
himself in a fishmonger’s shop. And to rely on one’s own talents, 


* Cornhill Magazine, August, 1869, p. 196. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. xXLI 


on the services one may have rendered, on cleverness, judgments 
strength, or official position, and to feel secure in these, is to court 
the fate of the clam. 

There are not very many men of science, and there are no satis- 
factory means of increasing the number; it is just as useless to ex- 
hort men to love science, or to sneer at them because they do not, 
as it is to advise them to be six feet three inches high or to condemn 
a man because his hair is not red. 

While the ideal man of science must have a “clear, cold, keen 
intellect, as inevitable and as merciless in its conclusions as a logic 
engine,” it would seem that, in the opinion of some, his greatness 
and superiority consists not so much in the amount of knowledge 
he possesses, or in what he does with it, as in the intensity and 
purity of his desire for knowledge. 

This so-called thirst for knowledge must be closely analogous to 
an instinctive desire for exercise of an organ or faculty, such as 
that which leads a rat to gnaw, or a man of fine physique to delight 
in exercise. Such instincts should not be neglected. If the rat 
does not gnaw, his teeth will become inconvenient or injurious to 
himself, but it is not clear that he deserves any special eulogium 
merely because he gnaws. 

It will be observed that the definition of a scientific man or 
man of science, says nothing about his manners or morals. We 
may infer that-a man devoted to science would have neither time 
nor inclination for dissipation or vice; that he would be virtuous 
either because of being passionless or because of his clear foresight 
of the consequences of yielding to temptation. 

My own experience, however, would indicate that either this 
inference is not correct or that some supposed scientific men have 
been wrongly classified as such. How far the possession of a scien- 
tific mind and of scientific knowledge compensates, or atones for, 
ill-breeding or immorality, for surliness, vanity, and petty jealousy, 
for neglect of wife or children, for uncleanliness, physical and 
mental, is a question which can only be answered in each individual 
case; but the mere fact that a man desires knowledge for its own 
sake appears to me to have little to do with such questions. I 
would prefer to know whether the man’s knowledge and work is of 
any use to his fellow-men, whether he is the cause of some happiness 
in others which would not exist without him. And it may be noted 
that while utility is of small account in the eyes of some eulogist, 

37 


XLII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


of the man of science they almost invariably base their claims for 
his honor and support upon his usefulness. : 

The precise limit beyond which a scientist should not make 
money has not yet been precisely determined, but in this vicinity 
there are some reasons for thinking that the maximum limit is 
about $5,000 per annum. If there are any members of the Philo- 
sophical Society of Washington who are making more than this, or 
who, as the result of careful and scientific introspection, discover in 
themselves the dawning of a desire to make more than this, they 
may console themselves with the reflection that the precise ethics 
and etiquette which should govern their action under such painful 
circumstances have not yet been formulated. The more they 
demonstrate their indifference to mere pecuniary considerations the 
more creditable it is to them; so much all are agreed upon; but 
this is nothing new, nor is it specially applicable to scientists. Yet 
while each may and must settle such questions as regards himself 
for himself, let him be very cautious and chary about trying to 
settle them for other people. Denunciations of other men engaged 
in scientific pursuits on the ground that their motives are not the 
proper ones are often based on insufficient or inaccurate knowledge, 
and seldom, I think, do good. 

This is a country and an age of hurry, and there seems to be a 
desire to rush scientific work as well as other things. One might 
suppose, from some of the literature on the subject, that the great 
object is to make discoveries as fast as possible; to get all the math- 
ematical problems worked out; all the chemical combinations made; 
all the insects and plants properly labeled; all the bones and mus- 
cles of every animal figured and described. From the point of view 
of the man of science there does not seem to be occasion for such 
haste. Suppose that every living thing were known, figured, and 
described. Would the naturalist be any happier? Those who wish 
to make use of the results of scientific investigation of course 
desire to hasten the work, and when they furnish the means we can- 
not object to their urgency. Moreover, there is certainly no occa- 
sion to fear that our stock of that peculiar form of bliss known as 
ignorance will be soon materially diminished. 

From my individual point of view, one of the prominent features _ 
in the scientific procession is that part of it which is connected with 
Government work. Our Society brings together a large number of 
scientific men connected with the various Departments; some of 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLIII 


them original investigators; most of them men whose chief, 
though not only, pleasure is study. A few of them have important 
administrative duties, and are brought into close relations with the 
heads of Departments and with Congress. Upon men in such posi- 
tions a double demand is made, and they are subject to criticism 
from two very different standpoints. On the one hand are the sci- 
entists, calling for investigations which shall increase knowledge 
without special reference to utility, and sometimes asking that em- 
ployment be given to a particular scientist on the ground that the 
work to which he wishes to devote himself is of no known use, and 
therefore will not support him. On the other hand is the demand 
from the business men’s point of view—that they shall show prac- 
tical results; that in demands for appropriations from the public 
funds they shall demonstrate that the use to be made of such appro- 
priations is for the public good, and that their accounts shall show 
that the money has been properly expended—“ properly,’ not 
merely in the sense of usefully, but also in the legal sense—in the 
sense which was meant by Congress in granting the funds. Nay, 
more, they must consider not only the intentions of Congress but 
the opinions of the accounting officers of the Treasury, the comp- 
troller and auditor, and their clerks, and not rely solely on their 
own interpretation of the statutes, if they would work to the best 
advantage, and not have life made a perpetual burden and vexation 
of spirit. 

There is a tendency on the part of business men and lawyers to 
the belief that scientific men are not good organizers or administra- 
tors, and should be kept in leading strings; that it is unwise to 
trust them with the expenditure of, or the accounting for, money, 
and that the precise direction in which they are to investigate should 
be pointed out to them. In other words, that they should be made 
problem-solving machines as far as possible. 

When we reflect on the number of persons who, like Mark Twain’s 
cat, feel that they are “nearly lightning on superintending;” on the 
desire for power and authority, which is almost universal, the ten- 
dency to this opinion is not to be wondered at. Moreover, as re- 
gards the man of science, there is some reason for it in the very 
terms by which he is defined, the characteristics for which he is 
chiefly eulogized. 

The typical man of science is, in fact, in many cases an abnor- 
mity, just as a great poet, a great painter, or a great musician is 


XLIV PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


apt to be, and this not only in an unusual development of one part 
of the brain, but in an inferior development in othérs. True, there 
are exceptions to this rule—great and illustrious exceptions; but I 
think we must admit that the man of science often lacks tact, and 
is indifferent to and careless about matters which do not concern 
his special work, and especially about matters of accounts and 
pecuniary details. Ifsuch a man is at the head of a bureau, whose 
work requires many subordinates and the disbursement of large 
sums of money, he may consider the business management of his 
office as a nuisance, and delegate as much of it as possible to some 
subordinate official, who, after a time, becomes the real head and 
director of the bureau. Evil results have, however, been very-rare, 
and the recognition of the possibility of their occurrence is by no 
means an admission that they are a necessity, and still less of the 
proposition that administrative officers should not be scientific men. 

I feel very sure that there are always available scientific men, 
thoroughly well informed in their several departments, who are also 
thoroughly good business men, and are as well qualified for admin- 
istrative work as any. When such men are really wanted they can 
always be found, and, as a matter of fact, a goodly number of them 
have been found, and are now in the Government service. 

The head of a bureau has great responsibilities; and while his 
position is, in many respects, a desirable one, it would not be eagerly 
sought for by most scientific men if its duties were fully understood. 

In the first place the bureau chief must give up a great part of 
his time to routine hack work. During his business, or office, hours 
he can do little else than this routine work, partly because of its 
amount, and partly because of the frequent interruptions to which 
he is subjected. His visitors are of all kinds and come from all 
sorts of motives—some to pass away half an hour, some to get infor- 
mation, some seeking office. It will not work well if he takes the 
ground that his time is too important to be wasted on casual callers 
and refers them to some assistant. 

In the second place he must, to a great extent at least, give up the 
pleasure of personal investigation of questions that specially interest 
him, and turn them over to others. It rarely happens that he can 
earry out his own plans in his own way, and perhaps it is well that 
this should be the case. The general character of his work is usually 
determined for him either by his predecessors, or by Congress, or by 
the general consensus of opinion of scientific men interested in the 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLV 


particular subject or subjects to which it relates. This last has very 
properly much weight; in fact, it has much more weight than one 
might suppose, if he judged from some criticisms made upon the work 
of some of our bureaus whose work is more or less scientific. In these 
criticisms it is urged that the work has not been properly planned and 
correlated; that it should not be left within the power of one man to 
say what should be done; that the plans for work should be prepared 
by disinterested scientific men—as, for instance, by a committee of 
the National Academy—and that the function of the bureau official 
should be executive only. 

I have seen a good deal of this kind of literature within the last 
ten or twelve years, and some of the authors of it are very distin- 
guished men in scientific work; yet I venture to question the wis- 
dom of such suggestions. As a rule, the plans for any extended 
scientific work to be undertaken by a Government department are 
the result of very extended consultations with specialists, and meet 
with the approval of the majority of them. Were it otherwise the 
difficulties in obtaining regular annual appropriations for such work 
would be great and cumulative, for in a short time the disapproval 
of the majority of the scientific public would make itself felt in 
Congress. It is true that the vis inertia of an established bureau 
is very great. The heads of Departments change with each new 
administration, but the heads of bureaus remain; and if an unfit 
man succeeds in obtaining one of these positions, it is a matter 
of great difficulty to displace him; but it seems to me to be wiser to 
direct the main effort to getting right men in right places rather 
than to attempt to elaborate a system which shall give good results 
with inferior men as the executive agents, which attempt is a waste 
of energy. 

You are all familiar with the results of the inquiry which has 
been made by a Congressional committee into the organization and 
work of certain bureaus which are especially connected with scien- 
tific interests, and with the different opinions which this inquiry has 
brought out from scientific men. I think that the conclusion of the 
majority of the committee, that the work is, on the whole, being 
well done, and that the people are getting the worth of their money, 
is generally assented to. True, some mistakes have ‘been made, 
some force has been wasted, some officials have not given satisfac- 
tion; but is it probable that any other system would give so much 
better results that it is wise to run the risks of change? 


XLVI PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


This question brings us to the only definite proposition which has 
been made in this direction, namely, the proposed Department of 
Science, to which all the bureaus whose work is mainly scientific, 
such as the Coast Survey, the Geological Survey, the Signal Service, 
the Naval Observatory, ete., shall be transferred. 

The arguments in favor of this are familiar to you, and, as re- 
gards one or two of the bureaus, it is probable that the proposed 
change would effect an improvement; but as to the desirability of 
centralization and consolidation of scientific interests and scientific 
work into one department under a single head, I confess that I have 
serious doubts. 

One of the strongest arguments in favor of such consolidation 
that I have seen is the address of the late president of the 
Chemical Society of Washington, Professor Clarke, “On the Re- 
lations of the Government to Chemistry,” delivered about a year 
ago. Professor Clarke advises the creation of a large, completely- 
equipped laboratory, planned by chemists and managed by chemists, 
in which all the chemical researches required by any department of 
the Government shall be made, and the abandonment of individual 
laboratories in the several bureaus on the ground that these last are 
small, imperfectly equipped, and not properly specialized ; that each 
chemist in them has too broad a range of duty and receives too 
small a salary to command the best professional ability. He would 
have a national laboratory, in which one specialist shall deal only 
with metals, another with food products, a third with drugs, ete., 
while over the whole, directing and correlating their work, shall 
preside the ideal chemist, the all-round man, recognized as the 
leader of the chemists of the United States. And so should the 
country get better and cheaper results. It is an enticing plan and 
one which might be extended to many other fields of work. Grant- 
ing the premises that we shall have the best possible equipment, 
with the best possible man at the head of it, and a sufficient corps 
of trained specialists, each of whom will contentedly do his own 
work as directed and be satisfied, so that there shall be no jealousies, 
or strikes, or boycotting, and we have made a long stride toward 
Utopia. But before we centralize in this way we must settle the 
question of classification. Just as in arranging a large library there 
are many books which belong in several different sections, so it is in 
applied science. Is it certain that the examination of food products 
or of drugs should be made under the direction of the national 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLVII 


chemist rather than under that of the Departments which are most 
interested in the composition and quality of these articles? This does 
not seem to me to be a self-evident proposition by any means. 

The opinion of a scientific man as to whether the Government 
should or should not undertake to carry out any particular branch of 
scientific research and publish the results, whether it should attempt 
to do such work through officers of the Army and Navy, or more 
or less exclusively through persons specially employed for the pur- 
pose, whether the scientific work shall be done under the direction 
of those who wish to use, and care only for, the practical results, or 
whether the scientific man shall himself be the administrative head 
and direct the manner in which his results.shall be applied; the 
opinion of a scientific man on such points, I say, will differ accord- 
ing to the part he expects or desires to take in the work, according 
to the nature of the work, according to whether he is an Army 
or Navy officer or not, according to whether he takes more 
pleasure in scientific investigations than in administrative prob- 
lems, and so forth. 

It is necessary, therefore, to apply a correction for personal equa- 
tion to each individual set of opinions before its true weight and value 
ean be estimated, and, unfortunately, no general formula for this 
purpose has yet been worked out. 

I can only indicate my own opinions, which are those of an Army 
officer, who has all he wants to do, who does not covet any of his 
neighbors’ work or goods, and who does not care to have any more 
masters than those whom he is at present trying to serve. You see 
that I give you some of the data for the formula by which you are 
to correct my statements, but this is all I can do. 

I am not inclined at present to urge the creation of a department 
of science as an independent department of the Government having 
at its head a Cabinet officer. Whether such an organization may 
become expedient in the future seems to me doubtful; but at all 
events I think the time has not yet come for it. 

I do not believe that Government should undertake scientific 
work merely or mainly because it is scientific, or because some 
useful results may possibly be obtained from it. It should do, or 
cause to be done, such scientific work as is needful for its own in- 
formation and guidance when such work cannot be done, or cannot 
be done so cheaply or conveniently, by private enterprise. Some 
kinds of work it can best have done by private contract, and not by 


XLVIII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


officials; others, by its own officers. To this last class belong those 
branches of scientific investigation, or the means for promoting 
them, which require long-continued labor and expenditure on a 
uniform plan—such as the work of the Government Observatory, 
of the Government surveys, of the collection of the statistics which 
are so much needed for legislative guidance, and in which we are at 
present so deficient, the formation of museums and libraries, and so 
forth. 

Considering the plans and operations of these Government insti- 
tutions from the point of view of the scientific public, it is highly 
desirable that they should contribute to the advancement of abstract 
science, as well as to fhe special practical ends for which they have 
been instituted; but from the point of view of the legislator, who 
has the responsibility of granting the funds for their support, the 
practical results should receive the chief consideration, and there- 
fore they should be the chief consideration on the part of those who 
are to administer these trusts. It must be borne in mind that while 
the average legislator is,in many cases, not qualified to judge a 
priori as to what practical results may be expected from a given 
plan for scientific work, he is, nevertheless, the court which is to 
decide the question according to the best evidence which he can get, 
or, rather, which is brought before him, and it is no unimportant 
part of the duty of those who are experts in these matters to fur- 
nish such evidence. 

But in saying that practical results should be the chief considera- 
tion of the Government and of its legislative and administrative 
agents it is not meant that these should be the only considerations. 
In the carrying out of any extensive piece of work which involves 
the collection of data, experimental inquiry, or the application of 
scientific results under new conditions there is more or less oppor- 
tunity to increase knowledge at the same time and with compara- 
tively little increased cost. Such opportunity should be taken ad- 
vantage of, and is also a proper subsidiary reason for adopting one 
plan of work in preference to another, or for selecting for appoint- 
ment persons qualified not only to do the particular work which is 
the main object, but also for other allied work of a more purely 
scientific character. 

On the same principle it seems to me proper and expedient that 
when permanent Government employees have at times not enough 
to do in their own departments, and can be usefully employed in 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLIX 


scientific work, it is quite legitimate and proper to thus make use 
of them. For example, it is desirable that this country should have 
such an organization of its Army and Navy as will permit of rapid 
expansion when the necessity arises, and this requires that more 
officers shall be educated and kept in the service than are needed for 
military and naval duty in time of peace. It has been the policy of 
the Government to employ some of these officers in work connected 
with other departments, and especially in work which requires 
such special training, scientific or administrative, or both, as such 
officers possess. ‘To this objections are raised, which may be summed 
up as follows: 

First, that such officers ought not to be given positions which 
_ would otherwise be filled by civilian scientists, because these places 
are more needed by the civilians as a means of earning subsistence, 
and because it tends to increase the competition for places and to 
’ lower salaries. Put in other words, the argument is that it is in- 
jurious to the interests of scientific men, taken as a body, that the 
Government should employ in investigations or work requiring 
special knowledge and skill men who have been educated and 
trained at its expense, and who are permanently employed and paid 
by it. This is analogous to the trades union and the anti-convict 
labor platforms. 

The second objection is that Army and Navy officers do not, asa 
rule, possess the scientific and technical knowledge to properly per- 
form duties lying outside of the sphere of the work for which they 
have been educated, and that they employ as subordinates really 
skilled scientific men, who make the plans and do most of the work, 
but do not receive proper credit for it. The reply to this is that it 
is a question of fact in each particular case, and that if the officer is 
able to select and employ good men to prepare the plans and to do 
the work, this in itself is a very good reason for giving him the 
duty of such selection and employment. 

A third objection is that when an officer of the Army or Navy is 
detailed for scientific or other special work the interests of this 
work and of the public are too often made subordinate to the 
interests of the naval or military service, more especially in the 
matter of change of station. For example, civil engineers object to 
the policy of placing river and harbor improvements in the hands 
of Army engineers, because one of the objects kept in view by the 
War Department in making details for this purpose is to vary the 


L PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


duty of the individual officer from time to time so as to give him a 
wider experience. Hence it may happen that an officer placed on 
duty in connection with the improvement of certain harbors on the 
Great Lakes shall, after three or four years, and just as he has gained 
sufficient experience of the peculiarities of lake work to make his 
supervision there peculiarly valuable, be transferred to work on the - 
improvement of the Lower Mississippi with which he may be quite 
unfamiliar. 

In like manner Professor Clarke objects to having a labora- 
tory connected with the medical department of the Navy on the 
ground that the officer in charge is changed every three years; 
consequently science suffers in order that naval routine may be pre- 
served. 

There is force in this class of objections, but the moral I should 
draw from them is, not that Army and Navy officers should not be 
allowed to do work outside their own departments or in science, 
but that when they are put upon such duty, the ordinary routine of 
change of station every three or four years should not be enforced 
upon them without careful consideration of the circumstances of the 
case, and satisfactory evidence that the work on which they are en- 
gaged will not suffer by the change. And, as a matter of fact, I 
believe this has been the policy pursued, and instances could be given 
where an officer has been kept twenty years at one station for this 
very reason. 

I pass over a number of objections that I have heard made to the 
employment of Army and Navy officers as administrators, on the 
ground that they are too “ bumptious,” or “domineering,” or “super- 
cilious,” or “finicky,” because every one knows what these mean and 
their force. An Army officer is not necessarily a polished gentleman ; 
neither is a civilian; and a good organizer and administrator, 
whether officer or civilian, will at times, and especially to some 
people, appear arbitrary and dictatorial. 

There is another objection to special details of Army or Navy 
officers for scientific duties which comes not so much from outside 
persons as from the War Department and the officers themselves, 
and it is this: Among such officers there are always a certain num- 
ber who not only prefer special details to routine duty, but who 
actively seek for such details, who are perpetual»eandidates for 
them. 

The proportion of men whose ideas as to their own scientific ac- 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. Lt 


quirements, merits, and claims to attention are excessive as com- 
pared with the ideas of their acquaintances on the same points is not 
greater in the Army than elsewhere, but when an Army officer is 
afflicted in this way the attack is sometimes very severe, and the 
so-called influence which he brings to bear may cause a good deal 
of annoyance to the Department, even if it be not sufficient to obtain 
his ends. I have heard officers of high rank, in a fit of impatience 
under such circumstances, express a most hearty and emphatic wish 
that no special details were possible, so that lobbying for them 
should be useless. This, however, seems to me to be too heroic a 
remedy for the disease, which, after all, only produces comparatively 
trifling irritation and discomfort. 

The same evil exists, to a much greater extent, in the civil 
branches of the Government. Few persons can fully appreciate 
the loss of time, the worry, and the annoyance to which the respon- 
sible heads of some of our bureaus for scientific work are subjected 
through the desire of people for official position and for mainte- 
nance by the Government. They have to stand always at the bat 
and protect their wickets from the balls which are bowled at them 
in every direction, even from behind by some of their own subor- 
dinates. 

_Itis true that a great majority of the balls go wide and cause 
little trouble, and a majority of the bowlers soon get tired and 
leave the field, but there are generally a few persistent ones who 
gradually acquire no small degree of skill in discovering the weak 
or unguarded points, and succeed in making things lively for a time. 
Considered from the point of view of the public interests, such men 
are useful, for although they cause some loss of valuable time, and 
occasionally do a little damage by promoting hostile legislation, yet 
their criticisms are often worth taking into account; they tend to 
prevent the machine from getting into a rut, and they promote 
activity and attention to business on the part of administrative 
chiefs. It is a saying among dog fanciers that a few fleas on a dog 
are good for him rather than otherwise, as they compel him to take 
some exercise under any circumstances. 

At all events I think it very doubtful whether the jealousies and 
desire for position for one’s self or one’s friends which exist under 
present circumstances would be materially diminished under any 
other form of organization, even under a department of science. 

Some conflict of interests now exists it is true; some work is dupli- 


Lil PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


cated ; but neither the conflict nor the duplication are necessarily 
wholly evil in themselves, nor in so far as they are evil are they 
necessary parts of the present system. This system is of the nature 
of a growth; it is organic and not a mere pudding-stone aggrega- 
tion of heterogeneous materials, and the wise course is to correct 
improper bendings and twistings gradually, prune judiciously, and 
go slow in trying to secure radical changes lest death or permanent 
deformity result. 

Tt will be seen that in what I have said I have not attempted to 
eulogize science or scientists in the abstract. I should be very 
sorry, however, to have given any one the impression that I think 
they should not be eulogized. Having read a number of eloquent 
tributes to their importance by way of inducing a proper frame of 
mind in which to prepare this address, it is possible that I overdid 
it a little, and was in a sort of reaction stage when I began to write. 
But the more I have thought on the subject, and the more care- 
fully I have sought to analyze the motives and character of those of 
my acquaintances who are either engaged in scientific work or who 
wish to be considered as so doing, and to compare them with those 
who have no pretensions to science, and who make none, the more 
I have been convinced that upon the whole the eulogium is the 
proper thing to give, and that it is not wise to be critical as to the 
true inwardness of all that we see or hear. 

At least nine-tenths of the praises which have been heaped upon 
scientific men as a body are thoroughly well deserved. Among them 
are to be found a very large proportion of true gentlemen, larger, 
I think, than is to be found in any other class of men—men char- 
acterized by modesty, unselfishness, scrupulous honesty, and truth- 
fulness, and by the full performance of their family and social duties. 

Even their foibles may be likable. A little vanity or thirst for 
publicity, zeal in claiming priority of discovery, or undue wrath 
over the other scientist’s theory, does not and should not detract 
from the esteem in which we hold them. A very good way of 
viewing characteristics which we do not like is to bear in mind that 
different parts of the brain have different functions; that all of 
them cannot act at once, and that their tendencies are sometimes 
contradictory. 

There are times when a scientific man does not think scientifically, 
when he does not want to so think, and possibly when it is best that 
he should not so think. There is wisdom in Sam. Lawson’s remark 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LIII 


that “ Folks that are always telling you what they don’t believe are 
sort o’ stringy and dry. There ain’t no ’sorption got out o’ not be- 
lieving nothing.” At one time the emotional, at another the intel- 
lectual, side of the scientific man has the ascendency, and one must 
appeal from one state to the other. Were scientific thinking rigor- 
ously carried out to practical results in every-day life there would 
be some very remarkable social changes, and perhaps some very 
disagreeable ones. 

That scientific pursuits give great pleasure without reference to 
their utility, or to the fame or profit to be derived from them; that 
they tend to make a man good company to himself and to bring 
him into pleasant associations is certain; and that a man’s own 
pleasure and happiness are things to be sought for in his work and 
companionship is also certain. If in this address I have ventured 
to hint that this may not be the only, nor even the most important, 
object in life, that one may be a scientific man, or even a man of 
science, and yet not be worthy of special reverence; because he may 
be at the same time an intensely selfish man, and even a vicious 
man, I hope that it is clearly understood that it is with no inten- 
tion of depreciating the glory of science or the honor which is due 
to the large number of scientific gentlemen whom I see around me. 

A scientific gentleman—all praise to him who merits this title— 
it is the blue ribbon of our day. 

We live in a fortunate time and place; in the early manhood of 
a mighty nation, and in its capital city, which every year makes 
more beautiful, and richer in the treasures of science, literature, and 
art which all the keels of the sea and the iron roads of the land are 
bringing to it. Life implies death; growth presages decay ; but we 
have good reasons for hoping that for our country and our people 
the evil days are yet far off. Yet we may not rest and eat lotus; 
we may not devote our lives to our own pleasure, even though it 
be pleasure derived from scientific investigation. No man lives for 
himself alone; the scientific man should do so least of all. There 
never was a time when the world had more need of him, and there 
never was a time when more care was needful lest his torch should 
prove a firebrand and destroy more than it illuminates. 

The old creeds are quivering; shifting; changing like the colored 
flames on the surface of the Bessemer crucible. They are being 
analyzed, and accounted for, and toned down, and explained, until 
many are doubting whether there is any solid substratum beneath ; 


LIV PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


but the instinct which gave those creeds their influence is un- 
changed. : 

The religions and philosophies of the Orient seem to have little 
in common with modern science. The sage of the east did not try 
to climb the ladder of knowledge step by step. He sought a 
wisdom which he supposed far superior to all knowledge of 
earthly phenomena obtainable through the senses. The man of 
science of the west seeks knowledge by gradual accumulation, 
striving by comparison and experiment to eliminate the errors 
of individual observations, and doubting the possibility of attain- 
ing wisdom in any other way. The knowledge which he has, or 
seeks, is knowledge which may be acquired partly by individual 
effort and partly by co-operation, which requires material resources 
for its development, the search for which may be organized and 
pursued through the help of others, which is analogous in some 
respects to property which may be used for power or pleasure. The 
theologian and the poet claim that there is a wisdom which is not 
acquired but attained to, which cannot be communicated or received 
at pleasure, which comes in a way vaguely expressed by the words 
intuition or inspiration, which acts through and upon the emotional 
rather than the intellectual faculties, and which, thus acting, is 
sometimes of irresistible power in exciting and ili a the actions 
of individuals and of communities. 

The answer of the modern biologist to the old Hebrew question, 
viz. “ Why are children born with their hands clenched while men 
die with their hands wide open?” would not in the least resemble 
that given by the Rabbis, yet this last it is well that the scientist 
should also remember: ‘“ Because on entering the world men would 
grasp everything, but on leaving it all slips away.” There exist in 
men certain mental phenomena, the study of which is included in 
what is known as ethics, and which are usually assumed to depend 
upon what is called moral law. Whether there is such a law and 
whether, if it exists, it can be logically deduced from observed facts 
in nature or is only known as a special revelation, are questions 
upon which scientific men in their present stage of development are 
not agreed. There is not yet any satisfactory scientific basis for — 
what is recognized as sound ethics and morality throughout the civil- 
ized world; these rest upon another foundation. 

This procession, bearing its lights of all kinds, smoky torches, 
clear-burning lamps, farthing rush-lights, and sputtering brimstone 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LV 


matches, passes through the few centuries of which we have a 
record, illuminating an area which varies, but which has been grow- 
ing steadily larger. The individual members of the procession come 
from, and pass into, shadow and darkness, but the light of the stream 
remains. Yet it does not seem so much darkness, an infinite night, 
whence we come and whither we go, as a fog which at a little dis- 
tance obscures or hides all things, but which, nevertheless, gives the 
impression that there is light beyond and above it. In this fog we 
are living and groping, stumbling down blind alleys, only to find 
that there is no thoroughfare, getting lost and circling about on our 
own tracks as on a jumbie prairie; but slowly and irregularly we 
do seem to be getting on, and to be establishing some points in the 
survey of the continent of our own ignorance, 

In some directions the man of science claims to lead the way; in 
others the artist, the poet, the devotee. Far reaching as the specu- 
lations of the man of science may be, ranging from the constitution 
and nature of a universal protyle, through the building of a universe 
to its resolution again into primal matter or modes of motion, he 
ean frame no hypothesis which shall explain consciousness, nor has 
he any data for a formula which shall tell what becomes of the in- 
dividual when he disappears in the all-surrounding mist. Does he 
go on seeking and learning in other ways or other worlds? The 
great mass of mankind think that they have some information bear- 
ing on these questions; but, if so, it is a part of the wisdom of the 
Orient, and not of the physical or natural science of the Occident. 
Whether after death there shall come increase of knowledge, with 
increase of desires and of means of satisfying them, or whether there 
shall be freedom from all desire, and an end of coming and going, 
we do not know; nor is there any reason to suppose that it is a part 
of the plan of the universe that we should know. We do know that 
the great majority of men think that there are such things as right 
and duty—God and a future life—and that to each man there comes 
the opportunity of doing something which he and others recognize 
to be his duty. The scientific explanation of a part of the process 
by which this has been brought about, as by natural selection, 
heredity, education, progressive changes in this or that particular 
mass of brain matter, has not much bearing on the practical ques- 
tion of “ What to do about it?” But it does, nevertheless, indicate 
that it is not a characteristic to be denounced, or opposed, or neg- 
lected, since, even in the “struggle-for-existence” theory, it has 


LVI PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


been, and still is, of immense importance in human social develop- 
ment. - 

“Four men,” says the Talmud, “entered Paradise. One beheld 
and died. One beheld and lost his senses. One destroyed the young 
plants. One only entered in peace and came out in peace.” Many 
are the mystic and cabalistic interpretations which have been given 
of this saying; and if for ‘“‘ Paradise” we read the “ world of knowl- 
edge” each of you can no doubt best interpret the parable for him- 
self. Speaking to a body of scientific men, each of whom has, I 
hope, also certain unscientific beliefs, desires, hopes, and longings, I 
will only say: “Be strong and of a good courage.” As scientific 
men, let us try to increase and diffuse knowledge; as men and citi- 
zens, let us try to be useful; and, in each capacity, let us do the 
work that comes to us honestly and thoroughly, and fear not the 
unknown future. ; 

When we examine that wonderful series of wave marks which we 
call the spectrum we find, as we go downwards, that the vibrations 
become slower, the dark bands wider, until at last we reach a point 
where there seems to be no more movement; the blackness is con- 
tinuous, the ray seems dead. Yet within this year Langley has 
found that a very long way lower down the pulsations again appear, 
and form, as it were, another spectrum; they never really ceased, 
but only changed in rhythm, requiring new apparatus or new senses 
to appreciate them. And it may well be that our human life is only 
a kind of lower spectrum, and that, beyond and above the broad black 
band which we call death, there are other modes of impulses—another 
spectrum—which registers the ceaseless beats of waves from the 
great central fountain of force, the heart of the universe, in modes 
of existence of which we can but dimly dream. 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


GENERAL MEETING. 


(1) 


PE BA ne 


ides 


: BULLETIN 


OF THE 


GENERAL MEETING. 


279TH MEETING. JANUARY 16, 1886. 
President BrLur1nas in the Chair. | 
Thirty-two members and guests present. 


Announcement was made of the election to membership of 
Messrs. BENJAMIN PicKMAN MANN and Cuartes Coorer Norv. 


The following report of the Auditing Committee was presented 
by its chairman, Mr. TonER: 
DECEMBER 24, 1885. 


The undersigned, a committee appointed at the annual meeting 
of the Philosophical Society of Washington, December 19, 1885, 
for the purpose of auditing the accounts of the Treasurer, beg 
leave to report as follows: 

We have examined the statement of receipts, including annual 
dues, sale of Bulletin, and interest on bonds, and find the same to 
be correct as stated. 

We have examined the statement of disbursements, and com-' 
pared the same with the vouchers, and find them to agree. 

We have examined the returned checks and the bank account 
with Riggs & Co., and find the balance, $484.02, to agree with the 
statements in the Treasurer’s report. 

We have examined the U.S. bonds belonging to the Society, and 
find them to be in amount and character as represented in the 


Treasurer’s report, aggregating $2,500. 
J. M. Toner, 


O. T. Mason, 
T. C. MENDENHALL, 
Committee. 


(3) 


4 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Mr. J. S. DILLER communicated 


NOTES ON THE GEOLOGY OF NORTHERN CALIFORNIA. 
) 


[ Abstract. ] 


Under the direction of Capt. Dutton I have spent the last three 
summers studying the geology of northern California and the ad- 
jacent portion of Oregon. The conclusions of a general nature 
referring to that region may be briefly summarized as follows: 

In the northern end of the Sierra Nevada and the central por- 
tion of the Coast range, among the highly plicated, more or less 
metamorphosed strata which are older than those of the Chico group, 
there appears to be but one horizon of limestone, and that is of Car- 
boniferous age. 

The northern end of the Sierra Nevada is made up of three 
tilted orographic blocks which are separated from each other by 
great faults. The westernmost of these blocks stretching far to the 
southeast appears to form the greater portion of the range. 

As in the Great Basin region the depressed side of each block 
was occupied by a body of water of considerable size. The deposits 
formed in these lakes gave rise to the fertile soils of American and 
Indian valleys. 

The plication of the strata in the Sierra Nevada range took place, 
at least in great part, about the close of the Jurassic or beginning 
of the Cretaceous period, but the faulting which really gave birth 
to the Sierra as a separate and distinct range by differentiating it 
from the great platform stretching eastward into the Great Basin 
region, did not take place until towards the close of the Tertiary or 
the beginning of the Quaternary. 

Although the faulting may have commenced earlier, the greater 
portion of the displacement has taken place since the deposition of 
a large part of the auriferous gravels and the beginning of the 
great volcanic outbursts in the vicinity of Lassen’s Peak. If we 
may accept numerous small earthquake shocks as evidence, the 
faulting still continues. 

The distribution of the rocks of the Chico group indicates that 
the western coast of the continent at that time lay along the western 
base of the Sierra extending around the northern end of the range 
in the vicinity of Lassen’s Peak and stretching far northeasterly 


into Oregon. Off the coast lay a large island which now forms 
& 


GENERAL MEETING. 5 


northwestern California and the adjacent portion of Oregon. This 
island extended as far southeast as the Pit river region where it 
was separated from the main land by a wide strait. 

Ali of the ridges developed out of the Cretacean island belong 
to the Coast range. 

The volcanic ridge of Lassen’s Peak lies between the northern 
end of the Sierra Nevada and the Coast range. The great volcanic 
field of Oregon and Washington Territory, to which Lassen’s Peak 
and the Cascade range belong, appears in a general way to be out- 
lined by the depression between the Cretacean island and the main 
land. A general account of the facts from which these conclusions 
are drawn will appear in Bulletin of the U. S. Geological Sur- 
vey No. 33. 


Mr. I. C. Russewu read a supplementary paper entitled 


NOTES ON THE FAULTS OF THE GREAT BASIN AND OF THE 
EASTERN BASE OF THE SIERRA NEVADA. 


[Abstract. ] 


The structure of the Great Basin was systematically studied by 
the geologists of the Fortieth Parallel Exploration, and subsequently 
by G. K. Gilbert and J. W. Powell. The results of these investiga- 
tions, so far as they relate to the faults of the region, are indicated 
in the bibliographic list which follows. 

The studies here referred to led to the recognition of a type of 
mountain structure named the “Great Basin system,’ which has 
been found to prevail over large portions of the United States west 
of the Rocky Mountains. A typical mountain of this system is a 
long, narrow orographic block, upraised along one edge, 7. e. a mono- 
clinal ridge. A mountain range having this structure usually 
presents an abrupt scarp, formed of the edges of broken strata, 
on ‘the side bordered by the fault, and slopes much more gently 
in the opposite direction. 

Mountain ranges of this character occupy the greater part of the 
area of interior drainage, known as the Great Basin, and at times 
overlap its borders. An older structure in which corrugation plays 
an important part has been recognized by several geologists in the 
desert ranges of Nevada and Utah, but these disturbances were 
produced previous to the faulting which gave origin to the present 
topographic relief. 


6 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The writer has observed Great Basin structure to extend through- 
out Western Utah, Northern Nevada, and into’ Oregon as far as 
Malheur Lake. On the west side of the Great Basin, at the imme- 
diate base of the Sierra Nevada, there is an immense compound 
displacement that can be followed all the way from Honey Lake on 
the north to beyond Owen’s Lake on the south, a distance of over 
390 miles. Along many of the faults composing this belt the 
records of a post-Quaternary movement may be clearly recognized. 
Fault scarps produced by recent movement have been observed in 
Eagle and Carson Valleys, south of Carson City, in Bridgeport 
Valley, and on the west side of Mono Lake. The earthquake in 
Owen’s Valley in 1872, was caused by a movement along one of 
the faults of this series. 

The eastern face of the Sierra Nevada is extremely abrupt and 
its western slope is gentle. Corrugations of older date than the 
faults which determine the present relief of the mountains may be 
observed at many localities. It thus agrees in its general features 
with many of the Basin ranges. The Sierra Nevada is essentially 
monoclinal in structure, but is traversed from north to south by 
faults which divide it into separate ranges, as may be seen in the 
neighborhood of Lake Tahoe and in the elevated region west of 
Mono Lake. The Great Basin structure here extends beyond the 
borders of the area of interior drainage, and is probably limited on 
the west by the great valley of California. How far north of Lake . 
Tahoe the secondary faults that divide the mountain mass may be 
traced is unknown, but they can certainly be followed to where the 
Central Pacific railroad crosses the mountains. 

The following list indicates where observations on the faults of 
the Great Basin system may be found: 

Clarence King: Reports of the Fortieth Parallel Exploration. 


Vol. I, 1878, pp. 735, 744-746; Vol. III, 1870, 
p. 451. 


J. D. Whitney: The Owens Valley earthquake. Overland 
Monthly, Aug. and Sept., 1872. 


Joseph Le Conte: On the Structure and Origin of Mountains, with 
special reference to recent objections to the 
“Contraction Theory.” American Journal of 
Science, Vol. XVI, 1878, pp. 95112. 


ig : A theory of the formation of the great features 
of the earth’s crust. American Journal of 
Science, Vol. IV, 1872, pp. 345-355, 460-472. 


G. K. Gilbert: 


J. W. Powell: 


C. E. Dutton: 


I. C. Russell: 


GENERAL MEETING. 7 
Progress report upon Geographical and Geological 
Explorations and Surveys West of the 100th 
Meridian, in 1872. Washington, 1874. p. 50. 


Report upon Geographical and Geological Explo- 
rations and Surveys west of the 100th Meri- 
dian. Washington, 1875. Vol. III, Geology, 
pp. 21-42. 


Contributions to the history of Lake Bonneville. 
In Second Annual Report of the U.S. Geo- 
logical Survey. Washington, 1882. pp. 192 
—200. 


A theory of the earthquakes of the Great Basin 
with a practical application. American 
Journal of Science, Vol. XX VII, 1884, pp. 
49-53. 


Basin Range System. See Report on Lands of 
the Arid Region of the United States. 
Washington, 1879. pp. 94-95. 


Basin Range Province. See Report on the 
Geology of the eastern portion of the Uinta 
Mountains. Washington, 1876. pp. 6-7, 23- 
25. 


Geology of the High Plateaus of Utah. Washing- 
ton, 1880. pp. 51-55. 


Sketch of the Geological History of Lake Lahon- 
tan. Third Annual Report of the U.S. 
Geological Survey. Washington, 1883. p. 
202. 


A Geological Reconnoissance in Southern Oregon. 
Fourth Annual Report of the U.S. Geologi- 
cal Survey. Washington, 1884. pp.442-455. 


Lake Lahontan. Monograph No. XI, U. 8. 
Geological Survey, pp. 24-28, 274-284. 


Mr. Gitpert remarked that the section exhibited by Mr. 
Diller appeared to demonstrate a history comprising (1) the folding 
of the slates and the formation of several faults and associated 
monoclines, (2) the general degradation of the country until the 
monoclinal ridges were approximately obliterated, and (3) a re- 
newal of movement on the old fault lines, giving rise to the exist- 


ing topography. 


8 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Mr. Wiis remarked that in 1883 he had had opportunity to 
study the Cascade Mountains north of the regiom described by Mr. 
Diller. The Sierra structure is apparently not found in the north- 
ern part of Washington Territory, and the eastern face of the 
Cascade range is probably not characterized like the Sierra by a 
great fault. 


Mr. Drier concurred in the statement that the Cascade range 
is built essentially of igneous rocks, and is not characterized by 
great faults, at least along its eastern base. 

The topography of the Sierra has entirely changed since the 
deposition of the auriferous gravels, and some of the fault move- 
ments are so recent that the stream terraces to which they have 
given rise are still preserved. 


Mr. G. K. GILBERT made a communication on 


RECENT CHANGES OF LEVEL IN THE BASIN OF LAKE ONTARIO. 


[The substance of this communication was presented to the 
American Association for the Advancement of Science at Ann 
Arbor, and appears in abstract in Science, Vol. VI, p. 222.] 


Remarks were made by Mr. E. Farqunar. 


280TH MEETING. JANUARY 30, 1886 
The President in the Chair. 
Fifty-five members and guests present. 


The Chair announced the appointment of the Committee on 
Communications. 


Mr. Greorce E. Curtis made a communication on 
LIEUTENANT LOCKWOOD’S EXPEDITION TO FARTHEST NORTH. 


[Abstract. ] 


The paper opened with a reference to the statement in the Ency- 
clopedia Britannica (article, Polar Regions, p. 326,) that “all this 
region [the northern coast of Greenland and the interior of Grinnell 


GENERAL MEETING. 9 


Land] had already been explored and exhaustively examined by 
the English expedition of 1875-76.” A refutation of this state- 
ment was not now necessary inasmuch as a retraction had already 
been made; but an impartial examination of Lieut. Lockwood’s 
observations was still required as a basis for our own confidence in 
the latitude attained. 

A description of the equipment of the expedition was given, with 
a sketch of the events of the journey, and extracts from the narra- 
tive report. The weights of the food and equipments drawn by the 
dog team furnished the basis of a discussion as to the value of dogs 
in arctic sledging. The weight ot’ food taken for the support of 
each man was about twice that taken for each dog. Now if a man 
can drag a sufficiently greater amount to compensate for the greater 
weight of his food, it is immaterial whether the motive force used 
be dogs or men. On this expedition the dog sledge was actually 
loaded so as to give a weight of about 100 lbs. to each dog; but the 
maximum weight that can be advantageously drawn by a man is 
only 125 or, perhaps, 150 lbs. The ratio of effective work performed 
to the weight of food consumed is, therefore, materially greater for 
dogs than for men, so that a substantial economical advantage is 
obtained by using dogs instead of men for sledge dragging. This 
advantage seems not to have been appreciated by the English ex- 
pedition of 1875’-76, whose heavy sledges and equipments were all 
drawn by hand. In addition to the more conspicuous causes of 
the failure of Lieut. Beaumont’s expedition on the Greenland coast, 
the neglect to make use of dogs must be added as an important 
element. 

The sextant observations made by Lieut. Lockwood for determin- 
ing the position of his farthest north were shown to be highly 
satisfactory. Sets of circum-meridian observations for latitude were 
made at midnight of May 14th and at noon of May 15th. The 
conditions of observation offer no sufficient reason for giving more 
weight to one set than to the other. The mean of these results 
gives 83° 24’ as the latitude attained by Lieut. Lockwood, and an 
uncertainty not greater than 1’ represent the accuracy of its deter- 
mination. 

The paper closed with the following tribute to the character of 
Lieut. Lockwood as an arctic explorer : 

I cannot close this review of Lieut. Lockwood’s expedition to 
farthest north without turning from the cold discussion of the astro- 


10 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


nomical and geographical records to speak of him of whose life and 
labors they constitute an imperishable memorial? 

The success of the expedition was not the result of chance, but 
was due to Lieut. Lockwood’s thorough knowledge of the details 
of such an undertaking, and to his indomitable energy in its execu- 
tion. During the preceding winter he had devoted himself to 
preparation for the work; had made a careful study of the man- 
agement and equipment of previous sledging expeditions—especially 
those of the English in 1875~’76—and profiting by the experience 
of his predecessors was able to avoid their mistakes. Lieut. Beau- 
mont’s journey on the Greenland coast was impeded by the heavy 
sledge, and the heavier equipments with which it was weighted. 
Lieut. Lockwood’s extraordinary distance was attained with a light 
sledge drawn by dogs and loaded with nothing but food and the 
barest necessities of a camp. Regardless of all personal comforts, 
everything was sacrificed to the objects of the expedition. 

Under the instruction of Mr. Israel, the young astronomer: 
Lieut. Lockwood had familiarized himself during the winter with 
all the astronomical observations necessary to be made by an ex- 
plorer, and with the return of the spring sun applied himself to 
practical observations with the sextant until he became an expert 
in its use. So good was his astronomical work that the accuracy 
of his observations is dependent only on the variability of the in- 
strument and the difficulty of the conditions of observation. 

In addition to a practical knowledge of arctic sledging, the expe- 
dition was undertaken with a determined energy of purpose, those 
qualities expressively termed “ grit” and “ pluck,” which no obstacle 
could defeat. Retaining only two companions at Cape Bryant, he 
sent back his supporting party and continued his advance over an 
unknown coast. Suffering continuously from cold, hunger, or 
fatigue, he pushed on with unflinching perseverance until one hun- 
dred and fifty miles of new coast were traversed and the national 
colors unfurled in the highest latitude ever attained by man. 

Simply to go a little nearer the pole than his predecessors was 
not, however, the controlling object of this expedition. Lieut. 
Lockwood’s own motives, as we read them in his journal, were 
these: “My great wish is to accomplish something on the north 
coast of Greenland that will reflect credit on myselfvand on the ex- 
pedition.” Inspired by this praiseworthy ambition, his skillful 
management resulted in its most successful realization. His mo- 


GENERAL MEETING. 11 


tives were not those of the visionary and enthusiast who “knows 
nothing and fears nothing,” but of an earnest practical explorer 
whose ambition is to add something to the world’s knowledge of 
the planet on which we live. The literal fidelity of his narrative, 
its freedom from an exaggeration that has too often marred the 
records of previous Arctic explorers, the exact and painstaking 
descriptions, and the careful distinction between what is seen and 
what is inferred, all bear witness to his conscientiousness in the 
search for truth. 

As an important element in the success of Lieut. Lockwood’s ex- 
peditions, due recognition must be given to the cordial, sympathetic 
and able co-operation of Sergeant Brainard. Chosen by Lieut. 
Lockwood to continue the journey to Cape Bryant, when all the 
remainder of the party returned, it was Brainard who pushed 
onward with him over one hundred and fifty miles of that desolate 
coast and reached the farthest north. It was likewise Lockwood 
and Brainard who a year later, in May, 1883, explored the interior 
of Grinnell Land and looked out on the shores of the western polar 
sea. 

But only one of these companions in exploration was destined 
to reach home to receive the honor due to their heroic achieve- 
ments—honor due, but, as yet, awarded neither to the living nor 
the dead. The story of the return is known to all, but perhaps not 
Lieut. Lockwood’s wonderful cheerfulness of spirit through that last 
terrible winter at Cape Sabine with death staring him in the face 
Lieut. Lockwood died on April 9, 1884, “from action of water on 
the heart induced by insufficient nutrition ’’—the official euphemism 
for starvation. This record of indescribable suffering, privation 
and death, following that of two years of heroic endeavor and 
achievement, is a tragedy which appeals to human hearts with a 
force unequalled by any story of fiction or by any drama of the 
stage. 

To Lieut. Lockwood’s achievements are applicable the familiar 
lines of Horace : 

‘‘ Hxegi monumentum aere perennius 
Regalique situ pyramidum altius, 
Quod non imber edax, non Aquilo impotens 


Possit diruere, aut innumerabilis 
Annorum series et fuga temporum.”’ 


Woven into the history of arctic discovery and engraven on our 


1a PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


maps, the substantial results of Lieut. Lockwood’s explorations form 
a tablet more enduring than brass, which the corroding storm, the 
fierce north wind, and the flight of ages cannot efface. 


In reply to a question by Mr. Mussey, Mr. Curtis stated that the 
time for longitude determination was obtained from one ordinary 
watch of good quality, and one pocket chronometer. Messrs. Datu 
and Rosrnson discussed the advantages and disadvantages of the 
use of dogs in arctic sledging, and attention was called to the im- 
portance of using snow shoes, and of coating the sledge runners 
with ice. 


Mr. O. T. Mason made a communication on 


TWO EXAMPLES OF SIMILAR INVENTIONS IN AREAS WIDELY APART. 


[Abstract. ] 


Anthropologists assign similar inventions observed in different 
parts of the world to one of the following causes : 

1. The migration of a certain race or people who made the in- 
vention. Upon this theory similar inventions argue the presence of 
the same people or race. 

2. The migration of ideas—that is, an invention may be made by 
a certain race or people and taught or loaned to peoples far removed 
in time and place. Upon this theory similar inventions argue iden- 
tity of origin, but not necessarily the consanguinity of those who 
practice them. 

3. In human culture, as in nature elsewhere, like causes produce 
like effects. Under the same stress and resources the same inven- 
tions will arise. 

Now, the question arises, which of these causes shall be invoked 
in specific cases to account for resemblances. 


We must first examine the word resemblance. 

Taking Aristotle’s four causes: 

‘The material cause, ex qua aliquid fit. 

The formal cause, per quam. 

The efficient cause, a qua. 

The final cause, propter quam. 

We must enlarge upon them as follows: Every human activity 
involves six fundamental considerations. 

1. The agent, or efficient cause. 


GENERAL MEETING. ° 13 


2. The material cause. 

3. The implemental cause. 

4, The formal cause. 

5. The processive cause—that is, the exact order and method of 
the action. 

6. The motive or function. | 

We might, also, include a series of concomitants, such as techni- 
eal vocabulary, all sorts of traditional lore and myths, social or- 
ganization, and even religious rites. 

Again, some of the six’causes are themselves generally the out- 
come of other causes, so that we have concatenations and genealo- 
gies of causes. 

Now for the application. Most men, when they say this thing 
resembles that, have reference only to one of our six causes. They 
mean simply that there is resemblance in form, or material, or 
technical method, or function. My plan would be to submit such 
resemblances to scrutiny to ascertain how far they extend, and, also, 
to examine resemblances known to be consanguine, or borrowed, 
or independent, to ascertain which of our characteristics are pecu- 
liar to them. In that way an inductive system of rules would be 
adduced. 

The two independent inventions which I exhibit are a beginning 
in that direction. One is a stitch in basketry, found only at Cape 
Flattery and on the Congo. This stitch is common enough in fish- 
traps, wattling fences, and cages, but in only these two areas have 
people thought to apply it to close basketry. It consists of vertical 
warp, a horizontal second warp, laid behind the first, and a coiling 
or sewing of these two together, so as to show a diagonal stitch in 
front and a vertical stitch inthe rear. Here the resemblance is in 
method alone. In all other respects the inventions differ. 

The other invention referred to is the throwing-stick of Austra- 
lians, Puru Purus, and Eskimo. These agree, in motive or func- 
tion and in the fundamental idea of a staff and a hook. Beyond 
this the Eskimo have invented a dozen additional attachments 
never dreamed of by the others. 


Mr. Murpocs supplemented the enumeration of throwing sticks 
by describing an undeveloped form used by the Siberian Eskimo. 
In reply to a question by Mr. Goode, Mr. Mason stated that he 
had not seen the Brazilian sticks; they are mentioned by many 


14 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


travelers. Mr. Mann and Mr. Murpoca described the manner in 
which the throwing stick is used by Eskimo in kyaks. The motion 
centers in the wrist and not the elbow or shoulder. 


281st MEETING. FEBRUARY 13, 1886. 
The President in the Chair. 
Fifty-five members and guests present. . 
Mr. J. H. Kipprr communicated an 
HISTORICAL SKETCH OF DEEP SEA TEMPERATURE OBSERVATIONS, 


illustrating the subject by numerous diagrams and by a collection 
of deep sea thermometers. 


Mr. E. B. Exxuiorr made a communication on the 
ANNUAL PROFIT TO BANKS OF NATIONAL BANK NOTE CIRCULATION, 
and a second communication on the 


QUANTITY OF UNITED STATES SUBSIDIARY SILVER COIN EXISTING 
AND IN CIRCULATION. 


In these papers he developed the formule used in computing cer- 
tain tables embodied in the report of the Comptroller of the 
Currency. 


Remarks were made by Messrs. Mussey and LAWRENCE. 


Mr. AsAPH HALL read a paper on 


THE NEW STAR IN THE NEBULA OF ANDROMEDA, 


giving an historical account of its discovery, growth and decadence. 
[This paper is printed in the American Journal of Science, 3d se- 
ries, vol. XXXI, p. 299.] 


GENERAL MEETING. 15 


282p Mretina. Frepruary 27, 1886. 
The President in the Chair. 
Fifty-six members and guests present. 


_ The Chair announced the election to membership of Mr. GrorGE 
JOTHAM CUMMINGS. 


Mr. AsApH HALL made a communication on 
THE IMAGES OF STARS, 


which was discussed by Messrs. Eastman, Curtis, and PAUvt. 
[This paper is published in the Sidereal Messenger, April, 1886.] 


Mr. R. S. WoopwarD made a communication 


ON THE CHANGES OF TERRESTRIAL LEVEL SURFACES DUE TO 
VARIATIONS IN DISTRIBUTION OF SUPERFICIAL MATTER. 


[To appear as a Bulletin of the U. 8. Geological Survey. ] 
He was followed by Mr. G. K. GitBert with a paper 


ON THE OBSERVED CHANGES OF LEVEL SURFACES IN THE BONNE- 
VILLE AREA, AND THEIR EXPLANATION ; 


and Mr. T. C. CHAMBERLIN then began a paper 


ON THE VARYING ATTITUDES OF FORMER LEVEL SURFACES IN 
THE GREAT LAKE REGION AND THE APPLICABILITY OF PRO- 
POSED EXPLANATIONS. 


2838p MEETING. Marca 138, 1886. 
Vice-President Harkness in the Chair. 
Thirty-nine members and guests present. 


The Secretary read a letter from the Secretary of the Council of 
the Anthropological Society, inviting the members of the Philo- 
sophical Society and their friends to attend the annual meeting of 


16 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


the Anthropological Society and listen to an address by its president, 
Major J. W. PowEL. " 


The Chair announced the election to membership of Messrs. Car- 
Los ALBERT KernastTon, RoLAnD Durr Irvine and ARTEMAS 
MARTIN. 


Mr. T. C. CHAMBERLIN completed his communication 


ON THE VARYING ATTITUDES OF FORMER LEVEL SURFACES IN 
THE GREAT LAKE REGION AND THE APPLICABILITY OF 
PROPOSED EXPLANATIONS. 


Remarks were made by Mr. Dutron. 


Mr. R. D. Irvine made a communication on 


THE ENLARGEMENT OF MINERAL FRAGMENTS AS A FACTOR IN 
ROCK ALTERATION, 


which was discussed by Messrs. Ippines, DitteR, Durron, and 
LAWRENCE. 


284TH MEETING. Marca 27, 1886. 
The President in the Chair. 
Thirty-three members and guests present. 
Mr. I. C. RusseLt made a communication on 


THE SUBAERIAL DECAY OF ROCKS AND THE ORIGIN OF THE RED 
CLAY OF CERTAIN FORMATIONS. 


This was discussed by Prof. Joun 8. Newserry, of New York 
city, and by Messrs. Goopr, Darton, IrvinG, and CHAMBERLIN. 


Mr. Romyn Hircucock made a communication on 


RECENT IMPROVEMENTS IN MICROSCOPIC OBJECTIVES, WITH DEMON- 
STRATION OF THE RESOLVING POWER OF A NEW 1#16TH INCH. 


Remarks were made by the President. 


GENERAL MEETING. 17 
Mr. Henry Farquuar read a communication on 


4 
A FONETIK LFABET. 


[Abstreekt.] 


Ais xlfabet cendertéyks tu reprizént de sawndz av Iyglic spiyte 
ez ytiwjuwali herd, bai twénti-nain létcerz. Av diyz 6, d, f, 9, h, 
k, 1, m, n, p, 7, 8, t, v, w, y end z hev der keestomeri sawndz; ¢ hez 
its sawnd «ez in benificiert [beneficiary ] —a sawnd akéyjcenali given 
tu s or t or ch, or mower 6fen tu sh; 7 iz kanfdind tu its Frente 
sawnd — hwite iz ool det iz left tu it hwen kambdind wid d in Iyglie, 
vez in edjutent [adjutant]; hwail de néyzal ytiwjuwali riten ng, ée 
th fleet send th carp, ar given bai de léteerz y, 06 end , biérod fram de 
Griyk wlfabet. Av de vawels, a iz xz in wad or bar, e xz in pet, 7 
xz in pit, o ez in on or or, wu ez in put; hwail de ddigrefs @ end @ 
ar yuwzd for de vawel sawndz heerd in beet [bat] send in bet [but; 
won, burr, stir, herd, heard, word, ete. ]. Deeblld létcerz indikeyt 
proléoyd sawndz: Z in dabll [double], m in prizmm [prism], a in 
stéari [starry], 0 in doon [dawn]. C&dcer loy véwels ar rigdrded sez 
impytier sawndz; end sloerz bifécer r ar dindwted bai @, téndensi 
tu klowz wid de lips bai w, zend wid de toy bai y, falowiy a cort vawel; 
dees wiy heev ew, ta, ow, we in beer, bier, boer, buer [bear, beer, 
bore, boor], aw, ow, ww in haws, flow, buwt [house, flow, boot], ey, iy, 
ay in beyt, biyt, bayt [bait, beat, bite]. 2&z egzempllz av dcr kam- 
binéyccenz, oil, wain, yuwz2, tényur, kyuer [oil, wine, use, tenure, cure] 
mey biy given. Ztksénted vdwelz ar markt, sékanderi xksents 
(sez on de foerst silabll ay vériabiliti) heviy de greyv sain, prinsipal 
weenz oe zekytiwt. 

Owiy tu de pdweerful influwens av de skuwlz in kiypiy cep zen ek- 
sésiv réveerens for de kanvénccenal stendard av spéliy, end tu de 
feekt dset de meedjériti av de weerdz av dweer leeygwedj ar nown tu 
cs bai der epicrens xz printed or riten redcer dn bai der sawnd 
xz spowken, der iz litll imifydiet préspekt av sceksés in de “spéliy- 
riform” mtiwvment, hwite eymz tu divélap d4woer spéliy intu woen 
mocer nfcrli fonétik. Naveerdelés, der ar praktikal ytiwsez for a 

39 


18 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


gud fonétik zlfabet. Feerst, it kud fernic a steendard ay proncensiéy- 
coen in dikeceneriz av ool sorts —huwz riydoerz wud des biy seyvd 
de tesk av leerniy a diferent sistem for iyte dikcceneri, xz et préz- 
ent. Sékand, it kud end cud form a régyular brente av instroek- 
coon in skuwlz, znd dees eesist in sikytceriy yiwniform proneen- 


ep te 


siéyceen. Ocerd, scem scete divdys iz olmowst a nisésiti, if wiy wud 
briy érdeer intu a biznes naw Oltugédcer keyatik ; treensliteer¢ycceen av 
neymz fram de Riwean, Brabik znd ceder leygwedjez nat yawziy 
de Rowman elfabet. Zz wiy filo now méJad kansistentli set préz- 
ent, der wud peerheps biy now greyt difikelti in estxbliciy ween; 
espécali if bai it de sayt av a neym kud giv en sepraksimet aidia 
haw it iz prondwnst bai dowz mowst feemiliar wid it. 


Mr. Mussry said that the principal difficulty in all phonetic 
alphabets was not in the alphabets themselves, but in the existing 
variety of pronunciation and the disagreements as to the true 
pronunciation of words. Pitman’s phonetic system—little short 
of an inspiration—was to his mind the best ever devised for 
practical use, though Bell’s system of visible speech enabled a 
person familiar with it to correctly pronounce words and sentences 
in any language whatever. 


Mr. Mauuery said that he had been connected with the prepa-. 
ration of a phonetic alphabet by the Bureau of Ethnology, with 
the object of collecting and recording the vocabularies of the 
languages of the North American Indians. In addition to the 
requisite that there should be a distinct character for every sound, 
it was made a fundamental rule that the characters should be 
limited to those in an ordinary font of English type, embracing 
however not only the Roman alphabet but such characters and dia- 
critical marks as the printers’ cases of average newspapers could 
furnish. This was accomplished so as to provide for many more 
sounds than are included in Mr. Farquhar’s scheme, yet without 
resort to the Greek letters used by him in several instances. It 
was done by the simple device of reversing the large number of 
letters in the Roman alphabet which present a markedly different 
appearance when so reversed, from*their erect position. This is 
entirely convenient to the printer and does not occasion awkward- 
ness in the current script to the recorder or writer for the press, as 


GENERAL MEETING. 19 


it is only necessary to mark the letter intended to be reversed, after 
writing it in the normal manner, and to notify the printer accord- 
ingly. In practice the letters intended to be reversed are marked 
by a cross beneath them, though a still more current method of 
distinction would be by the cedilla in using which the pen or pencil 
is not removed from the letter as formed. This is however more 
convenient to the writer than to the printer. 

The result of this scheme in practice has solved one part of the 
problem of a universal phonetic alphabet. Vocabularies and 
chrestomathies of unwritten languages have been recorded and 
printed, upon which grammars and dictionaries have also been pre- 
pared and printed, and from them the languages can be learned so 
as to be spoken intelligibly without oral instruction. The possibility 
of the use of such an alphabet with only such modification as would 
increase its simplicity, in the reform of the English literation, is not 
to be doubted, in view of its success under more difficult conditions. 
The actual obstacles to phonetic reform of fixed alphabets are, 
though perhaps insuperable, non-essential in the scientific view of 
the question. 


Concerning the gliding sounds mentioned by Mr. Farquhar, Mr. 
DoouittLE remarked that some of these appeared to be essential, 
while others were only accidental. 


285TH MEETING. APRIL 10, 1886. 
The President in the Chair. 
Fifty-nine members and guests present. 


The Chair announced the election to membership of Messrs. 
ALEXANDER GEORGE McAptIr and Ropert THomas HI ut. 


Mr. MALLERY read a communication on 
CUSTOMS OF EVERY-DAY LIFE. 
[Abstract. ] 


The scope of the paper excluded the more commonly noted cere- 
monial institutions, such as appear in regal courts, courts of justice, 
and legislative bodies, and embraced the ordinary modes of behavior 
among civilized people. These all have history and significance, 


20 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


are not the result of deliberate invention or convention, and in their 
present shape clearly exhibit the laws of evolution, though not always 
in the directions set forth in text-books and treatises on sociology, 
Comment was made upon the topics of social etiquette, precedence, 
titles, grammatical forms of personalty, the address and signatures 
of letters, forms and practices relating to written invitations and to 
social visits, and formularies of oral greeting, with examples or 
illustrations under each topic. 

Fashion was distinguished from custom as being imitative and 
transitory, although in some few instances genuine merit in a fashion 
led to its permanent adoption under the same law with which the 
convenient and useful portions of old customs have survived in 
modifications. 

Two points on which the paper specially declared disagreement 
with Herbert Spencer relate to the bow in salutation and to the 
hand-shake or grasp. The bow Mr. Spencer regards as but modi- 
fied from the natural expressions of physical fear and bodily subjec- 
tion noticed among sub-human animals and the lowest tribes of men, 
originating in actual prostration and groveling to which crawling 
and kneeling succeed, and the bow is but a simulated and partial 
prostration. A large class of obeisances doubtless had their origin 
in the attitudes of fear, and several were adduced in addition to 
those mentioned by Mr. Spencer, but it was contended that the sub- 
ject of the bow is much more complex than as presented by him, 
a separate and independent course of evolution being suggested. 
Evidence was collected from many sources, and especially from ges- 
ture speech, relating to the concepts of, and expressions for, higher 
and lower, superior and inferior, assent, submission and respect, all 
connected with the forward and downward inclination of the head 
in salutation. Regarding the uncovering of the head as a part of 
the masculine bow, the paper offered to Mr. Spencer a new illustra- 
tion of militancy, too often insisted upon in his Synthetic Philosophy 
but not definitely in this connection. The voluntary deprivation of 
removable head gear—once defensive—is often a mark of defeat and 
subjection. The modern formal military and naval salutes contain 
the same idea that the saluter is actually or symbolically powerless. 
Therefore the action of the removal of the hat, the present repre- 
sentative of the casque, helmet, or morion, is better"adapted to a 
“surrender” theory than to that of pretended “beggary” advocated 
by Mr. Spencer. 


GENERAL MEETING. yA 


That great writer believes that the hand-shake originated in a 
struggle, first real, afterwards fictitious, in which each of the per- 
formers attempted to kiss the hand of the other, which was resisted, 
thus producing a reciprocating movement of the joined hands. In 
examining this explanation the antiquity and prevalence of the kiss 
in salutation was questioned. The mutual kiss of affection or pas- 
sion by the lips between opposite sexes is not found among the lower 
tribes and is probably not of great antiquity. It was preceded 
without reference to sex by patting, stroking or rubbing different 
parts of the body—smelling and'sniffling being also common. The 
kiss of the hand is undoubtedly ancient and gestural, and is ap- 
parently not derived from that of the lips, which is gustatory. In- 
stances were admitted of the identical friendly contest for priority 
in kissing hands relied on by Mr. Spencer, but they were consid- 
ered to be connected with the topic of precedence as secondary, the 
joining of hands being primary and wholly unconnected with a 
“shake” or any motion after junction. Evidence was presented 
that the junction of hands in testimony and in expression of agree- 
ment and friendship is of too high antiquity and universality to be 
derived from a pantomimic contest about precedence for the compara. 
tively modern and limited kiss. 


Mr. Mason expressed the opinion that not all customs are indi- 
rectly derived, and cited the innovations of the day as instances of 
customs deliberately assumed for a definite purpose. 


Mr. MENDENHALL referred to the numerous ways in which Jap- 
anese customs are the inverse of ours. In beckoning, the fingers are 
turned down instead of up, and this is probably explained by the fact 
that in Japan those who are beckoned—namely, inferiors—are by 

custom or in theory prostrate. The kitchen of a hotel is placed at 

the front against the street. A horse is backed into the stable and 
led out. It is a matter of etiquette, and modesty also, that ladies 
turn their toes in. The Japanese do not shake hands; the bow is 
very low, and is begun twenty feet away. There is no kiss of cere- 
mony or friendship, but the kiss exists as an expression of passion. 
Japanese children play all the common games of our children in 
some modified form, except marbles. 


In reply to a question by Mr. Mason, Mr. MenpDENHALL said 
that a Japanese does not shake his own hands as a salutation to 


22 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


another, but may join them in bowing as a merely accidental atti- 
tude. Messrs. E. FarquHar and Mussry spoké of the antiquity 
of kissing as indicated by Hebrew and Greek literature. Other 
remarks were made by the President and by Mr. CLARKE. 


Mr. R. D. Mussey made a communication entitled 


WHEN I FIRST SAW THE CHOLERA BACILLUS. 


286TH MEETING. APRIL 24, 1886. 
The President in the Chair. 


Thirty members present. 


The President communicated an invitation from the American 
Historical Association to attend its sessions of April 27-29. 


Mr. G. Brown Goope and Mr. T. H. Bean made a joint com- 
munication on 


THE DISTRIBUTION OF FISHES IN THE OCEANIC ABYSSES AND 
MIDDLE STRATA. 


Remarks were made by Messrs. Paut, Harkness, BILurnes, 
DoouitrLeE, GooprE, WELLING, and Taytor, and by Prof. 
Epwarp D. Cops, of Philadelphia. 


Mr. GILBERT THOMPSON made a communication on 


THE PHYSICAL-GEOGRAPHICAL DIVISIONS OF THE SOUTHEASTERN 
PORTION OF THE UNITED STATES AND THEIR CORRESPONDING 
TOPOGRAPHICAL TYPES, 

[Abstract. ] 


Having charge of the geographical work carried on by the U. S. 
Geological Survey in that portion of the Appalachian region south 
of Pennsylvania and the Ohio river, I have had occasion to con- 
sider the classification of the region from the point of view of the 
geographer. It has previously been divided by many authors and 
into numerous sections, the basis of classification being geological 
botanical, agricultural, or commercial, and usually from a local 
standpoint. For my purposes the principal basis of classification 
is the character of the topographic relief, but this is so closely 


GENERAL MEETING. 23 


related to the features controlling other classifications that a large 
share of the boundaries coincide with lines previously drawn and 
the selection of appropriate designations is little more than a choice 
between names previously given. 

There are some parts of the United States where the drainage 
basin affords the best unit for the purposes of the physical geo- 
grapher. This holds for the basin of the Laurentian lakes, the basin 
of the Red River of the North, and the great Interior basin. But in 
the Appalachian region the drainage cannot be used. There is how- 
ever in this region a remarkable line of demarcation, known as the 
fall line, which finds its manifestation in connection with the drain- 
age, and is the natural boundary of an important division. If we 
follow the course of any river in the eastern part of the United 
States, south of New England, from its source to the sea, we discover 
that at a certain point it ceases to be rapid and turbulent, and 
becomes broad and slow-moving, and in many cases an estuary of 
the sea. At the point where this change occurs there is usually 
a fall or rapid. The familiar local example is the Potomac at 
Little Falls. I have traced this fall line from near Troy, N. Y., 
southward by the interior cities of Washington, Richmond, Colum- 
bia, and Montgomery, and thence to the Muscle Shoals of the 
Tennessee river. It is always the lower limit of water power 
and often the upper limit of navigation, and is therefore marked, 
and destined to be marked, by cities and towns of importance. In 
its northern portion it is at the head of tide, and nowhere does it 
exceed an altitude of 200 feet. It may yet be determined that it 
crosses the Saint Lawrence at the Lachine rapids and the Missis- 
sippi above Cairo, although no rapid exists at that point. Whether 
it may be traced farther and into Mexico remains to be determined. 

From the fall line to the shore of the sea there is a region having 
a gentle slope, traversed by slow-moving rivers, and fringed at al- 
most a dead level by deltas, swamps and everglades. This I have 
entitled the coastal plains, including as subdivisions the Atlantic 
plains and the Gulf plains. 

The area bounded by the fall line and by the Mississippi and 
Ohio rivers and a part of the drainage divide of the Laurentian 
lakes, might be taken as a whole as the Appalachian region, but it 
includes three sections so distinct in topographic type as to warrant 
separate designations. 

From the Ohio river southeastward and from the Mississippi 


24 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


eastward the country gradually rises until it reaches an altitude of 
about 2500 feet above sea level, where it is genexally cut off by an 
escarpment facing to the southeast and about 1200 feet in height. 
The composite name of Cumberland- Allegheny - Catskill plateau 
would serve to define it, but for brevity I have designated the whole 
as the Cumberland plateau. Its general topographic character is 
that of a table land deeply cut by a system of ramifying drainage. 
At the north the surface is somewhat rolling, and the plateau ends 
at the south in long, finger-like spurs. Its rivers and streams rise 
generally near the edge of the escarpment and flow toward the 
northwest. The Potomac however breaks across the edge and flows 
eastward, while the New and Tennessee rivers enter the plateau 
from the east and flow westward. 7 

From the Cumberland plateau eastward to the eastern foot of 
the Blue Ridge lies a belt to which the name of Appalachian re- 
gion is applied in a restricted and definite sense. It is characterized 
by numerous long, narrow mountain ridges, closely parallel to 
each other and bending in sympathy with the local curvature 
of the belt. Through large areas they are approximately uniform 
in height, but elsewhere they are unequal. Ina notable belt, every- 
where recognized in the local nomenclature as a valley, and travers- 
ing the region from north to south, the ridges are so low that they 
rank only as hills. At the north the principal mountain area lies 
west of the great valley and only the Blue Ridge on the east. At 
the south the valley lies close to the Cumberland plateau, and the 
Blue Ridge is expanded into a broad mountain district, culminating 
in Mt. Mitchell (6711 feet), the a sii summit east of the Rocky 
Mountains. 

The remaining area is the Piedmont region, an undulating plain, 
diversified by low spurs from the mountain region, and occasional 
isolated hills of considerable elevation. The streams are rapid, and 
the topographic relief gradually diminishes toward the fall line. 


The communication was fully illustrated by maps and topographic 
sketches, and by a profile from Louisville, Kentucky, to Charleston, 
South Carolina. Remarks were made by Messrs. GILBERT, HARK- 
NEss and Cope. 


GENERAL MEETING. 25 


287TH MneEtINnG. May 8, 1886. 
The President in the Chair. 


Thirty-five members present. 


The Chair announced the election to membership of Messrs. 
JosEPH Hammond Bryan and Merwin MARIE SNELL. 


Mr. Tuomas RussELu made the following communication on 


TEMPERATURES AT WHICH DIFFERENCES BETWEEN MERCURIAL 
AND AIR THERMOMETERS ARE GREATEST. 


Glass and mercury do not expand uniformly. An increase in 
temperature of one degree at one hundred degrees causes greater 
changes of volume than the same increase at zero. (In all refer- 
ences here to degrees and temperatures the centigrade scale is to be 
understood.) Normal mercurial thermometers, when corrected for 
their various ‘errors of construction, differ among themselves and 
also from the air-thermometer. 

At 40° the mercurial thermometer reads about 0.°2 higher than 
the air-thermometer. At— 38.°8, the melting point of mercury, it 
reads about 0.°2 lower. The quality of mercury in a thermometer 
has an influence on its reading. A thermometer containing roo00 
of lead in the mercury will read 0.°5 lower at 50° than if the 
mercury is pure. [H. J. Green.] 

Comparisons have been made at the Signal Office between an air- 
thermometer and a number of mercurials. Some deductions have 
been made from the results of this work as to the temperatures at 
which the differences between the two thermometers are greatest. 
From the same results there have also been derived values of the 
coefficients of expansion of glass dependent on the second and third 
powers of the temperatures. It is to these I wish to call your at- 
tention. 

The air-thermometer used was of the kind that measures tem- 
peratures by the varying pressure of a quantity of air kept at a 
constant volume. Five Tounelot mercurial thermometers were 
compared with this air-thermometer at temperatures from 0° to 
55°. Two Baudin thermometers were compared with it from 0° 
to — 38.°8. 

The freezing points of mercurial thermometers rise with age. A 
few days after a thermometer is filled this rise may amount to a 


26 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


whole degree. In a year after that it may rise an additional five- 
tenths of a degree; with succeeding years the *change is less and 
less. 

When a thermometer is raised to a high temperature its freezing 
point is depressed. The average depression for 100° is about 0.°2. 
On raising to a temperature lower than 100° the freezing point is 
also depressed, but not so much. For 50° the depression is about 
0.°05. For temperatures as high as 100° the depressions are about 
proportional to the squares of the temperatures by which they are 
produced. 

The cause of these changes of freezing point is in the nature of 
the glass. The mercury in the thermometer has nothing to do with 
them; neither has the atmospherig pressure. 

The amount of the changes depends on the composition of the 
glass in the thermometer-bulb. It has been recently ascertained by 
H. F. Wiebe that the change is greatest for glass containing equal 
quantities of potash and soda. A thermometer made of a variety 
of glass containing 14 per cent. of potash, 14 per cent. of soda, the 
remainder silica and oxide of lead, was found to have its freezing 
point depressed 0.°84 on raising it to 100°. Thermometers in which 
the potash or soda in the glass was replaced by lime were found 
to have the freezing points depressed only 0.°07 for the tempera- 
ture of 100°. 

To produce the maximum depression of freezing point peculiar 
to any temperature requires that the thermometer be kept at that 
temperature for a certain length of time. For a temperature of 
100° a half hour suffices; for 50° two hours are required. 

If the thermometer is kept at 100° longer than half an hour 
the depressed freezing point after that time begins to rise. If con- 
tinued at the higher temperature for two weeks the freezing point at 
the end of that time will be found to have risen about one degree. 
This fact is taken advantage of by some makers of thermometers 
to produce an instrument whose freezing point will vary but little 
in years subsequent to its manufacture. 

The depression of freezing point produced by high temperature 
is only temporary. ‘The thermometer in the course of time regains 
the reading of its freezing point corresponding to ordinary tempera- 
tures. The more quickly the depression is produced the more 
slowly the reading is regained. 

After a thermometer has been subjected to a temperature of 100° 


GENERAL MEETING. 27 


it will regain its ordinary freezing point reading in one month. 
The change in the first part of this period is much more rapid than 
towards the end. To recover the depression caused by 50° re- 
quires only two days. The older a thermometer the more quickly 
it gains its freezing point corresponding to ordinary temperatures. 
An instrument forty years old will regain its freezing point after 
exposure to 100° in one week while an instrument three years old 
requires a month. 

The more alternations of temperature a thermometer is subjected 
to the more quickly its freezing point rises. 

A thermometer subjected to a very high temperature, as 350°, will 
will have its freezing point raised from 12° to 20°. This rise is © 
not due to softness of the glass at the high temperature and a con- 
sequent diminution in the volume of the bulb by the atmospheric 
pressure. This is shown by experiments with weight-thermometers. 
In these the tubes are open to the pressure of the air and there is 
as much pressure inside as outside the bulb. 

As heating to 100° depresses the freezing point while heating to 
350° raises it there must be some intermediate temperature for 
which there is no change. This point is usually at the tempera- 
ture of about 160° to 180°, but varies widely with thermometers 
made of different kinds of glass. 

When a thermometer is subjected to a very low temperature a 
temporary rise in its freezing point is produced. To produce an 
appreciable rise requires a long-continued exposure. After being 
kept twenty-four hours at — 30° the freezing point is found to be 
about 0.05° higher than at first. 

One hundred degrees on the centigrade scale is taken as the tem- 
perature of steam from pure water boiling under a normal barometric 
pressure equal to 760 mm. of mercury. A variation of 1 mm. 
in the pressure will change the temperature 0.04°. 

Zero is taken as the temperature at which pure ice melts when 
subject to an atmosphere of pressure. An increase of a whole at- 
mosphere lowers the temperature of the melting point of ice 0.008°. 
This is to be distinguished from the effect of an atmosphere of 
pressure on the reading of a thermometer ; by compressing the bulb 
it causes the thermometer to read about 0.°2 higher than if there 
was no pressure. 

The fundamental distance on a normal thermometer is taken as 
the reading it would have at a true temperature of exactly 100° 


28 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


minus the reading of its depressed freezing point. This, which 
should be exactly one hundred degrees, rarely isso. When the fun- 
damental distance is taken in this way it is invariable with age. It 
is the same forty years after the thermometer is made as four hours 
after, provided the thermometer is kept at ordinary temperatures. 
The fundamental distance is not invariable when the raised freez- 
ing point is used in forming it instead of the depressed freezing 
point. In this case there is a constant diminution with age as the 
raised freezing point rises more rapidly than the boiling point. 
There is not uniformity of practice in the matter of forming the fun- 
damental distance, but it is greatly to be desired. 

Heating a thermometer to 350° causes a permanent increase in 
its fundamental distance between depressed freezing point and boil- 
ing, varying from 0.°4 to 0.°9. An increase of 0.°4 in the funda- 
mental distance corresponds to a decrease of sc part in the coefii- 
cient of expansion of the glass. 

The total correction of a mercurial normal thermometer for 
errors in its construction is composed of three parts: 

1st. The correction for erroneous fundamental distance. For 

any temperature this is a proportional part of the differ- 
ence between the fundamental distance and 100°. 

2nd. The calibration correction. This is the correction to the 

scale marks considered as subdividing the capacity of the 
tube from 0° to 100° into one hundred equal parts. It 
involves variations in the bore of the tube as well as irreg- 
ularities in the placing of the marks. 

3rd. The correction at freezing point. This is the amount the 

thermometer reads in melting ice above or below 0°. At 
any time it is the observed reading of the thermometer in 
melting ice immediately after exposure to the temperature 
measured. Sometimes it is impossible and it is almost 
always inconvenient to observe the freezing point of the 
thermometer immediately after observing a temperature. 
In such a case the position of the depressed freezing point 
for that temperature must be computed from the law of 
the variation of the freezing point. It is always prefera- 
ble however when the highest accuracy is required to ac- 
tually observe the freezing point. . 

When a thermometer is put in ice this is what happens: The 
column falls rapidly at first, then more slowly. Presently it be- 


GENERAL MEETING. 29 


comes stationary ; finally it begins to rise. Fifteen minutes after 
the thermometer reaches its lowest reading this rise is about 0.°01. 
It is best-in observing the freezing point of a thermometer to put it 
in ice thoroughly saturated with water. The ice should be con- 
tained in a vessel from which the water cannot flow off. A ther- 
mometer put in ice in this condition takes on the temperature of 
0° more quickly than if put in dry ice containing a good deal of 
air. This method of siicartlaa the freezing point was introduced 
by Baudin of Paris. 
There is another correction to a normal thermometer which is 
little known and rarely applied. Let: 
V = volume of bulb at 0°. 
v = volume of tube from 0° to 100° at temperature 0°. 
= coefficient of cubical expansion of glass. 
7 = coefficient of expansion of mercury. 
T = thermometer-reading corrected for calibration, ete. 
= true temperature. 
A consideration of the construction of the thermometer leads to 
this equation : 


Vd+)+ed+M 2 -va+y. (1) 


The volume of the bulb at ¢°, plus the volume of that part of the 
tube corresponding to the thermometer reading, is equal to the 
volume of the mercury at ¢°. For ¢= 100 the equation becomes: 

V+ £100) + + £100) = V1 + 100). (2) 

Eliminating 7 from (2) by means of its value found from (1) 

we have: Way 
T=. par gg (3) 

Taking as the coefficient of cubical expansion of glass, 2, the 
quantity 0.000026, the following values are found for 7'— ¢, for 
the various readings of the thermometer from — 40° to + 100°. 


fl T—t 

oC. (a 6 
— 40 — 0.145 
— 20 — 0.062 
0 0.000 
+ 20 + 0.042 
40 + 0.062 
50. + 0.065 
60. + 0.062 
80. + 0.042 


30 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


These are known as the Poggendorf corrections. They are due 
to the capacity of the tube from the zero to the ome-hundred degree 
mark, being different at different temperatures. 

In the following table are shown the results of the comparisons 
of a certain mercurial thermometer, Tounelot No. 4207, with the 
air-thermometer : 

Tounelot No. 4207. 


Correction . Correction to 
Scale reading. | as a normal ther- | reduce to the air Differences. 

mometer. thermometer. 
°c. ec, °c. oc. 
0.0 0.00 0.00 0.00 
5.6 + 0.05 + 0.01 + 0.04 
11.1 + 0.08 0.00 -- 0.08 
16.1 + 0.10 + 0.02 + 0.08 
22.2 + 0.15 + 0.05 + 0.10 
25.2 + 0.16 + 0.07 + 0.09 
30.1 +. 0.20 + 0.09 + 0.11 
35.4 + 0.22 + 0.10 + 0.12 
40.4 + 0.25 + 0.12 + 0.13 
45.1 + 0.25 + 0.16 + 0.09 
50.1 + 0.24 + 0.15 -+ 0.09 
52.7 + 0.24 + 0.16 + 0.08 
55.8 + 0.24 + 0.18 + 0.06 


If it be supposed that these differences are due to sensible terms 
in the expansion of glass and mercury dependent on the squares of 
the temperatures, an equation can be derived which will show that 
the maximum difference must be at 50°. But this is not so; the 
greatest difference is at about 40°. This agrees with what has 
been found by others. Rowland at Baltimore found the greatest 
difference at 40° to 45°; Mills in England found it at 35°, and 
Grunmach in Berlin at 30°. 

Forming a theory of the differences on the supposition that they 
depend on the third powers of the temperatures as well as the 
squares, equation (4) is obtained, which gives the relation between 
the thermometer reading, 7, and the true temperature, ¢. 


ee A, ) Sine B, 2 
— 4,144,100 baerrneny ta ane y 
1+ 4, 1 4%? 100 + Ys — Bs (100)° 
n— n—?, 
This is only approximate. The effects of the second and third 


(4) 


GENERAL MEETING. 31 


powers of the temperatures in changing the capacity of the tube 
from 0° to 100° are neglected. The capacity of the tube is only 4 
part of that of the bulb. 

f,, 2 2, are the coefficients of expansion for glass for the first, 
second, and third powers of the temperature. 7,, 7,, 7; are the 
same for mercury. 

To make an adjustment of the differences between the mercurial 


and air-thermometers equation (4) can be put in the form 
(100¢ — #) x + (10000¢ — #) y + 0.000026?— 0.0026¢+4=0 (5) 
i Ps ier 8 
a 
proximate than (4) but still sufficiently rigorous for the purpose 
intended. 

Forming observation-equations on this model with the observed 
differences A, as the absolute terms, and solving by the method of 
least squares, the values of x and y are found to be 


2 = — 0.0001391 
y = + 0.000000863 


Substituting these in (5) it becomes 
— 0.00788¢ + 0.000165 — 0.000000863# + a = 0. (6) 


: Ba ‘ he Me 
Differentiating (6) with respect to ¢ and A, and putting 7, = 0, 


in which « = anda = T—t. This is less ap- 


the following quadratic-equation is found 
0.0000025897 — 0.000330¢ + 0.00788 = 0, (7) 


the solution of which gives for the temperatures at which the differ- 
ences between the mercurial and air-thermometer are greatest t = 
31.8 and t= 95.8. To find the temperatures at which the mercurial 
and air-thermometer agree, put A = 0 in (6); the values of ¢ that 
then satisfy the equation are t = 0, t= 100, and ¢ = 91. 

At 32° the mercurial thermometer reads higher than the air- 
thermometer, at 96°, it reads lower. A curve representing the 
differences has the following form: 


25° 73" z00° 
Fig. 1.—T 4207 minus Air-thermometer. Abscissas = Temperatures. 


Centigrade. Ordinates = Differences. 


50° 


82 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


This agrees with what has been observed by Dr. Grunmach of 
the Berlin Aichungs Commission. He found the maximum differ- 
ence on a certain thermometer to be + 0.°12 at 29.°8, and another 
secondary maximum of — 0.°04 at 82°. 

A slight change in the values of « and y will make a large 
change in the position of the secondary maximum, For another 
thermometer investigated at the Signal Office this point was found 
to be at 130°. 

The values of « and y can be analyzed still further to ascertain 
whether consistent with known physical properties of glass and 
mercury. | 

Taking Broch’s values for the expansion of mercury, which are 
based on a re-reduction of Regnault’s observations, it is found, 
adapting the figures to the notation used here, that: 


y, = + 0.000181792 
y, = + 0.000000000175 
yg = + 0.000000000035116 


Substituting these values of y, and 7, in the equations 


and aking 3 = 0.000026 we get 


8, = + 0.000000021859 
2, = + 0.000000000099512 


The linear coefficient of expansion of a specimen of glass, such 
as is used in barometer-tubes and thermometers, has been very care- 
fully determined by Dr. Benoit of the International Bureau of 
Weights and Measures. Deriving from this the cubical coefficient,, 
in the notation used here, we have Dr. Benoit’s values 


2, = -+ 0.0000252 
8, = + 0.0000000144 


It will thus be seen that there is a good agreement between the 
two values of , found by the two different processes. 


Remarks were made by Messrs. Gippert, Harkness, and 
PAUL. 


GENERAL MEETING. 33 
Mr. J. H. Kipper made a communication on 
THE GILDING OF THERMOMETER BULBS, 
and was followed by Mr. H. ALLEN Hazen on 


EFFECTS OF SOLAR RADIATION UPON THERMOMETER BULBS 
HAVING DIFFERENT METALLIC COVERINGS. 


[Abstract. ] 


After showing the importance of shielding from or measuring the 
effects of solar radiation upon thermometer bulbs used in determin- 
ing the air temperature and indicating the attempts that have been 
made in obtaining satisfactory results in the past, Mr. Hazen 
explained the most recent work of Prof. Wild, of St. Petersburg. 
Prof. Wild had a bulb coated with copper by the galvanoplastic 
method, then the copper with gold, which latter was highly polished. 
From theoretical considerations he established a formula as follows : 


~=t,—c¢c(,—4,), 


in which t, = temperature of air sought; ¢, = that of the metallic- 
covered bulb; ¢, = that of a black bulb; and ¢ is a constant which 
he assumed at .15. The published observations indicated a very 
high reading of the metal-covered bulb, even higher than would 
have been obtained with a bare glass bulb. 

Mr. Hazen’s own experiments consisted in comparisons between 
bulbs as follows:- (1) black, (2) bright, (3, 4) with silver and gold 
deposited in an exceedingly thin layer and giving a most admirable 
surface, and (5, 6) with silver and gold deposited on copper as nearly 
as possible as suggested by Prof. Witp. These thermometers were 
exposed in sunshine in the open air as well as indoors. It was very 
difficult to shield from other radiations, dark heat, etc., but it was 
found that an exposure of two feet from a window pane gave fairly 
good results. The results are given in the accompanying table. In 
computing the actual value of ¢, from the formula it was found 
necessary to take the readings of the black and bright bulbs at each 
set and compute the ¢, by using .6 as the constant. It was found 
that the black and bright bulbs were the only ones that did not de- 
teriorate from day to day. All the metal-covered bulbs were 
carefully polished each day. 


40 


84 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Comparison of various coverings of thermometer bulbs (out of doors). 


7 
Bright i 


lower 
than Silver Gold Silver Gold 
Date. Black. black. deposit. deposit. plated. plated. 
6 a ¢e. > A ber e. ° Ge] 9 c. 
ANAT LAs OUsseriace 87.5 7.2 .60 9.0 -29 | 7.0 +65 "| 7.7 49 | 5.8 1.00 
PESTO! wi reaxasens 76.3 6.5 -60 8.2 -28 | 6.3 -65 | 6.9 -50 | 5.1 1.04 
ek et Watesivas 89.0 4.9 -60 6.3 -24 | 4.7 -67 | 5.5 42 | 3.7 1.11 
P20) eee ee 76.8 6.0 -60 Neo 32 | 5.6 -71 | 6.3 52 | 5.1 88 
Oe Cees ay 83.9 1.3 60 | 9.2 -27 | 6.7 -75 | T.4 -50 | 5.8 1.02 
Se \ Visvtesant 89.3 5.6 .60 7.6 -18 | 5.8 55 | 6.1 48 | 5.0 .80 
May = tc. vent 76.9 7.3 .60 9.4 .24 | 6.9 Bs (00) lake Gi 6 52 | 6.3 86 
a) Pc aeen 82.8 6.9 -60 8.8 -25 | 6.6 -67 | 7.7 43 | 5.8 ° .89 
el Ch 92.1 8.3 -60 | 10.3 27 | 7.9 -66 | 8.2 -60 | 7.6 Py 6’ 
Meant s tacmece 83.8 6.7 60 | 8.5 -26 | 6.4 Ai Gn | ge i 50 | 5.6 81 


The results in this table may be taken as relatively accurate, 
though the absolute values cannot be relied on. We find the 
constant in the case of the silver-deposited bulb less than one-half 
that of the bright or bare glass bulb; the gold-deposited runs 
a little higher; the silver-plated somewhat lower, while the gold- 
plated is the. highest of all. In the gold-deposited thermometer 
the covering was so thin that it showed a green light through. It 
has been shown that under these circumstances gold transmits a 
little heat. The gold-plated thermometer gives a remarkable result 
due partly to the thickness of the metal and partly to a slight 
roughness, it having been found impossible to deposit a perfectly 
smooth copper surface as a base. 

Incidentally these plated bulbs have furnished corroboration of a 
point presented to the Society some time ago, namely, the effect 
of a layer of ice upon a bulb in contracting it-at low tempera- 
tures. It is plain that at the temperature of deposition there 
would be no effect, but as the temperature was lowered, since 
the metal contracts faster than glass, the tendency would be to a 
too high reading of the thermometer—e. g., Thermometer No. 840 
gave too high readings at different temperatures as follows: at 12°, 
3.6; 30°, 1.4; 40°, 1.0; 50°, .7; 60°, .4, and 70°, .1. 


Remarks on these communications were made by Messrs. PAut, 
MENDENHALL, BILLiInes, and WoopWARD. 


GENERAL MEETING. 35 


288TH MEETING. May 22, 1886. 
Vice-President HarKNEss in the Chair. 
Forty-eight members and visitors present. 
Mr. Newton L. Bares read a communication entitled 


ORGANIC CELLS OF UNKNOWN ORIGIN AND FORM FOUND IN 
HUMAN FACES (TWO CASES),”* 


illustrating his remarks by specimens exhibited under the microscope. 


Referring to the composition of these cells, reported to contain four 
per cent. of silica, Mr. CLARKE called attention to the desirability 
of testing for other inorganic substances. In reply to a question as 
to where in the intestinal canal the cells had been found, Mr. Barrs 
replied that the evidence in the case indicated the lower part of 
the canal. 


' 
Mr. J. S. Brnuines made a communication 


ON MUSEUM SPECIMENS ILLUSTRATING BIOLOGY. 
[Abstract. ] 


After referring to the increasing interest on the part of the pub- 
lic in Biology and Natural History, as theories of evolution, natural 
selection, etc., are becoming better understood, and to the conse- 
quent increasing importance of museums or parts of museums in- 
tended to illustrate the structure and functions of animals, several 
types of museums were briefly described, including the collection at 
Florence, the Hunterian Museum, the average Medical School Mu- 
seum, the museums proposed by Drs. Roberts, Wilder, and Shu. 
feldt, etc. 

The special scope and purposes of the Army Medical Museum 
were stated to be to illustrate: 1. The effects, immediate and remote, 
of wounds and of those diseases most prevalent in the army, 2. ¢., 


* These cells are now believed to have come from the banana. If a trans- 
verse slice of banana is placed in a watch glass and covered with strong 
nitric acid, two rows of cells become colored and are apparent to the naked 
eye. A note on the subject may be found in the Boston Medical and Surgi- 
cal Journal, March 10th, 1883, p. 446. Similar changes doubtless take 
place by prolonged stay in the intestine, and when found clean and free 
from vegetable fiber these cells are likely to deceive expert microscopists. 


36 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


the diseases and injuries of adult males. 2. The work of the 
medical department of an army, modes of transporting sick and 
wounded, hospitals, medical supplies, instruments, ete. 3. Human 
anatomy and pathology of both sexes and all ages. This requires 
many specimens in comparative anatomy and pathology, which are 
indispensable for a correct understanding of the structure, develop- 
ment, abnormalities and diseases of man. It is not however proposed 
to form a museum of comparative anatomy—that belongs to the 
functions of the National Museum. 4. To show the morphologi- 
cal basis, or want of such basis, for ethnological classification, more 
especially: of the native races of America. This includes anthro- 
pometry and craniology. 5. To illustrate for medical investiga- 
tors and teachers the latest methods, the newest apparatus, etc., for 
biological investigation, and various modes of preparing and mount- 
ing specimens. In connection with this it is hoped to induce origi- 
nal workers to deposit in the museum type specimens or series of 
specimens illustrating their discoveries and methods. 

The classification and arrangement of specimens which it is pro- 
posed to carry out in the new Museum building were then briefly 
described. 

Various modes of preparing specimens were shown, including 
dissections under spirit, frozen and tinted sections, injections by cor- 
rosion, ete., and the difficulties in making and preserving such 
specimens were explained. 

A second communication on the same subject was made by Mr. 
G. Brown Goong, and a third, by request, by Mr. FRepERICK A. 
Lucas, of the National Museum, who spoke more especially of 
osteological specimens. The papers were all fully illustrated by 
specimens from the Medical and National Museums. 


Mr. Grorce P. MrerRILL made a communication 
ON GEOLOGICAL MUSEUMS. 


Remarks were made on the general subject of museums and their 
management by Prof. Epwarp Morsg, of Salem, Mass. 


GENERAL MEETING. 37 


289TH MEETING. OcToBER 9, 1886. 
The President in the Chair. 
Seventy-eight members and guests present. 


The Chair announced the election to membership of Messrs. 
Coorer CurticE, Henry MitrcHeLtt, Henry Gustav Bryer, 
and Newton LEMUEL Bares. 


The subject for the evening was 
THE CHARLESTON EARTHQUAKE, 


which was discussed by Messrs. T. C. MenpENHALL and W J Mc- 
GEE and Prof. CHarLEes G. Rockwoop of Princeton, N. J. 

Mr. MENDENHALL spoke of the odor observed on Sullivan’s 
Island previous to the shock, of the time of the clock-stopping 
shock in Charleston, of the detonations accompanying the various 
shocks and heard in Charleston, Summerville, and elsewhere, of the 
torsional movements of monuments, and of the directions in which 
various structures were thrown down. He exhibited an isoseismal 
map compiled from data gathered by the U.S. Signal Service. He 
also stated at second hand a novel theory for the origin of the earth- 
quake, and spoke of the convergence of opinion of geologists and 
physicists in regard to the condition of the interior of the earth. 
He accepted as the time of the clock-stopping shock in Charleston 
9h. 51’ 20” Pp. M. 

Mr. McGee described the geological relations of Charleston, 
showing that a depth of 2,000 feet of clastic rocks had been demon- 
strated beneath the city, and that the total depth to the crystalline 
rocks might be as much as one mile. He described the pheno- 
mena of deformation of rails and other railway structures, gave in 
detail an observation of a severe shock at Summerville, described the 
detonations, and exhibited numerous photographs illustrating the 
destructive work of the earthquake and the formation of craterlets 
and sinks. 

Prof. Rockwoop exhibited an isoseismal map compiled from data 
gathered by the Earthquake Commission, and characterized by far 
greater irregularities in the form of contours than were shown by 
Mr. Mendenhall’s map. He called attention to the fact that nearly 
all the isoseismal curves show salient angles toward the northwest. 
He dwelt upon the exceptional nature of this opportunity for earth- 
quake investigation, and urged that the utmost advantage be taken 


38 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 
\ 


of it. He spoke also of the complexity of earthquake movements, 
and the difficulties to be overcome in analysing them. He thought 
that the conspicious inequality in the violence of the shocks at lo- 
calities not widely separated was to be ascribed to the intersection 
and combination of rock waves deflected by reflection and refrac- 
tion. Two intersecting waves would be especially destructive at 
their nodal points, and comparatively harmless at their points of 
interference. 

It was announced by the President that the discussion would be 
continued at the next meeting. 


290TH MEETING. | OcToBER 23, 1886. 
The President in the Chair. 
Sixty-seven members and guests present. 
The discussion of 
THE CHARLESTON EARTHQUAKE 


was resumed, the principal speakers being Mr. Everrerr HayDEN 
and Mr. H. M. Paut. Remarks were made by Messrs. McGeEg, 
Bruuines, Rosinson, Durron, BELL, CLARKE, and GILBERT, and 
by Dr. E. P. Howxanp, who was present by invitation. 

Mr. Haypen first discussed a chart on which were plotted the 
areas disturbed by earthquakes in the southeastern United States 
from 1874 to 1885, compiled from Rockwood’s Notes in the Ameri- 
can Journal of Science. This indicated two earthquake belts, one 
along the Appalachians, the other along the coast. In the former 
28 shocks are recorded, in only 3 of which the area is as great as 
1,000 square miles (2 in central Virginia, and 1 in western North 
Carolina and northern Georgia); in the latter 5 are recorded, 
only 1 of which (that of 1879 in Florida and Georgia) was at all 
severe. So far as this evidence goes, therefore, we should have ex- 
pected a severe shock like that of August 31st to have originated 
in the Appalachians and to have been orogenic in character, an 
accompaniment of the gradual elevation of the range. 

He then proceeded to give a summary of the information which 
had reached the Geological Survey up to date, illustrating by charts 
of isoseismal and coseismal lines. The geologic and physical phe- 
nomena in the region of greatest intensity having been already dis- 


, 
iF 


THE \ 
CHARLESTON EARTHQUAKE \ 


from data in the hands of the 
U. Ss. GEOLOGICAL SURVEY 
Oct. 23, 1886. 
Everett Hayden, Asst. Geol., 


GENERAL MEETING. 39 


cussed at the last meeting were not touched upon. The data used 
came for the most part from correspondence with private parties, 
although some valuable information had been received from the 
Signal Service, Light-House Board, and Hydrographic Office—only 
a small portion, however, of what they would eventually furnish. 
The State Department had reported that the shock was felt very 
slightly in Bermuda, and would report later as to Cuba and the 
Bahamas. 

The isosetsmals were plotted on an enlarged photograph of the 
relief model of the eastern United States in the Coast Survey Office, 
which illustrated the general topographic features more graphically 
than an ordinary map. In the discussion special attention was paid 
to explaining their irregular shapes by reference to the surface con- 
figuration as well as the geologic structure of the country. The 
inclosed area, marked 4, in West Virginia and Kentucky, well 
illustrates the fact that a shock may be felt with greater severity 
beyond a mountain range than in its midst. The similar isolated 
areas of less intensity in Indiana and Illinois are also typical of 
variations due to local conformations ; were it possible to plot inten- 
sities in still greater detail there would doubtless be hundreds of 
such isolated districts all through the disturbed area. Other points 
dwelt upon were the unobstructed transmission of the vibrations 
along the parallel ridges of the range and up the valleys of the 
Connecticut and Hudson rivers; the obstruction offered by ridges, 
valleys, and strike of strata transverse to the direction of propaga- 
tion; and the rapid loss of energy in the sands and alluvial deposits 
of the northeast coast and lower Mississippi valley. The total 
land area included within the outer isoseismal is 774,000 square 
miles, and if we add only half as much more for ocean area it 
closely approximates to that given by Reclus for the great Lisbon 
earthquake. Special acknowledgement was made for valuable 
positive and negative reports received from members of the New 
England Meteorological Society through their secretary, Prof. W. 
M. Davis; they accurately fixed the limits of the disturbed area 
in New England. 

' The coseismals were plotted from the most reliable and consist- 
ent among a hundred or more good time observations, and special 
care was taken to make them conform to the actual facts, unin- 
fluenced by any preconceived theoretical ideas. Attention was 
called to certain peculiarities of these lines, such as their noticeable 


3 


pS 


\ 
5 CHARLESTON EARTHQUAKE \ 
from data in the hands of the 
U. S. GEOLOGICAL SURVBY 
Oct. 23, 1886. 
oF Byerett Hayden, Asst. Geol. 


THE 


ra 
ea 


| aS 
Tsoseismals baer 

5 
Bpicentrun *& 
Coseismals ——— = 


Note.—Euartiest time 3.51 P. M. 
(75th Meridian) 
August 31. 


40 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


prolongation to the northward and southwestward ; the narrow inter- 
vals where they run along the western flanks of, the Appalachians 
and across the Florida peninsula; and the wide intervals in the 
Ohio and upper Mississippi valleys. The following considerations 
were offered as helping to explain these apparently anomalous fea- 
tures: The crystalline Archean rocks and parallel ridges of the 
mountain chain favor a rapid axial transmission of the vibrations, 
The first tremors spreading to the northwestward, however, are cut. 
off and deadened by the mountains, so that it isa later phase of the 
wave which is felt and recorded beyond; having passed the range 
it then spreads with little obstruction and high velocity through 
comparatively level strata. Similarly in the littoral and alluvial 
deposits to the northeast, south, and southwest the earlier tremors 
are lost and later phases of the wave are successively recorded. 
It is especially to be remembered that all these times are from non- 
instrumental observations ; an exact instrumental observation made 
at Toronto, Ontario, by Prof. Chas. Carpmael (9: 54: 50 P. m.), 
could not be used here because so early as to be wholly inconsistent 
with all other reliable but non-instrumental observations. 

The epicentrum, or point on the surface directly above that part 
of the deep-lying fissure where the earliest vibrations originated, is 
placed by these coseismals about a hundred miles north of Charles- 
ton, which is not at all inconsistent with the fact that the greatest 
damage was caused in that city. In fact, it is to be expected that 
the destruction of buildings should be greater at a distance, where 
the angle of emergence is less. Moreover,'most of the evidence 
seems to point to a very deep-lying origin, in which case one can- 
not but attribute much of the local damage, as well as the continu- 
ance of shocks of considerable intensity but small area, to the 
character of the recent geologic formations in that region. Borings 
for artesian wells at Charleston indicate that the Tertiary and 
Cretaceous strata are very heterogeneous in character—sands, 
clays, limestone-marls, and imperfectly consolidated beds of con- 
glomerate, with occasional cavities containing running water—and 
much of the city is built upon made land. Such considerations 
may explain the extremely local character of many of the shocks 
which have been felt at various points in the State of South 
Carolina since August 31st, as well as the great intensity of the 
shock at Charleston on that date. Local sinks in the ground are re- 
ported even in northern Florida, far from the origin of the disturb- 


GENERAL MEETING. Al 


ance. An analogous case is seen in the fact that the great destruc- 
tion of life and property at Lisbon, in 1755, occurred in those por- 
tions of the city built on weak Tertiary formations, while houses on 
the firmly consolidated Secondary rocks suffered little damage. 

The following velocities of wave transmission are indicated : 


To— Feet per second. Miles per minute. 
MOMoOMtOe ONtAriO @ see os ee Coe 15,000 170 
Wreebington, D.C. 522s Lc) 18,000 148 
Prarie dur@hien,, Wise: 224 222-825 . 93800 106 

OURO a Soe eee cece Le eOU 141 


By way of comparison the following recorded velocities are of 
interest: Lisbon, 1755, 2,000 feet per second; Naples, 1857, 1775; 
St. Lawrence valley, 1870, 12,000; England, 1884, 9,200. 

Reported directions of transmission, while very often what we 
should expect, are yet generally so contradictory as to be of little 
value. Similarly the number of shocks felt is recorded so differently 
by different observers as to be very confusing ; the occurrence of 
two shocks at a point at some distance from the origin is explained 
by the hypothesis that the first traveled rapidly through the hard 
under-lying rocks, and the second more slowly through the softer 
and more recent strata above. The shock is reported as accom- 
panied by sounds of greater or less intensity all along the extent 
of Archean rocks from northern Alabama to Connecticut, and at 
points on the coastal plain within a radius of about 300 miles from 
the origin. 

The coincidence of an unusually high tide is worthy of remark ; 
the moon was near perigee, and there had been an eclipse of the 
sun only three days previously. The fact that no sea-wave was 
caused by the shock confirms the conclusion that the origin was in- 
land. The weather is generally reported to have been very still 
and: sultry, although there were no unusual barometric conditions. 
The summer had been an unusually dry one. 

Only two other recorded earthquakes in North America can be 
compared with this in either area or intensity: that at New Madrid, 
Missouri, in 1811, which was probably fully its equal, and that in 
the St. Lawrence valley in 1870, equal possibly in area but not in 
intensity. 

Mr. Paut explained the generally received classification of earth- 
quake waves, described some of the results of the Tokio earthquake 


42 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


studies, discussed the relation of destructiveness to amplitude of 
vibration and to rate of acceleration, and requested Mr. McGee to 
describe more specifically than at the last meeting the phenomena 
observed by him in connection with a severe shock in Summerville. 

Mr. McGee said that during the tremor the bedstead upon which 
he lay left the floor from fifteen to thirty times, the departures 
being roughly estimated at three per second. The clear ascent, as 
judged from the force of the return blow, ranged from one-fourth 
inch to two or three inches. The bed stood on the ground floor 
of a wooden house, supported on piers. Earlier shocks had crushed 
or driven down the piers under the heavier parts of the house, so 
that the weight was borne in large part by piers under verandas, etc. 

Mr. Paut said that if the floor in descending separated from the | 
legs of the bedstead its acceleration of motion must exceed that due 
to gravitation. The fall of the earth manifestly could not be faster 
than that of the bedstead. Assuming the accuracy of the observa- 
tion the only possible explanation would seem to be that the floor 
had behaved as an elastic spring. 

Dr. How.anp described a shock observed by himself, and said 
that of some hundreds of chimneys observed by him in Charleston 
75 per cent. had fallen to the west. 

The PrestpEnt spoke of the bearing of the earthquake upon sani- 
tary matters. The water mains. in Charleston had been run in 
some places through sewers, and there is no assurance that these 
mains are now in such condition as to render contamination im- 
possible. 

Mr. Durron inferred from the magnitude of the area through 
which the shock was felt, as compared with its moderate destruc- 
tiveness in the central region, that the centrum lay at great depth. 

Mr. Breit was much interested in the statement that, even at 
considerable distances from the centre of disturbance, the noise ac- 
companying the earthquake either preceded the shock or was per- 
ceived simultaneously with it. This, he thought, indicated that the 
sound was of local origin. The great velocity with which the 
earthquake disturbance had been propagated seemed to him to pre- 
clude the idea of a sound-wave from the centre of disturbance as 
the cause of the noise perceived. Any sound due to this cause 
should, he thought, at considerable distances, have been observed 
after the experience of the shock. 

He also spoke of the worthlessness of testimony regarding the 


GENERAL MEETING. 43 


direction of sounds proceeding from points below the observer. In 
this connection he directed attention to experiments relating to 
Binaural Audition which he had communicated to the American 
Association for the Advancement of Science in 1879;* and he 
recommended any one who placed reliance on the testimony that 
had been adduced relating to the direction of the earthquake noises 
to try the following experiment: 


To one end of a long pole attach an ordinary electric call-bell, 
and at the other end place a push-knob, by means of which the ex- 
perimenter can at will ring the bell. Let the person whose credi- 
bility as a witness is to be tested stand with his feet considerably 
apart, with his eyes closed and head still. The experimenter can 
then silently move the call-bell into any desired position before 
ringing, and the observer can indicate his appreciation of the direc- 
tion of the sound by pointing to the place from whence he conceives 
it to have emanated, 

Such being the disposition of the parties the experiment Mr. Bell 
would recommend is the following: Carefully and silently intro- 
duce the end of the pole between the legs of the observer so that 
the bell is directly underneath him. Now ring and ask your wit- 
ness to indicate by pointing the position of the bell. He had tried 
the experiment many times, and had been surprised, and even 
startled, by the result. The observer usually formed a distinct 
judgment as to the direction of the sound, but the one feature that 
was common to all the experiments was that the indicated direction 
was wrong. 

Mr. GitBert remarked that the simultaneous occurrence of deto- 
nations and tremors indicated that the sound waves were identical 
with some at least of the waves constituting the earthquake. It was 
therefore legitimate to compare the velocity of transmission of the 
earthquake waves with the velocity of transmission of sound in vari- 
ous media, and such comparison indicates that the portion of the 
crust traversed by the earthquake waves was characterized by an 
elasticity between that of gold and that of iron. 

Mr. Bex thought that deductions based upon the assumption 
that the disturbance had been propagated with the velocity of 


* The paper was published in extenso in the American Journal of Otology 
for July, 1880, vol. II, p. 169. See also Nature, vol. X XI, p. 310, and vol. 
XXII, pp. 586-7. 


44 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


sound should be received with caution; for it is well known that 
very great and sudden disturbances may be propagated through a 
medium with a greater velocity than the normal velocity of sound 
in that medium. In Captain Parry’s Arctic expedition it was 
noticed that distant observers heard the report of cannon before 
hearing the command to fire. 


The PRESIDENT announced that Mr. T. C. MENDENHALL, having 
removed from the city, had resigned his position on the General 
Committee of the Society, and that the committee had filled the 
vacancy by the election of Mr. Wiiu14Mm B. Tayxor. 


291st Meerrina. NovEeMBER 6, 1886. 


Vice-President MALLERY in the Chair. 


Twenty-three members and guests present. 
Mr. O. T. Mason made a communication on 


BOWYERS AND FLETCHERS. 


[Abstract. ] 


Whatever may be our theory of creation, the arts of mankind 
proceed from the same sources as the genera and species of natural 
objects. The design ‘of this paper is to demonstrate, by means of 
an art almost universally dispersed in time and place, that we may 
regard the implements and products of human industry in the light 
of biological specimens. They may be divided into families, genera, 
and species. They may be studied in their several ontogenies (that 
is, we may watch the unfolding of each individual thing from its 
raw material to its finished production). ‘They may be regarded as 
the products of specific evolution out of natural objects serving 
human wants and up to the most delicate machine performing the 
same function. They may be modified by their relationship, one to 
another, in sets, outfits, apparatus, just as the insect and flower are 
co-ordinately transformed. They observe the law of change under 
environment and geographical distribution. 

The bow, at first, was only an elastic limb or branch transformed 
little or none at all. From this parent form have developed three 


GENERAL MEETING. 45 


types under the control of the material, namely, the perfect, simple 
how, in lands where elastic woods abound; the compound bow, in 
localities where, by choice or necessity, horn, bone, and antler are 
preferred as material; and the sinew-backed bow, with its two sub- 
types of the corded back and the solid back. Each one of these 
types may be subdivided indefinitely by ethnic marks. 

The arrow, at first a reed or twig unmodified, was only a shaft 
with merely an indication of a head as in some of the lower forms. 
From this, by a normal evolution, have come the feather, fore-shaft, 
head, and barbs, differentiating into endless varieties under the stress 
of material, definite functions, and the thousand and one forces 
which together we may call its environment. 

A large collection of bows and arrows varying in material, form, 
and origin was exhibited to exemplify the theory set forth. 

The communication was discussed by Messrs. Taytor, E. Far- 
QUHAR, RitEy, Harkness, Dati, and Exxiorr. Mr. Taylor 
called attention to the break in the evolutionary history of the bow 
at its very beginning. The stride from the elastic throwing-stick 
to the bow is immense. The discussion turned chiefly upon the 
proper basis for museum classification of ethnological material, 
Messrs. Riley, Dall, and Elliott advocating a classification primarily 
by peoples or races, and Mr. Mason defending the evolutionary 
system, where classification by races is supplemented and traversed 
by a classification in which articles of a kind are placed together. 


Mr. G. K. Gitprrt began a communication on 
CERTAIN NEW AND SMALL MOUNTAIN RANGES, 


which was unfinished when the hour for adjournment arrived. 


292p MEETING. NovemMBER 20, 1886. 
The President in the Chair. 
Forty-two members and guests present. 
Mr. G. K. GILBERT completed his communication 
ON CERTAIN NEW AND SMALL MOUNTAIN RANGES, 


and remarks were made by Messrs. Brntines and Hazen. 


46 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 
Mr. Tuomas Russevu presented a communication on 
NORMAL BAROMETERS, 
which was discussed by Messrs. Brturncs and HARKNEss. 
Mr. N. H. Darron read a paper 


ON THE OCCURRENCE OF COPPER ORE IN THE TRIAS OF THE 


EASTERN UNITED STATES, 
and Mr. J. S. DitueEr followed with a communication on 


THE LATEST VOLCANIC ERUPTION IN NORTHERN CALIFORNIA AND 


ITS PECULIAR LAVA. 
[Published in Am. Jour. Sci., 3d series, vol. xxxiii.] 


Remarks on the last paper were made by Mr. Ipp1nes. 


2938p MEETING. DrcEeMBER 4, 1886. 


By courtesy of the trustees of the Columbian University the meet- 
ing was held in the law lecture-room of the University building. 
Invitation to attend the meeting was extended to the members of 
the Anthropological, Biological, and Chemical societies and of the 
Cusmos Club. ‘Two hundred and two persons were present. 


Vice-President MALLERY presided. 


The Chair read a letter from the secretary of the Chemical Society 
inviting the members of the Philosophical Society to listen, on the 
evening of Dec. 9, to an address by Prof. H. W. WILEY, retiring 
president of the Chemical Society, on “ Our Sugar Supply.” 


President Brituines then presented his annual address, the sub- 
ject being 


SCIENTIFIC MEN AND THEIR DUTIES. 
[Printed in full on pp. Xxxv-Lvi of this volume.] , 


A vote of thanks for the address was passed by the audience. 


GENERAL MEETING. 47 


2940H MEETING. DECEMBER 18, 1886. 


THE SIXTEENTH ANNUAL MEETING. 
The President in the Chair. 


The minutes of the 292d and 293d meetings were read and ap- 
proved. . 

The Chair read the order of business as prescribed by the Stand- 
ing Rules. 

The Secretary read the minutes of the fifteenth annual meeting. 
' The Chair announced the election to membership of Messrs. 
JosEePpH CLAYBAUGH GorDon, NeLtson Horatio Darton, MAr- 
SHALL McDonaup, Witi14mM LEE TRENHOLM, and WILLIAM 
Francis HILLEBRAND. 

The annual report of the Secretaries was read. [See page xxrx.] 

The annual report of the Treasurer was read [see page xxx] and 
referred to an Auditing Committee, consisting of Messrs. R. 8. 
Woodward, 8S. M. Burnett, and J. H. Kidder. 

The Treasurer read the list of members entitled, under Standing 
Rule 14, to vote for officers. 

After a recess of five minutes, the Society proceeded to the elec- 
tion of officers for the year 1887. [The result of the election ap- 
pears on page Xv. | 

The following amendment to the Constitution was offered by 
Mr. W. H. Dall, and laid on the table, as required by Article VI 
of the Constitution. 

In Article III insert, after “ consisting of,” the words the ex-prest- 
dents of the Society. 

In Article IV insert, before “other members,” the word nine. 
[The effect of the amendment is to make ex-presidents of the Society 
permanent members of the General Committee. ] 

The rough minutes of the meeting were then read, and the Society 
adjourned. 


ai Ne ead th yaite ioe iD), \" ta 
Pe 


LSE omy te Mae y; 


ait 


ye tircantene 


a 


1s f opr re 
ni re F a ittoed 


OUT 


ku! ‘ 
; ea 
Phu wm 
a aria  titgs 
t ‘7 man é tLaodi hh ¢ ee ncn) Rite Ch fh 
; + Neer mkt ak cA 
vg 
| f 
be i 
pe \ ih 
An, * 
t { , 3 
ni i} * b * 
oy = i 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


41 49 


STANDING RULES 


OF THE 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


1. The object of this Section is the consideration and discussion 
of papers relating to pure or applied mathematics. 


2. The special officers of the Section shall be a Chairman and a 
Secretary, who shall be elected at the first meeting of the Section 
in each year, and discharge the duties usually attaching to those 
offices. 


3. To bring a paper regularly before the Section it must be sub- 
mitted to the Standing Committee on Communications for the 
stated meetings of the Society, with the statement that it is for the 
Mathematical Section. 


4, Meetings shall be called by the Standing Committee on Com- 
munications whenever the extent or importance of the papers sub- 
mitted and approved appear to justify it. 


5. All members of the Philosophical Society who wish to do so 
may take part in the meetings of this Section. 


6. To every member who shall have notified the Secretary of the 
General Committee of his desire to receive them, announcements of 
the meetings of the Sections shall be sent by mail. 


7. The Section shall have power to adopt such rules of procedure 
as it may find expedient. 


51 


OFFICERS 


OF THE 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION FOR 4886. 


Chairman, Wn. B. Taytor. 


Secretary, Marcus BAKER. 


LIST OF MEMBERS WHO RECEIVE ANNOUNCEMENT OF THE 


ABBE, C. 
Avery, R.S8. 
BAKER, M. 
Bates, H. H. 
Bixiines, J. S. 
Burasss, H. §. 
CurisTiz, A. 8. 
CorFin, J. H.C. 
Curtis, G. E. 
DrLanp, T. L. 
Doouitrie, M. H. 
HASTMAN, J. R. 
EIMBECK, W. 
ExiottT, E. B. 
FARQUHAR, H. 
Fuint, A. S. 
GILBERT, G. K. 
Gore, J. H. 
Green, B. R. 
Hatt, A. 


MEETINGS. 


HArxKNEss, W. 
Hazpn, H. A. 
Hit, G. W. 
Hopextins, H. L. 
Kine, A. F. A. 
KumMEL, C. H. 
Leravour, H. B. 
McGerz, W J 
Martin, A. 
NEWcoB, §. 
PAUL, El. cite 
Ritter, W. F. M’K. 
Ropinson, T. 
SmiILeEy, C. W. 
Stone, O. 
Tayior, W. B. 
Urton, W. W. 
Wintock, W. C. 
Woopwarp, R. 8. 


~ 


ZIWET, A. 
52 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


22p MEETING. Marcu 24, 1886. 
The Chairman, Mr. G. W. H1u1, presided. 
Present, fourteen members and one invited guest. 


Election of officers of the section for the year 1886 was conducted 
by ballot, and resulted in the choice of Mr. W. B. Taytor as chair- 
man and Mr. Marcus BAKER as secretary. 


Mr. Henry FAarRQuHaAr made a communication on 


A COMPARISON OF THE BOSS AND AUWERS DECLINATION 
STANDARDS, 


in which the systematic difference between the standard of Dr. 
Auwers’ “ Fundamental-Catalog” and the “ Normal System of Prof. 
Boss was considered as a function of declination, and shown to be 
almost completely explained by the supposition of a tube-flexure 
inadequately allowed for, in the observations on which one or other 
standard depends. 


[A paper covering the same ground was afterward read by Mr. 
FarquuHar before the American Association for the Advancement 
of Science, and an abstract of it will appear in the proceedings of 
that body for the Buffalo meeting, 1886. ] . 


The paper was briefly discussed by Messrs. Hany, Hiuu, and 
Woopwarp. 
Mr. R. 8. Woopwarp then read a paper entitled 


ON THE POSITION AND SHAPE OF THE GEOID AS DEPENDENT ON 
LOCAL MASSES. 


[This will be published as a Bulletin of the United States Geo- 
logical Survey.] 


na 
v0 


54 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


23p MEETING. ApRIL 14, 1886. 


The Chairman, Mr. Wiii1aAm B. Taytor, elected at the last 
meeting, presided, and upon taking the chair offered a few remarks 
expressive of his appreciation of the honor conferred upon him and 
of his desire for the prosperity of the Section. 


Present, seventeen members and one guest. 


Mr. R. S. Woopwarp recited, in abstract, the principal points of 
his paper of the preceding meeting, and there ensued a general dis- 
cussion of the subject, in which Messrs. BAKER, DooxiTrie, HILL, 
Pau, THomAs RussELL, STONE, TAYLOR, aND WOODWARD par- 
ticipated. 


Mr. C. H. KumME t then presented a paper 


ON THE USE OF SOMOFF’S THEOREM FOR EVALUATION OF THE 
ELLIPTIC INTEGRAL OF THE THIRD SPECIES. 


[This paper will appear in full in Annals of Mathematics, vol. 2, 
Nos. 4 and 5.] 


Remarks were made by Mr. Hu. 


INDEX. 


Address of the President...........sssecsseee 

Administration of research......... 

Amendment to the constitution............. Nesaaiee 

American Historical Association, Invitation 
from the............. 22 

Annual Meeting.......cccccccrrseeeeers aedaoswasaitandes Chali; 


Anthropological Society, Invitation from the 15 
Appalachian region, Physical divisions of 


BUG esac acesses ness “precpenncosnamaeet aicestcneseaseaccnneas 22 
Arctic exploration..........ccee+ eoicn 1S 
Arrow, Development of the 44 
Auditing committee, Appointment of... 47 


— — Report Off........seseeeesesercnescnssenecrersecseceeees 3 

Bates, Newton L.: communication on or- 
ganic cells of unknown origin and form 
found in human f@CES..........0sseceeceeeeeceeees 35 


— election to membership 37 
Bean, T. H.: communication on the sitsets 
bution of fishes in the oceanic abysses 
and middle strata (Title).........cssseeceeceeres 22 
Bell, A. Graham : remarks on aural determi- 
nation of the direction of sound........... . 42 
— remarks on identity of sound and earth- 
QUAKC- WAVES... .ccesceesceceesececessens: cneesenenanes 43 
Beyer, H. G., Election to membership of...... 37 


Bibliography of faults of the Great Basin... 6 
Billings, J. S.: annual address as Presi- 


OM Giovcassscaccecssestvcvsncvecsccercuccensosccsesnee XXxv, 46 
— communication on museum specimens 

PUTS GAGS DIGIOLY.-cne.ccestuacdesccccceesscacecose 35 
— remarks on the Charleston earthquake... 42 
Bowyers and fletchers........... EOE CRORES ELESCCELULO 44 
Bryan, J. H., Election to membership of...... 25 
Bulletin, Rules for publication of............ Costas) LAE 
AGALON OAT ieccecccsecseccnen sre SAacereecbiaccehedtee preeenctes XXViii 
California, Notes on geology of northern...... + 
Pols PRODIEMABLIC..s..c.ccccvsvccccccnssessceecccscn sscecs 35 
Ceremonial institutiONS.............ceseeeeecseeeeees See) 


Chamberlin, T. C.: communication on the 
varying attitudes of former level sur- 
faces in the Great Lake region and the 
applicability of proposed explanations 
\ GILTRE) Vas eR Re ery Beak sccacuvscetes snerenvaqueswccactees 15, 16 

Charleston earthquake.........ccsseeeseeee seasserenos OS 

Chemical Society of Washington, Invitation 


FLOM THO see eieee ccacsnonevee sesssessessssvecssssssrese 46 | 


Page. 
Clarke, F. W.: cited on the relations of Goy- 
ero i 


ernment to chemistry... 
— remarks on problematic cells 
Committee on communications 


— — PUDLIcAtiONS..........eeseeceeeeeeeenes peas kVp, 
== Report) Of AUGITIN GE etic sc:cccsapsccscacsccccenccosses,  G 
—~ Rules of the Peneralwiccvccesccenccnceserasesreven so) XA 
Comparison of the Boss and Auwers decllna- 
TION ALANOALOS seccsnceostasersssecesrsrencarmscessve aw, Oe 
CONS PLGIUGEON oe ccpennteonseutospanenereeestexectdee 
Constitution, Proposed amendment to........ Se LE 


Cummings, G. J., Election to membership of 15 

Curtice, Cooper, Election to membership of. 87 

Curtis, George E.: communication on Lieut. 
Lockwood’s expedition to farthest north 8 


Customs of every day life.............sccsseese esses 19 

Dall, W. H.: offers amendment to the con- 
stitution of the Society......... caaunpapacenenes - 47 

— remarks on museum Classification............ 45 


Darton, N. H.: communication on the oc- 
eurrence of copper ore in the Trias of 
the eastern United States (Title)............ 46 

— Election to membership Of..............sssseeeeee 47 

Deceased members.......... 

Declination standards 

Diller, J. S.: communication on the geology 
Of Northern! CalifOrnis.. ....1..-ceceecesstwacccene 4,8 

— — — — latest volcanic eruption in north- 
ern California and its peculiar lava (Title) 46 

Doolittle, M. H.: remarks on a phonetic 


alphabet.......... aessnnre Gercase.vcsicensase saaveaner sone 19 
Duties of scientific men XXXV 
Barth Quakes... ..scccecesuccnescas anaes 37, 38 


Effects of solar radiation upon iietaneten 
bulbs having different metallic coverings. 33 
HMlection Of OffGOrs..: inc. scccseccscsaccseccustacucsens 47 
Elliott, E. B.: communication on the annual 
profit to banks of national bank note cir- 
culation (Title)......... Rorbeoteoceetrorseosorbonsin 14 
— —— — quantity of United States tanec 
iary silver coin existing and in circula- 
TION GD ULLE) scr cvececuscersuresveenancanse Giadaashcnn worse 14 
— remarks on museum classification.......... 45 
Farquhar, Henry: communication on acom- 
parison of the Boss and Auwers declina- 
PLON SEAN ALAS apeasiuscepesteevonsseaensnosaxcsastisy . 63 


(55) 


56 


Page. 
Farquhar, Henry: communication on a pho- 
MOC BINED OC cpavecscscacstvavcacvevatecsetersdassns 17 
Faults of the Great Basin and Sierra Nevada 65 
Fletchers and DOW YeTS...........cssscescssescnecessess 
General committee, Rules of. 
— meeting, Minutes Of.....2..ccccccereeeees Sedeneen’ 3 
Geology of northern California..........ceceeeeee 4 


Gilbert, G. K.: communication on certain 
new and small mountain ranges (Title)... 45 

— — — the observed changes of level sur- 
faces in the Bonneville area, and their 


explanation (TZitle)......0. s..ss00 Bedsseches edtee 15 
— — — recent changes of level in the basin 

Of Lake Ontario (Title) ........ ncccsssccecesseen 8 
— remarks on geology of Sierra Nevada...... 7 


— — — the Charleston earthquake.............. 43 
Goode, G. Brown: communication on the dis- 


tribution of fishes in the oceanic abysses 

and middle strata (Zitle)......ccessesestssesones 22 
——-— museum specimens illustrating bi- 

OLO LYS (DRE) ivcckspasenessncssasesnsscatescebanaadeune 36 
Gordon, J. C., Election to membership Of...... 4T 
Governmental administration of research... xlii 
Great Basin, Faults of the.............sscccssscceees 5 
Hall, Asaph: communication on the images 

Of CHO/StAIS) (CP UL1e) (vesanseurcs exe sossosdsexeesseusn 15 
— — — — new Star of Andromeda ( Title)...... 14 
Hayden, Everett: communication en the 

Charleston earthquake............cssssesscsseres 38 


Hazen, H. Allen: communication on effects 
of solar radiation upon thermometer 
bulbs having different metalliccoverings 33 
Hill, R. T., Election to membership of......... 19 
Hillebrand, W. F.,Electiontomembershipof 47 
Hitchcock, Romyn: communication on re- 
cent improvements in microscopic ob- 
jectives, with demonstration of the re- 
solving power of a new 1-16 inch (Title).. 16 
Howland, Dr. E. P.: remarks on the Charles- 
TOM GALCHQUAKO... se. ccsecessesserencstsscdestrenee 38 
Irving, R. D.: communication on the en- 
largement of mineral fragments as a 


factor in rock alteration (Title) ............0. 16 
— election to Membership.............ceeseeeeeeeeree 16 
Institutions, Ceremonial.....,..ccscosseseccrrsssccees 19 


Kenaston, C. A., Election to membership of. 16 
Kidder, J. H.: communication entitled, his- 
torical sketch of deep sea temperature 
QUSOLVALIONS) (CL ULLE) scsscessccicansannaces=ieusadoeer 14 
— — — the gilding of thermometer bulbs 


Kummell, C. H.: communication on the use 
of Somoff’s theorem for the evaluation 
of the elliptic integral of the third 
BDGCIOB ee sccssseceeccers sadetuesseutiandtunseues<itutpncice 54 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
Lucas, Frederick A.: communication on 
museum specimens illustrating biology 
(Title) ...asbcscessses osvscnsoeceascdee eee ee $736 
McAdie, A. G., Election to membership of... 19 
McDonald, Marshall, Election to member- 


SHIP) Of .cs26c62 veccivesecsaecesssseneheentenadeenn ae 47 
McGee, W J : communication on the Charles- 
ton earthquake...... seseccesosbeieaden so semianau inane 37 


— remarks on the Charleston earthquake.... 42 
Mallery, Garrick: communication on cus- 


toms of every day life.........ssesscsoussassenees Peet) 
— remarks on phonetié alphabets...........0 cep it. 
Mann, B. Pickman: election to membership 38 
— remarks on throwing sticks...........+e00 eons) ee 


Martin, Artemas, Election to membership of 16 
Mason, O. T.: 


communication on bowyers 


and fletchers:..:.2..0.05.<.+<dssseuertasdgaseeteneeee » 44 
— —— two examples of similar inventions 
in areas Widely apart............cessessssceee sopae 012 
— remarks on derivation of social customs. 21 
Mathematical section, Members of ey ecbasewe REA 
. 63 
aa 52 
== = Rules) Of, ....saseusscdouseceseucesbacanen nous ie Secoubal) (OL 
Members, Deceased....... sesoosutedseernedepeniyen soe XEVI 
= LAS OF 1.5: ..sscacdesscsnesusoerssesesneaeeusnearaeee Sones yO 
aaa INOWy covsseascondeesvavnthars Xxix, 3, 15, 16, 19, 25, 37, 47 
Mendenhall, T. C.: communication on the 
Charleston earthquake............ccccccssssescecees 37 
— remarks on Japanese customs.........+6 scone mee 
— resignation from General Committee......... 44 
Merrill, George P.: communication on geo- 
logical museums ( Tifle)....... Percaripec eer soa) eth 
Metallic coverings of thermometer bulbs.... 33 
Minutes of the General Meeting................ a I 


Mitchell, Henry, Election to membership of 37 
Murdoch, John: remarks on throwing 
BUCKS. << <.ccacnsscncartobecnossasteseeweee sesvessapeesenl gilee 
Museum classification..........csscse eaest asuevden! See 
Museum specimens illustrating biology....... 35 
Mussey, R. D.: communication entitled, 
when I first saw the cholera Bacillus 
(DUC) cicana dedsacsonsexteuedeeraneeeeeeeee Peetecy 
— remarks on phonetic alphabets........... prec hs) 
New members............ xxix, 3, 15, 16, 19, 25, 37, 47 
Notes on the faults of the Great Basin and of 
the eastern base of the Sierra Nevada... 65 


— — — geology of northern California....... oo 18 

Nott, C. C., Election to membership of......... 3 

Officers of Army and Navy in relation to 
scientific work..........006 x fheseapes Ee 


— elected December, 1885... 


Organic cells of unknown origin and form 
found in human feeces........:10. .esssulsestes 


& 


INDEX. 57 
Page. Page. 

Paul, H. M.: communication on the Charles- Spencer, Herbert: cited on ceremonial in- 
OR CATEN QUAKE)... .s6ccccscecesvcsscscsceontaceuss 41, 42 SUUULOU Se cs-cateasescecacestessccspensasseeseatracateasee 20 
PTO MIC THL DN ADO bi. eos sessonjenieccccvesecnessesceuseenes 17 | Standing committees...............002sesssesessee XLV, XV 


Physical-geographical divisions of the south- 
eastern portions of the United States and 
their corresponding topographical types 22 


MMESIC ONE'S ACATOSS......2. sosce see-ssseast«aacase XXXYV, 46 
Report, Annual, of the secretaries......... XxXix, 47 
Pe — — — LPCASULEY 4. ....0eseccen nsccsseccescssees XXX, 47 
— of auditing CommMittee................cceeceeeeeeees 3 
Riley, C. V.: remarks on museum classifica- 
ey leeectecs cancer senatnes caessacecnarsnsens sis's=tedeedeed 45 


Rockwood, Prof. Charles G.: communication 
on the Charleston earthquake................. 37 


Rules for publication of Bulletin... xiii 
— of the General Committee............ cee eee xii 
— — — Mathematical Section........00........... 51 
OCLC UY cciccvwais sccwsssncccucucesscnbaaccsseecesshee ix 


Russell, I. C.: communication on faults of 
the Great Basin and the eastern base of 
PRE SIOTITA NC VAGA...cdc.5scecccecsesccesensseeacees 5 

— — — the subaerial decay of rocks and the 
origin of the red clay of certain forma- 


LENILEN (CLEECG) cavcudsscvecateceeconcvctsccccsccverabsaaeen0 16 
Russell, Thomas: communication on nor- i 
mal barometers (Title)......ccess0ecccsescceceeres 46 
— — — temperatures at which differences 
between mercurial and air thermometers 
POI OTOALOSL sesssescnssass sscacsscessdaccactesadcanses 25 
Scientific men and their duties.................. XXXV 
Secretaries, Annual report of........ meee, 47) 
' Sierra Nevada, Faults of the......... Macaca sdateuane 4,5 


Similar inventions in areas widely apart...... 12 
Snell, M. M., Election to membership of...... 25 


Standing rules of the General Committee.... xii 
— — — — Mathematical Section................... 51 


—— — — Society......,...... ix 
Sbitel tin, basketiyar yatus ces cospcdacavecoesve) vedesras’ LD 
Taylor, W. B.: appointment to vacancy in 
General) COMMS escccssccaccteincdacecosncaccace 44 
— remarks as chairman of Mathematical 
BO CHOON occ cetcadenccsqaesttccesadaencninsecessbeaevess 54 
— — on the evolution of the bow...............00. 45 
Temperatures at which differences between 
mercurial and air thermometers are 
PTCRLSS ie ccanecsscsesens) areueaenscseunsaccesesesnves exces 25 
IPHELIN OCU Vo eecscseatstecoseacecessetsonteseaneoee cese 25, 33 
Thompson, Gilbert: communication on the 
physical-geographical divisions of the 
southeastern portion of the United 
States and their corresponding topo- 
graphical typgs Bacenelidduasssncatussnsdimestatseceesces 22 
ME RTO WIE SUCKS... .sc0s0sbecsasacecanseseetysnsescareneatts 13 
Treasurer, Annual report Of...........+sssee0 Xxx, 47 


Trenholm, W. L.: election to membership... 47 
Two examples of similar inventions in areas 


WIG CIV ADI b,.cconvs-coes scectaceucns acbateues saraterene 12 
Willis, Bailey: remarks on geology of Cas- 
CACO WLOUMUAING ssatscsescesa peeves scsveataedncenses c 


Woodward, R. S.: communication on the 
changes of terrestrial level surfaces due 
to variations in distribution of super- 


Aieiall rater (Lute) t<c-sescccawcenscesccuescoassetes 15 
—— — — position and shape of the geoidas 
dependent on local masses (Title)......... 53, 54 


at 4 i tae 
r 7 ae « 
. * i 4 \ F f ™] 
‘ , 
A + tes \ 
y S . 
i 
’ , ’ ‘ ' a y 
i 
’ 7 / Wy t > 
‘ - . x 
a Peli p 
ql wl i ; 
* 7 4 \ f 
1 A 1 
' 
r] { : 
ts 
N b ‘ yy z 
ni y " % > 
sf 
& t Ni yar 4 
‘ , i“ e* \ 
4 ’ 
ms’ 
3 af & 
< My y a v 
\ ; iw 4 ‘ f sy ee, 
pix ‘ i ; : 
r a 2 
4 
7 
veh 
r 
, ‘ 
¢ F 4 ot! 
; ‘ 
j ‘ ; 
' 
p ‘ ; 
i 
o ‘ + 
‘ a \ 
* a 
; : . a 
‘i ) f i — 
é } e. _ i is 
' * 
{ U P ‘ 
+ , P 
| T t ; 
a iy 7 7 AM: it vr 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY 


OF 


WASHINGTON. 


VOL,’ x. 


1S87. 


Containing the Minutes of the Society and of the Mathematical 
Section for the year 1887; together with the pro- 
ceedings of the Baird Memorial Meeting 
AND 


AN INDEX TO THE FIRST TEN VOLUMES. 


PUBLISHED BY THE CO-OPERATION OF THE SMITHSONIAN INSTITUTION. 


WASHINGTON: 
1888. 


‘ Pm y +) - UD 9 Tew i ate 
rr a i y ‘i heey + yao’ 


i oi 


ih, 
OEE EE Se ae 


ae 


Sn ene) iD BN ES. 


Page. 

SEEPS HUCIED IONIC = ees eee Sa erie. eee een ent Oe SAS VILE 
Branding isles Of the MOGlIeLy ooo aes see ne en oes eee co auee 1 
Standing Rules of the/General Committee =—-==- «22 -2eaas 222. XII 
iulesstor the eublication of the? Bulletins => 2y2 2 ews te see XIII 
Oficers elected) December 18) 1886 22s Vas OSs eee re see eee XIV 
Officers elected December 21, DOG hae Ae Os ee a RE EEO | OOK 
EN estre Cai IVT Fiat Gg A i ee AS ok eh ele ee a Ae XVII 
Pistiat Wecessed: Members’: 2- 2 ooo 2 5)s- Seis AP Ae eee Ds XXVIII 
prgmrninry one benship <1 5000 Se 2 ee ek Oe Se ee eo TE 
RUE NONE Aap Og canes Bees ON ge Cl) oe A ADEN CRE RAMONE DELILE SSR tye. 0 VAN cb Gat 
AHOUp A ReNOrt.or whetpecretariesues = Lis CEUs Se) Se eee OOLT 
PeannualsReportior the (reasuren2o2) ete 5 sr ces oe OO ey: 
Annual Address of the President, William Harkness ---__ -_~_ ___. ORE 


Bulletin of the General Meetings.____..---___ phe iste SE See 1 
Report.of the Auditing Committee 2A ts a 3 
Graphic methods in research, G. K. Gilberts-_-. -=__--4-_-— 4 
Geologic age of the lowest formation of Emmon’s Taconic sys- 

tem, C. D. Waleott, (Title only) _....-_.-. ie Ds 5 
Present status of mineralogy, F. W. Clarke, (Title ‘only 6 
Topography and geology of the cross timbers of Texas, R. T: 

Hill; (Title onty) =.= =2--_= See oe ea 6 
Sky elows of 1883, H. A. Hazen, ‘(Title OTL) eee Ee ek) BN 6 
Topography and structure in the Bays Mountains, Tennessee, 

Bailey Willis, (Pile ory) oS oe eee ee oe fi 
Geographical distribution of scientific men and institutions in 

the United States, G. Brown Goode, (Title only) _------ .--- 7 
Our city shade trees, their foes and their future, C. V. Riley, 

(Title COVA) Nae eee DB CE LESS AEDS eka A eM eR a eee 7 
Frequency of coincidences, Lester F. Ward_-_-- ---.-----..-- 8 
Theory of the wind-vane, G. E. Curtis, (Tvtle only)__-_----_- 9 
Electrometer as used in observations of atmospheric electricity, 

Cale Marvin. (Lecle Oni) eo SaaS oe ae ee ee ete a 
Development of perspective map from contour map, Bailey 

Vai ses svt PneLerernbyy 22055 Ste oe ie ee hk ee a a 9 
Plane table exhibited and explained, W. D. Johnson -___ -__. 9 
Relation between wind velocity and pressure, H. A. Hazen, 


Tce ratay Meenas Se Rn Eee eee ie ee ee Or ee SA EL 10) 
Mt. Rainier and its glaciers; Bailey Willis —-..~-...___. 10 
What is a topographic map? Marcus Baker ____ ___. 1. 11 
Counting-out rhymes of children, H. C. Bolton, (Title only)_- 13 
On a device for viewing the sun by light of any desired wave 

length, William HVarineus 0 tei). eeu) pati fa SA as 13 
What is topography? by M. H. Doolittle, W. D. “Johnson, 138i 

G. Ocden Gilbert "Thompson sos. ste eee SSS Te, TG 
The Muir elacier, Alaska, J. W. Chickering, (Title only) Mata 15 
Economic phase of the English sparrow questicn, C. Hart 

Morrionn (Petia eny jt ht Pe Ne 16 
The quaternary deposits and the great displacement of the 

middle Atlantic slope, W J McGee, (Pichetordyy ois Se 16 
Visit to scene of Charleston earthquake and resulting conclu- 

sions, ©.) Ey Dution, (tile only) 22-2. ss ee 16 


iii 


IV 


CONTENTS. 


South Florida notes, W. H. Dall, (Title only) -------.------- 
Depth of earthquake foci, C. E. Dutton --__-.--#_--_.---- 
Manchester meeting of the British Association for the advance- 

ment of Science, 1887, F. W. Clarke, (Title only) --------- 
Signal Service bibliography of meteorology, C. Abbe-__-_.-- 
Geographical distribution of fossil plants, L. F. Ward, (Title 

OVC) so a ree Re ae a ree 
Speed * propagation of the Charleston earthquake, C. E. 

Dutton and Simon Newcomb, (Title only) ----- -----. ---- 
Representation of comet orbits by models, William Harkness, 

(Witla ONY) onrn ass Hoan Se) 1 ae eee 
Statistics of the Philosophical Society, G. K. Gilbert ----___- 
Newton’s vis, M. H. Doolittle, (Title only) ----- ----------..- 
Reference indexing, B: Pickman Mann-_-_------. -__ -__- 
Presentation of the annual. address -.....-.._ _. = se 


Annual meeting 2.28 cise 22 oe ee 
Proceedings at the Baird memorial meeting -_-- -_-- -----_ ---. ---.- 


Introduction 255 2-2-2 oJ es oe he a a 
Relation of Professor Baird to participating societies, Garrick 

Mallery s2 222. s)o2/s225 Soa oa ee ee 
Professor Baird as administrator, Wm. B. Taylor___-__ -_-- Ps 
Professor Baird in science; Wi. H.. Dall -222 222s eae 
Personal characteristics of Professor Baird, J. W. Powell-_-- 


Bulletin‘of ‘the Mathematical Section, 22-223). ee eee 


Standing rules of the section— .._. —__. . =o eee 
List of officers and members of the section ..-.-.---. ---___- 
Association” ratios, MSE. Doolittles-.2 2-22) =o eee 
The rotten apple problem, a question in probabilities, Marcus 
Baker, M. H. Doolittle, G.W. Hill, G. E. Curtis, E. B. Elliott, 
Henry Farquhar, Artemas Martin, Alex. S. Christie, Ormond 
Stone 2.2. pio ae ee 
Free cooling of a homogeneous sphere, R. 8. Woodward, (Title 
Only) q22- 5 tte ee 
Brachisthode on the helicoid, C. H. Kummell_-_-- ---.---__- 
Motion of Hyperion, G.. We Hill 22.6.2. co eee 
Parallax of ¢)'Tauri, Asaph Halls = 
Most probable value of latitude from entangled observations 
in use}of Taleott’s method. sAl Ss. Klint 222 eee 
Mutual action of elements of electric currents, E. B. Elliott__ 
Association ratios, M.JH.’ Doolittle:22=~ £2. ee eee 
Solution of a problem in Science, Henry Farquhar, (Title only) 
Solutions of the trisection problem, Marcus Baker, G. E. Curtis_ 
Integration of differential equations admitting periodic inte- 
erals, Gi W.. Hill 2-22 cee oe So oa as cil eo 
Euler’s theorem (generally called Lambert’s), Asaph Hall.__- 
New form of computing machine, E. B. Elliott _----. ---__._ 
The constant P in observations of terrestrial magnetism, Wm, 
Harkness 25 22s Sees Sans oe ee 
Conditioned cooling of a homogeneous sphere, R. 8. Woodward- 
The orbit of Hyperion, Ormond Stone____ -_____ __-- -_...e 
Quotients of space-directed lines, HE. B. Elliott---__ -___ -__- 
Methods of finding n** power numbers whose sum is an nth 
power, Artemas Martin oto.) 22... 5.35 
Committees on mathematical communications__-_-__-------- 
Note on the publications of the Society_-__- .-...-- o_o mr 
Index to Veluumes IX At 29254 en et eee 


96 
96, 98 


100 
101 
102 


102 
103 
104 
105 


107 
111 
113 
117 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


CONSTITUTION, RULES, 


LISTS OF 


OFFICERS AND MEMBERS, 
CALENDAR, 
AND REPORTS OF 


SECRETARIES AND TREASURER. 


Anite} 


sine 


yo wig 4 
ae ea ~S 


CONSTITUTION 


OF 


THE PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ArticLE I. The name of this Society shall be Tor PHILOSOPHI- 
CAL Socrery oF WASHINGTON. 


ArticuE II. The officers of the Society shall be a President, 
four Vice-Presidents, a Treasurer, and two Secretaries. 


ArticuE III. There shall be a General Committee, consisting of 
the ex-Presidents of the Society, the officers of the Society, and nine 
other members.* 


ArticLe IV. The officers of the Society and the nine other mem- 
bers of the General Committee shall be elected annually by ballot; 
they shall hold office until their successors are elected, and shall 
have power to fill vacancies.* 


ArticLe V. It shall be the duty of the General Committee to 
make rules for the government of the Society, and to transact all 
its business. 


ArticLe VI. This constitution shall not be amended except by 
a three-fourths vcte of those present at an annual meeting for. the 
election of officers, and after notice of the proposed change shall 
have been given in writing at a stated meeting of the Society at 
least four weeks previously. 


. * Amended December 21, 1887. 


: wou Harite i" oy 


fe 


ay HOPMAN 8 iv vTating te H Ona 


ie 


21 plein eee my T ad thats ergot aie Re ene nh py RE 
ab ro ‘55 elie Mf Ass ve. 


ve » 1 ; b ‘ A ‘ m i * é ‘ 
‘Cea igebinw bow ae | Tine elon ates Ne via y Hs a 


f ‘Abii fir fay ome ans Hays ae Le mie 


. 2G) ACS aie ; ct ay 
: bea ante DEOL Kt icp etek honed gtie dk: VOR ah, 8 


: Bis bre y ay 3G fs hy EG AMT h Heh ct 


Laakietirnt abt toons 


ighG Vit whe pawns iyi) Cab feet ahem 


Pau y 


ern eee, Ti Fay 


er . ed Loar | La eee b poy ¢ z 
rings cous aay J bs} Kook Bae ¥ OATS Hh. Ae bo 


Pitt SEATS FS 


’ 


t¥ > 
Teta 43 te ay a 


; 5 fila 


Po 


STANDING RULES 


FOR THE GOVERNMENT OF THE 


os 
PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


1. The Stated Meetings of the Society shall be held at 8 o’clock 
P. M. on every alternate Saturday; the place of meeting to be 
designated by the General Committee. 

2. Notice of the time and place of meeting shall be sent to each 
member by one of the Secretaries. 

When necessary Special Meetings may be called by the President. 

3. The Annual Meeting for the election of officers shall be the 
last stated meeting in the month of December. 


The order of proceedings (which shall be announced by the 
Chair) shall be as follows: 

First, the reading of the minutes of the last Annual Meeting. 

Second, the presentation of the annual reports of the Secretaries, 
including the announcement of the names of members elected since 
the last Annual Meeting. 

Third, the presentation of the annual report of the Treasurer. 

Fourth, the announcement of the names of members who, having 
complied with section 14 of the Standing Rules, are entitled to vote 
on the election of officers. 

Fifth, the election of President. 

Sixth, the election of four Vice-Presidents. 

Seventh, the election of Treasurer. 

Eighth, the election of two Secretaries. 

Ninth, the election of nine members of the General Committee. 

Tenth, the consideration of Amendments to the Constitution of 
the Society, if any such shall have been proposed in accordance 
with Article VI of the Constitution. 

Eleventh, the reading of the rough minutes of the meeting. 

4, * Elections of officers are to be held as follows: 

In each case nominations shall be made by means of an informal 


* Amended May 7, 1887. 


x PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ballot, the result of which shall be announced by the. Secretary ; 
after which the first formal ballot shall be taken, 

In the ballot for Vice-Presidents, Secretaries, and members of the 
General Committee, each voter shall write on one ballot as many 
names as there are officers to be elected, viz., four on the first ballot 
for Vice-Presidents, two on the first for Secretaries, and nine on the 
first for members of the General. Committee; and on each subse- 
quent ballot as many names as there are persons yet to be elected ; 
and those persons who receive a majority of the votes cast shall be 
declared elected; Provided that the number of persons receiving a 
majority does not exceed the number of persons to be elected, in 
which case the vacancies shall be filled by the candidates receiving 
the highest majorities. 

If in any case the informal ballot result in giving a majority for 
any of the candidates, it may be declared formal by a majority vote. 


5. The Stated Meetings, with the exception of the Annual Meet- 
ing, shall be devoted to the consideration and discussion of scientific 
subjects. 

The Stated Meeting next preceding the Annual Meeting shall be 
set apart for the delivery of the President’s Annual Address. 


6. Sections representing special branches of science may be 
formed by the General Committee upon the written recommenda- 
tion of: twenty members of the Society. 


7. Persons interested in science, who are not residents of the Dis- 
trict of Columbia, may be present at any meeting of the Society, 
except the Annual Meeting, upon invitation of a member. 


8. On request of a member, the President or either uf the Secre- 
taries may, at his discretion, issue to any person a card of invitation 
to attend a specified meeting. Five cards of invitation to attend a 
meeting may be issued in blank to the reader of a paper at that 
meeting. 

9. Invitations to attend during three months the meetings of the 
Society and participate in the discussion of papers, may, by a vote 
of nine members of the General Committee, be issued to persons 
nominated by two members. 

10. Communications intended for publication under the auspices 
of the Society shall be submitted in writing to the General Com- 
mittee for approval. 


STANDING RULES. xI 


11. Any paper read before a Section may be repeated, either 
entire or by abstract, before a general meeting of the Society, if 
such repetition is recommended by the General Committee of the 
Society. . 


12. It is not permitted to report the proceedings of the Society or 
its Sections for publication, except by authority of the General 
Committee. 


13. *New members may be proposed in writing by three mem- 
bers of the Society for election by the General Committee ; but no 
person shall be admitted to the privileges of membership unless he 
signifies his acceptance thereof in writing, and pays his dues to the 
Treasurer, within two months after notification of his election. 


14. Each member shall pay annually to the Treasurer the sum 
of five dollars, and no member whose dues are unpaid shall vote at 
the Annual Meeting for the election of officers, or be entitled to a 
copy of the Bulletin. 

In the absence of the Treasurer, the Secretary is authorized to 
receive the dues of members. 

The names of those two years in arrears shall be dropped from 
the list of members. 

Notice of resignation of membership shall be given in writing to 
the General Committee through the President or one of the Secre- 
taries. 


15. The fiscal year shall terminate with the Annual Meeting. 


16. Any member who is absent from the District of Columbia - 
for more than twelve consecutive months may be excused from 
payment of dues during the period of his absence, in which case he 
will not be entitled to receive announcements of meetings or current 
numbers ‘of the Bulletin. 


17. Any member not in arrears may, by the payment of one 
hundred dollars at any one time, become a life member, and be 
relieved from all further annual dues and other assessments. 

All moneys received in payment of life membership shall be in- 
vested as portions of a permanent fund, which shall be directed 
solely to the furtherance of such special scientific work as may be 
ordered by the General Committee. 


*Amended Oct. 9, 1886. 


STANDING: RULES 


OF THE 


GENERAL COMMITTEE OF THE PHILOSOPHICAL 
SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


1. The President, Vice-Presidents, and Secretaries of the Society 
shall hold like offices in the General Committee. 


2. The President shall have power to call special meetings of the 
Committee, and to appoint Sub-Committees. 


3. The Sub-Committees shall prepare business for the General 
Committee, and perform such other duties as may be entrusted to 
them. 


4, There shall be two Standing Sub-Committees ; one on Com- 
munications for the Stated Meetings of the Society, and another on 
Publications. 


5. The General Committee shall meet at half-past seven o’clock 
on the evening of each Stated Meeting, and by adjournment at 
other times. 


6. For all purposes, except for the amendment of the Standing 
Rules of the Committee or of the Society, and the election of mem- 
bers, six members of the Committee shall constitute a quorum. 


7. The names of proposed new members recommended in con. 
formity with Section13 of the Standing Rules of the Society, may 
be presented at any meeting of the General Committee, but shall 
lie over for at least four weeks before final action, and the concur- 
rence of twelve members of the Committee shall be necessary to 
election. 

The Secretary of the General Committee shall keep a chronologi- 
cal register of the elections and acceptances of members. 


8. These Standing Rules, and those for the government of the 
Society, shall be modified only with the consent*of a majority of 
the members of the General Committee. 

xii 


RU OES 


FOR THE 


FUBLICATION. OF THE BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


1. The President’s Annual address shall be published in full. 


2. The annual reports of the Secretaries and of the Treasurer 
shall be published in full. 


3. When directed by the General Committee, any communication 
may be published in full. 


4, Abstracts of papers and remarks on the same will be pub- 
lished, when presented to the Secretary by the author in writing 
within two weeks of the evening of their delivery, and approved by 
the Committee on Publications. Brief abstracts prepared by one 
of the Secretaries and approved by the Committee on Publications 
may also be published. 


5. If the author of any paper read before a Section of the 
Society desires its publication, either in full or by abstract, it shall 
be referred to a committee to be appointed as the Section may 
determine. 

The report of this committee shall be forwarded to the Publica- 
tion Committee by the Secretary of the Section, together with any 
action of the Section taken thereon. 


6. Communications which have been published elsewhere, so as 
to be generally accessible, will appear in the Bulletin by title only, 
but with a reference to the place of publication, if made known in 
season to the Committee on Publications. 

X111 


OFRrICHRS 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON 


ELECTED DECEMBER 18, 1886. 


President _____ -_-__. WILLIAM HARKNESS. 

Vice-Presidents __..._.GARRICK MALLERY. C. E. Durron. 
J. R. EASTMAN. G. K. GILBERT. 

Treasurer .--- ohatih _ROBERT FLETCHER. 

Secretaries -.-~ -— ___.Marcus BAKER. J. H. KippeEr. 


MEMBERS AT LARGE OF THE GENERAL COMMITTEE. 


H. H. Bartzs. F. W. Ciarxke. 
W. H. Dat. E. B. Evxiorr. 
G. B. GoopE. C. V. RILEY. 

H. M. Pavt. W. C. WINLOCK. 


R. S. WoopwaRbD. 


STANDING COMMITTEES. 


On Communications : 


J. R. Eastman, Chairman. Marcus BAKER, J. H. Kipper. 
On Publications: 
Marcus Baker, Chairman. RoBERT FLETCHER. J. H. Kipper, 
S. F. Barrp. 


XIV 


OP Rt hikes 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON 


ELECTED DECEMBER 21, 1887. 


President ..___- --._..GARRICK MALLERY. 
Vice-Presidents ____J. R. HASTMAN. C. KE. Durron. 
G. K. GILBERT. G. Brown Goons. 
Treasurer ....------- ROBERT FLETCHER. 
Secretaries ....-____.MARCUS BAKER. W. C. WINLOCE. 


MEMBERS AT LARGE OF THE GENERAL COMMITTEE. 


H. H. Batzs. F. W. CLarkKE. 
W. iH. Datu. EK. B. ELwiorr. 
J. H. K1ipDER. S. P. Lanaiey. 
He M.PApE: C. V. RILEY: 


R. S. WooDWARD. 


PAST PRESIDENTS OF THE SOCIETY AND ex-Orricio MEM- 
BERS OF THE GENERAL COMMITTEE. 


J.S. Briirneas, 1886. Simon NeEewcoms, 1879, 1880. 
AsapH HALL, 1885. J. W. PowE Lt, 1883. 
Ws. Harxnszss, 1887. W. B. Tayrtor, 1882. 


J. C. WELLING, 1884. 


STANDING COMMITTEES. 
On Communications : 
G. K. GILBERT, Chairman. J. R. EASTMAN. G. Brown Goopz. 


On Publications: 


Marcus Baker, Chairman. RoBERT FLETCHER. W. C. WINLOCK. 
5. P. LANGLEY. 


xv 


TOO 


ae erin + 


. 4 
he # 
y ; 4 
Fi J , i. 
y ‘ wey LP PL retcie ery Fi 
‘ f 
= i ‘ b ? zs Pal : 4 We ° + vi ’ at = ¥ 
J F ty ] .. N ° : 4 ' 
‘ —< ‘ ? 4 Jee é 
is ey FLAT! PARA Pe 
: “ lat ae fe ' porte 
ied Aes : LET 8 ’ "iy ahh WG APS LSet 
t ~ 5 S 
ae wh fie hat) Pain, Wel OA 
a q , 
r y ig Hig : JASE, 
‘ wets } "¥e 4 é é rade “th * 
pat sy Bae) ake Daret es) yd 
4 ® re 
be ite! } rate 
~ ye : 
< : . y el m7 ah . 
: ; rae hae nea gd 
; 1S» ae ie CE RAAB TE). 
ru us, - a 4 ri 7 uy 
“oh Uae &Y is Bes os 8 ‘ 
i } o otis i 
; wt ‘See ilya ee # elo ween ares 
Z Shape | race dati lath ie 
wen ; ‘y F ws analvaeek nN | 
! © ah Date 
- ‘ 
) " w 5 
i hee he << 
i < * i " ‘ 
y \ 


r F 
i a bail 
‘ 
ral 4 a te 
1 Pet 2 nh a mers 
. 
on . re Nt 
my ae a ae Ww PoP en i elie; 
ith ae RAE Wo ean i Py eS 9 Aa +e 
tik 5 
i , n 
~ a 
( 
ft 
® 
ha . 
* he 
i ‘ “ 
ar ae 
; ° : 
1 : i. k 
: e : in 
a Yr 1 f 
‘ , ‘ fe 
} } 
Y hy ES ol ulin St 
ast ‘ fe Ne 


tare. ON » ee 


LIST OF MEMBERS 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON; 


TOGETHER WITH 


YEAR OF ADMISSION TO THE SOCIETY, POST-OFFICE 


1871. 


1875. 
1881. 
1873. 
1871. 


1879. 
1887. 


1881. 
1876. 


1875. 
1885. 


1871. 
1886. 
1884, 


ADDRESS, AND RESIDENCE. 


Corrected to December 31, 1887. 


ABBE, Prof. Cleveland, 
Signal Office, War Department. 2017 I street. 
AseErt, Mr. 8. T. (Sylvanus Thayer) 
810 19th street. 
Apams, Mr. Henry, 


Auxpis, Hon. A. O. (Asa Owen), 


1603 H street. 


1765 Mass. avenue. 
ANTISELL, Dr. Thomas (Founder), 
Patent Office. 1311 Q street. 


Avery, Mr. Robert S. (Robert Stanton), 


BasBcock, ie Wm. H. (William Henry), 
P. O. Box 220. 


Baker, Prof. Frank, 


320 A street se. 


1315 Corcoran street. 
Baker, Mr. Marcus, 
Geological Survey. 1125 17th street. 
Bancrort, George, 
1623 H street; in summer, Newport, R. I. 


Barus, Dr. Carl, 

Geological Survey. 2750 Q street. 
Bates, Mr. H. H. (Henry Hobart,) 

Patent Office. The Portland. 


Bates, Dr. N. L. (Newton Lemuel), U.S. N., 
283 Henry street, Brooklyn, EY 


Bray, Dr. T. H. (Tarleton Hoffman), 
National Museum. 1616 19th street 


XVII 


XVIII 
1875. 
1879. 
1881. 
1871. 
1875. 
1886. 
1871. 
1876. 
1883. 
1884. 
1884. 


1884. 
1883. 
1836. 
1883. 
1879. 
1874. 
1871. 
1882. 
1883. 
1885. 
1874. 
1880. 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


BEARDSLEE, Capt. L. A. (Lester Anthony), U.S. N. (At 
Little Falls, N. Y 


Betz, Mr. A. Graham (Alexander Graham), 
1336 19th street. 


Bex, Dr. C. A. (Chichester Alexander) (Absent), 


University College. London, England. 
Benet, Gen. S. V. (Stephen Vincent), U. 8. A. (Founder), 
Ordnance Office, War Dept. 1717 I street. 


BessExs, Dr. Emil, 
Glenn Dale, Md. 
Bryer, Dr. H. G. (Henry Gustav) (Absent), 
Navy Department. 
Bruines, Dr. John §. (John Shaw), U.S. A. (Founder), 
Army Medical Museum. 3027 N street. 
Brrnig, Capt. Rogers, Jr., U. S. A 
Office Chief of Ordnance, u; S.A. 1341 N. H. avenue. 
Boprisy, Mr. 8. H. (Sumner Homer), 
Geological Survey. 807 H street. 
BouTE..E, Capt. C. O. (Charles Otis), 
‘Coast and Geodetic Survey. 
Bow tes, Asst. Nav. Constr. Francis T. (Francis Tiffany), 


U.S. N. (Absent), 
Navy Department. 


Brown, Prof. S. J. (Stimson Joseph), U.S. N. (Absa 


Washburn Observatory. Madison, Wis. 
Browne, Dr. J. Mills (John Mills), U.S. N., 
Navy Department. The Portland. 


Bryan, Dr. J. H. (Joseph Hammond), 


1644 Connecticut avenue. 
Bureess, Mr. E. S. (Edward Sandford), 
High School. 1120 18th street. 
Burnett, Dr. Swan M. (Swan Moses), 
1734 K street. 
Busey, Dr. Samuel C. (Samuel Clagett), 
901 16th street, 
Casey, Col. Thomas Lincoln, U. 8. A. (Founder, absent), 
Army Building, cor. Green and Houston Sts., New York city. 
Cazrarc, Lieut. L. V. (Louis Vasmer), U.S. A. (Absent), 


Fortress Monroe, Va. 


CHAMBERLIN, Pres. T. C. (Thomas Crowder) (Absent), 


Madison, Wis. 
CuararD, Dr. Thomas M. (Thomas Marean), 
Geological Survey. Cosmos Club. 
CuicKERING, Prof. J. W., Jr. (John White), 


Deaf Mute College, Kendall Green. 


Curistiz, Mr. Alex. S. (Alexander Smyth), 
Coast and Geodetic Survey. 204 4th street se. 


~ 


1877. 
1874. 
1871. 


1880. 
1874. 
1873. 
1879. 
1886. 
1886. 
1884. 
1871. 
1886. 
1880. 
1872. 
1881. 
1884. 
1884. 
1876. 
1873. 


1872. 
1884. 
1871. 
1884. 


LIST OF MEMBERS. XIX 


CuarK, Mr. Edward, 
Architect’s Office, Capitol. 417 4th street. 


CLARKE, Prof. F. W. (Frank Wigglesworth), 

Geological Survey. 1425 Q street. 
CorFin, Prof. J. H. C. (John Huntington Crane), U.S. N. 

(Founder), 
1901 I street. 

Comstock, Prof. J. H. (John Henry) (Absent), 

Cornell University, Ithaca, N. Y. 
Cougs, Prof. Elliott, 

Smithsonian Institution. 1726 N street. 


Crate, Lieut. Robert, U. 8. A. (Absent), 


ar Department. 


Craic, Dr. Thomas (Absent), 
Johns Hopkins University, Baltimore, Md. 


CUMMINGS, Prof. G. J. (George Jotham), 
Howard University. 

Curticg, Dr. Cooper, 
Agricultural Department. 

Curtis, Mr. Geo. E. (George Edward) (Absent), 
Washburn College, Topeka, Kansas. 


Datu, Mr. Wm. H. (William Healey) (Founder), 


Smithsonian Institution. 1119 12th street. 
Darton, Mr. N. H. (Nelson Horatio), 
Geological Survey. 1412 N street. 


Davis, Commander C. H. (Charles Henry), U.S. N., 
Navy Department. 


Dean, Dr. R. C. (Richard Crain), U.S. N. (Absent), 
Navy Department. 45 Lafayette Place, N. Y. city. 


De Carnpry, Mr. Wm. A. (William Augustin), 


War Department. 1014 17th street. 
Dewey, Mr. Fred. P. (Frederic Perkins), 

National Museum. Lanier Heights. 
Ditter, Mr. J. S. (Joseph Silas), 

Geological Survey. 1804 16th street. 
Doouittiez, Mr. M. H. (Myrick Hascall), 

Coast and Geodetic Survey. 1925 I street. 
Dunwoopy, Lt. H. H. C. (Henry Harrison Chase), U.S. A. 

(Absent), 

War Department. 
Dutton, Capt. C. E. (Clarence Edward), U.S. A 

Geological Survey. 2119 I street. 
Ear, Mr. R. Edward (Robert Edward), 

National Museum. 1536 T street. 
EASTMAN, Fret J. R. (John Robie), U.S. N., 

Naval Observatory. 1905 N street. 


Ermseck, Mr. William, 
- Coast and Geodetic Survey. 


xx 


1871. 
1871. 
1885. 
1873. 
1874. 
1876. 
1881. 
1887. 
1872. 
1873. 
1882. 
1881. 


1873 


1875. 
1874. 
1875. 
1879. 
1885. 
1874. 
1875. 
1886. 
1880. 
1878. 
1839. 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ELpRreEDGE, Dr. Stewart (Absent), 
Yokohama, Japan. 


Exxiort, Mr. E. B. (Ezekiel Brown) (Founder), 


Gov’t Actuary, Treas. Dept. 1210 G street. 
Emmons, Mr. 8. F. (Samuel Franklin), 
Geological Survey. 1708 H street. 


Enputcu, Dr. F. M. (Frederic Miller) (Absent), 
Reading, Pa. 


Ewina, Gen. Hugh (Absent), 


Lancaster, Ohio. 


Farquuar, Mr. Edward, 


Patent Office Library. 1915 H street. 
Farquuar, Mr. Henry, 
Coast and Geodetic Survey. Brooks Station, D. C. 


Fernow, Mr. B. E. (Bernhard Eduard), 
Department of Agriculture. Cor. 8th and B streets sw. 


FrErRREL, Prof. William, 
1641 Broadway, Kansas City, Mo. 


FLEetTcHeER, Dr. Robert, 


Army Medical Museum. The Portland. 
Fuiint, Mr. A. S. (Albert Stowell), 

Naval Observatory. 1441 Chapin street. 
Fiint, Dr. J. M. (James Milton), U.S. N., 

Smithsonian Institution. The Portland. 


. Friston, Prof. Edward T, 


Columbian Oniversity, cor. 15th and H streets. 


GALLAUDET, President E. M. (Edward Miner), 
Deaf Mute College, Kendall Green. 


Gannett, Mr. Henry, 
GeologicalSurvey. 1881 Harewood ave., LeDroit Park. 


GitBert, Mr. G. K. (Grove Karl), 


Geological Survey. 1424 Corcoran street. 


Goppina, Dr. W. W. (William Whitney), 


Government Hospital for the Insane. 


Goocnu, Dr. F. A. (Frank Austin) (Absent), 


Yale College, New Haven, Connecticut. 


Goops, Mr. G. Brown (George Brown), 
Smithsonian Institution, 1203 N. H. ave. 


GoopFreEeLLow, Mr. Edward, 
Coast and Geodetic Survey. 


Gorpov, Prof. J. C. (Joseph Claybaugh), 
Deaf Mute College, Kendall Green. 


Gore, Prof. J. H. (James Howard), 
Columbian University. 1305 Q street. 
Graves, Mr. Walter H. (Walter Hayden) (Adsent), 


Denver, Colorado. 


Greevy, Gen. A. W. (Adolphus Washington), U.S. A., 
Signal Office, War Department. 1914 G street. 


1879. 


1875. 
1871. 


1875. 
1884. 
1879. 
1879. 


1871. 
1884. 
1885. 
1885. 
1871. 
1880. 
1886. 
1882. 
1884. 


1874. 
1879. 
1886. 
1886. 
1884. 
1885. 


LIST OF MEMBERS. XXI 


GREEN, Mr. Bernard R. (Bernard Richardson), 
Office of Building for State, War, and 
Navy Departments. 1788 N street. 
GREEN, Commander F. M. (Francis Mathews), U. S. N. 
(Absent), 
Navy Department. 
GREENE, Prof. B. F. (Benjamin Franklin), U. 8. N. (Pounder, 
absent), 
‘ West Lebanon, N. H. 


GREENE, Francis V. Crbaiye ores Vinton) (Absent), 
No. 1, Broadway, New York city. 
Grucory, Dr. J. M. (John Milton) (Absent), 
45 Albert st., Regent’s Park, London, England. 
GUNNELL, Surg. Gen’l F. M. (Francis M.), U.S. N.,. 
Navy Department. 600 20th street. 


Hains, Lt.-Col. P. C. (Peter Conover), U.S. A., 


Engineer’s Office, Potomac River Improve- 


ment, 2136 Pa. ave. 1824 Jefferson place. 
Hatt, Prof. Asaph, U. 8. N. (Founder), 
Naval Observatory. 2715 N street. 


Hatt, Mr. Asaph, Jr. (Absent), 


Yale Observatory, New Haven, Conn. 


Hauuock, Dr. William, 


Geological Survey. 29234 M street. 
Hampson, Mr. Thomas, 

Geological Survey. Lanier avenue. 
Harkness, Prof. William, U. 8. N. (Founder), 

Naval Observatory. Cosmos Club. 


Hasster, Dr. F. A. ye Augustus) (Absent), 
Santa Afia, Los Angeles Co., Cal. 
Haypen, Lieut. Everett, U. 8S. N., 
Hydrographic Office. 
Hazen, Prof. H. A. (Henry ‘Allen), 
P. O. Box 427. 1416 Corcoran street. 
Heap, Major D. P. (David Porter), U. 8. A. (Resigned), 


Engineer 3d and 4th Light House District, Tompkins- 
ville, N. Y. 


Hensnaw, Mr. H. W. (Henry Wetherbee), 

Bureau of Ethnology. 13 Lowa Circle. 
Hix, Mr. G. W. (George William), 

Nautical Almanac Office. 314 Indiana ave. 
Hi, Mr. R. T. (Robert Thomas), 

Geological Survey. 1626 15th street. 
HiLLeBranp, Dr. W. F. (William Francis), 

Geological Survey.’ 506 Maple ave., Le Droit Park. 
Hirexncock, Mr. Romyn, 

National Museum. Osaka, Japan. 


Hopexrns, Prof. H. L. (Howard Lincoln), 
Columbian University. 1532 19th street. 


‘4 


XXII 


1873. 
1887. 
1879, 
i874. 
1885. 
1886. 
1880. 
1871. 


1878. 


1879. 
1884. 
1873. 


1884. 
1886. 


1884. 
1880. 
1880. 


1875. 
1887. 


1887. 
1874. 


1887. 
1882. 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON, 


Ho.pen, Prof. E. S. (Edward Singleton) (Absent), 
Lick Observatory, San José, Cal. 


Houmes, Mr. J. H. (Jesse Herman), 
1811 I street. 
Ho.mes, Mr. W. H. (William Henry), 
Geological Survey. 1444 Stoughton street. 
Howe t, Mr. E. E. (Edwin pres (Absent), 
8 Oxford street, Rochester, NUYS 


Ipprnes, Mr. J. P. (Joseph pany: 


Geological Survey. 1028 Vermont ave. 
Irvine, Prof. R. D. (Roland Duer), 
Geological Survey. Madison, Wis. 


James, Rev. Owen (Absent), 
Scranton, Pa. 
Jenkins, Rear Admiral T. A. (Thornton Alexander),U.S.N. 
(Founder), 


2115 Pennsylvania ave. 


Jounson, Mr. A. B. (Arnold Burges), 
Light House Board, Treas. Dept. 501 Maple ave., 
Le Droit Park. 


Jounson, Dr. Joseph Taber, 
Private Hospital, 1728 K street. 


Jounson, Mr. Willard D. (Willard Drake), 
Geological Survey. 501 Maple ave., Le Droit Park. 


Jounston, Dr. W. W. (William Waring), 
KaurrMany, Mr. 8. H. (Samuel Hay), 


1603 K street. 


1000 M street. 

Kewnaston, Prof. C. A. (Carlos Albert), 

Howard University. 
Kerr, Mr. Mark B. (Mark Brickell), 

Geological Survey. 2104 H street. 
Kipper, Dr. J. H. (Jerome Henry), ; 

Smithsonian Institution. 1606 N. H. ave. 
Kiizpourne, Lieut. C. E. (Charles Evans), U.S. A. (Absent), 


War Department. 


Kine, Dr. A. F. A. (Albert Freeman Africanus), 


726 13th street. 
Kine, Mr. Harry, 
Geological Survey. 1319 Q street. 


Knicur, Mr. Fred J. (Fred Jay), 


Geological Survey. 


Knox, Hon. John Jay (Absent), 
Prest. Nat. Bank Republic, New York city. 


-19 E. 41st street. 
Know toy, Mr. F. H. (Frank Hall), 
National Museum. 202 Sth street se. 


KumMELL, Mr. C. H. (Charles Hugo), 
Coast and Geodetic Survey. 608 Q street. 


1887. 


1884. 
- 1874. 


1882. 
1871. 
1880. 


1886. 
1886. 
1883. 
1879. 
1876. 
1884. 
1875. 
1885. 
1886. 
1885. 
1878. 
1875. 
1884. 
1871. 


1885. 
1886. 


1884. 
1886. 


LIST OF MEMBERS. XXIII 


LaAnGctLey, Prof. S. P. (Samuel Pierpont), 


Secretary Smithsonian Institution. 
LAWRENCE, Mr. William, 


Leg, Dr. William, 
2111 Penna. ave. 1821 I street. 


Leravour, Mr. E. B. (Edward Brown) (Absent), 
Cambridge, Mass. 
Lincotn, Dr. N. 8. (Nathan Smith), 


Loomis, Mr. E. J. (Eben Jenks), 

Nautical Almanac Office. 1443 Stoughton street. 
McAprz, Mr. A. G. (Alexander George), 

U.S. Signal Office, St. Paul, Minn. 
McDona.p, Col. Marshall, 

U. 8. Fish Commission. 1515 R street. 
McGekg, Mr. W J, 

Geological Survey. 
McGurrg, Mr. Fred. B. (Frederick Bauders), 

1416 F street. 614 E street. 
McMortrig, Prof. William (Absent), 

University of Illinois, Champaign, Ill. 


Mauer, Mr. James A. (James Arran), 


Bellefontaine, Ohio. 


1514 H street. 


Geological Survey. 15 Grant Place. 
Ma.uery, Col. Garrick, U.S. A., 

Bureau of Ethnology. 1323 N street. 
Many, Mr. B: Pickman (Benjamin Pickman), 

Patent Office. 1918 Sunderland Place. 
Martin, Mr. Artemas, 

Coast and Geodetic Survey. 55 C street se. 
Marvin, Prof. C. F. (Charles Frederick), 

Signal Office, War Department. 1786 13th street. 


Marvin, Mr. Jos. B. (Joseph Badger), 
Lock Box 379. 
Mason, Prof. O. T. (Otis Tufton), . 
National Museum. 1305 Q street. 
Matruews, Dr. W. (Washington), U.S. A., 
Army Medical Museum. 1262 New Hampshire ave. 
Metcs, Gen. M. C. (Montgomery Cunningham), U. S. A. 
(Founder), 
1289 Vermont avenue. 
MENDENHALL, Prof. T. C. (Thomas Corwin) (Absent), 
Terre Haute, Ind. 
Merriam, Dr. C. Hart (Clinton Hart), 


Department of Agriculture. 1919 16th street. 
MERRILL, Mr. George P. (George Perkins), 
National Museum. 1602 19th street. 


MircHELL, Prof. Henry, 
43 Coast and Geodetic Survey. 1331 L street. 


XXIV. 
1883. 
1885. 
1884. 


1881. 
1871. 


1872. 


1871. 
1879. 
1884. 
1885. 
1884. 
1878. 
1871. 
1871. 
1871. 
1877. 
1874. 
1873. 
1884. 
1882. 

1874. 
1880. 
1879. 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Moraan, Dr. E. Carroll (Ethelbert Carroll), 
: 918 E street. 
Moser, Lieut. J. F. (Jefferson Franklin), U. 8S. N. (Absent), 
Navy Department. 
Murpoca, Mr. John, 
; Smithsonian Institution. 1429 Stoughton street. 
MusseEy, Gen. R. D. (Reuben Delavan), 
P. O. Box 618. 
NEwcoMB, Baik Simon, U.S. N. (Founder), 
Navy Department. 
Nicwots, Dr. C. H. (Charles Henry) (Absent), 
Bloomingdale Asylum, Boulevard and 117th street, 
New York city, N. Y. 
Nicuotson, Mr. W. L. (Walter Lamb) (Founder), 
2222 G street. 
Norpuorr, Mr. Charles, 
1732 H street. 
Norris, Dr. Basil, U. 8. A. (Absent), 


Vancouver Barracks, Wash. Ter. 


Nort, Judge C. C. (Charles Cooper), 


Court of Claims. 826 Connecticut ave. 
Oapen, Mr. H. G. (Herbert Gouverneur), 
Coast and Geodetic Survey. 1324 19th street. 


OsBoRNE, Mr. J. W. (John Walter), 
212 Delaware ave ne. 
Parke, Gen. John G. (John Grubb), U.S. A. (Founder), 
West Point, N. Y. 
ParRKER, Dr. Peter (died Jan. 10, 1888) (Founder), 


Parry, Dr. C. C. (Charles Christopher) (Absent), 
Davenport, Iowa. 


Paut, Mr. H. M. (Henry Martyn), 


Naval Observatory. 1915 G street. 
PEALE, Dr. A. C. (Albert Charles), 

Geological Survey. 1446 Stoughton street. 
Por, Gen. O. M. (Orlando Metcalfe), U.S. A. (Absent), 


West Congress street, Detroit, Mick. 
PorInDEXTER, Mr. W. M. (William Mundy), 
1505 Pennsylvania ave. 1227 15th street. 
Pope, Dr. B. F. (Benjamin Beare a S. A. (Absent), 
Surg. General’s Office, U. 
Powe tL, Major J. W. (John Walley), 
Geological Survey. 910 M street. 
Prentiss, Dr. D. W. (Daniel Webster), 
1101 14th street. 
PritcHert, Prof. H. 8. (Henry Smith) (Absent), 


Director of Observatory, Washington University, 
St. Louis, Mo. 


1882. 
1884. 
1883. 
1884. 


1878. 


1879. 


1884, 
1872. 
1882. 
1883. 
1883. 
1883. 


1871. 
1871. 

1887. 

1875. 
1874, 
1881. 
1879. 


1883. 
1882. 


1876. 


LIST OF MEMBERS. XXV 


RatuBuy, Mr. Richard, 
National Museum.. 1622 Massachusetts ave. 


Ray, Lieut. P. H, (Patrick Henry), U.S. A., 
Fort Gaston, Cal. 


RensHAWE, Mr. Jno. H. (John Henry), 


Geological Survey. 1215 L street. 
RicKsEcKER, Mr. Eugene, 
Geological Survey. 904 14th street. 
Riuey, Dr. C. V. (Charles Valentine), 
Department of Agriculture. 1700 13th street. 
Ritter, Mr. W. F. McK. (William Francis McKnight) 
(Absent), 


P. O. Box 50, Milton, Pa. 


Rosrnson, Mr. Thomas, 

U.S. Engineer Service. * Vienna, Va. 
Rogers, Mr. Joseph A. (Joseph Addison) (Absent), 

Naval Observatory. 
Russet, Mr. Israel C. (Israel Cook), 

Geological Survey. 42 B street ne. 


RussEtuL, Mr. Thomas, 
Sigual Office, War Department. 1344 Wallach Place. 


Saumon, Dr. D. E. (Daniel Elmer), 


Agricultural Department. 1716 13th street. 
Sampson, Commander W. T. (William Thomas), U.S. N. 
(Absent), 


Naval Academy, Annapolis, Md. 
Saviuue, Mr. J. H. (James Hamilton), 


1419 F street. 1315 M street. 
Scnort, Mr. Charles A. (Charles Anthony) (Founder), 
Coast and Geodetic Survey. 212 Ist street se. 


Srety, Col. F. A. (Franklin Austin), 
Patent Office. 


SHELLABARGER, Hon. Samuel, 


Room 31 Kellogg Building. 812 17th street. 
SHERMAN, Hon. John, 
U.S. Senate. 1319 K street. 


SHUFELDT, Dr. R. W. (Robert Wilson), U. S. A. (Adsent), 
Care Smithsonian Institution. 
SiasBEE, Commander C. D. (Charles Dwight), U. S. N 
(Absent), 
Naval Academy, Annapolis, Md. 


Sxrinner, Dr. J. O. (John Oscar), Ue S. A. (Absent), 
Surg. General’s Office, U. S. 


Smitey, Mr. Chas. W. (Charles Weales), 
U.S. Fish Commission. 943 Massachusets ave. 


Smiru, Chf. Eng. David, U.S. N., 
Navy Department. 


XXVI 
1880. 
1887. 
1886. 
1887. 
1872. 
1884. 
1874. 
1887. 
1881. 
1871. 
1875. 
1884. 
1878. 
1873. 
1886. 
1882. 
1882. 
1880. 
1883. 
1881. 
1872. 
1883. 
1876. 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Samira, Mr. Edwin, 
Coast and Geodetic Survey. 2024 Hillyer Place. 


Smytu, Mr. H. L. (Henry Lloyd), 
Geological Survey. 


Sneux, Mr. Merwin M. (Merwin-Marie), 


National Museum. 732 6th street. 


Spencer, Dr. J. W. (Joseph William), 


1012 17th street. 


Sporrorp, Mr. A. R. (Ainsworth Rand), 


Library of Congress. 1621 Massachusetts ave. 


Srrarns, Mr. R. E. C. (Robert Edwards Carter), 


Geol. Survey; Smithsonian Institution. 1213 12th St. 


Srong, Prof. Ormond (Absent), 
Leander McCormick Observatory, Univ. of Virginia. 


Symons, Capt. T. W. (Thomas William), U. S. A., 


District Building. 1727 De Sales street. 


Tay or, Mr. F. W. (Frederick William) (Absent), 


Smithsonian Institution. 


Tay or, Mr. William B. (William Bower) (Founder), 


Smithsonian Institution. 306 C street. 


Tuompson, Prof. A. H. (Almon Harris), 
Geological Survey. 


Tuompson, Mr. Gilbert, 


Geological Survey. 1448 Q street. 


Topp, Prof. David P. (David Peck) (Absent), 
Amherst College Observatory, Amherst, Mass. 


Toner, Dr. J. M, (Joseph Meredith), 


615 Louisiana ave. 


Trenuoim, Hon. W. L. (William Lee), 


Comptroller of the Currency. 1815 M street. 


True, Mr. F. W. (Frederick William), 


National Museum. 1101 14th street. 


Upton, Mr. Wm. W. (William Wirt), 
1416 F street. 1746 M street. 


Upton, Prof. Winslow (Absent), 

Brown University, Providence, R. I. 
Wat corr, Mr. C. D. (Charles Doolittle), 

Geological Survey ; National Museum. 
Wa.po, Prof. Frank (Absent), 

Forest ave., Cincinnati, Ohio. 

WALKER, Mr. F. A. (Francis Amasa) (Atsoay 

Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Boston, Mass. 
Wane, Mr. H. F. (Henry Francis) (Absent), 

Mass. Trigonometrical Survey, Cambridge, Mass. 


Warp, Mr. Lester F. (Lester Frank), . 
Geological Survey. 1464 Rhode Island ave. 


— ee 


1882. 


1885. 
1882. 
1873. 
1876. 
1884. 
1887. 
1885. 
1887. 
1885. 
1875. 
1880. 
1875. 
1871. 
1883. 
1885. 
1885. 
1887. 
1874, 
1884. 
1885. 


LIST OF MEMBERS. XXVII 


Wesster, Mr. A. L. (Albert Lowry) (Absent), 
107 Drexel Building, Broad street, New York city; 
West New Brighton, Staten Island, N. Y. 


WEED, Mr. W. H. (Walter Harvey), 


Geological Survey. 825 Vermont ave. 


Wetting, Mr. J. C. (James Clarke), 


1302 Connecticut ave. 


WHEELER, Capt. Geo. M. (George Montague), U.S. A., 


Lock Box 93. 930 16th street. 
Wuirte, Dr. C. A. (Charles Abiathar), 
Geological Survey. 3812 Maple ave., Le Droit Park. 


Wuirte, Dr. C. H. (Charles Henry), U.S. N., 


Museum of Hygiene. 


Wairine, Mr. H. L. (Henry Laurens), 


Coast and Geodetic Survey. West Tisbury, Mass. 
Wixuis, Mr. Bailey, 
Geological Survey. 1739 G street. 


Wixson, Mr. H. C. (Herbert Couper) (Absent), 
Carleton College Observatory, Northfield, Minn. 


Witson, Mr, H. M. (Herbert Michael), 
Geological Survey. 1715 G street. 


Witson, Mr. J. Ormond (James Ormond), 
1439 Massachusetts ave. 


Wintock, Mr. W. C. (William Crawford), 
Naval Observatory. 1923 H street. 


Woop, Mr. Joseph (Absent), 
Pittsburgh, Penn. 
Woop, Lieut. W. M. (William Maxwell), U.S. N. (Adsent), 
Navy Department. 


Woopwarp, Mr. R. S. (Robert Simpson), 


Geological Survey. 1804 Columbia road. 
WortmMan, Dr. J. L. (Jacob Lawson), 
Army Medical Museum. 1711 13th street. 


Wricut, Mr. Geo. M. (George Mitchell) (Absent), 
Akron, Ohio. 


Woirvemany, Mr. H. V. (Harry Vanderbilt), 


Geological Survey. 12353 5th street. 
Yarrow, Dr. H. C. (Harry Crécy), 

Army Medical Museum. 814 17th street. 
Yeates, Mr. W.S. (William Smith), 

Smithsonian Institution. 631 T street. 


ZiwEt, Mr. Alexander, 
64 Sibley street, Detroit, Mich. 


XXVIII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


LIST OF DECEASED MEMBERS. 


Name. 
Benjamin Alvord 
Orville Elias Babcock 
Theodorus Bailey 
Spencer Fullerton Baird 
Joseph K. Barnes 
Henry Wayne Blair 
Horace Capron 
Salmon Portland Chase . 
Frederick Collins 
Benjamin Faneuil Craig 
Charles Henry Crane 
Josiah Curtis 
Richard Dominicus Cutts 
Charles Henry Davis 
Frederick William Dorr 
Alexander B. Dyer 
Amos Beebe Eaton . 
Charles Ewing 
Elisha Foote . 
John Gray Foster 
Leonard Dunnell Gale 
Isaiah Hanscom . 
William Babcock Hecani 
Joseph Henry 
Franklin Benjamin wee! 


Andrew Atkinson Humphreys . 


Ferdinand Kampf : 
Washington Caruthers Kerr 
Jonathan Homer Lane 
Edward Phelps Lull 

Oscar A. Mack 


Archibald Robertson Mavving 4 


Fielding Bradford Meek 
James William Milner . 
Albert James Myer 
George Alexander Otis . 
Peter Parker. 

Carlile Pollock Patterson 
Titian Ramsay Peale 
Benjamin Peirce 

John Campbell Riley 
John Rodgers 


Admitted. 
« P1872 
1871 
F 1873 
Founder 
Founder 
1884 
Founder 
Founder 
1879 
Founder 
Founder 
1874 
1871 
1874 
1874 
Founder 
Founder 
1874 
Founder 
18738 
1874 
1873 
: 1881 
Founder 
‘ 1879 
Founder 
1875 
1883 
Founder 
1875 
1872 
1874 
Founder 
1874 
Founder 
Founder 
Founder 
1871 
Founder 
Founder 
1877 
1872 


LIST OF MEMBERS. XXIX 


Name. Admitted, 
Benjamin Franklin Sands . : : . . . Founder 
George Christian Shaeffer ‘ : ‘ : : Founder 
Henry Robinson Searle ‘ ; : : : Pl guna 8 2 G4 
William J. Twining . F : : : : 1878 
Joseph Janvier Woodward . : ‘ . ° . Founder 
John Maynard Woodworth . : m . 1874 
Mordecai Yarnall_ . A : , a diy ato l 

SUMMARY. 
Active members 4 : : x : 182 
Absent members . : : : : : 58 
Total . : : - “ ° 240 
Deceased members. : : . . - 49 


mi. Great Neat 


AS ie 


LS een ‘ vi ay Me Gia onan? NG 
Mn elas ks Rf dp uv dere hoayys bing 
‘ fe ; t 


pr FES SNe ee, Ps ax Ck Ply eR “Wt taetar ae 
. MLA Ricoto Baal ge rs | ada Diane 


' J Ny 
a fs { ny 
* . 
yt 1 oki ‘ 
1 Pua 
t A “ } 
are 
; ' 7 a: : 
. 7 
. ! 
ir y 
: ‘ ! 
‘ ( 
/ 
' 
j : } 
‘ tH ; 
' j } 
é@ 
: e 
it Me > 
i 
’ 
wal . 
\ ; . 
mh R : 4 
7 ' 
i ve 
\ 
F 
‘ 
i 
if 
: 4 Ay fs 
Pa " 
' 
, , A 
‘ \ 
J 1 
i 
ee Ko 
y ‘ i 
. 
. 4) Pa ‘3 
. 
= \ 
i r 15 {8,4 ‘ 
, “ T ’ 
y a f i 
a) \ aay 
\ Pa aX 
1 4 
Pari x jilaal , 
ay . > 
, ( * 
r ‘ i) < 
i it : i. 
i i ee) 
a # 
t he / 
LK 
‘ ii rs ; j tee 
me t; fa : 
i \ WS 
} : i < 
¥ x . ¢ ¥ 8) 
hi . ‘ “ 
Tihs i i 
* in wo 


XXXI 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


L061 
“9061 
“COGL 


““POGL 
seenaee ef 
reseeeeezggr 
10GL 


sesso 
“66ST 
** 8681 
sesreeeeee GOT 


e—~ 


02 ‘9 £26 cz TL 82 FL 62 ‘ot aT ST 2 Pace are rea ere aN ORI 
2 ‘s ¢% ‘IT 13 ‘8 os ‘ot ‘s | OL ‘2 6L ‘¢ eee CONT 
&z ‘6 9% ‘ZI 82 ‘FL 1S “LEG Lives 02 ‘9 sae POSE 
$B OL 13 Ser 62 ‘OL 1 i 8L S 8 % tA By) PiEDC cE aaeesbausbnssuestosveaey] tir 
SI ‘F Le? €z ‘6 93 ‘31 LZ ‘8 OSE ORS Grete “6ST 
0% ‘9 €z ‘6 G3 ‘IL 83 ‘FI 83 ‘FL 18 ‘L1 ‘g “16ST 
12 °L ¥6 ‘Or 9% ‘ZI 62 ‘ST ‘T SI ‘T SI ‘F “O68 
2 ‘8 G3 ‘TL 1G ‘SI SOLS. Ie Ones 61 ‘9 See COST: 
£% ‘6 96 ‘1 8% FI TELE SS. le SEF Te ‘L boamanans *{!1:) 6 
81 ‘F Te ‘2 €2 ‘6 0% ‘ZL 93 ‘ZL 63 ‘ST 

OL ‘¢ 3 ‘8 V ‘OL Le ‘SL 13 ‘81 0$ ‘OL ‘3 

02 ‘9 €3 ‘6 G3 ‘IL 63 ‘OT 83 ‘FL Te ‘a0 ‘g 

‘oun “ABN *|udy ‘youn «| “Arenaqoy | “Arcnave “SIvOA 


“1equis09q 


SSS 


Sy. See eee LOGT: 


Soar 
= 

sH 

an 


sereeeeeeeeeogoy 
raeewossneeeg coy 


- 


- 
O2rowo 


= 


1 
i~] 
N 


eon ae get nag) 


= 


Coods 
R 
=x 


= 


“LOQUIQAON | *19q0}00 “sIGIA 


“poystiqnd porzspso pur “bggr ‘4 aunf aaywu0g yerauax) ay) 0} peyiuqns 

“LLOITIY "g “G ‘YU Ad aauvaaug 

*aaesiniz ‘90, -Lobr 03 $9 -t 931 Ulf ., SUOSDAS 5, JDAARAIS ay Stttanp ssuroayy Sumpjoy 4of SA VALOLVS %wvusayo yz Suummys 
‘ALYIOOS IVOIHdOSOTIHA HHL FO USN AHL YOL UVGNATVO 


XXXII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ANNUAL REPORT OF THE SECRETARIES. 


WasuHinoton, D. C., December 21, 1887. 
To the Philosophical Society of Washington : 
We have the honor to present the following statistical data for 


“paper: 


The last Annual Report brought the record of membership 
down to December 18, 1886. The number of active mem- 
bers was then . . ; , ° ‘ , . « 283 
shis number has been increased by the addition of 14 new 
members, by the return of 1 absent member, and by the 
reinstatement of 2 members previously dropped. It has 
been diminished by the departure of 7 members, by the 
resignation of 1, and by the death of 3 members. The net 
increase of active members has thus been : é ‘ 6 
And the active membership is now. : : : Be 


The roll of new members is: 


W. H. Bascocr. F. H. Know.rTon. T. W. Symons 
EvEerReTr HAYDEN. S. P. Lanaury. H. L. WHITING 
J. H. Hotmzs. F. A. SEELY. H. C. WiLson 
Harry Kina. H. L. Smyru. H. V. WtUrDEMAN. 
F. J. Knieur. J. W. SPENCER. 

The roll of deceased members is: 
S. F. Barrp. W. B. Hazen. E. P. Luu. 


There have been 16 meetings, of which 14 have been for the pre- 
sentation and discussion of papers, 1 for the President’s Annual 
Address, and 1 for the Annual Reports and election of officers ; 
the average attendance (at the 14 meetings for presentation of 
papers), has been 49. There have been 12 meetings of the Mathe- 
matical Section; average attendance 17. 

The first 5 meetings of the year were held in the library of the 
Surgeon General’s Office, at which meetings the average attendance 
was 40; the 9 remaining meetings were held in the Assembly Hall 
of the Cosmos Club, at which the average attendance was 54. 

In the general meetings 37 communications have been presented ; 
in the Mathematical Section 20. Altogether 57 communications 


SECRETARIES’ REPORT. XXXIII 


have been made by 37 members and 1 guest. The number of 
members and guests who have participated in the discussions is 40. 
The total number who have contributed to the scientific proceed- 
ings is 47, or 25 per cent. of the present active membership. 

The General Committee has held 16 meetings; average attend- 
ance 13, the smallest attendance at any meeting being 11 and the 
largest 15. 

Of the present active membership 146, or 77 per cent., are em- 
ployed in the service of the Government, and 44, or 23 per cent., 
are not so employed. 

Marcus BAKER, 
J. H. Kipper, 
Secretaries. 


XXXIV PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


REPORT OF THE TREASURER. 


Mr. President and Gentlemen: 

The report which I shall presently have the honor to submit to 
you exhibits the total receipts and disbursements for the fiscal year 
ending with this meeting. 

The receipts, however, include amounts received for outstanding 
dues of previous years, and it is, therefore, proper to say that the 
income belonging to the year 1887 was $1,035.75, and the expendi- 
ture $568.22, leaving a net surplus for the year of $467.53. 

The unpaid dues of former years which have been collected in 
1887 amount to $120. 

The assets of the Society consist of: 


2 Government bonds, $1,000 and $500, at 4 per cent., $1,500 00 


1 : bond, 1,000, ab hay 1,000 00 
6 Cosmos Club mortgage bonds, cae ae 600 00 
Cash with Riggs & Co. : ; : : : : 942 05 
Wapaid dues. oa ie) Oia tea ee a 265 00 


Total . : : ; : : J . $4,307 05 


The removal of the Society from its old place of meeting at the 
Army Medical Museum made it nececessary to provide certain 
articles of furniture and equipment for use in its new quarters. 

The ninth volume of the Bulletin was duly issued in January to 
all members entitled to receive it, and to the societies and scientific 
journals with which it is customary for the Philosophical Society to 
exchange publications. 


XXXV 


TREASURER’S REPORT. 


‘wainsna4y, “THHOLATA LAIAAOW 
ee ee ee, oe 


1% 1ea‘T$ 


IF peed 


paint ea ee aonmaas === -=== or 99 SSSIYT [IM OOUBleg 


ere aIn}UINJ 19q}0 pus ‘ysop sul 
-pvor ‘9[qe} ‘pavoq-yov[q 10; pred yseo Ag 
(Sie a ae es *-oyo ‘ort yaoro ‘Arou0ry 
-vys ‘osvysod 10f solieja100g puB JdINSBOL, 
jo sosuedxe snosuvyjoosiu roy pred yseo Ag 
Sea ‘oqo ‘srvpnoi1o ‘sprvo [eysod 
—Suryurd snoouspeostut soy pred ysvo Ag 
=a ee “Saou .[Molteuie 
-YIV]T oY} Jo pus ‘Ayo100g oy} Jo ssutyoour 


uo sourpusyze sof sdoytuvl pred yseo Ag "1% ‘00d 


Adee apa ae Bees pee: urjolIng oy} 
JO XT ‘OA Suiddeim pur ‘Surpurq ‘sur 


-yurd s0j JoplomMyoq ® ppne pred yseo Ag -g ‘qoq 


“L881 


"1881 ‘IZ vaquacagq ‘NOLONIHSV MA 


1% 129't 


00-S81.= = 


oS GS 
OO GP mi » FIV 000'T » 
00 09$ ~~~777 "~~" "yueo sod F 48 OOG‘TS UO 
: Spuoq UO 4so19JUL IOJ * i 
00 006 
00 GI ~"888T ” ” ” 
00 G9L ~~ L881 ” ” ” 
00 OOT ~"988T ” ” ” 
00 02% ~~G881 JO sonp tos ” ” 
G) -"-Uuljo|[Ng JO Sa[Vs UIOIJ POAIODAL YSBVO 4, “TZ “09d 


39 G8Fk ~~~988T ‘GT “oq ‘puvy Uo Ysvo oouLleq OF, ; 
“188 


"a0 


‘uopburysn yy fo hyaroog yoorydosopyg ay) yp yUnOIP UL JadnsDasy, 94, "aq 


¥ 


{ 
\ 
. 
+ 
| ; 


ey ren 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. 


XXXVii 


‘ 
‘ 
r 

co 


4 


WVER 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT, 
WILLIAM HARKNESS. 


Delivered December 10, 1887. 


THE PROGRESS OF SCIENCE AS EXEMPLIFIED IN 
THE ART OF WEIGHING AND MEASURING. 


Two centuries ago the world was just beginning to awaken from an 
intellectual lethargy which had lasted a thousand years. During all 
that time the children had lived as their parents before them, the 
mechanical arts had been at a standstill, and the dicta of Aristotle 
had been the highest authority in science. But now the night of 
medievalism was approaching its end, and the dawn of modern 
progress was at hand. Galileo had laid the foundation for accurate 
clocks by discovering the isochronism of the simple pendulum; 
had proved that under the action of gravity light bodies fall as 
rapidly as heavy ones; had invented the telescope and with it dis- 
covered the spots on the sun, the mountains on the moon, the sat- 
ellites of Jupiter, and the so-called triple character of Saturn; and 
after rendering himself immortal by his advocacy of the Copernican 
system, had gone to his grave, aged, blind, and full of sorrows. His 
contemporary, Kepler, had discovered the laws which, while history 
endures, will associate his name with the theory of planetary motion, 
and he also had passed away. The first Cassini was still a young 
man, his son was a little child, and his grandson and great-grand- 
son, all of whom were destined to be directors of the Paris Observa- | 
tory, were yet unborn. The illustrious Huyghens, the discoverer 
of Saturn’s rings and the father of the undulatory theory of light, 
was in the zenith of his powers. The ingenious Hooke was a little 
younger, and Newton, towering above them all, had recently in- 
vented fluxions, and on the 28th of April, 1686, had presented his 
Principia to the Royal Society of London and given the theory 
of gravitation to the world. Bradley, who discovered nutation and 


44 Xxxix 


XL PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


the aberration of light; Franklin, the statesman and philosopher, 
who first drew the lightning from the clouds ; Dollond, the inventor 
of the achromatic telescope; Euler, the mathematician who was 
destined to accomplish so much in perfecting algebra, the calculus, 
and the lunar theory; Laplace, the author of the Mécanique 
Céleste; Rumford, who laid the foundation of the mechanical 
theory of heat; Dalton, the author of the atomic theory upon which 
all chemistry rests; and Bessel, the greatest of modern astrono- 
mers—these and others almost as illustrious, whom we cannot even 
name to-night, were still in the womb of time. 

Pure science first felt the effects of the new intellectual life and 
it was more than a century later before the arts yielded to its influ- 
ence. Then came Hargreaves, the inventor of the spinning-jenny; 
Arkwright, the inventor of the cotton-spinning frame; Watt, who 
gave us the condensing steam engine; Jacquard, the inventor of 
the loom for weaving figured stuffs ; Murdock, the originator of gas 
lighting; Evans, the inventor of the high-pressure steam engine; 
Fulton, the father of steam navigation; Trevithick, who ranks 
very near Watt and Evans in perfecting the steam engine; and 
Stephenson, the father of railroads. If now we add the names 
of those who have given us the telegraph, to wit: Gauss, the emi- 
nent physicist and the greatest mathematician of the present cen- 
tury ; Weber, Wheatstone, and Henry—all famous physicists—and — 
Morse, the inventor and engineer; we have before us the demi-gods 
who have transformed the ancient into the modern world, given us 
machinery which has multiplied the productive power of the human 
race many fold, annihilated time and space, and bestowed upon 
toiling millions a degree of comfort and luxury which was unknown 
to kings and emperors of old. 

The discoveries and inventions of the last two centuries have so 
far exceeded all others within historic times that we are amply jus- 
tified in calling this an age of phenomenal progress, and under the 
circumstances a little self-glorification is pardonable—perhaps even 
natural. The weekly and monthly records of scientific events 
which appear in so many newspapers and magazines are the imme- 
diate result of this, and the great increase of ephemeral scientific 
literature has led multitudes of educated people to believe that 
such records represent actual progress. The multiplication of 
bricks facilitates the building of houses, but does not necessarily 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLI 


improve architecture. Similarly, the multiplication of minor inves- 
tigations improves our knowledge of details, but rarely affects the 
great philosophic theories upon which science is founded. The im- 
portance of human actions is measured by the degree in which they 
affect human thought, and the only way of permanently affecting 
scientific thought is by modifying or extending scientific theories. 
The men who do that are neither numerous, nor do they require 
weekly paragraphs to record their deeds; but their names are hon- 
ored by posterity. Even in this golden age the advance of science 
is not steady, but is made by spasmodic leaps and bounds. Mere 
scientific brick making, commonly called progress, is always the 
order of the day until some genius startles the world by a discovery 
affecting accepted theories. Then every effort is directed in the 
new line of thought until it is measurably worked out, and after 
that brick making again resumes its place. While the progress in 
two centuries has been immense, the progress in a week or a month 
is usually almost nil. Optimism has its uses in many departments 
of human affairs, but science should be cool and dispassionate, 
having regard only for the truth. To make a trustworthy estimate 
of the actual state of the whole vast realm of science would be a 
task beyond the powers of any one man; but perhaps it will not 
be amiss to spend the time at our disposal this evening in briefly 
reviewing the recent progress and present condition of the funda- 
mental processes upon which the exact sciences rest—I allude to 
the methods of weighing and measuring. 

Physical science deals with many quantities, but they are all so 
related to each other that almost every one of them can be ex- 
pressed in terms of three fundamental units. As several systems 
of such units are possible, it is important to select the most con- 
venient, and the considerations which guide us in that respect are 
the following: 


1. The quantities selected should admit of very accurate com- 
parison with other quantities of the same kind. 


2. Such comparisons should be possible at all times, and in all 
places. 


3. The processes necessary for making such comparisons should 
be easy and direct. 


XLII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


4, The fundamental units should be such as to admit of easy defi- 
nitions and simple dimensions for the various derived units. 


Scientific men have long agreed that these requirements are best 
fulfilled by adopting as the fundamental units, a definite length, a 
definite mass, and a definite interval of time. Length is an element 
which can be very accurately measured and copied, but it must be 
defined by reference to some concrete material standard, as for 
example, a bar of metal, and as all substances expand and contract 
with changes of temperature, it is necessary to state the temperature 
at which the standard is correct. A standard of mass, consisting 
of a piece of platinum, quartz, or other material not easily affected 
by atmospheric influences, probably fulfills the conditions set forth 
above better than any other kind of magnitude. Its comparison 
with other bodies of approximately equal mass is effected by weigh- 
ing, and as that is among the most exact of all laboratory operations, 
very accurate copies of the standard can be made, and they can be 
carried from place to place with little risk of injury. Time is also 
an element which can be measured with extreme precision. The 
immediate instruments of measurement are clocks and chronometers, 
‘but their running is checked by astronomical observations and the 
ultimate standard is the rotation of the earth itself. 

It is important to note that the use of three fundamental units is 
simply a matter of convenience and not a theoretical necessity, for 
the unit of mass might be defined as that which at unit distance 
would generate in a material point unit velocity in unit time; and 
thus we should have a perfectly general system of measurement 
based upon only two fundamental units—namely, those of space and 
time. Such a system is quite practicable in astronomy, but cannot 
yet be applied with accuracy to ordinary terrestrial purposes. Ac- 
cording to the law of gravitation 

Mass = Acceleration X (Distance)? 


and as in the case of the earth we can measure the quantities on 
the right-hand side of that equation with considerable accuracy, we 
can satisfactorily determine the earth’s mass in terms of the supposed 
unit. That suffices for the needs of astronomy, but for other scien- 
tific and commercial purposes a standard of mass having a magni- 
tude of about a pound is necessary, and as two such,masses can be 
compared with each other from five to ten thousand times more 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLIII 


accurately than either of them can be determined in terms of the 
supposed unit, three fundamental units are preferable to two. 

The Chaldeans, Babylonians, Persians, Greeks, and Romans all 
seem to have had systems of weights and measures based upon toler- 
ably definite standards, but after the decline of the Roman Empire 
these standards seem to have been forgotten, and in the beginning 
of the sixteenth century the human body had so far become the 
standard of measurement that the units in common use, as for ex- 
ample, the foot, palm, etc., were frequently taken directly from it. 
The complete table of measures of length was then as follows: the 
breadth (not the length) of four barley corns make a digit, or finger 
breadth; four digits make a palm, (measured across the middle 
joints of the fingers;) four palms are one foot; a foot and a half 
is a cubit; ten palms, or two feet and a half, are a step; two steps, 
or five feet, are a pace; ten feet are a perch; one hundred and 
twenty-five paces are an Italic stadium ; eight stadia, or one thousand 
paces, are an Italic mile; four Italic miles, area German mile; and 
five Italic miles are a Swiss mile. It was then the practice to fur- 
nish standards of length in books by printing in them lines a foot or 
a palm long, according to the size of the page, and from these and 
other data it appears that the foot then used on the continent of 
Europe had a length of about ten English inches. 

In England the first attempts at scientific accuracy in matters of 
measurement date from the beginning of the seventeenth century, 
when John Greaves, who must be considered as the earliest of the 
scientific metrologists, directed attention to the difference between the 
Roman and English foot by tolerably accurate determinations of 
the former, and also attempted the investigation of the Roman 
weights. He was followed by Dr. Edward Bernard, who wrote a 
treatise on ancient weights and measures about 1685, and towards 
the end of the century the measurements of the length of a degree 
by Picard and J. D. Cassini awakened the attention of the French 
to the importance of rigorously exact standards. In considering 
the progress of science with respect to standards of length we may 
safely confine our inquiries to the English yard and the French 
toise and meter, for during the last two hundred years they have 
been almost the only standards adopted in scientific operations. 

The English measures of length have come down from the Saxons, 
but the oldest standards now existing are the Exchequer yards of 


XLIV PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Henry VII(1490)' and Elizabeth (1588).? These are both brass end 
measures, the former being an octagonal rod about half an inch in 
diameter, very coarsely made, and as rudely divided into inches on 
the right hand end and intg sixteenths of a yard on the left hand 
end; the latter a square rod with sides about half an inch wide, 
also divided into sixteenths of a yard and provided with a brass bed 
having end pieces between which the yard fits. One end of the bed 
is divided into inches and half inches. Francis Baily, who saw this 
Elizabethan standard in 1856, speaks of it as ‘this curious instru- 
ment, of which it is impossible, at the present day, to speak too much 
in derision or contempt. A common kitchen poker, filed at the ends 
in the rudest manner by the most bungling workman, would make 
as goodastandard. It has been broken asunder; and the two pieces 
have been dove-tailed together: but so badly that the joint is nearly 
as loose as that of a pair of tongs. The date of this fracture I could 
not ascertain, it having occurred beyond the memory or knowledge 
of any of the officers at the Exchequer. And yet, till within the 
last 10 years, to the disgrace of this country, copies of this measure 
have been circulated all over Europe and America, with a parch- 
ment document accompanying them (charged with a stamp that 
costs £3. 10s. exclusive of official fees) certifying that they are true 
copies of the English standard.”* 

in the year 1742 certain members of the Royal Society of Lon- 
don, and of the Royal Academy of Sciences of Paris, proposed that, 
in order to facilitate a comparison of the scientific operations car- 
ried on in the two countries, accurate standards of the measures 
and weights of both should be prepared and preserved in the ar- 
chives of each of these societies. This proposition having been 
approved, Mr. George Graham at the instance of the Royal Society 
had two substantial brass rods made, upon which he laid off, with 
the greatest care, the length of three English feet from the stap- 
dard yard kept at the Tower of London. These two rods, together 
with a set of troy weights, were then sent over to the Paris Acad- 
emy, which body, in like manner, had the measure of a French half 
toise set off upon the rods, and keeping one, as previously agreed, 
returned the other, together with a standard weight of two mares, 
to the Royal Society. In 1835, Baily declared this copy of the half 


143, p. 34, and 44, pp. 51-2. (See Bibliography on page xxix.) 
243, p. 25. 334, p. 146. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLV 


toise to be of little value because the original toise-¢talon was of 
iron, and the standard temperature in France differed from that in 
England.’ In his opinion the French should have sent over an 
iron half toise in exchange for the English brass yard; but this 
criticism loses much of its force when it is remembered that in 1742 
neither England nor France had fixed upon a temperature at which 
their standards were to be regarded as of the true length. On the 
return of the rod from Paris Mr. Graham caused Jonathan Sisson 
to divide the English yard and the French half toise each into three 
equal parts, after which the rod was deposited in the archives of 
the Royal Society, where it still remains.” Objection having been 
made that the original and legal standard yard of England was 
not the one at the Tower, but the Elizabethian standard at the Ex- 
chequer, the Royal Society requested Mr. Graham to compare his 
newly-made scale with the latter standard, and on Friday, April 
22, 1748, he did so in the presence of a committee of seven mem- 
bers of the Royal Society. In the following week the same gentle- 
men compared the Royal Society’s scale with the standards at 
Guildhall and the Tower, and also with the standard of the Clock- 
makers’ Company. These comparisons having shown that the copy 
of the Tower yard upon the Royal Society’s scale was about 0°0075 
of an inch longer than the standard at the Exchequer, Mr. Graham 
inscribed upon the Royal Society’s scale a copy of the latter stand- 
ard also, marking it with the letters Exch., to distinguish it from 
the former, which was marked E. (English), and from the half toise 
which was marked F. (French).’ 

In the year 1758 the House of Commons appointed a committee 
to inquire into the original standards of weights and measures of 
England; and, under instructions from that committee, the cele- 
brated instrument maker, John Bird, prepared two brass rods, 
respecting which the committee speak as follows in their report: 
“And having those rods, together with that of the Royal Society 
laid in the same place, at the receipt of the Exchequer, all night 
with the standards of length kept there, to prevent the variation 
which the difference of air might make upon them, they the next 
morning compared them all, and, by the means of beam compasses 
brought by Mr. Bird, found them to agree as near as it was possible.” * 
One of these rods was arranged as a matrix for testing end meas- 


134, p.87. 76, pp. 185-8. 97, pp. 541-556. #11, p. 434. 


XLVI PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ures, and the other was a line measure which the committee recom- 
mended should be made the legal standard of Erfgland, and which 
has since been known as Bird’s standard of 1758. Respecting the 
statement that after lying together all night the rods were a// found 
to agree as near as it was possible, Baily says: “This is somewhat 
remarkable, and requires further explanation, which unfortunately 
cannot now be accurately obtained. For it is notorious that the meas- 
ure of the yard of the Royal Society’s scale differs very considerably 
from the standard yard at the Exchequer: * * * Owing to 
this singular confusion of the lengths of the measures, which does 
not appear to have been unraveled by any subsequent Committee, 
it has happened that the Imperial standard yard * * * has 
been assumed nearly 1 + 140 of an inch longer than the ancient 
measure of the kingdom.”* There is little difficulty in surmising 
what Bird did. The Exchequer standard consisted of a rod and its 
matrix. The Royal Society’s committee assumed the rod to be the 
true standard of 36 inches, and upon that assumption Graham’s 
measurements gave for the length of the matrix 36°0102 inches, and 
for the length of the Royal Society’s yard 36:0075 inches. The 
Parliamentary committee of 1758 probably assumed the standard 
to consist of the rod and matrix together, which seems the better 
view; and by laying the rod in its matrix and measuring to the 
joint between them, Bird would have got a length of about 36-0051 
inches. The mean between that and 36°0075 would be 36:0063, 
which differs very little from the length of Bird’s standard result- 
ing from Sir George Shuckburgh’s measurements. Thus the com- 
mittee’s statement is justified, and there has been no falsification of 
the ancient standards. 

On December 1, 1758, Parliament created another committee on 
weights and measures which in April, 1759, repeated the reeommen- 
dation that Bird’s standard of 1758 should be legalized, and further 
recommended that a copy of it should be made and deposited in 
some public office, to be used only on special occasions.” The copy 
was made by Bird in 1760, but owing to circumstances entirely un- 
connected with the subject, no legislation followed for sixty-four 
years. 

The Royal Commission appointed during the reign of George III, 
to consider the subject of weights and measures, madevits first report 


134, p. 43. 212, p. 463. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLVII 


on June 24, 1819, and therein recommended the adoption of the 
standard of length which had been used by General Roy in measur- 
ing the base on Hounslow Heath ;* but in a second report made 
July 13, 1820, they wrote,“We * * * have examined, since 
our last report, the relation of the best authenticated standards of 
length at present in existence, to the instruments employed for 
measuring the base on Hounslow Heath, and in the late trigonome- 
trical operations—But we have very unexpectedly discovered, that 
an error has been committed in the construction of some of these 
instruments:? We aretherefore obliged to recur to the originals which 
they were intended to represent, and we have found reason to prefer 
the Parliamentary standard executed by Bird in 1760, which we 
had not before received, both as being laid down in the most ac- 
curate manner, and as the best agreeing with the most extensive 
comparisons, which have been hitherto executed by various observers, 
and circulated through Europe; and in particular with the scale 
employed by the late Sir George Shuckburgh.”* 

Accordingly, when in 1824 Parliament at length took action, 
Bird’s standard of 1760 was adopted instead of that of 1758. The 
former being a copy of a copy, its selection as a national standard 
of length seems so singular that the circumstances which brought 
about that result should scarcely be passed over in silence. Bird 
had a very accurate brass scale 90 inches long, which he used in 
all his dividing operations, whether upon circles or straight lines, 
and which Dr. Maskelyne said was 0°001 of an inch shorter on 
three feet than Graham’s Royal Society yard E.* In the year 1792, 
or 1793, the celebrated Edward Troughton made for himself a five 
_ foot scale, which conformed to Bird’s, and which he afterwards used 
in laying down the divisions of the various instruments that passed 
through his hands. This was the original of all the standard scales 
he ever made, and at the beginning of the present century he be- 
lieved these copies, which were made by the aid of micrometer 
microscopes, to be so exact that no variations could possibly be de- 
tected in them, either from the original or from each other. Among 
the earliest of the scales so made by Troughton was the one used by 
Sir George Shuckburgh in 1796-8 in his important scientific opera- 
tions for the improvement of the standards. Subsequently, the 
length of the meter was determined by comparison with this scale 


123, p. 4. 327, p. 92. $24, p. 3; also, 25 and 26. #13, p. 326. 


XLVIII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


and with the supposed fac-simile of it made by Troughton for Pro- 
fessor Pictet, of Geneva, and thus it happened “that on the conti- 
nent of Europe all measures were converted into English units by 
a reference to Sir George Shuckburgh’s scale. The Royal Commis- 
sion of 1819, believed Bird’s standard of 1760 to be identical with 
Shuckburgh’s scale, and they legalized it rather than the standard of 
1758, in order to avoid disturbing the value of the English yard 
which was then generally accepted for scientific purposes. 

There are yet four other scales of importance in the history 
of English standards—namely, the brass five-foot scale made for 
Sir George Shuckburgh by Troughton in 1796; two iron standard 
yards, marked 1A and 2A, made for the English Ordnance Survey 
department by Messrs. Troughton and Simms in 1826-’7, and the 
Royal Society’s standard yard constructed by Mr. George Dollond, 
under the direction of Captain Henry Kater, in 1851. 

Bearing in mind the preceding history, the genesis of the present 
English standard yard may be thus summarized: In 1742 Graham 
transferred to a bar made for the Royal Society a length which he 
intended should be that of the Tower yard, but which was really inter- 
mediate between the Exchequer standard yard of Elizabeth and its 
matrix. That length he marked with the letter E, and, although 
destitute of legal authority, it was immediately accepted as the 
scientific standard and was copied by the famous instrument makers 
of the time with all the accuracy then attainable. Thus itis in 
fact the prototype to which all the accurate scales made in Eng- 
land between 1742 and 1850 can be traced. Bird’s standard of 
1758 was compared with the Exchequer standard and with the 
Royal Society’s yard E, and was of a length between the two. 
Bird’s standard of 1760, legalized as the Imperial standard in June, 
1824, was copied from his standard of 1758. After becoming the Im- 
perial standard, Bird’s standard of 1760 was compared with Sir 
George Shuckburgh’s scale by Captain Kater in 1830 and by Mr. 
Francis Baily in 1834; with the Ordnance yards 1A and 2A in 
1834 by Lieutenant Murphy, R. E., Lieutenant Johnson, R. N., 
and Messrs. F. Baily and Donkin; and with Kater’s Royal Society 
yard by Captain Kater in 1831. On October 16th, 1834, the Im- 
perial standard (Bird’s standard of 1760) was destroyed by the 
burning of the Houses of Parliament, in which it was lodged, and 
very soon thereafter the Lords of the Treasury took measures to 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. XLIX 


recover its length. Preliminary inquiries were begun on May 11, 
1838, and on June 20, 1843, they resulted in the appointment of a 
Commission to superintend the construction of new Parliamentary 
standards of length and weight, among whose members the Astron- 
omer Royal (now Sir George B. Airy), Messrs. F. Baily, R. Sheep- 
shanks, and Prof. W. H. Miller, were prominent. The laborious 
investigations and experiments carried out by that Commission can- 
not be described here, but it will suffice to say that for determining 
the true length of the new standard Mr. Sheepshanks employed a 
provisional yard, marked upon a new brass bar designated “ Brass 
2,” which he compared as accurately as possible with Sir George 
Shuckburgh’s scale, the two Ordnance yards, and Kater’s Royal 
Society yard. The results in terms of the lost Imperial standard 
were as follows: 


Brass bar 2 = 36:000084 from comparison with Shuckburgh’s scale, 0-36 in. 


36-000280 ” - bs «10-46 in. 
36000303 from comparison with the Ordnance yard, 1A. 
36:000275 “cc ce ce ce cc DA? 


36-000229 from Capt. Kater’s Royal Society yard. 


Mean — 86:000284 


Respecting this mean Mr. Sheepshanks wrote: “This should be 
pretty near the truth; but I prefer 36:00025, if in such a matter 
such a difference be worth notice. I propose, therefore, in con- 
structing the new standard to assume that— 


Brass bar 2 = 36:00025 inches of lost Imperial standard at 62° Fah.”’ 


And upon that basis the standard now in use was constructed.’ 


Turning now to the French standards of length, it is known that 
the ancient toise de macons of Paris was probably the toise of 
Charlemagne (A. D. 742 to 814), or at least of some Emperor 
Charles, and that its étalon was situated in the court yard of the 
old Chatelet, on the outside of one of the pillars of the building. 
It still existed in 1714, but entirely falsified by the bending of the 
upper part of the pillar. In 1668 the ancient toise of the masons 
was reformed by shortening it five lines; but whether this reforma- 
tion was an arbitrary change, or merely a change to remedy the 


141, p. 664. 


L PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


effects of long use and restore the étalon to conformity with some 
more carefully preserved standard, is not quite clear." These old 
étalons were iron bars having their two ends turned up at right 
angles so as to form talons, and the standardizing of end measures 
was effected by fitting them between the talons. Being placed on 
the outside of some public building, they were exposed to wear from 
constant use, to rust, and even to intentional injury by malicious 
persons. Under such conditions every étalon would, sooner or later, 
become too long and require shortening. 

Respecting the ancient toise of the masons there are two contra- 
dictory stories. On December 1, 1714, La Hire showed to the 
French Academy what he characterized as “a very ancient instru- 
ment of mathematics, which has been made by one of our most ac- 
complished workmen with very great care, where the foot is marked, 
and which has served to re-establish the toise of the Chatelet, as I 
have been informed by our old mathematicians.”” Forty-four years 
later, on July 29, 1758, La Condamine stated to the Academy that 
“We know only by tradition that to adjust the length of the new 
standard, the width of the arcade or interior gate of the grand pa- 
vilion, which served as an entrance to the old Louvre, on the side 
of the rue Fromenteau was used. This opening, according to the 
plan, should have been twelve feet wide. Half of it was taken to 
fix the length of the new toise, which thus became five lines shorter 
than the old one.”* Of these two contradictory statements that of 
La Hire seems altogether most trustworthy, and the ordinary rules 
of evidence indicate that it should be accepted to the exclusion of 
the other. 

In 1668 the étalon of the new toise, since known as the toise-étalon 
du Chatelet, was fixed against the wall at the foot of the staircase 
of the grand Chatelet de Paris—by whom or at what season of the 
year is not known. Strange as it now seems, this standard—very 
roughly made, exposed in a public place for use or abuse by every- 
body, liable to rust, and certain to be falsified by constant wear— 
was actually used for adjusting the toise of Picard, that of Cassini,. 
the toise of Peru and of the North, that of La Caille, that of Mairan 
—in short, all the toises employed by the French in their geodetic 
operations during the seventeenth and eighteenth centuries. The 
lack of any other recognized standard made the use ofthis one im- 


11, p. 536 and 2, p. 395. 22, p. 395. $14, p. 484. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LI 


perative, but the French academicians were well aware of its defects 
and took precautions to guard against them. 

The first toise copied from the étalon of the Chatelet for scientific 
purposes was that used by Picard in his measurement of a degree of 
the meridian between Paris and Amiens.’ It was made about the 
year 1668, and would doubtless have become the scientific standard 
of France had it not unfortunately disappeared before the degree 
measurements of the eighteenth century were begun. The second 
toise copied from the étalon of the Chatelet for scientific purposes was 
that used by Messrs. Godin, Bouguer, and La Condamine for meas- 
uring the base of their arc of the meridian in Peru. This toise, 
since known as the toise du Pérou, was made by the artist Langlois 
under the immediate direction of Godin in 1735, and is still pre- 
served at the Paris Observatory.’ It is a rectangular bar of polished 
wrought iron, having a breadth of 1°58 English inches and a thick- 
ness of 0°30 of an inch. All the other toises used by the Academy 
in the eighteenth century were compared with it, and, ultimately, it 
was made the legal standard of France by an order of Louis XV, 
dated May 16,1766. As the toise of Peru is the oldest authentic 
copy of the toise of the Chatelet, the effect of this order was simply — 
to perpetuate the earliest known state of that ancient standard. 

The metric system originated from a motion made by Talleyrand 
in the National Assembly of France, in 1790, referring the question 
of the formation of an improved system of weights and measures, 
based upon a natural constant, to the French Academy of Sciences ; 
and the preliminary work was entrusted to five of the most eminent 
members of that Academy—namely, Lagrange, Laplace, Borda, 
Monge, and Condorcet. On March 19, 1791, these gentlemen, to- 
gether with Lalande, presented to the Academy a report contain- 
ing the complete scheme of the metric system. In pursuance of the 
recommendations in that report, the law of March 26, 1791, was 
enacted for the construction of the new system, and the Academy 
of Sciences was charged with the direction of the necessary opera- 
tions. Those requisite for the construction of a standard of length 
were: 


1. The determination of the difference of latitude between Dun- 
kirk and Barcelona. 


15, Art. 4, p. 15. 214, p. 487 and 46, p. C.2. 


LII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


2. The remeasurement of the ancient bases which had served for 
the measurement of a degree at the latitude of Paris, and for mak- 
ing the map of France. 


3. The verification by new observations of the series of triangles 
employed for measuring the meridian, and the prolongation of them 
as far as Barcelona. 


This work was entrusted to Méchain and Delambre, who carried 
it on during the seven years from 1791 to 1798, notwithstanding 
many great difficulties and dangers. The unit of length adopted 
in their operations was the toise of Peru, and from the are of 9° 40’ 
45” actually measured, they inferred the length of an arc of the meri- 
dian extending from the equator to the pole to be 5,130,740 toises. 
As the meter was to be one ten millionth of that distance, its length 
was made 0°5130740 of a toise, or, in the language of the committee, 
443-296 lines of the toise of Peru at a temperature of 15° Reaumur 
(162? Mok G12 Ee 

Before attempting to estimate how accurately the standards we 
have been considering were intercompared it will be well to describe 
briefly the methods by which the comparisons were effected. In 
1742 Graham used the only instruments then known for the pur- 
pose—namely, very exact beam compasses of various kinds, one 
having parallel jaws for taking the lengths of the standard rods, 
another with rounded ends for taking the lengths of the hollow beds, 
and still another having fine points in the usual manner. The 
jaws, or points, of all these instruments were movable by micro- 
meter screws having heads divided to show the eight hundredth 
part of an inch directly, and the tenth of that quantity by estima- 
tion; but Mr. Graham did not consider that the measurements 
could be depended upon to a greater accuracy than one 1600th of 
an inch.’ 

Troughton is generally regarded as the author of the application 
of micrometer microscopes to the comparison of standards of length, 
but the earliest record of their use for that purpose is by Sir George 
Shuckburgh in his work for the improvement of the standards of 
weight and measure in 1796-8. Since then their use has been 
general; first, because they are more accurate than beam compasses, 


119, pp. 432, 438 and 642. 27, pp. 645-6. 918, p. 187. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LIIlI 


and, second, because they avoid the injury to standard scales which 
necessarily results from placing the points of beam compasses upon 
their graduations. As the objective of the microscope forms a mag- 
nified image of the standard, upon which the micrometer wires are 
set by the aid of the eye piece, it is evident that in order to reduce 
the effect of imperfections in the micrometer, the objective should 
have the largest practicable magnifying power. To show the pro- 
gress in that direction the optical constants of the microscopes, by 
means of which some of the most important standards have been 
compared, are given in the accompanying table. 


Wan ui be oe 
3) oe . A o 
CWP Cle Cana E Dr 
Ties wns os 

Observer. = ES ire cas 
re alloy Cesk ooo 
wie | SS Sb sous 
3 2 Bu | ce BES 
3 3 ao aS) aoO8 

a = = cs > 
Inches. | Inches. 
1797 |; Sir Geo. Shuckburgh —.--__=__._ 14 Tat 1.50 | 0-01000 
tein peapt. Henry iater 28 oy ke 18 (aro See ee “00428 
SHSe ee CAM GIseis wily: =o sl ke la Le 27 (2.0) 3 00500 
Bee ree MUL yy. Wy eee ee (Oy fe “00500 
Boom) | We. mmcepsianks <5. es ae (2) | See ae 00358 
TeGenGens Avr. Clarkes, Heo. otuse 60 4. 0.67 00287 
1880 | Prof. W. A. Rogers, 1 in. obj. ---|__-__- LAs 8 ieee ae 00079 
ee ebb ODI. pee (Se.6) Po seoee ls 00035 
Ks a ae ON 2 PE eS (Bae ie ee 00019 
7.5 0.83 | 0:00394 


1888 | International Bureau ___________ 90 


Norr.—The magnifying power of Sir Geo. Shuckburgh’s microscope 
seems to be referred to a distance of twelve inches for distinct vision. The 
powers inclosed in parentheses are estimated upon the assumption that the 
respective micrometer screws had one hundred threads per inch. 


In the memoirs of the French Academy nothing is said respect- 
ing the method adopted by the Academicians for comparing their 
various toises ; but in his astronomy, Lalande states that the com- 
parisons were effected partly by beam compasses, and partly by 
superposing the toises upon each other and examining their ends, 
both by touch and with magnifying glasses; they being all end 
standards.’ For the definitive adjustment of the length of their 


116, p. 8. 


LIV PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


meters, which were also end standards, the French Metric Commis- 
sion used a lever comparator by Lenoir. 

In 1742 Graham used beam compasses, which he considered trust- 
worthy to 0°00062 of an inch, in comparing standards of length ; 
but at that time the French Academicians made their comparisons 
of toises only to one twentieth, or one thirtieth of a line, say 0:00300 
of an inch, and it was not until 1758 that La Condamine declared 
they should be compared to 0°01 of a line, or 000089 of an English 
inch “if our senses aided by the most perfect instruments can attain 
to that.”? Half a century later, ten times that accuracy was attained 
by the lever comparator of Lenoir, which was regarded as trust- 
worthy to 0°000077 of an inch.” 

The heads of micrometer microscopes are usually divided into 
one hundred equal parts, and if we regard one of these parts as the 
least reading of a microscope, then in 1797, Sir George Shuckburgh’s 
microscopes read to one ten thousandth of an inch; and the least 
reading of microscopes made since that date has varied from one 
twenty thousandth to one thirty-five thousandth of an inch. <A few 
investigators, among whom may be mentioned Professor W. A. 
Rogers, of Colby University, have made the least reading of their 
microscopes as small as one 90,000 of an inch, but it is doubtful if 
there is any advantage in so doing. At the present day the errors 
committed in comparing standards arise, not from lack of power in 
the microscopes, but from the difficulty of determining sufficiently 
exactly the temperature of the standard bars, and the effect of flexure 
upon the position of their graduations. In order to ascertain the 
length of a three foot standard with an error not exceeding 0:000020 
of an inch, its temperature must be known to 0:06° F. if it is of brass, 
or to 0°09° F. if it is of iron. To get thermometers that will indicate 
their own temperature to that degree of accuracy is by no means 
easy, but to determine the temperature of a bar from their readings 
is far more difficult. Again, we imagine the length of our standards 
to follow their temperature rigorously, but what proof is there that 
such is the case? If we determine the freezing point of an old ther- 
mometer, then raise it to the temperature of boiling water, and im- 
mediately thereafter again determine its freezing point, we in- 
variably find that the freezing point has fallen a little; and we ex- 
plain this by saying that the glass has taken a set, from which it 


114, p. 483. 2Base du Systéme Métrique. T. 3, pp. 447-462. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LV 


requires time to recover. Is it not probable that an effect similar 
in kind, although less in degree, occurs in all solids when their 
temparature is varying? When we look at the highly polished 
terminals of an end standard, we are apt to regard them as mathe- 
matical surfaces, separated by an interval which is perfectly definite, 
and which could be measured with infinite precision if we only had 
the necessary instrumental appliances; but is that a correct view? 
The atomic theory answers emphatically, No. According to it, all 
matter consists of atoms, or molecules, of a perfectly definite size, 
and with definite intervals between them ; but even if that is denied, 
the evidence is now overwhelming that matter is not homogeneous, 
but possesses a grain of some kind, regularly repeated at intervals 
which cannot be greater than one 2,000,000th nor less than one 400,- 
000,000th ofaninch. Accordingly, we must picture our standard bar 
as a conglomeration of grains of some kind or other, having magni- 
tudes of the order specified, and all in ceaseless motion, the ampli- 
tude of which depends upon the temperature of the bar. To our 
mental vision the polished terminals are therefore like the surface 
of a pot of boiling water, and we recognize that there must be a 
limit to the accuracy with which the interval between them can be 
measured. Asa basis for estimating how near this limit we have 
approached, it will suffice to say that for fifty years past it has been 
customary to state comparisons of standards of length to one 1,000,- 
000th of aninch. “Nevertheless, most authorities agree that although 
one 100,000th of an inch can be distinguished in the comparators, 
one 20,000th of an inch is about the limit of accuracy attainable 
in comparing standards. Possibly such a limit may be reached 
under the most favorable circumstances, but in the case of the yard 
and the meter, which are standard at different temperatures, the 
following values of the meter by observers of the highest repute 
render it doubtful if any thing like that accuracy has yet been at- 
tained. 

1818. Capt. Henry Kater . . . . 389:37079 inches. 

£66.05 Gens At Ro Clarke ty \m)\s204 12 (8937043), | 

1883. Prof. Wm. A. Rogers. . . .- 39°37027 “ 

1885. Gen. C. B. Comstock . . . . 389°36985 “ 


The earliest standard of English weight of which we have any 
very definite knowledge is the mint pound of the Tower of London. 
It weighed 5,400 troy grains, and the coinage was regulated by it 

45 


LVI PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


up to the year 1527, when it was abolished in favor of the troy 
pound of 5,760 grains. Contemporaneously with, the tower pound 
there was also the merchant’s pound, whose exact weight is now in- 
volved in so much doubt that it is impossible to decide whether it 
consisted of 6,750 or of 7,200 grains. The tower pound and the 
troy pound were used for weighing only gold, silver, and drugs, 
while all other commodities were weighed by the merchant’s pound 
until the thirteenth or fourteenth century, and after that by the 
avoirdupois pound. It is not certainly known when the troy and 
avoirdupois pounds were introduced into England, and there is no 
evidence of any relation between them when they first became 
standards. The present avoirdupois pound can be clearly proved 
to be of similar weight to the standard avoirdupois pound of Ed- 
ward III (A. D. 13827-1377), and there is good reason for believing 
that no substantial change has occurred either in its weight or in that 
of the troy pound since their respective establishment as standards 
in England. 

The oldest standard weights now existing in the English archives 
date from the reign of Queen Elizabeth, and consist of a set of bell- 
shaped avoirdupois weights of 56, 28, and 14 pounds, made in 1582 
and 7, 4, 2, and 1 pounds made in 1588; a set of flat circular 
avoirdupois weights of 8, 4, 2, and 1 pounds, and 8, 4, 2, 1, 3, 4, 3, 
and 7's ounces, made in 1588; and aset of cup-shaped troy weights, 
fitting one within the other, of 256, 128, 64, 32, 16, 8, 4, 2,1, 2, 4,% 
(hollow), and 4 (solid) ounces, also made in 1588.’ All these stand- 
ards were constructed by order of Queen Elizabeth, under the di- 
rection of a jury composed of eighteen merchants and eleven gold- 
smiths of London ; the avoirdupois weights being adjusted according 
to an ancient standard of 56 pounds, remaining in the Exchequer 
from the time of Edward III; and the troy weights being adjusted 
according to the ancient standard in Goldsmiths’ Hall.’ 

In view of the fact that the weight mentioned in all the old acts 
of Parliament, from the time of Edward I (A. D. 1274-1307) is 
universally admitted to be troy weight, the Parliamentary Com- 
mittee of 1758, appointed to inquire into the original standards of 
weights and measures in England, recommended that the troy pound 
should be made the unit or standard by which the avoirdupois and 
other weights should be regulated; and by their order three several 


111, p. 430. 211, pp. 485 and 443-448. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LVII 


troy pounds of soft gun-metal were very carefully adjusted under 
the direction of Mr. Joseph Harris, who was then assay master of 
the Mint. To ascertain the proper mass for these pounds the com- 
mittee caused Messrs. Harris and Gregory, of the Mint, to perform 
the following operations in their presence :* 

First.—In the before-mentioned set of troy weights, made in 1588, 
which were then the Exchequer standard, each weight, from that 
of 4 ounces up to that of 256 ounces, was compared successively 
with the sum of all the smaller weights; and by a process for which 
no valid reason can be assigned,’ it was concluded from these weigh- 
ings that the troy pound composed of the 8 and 4 ounce weights 
was 13 grains too light. 

Second.—The aforesaid 8 and 4 ounce weights of the Exchequer 
were compared with five other authoritative troy pounds, four of 
which belonged to the Mint and one to Mr. Freeman, who, like his 
father before him, was scale maker to the mint, and from the mean 
of these weighings it appeared that the sum of the Exchequer 8 and 
4 ounce weights was one grain too light. 

The Committee adopted the mean between the latter result and 
that which they had deduced from the Exchequer weights alone,’ 
and accordingly Mr. Harris made each of his three troy pounds 14 
grains heavier than the sum of the Exchequer 8 and 4 ounce weights; 
but sixty-six years were destined to elapse before Parliament took 
action respecting them. 

The Commissioners appointed in 1818 to establish a more uniform 
system of weights and measures, repeated the recommendations of 
the committee of 1758,° and as the avoirdupois pound which had 
long been used, although not legalized by any act of the legis- 
lature, was very nearly 7,000 troy grains, they recommended that 
7,000 such troy grains be declared to constitute a pound avoirdu- 
pois.* These recommendations were embodied in the act of Parlia- 
ment of June 17, 1824, and thus one of the troy pounds made in 
1758 became the Imperial standard. That standard, like Bird’s 
standard yard, was deposited in the Houses of Parliament and was 
burned up with them in October, 1834. 

The present English standard pound was made in 1844-46 by 
Prof. W. H. Miller, who was one of the members of the Commission 
appointed in 1848 to superintend the construction of the new par- 


111, p. 437. See Note B, below. ‘See 23, 24,and 25. ‘428, pp. 4-5. 


LVIII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


liamentary standards of length and weight destined to replace those 
destroyed in 1834. A number of weights had beem very accurately 
compared with the lost standard; namely, in 1824 or 1825, by 
Capt. Kater, five troy pounds of gun-metal, destined respectively 
for the use of the Exchequer, the Royal Mint, and the cities of 
London, Edinburgh, and Dublin; and in 1829, by Capt. v. Nehus, 
two troy pounds of brass and one of platinum, all in the custody 
of Prof. Schumacher, and a platinum troy pound belonging to the 
Royal Society. The first step for recovering the mass of the lost 
standard was manifestly to compare these weights among themselves, 
and upon so doing it was found that for the brass and gun-metal 
weights the discrepancies between the weighings made in 1824 and 
1844 amounted to 0°0226' of a grain, while for the two platinum 
weights the discrepancies between the weighings made in 1829 and 
1845 was only 0:00019? of a grain. With a single exception, all 
the new brass or gun-metal weights had become heavier since their 
first comparison with the lost standard, the change being probably 
due to oxydation of their surfaces, and on that account the new 
standard was made to depend solely upon the two platinum weights. 
For convenience of reference these weights were designated respec- 
tively Sp (Schumacher’s platinum), and RS (Royal Society). A 
provisional platinum troy pound, T, intermediate in mass between 
Sp and RS was next prepared, and from 286 comparisons made in 
January, February, July, and August, 1845, it was found that in a 
vacuum *® ‘ 

T = Sp+ 0°00105 grain, 
while from 122 comparisons made in January, July, and August, 
1845, 

T = RS — 0:00429 grain. 

By combining these values with the results of the weighings 

made in 1824-29, namely, 

Sp = U — 0°52956 grain, 

RS = U — 0°52441 grain, 
where U designates the lost standard—the comparisons with Sp. 
gave 

T = U — 0°52851 grain, 
while those with RS gave 

T = U — 052870 grain. = 


140, p. 772. 240, p. 941. $40, pp. 819-20, 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LIX 


To the first of these expressions double weight was assigned, be- 
couse the comparisons of T and U with Sp were about twice as 
numerous as those with RS. The resulting mean was therefore 

 T=U — 052857 grains = 575947148 grains, 
and from that value of T the new standard avoirdupois pound of 
7000 grains was constructed. 

From some time in the fifteenth century until the adoption of the 
metric system in August, 1793, the system of weights employed in 
France was the poids de mare, having for its ultimate standard the 
pile de Charlemagne, which was then kept in the Mint, and is now 
deposited in the Conservatoire des Arts et Métiers. The table of 


this weight was 
72 grains = 1 gros = 72 grains. 
8 gros =lonce= 576 “ 
8 onces = 1 marc= 4608 “ 


2 mares = 1 livre= 9216 < 


The origin of the pile de Charlemagne is not certainly known, 
but it is thought to have been made by direction of King John (A. 
D. 1350-1364). It consists of a set of brass cup-weights, fitting 
one within the other, and the whole weighing fifty marcs. The 
nominal and actual weights of the several pieces are as follows:* 


Mares. Grains. 


Boite de 20 mares . 20 + 1:4 
Piécede1l4 “ . 144 45 
de 8 “* 8 — 04 
dani a ie mee Ot], 

PN eines x) esos 120 

rege a ot Bite) OF 
Marc divisé yh: ey ( 
50” =,7.0°0 


In determining the relation of the poids de mare to the metric 
weights, the committee for the construction of the kilogram regarded 
the entire pile de Charlemagne as a standard of fifty marcs, and 
considered the individual pieces as subject to the corrections stated. 
On that basis they found 

1 kilogram = 18827:15 French grains? 
and as a kilogram is equal to 15432'34874° English troy grains, we 


have 
1 livre, poids de mare = 7554°22 troy grains. 
= 489°506 grams. 


417, pp. 270-71. 7 Base du Systéme Métrique. T. 3, p. 638. 340, p. 898. 


LX PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The metric standard of weight, called a kilogram, was constructed 
under the direction of the French Academy of Sciences simulta- 
neously with the meter; the work being done principally by Lefévre- 
Gineau and Borda. It was intended that the kilogram should have 
the same mass as a cubic decimeter of pure water at maximum 
density, and the experimental determination of that mass was made 
by finding the difference of weight in air and in water of a hollow 
brass cylinder whose exterior dimensions at a temperature of 17°6° 
C. were, height = 2'437672 decimeters, diameter = 2°428568 deci- 
meters, volume = 11°2900054 cubic decimeters. The difference of 
weight in question was first measured in terms of certain brass 
weights, by the aid of which the platinum kilogram of the archives 
was subsequently constructed, special care being taken to apply the 
corrections necessary to reduce all the weighings to what they 
would have been if made in a vacuum.’ 

The best results hitherto obtained for the weight of a cubic deci- 
meter of water, expressed in terms of the kilogram of the archives, 
are as follows :? 


Weight of 
a cubic 
Date. Country. Observer. decimeter 
of water | 
at 4° C. 
Grams. 
1795 ....-| France_._-- Leféyre-Ginea- 24. 2 soe 1000-000 
797 _- 
England ---| Shuckburgh and Kater __--_-_____-__- 1000-480 
1821_- 
1825____] Sweden -__-| Berzelius, Svanberg, and Akermann-_-_-| 1000-296 
1880.-22)), Austria's, 5) Siampien. 220562 ce eel ee 999-653 
184ic.2*| Russia's ON Koper ee Seo ie eee 999-989 
AMean_\. oY OU 1000-084 


1 Base du Systéme Métrique, T. 8, pp. 574-5. 
2 This table has been deduced from the data given by Prof, Miller in 40, 
p- 760. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LXI 


These results show the extreme difficulty of determining the exact 
mass of a given volume of water. The discordance between the 
different observers amounts to more than one part in a thousand, 
while good weighings are exact to one part in eight or ten millions. 
Without doubt two weights can be compared at least a thousand 
times more accurately than either of them can be reproduced by 
weighing a specified volume of water, and for that reason the kilo- 
gram, like the English pound, can now be regarded only as an ar- 
bitrary standard of which copies must be taken by direct compari- 
son. As already stated, the kilogram is equivalent to 15432°54874 
English troy grains, or about two pounds three ounces avoirdupois. 

In consequence of the circumstance that the mass of a body is not 
affected either by temperature or flexure, weighing is an easier pro- 
cess than measuring ; but in order to obtain precise results many 
precautions are necessary. Imagine a balance with a block of wood 
tied to its right-hand pan and accurately counterpoised by lead 
weights in its left-hand pan. If with things so arranged the bal- 
ance were immersed in water the equilibrium would be instantly 
destroyed and to restore it all the weights would have to be re- 
moved from the left-hand pan, and some of them would have to be 
placed in the right-hand pan to overcome the buoyancy of the wood. 
The atmosphere behaves precisely as the water does, and although 
its effect is minute enough to be neglected in ordinary business 
affairs, it must be taken into account when scientific accuracy is 
desired. To that end the weighing must either be made in a vacuum, 
or the difference of the buoyant effect of the air upon the substances 
in the two pans must be computed and allowed for. As very few 
vacuum balances exist, the latter method is usually employed. The 
data necessary for the computation are the latitude of the place 
where the weighing is made and its altitude above the sea level; 
the weights, specific gravities, and coefficients of expansion of each 
of the substances in the two pans; the temperature of the air, its 
barometric pressure, and the pressure, both of the aqueous vapor, 
and of the carbonic anhydride, contained in it. 

Judging from the adjustment of the pile de Charlemagne, and 
the Exchequer troy weights of Queen Elizabeth, the accuracy at- 
tained in weighing gold and silver at the mints during the four- 
teenth, fifteenth, and sixteenth centuries must have been about one 
part in ten thousand. The balance which Mr. Harris of the Lon- 


LXII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


don mint used in 1743 indicated one-eighth of a grain on a troy 
pound, or about one part in 50,000; while according to Sir George 
Shuckburgh the balance used by Messrs. Harris and Bird in mak- 
ing their observations upon the Exchequer weights, apparently in 
1758 or 1759, turned with one 230,000th part of its load. In 1798 
Sir George Shuckburgh had a balance sensitive enough to indicate 
0:01 of a grain when loaded with 16,000 grains, or about one part 
in 1,600,000. The balance used by Fortin in 1799, in adjusting 
the kilogram of the archives, was not quite so delicate, its sensi- 
tiveness being only the 1,000,000th part of its load; but in 1844, 
for the adjustment of the present English standard pound, Professor 
Miller employed a balance whose index moved about 0°01 of an 
inch for a change of 0°002 of a grain in a load of 7,000 grains” He 
read the index with a microscope, and found the probable error of 
a single comparison of two avoirdupois pounds to be one 12,000,000th 
of either, or about 0:00058 of a grain. At the present time it is 
claimed that two avoirdupois pounds can be compared with an 
error not exceeding 0°0002 of a grain; and two kilograms with an 
error not exceeding 0°02 of a milligram. 

The mean solar day is the natural unit of time for the human 
race, and it is universally adopted among all civilized nations. 
Our ultimate standard of time is therefore the rotation of the earth 
upon its axis, and from that rotation we determine the errors of our 
clocks and watches by astronomical observations. For many pur- 
poses it suffices to make these observations upon the sun, but when 
the utmost precision is desired it is better to make them on the 
stars. Until the close of the seventeenth century quadrants were 
employed for that purpose, and so late as 1680 Flamsteed, the first 
English astronomer royal, thought himself fortunate when he suc- 
ceeded in constructing one which enabled him to be sure of his ob- 
served times within three seconds.’ About 1690 Roemer invented 
the transit instrument, which soon superseded the quadrant, and 
still remains the best appliance for determining time Most of his 
observations were destroyed by a fire in 1728, but the few which 
have come down to us show that as early as 1706 he determined 
time with an accuracy which has not yet been very greatly sur- 


118, p. 148. 240, pp. 762 and 943. 
8 Account of the Rev. John Flamsteed. By Francis Baily. pp. 45-6. 
(London, 1835. 4to.) 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LXIIl1 . 


passed. Probably the corrections found in the least square adjust- 
ment of extensive systems of longitude determinations afford the 
best criterion for estimating the accuracy of first-class modern time 
observations, and from them it appears that the error of such ob- 
servations may rise as high as + 0°05 of a second. 

During the intervals between successive observations of the 
heavenly bodies we necessarily depend upon clocks and chronom- 
eters for our knowledge of the time, and very erroneous ideas are 
frequently entertained respecting the accuracy of their running. 
The subject is one upon which it is difficult to obtain exact infor- 
mation, but there are few time-pieces which will run for a week 
without varying more than three-quarters of a second from their 
predicted error. As the number of seconds in a week is 604,800, 
this amounts to saying that the best time-pieces can be trusted to 
measure a week within one part in 756,000. Nevertheless, clocks 
and chronometers are but adjuncts to our chief time-piece, which is 
the earth itself, and upon the constancy of its rotation depends the 
preservation of our present unit of time. Early in this century 
Laplace and Poisson were believed to have proved that the length 
of the siderial day had not changed by so much as the one hun- 
dredth part of a second during the last 2,500 years, but later inves- 
tigations show that they were mistaken, and, so far as we can now 
see, the friction produced by the tides in the ocean must be steadily 
reducing the velocity with which the earth rotates about its axis. 
The change is too slow to become sensible within the lifetime of a 
human being, but its ultimate consequences will be most momentous. 

Ages ago it was remarked that all things run in cycles, and there 
is enough truth in the saying to make it as applicable now as on the 
day it was uttered. The Babylonian or Chaldean system of weights 
and measures seems to be the original from which the Egyptian 
system was derived, and is probably the most ancient of which we 
have any knowledge. Its unit of length was the cubit, of which 
there were two varieties, the natural and the royal. The foot was 
two-thirds of the natural cubit. Respecting the earliest Chaldean 
and Egyptian system of weights no very satisfactory information 
exists, but the best authorities agree that the weight of water con- 
tained in the measure of a cubic foot constituted the talent, or larger 
unit of weight, and that the sixtieth or fiftieth parts of the talent 
constituted, respectively, the Chaldean and Egyptian values of the 
mina, or lesser unit of commercial weight. Doubtless these weights 


LXIV PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


varied considerably at different times and places, just as the modern 
pound has varied, but the relations stated are belfeved to have been 
the original ones. The ancient Chaldeans used not only the decimal 
system of notation, which is evidently the primitive one, but also a 
duodecimal system, as shown by the division of the year into twelve 
months, the equinoctial day and night each into twelve hours, the 
zodiac into twelve signs, etc., and a sexagesimal system by which 
the hour was divided into sixty minutes, the signs of the zodiac into 
thirty parts or degrees, and the circle into 360 degrees, with further 
sexagesimal subdivisions. The duodecimal and sexagesimal systems 
seem to have originated with the Chaldean astronomers, who, for 
some reason which is not now evident, preferred them to the decimal 
system, and by the weight of their scientific authority impressed 
them upon their system of weights and measures. Now observe how 
closely the scientific thought of to-day repeats the scientific thought 
of four thousand years ago. These old Chaldeans took from the 
human body what they regarded as a suitable unit of length, and 
for their unit of mass they adopted a cube of water bearing simple 
relations to their unit of length. Four thousand years later, when 
these simple relations had been forgotten and impaired, some of the 
most eminent scientists of the last century again undertook the 
task of constructing a system of weights and measures. With them 
the duodecimal and sexagesimal systems were out of favor, while 
the decimal system was highly fashionable, and for that reason they 
subdivided their units decimally instead of duodecimally, sexagesi- 
mally, or by powers of two; but they reverted to the old Chaldean 
device for obtaining simple relations between their units of length 
and mass, and to that fact alone the French metric system owes its sur- 
vival. Every one now knows that the meter is not the ten millionth 
part of a quadrant of the earth’s meridian, and in mathematical 
physics, where the numbers are all so complicated that they can 
only be dealt with by the aid of logarithms, and the constant =, an 
utterly irrational quantity, crops up in almost every integral, mere 
decimal subdivision of the units counts for very little. But in 
some departments of science, as, for example, chemistry, a simple 
relation between the unit of length (which determines volume), the 
unit of mass, and the unit of specific gravity, is of prime impor- 
tance; and wherever that is the case the metric system»will be used. 
To engineers such relations are of small moment, and consequently 
among English-speaking engineers the metric system is making no 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LXV 


progress, while, on the other hand, the chemists have eagerly 
adopted it. As the English yard and pound are the direct descend- 
ants of the Chaldean-Babylonian natural cubit and mina, it is not 
surprising that the yard should be only 0°48 of an inch shorter 
than the double cubit, and the avoirdupois pound only 665 grains 
lighter than the Babylonian commercial mina; but, considering the 
origin of the metric system, it is rather curious that the meter is 
only 1:97 inches shorter than the Chaldean double royal cubit, and 
the kilogram only 102 grains heavier than the Babylonian royal 
mina. Thus, without much exaggeration, we may regard the pres- 
ent English and French fundamental units of length and mass as 
representing respectively the commercial and royal units of length 
and mass of the Chaldeans of four thousands years ago. 

Science tells us that the energy of the solar system is being slowly 
dissipated in the form of radiant heat; that ultimately the sun will 
grow dim; life will die out on the planets; one by one they will 
tumble into the expiring sun; and at last darkness and the bitter 
cold of the absolute zero will reign over all. In that far-distant 
future imagine some wandering human spirit to have penetrated to 
a part of space immeasurably beyond the range of our most pow- 
erful telescopes, and there, upon an orb where the mechanical arts 
flourish as they do here, let him be asked to reproduce the standards 
of length, mass, and time with which we are now familiar. In the 
presence of such a demand the science of the seventeenth and eight- 
eenth centuries would be powerless. The spin of the earth which 
measures our days and nights would be irretrievably gone; our yards, 
our meters, our pounds, our kilograms would have tumbled with the 
earth into the ruins of the sun, and become part of the debris of the 
solar system. Could they be recovered from the dead past and live 
again? The science of all previous ages mournfully answers, No; 
but with the science of the nineteenth century it is otherwise. The 
spectroscope has taught us that throughout the visible universe the 
constitution of matter is the same. Everywhere the rythmic motions 
of the atoms are absolutely identical, and to them, and the light 
which they emit, our wandering spirit would turn for the recovery 
of the long-lost standards. By means of a diffraction grating and 
an accurate goniometer he could recover the yard from the wave 
length of sodium light with an error not exceeding one or two thou- 
sandths of an inch. Water is everywhere, and with his newly re- 


LXVI PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


covered yard he could measure a cubic foot of it, and thus recover 
the standard of mass which we call a pound. ‘The recovery of our 
standard of time would be more difficult; but even that could be 
accomplished with an error not exceeding half a minute in a day. 
One way would be to perform Michelson’s modification of Foucault’s 
experiment for determining the velocity of light. Another way 
would be to make a Siemen’s mercury unit of electrical resistance, 
and then, either by the British Association method or by Lord 
Rayleigh’s modification of Lorenz’s method, find the velocity which 
measures its resistance in absolute units. Still another way would 
be to find the ratio of the electro-static and electro-magnetic units 
of electricity. Thus all the units now used in transacting the world’s 
business could be made to reappear, if not with scientific, at least 
with commercial accuracy, on the other side of an abyss of time and 
space before which the human mind shrinks back in dismay. The 
science of the eighteenth century sought to render itself immortal 
by basing its standard units upon the solid earth, but the science of 
the nineteenth century soars far beyond the solar system and con- 
nects its units with the ultimate atoms which constitute the universe 
itself. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LXVII 


NOTE A. 


The appended table exhibits the principal comparisons hitherto 
made of the more important early English standards of length. 
The significations of the reference numbers, and the authorities for 
the descriptions of the standards, are as follows: 


No. 1. Standard yard of Henry VII (1490); an end measure 
formed of an octagonal brass rod half an inch in diameter. 


No. 2. Standard yard of Queen Elizabeth (1588); an end meas- 
ure formed of a brass rod six-tenths of an inch square. 


No. 3. Matrix to Queen Elizabeth’s standard yard (1588); of 
brass, 14 inches wide, 1 inch thick, and 49 inches long. 

No. 4. Standerd ell of Queen Elizabeth (1588); an end meas- 
ure of brass, six-tenths of an inch square. 

No. 5. Standard yard of the Clock-makers’ Company (1671); a 
matrix, formed by two pins in an octagonal brass rod half an inch 
in diameter. 

No. 6. Standard yard at the Tower; a line measure, marked on 
a brass bar seven-tenths of an inch square and 41 inches long. 


No. 7. Graham’s Royal Society scale (1742); a line measure, 
on a brass bar half an inch wide, one-quarter of an inch thick, and 
42 inches long. ‘Line marked E. Mem. Roy. Ast.Soc., Vol.9, p.82. 


No. 8. Ditto. Line marked Exch. 
No. 9. Ditto. Paris half toise; marked F. 


Numbers 1 to 9 are described in the Philosophical Transactions, 
1743, pp. 647-550. 


No. 10. Bird’s standard yard of 1758; a line measure, on a 
brass bar 1:01 inches square, and 39:06 inches long. Mem. Roy. 
Ast. Soe., Vol. 9, p. 80. 

No. 11. Bird’s standard yard of 1760; a line measure, on a 


brass bar 1°05 inches square, and 39°73 inches long. Mem. Roy. 
Ast. Soc., Vol. 9, pp. 80-82. 


No. 12. General Roy’s scale; a line measure, upon a brass bar 
0°55 of an inch broad, about 0°22 of an inch thick, and 42°8 inches 


LXVIII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


long; divided by Bird. Phil. Trans., 1785, p. 401, and Measure- 
ment of Lough Foyle Base, p. 73. ’ 


No. 18. Ramsden’s bar, used in the trigonometrical survey of 
Great Britain. Phil. Trans., 1821, p. 91; and Measurement of 
Lough Foyle Base, pp. 73-4. 


No. 14. Sir Geo. Shuckburgh’s scale (1796); a line measure, 
upon a brass bar 1°4 inches broad, 0°42 of an inch thick, and 67-7 
inches long. Space compared, 0 to 36". Phil. Trans., 1798, p. 
133, and Mem. Roy. Ast. Soc., Vol. 9, pp. 84-5. 


No. 15. Ditto. Space compared, 10 to 46". 


No. 16. Ordnance yard 1A (1827); a line measure, upon an 
iron bar 1°45 inches broad, 2°5 inches deep, and rather more than 
3 feet long. Measurement of Lough Foyle Base, pp. 71, 82 and [28]. 


No. 17. Ordnance yard 2A (1827). Similar to 1A. Same 
authorities. 


No. 18. Captain Kater’s Royal Society yard (1831); a line 
measure, upon a brass plate 0°07 of an inch thick. Phil. Trans., 
1831, p. 345. 


No. 19. The Royal Astronomical Society’s standard scale (1834) ; 
a line measure, upon a brass tube 1°12 inches exterior diameter, 
0°74 of an inch interior diameter, and 63 inches long. The central 
yard was the space compared. Mem. Roy. Ast. Soc., Vol. 9, p. 69. 


No. 20. “Col. Lambton’s standard;” a line measure, upon a 
brass plate 0°92 of an inch broad, 0°21 of an inch thick, and 66} 
inches long; strengthened by an edge bar of nearly the same breadth, 
but only 0°08 of an inch thick. Phil. Trans., 1821, p. 88, and Mem. 
Roy. Ast. Soc., Vol. 9, pp. 82-3. 


The authorities for the comparisons given in the various columns 
of the table are as follows: 


Column A.—Comparisons by Mr. George Graham. Phil. Trans., 
17438, pp. 187, and 547-550. 


Column B.—Comparisons by Sir Geo. Shuckburgh. Phil. Trans., 
1798, pp. 167-181. 


Column C.—Comparisons by Capt. Kater. Phil. Trans., 1818, 
p. 55, and 1821, p. 91. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LXIxX 


Column D.—Comparisons by Capt. Kater. Phil. Trans., 1830, 
p. 377, and 1831, p. 347. 


Column E.—Comparisons by Francis Baily, Esq. Mem. Roy. 
Ast. Soc., Vol. 9, p. 145. 


-Column F.—Comporisons by Francis Baily, Esq. Mem. Roy. 
Ast. Soc., Vol. 9, p. 120. 


Column G.—Values adopted by R. Sheepshanks, Esq. Phil. - 
Trans., 1857, p. 661. 


The values used by Mr. Sheepshanks in 1848 to determine the 
length of the present Imperial standard yard were Nos. 14 D, 15 F, 
16 and 17 G, and 18 D. 

It will be observed that several different units are employed in 
the various columns of the table, and care must be taken to allow 
for that circumstance when comparing numbers not situated in the 
same column. 


Comparisons of the Fundamental English Standards of Length. 


oo on B. c. D. E. F. G. 
No. 
Inches. Inches. Inches. Inches. Inches. Inches. Inches. 
Dicaaas 35°9929 35°966 
beers 36°0000 35°993 
= haere 36'0102 
4...... 45°0494 44.964 
Beavaes 35°9790 
acres 36°0111 
vhayres 86°0075 36°0013 SGO:002007, \alsancocvnnsancssede 36°001473 
Sovak 36°0000 SOD diel [baasasvicnascieses|casncsvavedasscnns 35993684 
Dessute 38°355 38°3561 
ELDe gues | cadukuseeceseveces 36°00023 | 36°000802 
iE acetal caacyetle |ccieweses|cvccnseacenonaee 36.000659 367000000 35°999624 36°000000 36.060000 
Peeent ola scavensencelssske|acecarecsnasspaace 36°001537 
Dore cas|acussustuesvcescse|\sussctantocdwcnen 36°003147 
Dae ccct|-peoneselenetpescs|cesaseveapcatbens« 36°000642 36°00009 36000185 
tera celieesadsccssucasecs oO OUU IN feasicredicnceessus| sete vcacssceunres 35°999921 36°000058 
Pi Gyecadeal seeeatvets rettacks| sxccaviassearsnseat|bacdzancnsrescvasn|Shedaccraviccnesds|accuctarscoscccwes|caseua sueetacruce 35°999716 


Dilisvansal sevaatecensesdesds|yseccvsvncceccvusve|suscud hocsececooss Hediesstivenesisantue| aebacedesteaccoewa| saateneamas conse 35°999892 


LXx PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON, 


NOTE B. 


By direction of the Parliamentary Committee of 1758, and in 
the presence both of that body and of Mr. Farley, deputy chamber- 
lain, Messrs. Harris and Gregory of the London Mint compared 
the several standard troy weights of the Exchequer, with the fol- 
lowing results : 


4-02. weight = All smaller weights — + grain. 


sO zs cA ye tess +3 * 
Le-oz.,  & == ' aed gt 
82-02. f= i + 2 grains. 
64025, ‘=m a +3 « 

128-02. “ = rf +14 * 
256-02. “ = ‘ —21 “ 


The weighings which yielded these results were made at the Lon- 
don Mint; the instruments employed being “a very curious and 
exact pair of scales, belonging to Mr. Harris, and the scales used 
at the Mint for the weighing of gold.” After recording the results. 
in their report,’ the Committee continued as follows: 


“Therefore beginning the difference from the sixteen-ounce weight, ond 
corrying it on to the greatest troy weight in the Exchequer, the total differ- 
ence will be eight grains and one-half.” 

“The fourth part of which is two grains upon sixteen ounces, which is a 
grain and a half upon the twelve ounces or pound troy.” 

‘Then the eight and four ounces troy of the Exchequer were compared. 
with the following weights: ”’ 


“ First, with the pound troy used at the Mint in weighing of gold, which 
was heavier than that at the Exchequer one grain.” 

‘« Secondly, with the eight and four ounces at the Mint of the 6th of 
Queen Anne, 1707, which was heavier than that at the Exchequer half a 
grain.” 

‘The eight and four ounces of Queen Elizabeth 1588 at the Mint, was 
heavier than that at the Exchequer three quarters of a grain; another of 
the same year of Queen Elizabeth at the Mint, stampt with a tower, a 
thistle and crown, and EL and crown, was heavier than that at the Ex- 


chequer one grain.” 


+ ALY, p..437. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LXXI 


‘Mr. Freeman produced a four and eight ounce of the 6th of Queen 
Anne 1707 by which he makes weights for sale, which was heavier than 
the same weights at the Exchequer one grain and three quarters: There- 
fore, upon an average of all these weights, the pound troy should be one 
grain heavier than the weights at the Exchequer, and that added to the 
grain and a half, which, upon the former experiments, the weights at the 
Exchequer are too light a medium taken from thence makes the proper 
increase of the Exchequer pound troy to be one grain and one quarter.” 

‘« And it is to be observed, that the pound troy weight at the Mint, which 
is now used for gold, and the eight and four ounces at the Mint, marked 
with a tower, and in the time of Queen Elizabeth, are both one grain 
heavier than the eight and four ounces of the Exchequer.”’ 

‘« And considering that the Exchequer weights have been used ever since 
the 30th of Queen Hlizabeth, 1588, one hundred and seventy years to size 
other weights by, it is highly probable that the difference may have been 
occasioned by the frequent use of the standard.”’ 

‘‘ Your Committee endeavored to compare the trey weights with the 
original standard at Goldsmith’s Hall, from whence it is said, in the afore- 
said verdict of the 29th and 30th of Elizadeth, that the weights now at the 
Exchequer were made, and for that purpose sent to Goldsmith’s Hall for 
the said weights; but were informed that no such were to be found there, 
the Goldsmith’s having no weights older than those at the Exchequer; ”’ 


The Committee’s statement respecting the way in which the cor- 
rection of 1% grains was deduced from the weighings of the Ex- 
chequer weights is very obscure, and the result is not justified by 
generally accepted principles. If we put x for the sum of all the 
weights smaller than 4 ounces, then the results of the weighings 
made by the Committee may be written in the form: 


4-oz. divided = 12 


4-oz. weight = 1la— } grain. 
8-0z. weight = 22+ 4 grain. 
16-0z. weight = 42+ } grain. 
32-0z. weight = 8% + 2% grains. (1) 


64-0z. weight = 16 x + 5% grains. 
128-0z. weight = 32 2 + 22 grains. 
256-02. weight = 642+ 9 grains. 


Before proceeding further we must decide in what sense these 
weights are to be regarded as standards, and perhaps the most 
natural course will be to regard the entire set as a standard of 512 


46 


LXXII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


troy ounces. In that case the summation of the several columns 
gives 
512 ounces = 128 x + 39 grains” 

whence 

x = 4 ounces — 0°3047 grain (2) 
and by substituting that value in the equations (1) we obtain the 
corrections to the several weights given in the second column of 
Table I. 


TABLE I.—Oorrections to the Exchequer Standard Troy Weights of 1588, 
derived from the Weighings made by Messrs. Harris and Chisholm. 


Denomination Apparent |Committee’s} Chisholm’s Loss by 

of correction | correction | correction | wear in 115 
Weight. in 1758. in 1758. in 1873. years. 

Grains. Grains. Grains. 
4 ounces divided__| — 0°30 — 0-42 — 1:27 
aigunees’. =. 55 “67 0-01 
SiOUNCES; saa === 136 0:58 0-51 
DGrounces*<="= 52202 “97 1-42 2'42 
SAOUMCRS = ee — 0-19 1:08 2:74 
64ounces' 221422225 + 0°62 — 1:17 3°87 
128 ounces -.----..-- + 12-25 + 8:67 4:39 
256,0unces === -e- — 10:50 — 17°67 — 35:91 
Sums) sees ae + 0:00 — 14°34 — 51:12 


From equations (1) and (2) we have 

4 ounces = 4-oz. weight + 0°5547 grain. 

8 ounces = 8-0z. weight + 0°3594 grain. 
whence it follows that the sum of the eight and four ounce weights, 
which constituted the Exchequer standard troy pound, was too light 
by 0°9141 of a grain. As the mean correction obtained from the 
four weights belonging respectively to the Mint and to Mr. Free- 
man agrees closely with this result, the true correction to the Ex- 
chequer standard must have been very approximately one grain; 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LXXIII 


and in adopting one and one-quarter grains the Committee seem to 
have augmented the weight of the troy pound by about one-quarter 
ofa grain. The corrections which result to the Exchequer troy 
weights upon the Committee’s assumption that the sum of the eight 
and four ounce weights was one and one-quarter grains too light 
are given in the third column of Table I; while the fourth column 
contains the corrections found by Mr. Chisholm in 1873,’ and the 
fifth column shows the loss of weight which occurred between 1758 
and 1873. In view of the fact that these weights were constantly 
used for comparing local standards during a period of no less than 
225 years, from 1588 to 1825, their excellent preservation is very 
remarkable. 

In the report of the Committee of 1758 there is another set of 
comparisons of the Exchequer troy weights;? said comparisons 
having been made on April 14, 1758, in accordance with the di- 
rections of the Committee, by Mr. Freeman and Mr. Reed, expert 
scale makers, in the presence of Mr. Farley, deputy chamberlain, 
They are as follows: 


$-oz. hollow = 4-oz. solid + 4 grain. 
t-oz. weight = All smaller weights — 4 grain. 


3-02. “ pau “c v2.4 4 “ 
[Ca Sy —} * 
9-072. “ poe 6 ae “ 
402, “ = 5 + 0 grains. 
8-02, “ = te ce | a i 
16-oz. se = ss +0 “c 
s2-o7, SS : “ sgh. fiat 
64-02. “e = sc +0 “ 
12007, 08 = ae +15 “ 
256-0z,. “ = - —24 *“ 


In these equations the symbol + 0 is used to indicate the relation 
which the Committee expressed by saying that the weights “very 
nearly agreed.” 

Regarding the entire set of weights as a standard of 512 ounces, 
and putting x for the mass of the 4-oz. solid weight, we have 

$-oz. solid = Ia. 
$-oz. hollow = 12 -+ 3 grain. 


143, p. 21. 711, p. 435. 


LXXIV PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


}-oz. weight = 2a. 
MOR Hip tee Ax. ° 
1S 8x. 
DOS. Faso, 1k 
4oz, “ = 32¢-+ 3 grain. (8) 
POOL) cee Sty, OME rete ee 
16-oz. “ = 128%- 2 grains. 
32-02. °) 0" SS Zobs so 
i ei ——TANE EY fe eS a 
128-07. 0" | = 1024¢--27 
256-02..." » == 20468 --1b 


Summing the various columns 
512 ounces = 40962 + 54 grains 


whence 
x = t ounce — 0°01318 grains, (4) 


and by substituting that value in the equations (8) we obtain the 
corrections given for the several weights in the second column of 
Table If. The third column contains the corrections which result 
upon the Committee’s assumption that the sum of the eight and four 
ounce weights was one and one-quarter grains too light; and the 
fourth and fifth colums contain corrections given by Mr. Chisholm 
in his seventh annual report.’ Mr. Chisholm does not explain how he 
obtained the corrections quoted in the fourth column of the table, but 
their close agreement with those in the third column renders it 
almost certain that they were computed from the comparisons made 
by Messrs. Freeman and Reed. As the Committee of 1758 used 
Mr. Harris’ weighings to the exclusion of those by Messrs. Freeman 
and Reed, the adoption of the opposite course by Mr. Chisholm is 
perhaps explained by the circumstance that in his report on the 
Exchequer standards’ he has quoted the weighings by Messrs. Free- 
man and Reed and has attributed them to Mr. Harris. 

In addition to being less exact, the weighings by Mr. Freeman 
differ from those by Mr. Harris principally in the sign of the cor- 
rection to the 32-ounce weight ; the former stating that the 32-ounce 
weight was lighter than the sum of all the smaller weights, and the 
latter that it was heavier. To ascertain which was right we have 


148, p. 21. 748, p. 11. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LXXV 


only to compare the resulting systems of corrections with those found 
by Mr. Chisholm in 1873. Table I shows that according to Mr. 
Harris’ weighings all the weights have grown lighter during the in- 
terval from 1758 to 1873, while Table II shows that according to 
Mr. Freeman’s weighings some have grown lighter and others heavier, 
and that by quantities which cannot be attributed to accidental 
errors in the weighings. In view of these facts there cannot be a 
doubt that the Committee of 1758 was right in using only Mr. 
Harris’ weighings, and it seems equally certain that the numbers in 
Table I should be adopted to the exclusion of those in Table II. 


TaBLE II.—Corrections to the Exchequer Standard Troy Weights of 1588, 
derived from the Weighings made by Messrs. Freeman and Chisholm. 


Denomination Apparent | Committee’s Corrections given by 
of correction | correction Mr. Chisholm 

Weight. in 1758. in 1758 in 1758. in 1873. 

Grains. Grains. Grains. Grains. 
$ ounce solid ____- — 0-01 — 0°03 0-0 — 0:06 
4 ounce hollow ---| + 0°49 + 0-47 + 05. + 0:40 
2 ounce 2.2 a — 0-08 — 0-06 ‘0 — 0-21 
2 OUNCE Sin 502% 05 Tii! ‘0 36 
ronmour 2 os82 oo. “lt 23 0-0 0-45 
2 ounces 2. — 0-21 46 — 10 1:01 
4 ounces ~---_--~_-_ + 0:08 42 0-5 0:68 
Siounces) 22023225 16 0-83 0-75 — 1:09 
16 ounces --------- + 0-31 1:68 1-75 3°84 
Sa Ounces 2... =.= — 1°38 5°36 5:5 3°82 
G4, ounces) 222) == — 0°75 BG ate. ioe — 5:04 
128) ounces" 222 + 13-50 2-40 + 30 + 4:28 
ZD0).OUNCES = 225s — 12-00 — 43°81 — 45:0 — 53°58 


EAS aes at + 0-00 -— 63°62 — 61:0 — 65°46 


LXXVI PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


From comparisons of their troy pound with their avoirdupois 
pound, and with the two-mare weight sent to them by the French 
Academy in 1742, the Royal Society of London found’— 


_ 1. That the English avoirdupois pound weighed 7,004 troy grains; 

2. That the French livre, consisting of two marcs, weighed 7,560 
troy grains ; 
and for three-quarters of a century the latter value was universally 
accepted. Further, when the metric system came into being, the 
kilogram was declared to consist of 18,827°15 French grains, of 
which the livre contained 9216’; or, in other words, the kilogram 
was declared equal to 2'04288 livres; whence, with the Royal So- 
ciety’s value of the livre, the English equivalent of the kilogram was 
computed to be 15,444 troy grains. 

During some experiments at the London Mint in March, 1820, 
it was found that the French livre belonging to that institution 
weighed only 7555 troy grains. This discovery led to an examina- 
tion of the Royal Society’s standards of 1742, which had been care- 
fully preserved, and it was found that their livre agreed with that 
at the Mint, but their troy pound was nearly four grains lighter 
than the Imperial standard of 1758, and their avoirdupois pound 
weighed only 7000 troy grains instead of 7004.° Thus it was rendered 
almost certain that the accepted English equivalent of the kilogram 
was about ten grains too large, and to remove all possible doubt, 
a direct comparison of the English and French standards of weight 
was effected in 1821*, through the co-operation of the respective 
governments, and then it was definitively ascertained that the weight 
of the kilogram is only 15,435 troy grains. 


The facts respecting the Royal Society’s standards of 1742 are 
as follows: 


1. The weighings recorded in the Philosophical Transactions, 
1743, pages 553 and 556, give 


16, p. 187. It is usual to designate 1742 as the date of the exchange of 
standards, but the remark of Cassini de Thury (4, p. 135) shows that the 
true date must have been prior to April, 1738. In his paper of November, 
1742, Graham makes only the indefinite statement that the exchange was 
‘« proposed some time since.’’ . 

2Base du Systéme Métrique, T. 3, p. 638. 

3See 36, Vol. 1, p. 140, and 28, p. 19. #28, pp. 19-22. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LXXVII 


R. 8. troy lb. = Exch. (8 0z. + 4 02.) — 4 grain. (5) 

R. 8. troy lb. = Mint (8 oz. + 402.) — 23 grains. (6) 
whence 

Exch. (8 oz. + 4 oz.) = Mint (8 oz. + 4 oz.) — 1% grains. (7) 


2. The weighings by Mr. Harris, for the Parliamentary Com- 
mittee of 1758, give’ 


Exch. (8 oz. + 4 oz.) = Mint (8 oz. + 4 0z.) — 4 grain. (8) 
whence, by (6), 
R.S. troy lb. = Exch. (8 oz. + 4 0z.) — 1% grains. (9) 


In equations (6) and (8) the weights at the Mint were those of 
the sixth of Queen Anne, 1707. 


3. In the Philosophical Transactions, 1742, page 187, it is stated 
that the Paris two-marc weight weighs 7560 troy grains. As the 
true weight of two marcs is 755422 grains, this implies that the 
Royal Society’s troy pound was too light by 5°78 (5760 ~ 7560) = 
4:40 grains. 

In the Philosophical Transactions, 1742, page 187, it is stated 
that the Royal Society’s avoirdupois pound weighed 7004 troy 
grains, while the comparisons made in 1820 show that its weight 
was then only 7000 such grains. This implies that the Royal So- 
ciety’s troy pound was too light by 400 (5760 ~ 7000) = 3:29 
grains. 

Finally, the comparisons of 1820 showed that the Royal Society’s 
troy pound was “nearly four grains too light.” 

The mean of these three independent results shows that the Royal 
Society’s troy pound was 3°9 grains lighter than the Imperial 
standard of 1758; whence 


R. S. troy Ib. + 3°9 grains = Standard of 1758 (10) 
but 
Standard of 1758 = Exch. (8 oz. + 4 oz.) + 14 grains (11) 


and therefore 
R. S. troy Ib. = Exch. (8 oz. + 4 oz.) — 2% grains. (12) 


Considering the indefiniteness of the data respecting the weigh- 


111, p. 487. 


LXXVIII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ings made in 1820, equations (9) and (12) agree fairly well, but 
equation (5) is very discordant, as are also equations (7) and (8). 
All the evidence seems to point to an error of about one and one 
half grains in equation (5); and if instead of (5) we write ( 
R. S. Troy lb. = Exch. (8 0z. + 4 0z.) — 2 grains (5’) 

(7) will become 

Exch. (8 oz. + 4 0z.) = Mint (8 oz. + 4 oz.) — # grain (7’) 
and then all the equations will be reasonably accordant. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LXXIX 


LIST OF THE PRINCIPAL AUTHORITIES CONSULTED IN 
THE PREPARATION OF THE FOREGOING ADDRESS. 


Norz.—The abbreviation “EH. P. P.”’ is used to designate English Par- 
liamentary Papers. Some of these papers are of folio size and others of oc- 
tavo size, but in the official sets they are all bound up indiscriminately in 
volumes of folio size, measuring 13 by 84 inches. 

Throughout the preceding pages authorities in this list are usually cited 
by number and page. For example, ‘‘27, p. 91’’ would indicate page 91 
of Capt. Kater’s account of his comparisons of various British standards of 
linear measure, contained in the Philosophical Transactions for 1821. 


1.—Picarp; M. L’Asst. De Mensuris. Divers ouvrages. Mem. de 
l’Acad. Roy. des Sciences, 1666-1699, Tome 6, pp. 532-549. Paris, 1780. 


2.—HirE; M. DELA. Comparaison du pied antique Romain a celui du 
Chatelet de Paris, avec quelques remarques sur d’autres mesures. Mem. de 
l’Acad. Roy. des Sciences, 1714, pp. 394-400. Paris, 1717. 


3.—MAvPERTUIS. La figure de la terre, déterminée par les observations 
de MM. de Maupertuis, Clairaut, Camus, le Monnier, * * * Outhier, 
* * * Celsius, * * * faites par ordre du Roy au cercle polaire. 
Paris, 1738. 16mo., pp. xxviii + 184. 


4.—CASsINI DE THuRY. Sur la propagation du son. (On p. 135 has 
statement respecting standards of length exchanged between the French 
Academy and the English Royal Society. ) Mem. de l’Acad. ey des Sci- 
ences, 1738, pp. 128-146. Paris, 1740. 


5.—Dégré du méridien entre Paris et Amiens, déterminé par la mesure 
de M. Picard et par les observations de MM. de Maupertuis, Clairaut, 
Camus, le Monnier, * * * Paris, 1740, 16mo, pp. lvj + 116. 


6.—GRAHAM; GrorGE. An account of the proportions of the English 
and French measures and weights, from the standards of the same, kept at 
the Royal Society. Phil. Trans., 1742, pp. [185-188]. 


7.—GRAHAM; GEORGE. An account of a comparison lately made by 
. some gentlemen of the Royal Society, of the standard of a yard, and the 
several weights lately made for their use; with the original standards of 
measures and weights in the Exchequer, and some others kept for public 
use, at Guild-hall, Founders-hall, the Tower, ete. Phil. Trans., 1743, pp. 
[541-556]. 


8.—CAssINI DE THuRyY. Ja meridienne de l’observatoire royal de Paris, 
vérifiée dans toute l’étendue du royaume par de nouvelles observations: 
Paris, 1744. 8vo, pp. 292 + ccxxxvj. 


LXXxX PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


9.—CoNDAMINE; M. DELA. Nouveau projet d’une mesure invariable, 
propre 2 servir de mesure commune & toutes les nations: Mem. de l’Acad. 
Roy. des. Sciences, 1747, pp. 489-514. Paris, 1752. 


10.—BovuauER, Camus, CassInI DE THury & PINGRE. Operations 
faites par ordre de l’Académie pour mesurer ]’intervalle entre les centres des 
Pyramides de Villejuive & de Juvisy, &c. Mem. de 1’Acad. Royale des 
Sciences, 1754, pp. 172-186. Paris, 1759. 


11.—1758. Report from the Committee appointed to inquire into the 
original standards of weights and measures in this Kingdom, and to con- 
sider the laws relating thereto. (Agreed to by the House June 2, 1758.) 
Printed on pp. 411-451 of Reports from Committees of the House of Com- 
mons, which have been printed by order of the House, and are not inserted 
in the Journals. Reprinted by order of the House. Vol. 2. (June 10, 
1787, to May 21, 1765). Folio, 163’” x 103/”. pp. 468. 


12.—1759. Report from the Committee appointed (upon the first day of 
Dec., 1758) to inquire into the original standards of weights and measures 
in this Kingdom, and to consider the laws relating thereto. (Agreed to by 
the House April 12, 1759.) Printed on pp. 453-463 of Reports from Com- 
mittees of the House of Commons, which have been printed by order of the 
House, and are not inserted in the Journals. Reprinted by order of the 
House. Vol. 2. (June 10, 1737, to May 21, 1765). Folio, 163/7 x 1032/7. 
pp. 468. 


13.—MAsSKELYNE; Rev. Nrviu (Ast. Royal). The length of a degree 
of latitude in the province of Maryland and Pennsylvania, deduced from 
the foregoing operations (by Messrs. Chas. Mason and Jeremiah Dixon) ; 
by the Astronomer Royal. Phil. Trans., 1768, pp. 8238-325. 


14.—ConDAMINE; M. DE LA. Remarques sur la toise-étalon du Chate- 
let, ct sur les diverses toises employées aux mesures des degrés terrestres & 
& celle du pendule 4 secondes. Mem, de l’Acad. Roy. des Sciences, 1772, 
2° partie. pp. 482-501. Paris, 1776. 


15.—Roy; Maj.-Gen. Wm. An account of a measurement of a base on 
Hounslow Heath. (Four large fulding plates.) Phil. Trans., 1785, pp. 
385-480. 


16.—La LAanpDE; JEROME LE FRANQAIS. De la grandeur et de la figure 
de la terre. Astronomie, Tome 3, pp. 1-47. (8d edition; Paris, 1792.) 


17.—Borpa, CouLoMB, LEGENDRE, LAPLACE, Prony, et Brisson. Rap- 
port sur la vérification de l’étalon qui doit servir pour la fabrication des 
poids républicains. Annales de Chimie, Paris, 1797, Tome 20, pp. 269-278. 


18.—SHUCKBURGH EVELYN; Sir Gro. An account of some endeavors 
to ascertain a standard of weight and measure. Phil. Trans., 1798, pp. 
133-182. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LXXXI 


19.—VAN-SWINDEN, TRALLES, LapLace, LEGENDRE, M&cHAIN, DE- 
LAMBRE, Ciscar. Rapport Sur le détermination de la grandeur de l’are 
du méridien compris entre les paralléles de Dunkerque et Barcelone, et sur 
la longueur du métre qu’on en déduit. Base du Systeme Métrique Décimal, 
Tome 8, pp. 415-483. Paris, 1810. 4to. 


20.—KateEr; Capt. Henry. An account of experiments for determin- 
ing the length of the pendulum vibrating seconds in the latitude of London. 
Phil. Trars., 1818, pp. 33-102. 


21.—KatrEr; Capt. Henry. On the length of the French métre esti- 
mated in parts of the English standard. Phil. Trans., 1818, pp. 103-109. 


22.—Experiments relating to the pendulum vibrating seconds of time in 
the latitude of London. 41 pp. (KE. P. P.) Accounts and papers. Ses- 
sion, 27 Jan.-10 June, 1818. Vol. 15. Folio, 18}/” x 83’’. This is a ver- 
batim reprint of Capt. Kater’s papers in the Phil. Trans., 1818, pp. 33 to 109. 


23.—BankKS, CLERK, GILBERT, WOLLASTON, YouNG, and KaTEr. First 
Report of the Commissioners appointed to consider the subject of weights 
and measures. (Dated 24 June, 1819) 17 pp. (HE. P. P.) Report from 
Commissioners. Session, 21 Jan.-13 July, 1819. Vol. 11. Folio, 1341/7 
xBy”. 


24.—CLERK, GILBERT, WOLLASTON, YouNG & Kater. Second Report 
of the Commissioners appointed by His Majesty to consider the subject of 
weights and measures. (Dated July 18, 1820) 40 pp. (E. P. P.) Reports 
from Commissioners. Session, 21 April to 23 Nov. 1820. Vol. 7. Folio, 
13}/7 x 83/7. 


25.—CLERK, GILBERT, WOLLAsTON, Youna & Kater. Third Report 
of the Commissioners appointed by His Majesty to consider the subject of 
weights and measures. (Dated Mar. 31,1821) 6 pp. (EH. P.P.) Reports 
from Committees. Session, 23 Jan. to 11 July, 1821. Vol. 4. Folio, 
13}// x 83/7. 


26.—Report from the Select Committee on weights and measures. (Dated 
May 28, 1821) 7 pp. (E. P.P.) Reports from Committees. Session, 23 
Jan. to 11 July, 1821. Vol. 4. Folio, 13}/” x 83/7. 


27.—Katiur; Capt. Henry. An account of the comparison of various 
British standards of linear measure. Phil. Trans., 1821, pp. 75-94. 


28.—Report from the Select Committee of the House of Lords * * * 
(on petition from Glasgow relative to) * * * the bill entitled ‘* An act 
for ascertaining and establishing uniformity of weights and measures’’ 
* * * together with the minutes of evidence taken before said Commit- 
tee. (Dated 2 Mar., 1824) 35 pp. (EH. P. P.) Reports from Committees. 
Session, 3 Feb. to 25 June, 1824. Vol. 7. Folio, 18/7 x 8}//. 


29.—Kater; Capt. Henry. An account of the construction and adjust- 
e 


LXXXII PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ment of the new standards of weights and measures of the United Kingdom 
of Great Britain and Ireland. Phil. Trans., 1826, part 2, pp. 1-52. 


80.—KatEer; Capt. Henry. On errors in standards of linear measure, 
srising from the thickness of the bar on which they are traced. Phil. 
Trans., 1830, pp. 359-881. 


31.—KaTER, Capt. Henry. An account of the construction and verifica- 
tion of a copy of the imperial standard yard made for the Royal Society. 
Phil. Trans., 1831, pp. 345-347. 


32.—Minutes of evidence taken before the Select Committee on bill to 
amend and render more effectual two acts of the 5th and 6th years of the 
reign of his late Majesty King George the 4th, relating to weights and 
measures. 67 pp. (E. P. P.) Reports from Committees. 1834. Vol. 18, 
part 1. Folio, 18/7 x 83/7. 


33.—Report from the Select Committee on the weights and measures act; 
together with the minutes of evidence. (Dated 17 June, 1835) 60 pp. (E. 
P. P.) Reports from Committees, Session, 19 Feb.-10 Sep., 1835. Vol. 
18. Folio, 18/7 x 83/’. 

34.—BaILy; Francis. Report on the new Standard Scale of this (the 
Royal Astronomical) Society. (Gives also a history of English standards 
of length.) Mem. Roy. Ast. Soc., 1836. Vol. 9, pp. 35-184. 


35.—AtIry, Batty, BeTHUNE, HeRscHEL, LEFEVRE, LUBBOCK, PEA- 
COCK, SHEEPSHANKS. Report of the Commissioners appointed to consider 
the steps to be taken for restoration of the standards of weight and measure. 
(Dated 21 Dec., 1841) 106 pp.. (HE. P. P.) Reports from Commissioners. 
Session, 3 Feb.-12 Aug., 1842. Vol. 25. Folio. 

86.—KELLY; Patrick. The universal cambist: being a full and accu- 
rate treatise on the exchanges, coins, weights, and measures of all trading 
nations and their colonies. By P. Kelly, LL.D. 2nd edition. London, 
1835. 2vols.,4to. Vol. 1, pp. xl-++ 422; Vol. 2, pp. xxiv + 380. 


37.—YOLLAND; Capt. Wm. An account of the measurement of Lough 
Foyle base in Ireland, with its verification and extension by triangulation ; 
ete., etc. Pub. by order of the Hon. Board of Ordnance. London, 1847. 
4to, pp. 154 + [117]. 

38.—AtrRy, RossE, WROTTESLEY, LEFEVRE, LUBBOCK, PEACOCK, SHEEP- 
SHANKS, HERSCHEL, MILLER. Report of the Commissioners appointed to 
superintend the construction of new parliamentary standards of length and 
weight. (Dated March 28, 1854) 23 pp. (EH. P. P.) Reports from Com- 
missioners. Session, 81 Jan.-12 Aug., 1854. Vol. 19. Folio, 13/7 % 83/7. 


39.—Abstract of ‘‘ Report of the Commissioners appointed to consider the 
steps to be taken for restoration of the standards of weight and measure.”’ 
16 pp. (EH. P. P.) Reports from Commissioners. Session, 12 Dec., 1854- 
14 Aug., 1855. Vol. 15. Folio, 13/7 K 83/7. 


40.—MiILuER; Prof. W. H. On the construction of the new imperial 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LXXXIII 


standard pound, and its copies of platinum; and on the comparison of the 
imperial standard pound with the Kilogramme des Archives. Phil. Trans., 
1856. pp. 753-946. 


41.—Airy; Sir Gro. B. Account of the construction of the new national 
standard of length, and of its principal copies. Phil. Trans., 1857. pp. 
621-702. 

42.—CLARKE; Capt. A. R. Comparisons of the standards of length of 
England, France, Belgium, Prussia, Russia, India, Australia, made at the 
Ordnance Survey Office, Southampton. Published by order of the Secretary 
of State for War. London, 1866. . 4to, pp. 287. 


43.—CHIsSHOLM; Henry WIttIAMs. Seventh annual report of the 
Warden of the Standards on the proceedings and business of the standard 
weights and measures department of the Board of Trade. For 1872-3. 
8vo, pp. 105. (Contains: Appendix IV.—Account of the standard weights 
and measures of Queen Elizabeth. pp. 10-26: Appendix V.—Account of 
the standard weights 9nd measures of Henry VII. pp. 27-34: Appendix 
VI.—New standard weights and measures constructed and legalised from 
the reign of Queen Elizabeth to George IV. pp. 35-40.) (EH. P. P.) Re- 
ports from Commissioners. Session, 6 Feb.-5 Aug., 1873. Vol. 38. 


44.—CuisHoLm; H. W. On the science of weighing and measuring, 
and standards of measure and weight. By H. W. Chisholm, warden of the 
standards. 16mo, pp, xvi + 192. London: Macmillan & Co. 1877. 


45.—Hitearp; Juxtius E. Report on the comparison of American and 
British standard yards. Report of the Superintendent of the U.S. Coast 
Survey, 1877. Appendix No. 12, pp. 148-181. 4to. 


46.—WotutFr; C. Recherches historiques sur les étalons de poids et mes- 
ures de l’Observatoire, et les appareils qui ont servi a les construire. An- 
nales de l’Observatoire de Paris. Mémoirs, Tome 17, pp. C.1-C.78. (Pub- 
lished in 18838.) 

47.—Wo.F; C. Résultats des comparaisons de la toise du Pérou au mé- 
tre international, exécutées au Bureau international des Poids et Mesures 
por M. Benoit. Comptes Rendus, 3 Avril, 1888. Tome 106. pp. 977-982. 


48.—Copies ‘‘of a letter from the Comptroller General of the Exchequer 
to the Treasury, dated 3 June, 1863, transmitting a report on the Exchequer 
standards of weight and measure, dated 27 April, 1863, by Mr. Chisholm, 
chief clerk in the office of the Comptroller General of the Exchequer; to- 
gether with a copy of his report: ’’ and, of a memorandum by the Astron- 
omer Royal, dated 24 April, 1862, containing notes for the Committee on 
Weights and Measures, 1862. 51 pp. (Contains a complete descriptive list 
of ail the old Exchequer standards; a discussion on the moneyer’s pound ; 
and a history of English legislation on weights and measures.) (EH. P. P.) 
Trade (Generally). Session, 4 Feb.-29 July, 1864. Vol. 58. Folio. 


49.—Annual reports of the Warden of the Standards on the proceedings 
and business of the standard weights and measures department of the Board 


LXXXIV PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


of Trade. 8vo. (Printed as English Parliamentary Papers, and contained 
in the volumes of ‘‘Reports from Commissioners.’’) 


No. of Have: No. of Volume of Reports from 
Report Pages. Commissioners. 
Stee oy ee 1866-7 19 1867, Vol. 19. 
7 ae IDE 1867-8 18 1867-8, Vol. 27. 
odo 2- ues 1868-9 18 1868-9, Vol. 28. 
AtWe seth 1869-70 25 1870, Vol. 27. 
Sthve se oh AB WOel 46 1871, Vol. 24. 
Gili hoe 1871-2 208 1872, Vol. 35. 
(i eae PES 1872-3 105 1873, Vol. 38. 
Bie eon eet 1873-4 138 1874, Vol. 32. 
19 cena 1874-5 58 1875, Vol. 27. 
Othe eset 1875-6 68 1876, Vol. 26. 
Ne ys epee a -| 1876-7 12 1877, Vol. 33. 
Ty) ele 1877-8 12 1878, Vol. 36. 


50.—Reports of the Commissioners appointed to inquire into the condi- 
tion of the Exchequer (now Board of Trade) standards. Presented to both 
Houses of Parliament by command of Her Majesty. Folio. (Printed as 
English Parliamentary Papers, and contained in the volumes of ‘“ Reports 
from Commissioners.’’) 


No. of | No. of Volume of Reports from 


Report. ao Pages. Commissioners. 
eee aes 24 July, 1868___-- 8 1867-8, Vol. 27. 
1: EN Saar 8 April, 1869___-- 133 1868-9, Vol. 23. 
Oath l2 Hs ese e 1 February, 1870_ 159 1870, Vol. 27. 
C0) ae ae 21 May, 1870 -.+.. 438 1870, Vol. 27. 

5 | | pepe BS bl 38 August, 1870._- 265 1871, Vol. 24. 
General Index......__...~_- 101 1873, Vol. 38. 


* On the abolition of troy weight. 
+ On the inspection of weights and measures, etc. 


ANNUAL ADDRESS OF THE PRESIDENT. LXXXV 


51.—ArryY; Sir Geo. B. Extracts of papers, printed and manuscript, 
laid before the Commission appointed to consider the steps to be taken for 
restoration of the standards of weight and measure, and the subjects con- 
nected therewith. Arranged by G. B. Airy, Esq., Astronomer Royal. 
Printed by ordet of the Lords Commissioners of the Treasury. London, 
1840. 4to, 155 pp. (Consists of a vast number of brief extracts giving the 
opinions of many experts upon various points connected with the construc- 
tion and use of standards of weight and measure, and the advantages and 
disadvantages of various systems of such standards.) 


52.—CLARKE; Lt. Col. A. R. Results of the comparisons of the stand- 
ards of length of England, Austria, Spain, United States, Cape of Good 
Hope, and of a second Russian Standard, made at the Ordnance Survey 
Office, Southampton. By Lieutenant-Colonel A. R. Clarke, C. B., R. E., 
F. R.S., &c., under the direction of Major-General Sir Henry James, R. E., 
F. R.S., &c., director-general of the Ordnance Survey. With a preface 
and notes on the Greek and Egyptian measures of length by Sir Henry 
James. Phil. Trans., 1873, pp. 445-469. 


53.—ADAMS; JoHN Quincy. Report upon weights and measures, by 
John Quincey Adams, Secretary of State of the United States. Prepared in 
obedience to the resolution of the Senate of the 3d of March, 1817. Wash- 
ington: printed by Gales & Seaton. 1821. 8vo, pp. 245. (Contains report 
of F. R. Hessler on comparisons of English and French measures. pp. 153- 
170.) 


54.—ALEXANDER; J.H. Report (made to the governor of Maryland) on 
the standards of weight and measure for the State of Maryland; and on the 
construction of the yard-measures. Baltimore, Dec. 13, 1845. 8vo, pp. 
iv +.213. 


55.—HAssLER; FERDINAND RopOLPH. Comparison of weights and meas- 
ures of length and capacity. Reported to the Senate of the United States 
by the Treasury Department in 1832, and made by Ferd. Rod. Hassler. 22d 
Congress, lst Session, Ho. of Reps., Doc. No. 299. Washington, 1832. S8vo, 
122 pp., with 4 folding plates. (Contains a paper by Trallés giving impor- 
tant details, not published elsewhere, respecting the original iron meters of 
the Commission des Poids et Mesures of 1799.) 


56.—HassLer; F.R. Report from the Secretary of the Treasury, trans- 
mitting the report of F. R. Hassler, superintendent of the Coast Survey, and 
of the fabrication of standard weights and measures. 25th Congress, 2d 
Session, Senate, Doc. No. 79. Washington, 1837. 8vo,16. pp. (Explains 
method adopted for determining subdivisions of the troy pound.) 


57.—HassLER; F. R. Report upon the standards of the liquid capacity 
measures of the system of uniform standards for the United States; with 
description of a new original barometer, and of the balance for adjusting 
the half bushels by their weight of distilled water. By F. R. Hassler. 27th 


LXXXVI PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Congress, 2d Session, Senate, Doc. No. 225. Washington, 1842. 8vo, 
26 pp. and 3 folding plates. 


58.—Bacux, A. D., & McCutton, R. 8. Reports from the Secretary of 
the Treasury, of scientific investigations in relation to sugar and hydrome- 
ters, made, under the superintendence of Prof. A. D. Bache, by Prof. R. S. 
McCulloh. 80th Congress, lst Session, Senate, Ex. Doc. No. 50. Wash- 
ington, 1848. 8vo, pp. 658. 


59.—BacurE; Prof. ALEXANDER D. Report to the Treasury Department 
on the progress of the work of constructing standards of weights and measures 
for the custom-houses, and balances for the States, and in supplying stand- 
ard hydrometers to the custom-houses, from 1 Jan., 1848, to 31 Dec., 1856. 
34th Congress, 8d Session, Senate, Ex. Doc, No. 27. Washington, 1857. 
8vo, 218 pp. with 6 folding plates. (Contains descriptions of yard dividing 
engine, and various comparators. ) 


60.—RocrErs; Prof. W. A. On the present state of the question of stand- 
ards of length. (Contains a bibliography.) Proceed. Amer. Acad. of Arts 
and Sciences, 1879-80. Vol. 15. pp. 278-312. 


61.—RogeErs; Prof. W. A. On two forms of comparators for measures 
of length. 8vo, 12 pp. American Quarterly Microscopical Journal, April, 
1879. 


62.—RogeErs; Prof. Wm. A. Studies in metrology. 5 Plates. (Con- 
tains description of the Rogers-Bond universal comparator.) Proceed. 
Amer. Acad. of Arts and Sciences, 1882-’3. Vol. 18, pp. 287-398. 8vo. 


63.—Rogers; Prof. W. A. An examination of the standards of length 
constructed by the Société Génevoise. Proceed. Amer. Acad. of Arts and 
Sciences, 1884—’5. Vol. 20, pp. 379-3889. 8vo. 


‘ 


64.—Rocrrs; Prof. W. A. A study of the centimeter marked ‘A,” 
prepared by the U.S. Bureau of Weights and Measures for the Committee 
on Micrometry. 8vo,23 pp. Proc. Amer. Society of Microscopists. Vol. 
82, p. 184. 


65 —Rogers; Prof. Wm. A. Ona practical solution of the perfect screw 
problem. 8vo,44 pp. Trans. Amer. Soc. of Mechanical Engineers. Vol. 5. 


66.—Roarrs; Prof. W. A. A critical study of the action of a diamond 
in ruling lines upon glass. 8vo,17pp. Proc. Amer. Society of Microscop- 
ists. Vol. 82, p. 149. 


67.—Travaux et mémoires du Bureau International des Poids et Mesures, 
publiés sous ’autorité du Comité International, par le Directeur du Bureau. 
Paris. 4to. Tome 1, 1881, 391 pp.; T. 2, 1883, 413 pp.; T. 3, 1884, $48 
pp.; T. 4, 1885, 421 pp.; T. 5, 1886, 416 pp. 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 


295TH MEETING. JANUARY 15, 1887. 
President HARKNEss in the Chair. 
Fifty-one members present. 


Announcement was made of the election to membership of Messrs. 
Henry Laurens Wuitrine and THomas WILLIAM Symons. 


The following report of the Auditing Committee was presented 
by its chairman, Mr. Woopwarp, and was accepted : 


JANUARY 15, 1887. 


The undersigned, a committee appointed at the annual meeting 
of the Philosophical Society of Washington, December 18, 1886, for 
the purpose of auditing the accounts of the Treasurer, beg leave to 
report as follows: 

We have examined the statement of receipts, including annual 
dues, sale of Bulletin, and interest on bonds, and find the same to 
be correct. 

We have examined the statement of disbursements and compared 
the same with the vouchers, and find them to agree. 

We have examined the returned checks and the bank account 
with Riggs & Co., and find the balance, $485.52, to agree with the 
statement of the Treasurer’s report. 

We have examined the United States and other bonds belonging 
to the Society, and find them to be in amount and character as rep- 
resented in the Treasurer’s report, aggregating $3,100. 

R. S. Woopwarp, 

Swan M. Burnett, 

J. H. Kipper, 
Committee. 


(8) 


4 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Mr. G. K. GitBert presented a communication entitled 


GRAPHIC METHODS IN RESEARCH. 


[Abstract. ] 


An algebraic equation between two variables is the equivalent of 
a plane curve, or, more strictly, of a line lying in a plane. An 
equation containing three variables is the equivalent of a surface. 
If in such an equation one of the variables be assumed equal to 1, 2, 
3, ete., successively, there result a series of equations involving the 
other two variables. Each of these equations may be represented 
by a line in a plane, and the system of lines thus produced is the 
representative of the original equation between three variables. The 
single curve may be called a nomogram, the system of curves an 
asogram. 

In the simplest use of the graphic method in research the simul- 
taneous quantitative observations of two phenomena are represented 
on cross-section paper by a dot, a series of observations are repre- 
sented by a system of dots, and a line is drawn through or among 
these dots. This line expresses the law of the relation between the 
two phenomena and is a nomogram. 

When simultaneous observations are made of three phenomena, 
two of the observations are expressed by a dot on section paper and 
the third by a number attached to the dot. All the observations 
having been represented by such numbered dots, a system of lines 
is drawn over the area occupied by the dots, each line representing 
an integral value of one of the variable phenomena, and being 
drawn so as to pass through the dots marked with the correspond- 
ing number. An isogram is thus produced without recourse to the 
algebraic equation. 

In the compound nomogram, two or more curves are drawn on the 
same sheet, and with one system of ordinates in common. Each of 
these curves represents an equation with two variables, one vari- 
able being common to all the equations. By this means two or 
more variable phenomena are compared with each other through 
the mediation of another phenomenon with which they are related. 

In the compound isogram two or more isograms are drawn on the 
same sheet. Each isogram is the equivalent of an equation between 
three variables, two variables being common to all the isograms, 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 5 


and one peculiar to each. By this means, variable phenomena are 
compared with each other with reference to two other phenomena, 

There are also phases of the graphic method in which lines are 
not drawn, the arrangement of the platted dots being such that they 
cannot be replaced by lines, but nevertheless lead to legitimate in- 
ferences. 

The function of the graphic method in research is the classifica- 
tion of observations and their generalization, or the discovery of 
their laws of relation. The same function is performed by math- 
ematical analysis, both processes being restricted to the discussion 
of quantitative observations. As compared to the mathematical 
method, the graphic is more rapid and less precise. In matters 
difficult of comprehension it aids the imagination by introducing a 
sensory impression, and in this manner it suggests inferences and 
hypotheses which might readily be overlooked if mathematical 
methods were employed alone. 


Mr. H. A. Hazen remarked upon the importance of this method 
in meteorology. He suggested some precautions to be taken in at- 
tempting to trace a connection by maximum or mininum epochs 
between elements which are not clearly related or caused by the 
same force. 


Mr. Marcus Baker thought that the graphic method had its 
chief use in rough approximations, and drew attention to the great 
strides which had been made in geometry by the introduction of 
analytical methods, supplementing and in part supplanting graphie 
methods. 


Mr. Paut remarked that the graphic method might be useful in 
a preliminary determination of the most promising of several meth- 
ods of possible analysis. 


Mr. C. D. Watcort read a paper entitled 


THE GEOLOGIC AGE OF THE LOWEST FORMATION OF EMMONS’ 
TACONIC SYSTEM, 
illustrated by maps, drawings, etc. 


[This paper, in abstract, appeared in the American Journal of Science, 
8d series, 8°, New Haven, 1887, February, vol. 33, pp. 153-154. ] 


6 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


296TH MEETING. JANUARY 29, 1887, 
The President in the Chair. 


Thirty-six members present. 


Announcement was made by the President of the death of Gen- 
eral Witi1AmM B. Hazen, a member of the Society, which took 
place at 8 p. m., January 16. 


Mr. F. W. CLarke read a paper entitled 


THE PRESENT STATUS OF MINERALOGY. 
[This paper is expected to appear in the Popular Science Monthly. ] 


A paper by Mr. R. T. H1x1, entitled 
THE TOPOGRAPHY AND GEOLOGY OF THE CROSS TIMBERS OF TEXAS, 


was then read by Mr. W J McoGex, as Mr. Hit had been called 
away from the city after his paper was placed upon the programme. 


[This paper appeared in full in the American Journal of Science, 3d 
series, 8°, New Haven, 1887, April, vol. 83, pp. 291-303. ] 


297TH MEETING. Frpruary 12, 1887. 
The President in the Chair. 


Forty-one members and guests present. 


The President announced that Mr. Frank Hatt Knowiton 
had been elected to and had accepted membership in the Society. 

A letter was read from the secretary of the Anthropological 
Society announcing that Mr. Alfred Russell Wallace would deliver 
an address Tuesday evening, February 15, on “Social versus Polit- 
ical Economy” before the Anthropological Society, and inviting 
the members of the Philosophical Society and their friends to be 
present on that occasion. 


Mr. H. A. HAzen made a communication on 


THE SKY GLOWS OF 1883. 


This communication was discussed by Messrs. Paun, E. Far- 
QuHAR, WINLOCK, and the author. 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 7 


Mr. BartLey WILLIs presented a paper on 


THE TOPOGRAPHY AND STRUCTURE IN THE BAYS MOUNTAINS, 
TENNESSEE. 


[This paper appeared in the School of Mines Quarterly, Columbia Col- 
lege, 8°, New York, 1887, April, vol. 8, No. 3, pp. 242-252.] 


Mr. G. Brown GoopE made a communication on 


THE GEOGRAPHICAL DISTRIBUTION OF SCIENTIFIC MEN AND IN- 
STITUTIONS IN THE UNITED STATES. 


[An abstract of this communication appeared in The Epoch, 4°, New 
York, 1887, June 24, vol. 1, pp. 467-468. ] 


298TH MEETING. FEBRUARY 26, 1887. 
The President in the Chair. 
Thirty-nine members and guests present. 


The President announced the election to and acceptance of mem- 
bership of Mr. Franxkury Austin SEELY. 


Mr. C. V. Ritery read a paper upon 
OUR CITY SHADE-TREES, THEIR FOES AND THEIR FUTURE, 
illustrated by drawings and specimens. 


[This paper was afterwards elaborated and published as Bulletin No. 10 
of the entomological division of the Department of Agriculture, published 
May 7, 1887, with the following title: 

U. S. Department of Agriculture. Division of Entomology. Bulletin 
No 10. Our shade-trees and their insect defoliators, Being a consideration 
of the four most injurious species which affect the trees of the capital; with 
means of destroying them. By C. V. Riley, entomologist. Washington : 
Government Printing Office, 1887. 69 pp., 8°, illustrated. ] 


This communication was discussed by Messrs. GirBpert, Mer- 
RIAM, and EL.iorr. 


8 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Mr. Lester F. Warp made a communication entitled 


THE FREQUENCY OF COINCIDENCES. 


[Abstract. ] 


Every one is constantly meeting with coincidences in every-day 
life, but few ever take the trouble to record them. Mr. Ward had 
always been struck by their frequent occurrence and remarkable 
character, but until within about fifteen years had been content, 
as most people are, to allow them to pass with only a momentary 
expression of surprise. Certain comments upon them, however, 
which he had met with in the writings of Auguste Comte and Dr. 
George M. Beard had led him to take a wider view of their signifi- 
cance and to commence in the year 1875 the practice of jotting 
down in his note-book some of the more interesting and striking of 
them. In this way a large collection of instances had accumulated, 
a few of which were selected for presentation to the Society. These 
were read directly from his notes, without change of phraseology, in 
order to preserve their literal accuracy. Most of them were of a 
character which, according to the mathematical law of probabil- 
ities, would not occur again within any finite limitation of the 
events with which they were associated. 

The only application which it was attempted to make of the facts 
was to point out their bearing upon the investigations which had 
been recently conducted by the British Society for Psychical Re- 
search, from which, in Mr. Ward’s opinion, unwarranted conclu- 
sions had been drawn, and which, he believed, receive their true 
explanation only when the frequency of coincidences is fully recog- 
nized. 


This communication was discussed by Messrs. WoopwarpD and 
CLARKE. 


299TH MEETING. Marca 12, 1887. 
The President in the Chair. 
Thirty-four members and guests present. - 


The President announced the death on March 5th, at Pensacola, 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 9 


Florida, of Capt. Epwarp Puetps Lut, U.S. N.,a member of 
this Society. 


The President also announced that Mr. HERBERT CourErR WIL- 
son had been elected to and had accepted membership in the Society. 


Mr. G. E. Curtis read a paper on 


THE THEORY OF THE WIND-VANE. 


[This paper appeared in the American Journal of Science, 3d series, 8°, 
New Haven, 1887, July, vol. 34, pp. 44-52. It has also been reprinted in 
the American Meteorological Journal, 8°, Ann Arbor, Mich., 1887, Sep- 
tember, vol. 4, No. 5, pp. 215-224.] 


Mr. H. A. Hazen thought that Mr. Curtis’s formule showed 
that a single-tailed vane is more sensitive than a doubled-tailed one 
and would define a sensitive vane as that one which most quickly 
assumes the direction of the wind. 


Mr. Bares regarded these formule, presented by Mr. Curtis, 
which had been deduced for inelastic fluids moving in right lines as 
inapplicable to elastic fluids moving in curved lines and often 
affected by vortices. 


Further remarks were made by Messrs. ABBE, WoopWARD, and 
CurTISs. 


Mr. C. F. Marvin made a communication on 


THE ELECTROMETER AS USED IN OBSERVATIONS OF ATMOSPHERIC 
ELECTRICITY, 


exhibiting in connection with it a diagram and the instrument 
itself. 


Mr. Bartry WILLIS made a communication on the 
DEVELOPMENT OF A PERSPECTIVE MAP FROM A CONTOUR MAP, 
illustrated by three sketches and diagrams. 


Mr. W. D. Jounnson exhibited and explained a new plane table, 
presenting a number of improvements, especially as to increased 
stability, compactness, levelling, and mode of attaching the paper 
to the board, 


10 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 
300TH MEETING. Marcu 26, 1887. 
7 


The President in the Chair. 


Seventy-one members and guests present. 


This meeting was held in the Assembly Hall of the Cosmos Club, 
southeast corner of H street and Madison Place, the Club having 
offered the use of its hall as a meeting place for the Society. Pre- 
ceding meetings during this year and during several former years, 
were by the courtesy of the Surgeon General of the United States 
Army, held in the library of the Surgeon General’s Office on the 
east side of 10th and between E and F streets N. W. 

The President briefly alluded to this removal to more commodi- 
ous quarters upon the 300th meeting of the Society as marking an 
epoch in its history. 


Announcement was made of the election to membership of Mr. 
SAMUEL Prerpont LANGLEY and Mr. Harry Kina. 


Mr. H. A. Hazen read a paper upon the 


RELATION BETWEEN WIND VELOCITY AND PRESSURE, 


illustrated by an apparatus resembling that used by him in recent 
experiments at the Smithsonian Institution. 


[This paper appeared in the American Journal of Science, 3d series, 8°, 
New Haven, 1887, October, vol. 34, pp. 241-248. ] 


The paper was discussed by Messrs. BrLLines, WoopWARD, 
HArkKNEsS, Pavt, and the author. 


Mr. BatLtey WILLIS made a communication on 
MT. RAINIER AND ITS GLACIERS, 


illustrated by perspective drawings of Rainier and Shasta, derived 
from contour maps by the method explained at the last meeting. 
The facts brought out by the illustrations and remarks indicate that 
Rainier was a point of intense volcanic activity long since extinct, 
and Shasta one of long continued less violent eruption. Rainier isa 
ruin, Shasta a complete cone. 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 11 


Mr. DiLueEr followed with an account of Mt. Shasta, contrasting 
it with Mt. Rainier. 


These communicafions were discussed by Messrs. Durron and 
WILLIs. 


Mr. Marcus BAKER made a communication entitled 


WHAT IS A TOPOGRAPHIC MAP? 
[Abstract. ] 


Referring to the volume of testimony taken by a joint committee 
of the two houses of Congress charged with the duty of investigating 
the relations of certain scientific bureaus, Mr. Baker remarked that 
the time seemed opportune to discuss dispassionately certain points 
previously discussed controversially. 

Great diversity of view and of usage as to what constitutes topog- 
raphy, topographic survey, topographic map, etc., was brought out by 
citations from various authors and witnesses. 

According to some, the relief of a portion of country constitutes 
its topography; according to others, relief, drainage, and culture 
together make up topography; still others find that the delineation 
or representation of such features constitutes topography. Topog- 
raphy is also defined as “description of places” and as “a branch 
of surveying.” 

A rather large and mixed assortment of maps was exhibited. 
These maps, made by different nations, on different scales, in differ- 
ent styles and colors, with different conventions and symbols, and 
differing as to accuracy and completeness, were offered as samples 
of a very large assortment, which it was proposed to classify. 
“Topographic maps” should form one of the various classes into 
which it would be desirable or convenient to divide maps. To de- 
termine what principles should be adopted as guides for including 
or excluding from this class was the object of the enquiry. 

It was suggested that a satisfactory definition of “topographic 
map” must take account of four things, viz.: 

(a) scale. 

(b) purpose. 

(c) features to be represented. 
(d) accuracy. 


12 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


(a) Maps on a very small scale may be called generalized maps, 
and, though showing topographic features as fully and completely 
as the scale will permit, are still not properly,topographic but gen- 
eralized maps. 

Maps on very large scales, on the other hand, though sometimes 
containing curves of equal altitude or contours, are yet rather dia- 
grams or plans than topographic maps. 

The topographic map requires a scale somewhere between the 
small scale generalized map and the very large scale plan. 

(b) The class to which any given map must be referred further 
depends upon its purpose. Ifthe purpose is to exhibit the geologic 
structure, it is a geologic map; if designed for military purposes, a 
military map; if for nautical purposes, a nautical map—or, as it is 
called, a chart—and if for exhibiting the topography, a topographic 
map. If a topographic map is colored to exhibit the geologic 
structure of the region shown, it is no longer a topographic but a 
geologic map, ete. Most of the maps of the Coast Survey, though 
exhibiting more or less topography, would not be classed with topo- 
graphic maps, but with charts, being designed for nautical pur- 
poses. 

(ec) The features to be exhibited on a map, in order that it may 
be classed as topographic, are (1) the relief, (2) the drainage, in- 
cluding in this term the whole water system of ponds, lakes, swamps, 
streams, etc., and (3) the culture, this term implying the works of 
man of such size or importance as to warrant their being classed as 
topographic features. What features are topographic depends upon 
the scale of the map. 

(d) With respect to accuracy we shall have topographic maps 
and topographic sketches. A topographic sketch controlled by 
locations is a topographic map; not so controlled, it remains a 
sketch. 


This communication was discussed by Messrs. G. Toompson, H. 
Farquuar, R. D. Mussty, and the author. 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 13 
3801sr M&eETING. APRIL 9, 1887. 
The President in the Chair. 
Seventy-three members and guests present. 


Prof H. Carrineton Bourton, of Hartford, Conn., read, by in- 
vitation, a paper on the 


COUNTING-OUT RHYMES OF CHILDREN, THEIR ANTIQUITY, ORIGIN 
AND WIDE DISTRIBUTION. 


[Published in a volume of same name by Elliot Stock, London. Also 
read before the New York Academy of Sciences. ] 


This paper was discussed by Messrs. Easrman, Brnurnes, Mus- 
sry, Hazen, Warp, Mason, Epwarp Eceieston, BABcock, and 
by the author. In the course of the discussion several new rhymes 
were brought forward together with many interesting references to 
particular customs and formule of speech. 


3802p. MEETING. APRIL 23, 1887. 
The President in the Chair. 


Sixty members and guests present. 
Mr. Harxness presented a communication 


ON A DEVICE FOR VIEWING THE SUN BY LIGHT OF ANY DESIRED 
WAVE LENGTH. 


[Abstract. ] 


If two precisely similar prisms are placed in contact, with their 
refracting angles facing in opposite directions, the outer surfaces of 
the combination will be parellel to each other, and light falling 
upon the first prism will emerge from the second parallel to its origi- 
nal direction and without suffering any dispersion whatever. So 
long as the two prisms remain in contact the combination is, in 
effect, a piece of thick plano-parallel glass, and objects seen through 
it present only their natural colors. If, however, the prisms are 
separated by a considerable interval a different action occurs. A 


14 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


small pencil of nearly parallel rays falling upon the first prism 
then suffers so much dispersion before reaching» the second prism 
that the latter can no longer reunite the rays of different wave- 
lengths, but it will still render them parallel to the directions they 
had before entering the first prism. Thus all the conditions neces- 
sary for affording distinct vision of the radiant to an eye situated 
behind the second prism are fulfilled, and at the same time the 
wave-length of the light received by the eye can be completely con- 
trolled by the adjustment of the prisms. 

In the experimental apparatus actually constructed two sixty- 
degree prisms were employed, separated by an interval of thirty- 
eight inches. These prisms were fixed relatively to each other, and 
behind the second one a viewing telescope of 6.5 inches focal dis- 
tance and 0.84 of an inch clear aperture was mounted in such a 
way that it could be moved through an arc sufficient to bring rays 
of any desired wave-length to the center of its field. Slits were 
placed immediately behind the first prism and before the objective 
of the viewing telescope. Thus arranged, the instrument gave 
images of the whole sun composed of tolerably homogeneous light ; 
but the image of the surrounding sky was not composed of homoge- 
neous light, and to remedy that defect a somewhat different arrange- 
ment of the slits will be tried. 


This communication was followed by a symposium upon the ques- 
tion, 


WHAT IS TOPOGRAPHY ? 


participated in by Messrs. M. H. Doorrrrix, W. D. Jounson, H. 
G. OapEN, and GILBERT THOMPSON. 


Mr. DoortrrLeE began by declaring his ignorance until recently 
of the subject and his resulting fitness to investigate without preju- 
dice. He then pointed out the origin and development of the terms 
geography, chorography, and topography, referring to the death of 
the term chorography at the ripe old age of 1,500 years or there- 
abouts and the alteration with time of the meaning of the words 
geography and topography. The early meaning of topography, 
description of places, appears to be obsolete or obsolescent. The 
existing confusion concerning the meaning of the word topography 
was made strikingly manifest by quotations from dictionaries. 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 15 


Mr. W. D. Jounson followed with a written communication, in 
which he took the ground that topography had within recent years 
lost almost or quite completely its old significance of description of 
places, and was now almost universally understood to refer to sur- 
face forms, the ups and downs, the hills and valleys, etc., and to 
nothing else. This position was defended by very diverse and 
numerous citations. 

Mr. H. G. Oapen followed with a written communication, in 
which he argued that the topographical features which, taken to- 
gether, constitute topography, comprise not only natural relief, but 
artificial relief also, such as railway cuts and embankments, dams, 
mounds, etc., and that generally hills and valleys, streams and ponds, 
towns and roads, etc., should be, as they have been, regarded as 
topographical features. 

Mr. Gitpert THompson held that permanent hill features alone 
constitute topography, and set forth the general applicability of 
this view by illustrative crayon drawings. 

A general discussion followed, participated in by Messrs. W. D. 
Jounson, G. THompson, DooLitrLE, WINLOcCK, HarKness, E. 
_ Farquaar, and M. Baker. 


3038p MEETING. May 7, 1887. 
The President in the Chair. 
Forty-four members and guests present. 


Announcement was made of the election to membership of Mr. 
Harry VANDERBILT WURDEMANN. 


Mr. J. W. CHICKERING read a paper on 
THE MUIR GLACIER, ALASKA, 
illustrated by a map and diagram. 


Mr. Marcus Baker commented on this communication and re- 
marked that in a careful inspection of the shores of Lynn Canal in 
1880 he was unable to discover more than a small proportion of the 
glaciers reported by Mr. Muir. 


16 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 
Mr. C. Harr Merriam read a paper upon 


> . 
THE ECONOMIC PHASE OF THE ENGLISH SPARROW QUESTION. 


[This paper appeared in the Report of the Commissioner of Agriculture, 
1886, 8°, Washington, Government Printing Office, 1887, pp. 227-246; with 


map. ] 


Respecting the law protecting sparrows Mr. Hazen drew atten- 
tion to the fact that a colored boy had recently been fined two 
dollars in the Police Court of Washington for throwing stones at 
sparrows. 


Mr. W J McGer made an oral communication entitled 


THE QUATERNARY DEPOSITS AND THE GREAT DISPLACEMENT OF 
THE MIDDLE ATLANTIC SLOPE, 


embodying the results of investigations set forth in part in a memoir 
on the geology of the head of Chesapeake Bay, contained in the 
Seventh Annual Report of the U.S. Geological Survey, and in part 
in an article entitled Three Formations of the Middle Atlantic 
Slope, which is expected to appear in the American Journal of - 
Science for February and March, 1888. 


304TH MEETING. May 21, 1887. 
The President in the Chair. 
Forty-five members and guests present. 
Mr. C. Ek. Durron made a communication on P 


A RECENT VISIT TO THE SCENE OF THE CHARLESTON EARTH- 
QUAKE AND RESULTING CONCLUSIONS. 


Mr. W. H. Dau made a communication entitled 
SOUTH FLORIDA NOTES. 


Remarks on this communication were made by Messrs. Bov- 
TELLE, HEAD, and Toner. 


Adjourned to October 15. 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 17 


305tH MEETING. OcToBER 15, 1887. 
The President in the Chair. 


Fifty-one members and guests present. 


The President announced the death at Wood’s Holl, Massachu- 
setts, on August 19, 1887, of Prof. Spencer FuLLertTon Barrp, 
one of the original members of the Society. 


Mr. C. E. Durron made a communication 
ON THE DEPTH OF EARTHQUAKE FOCI. 
[Abstract. ] 


Mr. Dutton first referred to the various methods which had been 
resorted to in order to ascertain the depths of earthquake foci. The 
method suggested by Mallet and based on the assumption that the 
lines of fracture in the walls of buildings tended to arrange them- 
selves transversely to the direction of propagation, he believed to be 
unavailable and not sustained by observation. The motions of 
buildings ‘and of the ground itself during an earthquake were 
highly complex, and, moreover, the lines of fracture, he believed, 
were influenced far more forcibly by the nature of the structure, 
the openings in the walls, and the natural directions of vibration 
than by the directions of the impulses themselves. 

Seebach’s method, by ascertaining the variation of the speed of 
the wave along the surface of the ground in the vicinity of the epi- 
centrum, was regarded as impracticable, though the mathematical 
considerations upon which it was founded were doubtless correct. 
The speed of propagation is so high and the difficulty of obtaining 
time observations of sufficient precision is so great that this mode 
of solution must fail for want of the requisite data. Seebach seems 
to have been under the impression that this speed was not more 
than a very few hundred metres per second. The Charleston earth- 
quake was transmitted with a speed probably exceeding 5,000 metres 
per second, and Mr. Dutton was of the opinion that all true earth- 
quakes were propagated with a speed differing but little from that ; 


but, even if the speed were no greater than Seebach supposed, it 
48 


18 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


would still be expecting too much of human fallibility to suppose 
that data of sufficient accuracy could ever be obtained. 

There is, however, a method which is dependent, not upon time 
data, but upon observations of intensity, which seems to offer the 
means of computing the desired quantity. It is well known that 
the intensity or energy per unit area of wave front diminishes as 
the wave moves outwards from the centrum. Like all radiant 
energy, it must be subject to the law of variation inversely as the 
square of the distance. If the elasticity of the medium were perfect 
and its density uniform the law would be rigorous. As a matter of 
fact, it is not so; but, on the other hand, we are assured that the 
elasticity cannot be very imperfect, since if it were so the propaga- 
tion of impulses to very great distances would be impossible, and 
the waves would soon be extinguished in work done upon the me- 
dium itself. Nor is there reason to suppose that the variations of 
density are extreme. Thus, while the law of inverse squares may 
be in some measure impaired, it may still be assumed as an approxi- 
mate expression of the reality. 

If, then, we were able to form a just estimate of the rate of varia- 
tion of the intensity along lines radiating from the epicentrum, we 
should have the means of computing the depth of the focus. Thus, 
if O be the focus and E the epicentrum and P any point at a dis- 


tance from the epicentrum, the intensity at P would be inversely 
proportional to the square of OP. Calling EP = 2,0 P=r, and 
OE = q, and designating by a the intensity at unit distance and 
by y the intensity at any other distance x, we have the equation: 


~ 


This equation corresponds to a curve whose figure is approxi- 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 19 


mately represented in the diagram, and the curve will have a point 
of inflexion at which the decrease in the value of y as EP in- 
creases will be a maximum. Differentiating the equation twice 
and equating the value of the second differential coefficient to zero 
will give us the co-ordinates of this point of inflexion. The value 
of the abscissa of this point will be | 


ie 
V3 


Ui yi —— 


From this value the constant a has disappeared, showing that it 
is independent of the intensity of the original shock and dependent 
upon the depth alone. The application of this analysis to the 
problem is as follows: As we recede from the épicentrum the inten- 
sity diminishes, but it does not diminish at a uniform rate with the 
distance. ‘There is some critical distance from the epicentrum at 
which the rate of decrease of intensity has a maximum yalue. 
This critical distance depends upon the depth of the focus and 
upon nothing else, and the magnitude of this distance is equal to 
the depth divided by 3, and, conversely, the depth of the focus 
is equal to the critical distance multiplied by 1/3. If, then, we can 
locate the epicentrum and the points where the intensity diminishes 
with greatest rapidity, we have at once the means of determining 
the depth of the focus. In the case of the Charleston earthquake 
this location has been approximately made and a depth of about 
twelve miles has been deduced for the focus of the principal shock. 

After a description of Mallet’s second method of investigation by 
the observation of the overturning power of earthquakes, the sub- 
ject was discussed by the President and by Messrs. H. Farquuar, 
GILBERT, and Dutton. 


Mr. F. W. CLarkeE made an oral communication on the 


MANCHESTER MEETING OF THE BRITISH ASSOCIATION FOR THE 
ADVANCEMENT OF SCIENCE, 1887. 


Remarks upon this communication were made by Mr. ABBE. 


20 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 
306TH MEETING. OcToBER 29, 1887. 
> 
The President in the Chair. 


Forty-one members and guests present. 


Announcement was made by the President of the election to and 
acceptance of membership of Mr. Jrsss Herman Homes. 

The President also referred to the loss sustained by the scientific 
world in the death of Prof. Spencer F. Barrp, and announced 
that the General Committee had taken the preliminary steps for 
arranging a memorial meeting in commemoration of his life and 
scientific work. 


Mr. CLEvELAND ABBE read the following paper entitled 
THE SIGNAL SERVICE BIBLIOGRAPHY OF METEOROLOGY. 


Mr. ABBE stated that in 1872 he began, at his own expense 
and for personal use, a more systematic collection of the titles of 
works bearing upon all subjects that he was interested in, especially 
meteorology. After corresponding in 1874 with the committee 
of the Royal Society as to the probability of the publication of 
their proposed subject-index to their Catalogue of scientific papers, 
and being officially informed that this work would not be under- 
taken, he decided to complete his systematic examination of all 
the titles in that great work and copy the appropriate ones for 
his own use. In 1878, when this work was nearly completed, so far 
as regards the first six volumes, he addressed a note to Prof. Hann, 
of Vienna, stating what he had done and inquiring whether any 
one in Europe was similarly engaged. Almost simultaneously with 
this Prof. Hann received and published’ a letter from Dr. Hell- 
mann, of Berlin, dated January 10, 1879, urging the importance of 
a general index to the literature of meteorology. This letter had 
evidently been suggested by a circular issued in October, 1878, by 
the permanent committee of the first meteorological congress at 
Vienna, proposing a programme for the second congress about to 
be held at Rome in the approaching month of April, 1879. In this 
circular the committee asked that the delegates prepare catalogues 


1Ztschr. Met., Wien, 1879, xiv, 96. 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 21 


of the meteorological observations, published or unpublished, for 
their respective countries. 

At the Rome conference Dr. Hellmann’s letter was presented on 
April 21 and by the congress referred to the newly-appointed Inter- 
national meteorological committee. The congress also adopted 
resolutions’ asking the delegates to prepare lists of the observations 
for their respective countries, and the directors of meteorological 
libraries to add lists of the works not found in the published library 
catalogues of the Meteorological society of London and the observ- 
atory at Brussels, or in Mr. Abbe’s cards. 

After the meeting at Rome Mr. Abbe received a letter from Dr. 
Hellmann, to which he replied August 22, 1879, offering to co- 
operate in the preparation of a general bibliography and to transfer 
his cards either to the International meteorological committee or to 
Dr. Hellmann personally, on the repayment of his expenses. 

At the same time a similar offer was made to General Myer, 
Chief signal officer, under the impression that the latter would be 
pleased to complete the work as an official matter. 

At the first or Berne meeting of the International meteorological 
committee in August, 1880, letters of Dr. Hellmann were read 
dated January 20 and July 20, 1880, giving a detailed scheme for 
combining the various works and for the preparation of a catalogue, 
and embodying Mr. Abbe’s proposal of August, 1879, as well as 
a similar one from Mr. G. J. Symons of London’. The committee, 
however, resolved that each country be requested to furnish lists 
of observations and that Messrs. Scott and Hellmann be a sub- 
committee to consider the means of carrying out Dr. Hellmann’s 
scheme.* 

In the fall of 1881, Mr. Abbe wrote to Mr. Symons for more de- 
tails as to his work. Mr. Symons’ reply and Mr. Abbe’s renewal 
of his previous offer were then laid before General Hazen, Chief 
signal officer, who decided to purchase the catalogues of both these 
gentlemen with a view to their combination and completion by the 
Signal office in case the International committee did not do this. 
In November, 1881, Mr. Symons was authorized to prepare at the 
expense of the Signal office, a copy of all meteorological titles in his 


?Rep. pr. internat. meteoral. cong. Rome 1879, Lond., 1879, p. 21, 75. 
3 Rep. pr. internat, meteoral. comm. Berne 1880, eee , 1881, p. 38, 40. 
4Thid., p. 8-9. 


22 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


collection, and in December, 1881, M- Abbe’s cards were pur- 
chased. 

Mr. Symons’ catalogue was received in October, 1883, and on 
March 4, 1884, Mr. C. J. Sawyer, librarian of the Signal office, 
was relieved from the care of the library, and, as bibliographer, 
ordered to devote his whole time to the completion of this work, 
which was then transferred from the library to the study room 
division of the Signal office. 

At the second meeting of the International meteorological com- 
mittee, at Copenhagen, in August, 1882, Messrs. Scott and Hell- | 
mann reported that the Meteorological office could not print the 
proposed catalogue and that subscriptions were not practicable. 
They therefore recommended each meteorological service to publish 
a national bibliography, for which Hellmann’s Repertorium der 
deutschen Meteorologie, prepared in accordance with the ideas of 
the committee and now just about to be published, should serve as 
a model. It need only be added that since 1882 the International 
meteorological committee have, with other meteorologists, acqui- 
esced in the arrangement by which the Signal service has under- 
taken to complete and, if possible, publish for its own and for gen- 
eral use a general index to the literature of meteorology. 

The importance of this work is especially endorsed by General 
Greely, who, in his current annual report, October, 1887, as Chief 
signal officer, says: 


The practical value of such a bibliography has been fully shown 
by its constant use in current office work, and, in addition to the 
official demands, almost daily calls for information have been re- 
ceived from parties not connected with the service. The result of 
this work is the collection of special bibliographies, which ensures 
those consulting it a complete index of what has been accomplished 
in each special line of meteorology. As has been well said, the 
progress of meteorology is retarded and labor therein wasted owing 
to the impossibility of ascertaining what has been done in its various 
branches—an experience which, as scientific men well know, is by 
no means confined to this science. The cost of time and labor to 
the Government for the preparation of this work cannot be less than 
$12,000 to $15,000, and the result of these labors has been the com- 
pletion of a work which is of great value, both practically and sci- 
entifically, to the entire world. The catalogue in its present condi- 
tion is valuable, and sufficient for the pressing needs of this service, 
but to view it in this light would evince a narrow and selfish dispo- 
sition not in keeping with the scientific spirit of the age. At a cost 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 93 


of probably $8,000 or $19,000 this work can be printed and dis- 
tributed to the world as a monument and evidence of the growing 
scientific tendency of this nation. If such action is taken by Con- 
gress, the Chief Signal Officer has no doubt, from the willing spirit 
and hearty co-operation shown by leading scientists of other coun- 
tries, that future international co-operation will secure, by a system 
of rotation, from the various European governments the publication 
of a series of supplements which will keep the world abreast of the 
steadily increasing volume of meteorological publications. A large 
number of American and foreign meteorologists and librarians have 
given largely of their time and energy in the compilation of this 
bibliography, as is shown by the fact that over one-half of the mate- 
rial has been contributed from foreign countries, so that the bibli- 
ography represents not only a large expenditure on the part of the 
United States, but also many years of additional gratuitous labor. 
The material could not be duplicated, and it would seem but a re- 
spectable reciprocity of exchange that the Government should print 
the catalogue, so as to enable the voluntary contributors to avail 
themselves of the complete work. This fulfilment of obligations to 
contributors by a public catalogue is an act of justice; but, in addi- 
tion, it should be considered that this bibliography will be of great 
practical value to the agricultural, commercial, engineering, and 
medical interests not only of the United States, but of the world. 


Mr. ABBE stated that he had asked Mr. Sawyer to present to the 
Philosophical society some account of his work, now nearing com- 
pletion, but, as he could not be present, Mr. Abbe read the following 
memorandum prepared by Mr. Sawyer: 


MEMORANDUM ON THE SIGNAL SERVICE BIBLIOGRAPHY OF 
METEOROLOGY AND TERRESTRIAL MAGNETISM. 


The bibliographical work of the Signal office dates from 1881, 
and officially originated in correspondence begun by Prof. Abbe 
with Prof. G. J. Symons, of London, Dr. G. Hellmann, of Berlin, 
and Dr. A. Lancaster, of Brussels, who all manifested the greatest 
interest in the proposed catalogue and have been the most impor- 
tant contributors to it. 

The meteorological titles in the Catalogue of scientific papers. 
Compiled by the Royal society of London, vols. i-vi (z800-1863), had 
already been selected and extracted by Prof. Abbe and were trans- 
ferred to the Signal office in December, 1881, on the repayment of 
the expenses incurred by him in the work. At the request of the 
Signal office. Prof. Symons undertook to furnish copies of all titles 
on meteorology and terrestrial magnetism contained in his extensive 


24 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


collection of titles on astronomy, meteorology, and allied sciences, 
the expense to the office to be only his actual outlay for clerical 
assistance. Prof. Symons’ catalogue already represented many 
years of bibliographical research, and to it he now added many 
titles, securing the co-operation of European meteorologists by per- 
sonal visits and by correspondence, and including the more impor- 
tant English libraries. 

This catalogue was received late in 1883, about two years having 
been spent in its compilation; it consisted of about 18,000 titles, 
chiefly of separate works, and may be considered as the foundation 
of the present bibliography. No further work was done until 
March, 1884, when an effort to secure the services of Prof. Lancaster 
having failed, the librarian of the Signal office was assigned to the 
work of preparing the catalogue for publication. 

The original intention had been to extend Prof. Symons’ work 
only by the combination of titles from the Royal Society catalogue, 
including those in vols. vii and viii (1864-1873), selected but 
not yet copied by Prof. Abbe, the catalogue to be arranged by 
authors and to form only a first contribution to the general meteoro- 
logical bibliography desired. 

But the large amount of material on hand, and the conviction 
that some recent contributions to the subject, especially the Reper- 
torium der deutschen Meteorologie by Dr. Hellmann, should be in- 
cluded, and that the periodical literature previous to 1800 and 
subsequent to 1873 should be represented, led to the consideration 
of an enlargement in the scope of the work. It was foreseen that 
the necessary delay in securing an appropriation for publication 
would afford opportunity for still further extension, and it was 
decided March 15, 1884, to complete the compilation so far as 
possible without postponing publication for this purpose and to 
issue an approximately complete general bibliography, of such form 
as to serve as a basis for supplementary volumes. 

In pursuance of this plan, every effort has been made to secure 
contributions, especially by indexing periodicals, by examination of 
printed and manuscript catalogues and bibliographies, and by cor- 
respondence with meteorologists and librarians. 

The lacunz in periodical literature have been filled by indexing 
all periodicals available previous to 1800 and subsequent to 1873, 
and by the examination of all indexes, bibliographies, &ec., avail- 
able, such as Reuss, Young, Poggendorff, Kerl, Fortschritte der 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 25 


Physik, and many others. It was found that the general indexing 
of the Royal society for the period from 1800 to 1878, was not 
full enough for this special bibliography, and all periodicals rich in 
meteorological literature were reindexed. 

The International meteorological committee had already consid- 
ered the subject of meteorological bibliography, and, unable to secure 
at once the publication of a general bibliography, had recommended 
that each country compile a list of its own observations and that 
special national bibliographies be prepared wherever possible. 
Some work had been done in accordance with this recommendation, 
especially in Germany and Russia, and an attempt was made by 
the Signal office to secure the extension of this work and to obtain 
from foreign meteorologists and librarians, bibliographies for their 
respective countries. The great interest in the work was shown by 
the hearty co-operation from all sections. 

Among the special bibliographies received the following may be 
mentioned as among the most complete and valuable: Germany, by 
Dr. Hellmann; Japan, by Dr. Knipping; Norway, by Prof. Mohn ; 
Poland, by Prof. Karlinski; Portugal, by J. C. de Brito—Capello ; 
Roumania, by Dr. Hepites; Russia, by Profs. Wild and Woeikof ; 
South Africa, by Dr. Gamble; Sweden, by C. G. Fineman and C. 
Annerstedt ; Victoria, by R. L. J. Ellery. 

All the meteorological libraries of the world are represented, in- 
cluding, as worthy of special mention, those of the Meteorological 
office and Royal Meteorological Society, of London; the Societé 
météorologique de France, Paris; the large manuscript collection 
of Prof. Poey, the Ronald’s, Poulkova, and Brussels catalogues, all 
contained in the catalogue of Prof. Symons; the Deutsche Seewarte, 
Hamburg (including the library of the late Prof. Dove), and the 
k. k. Central-Anstalt, of Vienna (with that of Prof. Hann), added 
by the Signal office. The number of scientific and general libraries 
represented is very large. 

Letters, requesting lists of their works, were sent to about 400 
writers (exclusive of those in Germany, where this method had been 
employed by Dr. Hellmann), and the replies received have been of 
the greatest value in the representation of living authors. 

The desirability of securing as great completeness as possible, the 
expectation of an early publication, and the fact that the Symons 
and Hellmann catalogues ceased with 1881, led to the adoption of 
this date as the close of the bibliography, and the following state- 


26 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ment of the titles on hand includes only those of works published 
before January 1,1882. <A large amount of material for subsequent 
years has been collected but has not been submitted to classification. 
It may be included in supplementary volumes, or incorporated with 
the bibliography if publication be delayed. 

The chief sources of material and approximate number of titles 
added to the bibliography, after the rejection of duplicates, are as 
follows : 


Prof. Symons’ catalogue ; : ‘ : : . 18,000 
Royal Society catalogue, i-viii : : Z : j 11,000 
Hellmann, Repertorium . 5,000 
Printed catalogues and bibliographies, including R Reuss, Poggendorf ‘ 
&e. (400 vols.) ¢ : 4,000 
Manuscript catalogues and bibliographies . . : . 3,000 
Periodicals indexed (6,400 vols.) . , : : 3 12,000 
Total number before final revision . - - 53,000 


Number of independent titles after final revision, about 50,000 


The duplication of titles by double classification will increase the 
number of entries to about 55,000. 

The form adopted for the work is that of a classed subject cata- 
logue, with full author index. The general plan of the subject 
catalogue is similar to that of the Poulkova catalogue and that 
adopted by Drs. Houzeau and Lancaster for their Bibliographie 
générale de Pastronomie, the arrangement being chronological under 
each subject. The classification is based upon a scheme submitted 
by Dr. Lancaster, at the request of the Signal office, some minor 
modifications having been made after careful study and consulta- 
tion with other meteorologists and bibliographers. 

The general divisions of the classification are shown by the fol- 
lowing outlines : 


A. History and bibliography. 
LG  duekeorelos B. General and collected works. 
areas 8Y-1 ©. Organization and methods. 
D. Instruments. 
(1. Temperature. 
= : 
(A. Physics of the at- } 3. scat 
| Zouaphena. ls Optical phenomena. 
TL ‘theoratieat aes 5 ma is 
teorology. BO NWidahinnios. Or ake 2 Generali 
| atmosphere. Storess! 
L 


C. Cosmic relations of wis eee 


GENERAL MEETINGS. aT 


A. Weather prediction. 

B. Agricultural meteorology. 
. Medical meteorology. 
. Climatology. 


C 
D 
A. General. 
B 


. Observations, instruments, and 


& d methods. 
IV. Terrestrial magnetism. : Gl Waning: 


D. Distribution. 
E. Connection with meteorology. 


III. Applied meteorology. 


VY. Observations (meteorological and magnetic) classed geographically. 


These have been largely subdivided, the number of divisions em- 
ployed in the preliminary classification being 169. This number 
will be varied somewhat in revision, the final classification depend- 
ing largely on the number and character of the titles in each class. 

The following example will indicate the character of the subdi- 
vision : 

. General. 
. Description. 
. Height. 


II. A. 5. f. Aurora. 14 4. Frequency. 
5. Periodicity. 
6 


—_, 
ohre 


. Connection with meteorological phenomena. 
7. Connection with terrestrial magnetism. 


The classification has been from originals, where possible, and all 
resources of the libraries available have been used for this purpose, 
Where access to the work or article was not possible, correspondence 
was maintained for the explanation of doubtful titles. The assign- 
ment of cards to their subjects has been completed, but they are not 
yet arranged under their respective heads. Consequently, no state- 
ment of the number of titles under each class can yet be made, but 
a rough estimate shows that of the 50,000 titles about 5,000 will be 
under observations and 3,000 under terrestrial magnetism, leaving 
about 42,000 entries for meteorological discussions. 

The author index is similar to that adopted by Drs. Houzeau and 
Lancaster, giving under the full name of the author, and for each 
title, an abbreviation of the subject under which it is classed, the 
date of publication, and the reference. The index, as completed, 
contains about 12,500 authors, or an average of four independent 
titles for each author. A biographical note may be included under 
each author. 

The bibliography will be completed early in 1888, the only work 


now remaining being arrangement by subjects, revision, sub-class- 


28 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ification of observations, preparation of subject index and periodical 
list. The technical preparation of copy will follow when the appro- 
priation for publication is made. 


This communication was discussed by Messrs. Mann, Fiercuer, 
Marcus Baker, GILBERT, and the author. 


Mr. Lester F. WarpD made a communication 
ON THE GEOGRAPHICAL DISTRIBUTION OF FOSSIL PLANTS, 


illustrated by a map. 


[This paper will appear in full in the Eighth Annual Report of the U.S. 
Geological Survey, for the fiscal year 1886-’87.] 


307TH MEETING. NoveMBER 12, 1887. 
The President in the Chair. 
Fifty-two members and guests present. 


Announcement was made by the President of the election to and 
acceptance of membership of WiLL1AM Henry Bascocx. 


Mr. C. E. Durron presented a communication which had been 
jointly prepared by himself and Mr. 8. Newcoms on 


THE SPEED OF PROPAGATION OF THE CHARLESTON EARTHQUAKE. 


[This paper appeared in full in The American Journal of Science, 3d 
series, 8°, New Haven, 1888, January, vol. 35, pp. 1-15.] 


This paper was briefly discussed by Mr. CLARK and Mr. Dutton. 
Mr. HARKNESS read a paper 
ON THE REPRESENTATION OF COMET ORBITS BY MODELS, 


illustrated by card-board models. 


[This paper appeared in The Sidereal Messenger; conducted by Wm. W. 
Payne. 8°. Northfield, Minn., Carleton College observatory, 1887, Decem- 
ber, vol. 6, No. 10, pp. 829-349. ] 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 29 
308TH MEETING. NovEeMBER 26, 1887. 
The President in the Chair. 


Fifty members and guests present. 


A circular letter from the New York Academy of Sciences, re- 
questing co-operation in erecting a monument to the memory of the 
ornithologist Audubon, was laid before the Society by the Secretary. 


Mr. G. K. GiLtpert presented a communication entitled 


STATISTICS OF THE PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY FROM ITS 
FOUNDATION. 


[ Abstract. ] 


The following data, except when otherwise noted, are compiled 
from the published records of the Society.* 

The Society was organized March 13, 1871, with a membership 
of 44, and this was increased during the same year by the election 
of 17. In each succeeding year new members were elected, the 
smallest number being 8, in 1876, and the largest 35, in 1884. 
From time to time members have been dropped from the list for 
non-payment of dues, others have died, and others resigned. The 
average annual number of new members has been 18. The total 
number of resignations has been 24. The membership has always 
been classified as resident and non-resident, or “active” and 
“absent.” From time to time a list of the members has been pub- 
lished in the Bulletin, and since 1879 these lists have been annual. 
The following table shows the number of active members at each of 
the indicated dates. It also shows the gross annual accession to 
membership, and likewise the average attendance at ordinary meet- 
ings for each year, beginning with 1875, previous to which time the 
attendance is not noted in the published minutes. The year 1882 
had the minimum attendance, 34, and 1887 the maximum, 49. The 
general average of attendance at meetings for the reading of papers 
is 40; at meetings for the election of officers, 36. 


*The paper, as read, did not include the statistics for 1887, which were 
necessarily imperfect at that time. The abstract for printing was brought 
down to December 21, 1887, the date of the annual meeting. Certain indi- 
cated data on membership were brought only to December 1, 1887. 


30 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


TABLE I. 


Membership and Attendance of the Philosophical Society, by Years. 


22 ap | $2 
aA GIN Ge Ae a Ue 
Z --o LE om no | 
if z=) o& "82 ? DS New societies or 
eee 3 5 ae oS a Bre ganized. 
E 255 pos o4 
> ee Bee 22S 
® o2°0o > a & Bsc 
Zi A < a 
us ys eames) it rf ae Se yd se 
1872 eco)h) 24 sesh cere ee 
LST oe 2a 2S ieee ee eee ee 
1874 sou hla nesses 
1875-2]: 22) 24, Meets 35 .29 
Meh (KO) soe Biel ae a oe a Se 37 es 
1S 2e =) LO Sif 255 aa 40 ay 
1878 ___- Bi a cs Mit Bde pera 40 oh 
1879 ...-|, 22 | 185, Apr, 2 -- 40 29 Anth. Soc., Feb. 17. 
1880... 19 | 154, July 20__ 41 | Biol. Soc., Dec. 3. 
1881...) 18. | 162, dimly 182: 38 25 
1882 2...) 16 | 149, May i... 34 .23 
1883 42.4), 17 9-149, Dee 31-2 38 26 Math. Sec., Mar. 29. 
1884 _.-..| 385 | 178, Dee. 20_+ 42 .26 Chem. Soc., Jan. 31. 
1885_---| 22 | 179, Jan.16__| 47 OR 
PESGet2— |, 718 183, Dec. 18_- 47 AAG 
VSSieSe a lo aLOle Mec iale ae 49 .26 
Meaniues!” 18.6 | seen ayo 40 .265 


In a general way there has been a continuous growth of the So- 
ciety as regards membership, and the rate of growth, whether con- 
sidered as a geometric ratio or as an arithmetic increment, has 
progressively diminished. The average attendance has likewise 
increased, but its law is not evident. The ratio of attendance to 
membership has ranged in ten recorded years from .23 to .29, the 
mean being .265. 

The total active membership passed through a secondary maximum 
in 1880 and a minimum in 1882-’83. The current attendance 
exhibits a subsidiary maximum from 1877-’80 and a minimum in 
1882. The curve of accessions shows maxima in 1874, 1879, and 
1884. While there are many series of contemporaneous events 
with which these might be compared,,one only will be considered, 
namely, the formation of other scientific societies in ‘Washington 
and the formation of the Mathematical Section within our Society. 


GENERAI MEETINGS. ou 


The Anthropological Society was organized February 17, 1879, and 
has now a membership of 154. The Biological Society was organ- 
ized December 3, 1880, and has a membership of 174. The Mathe- 
matical Section of the Philosophical Society held its first meeting 
March 29, 1883. The Chemical Society was organized January 31, 
1884, and now numbers 44 members. During the two years fol- 
lowing the institution of the Anthropological Society our Society 
witnessed maxima in the accession to membership, in the total 
membership, in the attendance, and in the ratio of attendance to 
membership. During the two years following the foundation of 
the Biological Society each of these quantities reached or passed a 
minimum. ‘The year of the organization of the Mathematical Sec- 
tion was characterized by an increase of attendance, but not of 
membership. In the four years elapsed since the beginning of the 
Chemical Society our membership and attendance have steadily 
increased, their ratio remaining constant. If the relation of our 
record to the Biological Society only were considered, it would be 
easy to infer that our Society suffered from the formation of another 
scientific society, but a contrary inference would be drawn from a 
comparison of our record with the histories of the Anthropological 
and Chemical Societies, and in view of all the facts it appears proper 
to conclude that our membership and attendance have not been 
materially influenced by the organization of the other societies. 

The data of attendance have been, classified by months likewise 
and finally by half-months, with the result which appears in Table 
II. The data cover a period of 12 years, but are somewhat imper- 
fect. To diminish the error from imperfection of record, a general 
correction for annual phase was applied to all the observations— 
that is to say, they were all reduced to consistency with a mean 
attendance of 40. Only ordinary meetings for the reading of papers 
were included, and the year 1887 was omitted because the attend- 
ance appeared to be greatly affected by the change of quarters 
(March 26) from the Army Medical Museum to the Assembly Hall 
of the Cosmos Club. 


on PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


. 


TABLE II. 


Average Attendance at Ordinary Meetings for Hach Half-Month, 
Compiled from Records for 11 Years, 1875-1886. 


October, first half =... 39:8; March; first half. 22-2222 eee 
6 second half._-. ..-. 40.5 Li second half (eee 40.3 
November, first half ------ .--- 45.0 | April, first half .--...-._-.-.. 48.0 
ve second half____ -__. 43.9 be second half.2_ = saya 40.3 
December)~ first half 2-22 222 -"43°2)|\May, “first half 222" 32s see StS 
second half._-.--__ 40.8 ts second half____ ____ SEB ee 
January, — first half _...-.__ 61.6,| June, ‘first half 2... 2c 33.7 
st second half__.. ..... 45.9 a second half os ss eneee 28.6 
February, first half _--..+--_. 41.3 
3 second half ._..-.-. 41.0 


In compiling the statistics of papers or communications before 
the Society, everything has been included which was prepared or 
announced beforehand, whether offered independently or as part of 
a symposium, but the remarks of one member upon the communica- 
tion of another have not been included. The impossibility of other- 
wise making a consistent distinction has led to the inclusion of every 
exhibition of apparatus and every reading of a letter upon a scien- 
tific subject. The biographical memoirs of deceased members which 
have from time to time been read are included, but not the com- 
memorative resolutions. 

The Society has listened in 17 years to 713 papers, as thus de- 
fined, an average of 42 per year. Six hundred and ninety- 
two of these have been presented before ordinary meetings, an 
average of 41 per year. There have been in the same period 
277 ordinary meetings, and the average number of papers per 
meeting has been 2.5. The number of ordinary meetings and 
the total number of meetings per year were both somewhat greater 
in the earlier history of the Society than in the later, a tendency 
having developed to omit one or two meetings in June. There 
were also more papers read in the earlier years than in the 
later, and the diminution in papers has been slightly greater than the 
diminution in the number of meetings, so that the average number 
of papers per meeting has fallen off from 2.8 to 2.4. 

For the purpose of exhibiting the subjects which have received 
the attention of the Society, the entire series of papers has been 
grouped in ten classes, the discrimination being based on the titles 
and abstracts, and, to some extent, in the absence of abstract, on the 
memory of the compiler. Papers belonging properly to two or 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 33 


more of the selected classes have been entered in each, and such 
duplicate entries have been treated as integers and not as fractions. 
To an extent dependent on this treatment the deduced ratios are 
inaccurate. 

It should be observed that the selection of classes has depended 
largely on the nature of the material to classify. As the statistics 
grew out of the work of indexing the Bulletin, the selection was 
affected by the needs of the indexer, and as it was desired to learn 
the influence of the organization of other societies on the scope of our 
proceedings, the selection was affected by the classification of sub- 
jects among the other societies. The following is the classification: 
Group 1, Mathematics ; Group 2, Astronomy, including calendars; 
Group 3, Physics, including molecular physics, electricity, acous- 
tics, optics, and microscopy, which last subject happens in the litera- 
ture of the Society to be almost entirely optical; Group 4, Chemis- 
try and mineralogy ; Group 5, Meteorology and thermometry ; Group 
6, Geology ; Group 7, Geography, including physical geography, 
surveying, and travel and exploration; Gruup 8, Biology, includ- 
ing zoology, botany, and human anatomy and physiology ; Group 
9, Anthropology, including ethnology, archzology, psychology, an- 
thropometry, political economy, and social science and statistics; 
Group 10, Miscellaneous, chiefly technology, but including also 
biography and general philosophy. It will be seen that chemistry, 
biology, and anthropology are defined so as to include the scopes of 
the Chemical, Biological, and Anthropological Societies. 

For convenience of discussion, the period of 17 years covered by 
the statistics has been divided into five unequal parts, such that three 
of the lines of separation correspond with the epochs of commence- 
ment of the three sister societies. The time divisions begin on the 
years 1871, 1875, 1879, 1881, and 1884, and contain, respectively, 4, 
4, 2,3, and 4 years. At the end of the second the Anthropological 
Society was established, at the end of the third the Biological, at the 
end of the fourth the Chemical. The Mathematical Section was 
organized one year before the Chemical Society. For each time 
division the number of papers of each class was ascertained, and 
from these numbers were computed the percentages which appear in 


Table ITI. 
49 


34 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


TABLE III. 


Percentages of Papers on Different Subjects for Different Periods. 


Periods. 

1871 
Subjects. to 
1871— | 1875- | 1879- | 1881— | 1884- | 1887. 
1874. | 1878. | 1880. | 1883. | 1887. 


1. Mathematics.____....|. 6 5 2 9 


2 5 
2) UAstronomiyge see 23 18 18 7 6 16 
é:° Physics 2.202 2s 10 14 12 12 9 it 
4D \Chemistryieseeasees=s 4 2 6 1 4 3 
5. Meteorology -:_-- ---- Y 5 4 13 11 8 
6) Geology: 2-22), 2222 6 8 9 14 27 13 
i} Geography jest. ae 15 13 7 7 10 11 
8: (Biclogy -= ase ena 9 9 10 9 6 8 
9. Anthropology ~~. ---- 6 15 19 11 3 12 
10. Miscellaneous -___ -__- 12 11 13 Wi 12 13 


100 100 100 100 100 100 


It appears from this table that in the two periods previous to the 
organization of the Anthropological Society the subject of anthro- 
pology furnished first 6 and then 15 per cent. of our material, and 
in the following periods it furnished 19,11, and 15 per cents. Biol- 
ogy furnished in the first three periods 9, 9, and 10 per cents., and 
after the beginning of the Biological Society 9 per cent. and 6 per 
cent. The percentages of chemistry for the first four periods are 4, 2, 
6, and 1, and for the single period of four years since the organization 
of the Chemical Society, 4. These figures show that the organiza- 
tion of scientific societies devoting themselves to the cultivation of 
special scientific fields has not materially affected the interest of our 
Society in the same sciences, so far as that interest may be judged 
by the number of communications presented. 

The table is not arranged to exhibit the effect upon our general 
meeting of the institution of the Mathematical Section, but an inde- 
pendent computation has been made with the following result: In 
12 years previous to the Mathematical Section the Society listened 
to 28 mathematical papers, an average of 2.3 per year, In the five 
years following the general meeting listened to six mathematical 
papers, an average of 1.2 per year. While the amount of mathe- 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 39 


matics before the Society in general meeting has been greatly dimin- 
ished, the subject has not been entirely eliminated. 

The general fact appears to be that the Philosophical Society, 
being composed partly of men with a wide interest in scientific 
matters and partly of specialists in many scientific branches, affords 
a fitting arena for the discussion of subjects of general scientific 
interest, but is not equally adapted to the presentation of highly 
specialized researches. By a process of natural and unconscious 
selection it has discountenanced those papers which from their 
nature can interest only the devotees of a single science, and it, 
therefore, has not fully met the needs of the scientific community of 
Washington. The natural and proper result has been the institu- 
tion, without and within the Society, of organizations undertaking 
the cultivation of narrower fields, and these have found material of 
their own without detraction of material which natually came to us. 
In anthropology, in biclogy, in chemistry, and in mathematics we 
still receive the communications which have a broad interest, and, 
as such papers are largely written from a philosophic point of view, 
it may well be that we are gainers by the multiplication of organi- 
zations. 

But while the modifications which have occurred in the ratios 
in which various subjects have been represented on the floor of the 
Society do not indicate an important yielding of our program to 
outside influence, they do indicate progressive tendencies in other 
directions. Astronomy, which during the first period was the lead- 
ing theme, with a percentage of 23, has fallen, through 18, 18, and 
7, to 6 per cent.; geography, with 15 per cent. and 13 per cent. for 
the first two periods, has 7, 7, and 10 for the last three. Geology, on 
the other hand, with 6 per cent. at first, has increased steadily, 
through 8, 9, and 14, to 27 per cent., and anthropology and meteor- 
ology, while exhibiting fluctuations, have on the whole increased 
their percentages. During the first period astronomy and geography 
together gave 5 times as many papers as geology; during the last 
period their combined volume is only two-thirds that of geology. 
The general explanation is not far to seek. Geology has gained in 
importance on the floor of the Society because of the rapid growth 
of the Geological Survey, which has brought to the city and to the 
Society a large number of geologists. The increased attention of 
the Society to meteorology is traceable to the establishment of the 
Study Room of the Weather Bureau, and the increase in anthro- 


36 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


pology is correlated with the growth of the Bureau of Ethnology. 
The great modification in the relative attention given to different 
subjects is due to the large amount of new blood acquired by the 
Society. 

The statistics of the Mathematical Section are exhibited in the 
following table: 


TaBLeE IV. 
Statisties of the Mathematical Section from its Establishment to 1887. 


Wapiti ss aoe gs eS eye 1888. | 1884. | 1885. | 1886. | 1887. - 
Number ofpmectings == As 0 eek 9 6 6 2 12 
Number of communications ___-__. ._-.| ~18 11 14 3 20 
Average'attendince ls oO Loe se kee. 15 15 15 16 17 
Number-ofmemibers) 008 Jo ee 8b 3 41 40 44 


The whole number of papers presented to the Society, including 
those addressed to ordinary and special meetings and to the Mathe- 
matical Section, has been 786, and they have been communicated 
by 184 persons. Fifty-seven guests and correspondents of the So- 
ciety have furnished 67 papers, and 127 members have furnished 
719. The total number of persons who have at various times been 
elected to the Society is 312, and two-fifths of these have contributed 
something more than remarks to the proceedings. 

The following numerical data concerning the membership and 
common membership of the Philosophical and three other scientific 
societies were derived from what is known as the “Consolidated List 
of the Philosophical Society,” a list containing the names of the 
active members of the four societies and the resident members of 
the Cosmos Club. The list had been corrected to December 1, 1887. 
In Table V the Anthropological, Biological, Chemical, and Philo- 
sophical Societies are indicated by the initial letters of their names. 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 37 
TABLE V. 


Common Membership of Four Societies. 


Members of | Members of | Members of | Members of all four___-_-__- 3 
one only. two only. | three only. ee three only __--__ 34 
ce three or more___ 387 
Mees FOAL, Bice ae Bs On yn two only -----_- 78 
eee LOU WAR C2 2 as VAC Be P28 ss 
Ores 22) EAC 28 ACO. Bake ‘f two or more -_-- 115 
peer (OL enon 22) Ossie. "oO a oneonly 22.3... 293 
DB eed Ben 5) 
Oba cphecag 0, 
293 78 34 Total number of persons__ 408 
Total memberships. Overlap, by pairs. 
Nea eee ce eee ee eee ee A, | WAC BS oie ee el ee ee ee AS 
eee ten aren ee EAE pe eS UTA PAR IC). Eee | es nie Ea ge a a 
Al Renee SR ee! VAS Ae ee ee UY os Va GD, 
SE aL ee San Fae at IS 1 LS il 5a ay Se a rents A ene gs) 
omc (i Se Se et pe Rae OS 
Eee ee pe eee RL OO, | Com reat as oe Se ee Bu eG 
INGt bOta he ee eee 408 


Difference (due to overlap). 155 


Fifty-two per cent. of the members of the Philosophical Society 
are likewise in one or more of the other societies. The correspond- 
ing percentages for the other societies are: Chemical, 50; Anthro- 
pological, 49; Biological, 42. 

The Cosmos Club has a resident membership of 227, of whom 
128, or 56 per cent., belong to one or more of the four societies. 


38 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 
Mr. M. H. DoouirrLeE read a paper 
ON NEWTON’S VIS, 
and was followed by 
Mr. B: Pickman Mann, who read a paper 
ON REFERENCE INDEXING. 


[Abstract. ] 


The author described in part the systems of indexing the litera- 
ture of science which he had practised for many years, with illus- 
trative examples and an argument to show their general mie 
bility and value. 

He commented upon the extent and variety of the literature 
of science as a whole, and the impossibility of obtaining a knowl- 
edge of the literature relating to special departments of research 
without the aid of indices prepared for the purpose. He then 
dwelt upon the multitude of separate, partial indices now in ex- 
istence, upon the difficulties experienced in making use of these 
indices, and the waste of labor expended in disconnected attempts 
to obviate these difficulties. He adverted to the advantages which 
would accrue to all students through co-operative effort to obviate 
the difficulties described, and remarked upon the necessity, in case 
such co-operation were to take place, of determining upon a system 
of carrying it out. He considered the advantages which would be 
gained for temporary purposes by the combination of existing in- 
dices into one index to be the property of the co-operators and 
accessible either directly or mediately to all persons interested. He 
then passed to a consideration of systems by which indices have 
been constructed hitherto, and those which should obtain in the 
formation of such an index as was contemplated here. 


309TH MEETING. DerEcEMBER 10, 1887. 


By courtesy of the trustees of the Columbian University the 
meeting was held in the law lecture-room of the University building. 
Invitations to “yourself and friends” to attend the meeting had 
been mailed to all members of the Anthropological, Biological, and 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 39 


Chemical Societies, and of the Cosmos Club. About one hundred 
persons were present. 


Vice-President MALLERY presided. 
President HARKNEss then presented his annual address, the sub- 
ject being 
THE PROGRESS OF SCIENCE AS EXEMPLIFIED IN THE ART OF 
WEIGHING AND MEASURING. 


[Printed in full on page xxxvii of this volume. ] 


A vote of thanks for the address was passed by the audience. 


310TH MEETING. DECEMBER 21, 1887. 


THE SEVENTEENTH ANNUAL MEETING. 


The President in the Chair. 
Thirty-eight members present. 
The minutes of the 294th, 308th, and 309th meetings were read 
and approved. 


The President announced the election to and acceptance of mem- 
bership of Mr. JosepH WILLIAM SPENCER. 


The annual report of the Secretaries was read and accepted. 
[Printed in full on pp. Xxx1I, xxxu1I of this volume. ] 


The annual report of the Treasurer was read and referred to an 
auditing committee consisting of Messrs. J. 8. Billings, J. C. Well- 
ing, and C. O. Boutelle. 

[Treasurer’s report printed in full on pp. XxxIv, xxxv of this volume. ] 

The Treasurer read the list of members entitled, under Standing 
Rule 14, to vote at the annual meeting. 


The constitutional amendment proposed by Mr. Dau at the 
last annual meeting was adopted by a vote of 26 for to 3 against it. 


Election of officers was then held. 


[The result is printed on page xv of this volume. ] 


The rough minutes of the meeting were then read and the Society 
adjourned. 


1 Wika ape 
‘toying « 


sa) le 
: st ind f ¢i 
STW ee! Fe ae A; 4 ihe ae 


ees ry vey eee RTT, Coen 


; phe ee ; + ae ee ee Ba om ie? tnd f es et ee feoaerts Lt k i 


vy A‘ ; : Coe oie bs on } 
ia ; wg, ‘ ‘ KM OAs Pipa Ae fm 


PROCEEDINGS 


AT A MEETING COMMEMORATIVE OF 


THE LIFE AND SCIENTIFIC WORK 


SeRNCERY FULLERTON BAIRD, 
HELD JANUARY 11, 1888, 


ANTHROPOLOGICAL, BIOLOGICAL, AND PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETIES 
OF WASHINGTON. 


(41) 


INTRODUCTION. 


On August 19, 1887, Spencer FuLieRTon Bairp, Secretary of 
the Smithsonian Institution, Director of the U. S. National Museum, 
and U.S. Commissioner of Fish and Fisheries, died at Wood’s Holl, 
Massachusetts, his post of duty in the last named office. His death 
at once excited throughout the world feelings and expressions of 
profound regret. At that time nearly all of his Washington asso- 
ciates in scientific pursuits were absent from the city, on field duty 
or in vacation, and were thus unable to jointly testify to the affec- 
tion and respect in which he was held by them. 

And especially the scientific societies of Washington, none of 
which meet during the summer months, were unable to immediately 
take any action in the matter or to give organized expression to the 
sentiments of their members. 

With the resumption of meetings, however, it was determined 
that such expression should be given with all ceremonial complete- 
ness, and as the senior of the Washington scientific societies, and 
the one with which Professor Baird had been most closely con- 
nected, the Philosophical Society took the initial steps in arranging 
a joint meeting with the Anthropological and Biological Societies, 
a meeting which might enable the members and their friends to 
testify not only their profound respect for this foremost scientific 
leader, but also their affectionate regard for the man. 

The appended invitation and programme, which was mailed to 
all members of the Philosophical, Anthropological, Biological, and 
Chemical Societies, and of the Cosmos Club, sets forth the form 
taken in those arrangements : 

(48) 


44 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


WASHINGTON, January 4, 1888. 
Sir: 

The Philosophical Society in conjunction with the other scientific 
societies of the city will hold a meeting on Wednesday evening, 
January the eleventh, in commemoration of the life and services 
to science of the late Spencer Futierton Barrp, Secretary of 
the Smithsonian Institution, Director of the National Museum, and 
United States Commissioner of Fish and Fisheries. 

Members of the societies, and ladies and gentlemen whom they 
may desire to invite, will assemble in the lecture-room of the Colum- 
bian University, on the southeast corner of H and Fifteenth streets, 
at a quarter past eight o’clock. 


Your presence on this occasion is earnestly desired. 


C. E. Dutton, 

RoBERT FLETCHER, 

J. H. Kipper, 
Committee of Management. 


Opening of the meeting, by the President of the Philosophical 
Society. 

Professor Baird as Administrator, Mr. W. B. Tayntor, of the 
Smithsonian Institution. 

Professor Baird in Science, Mr. W. H. DAtt, President of the Bio- 
logical Society. 


The Personal Characteristics of Professor Baird, Mr. J. W. 
PowELL, President of the Anthropological Society. 


Mr. Garrick Mauuery, President of the Philosophical Society, 
called the meeting to order at the time and place above named. 


RELATIONS BETWEEN PROFESSOR BAIRD AND 
PARTICIPATING SOCIETIES. 


By Mr. Garrick MALLERY, President of the Philosophical Society. 


Lapies AND GENTLEMEN: 


During several winters before 1871, a club, with commingled 
social and scientific purposes, used to meet in this city at the houses 
or its members. <A single paper on some scientific subject was read, 
usually by the host of the evening, following which was a discussion. 
Supper was always provided. The title of the club only related 
to the night of meeting, Saturday, and the organization was so 
loose that several of the survivors among the regular participants 
at the meetings do not now remember whether they were actual 
members, or indeed that there was a definite membership. As the 
city of Washington emerged from the condition of a Southern vil- 
lage, and the benign policy of the Government increased the num- 
ber and force of the scientific institutions at the Capital, the need of 
an organization which should bring scientific men together on an 
equal footing and give more time to papers and their discussion 
became manifest. To meet this want the attendants of the Saturday- 
Night Club, on March 15th, 1871, formed the Philosophical Society 
of Washington, its object, in the words of the call, being “the free 
exchange of views on scientific subjects and the promotion of scien- 
tific inquiry among its members.” 

The term “Philosophical,” as the first president of the Society, 
Joseph Henry, stated in his first address, was chosen after consider- 
able deliberation, “not to denote, as it generally does in the present 
day, the unbounded field of speculative thought, which embraces 
the possible as well as the actual of existence, but to be used in its 
restricted sense to indicate those branches of knowledge that relate 
to the positive facts and laws of the physical and moral universe.” 

Of the forty-three gentlemen who signed the call twenty-one are 
now dead. Professor Baird was prominent among the founders, 
and served continuously as a member of the General Committee from 
the organization to November 10th, 1877, and from that date until 

(45) 


46 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


his death, on August 19th last, he was a member of the Committee'on 
Publications. - 

The first communication of a scientific paper to the Society was 
made by him on March 18th, 1871. The mostimportant and extended 
original papers communicated by him were “On the decrease of 
fish on the southern coast of New England,” presented March 23d, 
1872, and “On the artificial propagation of the cod, describing the 
measures and process adopted at Gloucester, Mass., and the success 
thus far obtained,” presented March 1st, 1879. 

The last-mentioned occasion is memorable to me, and some account 
of it will be interesting to the younger members of the Society, few 
of whom ever heard Professor Baird’s voice raised in its hall. I 
happened to join him on his way to the meeting, and during the walk 
he spoke of the struggle at that moment between the sense of duty 
requiring him to take his part in the proceedings of the Society and 
his repugnance to making any formal address. This modesty— 
indeed, timidity—in an eminent writer and thinker, whose lightest 
words were sure of eager attention in a society composed mainly of 
his personal friends and wholly of his admirers, was the more remark- 
able because his address, presented a few minutes later, was most 
pleasing in its delivery as well as instructive in its substance. He 
spoke without notes, and, though his style was conversational and 
in no degree oratorical, his appropriate words in their rapid flow ex- 
pressed his thoughts clearly, completely, and in orderly sequence. 

During the same walk, Professor Baird mentioned with earnest 
commendation the usage of the Society by which the perfect equality 
of members is recognized through the omission of all official and 
professional titles. This was not a merely unwritten custom but was 
founded on a binding resolution, appearing in the minutes of June 
6th, 1874. The Society is probably the only non-esoteric body in the 
United States in which the titles of Judge and General, Professor and 
Doctor, Governor, Senator, and even Honorable Member are for- 
bidden; the simple and dignified Mr., the modern form of Magister, 
being the only address allowed. Perhaps the plethora of titles and 
the burdensome hierarchical gradations in Washington compelled 
this measure of relief. 

The Anthropological Society was founded February 17th, 1879, its 
defined object being “to encourage the study of the natural history 
of man, especially with reference to America.” Professor Baird 
warmly approved of the organization of this Society, took constant 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 47 


interest in it, and, at the time of his death, was the only honorary 
member residing in the United States on its rolls. 

The Biological Society was organized December 3d, 1880, “to en- 
courage the study of the biological sciences,” and Professor Baird was 
the only honorary member ever elected by it. He did not take an 
active part in the proceedings of either of the last-mentioned socie- 
ties but gave them material assistance, Both of them met at first 
in the Regents’ Room of the Smithsonian Institution, placed by him 
at their disposal, and he provided for the stereotyping and circula- 
tion of their volumes of Transactions, a benefaction which the 
Philosophical Society had earlier enjoyed. 

President Henry, in his address before mentioned, stated that in 
no other city in the United States was there, in proportion to the 
number of its inhabitants, so many men actively engaged in pur- 
suits connected with science as in Washington. In the seven fol- 
lowing years the number of persons in the city engaged in scien- 
tific work was nearly doubled, and most of them joined the Philo- 
sophical Society, so that in the year 1878 it had become recognized 
as the most efficient scientific body on this continent with a mem- 
bership confined to a single locality. The criteria of this superiority 
were not only the large membership and regular attendance of 
members, but the number, quality, and variety of the papers pre- 
sented and discussed. This abundance and, as was proved by the 
later successful establishment of differentiated societies as an over- 
flow, this superabundance of scientific papers occupied every mo- 
ment of the meetings, so that the members, as such, had no oppor- 
tunity to become acquainted with one another or to interchange 
views, except in the formal discussions following the papers an- 
nounced in the printed programs. ‘There was no provision for 
social introduction or intercourse. ‘This appreciated want, the 
converse of the inadequacy of the Saturday-Night Club, resulted 
in the foundation of the Cosmos Club, on December 13th, 1878, 
in the organization of which all the members of the Philosophical 
Society were invited to join. It is needless to descant upon the 
unique character of the Cosmos Club in its membership and objects, 
its vital connection with science, literature, and art, and its imme- 
diate but enduring success. The remark, however, is pertinent that, 
in the winter of 1878, an unprecedented agitation, excited by im- 
pending national legislation, perturbed the scientific circles of the 
Capital, during which the proposition to form the Club was attacked 


48 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


with virulence as a scheme in the selfish interest of a few individ- 
uals, and one fraught with machiavelian political designs ; but when 
Professor Baird manifested his approval of the plan by accepting 
the first presidency of the Club after its formal organization, con- 
fidence in him was so dominant that suspicion was allayed and 
opposition disappeared. To him profound thanks are due for the 
timely establishment of the most important institution in the con- 
joint social and scientific life of Washington. 

But by his work in the organization of these several societies and 
of the Cosmos Club, Professor Baird was, as in his other fields of 
labor, a benefactor and not a participant in the benefits secured to 
others. He was imbued with the cardinal principle of the Smith- 
sonian Institution not only to establish and assist all useful agencies 
for the promotion of the well-being of man, but afterwards, when 
they had attained to successful operation, to leave them to them- 
selves and explore new fields of beneficence. It was also his own 
character, apart from any formulated maxim of the Institution, 
that he could not rest in the personal enjoyment of accomplished 
results. He was one of the ceaseless workers, born 


‘To scorn delights, and live laborious days,” 


until 
‘Comes the blind Fury with th’ abhorred shears 


And slits the thin-spun life. But not the praise!” 


It is for us now, repressing sorrow, to join in tributes of praise to 
our benefactor. 


PROFESSOR BAIRD AS ADMINISTRATOR. 


By Mr. Wo. B. Taytor, of the Smithsonian Institution. 


We are met this evening to express in a memorial service our 
respect for an honored fellow-member of our several societies, lately 
deceased, and to indulge as well in an interchange of affectionate 
reminiscence of a departed friend. ° 

Spencer Fullerton Baird was born at Reading, Pa., February 3, 
1823. He was graduated at Dickinson College, in Carlisle, Pa., in 
1840, at the age of seventeen, and with an original fondness for 
natural history and the study of the out-door world he spent several 
years in his favorite pursuits and in collecting animal specimens 
for preservation. In 1845, at the youthful age of twenty-two, he 
was elected Professor of Natural History in his alma mater—Dick- 
inson College. 

Three years later, in 1848, while still pursuing with ardor the 
study of nature, he applied for and obtained from the Smithsonian 
Institution (then recently established) its first modest grant for the 
promotion of original research. This was to be applied to the ex- 
ploration of bone caves, and to the development of the local natural 
history of southeastern Pennsylvania. The transaction appears to 
have been the occasion of first bringing the young professor to the 
favorable notice of the Smithsonian Director, Professor Henry, and 
of initiating between the two a mutual respect and friendship that 
continued throughout their several lives. 

The early history of the Smithsonian Institution was signalized 
by a long struggle—both in the Board of its Regents and in the 
Halls of Congress—between the votaries of literature and those of 
science for the disposal of the Smithson fund. During this period, 
in 1850, when it was seen that the income of this institution was 
not to be absorbed in the building up of a great National Library, 
Professor Henry asked of the Regents authority to appoint an As- 
sistant Secretary in the department of natural history to take 
charge of the Museum and to aid in the publications and other in- 
terests of the establishment. A resolution authorizing such an 
appointment being adopted, Henry selected Professor Baird, of 

50 (49) 


50 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Dickinson College, as the one well fitted for the place. The ap- 
pointment was unanimously confirmed by the Board July 5, 1850, 
and Professor Baird -being notified at once accepted and entered 
upon his new duties. He deposited in the Museum his own valu- 
able collections, comprising an extensive series of the skins of 
various mammals (European as well as American), a large number 
of bird skins (unmounted), representing about 500 American species 
and half as many European species, a rich variety of birds’ nests 
and birds’ eggs, more than 500 glass jars, tin vessels, and kegs con- 
taining alcoholic specimens of reptiles and fishes, and a number of 
vertebrate skeletons and of fossil remains. 

The new Assistant Secretary was truly in his element, and showed 
himself pre-eminently “the right man in the right place.’ In 
Henry’s Fourth Annual Report (that for 1850), after recording the 
appointment of his Assistant, he adds: “ He entered on his duties 
in July last and, besides being actively engaged in organizing the 
department of natural history, he has rendered important service 
in conducting our foreign exchanges and attending to the business 
of the press.” 

The Smithsonian system of exchanges was instituted for the pur- 
pose of facilitating the reciprocal transmission between the Old World 
and the New of the memoirs of learned societies, and this system has 
become an essential agency in the interchange and diffusion of 
knowledge, and in the more rapid advancement of scientific dis- 
covery, by a wider and prompter co-operation. Previous to this 
inauguration such distant scientific information was so rarely and 
inconveniently accessible, largely through the delays and harass- 
ments of customs exactions, that important principles had not un- 
frequently been re-discovered abroad or at home, and sometimes with 
a considerable interval of time, to subsequently disturb and dispute 
a coveted and settled priority. 

By the urgent zeal of the Smithsonian Director, representing to 
foreign powers that only gratuitous distribution of the literary and 
scientific memoirs of societies or of individuals (not usually found 
on sale) was undertaken by the Institution, and that no commercial 
enterprise calculated in any way to interfere with the legitimate 
operations of trade was attempted—one port after another was 
opened to its packages, until, in the course of a few» years, the an- 
nouncement was made that the Smithsonian exchanges were allowed 


GENERAL MEETINGS. Bil 


to pass through every custom-house on earth, unopened and un- 
questioned. 

Creditable as this special liberality is, it has not yet, unfortunately, 
been applied to the customary channels of book lore, and the quest 
for knowledge is still held by a majority of civilized nations as an 
indulgence very proper to be taxed. Our own legislators have also 
made our higher education a source of revenue; possibly with a 
view to the “incidental protection” of American science by the 
heavy tariff laid on the foreign and imported article. 

The advantage to the cause of science from this Smithsonian sys- 
tem of international exchange of intellectual products, free of duty, 
and with the freight expenses assumed by the Institution, can scarcely 
be too highly appreciated. In the early promotion of this benefi- 
cent scheme, Professor Baird became an energetic agent and sympa- 
thetic co-adjutor of the Smithsonian Secretary. The remarkable 
development of this service may be sufficiently indicated by a glance 
at the amount of material transmitted through this Institution, on 
each tenth year for thirty years, showing something like a geometrical 
ratio of increase. The total weight of books, pamphlets, and charts 
distributed in 1855 was about six tons; in 1865, about nine tons; in 
1875, about twenty tons; and in 1885, about eighty-five tons. With 
the rapid growth of the exchange operations, the active and compre- 
hensive faculties of Professor Baird seemed but to find a better field 
of exercise. 

At the same time, the accumulating collections of the museuam— 
increased in 1858 by the transfer from the Patent Office to the Smith- 
sonian building of the interesting contributions from the earlier 
national exploring expeditions—demanded a large share of attention 
for their proper arrangement, exposition, and superintendence.* To 
say that this important work of organization was zealously and 
judiciously carried out, is to characterize but imperfectly the di- 
rective skill and energy of the museum curator. 

Of Professor Baird’s work in original biologic research,—of his 
contributions to various scientific journals and society proceedings,— 
of his English translation of the popular “Iconographice Encyclo- 


* This accession of the Government deposit of ethnological and natural 
history specimens was estimated by Professor Baird, in his report for 1858, 
as comprising not more than a fourth of the material already in the Smith- 
sonian Museum or a fifth of the aggregate amount. 


52 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


peedia,” of his editorship of the “Annual Record of Science and In- 
dustry” for eight years,—and of his other publicatfons,—it is not 
proposed here to speak. This aspect of his intellectual life will be 
discussed by one in every respect far more competent to a just and 
discriminating presentation of the theme. The present remarks will 
be confined to a cursory review of Professor Baird’s varied admin- 
istrative work. 

For a number of years a notable decline in the productivéness of 
our extended fisheries had been with anxiety observed, the annual 
yield of this important element of our food supply having in many 
cases fallen off one-half of its amount a quarter of a century earlier. 
So serious a diminution and consequent enhancement of cost of sub- 
sistence was becoming a menacing problem. Were our leading 
food-fishes undergoing a process of slow but certain extinction? 
Several of the States (especially those of New England) appointed 
commissions of inquiry into the causes and remedies of the threaten- 
ing evil, but with little result. 

In the stern competitive struggle that from the dawn of terres- 
trial paleeontogeny has been ordained by nature as the feudal tenure 
of all existence, and from which service man himself is not ex- 
empted, the feebleness of early youth in the individuals of every 
race would speedily terminate the biology of our planet were 
not provisions made for bridging over these cross lines of weakness 
to preserve the continuity of species. In the lower classes of being 
we find the crude expedient of a fertility so enormous as to allow 
of the wholesale destruction of the unprotected eggs or of their 
brood, and yet leave a remnant to spare for the chances of reaching 
adult age. In numerous other classes,a marvellous sagacity is dis- 
played by the mother in depositing her eggs where they will be least 
exposed to accident or voracious attack, and where the progeny (that 
she shall never see) will meet with their appropriate sustenance. 
In insects this peculiar instinct—so difficult of explanation as “in- 
herited experience”—is perhaps most strikingly displayed. And 
lastly, when we ascend to the higher classes of birds and mammals, 
we find the parental sentiment developed to an untiring vigilance 
for the protection ,and provident care for the nutrition, of the new 
generation until it is able to take up for itself the battle of life. 

As an illustration of the reckless prodigality of productiveness in 
some of the lower families of the vertebrate branch it may be recalled 
that a single salmon will lay five thousand eggs; a trout, fifteen thou- 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 53 


sand eggs; a perch, a herring, or a shad, thirty thousand eggs; a 
pike, one hundred thousand eggs; a carp, four hundred thousand 
eggs; a mackerel, five hundred thousand eggs; a flounder, one 
million eggs; a haddock, one million and a half of eggs; a halibut, 
two and a half millions of eggs; a pollock, four million eggs; a cod- 
fish of medium size, five million eggs; a large-sized cod, nine million 
eggs, and a turbot, nine million eggs. Such numbers are simply 
astounding; they cannot be realized. And how great the marvel 
when we consider that each of these nine million units is a potential 
fish, capable of development into all the perfected attributes and 
functions of the parent form! Among the lower invertebrates may 
be simply instanced the oyster—capable of producing the incredible 
number of twenty or thirty million eggs, and if of large size as many 
as forty or fifty million eggs. 

If with this amazing fertility the various kinds of fish just named 
are not rapidly increasing, but are stationary or even decreasing in 
numbers, how overwhelming must be their early destruction. Even 
after allowing for the many millions of adult fish taken by man it 
is obvious that of many species not one in a thousand or in ten thou- 
sand of eggs or of the newly hatched can survive to maturity. Pro- 
fessor Mobius estimates that for every grown oyster upon the beds 
of Schleswig-Holstein more than a million have died. 

To avert, if possible, the menace of increasing scarcity of fish 
supply the attention of Congress was directed to the subject ;—the 
more properly since in our National Government resided the juris- 
diction over our extended sea coasts. By a joint resolution, approved 
February 9, 1871, the President was authorized and required to 
appoint a person of proved scientific and practical acquaintance with 
the fishes of the coast to be Commissioner of Fishes and Fisheries, 
with the duty to prosecute investigations into the causes of diminu- 
tion, if any, in numbers of the food-fishes of the coast and the lakes 
of the United States, and to report whether any and what protective, 
prohibitory, or precautionary measures should be adopted in the 
premises. 

No man more suitable for this important and responsible position 
than Professor Baird could have been selected. He was at once 
appointed by President Grant and confirmed by the Senate as the 
Commissioner. In his first report he announced, as the result of a 
most careful and thorough examination, that the decrease of the 
shore fishes of the New England waters during the preceding twenty 


54 ' PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


years was fully substantiated, and that it had been much more rapid 
since the year 1865. 

In furtherance of his great work, the resources of the Smithsonian 
Institution were freely placed at the disposal of the Commissioner; 
and, in the same report, he gratefully acknowledges this hearty co- 
operation by saying: “I am indebted to Professor Henry for per- 
mission to use the extensive collection of apparatus belonging to the 
Smithsonian Institution, in the way of nets, dredges, tanks, &c., and 
thus saving the considerable outlay which would otherwise have been 
necessary.” 

The new studies into the life-history of the principal shore 
fishes,—into the character and range of their enemies, and into 
their appropriate means of subsistence, requisite to an intelligent 
consideration of the conditions most favorable to their propaga- 
tion,—involved investigations embracing the entire marine fauna 
of the coast, vertebrate and invertebrate. These extensive and 
varied researches necessarily demanded the aid of skilled assist- 
ants—of a corps of eminent specialists in marine biology, and a 
corresponding division of labor. 

The results of these investigations have been given to the world 
in hundreds of memoirs, published in the Reports and Bulletins of 
the Commission, and in the Proceedings and Bulletins of the National 
Museum. And it is quite within bounds to say that in importance, 
in variety, and in extent of original information thus communicated, 
no such quantity of contribution to our knowledge of zoology has 
ever emanated from any other organization within the same in- 
terval of time. Many species of fishes entirely new to science have 
been discovered and carefully described; and the number of in- 
vertebrate forms known to inhabit the waters explored, has prob- 
ably been fully doubled. 

It was found, from the abundance of the lower forms of life, that 
the decline of the useful fishes had not resulted from any lack of 
their accustomed food-supply; nor had it resulted apparently from 
any less favorable conditions of environment, nor from the preya- 
lence of any epidemic diseases. It was therefore a consequence of 
excess in their destruction. 

Among all the ravages of predaceous fishes it was,found that the 
“bluefish” was the most voracious and devastating pirate of the 
coast. In the report it is stated: “Sometimes among a school of 
herring or menhaden thousands of bluefish will be seen biting off 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 5d 


the tail of one and then another, destroying ten times as many fish 
as they really need for food, and leaving in their track the surface 
of the water covered with the blood and fragments of the mangled 
fish.” Fortunately this fish is itself valuable for food, and it is ac- 
cordingly taken in large numbers.* 

But by far the most rapacious and destructive scourge of the 
waters is man himself. By reckless extravagance in his methods of 
capture he would soon consume the capital of his abundant patri- 
mony were no restraints imposed upon the thoughtless improvidence 
of his greed. With the growth of population and demand and the 
improved facilities for rapid transportation, the stimulus to inventive 
ingenuity occasioned the establishing of fish-traps and fish-pounds 
on a large scale that gathered thousands in their confines, with little 
regard to the probable supply of the future. As these traps and 
pounds were placed directly in the way of the fish to their spawn- 
ing beds, it resulted that a very large proportion of spawn fishes 
were taken by them, thus greatly reducing the prospects of the suc- 
ceeding generation. 

Whatever protective measures might be deemed expedient to 
check this spendthrift waste, it was seen that the most immediate 
and’ promising work of the Commissioner would be to promote the 
rapid multiplication of fish ; and to this dominant interest the an- 
nual appropriations by Congress have been more and more largely 
directed. 

Pisciculture is by no means a recent art, it having been exten- 
sively practiced by the Chinese for a number of centuries; and even 
the artificial fecundation of fish-spawn is nearly a century and a 
third old, having been apparently first introduced by Jacobi, a 
German, of Westphalia. Most of the European nations had already 
given attention to the practical application of fish-culture, and in 
different parts of our own country enterprising individuals had un- 
dertaken the operation with gratifying results. 

Under the organizing direction of Professor Baird a careful study 
was made of existing methods, extended experiments on artificial 
propagation were conducted, and successive improvements in the 
various stages of incubation, hatching, and development. intro- 


* In his first report, Professor Baird says: ‘‘I am myself cognizant of the 
capture of no less than 20,000 bluefish, representing a weight of at least one 
hundred thousand pounds, in one weir in the course of a single night.” 


56 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


duced,—each detail receiving a scientific treatment,—until a scale 
of success has been effected far more complete and Satisfactory than 
ever before attained. While under natural conditions but a small 
proportion of the spawn deposited is hatched (the greater mass 
being eagerly devoured by various aquatic tribes), and of the por- 
tion hatched but a small percentage escapes to reach maturity, 
under the careful breeding of art fully ninety per cent. of all the 
eggs secured are fertilized and successfully developed. 

Of the practical results of this great national enterprise it is un- 
necessary to speak. A dozen varieties of our best food-fishes have 
been disseminated throughout the inland waters and the seaboard 
of our country in increasing quantities; transported in the form of 
the young fry, or in that of fertilized eggs to other hatching stations; 
and while an accurate estimate is, perhaps, at present not easily 
attainable, it will hardly be held an exaggeration to say that these 
productions are to be numbered by thousands of millions. Of these, 
many millions (by a most praiseworthy public courtesy) have been 
distributed to foreign countries—to Australia, to Brazil, to Canada, 
to England, to France, to Germany, to Mexico, to The Netherlands, 
to Scotland, and to Switzerland. 

In the great International Fisheries Exhibition at Berlin in 1880 
our national commission was authorized by Congress to participate. 
Professor Baird appointed as his deputy to personally superintend 
this movement Professor Goode, the present Fish Commissioner, 
under whose energetic direction, in a remarkably short space of 
time, the marvellous American exhibit was organized, transported, 
and installed, to the wonder and admiration of every visitor. The 
head of the American Commission was hailed by the President of 
the German Fisheries Association as the “chief fish-culturist in the 
world,” and to him was awarded for the most complete and impos- 
ing display of all the details and accessories of his scientific art the 
unique first-honor prize of the exhibition, the gift of the Emperor 
of Germany. 

But time fails to permit more than a passing glance at other fields 
of activity no less important in which Professor Baird employed his 
remarkable powers of executive management. The Smithsonian 
Institution from its inception had given great encouragement to 
explorations, and its director had zealously labored tovenlist, as far 
as practicable, the various expeditions undertaken by the Govern- 
ment, in the extension of scientific research. These efforts were lib- 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 57 


erally responded to by the Executive Departments, and trained ex- 
perimentalists and observers were given every facility for physical, 
physiographical, and biological investigations at distant points. 
The Institution thus became almost the Government superintendent 
of scientific expeditions. In all that pertained to ethnology and 
natural history Professor Baird became of course the leading spirit, 
and the various circulars of direction and of inquiry issued by him 
show with what range and thoroughness he supervised this wide 
department, while the resulting memoirs and valuable museum 
accessions attest as their fruits the practical wisdom of the measures 
and methods adopted. 

Congress having made provision for the representation by the 
Government in the National Centennial Exhibition to be held at 
Philadelphia, the President of the United States requested the Ex- 
ecutive Departments, together with the Smithsonian Institution, to 
co-operate in a collection illustrative of our progress and resources. 
In his report for 1875, Professor Baird formulated (as requested by 
Professor Henry) his plans for the different details of the projected 
exhibit, and, these being adopted, were carried out to a result that 
made the Smithsonian display the leading attraction of the exten- 
sive Government building. 

At the death of Professor Henry, in 1878, his faithful assistant 
and coadjutor was elected by the Regents as his successor, and his 
long familiarity with the different lines of active operations pursued 
by the Institution made him from the start an efficient director. 
Another grave responsibility was thus thrown entirely upon his 
shoulders, and he proved himself equal to the occasion. 

In 1879, Congress made an appropriation (since continued an- 
nually) for the prosecution of North American ethnology, to be 
expended under the direction of the Smithsonian Institution. For 
the administration of this important trust, Professor Baird selected 
one whom he knew to be peculiarly fitted by training, by zeal, and 
by congenial tastes, to pursue successfully the anthropologic study 
of our waning aborigines, and the new Bureau of Ethnology was 
judiciously committed to the control of the distinguished director of 
the Geological Survey, Major Powell. 

In the same year (that following Henry’s death) an appropria- 
tion (for many years importunately besought of Congress) was made 
for the erection of a national museum building. In 1882 the com- 
pletion of this building rendered necessary the re-organization of the 


58 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Museum, with a staff of expert curators, on a scale commensurate 
with its importance, and the abundance of its prevfously stored ma- 
terial. 

Professor Baird had now become the manager of three great 
establishments—the Fisheries Commission, the Smithsonian Insti- 
tution, and the National Museum; either one of which was a charge 
sufficient to fully task the energies of a vigorous man. No wonder, 
with the strain of unremitted though divided attention to these 
exacting duties, that while unconscious himself of any unaccustomed 
or undue exertions, he should find even his robust and stalwart 
strength was slowly failing under his accumulated labors, 

Informed by his medical adviser that an entire and continued 
rest from all intellectual exertion was necessary to restore his nervous 
energies to their wonted tone, he reluctantly accepted the decision. 
A year ago he asked from the Smithsonian Regents authority to ap- 
point two official assistants to relieve him from the greater portion 
of his responsibility, and in hearty compliance with his expressed 
desire, the eminent astronomer and physicist, Professor Langley, was 
appointed assistant in charge of the Smithsonian operations, and 
his well-tried friend and collaborator, Professor Goode, was ap- 
pointed assistant in charge of the Museum affairs. 

But the relaxation came too late. After a vigorous resistance of 
his strong constitution to the encroachments of internal organic 
derangements, he finally succumbed to the Destroyer, and quietly 
breathed his last on the 19th of August, 1887;—another example 
(far more frequent in the higher than in the lower fields of occupa- 
tion) of sacrifice to over-work,. 

From eyen this hurried and imperfect sketch of Professor Baird’s 
diversified administrative work it is at once apparent. that he pos- 
sessed, in a pre-eminent degree, two great capacities,—the faculty for 
successful organization, and the faculty for continuous labor, As 
a biologist he had made a study of the entire range of organic 
nature—vegetable and animal; and with the accuracy of the special- 
ist, he combined the larger and fuller perception of the general zoolo- 
gist as to the functional and genetic inter-relations of animated being. 
The tenor of his mind was rather synthetic than analytic. While 
he ever displayed a marvellous memory for particulars and a com- 
prehensive grasp of details, these were apprehended amore as the 
constituents of a general end or purpose, than as the residuals of a 
disjunctive conception. Clear-sighted and determined, he prevised 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 59 


and compassed the result in the means. Simple and unostentatious, 
he received with ready affability a visitor, even when most pre-occu- 
pied. What young naturalist ever applied to him for the resolution 
of a difficulty or uncertainty without receiving cordial attention and 
satisfactory enlightenment? 

Great as were his undoubted services in the original discovery of 
biologic truths, it may well be doubted whether his indirect influ- 
ence in the advancement of science was not still greater, by the 
assistance and encouragement given to others and by his numerous 
official occasions of directing the efforts of the aspiring into channels 
of novel exploration whenever the opportunities of land or naval 
expeditions presented themselves. 

Now that the first shock of bereavement at missing one who has 
occupied a prominent place in the public eye, as well as in our 
private regard, has somewhat subsided, we but the more clearly 
realize that in the lamented death of Spencer F. Baird the scientific 
world has lost an accomplished and illustrious naturalist, the insti- 
tutions over which he presided an energetic and judicious admin- 
istrator, and we, assembled here, an exalted associate, a faithful 
counsellor, an ever open-hearted friend. 


Glee ot cee 


pests aehitit i in 
the Pin eh betes a 
eh prado yeoK 


as DESERT CCE RAR AGE aaa 


‘ tis 
i eee ; 
ivy Waa ee, 


pe bay 


v8 get ay iy 
atte Pi y 


bale ey 


sf phy sett 
; as ol oe Atm y eb ited et 
y 
(ities id j rAd tt aac ale 
rf 2 Pu bon tet alli Trot vol tbh aa 
r oabestbiy tithy.cth mele Pune eae 
erat! veak eS pwawan! . gee ingot on eine 
PEE CA RRR OT ee 
wie arth ea el Thy ie 2Re 
OS RITE Tae i ; ary 6 | Pe 
ft 
i bt es se 
shit aE, 2h BE 
i er SALE edly Gi ie ee 
eS Cate AE aa 2 SE ; 
ia 13 ye yf W oS 7 F143 if 
’ bs bay iityy 
1 . a7 t i ; ' “a 
a) ee Oa ee j ] 
A fit oy; -~ & 
- 
r iho 
. ‘i 
5 q A 
4 
: 
; + 
d rh iy 
ey ie ee 
f 
4 
uy ‘ 
. ‘ 
4 } 4 us ‘ < ig 
i é * 
‘ iN 13 
Ne 


PROFESSOR BAIRD IN SCIENCE. 


By Mr. Wo. H. DALL, President of the Biological Society. 


In accepting the honor of addressing you this evening on the bio- 
logical work of Prof. Spencer F. Baird it is hardly necessary to state 
that I have felt keenly the inadequacy of my own equipment for 
the task. Not only does it happen that my own work has been 
almost entirely in departments of biology different from those which 
he adorned, but my early efforts were fostered by his wisdom and 
geniality, the period of my scientific studies has coincided with an 
acquaintance which ripened into affection and admiration, they 
have depended for their results upon opportunities largely due to 
the intervention of Professor Baird, and I feel that the best and 
truest of him is that which cannot be put in words. The sense of 
personal loss, as with many of you, is still so keen as to accentuate 
the difficulty of doing justice to the theme assigned me. 

I should have almost despaired of myself on this occasion were it 
not that others have aided me in my endeavor to set forth the debt 
owed by the various departments of research to Professor Baird’s 
original investigations. To naturalists so distinguished in their 
specialities as Ridgway, Stejneger, Goode, Coues, Allen, Merriam, 
and Yarrow, I am indebted either for direct contributions toward 
the substance of this address or for matter in their published works 
which has been similarly utilized. 

Professor Baird’s scientific activity was exhibited in three prin- 
cipal directions: First, in original investigation of the zodlogy of 
vertebrates; second, in the diffusion of scientific knowledge and 
methods through official documents, reports, cyclopedias, and records 
of progress; and lastly, in the organization and administration of 
scientific agencies such as the National Museum or the Fish Com- 
mission, which include in their scope not merely public education 
or economic applications of science, but the promotion of research. 
Behind all these and hardly less important for science was the per- 
sonal influence of the man himself, which shone through all the 
planes of his activity as coruscations light the facets of a gem. 


(61) 


62 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Although it is very difficult to separate the phases of his work, 
one from another, so closely were they inter-related, my theme to- 
night is restricted to the impress left upon zodlogical science by 
Baird’s original investigations. So great has been his reputation as 
an organizer, so numerous have been the publications in which he 
has garnered for the public the precious grain of the annual scien- 
tific harvest, that the extent and importance of his original work, 
except by specialists, is in danger of being overlooked. 

We owe an excellent bibliography of his publications to Professor 
Goode. From this we learn that, up to the end of 1882, the list 
comprises nearly eleven hundred titles, from which, after deduction 
of all notices, reviews, official reports, and works edited for others, 
some two hundred formal contributions to scientific literature re- 
main, many of which are works of monographic character and ex- 
tensive scope. 

With the exception of a single early botanical paper these relate 
to the vertebrates of America and, in their several branches, cover 
nearly the entire field. Although descriptions of species in them- 
selves afford a poor criterion of the value of the work containing 
them, it is interesting to note that, among the terrestrial vertebrates, 
the proportion of the fauna first made known by Baird to the total 
number recognized at the time as North American varied: from 
twenty-two per cent. of the whole to forty per cent. in different 
groups. 

His method of study of new material was as far removed as possi- 
ble from bookishness. In the case of the collections from Hudson 
Bay or the Pacific Railroad Surveys, when birds, mammals, or rep- 
tiles sometimes came to hand by hundreds, each specimen having 
the collector’s data attached, the whole collection was thrown to- 
gether, each form to be sorted out on its merits and studied in the 
light of a multitude of specimens. 

Professor Baird’s early life had included so much of exercise in 
the shape of long pedestrian journeys with gun and gamebag, so 
much familiarity with the wood-life of his favorite birds and mam- 
mals, that it would have been in any case impossible to class him 
with the closet-naturalist, while to this knowledge he added a genius 
for thorough, patient, and exhaustive research into all which con- 
cerned the subject of his study, and a wonderful inventiveness in 
labor-saving devices for labelling, museum work, and registration. 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 63 


He had a wonderful capacity for work. He undertook and car- 
ried out successfully tasks which it would seem nobody else would 
have dared to attempt, or, attempting, would have been physically 
unable to complete. In the case of the immense volume on the 
mammals of the Pacific Railroad Surveys he says in the preface, 
July 20, 1857: 


“ The examination of the material was actually commenced early 
in 1855 and many of the articles written in that year or 1856. 
With the continual accession of additional specimens it became 
finally necessary to rewrite, alter, or extend all that had been pre- 
pared prior to the present year (1857). It is to this that the fre- 
quent want of uniformity is due, the time allowed not being suffi- 
cient in many cases to permit the reworking of the whole matter. 
* %* * Jt is, perhaps, unnecessary to state that the matter of the 
present report is entirely original throughout. * * * It is 
proper to state that, owing to various circumstances, the work was 
necessarily passed through the press with a rapidity probably un- 
exampled in the history of natural-history printing, allowing very 
little opportunity for that critical and leisurely examination so 
necessary in correcting a work of the kind. For most of the time 
the proof has been furnished and read at the rate of twenty-four to 
thirty-two pages per day, nearly 400 pages having been set up, 
read, and printed during the first half of July alone. Owing to 
the urgent necessity for the speedy completion of the volume, no | 
time was allowed for the revision of the manuscript as a complete 
work, nor, indeed, of its separate portions, and, for much of the 
time, the preparation of much of the manuscript was only a few 
hours in advance of its delivery to the compositor.” 


The volume above referred to contains over 800 quarto pages 
and 42 plates. The manuscript was entirely prepared after six 
o'clock of working days which had been spent in the active admin- . 
istrative and executive work of the Assistant Secretary of the 
Smithsonian Institution, then unassisted by stenographer or other 
clerical supplement. Fortunately for science Baird did not always 
have to work under such circumstances, but the incident shows 
what he was capable of doing when the occasion seemed to him to 
warrant it. Probably no other work of equal importance, on any 
subject, was ever carried out under such pressure. 


Mammals.—Professor Baird’s contributions to a knowledge of 
North American Mammals, though less voluminous than those re- 
lating to birds, are not less important. Previous to this time but 


64 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


one general work on the subject had been published, that of Audu- 
bon and Bachman on the Quadrupeds of Nortl America, which 
was issued in three volumes, from 1846 to 1854.* Immediately 
after the completion of this great work collections began to pour 
into the Smithsonian Institution from the various exploring parties 
of the Pacific Railway Surveys. This material comprised so large 
a number of new species, and cast so much light upon many pre- 
viously doubtful points concerning the relations of species already 
described, that a revision of the whole subject became necessary. 
Hence Professor Baird at once set about the preparation of the book 
commonly known as the Mammals of North America. I have already 
alluded to the manner in which it was prepared. This great work 
was rapidly pushed to completion and appeared in 1857, just three 
years after the publication of the last volume of Audubon and 
Bachman’s Quadrupeds. It constitutes the eighth volume of the 
Pacific Railroad Reports, and is a ponderous quarto of more than 
800 pages, accompanied by numerous excellent plates. 

Though published thirty years ago, this work still remains the 
standard general treatise on North American mammals. It con- 
tains no biographical matter, but consists wholly of technical de- 
scriptions. It treats of all the mammals then known from the 
. continent of North America north of Mexico, except the bats and 
the truly pelagic forms—whales, sea cows, and seals. The total 
number of known species was increased nearly twenty-five per 
cent. 

In fullness of synonymy, and in the correct assignment of species 
previously described, Professor Baird was much in advance of pre- 
vious workers. The descriptions, which are models of painstaking 
accuracy and precision, are taken from the specimens themselves, 
and are accompanied by long tables of measurements, the value of 
which more than justifies the enormous expenditure of time neces- 
sary in their preparation. Much more attention was paid to crani- 
ological characters than had been the custom with previous writers, 
which fact contributes largely to the permanent value of the work. 

Professor Baird’s long training as a careful observer, his power 
of concentrating his knowledge of matters under investigation, the 


*The volume on Mammals of Richardson’s Fauna Boreali Americana 
does not fall under this head, because it treats only of the northern portion 
of the continent. 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 65 


wide scope of his information on nearly all departments of natural 
science, his clear perception of details, together with his excellent 
judgment, which was as marked in matters of minor detail as in 
those requiring great executive ability, enabled him to draw con- 
clusions which subsequent accumulations of material have verified 
in & surprising manner ; in fact, his pre-eminent superiority as a 
systematic zodlogist is everywhere apparent. 


Birds.— When the great interest he took in birds is considered, 
and the long period over which his studies extended, it is somewhat 
surprising to find that the number of separate papers on ornithology 
published by Professor Baird sums up only some seventy-nine titles. 
It is less to their number that he owed his fame as an ornithologist 
than to their quality, combined with the fact that several of these 
publications covered practically the entire field of North American 
ornithology, and were of the nature of monographs. 

“His reputation was, indeed, established,” says Ridgway, “ by 
the first of his separate works, usually known and quoted as the 
“Birds of North America,” though not published under this title 
until two years after it had been printed by the Government as 
Volume IX of the Pacific Railroad Reports. With the publication 
of this great quarto volume, containing more than a thousand pages, 
in 1868, began what has been fitly termed by Dr. Elliott Coues the 
“Bairdian period” of American ornithology. This period, cover- 
ing almost thirty years, was characterized by an activity in ornitho- 
logical research and a rapidity of advancement without a parallel 
in the history of the science. 

Of the “Birds of North America” Coues states* that “it repre- 
sents the most important single step ever taken in the progress of 
American ornithology in all that relates to the technicalities.” The 
nomenclature was entirely remodeled from that previously in cur- 
rent use, and for the first time was brought abreast of the systematic 
acquirements of the time. The synonymy of the work, in which is 
embodied the history of investigation relating to each species, is 
more extensive, reliable, and elaborate than any before presented. 
With few exceptions, citations were original, and when, as occasion- 
ally happened, they were necessarily at second-hand the fact was 


* Bibl. app. to the Birds of the Colorado Valley, p. 650. 
51 


66 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


always indicated. The text comprised not only diagnoses and de- 
scriptions of each species, but extended and elaborate commentary, 
comparisons and criticisms. 

In this learned and sagacious work Professor Baird was aided by 
Cassin and Lawrence, two of the leading ornithologists of America. 
It exerted an influence perhaps stronger and more widely felt than 
any of its predecessors, Audubon and Wilson not excepted, and 
marked an epoch in the history of American ornithology. The 
data original to and embodied in this work have been used again 
and again by subsequent writers with various modifications. Such 
a monument of original research is likely to remain for an indefinite 
period a source of inspiration to other writers, while its authority 
as a work of reference will always endure. 

The publication of this work rendered possible the studies and 
progress of a large number of persons, who without it would hardly 
have been able to enter the domain of scientific ornithology, but 
who, aided by the book as a standard of reference and by the genial 
correspondence and pregnant suggestions of its author, have made 
reputations of more or less distinction for valuable and permanent 
original investigation. The number of those who profited by this 
stimulation has been very large and in this way arose what has 
been called* the Bairdian School of Ornithologists, a school char- 
acterized by exactitude in matters of fact, conciseness in deductive 
statement, and careful analysis of the subject in all its various 
bearings. Its work is marked by a careful separation of the data 
from the conclusions derived from them, so that conclusions or 
arguments can be traced back to their sources and duly weighed, 
while the writings of the older European school afford little basis 
for analysis. In substance, according to Dr. Stejneger, the Euro- 
pean method required an investigator to accept an author’s state- 
ments and conclusions on his personal responsibility alone, while 
the method originated by Baird furnishes him with tangible facts 
from which to make his deductions. 

These distinctive features were still further developed by the 
publication in 1864-66 of the “Review of American Birds,” a 
work of unequalled merit, displaying in their perfection Professor 
Baird’s wonderful powers of analysis and synthesis, so strongly 
combined in his treatment of difficult problems. Although never 


*Stejneger, Proc. U. S. Nat. Mus., VII, 1884, p. 76. 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 67 


completed, this work has received unstinted praise from all compe- 
tent to estimate it. It is said on excellent authority that no other 
single work on American birds has made so profound an impression 
on foreign ornithologists, notwithstanding the fact that circum- 
stances prevented it from being made complete. 

Although in his systematic work Professor Baird, like other 
naturalists, built partly on the scientific foundations laid by his 
predecessors and contemporaries, always with due acknowledge- 
ment, the high value of his work in this direction was largely 
due to an unerring instinct which enabled him to recognize and 
confirm the best features of the work of others and by adding ma- 
terial from his own lines of original research to combine the whole 
into a fabric which was a distinct advance on anything previously 
offered to the scientific world. 

While the bent of his genius-led him, in this as in other depart- 
ments, to devote a main proportion of his work to the systematic 
biology which was the need of the time, and which, with the explora- 
tion and description upon which it is based, must always precede 
and lay the track for the theoretical biology more in vogue to-day, 
it must not be supposed that the work of Baird was confined to de- 
scriptive and systematic work. With the latter in his publications 
are combined a host of biographical data such as the field naturalist 
revels in. One of the earliest and most pregnant papers bearing 
on mutations of specific forms which have been contributed to the 
literature of evolution by American biologists is to be found in his 
article on the “Distribution and Migrations of North American 
Birds” published in the American Journal of Science in 1866.* 
In this paper, an abstract of a memoir presented to the National 
Academy of Sciences in 1865, are to be found the germs of much 
of the admirable work which has since been elaborated by other 
biologists on the correlation of geographical distribution and the 
peculiarities of the environment, with the modifications of color, 
size, and structure in the forms of animal life, called species. 

Unlike some of his contemporaries twenty years ago, the views of 
Darwin excited in him no reaction of mind against the hypotheses 
then novel and revolutionary. His friendly reception of the new 
theories was so quiet and undisturbed that, to a novice seeking his 


*Am. Jour. Sci. and Arts, 2nd Series, XII, pp. 78-90, 184-92, 337-47, 
1866. 


68 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


inal. How well this work was done is shown by the fact that, in 
spite of the changes which are constant in zodlogical classification, 
nearly all the species still retain the names he applied tothem. The 
descriptions were so carefully prepared that later students have never 
been troubled in making their identifications. 

Notwithstanding his multifarious duties in later years, Professor 
Baird never lost his interest in these animals, and up to the last 
afforded every aid and encouragement to those studying them. 
Much of the work done in this country by such herpetologists as. 
Girard, Kennicott, Hallowell, Cope, and others, found in his ex- 
ample and encouragement the stimulus which made it possible, was 
built on the foundations which he laid, and owes its publication to 
agencies which he promoted or controlled. 


Fishes.—Professor Baird’s contributions to ichthyological liter- 
ature number some fourteen or fifteen papers, chiefly of a descriptive 
character, embodying the results of original research into the ichthy- 
ology of western and southwestern America and of the marine 
fishes of New Jersey and New York. Most of these papers were 
published jointly with Charles Girard. 

Besides these, however, he added more than four hundred titles 
to the list of reviews, notices, reports, translations, and official docu- 
ments relating to economic ichthyology, fish culture, and the gen- 
eral progress of the science. In this way he was instrumental 
in bringing together for the use and benefit of the English-speaking 
public the largest body of facts relating to fish and fisheries ever 
prepared and digested for such purposes by any individual or 
organization. Recognized by experts of foreign countries with one 
accord, as the most eminent living authority on economic ichthy- 
ology, America owes to his fostering care and unwearied labor the 
existence of a whole generation of ichthyologists, breeders of fishes, 
and inventors of appliances of all sorts for use in connection 
with the taking, preservation, and increase of these animals. So 
thoroughly is this understood by all who are in any way acquainted 
with American fish and fisheries, that to them this statement will 
appear a truism. 

It does not enter into the purpose of this address to enumerate 
the economic results of the Commission which grew inte. such stately 
proportions under his skillful and progressive leadership, nor yet 
to enumerate the multitudinous researches in pure as well as eco- 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 69 


advice and opinion amid the clatter of contending voices, it seemed 
almost as if the main features of the scientific gospel of the new era 
had existed in the mind of Baird from the very beginning. His 
thorough apprenticeship in the study of details of structure and their 
expression in systematic classification, as well as his cautious and 
judicial habit of mind, prevented him, notwithstanding his hearty 
recognition of evolutionary processes, from falling into those exuber- 
ancies of utterance and hypothesis characteristic of narrowness and 
immaturity which, within the memory of most of us, have enjoyed 
a sort of vogue now happily on the decline. 


Batrachians and Serpents—Professor Baird’s contributions to 
herpetology began as early as 1849, his first paper being a revision 
of the North American tailed batrachians which appeared in the 
Journal of the Academy of Natural Sciences of Philadelphia. Ex- 
cluding notices of the work of others in the Annual Record between 
1849 and 1880, he published fourteen papers on this branch of science 
beside nine of which he was the joint author with Charles Girard. 
His activity in original work in this, as in some other directions, 
came to an end with the assumption of the burden of administrative 
work required by the organization and development of the Fish 
Commission. 

Many of his herpetological papers were elaborate studies. One 
of the most important of the early memoirs was that on the reptiles 
of Stansbury’s expedition to the valley of the Great Salt Lake, and 
another, that on those collected by the United States exploring ex- 
pedition under Wilkes. The catalogue of North American Reptiles 
in the collection of the Smithsonian Institution is a classical work, 
serving to the present day as a text-book for students of herpetology. 
In 1859 appeared his great study of the reptiles collected by the 
parties engaged in the explorations for a Pacific railroad, a monu- 
ment of patient research and discriminating analysis. After this 
his contributions to the subject were mostly short papers or an- 
nouncements of new or interesting facts. 

At the time Professor Baird began his studies of the amphibia 
little had been done for herpetology in America. The classical work 
of Holbrook contained little more than descriptions of Southern 
species and the work of Duméril and Bibron was equally meagre. 
Immense collections were placed in Baird’s hands from the Western 
plains, and the work upon these was necessarily in great part orig- 


70 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


nomic biology for which this organization has furnished material 
and means. No more emphatic object-lesson of the vital relations 
existing between research, as such, and the promotion of the ma- 
terial interests of mankind has ever been furnished to the so-called 
“ practical man” than that afforded by the work of the United 
States Fish Commission as directed by Professor Baird. 

Whether germane to the subject of scientific research or not, the 
most narrow specialist can hardly grudge an allusion to the grandeur 
of the methods by which the food supply of a nation was provided, 
hundreds of rivers stocked with fish, and the very depths of ocean 
were repopulated. Typically American we may call them in their 
audacity and their success. The Fishery boards of foreign countries, 
first quietly indifferent, then loudly incredulous, in due time became 
interested inquirers and enthusiastic followers. In a few years we 
may fairly expect to see the food supply of the entire civilized 
world materially increased, with all the benefits which that implies, 
and this result will in the main be owing to the unremunerated 
and devoted exertions of Spencer F. Baird. 


THE PERSONAL CHARACTERISTICS OF PROFESSOR 
BAIRD. 


By Mr. J. W. Powtti, President of the Anthropological Society. 


Baird was one of the learned men of the world, and, to a degree 
perhaps unexampled in history, he was the discoverer of the knowl- 
edge he possessed. He knew the birds of the air, from the ptarmi- 
gan that lives among everlasting snows, to the humming-bird that 
revels among the orchids of the tropics; he knew the beasts of the 
forests and the prairies, and the reptiles that crawl through desert 
sands or slimy marshes; he knew the fishes that scale mountain 
torrents, that bask in quiet lakes, or that journey from zone to zone 
through the deep waters of the sea. In all this realm of nature he 
had a minute and comprehensive knowledge that no other man has 
ever acquired. What others have recorded in this field of research 
he knew, and to their discoveries he made a contribution of his own 

so bounteous, so stupendous, that he is oot as the master of 
systematic zodlogists. 

All of Baird’s scientific work is an illustration of modern induc- 
tive or scientific reasoning. The inductions or general principles of 
modern science are reached by the accumulation of vast stores of 
facts. He knew how to accumulate facts; how to reject the trivial 
and select the significant. Modern science is almost buried under 
the débris of observation, the record of facts without meaning, 
the sands of fact that are ground from the rock of truth by the at- 
trition of mind; but Baird could walk over the sands and see the 
diamonds. Then he knew how to marshal significant facts into 
systems, and to weld them into fundamental principles. In all his 
works there can be discovered no taint of a priori reasoning or 
syllogistic logic; for in his mind there was no room for controversy, 
and disputation fled before the light of his genius. Formal logic, 
a disease of modern thought,—the contagion of Aristotleina,—never 


(71) 


72 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ravaged his brain. With healthful directness, he sought the truth 
guided by wise inference, and told the truth in its simplicity. 

Baird was an organizer of the agencies of research. When a 
bold explorer essayed to penetrate the seas of ice by the path of 
peril and in quest of fame, Baird would ever so manage that a corps 
of quiet scholars should be attached to the expedition to study the 
climate of the Arctic zone, the geology of the Arctic rocks, the flora 
of the Arctic lands, or the fauna of the Arctic fields; and the best 
knowledge we have of the igloo-dwellers, the Eskimo whose home 
is on the ice of the North, has been brought to us by the quiet students 
he succeeded in attaching to Arctic exploring expeditions: and so 
the love of glory was made to serve the cause of truth. 

When, in the interests of international commerce, expeditions 
were sent to explore and survey routes of travel and transportation 
across Central America from sea to sea, he managed to send with 
them corps of scientific men whose function it was to bring from 
the tropics all forms of its abundant life, vegetal and animal, and ~ 
the relics of the arts of the people of Central America as they are 
exhibited in stone and clay and gold; and the National Museum 
has been enriched by the results of this labor, and the boundaries 
of human knowledge extended thereby: and so the greed of gain 
was made to serve the love of truth. 

When our army was distributed on the frontiers of the land, he 
everywhere enlisted our scholarly officers into the service of science 
and he transformed the military post into a station of research, an 
Indian campaign into a scientific expedition. Scott, Marcy, Mc- 
Clellan, Thomas, and many other of the great generals of America, 
were students of natural history and collectors for Baird. When 
our navy cruised around our shores, its officers were inspired with 
that love of nature which made every voyage of military duty a 
voyage of discovery in the realms of natural science; when they 
journeyed among the islands of the sea they brought back stores of 
scientific materials, and when they sailed through the littoral waters 
of other continents they made voyages of scientific investigation. 
Many of these earlier naturalists of the Navy in subsequent times 
became commodores and admirals. ' 

But time would fail me to tell of the exploring expeditions and 
the railroad surveys throughout America, and the travels through- 
out the world, which he utilized in the interest of science, or of 
which he was the immediate projector. Of the abundant material 


GENERAI. MEETINGS. 73 


thus gathered from all parts of the world, some has gone to enrich 
American institutions of learning, and some has been gathered into 
the National Museum—the outgrowth of Baird’s organizing genius 
and a splendid monument to his memory. 

The hills of the land stretch not so far as the billows of the sea; 
the heights of the mountains are not so great as the depths of the 
ocean; and so the world was unknown until this greater region was 
explored. The treasures of the land did not satisfy the desires of 
Baird; he must also have the treasures of the sea, and so he organ- 
ized a fish commission, with its great laboratories and vessels of 
research. ° 

“What hid’st thou in thy treasure-caves and cells, 
Thou hollow-sounding and mysterious main ? 
Pale, glistening pearls and rainbow-colored shells, 
Bright things which gleam unreck’d of, and in vain. 


Keep, keep thy riches, melancholy sea! 
We ask not such from thee.” 


What the scholar asked of the sea was all its forms of life, its 
organisms minute and lowly, its crawling articulates, its pearl- 
housed mollusks, its fishes that swim in armies, and its leviathans 
that prowl among the waves—the life of the reedy shore, the life 
of the ocean-current, and the life of the deep sea. So, with many 
ingenious appliances, he and his lieutenants sailed away to explore 
the ocean’s mystery. 

So the Fish Commission was an agency of research; but it was 
more; he made it an agency by which science is applied to the 
relief of the wants of mankind, by which a cheap, nutritious, health- 
ful, and luxurious food is to be given to the millions of men. He 
affirmed that for the production of food an acre of water is more 
than equal to ten acres of land, thus giving to the gloomy doctrine 
of Malthus its ultimate refutation, and tearing away the veil of 
despair from the horizon of the poor; for, when the sea shall serve 
man with all the food that can be gathered from its broad expanse, 
the land cannot contain the millions whom it is thus possible to 
supply. 

In the research thus organized the materials for the work of 
other scientific men were gathered. When a great genius reads to 
the world a chapter from the book of nature the story is so beau- 
tiful that many are stimulated to search in the same field for new 
chapters of the same story. Thus it was that the publication of 


74 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON, 


Baird’s great works on natural history developed in America a 
great corps of naturalists, many of whom have become illustrious, 
and the stimulus of his work was felt throughout Europe. In the 
research which he organized the materials were furnished for this 
corps of naturalists; but his agency in the development of this body 
of workers was even more direct. He incited the men personally 
to undertake and continuously prosecute their investigations. He 
enlisted the men himself, he trained them himself, he himself fur- 
nished them with the materials and instruments of research, and, 
best of all, was their guide and great exemplar. Thus it was that 
the three institutions ovér which he presided—the Smithsonian In- 
stitution, the National Museum, and the Fish Commission—were 
woven into one great organization—an university of instruction in 
the methods of scientific research, including in its scope the entire 
field of biology and anthropology. Such is Baird the investigator, - 
Baird the organizer, and Baird the instructor in the length, breadth, 
and thickness of his genius, the solidarity of a great man. 

All that I have said is a part of the public record; it is found in 
the great libraries of the world; but, however exalted the feeling 
of admiration we may entertain for Baird as a scholar and admin- 
istrator, it is to his attributes as a man, as disclosed in his personal 
relations with friends, associates, and contemporary men of affairs, 
that we most fondly turn. It is in these relations that he most 
clearly exhibited those kindly and modest traits of character which 
made him so universally beloved. 

As a man of affairs, Professor Baird exhibited great sagacity. 
His plans for the organization of scientific work were of great mag- 
nitude, and had they been presented to the administrative officers 
of the Government or to legislative bodies with exaggeration, or 
even had they been presented with the glow of an enthusiastic 
missionary of science, they might well have encountered opposition. 
But Baird had a wonderful faculty of presenting his plans with 
extreme modesty, and with a degree of understatement, but sugges- 
tion of possibilities which speedily caused him to whom the appeal 
was made himself to become an advocate of the Professor’s measure. 
He had traits of character in this respect which are hard to explain, 
and which seem at first to be contradictory. In the advocacy of 
measures his modesty amounted almost to timidity, and he avoided 
alike argumentation and ostentation, and he presented his measures 
with the directness of a child. Notwithstanding all this, there was 


GENERAL MEETINGS. fo 


such a poise of faculties—such dignity of mien—that he impressed 
those with whom he came in contact as a venerable and wise patri- 
arch. He seemed devoid of personal interest or feeling, and solici- 
tous only for the welfare of those to whom he was in fact appealing, 
and he conveyed the impression that he was giving benignant ad- 
vice. Thus the shrinking, sensitive man, who could not even stand 
before a public body, such as a committee of Congress or a scientific 
society and advocate a cause, could, from his seat by the fireside or 
at the desk, so illumine the subject with which he had to deal that 
men stood round him to gather his words, that nothing should be 
lost, for in the exposition of his subject he illumined everything 
with clear statement, arising from an exhaustive knowledge and 
full understanding of results. 

As the director of the work of research in which other men were 
engaged, Professor Baird had marvelous insight and skill. The 
appliances of modern research, alike in the inorganic world and in 
biology, have come to be multifarious and diverse, and there is this 
peculiarity about their use: That once used, so that the secret of 
nature which they were planned to unlock has been revealed, they 
speedily become obsolete, and immediately new keys, new appa- 
ratus, new devices are necessary. Thus toa large extent skill in | 
research is absorbed in the skill necessary for the development of 
the agencies of research. A continuous line of research, prose- 
cuted by a corps of men so that the boundaries of knowledge are 
carried. far forward, can result only from a continuous line of in- 
ventions in the apparatus of research, and it was here that Baird 
exhibited his skill. His own devices were many and constant, and 
ever he was fertile in suggestions to his assistants. No wonder, 
then, that so many of the secrets of nature were unlocked through 
his agency. It was in the direction of this work of research that 
the man Baird stood forth as a giant; it was where his vast knowl- 
edge of details was most apparent; it was where his marvellous 
skill was most shown ; it was where his insight into human char- 
acter was most exhibited. With clearness he formulated his inter- 
rogatories ; with aptness he selected his course of procedure; with 
judgment he sought the aid of others, and with suggestiveness di- 
rected their work. And, lo! his questions were speedily answered. 
It was in this manner that his own good hands were supplemented 
by the hands of many, that his own great mind was re-enforced by 


76 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIELY OF WASHINGTON. 


the best mental activity of many assistants; and thus the whole 
body of men under his control worked together as one organic in- 
teger for the increase and diffusion of knowledge among men. 

In his work with his assistants he scrupulously provided that 
every one should receive the meed of honor due for successful re- 
search and treated all with generosity. Many an investigation 
begun by himself was turned over to assistants when he found that 
valuable conclusions could be reached; and these assistants, who 
were his warm friends, his younger brothers, reaped the reward ; 
and he had more joy over every young man’s success than over the 
triumphs and honors heaped upon himself from every quarter of 
the globe. He was the sympathetic counsellor of many men; into 
his ears were poured the sorrows and joys of others, and he 
mourned with the mourning and rejoiced with the rejoicing. To 
those in need his hand was ready and his purse was open, and 
many and many were the poor who called him “blessed.” Though 
aman of great force of character, a man of great learning, a man 
upon whom had been showered the honors of the scientific world, 
in character he was as simple as a child. He had a fund of 
“folk-lore,” and loved the books and papers written for children. 
In his later years, weakened with disease and burdened with many 
labors, he still read St. Nicholas from month to month, and kept 
the run of every little story, and was glad to be “a child again.” 
His life at home was pure and sweet, and full of joys, for he gave 
and received love and trust and tender care. But the history of 
his home life is sacred. Its words and acts abide in the hearts of 
the wife and the daughter. 

For many long months he contemplated the day of parting. 
Labor that knew no rest, responsibility that was never lifted from 
his shoulders, too soon brought his life to an end. In the summer of 
the past year he returned to his work by the seaside, that he might 
die in its midst. There at Wood’s Holl he had created the greatest 
biologic laboratory of the world; and in that laboratory, with the 
best results of his life-work all about him, he calmly and philosoph- 
ically waited for the time of times. Three days before he died he 
asked to be placed in a chair provided with wheels. On this he 
was moved around the pier, past the vessels which he had built for 
research, and through the laboratory, where many men were at 
work at their biologic investigations. For every one he had a word 
of good cheer, though he knew it was the last. At the same time, 


GENERAL MEETINGS. 77 


along the pier and through the laboratory, a little child was 
wheeled. “We are rivals,” he said, “ but I think that I am the 
bigger baby.” In this supreme hour he was playing with a child. 
Then he was carried to his chamber, where he soon became in- 
sensible, and remained so until he was no more. 

“‘ Blessed are the pure in heart, for they shall see God.” 


AGRE IEILA 


re 6d iA Rag en tg A 
Pata reeset: A NE OR So haa Posetsey wate ae 
huh : ai nee i t ‘, aos * ane 


Rhgomts i 1 Se Aaa eS ria Mah fw 45 ipenlatiowen | . 


‘ * » hog 27 i 
ead Sehr | Y te Sn J t fay 4 ps iV eek Le pe he oh ete ? 
Paha WectgiDn a) Vib)? we ? i “PCE Prete vst) Meee ge bs thew ‘oat gee 
f ’ , - 7 Pi 4. = 
me? Py “al a \ : % . rd i. Poe Pky d ath Be 
; ea and f , ye ft rea ; ; 
c to ‘ 
, . * < 
; er A ‘ 
F : 
vo ‘ ‘ \= 1 avy 
hon’ f 
é i 
a 
, { i 
¢ 
3 ays 
\ ds 2 . 
dg ewe 
\ ey " 1 
‘ 
‘ 
4 | 
} v ‘ 
» 
\ 
a 
‘ 
a 7 
¥ 
i) ‘ 
i] 
\ 
‘ ' 
1 
t 
| q é f 
‘ ; 
; Afi 
, ‘ 
4 
y Wee ids 
) in 
ft 
‘ i 
ay x . 
' 4 
ue ¥ , 
ni p. IY , i 
ee ‘ ‘ \ 
: voy els *y, iis 
re 
Re Witte 
ent ‘ é 
ar a ‘ \ Vive he 
" ’ } ae ‘y 1 
in| ~ oft * J 
ve ' eA r 
1rd BY 
‘ ed 
ti i‘ ¢ 
‘ ‘Pat i 
sy 
bP yr 
” en Mets 
At \ Ha 
f ‘ i 
NEM AE Tae ye i 
Abc Dm f 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


(79) 


a 


tee 


STANDING RULES 


OF THE 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


1. The object of this Section is the consideration and discussion 
of papers relating to pure or applied mathematics. 


2. The special officers of the Section shall be a Chairman and a 
Secretary, who shall be elected at the first meeting of the Section 
in each year, and discharge the duties usually attaching to those 
offices. 


3. To bring a paper regularly before the Section it must be sub- 
mitted to the Standing Committee on Communications for the 
stated meetings of the Society, with the statement that it is for the 
Mathematical Section. 


4, Meetings shall be called by the Standing Committee on Com- 
munications whenever the extent or importance of the papers sub- 
mitted and approved appear to justify it. 


5. All members of the Philosophical Society who wish to do so 
may take part in the meetings of this Section. 


6. To every member who shall have notified the Secretary of the 
General Committee of his desire to receive them, announcements of 
the meetings of the Section shall be sent by mail. 


7. The Section shall have power to adopt such rules of procedure 
as it may find expedient. 


52 (81) 


LIST OF OFFICERS AND MEMBERS 


OF THE 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION OF THE PHILOSOPHICAL 
SOCIETY FOR THE YEAR 1887. 


Chairman, Wa. B. Taytor. Secretary, R. 8S. Woopwarp. 


ABBE, C. Hazun, H. A. 
Avrry, R. 8. FirraG.¢ Ga Wie 
Baker, M. Hopexins, H. L. 
Bates, H, H. Kine, A. F. A. 
Briuines, J. 8. KumMMELL, C. H. 
Burasss, E. S$. Martin, A. . 
CurisTI£, A. S. Marvin, C. F. 
Corrin, J. H. C. McAptiz, A. G. 
Curtis, G. E. McGrz, W J 
DeLanp, T. L. NeEwcoms, S. 
DooritTLz, M. H. PAu, Hi MM: 
Dutton, C. E. Ritter, W. F. M’K. 
Eastman, J. R. Roxsrnson, T. 
EIMBECK, W. . RUSSELL, T. 
Exxiott, E. B. Smizzy, C. W. 
FarquHar, H. Strong, O. 

Fuint, A. 8. TaYLor, W. B. 
GILBERT, G. K. Upton, W. W. 
Gore, J. H. Witson, H. C. 
GrReEN, B. R. WINLOCK, W. C. 
TALS; ‘A. Woopwarp, R.'S. 
Harkness, W. ZIweET, ALEX. 


(82) 


BULLETIN 


OF THE 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 


24TH MEETING. FrEepruary 16, 1887. 
The Chairman, Mr. Wn. B. Taytor, presided. 
Present, eighteen members and one guest. 


The Section proceeded to the election of officers for 1887 by ap- 
pointing a Nominating Committee consisting of Messrs. FARQUHAR, 
Baker, and HI. 

The Committee nominated Mr. Wm. B. Taytor for Chairman 
and Mr. R.S.Woopwarp for Secretary ; these nominees were elected 
by acclamation. 


Mr. M. H. Doo.itt_eE read a paper on 


ASSOCIATION RATIOS. 
[Abstract. ] 


The present communication is an effort in the direction of a 
science of statistics. It includes the principles involved in my 
communication* of December 3, 1884, but presents them in a more 
general manner. 

Suppose that there are s occasions on which the presence or ab- 
sence of the phenomena A and B are determined by observation. 
Suppose that there are a instances of the occurrence of A, and } 
instances of the occurrence of B, each including ¢ instances in which 
A is associated with B. There remain s—a—6- ¢ instances in 
which A and B are both absent. If a—6 =e, the two phenomena 
are always found associated, and the association may be regarded 
as perfect. If either A or B is ever found alone, the association is 


*The verification of predictions. See Bulletin of Phil. Soc. for 1884, 


vol. 8, pp. 122-127. 
(83) 


84 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


imperfect. I assume that the extent of association is a quantity 
2 


capable of numerical expression, and further assume it = one 
This is tantamount to the assumption that whenever either of the 

; Oo, aor! 5 ae 
ratios ; or iF is constant, the extent of association varies directly as 
the other ratio, and = 1 when they each = 1. 

Not-A and Not-B may also be regarded as phenomena whose 
presence is equivalent to the absence of A and B and vice versa, 
Not-A, therefore, occurs s — a times; and Not-B s— 6 times. The 
following table will hardly need further explanation: 


Phenomena. Both oceur, Neither occurs. Extent of association. 
2 
A and B c s—a—b+e LD 
ab 
pe vat (a—c)? 
A and Not-B a—c hee veo 
As pis (b—c/) 
Not-A and B b—c hee en 
mae ee 2 
Not-A and Not-B s—a—b+e c (s—a—b+¢e) 


(s—a)(s—b)° 


For illustration, let blindness and deafness be the phenomena 
denoted respectively by A and B. Then the extent of association 


2 
between blindness and deafness = 3 that between sight and 
_ (b—c) 
deafness = (s—a)d’ Xe. 


I call the above expressions for extent of association indiscrimi- 
nate association ratios. It is important now to understand that the 
magnitude of each is determined both by general and special causes. 
In an ordinary community the indiscriminate association ratio be- 
tween sight and hearing is very large, nearly =1, for the general 
reason that most people can see whether they can hear or not, and 
most people can hear whether they can see or not. If there is a 
special reason why a larger proportion of men able to see than of 
blind men shall be able to hear, this special reason will tend to in- 
crease the indiscriminate association ratio, and a contrary special 
reason will tend to diminish it. 

I now seek to obtain a discriminate association ‘ratio, whose 
magnitude shall be affected by special causes only, and which may 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 85 


therefore serve as a measure of their efficiency. The general problem 
may be stated as follows: Having given the number of instances 
respectively in which things are both thus and so, in which they 
are thus but not so, in which they are so but not thus, and in which 
they are neither thus nor so, it is required to eliminate the general 
quantitative relativity inhering in the mere thingness of the things, 
and to determine the special quantitative relativity subsisting be- 
tween the thusness and the soness of the things. 

If no special causes are in operation, the number of instances in 


which both A and B occur should be = 2 according to the general 
theory of probabilities. The operation of such causes is therefore 


ee i ab 
indicated by a difference between the values of c and Now, 
: Bho, : ; 

instead of the ratio — which varies directly as c, let us form a 


ratio which shall vary directly as gun and which shall = 1 


whenec=a, These conditions give us the ratio 


z ab 
s cs — ab 
ath ab a (s—b) 
$ 
, ‘ stane es — ab 
In like manner, instead of the ratio 5 We have Gay Now, as- 


suming that whenever either of these derivative ratios is constant, 

the required discriminate association ratio varies directly as the 

other ratio varies, and that it equals unity when they each equal 
wnat: , es —ab) . 

unity, it is found equal to their product = Pea. 


For the phenomena A and Not-B the number of concurrences 


s—b : : 
probable from general causes es and subtracting this quan- 


tity from a—c, from a, and from s—b, the indiscriminate 

: 2 

association ratio Sosa) becomes Maen ore: June which differs 
a (s—b) ab (s—a) (s— b) 

from the discriminate association ratio for A and B merely in the 

algebraic sign of the quantity under the exponent. This is as it 

should be. Sight is precisely as favorable or unfavorable to hear- 


86 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


ing as it is unfavorable or favorable to deafness. In like manner 
the same discriminate association ratio is obtained for the phenomena 
Not-A and B, and for Not-A and Not-B. The logical relation be- 
tween sight and hearing is just as close as that between sight and 
deafness, as that between blindness and hearing, and as that be- 
tween blindness and deafness. It is in fact the same relation stated 
in different words. 
The sum of the four indiscriminate association ratios is 


(b—c) , (s—a—b-+c)’ 


(es — ab)? 
Gaon” (s—a) (s—b) 


at T ab(@—a) (s—b) 


¢ , (a—e) 
ab oy a(s—b) aH 

Hence the discriminate association ratio = the sum of the indis- 
criminate association ratios —1, Since every instance of A or of 
Not-A is necessarily associated with an instance of B or of Not-B 
and every instance of B or of Not-B is necessarily associated with 
an instance of A or of Not-A, this alternative association is perfect, 
and its extent =1 whatever A and B may denote. The excess of 
the sum of the indiscriminate association ratios above unity may, 
therefore, be taken as a measure of that portion of the aggregate 
which is peculiar to any special signification of A and B. Such 
association as belongs necessarily to any two classes of phenomena 
whatever having been eliminated, the discriminate association ratio 
measures that residue which indicates special relations. 


I call c¢ —— the concurrence residual. If ¢ is less than = the 


concurrence residual is negative and indicates that special causes 
prevent oftener than they produce positive association between A 
and B. Ifc=0 and a=s—6, the negative association (or disso- 
ciation) is perfect, and the discriminate association ratio =1. These 
conditions signify that the two phenomena are never both present 
and are never both absent. 

Denoting the discriminate association ratio by y, the concurrence 


residual by x, and the class residuals a — = and b oe respect- 


ively by a and #, we have the equation 


and regarding x and y as variables and @ and £ as constants this 
equation is represented in Cartesian co-ordinates by a parabola. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 87 


The value of the discriminate association ratio is not affected by 
interchange of a and 6. It is assumed that association and recip- 
rocal association are equal. 

The concurrence residual is significant in proportion to its square; 
and this is in accordance with the general comparative importance 
of residuals in the theory of least squares. 

When s is infinite, with a, 6, and ¢ each finite, the discriminate 

2 
association ratio reduces to the indiscriminate =. 
chances are as infinity to one against fortuitous concurrence; and the 
extent of association must be regarded as based wholly on special 
relations. 


In this case the 


This paper was briefly discussed by Messrs. GILBERT, H. Far- 
QUHAR, BAKER, and the author. 


25TH MEETING. , Marcu 2, 1887. 
The Chairman presided. 


Present, twenty-one members and two guests. 
A symposium was held on the following problem in probabilities: 


ONE-THIRD OF THE APPLES ON A TREE ARE ROTTEN AND ONE- 
FOURTH ARE WORMY, WHAT IS THE PROBABILITY THAT AN APPLE 
TAKEN AT RANDOM FROM THE TREE WILL BE (1) ROTTEN ONLY; 
(2) WoRMY ONLY; (8) BOTH ROTTEN AND WORMY; AND (4) 
SOUND? 


The discussion was begun by Mr. M. Baker who gave an analyt- 
ical statement of the conditions of the problem and concluded that 
the problem was an indeterminate one until some assumptions were 
introduced. Without introducing anything additional to that stated 
he concluded that the four probabilities were respectively 

oo. 2 d dO d 
rae na PHN ig? 1 Nema i a Paras 
where d = the number of sound apples and s the total number of 
apples. 


88 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Mr. DoouirtLe, proceeding on the hypothesis that the problem 
is indeterminate, gave an infinite series of possible values for the 
respective probabilities. But he thought the problem should be 
understood as determinate, and assigned 51, as the proper value for 
the third probability. 

Mr. Hi. expressed the opinion that the probability + for a 
rotten and wormy apple is the proper value, but gave a solution of 
the problem by means of double integrals which brought out a dif- 
ferent result. 


Messrs. Curtis, ELLIOTT, and FARQUHAR gave different solutions 
leading to 51, for the third probability. 


Mr. FarquHar objected to the result + as involving the absurdity 
that if one-fourth are wormy the probability of the combination is 
exactly the same for all values of the rotten between + and ?; and 
also further objected to calling a probability “indeterminate” be- 
cause it was not a certainty. 


Mr. Martin gave a brief history of the problem, which appeared 
originally in his Mathematical Visitor,* and of which he gave three 
solutions leading to 3 for the third probability. He stated that the 
correctness of his solution depended on the correctness of the view 
that all possible values of any one of the probabilities are equally 
probable. 

The subject was further discussed by Messrs. GILBERT, CHRISTIE, 
and WoopWARrD. 

Mr. Huu also read a letter from Prof. A. HAuu relating to the 
problem. 

The discussion was closed with some remarks by the Chairman 
on the language of the problem and its proper interpretation. 


*The Mathematical Visitor; edited and published by A. Martin. 4°. 
Erie, Pa. 1881. Vol. 1, No. 4, January, 1880, p. 115, problem 180; solu- 
tions pp. 180-181. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 89 


26TH MEETING. Marca 16, 1887. 


The Chairman presided. 


Present, sixteen members. 


Mr. CuristI& read a paper on 
A PROBLEM IN PROBABILITIES. 


In this paper he reviewed the conditions of the question in prob- 
abilities discussed at the previous meeting. He considered it a 
question susceptible of a detinite answer, dependent only on a logi- 
cal and mandatory application of the elementary principles of prob- 
ability. In his analysis he derived expressions for the possible 
combinations of the several events and deduced therefrom a func- 
tion representing the probability of the probability of the compound 
event (rottenness and worminess), the variable in this function being 
the probability sought. The value of the variable making the func- 
tion a maximum was taken as the required probability, the result 
being 545. 

If nm = total number of apples, 7 = number rotten, w= number 


wormy, «= number both rotten and wormy, then 
@@+1) w+) (ae L) Ga Dd) , ; 
a? Te eo —lor”’>2z>2", 


and the chance of a particular apple being both rotten and wormy 
/ 


is =, When # and” are integral the chance is either of or 4 , that 


gt 2” 


a When n, 7, w are all infinite, the case of continuous 


is 
: . Tw 
number, this chance is ar 


Mr. Stone took the ground that the problem is susceptible of but 
one interpretation, and gave a geometric solution leading to zs for 
the probability of the compound event. He also gave some in- 
stances of allied questions in dependent probabilities. : 

An animated discussion, extending over the remaining time of - 
the meeting, then followed. Of those who participated in the dis- . 
cussion, Messrs. CHRISTIE, Curtis, Doouirrye, Exuiorr, Hr11, 
KUMMELL, STONE and Zrwer considered the problem determinate, 
while Messrs. BAKER, Harkness, and Woopwarp considered it 
indeterminate. 


90 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


27TH MEETING. Marca 30, 1887. 
The Chairman presided. 


Present, twelve members and two guests. 


Mr. R. S. Woopwarp read a paper on 


THE FREE COOLING OF A HOMOGENEOUS SPHERE INITIALLY 
HEATED TO A UNIFORM TEMPERATURE. 


[This paper appeared in full in the Annals of Mathematics. 4°. Char- 
lottesville, Va. 1887, June; vol. 8, no. 8, pp. 75-88. Also separately 
printed. ] 


Remarks were made on this paper by Messrs. KuMMELL, Hi11, 
and the Chairman. 


ad 


Mr. KuMMELL read a paper on 
THE BRACHISTHODE ON THE HELICOID. 
[ Abstract. ] 


The characteristics of this class of curves and the methods of com- 
puting their lengths in the several cases were explained and dis- 
cussed. Accurately constructed stereoscopic diagrams of several of — 
these curves were exhibited. 


[This paper is expected to appear in the Mathematical Visitor. ] 


28TH MEETING. Aprit 138, 1887 
The Chairman presided. 


Present, nineteen members and one guest. 
Mr. G. W. Hi read a paper on 
THE MOTION OF HYPERION. 


Although designed to meet the special case presented by Hyperion, 
Mr. Hrx1x’s paper treated the general problem of three bodies under 
the restrictions that they are all nearly in the same plane and that 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 91 


the mass of the one whose motion is sought is negligible in compar- 
ison with the masses of the other two. The potential function for 
the disturbed body was put in a general form for the purpose of 
ascertaining the most advantageous variables for its development, 
and some of the particular forms were derived and discussed. Mr. 
Hrxt also indicated the methods which might be most advantage- 
ously followed in the application of his theory to Hyperion. 

This paper was discussed by Mr. A. Haut, who alluded to the 
unique character of the motion of Hyperion, and stated some of the 
more interesting facts concerning the observations of this satellite 
and the failure of the theories thus far advanced to represent its 
motion. 

Other remarks were made by the Chairman and Mr. Woopwarp. 


[This paper appeared in full in the Annals of Mathematics. 4°. Char- 
lottesville, Va. 1887, June; vol. 3, no. 8, pp. 65-78. Also separately 
printed.] 


Mr. A. Hau presented a paper’ on 
THE PARALLAX OF @ TAURI. 


He gave a historical account of the early attempts at the deter- 
mination of stellar parallax together with some of the results at- 
‘tained. He exhibited in tabular form the principal data on which 
his value for the parallax of «Tauri depends. In contrasting his 
result with the larger value for the same star determined by SrRUVE 
he stated that his values for parallax are generally smaller than those 
of other observers. 

The brief discussion which followed was participated in by Messrs. 
Eastman, Pavt, and others. 


29TH MEETING. APRIL 27, 1887. 
The Chairman presided. 


Present, thirteen members. 


Mr. A. S. Furnt read a paper on 


THE MOST PROBABLE VALUE OF THE LATITUDE AND ITS THEORET- 
ICAL WEIGHT FROM ENTANGLED OBSERVATIONS OCCURRING IN 
THE USE OF TALCOTT’S METHOD. 


In this paper Mr. Fun showed first how to express the weighted 


92 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


mean value of the latitude and its weight in the most general case 
of entanglemept in terms of the results from individual pairs of 
stars and their symbolical weights. To find the numerical values 
of these symbolical weights he made use of the principle that 
the weights of the individual results must be such as to make the 
probable error of the weighted mean a minimum. After treating 
the most general case he considered some of the special.cases occur- 
ring most commonly, and deduced practical formulas for computing 
the weights of individual results. In illustration of his methods he 
gave the details of the numerical operations in one of the more com- 
plex cases presented in actual work. 


In the discussion which followed, Mr. HArKNeEss derived, by a 
different and less complex process, some of the formulas given by 
Mr. Fuint. Others participating in the discussion were Messrs. 
Pau, FArRquHAR, STONE, and WoopWARD. 


Mr. E. B. Ex.iorr began the presentation of a paper on 


THE MUTUAL ACTION OF ELEMENTS OF ELECTRIC CURRENTS. 


30TH MEETING. May 11, 1887. 
The Chairman presided. 


Present, ten members and two guests. 
Mr. E. B. Exxiorr continued his paper on 
THE MUTUAL ACTION OF ELEMENTS OF ELECTRIC CURRENTS. 


He stated that Ampére’s theory of such currents involves the 
assumption that the action between the elements is limited in direc- 
tion to the line joining them. In conformity with this assumption 
the result reached by Ampére, and now usually given in text 
books, is that the action is proportional to 

4 cos 0 cos 6 — sin @ sin & cos a, 
in which 6 and @’ are respectively the angles between the directions 
of the elements and the line joining them, and » is the angle be- 
tween the two planes defined by the directions of the elements and 
the line joining them. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 93 


In his own investigation Mr. Exttortr makes no assumption or 
restriction with reference to the direction of the action of the ele- 
ments and finds the action proportional to the following expression : 


(cos 0+ sin @. 7) (cos 0’ + sin 0’ cosw.i+sin@ sinw.7)= 


cos 9 cos 0’ — sin 6 sin & cos w 

+ (sin @ cos & + cos 0 sin & cos w) t 
+ cos @sin # sinw.j 

+ sin @sin 6 sin w .77. 


In this expression 0, 6’ and w have the same signification as stated 
above, and 2, 7 and 7% (or its equivalent &) are quadrantal versors. 
The first term of this formula represents action in the line joining 
the elements; the second term represents action in the plane of the 
connecting line and one of the elements and perpendicular to the 
connecting line; the third term represents action in a direction at 
right angles to the plane just mentioned; and the fourth term rep- 
resents torsion in a plane perpendicular to the connecting line. 
The actions resulting in some special cases, as when the elements 
lie in one plane, etc., were explained and discussed. 


[This paper was presented to the American Association for the Advance- 
ment of Science at its New York meeting, August, 1887, and appeared in 
the Electrical World; a weekly review, ete. fol. New York, 1887, Au- 
gust 27; vol. 10, no. 9, p. 116. Also separately printed. ] 


Mr. Hit, following Maxwell, gave some of the principal steps 
in the process which leads to Ampére’s result, indicating that that 
process differs from Mr. Exuiort’s in leaving out of account cer- 
tain couples and in assuming a certain undetermined quantity to 
be zero. 


The paper was further discussed by Mr. Harkness, the Chair- 
man, and others. 


Mr. Doo.irrLe began the presentation of a paper on 


ASSOCIATION RATIOS. 


94 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON, 


3lst MEETING. May 25, 1887. 


The Chairman presided. 
Present, sixteen members and one guest. 
Mr. M. H. Doo.irr.e continued his paper on 
ASSOCIATION RATIOS, 


which consisted chiefly in a review and criticism of an article* by 


Mr. G. K. Ginsert on Finley’s Tornado Predictions. The follow- 
ing is an abstract of Mr. DooLrrre’s paper: 
By Mr. GILBeERt’s notation: 


s = whole number of predictions. 

p = number of positive predictions. 

o = number of occurrences. 

= number of verifications of positive predictions. 

p' =s8— p= number of negative predictions. 

o' =s —o = number of non-occcurrences. 

o —c= “measure of the failure in inclusion.” 
p—c= “measure of the failure in exclusion.” 


We should also have for consistency 
c= measure of success in inclusion. 
ce =s—o—p-+c= measire of success in exclusion. 
He says, “If inclusion and exclusion are equally important their 


measures bear the same weights.” This is as true for success as for 


failure, but Mr. GILBERT gives to the measure of success in exclusion 
no weight whatever, and entirely disregards it. 
He has 


o + p — 2c = measure of the general failure of prediction. 
We should also have 


3—o—p-+ 2c= measure of the general success in prediction. 


The latter measure consists of the “favorable cases;” the former 


* American Meteorological Journal. 8°. 


Detroit, Mich., 1884, Sep- 
tember; vol. 1, no. 5, pp. 166-172. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 95 


of the “unfavorable ;” and the “ratio of verification (the favorable 
cases divided by the sum of the favorable and unfavorable,” becomes 


Sip On ae —_ 
8 


v= 


And this is Mr, Frnuey’s method of computation. 
Mr. GrLBERT then employs a process to which he gives no name, 
but which may be called the elimination of hypothetical chance. 


: ) Pa ie ae sa . 
He estimates that e verifications of positive predictions might 


have been expected if the same number of positive predictions had 
been made at random, and sets these cases aside as ot neither 


discrimination nor want of it. In effect, he subtracts 22 © from each 


of the quantities 0, p, and ¢, and proceeds with the wees This 
portion of his reasoning is regarded as sound, and the process may 
be applied with great bn to properly formed ratios. 


The ratio v is 


c ay vay e+ c 

a  ?p ra pr 
To eliminate hypothetical chance, “E should be subtracted from 
each of the quantities ¢ and p, ¢ and ©? Cage é and p’. Denoting 


the result by @, 


ee ie a OD. 
4 2 (es — op) 


~ p(s—0) +0(s—p) 


When 
p= 100, o= 51, c= 28, s = 2808; 
then 
p = 27038, = 2752, é= 2680 ; 
and 


__ 26°18 + 26:18 355. 
~ 98:18 + 49° Ag 


The above formula, like many others, successfully passes all the 
tests which Mr. Gilbert devised for his own formula, but it fails 
Ss 


96 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


under others, and it is not maintained that it has any scientific 
value. . 

Mr. Gilbert says that he hopes “to show that Mr. Finley’s method 
involves a serious fallacy. This fallacy consists in the assumption 
that verifications of a rare event may be classed with verifications 
of the predictions of frequent events without any system of weight- 
ing.” It is not perceived that Mr. Gilbert has furnished any such 
system. The fallacy, perhaps, consists rather in the supposition 
that any valuable result can be obtained by averaging the percent- 
ages of verification of heterogeneous classes of predictions. Mr, 
Finley correctly computed his indiscriminate percentage of verifi- 
cation, and thereby furnished a striking and, perhaps, much-needed 
illustration of the’ worthlessness of such computations. The elimi- 
nation of hypothetical chance from such mixed percentages merely 
renders their worthlessness less apparent. 


This paper was briefly discussed by Messrs, Curtis, FARQUHAR 
Hitt, Baker, and Woopwarp. 


Mr. H. FarquHar presented a solution and generalization of a 
problem, proposed in Science,* requiring the division of a rectangle, 
by asingle step-cut, into two parts which when put together will 
form a square. 


Mr. Marcus Baker presented a communication on 
A COLLECTION OF SOLUTIONS OF THE TRISECTION PROBLEM. 
[ Abstract. ] 


The communication consisted of an informal statement from notes 
and memoranda of progress in the direction of an exhaustive col- 
lection of real solutions of the problem to trisect an angle. It was 
pointed out that, though the problem was a very old and very 
famous one, energy is constantly wasted in its study by those igno- 
rant of what has been done, and that this misdirected energy might, 
in large part, be due to the want of any satisfactory digest of results 
hitherto attained. The author had himself felt the need of such a 
digest, and, finding none, had some years ago begun a collection of 

*See Science. 4°. New York, 1887, May 20; vol. 9, no. 224, p. 488, 
query 5 


a 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 97 


notes and memoranda, with a view to the preparation of a fairly 
complete collection of solutions of the problem and the preparation 
of a bibliography. 

Progress in the work had been slow, and the results are still very 
incomplete, especially the bibliographic part, which was deemed the 
most important. 

The present collection of notes contained about a dozen different 
solutions of the problem and a suggested classification for a digest 
of the subject as follows: 


. Historical Introduction. 

. Trisection by the conic sections. 

. Trisection by special or higher curves. 
. Trisection by mechanical devices. 

. Trisection by approximation. 

. False trisections. 

. Bibliography. 


NAnooarh Wh re 


Of the trisections by the conic sections five were enumerated, 
viz: 

1. By parabola and circle. 

2. By parabola and parabola. 

3. By parabola and hyperbola. 

4, By the equilateral hyperbola. 

5. By the hyperbola, whose asymptotes form an angle of 120°. 


Trisections by the following curves were also enumerated : 


1. Conchoid of Nicomedes. 

2. Conchoid on circular base = trisectrix = planetary curve of 
~ Ptolemy = special case of limagon of Pascal. 

3. Cycloid. 

4, Epicycloid or trochoid. 

5. Quadratrix of Dinostratus or Hippias of Elis, 

6. Quadratrix of Tschirnhausen. 

7. Spiral of Archimedes. 


Respecting the cissoid of Diocles, it was remarked that no solu- 
tion of the trisection problem, by its aid, had been found. Also 
respecting the cycloid, which Sir Isaac Newton is said to state may 
be used to trisect an angle, no solution by means of it had been 


found, but the author had himself made one recently. 
53 


98 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Of the various mechanical devices used for trisection the linkage 
of Thomas of Ceva was given, others being referredeto only. 

Of false trisections, the number was stated to be very large and of 
unequal value, some giving close approximations and others failing 
ignominiously. Finally, in the bibliography, now containing some 
fifty references, and believed to be only the beginning of a reason- 
ably full list, it was proposed to make an authors’ catalogue of en- 
tries, and to follow each reference with a very brief characterization 
of the contents of the article. 

The foregoing scheme had beet laid out but latterly had made no 
progress, and the opinion of the section was sought as to the desira- 
bility or advisability of carrying the work on. 

Mr. Curtis made the following remarks: 

Six or eight years ago I began a similar collection of trisection 
methods, in looking over which I find a number of solutions addi- 
tional to those presented by Mr. Baker. 

The following six belong to the class in which an angle is trisected 
by means of curves : 


(1) y+ ay — azy + bx? =0; 
the ophiuride of Dietrich Uhlhorn (1764-1837). 
(2a? — yp)? 
. 
(2) Ae 4a? — y 4 


the polyode of Dr. Wm. Hillhouse,* Prof. J. W. Nicholson,} J. Bruen 
Miller.t 
(3) Ao? + 12y?=(VY1—a? + 9) — 8y V1 — +4. 

Dr. Wm. Hillhouse. 


(4) [Curve drawn, but equation not given. ] Ibid. 


*The Analyst; edited and published by J. E. Hendricks. 8°. Des 
Moines, Iowa. 1882, November, vol. 9, no. 6, pp. 181-:84. See also same, 
1876, September, vol. 3, no. 5, p. 151. 


ft Same. 1888, March, vol. 10, no. 2, pp. 41-48. See also The Multisector 
and Polyode. By Prof. J. W. Nicholson, M. A., Professor of Mathematics. 
Louisiana State University. 8°. New Orleans; published at the Times- 
Democrat. 14 pp. 


${ Van Nostrand’s Engineering Magazine. 8°. New York, D. Van Nos- 
trand, 1880, March, vol. 22, no. 135, pp. 206-209. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 99 


2 {=A\?2 
© av (ot 4) 1 
“+ (Vim +¥3—y) Thad. 
(6) w+ (8y— 4y°)? =r” Ibid. 


Dr. William Hillhouse, of New Haven, has not only shown that 
the last five curves may be used for trisecting an angle, but has 
devised instruments for describing them. This latter step, as I 
view the problem of trisection, is a necessary part of any real solu- 
tion by means of curves. The simple determination of the equations 
that will satisfy the analytical conditions of trisection, without the 
instrumental means for describing the curves, does not constitute a 
solution of the problem. It is essentially something to be done, not 
something merely to be proved, and its fame arises from the im- 
possibility of making the trisection of an angle by means of a ruler 
and pair of compasses. Any proposed solution, therefore, must in- 
dicate a geometrical instrument for accomplishing it, and the nature 
of the motion applied therein determines the character of the solu- 
tion. 

A class of solutions, regarded the most elegant of all, is that in 
which link machines trisect the angle directly, without the aid of 
interposed curves. Of this class I have found three instruments, 
invented respectively by the Marquis de |’Hépital (1661-1704), 
A. B. Kempe, and Professor Sylvester. That of |’Hépital is a com- 
bination of link and sliding motion ; those of Kempe and Sylvester 
are pure linkages. With respect to the two latter, I wish to call 
attention to the elementary character of the solution. Euclid’s 
postulates require us to be able to draw a straight line and a circle, 
and it is frequently assumed that they imply the use of a straight- 
edge and a pair of compasses. But, manifestly, any other instru- 
ments that can describe the circle and the straight line satisfy 
equally the requirements of the postulates. Moreover, the use of a 
straight edge assumes as accomplished the very thing proposed to 
be done; whence the straight-edge is not an original instrument 
for describing a straight line. Such an instrument is given by the 
linkage of Peaucellier. More originally, therefore, than by the 
straight-edge, the postulates of Euclid may be assumed to imply 
the use of pure link motion. Wherefore, if pure link motion be 
considered as postulated by Euclidian geometry, the trisection of 
an angle becomes one of the simplest of geometrical problems. 


100 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Mr. KumMMeE LL remarked that the supposed analogy between the 
duplication of a cube and the trisection of an angle does not exist, 
since the latter requires a cubic with three real roots, while the 
former requires a cubic having one real and two imaginary roots. 

The subject was further discussed briefly by the Chairman and 
Mr. Bates. 


32D MEETING. OcToBER 19, 1887. 
The Chairman presided. 


Present, sixteen members and one guest. 


Mr. G. W. Hix read a paper on 


THE INTEGRATION OF DIFFERENTIAL EQUATIONS ADMITTING PE- 
RIODIC INTEGRALS. 


[ Abstract. ] 


The independent variable being conceived as time, a system of 
ordinary differential equations may be said to admit periodic inte- 
crals when the values of the dependent variables, either exactly or 
with an approximate tendency, after a certain lapse of time, repeat 
their series of values. In the latter case the longer the lapse is 
made the more nearly is the repetition brought about. Strange as 
it may seem, this subject, except in the case of simply periodic inte- 
grals, is, at present, not completely understood. The text-books on 
differential equations are almost wholly engaged with the cases, 
which, by certain artifices, can be integrated in finite terms or re- 
duced to quadratures. In the treatment of physical problems, 
however, we seldom meet with equations of this class.) Far more 
frequently it is found that methods of approximation must be re- 
sorted to. Cauchy appears to be the author who has done the most 
for the elucidation of this part of the subject. His memoirs are in 
his later Exercises and in the volumes of the Comptes Rendus for 
1856 and 1857. 

In this paper the mode in which simply periodic integrals arise 
was discussed, and the theory afterwards illustrated by treating the 
following problem: 

Find the conditions of motion of any number of material points mov- 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 101 


ing about a centre under the action of central forces whose potential is 
a function of the sum of the squares of the radii vectores. 

The differential equations of this problem, in the case where the 
radii are supposed to describe no areas, were first integrated by 
Binet.* But the addition to the forces of the terms arising from cen- 
trifugal action much enhances the interest of the problem. 

The chief point of interest brought out by the solution was that 
while the directions of the points, whether as seen from the centre 
or from each other, all return to the same values after the lapse of 
a certain time, as do also the ratios of the radii vectores, the absolute 
values of the latter have all a factor whose period is generally dif- 
ferent from the former. Thus the movement of the system may be 
conceived as taking place under the operation of two distinct causes, 
viz: the first producing a revolution of all the points about the 
centre in closed curves in the same time, while the second, having a 
different period, changes the scale of representation of the system in 
space. 

[This paper appeared in full in the Annals of Mathematics. 4°. Char- 
lottesville, Va. 1887, October; vol. 3, no. 5, pp. 145-153. ] 


Mr, H1w’s paper was briefly discussed by Mr. A. Haru and the 
Chairman. 
Mr. A. HAut read a paper on 


EULER'S THEOREM (GENERALLY CALLED LAMBERT’S). 
[Abstract. ] 


This theorem is well known to astronomers and is very useful in 
computing the orbits of comets. The time of the passage of the 
comet from one point to another of its orbit is expressed by means 
of the two radii vectores drawn to the points, and the chord joining 
these points. For many years, and by miny writers even of the 
present time, this theorem is attributed to Lambert. Mr. Haru 
stated that it was first given by Euler about 1743. He gives two 
proofs for the parabola, and then extends the theorem to the 
ellipse. For this case Euler gives first an expression for the peri- 
helion distance in terms of the sum of the two radii vectores and 
the chord. He then gives an approximate expression for the time 
of describing the are in terms of the perihelion distance, the radii 


* Journal de mathématiques; par J. Liouville. 4°. Paris, 1837. 1st 
series, vol. 2, p. 457. 


102 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


vectores and the eccentricity of the ellipse, and directs us to sub- 
stitute the value of the perihelion distance. Euler does not, there- 
fore, give an explicit expression for the time in terms of the radii 
vectores and the chord, although he points out how this may be 
done. Considering the results that he obtained, Mr. HAut thinks 
that this theorem, with respect to all the conic sections, should be 
known by the name of Euler. 

Remarks on this communication’ were made by Messrs. Hr.1, 
Strong, and WINLOCK. 


33D MEETING NOVEMBER 2, 1887. 
The Chairman presided. 


Present, fifteen members and one guest. 


Mr. E. B. Etuiorr gave a brief description of a new form of com- 
puting machine, which prints and arranges in the usual form for 
addition any series of numbers and then prints their sum, the work 
of the operator being merely mechanical as in the use of the type- 
writer. Although designed especially for performing and printing 
work in addition, the machine may also be used for multiplication 
and division. 


Mr. Wm. HArKNEss presented a paper on 
THE CONSTANT P IN OBSERVATIONS OF TERRESTRIAL MAGNETISM. 


It was explained that this paper arose from a correspondence in 
Nature concerning the modes of computing the constant. In a letter 
published in the number of that journal for August 18th, 1887, Mr. 
Harkness referred to an expression for P given in Stewart and 
Gee’s Practical Physics, and suggested a more convenient form for 
logarithmic computation. In the number for September 8th, Mr. 
William Ellis gave another but somewhat less accurate expression 
for the computation of P; and in the number for September 29th, 
Prof. Arthur W. Riicker gave what he considered a more accurate 
expression than either of the others. 

Starting from the fundamental equations of Gauss, Mr. Harx- 
NEss derived a formula for P correct to terms of the second order 
inclusive. He then showed that Riicker’s formula, which pur- 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 103 


ported to give terms of the second order, was incorrect, and pointed 
out that the error in Riicker’s process consisted in expanding to 
terms of the second order an expression which included only terms 
of the first order. 

This paper was briefly discussed by Messrs. Hatt, ABBE, Kum- 
MELL, and HARKNEsS. 

This and other related papers appeared in Nature.* 


Mr. R. 8. Woopwarp read a paper on 
THE CONDITIONED COOLING OF A HOMOGENEOUS SPHERE. 


The salient features only of this paper were presented. The funda- 
mental assumptions and analytical conditions of the problem were 
indicated, and especial attention was directed to the distinction be- 
tween the case of “conditioned cooling” and that of “free cooling,” 
which latter was discussed by the author, at the 27th meeting of 
the section. It was shown that the solution for the more complex 
case of “conditioned cooling” is derivable by a comparatively simple 
process from the solution for “free cooling.” The probable discrep- 
ancy between the data presented by the earth as a cooling sphere 
and those assumed in the solution of the problem, and the additional 
data requisite for a more complete solution were pointed out. 

The presentation of the paper was followed by an informal dis- 
cussion participated in by nearly all present. This discussion re- 
ferred chiefly to the physical features of the earth as a cooling sphere, 
and served to disclose a diversity of opinion concerning the con- 
ductive and convective properties of such large masses. 


[This paper appeared in full in the Annals of Mathematics. 4°. Char- 
lottesville, Va. 1887, October; vol. 3, no. 5, pp. 129-144.] 
o 


* Nature, a weekly illustrated journal of science. 4°. London, 1887-1888. 
1887, Aug. 18, vol. 36, no. 929, p. 366. Ontheconstant P; by Wm. Harkness. 
Sept. 8, vol. 36, no. 932, p. 436. Same; by Wm. Ellis. 
Sept. 29, vol. 36, no. 935, p. 508. Same; by A. W. Ricker. 
Dec. 8, vol. 37, no. 945, pp. 127-128. Same; by Harkness and re- 
joinder by Ricker. 
1888, Jan. 19, vol. 37, no. 951, pp. 272-273. Same; by Harkness and re- 
joinder by Rucker. 


104 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


34TH MEETING. NoveMBER 16, 1887. 


The Chairman presided. 
Present, ten members. 
Mr. Ormonp STonE read a paper on 


THE ORBIT OF HYPERION. 
[Abstract. ] 


The principal difficulty in the integration of the equations of motion 
in the case of the problem of three bodies arises in the integration of 
terms involving the inverse powers of the distances between the dis- 
turbed and disturbing bodies. When the ratio between the radius 
vectors is not too near unity, the inverse powers referred to can be 
developed in rapidly converging series in terms of cosines of multiples 
of the elongation. When, however, these ratios do not differ greatly 
from unity the convergence of the series mentioned is very slow. If, 
in addition, the mean motions of the two bodies are nearly com- 
mensurate, the ordinary methods of solving the problem become in- 
applicable. 

Such a case presents itself in the determination of the perturba- 
tions of Hyperion produced by Titan. On the other hand the mutual 
inclination of the orbits of these satellites is so small as to have eluded 
detection ; the eccentricity of the orbit of Titan is less. than 0.03, and 
the position of the aposaturnium of Hyperion so nearly coincides, 
at least at present, with the point of conjunction of the two satellites 
as to give rise to a suspicion that the eccentricity of its orbit is, in 
reality, small, and that the apparent eccentricity is principally due 
to the perturbations produced by Titan. 

In view of these circumstances, that part of the disturbance has 
been investigated, which may be determined by neglecfing the mutual 
inclination and the eccentricities of the orbits of both bodies, reserv- 
ing a discussion of the remaining portion for another paper. It was 
accordingly assumed that 


r=a(1+a,cosd+a, cos20+...), 
oe = n(n, cos 9-+ n, cos 20+ ...); 


where r and w are the radius vector and longitude in orbit of Hype- 
rion, @ is the mean angular distance between the radius vectors of 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 105 


Titan and Hyperion, a and n are the mean values of r and w, and 
a,, n,, etc., are constants to be determined. In the differential equa- 
tions of motion for r and w, those terms not containing explicitly the 
mass of Titan were expanded by Taylor’s theorem into series of 
sums of terms containing cosines of multiples of @ affected with con- 
stant coefficients; while the terms containing the mass of Titan ex- 
plicitly were expanded mechanically into a series of cosines of mul- 
tiples of @ by means of assumed values of the coefficients. Equating 
the coefficients of the cosines of equal multiples of 0, a number of 
equations were obtained from which to derive a corresponding num- 
ber of the quantities a,, ,, etc. With these new values were ob- 
tained and the process repeated. Instead, however, of considering 
m’ (the mass of Titan) as known, a, was assumed to be given and m’ 
was considered as one of the unknowns. 


[This paper appeared in full in the Annals of Mathematics. 4°. Char- 
lottesville, Va., 1887. Vol. 8, No. 6, p. 161.] 


Brief remarks on. Mr. Stonn’s communication were made by the 
Chairman and by Messrs. Bakrr, H1Lu, and KuMMELL. 


Mr. E. B. Exxiorr presented a paper on 
THE QUOTIENTS OF SPACE-DIRECTED LINES. 


He wrote down some of the fundamental relations of this analy- 
sis and explained the nature and properties of the special symbols 
employed. He called attention to the lectures of Hamilton on 
quaternions, and to his “letters” on the same subject, as they ap- 
pear in Nichol’s Cyclopedia ;* and commented on the transition 
from Hamilton’s primary conception of a quarternion as a quotient 
of two directed right lines in space to his secondary conception of 
a quaternion as the sum of a directed right line and a number. 


The presentation of this paper was followed by a discussion, in 
which Messrs. BAKER, H1Lu, Sronr, Woopwarb, and the Chair- 
man participated. 


* See A cyclopedia of the physical sciences, ete., by J. P. Nichol. * * 
8°. London and Glasgow, 1857. pp. 625-628. 


106 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 
35TH MEETING. NOVEMBER 30, 1887. 
The Chairman presided. ry 
Eleven members present. 


Mr. E. B. Exxiorr continued his remarks, begun at the last 
meeting, on 


THE QUOTIENTS OF SPACE-DIRECTED LINES. 


[Abstract. ] 


Mr. Exxiorr said that the quotient of two space-directed lines is 
not a line, but is abstract. It is a quantity which applied as a mul- 
tiplier to one of the space-directed lines will produce the other. 

He then gave as an illustration of this principle its application to 
the problem of the mutual action of the elements of electric currents. 

Let » and »’ represent, respectively, in length, current strength, 

and direction, two elements of electric currents. 

p and p’ represent, respectively, in length and direction, the 
lines connecting the centers of the elements. 

6 represent the angle made by the element » with the line 
connecting the elements » and wv’; that is, with p. 

¢ represent the angle made by the element /’ with its rectan- 
gular projection in the primary plane; that is, the plane 
determined by the element » and the connecting line p. 

¢ represent the angle made in the primary plane by the rec- 
tangular projection of the element »’ and the connecting 
line p’. 

The effect of the action of » on yp’ will be as the product of the 
current strength, the length, and the direction of the elements, and 
inversely as the square of the distance, and the direction of the ac- 
tion will be expressed “by the following formula: 


utxu4 = cos 0 cos / cos gy — sin 0 cos ¥ sin ¢ 
+ [cos @ cos ¢ sin g + sin @ cos ¢ cos g]% 
+ cos@sin¢.9 
+ sinésing.y; 


~ 


in which the first line denotes action (transference) in the direction 
of the line connecting the centers of the elements; the second line 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 107 


denotes action (transference) in the primary plane, but perpendic- 
ular to the direction of the connecting line; the third line denotes 
the actgn (transference) perpendicular to the connecting line in a 
plane perpendicular to the primary plane; the fourth line denotes 
action (torsion) in a plane perpendicular to the primary plane. 

If instead of the angles ¢ and ¢ the angles # and w are used, 
denoting the angle made by »’, with the line connecting the centers 
of the elements, that is, with p’; and w denoting the angle which the 
plane of y’ and p’ makes with the plane of » and p, the direction 
of the resulting action will be expressed by the following formula: 


See us = cos cos ’— sin @ sin @ cos w 
+ [sin @ cos &’+ cos @ sin @ cos w]i 
+ cos@ sin sinw .j 
+ sin @ sin sinw . i. 

The values of the four parts of this formula are identical, respect- 
ively, with the corresponding parts of the former one. 

The mutual action of the unit-right- quotients (or quadrantal 
versors) 2,7 and 77 are such that ? = —1; 7?= —1; and ri (or its 
substitute k*) = —1, from which it readily appears that 7=h= 
— ji; jk=i=—ki; and ki=j = — ik. 


Brief remarks on Mr. Etuiorr’s paper were made by the Chair- 
man and by Mr. CuristTIE. 
Mr. ArremMAs Martin presented a paper on 


METHODS OF FINDING N™-POWER NUMBERS WHOSE SUM IS AN 
N"™-POWER; WITH EXAMPLES. 


[ Abstract. ] 
First method: 


Let 17+ 27+ 374+ 474+ 1. Le = 8 
and assume the auxiliary formula 


GD. SS Orie ts e1 va Ey 
also assume d such that 


whence 


Seep (pF gee oh 2) 


108 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


The solution now consists in determining by trial whether d can 
be separated into n”-power numbers, all different.» 


Second method: r 


In equation (1) a may sometimes be separated by trial into 
n*-power numbers, all different. 


Third method: 


Assuming b” nearly equal to but less than S, ,, and putting r for 
the difference, we have 
Saeed a Me : y (3) 


In formula (1) p and q may be any numbers chosen at pleasure. 
In formula (2) x should be chosen equal to or greater than the 
number of powers sought, and p and q any numbers that will give 
d positive, provided p be not less than z. 

In formula (3) 6 must be greater than a. 

Formulse (1) and (2) are taken from Dr, Hart* who has treated 
the cases of squares and cubes at some length. Formula (8) is found 
to be especially serviceable if a large number of powers is sought. 

Examples.—The values of S., , for n = 2, 3, 4, and 5, respectively, 
are here set down for reference’ as follows : 


Sot ee @t) Qe+)); 


x, 


S ,=42(@+); 


S,4= 30% (62*+ 152°+ 102°—1); 


8, p= te? w+ 1)? (22*+ 2a —1). 
22 
Ex. 1. Using formula (2) assume «= 5, p= 6, and q=1. 
Then d= 42, which by trial is found equal to 
1?+ 47+ 5’, whence 
?+3?+6=7*. 


*See The Mathematical Magazine. Edited and published by Artemas 
Martin. 4°. Erie, Pa. 1882-1884. Vol.1, No.1 seta 1882], pp. 8-9, 
and No. 11 [July, 1884], pp. 173-176. 


Ex. 4. 


II. n=3: 


Ez. 1. 


Ex. 2. 


Ex. 3. 


Ill. n= 4: 


Ex. 1. 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 109 


. Using formula (1) assume p = 8 and gq = 38; whence 


a = 57, which is by trial found equal to 17+ 2?-+ 
47+. 6? and 
1+ 2?+ 47+ 67+ 8? =117, 


. Using formula (3) assume z = 50 and 6 = 206; then 


7 = 489, which by trial is found equal to 

1? + 2? + 22 or 5?+ 8?-+ 20, etc.; 
whence we have two sets of 47 numbers, the sum of 
whose squares is a square, 

Using formula (3) assume z= 100 and 6=1750; 
then r = 2850, which by trial is found to equal 
4? 5?-++ 53?; whence 
V+ 2+ 34+ 6477+... 

+ 52’ 547+... . +100°=1750? 


Using formula (2) assume «= 5, p= 5, g=1, whence 
d = 134, which by trial is found equal to 1°+ 2°-+ 5%, 
whence 

3+ 44 53 = 6% 

Using formula (1) assume p =8, g =1, whence a =217, 

which by trial is found to equal 1°+ 6°; hence 
13+ 33+ 48+ 58+ 8 = 9, 

Using formula (3) assume «= 100 and b= 294; 
whence 7 = 90 316, which by trial is found to equal 
1°-+ 6+ 11°-+ 21°+ 43°, whence 
J+ ..5+774+ ..10°4+12%4+ .. 

20° + 228+ .. 42?+ 444. . + 100° = 294°. 


. Using formula (3) assume «=1000 and 6= 6303; 


whence r= 5 869 873, which by trial is. found to 
equal 1° + 2° + 10°-+ 16° + 32°+ 180°; hence, 


a+ ..9+11°5+ ..15+174.. 
313+ 33°-+ .. 1797+ 181° + . . 1000°= 6303%. 


Using formula (2) assume e=10, p=14, and q=1; 
whence d = 13 124, which by trial is found equal to 
“144+ 2+ 3+ 5'+ 7+ 10*, whence 
4* + 6+ 8*-++ 9+ 14*= 15+, 


110 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Ex. 2. Using formula (3) assume «= 100 and 6 = 212; 
whence r = 30370194, which by*trial is found 
equal to 
1*-+ 2+ 3*-+ 44+ 8+ 10*+ 14*+ 24*-+ 4244721; 
hence if all the natural numbers from 1 to 100, ex- 
cept the ten above given, be raised to the fourth 
power and added, their sum equals 212*. 

Be is) aa / 

Ex. 1. Using formula (2) assume = 10, p=11, and q=1; 
whence d = 133 044, which by trial is found to equal 
15+ 2°+ 3°+ 8+ 10°, and therefore 

445+ 6+7+ 99+ 11? = 12°. 

Ex. 2. Using formula (1) assume p = 29 and g=1; whence 
a = 3788851, which by trial is found equal to 
5°>+10°+ 11°+ 16°-+ 19°; hence 

5+ 10°-+ 11° + 16°+ 19° + 29° = 30°. 

Ex. 3. Using formula (2) assume «=18, p=31, q=1; 
whence d= 1 731 920, which by trial is found to 
equal 1°+2°-+ 4°-++ 5°+ 9°+12°+17°, and therefore 
3+6+ 77+ 8+10°+11°+ 

13°+ 14° + 15° + 16°+ 18° + 31° = 32°. 

In finding these numbers, use has been made of Barlow’s tables of 

fourth and fifth powers. To further facilitate the work the values 
of Sz,n for n=4 and n= 5 were tabulated. 


This paper was discussed briefly by the Chairman and by Messrs. 
DoouirrLe, Hitt, BAKER, and KUMMELL. 


NOTE. 


The following members have assisted the Chairman and Secretary 
in the examination of abstracts of communications to the Mathe- 


matical Section: 


Title. Author. Third member. 
Association ratios. M. H. Doolittle. G. K. Gilbert. 
A collection of solutions of the Marcus Baker. 
+ a . Asaph Hall. 
trisection problem. G, E. Curtis. 
The orbit of Hyperion. Ormond Stone. Asaph Hall. 
Methods of finding x*b-power Artemas Martin. Marcus Baker. 


numbers whose sum is an 2th 


power. 


(111) 


NOTE ON THE PUBLICATIONS OF THE SOCIETY. 


The ten volumes of the bulletin now issued cover the proceedings 
of the Society from its organization in March, 1871, to the end of 
December, 1887, a period of 17 years. Volumes 1 to 3 of the Bulletin 
apply to irregular periods; volume 4 gives the proceedings for a 
Society’s year, beginning in October of one calendar year and end- 
ing in June of the next. In 1882, the Society’s year was changed 
to coincidence with the calendar year, and volume 5 contains the 
minutes from October, 1881, to December, 1882, inclusive. Volumes 
6 to 10 cover, respectively, the calendar years 1883-1887. 

The pages of all the volumes have been stereotyped at the expense 
of the Smithsonian Institution, and after the Society’s edition, usually 
of 500 copies, has been printed, the plates have gone into the cus- 
tody of the Institution, which has subsequently issued an edition of 
its own, constituting a paper of its Miscellaneous Collections. In 
the Smithsonian edition, volumes 1, 2, and 3 of the Bulletin consti- 
tute volume 20 of the Miscellaneous Collections, and volumes 4 and 
5 constitute part of volume 25 of the Miscellaneous Collections, 
Volumes 6 to 8 have been reprinted by the Institution, but not yet 
gathered into a Collections volume for binding. Their numbers in 
the Smithsonian list are as follows: 


ae. 8 et ee ROP A O48 
Ie ge ne. eee ee Oe 
Oh Go a 6 sw es as cae NO Gao 


The Smithsonian edition is in the main typographically identical 
with the Society’s edition, but the following differences are to be 
noted. 

Volume 20 of the Smithsoniau Collections contains, in addition, 
the following title page and contents: 

Smithsonian Miscellaneous Collections. Vol. XX. (Vignette and 
motto.) Washington: Published by the Smithsonian Institution. 
1881. 

Contents. Article I. Bulletin of the Philosophical Society of 
Washington. Vol. I, March, 1871, to June, 1874. Pp. 218. 

54 (118) 


114 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Article II. Bulletin of the Philosophical Society of Washington. 
Vol. II, October 10, 1874, to November 2, 1878. Pp. 452. 

Article III. Bulletin of the Philosophical Society of Washington. 
Vol. III, November 9, 1878, to June 19, 1880. Pp. 169. 

The plates for this volume were changed by way of correction in 
a number of details, and the following list of differences may be re- 
garded as corrigenda for volumes 1, 2, and 3 of the Society’s edition. 


Page. 
51 
38 
54 
57 
57 
57 


DIFFERENCES IN VOLUME I oF BULLETIN. 


Tine. 


iT 
12 
38 


Society's edition. 
Benj. F. Pierce 
34, 35 
B. F. Taylor 
erosions 
particles, 
is a minimum 
marl-gravel 
sufficed, 
west, 
water, 

o. London 
Glaishen 

J. K. Gilbert 
Division 
Raibal Plateau 
Sandstones 

87 


Smithsonian edition. 
Benj. Pierce 
36, 37 
W. B. Taylor 
erosion 
particles 
is at a minimum 
marl, gravel 
sufficed 
west 
water 
of London 
Glaisher 
G. K. Gilbert 
division 
Kaibab Plateau 
Sandstone 
89 


DIFFERENCES IN VOLUME II or BULLETIN. 


Line. 


31 


Society’s edition. 
Carl 
Cripsey 
00279 
among the Esquimaux 
tribes by 
A. H. Spofford 


* Appendix. 


Smithsonian edition. 
Karl 
Crissey 
00729 
resulting from gram- 
matical 


A. R. Spofford 


MATHEMATICAL SECTION. 115 


Line. Society’s edition. 
22 Dalton 
16 Meyer 


2 EK. K. Gilbert 
7 September 
2 E.K. Gilbert 
18 E. K. Gilbert 
2 Charles C. Boerner 


7 Whyte 
15 B.A. Alvord 
8 Espey . 
30 Whyte 
6 M.B. Meek 


16 “The Henry Mountains,” 


22 ~2B.F. Green 
30 Greene 

15 Woowdard 

27 Henry Parker 


last great, that 


388 Martin 
9 Cox 
3. J. W. Clark 


24 Gallandet 

10 La Verrier’s 
2 Observations 

12 Esquimaux 


Smithsonian edition. 
Dutton 
Mayer 
G. K. Gilbert 
September. 
G. K. Gilbert 
G. K. Gilbert 
Charles G. Boerner 
White 
B. Alvord 
Espy 
White 
F. B. Meek 
The Henry Mountains, 
B. F. Greene 
Green 
Woodward 
Henry, Parker 
great that 
Martyn 
Coues 
F. W. Clark 
Gallaudet 
Le Verrier’s 
Observatories 
the extension of 


DIFFERENCES IN VOLUME III or BULLETIN. 


Line. Society’s edition. 


2 I-XV 
4 David B. Todd 
8 Icthys 


12 Phosphhorescent 


387 base 
36 G. W. Osborne 


56 foot note 


Smithsonian edition. 

i-xv 

David P. Todd 

Tethys 

Phosphorescent 

bases 

J. W. Osborne 

In the above diagram, 
the symbol oc should 
be a, and oc// 2 should 
be a// 2. 


116 


Page. 
57 


58 
58 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Line. 
17 
9 
14 


59 foot note 


117 
120 
124 


195 


126 
126 


127 
127 
156 
159 
164 
165 
168 
168 
168 
168 
168 
169 
169 


30 


Society’s edition. 


0.49788, 15817, 54736. 


b? 
Ta 


m 


Nevada 

Michaelson 

Alfred 

G. W. Osborne 

carboniferous 

to and in consequence 
of 

when known 

miocene 

Nicholas 

Instition 

Hoarlem 

R. Craig 

Aztic 

A. Michelson 

119 and 147 

G. W. Osborne 

S. W. Powell 

C. S. Schott 

L. L. Woodward 


Smithsonian edition. 


0.49788 15817 54736. 
2 

i 

in 

In this page and the fol- 
lowing, the symbol 7 
(for radius) should 
read r. 

Wyoming 

Michelson 

Albert 

J. W. Osborne 

Carboniferous 

streams, which result 
from 

as far as known 

Miocene 

Nichols 

Institution 

Haarlem 

T. Craig 

Aztec 

A. A. Michelson 

119 and 148 

J. W. Osborne 

J. W. Powell 

C. A. Schott 

J. J. Woodward 


Volume 25 of the Smithsonian Collections has the following title- 


page and contents. 


Smithsonian Miscellaneous Collections. Vol. XXV. (Vignette 
and motto.) Washington: Published by the Smithsonian Institu- 


tion. 


1883. 


Table of Contents. 
Article I. (498.) Bulletin of the Philosophical Society of Wash- 
ington. Vol. IV. October 9, 1880, to June 11,1881. 1883. Pp. 


189. 


Article II. 
Washington. 


1883. Pp. 189. 


(503.) Bulletin of the Philosophical Society of 
Vol. V. October 8, 1881, to December 16, 1882. 


INDEX TO VOLUMES. I-X. 


Volume, Roman pagination, Arabic pagination, and pagination of appendix are distinguished 


thus: ix, xvi, 23, (17). 


The pages of appendices are differently numbered at top and at bottom; 


the pagination at bottom. 


the index refers to 


The titles of all papers read to the Society are entered (with some duplication) under the 
following words: Acoustics, Anatomy, Anthropology, Archeology, Astronomy, Biography, Biology, 
Botany, Calendars, Chemistry, Electricity, Geography, Geology, Mathematics, Meteorology, Mi- 
croscopy, Mineralogy, Miscellaneous, Oceanography, Optics, Physics, Political Economy, Psychol- 
ogy, Seismology, Social Science, Thermometry, Zoology. 


Page. 
Abbe, Cleveland, communication on the 
aerial currents observed in balloon as- 
GENSIONS,. ADSt7 ACT ..ccccsecccescesvasssce Rok OS 
the laws governing the movement of 
storm centers. ADStract .........ssceccceeee i 99 
the position of the planes of certain ne- 
bulea. Abstract and reference.......0. a0. i 109 
report of the committee to collect in- 
formation relative to the meteor of 


December 24th, 1873. In full. 2 
FIQures....eoee eedesecncassbasbesne res 41 123, 139 
the aurora. betract Bec ccivssea saunas sedcctecs iv 21 
determining the temperature of the air. 
Abstract......0+ Saatep acess see iua tas ced sccecesassse wi 24 
methods of verifying weather predic- 
tions. Abstract ........ Bretserieccestaeccess vili 8 
Signal Service bibliography of meteor- 
ology. In full....cceoee frtic Antotees couse eee x 


TOMALES ON AULOTAS ..cecovee reece eeeeees 
Stone Mountain patna ane... 


land and S€a DreeZeS ............cessesees ovens 
the mean terrestrial ellipsoid, the geoid, 
and levelling ...... Resehansenneiercnetsasowents whi §=24 
MIAROURICALONOATcitstectescdatsusseccncessecsccres ii 93 
polarization of light by a narrow slit...dd1 124 
Benjamin Peirce.......... monczrarhionereceencheen iv 25 
GHOMAINENSOF SOUNG....c.2-cccscers-secseeccoces v 37 
deflection Of rivers .............02..ssseeeeeeee vii 23 


report as treasurer..v 176, 180, vi xxii, vii xxiv 
Abbe de l’Epee’s instruction of thedumb..vi 63 
Abbe, Prof. E., Apertometer of.................dli 18 

Cited ON MICTOSCOPY.........eeeeee 
Abbey, Westminster S., letter ona ree foun 

on the Florida coast. Read by C. Abbe. 
BVGYQUSEN Mel oxecustsatesssacadccceseenesrsnsescrceer ii 202 
Abel’s researches in elliptic integrals.....wii 106 
_ ACHroMatic ODjeCtiVe......ceccccssccrerersceccreehdd 65 


Page. 
Achromatic objectives, Corrections of....... ili 39 
Acoustic investigations by Joseph Henry..4i 344 
Acoustics, List of papers on: 
on phenomena of sound and experiments 
with tuning forks, J. Henry. Title 
ONG aaeestinvc tates Uea erento a 22 
on sound in relation to fog-signals, from 
investigations under the direction of 
the U.S. Light House Board. J. Henry 
Ti SUL ss ceseuesesvayoutins cocsentedsacceeee Ons AM (45) 
recent experimental researches in acous- 
tics, by Prof. A. M. Mayer. J. E. Hil- 
PAL) “DWE OMe sicssicrcsacsescocesnvceneseeeees i 90 
experiments on fog signals during the 
pastsummer. J. Henry. Title only...t 90 
[letter on fog-signals.] J. Tyndall. Com- 
municated by J. Henry. No abstract...i 91 


on audition. J. Henry. Title only......... ii 22 
on fog-signals and abnormal conditions of 
sound. J. Henry. Reference............ di 37 
sound in connection with fog signals. J. 
Henry. Reference........ listeecedcqsaneecendd li 57 
acoustic refraction. W. B. Taylor. Ab- 
BUT GCLsctttesentaneastascevenshavehone erry | leeeiy 


an account of ropesmtionyt on Bodied! in its 
application to fog-signals. Annual ad- 


dress, 1875. J. Henry. Reference......ii 60 
exhibition of a telaphon. E. Gray. Ab- 

SUN ALLaveakssatrecadceagasscuwacninetevake tance inne sete ii 67 
[fog-signals.] J. eary, Abstract.........44 85 
the telephone. A. G, Bell. Uneaiat aNaven ii 103 
commentsonthe telephone. E. B. Elliott. 

THEME OMA scdaxessascatccaasstacuseces aratevssensaaves di 111 


{scientific method and its application to 
acoustic researches in connection with 
fog signals.] Annual address, 1877. J. 
Henry. Jn full........ asehes ebnctedteueccdsseed ii 162 


118 


Page. 
Acoustics, List of papers on—Continued. 
the telephote. E. B. Elliott. Abstract...i& 192 
musical intervals. E. B. Elliott. Ab- 
SEPOCT...000 Mavala ihecsestsNisubsrensesevesessncedened ii 199 
binaural audition. A.G. Bell. Abstraet.Adi 68, 69 
the spectrophone. A. G. Bell, In full. 
a 


upon a modification of Wheatstone’s mi- 
crophone and its applicability to radio- 
phonic researches. A.G. Bell. Jn full. 


recent investigations by the Light House 
Board on the anomalies of sound from 


fog-signals. A. B. Johnson. In full. 

Baap ey Li figuyressevavcstserssavenasacdsuschacncate vi 23 
anomalies of sound signals. J.C. Welling. 

Upiifutllcusavenencsasesdnacteoeacesvaetesse sevens ceeett v 39 


the difficulty in determining the direction 
ofsound. A.B.Johnson. Abstract.-wiii 11, 12 
the mechanism of “clicks” and “clucks.” 


Ay G2» Bell. .Ditle only: ticicestecceseeess vili 18 
Action at & GiStaNnCe........cecececsscescccessassssses ~v 156 
Adams, Prof. Carl, cited on Malfatti’s prob- 

lem ...... Dbasbusssnenacsieie eebeewonee sebebnascnentee ii 118 
adams, Prof. W. G., cited on electric resist- 

ANCEvsiasherees shavdeGhabcvsphtssishecroneetesaseabt iv 154 
Address of chairman of Mathematical Sec- 

TION 2.200005 Rusdatemavessines Peschucusenenadeenenerck vi 117 

of President Beare VST lisvecesserseacanscceaes iv, 34 
Henrys US7TGiecccens-scse se gch Sevaugnsecaadtecnarat ii 60 
TOM ys L877 pecvsccstecustasscevasssestpeceveeeecees ii 162 
Newcomb, 1879... ..ccceccccoseceeeoee aude cnessaeen did 52 


Newcomb, 1880... 
Woodward, 1881.. 


Taylor, 1882........ 

Powell, 1883 ............. Sbskedpeberes WA KRVTI, 10 

Welling, 1884... wii xxix, 81 

a pA S86 ycesstsweccncrecccstaen eee Wiki x xxiii, 30 

IBIS CSGiscssencts ese csseceescnns serene ix xxxv, 46 

Harknege: DSSTide. aiicneecsseussesceeneus x xxXvii, 39 

of retiring president, Resolution concern- 

ADs evens Sercesonessos BubavsvcteastadsstwavaxeenueeeT iv 30 


on the life and character of Joseph Henry, 
44 203, 368, 370 


Adhesion and CoheSion............ssessessereeeeneee v 136 
Adirondack region, Proposed reservoirs in 
CBs. cceikevwane spent ecw seetueteccessalaueccersdssnves ii 67, 82 
Adjustment of conditioned observations, viii 41 
Of tHE CAVED ATs, neq cayentewewewascatssccaesdasnnesra: ii 59 
Administration of scientifie work ........... ix xliii 
Adulteration of food........... Bei avlack dana sehousens iv 39 
Aerolite. See Meteor. 
Agassiz, Louis, Announcement of oath of.i 93 
Resolutions on death of....... pavawsuateesenacarnr A 95 


Agricola, Georg, cited on mineralogy.........8 77 
Ague, Conservative function Of.....ccseeece 5 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Air, Contamination Of ccccicsccovsssnessccstseceare iv 37 

Alaska, Discoveries in’....... 
Glaciation in....... 
Results of envels 3 in.. 


Value to the United States ofa, iesecsagehneeeaen 
Alaska-Siberia boundary .......0. cesssseeceeeee iv 123 
Albertype process of photo-engraving........l 42 
Aleutian Islands, Shell heaps of.............00+ ii 65 


Alexander, Stephen, communceation on the 
zodiacal light. Read by J. E. Hilgard. 


En: full, 9: fig“ures ics cosssccoeseced ocakeeied 1105, (19) 
Algebra, Logical 
Algorithm of the arithmetico-geometric 

INOS gaanecasbauecacessnaeecsase aspteuprearemraatey vil 102 
Alignment curves on any surface............. vi 123 
Allard, M. E., cited on the light-house service 

of the United States................sssssss 
Alluvial basin of the Mississippi.... 
Alphabet, PHONG :....<cs:<00cseesseoctuesaseeenners 
Altitude of the Caspian and Aral seas........ ii 34 
Altitudes deduced from combination of rail- 

road levellings........ ccnp dsteseusteeenpeannaeal fi 23 
Alvord, Benjamin, cited on gravitation form- 

Ti iscecccenne sss sseunacilasaessetsgueaaeeraaane sees Wild 40 


communication on the habitability of the 


elevated plateaus of the west. Title 

ONT cs tivcasesrnke Soucuclaveousvevenadueue eeeeeeeEeeeeae i 74 
the recent earthquakes in North Caro- 

lina.) Abstract ..22..:<.0hessscanenceseaeeaaeeeee 1101 
the mortality among army officers. Ref- 

EN ENCE... ovwucvaccnacosdsbucucsstes ten isaseeeeennannaane ii 49 
proposed governmental insurance. Wo 

ADSETACE.....2-..00000 BEERS eeeeecrecocin cn caseaus ii 49 


a trigonometrical formula. Title only...ii 104 
the intersection of circles and the inter- 
section of spheres. Title only.......... Ai 198 
new points respecting the intersections 
of circles and the intersections of 


spheres. Title ionts).scscvccecanaesenteeeeeee Ad 201 
life and work of Joseph Henry. Jn 
fils snanscacsosansyoesdenenasaaee sap vaserarese pan aacent ii 370 
a curious fallacy as to the theory of gray- 
itation. In full.....\..cccscavessoncusuureenenenen ve 8 
some of the properties of Steiner’s power 
Circle. Title Onltfissccconscasnadetvesevaeseeeeae 


the compass plant. Reference 
aspecial case in maxima and minima. 


ADSEr Obi accceciicoans eocesusdvseceiangukeeaeneeene wi 149 
Death Ofise..edsincsmeene scbeedeeeet vii 72, 127 
List of mathematical papers by........... -vik 128 
Memorial tO. ..cccuaeccsssccvaresees deapsteratureanes wii 127 


remarks on Lake Bonneville... shtiee ed MOS 


Benjamin Peirce... 


Arkansas bonds..........+ 
agricultural colle ges..........ccccsecccee sees: wi 106 
Amendment to constitution.............. ix 47,x 39 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 
Amendment to standing rules....iii 149, iv 
xi, 38, vilix, xi 


American Academy of Arts and Sci- 

ONCEH)...c.ccned Epatvanuesseverteucessdataae wili xxxvi 
American Association for the Advancement 

of Science........... antdsesssscsdccssee WAG, XXXIX 
American Philosophical Society........ viii xxxiv 
American scientific societies............ witli xxxiii 
Ampére, Law of........ aaeaesee Gutvesarsuaswdkeauesne «ev 139 
Anal notch in Pleurotomaria..............sse0 Adi 76 
Analysis of meteorite......... paneesuseersseuvcecers vii 32 


Anatomy and Physiology, List of 
papers on: 
on the alleged hermaphrodite described 
by Drs. Accly, Blackman, and Jackson. 
J.J.Woodward. Abstractandreferencei 24 
on the fluctuations of the temperature of 
the human body. B. F. Craig. Ref- 


ET ENCE res .scasese Waeenbevoostenenadedencrancuea Seretucres i 31 
on fractures of the inner table of the cra- 
nium. G. A. Otis. Title only......000.0 i 73 


[letter on autopsy of Agassiz.] Dr. Jack- 
son. Communicated by J. J. Woodward. 
Wo abstract....... eccaa eee econcorcase sehvcestes dt 92 
on the similarity between the red blood- 
corpuscles of man and those of certain 
other mammals, especially the dog; 
considered in connection with the di- 
agnosis of blood-stains in criminal 
eases. J.J. Woodward. Abstract and 
PEPETERCE ccc esaveesnsnoneese secsunerese pentesaueveses ii 20 
explanatory note in regard to the diagnosis 
of blood-stains. J. G. Richardson. 
Communicated by J. J. Woodward. Ref- 


ROUGE Aches vatevassqncceeuavsaveecesacséeaacs apaseuet fi 41 
the conservative element in disease. A. 
yA ISIN ADSI ACh occccence seseoe-ceces Ad 111 


the conservative influence of disease as 
illustrated in the phenomena of pul- 
monary phthisis. A. F. A. King. Ab- 
REM CCl tacaecusnvescosces davacsscusascnessateccocscacas fi 124 
the influence of the cardiac and respiratory 
movements upon the motion of the 
lymph. 8.C. Busey. Abstract and ref- 


asymmetry in the form of the human cra- 
nium. C.A.White. Title only........ «Ai 190 
the physiology of civilization. H. Reed. 
ERTCEIONUY cavccessasccosssasanste ataweresneeteass iii 20 
color perception and color blindness. S. 
M. Burnett. Abstract and reference...iw 54 
on the influence of the constant use of 
high-heeled shoes upon the health and 
form of the female, and upon the rela- 
tion of the pelvic organs. S.C. Busey. 
ADSUFGECE scuscsscsesscsesscoce aonpeea selcccawarshe v 117 


119 


Page. 
Anatomy and Physiology, List of 
papers on—Continued. 
modern ideas of brain mechanism. F. 


Baker. Title onlt/.......00..0+ Sensavszseesst@ Rane 17, 
Anaxagoras’ philosopDy ......s0sseceeceeees wii xxxii 
Andromeda, New star in........ eaunakeletedenentake ix 14 
Animal population of'the globe.............. wv 27 


Annual address. See Address. 
Annual meeting. See Election of officers and 


Address. 
Anomalies of sound from fog-signals ...... Vv 23, 39 
Anthropological Society of Washington ..... x 46 
Invitation from...... tackevesneess -wili 5, ix 15, x 6 
Anthropological work of the Smithsonian 
ENSHIUUUION. «. scccsccccescousviasneee soseusesteontan ii 299 


Anthropology, List of papers on. 
also, Archeology.) 
on the characteristics and zoological rela- 
tions of man. T.Gill. <Abstract.........8 24 
on the mythology of the Numas. J. W. 
Powell.” Heferencetsccccssascesssccevessascesate i 96 
on the genesis and demonology of the 
Numa tribe of Indians. J. W. Powell. 


UR OP EVGICE!.acecesansteraves sev; andasatentuasscanaeee .-l 104 
a calendar of the DakotaIndians. G. Mal- 
lery. Abstract and reference..........0++ ii 90 


the philosophy of the North American In- 
dians. J. W. Powell. Title only. 109, 110 
some common errors respecting the North 
American Indians. G. Mallery. <Ab- 
SET ACE ANE TESETENCE. .ascserecresssentnaonoucceas 44175 
poisons among the North American In- 
dians. J. W. Powell. Abstract......... ii 182 
the use of poisoned arrows by North Amer- 
ican Indians. E. Coues and W. J. Hoff- 
man. Title only....... neeceeaneeene puschesners li 183 
the evelution of language. J. W. Powell. 
PREG OMY ice recevecacyvartatiesacasare Sencsewacsert ii 199 
the progressive dispersion of mankind 
over the surface of the earth. A. Win- 
chell. Title only....... ausndabeetettecsseeal Aid 32 
the future of the human race regarded 
from the standpoint of evolution. S. 
Newcomb. Presidential address. Title 


on the gentile system of the Omahas. J. 
O. Dorsey. In full; 3 figures....... soseeddd 128 
comparison of written language, with that 
which is spoken only. O. T. Mason. 
ADSETACEscscnsenessasnece reece area thy onvenet hii 139 
limitations to the use of some anthropo- 
logic data. J. W. Powell. Refer- 


the three methods of evolution. 
Powell. Presidential address. In full. 
vi xxvii, 110 


120 


Page. 
Anthropology, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
composite photography applied to crani- 


ology. J.S. Billings. Abstract......wil 25 
natural naturalists. W. Matthews. Read 
by J. S. Billings. Abstract.......0+++ vii 73 


mythological dry paintings of the Navajos. 
W. Matthews. Abstract........0000.Wddi 14 
anthropometric and reaction-time appa- 
ratus. J.S. Billings and W. Matthews. 
ADSEL ACE cccsasesse0ccens peceasaseeene Peprrerrcct 7+ | Yan s: 
two examples of similar inventions in areas 
widely apart. O.T. Mason. Abstract.ix 12 
eustoms of every-day life. G. Mallery. 
BA DBE: RE Ge tens suetcs aso al cgeaueaeaisvartecaad tuvach ix 19 
bowyers and fletchers. O.T. Mason. Ab- 


counting out rhymes of children; their 
antiquity, origin and wide distribu- 


tion. H.C. Bolton. Reference........... x 13 
Anticlinal and synclinal axes........ phanyasatean Ai (22) 
Antisell, Thomas, communication on dust 

from Armenia. Wo abstract.......000008 25 

meteorology of Japan. Title only ........4 70 
visit to Japan. No abstract.....cscssecceres di 84 


terrestrial geogony. Title only.Ai 132, 133, 134 
temperatures of the Pacific Ocean. Ab- 


stract ..... Saedg y:broecteode sentds sus te anadeatanewae ii 192 
chemical molecular changes. Title 
ONUY, ‘soar sssnsccnaxenosene ganda cata -eRaReRenUtadsed ili 28 
the building up of organic matter. Title 
ONLY ..2e000 una oneasebopenstnan<aebise-esb ast deerman sa v 97 
TeMarks ON WaterspOuts........ecsecceeseecesees ii 104 
faunal accommodation........ satasoaneresnved ii 181 
POISONER ALLOWS... ssicncsecscaonsnscceseccnsacens ii 183 
vegetation and environment .............6 ii 183 
Wasat@byfaltecc. sssasscsesdsecnerssen cn sSocecreetr. ii 196 
TAVAGES Of FOLCCOs.<.stencsa-s0enacocenenascscesess v 98 
artesian water on the Plains................ -v 101 
thermometer CXPOSUTE.......sccccseeseeee eee wi 47 
dissociation....... cece hte ere ocensoe Merc ererts vii 16 
Volcanic AUSt...........0.0.cceceee ees wii 20, 25, 26 
cause of thunderstorms 
OH OMsi cc cercodanscnenasvadeedhesecctecyxsuesieceee 
Antlers, Morphology a bays savabaanccenstacesareneeee ii 135 
APIONEGMIGLONS cecnesnccvensspeneseonsesseatonnawenucnerad iii 18 
Aphakia.......ccsce reese dancusteuaiereukensandatsapeanssnte wi 5 
Appalachian MOUNtAINS...........secceceeseeeeeres iv 60 
LOPORV API Vic sisshenscrhigesdaccetdaredeetssnasddansaneeus ix 22 
Apparatus, Base-lime..........-scccscccssseesceneoees Aid 35 
for examination of the CY@.......sseceeeee ili 53 
for exhibiting local time at all points of 
GHG SLOWG ii vatea tas cas sececadexessacccted saseard iii 107 
for viewing the sun by light of any desired 
wave length........ iienenbs irdaaswaey Dabatnadeete x18 
to facilitate “sweeping”? .........cccceserseeees iii 142 
Apples, Problem of rotten and wormy.....x 87, 89 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Aral'seéa, Altitade Of. ..2.....cccssonceuse is cevendaneaes il 
Archzeology, List of papers on: 
{exhibition of] archeological specimens. 


QO. T: Mason. Title ont... Jcsscessesees ii 48 
the classification of objects of archeology. 
O. T. Mason. Title only.......1s.0000ecceees ii 50 


remarks on the Papyrus Ebers. J. J.Wood- 
Ward. ADSst7Qcl....cc:cccsuscuosssacere-uusunsap Ran OEE 
the succession of the strata of the shell- 


heaps of the Aleutian Islands. W. H. 
Dall. ADStract ....ssessseceee woadshdaap eerie ii 65 
the international symbols for charts of pre- 
historic archewology. O. T. Mason. 
ADSENGCE. cite weesaystinderesseeaces esapceadtentl 1171, 72 
prehistoric copper. J. D. Butler. Title 
Otay ccatearseisnaeedeazp se ecuscbenesee ossheasstendees@Raoiltis 


the fresh-water shell-heaps of the interior 
rivers of North America. C. A. White. 
Tle ON scsscanconecsauens sxsuncsstnen asada iii 32 

the decipherment of some Aztec monu- 
ments lately discovered in Guatemala. 


O. T. Mason. idle onlyy.....00 '-.-0-s0nen0 iii 37 
Arctic exploration......... sosseessh 92, 11 89, ix 8 
Argentine COIMage ......seeccseseserees-ceeee 
Aristotle cited on atoms... 

MiNETAlOZY....sereerceceeee 

Arithmetic, Binary.......... 
Arizona, Physical features of........ haqsnaexeae esol 54 
Volesnic activity ind ..0...sccccesscoscsucneansuetanee i 99 

Army and Navy officers as scientifle admin- 

IStratOTs.....eccoee ose dssetdaanasensae a oe 
officers, Mortality none Kekees evened tenance li 49 
Medical Museum... ...cessesssndescoabecnaune FAT: ix 35 
Medical Museum building...........0..00 x 10, 31 


Arrow, Sir F., cited on phenomena of sound. 
At (49), (50) 


Arrows, Poisoned............00+ cosseneccantseasuill EB pn ea 
Artesian well with geyser action............ ecce hk LOS 
wells on the Great Plains.........ccsee csseeeeW LOL 
Arts, Evolution of ..........cese» adeeeninagaeen vi xlviii 
Assembly Hall of Cosmos Club.......s00---.-.X 10, 31 
Association ratios........ sneeeaes eacaneat sascssatensK Gay OF 
Astigmatism = wwii 64 
Hoeal, limes \it).c.cks:svcsumvecroaees a oles saueanuanme yee 
Astronomy, List of paper: on. (See also 


Calendars) : 

on the elements of the Comet I, 1871. A. 
Hall. Communicated by B. F. Sands. 
ADSEtract...ce0 pdxsbetsstaaeaaens oatehguatyentteasnen i 23 

on two immense meteorites at Conception 
and San Gregorio, Mexico. H. B. 
Butcher... Reference. sccssssesesenedueteceeaad A 24 

on astronomical photography. A. Hall. 
Abstract and reference...ec0ecceserseesereersd 28 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 


Astronomy, List of papers on—Cont'd. 
on the transits of Venus, past and future. 


S.Newcomb. Title onlyy............ccccesses i 
on the heat of the sun. B. Peirce. Ab- 
RUNTCLocccccuscc cee. Gassaeeessniervcd Seedesetace wedeeat- i 


on the physivzal constitution of the co- 
rona ofthe sun. W. Harkness. Refer- 


on the spectrum of Encke’s comet and 
the appearence of Tuttle’s comet. W. 
Harkness. Reference.......06 Seebene ise sees i 
on the astronomical proof of the existence 
of a resisting medium in space. A. 


EU Mets PIRETET CNC Ocaks csc accsdecsesoctuses ocsceseenell 
{on the speetrum of Encke’s comet.] W. 
Harkness. Reference....... wuvecasmtebebyeccce i 


on the appearance of Encke’s comet as 
seen at Harvard College observatory. 
CASHPSICO:) WEferencOriciccarcccases svereeve i 
on the density of the hypothetical resist- 
ing medium in space. W. Harkness. 


Reference......++ anerentnsrdestabusvesivesveseeeaes a! 
on the possibility of a universal atmos- 
phere. S. Newcomb. Title only......... i 


on the discovery of’ new planets having 
especial reference to the asteroids. J. 
C. Watson. Title only... sectsearene ek 
[letter on solar eclipse.] Gant. bemegoniiti 
Communicated by W. Harkness. No ab- 
iMG lapscsocsdavsecvcusvessesvses dddsvastweccceccR 
[letters on idandete Gikeevaioty| Bara: 
Gould. Communicated by J. H. C. Coffin 
and J. J. Woodward. No abstract........ i 
on the determination of the errors of a 
provisory catalogue of tundamental 
stars. O.Stone. Title only...........s000 i 
on the progress of the construction of the 
new telescope for the Naval Observa- 
tory. S. Newcomb. Reference....... i 62 
on our present knowledge of the planet 
Jupiter. W.B. Taylor. Title only.....i 
Maps prepared by G. W. Hil! for use in 
connection with the transit of Venus 
in December, 1874. J. H. C. Coffin. 
Refer ence.........0.e000 We ceseeeseeuce sencadsnenrenees i 
on stellar photometry. .S. Peirce. ‘Ref: 


the proceedings of the commission to 
arrange for the observation of the next 
transit of Venus. S. Newcomb. Title 
Ei conebassesesnete ose eedveaneereceewaees musiesess ee 
@ comparison of the thermometers used 
to determine the correction for at- 
mospheric refraction at the U. S. 
Naval Observatory. J. R. Eastman. 
PRU LISEEL) cantahsewescacssdonasceus davtat ioscasncectude i 


29 


31 


31 


34 


34 


34 


35 


39 


52 


53 


56 


57 


62 


63 


63 


63 


68 


121 


Page. 


Astronomy, List of papers on—Cont’d. 


on the results of astronomical obserya- 
tions at Sherman Station, Wyoming 
Terr. R. b. Cutts. Abstract and refer- 
ence.. Siena eee As eccoocen ey cera 
on the (austin of ‘the Patni of comets’ 
tails. B. Peirce. Reference.............00 i 
on the general star catalogue prepared 
from the observations at the Naval Ob- 
servatory since 1845. M. Yarnall. Ref- 
OMEN Cred adssaddasevesuurccudeccccaieccaysscestcueceonss i 
on the power necessary to drive the pend- 
ulum of an astronomical clock. W. 
Harkness: Zttle Onyf....c-csscssssssccseasses i 
on a proposed method of observing astron- 
omical transits. E. Foote. Title only. 
the frequency of the occurrence of the 
zero and the nine digits in the tenths 
of seconds from the chronographic 
record of transit observations. J. R. 
ASEAN. “CAOSETILCL....cecc.ccesecteeesecsrscrs i 
[letter on the Cordoba Observatory.] B. 
A. Gould. Communicated by J. J. Wood- 
ward. NO Adstract....sss:..560cceccssnesve cone i 
[letter on proposed observatory.] J. Lick. 
Communicated by J. Henry. No ab- 
SET ACE re cwascacs scantvassccerecssessc ebcemeanncecsuseyen i 
a detailed account of the construction of 
the lenses and other interesting por- 
tions of the large telescope now estab- 
lished at the Naval Observatory. A. 
Clarks ULNA ONY.3.<.ceteasececusctesesxeteceers i 
on the determination of the personal er- 
rors in the observation of astronomical 
transits. J. E. Hilgard. Title only...i 
on comets and meteors. A. Hall. Refer- 


[the meteor of December 24, 1873.] P. 
Parker. Wo abstract... .....00 Sarr rannc i 
[letter on the meteor of December 24, 1873.] 
B. Hallowell. Communicated by J. 
Henry: INO GO8t7 Web xs052 0-05 ssccse sanusnens i 


_ on the adopted value of the sun’s appar- 


ent diameter. E.S. Holden. Jn full, 


70 


74 


74 


74 


75 


85 


88 


91 


92 


92 
94 


94 


95 


4 95, (3) 


=on various hypotheses in reference to 


space. C.S. Peirce. Title only........... i 
on specimens of meteoric iron from Chi- 
huahua, Mexico, and the structure of 
meteorites in general. IF. M. Endlich. 
DUEL OMe) iccxasavsbvonecs coaccuasett von-neceeneasetes i 
on meteor trains, and the upper atmos- 
pheriecurrents. J. Henry. Title only.i 
on the apparatus to be used in the observa- 
tions of the approaching transit of 
Venus. W. Harkness. 


97 


98 


98 


Title only......4 102 


122 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON 


Page. 
Astronomy, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
on the zodiacal light. S. Alexander. Com- 
municated by J. E. Hilgard. In full; 9 
TROPA ER ccs aN as tonim ncacchenepiedarntessteusted 1105, (19) 
on Sir William Herschel’s observations of 
the satellites of Uranus. E.S. Holden. 
Tit PUY .cscascecenvsecscersoscesswoscsepseesesees i 106, (30) 
a new apparatus for the investigation of 
personal error in astronomical transit 
observations. J. E. Hilgard. Title 
Ot pmectendcatebsae tence custancasceseaseansa anaes eeseeeeh 106 
on the position of the planes of certain 
nebule, C. Abbe. Abstract and refer- 


NOB vascaverceesviencassanae pike ences Bvedettewteas & LOD) 
on the correction of a comet’s orbit. O. 
Stone. Reference... ié3 scesechl §=22 


[letier on transit of Veuis; 1874] ms ‘HL, F. 
Peters. Communicated by A. Hall. <Ab- 
SUT OCU. cansacsskeoreaes ada dassusedueces sodeacesdnsucet ii 31 
[letter on transit of Venus, 1874.] C. W. 
Raymond. Communicated by A. Hall. 
SAIDSURGET .ccesantencasdersrertceeevenssecseacdens wed 31 
[letters] on the operations of the several 
parties sent from the United States to 
observe the transit of Venus on the 8th 
of Dee’r, 1874. A. Hall. Abstract. ....44 31,32 
[letter on transit of Venus, 1874.] W. Hark- 
ness. Communicated by A. Hall. <Ab- 
SUNACE sevccrcencsccsncsecnastorcnacsscodcssneanseusnan ii 32 
[letter on transit of ae 1874.] G. David- 
son. Communicated by A. Hall. Ab- 
SUCH stcesnattvies race on series ea Sacer ti 
the expedition to Pekin for observing the 
late transit of Venus [1874]. C. A. 


VOW, ee ALOSUOCH ssdansnsnthcesn «cnokesanceboes ii 33 
on the transit of Venus [1874]. S. New- 
COMP. —LIGle ONLY \ccedourssnansneanse meestarredk, 40 


two drawings of nebula, made with the 
XXVI-inch telescope of the U.S. Naval 
Observatory, by Mr. L. Trouvelot, of 
Cambridge, Mass. E.S. Holden. Ab- 
SUNCED rcacussiadacvonscvascusceisee cvioccosences spocssee Ai 51 
the methods of measuring the inequalities 
of the pivots of a transit instrument. 


W. Harkness. Title only.....cccere covers ii 68 
the temperature of space. W. B. Taylor. 

CA DSU OChoasuvetaansnonotin shee cucsvecessrass<ausanis ii 73 
[search for Vulcan.] E. S. Holden. <Ab- 

SUPACEcoresevsscancencsasyoscesceaseverseusapensions=ne ii 85 
the appearance of Saturn’s rings. A. Hall. 

A DSENGECD scence cccucrssceaccen seeuuds=voternseuperase ii 94 


on reference catalogues of astronomical 
papers and memoirs. E. S. Holden. 
Abstract....... btavskpseead poasereghaveciekennenant Mi 95 

the shadow of the ball of Saturn projected 
ontherings. E.8. Holden. Abstract..ii 101 


Page. 


Astronomy, List of papers on—Cont’d. 


a bright spot which [has] recently become 
visible on the ball of Saturn. A. Hall. 
Abstract... cae «Ad 102 

the coamogony. 's. Naweomb, Title outer ii 113 

report of the committee to collect informa- 
tion relative to the meteor of Decem- 
ber 24th, 1873. Read by C. Abbe. In 
full; 2 figures, 1 MAD ..ccccceereeceereekd 123, 139 

the position of the centre of gravity of the 
apparent disk of a planet. A. Hall. 
Reference ..... acuecebasesed=neeneate WecteneWeaae ii 181 
the results of [a] search for satellites of 
Mars. <A. Hall. Abstract and refer- 
ENCE sdvueiiceucds tusscwecesesssecesaeuehae cacnbopennean di 186 
the nebular hypothesis and the inner moon 
of Mars. M. H. Doolittle. Abstract, 
ii 1838, 190 
aerolithic disturbance of planetary mo- 
tions. M.H. Doolittle. <Abstract......41 190 

the recent transit of Mercury [1878]. S. 
Newcomb. AdSstract....ccccrscssscssecscerehd 199 

& new eye-piece for observing personal 
equations. A. Schott. Title only......i4 200 

the velocity of light and determination of 
the solar parallax. W. Harkness. Title 
OMe .ssnnncscovuscsosdbsedsecuenebsensvesnusseshsaunteam meen 

observations of the total solar eclipse, July 
29,1878. S. Newcomb. Abstract.......i% 202 

notes on the brightness and the stellar 
magnitude of the third Saturnian sat- 
ellite, Tethys. E.S. Holden. Read by 
A. N. Skinner. Ditle only......0000...-. Add 18 

on the supposed discovery ot a trans-Nep- 
tunian planet at the U. S. Naval Ob- 
servatory in 1850. A. Hall. Abstract.dil 20 

a note on the precession of stars in right 
ascension. A.N.Skinner. Title only, 


see eeeeeeneee 


iii 21 
on the satellites of Saturn. A. Hall. Ab- 
SEPACE «2.0000 Coktaesbodesteterase ccaseesnens Carte iii 26 
@ personal equation instrument. J. R. 
Eastman. Abstract........ avodeanet See Lil 33, 37 
the recurrence of eclipses. S. Newcomb. 
Title Ot .: ccscavatnsaczssacuscceaeanee oraneen Ald 33 
notes on the orbits of Titan and Hyperion. 
A. Hall. AbSt7 Get.....ccuss-2s ceansasnarennaye ee aeeeO 


some results from the dissussion of the 
observations of the transit of Mercury 
of May 6, 1878. J. R. Eastman Ab- 
STTACL .. 200000 eeaneueasaee Berenice: enneseestead iii 43 
a recent visit to California to inspect a site 
for the new Lick Observatory. S. New- 
COMb. Title Only .....cMWrsecccrrscscsconsokht 45 
solar parallax from the velocity of light. 
D. P. Todd. Reference........ asaeoe eases iii 74 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 


Astronomy, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
a pile of balls. M. H. Doolittle. Abstract, 
ili 
on the solar corona. W. Harkness. <Ab- 
review of B. A. Gould’s Uranometria Ar- 
gentina. E. S. Holden. Reference, 
id 119, 
remarks on the total solar eclipse of Jan- 
uary llth, 1880. E. Frisby. <Abstract, 
ili 


on a mechanical attachment for equatorial 


mountings to facilitate sweeping in 
right ascension. D. P. Todd. Abstract 
NOME EPENCE ma sanccocdscuegastesnsbeveccascacrs hid 
on asimple method of deriving some equa- 
tions used in the theory of the moon 
and of the planets. W. F. McK. Ritter. 


SPraNUL caeopapy dat vansvuuusbpsvaesvesseesttpioveesdcs iv 
on the orbit of Swift’s cae E. Frisby. 
AD SEP EChiesenwericcvtss Mafsdsnvbnasrcaentscusens ste iv 


the solar parallax as derived from the 
American photographs of the transit 
of Venus, 1874, December 8-9. D. P. 
Todd. Abstract and reference..........4V 
the relative accuracy of different methods 
of determining the solar parallax. W. 


Harkness, (Roferences.cicccasecdccosceccess v 
on the total lunar eclipse of June 11, 1881. 
Wa bBalavylorin Abstracts. cc: iccscscctesess Vv 


the Florida expedition for observation of 
the transit of Venus [1882]. J. R. East- 


Man. Abstract..........000 nore: daeceoses vi 
note on the rings of Saturn. W. B. Taylor. 
EADHURMEC Ian csepddvaserenuvasacs inemwesvuseccocoevess wi 


the determination of the mass of a planet 
from observation of tio satellites. A. 
Rca CADRE CE rversctcestacersedesstvectoctecas vi 
certain possible abbreviations in the com- 
putation of the long-period perturba- 
tions of the moon’s motion due to the 
direct action of the planets. G. W. 
Hill. Abstraet and reference............. vi 

& new meteorite. J. R. Eastman. 
BORGCU grosusensuvsdesasss scbuvecisssseasvuess euseees vii 
the formuls for computing the position of 
a satellite. A. Hall. In full. 1 figure. 
vil 

a case of discontinuity in elliptic orbits. 
W.B. Taylor. <Abstract...... SOCERCCELAY vil 
variations of latitude. A. Hall. Abstract 
CNG TES ET ENCE. 0055. sccceccvesusreeceuvavsessse viii 
comets II and III, 1884, W. C. Winlock. 
STATLO[OVEri/ Cons atasestnsncedavenvavascecaevoerecs viii 

the asteroids. G.L. Ravené. Title only, 
vili 18, 


76 


116 


122 


121 


57 


59 


168 


39 


90 


21 


136 


93 


122 


10 


16 


64 


123 


Page. 
Astronomy, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
flexures of transit instruments. W. Hark- 

BLOSA PANEL LCH aiccssenctdctecdsdcdeonteecas will 27 
physical observations of Wolf’s comet 

(1884 I[I). W. C. Winlock. Abstract, 

wil 37 
the theory of Mercury. G. L. 

LAID SD NLC ead vecnsteananentsapavarsadesss<utaiacss viii 41 
secular perturbations of Polyhymnia by 

Jupiter. W.F. McK. Ritter. Abstract, 

viii 54 
the new star in the nebula’of Andromeda. 

Ry Halli “Reference acescveczsucvaies sabessses ix 14 
the images of stars. A. Hall. Reference.ix 15 
a comparison of the Boss and Auwers’ de- 

elination standards. H. Farquhar. 

Abstract And TefEerenee...cccserereeseee sense ix 53 
on a device for viewing the sun by light of 

any desired wave length. W. Hark- 

MOSES ped DEENAGLicesenacoustsurcecacierverssentrete x 13 
on the representation of comet orbits by 


models. W. Harkness. Reference... 28 
The motion of Hyperion. G. W. Hill. Ab- 

StrACE ANA TELETENCE.....02s-00s00r0recseeoe Percee ke. 
the parallax of @Tauri. A. Hall. Ab- 

SUNG Lanses! sug can sancn devas qansennynendssaadenapaiean pte 


the most protable value of the latitude 
and its theoretical weight from en- 
tangled observations occurring in the 
use of Talcott’s method. Abstract....x 91 

Euler’s theorem (generally called Lam- 


bert’s). A. Hall. ADStract.........0-se0e» x 101 

the orbit of Hyperion. O. Stone. Abstract 
NUD EF CENCE. rocssssenvescseuscorersessachsnsnaeree x 104 
Atmospheric temperature determination..wi 24 
Atomic motions........ epee en pep contre acced v 143 

philosophy, physical and metaphysical, 
wii xxix 
VOMIEMIONCUIVO\iosasssascnvcseoatesteetap co's sleneaes vii 15 
volumes of crystallized and double salts. 103 
WIG Siivsancennsccecsraresacosecsveosautrestaasdves wii xlvii 

SONI 8 aoauiesvncensiiaa-léabusebidcnudecuuseiesnunvaesaansarst 


Attraction, Infinite, of a finite mass..4119, viii 58 
Auditing Committee. See Committee. 


AUGIHION,, DINAOTAl hs cesecctecssacnssscepcteasscecentd ili 69 
Avigora, LOIS HtOln ccs cccavesstPavcseestaastaccssesuss iv 21 

of Bebritary Athy ISToiectose. chant acketccavenpal he i 47 

THEOFIOS (OL scat eccecteccasesnetesgrecentusseatentens i 43 
Auwers’ declination standards...........,...06 ix 53 
Avicenna, cited on mineralogy... .........0c0000 1 ar ivs 
Avogadro, Law Of ..............0-000 slaactertissenetan v 139 


124 


Page. 
Babcock, O. E., Death of ...........06 pisdsaneb «wil 72 
Bacillus Malaria...... sees veudatedsucccucta wiv 39 
Bache, A. D., Eulogy 01.......0c.cscocccccecsesseees i 35 
BAC hel igtecccvercess areccdatddeccececescetensteécsesscessecaessk 40 
and spontaneous generation...............00+ ii 109 
Baer’s law......... Raceecetenacee peaeibaed ravi teteprere vii 21 
Baeyer, cited on corrections to levelling for 
deflection of the plumb line............. fi 25 
Bagehot, cited on occult force..........Wi XXxiii 
Bailey, T., Death of........ bbaacenas ceuvauensuay di 109, 111 
Baird, S. F.,and scientific societies...........X 45 
as an administrator........ aba igeaneasendent mdevns x 49 


communication on the decrease of fish on 
the southern coast of New England. 


Reference........00 Seen eerpauusn pean ieassipet ees Wea 

the artificial propagation of the cod. 
Abstract....... a jnuudarsecaueacuanibeng ecessccevash Ah 29 
WIGHUN Olvsoctssesecanassatedssa Rersaneasevisaseuncn x 17, 20, 76 
Meeting commemorative Of..........s008 ese x 41 
Personal characteristics Of.........sss++e+ ee pelr(l 

remarks on archsological collection by 
Gr UAC Nas sacaancesetecoussacacstuaeseune i eshess ii 48 
Scientific work Of.........csseseees dacevdiahensseae x 61 
Bairdian school of ornithologists............+4. x 66 


Baker, Frank, communication on modern 

ideas of brain mechanism. Title only, 
vili 17 
remarks on audition........0.. susscancsescases WME Lcd 

Baker, Marcus, communication on the his- 

tory of Malfatti’s problem. Jn full. 2 
SLUT CB us nannencnosdvevadupeearesape:=cstidcandnsaatcd ii 113 

a geometric problem, with bibliograph- 
ical notes. In full. 4 figures......... Ail 53, 55 

the boundary line between Alaska and 
Siberia. In full. Map........ccce000 iv 123 

a geometrical question relating to 
BPHSLOS rh WM Ul wanmssnenpeccssasvencseavsnaxee v 107 

Benjamin Alvord. Read by E. B. Elliott. 
TU PUM ce sess vcnssoenestaes aeadresansoaceaneanivens vil 127 

a collection of formule for the area of a 
plane triangle. Reference............+ vili 37 

a group of circles related to Feuerbach’s 
Circle. In full. 4 figures...ccccrereeees wilt 45 
What is a topographic map? Abstract.x 11 
a problem in probabilities. Abstract...x 87 

a collection of solutions of the trisection 


problem. <Abstract........ Bde saree x 96 
remarks on Alaskan glaciers ...... x 15 
a geometrical problem...........+.+ 


graphics 
Benj SimimeAlvord,\ cissscorsavsaacsetvensaesets 


Balloon ascensions and air currents............ i 35 
Bancroft, H. H., cited on diminution of In- 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


; Page. 
Barker, Prof. G. F., cited on diatomic mole- 


wv 50 
case? 
Barnard, Gen., cited on precession and ter- 


NETVE CUTLTENES.....c000ccscacercecsecevscceee 


Festrial rigidity. ......scscassocssscccssseccossdk 18 
Barnes, J. K., Death of..............0+ Tt ey | 
Barometric gradient as related to velocity 

and direction Of WiNDG.......c0sseccee «eee 106 

hypsometry........ dos onessdescusuduvensedudesdassunmeekanicee 
New method of........ anecayen Sey ere 
observations modified by wind...........0.W 91 
pressure and wind velocity.........c00 ey od 6) 
and wirids in relation to tides...........00.4 53 
Bartholin, cited on mineralogy ......s0-.eeeeeeed 77 
Basaltic columns....... do odunddsveaueanetniiaa ica vili 19 

Basch’s experiments on the circulation of 

uietemelKoyer Merete error oar 

Base-line apparatus... 
at Kanab, Utal.......s00cceeee 
measurement near Atlanta. 
Basketry....... seco ak tadzeqeneouead asrvesiiabieescdpheeok kauanes 

Bates, H. H., cited on gravitation formula, 
wiii 39, 40 

communication on the motion of a particle 


towards an attracting centre. Title 
ONLY ..ercaceoense se seecevee suede atusedageaeriran dp uesnke i 89 
movementofa particle attracted towards 
A point. ADSErAact...ceue-0e siastvles ngveten sme aD 
the nature of matter. Reference.....Wi 5 
the physical basis of phenomena. Jn 
SUll. ZSIGUTES ss .seerereecceeee osaneoes seceeee Whi 40 
remarks on wind-vane formula........ noaeadel) ga? 


Bates, N. L., communication on organic 
cells of unknown origin and form 
found in human feces (two cases). 


Title only....+.0 Scbscantnscxaqe eaten svete (Bb 
Baudin’s method in thermometry........0.0.4X 29 
Bayma, Prof. J., cited on action at a dis- 

TBNCCs.cesess apres cl da és dvavstocnssusseude<sa@unnene wv 158 


Bay's Mountains, Tenn....scsss sssasesnssesscseeassete ) 117 
Bean, T. H., communication on the distri- 
bution of fishes in the oceanic abysses 
and middle strata. Title only........0AK 22 
Bebb, M. S., cited on salices........00-s0.ee4¥ 110 
Becquerel, A. E., cited on chemical rays....v 135 
Bede, cited on cure of dumbness........000...Vi 53 
Behring’s Strait. .......s.00 en dv 123 
Bell, A. G., communication on the tele- 


sn eerereeseeesees 


phone,  Abstr@etscsvccegssxscesessenvmenphennet ii 103 
binaural audition. Abstract iii 68, 69 
the spectrophone, Jn full. Plate .....iw 142 


a modification of Wheatstone’s micro- 
phone and its applicability to radio- 
phonie researches. In full. Plate, 

iv 183 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 


Bell, A. G., communications on—Cont’d. 
fallacies concerning the deaf, and the 
influence of such fallacies in prevent- 
ing the amelioration of their condi- 


tion. In full........ Soreenetea reas saeatesecsnase vi 
the mechanism of “clicks” and 
“clucks.” Title Only .....0....sesscsccees viii 


remarks on temperature observations...vi 


48 


18 
47 


earthquake waves and sound waves..Ax 42, 43 


Bellroth, cited on microscopic organisms, 


ii 110 
Beman, Prof. W. W., Solution of a geometri- 

Cal problem DY.....c.ecesesccase cisvaseNeneecis Aid 65 
Benedict, Prof. F. N., Survey DYuscectesneseatar ii 67 
Benoit’s coefficient of expansion of glass, 

ix 32 
Bentham and Hooker, cited on classification 

ISP GS tie arte ca welasccssanccenasree iv 108, 110, 113 
Bergman, cited on Mineralogy..........sceeceeees i 78 
Bernstein, cited on muscular contraction..v 58 

nerve action............. @cencsescecsess eccscccsecens v 61 
Berzelius, cited on mineralogy.......cccoeve i 78, 79 
Bessel’s method for computing positions of 

BBO MIEGM eae chteced tax tercaseeesssasnsestsapanens vii 94 
Bessels, Emil, communication on some of 

the results of the Polaris north pole 

expedition. Title only........ SiesWasiene sea A 92 

the hygrometrical condition of fe air 

in high latitudes. Title only... ii 66 

the late English polar expedition. Ab- 

APEC Dedeaweasensaekcapcsssernech esses sesesvacdn ences ii 89 

remarks on Arctic glaciers... seed 36 
Bibliographic notes ona eames ical prob- 

EA y seco ewaapacsccecsaceusrercenser pevrodeetcacrvens iii 64 

Bibliography of astronoMy.........ccsceecsecssrned 95 
Benjamin Alvord........... Sreshaduaevasanes «vii 128 
RPE EASA Cletancenstvetuacavacc=sandesueslcopres cesnse x 62 
UGA ASIN TANGER cscacscacccnvccccscsesscees ix 6 
PQSAPBVHONTYa-.ccccssescesseee veces. rc teeeepace ii 360 
IMTAUEIS PLODLCUA raicessvas cvccecsesessece scenes ii 120 
medical medals........... Wi 40 
PRGUCONOLOLV:.cc-seciessunkcssnessuscosnédostncees Xx 20, 23 
North American geology......ccccccecee Wik 71 
GAS OETA oscesssecvsee Srecaebn ete ccheeesGs sesnes iv 181 
RGICOCC cesstssivctnectsatucscnenaodusvers mass ii 302, x 38 
trisection problem............. Rieeeecvsicesne Xx 97, 98 

Bigelow, Dr., cited on gaseous disinfec- 

Duta Niecapetcentestececwcussdcasecisedetesasccnsscsewuase iv 38 
Billings, J.S., communication on some mi- 

MUS TONET. ABSETGCh.... faceenakcccsscocsesee i 42 

the collection of a large library. Ab- 

stract.. Bieetevsts ieoucons ark 102 


bacteria ran eduatadenke poremion! 


PAOBTINEL Ee casece cores rasctenaactsanverisuesesdeeigaste, ii 109 


Board of 
wkd 


the work of the National 
Health. Title only...-...000. 


50 


125 


Page. 


Billings, J.S., communications on--Cont’d. 
the scientific work carried on under the 
direction of the National Board of 


Me@alths: “ASU ch, <csssncsss-cseccsscvecspesst iv 37 
mortality statistics of the ‘'enth Census. 
CAIDSEN GC Uacrsvucananaaeidp nips scnousssausouss iv 163, 164 
the ventilation of the House of Repre- 
sentatives. ADSEract.........ccccceerseses ae. 199) 
composite photography applied to crani- 
OOS Yn PADSELO Cis surasccaenestivecnecsnaxsor02 wii 25 
a collection of microscopes. No ab- 
SHUG avevacvasnyvecwassnseieuscsnsutarsecrtess costes vil 73 
the vital statistics of the Tenth U. S. 
Census: -Refergnee .cscpceners<aaceorvatsns viii 4 
anthropometric and reaction-time ap- 
paratus. Abstract........%. . Whih 25 
germ cultures, ADdstract......sscceeceee viii 30 
museum specimens illustrating biology. 
ALLSERGCE, saci octeases>stecvaWecectetacccctetansseare ix 35 
scientific men and their duties. Presi- 
dential address. In full......... Ax xxxy, 46 
remarks on mosquital inoculation......... vi 10 
DiblO Sra ph yn. vesssastacsscescacartatessciees Pe ate 
$9390 Clove caseeepnccnuakaysessandesusandenany erenassian viii 28 
care of pamphlets «.Wiii 29 
Charleston earthquake.............sssscseeees ix 42 
Bi-metalligmalicscssscancacskeacsess stansyy dii 78, 107, iv 141 
Binary arithmetic, Experiments in........ -vi 3, 38 
Binaural AUGGION. ...,c0ccncrecsssoncsessserseosacnssdhdee 09 
BinOenlar MICLOSCOPES:.c.ccccesecnscesoncscacaenves iv 35 
TRIOPOMM ss. saceapescassncescens cocoa svsascsscnecvesvaste eiswenss v 102 
Biography, List of papers on: 
on the life and scientific labors of the late 
Alexander Dallas Bache. J. Henry. 
PES OLET CIC C an sosasncca seuss dnonasessanerenecimanacerees i 35 
biographical notice of Avebibald Robert- 
son Marvine. J. W. Powell. Jn full, 
ii 83, (53) 
life and character of Joseph Henry. J.C. 
Welling (27 fult.c:.sssacsssesersecssoeashuee Ad 203 
amemoir of Joseph Henry. A sketch of 
his scientific work. W.B.'Taylor. In 
PubLUcccrepicare Saectaitnee Sissevbotieaeetarens ii 203, 230 
address commemorative of Joseph Henry. 
PoParkers Cli Sull ccscsessvavessentnccsterse te ik 368 
[address commemorative of] Joseph 
Henry. B. Alvord. In full..............44 370 
[remarks commemorative of Jonathan 
Homer Lane.] J. E. Hilgard. In 
OPLEUE mses panntatsansesrpeneeseiiieaaeee sreendastaeee iii 1 
a biographical sketch of the late Dr. |G. A.] 
Otis. J. J. Woodward. In full......... iv 171 
[eulogy on A. A. Humphreys.] J. C. Well- 
Ing, -AOSETACE: .cceesccsch cansscrsvecscapasspan vii 4 


memorial [to Benjamin Alvord.] M. Baker 
and E. B. Elliott. In full... 


epaspelus ane vii 127 


126 


Page. 


Biography, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
relations between Professor Baird and 


participating societies. G. Mallery. 
Te JU. sosasacess Petakusncisaescecesee stceeanencsacies x45 
Professor Baird as an administrator. W. 
B. Taylor. In full.........00. praneduadeaacaver’ x 49 
Professor Baird in science. W. H. Dall. 
TUNEL GCsnovcasauetsteepsaseces wovananeastanpcast ere Seas) b 
the personal characteristics of Professor 
Baird. J. W. Powell. Jn full............ 2 yi 
Biological Society, Invitation from....wii 5, 
wili 4 
Biological Society of Washington.............. x 47 
Biology, List of papers on. (See also 
Zoology and Botany :) 
bacteria and spontaneous generation. J. 
S. Billings. Abstract........ acsackuae everest 109 
principles of morphology. T. Gill. Refer- 
ONCE. x. SassterencuccctervasheRarvsasoneatbnens aes iv 123 
modern philosophical conceptions of life. 
J. J. Woodward. Presidential address. 
DTU esecestionnsoncasnest Huea ss aeceeeacoscteen on: v 49 
on the organic compounds in their rela- 
tions to life. L.F. Ward. Title only..w 91 
on the building up of organic matter. T. 
Antiselll.: PORE OMe 22.56, secs -ascevenenscees vi 97 
on the possibilities of protoplasm. E. © 
Coues. Abstract and reference.........6.¥ 102 
the three methods of evolution. J. W. 
Powell. Presidential address. In full. 


wi xxvii, 110 


Abstract. 
vill 
organic cells of unknown origin and form 
found in human feces (two cases). N. 


germ eultures. J. S. Billings. 


30 


Li. Bates, Title Only....oc..cccce.sevee-aoene ix 35 
on museum specimens illustrating bi- 
ology. Symposium. Abstract.........AX 35 
Black drop... x ...4i 199, wi 23 
Black Hills of ‘Dakota: Peowepsedeuseaes parteenesecess iii 125 
Blair He We. WD CAbW OT Oe csaersecconeece we Wii 81 
PIN GNSSS OOlOT (cacsacscceeeseuncictec cesstes Neaaerns iv 54 
Blood corpuscles of man and other animals 
COMPANOG wresussanscrssussoased selieseeidevesvesneRe 2,4 
Blue Ridge, Fault in...... sabe sawanvesces 30 
Board of Health, National 37 
Boerner, C. G., letter on a shower of the 
Rocky Mountain grasshoppers. Com- 
municated by J. Henry. Abstract....... ii 87 
BOROslO Crate ecns.cessacencuscresscanen Seeoescnaa vil 34 
Bolton, Prof. H. C.,communication on count- 
ing-out rhymes of children, their an- 
tiquity, origin, and wide distribution. 
Reference....... cacy suncechanusanchsenpreeseer ean ese x 13 
RON DOVILG, Titie) scc.cccsconeesevcnssverhekscoan i 84, ii 103 
Boscovich’s philosophy of matter.....wii xlv, 49 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page 
Boss’ declination standar@s.........0:..ssecsseee ix 53 
Botany, List of papers on. (See also Bi- 
ology :) 
on some minute fungi. J.S. Billings. Ab- 


SEL ACE ca cruespsanvanasyanaste anesnntsaantni Bement i 42 
descriptions of new species of fossil plants 
from Alleghany Co., Virginia; with 
some remarks on the rock seen along 
the Chesapeake and Ohio Railroad, 
near the White Sulphur Springs of 
Greenbrier County, West Virginia. F. 
B. Meek. Read by T. Gill. In full. 2 
WLQLCS ..sescccene Qeicocaniie ssuctetensdaaaniee 162, ii (26) 
on the cause and remedy of the potato rot. 
LL.D. Gale, Ditle O70) ..ccsscsassenscasvaswan i 97 
[plants common to Japan and eastern 
America.] A.Gray. Abstract......... ii 42 
the climate of plants. L. D. Gale. Ab- 
SUP GEE <ccaccende ccoceesaanccs)auenceenedessinteeeeeane 44 183 
the natural system,of plants. L. F. Ward. 
DUtle ONY. ouasonaneueseadseoscunsadeancaeeaeel 41 18%, 187 
field and closet notes on the flora of Wash- 
ington and vicinity. L.F.Ward. Ab- 
SUPOCE. tierce. cen -usrceraschsnassaaecsse antennae iv 64 


CHEE ccavsecsasneesundcnacoshusnsnchovsesassnnrcatenel v 106 
the flora of the Laramie group. ae F. 

Ward. “Refenence...cc--csxoossacans letee vili 17 
our city shade-trees, their foes and their 


future. C.V. Riley. 'Reference........X 7 

on the geographical distribution of fossil 
plants. L. F.Ward. Reference......... x 28 

Boundary line between Alaska and Siberia, 
iv 123 

Boutelle, C. O., remarks on deflection of 
rivers ........ sbendeavesasasne 3s afuaaxt eee cocceeeWAk 24 


Bowditch, N., and the Mecanique Celeste, 
will xxxvi 


Bowyers and fletchers......... Ppa eesce rc ix 44 
Boyle, R., cited on atomic philosophy.....wii xlv 
Boyle SAW eececscosscccsecateccusccsuesncussdeventuseuite v 139 
ArA@DASGNOGC sy) -easseswecccsnsneecuenanene aaieaciteeene wi 124 

on the helicoid...... nenewese seks @nansuaieeeene ws spangece a 


Brain and phosphorus.......cscesceccosecresseeseeees ar 5 
TEM PCTALUTES, wg.... ceccensecesscenscceees osnesseanne «v.75 
Brainard’s Arctic exploration........ ceseneesase ie 11 

Bremiker, Dr., cited on alignment curves, 
wi 124, 126 

Brewer, Prof. W. H., remarks on the potato 
PD Ussseseccoucoss Area panne ween ecnpervhepunaeaniie i 97 

Brianchon, cited on Feuerbach’s circle, 
wili 45 


Brooks, W. K., communication on the em- 
bryology of Lingula and the systematic 
relations of the Brachiopods. Title 
ONLY. conacncsceseceecnccuscostsues qeccennesuncanauiat ili 33 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 

Brown, Judge A., cited on difficulty of de- 
termination of sound direction.....vidd 12 

Brown, W. R., cited on conservation of 
ENGY SY cs svadevcercnsceossce 62 
force and matter..... 31 
RAC CUNT ACU Us ca csesesc cascess scoecs saesnesee 75 
Buchan, cited on barometric pressures...... i 108 
Bulletin, Cost of printiny...... sasualgustrescsce secs v 177 
PSHM UTLON MISE Ofenccccsessconsvancentesssesaeve’ iii 159 
of the Mathematical Section...... vi 121, vii 87, 
wiii 37, ix 53, x 79 
of the Society, Function of the............... cx 


Rules for publication of........1 ii, di Vii, iif vii, 
iv 13, v 13, vi xxxiii, 135, wii xiii, viii 
xiii, ix xiii, x xiii 


Bulletins, Note on....... sibpaasssscsceoas Wikensavesse x 113 
Bulwer, J, cited on visible speech............Wh 54 
SSPE E ADDON LING cen sccasy-seunkcee icesascecateseasceend vii 14 


Burchard, H. N., communication on the sil- 
ver question. ADStract.........0..sc0dhd 109 
remarks on agricultural production.....wii 20 

Burdon, W., Solution of a geometrical prob- 


Bureau of Ethnology............. Redustaerteen con ax 57 

Burger, Franz, Electric investigations by..w 47 
Burnett, S. M., communication on color per- 
ception andcolor blindness. Abstract 

Mee ROP ERD IRCB ce vacvenascsudsescacssdacveveqraaces iv 54 
refraction in the principal meridians ofa 
triaxial ellipsoid ; regular astigmatism 


and cylindrical lenses. Reference...... wi 4 
the character of the focal lines in astig- 
MO SGISIN.) CAIGSEFOCE.:< ceases cconsecoscccons wi 45 


why the eyes of animals shine in the 
dark. Abstract and reference..........vil 13 

Are there separate centres for light-, 
form-, and color-perception? Abstract 


and reference........ Aogniaconcccee atc bereee wii 72 
the Javal and Schidtz ophthalmometer. 
MWUEDEOI MY caventssncde«cestecerseqanscceces sucess vili 11 


Busey, S. C., communication on the gather- 
ing, packing, transportation, and ex- 
posure of fruits for sale. Title only...44 16 

the influence of the cardiac and respira- 
tory movements upon the motion of 
the lymph. Abstract and referénce....i4 133 
the relation of the meteorological condi- 
tions to the summer diarrheal dis- 
eases. Abstract and reference......... wiv 165 
the influence of the constant use of high- 
heeled shoes upon the health and form 
of the female, and upon the relation 
of the pelvic organs. Abstract.........W 117 

Butcher, H. B., communication on two im- 
mense meteorites at Conception and 
San Gregorio, Mexico. Reference......4 24 


127 


Page. 
Butler, J. D., communication on prehistoric 
COMPS CALLE ONLY s.. sess desccncaecnacce tooese di 185 
Byasson, H., cited on phosphorus and cere- 
DTRWACTIVIDY cs cccecesrcseusseiesseccece eeauses sens 00 
By-Laws. See Standing Rules. 


Calcium sulphide, Clock faces coated with, 
iii 33 
Calendar of the Society......... wii xxii, viii xxx, 
ix xxvii, x xxxi 

Calendars and Time Standards, List of 

papers on: 

on a Gregorian calendar. E. Frisby. Ab- 
SUA Lissccnsavusascnccecseneneecenceees etussrs eee a 75 

onaproposed reformation of the Gregorian 
ealendar. J. E. Hilgard. Abstract..ii 29, 30 

ealendar formule. E. B. Elliott. Abstract, 
ii 37 

a calendar proposed by a Persian astrono- 
mer in 1079. W. B. Taylor. Abstract.ii 38 

adjustment of the calendar. E. B. Elliott. 
AID SEP ACE iatts accalonnconan-cderocteceseeneeees osteeds ii 59 

standards of time—international, sec- 

tional, and local. E. B. Elliott. Ab- 
SUNGCE cv cdactoarseseesu Peenemeswalceverney enceresaivesed ks hog) 

meridional time for railway and tele- 

graphic purposes. E. Bb. Elliott. Ab- 


SUNGCL. ceccnsasnnavenance dadecetovearcvacestyste ave cot di 202 
ona system of standard time. A.S. Chris- 
TOs" ADBORUCEstertacecedeecaces teceee Sua denslcnsee v 112 


the action of the International Geodetic 
Association as to an initial meridian 
and universal time. R. D. Cutts. Ab- 


SULACU ra bercecauscnen Reutunoredevecspace ton creneee «vi 106 
California, Geology of northern......... nto ix 4 
atest VOlGanO/ in s21--ecacoccsccecocevscrececsaceves ix 46 
Cambrian system in the United States and 
Canada... ..... petbaencancevececeysctorsrecsenn err vi 
Campagna, Eucalyptus on the........ 
Capron, Horace, communication on Japan. 
TUULETORUD aasscsutperacanscermeecrtoecaenctserecces ii 79 
Death of..........cs00 Buenasereteceasaas Sagetacauwaes viii 8 
Carbonate deposits of Leadville, Colo....... vi 32 
Care of pamphlets........ eu sacaaemccdvedetaceanter vill 29 
Carpenter, Dr. W. B., cited on binocular mi- 
CLOSCOPOScapsectcesbunsecuesaverenusssetcewcrsnanne iv 35 
Cartesian philosophy........ shnteucesseueere seater wii xii 
Caspian Sea, Altitude Of.........0..cccsee screed 34 
Catalogue of astronomical papers...........6. wid 95 
of stars prepared at U.S. Naval Observa- 
GORY: cascscencarnctasscntrcertneecatincosrensese weeenets i 74 
Catlin, cited on color, number, and theology 
Of UNG IAN a eacseatcccteesitee eet eers Speecoaeeeet: 41:175 
Cells found in human fCESB.......00..e000seeees ix 35 
Census, Mortality statistics of the Tenth, 
iv 164 


128 


Page. 
Census, Vital statistics of the Tenth...... will 4 
Centre of population of United States......... 4 35 
United Spates....cccsccrcssrcess bsbbanekonaouaaencn ak 22 
Centres for light-,form-, and color-percep- 
AG cesnensrotunshssyassnennsn sapessaineeRaswane vii 72 
Ceremonial institutions, Origin of certain.ix 19 
Cernuschi, cited on bi-metallism............ Alii 108 
Chadwick, Lt. Com’d’r F. E., cited on sound 
SIVA BIIOS top cvcnocssccoagspedatresascsepestsveussscliy Oo 
Challis, Prof. J., ale on pinehietey siireie v 152, 154 
POV CO sas store ssnacessaarnph ease caesbenseaiassees eareneteas v 128 
Chamberlin, T. C., communication on What 
isa glacier? ADStract..........eseersees vil 38 


the varying attitudes of former level 
surfaces in the Great Lake region and 
the applicability of proposed explana- 

PLONS.) (DULG OMY isaqodessascsscaseesssaensxshi lO,.10 

remarks on the loess of Iowa and Ne- 

Dr sslidassccceuenvecceessss obonaasas Ceerecee cers iv 121 
Champlain, Ice on Lake........0.---s000 Retanaaiins fi (22) 
Changes of terrestrial level surfaces due to 

variations in the distribution of super- 


ficial matter.........css00. vii 92, 101, ix 15, 53 
Chapman’s Flora of the Southern States, 

iv 99 

Charles, Law of .........+ vaneeenanns siattss ea Vv 139 

Charleston earthquake............. ix 37, ‘38, - x 17, 28 

Charts of archwology....... peseas daetncndsveAuganatnd fi 72 


Chase, Salmon P., Resolutions on death of.4 87 
Chatard, T. M., remarks on earth, tremors, 


viii 28 

Chemical equivalency ...ccceeeseseeee seeeeeee Wid Xl Vii 
DMV ses ssa envad dnocekes aaueceaan Wade Eubeoh dantau Re aenshaenas v 135 
BIGGS Ol VALALILY; +c <ccaves=asdsvedesiacacecsccseshacnsoen v 53 


Society, Invitation from............wiii 29, ix 46 
theory of volcanism ........ Reed aac vi 90, 93 
Chemistry, Li-t of papers on: 
[exhibition of apparatus for the genera- 
tion of ozone.] B. F. Craig. Wo ab- 
BLT Dos: donansonees Cpnce er soeen arrecheL aire ee eencghe Da 
on the cause and remedy of the potato rot. 
Li. D. Gale. Title O7ty.....0 ceccossrssccevvech 97 
on the chemistry of the Bessemer pro- 
cess. C. E. Dutton. Title only......... wi 98 
on the atomic volumes of crystallized and 
double salts. F. W. Clarke. Refer- 
ENCE: .nccere avacmnone mucasesna Bi sActer tee roscn Gea eet i 103 
on the molecular heats of similar com- 
pounds. F.W. Clarke. <Abstract....... i 104 
on the coloring agent of gems. F. M. End- 
TiCH, -ALOSti ACE cccsacsoccccs, orsssenecessnesceace li 31 
the estimation of manganese as pyrophos- 
phate. C. E. Munroe. Communicated 
by T. Antisell. Refcrence.......0.0...ps.v0 di 132 
chemical remarks on terrestrial geogony. 
T. Antisell. Title only...........4d 132, 133, 134 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
Chemistry, List of papers on—Cont'd. 

observations on “chemical molecular 
changes. T.Antisell. Title only......idi 28 

the origin of the chemical elements. L. 
FB. Ward. ‘Tetle ont}... cssssscccseseeeny Adi 33 

a case of peculiar corrosive action on me- 
tallictin. J.W. Osborne. Title only..dii Pi 

determination of the specific gravity of 

solids by the common hydrometer. 


C. EB. Munroe. Tit full... .eossssssoeeeoserse vi 26 
the periodic law of chemical elements. F. 

W. Clarke.  ADStraehisesccnscnseccteuenes vii 15 
music and the chemical elements. M. H. 

Doolittle. Abstract ...........000 eocsss WA 20,27) 
an attempt at a theory of odor. F. W. 

Clarke. <Abstract.......... cobeves WARK OT 


Chickering, J. W., communication on the 
correlation of the winds and the tem- 
peratures of the surface waters of the 
ocean along the coast of New Hamp- 


Shire. Abstract wst.cccccusscneen sabevesneaaaen Ai 17 
Luray cave. . Title Ontty ..asense:esssnavanerss iii 65 
Roan Mountain, N.C. In full.........00 iv 60 
the thermal belts of North Carolina. Ab- 

SEPOCE 0 onsecnei=arsenne ausnseseesnakteeceeenreyene wi 11 


the Muir glacier, Alaska. Title only..m 15 
Chesapeake and Ohio Railroad, Geology 


Chimera, New species Of............ 
Chinese language..........+++- 
CHitONId Sd... .sccss.<oa00-0000 sas anaanestgteeee tana 


Chorography........ oicessnsoseascauspsaine ghaasmimaeee Ahr opel | 

Christie, A. S., communication on a system 
of standard time. Abstract.......... mantic wile 

a quasi general differentiation. Title 
ONLY ..eceees aiaaeee ey ausdbasdesetnfeneeeaenee vi 122 
contact of plane curves. Abstract......wi 157 

a form of the multinomial theorem. 
Title only.....00 oa.asengsevanssadeamaeeaneen eee vii 101 
a problem in probabilities. Abstract...x 89 
remark on infinitesimals ...........cseseesseees wi 135 
ChristMas CVE MEtOOL.......00 seeceeesesece-cecnesee 4i 139 

Chronograph readings, Relative frequaney 
Of Gigits Arico scccacaccucastereeeeen hanasssansine i 85 
Circle, Quadrature Of,........0..++0+8 dideeeuntanseeaas p Gea f 
Circles related to Feuerbach’s circle.....wiit 45 
Cireular on the meteor of Dec. 24, 1873...... ii 139 
Circumference, Ratio of, to diameter.......... 2 ts 


Clark, Alvan, communication on the con- 
struction of the lenses and other inter- 
esting portions of the large telescope 
now established at the Nayal Observa- 
tory. Title only.......c.000 snachausttl coseasteedl ne 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 
Clarke, F. W., communication on the atomic 
volumes of crystallized and doubie salts. 


Reference........ corteosteacé Soap anseneaeeeucenecens’ 4 103 

the molecular heats of similar com- 
PSUUTIC Sere URUMOLCL cccssvessencnsecee vosceusosees i 104 

* the periodic law of the elements. Ab- 
MANU memna teaser netencsecacccare-ecrsecateasscn wii 15 

topaz from Stoneham, Maine. Abstract 
ANE TEPET ENCE. caccgscaasnestanencasse StsecccsWEln 866 

an attempt at a theory of odor. Ab- 
RG Hnate kb eccvacen pesstncencnaasons Jones see Wil = 27 
the Flood Rock explosion. Abstract..wiii 28 


the present status of mineralogy. Title 
RIEU ete tee tan taser geecene seugetenidenecnrad vase eck oa x=A6 

the Manchester meeting of the British 
Association for the Advancement of 


Science, 1887. Title Only.....s0...cceeeeeee x 19 
remarks on chemical theories of volcan- 
BOYD <5 <aeses Baetsenccnenesescars eattascberesdecnacnseuc vi 93 


Classification of insectivorous mammals...v 118 


Clausen, cited on computation of 7............ i 58 
Clausius’ researches in molecular physics, 
v 138, 140 
Clerk-Maxwell. See Maxwell. 
Clifford’s philosophy.............-s00+ cepeenentte vii liii 
Climate and variations in solar radiation..vi 10 
OL PIATIUS serene scene aawatehces saaanas aeecasatisenseuctess ii 183 
Of Roan MOuntain.....scecsececcceeeseccee scenes iv 62 
Quaternary, of the Great Basin....... erane vi 21 
Climatic influence of land areas............ ‘edd 46 


Clingman, T. L., communication on the 
earthquake phenomena recently ex- 
perienced in Nerth Carolina. Abstract 
GNA TEFETENCE.....snceseerecsssenecees copsceeoeos i 104 

the falling of waterspouts in North Caro- 


lina. Abstract ii 104 
Cloud bursts in North Carolina........ et cters ii 104 
Coal, Formation of........... Rate a vi 28 
MGORSUAL PLATING: s.ccensce cesstecesase ens Bpeeweveuesene ix 23 


Coffin, J. H. C., cited on cyclonic motion...i 108 
communication on maps prepared by G. 
W. Hill for use in connection with the 
transit of Venus in December, 1874. 


RREPCPENCE..2...cccccceees selosesercsceosseum peenttones i 63 
Sumner’s method in navigation. In 
FUlL... 20000 nostette Beasrdzcetrsdsavse cecried aseneeces ii 105 
FEMALKS ON CAICNAALG.........cccseecceecerssess ii 29, 60 
standard time...........ss00 oe .. di 202, -v 115 
OPAC tenetentonesescreaccerse-srcapmancassencartcudenees ‘v 127 
and adhesion........ Aecehoree rect deccocee edie v 136 
Coin, Amount of subsidiary silver............ 14 
Coinage, International...............c00-cecesceeeee iii 38 
of the Argentine Republic............... tie is 65 
PUPINRC FO NCES recensrnserccesucssstts seats tucbsaceteveests x 8 


55 


129 


Page. 
Coins, Exhibition of............. Wicaust vadccecsecdtevs wv 22 
Collier, Peter, communication on sugar from 
SOPSRUMS ADEE ACh acisecssssoscascovscetes iii 140 
Color of Indians................. pubasnar ceeds Prreceopy «a iis 
perception and color blindness.............. iv 54 
tests ...........6. peaUuabapevnavwantbaatecee So epee Pes did 54 
Colorado of the West, Valley of the............. i 48 
Coloring agent of gems........... Senasveadcenamevers ii 31 
Columnar structure in the diabase of Orange 
MG ING Secasseseese esstakt etl eecccccces reece Wk 19 
Comet, Barnard’s.............. ebivsuvabbokunsteseneee viii 17 
Hn eke szakieswscivecsated aldvelsuataeusdecs ccs cadcanens 434, 35 
I, 1871, Elements of. ... 23 
III, 1884, (Wolf’s)..... Raccnake 37 
Orbit OFSWiL}Sicscesesctesicescccecedes 59 
orbits illustrated by models..... 28 
Spectrum of Encke’s............ Meacssencc eae i 34 
Tuttle piseksciceseces odtudaanvehestccese eres, Percorerne i 34 
Comets and. MeteEOrs.........ccccccoosssenesscenscventes i 94 
Comet’s orbit, Correction Of............cec00e eee ii 22 
Comets’ tails.......... foceamets sesuecerecsdatdcceteccasan ol 74 


Committee, auditing, Appointment of...v 84, 174, 
vi 111, vii 82, viii 31, ix 47, x 39. 
Report of... Vv 89, vi 5, vil 15, viii 3, ix 3, x 3. 
Resolution on....... Saseescl cvccanuer veces tun ecesee Vv 84 
on communications...... i 21, tiv Vili, 161, iff 151, 
iv 31, 39, v 14, 175, wi xiv, xv, wii xiv, xv, 
viii xiv, xv, ix xiv, xv, x xiv, xv. 
on mathematical papers......wi 135, 161, wii 129, 
viii 63,x 111 
on mathematical papers, Resolution on.-wi 135 
on the meteor of December 24, 1873...... i 94, 98, 
ii 139 
on papers and essays. See Committee on Com- 
munications. 
on publications.....i 21, di viii, 161, iii 151, v 14, 
175, vi xiv, xv, wii xiv, xv, viii xiv, xv, 
ix xiv, xv, xX xiv, xv. 
to draft resolutions on the death of 


A. J. Myer soo LV 23, 31 
G. A. Otis.. seAV 120, 134 
to draft mesa iuciuns on nee discovery of the 
Satellites Of Mars....csscoseccccsesccees oor ii 186 
to nominate officers of Mathematical Sec- 
CLOW cosuastaslonsuscoobsneso ares cipousevusse tices beet x 83 
Communications, List of. See Acoustics, 
Anatomy, Anthropology, Archeology, 
Astronomy, Biography, Biology, Botany, 


130 


Page. 
Calendars, Chemistry, Electricity, Geog- 
raphy, Geology, Mathematics, Meteor- 
ology, Microscopy, Mineralogy, Miscella- 
neous, Oceanography, Optics, Physics, 
Political Economy, Psychology, Seis- 
mology, Social Science, Thermometry, 


Zoology. 

Statistics Of....cccrecccessserrccess jugdubentebanta dbase oe 
CoMPpass PlANt...cccccsrevessceeeeene reeves sontusves seee¥ 106 
Composite photography ‘anglied to crani- 

OLOZY see seeee pusvavaseddvondnd paasaearavna Wad vos Vil 26 
Composition Of CLLOL ...cepeeeesceereeneeseeseeeesees v 106 
Computation by method of least squares.,...0 62, 

vi 150, wilt 41 
Of & COMETS OFDIt...cossressoreresececeorrersevcasssekh 22 


planetary perturbations of the moon 


wi 136 

Computing the position of a satellite...... vil 93 

MACON sicccescennsscdsesecuscsexansenseccudested aidiee x 102 

Comte, Auguste, cited On LOrCOS.....c6eeseeee ‘v 127 
Conditioned observations, Adjustment of, 

wilt 41 


Conservation Of CNELZY..cccsseersecsersercererree Wh 62 


Conservative element in disease......... Ai 111, 124 
Consolidated list.......ccsererseesecceerevseees avivens x 36 
Constant P in terrestrial magnetism ......... x 102 


Constitution...& xv, if iii, Af iii, iw 5, -v 6, wi vii, 
vii vii, vill vii, ix vii, x vii 
Adoption Of,...ccccrcsorseccesesssessveveresersseesveres i 20, 21 
AMCNAMEHNE tO. ccecccceecceeeseeeees sutevdviabn ix 47, x 39 
Contact Of PlAN© CUIVES,...cccecessececerereneeeees 
Contraction hypothesis...... a a 90, vill 18 
Corona of the sun...... Marsbipninanetone 431, iM 116, 121 
Corrections to normal thermometers........ ix 28 
Corrigenda...44 p. 4 of cover, tid 148, vi 162, x 114 
Coseismal MAP... tin apsennccaesiss Yard badsgent ix 39 
Cosmos assembly hall.....seccceseeeee x xxxi, 10, 31 
Cosmos Club, Organization Of ....cccreeeeereK 47 
Cotes, Roger, cited on ultimate causes......v 163 
Coues, Elliott, cited on Baird’s “Birds of 
North America”? soscossccarsccccsevscescsevecss& 6D 
poisoned wounds from arrows.........+..Ab 182 
communication on the structure and 
homologies of the limbs, especially in 


AVES. Title One .cccccccscovedceravsecssoncaccass i 96 

the use of poisoned arrows by North 
American Indians. Title only........... ii 183 

the possibilities of protoplasm. Abstract 
ANE TEFCTENCE.. 1000200000 0000 wea ha dain) neva «vw 102 
remarks on poisoned arrows.......-++ uvhduke ii 183 
Counting-out rhymes........ penscntededadgmnbsddensepede\ 00 
Cracks in ice on Lake Champlain.........++ ii (22) 


Craig, B. F., communication on the fluctua- 
tions of the temperature of the human 
DOAY. REfEreNCl..rcccsrsoreresrvrsescresaserser Ol 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


* 
Page 
Craig, B. F., communication on—Cont’d. 
apothecaries’ weights and measures, 
Title ONUs).occoonsrsevesses 0 senveesaheaptivannti ae 
thermometers. Title Only....c..cccssseeeerree 42 
a method of verifying with exactness the 
indications of a thermometer. Title - 
ONY ...seeree0 evatgnosevdaeaereaeee os ccvgedounsevedninan OMe 
apparatus for the generation of ozone. 
INO. ADEE ACbrseesccceese cones cosbonabunegermlen @eameRnenoel 
the water supply of cities. Title only...4 65 
Resolutions on the death Of.......cecsseeeeeseedl 130 
Craig, Thomas, communication on vortex 
motion in ordinary fluids. Reference, 
iii 143 
Orane, 0,.H,, Death Of-icsssssocsssosescsssyannssnrnr al 
Craniologysercseceeers sas testes aid gia 
Crelle, Dr. A. L., cited on Malfatti’s prob- 
LOUN iivesteiessennhusseeonee covsce sooesebonbentnobsenesMa) LAD 
Croll, Prof. J., cited on action at a distance 
v 156 
Croll’s GheOLy.., .ssscse+senscdveceesesnsnsysusheseniTnn en Tee na 
Crookes, W., cited on matter .......ecceceesseeeeeW 129 
Crookes’ radiometer........... eee poked BO 
Cross Timbers of Texas............ aupomes 0 
Crumpling of the earth’s crust...............Wilt 18 
Crystalline state of matter............. ssedivenshah:, OF 
Oullure media. ...:00+ ssssssevsisenenninean eanaee vill 30 
Cumberland plateau.......6..+ 
Currents shown by drifting buoys..........wil 14 
Curtis, G. E., communication on the rela- 
tions between northers and magnetic 


disturbances at Havana. Reference, 

( vil 25 
Lieutenant Lockwood’s expedition to 
farthest north. Abstract......00kK 8 
the theory of the wind-vane. Refer- 
ONCE. scvcscreereesscenescoesevesccssasrcccsssesceseceseoK 0 
a problem in probabilities. No ab. 
SEPACE..000 soecer eoveenssovebesee eccrssennenesssoonessem 88 
solutions of the trisection problem. Ab- 

BUT ACE ssrecerecesece ssenevestoode soscoansecessesevnssess x 98 
remarks on verification of weather pre- 
CiCtHlOns iissssssesrevvnnave eovovasosboasash --Wili 9 


Curtis, Josiah, letter on Hayden’s Survey. 


Communicated by EF. B, Elliott. No ab- 
BUNGCL cssarectvsactvprstmicin osoenpuencsuuunaak nevatsyoe (08 
Daasth Of miwuuiria ecccesocccsees cossseapeceseasassss Wk MD 
Curve of the fourth depressants eieok OO 
Curves, Alignment........... ovppboeves ovosnsWh 128 


Customs of every day life..... 


Cutts, R. D., communication on the misap- 
plication of geographical terms, as 
bearing especially On the question of 


the fishery right treaties. Abstract...4 39 


‘ 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 
Cutts, R. D., communication on—Cont’d. 
the results of astronomical observations 
at Sherman Station, Wyoming Terr. 
Abstract and reference.........0+. sesswccenehuset ay CO 
the action of the International Geodetic 
Association as to an initial meridian 


and universal time. Abstract...........wi 106 
Death of....... jacana SEReer ene aatanacspaaatanss vi 111 
Cyclones, Movement of....... 2b5 Sireecbec = 


MEME A eoue roe callssswaepscxsaspns capeseuberetaheeasasssi il 
Dall, W. H., communication on the relative 
value of Alaska to the United States, as 
compared with that of other territorial 
acquisitions. Abstract and reference..4 25 
elevations and depressions in Alaska. 
No abstract........ “OER a eoce ee ncocereeoeacee: ii 27 
the succession of the strata of the shell 
heaps of the Aleutian islands. <Ab- 
SUP ARE esceees etea sins eS orecer Dusseuace the seepes li 65 
the results of recent investigations into 
the natural history of the Chitonide. 


ADSET ACE. ...eccsceseoeses Satori pec Ai 193 
the museums and zoological gardens of 
Northern Europe. Title only........ iii 19, 21 


the muscles of the oyster. Abstract..iii 36 
the deep sea dredgings in the Gulf of 
Mexico and the West Indies in 1873- 
1878, by Professors Louis and Alex- 
ander Agassiz and the officers of the 
U.S. Coast Survey. Title only......... iii 45 
some recent observations on mollusks. 
Abstract....... cue, sees Be seudcaseousdcsece EResahe aii (75 
the boundary line between Alaska and 
British America. Title only... ..... ili 77 
recent discoveries in Alaska north of 
Behring Strait. Abstract..............1V 163 
some peculiar features of mollusks found 
at great depths. ADStract .......00...0000 v 90 
glaciation in Alaska. Abstract........... vi 33 
recent advances in our knowledge of the 
limpets. ADStrACl...ccccccsrscccssresseeeee Wah 4 
certain appendages of the mollusca. 


Reference... ee Oo eceectod eeeer oe vii 32 
Whatisa glacier? Abstract...........+ vii 38 
two remarkable forms of mollusks, Ab- 

StrAct ANA TEFETENCE.....0000re0001 eceeeere vili 5 
South Florida notes. Title only.......ss0+ x 16 
Professor Baird in science. In full.....X 61 

remarks on the glacial period.................41 36 
IAN ERIG TLE OSsewnsonakshenscsunacessacneceos essivassssay 89 
teredo borings........ Nesadicisuavasdvivasysuapee=es al OS 


glaciation and climate................ mecsedse Way. LL 5 


131 


Page. 

Dall, W. H., remarks on—Cont’d. 
VORTAC OCS) ccurctacsancssccersesasreasveceesh repre vii 3 
GNILEINS DUO Se esssscessssucesscesnsccate Serr baven at aa Ds! 
deflection of rivers..............06 askeuwaney .Wil 24 
the Bogosloff eruption........ peatveskensaves wii 34 
AYCCCE'SOXPLOVAWON \-.2 .csoscesuswannavanessatas ix 12 
Dalton’s atomic philosophy..............000 vii xlvii 
Ta Wiet susves eduncsdevaccuutscccercvaccss¥assanaaceedsnonasedac v 139 
Dana, J. D., cited on mineralogy.............. i 78, 79 


Darton, N. H., communication on the oceur- 
rence of copper ore in the Trias of the 
Eastern United States. “Title only...ix 46 


Darwin’s doctrine of gemmules.......,....... vii liii 
law of the distribution of volcanoes....vi 89, 91 
Dase, cited on computation Of 7.2... .cccceees i 58 


Davidson, George, letter on transit of Venus, 
1874. Communicated by Asaph Hail. 
ADS ACh cccavectss sons Sescarersenser dasdacevasat ii 32 
Davidson, Lieut., cited on the co-ordinates 
of Bald Head, Alaska ......ccssceeee coon iv 126 
Davis; CrES Death: Ofsssestcdk:vesseseakeeccaeec UAL 
Dawson, Prof. J. W., cited on fossil plants 
FrOM Virginia.......00...ssssseeccsessseakl (38), (42) 


Deaf mutes, Fallacies concerning............ vi 48 
DIAN SUALOS OL icecsvach des \ecdvaressanccabousssene iv 55 
Death) of Ta Agassi zirieds cece cceieycrespevecsasveusssecs i 93 
BfAlVOrd tin ccstcarsccnerscrivexcecaceeawescses vii 72, 127 
O. E. Babcock.......... sage ceaqcucaveanecsdeens¥s vii 72 
ShieGBaindesee ..X 17, 20 43, 76 
"BSB ail Oy ccisavesetevases sce ciavvocccsedvecsecdas 4i 109, 111 
FR SAW sdb VLPs fav isebicccscescecice i tesnsracean bares vii 81 
FE CAPLOU Pinccusctabescqeessadcvestseqsesassavene viii 8 
BeyPROHASOEN ce cecsecoscncenectaee le conteeavcawsines i 87 
C. 
J. 
R. 
C. 
Ase BE AtOn's, cise cevavescess msaehvabnacarytsien seeeedd 111 
E. F 
L. 
WwW 


J 
WETS LOU ccisessscasvossareeses 
F 


B. Hough........ vatdunee delauves cbounvaneante 
A. A. Humphreys........... 
Ma pil ey casscehavevestsrovsanssse seadsseecanweked ii 189 


A. R, Marvine...........00 Satonscrantbenucced ii 83, (53) 
Bee Bi MGO)K ic sasses seoson sevacusnucadevesnucvetenttet ii 111 
Bed WEY Ol csvcaveccseseende ative cead egecsuceaes iv 23,31 


Bis ROINGO ls ses) csucvuscccsscencorcecuereetanuectts Wi al 23 


132 


Page 
Death of—Cont’d. 
J.C. Riley...... Soswernrdvephiacawensensautsew cress iid 28 
J. Rodgers....... Ridteshctss savece cesetsasted -v 102 
BP UNSRMGS Gitta rectsesescvescaceserscencncsunccouss vi 41 
G. C. Shaeffer.............. serebadeessh. (00. 
We aU Estes stzsessscccesscoccccnmscsanahsean'® AUm 
J. J. Woodward....... oe recc o vesconas WAL 12, 75 
M. Yarnall...... pac astven saenalccaeaage eiudcvecenae Ait 28 
Declination standards....... audeevespenasteneeass=h ix 53 
Deep sea mollusks.........eeeee © eecemns Jotecenae v 90 
MD GHIUCLON Sseseececuce sar cceeesscabieccorshcpsoanpeeencans Eo AG 
Degradation. See Erosion. 
Delgarno, G., cited on instruction of the 

UID is eates-sstuaeas eeeconsen eedeeered pidetecatenc® wa UL 
Delta of the Mississippi river.......... macesceces i (10) 
Democritus’ philosophy........... careereee Vil xxxiv 
De nihilo nihil fit.....00..cceeee canst «Vii xxx, xxxili 
Denver, Altitude of........ Peteescratstcuntcaseaeecavan ih 24 
Department Of SCIONCE......00.cesseereeceeeee dX XIVI 
Depauperation of Limnea........ necétincteecoa iid 75 
Derham, Dr. W., cited on echoes..........-seee v 41 
De Tocqueville, cited on destruction of In- 

IANS eektens eter rcecssaceeeces cee tes consepanescacnecs Ad 175 
Device for viewing the sun by light of any 

desired wave length......... cebnereseeserstes x’ 13 
Devonian strata near Sulphur Springs, W. 

Wiciiec tonacheceunacerencstraneryseanacantsn SU eereccee ii (27) 
Dewar, Prof., cited on the radiometev....... ii 81 
Diagnosis of bDlOOG-StAiNS......cecrereeeseers ii 20, 41 
Diarrheal diseases and weather.............. iv 165 
DistOMie SCA]? crise sccacessrececbcocecnccwcee eneaeas vii 26 
Differential equations admitting periodic 

AWCCE TAS: «ress ssscncccesessecse Beeeeneee cocoon x 100 
Diffraction fringes..u.....)sececcesocveseccecen sehaic iii 119 

phenomena in the field of the micro- 

ROO errr cessesoceccsvcssdssacralceessiepeecsco ss ese ii 60 


Diller, J.S., communication on the volcanic 

sand which fell at Unalashka October 

20, 1883, and some considerations con- 
cerning its composition. Abstract..wii 33 

topaz from Stoneham, Maine. Abstract 


LUE MEP OTENCCwtsaunentenen vecece crasnccssaasece viii 5 
the geology of northern California: Ab- 
SUL ACU veccecees Rae anostantanausacesetercatenesm ae oe 


the latest Shiai eruption in northern 
California and its peculiar lava. Refer- 
ONCEu. ccksucensceecctracsvaswecesedseuse Sstragiceecreen ix 46 
Mount Shasta contrasted with Mount 
Rainier. Wo adstract..........00esseeeeceees c peap til 
remarks on geology of Cascade Moun- 
GALA eoudsautccuvcuvaetsearevsusarcteucacaceeeencces ix 8 
Krakatoan dust........... 
DiOrtEROMS ciscsvseesess sss0~pevecdsdeen 


Diptheria, Fuatalation Ob yekssectasotes canes ored: 
Direction of sound, Determination of......ili 69, 
wiil 12, ix 43 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
Discontinuity in elliptig orbits......+0..... Wil 122 
Discovery of the satellites of Mars.......... if 186 
Disease and climate..............00+ Greco SP 
Conservative slement in.............00000 41 111, 124 
Disinfection by gases...........cc00+ wsnansae aoa iv 38 
OL SNIPE, cess, s0ccersensstaceasnceceen daswossavaesauerss Ramen 
Dismal Swamp, Geology Ofv.eccceseseesecereeeWh 28 
Displacement, Geologic.............0 eacuccnsuceatt i 75 
of the middle Atlantic slope.... 
Dissipation of energy..........cceceee 
Distances on any spheroid....... 
Distribution of fossil plants............cc000 
TOSINMIEIS veces cccusctvesssvcsencnecetnreenne rpescri: ii 26 


scientific men and institutions...........% 7 
the surplus money of the United States 

AMONG the States.....cccccccocorsseees wee WA 103 

District of Columbia, Flora of... 
Diurnal variation of magnetic ‘dealinattans 

iii 46 
Dixwell, G. B., communication on cylinder 
condensation, steam jackets, and su- 

perheated steam. Title only............ ii 64 
Doane, G. C., report of the Yellowstone ex- 
pedition of 1870. Communicated by S. 

F. Baird. Reference.........s000. Rereeernaccce) 2! 
Dobson, Surgeon-Major, cited on insectivor- 

ous mammals ........ ‘v 118, 120 

Dog, Malformed..............sccs0 oacocctnteneeenn weed 185 
Doolittle, M. H., communication on the neb- 
ular hypothesis and the inner moon 


Peete eee ence serene 


of Mars.. “Abstract... ssssseces esseeeeK 188, 190 
the influence of aerolites on planetary 

Motion. AOstACL..:225ossccnecsseeteeesestenee ii 190 
aerolithic disturbance of planetary mo- 

tions. Abstract............ eve nuchvaninvuan ners ii 190 
a pile of balls. Abstract...........0000 w-. ddd 76 
the silver question. Abstract....... iii 103, 112 


the geometrical problem to determinea 
circle equally distant from four points. 


ADSITGCE. <0, cstesess occsceasduceessd stiunoneeabeate v 88 
substance, matter, motion, and force. 

PUtle ONY sccen sccccttsessaectepeseinten den peneees WhO 
infinite and infinitesimal quantities. 

ADSENGCES.ccossces aesstenecerenenee oteaa te eaten wi 133 
the rejection of doubtful observations, 

A GSU ACES. «conccoscactunse o seseneesussameennn Ruane wi 152 
music and the chemical elements. 

ABSIT ECE. conncecses eescanee saere aanvaceouceeene vii 26, 27 
the verification of predictions. Ab- 

SUT ACE ccecns Le waneeieeaasee seceeeeWAk 122 
cause and chance in the concurrence of 

phenomena. Title only.......... seo Wild 54 
What is topography? Abstract............ x i4 
Newton’s vis. Title only,........0000+ Mae chest 
association ratios. Abstr@wt........ beancenteakt nee 


a problem in probabilities. Abstract...x 88 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 
Doolittle, M. H., communication on—Cont’d. 
association ratios. Abstract............ x 93, 94 
remarks on sesquisection...........0. sees will 52 
gravitation formula .......... 
phonetic alphabet............. 
bi-metallism...........0s0000 


the need of a biometer 
binary arithmetic 
Dorsey, J. Owen, eee uaietion on the 
gentile system of the Omahas. Jn full. 


EMI CCUER cease csiavet dencsesane transscuestcchelstse? ili 128 
Drainage system and loess of eastern Iowa, 
wi 93 
Olio BIRCKs Hills... ..ssc.vesncoavcetscees coved 125 
BV SUGIN Siren is se sccicce danas cuovaetacauvdssaisscecdss'ee Beearee (49) 
Draper, Prof. J. W., cited on photography...i 47 
ACUTE CT OVLEY .c5cs5 veccacdieve .vosaakscscsdcncees v 135 
Dreams in their relation with psychology..vi 37 
BE EES SRN LTO seg caper ccnsvaacavasdesacurseaceteness vi 94 
Drift of Iowa and Nebraska............cceceeees iv 120 
Dry painting of the Navajos...............000 viii 14 
Duane, Gen., cited on fog signals............ Vv 32, 43 
phenomena of sound,...............0 ii (49), (50) 
Du Bois-Raymond, Experiments in animal 
electricity Dy...........ccesscesssees v 57, 60, 61, 62 


Dudley, P. H., communication on the uses 
of the dynagraph, and the work per- 
formed in determining the resistance 


of trains, ete. Abstract...... Gaaccecanaeee iii 29 
Dulong and Petit, Law of............... v 139 
Thermometric experiments of.......... v 91, 93 
Dumbness of deaf children.................0066 vi 48 
Du Pré, Warren, cited on earthquakes....... i101 


Dutton, C. E., communication on the meas- 
urement of the pressure developed by 
the explosion of gunpowder in fire- 
arms. Title only........ Baad dweracenccertenssces i 52 

some recent experiments on different 
kinds of gunpowder at Fortress Mon- 
OU pa TL ULG. OT sec wneuarcaians tattyasacarscesescoes i 54 

the causes of the elevations and subsi- 


dences of the earth’s surface. Title 
WH rntancesud cestecassotece <eccsicisvatessatssvesecss i 74 
geological time. Title only......... pete eens i 89 


Mallet’s theory of the formation of the 
physical features of the earth. Title 


SUA Ciieteetneatunncensssesensncsasvennsene Geeaccecaetasenc i 90 
recent improvements in the economy of 
fuel. Title only........ sencecsuns cbatois Rereree i 96 
recent improvements in the manufac- 
ture of steel. Title only......ss0r..2000seeees i 97 
the chemistry of the Bessemer process. 
Title only........ Suuevadaseas hack aveuneoseeudseccesess i 98 
the glacial period. Title only........ ..... ii 26 


the causes of glacial climate. Abstract, 


di 43, 45 


133 


Page. 
Dutton, C. E., communication on—Cont’d. 
the geological character of the Colorado 


DUVETS /DULUE OMY ccaccceas ccsciaccecechescuuset lil 28 
the succession of volcanic eruptions. 
TRELE ONY: csntannacnusscsnaccsesacnnsdetevascns iii 36, 37 
the Permian formation of North Amer- 
TCR e ADSUR CEL cswcsssnasvencechesdsusdee .- Add 65, 67 
the silver question. Jn full......... sentkeh 28 
the scenery of the Grand Cajion district. 
Title only... savavancascaatresasnitesnessasccced iv 120 
the Vermilion cliffs and the valley of 
the Virgen in southern Utah. C. E. 
Dutton. Title only........ Beane awatsane ke iv 122 
the geology of the Hawaiian islands. 
AGSENC Cl icccccuconcesniocssues pavenchscenensucneeen vi 13 
the voleanie problem stated. Abstract, 
vi 87 
Whatisaglacier? Abstract.............. vii 39 


the volcanoes and lava fields of New 
MexiCos) AlDStract..casscsccccsvetsttcesse-sg VERON G 

practical geology versus speculative 
physics. Title only... .....0-008 .o0e-.s. Wiad 4, 5 

a recent visit to the scene of the Charles- 
ton earthquake and resulting conclu- 


SION Ss) WLULE OMA icctnsadexcovtsenvccubsvsereones x 16 
the depth of earthquake foci. Abstract. 

VU fiGurre.cccssve Waves venbadesunctosvecnuecsatcenesavect > sane 
the speed of propagation of the Charles- 

ton earthquake. Reference...,...10....... x 28 

remarks on distribution of volcanic ac- 

ML OTscs oven anebvectuvecusarsivcstspetsccasuceuscetetereets i 102 
wind and temperature observations.....ii 18 
Fefraction: Of SOUNG..<..csc-veeccascssvoscecenses ii 58 
geology of the Colorado region............ ii 76 
the earth’s interior..............00 mettsdbercaes ii (77 
charcoal in the Crift...........ssccccecessceees iv 122 
separation of minerals by density......wi 27 
nebular hy pothesis. cack scntsedscssovcerses wi 45 
temperature observation...........:c0 see vi 48 
outlines of continents 24 
SUN! SlOWSsscsesesescesccsveves Wablasvonrsceususeuvy's wii 35 
Indian observation of nature...... dendene vil 74 
earthquake detonations............0.seee viii 28 
Charleston earthquake........... adbcaekee saad ix 42 

Dynabraph, (De icccsieecsssetveorses waveastececucrees iii 29 
Dynamic hypothesis...............ccccesseseee Peon fie. &.%.< 
EHHEOTICS OF LOLCOs s2.sicccccesscsscsstsessuvovssvwanct v 126 


Eastman, J. R., cited on individual vocabu- 
JATIOSsecavsocsncscecceetcattnssecasavenceacueerscecse ii (21) 

communication on a comparison of the 

thermometers used to determine the 

correction for atmospheric refraction 

at the U. S. Naval Observatory. Ab- 
SETAC ocancscnetansonscvs esi dveaatapmeeeen Saasaupadsnen i 68 


154 


Page. 
Eastman, J. R., communication on—Cont’d. 
the frequency of the occurrence of the 
zero and the nine digits in the tenths 
of seconds as obtained from the chro- 
nographie record of transit observa- 
MAC SenA ORPRIRCY , ve dccncesossssvscrseeuvaiensacuras i 85 
the comparison of rain-gauges at differ- 
ent elevations. Abstract........ presasesaqel 40) 
a personal equation instrument. <Ab- 
MPT EC Lineddatadsankenhycuusrissssaenescaseair caseen iii 33, 37 
some results from the discussion of the 
observations of the transit of Mercury 
of May 6, 1878. Abstract..........0..s000 Alii 43 
the Florida expedition for observation 
of the transit of Venus [1882]. Ab- 


BU CUrcudstates shea taapedsserenussenscres cacaepene vi 21 
the Rochester (Minnesota) tornado. Ab- 
SEP ACE csccvavs sigaataseesdsesssagbacesentaréscccnses wil 3 
anew meteorite. Abstract... vii 32 
remarks on vocabularies ........ pacsuisetentee ss ii 28 
Eaton, A. B., communication on the preser- 
vation of foods, Title onlyy.........-ceee00e i 22 
Death of........ itaenededcdasd stuns tare teva seen eee ii 111 
Eaton, Prof., cited on classification of ferns, 
iv 110 
Barth, Interior: x... 000. ccecleoescsce dessus ii 76 
tremors as shown uP astronomical obser- 
PVAULOUSi ers /osscuseduvucatavediivecresannutacsatsve Seer 2U 
at Niagara aialia, Josdusdsceuaepenest staswahtoey .. dv 186 
Welocity of casteccuhscesessncesewsttevssecneetea viii 28 
Earthquake. See Seismology. 
Earth’s crust, Crumpling Of ...........cescc00 viii 18 
interior, Condition Of. .icseccsesicedcceceoceenct vili 7 
Easter, Computation of........ ideo Siete wi 15 
Echo from surface of ocean....... tec cheeensincchier ii 171 
Echoes, Tyndall on............eers poss dee eee Aeecd vi 41 
Eclipse of the moon, June 11, 1881............. v 90 
sun, January 11; P8802 oc iee.dect eves cones iii 121 
SUB) JOLY! 29, 1878 .csieiccidevesstsectes ii 202, iff 116 
Economie phase of the English sparrow 
BOSTON cos susscdapceseeeh ssdsensesshen dvescwel leans x 16 
Economies. See Political Economy. 
HMducation, in) Ja paninis2.te.sscsrecsevestwesecssaneons ii 69 
Edwards, W. H., cited on the aes of the 
Rynaphalides ideanagheehaneebesea Tar rereccce iii 42 
Hidocenter ....... Bennde Jeep hkoreucaaunaasa ieee apn cae viii 47 
Eimbeck, Wm., cited on the diorthode.....wi 132 
FOIASHICLOY.- ccc ceiccscactossspassicndncsionnescvsucdcnsebeh oeeebs v 130 
Election of officers........... i 20, 32, 64, 91, ii 16, 59, 


86,161, ii 17, 51, iv 29, v 84, 174, willl 
wii 81, viii 80, ix 47, x 39. 

officers of the Mathematical Section...wi 122, 
vii 87, viii 37, ix 53, x 83 


Electric receivers............ Seren Ca tore iv 153 
researches by Ncasenn “ee Stenecta Socal aees ii 236 
Electricity as a primitive force..... «W 168 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
Electricity, List of papers on (See also 
Acoustics) : 


on the recording systems of the trans- 
atlantic cables. J. E. Hilgard. Title 


ONMY.....00000 vseaeee bdevckenuvsuaveWakn anaes wecedeee) Deh 
[a method of lighting gas jets by electric- 
ity.] Dr. Van Sant. Vo abstract......4 66 


on electricity engendered by the driving 
belt of the machinery for ventilating 
the Capitol at Washington. J. Henry. 


ADS ACl....eeeeee nbsvhpscbanas eeeereae eae ossederirhy AQ 
Jablokoff’s electric candle. J. E. Hilgard. 

LUELE OT. cdsnonndaceuncioonaesseveneeneat aaa aeostae iii 19 
large area illumination by electricity. E. 

B. Elliott. Dvthe onli)... .ccccesncoscseraces fii 45 
the storage of electric energy. C. H. Koyl. 

AlDStT OC scsscssensoassen oc enuvesisdaneevansetsaaeheene vi 46 


units of force and energy, including elec- 
tric units. E. B. Elliott. Title only, 


wi 137 

electric lighting. E.B. Elliott. Title only, 
vii 80 

[exhibition of a volt-meter.] T. C. Men- 
denhall. Abstract..........seccssveee soe Wild = 26 


the electrometer as used in observations 

of atmospheric electricity. C. F. Mar- 

vin. Title only.... Pri 

the mutual action of Geen ee of alsoug ic 
currents. E. B. Elliott. Abstract and 

TEFCTENCE .10.0ce0000 é senncneecoducuesuspaseeyaaeeaaee x 92 

the quotients of space-directed lines. E. 

B. Elliott. Abstract... sveneageee x 105, 106 
Elements, Periodic law Of..............css0eeeee wii 15 
Elevation. See Altitude. 

Eliot and Storer, cited on atoms...........+.00.¥ 128 
Elliott, E. B., calendar of the Society...wii xxii, 
viii xxx, ix xxvii, x xxxi 
communication on the statisties of the 
borrowing power of the United States. 

Title ONLY... .cccersccossens achateenegeeee iateewarees i 29 

the new coinage of Japan. Title only...4 31 
the locus of the point of equal illumi- 
nation by two unequal lights treated 

by the quaternion analysis. Title only, 


i 35 
the adjustment of census returns. Title 
OTUB) cavestonexeas saben svsnsseuensveshy -eeeeeeeee peeve (G0 
life and annuity tables, based on the 
census Of 1870. Title Only ....ecceceeceeeee wATa 
international coinage. Title only......... i 75 
change in value of dollar. Wo abstract, 
i 91 


the credit of the United States, as shown 
by the value of its securities. Title 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 


Elliott, E. B., communication on—Cont’d. 


the use of metric weights and balances 
for postal purposes in the United 
States. - Abstract ...... .ccsscccoccececeee eect Wap Uy 
further remarks on metric weights and 
balances for the postal service. Ab- 
BUN BOO er ceestesscnckceseateass pecnescahasctaensbusens ii 19 
the transition in Germany, and the 
Scandinavian nations of Sweden, Nor- 
way, and Denmark, from the silver 
standard of coinage and money of ac- 
count toa gold standard.......cesseccsse fi 25 
calendar formule. Abstract......... ersten | uy 
affected quantities of the first order. 
SIRLEO VOTE iatnedadeessessscecccseccsccucesnscececcceR ht Ai 
the mutual relations as to price of gold, 
silver bullion, silver coin, and green- 
backs. Title only......... Saecueiseceasenensereat “OU 
the mutual relation as to price of gold, 
greenbacks, silver bullion, and silver 
ReGURN ME METAS [ECE Usuecanstescccassrencsanea rates veces ii 52 
adjustment of the calendar. <Abstract.ii 59 
two propositions, now before Congress, 
for changing the coin of the United 


States. Title onlt......c.cccoscccsiseeseessses Ai 68 
force and momentum. Title only........ ii 84 
monetary standards. Title only......... wi 85 


mutual relations of gold and silver, and 

of prices of commodities. <Abstract...ii 87 
the telephone. Title only/........ss00-.sseeees di 111 
a statistical diagram. Wo abstract......44 134 
optional money standards. Title only..4i 135 
standards of time—international, sec- 


tional, and local. Abstract......... sccorod 137, 
the telephote. Abstract.......ec0. s+» manana ii 192 
musical intervals. Abstract...........00 1i 199 


the adjustment of the Carlisle tables of 
reversions and annuities. Title only..ii 201 
meridional time for railway and tele- 
graphic purposes. Abstract........-..... ii 202 
the progress of international coinage in 
France and America. Title only.....iii 27 
the subject of international coinage. 
Abstract........ Reasanneaesencese peenCadinessapac ili 38 
large area illumination by electricity. 
Title OnMp......eccccsecceese eeseeath Basesscesanss iii 45 
the silver question. Abstract....... iid 103, 107 
the construction of the Government 
sinking fund. Abstract...........ccsse0 iii 113 
bi-metallism. <Abstract....... “Sfesteeescees iv 141 
accrued interest on Government secur- 
ities, Title only......-..s00se epeeBaaectsecsesen v 21 
the credit of the United States, past, 
present, and prospective. Title only..v 102 
some formule relating to Government 
securities. Title only... .cccseccccseee seoeeeeW 106 


135 


Page. 


Elliott, E. B., communication on—Cont’d. 


survivorships, with tables and formulas 

of construction. Title only....... sneretaaW) Lae 
formulas for the computation of Easter. 

In full... Res ecnetxeouanudunasancsvascvesyosen vi 14 
units of force and energy, including 

electric units. Title only...........000e. vi 137 
a financial problem. Title only........... vi 149 
electric lighting. Title only.............. vii 80 
Benjamin Alvord. Jn full............c000eWid 127 


example illustrating the use of a certain 
symbol in the caleulus of affected 
quantity. Title only........00..0000e0002. Wid 
quantity of United States subsidiary sil- 
ver coin existing and in circulation. 
TWEE TOI N) ocoz swccevets a ceurevesecerctureeacsteses: ix 
annual profit to banks of national bank 
note circulation. Title only..........00 Ax 
a problem in probabilities. Wo abstract, 
x 

the mutual action of elements of elec- 
tric currents. Abstract and reference..x 


37 


88 


92 


anew computing machine. Abstract...x 102 


the quotients of space-directed lines. 


AUBET ACE. ccccsexee Bucedanduasneay eadaacunemanne x 105, 106 
remarks ON Auroras.......s0reee wk 45, iw 22 
calendar reform.......... “agree anaeehseste ii 30 
bi-metallism............ ea sannsan hate seacaaaat seseeekdd 103 
. Benjamin Peirce.......... aeavacbacheubeanscesers iv 24 
small loans by banks ......... RePEreccencce iv 34 
the metric system ............ *Cercconace see Wd 
standard time........ sraaecnrechees hee mueponnene 
infinitesimals........ PERE reo creer nae ceacee 
theory of errors 
LOFDAGO ee cncensscaccses aes 
sun glows...... semlisunbisae cuscddvemenutssseaadarte vii 17 
TRYVHEAGION eccheee ct uact soc encaceceoedscettee sos Wid 20 
Poole’s euharmonic organ..........s0000 vil 28 
Elliott, H. W., communication on the habits 
of the fur-bearing seals of the islands 
of St. Paul and St. George, Behring Sea. 
Reference........ iaecennsesneasnest anceineeeone enue Ba) | 
Elliptic integral of the third species.........% 54 
integrals....... ieenseubnee bs tn aicvatee Wietenee renee vii 102 
Ellis, William, cited on the constant P........ x 102 
Emmons, S. F., communication on ore de- 
position by replacement. Abstract and 
WB CTETICE wasesacceccarentuets Secsradn; cers cececicsn “vi 32 
What isa glacier? Abstract....... aisscciWAk. (Sy 
remarks On glaciers..........cseccsersee cece Wh | 9 
Emmons’ Taconic system .......... ecernaddameuacee > ibe) 
WON CKGS: CONIBE sa sccccusvancsacaes cxevccteereee sevens 134, 35 
Endlich, F. M., communication on mineral 
systems. In full....... abaeanease anauetere Beater atest 
electrical phenomena in the Rocky 
Mountains. Title only....cccscccsscsessessen 95 


136 


Page. 
Endlich, F. M., communication on—Cont’d. 
two bricks from the great wall of China. 
Title only.....-+ sasetoscsencoonsens maweneseneasecaes i 98 
specimens of meteoric iron from Chi- 
huahua, Mexico, and the structure of 
meteorites in general. Title only......4 98 
the occurrence of pure tellurium in cer- 
tain gold mines of Colorado. Title 
ONLY ..reccccccceree dveoceses: ssudunadeneunyos sebaen aaa i 101 
the coloring agent of gems. Abstract, 
li 31 


some interesting cases of metamor- 


phism. Title Only... eeeeeee neenwaaeare iii 27 


FEMOV EY ois sevcssccuspossenccesees 5 

Conservation and ikstnation OL cSaccesnacsnus a ea 
Engelman, Dr. G., cited on Quercus......... iv 110 
English sparrow question... 
Entomology. See Zoology. 
Eotyos, cited on sounds produced by me- 


. 


Avesssscebusvenceataness LO 


WOGOUS sue nscuscnpceussdechesber tassseenencanns SEseeeee di 157 
Epicurus cited on philosonky Sonceesras vii xxx 
Erie, Altitude of Lake........cceeeeeees err ae 
Erosion as related to displacement............ ii 75 

by drifting sand... ........- aceerere renteeascnn: i 57 
Errata......... ii p. 4 of cover, iii 148, vi 162, x 114 
Errors, Composition of...... Dre vccnaunncaebsersnccesr v 106 

respecting the North American Indians..4i 175 

BD NGOLY) Olseceacacescsuscetioctnsnsancace niche wi 138, 152 
Eruption, Latest, in Northern California, 

ix 46 

Theories of....... Wanasaatise rosasdidesessarvetpcawcccae REO 
Eskimo shell heaps.......0.-ccccsseesesseeseres eeeees ii 65 
Estimation of manganese as pyrophosphate, 

ii 132 
Ether, Hypothesis of an.......... erasaaisehen vi xxix 
Ethnology. See Anthropology. 
Eucalyptus on the Roman campagna........ vi 36 
Euler ignored by Am. Phil. Soc.......wiii xxxvii 
Wuler’s theorem. ...cccscccssosessescscccscccesoseceserer XK LOL 
Eulogy on A. D. Bache... Shera eostees i 35 
A. A. Humphreys..... acedsspsocesaadeW By 3h. 


FLVOlUtOS.....cccescecvccscesessccccneecccece sence covesseess WAR LOT 
Evolution and phthisis.... sssaccolenesaceveMh, 125 
Methods Of.....cs0ssecccseve sscsee connec cdvdscoces WA XX VIL 
Of the DOW ANd ALLOW... ..eccrscrerececcesseceeee: ix 44 
elaments........ suucdspnesendasness poececre tne vii 16 
Expansion and beating of ice fields......... ii (22) 
Experimentation............. dapaspapresecess di 163, wil li 
Explosion at Flood ROCK. cs..secssessseeeseeees viii 28 
** Explosion” of meteor explained........... -li 143 
Exposure of thermometers.........-+.Wi 46, Wii 80 
Eye, Optical dofects of........... eArbenssaniaa macneber i 22 


Eyes, Apparatus for lesting.......cccccceceeeeddd 53 
shining in the dark..,......ccsscccsssrerceereeWhd 13 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page 
Falconida, Natural r wei Of ....cssse AL 
Pal LMG ve ssecscunseucee ea cadersaiataes pele Fa: 23 
Fallacies AF Se tae: deck. 48 
Fallacy as to the theory of gravitation...... v 85 
Faraday, cited on Matter..........ccceseescerees vii 48 
Farquhar, Edward, cited on personal vocab- 
TUT Yes. sccnssesteueevanteonvacent PORE ii ii (18) 


communication on certain remarkable 

effects of lightning. Read by — 
Henry. Title only. .cccececeeeeee Feneebopauuend 42 

dreams in their relation with aR 
OBY- ADSEN ACT. :..:c..snssncnecasessnsdvessestte Og 


TOMALES ON the AULOTLA.......00 sever seceereerees iv 22 
FOTNAGOGS ces. dacvecscsosscpebddecuducnscusee een vii 3 
thunder storms.......... o sseseaeeduneae sccoses WRAL) TD 


determining the direction of sound..wili 13 
Farquhar, Henry, communication on exper- 
iments in binary arithmetic. Abstract, 


v 125, wi3 
further experiments in binary arith- 
metic. <Abstract............ in Zacecooss conseeey ame 
form of least-square computation. In 
Jul eavicsspewesanton odeubeutecsocesassnesseweuexsnneaianm one 
the problem discussed by Mr. Alvord. 
ADSI OCtacsssccncsssuased ta wi 152 


the theoretical discussion in Prof. P. G. 
Tait’s ‘‘Encyclopedia Britannica” 
article on mechanics. Abstract......vii 29 

empirical formule for the diminution 
of amplitude of a freely-oscillating 
pendulum. <Abstract..........0... dosncbe Why 80) 

a Fonetic Alfabet. Abstract........... ix, 17 

a comparison of the Boss and Auwers 
declination standards. Abstract and 
PELEVENMCE..scccscscdscucesustnsngraedateniies HAS. 53 

a problem in probabilities. bien 88 

a solution and generalization ofa a 
lem requiring the division of a rec- 
tangle into parts which form a square. 


INO 'GDSUOCl...0nacescececananuestsseeeeeaeeee aperknee ey OO 
remarks on standard time........0...ss000-5W 114 
infinitesimal .coccccuscesvcanousnsceptettaaneeeneee 
Grvifting DUO S....<..c.cc0scssesepesesensdeneente 
earth tremors......... ovestecnueeanee cchenaeete 
Fault at the base of the Wasatch Moun- 
TAINS: .cccu0s seavseuaesecsesucnsesancnselneeaenieeeene ii 103 
near Harper's Ferry.......cc.sc-ccsessssneonseuse vi 30 
GAN OS ssctncacevecepee occindsa venueounsesounesaiie ttt mnnneae ii 195 
Faults, Geologic.........see aeeieet esvvnsnaebane 4i 75,76 
in the Sierra Nevada........006 sss. moos che ix 4, 5 
of the Great Basin. ...c0.0:sssccscossecveuseduunesee ix 5 
Ferguson, J., observation of supposed trans- 
Neptunian planet............sccccssseee «Add 20 
Ferrel, William, cited on deflection of vivers 
by rotation.......... aang enadaeees sivas ene wii 22 


law Of SCOTINS A. .cccssteccavcsscacocascesauencstapne mint 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-x. 


Page. 
Ferrel, William, cited on—Cont’d. 
thermometry..............-6 Gecaewoneesedanae racks wi 25 
communication on the effects of winds 
and barometric pressure on the tides 
of Boston, and on the mean level of 
the sea. Abstract and reference.......... 1 53 
the law connecting the velocity and di- 
rection of the wind with the baro- 


metric gradient. Abstract...........s00 «i 106 

the conditions determining tempera- 
LINO: EI fbb eaiwve-actesake deca ‘eandvaxee oeeurene v 90, 91 

solar radiation at Sherman, Wyoming. 
“Title only........0000ee0. Be apeetneseatucestasenvare v 101 
Feuerbach’s Circle..........sssesecsees ethtee Vill 45 

Finance. See Political Economy. 

Financial problem.............00000+ evsneaabebeleoased vi 149 

Fish, Decrease of, on the southern coast of 
New. England)... .ccccscsscs-csesccsees seuneveneten i 52 
fauna of Massachusetts......... oe Scescec |B) 
New species Of...........sssscocssoes peWasveneventasncea: LOce 


did 116 
64 


Remarkable ingestion Of...............s0e00008 
Fishes, Shoulder girdle of .... 
Fisheries exhibitions.. 


OT DREN ORIG. oscacscsuccecserdcessevees 
Fishery Commission’s work...... ..X 52, 69 
right treaties, Tuterpretation of... EE CREETEAL i 39 


Fletcher, Robert, communication on recent 
experiments on serpent venom. Ref- 

OP ENGE cdcuvareecsdsuiescnccesncacesicauccovacvasessoct vi 38 

report as treasurer.....wii 82, will XXVlii, 31, ix 

Xxx, 47, XK xxxiv, 39 

Fletchers and bowWyerS...........sssseeeeeees evs 44 

Flexures of transit instruments...... soos Whid = 27 
Flint, A. S., communication on the most 
probable value of the latitude and its 
theoretical weight from entangled ob- 
servations occurring in the use of Tal- 


cott’s Method. ADstract......eceee x 91 
Flora of Laramie group..... -Vili 17 
EGA MOUNUAIN. ...sctosfesttevecoctscsosvescocces iv 63 
Washington and vicinity... iv 64 
Floras of America and Japan...........:.. Boncuce ii 42 
different regions compared....... aeectete iv 99 
Florida expedition fer observation of the 
transit of Venus........ Rarceee aeceebse deveceee wi 21 


Submergence of. ........ 
Flood Rock explosion 
Focal lines in astigmatism 
Fog signals and acoustics..... 


41 37, 57, 60, 167, 345, 
(45), dv 135, wv 23, 39 
Food adulteration...............cee0- A oceateeeesuke iv 39 
Foote, Elisha, communication on the laws of 
condensation of aqueous vapor in the 


atmosphere. Titl@only........0...00 Sepeees 4 74 
& proposed method of observing astro- 
nomical transits. Title only 2.0.0... i 75 


137 


Page. 
Foote, Elisha, communication on—Cont’d, 
some causes that produce rain. Title 
ONLY... .eeene eeseaeee Repuueahseesassasecsscaccnsuacsss «os i 98 
the causes of electrical developments in 


thunder storms. Abstract 
Death Of 2 xvcsssstaccsicacdes Wideseacduasieceuude sees vi 
27, Vv 126, wi xxviii, wii 47 
absstaSaaesaec pWapuscanesaaseacconivet wv ST 
NE Co be Re aes Yii 30 
Forecasts, verification Of.......ssccccsscesseees viii 8 
Formula for the length of 4 seconds-pendu- 
HUN came nse ceccaserossacee sinadaauedins ative davas vii 101 
Formule for area of a plane triangle......vidi 37 
diminution of pendulum swing......... vii 89 
Fort Yukon, Determination of position of..i 22 
Fossil plants, Distribution Of..........s0000000--: x 29 
from Alleghany Co.,Va........ ahesaene sovecseel (26) 
Fossils in aerolites.......c.ssccsccccssece meacaanaetist v 66 
Foster, M., cited on muscular contraction..v 60 
nerve Currents..........008 esbescppevancases aeeaee ve 62 


Fourier, cited on the temperature of space..ii 73 

Forshey, C. G., communication on the allu- 
vial basin of the Mississippi river 
styled the delta. Im full............00 i 98, (10) 

-v 76 


Frank, F., cited on brain temperatures... 
Franklin’s scientifie work 


TCG WIL. secteccescccucs adedeauscess aac 
Fremont, Dr. H. F., Researches on inocula- 
tion of diptheria Dy.. ......c0scccseseeeses iv 38 


Frisby, E., communication on a series for 
the determination of the number ex- 
pressing the ratio of the circumfer- 


ence to the diameter. In full 57 
a Gregorian calendar. Abstract............4 75 
BOTIOSS | LULLEONUY nacenesscncdssusscariactsdeseesce 193 
the total solar eclipse of January 11th, 

TSSOP A USUOCE roniecsesctasescadvastocrtercee: iii 121 


magic squares. Abstract. 6 figures...idi 143 
the orbit of Swift’s comet. Abstract..iw 59 
remarks on calendars............ autgecacentsusee li 38 
Frost limits in North Carolina 
Fundamental distance in thermometry....ix 27 
Fungi, Microscopic...... eeecaeasresy facebaas devotees i 42 


Gale, L. D., communication on the cause 
and remedy of the potato rot. Title 

ONY wicesavsedsnccesedevnerrseetercdécs Seen secermaseen: i 97 
the geology of the lignite formation, 
and on a hitherto undescribed de- 
posit discovered in 1834 in New York 


Daly. Dvtle! On ye ccasuvesceaccctecsces cecdberede 4 106 
the failure of the wooden pavements of 
Washington City. Abstract.............. ii 26 
the climate of plants. Abstract...........4i 183 
remarks on the bowlders of LongIsland.ii 27 
Death of........ uuccbraadudds cebcuecsbeoscesees euwuwcee wi 48 


138 


. 


Page 

Galen, cited on life......... bebantesccadctboatsuasceades v 51 

Galileo, cited on Saturn’s rings........cceeeeee wi 44 
Gallaudet, E. M., communication on uncon- 

scious cerebration. Title only........ ii 48 


the international convention of the 
teachers of the deaf and dumb, at 


WMitians A-AUSUP GCE octet vanacasdeeasence saness iv 55 
remarks on gesture language and visible 
BPGCOM as. coscsnsenssoycencesenssruyawenspbbenese vi 77 
Gamgee, A., cited on muscular contrac- 
GION ceiececececncce ccscccncupsvsacnesqscceuvcoscsss v 59, 60 
NETVE CULLENtS........ccceee rocactachceccnichenre v 62 


Gardner, J. T., communication on the use of 
railroad levellings in determining ele- 
vations on the great lakes and rivers 
in the United States and in the Rocky 


Mountains. Abstract and reference..ii 23 
Gaseg) Theory Ofeiipscsiewsteessessess ssanesasccseaecoee v 138 
Gauss, cited on computation of 7.............. i 59 
Ganga aon rire condos cecctnce tees senanes coteee vii 102 

method for computing variation of ele- 

MON tS/Of An) OFDiti ccceccsreccsosecaseesesste viii 41 

ATANSLOFMALION <. ...ccccccsecccoscesscssees stisance Wan 110 
Gay-Lussac, Law Of..........-066 dvunad eaaeaesspisasse 


General committee rules. 


See Standing 


Rules. 
Gentile system of the Omahas........... wee did 128 
Geographical distribution of mammals......4i 26 
terms and fishery treaties....... piasbaures eagened i 39 


Geography, List of papers on (see also 
Oceanography and Seismology) : 
official report of the Yellowstone expedi- 
tion of 1870. G.C. Doane. Communi- 
cated by S. F. Baird. Reference..........4 21 
[exhibition of map of the headwaters of 
the Yellowstone and Lewis rivers.] M. 


C. Meigs. Vo abstract............+ pseiaateey a, 21 
‘geographical centre of the United States.] 
J. EB. Hilgard. ADstract.......ecrosseecccess i 22 


on the results of travels in Alaska and the 
determination of the position of Fort 
Yukon. C. W. Raymond. Communi- 
cated by T. L. Casey. Reference.......... i 22 
[exhibition of dust from Armenia.] T. 
ANItISCNIE)) 2VO QDSEF UCT. ccovcnssacscsnecosoeces a 25 
on the relative value of Alaska to the 
United States, as compared with that 
of other territorial acquisitions. W. 
H. Dall. Abstract and reference.......... i 25 
on the distribution of the population of 
the United States. J. E. Hilgard. Title 


ONY acasusce casteu so puedeapancciaynnsnaceunesenettonsstat i 29 
on observations made on a journey to Cali- 
fornia. J. Henry. Title omly.............. i 31 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 


Geography, List ofpapers on—Cont’d. 


on the westward movement of the popula- 
tion of the United States. J. E. Hil- 
Bards, WeEfEr encecsscssicossexconsavascusnteceeenae 
on the misapplication of geographical 
terms, as bearing especially on the 
question of the fishery right treaties. 
R. D. Cutts. Abstract.........0 odairaegeree 
recent explorations in Syria under the 
auspices of the Palestine exploration 
fund. Prof. Porter. Title only..........4 
on certain recent geological and geograph- 
ical researches in Arizona and Nevada. 
G.K. Gilbert. Abstract....:.:.ccs-csesessorl 
[a visit to Egypt.] W.T. Sherman. Wo 


QOBUGLE .oi-vasccseccecsamaes cncesntaneany bikade dan emne 
on the fluctuations of the river Nile. J. 
Henry. Title only........0.00 pnsnovsces¥seyene i 


[letter on the Hayden Survey.] J. Curtis. 
Communicated by E. B. Elliott. No ab- 
SUL BClrascccnsesesgenaatsecauae aanccnb{duasduleseueeneey i 
on some measurements of heights by a 
pocket aneroid, W. Harkness. Title 
ON fics jsnnevacnnssptesse:penph-sadeeeneeaeneee soasceusanll 
[on the Goldschmidt aneroid barometer.] 
J. E. Hilgard. Wo abstract.........-.ses-d 
[travels in Turkey and the Caucasus.] W. 
T. Sherman. No abstract........0...csses i 
on the proceedings of the International 
Metrological Commission. J. E. Hil- 
gard. Title only.......... neuasounsceunnaehenne i 
on the habitability of the elevated plateaus 
ofthe West. B. Alvord. Title only...a 
on the use of the cafions of the Colorado 
for weighing the earth. G. K. Gilbert. 
Title only....... Boer tra tc s cpauencs=aemechtaa ht 
on the recent determination of the longi- 
tude between Paris and Greenwich. 
J. E. Hilgard. Title only........ chbsonodeas i 
on some of the results of the Polaris North 
Pole Expedition. E. Bessels. Refer- 
TONCO ..sesesseressecoseisunsveaaccataePaeeneee sodactaneal 
a method of describing and locating with 
ease the approximate positions of geo- 
graphical regions. J. M. Toner. Title 
GI sihsscsnansseecssanpeaenney oh psanpavsweneneegeenad ree | 
on two bricks from the great wall of China. 
F.M. Endlich. Title only.......0.scceses 
on the alluvial basin of the Mississippi 
river styled the delta. C. G. Forshey. 


35 


39 


8 


65 


68 


74 


88 


92 


97 


98 


T7 FUl sccosssecasrsmavessscensas secu gee enna i 98 (10) 


on the use of railroad levellings in deter- 
mining elevations on the great lakes 
and rivers in the United States and in 
the Rocky Mountains. J.T. Gardner. 
Abstract and reference....... aeohebeate oeeree | 


23 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 
Geography, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
on the geographical distribution of mam- 
mals. T. Gill. Abstract....... pavenwadadee! ii 26 
on the movements caused in large ice- 
fields by expansion and contraction, 
as illustrative of the formation of anti- 
clinal and synclinal axes in geological 
formations. M.C. Meigs. In full. 4 
SMPUIC ES vocsudavarkanxsosesubunnddendatcrernaceues di 33, (22) 
on the Uintah Mountains. J. W. Powell. 
Te TLGL OMG ncnkt wh saostes és acvichesspassenp (icenide 1 O4 
the results of a recent determination of 
the elevation of the Caspian and Aral 
seas. A. Woeikoff. <Abstract.......... ii 34 
account of progress of the International 
Metrical Commission. J. E. Hilgard. 
Title oniij....s.0.00.0000 paidsshapsetashed Rusaxtuanes ii 41 
the measurement of a base-line for the 
primary triangulation of the United 


States Coast Survey near Atlanta, 
Georgia. J. E. Hilgard. Abstract and 
MOPETENC Cress ccnescwsons scsuadocsconessons vecteeaven ay 50 
the watershed of the Adirondack region. 
BLP. Judd. Abstract........s0s<c.cscesesese ii 67 
[voyage of the U.S.S.Swatara.] W. Hark- 
NESS. WO AHSEACE...ccccccesvesassse seseeeel 68, 69 
Japan. H.Capron. Title only..........++ eekd 879 
the Adirondack watershed. F. F. Judd. 
ADSET GCE .....c06s0-neseeces eats easbchenntads castuanud di 82 


the deviations of the plumb-line as deter- 
mined in the survey of the 49th paral- 
lel of latitude. F. V. Greene. Ab- 
SUTACE ANA TEFETENCE......-0.--00s.cerceeenceeee ii 82 
[route for] the interoceanic canal through 
Nicaragua. E.P. Lull. Title only...ii 83 
[visit to Japan.] T.Antisell. Wo abstract, 


ii 84 

the late English polar expedition. E. 
DIRS SSOIS) pA OSU OCE cdewnnenancesseacccdde sasses ii 89 

aspecial method of barometric hypsome- 
try. G.K.Gilbert. <Abstract............ ii 131 

standard scales or measures of length. J. 
Bel eard. cADSErRCE tees econ cceecslecceus ii 136 

&@ proposed new leveling instrument. G. 
K. Gilbert. ADStract...cecrrosseccseeesccoes ii 184 

the recent history of Great Salt Lake. G. 
} ee (Gilbert., A Dabratiics.wdewssnsaxescestowess ii 187 

the lands of the arid region of the United 
States. J.W. Powell. Abstract........ ii 189 


on the Kanab base-line, and a proposed 
new method of base measurement. 
G. K. Gilbert. Abstract........ Se iii 34 
the secular change in the magnetic decli- 
nation in the United States and at some 
foreign stations. C. A. Schott. Ab- 
ENDL ccauscissassenass Gaspesesuneeeasteesi easy use 40) 


139 


Page- 
Geography, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
[Luray cave.] J. W. Chickering. Title 
OMY caiwndesndnessecn Spepen ane Shee pioweeavenanoten iil 65 
on the boundary line between Alaska and 


British America. W. H. Dall. Title 

OTA A) rokesrecsta nace cauha dah as teaavacesteavieoecessshal }17T 
a model of the basin of the Gulf of Mexico. 

J. E. Hilgard. <Abstract.............--00- iv 52 
notes on Roan Mountain, North Carolina. 

J.W. Chickering. In full........cesssees iv 60 
the scenery of the Grand Cafion district. 

C. E. Dutton. Title only........... vesee eV 120 


the Vermilion Cliffs and the valley of the 
Virgen, in Southern Utah. C. E. Dut- 


LOM.) -2UELe OMe... sacasuavsaesethate asecseeyeces iv 122 
boundary line between Alaska and Siberia. 

M. Baker. In full. Map......... posaans iv 123 
recent discoveries in Alaska north of Behr- 

ing strait.. W. H. Dall. <Abstract.....iv 163 
on barometric hypsometry. G.K. Gilbert. 

FELON ONCE. wccanicccudvenctt sex csenateeesaceed tatees v 48 


alignment curves on any surface, with 
special application to the ellipsoid. C. 
H. Kummell. Abstract. 1 figure.....wi 123 
graphic tables for computing altitudes 
from barometric data. G. K. Gilbert. 
FRE ET ONCE sss anvcsecssensssnasenenes Rapaecnesseeeee vi 136 
the existing glaciers of the High Sierra of 
California. I.C. Russell. Abstract and 
TEPETENCE.  DHUGWES..sccrcecerenncacsaessecne vii 5 
some physical and economic features of 
the Upper Missouri system. L. F. 
Wns Reference... 0-cecctseresassceunescios vii 20 
the diversion of water courses by the rota- 
tion of the earth. G. K. Gilbert. Ab- 


Stract ANd TEfeEereNce.......eereseeceees nog vil 21 
What is a glacier? Symposium. Ab- 
OVE 0) Do eeso- Eo peLOLe reo Dee Poe Baa vii 37 
a concrete problem in hydrostatics. G. K. 
Gilbert. Abstract..........00 sescuwaracucs vil 92 
a formula for the length of a seconds- 
pendulum. G. W. Hill. Reference, 
vii 101 


discussion of aconcrete problem in hydro- 
statics proposed by Mr. G. K. Gilbert. 
R.S. Woodward. Title only........0 vii 101 
variations of latitude. A. Hall. Abstract 
ONE TESETENCEccccssnenveccorses secsecesseens Wh 10 
distances on any spheroid. C. H. Kum- 
mell. Abstract and reference......... viii 52 
some practical features of a field time de- 
termination with a meridian transit. 


R.S. Woodward. Abstract............Wiil 55 
Lieutenant Lockwood’s expediticn to 

farthest north. G. E. Curtis. Ab- 

BUMECH povateet pst ost dhbsasveabe rereettecastrrek tere ix 8 


Geoidal 


140 


Page. 


Geography, List of papers on—Cont’d. 

on the changes of terrestrial level surfaces 
due to variations in distribution of 
superficial matter. R. S. Woodward. 
SELES EREVE Gas ddcdsabaveauciee cbsdsvasdessnreaurdcenad ix 

the physical- poaucaphieal divisions of the 
southeastern portion of the United 
States and their corresponding topo- 
graphical types. G. Thompson. <Ab- 


on the position and shape of the geoid as 
dependent on local masses. R. S. 


15 


22 


Woodward. Reference........ oseeee AX 53, 54 


the topography and geology of the Cross 
Timbers of Texas. R.T. Hill. Read 
by WJ McGee. Reference.........00 se 
the topography and structure in the Bays 
Mountains, Tennessee. B. Willis Ref- 


development of a perspective map from a 
contour map. B. Willis. Title only...x 
{exhibition of a new plane table.] W. D. 
Johnson. Wo abstract...........sc00 decezee x 
Mt. Rainier and its glaciers. B. Willis. 
WAIGRIAIIEL edt tdoccoeasecesanescnesesteheccneraseunens x 
What is a topographical pats M. Baker. 
PDEA ECD arsaseocsnvessvonevwartvcnseyvccecsessonaees x 


the Muir glacier, Alaska. J. W. Chicker- 
ines LU Lhe ONT Y axaccenotaacet <csleesuctocaanese x 
South Florida notes. W. H. Dall. Title 
DIU am dudounvioede sane sercvesestuapensen nearness tases x 
the progress of science as exemplified in 
the art of weighing and measuring. 
W. Harkness. Presidential address. In 


Wf UU yaccesecnapenucarsvedener=taidcaseseuetcases X xxxvii, 39 


the most probable value of the latitude and 
its theoretical weight from entangled 
observations occurring in the use of 
Taleott’s method. A. 8. Flint. <Ab- 
BUT OCU, cat acdedvecvevnedessscnpcxonadesccdearassavehans x 
deformation by local masses 


vii 92, 101, ix 15, 


Geology, List of papers on. (See also Seis- 
mology.) 

remarks on the structural geology of the 
valley of the Colorado of the West. J. 
We Powell? “AbsOra@ety ciccccss: <deccatsoocbses i 

on certain recent geological and geograph- 
ical researches in Arizona and Ne- 


vada. G. K. Gilbert. Abstract........... i 
on sand sculpture in the West. G. K. Gil- 
Wert LA Dairaer .k csereeecguasces wecoveaaweeasue i 


descriptions of new species of fossil plants 
from Alleghany County,Virginia; with 


~ 


upl 


53 


48 


54 


57 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 


Geology, List of papexs on—Cont'd. 


some remarks on the rock seen along 
the Chesapeake and Ohio railroad, 
near the White Sulphur Springs of 
Greenbrier County,West Virginia. F. 
B. Meek. In full 2 plates......... 
on the causes of the elevations and sub- 
sidences of the earth’s surface. C. E. 
Dutton. Title only.........00 saesduuueee “Paiey | 
on the glacial epoch in Utah and Nevada. 
G. K. Gilbert. Abstract........ waetey angeul 
on geological time. (. E. Dutton. Title 
ON ixeusssessaaied Scedee dicvadsdeusccvectsnesatieeteenae i 
on Mallet’s theory of the formation of 
the physical features of the earth. C. 
E. Dutton. Title only.....0000 asaspapaced i 
on the recent earthquakes in North Caro- 
lina. 
onacold geyser or intermittent artesian 
wellin Ohio. G.K.Gilbert. Abstract, 


162, td (26) 


74 


84 


89 


90 


B. Alvord. + Abstraet:.cccsssessesness i 101 


i 103 


on the geology of the lignite formation, 
and on a hitherto undescribed deposit 
discovered in 1834 in New York bay. 
L. D. Gale. 
on the age of the Tonto sand-tones. 
Gilbert. 
on the glacial period. C. E. Dutton. Title 
ONL ireedasecs ddvancenecsecney ds sia dveeusiaasocteonieeee Al 
[geological history of Lake Winnipeg.] G. 
K. Warren. Abstract...... PEEP ESOAcciccec ii 
[elevations and depressions in Alaska] 
W.H. Dall. Wo abstract....... veavaraegy ohh 
on the movements caused in large ice- 
fields by expansion and contraction, as 
illustrative of the formation of anti- 
clinal and synclinal axes in geological 
formations. M. C. Meigs. Jn full. 4 


G. K. 


Title onlty...isecesccesses anaes i 106 


Abstract and reference.........4 109 


26 


27 


27 


PUG UTES co coceen cons venvorgeuteceseuaeaeuseeeeemm ii 33, (22) 


on the Uintah Mountains. 

ithe Orlay ese secececunssscoeaeneees vetapaeoen Per! | 
the glacial theory. J. Henry. Abstract..ii 
the causes of glacial climate. Symposium. 


VAIDSENGCE: |..ucr'dnavsdacdscutenthessenseeeeeee seek 43, 


ripple-marks. G. K. Gilbert. Abstract...di 
some types of mountain building. J. W. 

Powell. . -Wutleorly tic dsssscecaes sntectetee ii 
landslips and lakelets. G.K. Gilbert. Ab- 


monoclinal ridges. J. W. Powell. 
BUNACE.. 5 sccevd ons scdscve'dsasnncnchensuepeeteeeieeaane ii 
the distribution of thermal springs in the 
United States. G. K. Gilbert. Title 
only... dadtccnohecnceesMlle:ss saguteeenuee ii 
(ecdlogistand versus piysielabll J.W. Pow- 
Olli, :. NO, CO8bT ACE .c.noccessasossssenenesseaeeetne ii 


35 


45 
61 


65 


69 


74 


80 


85 


a 


: INDEX TO VOLUMES 


Page. 
Geology, List of papers on—Cont’d. 

Lake Bonneville. G. K. Gilbert. Abstract 
ANA TEFETENCE...0.seeesereees repaceens Decent ii 103 

the structure of the Henry Mountains. G. 

K. Gilbert. Abstract and reference, 
41 112, 113 

chemical remarks on terrestrial geogony. 
T. Antisell. Title only...........i 132, 133, 134 

the Wasatch a growing mountain. G. K. 
Gilbert. ADSéract......cerecscasescoarscesesees 1i 195 

on some interesting cases of metamorph- 
ism. F.M. Endlich. Title only......ii 27 

the geological character of the Colorado 
river. C. E. Dutton. Title only......iif 28 

the succession of voleanie eruptions. C. 
E. Dutton. Title only...........0. 00000 ili 36, 37 

on the Permian formation of North Amer- 
ica. C. E. Dutton. Abstract......... Aid 65, 67 

the subject of the Permian formation in 

North America. C. A. White. Ab- 
SIT UN Ubewbuadussudec sdoveesesansvesdavesesceese eases iii 104 

on the oscillations of Lake Bonneville. G. 
KaGilbert. Title only: ....cc...sacssecceses iii 113 

the drainage system of the Black Hills. 
G. K. Gilbert. <Abstract............ desvessAdl 125 

quaternary deposits of western Iowa and 

eastern Nebraska. J. E. Todd. Ab- 


the Vermilion cliffs and the valley of the 
Virgen in southern Utah. C. E. Dut- 
OW otty LU TLO OME censosecescs -cstconsscacareecece iv 122 

the origin of the topographical features of 
lakeshores. G. K.Gilbert. Title only.iv 170 

the quaternary climate of the Great 


Basin. G.K. Gilbert. Reference...... Ve Pal 
on artesian wells on the Great Plains. C. 

AD WIC: RESET ENCE ccccccccsscscsccescevece v 101 
geology of the Hawaiian islands. C. E. 

Watton, « ADSEACicrrssserescsvssessccsccsesse vi 13 
_the geology of Hatteras and the neighbor- 

ing coast. W.C. Kerr. Abstract.....vi 28 


topographical indications of a fault near 
Harper’s Ferry. H. F. Wailing. Ab- 


MENACE st ascndaps scsess sevescasccusss isveuaests ostiee vi 30 
ore deposition by replacement. S.F. Em- 
mons. Abstract and reference........ Baw e S2 
glaciation in Alaska. W. H. Dall. Ab- 
BUNDC Umessatcsvasvce disses ractevcanecucevistocss faecus vi 33 
the volcanic problem, stated. C. E. Dut- 
ton. Abstract.........+ iaaienteieastoretetcens vi 87 


the drainage system and the distribution 
of the loess of eastern Iowa. W J 
McGee. Abstract......... ageaetadenewcveses avi 93 
the Cambrian system in the United States 
and Canada. C. D. Walcott. Abstract. 
1 figure... earebuuescsesevesttur acces RAL TS vi 98 


xX 


141 


Page. 


Geology, List of papers on—Cont’d. 

the existing glaciers of the High Sierra of 
California. I. C. Russell. Abstract and 
reference. 2 figures... Meaeacrenis seers WAR 
the mica mines of North Carolina. W. C. 
Bern. AOStract i, cessesse casscccceres eoseee Wh 
deposits of voleanic dust in the Great 
Basin. I. ©. Russell. Abstract...... vii 
the diversion of water courses by the rota- 
tion of the earth. G. K. Gilbert. Ab- 
stract and reference........+ caaecheeaneteecs vii 
the volcanic sand which fell at Unalashka 
October 20, 1883, and some eonsidera- 
tions concerning its composition. J. 

Se Dillons Albsinacicccscwatcassencsssersece vii 
the methods of modern petrography. G. 
H. Williams. Abstract........ pee acearn -vii 
What isa glacier? Symposium. Abstract, 
; vii 

the strata exposed in the east shaft of the 
water-works extension. T. Robinson. 
ADSErGCE...02. 00.000 Sued unssavashcnacurepennters vii 
plan for the subject bibliography of North 
American geologic literature. G. K. 
Gilbert. Title only.,.....00.0-.0cevses eee vii 
plan for the subject bibliography of North 
American geologic literature. J. W. 
Powell. Tvtle Only....csecrsocecssseee cooee Wii 

the volcanoes and lava fields of New Mex- 
ico. C.E. Dutton. Abséract........... vii 

a concrete problem in hydrostatics. G. K. 
Gilberts “AGSiract ....sc-cosssscssessesnesses vil 
discussion of a concrete problem in hydro- 
statics proposed by Mr. G. K. Gilbert. 


18 


21 


36 


69 


7 


7 


76 


92 


R.S. Woodward. Title only........00. vii 101 


practical geology versus speculative phys- 
ics. C. E. Dutton. 
geological and physical theories. W.B. 
Taylor. Abstract... Senaucenedsaent viii 
variations of latitude. A. Hall. Abstract 
ANd TefErence........s00000 Sceeccne seeseeceeeee WiLL 
the flora of the Laramie group. L. F. 
Ward. Reference....... pusaeuastcspae ccs Whi 
problems connected with the physics of 
the earth’s crust. H. M. Paul. Title 


Title only....... viii 4,5 


10 


17 


ON vosncesensccusen Sranacanoecnsosachasaanesen -viii 17, 18 


the crumpling of the earth’s crust. W. B. 
Taylor. Abstract and reference......viit 
the columnar structure in the diabase of 
Orange Mountain, N. J. J. P. Iddings. 
Abstract. 4 figures ....ccsscccccecocscssces viii 
the terraces of the Potomac valley. WJ 
McGee. Title only.......00ee00 coe sveeee Whi 
notes on the geology of northern Califor- 
nia. J.S. Diller. Abstract.............. ix 


18 


19 


142 


Page. 


Geology, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
notes on the faults of the Great Basin and 
of the eastern base of the Sierra Ne- 
vada. I. C. Russell. Abstract......... ix 
recent changes of level in the basin of 
Lake Ontario. G. K. Gilbert. Refer- 


on the changes of terrestrial level surfaces 
due to variations in distribution of 
superficial matter. R. S. Woodward. 
SEPRTON ONC G ss ocsanes aaseabananansyue-escateesanes ix 

on the observed changes of level surfaces 
in the Bonneville area, and their ex- 
planation. G. K. Gilbert. Title only, 

ix 

on the varying attitudes of former level 
surfaces in the Great Lake region and 
the applicability of proposed explana- 
tions. T. C. Chamberlin. 
the enlargement of mineral fragments as 
a factor in rock alteration. R. D. Irv- 
Ines Letle Only ys casticaseasvanecstetessteeands ix 
the subaerial decay of rocks and the ori- 
gin of the red clay of certain forma- 
tions. I. C. Russell. Title only........ ix 

on geological museums. G. P. Merrill. 
TICLE OU sc causazseossndunsceesternncceseadennee eX 
certain new and small mountain ranges. 
G. K. Gilbert. Title o7nly......<cs-ceseone ix 

on the occurrence of copper ore in the 
Trias of the Eastern United States. N. 

Hep DRetOns yp LULlalOvley -sosececassstedsecentes ix 
the latest voleanie eruption in northern 
California and its peculiar lava. J.S. 
Diller. Reference vectacs roscssscancvasse eanovd ix 

on the position and shape of the geoid as 
dependent on local masses. R. S. 


Woodward. Leference.......sce.ceseeres ix 53, 


the geologic age of the lowest formation of 
Emmons’ Taconic goin C. D. Wal- 
cott. Reference......i.... aeaeae ok 
the topography and eoiaes “of tile’ ‘Coeds 
Timbers of Texas. R. T. Hill. Read 
by WJ McGee. Reference...........0-++0+ x 
the topography and structure in the Bays 


Mountains, Tennessee. hk. Willis. 
TREE OTA ves Nevens Ga sedtevadeonstvesesoesueemeceesicee x 
Mt. Rainier and its glaciers. B. Willis. 
BADSENGELer svarsscvausewcwevecuspemtestesusdien castes x 
[Mt. Shasta, contrasted with Mt. Rainier.] 
J. S. Diller. NO Gbsinact::..cccbesseveccve x 
the Muir glacier, Alaska. J. W. Chicker- 
Une. Ditlesonly casececssterceisesecseeds ee 4 


the quaternary deposits and the great dis- 
placement of the Middle Atlantic 
siope. WJ McGee. Reference..........X 


5 


15 


15 


Title only..ix 15, 16 


36 


45 


54 


5 


15 


16 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 


Geology, List of papgrs on—Cont'd. 
South Florida notes. W. H. Dall. Title 
on the geographical. distribution of foss:! 
plants. L. F. Ward. Reference......... x 


28 


Geometrical probiems............Li4 55, 64, -v 88, 107, 
wi 157, wii 45 


Geometry, GYASS MAD 1" Siiccsceseaccsceleeseetene viii 
Germ culture... eeededéee vco'scaeces oven Meagan 


53 
30 


Gesture lan EE sansa saacnayeccenten ao seearee vi 63, 84 


Geyser, ACO] dstss.tecs.csss0tecseesdenpsee scence i 
Gilbert, G. K., cited on wind aed barometric 
Observation... .rscserssnsers wees sere 


verification of predictions..,..wii 122, x 94, 96 
communication on certain recent geolog- 


ical and geographical researches in 
Arizonaand Nevada. Abstract.. ....... i 
sand sculpture in the West. Abstract, 
i 

the glacial epoch in Utah and Nevada. 
ADSEr GE 05505 <opccesasnncaerecenenpenterese eee i 
the use of the cafions of the Colorado for 
weighing the earth. Title only..........4 

a cold geyser or intermittent artesian 
well in: Ohio. \Abstract...c.:eemenee i 
the age of the Tonto sandstones. 
stract and reference Sdekececeeag as 
ripple-marks. Abstract.......-....00 saeekes ii 
the horary oscillations of the tempera- 
ture of the atmosphere. Abstract....ii 
horary oscillations of the atmosphere. 
ALDSER ACE. ct scscontesstess i “couhbaessheeseteu see eaaane ii 
landslips and lakelets, Abainde wawietialies ii 
the distribution of thermal springs in 
the United States. Title only............ ii 
Lake Bonneville. Abstract and refer- 


the structure of the Henry Mountains. 
Abstract and reference....cecccc0e sees ii 112, 
a special method of barometric hyp- 
sometry.: Abstract......1.ccecnsccdsenes eee ii 
a proposed new leveling instrument. 
ADSUrGCE...cc.ccoasee oucides stwadcuceteces HAtaENE ii 
the recent history of Great Salt Lake. 
ADSEPACE ica: cvonenccnnyecencovectase eee nee ii 
the Wasatch a growing mountain. Ab- 
SEP ACE .0sccsnecdeccdicns casess dueecesnswadeerseneeanee ii 
the Kanab base-line, and a proposed 
new method of base measurement. 
ALBEE ACE. sacs ssnansssenveiisakase ere iii 
air currents on mountain slopes. Ab- 
BUTLCE coven snares sue deddesacveeseaseenauversaa tiie iii 
the oscillations of Lake Bonneville. 
TLC ONG). icscasstncozesscy aa ies ce cts aSeenee iil 
the drainage system of the Black Hills. 
AD BUT ACE, sn ccssishenansvanstusnnerte scean ciate Srey tt 


103 


109 


67 


34 


38 


113 


125 


P 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-xX. 


Page. 


Gilbert, G. K., communication on—Cont’d. 
the origin of the topographical features 


of lake shores. Title only ......0.s0+00 iv 
the quaternary climate of the Great 
AMBIT eT ePDeTENETICD <yocesednactsseccc «doce: ebook Vv 
barometric hypsometty. Reference......v 
errors of barometric observations pro- 
duced by wind. Reference.......s0 +++ Vv 
a graphic table for computation. Ab- 
SEPACT.....0000 pletssekansanucecsss era enusod sennensas Vv 


the response of terrestrial climate to 
secular variations in solar radiation. 
PADSETACE....0000: sdee ssevereccconsccacavorseecarsee vi 
graphic tables for computing altitudes 
from barometric data. Reference.....vi 
the diversion of water courses by the 
rotation of the earth. Abstract and 
TEPET ENCE. <.cccccatuccoccsseccsscees coven coecserse vii 
the subject bibliography of North Amer- 
ican geologic literature. Title only..vii 


the problem of the knight's tour. <Ab- 
Uae Uevernen eva senadssatesssds cre cnoesseeccssesnass vii 
a concrete problem in hydrostatics. Ab- 
SETACE.. 2.000 Rerredacees spurt re caeeca bot ep an Pee vii 
recent changes of level in the basin of 
Lake Ontario. Reference........ Chereeceee ix 


the observed changes of level surfaces 
in the Bonneville area, and their ex- 


planation. Title only........0+008 ace isseoo 
certain newand small mountain ranges. 
Title only... .e0e msuvsoanunsnasbes auaeceesy seereass ix 


graphic methodsinresearch, Abstract..x 
statistics of the Philosophical Society 


from its foundation. Abstract........... x 
remarks ON VOCADUIATIES........ccceeseceeseees ii 
fresh water shells in brackish water...ii 
THe PELTMian Of WAH <..c..cccccccasssesescesess iii 
artesian wells on the Plains...............0.- v 
drainage system of Iowa...... ric onceeppes vi 
GFISIN Of PUMICEs...2..cccccucsecescceee eoseeee WAl 
verification of predictions.. Vii 
terrestrial rigidity......... cppecce 


care of pamphlets 
geology of northern California pageants eevee X 
earthquake waves and sound wayes, 
ix 
Gilded thermometer bulbs............0s00+ pedeeo kx. 


Gill, T. N., communication on the character- 
istics snd zoological relations of man. 
ADSErGACE.....0....0000 ReAaeSe ron seated cateenneadaes i 

additions to the fish fauna of Massachu- 
setts, due to the researches of Prof. 8. 
F. Baird, U. S. Fish Commissioner. 
Reference........ nanetee saces Ree Pecrce een, eee i 
the tapir of the Andes and tis allied 
forms. Title onlt/........ssccccscccoere paneebanes i 


170 


21 
48 


91 


120 


10 


136 


24 


29 


39 


148 


Page. 


Gill, T. N., communication on—Cont’d. 
atunny new tothe American coast. Title 


OM iiderscersce Leavateductanstpeadueehatetensereeacencess i 47 
the homologies of the shoulder idle of 
fishes. References....... pasaisdacaasnedtne wens a 64 
tbe Scombrocottus baimisheus of Peters. 
Title only......00 peidcsaWaeoes sc crnaantarenaksdeiie 1 68 
the homologies of the arm in fishes, and 
the development of the humerus in 
ganoids. Title onli......00 000 Sate Poe Ma) 
the primates and their relations to man. 
Putte ONY oiceseecsecensek eden dentetserde athneresesky 90 
the structure and shape of Palzothe- 
PUM? WADSerachiacvn weevesscesvste tes cetereds i 99 
the geographical distribution of mam- 
mals. Abstract... iebekee sessed §=26 
the causes of the placial aes Ab- 
BET Povo cccccha tess deasbanvasetucrtsnesreasnen Reneeesd ii 47 
the progress of the natural sciences dur- 
ing the past century. Jeference....... ii 56 
the relations and sequences of the family 
Centrarchoides. Title only.......+..00 ii 113 
the morphology of the antlers of the 
Cervides. Abstract and reference...... ii 135 
anew species of Chimeera found in Amer- 
ican waters. ADStract..........sc0-cecerees di 182 
the family of Ceratiids. Title only......ii 202 
the Prodromus methodi mammalium of 
ESHOUM. ePID Ul seni-savediaceeccustatesteontee ii 15, (3) 
some remarkable instan ces of ingestion 
among fishes. Abdstract..........cssses0 ili 116 
principles of morphology. Refcrence.iv 123 
the classification of the insectivorous 
mamnmals. In full.....cs00+ Saksadsaestto wv 118 
analogues in zoo-geography. Title only, 
wi 41 
ichthyological results of the voyage of 
the Albatross. Title only........ Sidsacene vi 48 
remarks on the decrease of fish on the 
southern coast of New England......... i 52 
vocabularies......... eciusiddeaVitewecddassacacsete ii 28 
Peruvian fishes.........-...ce00 
geological climates............ 
Calendars) iciccesesseceven bhene barns 
Dakota calendar.......... Sec ctharaeacebeeeeurneete 
marine fishes in fresh waters...........6 ii 181 
resemblances in biolOgy..........ssesesseeess ii 187 
an occurrence of the tarpa........cseceeee ii 202 
ravages by teredo.......-..0...s00 
VitAliforGesiscuscszesssepeetensss 
Glacial epoch, Cause of.......... 
in Utah and Nevada............ssceeee Sevscaneuphe OF 
Glaciation in Alaska.............ssssee00 PevenpiveosiWAky 1 
Glacier tables acaseseesn Sidddecsvecevroncere 7 
37 
15 


144 


Glaciers of the High Sierra....... Thre we Wht 5 
Mb. Rainier. ..cccccccccscoceee. basdevenseuanuisiadiauame LO 
Glaisher, cited on barometric gradient........2 107 
Gley, E., cited on the pulse.......sseseeeeeeeeW 78 
Goethe, cited on apptied science.............Wil 12 
Gold and silver and the prices of commodi- 
ANA SILVET COINAZE.....-seceereeeeereeees 
Gold-silver ratiO.........c00sccccesees didcwdcpeseppacomWy LOL 
Goode, G. B., Bibliography of S. F. Baird 
TW enusareeuteseesraen Sudupbeacsvoee sands cts Recauseaveuee x 62 
communication on the swordfish and its 
allies. Reference........000+-ccccrrereseeerekW 162 
the fisheries of the world. Reference...v 117 
fisheries exhibitions. Reference........vil 26 
the systematic care of pamphlets. Ab- 
stract ANd TEFETENCE.....000--s-00-seeeeeeeWhik 29 
the distribution of fishes in the oceanic 
abysses and middle strata. Title only, 


museum specimens illustrating biology. 
Title Only ......-0000 sachs reasndastessernsessseeeese TOO 
the geographical distribution of scien- 
tific men and institutions in the United 
States. Reference..... aiverateend&eey 0 
Goodfellow, E., remarks commemorative of 
Benjamin Peirce............-sseses seedueaevW e720 
Gould, RB. A., letters on Cordoba Observatory. 
Communicated by J. H. C. Coffin and J. 
J. Woodward. Wo abstract...... pease eens i O7 
letter on Cordoba Observatory. Commu- 
nicated by J. J. Woodward. No ab- 
SEPACE .ccceccece sosanene Redspeseusemneters sedans eeseues a 88 
communication on scientific culture in 
the Argentine Republic. Wo abstract.....ii 15 
the coinage of the Argentine Republic. 
Read by E. B. Elliott. Abstract........dd 65 
Governmental endowment of research... viii xli 


Graham, LAW Of,....0..c-esccsecsceesccvccees 
Graphic methods in research 
table for computation....... ssscesseeseeW 120, WA 136 
Grasshoppers, Shower Of.........sssecessseseeeeenes ii 87 
Grassmann’s system of geometry.......00..Wiil 53 
Giraivat tlOMsssccceucscseckevecsseoessescvacapsasnesaca WRIts(47. 
Fallacy CONCErNING....seerseeeeree secnsassse a OD. 
Modification of formula Of...........0.-s00 viii 39 
Gray, Asa, cited on the Glaseification of 
Plants......ceceveves ASitteeeecceer iv 108, 109, 110 


communication on plants common to 


Japan and eastern America, <Ab- 
SEPACE ...20000 aiannnainauseden cusses syedusabe=hneeeaes fi 42 

Gray, Elisha, communication on a telaphon. 
ADSErACE....00-e00e Shree cae nee edustosgsaa sel MAM: 
Gray, L. C., cited on brain temperatures....v 76 
Great Basin, Faults of............ Be a cesadndee haves ix 5 
Later geology Of.......0.++ Sesrartayasnnsnes seen eTe 


ix 22 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
Great Basin, Quaternary climate of............W 21 
ranges, Bibliography Of...scsmseeeecereAX 6 
Volcanic Cust im.....0c0cesesescescsesse 
Great Salt Lake, Fluctuations of.........41 187, 188 
Great Spirit, The, a mistake........... sacvsceuneeth LED 
Grecian atomic philosophy............+-sess.Wil XXix 
Greely, A. W., cited on bibliography of me- 
COOTOLOSY vsccseneasnccvaddessauns sosunhsapuswansasteeieanaee 
Green, H.J., cited on thermometry..........d% 25 
Greene, B. F., communication on the Navy 
compass. Title Ony.......00+00 asecsacsusept L2O 
an adjustable binnacle for the correction 
of aship’s compass. Title only.........A4 134 
Greene, F. V., communication on the devia- 
tions of the plumb-line as determined 
in the survey of the 49th parallel of 
latitude. Abstract and reference........44 82 


Gregorian calendar, A........ PETEERE cosnacsonsisnnanse i 75 

Proposed reformation Of.........-ceecceeeeeedl 29 
Growth of stones and organisMS.........00...W 67 
Grunmacn, Dr., cited on thermometry..ix 30, 32 
Gudermann’s notation..........:.ceeeeene soceseee WA 103 
Gulf of Mexico, Model Of..........+++. Pe aneeeceee iv 52 
Gulf stream, Channel Of...........+« ie nessun aeons aren 


Gunnell, F. M., communication on yellow 
fever disinfection. Abstract............d4f 51 
Guthrie, Prof. F., cited on attraction.........w 150 

Guyot, Arnold, cited on the Appalachians, 
iv 61 

distribution of mountains and plains, 
viii 19 


Habits of fur-bearing SCal8......ssceccrcerecerereee 91 
Hahn, O., cited on fossils in aerolites ....... “Vv 66 
Hall, Asaph, communication on the elements 


of the Comet I, 1871. Read by B. F. 
Sands. Abstract ..........0000- Sanenb soc enpaseat manne 
astronomical photography. Abstract and 
MEPETENCE s-nsscesescs, ncaeessnnson scasnie'suusateteene i 26 
acurve of the fourth degree. Abies 
and reference........ ovesdeseuueae 5 aaaale ces eeieae i 30 


the astronomical proof of the existence 
of aresisting mediuminspace. Refer- 


OMNCCiocccecncsecesescoscsisoicansavanexhassuaduslcensinaetenntnas 
an historical note on the method of least 
squares. Reference... osvabvencagen shag eR 


the experimental determination of the 
ratio of the circumference to the 
diameter, based on the principles of 
the calculus of probabilities. Title 
OU <n snovvavussoacoponasanasnens ancennssserentassseaeen mt 

the rectilinear motion of a particle 
toward an attracting centre. Refer- 
ENCE... severe dhaishes cece Reeeate wxelceaue osuipacansn ss eee 

comets and meteors. Reference............ i 94 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-xX. 


Page. 
Hall, Asaph, communication on—Cont’d. 
the method adopted in writing the in- 
ternational scientific telegrams, Ab- 
BUTCCE scvcandsvcenesscncure peebad aaaacdvonsswans serra i 101 
the operations of the several parties sent 
from the United States to observe the 
transit of Venus on the 8th of Decem- 


Gry USTAS -ADStract..ovcccccceseteses scuase 4i 31, 32 
approximate quadratures. Abstract, 
ii 48 
the appearance of Saturn’s rings. Ab- 
StTACT «2.200 CUnSE Ene eO-EeD Conc ebenspes maces ii 94 


a bright spot which has recently become 
visible on the ball of Saturn. Ab- 


the position of the centre of gravity of 
the apparent disk of a planet. Refer- 


IRE Baek ces ce caskecasdeties Biaeeamtsyescscscrnsnsscshs li 181 
the results of a search for satellites of 
Mars. Abstract and reference..........+ ii 186 


the supposed discovery of a trans-Nep- 
tunian planet at the U. S. Naval Ob- 


servatory in 1850. Abstract............ iii 20 
the satellites of Saturn. Abstract....... did 26 
the orbits of ‘Titan and Hyperion. Ab- 

BUNA iaec-ayeeet teecte cuss datovesceccrscuscecceus .- did 40 
inaugural address as chairman of the 

Mathematical Section. Jn full........ vi 117 


the determination of the mass of a 
planet from observation of two satel- 
Lites. ADSEraCL...:c..c0c0ce0n0s Saancceedne oe WA 132 

the formule for computing the position 
of asatellite. In full. 1 figure......vwid 93 

American scientific societies. Presiden- 
tial address. In full...........0 viil xxxili, 30 

variations of latitude. Abstract and ref- 
ETENCE....00r0000e wepssenessenen pap emaest iahuseaeons viii 10 

the new star in the nebula of Andro- 
MNGWAs” ESELONCE cea. cacessecvccessseasceseons ix 14 

the images of stars. Reference............ ix 15 

a problem in probabilites. Read by G. 
EAT be) NO AD SEN ACE, <issccs seveaceos ssbiuss x 88 

the parallax of a Tauri. Abstract....... .x 91 


Euler’s theorem (generally called Lam- 
bert’s). Abstract.............. ecksnneshGaicies x 101 
Longitude of Plover Bay by.......... iv 124, 126 
remarks on planetary motions...ii 188, 189, 192 
transit of Mercury............. Stes sacee seaetenks ii 199 
criteria for the rejection of observa- 
GROFIT S seteet aes Sis cruncel conus tecceesascaeiet scores wi 155 
Grassmann’s geometry... 
time determinations...............68 Eenite 
Hall, G. S,, communication on mene expe- 
riments on reaction time and the time 
BOUSGs8 eM VOLC IOV acsccccvtoceanadscdesenens viii 4 
Haller, A. von, cited on nerve currents.....v 61 


56 


145 


Page. 
Hallowell, Benjamin, letter on the meteor 
of December 24, 1873. Communicated 


by J. Henry. No abstract......10.seceseees 4 95 
Halo, A remarkable solar.........ccscccssssecsesees v 112 
Hamilton, Sir W., cited on ultimate causes, 

v 163, 166 


Harkness, William, communication on the 
physical constitution of the corona of 


GHG! SUM MTPEfENENCE.ct 22.0) savarsdccubecescctde i 31 
the spectrum of Encke’s comet. Refer- 
ONCE canoaicateubsnpenterancusenees paepelist a acsens baat i 34 


the spectrum of Encke’s comet, and the 
appearance of Tuttle’s comet. Refer- 
OMCO ss ciecatnseucsentacennsans weadenbienveeaansewentey i 34 

the density of the hypothetical resisting 
medium in space. Title and refer- 


OME GretNastness want aboe tiees.sensovounseccoccsauaussnvesces i 39 
some measurements of heights by a 
pocket aneroid. Title onlt/...cecceseseeee. i 64 


the power necessary to drive the pendu- 
lum of an astronomical clock. Title 
ONY se.neeee Roesacen Atvetncete tara STEPS Se tet eseeteseuene i 74 

the distribution of temperature over the 
surface of the globe. Reference.........4 96 

the apparatus to be used in the observa- 
tions of the approaching transit of 


Venues, TRIE ON Ys... cseveatt vecccvesesetros i 102 
the transit of Venus in 1874. Communi- 
cated by A. Hall. Abstract.......cccccooe ii 32 


the methods of measuring the inequali- 
ties of the pivcts of the transit instru- 


MENG, CLELE OIG. ws ccnssnsonscnsacuccdavecsets li 68 
the voyage of the U.S. S. Swatara. Wo 

CLOSET GCE, <cstuecuassccnnnescasacetsssss-cueup senses 41 68, 69 
the velocity of light and determination 

of the solar parallax. Title only........ ii 201 
the color corrections of achromatic ob- 

jectives. ADStract.........ccc0csevencess iii 39 


the number of lenses required in an 

. achromatic objective, consisting of in- 
finitely thin lenses in contact, in order 
that, with any given law of dispersion 
whatever, the greatest possible num- 
ber of light-rays of different degrees 
of refrangibility may be brought to a 
common focus. Jn full......... acbaeeict iii 65 

the solar corona. Abstract.......s0......4id 116 

the relative accuracy of different meth- 
ods of determining the solar parallax. 
REFERENCE cnvencecves caoasteehasic>hasaésnudespantine v 39 

the monochromatic aberration of the 


human eye in aphakia. Reference, 
wi 5 

flexures of transit instruments. Ab- 
BUUTCheccccatsespsnesshasbecuntenanen wceeveusessss WOE / 27 


146 


Page. 
Harkness, William, communication on—Cont’d. 


the progress of science as exemplified 
in the art of weighing and measuring. 


Presidential address. In full....x xxxvii, 39 


a device for viewing the sun by light of 
any desired wave length. Abstract...x 
the representation of comet orbits by 
MOdelS. Reference... sececereescseeee “ete < 
the constant P in observations of terres- 
trial MagnetiSM......cecceeeers 


13 


28 


ee se secene scenes x 102 


remarks on the black drop.........+ csebabseva ii 199 


results from photographs of the transit 
of Venus..... 


vital force........ SadRuuEvadsssussoheavsaceseh=s seevaee v 105 


temperature observations........ Seceeseevas Wk 
NYZrOMEtry.....e.eeeee cneevee Rech byauvenssranEnd vi 


ZIAcCie?S ...... 0000 
vision......... PEOPLE 
problem in probabilities......... 
Harper’s Ferry, Fault near ......s..ssereeeree avi 


serene cescs eee 


26 
36 


30 


Hart, A. S., cited on Malfatti’s problem..ia 117, 119 


Harting, cited on mineral aggregates...... ili 
Hartley, J., Solution of a geometrical prob- 

LGYI2) OY sirasccancowasdcnanenevasccaass SakaeEs a veouseREh 
Hatteras, Geology of Cape...... NonsuetereessersceN& 
Hausen, C. A., cited on nerve currents...... v 


64 
28 


Hauy, Cited on MineralOgy....ccescerneeeeeeeeed 77, 78 


Havana magnetic disturbance and north- 


Hawaiian geology ...ccccccrseceerseeee paceneunens Pee | 
Hayden, Everett, communication on the 
Charleston earthquake. Abstract. 
AVIOD scasunssseuessues Sitbvsonescaurncsascunvancarennyra ks 
Hayden, F. V.,cited on base-line methods..4it 
Hazen, H. A., communication on the retarda- 
tion of storm centres at elevated sta- 
tions and high wind as a probable 


38 
34 


cause. In full .......0 ecuaaneemeneuterssene v 108 


the coming winter of 188283. Ab- 


SUPUCE, «cteanansounanese Aton Gnokiceesebscguyeseee v 122 


hygrometric observations. Abstract...vi 
thermometer exposure. Abstract......vi 
thesun glows. Abstract and reference..wil 
thermometer exposure. Abstract.....wil 
thunderstorms of 1884. Abstract......wili 
the condensing hygrometer and sling 
psychrometer. <Abstract....... seveeeee WALL 
effects of solar radiation upon thermom- 
eter bulbs having different metallic 
LOVETINGS. ADSEACE ...cceerereeesererererve dX 
the sky glows of 1883. Title only..........X 
felation between wind velocity and 
PTOSSUTE. REference....se.seccemeseressceeeeeK 
remarks on deflection of rivers............Wii 


36 


10 
24 


Heats, Molecular.....sceccccceeee 
Hell Gate explosion......se.seeseceeere sesceeees WALL 28 
Hellmann, Dr. G., bibliographic work in 


Helmert cited on alignment curves.... 
Henry, Joseph, Address on the life and char- 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
Hazen, H. A., remarkg on—Cont’d. 

. Weather prediction........cccccssrsseeeees Wid 9 
Care Of pamphlets.........ccccccssrcsseeee WHEL 29 
REVOPUMICH i cractcccscscsecsseses Soccosscacisacsasheaseemer mes 
WING! “VANIORScrrtaeecccccsesse cadeeradeee 
the sparrow question ........... actoeeaee otek eG 

Hazen, W. B., bibliography of meteorology 
x 21 
Death of....... aaptapantreaeaeen scesaceetonnaee Gescsrecuraaea ae 
Heatiof (Ne Stn icc... ..ccccssscsercanesssbenasentansenneene i 31 
THeOry Ofiicscesepusctessesseee cree seaneaxaaacan; Se 


sucodes succeat neh uasenen aba 
MCtCOTOlOZY....ssccerseeeesere serene 20, 21, 23, 25 
wi 124, 126 


CECT Ol scscesscesscrecass svcseesececeeeed 203, 368, 370 
cited on a telephonic experiment...........44 104 


adhesion and cohesion......... dcccceveteanpans Lou 
land and S€a DIe@ZeS.....csccereceeseseceecees wv 29 
sound anomalies....... 11 58, iv 135, wv 33, 40, 43 
the Philosophical Society................ Pesce Sth 
Washington as a scientific center......... = 47. 


communication on phenomena of sound 
and primes with arg forks. 
Title only... oto eseescenen tocenpeegaaiee 
observations maiaaele ona jouer to Cali- 
fornia. Title OnMzy....cncccvscnvessere Ses seaman i 31 
the organization and objects of the So- 
ciety. Presidential address. In full, 


iv, 34 


the life and scientific labors of the late 
Alexander Dallas Bache. Reference...4 35 

the expenditure of the income of the 
Bache fund for 1872. . Title only.........4 

the fluctuations of the river Nile. Title 


the condition of the Society. Vo ab- 
stract... 
sound in volanan to foe eipalae ‘teeta in- 
vestigations under the direction of the 
U.S. Light House Board. Jn full......1 65, 
ii (45) 
atmospheric electricity. Title only....4 75, 87 
experiments on fog signals during the 
past summer. 
a method of developing magnetism in 
barsof steel. Title only.......... acoseesiauk! (OM 
meteor trains, and the upper atmos- 
pheric currents, ttle only.........004 98 
Giffard’s injector. 
AUCition. Title only....cccccccecscosecrcesre Ad 22 
the glacial theory. Abséract...............4 35 
fog signals and abnormal conditions of 
SOUNA. Referencé...ercrccccsrscssrerecsrccsrordh 37 


53 
ONLY ...0000+ Seeoceense cocescewes sas cveessbeeueacaeueeaet i 63 
64 


Title Only.c....cccceeees eevee 90 


Title Onl y......0crccveeeed 99 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-xX. 


Page. 
Henry, Joseph, communication on—Cont’d. 
electricity engendered by the driving 
belt of the machinery for ventilating 
the Capitol at Washington. Abstract.ii 40 
sound in connection with fog signals. 
PAP ERELLE Ota wanescudseadassctneaashineodsxes saaxcsnsn ii 57 
Deal-VIsions | DUtle ONUY.....-csse<sasevencessaes: ii 60 
researches on sound in its application 
to fog signals. Presidential address. 


TROP ONC COs winccecsecteszsecs Sra cetanvaeanseoes cane ae ii 60 
illuminating materials. Title only......41 71 
Crookes’ radiometers. Abstract..........41 80 
[fog signals.] Abstract......... Weesttesveacccckly, (80 
paper made of asbestos. Title only......ii 86 


scientific method and its application to 
acoustic researches in connection with 
fog signals. Presidential address. In 


MUMS esdenstadercssesesa acct 


WALCTSPOULS......ccccsececccceee 
Resolutions on the death Of......0s.seeeee li 196 
Henry, Mrs. Joseph, Death of... vw 97 
PEPETME Vp NOUGAT Sievzevcsdnescosstdecccccvepccscscaassss ii 113 
Heraclitus, cited on philosophy...... .. Wii xxxi 
Herapath, J., cited on elasticity........ feececeree v 130 
Hering’s theory Of Col0r.......s0sssecssvescccenees iv 54 
Hermann, cited on muscular contraction 
v 58, 59 
nerve currents............. arcercerpeecreaercercen 6 Lo! 
Hermaphrodite, Alleged..........scessseeeeee deconaehn OH 
Herschel, Sir John, cited on cohesion........ v 129 
NONCOitcsarassvevacasdeatases aNukepasecsesetussaces v 151, 153 
MANY Scaaseeses ances Seccects suasacxeadsesacecusaauccsonancsec v 169 
RUNMGALC Mit Oa cusdeddectivercercteoeccescceseassW LLG 
satellites of Uranus...............+4 
temperature of space.... 
TIOOLY OL GLLOMS<, casas saccsucarsxereesesse wi 138, 140 
Herschel, Sir William, cited on relation of 
DSTO HPAL csavcsesersctesssecsvdesdssescaccaseen'™ LOS 
Satellites Of UTanus.........0scececcssssereseeese-d (30) 
PUMP tenceraaseecarsestuscasvebvagsedbvcresratcssvaenc ii 102 
Saturn’s ringS........0. Srosoeoocncen ppccanecereo wi 43 
BEISH-heeled SHOCS....ccscccersssesonscccpecseseosseeccW LIT 
High power definition.................. Ssantivenansaee i 47 
PRIN SIGrraSlACICLS 00... cccveccccdsbesecutercoocas wii 5 


Hilgard, J. E., cited on earthquake tides...w 144 
communication on the distange trav- 
ersed by approaching the North Pole 

on aloxodromic curve. Title only.....i 21 


achronograph. Wo abstract.............00+ i 22° 
the geographical centre of the United 
BGSteR a CA OBETECE.cacscesscncotseasverere Crete 124 


147 


Page. 
Hilgard, J. E., communication on—Cont’d. 
achronoscope. Wo abstract......ccccccseeees #223 
the distribution of the population in the 
United States. Title only ..........0006 0 i 29 
an exponential formula having reference 
to the tolerance allowed at the U.S. 
WINGS TULLE Oa. newecevestonscedsocscessecver>s i. 31 
the westward movement of the popula- 
tion of the United States. Reference.i 3 
the aurora of February 4th. Abstract...i 47 


Hindoo arithmetic. Title only.............- i 53 
the recording systems of the trans-At- 
lantic cables. Title only......s.cccseesseeees bbs 
the Goldschmidt aneroid barometer. Vo 
GDSENGCE.......000000 Selaaivancauavaeaceneneeneretncnces i 65 
the proceedings of the International 
Metrological Commission. Title 
ONLY....000 Mianeaaadanneae Octo oertenseosaenenabc receieros 
an inquiry into the law of probability. 
DULG, ORG Sreacvcsstteeyvacsscessoeseseensadteyataen’ i 34 
the air thermometer of Prof. Jolly. Title 
OTe cnvaacmuseunenecarsenace van suscsesa oecasearareenenee i 89 


the recent determination of the longi- 
tude between Paris and Greenwich. 
Title only .......00.0 Ssecataceacenrsceesanessnaucases i 89 
recent experimental researches in 
acoustics, by Prof. A.M. Mayer. Title 
OM far ssuseen eertdewccsesasesl witesccsicctnewminatceete i 90 
the determination of the personal errors 
in the observation of astronomical 
transits. Title only....... eiabbsserssanceuae sek 92 
f& new apparatus for the investigation of 
personal error in astronomical transit 


Observations. Title o7ly......ssseceeseeees i 106 
a proposed reformation of the Gregorian 
Calendar.) ADStract:.:....ssstscnecscadesce ii 29, 30 


the proceedings of the International 
Metrical Commission. Title only.....di 41 

iron facing copper plates. Abstract....ii 42 

the measurement of a base-line for the 
primary triangulation of the United 
States Coast Survey near Atlanta, 


Georgia. Abstract and reference........ di 50 
standard scales, or measures of length. 

Abstract....... dazaabeencyenactscedeseteene ee neers ii 136 
an optical salinometer. Abstract......... ii 185 
Jablokoff’s electric candle. Title 

ONLY... 00000 ateecne meadadicnaevescetherreuatecsatenG iii 19 


phosphorescent clocks. <Abstract......i4i 33 
remarks commemorative of Jonathan 


Homer Lane.) Ft! fublcccic. .ccccsscncsctes iil 122 
a model of the basin of the Gulf of Mex- 
1COs ~ADSPRACE :ctcctsecnersee seveucee eareeeny wiv 52 


Siemens’ deep sea thermometer and 
Carré’s ice machine. Title only,........ v 100 
FEMALES ON DULOLAS....0c0.ceevsescesccesen eee wel 46, 48 


148 


Page. 
Hilgard, J. E., remarks on—Cont'd. 
persistent observation of phenomena..ii 19 


vocabularies ........eces Gaccsne is eopsanounseh Medea fi 28 
calendar reform........++++ 30 
photographs of the sun... 33 
cause of glacial climate...........sseeseeere Ai 36 
a new meteorological instrument........ ii 64 
Dakota Calendar.......-ccccorcsvesecccccnsccceeces fi 92 
Peirce’s Linear Associative Algebra...iv 24 
unification of longitudes and time...... vi 109 


Hilgard, Theodore, communication on the 
number of the cephalic vertebre. 
Reference... ..csaeeaseecesenersseenes cccsee sncesoes i 26 

Hill, G. W., communication on certain pos- 
sible abbreviations in the computation 
of the long-period perturbations of 
the moon’s motion due to the direct 
action of the planets. Abstract and 


TOPEP ENCE. ...ceecee weecceenersnncrenscessoncnnones vi 136 
a formula for the ler zth of a seconds- 
pendulum. Reference........ oases -vii 101 


a problem in probabilities. Abstract..x 88 
the motion of Hyperion. Abstract and 
TEPOTONGCE::.ccsssvsenuastuenessssserssnndnendessgpesseX OU) 
the tuiceren on of differential Ee aotlons 
admitting periodic integrals. Abstract 
ANA TEFSETENCE.....rccerrerecescrsesserscsceseseecees x 100 
remarks on infinitesimals.......0..-.e0seeee wi 135 
gravitation formula.....ccsecceeerereee WHEL 40 
adjustment of conditioned observations, 


vili 41 

GTASSMANN’S FCOMELTYsse-eeceserrereeeeee ewili 53 
density Of MerCury........cccseceseecere .Whih 45 
problem in probabilities...........s00 Saree x 89 
electric currents........ ieeras rece sas scarenaree Oe 
Hill, M., cited on visible speech.......00 vi 78, 80 


Hill, R.T., communication on the topography 
and geology of the Cross Timbers of 
Texas. Read by WJ McGee. Reference, 


x, 6 
Hillhouse, Dr. William, cited on trisection of 
AVGICS...scassesnecvstsescvhvessccccesesnsen eeerer| x 99 
Hind, cited on supposed trans-Neptunian 
planet......... Ridenesanuaend Bus Acsibsuanedsbeceeie iii 20 
Historical note on binocular microscopes, 
iv 35 
on the method of least squares.........:....4 62 
History of a geometrical problem............d44 64 
Malfatti’s problem..........-sceeees Meas rovcr ii 113 


Hitchcock, Romyn, communication on re- 
cent improvements in microscopic ob- 
jectives, with demonstration of the 
resolying power of a new 1-16th inch. 
TWGLG (OY sinunnvasconneesnene=ssarsencevesesesnuses ix 16 

Hoffman, Dr. A. W., cited on ultimate 
CAUSES. «02506 «ev 166 


se seweceseereees aeeeee Oeeereneccoes 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
Hoffman, W. J., cited ®n the poisoning of 
BYTOWS sacapmacceebaven gapbebsaspen das saeane pvany ii 182 


communication on the use of poisoned 
arrows by North American Indians. 
TU16; ONY. n0sse osu 1 nenhl keananen i eareneaeee eee ti 183 
Holden, E.S., communication on the adopted 
value of the sun’s apparent diameter. 
Tits fal cic wsioxaseevcesceutoehe sjeapes asa easeCeeanne 195, (3) 
Sir William Herschel’s observations of 
the satellites of Uranus. Jn full... 106, (30) 
the number of words used in speaking 
and writing. In full....... soncnseees ii 28, (16) 
two drawings of nebulee, made with the 
xxvi-inch telescope of the U.S. Naval 
Observatory, by Mr. L. Trouvelot, of 
Cambridge, Mass. Abstract..........000 ii 51 
search for Vulean. Abstract... .. Sontenans ii 85 
reference catalogues of astronomical 
papers and memoirs. Abstract...... wld 695 
the shadow of the ball of Saturn pro- 
jected on the rings. Abstract....... «Ad 101 
the brightness and the stellar magni- 
tude of the third Saturnian satellite, 
Tethys. Read by A. NV. Skinner. Title 
ON nercenvaseses ee anaeene cohsupaannse Beteeeano ii 18 
B. A. Gould’s Uranometria Argentina. 
FRCference.. scassecncasasssacarssu session iii 119, 122 
Holmes, W. H., remarks on glaciers....... wii 8 
Homologies of the shoulder girdle of fishes. 64 


Homophenes... wensse seocuedsens snovessseenesepeiiin aie annem 
Hooker, Ther pmeenal phservdideas by..w 94 
Hooker, R., cited on natural law.. «Vv 173 
Hoosac tunnel, Acoustic features ahs <gaace econ 172: 
Hopkins, cited on the liquidity of the earth’s 
TNGOTION so-nseconssnngse o anpanvaceudaataentees li 76, 73 
temperature Of SPAaCe.......cessee soccssdensent@l | fee 


Hough, F. B., communication on the culti- 
vation of Eucalyptus on the Roman 


Campagna. Reference Reena Wale 
Death of........ enaeneareeenG Ssogeneetpuaispennae see Wild 25 
House of Representatives, Ventilation of, 
vi 9% 
Howland, Dr. E. P., remarks on Charleston 
earthquake....... Serer cass oaceanbsnageeeatne ix 42 
Hubbard, G. G., remarks on visible speech, 
wi 82 
Hughes’ Microphone...........csseceee covveees sued 184 
Humboldt, Baron von, cited on transmission 
Of SOUNG,.. 0.0 ccsesoceessussessesansseeeeuee wenden v 41 
Humidity observations......... Se rtece secre Wh 36 
Humphreys, A. A., Eulogy on...... ee poo: Vii 4 
DG AGW Of: i ssncncancccicevenspiudsounenas etasales ee vii 3, 4 


Humphreys and Abbot, cited on the delta 

of the Mississippi.....2......+..M (10), (12), (13) 
Huron, Altitude of Lake.......... ivabeene akseneonspthy) soo 
Huxley, T. H., cited on vital principle.....w 78 


INDEX “4TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 
Hydrometer employed to determine Specific 


Hygrometric observations........... Saseasncneaes vi 36 
Hymers, J., cited on Malfatti’s problem.....ii 118 
Hyperion, Orbit of.................lii 26, 40, x 90, 104 
Hypothesis, Use of............065 -eeeeedl 164, Vi x xxiii 


Hypsometry, Barometric... 
New method Of.....cs00-.eeeee caseb 


Ice fields, Anticlinal and synclinal axes 
lava saccasserenesasss=< Gvess\oetbancan BEaccuanevanne Ai (22) 
SON AITINCS crs tract ipcnaranccucswhcsscesscecssse'caeassene vii 6 
Iddings, J. P., communication on the col- 
umnar structure in the diabase of 
Orange Mountain, N. J. Abstract. 4 


BITUMEN as cc uusioncavestanspesuaascvawesssaae cocsee Wadd 19 
AIRS EDTA OL sci ecaces sssevsscecsscasccescescasscoue iv 99 
PUTET SC VAD OOYALNIAL.. <cccrsc-nsavesscascances cose i 68 
Illumination of objects for examination with 

certain immersion objectives.......... ii 126 
Images Of stars........0--scsees RN unurentaaaraton sp Na=aPy ix 15 


Impressions on polished glass.....cssce seeesee ii 39 
Indexing scientific literature.......... cncett sae x 38 
Indian explanation of gravitation......... wi xxxi 
Indians as observers of nature......... Aree vil 73 
Errors respecting... ....... Seema senceuetresnseasves ii 175 
(See also Anthropology.) 
Inductive reasonin-......... Gakatineses ca-epetastese vii lii 
Inertia 48 
Infinite and infinitesimal quantities.........wi 133 
PURULACTION Se racetccs acvenss<es a senecacensenses 1119, wili 58 
Ingestion/among fishes.............csssseesescseees iii 116 
Initial meridian, Proposed.............0sseecssess wi 106 
Inoculation of diphtheria..............csssecceees iv 38 
BAL OUP MATMOSGUTOCS., ccscsenesaseosscsncscccsn ess wi 6 
Insecticides........... peeeeeean ean Ucawesassnctaascescars vii 10 
Insectivorous MAMMA s.......cccceesssesssseceeses v 118s 
Institutions, Evolution oOf............ ..cccsces vi xlviii 
Integrals, HMiptic. ..-...c.s:scesesacesseee wii 102, ix 54 


Integration of differential equations admit- 


Intermarriage of the deaf..........cccseesseceeees vi 83 
International coinage........ ak 
convention of teachers of the deaf and 
PUVOUUD turseccnssersacnvece=s orcad mesennetusy ey asaaen iv 55 
Geodetic Association on standard time..vi 106 
scientific telegraMs.........e.cceecse socseess dress i 101 
symbols for archeologie charts............... ii 72 
PATBOP VAIS WLUISECAIL, Ve ocosep sceucustscuccuelevsacieasees ii 199 


Investigation, Methods Of...............ss000-----Ad 163 
Iowa, Loess and drainage system of........wi 93 
OVP USNITE DV Oli decaccnagneactevaaakesapiesisexsvaare cus iv 120 

Irby, J. R. M., communication on the erys- 
t talline state of matter. Abstract.....iii 39 


149 


Page. 
Irving, R. D., communication on the en- 
largement of mineral fragments as a 
factor in rock alteration. Title only.ix 16 


ESD Bra Man cestnedesnaeseasaivesves « 

Isoseismal map.............000 

Ivory, James, cited on action at no dis- 
GEUNCOt pucwanteunanenechanasusecustss is sskusesareccece v 161 


Jacobi’s method for removing side-coeffi- 
CIOWMUSts csscadacadentvecencassresseosnccectessee viii 41 


notation....... Beaasipencccee vii 103 
Jackson, President, cited on the distribution 
of surplus among the States............ vi 103 


Jackson, Dr., letter on autopsy of Agassiz. 
Communicated by J. J. Woodward. No 


QUSUTOEE.. soncacessstushsanssoeFaqeterretas crete 
Japan, Education in.............. 
JAPANESE COINAGE......ssc0seeeeereeees 
dry painting ......... masaaenan/rs dav sxenleveratstetes 
Jenkins, T. A., remarks on drifting buoy, 


vii 15 
Johnson, A. B., communication on the his- 
tory of the light house establishment 
of the United States. Abstract and 

TEI CUOUEC nircsastenesaatcnevestecvorsetaserter ene iv 135 
recent investigations by the Light-House 
Board on the anomalies of sound from 

fog-signals. In full. 2maps. 1 figure.w 23 
some peculiar ravages of the Teredo 


TAVALIS:, | CLRLLE ONLY. sccsosscecaneactesnecersane v 98 
some eccentricities of ocean currents. 
CAD SEV OGUie . ctvare cocetevencatsevceacsasvsertns Wii 14 


the difficulty iv determining the direc- 
tion of sound. Abstract.............Wiii 11, 12 
Johnson, W. D., communication on a new 


plane table. Wo abstract............c.ceeeee SiG 
What is topography? Abstract............. x 15 
Johnston, Gen., cited on the phenomena of 
SOMMN GM ecoeceresucesechcntescoateeereneswceereere ii (48) 
Jones, B., cited on phosphorus and brain 
CUS CASO es carsneshresseeaesteatecayaneseneeesoeerr eee vi 75 


Jones, Rey. George, cited on zodiacal light, 
4 (19), (20), (21), (26) 
Journals of mathematies......... .......::2eese.Wi 117 
Judd, F. F., communication on the water- 
shed of the Adirondack region. <Ab- 


SUL CCL ansencctravacsaanndsnececensescevosturceeranaet ii 67 
the Adirondack watershed. Abstract.ii. 82 
Jukes, cited on ripple marks.............0.0.. ii 61, 62 
Juvet, ——, communication on a time globe. 
ADSEP EL: Veacs codec stnctoecucnecseeceeeenee iii 106 
Kampf, Ferdinand, Death of.................00.. ii 189 
Kanab aSonline: cs <secscus<ceecsusadecasserus erect iii 34 
Keith, Reuel, communication on achro- 
matic object glasses. Title only........ i 73 


150 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
Keith, Reuel, communication on—Cont’d. 
the nature of the force of gravitation. 
TULLE SONU iiovdatestaubesasseesernee tapers titers Bo 
Kempe, A. B., Trisection linkage Of..........X% 99 
Kerosene Oil tests..........cccccsersessees avessrencRR a 
Kerr, M. B., remarks on glaciers..... ..... wil 8 
Kerr, W. C., communication on the geology * 
of Hatteras and the neighboring coast. 


PA DELI EG lusesaceusseicssedacadevacersecss ssenee eecnse vi 28 
the mica mines of North Carolina. Ab- 
SLI ACT...ccccsecccecccessseses eoene 9 
Death Of......cssccossvecessss‘sosnnges pdocewse esas wiii 25 
Kidder, J. H., communication on deep sea 
temperature observations. Title only, 
ix 14 
the gilding of thermometer bulbs. Title 
OM). wecesecascddaccntoysscaceacvedarys sores eciearieee ix 33 
WRIA CR so ccsccscccovsedscbéedesasscessprcctncsenaccerenss Wh 13 
Kinematic theories of force....... v 126, vi xxviii 


King, A. F. A., communication on the con- 
servative element in disease. <Ab- 
SUMLCle sserusesl sa cnestesastnega>paasasctasuessaucedene ii 111 

the conservative influence of disease as 
illustrated in the phenomena of pul- 
monary phthisis. <Abstract.........s0 ii 124 

the prevention of malarial diseases, illus- 
trating, inter alia, the conservative 
function ofague. Abstract......... ... Wi 5 

King, C., cited on geology of Great Basin...4 56 

King, Major, communication on the con- 
struction of the bridge across East 
River between Brooklyn and New 
VOR soy eLELUG OM rvosacsstssatantacs ousssaveesase i 2 

the fatigue of metals. Title only..........4 53 

King, S. A.. communication on the aerial 
currents observed in fifty balloon as- 
censions. Read by C. Abbe. In full...4 35 

Klaproth, cited on mineralogy..........02 sees i 78 

MAUS OWT aa rnen tacassvaxcs eves eceneece-casssvesvee vii 88 

Knox, J. J.,communication on the distribu- 
tion of loans in the Bank of France, 
the national banks of the United 
States, and the Imperial Bank of Ger- 
ANG 5 A OSEPOCLs cacesarepssasesossaaaccienesh= iv 31 

the distribution of the surplus money of 
the United States among the States..vi 103 


Kolb, Baron, cited on population.............. iv 28 
Koyl, C. H., communication on the storage 
of electric energy. Abstract............ vw 46 


Krakatoa and sun glowS.......seccsseres 
Kummell, C. H., communication en compo- 
sition of error from single causes of 

error. Reference..........0- Sausoeehraeenudseice -v 106 
alignment curves on any surface, with 
special application to the ellipsoid. 

AdStract. Lfig“ure.c.ccsoceeceers persave cease vi 123 


Page. 
Kummell, C. H., communication on—Cont’d. 
the theory of error practically tested 
by target-shooting. Abstract. 2 figures, 


vi 138 
curves similar to their evolutes. Ab- 
SUT ACh sc csnccossevarcedeceusssunca waapenaeaeaneaa oo VAR vat 


the quadric transformation of elliptic 
integrals, combined with the algo- 
rithm of the arithmetico-geometric 
mean. Abstract......... Bene caveeeue «Wii 101, 102 
an artifice sometimes useful for the ad- 
justment of conditioned observations. 
Abstract......00+ eseeusaesacessesseceasessossesseiteaane 
distances on any spheroid. Abstract and 
TEPETENCE..reeceaee avarteeee scaRireneee spoeeaetaee vili 52 
Can the attraction of a finite mass be in- 
finite? Jn full....... casacenssssaseesean Wild 58 
the use of Somoff’s theorem for evalua- 
tion of the elliptic integral of the third 


Species. BReEference..........e.cccscsscoes Ax 54 
the brachisthode on the helicoid. Ref- 
CTENCE. se reeeee PeRcoeece sdesoossesueessuuneeee oanaecee x 90 
remarks on temperature readings........Wi 26 
infinitesimals............s000+. sooo Wh 135 
conic sections sseeee Wk 149 
music and the eleMents......ceccccceeeeeeeWhd 28 
Feuerbach’s Circle........cccssssessssscoesee will 52 


— time determinations......... seve Whid 58 
problem in probabilities ... 


trisection Of ANGIOS......sssccresecsserereeeeee& 100 


Lagrange ignored by the Am. Phil. Soc., 
viii xxxviii 
Lagrange’s Method ....ssescessceeessreeree 
Lake Bonneville. ........ pelaeane panes Sesrit. 
and the ZeOid... ...s..eseeeeeee Wd 92, 101, 2x 15 
Lake Champlain, Ice phenomena on........ ii (22) 
Lake Erie, Altitude Of...........cccscssscccore sesveek 23 


Lake, Great Salt........csesccsees asosschansenpese li 187, 188 
Lake Lahontan......... svrecesasennee cub daos=smansere vii 18 
Lake Michigan, Altitude Of...........ccssesesseees ii 23 
Lake Ontario, Changes of level in the basin 
Okiawaccnsse Svesdbussucpeunee on see cpesceuosassaxeneinasl eee 
Lakelets and landslipS......cssccccssccceesseseeees Ai 69 
Lancaster’s classification of meteorological 
TitCTALUTOC...0.....ccscveseres sisaeeseanes Mfrs: 
Landen’s transformation...........00 e000 eaases vii 107 
Lands of the arid region..........000 eavelidne paeaae ii 189 
Landslips and lakelets............. covssoussesnacssea nee 
Lane, J. H., cited on solar physics.. .... Batty i sl 
BO PY Of.....csccseccccaosesacecsacsvenscas sees enseanue aii 122 
Resolution on the death Of..........cs+seehdd 123 
Language, Evolution Of.............sssesseesesees vi xlix 
written and SPOKE. .......00-sessecceceees beret ili 139 
Laplace cited on the solar atmosphere and 
ZOdiacal light..........ce0seees scoccnsoch (19), (aay) 


_—_"* 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 


Laplace ignored by the Am. Phil. Soc., 
villi xxxviii 
ATANIIC) HOTA vecrassnsoncvareuctons Sustnbeusseusseest viii 17 
Lassell cited on the satellites of Uranus, 
i (30), (34) 
Observations of Hyperion by.................if1 40 


Latent heat..... ...... Ba suannasanusuureasanceoses sweatsbne v 137 
Impressions ON G]ASS......ss0eceeeeree «At 39 
Latimer, George, Legacy by..........0. di 48 
Latitude, A methoa of determining........... ii 105 
GCOMPUTALIONS «....ccsscccscscnnsessecnseens ncesdeseeenem Ok 
of Lockwood’s farthest north................be 9 
variations oOf........ fecaes Mecousedane 
Lava fields of New Mexico.,......ssesceseseeees 
Leadville ores ..........00+ eerecae aehoocacveasscsvarces 
Least square computation........... 
RENAEC Sap ereceexe-cawcssteneavacsecetGa nesasers Sepneneare i 62, 89 
Le Conte, John, communication on the mi- 
croscopical structure of wool............ ii 62 
Lee, W., communication on medallic medi- 
Cal history. ADstract...........ccsereoeee vi 39 
Lefavour, E. B., remarks on infinitesimals, 
wi 135 
music and the elements............sess000 vii 28 


Lefroy, letter on changes of sea-level at Ber- 
muda. Communicated by J. Henry. 
Wo abstract........... piensuancetaptaneeeacueresercve a 75 
Legendre ignored by the Am. Phil. Soc., 
wilt xxxviii 
Lehmus, Prof. D.C. L., cited on Malfatti’s 


problem............. aa neeenauea Wcccsctivancaccsens ii 115 
Leibnitz cited on Newton’s philosophy......v 162 
Leibnitz’s philosophy......... Reeepaiununers eoeeeee Wid X]ii 
Lenses, Achromatic combination of........ 

Cylindrical.......... piediddaagesnwasaceusausanssa seascwat 
Le Sage’s theory of cohesion............0..-...W 129 
Lesquereux, Prof. L., cited on fossil plants 

POM: VAT SINIAS coccccsccccessverecsos s-eeehl (38), (40) 
Levees of the Mississippi delta................06+ i (14) 
Levelling instrument, Proposed................4d 184 


Lewes, G. H., cited on action at a distance..w 157 
YEpee’s instruction of the dumb.. 
Ley cited on cyclonic motion........... 
V’Hospital’s trisection instrument... 
Liagre’s theory of target shooting 
Library of the Surgeon General’s Office......1 92 
Lick, James, letter on proposed observatory. 
Communicated bis J. Henry. No ab- 


SEPACE .0100000 aap staveeeaesnaaas eacuedivasenyeussbeasench’. OL 
Life...... Asaiaackane paaeeeslehcanssens ia 21, v 49, 102 
and slnohviaity. sa suemeaseasasseasTw BT 
foree...... Sradasecceons arcentstuectscee' We, OF 
Modern philosophical conceptions of.....w 49 
Light and SOUNG..........ccsceccssrrcceeeesseseeredW 143 

of the sun, passed through a narrow slit, 
iii 119 


151 


Page. 

Light-house establishment of the United 
RPGC Rmadeatacsecusiecascceses “preconcnecne Pare bce St} 
BASIE CAMISG Of ..ccccsenascscasscstteseresecccees ii 189 
Limnea megasoma, Depauperation of......d41 75 
Bimpets ye -cckccsces Macunbancalicavadceresatarscts et.....Wih 4 
Linneus, cited on growth of stones............W 67 
WAMOTAOL Yer sateustesrsycatteacaseseses roche i 77 
Lippman, G., cited on electricity................. v 168 
List of deceased members...... lil xiv, viii xxv, 
ix xxvi, x xxviii 
members......1 19, (37), 44 ix, iif ix, 153, iv 15, 
vil5, vi xvi, vii xvi, vili xvi, ix xvi, 


x xvi 
members of the Mathematical Section. 
vi 116, vii 86, viii 36, ix 52, x 82 


recipients of the Bulletin................... iii 159 
The consolidated.............se0 was epaewendeee neces x 36 
Lister, Prof. J,, cited on germ enlture aneses li 109 
Lithology. See Geology. 
Littrow’s telegraphic system........ gevaveundhensee i 101 
Loans by banks in France, Germany, and 
the United States.............. Che reece av 31 
Lockwood’s expedition to farthest north.ix 8 
Locusts, SHOWer Of. <dvsssaps<casesaccesonessdvaweecees ii 87 
Lodge, Dr. O. J., cited on electricity..........v 168 
Loess of eastern LOWS.........sccsscceees aeeaehes vi 93 
OriginpOts Ces lsesocedesresctsoansess cvoscduvesste iv 121 
Logical algebra........sssssvessee» Motwansesehas sudan wel 88 
Lombard, J. S., cited on brain temperatures, 
-_w 75 
Longitude computation.........cccccseerseseess -Wili 52 
Loomis, Elias, cited on cyclonic motion, 
1107, 108 
retardation of storm Centres............se00 
Lovering, Prof., cited on auroras....... wanayan 
Loxodrome...... meNesrsarenesensuadeduemensrae asaestesty 


Lueas, F. A., communication on museum 
specimens illustrating biology. Title 
OND eicrsscatussacesteessaducsadassnasucnaqastes sccconkx 36 

Lucretius’ A ee Waeiauavs Ceoreaconcecctey vil xxxvii 

Lull, E. P., communication on the inter- 
oceanic canal through Nicaragua. 


THELGIONUaacacneeactcannctiarseet weceeneeae stasaede) 83 

DG HEN Of eacanawecsnunecenncceoaseesees Bvaaencasseartcure eS ES) 
Thun ar theory siccaesiuccsucsatercessctacesecss iv 57, vi 136 
variation of magnetic declination.........i41 47 
Lymph, Motion of the............:ecccsssesseeees 2.8 133 


McClellan, Gen., cited on phenomena of 
BOUND lsecepcscocens agduasesvexenGnuenaussenesasess eed (48) 
McCullough, Hon. H., remarks on U.S. sur- 
plus given to the State of Indiana...vi 106 
McDowell, S., cited on thermal belts....... away UE 
McGee, W J, communication on the drain- 
age system and the distribution of the 
loess of eastern Iowa. Abstract......wi 93 


152 


Page. 
McGee, W J, communication on—Cont’d. 
What isa glacier? Abstract... Wil 38 
the terraces of the Potomac valley. 
TRLIGIOTUM tconesvansveaseses cvsseyevinnase ocoeees WAdd = 24 
the Charleston earthquake. Abstract.ix 37 
the quaternary deposits and the great 
displacement of the middle Atlantic 
slope. Reference......... dacsessarsescecvacanm, 16 
42 


58 


McKenney and Hall, cited on diminution of 
PN GIBNSE ii chive tes deectstcembssorsed Racuvasets che di 175 
MeMurtrie, William, communication on the 
meteorological conditions affecting the 


culture of the sugar beet. Reference, 

aii 142 

Magic Squares.....ceee wees wdadavdcuppedddaasdaentvene ili 143 

Magnetic declination, Secular change in.idi 45 

disturbance and northers....... petenduactouat wit 25 

BUOLING icc sertiewne Wadauecdwudsuutandes eawecenepend dil 47 
Magnetism. See Electricity. 

Main, R., cited on Saturn’s rings.............. wi 42 

Mairan, cited on auroras,y.......ceeeee Sbsekcherdanee a 44 

Malarial diseases, Prevention of..............Wl 5 

Malfatti’s problem.............. secceeee asbbeaeudeciyads di 113 


Mallery, Garrick, communication on a cal- 
endar of the Dakota Indians. Abstract 

GNA TEfETENCE.. 110001 s00000 00008 sstecwentsepeeoave ii 90 
some common errors respecting the 
North American Indians. Abstract 

GANG PELERCN COs azacadsutaas Setesdeassactuveveateats ii 175 

customs of every-day life. Abstract...ix 19 
relations between Professor Baird and 


participating societies....... deusdestersscece x 45 
remarks on phonetic alphabets.............. ix 18 
Mallet’s contraction hypothesis..............5 vi 90 
method of determining earthquake foci, 
x 17, 19 
Maloney, J. A., Electric investigations by..w 47 
Mammals, Classification Of..........ssseeceeeee coal '(8) 
DIStHIBULLOMO Ree sedaliseccaces dvedavestscdacwesseee ii 26 
INSEGELVOLOUS: Weisise sete catscbticesssvcesseaee” LLS 
Manganese, Estimation of...... Wedtaleatevdebet Mn Loe 
Man, Zoological relations of....... abinwevadeen deat i 24 
Mann, B. P., communieation on tennis 
indaxiug: Abstract....... sliitasoddeaivane x '88 
remarks on care of pamphlets............ viii 29 
PHYOWINE-SICKR csicdvereesssaxs sptecdeceusswceses ix 14 
Map of Charleston earthquake............... ix 37, 39 
Gulf of Mexico........6 dagdusveuniidage idddannseeW LOS 
path of meteor of December 24, 1873....i1 160 
Topographic, iictcs cccedvavcercoucesucscocaddtuaverest poppy 
Maps for use in connection with the transit 
Of Wiens, LOA cices esd d dees aterdecdeaalhs i 63 
Marcou, J., cited on paleozoic rocks......... vi 102 
Mariotio, Liaw OPsincisdevoest. Deb tuobestes désedewenvee v 139 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 

Mars, Satellites of........ 11 181,186, 188,190, wi 45 
Marsh, Hon. G. P., cited on individual yo- 

CADULATICS,..recscccccvoegee -secerseeee shh (16), (19), (21) 

Marth’s Method... ..cccccssesssssceceee so caty see Wh 98 
Martin, Artemas, communication on a prob- 

lem in probabilities. Abstract..........% 80 
methods of finding nth-power numbers 

whose sum isan nth-power. Abstract.x 107 


Letter from...cccsas'scensvaveasdivasqatecetes eine vil 987 
Marvin, C. F., communication on the Flood 
Rock explosion. Title only...........Wiiid 28 


the electrometer as used in observations 
of atmosphericelectricity. Titleonly.x 9 


Marvine, A. R., Biographical notice of......i (53) 
Resolutions on the death of........ Perprpeer: «We | 

Mass of a planet determined from observa- 
tions on two satellites.......... sscucyediinee vi 132 


Mason, O. T., communication on archsolog- 
ical specimens. Title only......s0.-.4k 48 

the classification af objects of archs- 
ology. Title only......s000 Ears | a 

international symbols for charts of pre- 
historical archeology. Title only...ii 71, 72 

the decipherment of some Aztec monu- 

ments lately discovered in Guatemala. 
Title On y....0r0ccorsceorerene sdéeue cvcedesdasueeaeaeel nay) 

comparison of written language with 

that which is spoken only. Abstract, 
ili 139 

two examples of similar inventions in 
areas widely apart. Abstract.........4K 12 
bowyers and fletchers. Abstract.........4% 44 

remarks on implements of Australia, Aleu- 
tian Islands, and North America....... ii 66 
the telephone.................. soscccuenacevupheat inmate 
ancient Indian population.... ....li 180 
charcoal in the drift............ eoseusnsetenuey iv 122 
Indian observation of nature............. wii 74 
Origin.of CUStOMS..\..citc-cccsctessoesaas oven See 

Mason, ——, communication on kerosene 
oil tests. Abstract....... sat Soe hee cnedee atm 
Mathematical journals............... 
Mathematical Section, Minutes of...wi 121, vii 87, 


viii 37, ix 53, x 83 
Organization: OF a:sssesscssicsrsanssceeaneines vi 28, 121 
Place of Meeting.......s..cccsecee gchddetakiaet vii 81 
Statistios (Of. <.cisccsccusadeceaaepeanene ~veenseok 34, 36 
Mathematics, List of papers on (See also 
Astronomy): 


on the distance traversed by approaching 
the North Pole on a loxodromie curve. 


J. E. Hilgard. Title only ic..sececsenssceses A 21 
[exhibition of chronograph.] J. E. Hil- 
gard. Wo abstract...........0 pesedeusneaneien i 22 


on acurve of the fourth degree. A. Hall. 
Abstract and reference......00008 apes euieey i 30 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-xX. 


Page. 
Mathematics, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
on an exponential formula having refer- 
ence to the tolerance allowed at the 
U.S. Mint. J. E. Hilgard. Title only, 
i 31 
on the locus of the point of equal illumi- 
nation by two unequal lights treated 
by the quaternion analysis. E. B. 
BT Obbs LEA ONY: ctsctvsccsccasesssestsecsveel’ OO 
on Hindoo arithmetic. J. E. Hilgard. 
Title only.......0ess000 Riuceseetaveb sesanedeeusdaubens i 53 
on a series for the determination of the 
number expressing the ratio of the 
circumference to the diameter. E. 
PISO Ey KLE) PUMislassacddesntneoccchacsceceoscsecs i 57 
on the experimental determination of the 
ratio of the circumference to the di- 
ameter, based on the principles of the 
ealculus of probabilities. A. Hall. 
SR MERCTOTIDY rate cetewadaatarencasaceatckaeatunesnassssie i 62 
an historical note on the method of least 
squares. A. Hall. Reference.............. i 62 
an inquiry into the law of probability. J. 
E. Hilgard. Title only.....ccccsrcereesereed 84 
on logical algebra. C. S. Peirce. Refer- 
ENCE .. ssaveccesceese wavdacenhess Recawtutaecasedswexsssses 08 
on the mechanical representation of a 
problem in least squares. S. New- 
COM. Reference......ccceeeeeccvee estense ncaa: i 89 
on quaternions, as developed from the gen- 
eral theory of the logic of relatives. 
C. 8. Peirce. Title only........ 004. sso 94 
on affected quantities of the first order. 
BE. B. Elliott. Title only.......0..... coos ii 42 
approximate quadratures. A. Hall. Ab- 
BURGOD. ateuvseccudecdeed cscduncuusevey Rates Uussueneus ii 48 
some recent investigations on the theory 


of invariants. J. J. Sylvester. Title 

ONY seatansccsazctes seven sessenbe Siadiea deeds Wesseaeee di 95 
a trigonometrical formula. B. Alvord. 

MDROLE OTE cstsnevscentbecceanstvsscsancedesssen tecess ii 104 


the history of Malfetti’s problem. M. 
Baker. Infull. 2 figures ...di 113 

series. E. Frisby. Title only.......s...00 ii 193 

the intersection of circles and the inter- 
section of spheres. B. Alvord. Title 


an adjustment of the Carlisle tables of re- 
versions and annuities. E. B. Elliott. 
AUDI OY davevastccsauatarsiatssacdeccevervesrcxsades 41 201 

new points respecting the intersections 
of circles and the intersections of 
spheres. B. Alvord. Title only........ ii 201 

discussion of a geometrical problem, with 
bibliographical notes. M. Baker. Jn 
UPD ar AUG UT EG ta taesne sessscceddecccnccceseeee iii 53, 55 


153 


Page. 
Mathematics, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
on magic squares. E. Frisby. Abstract. 
PUPP Cbteee cee tatscsdessesucwshvsseshcuesacacenas ili 143 
on the geometrical problem to determine 
a circle equally distant from four 
points. M.H. Doolittle. Abstract...w 88 
on some of the properties of Steiner’s 
power-circle. B. Alvord. Title only.w 89 
on composition of error from single causes 
of error. ©.H. Kummell. Reference, 
v 106 
on a geometrical question relating to 
spheres. M. Baker. In full.....s0.-00+. v 107 
on a graphic table for computation. G. K. 
Gilbert. Abstract......ecasccccccsserscsecsesW 120 
experiments in binary arithmetic. H. 
Farquhar. Abstract........ secducavan aE ony) Waid 
formulas for the computation of Easter. 
BBE iotie Puli ceecesesnactesasnaces vi 14 
further experiments in binary arithmetic. 
He Farquhar.) AUStractis..sccccccvessuessc vi 38 
inaugural address of the chairman of the 


Mathematical Section. A. Hall. In 

full.cccrsse Rnacaoapecnecaens eresecsade aearaceunussmWat LLG 
& quasi general differentiation. A. S. 

Christie. “Tile Onlafescccccccscsencecsocacese vi 122 
infinite and infinitesimal quantities. M. 

H. Doolittle. Abstract .........s000 voeeee WA 133 


certain possible abbreviations in the com- 
putation of the long-period perturba- 
tions of the moon’s motion due to the 
direct action of the planets. G. W. 
Hill. Abstract and reference.......+ eV 136 
the theory of errors practically tested by 
target-shooting. C.H. Kummell. Ab- 
Stract. 2 figures.......esesceee Secnsesues onseeee WA 138 
a special case in maxima and minima. B. 
Alvord.  “Ab8tract......<.-0ccse-ccccecaee soos WA 149 
form of least-square computation. H. Far- 
quhar. In full......c00...s000 onsekt eassudian vi 150 
note on the problem discussed by Mr. Al- 
vord. H. Farquhar. <Abstract.........wi 152 
the rejection of doubtful observations, M. 
H. Doolittle. Abstract.........cccccosees «Wi 152 
the special treatment of certain forms of 


observation-equations. R. S. Wood- 

WDC. | AUST QElialacesaetenveseusesssncatureaes vi 156 
contact of plane curves. A. S. Christie. 

VAIO BET ECP siecacavecqasatcedaesbevenncsbsscenceaunnds vi 157 


curves similar to their evolutes. C. H. 
Kummell. Abstract......ss00...sc0s000eWhl 87 

the problem of the knight’s tour. 
Gilberts) MAOsOrGet  creccsscactseccsss arenes vii 88 

empirical formule for the diminution of 
amplitude of a freely-oscillating pen- 
dulum. H. Farquhar. Abstract.....vii 89 


154 


Page. 
Mathematics, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
the formule for computing the position of 


asatellite. A. Hall. In full.......000 vil 93 
a form of the multinomial theorem. A.S. 
Christie. Title only......+ quusacean seseeee Wh 101 


the quadric transformation of elliptic inte- 

grals, combined with the algorithm of 

the arithmetico-geometric mean. C. 
H. Kummell. Abstract........... vii 101, 102 

a case of discontinuity in elliptic orbits. 
W. B. Taylor. Abstract....... anavownesde wil 122 
the verification of predictions. 
Doolittle. <Abstract....... eaadeens goaeesee vii 122 

methods of verifying weather predictions. 
CADE, CADSETACE seccucvscssssn-s-cc Wak 6 

example illustrating the use of a certain 

symbol in the calculus of affected 
quantity. E.B. Elliott. Title only..wiii 37 

a collection of formuls for the area of a 

plane triangle. M. Baker. Reference, 
viii 37 

an artifice sometimes useful for the adjust- 

ment of conditioned observations. C. 
H. Kummell. Abstract......... eoceveee Wii = 41 

a group of circles related to Feuerbach’s 

circle. M. Baker. Jn full. 4 figures, 
wiii 45 

distances on any spheroid. C. H. Kum- 
mell. Abstract and reference........ «wii 52 

on Grassmann’s system of geometry. A. 
Ziwet. Reference......cccccsrcrrereereeeee Wild 53 

cause and chance in the concurrence of 

phenomena. M. H. Doolittle. Title 
OMY. A csndssesarsocceansushostantonccsascsponcessss Ae, 10+ 

Can the attraction of a finite mass be infi- 
nite? C.H.Kummell. Jn full.....vili 58 

on the use of Somoff’s theorem for the 

evaluation of the elliptic integral of 

the third species. C. H. Kummell. 


Reference .....0+ rrearotrercce anceheecaane ix 54 
graphic methods in eat. G. K. Gil- 

bert. ADSEACE.....cccccocersercevcccesecesess ok 
association ratios. M. H. Doolittle. Ab- 

SET ACE....ccceee ceacesscssucwosens occ anecen saplasigusitee oie x 83 
a problem in probabilities. Symposium. 

PADSULOCisinaspeosinecseddccusncontannnuhs cnaxaavar x 87, 89 


on the free cooling of a homogeneous 
sphere initially heated to a uniform 


temperature. R.S. Woodward. Ref- 

CTENCE. .ererere sunseeseneatas Ane acencbae eee x 90 
on the brachisthode on the helicoid. C. 

H. Kummell. Reference......... ebadudenen x 90 
the motion of Hyperion. G. W. Hill. Ab- 

stract and reference........+.0+8 abeacton rs skee x 90 
the parallax of @ Tauri. A. Hall. Abd. 


BE ACT icuecanstacenc sovtsvoescestavecunnvsectusssschnene x 91 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
Mathematics, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
the most probable value of the latitude and 
its theoretical weight from entangled 
observations occurring in the use of 
Talcott’s method. A. S. Flint. Ab- 


SULGCH:. -crapcsvsccscuctduapeers ech secs aston sseuedsuuen x 91 
association ratios. M. H. Doolittle. Ab- 
SET ACT.....00008 PT es ei 


[solution and generalization of a problem 
requiring the division of a rectangle 
into parts which form a square.] H. 
Farquhar. No abstract .......scecercsceesK 96 

a collection of solutions of the trisection 
problem. M. Baker. Abstratt.......... x 96 

[on the trisection problem.] G. E. Curtis. 

AD SU GEE icvasteceaccocacs sessaesisepeniveveseaaeiane x 98 
the integration of differential equations 

admitting periodic integrals. G. W. 

Hill. Abstract and reference........0.+-+.X 100 

Euler’s theorem (generally called Lam- 
bert’s). A. Hall. Abstract......ccc000.-X 101 

[anew computing machine.] E. B. Elliott. 
ADSEN GCE iasenssncscsonctusiacsonsesnsmpbenseeeemesiaenntiee 

on the constant P in observations of ter- 
restrial magnetism. W. Harkness. 
Abstract and reference...» assesanawaashae Oe 

the conditioned cooling of a homoge- 
neous sphere. R.S. Woodward. Ref- 


ET ENCE. .2.000. aseosssnsanasanndsceusteseamueessteenetem ML Ee 
the orbit of Hyperion. O.Stone. Abstract 
ANd TEfEreENce.......+0008 adotuobet sesbchouuns aemeamewc EE 


the quotients of space-directed lines. E. 
B. Elliott. ADstract....ccccccccsseseeeeeX 105, 106 
methods of finding nth-power numbers 
whose sum isan nth-power. A. Martin. 


ADSEPACE....cceseeeere esuadseseuanenvn poo scoperatean eeAET| 
Matter and force..........cssecciescccesees Vii 30 
Combination Of.........csssss0e i: vi xxxv 
Properties Of.......-.sscsee« i 27,v 127, wi 5, vil 40 


Three states Of....:caccsesscsnoccseceseussupeeneassnstnteeuons 
Matteucci cited on muscular contraciion...w 59 
Matthews, Washington, communication on 

natural naturalists. Read by J. S. Bill- 


ings. ADSErACE......ccserereres fcalvgeeeneneneee vii 73 

mythological dry paintings of the Nava- 
jos. ADstract.c......cs0 A heotanee -wili 14 

anthropometric sad reaction-time appa- 
ratus. Abstract. soveceesWhhd 25 
Mauna Dios. .desecsesseensacnes ods cntcvnevva teddsanbeeeentt vi 13 
Maxima and minima, Special case in..wi 149, 152 
Maxwell, Prof. J. C., cited on matter.........W 128 
ON C1AStICItY......cseseereeereee scecodat een aeeetys +0 132 


theories of heat. 

radiant energy......... a 
Boyle's law. .scc..s:sessses:sesvsccenssssosunnetessons hae 
Molecular Orbits........ sc. ccceeeeeeeee -v 140, 147, 149 


-_ 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-xX. 


Page. 
Maxwell, Prof. J. C., cited on—Cont’d. 
dissipation of molecular energy........... v 153 
surface repulsiOn.,......0.....eeeeee aeeceeenenss 7 LOD)! 
WOTUOXMEINOS veescssevsscnnsceccosatnseeraccscne Wik) LAV 
Matter... ce. adsiieaserctross RasUexseesssdenains vii 44 
Mayer, A. M., communication on a method 
of determining a definite interval of 
time, and its application to measuring 
the number of vibrations of solid bod- 
TOS: TRG ONY. ccccscsrencecewsascccccesscccceolh 64 


Mayer’s topophone......... Beecedesaetsusastdususss viii 13 
Mechanical representation of a problem in 
least SQUATES ..........0008 Specksaneuntennesshvsne i 89 
Medallic medical history............s08- saveustaW a> 39 
Medals, Exhibition Of................06+ mogereoscsese vi 22 
Meehan, Thos., cited on the common names 
of plants........ eabcnscecacesen seston cuadeavenses iv 113 


Meek, F. B., communication on new species 
of fossil plants from Alleghany Co., 
Virginia; with some remarks on the 
rock seen along the Chesapeake and 
Ohio railroad, near the White Sulphur 
Springs of Greenbrier county, West 
Virginia. Read by T. Gill. In full. 2 
1 62, 44 (26) 
Death of............ Ryasee coameckansersesces=n bosehebsccdh SLE 
Meigs, M. C., communication on a map of 
the head waters of the Yellowstone 
and Lewis rivers. Wo abstract........ wi 21 
the movements caused in large ice-fields 
by expansion and contraction, as illus- 
trative of the formation of anticlinal 
and synclinal axes in geological for- 
mations. Infull. 4 figures....... ese 33, (22) 
remarks on glacial period.........csseecerseeedl 37 
Members. See List of Members. 
Membership statistics of scientific socie- 


LEIS eee cacao eenadavein weeseubssune iesemaecss as vervse x 29 
Memoir on the scientific work of Joseph 

FTGUINV cssasnssnunsnsceassenseee Ruaedapandepasesseucns 4i 203 
Memorial to B. AlVOrd ......ssseesssees cesses cosees vii 127 


(See also Biography.) 
Mendenhall, T. C., communication on the 
measurement of temperature at dis- 
tant points. Title only.......0.000000..Viik 18 
the Charleston earthquake. Abstract, 
ix 37 
remarks on Japanese custom......... Seabnes 
Mercadier, M., cited on radiophony.......... iv 158 
Mercury, Theory Of.....cccccs-cccessseeee-cooveeeeWhdk 941 
Transit Of...........0+ oh 
Meridian, Proposed initial..............seeceeeee vi 106 
Meridian transit time determinations...wili 55 
Merriam, C. H., communication on the eco- 
nomic phase of the English sparrow 
question. Referencé........sseceesseereeeeees x 16 


seeneee eens 


155 


Page. 

Merrill, G. P., communication on geological 
museums. Title only........ Exented Goecaetes ix 36 

Metaphysic philosophy. 

MGtAD DIV RIGS Uicvenscdane sadevaesecsanccodssscadeandasc wii xxix 

Metcalf, Capt. H., cited on theory of target 
AVA CULCGsgaceresstevanscecsuaueayarsacuessebedaveres vi 145 
Meteor, Explanation of explosion of......... ii 143 
of December 24, 1873........0++ soeseeh 94, 41 123, 139 


(See also Meteors.) 
Meteoric matter and planetary motions, 


11 188, 190 

Meteorite, A new........... ehdepuececadanancsveuivees wii 32 
Meteorites at Concepcion and San Gregorio, 

New MeXiIGO.2cossancsipucteciesatunsssveustesace a 24 

Meteorological work by Joseph Henry...... ii 236 

of the Smithsonian Institution............ ii 295 


Meteorology, List of papers on (See also 
Thermometry) : 
on the aerial currents observed in fifty 
balloon ascensions.. S. A. King. Com- 
municated by C. Abbe. In full........ eo 35 
{on aerial currents observed in balloon 
ascensions.] C. Abbe. Abstract.......1 38 
on certain remarkable effects of lightning. 
E. J. Farquhar. Communicated by 
Je Henry. Tite OnUY.s.caswsasecedcssencassvons i 42 
on the aurora. W.B. Taylor. Abstract... 43 
on the aurora of February 4th [1872]. J. E. 
Hilgard. Abstract.......... Pepsentina React 4 47 
on the effects of winds and barometric 
pressure on the tides of Boston, and 


on the mean level of the sea. W. Fer- 

rel. Abstract and reference..........00 Pee wats 
on the meteorology of Japan. T. Antisell. 

DULCGs OF efeccanesavcessesoaucessseccsssadonsssoacscess i 70 


on the results of astronomical observa- 
tions at Sherman Station, Wyoming 
Terr. R. D. Cutts. Abstract and refer- 


on the laws of condensation of aqueous 


vapor in the atmosphere. E. Foote. 

DULUEL OVE Pasecewstsat cucdancusthreueri=tavaicetsececes i 74 
on the meteorology of Russia. A. Woeikof. 

PRET OCEMEG nenacdocustavsecseainetncddcucast ores asenel 00 
on atmospheric electricity. (3 papers.) J. 

RS nryan atte ONY sacs.cesnntsttecsesceecse i 75, 87 


on electrical phenomena in the Rocky 
Mountains. F. M. Endlich. Title only, 

a 95 
on the distribution of temperature over 


the surface of the globe. W. Hark- 

MIGSSs , PRES ETENCEseoose socweceesiarcuronestosununen i 96 
on some causes that produce rain. E. 

Foote. Title only...........--- Sonaunenas fewenne i 98 


on the laws governing the movement of 
storm centres. C. Abbe. Abstract... 4 99 


156 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
Meteorology, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
on the law connecting the velocity and di- 
rection of the wind with the barometric 
gradient. W. Ferrel. Abstract.........4 106 
on the correlation of the winds and the 
temperatures of the surface waters of 
the ocean along the coast of New 
Hampshire. J. W. Chickering. Ab- 
BUT ACT. ccccccrscsscesccssccccnescocecconnsssessns scones ii 17 
meteorological observations in Peru, and 
some of the meteorological conditions 
of that country. A. Woeikof. Title 
ONLY ..esvscseereeresseeessensecaceens carsesseenesaneens di 35 
the glacial theory. J. Henry. Abstract..ii 35 
the causes of glacial climate. Symposium. 
JADSEN ACs act saacsusecsancavaskanesketcesxesaeakn di 43, 45 
the comparison of rain-gauges at different 
elevations. J. R. Eastman. Abstract..ii 49 
a new meteorological instrument. J. W. 
Osborne. ADStracte.....c.scceceecesessesseees ii 63 
the hygrometrical condition of the air in 
high latitudes. E. Bessels. Title only, 
ii 66 
the horary oscillations of the temperature 
of the atmosphere. G. K. Gilbert. Ab- 


GUL ACT os sencnnssonnen cssabslsbose-sbecs-remnsndesadenee ii 67 
horary oscillations of the atmosphere. G. 
K. Gilbert. ADStract........ccccceeseeeceeees ii 69 


facts relating to the falling of waterspouts 
in North Carolina, T. L. Clingman. 
MAD REROCL.esavarskcdavduptdeanetss teas ndaeon ceases’ ii 104 
the causes of electrical developments in 
thunderstorms. E. Foote. Abstract..ii 189 
suggestions respecting the study of mete- 
orology in regard to the causes of yel- 
low fever. J. W. Osborne. Title only, 
ili 21, 27 
a@ curious manifestation of foree by the 
wind. J. W. Osborne. Title only....iid 27 
air currents on mountain slopes. G. K. 
Gilbert. ADSstract...........s00sseees PRP erhi | Gest] 
on the meteorological conditions affect- 
ing the culture of the sugar beet. W. 
MeMurtrie. Reference... .....-0 id 142 
[the aurora borealis.] C. Abbe. Abstract.iv 21 
on the’ conditions determining tempera- 
ture. W. Ferrel. In full.........0.se00 v 90, 91 
on errors of barometric observations pro- 
duced by wind. G. K. Gilbert. Refer- 


ENCE... sccceseeree ef fcce ew OL 
on solar railiation ee pentane Wyoming. 
W. Ferrel. Title only....... Meatenesosuneare «v 101 


on the retardation of storm centres at ele- 
vated stations, and high wind as a 
probable cause. H. A. Hazen. In 
PUL liisinicdvdavssenestiuorseunntsnsectodmesesnetenores Se (LUD 


Page. 
Meteorology, List of papers on—Cont’d. 

[a remarkable halo.] W.B. Taylor. Ab- 
SEP GEE. scacenscatessnascdeseu 0 svcasoasess BAverin eeW 112 

on a graphic table for computation. G. K. 
Gilbert. ADS¢rGCE...cccscccsssee-consscnnssace ee nkeae 

on the coming winter of 1882-83. H. A. 
Hazen. ADStract..:.csccssseccsscscosecsecasssaW Lam 

the response of terrestrial climate to secu- 

lar variations in solar radiation. G.K. 


Gilbert. Abstract......... necandaln eerie. « foul) 
the thermal belts of North Carolina. J. W. 
Chickering. Abstract.........0- Perper (geil ( 
hygrometric observations. H. A. Hazen. 
Abstract.....c.00 eperesbaappeaetsieareea a=sasgexns aes 
the Rochester (Minnesota) tornado. J. R. 
Eastman. Abstract........s-.sces-0e0 ere | as} 
the sun-glows. H. A. Hazen. Abstract 
ANd TEfEFeENCe .......0006 ca veopoe suse susucope Rata 


the relations between northers and mag- 
netis disturbances at Havana. G. E. 
Curtis. Reference........ save auaneansaiieed «vii 25 
methods of verifying weather predictions. 
OW Abbe. AUSETACE: scccsccasccassene seoceee Wid 68 
thunderstorms of 1884. H.A. Hazen. Ab- 
SLTACT....0000 pabaveecomnned we :coselaseasennbecieey mE 
the condensing hygrometer and sling psy- 


chrometer. H. A. Hazen. Abstract, 
wili 25 

normal barometers. T. Russell. Title 
OO csactas teres Da yeeeaeeneacniesdeaamaaa Brena baal 

the sky-glows of 1883. H. A. Hazen. Title 
OTUG score cstonecopeuncs taasieeyusexy scene Bee 

the theory of the wind-vane. G. E. Curtis. 
Reference....... pfeerictae cosceuae ovnsapenwsuasanaseae nine 


the electrometer as used in observations 
of atmospheric electricity. C. F. Mar- 
Vil: Detle O70. ..cscccescsessesvesscaneneneenaee x4 
relation between wind velocity and press- 
ure. H. A. Hazen. Reference........X 10 
the Signal Service bibliography of meteor- 
ology. C. Abbe. Jn full...........+ exnqensa need 
memorandum on the Signal Service bibli- 
ography of meteorology and terrestrial 
magnetism. C. J. Sawyer. Read by 
C. Abbe. In full........ sgakasdusscuaneeel aati non cou ad 
Meteors and comets 94 
Method of least squares..i 62, 89, vi 150, viii 41 
POSOALGD so secccc tadeses «Ai 163, Vi xxxiii, wii li 
Methods of Cvolution. ..........ccsseccesee serene vi xxvii 
Modern petrography.....ceccccceceseee ceeee 
verifying predictions .........0-sesccocccees 
verifying weather predictions.........vili 8 


Metric system.......ccs.ssccccees seeue snaacnpaEnenmeeeae vi 4 
advocated by Geodetic Commission....vi 109 
for postal purpoSes.........sescrscsecsesssssekl 15, 19 


IN MUCTOSCOPY’ cs. ceececccsesedvavaccsedensenataneraanees 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 
VO RICO, GUnIE. Of csecaseusesedssuecottvcassanensaavenesnckWs, OZ 
Meyer’s atomic VoOlUME CUIVE.......00e0e. WA 15 
Mica mines of North Carolina....... CesseseraeWaen 99) 


Michelson, A. A..communication on the mod- 
ifications suffered by light in passing 
throughavery narrowslit. Abstract..iii 119 


DICTON A125 c0<c08 audspenusesreesseas eaietcessreanesastes antes itd 23 
Microphone, Hughes’ 
Modification of Wheatstone’s..............-..4W 183 
Microscopy, List of papers on (See also 
Optics) : 


on the desirability of reproducing photo- 
graphs of scientific objects and cspe- 
cially of magnified microscopical prep- 
arations in a permanent form by some 
photo-mechanicalmethod. J.J.Wood- 
WAL. ADSETACE....cccerscccccssrsesscnenee Sao Wee! 
on the use of monochromatic sunlight as 
an aid to high power definition. J.J. 
Woodward. Abstract and reference....4 47 
on micrometric writing on glass. J. J. 
Woodward. Title only........0+eee0 set 93 
on the modern microscope, Nobert’s lines, 
and the attempts of others to construct 
them. J.J.Woodward. Title only...i& 25 
diffraction phenomena in the field of the 
microscope. J.J. Woodward. Abstract 
ANA TEFETENCE.....+.0+0eeee0e secsboneectarce Sevencskh, 60 
the microscopical structure of wool. J.J. 
Woodward and John Leconte. Title 
ONMRY...sccronssvcccsnerecceceserooneacscensssees Seee seed 62 
the use of photography in connection with 
the micrometer measurement of blood 
corpuscles. J. J. Woodward. Title 
ONY sccresevess-sanss Seaeapaneeaseenass Recess nieces ii 79 
a simple device for the illumination of 
balsam-mounted objects for examina- 
tion with certain immersion objectives 
whose “balsam angle” is 90° or up- 
wards. J. J.Woodward. Jn full. 1 
HUGUET Osncseaestagdesccaccisssanseasecne pecbensiesenetes ii 126 
on the apertometer of Prof. E. Abbe, of 
Jena, Germany. J.J.Woodward. Ab- 


BUA itedsetcewatcuelapwareseccabienaswenwendsatancs sss iii 18 
on a standard for micrometry. J. J. Wood- 
ward. <Abstract.......... RPaugusabshecceyetanes fii 22 


on the oil-immersion objectives of Zeiss, 
and on convenient methods of obtain- 
ing oblique illumination for these and 
similer objectives. J. J. Woodward. 
Abstract....... <-SeapeEer pestaendesnbeses daseet fii 25 

a@ new apertometer for microscopic ob- 
jectives. J. J. Woodward. Title 
if iastacanvapeerpeceseccsssnacnvanacuensives sveeond hii 37 


157 


Page. 
Microscopy, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
Riddell’s binocular microscopes—an his- 
torical notice. J. J. Woodward. Ab- 


Stract ANd TEfEereNnce.....r.wseeerseseee Perec? 5.0 ee 
[exhibition of a collection of microscopes.] 
J.S. Billings. Wo abstract..............Wii 73 


recent improvements in microscopic ob- 
jectives, with demonstration of the 
resolving power of a new 1-16th inch. 


R. Hitcheock. Title only......... co 1G 
Milneria minima........... sesacssns cere + vili 5 
Mills, cited on thermometry.........0+seeee4K 30 
Mind and body....... Seediert baleen chemise raene “cota Whats 


Mineralogy, List of papers on: 

on mineralogical systems. F. M. Endlich. 
TAU fiblbccwmescceetencncsuacarany SLATS Sere pone i 

on specimens of meteoric iron from Chi- 
huahua, Mexico, and the structure of 
meteorites in general. F.M. Endlich. 
TEI OW iseacessuceeucsseusss savebesaguncanesnaespare i 98 

on the occurrence of pure tellurium in 
certain gold mines of Colorado. F. M. 


Endlich. Title only......cseeseceeeeess Stcospe LOL 
on some interesting cases of metamorph- 
ism. F.M. Endlich. Title only......idi 27 


some observations on the crystalline state 
of matter. J. R. M. Irby. Abstract..dit 39 
topaz from Stoneham, Maine. F.W. Clarke 
and J. S. Diller. Abstract and refer- 
CULE Tanroadeue vss esos te datenanacar<-ceseeseinyanl wilt 5 
the enlargement of mineral fragments as 


a factor in rock alteration. R. D. 

Trying.  Ditle! Orde). ...ccssvecsenesacsncsnsavun ix 16 
the present status of mineralogy, F. W. 

Clarke. Title Only.....coserees ssusessnsven x 6 


Misapplication of geographical termS........4 39 
Miscellaneous Papers, List of: 
anniversary address, Nov. 18, 1871; [on the 
organization and objects of the Soci- 
ety.] J. Henry. In full......0..... erseeedl V, 34 
on the preservation of foods. A. B. Eaton. 
Title O11 tarssnesssereereccvevee-ovonsse Seorecc re i 22 
[exhibition of a chronoscope.] J. E. Hil- 
gard. NO Adstract...cecreeseceeereee aapean asec R) Sos 
on the construction of the bridge across 
East River between Brooklyn and New 
York. Major King. Title only...........4 23 
on the new coinage of Japan. BH. B. Elliott. 
Title Only... cco sasccses tohbebectensacctes neers Ob 
on apothecaries’ weights and measures. 
B.F. Craig. Title only......00-00 RscenusesscR ga’ 
on the measurement of the pressure de- 
yeloped by the explosion of gun- 
powder in firearms. C. E, Dutton. 
Title onlafinsserersscrsrscessecersseeceervsccsservech 52 


158 


Page. 


Misceliasieaias Papers, List of—Cont’d. 
on the expenditure of the income of the 
Bache fund for 1872. J. Henry. Title 
Wifeitiecracanesnetan resets escceceoataceeeatserausabancnese i 
an account of some recent experiments on 
different kinds of gunpowder at Fort- 


ress Monroe. C. E. Dutton. Title 
vad Hestbccodencechecerhthr so neeeen ac erence i 
[the Woodbury photo-relief process.] J. 
J. Woodward. Abstract.......... cco | 
[the condition of the Society.] J. Henry. 
UNO GUSENECTS eeacseneeaetecsness reecscepenccceccen i 
on the water supply of cities. B. F. Craig. 
TULLE OU cnacsdacaseneyessednentonsscanatteres eteen i 
on the collection of a large library. J.S. 
Bilbings. * A Ustraebacsicccccacsssccservevsucect i 
a description of a new spirometer. G. A. 
Otisn Pitleondy Madvc.cesesotsscssareeses meter! 
on recent improvements in the economy 
of fuel. C. BE. Dutton. Title only...... i 


on recent improvements in the manufac- 


ture of steel. C.E.Dutton. Titleonly, 
i 
on Giffard’s injector. J. Henry. Title 


on the method adopted in writing the in- 
ternational scientific telegrams. A. 
PLU et AU SUMOCtaserarechspasenaeaeesaestesaarnsuse i 
{on scientific culture in the Argentine Re- 
public.] B.A.Gould. Wo abstract...ii 
on the present state of the sciences. C. 
W.Shields. Abstract and references...ii 
on the gathering, packing, transportation, 
and exposure of fruits for sale. 8. C. 
IBS OV es! SLU CON pin ccovarccvoracespestsassere ii 
on the failure of the wooden pavements of 
Washington City. L. D. Gale. <Ab- 


on latent impressions on polished glass 
plates produced by heating the plates 
in close connection with engraved me- 
tallic plates. A.C. Ross. Abstract...ii 
iron facing copper plates. J. E. Hilgard. 
CADEUT ACE. anancsatsnaceasss aenenn Speke nseaennestan gas ii 
the progress of the natural sciences dur- 
ing the past century. T. N. Gill. Ref- 
CRBC baneeneeuccustueescan sues veneurwuceew esata: sence ii 
cylinder condensation, steam jackets, and 
superheated steam. G. B. Dixwell. 
Title only... loose spaces 
the coinage of ‘tha Cee oatiae Hepatic. 
B. A. Gould. Communicated by E. B. 
FLUWOtt. ADSI ACE. .cccccvnnedsocscetnnssacassse fi 
the progress which [has] been made in 
educational matters in [Japan.] D. 
Murray. <AbdStract........000 


53 


54 


57 


64 


65 


92 


94 


96 


97 


99 


16 


26 


39 


42 


56 


64 


65 


69 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
Miscellaneous Papers, List of—Cont'd. 
illuminating materials. J. Henry. Title 
ON Mi .saeecasnssaciee Sanazegaassouacter saneneee sceecp UL 
[kerosene oil tests.] Mason. Ab- 
BUN AGEs sesoniekusssasesuacene Saasecssspenddeateterten i152 
paper made of asbestos. J. Hen Title 
OMMY scoccatavacsorenannnaseesssssaxaduaescetsatnaeaaegl ii 86 
the burning of theatres and public halls. 
‘J.M. Toner. Reference........ Seneursenein fi 95 


the rulings on glass by Mr. Rogers, of 
Cambridge. J.J.Woodward. Abstract, 

ii 130 
the uses of [the] dynagraph, and the work 
performed in determining the resist- 
ance of trains, ete. P. H. Dudley. Ab- 


BUT BC bccron nnoncen <encsseasionunperseauseessotgaateeaae iii 29 
phosphorescent clocks. J. E. Hilgard 
ADSUN GEE: voccsrssovasnasesonsssscuetseeeentegeeane lii 33 


the work of tho National Board of Health. 
J.S8. Billings. Title o7ly......ssscce--csskal BO 
[yellow fever disinfection.] F. M. Gun- 


nell. “ADStrack:. scocctcocsousessccertseteneeee fii 51 
{exhibition of a time globe.] -—— Juvet. 
ADSErOCb icc corscuscscsesnccenecscsane tettteee eee tii 106 
sugar from sorghum. P. Collier. Abstract, 
iii 140 
the scientific work carried on under the 
direction of the National Board of 
Health. J. S. Billings. Abstract, 
iv 37 


the history of the light house establish- 
ment of the United States. A. B. 
Johnson. Abstract and reference......4v 135 
relation of meteorological conditions to 
the summer diarrheal diseases. 5S. ©. 
Busey. Abstract and reference......... iv 165 
[exhibition of a panoramic photograph.] 
W..B. Taylor: Abstracti:..nassccsucesae ee 
[exhibition of coins and medals.] J. M. 
Toner. (ADStract....c.cessssacssanseestaeveaeenn v 22 
on the ventilation of the House of Repre- 
sentatives. J. S. Billings. Abstract, 
vw 99 
on the philosophical order of the sciences. 
C. W. Shields. Reference............ see v 105 
on the fisheries of the world. G. B. Goode. 
FEET ENCE....ccccscnononseee eisanemeas soeadeeeenaes Ww UT 
the cultivation of eucalyptus on the 
Roman Campagna. F. B. Hough. Ref- 
CT ENCE... .scevcee vededdnendecaeereaemnene astveun denne vi 36 
sketches from medallic medical history. 
W. Lee. Adstract.....ccccrscessscssssescssess Wk Oo 
fisheries exhibitions. G. B.Goode. Ref- 
CLENCE. ..ceceee Reecinascccenueceaxeue <sccess soonsn wil 26 
American scientific societies. A. Hall. 
Presidential address. In full..witd xxxiii, 30 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 
Miscellaneous Papers, List of—Cont’d. 
the systematic care of pamphlets. G. 
Brown Goode. Abstract and reference, 
vili 29 
the systematic care of pamphlets. C. V. 
PROMO Vi CAUSE EET se ccecvaassascssuaedsnexbas viii 29 


scientific men and their duties. J.S. Bill- 
ings. Presidential address. In full, 
ix xxxy, 46 


when I first saw the cholera bacillus. R. 
D. Mussey. Title only........c..00-..000004K 22 
the frequency of coincidences. L. F. 
WWE Cle EAL USEIEEL cccnscasssasvsssn.coessevesccssce x8 
Manchester meeting of the British Asso- 
ciation for the Advancement of Sci- 
ence, 1887. F. W. Clarke. Title only...x 19 
on reference indexing. B.P. Mann. Ab- 


stract....... Secnesyapseces Savadeses Pi cansecheeer PeLere x 38 
Mississippi delta.......... comphteceice Pp test ceeePees i (10) 
Missouri, Valley of the Upper........ gecaGastes wii 20 


Mivart, St. G., cited on life... ....cccccesscosee ee W 52 
Model of the basin of the Gulf of Mexico.iw 52 


Mohs, cited on mineralogy............ 2 rere Wehr) 
Molecular excursions........ bi o-ececoreceecehet vw 140, 141 
heats of similar compounds.............. aeekees i 104 
IRIWO PICS cc, sscccsasccsasesccoss accouectrensssoertoee cure WEE 
physies. See Physics. 
Molecules, atoms, and waves........ Renee amakee net i 66 
SIZO Oly sacsecnan<cc00 peeeabassn Satvent Sabesncenececrsta -v 141 


NECIRENTAL OCU, (Ole sscaxscsslcncssecesayeaseancacnnccace v 147 
Mollusks, Appendages of......... Pee DOE wil 32 
found at great depths................scesee aoe ult 
Observations ON..........ccccecsecocccese-ceccseeekd 75 
Two remarkable........s.... ae here senceesneses vili 5 
Moore, Commander, cited on Plover Bay..iw 124 
MESO ML MOOLYIOL -dersrsadsasessssssenaaarnecs iv 57, vi 136 
Moon’s eclipse of June 11, 1881................... v 90 
motion, Computation Of................ pn-cecnead vi 136 
Money, Gold and silver............... Weeeosasn iii 78, 107 
Mono Craters........ssseeee stnsauackendedvastessounczses vii 19 
Monochromatic aberration in aphakia.....wi 5 
sunlight as an aid to high definition........1 47 
MOOG AN TAGES. wcccessccscnesecestpoctsrncssasens 
More, Henry, cited on matter........ 
Morphology, Biologic.........00.0-sess 
of the antlers of the Cervide.................. 
Morse, E.S., cited on disparity of sexes in 
SILC CUMPA epwesednslcnanceese-eessaecntasecasccess iii (75 


Mortality among army officers.... 


statistics of the tenth census................1V 164 


Mosher, Experiments of ....... Pepe deg agua caane wii 40 
Mosler, cited on phosphorus and cerebral 

BRODLVELU ict cap onvessucecbacsesvecsenaca Rarmaetaneeac Ws»), 00 
MOSguito INOCUIATION.......ccsecccsssesesccasssesees wi 5 
Mosso, Plethysmograph of,......... epenceare aceave Win) tit, 
Motion, Laws of........ renee srocatee 


siiiecesee WEE OD 


159 


Page. 
Motion, Modes Of...........sssesseeseccssseeeee Wi XXXVIii 
of a particle toward an attracting centre, 


188, 1119, wii 122 
Transmutation of........ suvevsuscaperancsencss WE VIAL 
Mount Dana glacier......... 5 
Mount Lyell glacier. 6 
Mount Rainier and its glaciers........ aaecuneranoun LO 
Mount Taylor, Geology Of.........ccssseeeeseeees vii 77 
Mount Washington meteorological observa- 
LOUIS c-aascoenncenensenatane Sanaue sid aanuuawenssaeasens v 108 
Movement of storm centres 
Muivr’s glacier observations............ssssesees 


Munroe, C. E., communication on the esti- 
mation of manganese as pyrophos- 
phate. Read by T. Antisell. Reference. 132 

the determination of the specific gravity 
of solids by the common hydrometer. 


Lia PULUN cee at anccaesekecacedanees Ghovucavsecpsaneeee vi 26 
Murdoch, John, remarks on throwing- 
sticks..........006 MawestenconsdbNasavastececsrareras ix 13 


Murray, David, communication on the pro- 
gress which has been made in educa- 
ii 69 


tional mattersin Japan. Abstract.... 
Muscular Contraction,....c.cccccesssescessecensesse 
Museum, National a 
Museum specimens illustrating biology.. ix 35 
Music and the chemical elements........... vii 26 
Musical intervals........ arcaesen nacenavadehesasan seve did 199 
Mussey, R. D., communication on the appli- 

cation of physical methods to intel- 


lectual science. Abstract.......0....0 vii 18 
when I first saw the cholera bacillus. 
UGLE OU onannescasonavannnasentncestac¥etaasatanas ix 22 
remarks on artesian Wells.........c.cccseesesees v 101 
Phonetic alpHabetsi.....sccsatccssscascenccses ix 18 
Myer, A..J., Death Of..........sseessees abvecrsusnecsolW? sock 
Resolution on the death Of..,...........eeceeee iv 31 
Mythological dry painting of the Navajos, 
viii 14 
Mythology of the Numas...........sscssscorsssseenes i 96 
National Academy of Sciences............... vili xl 
National Board of Health, Scientific work by 
HG oe acus sezavecctte tears donates tcscceuccteeccses iv 37 
National Museum.... 41292, x 57 
Natural! Naturalists: ...cscsessscoscascusdescdaseeesse vii 73 
Navajo dry painting...........s.0eseree eatveoseed vill 14 
Nayal Observatory, New telescope of........4 62, 63 
SAV CACAO SUGs.. ccc cepcunccuscacssscususegoss cesses i 74 
Navigation, Sumner’s method in.............0 ii 105 
Nebraska, Quaternary of... 
Nebula of Andromeda........c.seeceeee 
Nebulae, Drawings Of........... sescess pa sedensuneens tay 
Planes of certain....... Saeints ease saudi) nosespevetons i 109 


Nebular hypothesis and the satellites of 
MarSer....2eseceeceesessesrecdd 186, 188, 190, WA 45 


160 


Page. 

Necks Of VOICANOES .eecssccecsscscsversessressscrees vil 78 
Nerve CUPLENtS...crrccssecccrsresceoseeee 60 
Névé and glacier defined.......... 37 
Nevada, Glacial epoch in... om 84 
Physical features Of.......cecessseressseeves aeiscues | O4 


Volcanic activity in .....crccccscrcscecccscerseet 99 
New Hampshire, Relation of winds to sea 

temperature on the coast Of.,........+++ 4i 17 

New Mexican volcanoes and lava-fields...wii 76 

ING W BEAK sis sctcccoaseusssassceapensanssanshecpunesa weneaaet 14 
Newberry, Dr. J. S., cited on fossil plants 

frOM Vir Pinder. sssseesscscees kanes 4i (38), (42) 
Newcomb, Simon, communication on the 
transits of Venus, past and future. 


TIDE ‘ONUY caivaspeseceasacces shuncsncoxss hsteheisesesl 29 
the possibility of a universal atmos- 
phere. Title only.....0seccccresers eakteae week 52 


the progress of the construction of the 
new telescope for the Naval Observa- 
tory. Reference... eosssoreeh 62, 63 
the proceedings of the commission to 
arrange for the observation of the next 
transit of Venus. Title only.....ccceeek 65 
the mechanical representation of a 
problem in least squares. Reference. 89 
the transit of Venus. Title only....c.0.0.dk 41 
u thermodynamic theory of the spec- 
trum. Title only.......++ shidtencasccoven iii 41, 43 
the cosmogony. Title Only.......cecse-e-ee-d 113 
the recent transit of Mercury [1878]. 


ee eeeeeneeeneeseee 


ADBSErGCE.ce..c0-osscvscccsceserssosccessceereccesses ii 199 
observations of the total solar eclipse, 
July 29,1878. ADStract...ccerceeesceeeeens Ai 202 


the recurrence ofeclipses. Titleonly.did 33 
a recent visit to California to inspect a 
site for the new Lick observatory. 
Title on ly....-.000+s spirit PAT enter ssoose Add = 45 
the future of the human race regarded 
from the standpoint of evolution. 
Presidential address,1879. Title only..did 52 
the principles of taxation. Title only, 
iii 119 
the relation of scientific method to so- 
cial progress. Presidential address, 1880. 


Tr FUlll...ceeveveese seduvevsebuceeh casadeanwsanehenss iv 40 
the speed of propagation of the Charles- 

ton earthquake. Reference.......-.sses x 28 

TEMALES ON AULOLAS....cecceceeseesccsee serene cesens i 46 

the radiometer......... Pinrarrertreceerc by ih 
passage of light through a narrow slit, 

iii 120 

AULTOLAS.serscccereereeeeeseerees aanpRewERAes iv 22 


Benjamin Peirce... Riristagmestxasmesed iv 26 
Newton, Henry, Researches in the Black 
Hill Dy... .ccccceseeree reese eecuseaveburdnte hace did 125 


Newton, Prof. H. A., cited on the aurora..iv 22 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 

Newton, Sir Isaac, cited on action at a dis- 
TANGO sccrcnovcdsscvcences co sssacebennsssseanesMeenariiey ieee 
atoms......... ose sdsars ae SAL 
elasticity sosondsauncge Len 
laws of orbits........... docctssacces Reet 
the spectrum............ cuee suqnvaueent Hie 
the ultimate............. coonssusssser AOU An 
trisection of angles......... a eecesee setoasvuckesecae out 
Newton’s rings.......... eehaeceow ented asvsomeaanevanne mkt 

Newtonian formula of gravitation, Modifica- 
LOMO Tpatedesnsasrenseon sobscedepaaoscbane WMRTnICRm 


PHILOSOPHY iii ce cccevessoccccnsocseucavenssspiasreantnaaanamm 
Niagara Falls, Earth tremors at..........s00e04W 186 
Nichol, J. P., Thermometric experiments 

of... be cuseucsueccusbossouustneiuwenssashititeimmntm 
Wehilaon) W. ni randnt “of the committee 
to collect information relative to the 
meteor of December 24th, 1873. In full. 
Map And 2 figures ..ececccece -seseceeccereseeshl 139 
remarks on the effect of magnetism on 
the length of magnetic bars............. Ad 373 
Nomogram......... canthenanemmaetean cocstsedessnstes aurea ana 
Normal section in geodesy........eeseceesereee Wh 123 
North American Indians, Errors respecting, 
4 175 
North Carolina coast, Geology Of.............Wk 28 
Earth quakes.....ccrccorccecsscseres oussspseeanel LOL g Oe 
Mich MINES: s::.....0..cevcassccccnsssuswasenshere teeta 
thermal belts adauabtavtpbeehay ks 
WAterSPpOUts.......00seeccercoesseers woonetie sen asanee ii 104 
Northers and magnetic disturbance........wil 25 
Nth-power numbers whose sum is an nth- 
POWEY...resccceee eocsccevecscsee cossseens ccscscnsngecde 100) 
Numas, Genesis and demonology of... 

Mythology of.......+.. Eaapsieha Niet Tapas 

Nymphalidae, Pupation Of.......:scceeceeceeees 


Objective, Interior angle of...... 
Achromatic...... assseuyelneveaateni sunacehe soosenevas Ray (OG 
Objectives, Color corrections to achromatic, 
iii 39 
Oil-iMMETSION....cereereeeeeeee scesesauseennee ae 
Oblateness of the earth, Change f TNs cesta viii 19 
Oblique illumination in microscopy.........dil 25 
Observation and experimentation, Princi- 
PlOS Of.cs0ccsscconsscceasssecovenssuessenssee LUNs e anna 
Observation equations, Special treatment of 
COYEATN ceccnsseosnssss ccdaccessccacessse A LOGs MRM 
Observations of the meteor of Dec. 24,1873..4% 144 
Occult force.........00.-cc0008 see WA Xxxiii 
QUGNIGIOS coos cesoccnccsssasouss cessnnserguay pep ecnvostnnW  aeen 
Oceanography, List of papers on: 
on the effects of winds and barometric 
pressure on the tid@s of Boston, and 
on the mean level of the sea. W. Fer- 
rel. Abstract and reference. ..rrccrereed 5d 


tone eeeeenee 


Se 


eS 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 
Oceanography, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
[letter on changes of sea-level at Ber- 
muda.] J.H. Lefroy. Communicated by 
 ELENTYs | VO) COBINGCU 0. .ctss0snccnnscnssnene a 75 
on the tides of the Bay of Fundy. Mr. 
Ramsay. Communicated by J. J.Wood- 
WOOT. P TREE ONUY <...0..5500cevoserccosursssoannc A 94 
Sumner’s method in navigation. J. H.C. 
OEE g PIE IU Elasconessasssdnescccevsuncoss sesseon 44 105 
the navy compass. B. F. Greene. Title 


an adjustable binnacle for the correction 
of a ship’s compass. B. F. Greene. 


TUTPOGNoccctnosccaacsssasccs|seosescnseseoeecesnse ii 134 
optical salinometer. J. E. Hilgard. <Ab- 

BUMECUaasencadssesene sess sersSe neers Eearaauehs di 185 
temperatures of the Pacific Ozean. T. 

ADMISEMS ADSINACTi i. ..scnecssccocccccccecone ii 192 


the deepsea dredgings in the Gulf of Mex- 
ico and the West Indies in 1873-1878, 
by Professors Louis and Alexander 
Agassiz and the officers of the U.S. 
Coast Survey. W.H. Dall. Title only, 
iti 45 
on Siemens’ deep sea thermometer and 
Carré’s ice machine. J. E. Hilgard. 


Title OnM ef c...0scccececeee Sivcsasupviedaterssaussseces v 100 
some eccentricities of ocean currents. A. 
BS JORNSON. AGSENACL ccaceccsscccosseds vii 14 


historical sketch of deep sea temperature 


observations. J. H. Kidder. Title 

PO a erereonriserenaevvedt deepraseiccacnas-ser---usesace ix 14 
Odor, Theory of....... osavenescsbatecvecasgu: cecetes vill 27 
Office, Rotation in..........cecceeseee aaencastesuantecnt v 49 
Officers, Duties of. (See Standing Rules.) 


for 1871 
1872... 


v 14, 85, 112 


SES ries paces cusuavrssenessecevsianesst v 175, vi xiv, 41, 122 
Hispitacnsasecctnnccescececsnhcacseees vi xv, vii xiv, 36, 85 


of the Army and Navy as scientific admin- 
ISLLAON A se ocstseusaseuncudoas sn “esheosh nackeces ix xlix 


57 


161 


Page. 
Ogden, H.G., communication on What is to- 
POPTAUDY CAUSE UC laacscsecccccasceecvecceses x15 
Oil-immersion objectives... oa did 25 
Oldberg. R., The Flora Goremnbiana of .....iw 65 
Omaha Indians, Gentile system of............ iii 128 
Omar Cheyam, Calendar proposed by........ ii 38 
Onatsevich, Lt. M. S., Co-ordinates of Plover 
Biyp Dye. ceonarccmesneanecenarecossesesnscs sovsenast iv 128 
Ontario Basin, Changes of level in............ ix 8 
Ophthalmology. (See Optics.) 
Optical salinOmetercececectscsssectecckssecs acovcce ii 185 
Optics, List of papers on (see also Micros- 


copy): 
on a new method for detecting and 
measuring the optical defects of the 


eye. W. Thomson. Reference............ i 22 
on achromatic object glasses. R. Keith. 

AWULE OT) Saasascacssosseusccssrsaesesessenecestorets i 73 
{exhibition of spectra and spectroscopes.] 

J.J.Woodward. Wo abstract............ i 89 
half-vision. J. Henry. Title only........... ii 60 
the markings on Navicularhomboides. J. 

J. Woodward. Title only..........c0.s00 li 69 
the color corrections of achromatic object- 

ives. W. Harkness. Abstract......... iii 39 
a thermodynamic theory of the speetrum. 

8. Newcomb. Title only............++ iii 41, 43 


some apparatus recently brought into use 
by the medical department of the 
Army for the examination of the eye. 

J. J. Woodward. Abstract.............+. fii 53 
the number of lenses required in an ach- 
romatie objective, consisting of infi- 
nitely thin lenses in contact, in order 
that, with any given law of dispersion 
whatever, the greatest possible num- 
ber of light-rays of different degrees 
of refrangibility may be brought to a 
common focus. W. Harkness. Jn 

SUllvcconasecee wyewesssestscaverssnocassusnssscsoussssskil 6D 
the modificatious suffered by light in pass- 
ing through a very narrow slit. A. A. 

Michelson’, “ADStrAChcssencsctaccsacrecess iii 119 
color perception and color blindness. S. 
M. Burnett. Abstract and reference, 

iv 54 
refraction in the principal meridians of a 
triaxial ellipsoid, regular astigmatism 
and cylindrical lenses. §S. M. Burnett. 

PREPEPETICE ssceatessnaeccurs aceeepenardnioeecnons vi 4 
the monochromatic aberration of the 
human eye in aphakia. W. Harkness. 

FROLOTONEE ee cvacestcdcatteddeorenctscace erecta wi 5 
the character of the focal lines in astig- 
matism. S. M. Burnett. Abstract, 

wi 45 


162 


Page. 
Optics, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
why the eyes of animals shine in the dark. 
S. M. Burnett. Abstract and reference, 


vii 13 
the Javal and Schidtz ophthalmometer. 
S.M. Burnett. Title only.........000. viii 11 


on a device for viewing the sun by light 
of any desired wave length. W. Hark- 


NESS. - ADSEACE....seeereereere aiuapWabereventeuad x).13 
Orange Mountain, N. J........+00 aueduenenene viii 19 
Orbit of comet, Correction Of.........ss0--ee+ fi 22 

Hyperion....... cesdaaae paced aneniacte pas x 90, 104 
Swift's COMOEciccsicscecssscnsccuvostcccnscsseress iv 59 
Orbits illustrated by models............«+ sbasade x 28 
of Titan and Hyperion......... Meaeannney acne iii 26, 40 
Special case in elliptic........0..ceccceseeee: wii 122 
Ore deposition by replacement............++++ vi 32 
Organization of the Society............ iv, 19, 20, 21 
OTEROCONTOL aos: cuncits us duaccenssoundscsncnrescrrsnseos viii 47 
Osborne, J. A., cited on the pupation of the 
Nymphalida............sccccsssesseees Prorerret  2 ul 


Osborne, J. W., communication on a new 
meteorological instrument. Abstract, 

ii 63 
the study of meteorology in regard to 


the causes of yellow fever. Title only, 
did 21, 27 

a curious manifestation of force by the 
WING: D406 ONY svessccsasnessatasusensnovenas fii 27 

a case of peculiar corrosive action on 
metallic tin. Title only......cciceecoeseee dd 44 
remarks ON AUTLOTAS,....... «+46 bavsnevanat vated iv 22 

Otis, G. A., Biographical sketch of 

Bibliography Of...........++ Maonctasddeunatsetncate iv 181 

communication on fractures of the inner 
table of the cranium. Title iit rea i 73 
anew spirometer. Title only... corel 94 
TVG at Sc aaeretscesanubene covscscaduenseuenanauessdaaeae iv 120 
Resolutions on the death of L seabentusadeieuaien iv 134 


Ox-eye daisy a3 an insecticide.........00. Wd 12 


Pacific Ocean, Temperatures and currents 
Olszeossivknsrnaiscametss ep rreoreer etree agesesassh 102 

Painting with dry colors............... cccocseeWhid 14 

Paleontology. (See Zoology and Botany.) 


Pamphlets, Care of... 
Papers read to the Society. (See Acoustics, 
Anatomy, Anthropology, Archeology, 
Astronomy, Biography, Biology, Botany, 
Calendars, Chemistry, Electricity, Geog- 
raphy, Geology, Mathematics, Meteor- 
ology, Microscopy, Mineralogy, Miscella- 
neous, Oceanography, Optics, Physics, 
Political Economy, Psychology, Seis- 


cocceegeocscceneeces vili 29 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
mology, Social Science, Thermometry, 
Zoology.) ° 

Statistics of the Society’s............ ssenbeceacene OG 
Papyrus Ebers........ sscseosseneshk 04 


Parallax of a auri.ci.ccse-cess aaeecnanveta osbaccaseate x Dt 
Methods of MeasuTiNG.......-ssessseeceeeee erie.) 
Parker, Peter, communication on the me- 
teor of December 24, 1873. Wo ab- 
BUNGEE cvevosaes asuactadaabatangere re 
Joseph Henry. In full cosccsceseccosececsersi Ah GUS 
remarks on Chinese vocabularies...........44 28 
calendars........... sevenssea vaacnseseunaetete soenep hh it 
electrical treatMent.....cccrrecccsscseccsecsreoshs 40 
origin of the American Indiansg............41 94 
report of the committee to collect infor- 
mation relative to the meteor of De- 
cember 24th, 1873. In full. Map and 


2 SUGUT CS sasnsssssracuevesasas oo shasnesunsansepeine eee 
resolutions on the death of Salmon P. 
CHASE..;.cnccccvevossnsncssnsreeeet sasseauecake anasenh TST) 
Patterson, H. N., cited on the flora of Illi- 
yo Barre dos sonscausceusers acasseussenyeneaeneniee nina 
Paucker, Prof. M. G., cited on Malfatti’s 
problem.......... ooceesasess suesdscuueusesetesereaan ne nneas 


Paul, H. M., communication on earth trem- 
ors as shown by astronomical observa- 
tions.  ADSETACT......00scccceses sesccacntsarcesanl aan 
problems connected with the physics of 
the earth’s crust. Title only......wiid 17, 18 
the Flood Rock explosion. Title only, 
vill 28 
the Charleston earthquake. Abstract.ix 41 
TEMAS ON SUN ZlOWSsc.cccsserscccceseceseesWAk 3D 
earthquakes....... ....00e ececsseesncesese VA Cones 
the topophone.........000 oousenonccsaasavspse Wma Enea 
dry painting by the Japanese........... Will 16 
time determinations........... cagsaneas «Wii 58 
PTAPNICS i siscsecasne sosasuaadaunaeaee sanassennansdes deceiae 
Pavemeuts, Failure of WoOdeN.........000+0----dd 26 
Peale, T. R., Death. Of..cccscssccssscccsscscusesssa Maan 
Peirce, Benjamin, cited on curves similar 
to their CVOlULCS,......c:sescccssesescesneeus vii 87 
communication on the heat of the sun. 
Abstract....... wdsaesonecadses! 'aodpreesenvan yi aeeaaEm mma 
the theories of the nature of comet’s 
tails. Reference........ 
PIOBEN OF; cccsssvssvesssurguasences 
Remarks commemorative Of 23 
Resolutions on death of............: avesnuousso sR Win lomh 
Peirce, C. S., cited on verification of predic- 
tions....... preanneweneden aus osseusenaeseusupten Wa Lam 
communication on the appearance of 
Encke’s comet as seen at Harvard Col- 
lege Observatory. References 35 
stellar photometry. Referencé........00004 63 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 
Peirce, C. S., communication on—Cont’d. 
the coincidence of the geographical dis- 
tribution of rain fall and illiteracy, as 
shown by the statistical maps of the 
ninth census reports. Abstract...... wok 68 
logical algebra. Reference... aA 88 
quaternions, as developed from the gen- 
eral theory of the logic of relatives. 


Title Only........c00c00 Reeentinnchtnaccacesceasenes i 94 
various hypotheses in reference to 
BAGO. LUE ONUY-ceancancecaesuccseiscencojcncues i 97 
Peirce’s criterion........ facaaten SeNagnaadsasaderasees wi 155 
Pendulum formule ............222eeeeseeeeeee: vii 89, 101 
Perception of color, form, and light......... vil 72 
Periodic integrals......... essere sped stesnacssi LOO 


law of the amical elements. een Wad 15 
Permian formation of North Miiorica, sua 67, 104 
PACU STATE CHL OTG AI necsgavnroxveasades abaesesvosen scien ii 38 
Perturbations of moon’s motion, Computa- 

tion of..... sess WA 136 


Polyhymnia by Jupiter...........ssecsee vili 54 
Peru, Meteorology Of..........s++ apsacedncaaendncnee di 35 
Peters, Prof. C. H. F., cited on supposed 

trans-Neptunian planet...........0.00- iii 20 
letter on transit of Venus, 1874. Commu- 
nicated by A. Hall. Abstract... .s000 ii 31 
Petrographic methods...........+ ceeuerececehense vil 36 
Phenomena, Physical basis Of.............00008 vii 40 
Philosophical Society of Washington.....wiil xlv 

BERS HUO Rtctacissssdesstess-ssccccsaceescsacsecsensece x 47 

why this name was Chosen......00.e000 iv,x45 
Peel DRUG Eacccvaceraceecseccsiscsesenesecsiecsecs ix 17 
Phosphorescent clocks....... aohtantcocte ecard iii 33 
Phosphorus and cerebral activity......... coos tO 
PHOtO-ENYraAviNg.......0sseeesseees crecett bere mcocaedy SAD: 
Photographie panorama......... Reeeeenes parenausara v 21 


Photographing the sun’s corona........... sseeddd 117 
transit of Venus, 1882............ Bape dtsaneabse vi 21 
Photographs of transit of Venus, 1874........ ii 31 
Photography as an aid to astronomy...........4 28 
ATIC LO LOSCATCH....c-cosursscusseventesnesen ee eal 
COMPOSIEC. 0.0. ccrreeseecsece 25 
Photometry, Stellar 63 
PAU MOUOsstansascveces tcoasaccnashacscaasstateccenescas iv 143 
PTT SIS pespuynesucednewseresecenssos's stecuatateprentenateasss ii 124 


Physical geography. 
Geology.) 
Physical-geographical divisions of the south- 
eastern portion of the United States, 
ix 22 
Physical investigations by Joseph Henry..ii 271 
method in intellectual sciences...........wid 18 
Physics, List of papers on (see also Acous- 
tics, Optics, Electricity) : 
on the nature and origin of force. W. B. 
Taylor. Abstract and referencés...00ved 27 


(See Geography and 


163 


Page. 
Physics, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
on the fatigue of metals. Major King. 


STN iE OT escecusesunshedsesisiascesaseonsiacsasss accent i 53 
on waves, molecules, and atoms. W. B 
PRA VIO AASCE CCl aroccssedecusesacesccavacconses i 66 


on the rectilinear motion of a particle 
toward an attracting centre. A. Hall. 
BefErence.re...00000 ainaatosctenckacearparcen ators i 88 
on the motion of a particle sony an at- 


tracting centre. H. H. Bates. Title 

ON Y..0.canceoeee aungsenpeuneateaueeintcenede auseers sae i 89 
on the nature of the force of gravitation. 

R. Keith. Title only........0.000 Seeeweaovesne i 89 


on a method of developing magneti-m in 
bars of steel. J. Henry. Title only, 
i 97 
on the movement of a particle attracted 
towards a point. H. H. Bates. Ab- 
SUP CU tence stave cscs erccccweusedarcecnscenanayeachave ii 19 
a method of determining a definite inter- 
val of time, and its application to meas- 
uring the number of vibrations of solid 
bodies. A.M. Mayer. Title only......i1 64 
Crookes’ radiometers. J. Henry. ,Ab- 
Str ACT. ...000. Seca seareesucdl) OO 
forceand momentum. E.B. Elliott. Title 
OTUs cccasncosensasae Guvpsscesancscesescquscesdeudsacs ii 84 
a thermodynamic theory of the spectrum. 
S. Newcomb. Title only........... .-» Adi 41, 43 
vortex motion in ordinary fluids. T. 
CEAIS POPES CMRCEcccaveedcececectucverssaaeces tii 143 
curious fallacy as to the theory of gravita- 
tion. B. Alvord. Jn full....sccscccscevsees ve 85 
on physics and occult qualities. W. B. 
Taylor. Presidential address. In full, 
v 125, 126 
J. W. 
In full, 
vi xxvii, 110 
H. H. Bates. Ref- 


se ccareerecesesesresceeseses 


the three methods of evolution. 
Powell. Presidential address. 


the nature of matter. 


OT ENLCEs accsevacesucetssunossdtcacsssahes oacuveceveves wi 5 
substance, matter, motion, and force. M. 
H. Doolittle. Title only..........0.00seeeee vi 14 


the atomic philosophy, physical and meta- 
physical. J. C. Welling. Presidential 
address. In full....... Panta soe Wii XXix, 81 
music and the chemical elements. M. H. 
Doolittle. Abstract ....csc.s.ss00s00es Wid 26, 27 
review of the theoretical discussion in 
Prof. P. G. Tait’s ‘‘ Encyclopsedia Brit- 
annica” article on mechanics. 4H. 
Farquhar. <Abstract...........s000 ccorece WAR 29 
the physical basis of phenomena. H. H. 
Bates) av fist cac.coceaceuerccessensecesucevs vii 40 
a formula for the length of a seconds- 
pendulum. G.W. Hill. Reference..vii 101 


164 


Page. 


Physics, List of papers on—Cont’d. 

a slight modification of the Newtonian 
formula of gravitation. W. B. Taylor. 
PAIGBIT CT Ace ecrseissucccensineianeesdpsestasspnWAae G0 

Can the attraction of a finite mass be infi- 


nite? C.H.Kummell. Jn full.....viti 58 
Newton's vis. M. H. Doolittle. Title only, 
x 38 


the free cooling of a homogeneous sphere 
initially heated to a uniform tempera- 
ture. R.S. Woodward. Reference.....x 90 
the conditioned cooling of a homogeneous 


sphere. R.S. Woodward. Reference.x 103 
Physics of the Mississippi river........ situs ara i (13) 
Pied Mont regiON..rscesooccenssnersccssesscerscaersnsned& 24 
Pile Of Dall Sicvcecapcascnnsnabencas'sansnets Receeeu cpeseense iii 76 
Piles bored by teredo.......c0.ceeeersenessenveeeeeeee 
PISCicultUre........0secocreeeeeeccseeees 
Plains, Artesian wells on the... 

Plane curves, Contact Of.........:sscccssereeceeees 
Planet, Centre of apparent disk of............ ii 181 
search for intra-Mercurial...........-s-seseeee ii 85 
supposed discovery of a trans-Neptunian, 
iii 20 
Planetary mass determined from two satel- 
MTGE Sieuphsdgapessnsnss mac oveusduarusheanuneane Sansuae vi 132 


motion as affected by meteoric matter, 
ii 188, 189, 190 


AVS OLIOTIS Soevesvavenvscudescecanteadsansensseecenen iii 26, vi 41 
perturbations of the MOON.........sceesesseeee vi 136 
Planets, THEOTY Of: ...scccess-neaasecessaesccsonacsans iv 57 
Plants, Climate Of.....c.sosscereccssnsscsvacconsosssnnes ii 183 
ON Roan Mountain............000 recess seccescceves iv 63 
IPIRGEAIO PION sccveccunacsunasstessausand haasten 155, wii 76 
Plato cited on philosophy..........sseeeee+e vii xxxvi 
PlethySMOgraphs.......cccceccccccrseccscesnneseesseese We ad 
Pleurotomaria, Notch in shell of............... iii 76 
(PIOVET BY, AOS KA, terccrachcseradsvnuokbescoauneunsne iv 124 

Plucker, Prof. J.,cited on Malfatti’s ; problem 
ii 118 


Plumb-line deflection...i4 82, wii 92, 101, ix 15, 53 
Poggendorf corrections in thermometry..ix 29 
Poinsot, Louis, cited on impact of inelastic 


IDO GUOR. csadesnascaadsccssseusen pasiaeeabanen tone ten v 131 
POISONEA BILTOWS......eceeeccececees seseescseeeces 411180, 182 
Poisson cited on temperature of space.....ki 75 
Polar EXPeditionn.........cseereererenene asasvokinmassans ii 89 
Polaris expedition..,....... MigudhkGcossupaasaesasarans i 92 
Polarization of light by a narrow slit..d% 119, 124 
Pole, Shifting of the earth’s.......-.sseessse viii 10 


Political Economy, List of papers on: 
on the statistics of the borrowing power of 
the United States. E. B. Elliott. Title 
ONY nreo0scnsseecaccsvnesee Daasachoncneaisastcstianmceddan i 29 
on international coinage. E. B. Elliott. 
Title only... PR Wire) 


aaenet nem nerieee 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON 


Page. 

Political Economy, List of papers on— 
Cont'd. 

[chonge in value of dollar.] E. B. Elliott. 

Vo abstract......... orssapes ere: 
on the credit of the United States, as 
shown by the value of its securities. 

E. B, Elliott. Title onlyy......00+000seeeeeeek 109 
on the transition in Germany, and the 
Seandinavian nations of Sweden, Nor- 
way, and Denmark, from the silver 
standard of coinage and money of ac- 
count to a gold standard. E. B, Elli- 

Obbesistinsescsnenesreree Syn pseussusushaeensp eee 
the mutual relations as to price of gold, 
silver bullion, silver coin, and green- 

backs. E. B. Elliott. Title only....... ii 50 
mutual relation as to price of gold, green- 
backs, silver bullion, and silver coin. 

E. B. Elliott. In full....... ake rapeee area ii 52 
two propositions, now before Congress, for 
changing the coin of the United States. 

E. B. Elliott. Title only....c..00c00e004k 68 
monetary standards. E. B. Elliott. Title 

ONY. cccccceess sasnsvessndaden tenes paspasaanenaaiaeae li 85 
mutual relations of gold and silver, and of 
prices of commodities. E. B. Elliott. 


seens ee eeneseereeees 


ADSUV ACL. aicccssusssccancosaspenens Bearers coc ii 87 
optional monetary standards. E. B. Elli- 
‘ott. Title Onl tp.csccccscscepssoses sdasaus cots nanete BneTEM 


the progress of international coinage in 
France and America. E. B. Elliott. 
Title OM ...-0--c0csescconceosesoesssgncessneivepesee mien 

the subject of international coinage. E. 


B. Elliott. Abstract. ..o.ccsse-sscsdssesiupten annie 
the silver question. ©. E. Dutton. In 

Ft Ul enwswene) cota tasstnveanannan Heer ay iii 78 
the silver question. Symposium. <Ab- 

BEPC esas aavbhsonos vnsstavarseeserenl Ssokpensh epee bh hiv 


the construction of the Government sink- 
ing fund. E.R. Elliott. Abstract...4it 113 
the principles of taxation. S. Newcomb. 
TUtle ONY ...cascsassssaes avbabsneaaive wannCUnernnts iii 119 
the distribution of loans in the Bank of 
France, the national banks of the 
United States, and the Imperial Bank 


of Germany. J. J. Knox. Abstract, 
iv 32 

[bi-metallism.] E. B. Elliott. Abstract, 
iv 141 


accrued interest on Government securi- 
ties. E.B. Elliott. Title only..........W 21 

on the credit of the United States, past, 
present and prospective. E, B. Elliott. 
Title only... decia shies hap cose ccccsese sesereeW 102 

on some formule relating to Government 
securities. E.B. Elliott. Title only...w 106 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-x. 


Page. 
Political Economy, List of papers on— 
Cont'd. 
the distribution of tho surplus money of 
the United States among the States. 


Je Je KNOX, ADSUFACE ....-..-000000 nissasacoWe LOG 
a financial problem. E.B. Elliott. Title 
MID ietrctnunttenesacane=sshesussececeeerccenecsscees vi 149 


annual profit to banks of national bank 
note circulation. E. B. Elliott. Title 
PU asec cevesasssancene Poatueseasanessenncesscsesees ix 14 

quantity of United States subsidiary silver 
coin existing and in circulation. E. 


B. Elliott. Title only........0+ Rersnccceasce ix 14 
Polyhymnia, Perturbations of........ weeasee vill 54 
Poncelet, cited on Feuerbach’s circle....wili 45 
Population, Animal, of the globe............... iv 27 

of the earth.......... ldscate Maepceaseagaaed Sat reanaees iv 28 
Westward movement: Of............sssssesscseeses i 35 


Porter, ——, communication on recent ex- 
plorations in Syria under the auspices 
of the Palestine Exploration Fund. 


Title only.......00 neeeene oct pas caeuaes aateenedt) D4. 
Porter, Miss S., cited on the instruction of 
GIVGVAGAT cccecasccesuess eapastudesare duccdasces aan vi 81 
Porter, R. P., cited on statistics of sheep..iv 28 
Portrait of S. F. Baird........ Sea sveaseeey anecue’cnres x 41 
of Joseph Henry ....4i frontispiece. 
Potato rot........ abUpoecctuencccnacsecraccteunnceracccucssscs i 97 
Pouillet, cited on temperature of space.....ii 73 
Pouillet’s formula for rate of cooling...... naw OL 


Powell, J. W., communication on the struct- 
ural geology of the valley of the Colo- 
rado of the West. ADStract......ss00....0 i 48 

the mythology of the Numas. Refer- 
ENCE... 0000 foeenes eadecsaten) ce =noss Rabessesearnecunvnd i 96 
the genesis and demonology of the 
Numa tribe of Indians. Reference.....4 104 
the Uintah Mountains. Title orly...... ii 34 
the causes of the glacial climate. Ab- 
BATE E cances ven chavs Manentaedatsveeliuvcweceo'dscons di 44, 45 
some types of mountain building. Title 
OT sateen adecnevisanevas ace Sadatuetdaniivertcear cerdacc ii 65 
monoclinal ridges. Abstract...........0 wit 74 
life of Archibald Robertson Marvine. In 
[filllstennaceisbaatan) sasuvssacaceuseavervets seuss .li 83, (53) 
geologists versus physicists. Vo abstract, 
fi 85 
the philosophy of the North American 
Indians. Title only.......s0000.-seeeeee4d 109, 110 
poisons among the North American In- 
ATATAB) SAUDSITOCL.nsacecsade stecantecnnescevouecd ii 182 
the lands of the arid region of the United 
MbATOSs) “ADS E Chae )..ccclseroceonsetersseses «sli 189 
the evolution of language. Title only.ii 199 
limitations to the use of some anthro- 
pologic data. Reference............6 eek 134 


165 


Page. 
Powell, J. W., communication on—Cont’d. 
the three methods of evolution. Presi- 
dential address. In full....... «Wi xxvii, 110 
plan for the subject bibliography of 
North American geologic literature. 


Title only....... NesSupeakikessabase ekanesaeseecs vii 71 
the personal characteristics of Professor 
Baird. In full .....c00 peeitectnastees prea tyre oars l 


remarks ON AULOLAS.......008- 
voleanism in Arizona and Nevada.........4 99 


distribution of voleanie action............... i 102 
the vocabulary of the Utes.............s000 ii 28 
Fipple MAVIKS!. ses svaceccaceseetees 
khivas....... Sound edaschus/rsdwudeusevudaxseecccdessuces: ii 66 
Tan@slipilalse stirs cccsteciaceccseseteors 


interior of the earth..........s00. 


mounds as evidence of population...... ii 181 
western Permian strata.....ssssesscseecoeees iii 106 
organization of primitive society........ ili 137 
plants of Washington and vicinity......iw 119 
RUTOLAS....00 seifancuse spect Rorecenes CoeckRCMmOAccect iv 22 
uniformity of peak altitudes in the Ap- 
Palachiang.:.ccc:..cccseccceese eae ES iv 64 
force and vital principle.......... .......000 v 104 
eruption and elevation..........ccce.e-ees vi 92, 93 
drainage system Of LOWS.....sse.cccccscessecseses vi 97 
glaciers... dan deapasvausoascctccaessersccatscs vii 8 
distribution of volcanic eruption...... vii 79 
Precession and terrestrial rigidity......... 1177, 78 
Precipitation measured at different heights, 
ii 49 
Preece, cited on photophonic experiments, 
iv 149 
radiophony......... aecascocussnce ecareutncseccer iv 183 
Predictions of weather and their verifics- 
tion....... sbvaslunescesuaved taeeests sseeeee Wid 122, Vill 8 


Presidential address. See Address. 

Pressure and temperature, Diurnal changes 
Of eS Ia are jie are ie ee ii 67, 69 

Prevost’s theory of exchanges 

Price, cited on infinite attraction...........wili 58 

Price-Edwards E., cited on refraction of 


SOUM Gites svencsttcoviec cacatece ecidusshactusateassee iv 137 
Prices of gold, greenbacks, and silver....... di 52 
Probabilities, Meteorologic...........c.c0ceseeee v 122 


Problem concerning Spheres.......00..ccccceeeee v 107 
IN ANCIAIS avaceh cesserccevecs one 


Problems in geometry......... Ai 55, 64, v 88, 107, 
vi 157, vili 45, x 96 

Proctor, Richard, cited on the zodiacal light, 
i (20), (22) 
Prodromus Methodi Mammalium........... e+e (3) 


166 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
Prognostication for the winter of 1882-83....w 122 
PYOOLCH OCC. sccisteaacoserntoehesscheessesaavresngoncdencue vi 123 
IPYOURGON Gs. dvarcesicaenrocnsiotriatyoaes ss UecceenW ado 


Protoplasm, Possibilities Of.............sssseeeeeeW 102 
PAY GHICHUSOSBALC Hs cos tcssvsccauscvscvecscesensssentnark | | G 
PSY CHGLOPY cictsssasscescses Resavectaetcands qua seuesanaeeay v 72 
Psychology, List of papers on: 
on logical algebra. C. S. Peirce. Refer- 
BVMME ec tanancnsnseatavospanssnne nlgdeueakechoppeeer beeen i 88 
on. the number of words used in speaking 
and writing. E. S. Holden. In full, 
Ai 28, (16) 
unconscious cerebration. E. M. Gallaudet. 


Title only. ..cee- coerce Raeaaaanenanaenusaanaeras ii 48 
dreams in their relation with psychology. 
E. J. Farquhar. Abstract..........csse00 vi 37 


the atomic philosophy, physical and meta- 
physical. J. C. Welling. Presidential 
Address. In fUlli....cccccesennsseeoes vii xxix, 81 
the application of physical methods td in- 
tellectual science. R.D.Mussey. Ab- 
BENGACT kes vay sade ceausnenccusuosivmmcesbunsspxanhiss vil 18 
Are there separate centers for light-, form-, 
and color-perception? S.M. Burnett. 
Abstract and reference....cecerseerevceseee vii 72 
recent experiments on reaction time and 
the time sense. G.S. Hall. Title 


1s ERE ROSE AEE See SERIES vili 4 
modern ideas of brain mechanism. F. 
Balers: < Title Onyy ics: accessor ckeocesesers viii 17 


anthropometric and reaction-time appa- 
ratus. J.S. Billings and W. Matthews. 


Abstract......00 Sourccebrenecn suvenuieeeee Wild = 25 

an attempt at a theory of odor. F. W. 
Clarke. “ADStrackisiieckecisescscesaecssess viii 27 

the frequency of coincidences. L. F. 
Ward. Abstract......... auaeutenecars meaner x's 
Psychrometer, Sling.....,...0000 “eevee viii 25 


Publication of mathematical papeeas -vi 115, 135 
of bulletin. See Bulletin. 

Publications of scientific societies...wiii xxxvii 
the Philosophical Society...........0secssee x 114 

Pumpelly, Prof. R., Researches on sewage in 

ROU SsOseteevece civapanacvstacicevnssarsauneepecence 
Pupation of the Nymphalidz 
Pyrethrum powder. .ccr.ccoserseees 


Pythagorean philosophy... ........:seeeeee 
Quadrature of Circle........ssecccessseeeeee Baeecaree i 57 
Quadratiures, APPrOXiMALC..........00ssscee-ceees ii 48 
Quadric transformation of elliptic integrals, 
vii 102 
Quaternary climate of the Great Basin...... wv 21 
deposits of western Iowa and eastern Ne- 
DTS. s weve sepvancsanasaareveresiaaveuedencssavecs iv 120 


of the middle Atlantic slope... ..........s00000. 16 


Page. 
Quimby, Prof., cited on the aurora of Feb. 
WAL Sto canandava seni Da vcctasssssancexeny seumnannees Ae 


Quotients of space-directed lines.........x 105, 106 


Radcliffe, C. B., cited on muscular contrac- 


GION sso capseeneosabsestessunteees 
Radiometer......... 
Radiophony ty 143, 183 
Railroad levellings and their hypsometrie 
VHLNGry.wcessesssaccers pananertesusssuntie cbisaw cate ene 
trains, Resistance Of.........0. 29 
Rain-fall and illiteracy 68 


Rain-gauges at different elevations...........4 49 
Rainier and its glaciers.......:ccccsessscsssssesssssKy AO 
Ramsey, ——, letter on die wee of ‘the. Bay 
of Mundy: Communicated by J. J. Wood- 
ward. Title only...... 00006 uacsoaseaeaneeeaal i 94 
Rankine, W. J. M., cited on reconcentration 
OL GENCY Lc. sssccussenccsersecsvuscecucmecueaeane spec We Laas 
Ratio of circumference to diameter............ i 57 
Ravené, Gustave, communication on the as- 
teroids. Title only ........sss000--00e- Wii 18, 54 
the theory of Mercury. Abstract.....wili 41 
Rayleigh, Lord, cited on sound produced by 
HOB scesteesoansepetscdesdey tasaxeeee eee iv 150, 183 
Raymond, C. W., communication on the re- 
sults of travels in Alaska and the de- 
termination of the position of Fort 
Yukon. Communicated by T. L. Casey. 
BESET EN CEss. oacive vvecsueue souvesiesncarucuuaselltenmenym anaes 
letter on traneit of Venue 1874. Conn J 
nicated by A. Hall. Abstract.............d4 31 
Reaumur cited on the pupation of the Nym- 
phalidee....... ieacnhosadecden ss countne as aetna did 41 


Reed, Henry, communication on the physi- 


ology of civilization. Title only......iif 20 
Reference indexing......... secthsuuexaasgheesteaaiem x 38 
Refraction in the principal meridians of a 

triaxial ellipsoid.............csssse» scuemuaeed wi 4 

Of SOMME wrctassceacsesvensens 41 57, 167 (48), v 35, 39, 44 
Uncertainty of correction for atmos- 

DTIOLIG vvsenscoosscocsactoanenvasccecetiee eaten i 69 
Rejection of doubtful observations........... wi 152 
Religion and science...... auben ss censeneeeneenee 11 16, 224 
Removal of place of meeting......... X xxxi, 10, 31 
Remsen, Prof. Ira, Researches on impure air 

[DVirsiscatese <euaupeulonusasseonseahneueteeseammne acca Be) 
Report of committee to collect information 

relative to the meteor of December 


PAT, W8T3iccnsccdsvocscsseueceausd duunenapecncentam ii 139 
Representation of comet orbits by models, 

x 28 

Research, Endowment of........ sananen eeeeeee Wha Xl 

Method of ci cscccaseceennd ii 163, iv 40, wii li, x 4 

Resistance of railway trains... 28..........00- fli 29 

Resisting Medium in Space..............eserees 134, 39 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 

Resolution on acceptance of membership, 
iii 149 
NUACItINgG COMMILELCE......cssscereeesseeensenvenes vi 84 
committees on mathematical papers..vi 135 
discovery of the satellites of Mars........ ii 186 
resigned and dropped members.......... “Vv 84 
GRSES GALLE Wem N'e? st aconsacescdlsenicevss seu sees 104, XK 46 
providing for presidential address......... iv 30 


Resolutions of the International Geodetic 
Commission en unification of longi- 


tudes and time....... epaeseea ensebacsuonersst vi 107 
on the death of L. AgassiZ......secceeces cee i 94 
B. Alvord...... aeeecorneee vii 127 
Be PNORASGsccccecsscnce aero i 87 
B. F. Craig......... berbcseert! ii 130 
Mp EROUUT Vee: toveusnananceavcases ii 196 
Po EU MUNNG seccssrscscackasrn 
A. R. Marvine 
A. J. Myer.,...... 
GeAyOUIS.cocasxe 
B. Peirce........ 
Os WOU GOI Sicecccsccssascecnce 
G. C. Schaeffer ...........0. i 90 
J. J. Woodward......... wit 75 
Review of Tait’s article on mechanics.....vil 29 
Reynolds, Prof., cited on refraction of sound, 
11 58, v 40, 44 
Rhymes, Counting outta.............ccccsesssesscevees xs 
Richardson, J. G,, communication in regard 
to the diagnosis of blood-stains. Read 
by J. J. Woodward. Reference........... ii 41 
Riddell, Dr. J. L., Discovery in microscopy 
arwesraueccesccne ses pee neseeecetareespsceaess Sie hoy ate 
Ridges, Monoclinal........... Seebrehsnece scat snsecnens ii 74 
Ridgway, Robert, cited on Baird’s “ Birds 
of North America””.......... chchoRcH DAB x 65 
communication on a natural arrangement 
of the Falconide. Read by T. Gill. 
MBP OPOREEs caccencsands NEasesiswansed Retrcaducstnade Ai 41 
Rigidity of the earth.......060.0..ccccscseescseecoess ii 76 
Riley, C. V., communication on the pupation 
of the Nymphalide. Abstract......... fii 41 
the issuance of silk worms from their 
cocoons and some striking departures 
from normal habits in insects. Title 
UTE pevadmctaptestesadencserstexsksetnetveeensenees<a7- iii 44 
recent advances in economic entomol- 
ogy. Abstract... ....... Sea sreseeeeaeaera aed -vii 10 
the systematic care of pamphlets. Ab- 
UM CSCL seus sshadasandanacnaconse Ruaenadsnenetepantes vill 29 
our city shade-trees, their foes and their 
future. Reference.............. Secarstusedsseccays | 
Sys eda Gng OAL Of .cs-csccescossescsces Soeceopeeeed iii 28 


Rings of Saturn........ 
Ripple marks 


Ritter, J. W., cited on the chemical rays...v 135 


167 


Page. 


Ritter, W. F. McK., communication on a 
simple method of deriving some equa- 
tions used in the theory of the moon 


and of the planets. Jn full....... ckcecis iv 57 
secular perturbations of Polyhymnia by 
DUPILOL., LADS ACEicsenccrccrcsecccecse soc WEA 54 
Rivers and terrestrial rotation........ Batcress vii 21 
Of Towa.......000 euaponuusbencnscuesessccucpavsassascscae vi 93 
ROam Mountains stcssscue-Cscssrcvseaccersesacensaccec iv 60 
Robinson, J., Flora of Hee Co., Mass., by 
iv 95 
Robinson, T., communication on the strata 
exposed in the east shaft of the water- 
works extension. Abstract............ vii 69 
Was the earthquake of September 19th 
[1884] felt in the District of Columbia ? 
ALUSENGCL panssaucosesakesacstenaeoneenie Ccets -vil 73 
remarks on deflection of rivers............ vii 24 
measuring earth tremors........ ...000» -viiil 28 
Robison, Prof. J., cited on elasticity...........W 132 
ING WtON'S TINGS... access castcoverecnectveusseset Maul OE 
Rochester tornado............ Rapheavactneheaee Pace! Ne! 
Rockwood, C. G., communication on the 
Charleston earthquake. Abstract...ix 387 
Rodgers, John, Death of......... epeeeceneene -v 102, 105 
Rogers, Prof. H. D., cited on the Devonian 
in Pennsylvania..........sseccsee.s---ekd (34), (38) 
Rogers, Prof. W. B., cited on geology at Sul- 
PHU Springs, W/V astessccres cczonesee ii (27), (30) 


Rogers’ rulings on glass 
Ross, A. C., communication on latent im- 
pressions on polished glass pjates pro- 
duced by heating the plates in close 
connection with engraved metallic 


plates. <Abstract......... bessvunasssacesrca tet ii 
Rotation and rivers.........ccecccccssceees Waacares vii 
in office........ Sebbanesansvecdscuciseessasceus pac 


Rowland, cited on thermometry...........c00. 4X 
Ricker, Prof. A. W., cited on the constant P, 


x 
Rule on communications from sections...vi 
Rules for Publication of Bulletin. See 
Bulletin. 
Standing. See Standing rules. 
Rulings on glass.........06 coeeneeron Ravsccnensatens At 


Rumford, Count, cited on theories of heat..v 
Russell, I. C., communication on the exist- 
ing glaciers of the High Sierra of Cali- 
fornia. Abstract and ee 2 fig- 
MUNGO nenadaseunsrasusadvessanas = cacven WAR 
decosiisl of yolentic dast in the Great 
Basin. Abstract......... Ocreosnacor cone Wh 
Whatisa glacier? Abstract.............. vii 
the faults of the Great Basin and of the 
eastern base of the Sierra Nevada. 
ADSEECLissoscvvcscces 


sorees 


130 


18 
37 


5 


168 


Page. 
Russell, I. C., communication on—Cont’d. 

the subaerial decay of rocks and the 
origin of the red clay of certain forma- 

GIONS. Title O71 ..e...cceccococrreeserenereees ix 16 
Russell, Thomas, communication on tem- 
peratures at which differences be- 
tween mercurial and air thermometers 

are greatest. In full. 1 figure..........1K 25 


normal barometers. Title only.......4K 46 
RUMSSIAN MOELCOTOLOLY....:000cseseecnnseesasesescodneoees i 75 
Rutherford, cited on computation of 7........ i 58 
Sabine, Gen., cited on Plover Bay............. iv 125 
St. George Island, Seals ON.....scceeeeeereeee ros tte 
St. Louis directrix, Altitude of...... saciid Ferre: bee" 
St. Paul Island, Seals on........ aavercenaevancenees bas i OL 
SPLINOMOLOT ics ctesecrcceacstcerectussevees lavease gecesstageh SD 
Sand sculpture........00-+ Seepine aapapseuusesenaenree OND! 
Sanderson, Dr. Burden, cited on bacteria.ii 109 
Sands, B. F., Death of............00+ Gschaabresecrs wi 41 
Sandwich Islands, Geology Of...........c+.00++ vi 13 
Satellites, Computations concerning........ vii 93 

Of MArs....cesecseeee seseseedl 181, 186, 188, 190, Wi 45 

Saturn.........63. Sepibeneec alapeuinscaree cevenaeses iii 26, 40 

ROMATVH AS ccaneagucng=canaacmspene mepancienenas oven teeseeed i (30) 
Saturday-Night Club......... epee cess eunussebe sox” 45 
Saturn and its rings, Revolution of....... se-eedd 188 

Bright spot on......... Atco Aes deeee oh se Ad 102 
IWS Ol aaccsecsccsteecessasuveany ii 94, 102,188, wi 41 
Satellites of.......... Se ek eae Lo ...Aid 26, 40 
DO RUOWOlsspsscnessenescuescens aseessauhcnevsuseeancesee ii 102 
Saville, J. H., communication on the new 
Japanese coinage. Title only.........++ i 51 


Sawyer, C. J., communication on the Signal , 
Service bibliography of meteorology 
and terrestrial magnetism. Read by 


C. Abbe. In full.....--cse0ve Mitubed laveceestecre x 23 
Schaeffer, G. C., Resolutions on the death 

OL ve sadeadede céiece cxcoposscadecssesasctaceeszacascctteaas i 90 
Schellbach, Prof. K. H., cited on Malfatti's 

problem........ ciaissuucs eavansneeeeeunenediae Meese: ii 118 
BCHOGISIOL SADAM cosccesstanvaccosv ves olecusyeersnacane ii 69 


Schott, C. A., communication on a new eye- 
piece for observing personal equations. 
TitlesONU -coieresnast-assscevencss srAcnerctis nto: ii 200 

the secular change in the magnetic de- 
clination in the United States and at 


some foreign stations. Abstract...... iii 45 
remarks on calendars.........+. Gisesustizacea patie ii 38 
rigidity of the earth....... Stren areccrne ret Peis 
Sciences, Philosophic order Of...........ssss000 v 105 
ETGBONU STAC Ol vaceceres cesses asnececusesestece> “sore ii 16 
Progress Of.....csscescoss Savtege ddsuve qiatensuoas deters ii 56 
Scientific administrators........ aebahceaatetivy ~Ax xliii 


OXPCTIMENtAtiON.....cccrrccrseresrreseres fi 163, wil li 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


- 


Page. 

Scientific men and their duties............4x xxxv 
Distribution Of.....ccgie sess .c.-ce20s0ssasseepeeneee nn 
method.......... sevcccosocee A LOG, Wk XE EI RE 
and social Progress.........sccseeee soassscaesW "AO 
societies i vi, viil xxxiii 


of Washington, and Professor Baird.....m 45 
of Washington, Proposed federation of, 


v 102 
of Washington, Statistics of..... 0... x 29 
work by state aid.......... doudesycaducoaeeamaaieme vili xli 
Scrope, G. P., cited on columnar atra peal 
vili 24 
Sea level influenced by winds and haro- 
MEtTiC PFESSUTEC..-..000-000e e000 vabboaeneseaeee i 53 
Seals)Fur-Dearing.,cssssecccsverssenecersrd eosnevienaea Tees bf 
Secchi, Angelo, cited on elasticity.......... ... v 1380 
Saturn’s/ Tings. cxsuscsecetacstensoestee nvens eueiae vi 43 


Seconds-pendulum formula 
Secretaries’ report...wi 111, wii ie “viii xxvii, 
ix xxix, x xxx 
Secular change in magnetic declination...i#i 45 
perturbations of Polyhymnia by Jupiter, 
wiii 54 
Seebach’s method of determining earth- 
QUA C LOCI .i0.5 s00esceps <evctssoncssses-asaneeeeneecan 
Seitz, E. B., cited on Malfatti’s problem.....ii 118 
Seismology, List of papers on: 
on the earthquake phenomena recently 
experienced in North Carolina. T. L. 
Clingman. Abstract and reference......4 104 
earth tremors as shown by astronomical 
observations. H.M.Paul. Abstract.iid 125 
earth vibrations at Niagara Falls. J. M. 
Toner. ADSErACl...ccoseascaccccocesesssorassm iy OO 
seismographic record obtained in Japan. 
E. Smith. Title onley....0e.ece-ssccoceoese vi 87 
Was the earthquake of September 19th 
[1884] felt in the District of Columbia? 
T. Robinson. ADSéract........s.000 ssosee vii 73 
the Flood Rock explosion. F.W. Clarke, 
Cc. F. Marvin, and H. M. Paul. Ab- 


SEPACE..000 cnuvewonteseaenba pbeneelaonesegen oe Wili 28 
the Charleston eduihadaen Symposium. 
Abstract. Mapics....ssccsers Brerenccaacce ix 37, 38 _ 


a recent visit to the scene of the Charles- 
ton earthquake and resulting conclu- 


sions. C. E. Dutton. Title only.......% 16 
on the depth of earthquake foci. C. E. 
Dutton. Title only......00-.eccesescecees savers > pas ly 


the speed of propagation of the Charleston 

earthquake. C.E. Dutton and S. New- 
COMD. BefErenCe.......5s00-coscesesnceorvasuses ie |) 2 

Series for determining the ratio of cireum- 


, ference to diameter......... Porc i 657 
Serpent VeNOM...........cceeseeeeee! hips once casenbens wi 38 
Sewage in SOils........++ aisyaeuced adv epaga aseaghavensse Sate 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page 
Sexes, Disparity of, in mollusks............... iii 75 
Shade trees and their f0eS.............cceeeeceeees ° aeihy f 
Shanks, cited on computation of 7.............. i 58 
Shasta, Mount........... Srarasantaneene ein tasaenunwsnwarns x Ak0 
Shastina, Voleanic sand from................+ 33 
Shell heaps of the Aleutian islands.......... 65 
Shelters for thermometers........ eiuweaenceseucue vi 46 
Sherman, W. T., communication on a visit 
to Egypt. Wo abstract............100 cesses i 63 
travels in Turkey and the Caucasus. 
No abstract........... eXaeeesbecsecessdauxcpnecusescs ai 65 
Sherman, Wyoming, as a site for an astron- 
(OMICH] "ODSELVALOLY....0-2<cceccsssnreesneeccees i 70 
Shields, C.W., communication on the present 
state of the sciences. Abstract and 
TEFETENCES .....00008 SeesPenaeabharsuccsdascwasedapses ii 16 
the philosophical order of the sciences. 
Reference....... “consteetes meveqatancsioscenesiersee. v 105 
Shoes, high-heeled,........... 
Shoulder girdle of fishes 
Shrinkage cracking in basalt............00 viii 20 
Siberia-Alaska DOUNGArY...........cc00 ceeee seen iv 123 
Sibscota, G., cited on dumbness and deaf- 
seeveee Wh 49 
Side-coefficients, Removal Of.............+00+ viii 41 
Siemens, C. W., cited on conservation of 
BGI MISO OLS Vises ievsussaarsssasssensessvenes Savev en Wil te 
Sierra Nevada, Geology Of,..........s0.scseeesseees ix 4,5 
PI CIOL Es. ctccsaxessactunses 5 
Sign IANSUAGEC........ccccsececeesseeverees accvensseus WA 055,55 
Signal Service hibliography of meteorology, 
x 20, 23 
Silver coin, Quantity Of........00.c06 cssceeeeeees ix 14 
Silver-gold ratio...... PRS at teucccecaatpoashasdashs iv 141 
Silver question, The,.............06 seoorcte 111 78, 107 
Similar inventions in areas widely apart, 
ix 12 
Sinking fund, The United States.............. iii 113 
RUMP OU ete aaereeyhoaeeseuavasecccsstersesase pgieeraenacsate~ 41 85, (51) 
Skinner, A. N., communication on the pre- 
cession of stars in right ascension. 
Title only........c0e0 erce eet Coser o DOeeeEPEEEe iii 21 
Sling psychrometer..........sessssecceceeseeceenee villi 25 
thermometet........ abtbecwcsdueptvefusabess vi 46, vii 80 
Smart, Dr. Chas., Researches on food adult- 
CYAtiOn DY....<:--:..s000 sea cemaseminenbresatads dav 39 
Smith, Edwin, communication on a seismo- 
graphic record obtained in Japan. 
Title On1Yy.....0.000».0000 Bienidcnatuvwaonssvaucose vi 87 
Smithsonian bonds of State of Arkansas...wi 105 
edition of the Bulletin............. Sectecuansdases x 113 
Smithsonian Institution under administra- 
POW OL alll. SHAE O cacsacnssacascacencssecesasnce x 49 
under administration of Joseph Henry, 
di 285 


BINBG VOOM cerccccecce-ncscsescsecceceexs Le coaatieas vi 38 


169 


Page. 
OCIA WOLUDIOR scccccvctaveressaccescsanctenececsee vi xlviii 
progress and scientific method ............. iv 40 


Social Science and Statistics, List of 
papers on: 
on the adjustment of census returns. E. 
B. BMMObb. | Title On Ueyirsicaacessccscoccee nesses i 63 
on the coincidence of the geographical 
distribution of rainfall and of illiter- 
acy, as shown by the statistical maps 
of the ninth census reports C. 8. 
Peirce: Abstr clavcisusvexsssen ehcrepenesacc- i 68 
on life and annuity tables, based on the 
census of 1870. E. B. Elliott. Title 
ONG aivacceuaasudaavacevabhceharaevencawaacauaddaumncnres i 74 
on the use of metric weights and balances 
for postal purposes in the United 
States. E. B. Elliott. <Abstract.......di 15 
further remarks on metric weights and 
balances for the postal service. E. B. 
Biott., CADStroehiiss «cna cecrenucnce scene ii 19 
on proposed reforms in spelling the Eng- 
llsh language. A. R. Spofford. Title 


OTM ona gusesacpaeavlauauaashvec>sabaesenaesesesamed see ii 42 
the mortality among army officers. B. 

AN VOT Cs TeefOnenCercs.tecdcnsneon Sascaven nants ii 49 
[proposed governmental insurance.] RB. 

Alvord NVOGDStr er. swccssscctss cssencsoarss ii 49 
[a statistical diagram.] E. B. Elliott. Vo 

(DUSUL CCE tasscdite sonasanctnspsascaessnaseaneaiwe reais ii 134 
animal population of the globe. L. F 

WES GAGA CE bccnnpsacparones sanasecannacssae iv 27 


the relation of scientific method {fo social 
progress. 8S. Newcomb. Presidentinl 
MOSES, oLIW PULL cctscce-atncseostseccuasza cases iv 40 
the international convention of the teach- 
ers of the deaf and dumb, at Milan. 


E. M. Gallaudet. Abstract............... iv 55 
mortality statistics of the Tenth Census. 
J.S. Billings. Abstract............. iv 163, 164 


on survivorships, with tables and formulas 
of construction. E. B. Elliott. Title 
ONLY ..22000e PCaansereeseassis ceerere maserrero-ce aco ‘v 122 
fallacies concerning the deaf, and the in- 
fluence of such fallacies in preventing 
the amelioration of their condition. 
Asi Gre Belly GIGt FUU):; cs sccssessenenccecne comes vi 48 
the vital statistics of the Tenth U.S. Cen- 
sus, J.S. Billings. Reference....... viii 4 
a fonetic elfabet. H. Farquhar. Abstract. 
1b oa iy 
the geographical distribution of scientific 
men and institutions in the United 
States. G.B.Goode. Reference........X 7 
the economic phase of the English spar- 
row question. C.H. Merriam. Refer- 
ENCE. .rceccres hab aussnessssdurasihnseess tecesersesccee 16 


170 


Page. 
Social Science and Statistics, List of 
papers on—Cont’d. 
statistics of the Philosophical Society from 
its foundation. G. K. Gilbert. Ab- 
Stract. 00 PisTechantactusscpsess eossuerecthpeaesessseeLeO 
the progress of science as exemplified in 
the art of weighing and measuring. 


W. Harkness. In full.........0+ X XxXvii, 39 
association ratios. M. H. Doolittle. Ab- 
GUVUCUslcascstsvocuenceestace aac Reelaeuannarbnalisievinn x 8&3 
association ratios. M. H. Doolittle. Ab- 
GUITICE. nauavuccsedcustcnciacabassessunrdecanbeann ascents x 94 
Societies, American scientific... viii xxxiii 


ICTON ELGG cc ccssssnccssnacnpevcuiseup aveneveveanecasesekus i vi 
SUNG PYOLESROL BAIN satsctsaccesssssascnevacessce x 45 
SURLISHICS) Of casuscacseclcareestuscrecuses uapauvenabvecess x, 29 
OWS ANG SCWALC. avadversnescncsecen secon svcosesssrss iv 38 
OMA COLOUG siareccccoscactactsnscusscsceasde 131, 141 116, 121 
eclipse, Jan. 11, 1880.........ccc.csccscesescesceses fii 121 
Uri 20S TS ce cenesttocssersereee Ad 202, dif 116 
heat variations and climate.............s0+ vi 10 


parallax derived from transit of Venus, 


MEthOS.........sesa000s Shasusassateckaacestassetetes v 39 
Solid, liquid, and gas defined.............2eee000 v 136 
SOMOF ’s THEOTEM........seerccscereccrersscoese Sapecey ix 54 
Sondhauss, cited on refraction of sound....4i 57 
BOrehi SUA. cts ecerecekcncecncnseasssncscsrevectar iii 140 
OU liscenstatravechasacsccbasseasssnsnsedsvassessaccmascnsednsce v 103 
Sound, Abnormal phenomena Of......... seers ii 37 

and fog man irate ii 57, 60, (45), iw 135, wv 23, 39 
DC Aiccsssasevsarsasns Fhoosierenc es neencete Av 143, 183 
TUTE eecccnsesveneccunetetens taneuasamtocesececssas faced iv 143 

Determination of direction of. li 69, Vili 12 

TEOMT CWO SYTOUS: .cccsscescscecccencsnecdsnsese acne Ai 85 

Joseph Henry’s researches ON......s00..e0e di 344 

Refraction Of...........66 41 57, 167, (48), wv 35, 39, 44 

velocity and air temperature.............-00 vi 47 

waves and earthquake Waves...........0+ ix 42, 43 


(See also Acoustics.) 
Sounds accompanying and following meteor 
of December 24, 1873. 


South! Mountain fhUUtiiessavsasenca-nosxs-cn caensene 
ECO rececipauncsssesroccacsess ccvessy ates 
Resisting Medium in..........ccceccseserscsceees 
Temperature Of.......csscccssee eksahpowananevaeierate ii 73 
Space-directed lines......cssecsecseseeseeeeeeeeX 105, 106 
Sparrows, 10} ota) ha ee eae aes aah ae ah a x) 16 
Specific gravity method.............ccssccseccceee vi 26 
SPECULOPNOMO sucess yataadencarccccasavaxcressreas iv 143, 161 
Spectrum of Encke's COMEL......ccccessseeecceres i 34 
COLON A cr eeacaracencavaneussnencesseecaVarereneseonstst 4i1 117 - 


Speech, Visible iv 55, vi 60 
Speed of propagation of the Charleston 
earthquake...........+ neent oneonesany Monadaeeess Vl 15/20 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page 
Spencer, Herbert, cited on ceremonies....4x 20 
growth Of crystals.d.........00sscccssseses vaaset ON 
MIOTION sschesmsssceued semandoanesnauatee 
NLOTVE CUITEDES, cioccersdcccces ecccpecnscnacusunseus vi 62 
THO WIG: sc vear csaseacasaeexs a aacapots «ee W 164, 166 
Spheres, Problem concerning capussnas LOT 
Spheroid, Distances on any............. Spied 


Spofford, A. R., communication on proposed 
reforms in spelling the English lan- 
Title only... ossus sunaadenceNeunncee ii 42 
.-Al 109,» 64, 103 
score) (22 


guage. 
Spontaneous generation......... 
Standard for MicrOMEtry......ccccseceeeees 
Standard time.......scccssesssenssnccess 


adopted by the society .............. seaman 
A system of......... Seasasteeeaerere panana 
Standards of declination...........ccceeee 
LENS UH iseseneasspoescecs speesecechack psopenssneetneeee Lee 
VEAL Oi vucenvctucarccouss cedseasdonwace Rercsitecto ili 78, 107 


Standing rules of the General Committee, a 
xvii, if vi, iit vi, 149, iv 11, v 11, vi xii, 
wii xii, viii xii, ix xii, x xii 
Standing rules of the Mathematical Section, 
vi 115, vii 85, vili 35, ix 51,x 81 
Standing rules of the Society..4 xvi, if iv, iff 
iv, 149, iw 7, 30, 38, v 7, vi ix, vil ix, 
viii ix, ix ix, x ix 
Star catalogue Sere at U. S. Naval Ob- 


SOLVALOLY: sc ccscctasss| ce acvecsoncsseaeduessutennnnnt i 74 
New..... mateeren aves vaeensave teas yesetpenaeneal ix 14 
Stars, Aenean Of ccccssee-sussacevuuspseecsrnanh Am mmrny 
TMB LES “OL. a cecseonssnssn crnecnetcnet serene veAX 15 
Station Crrors....0..seeeee ison Nenany ane esnoscce eekh 82 
Statistics. (See Social Science.) 
Steam as a disinfectant........eceeeee ccc cscassuekRn Oe 
Steiner, Prof. J., cited on Malfatti’s problem, 
fi (115 
on Feuerbach’s Circle....,....0+++++ sseeeee Wild 46 
Stellar photometry.......... agree oqueccce\ssnanseee wane 
Steno, cited on crystallography................+. 2 ey i 


Sternberg, Dr. G. M., Researches on Bacillus 


TUSIATIES seasncccnnseconccenecss ssoasevaeeenae sisause iv 39 


Stokes, Professor, cited on refraction of 
AOUNGs: sseccssncccssns nena desopenennee 41 58, (47), v 40 

Stone, Ormond, communication on the de- 
termination of the errors of a pro- 
visory catalogue of fundamental stars. 


TUGLE: OFU1Y aves sessntenenaseusdonsvaunden cane aeeakRtd i 62 
the correction of a comet’s orbit. Refer- 
OTIC .onceannscacéeanedeavasexsleeesaetenneeaaeaeenm Ah 22 


a problem in probabilities. Abstract....x 89 
the orbit of Hyperion. Abstract and ref- 
CLENCE, s.gaccocesnesreceseses an scisuookecaseneey asebece x 104 
Stoneham, Me., Topaz from.........sececseeeee wili 5 
Stoney, cited on the radiometer... ii 81 
Storage of electric CNETYY.....MWerereeeeerereeeW 46 
Storm centres, Movement of....... ecavagkesaachsnee meet 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 
Storm centres, Retardation of........ ev 108 
BSPOLINS ANGAUTOTAS...vccosseceseccseclhucvcesertse csehes a 45 
EUW OL vaste Atavus pesakhatencdntuassvecesveucossuncazesces 
Thunder 
Storr, Dr. G. C. C., cited on the classification 
of mammals....... Bosnecartet ap seube cet eeacaathed fi (3) 
Strata exposed in shaft of water-works ex- 
HOUIBION sbseticteccsscs ceearedecanteoearstase cect vii 69 


Struve, Otto, cited on determination of 
planet’s mass from observations on 


RPLDCNI UGGS se ecetcrassscvecses- cer ucaess cesses eterst wi 132 
Satellites) of Uranus. ...c....esccsesscocscecescnses 
SARC OSsantcnsseacaccss<csscusesbooesebssans 

Stryker artesian well............. 

BUWDStRNGO.i..2.00acccesses nuccheecrae os 

Sugar beet culture and climate........... seoeokdd 142 
from sorghum........... Gaeetasemavensnerteesaneh iii 140 

Sumner, W.G., cited on bi-metallism...... ili 84 

Sumner’s method in navigation... ......... 44 105 

Suan, Heat Of.ic..<05025 00000 Bs cpestenenitcttedetschassencns i. SE 


viewed by light of any desired wave 


COTrOna::.2i.55 Ricdbarasesuehi cawepstsssscnes 431, 411 116, 121 
Surplus, Proposal to distribute the........... vi 103 
Sweeping mechanism. fii 142 
Swift, Dean, cited on the scientific crank, 


viii xl 
Swift's comet, Orbit of...........sccssssscecesssneds iv 59 
Swordfish and its allies...............c.cssseeeeees iv 162 
Sylvester, J. J., communication on the 
theory of invariants. Title only....... fi 95 
Trisection linkage Of.............0044.. 99 
Symbols, Archeologic........... aioccasavedcekontonesy 72 
Symons, Prof. G. J., Bibliographic work of, 
x 21, 23 
Symposium on the cause of the glacial cli- 
MI FEED ceceatace nu antasucatencdiehsdauepeeacauess sees ii 43, 45 
the silver question.....s00.seceee eeseee df 78, 107 


the Charleston earthquake ix 37, 38 


Whats TOpOLrapny 2 eccisac.sedestecccesscesseee x 14 

a problem in probabilities... ..............% 87, 89 

Systems of mineralogy........0. secce oe maakastvaanse rir 

Taconic system of Emmon........... Rsalicsvones 6 
Tainter, S., Photophonic experiments by. 

iv 145, 150 


Tait, Prof. P. G., cited on force..v 128, 152, vii 29 
Talbot, H. F.,cited on the history of Mal- 


fatti’s problem.......... mies aatiane peeecdes coos dd 114 
PUP OUU A TOL asc ncreiectntgacscoscwscivesresecusves x 91 
Target-shooting and the theory of errors..vi 138 
Taxonomic terms of Storr...... seeeers(T) 
Taylor, F. W., Analysis Dy.....sccsesessssseees vil 32 


171 


Page. 
Taylor, W. B., communication on the nature 
and origin of force. Abstract and ref- 
EPENCE...00000 paceniaecd cass Hwacesoaseceaascenedae nas Ak 27 


the aurora. Abstract 43 
our present knowledge of the planet 
Jupiter. Title only........0.- sacunewakeeutnsee i 62 
waves, molecules, and atoms. Abstract, 
i 66 
a calendar proposed by a Persian astron- 
omer in1079. Abstract....... a sacavadicees ii 38 
the causes of the glacial climate. Ab- 
SETACT....008 Chee Byaennesnceneseesdseanataeds ii 43, 46 
acoustic refraction. Abstract.............. ii 57 


the temperature of space. Abstract.....ii 73 
Joseph Henry. Asketch of his scientific 

WOT. Tit fiill...rccccerecocssoroseeseseese 203, 230 
a panoramic photograph. Abstract.....v 21 
the total lunar eclipse of June 11, 1881. 

A DSU GC hisestenatascssesesssysayer Ab Secctenericd v 90 
aremarkable halo. Abstract..............- v 112 
physics and occult qualities. Presiden- 

tial address. In full... Revecearens Vv 125, 126 
the rings of Saturn. <Abstract............ vi 41 
a case of discontinuity in elliptic orbits. 

PAUSUL.W.Clcacnucsovaneossenscssevhstheveisexsctsenes vii 122 
geological and physical theories. Ab- 


the crumpling of the earth’s crust. Ab- 
SERACE.ONA TEFETENCE, .c.cesercsscensusteres viii 18 

slight modification of the Newtonian 
formula of gravitation. Abstract...viii 39 

Professor Baird as an administrator. In 


NfUillecwokcnunvardaessads vreddswaesnpenanvun wacvemsensterd x 49 
remarks on calendar reform.......... sees ii 30 
interior Of the Carth.......ccscccscsersssesces i176, 77 


MALI OMI GLO. oc cchtacnscwsvorscuenocssneresscrensteaey ii 80 
Planetary MOtIONS............02 cesses seeeee ii 188, 189 
amplitude of light waves..... ........44l 120, 125 
death of J. H. Lane.......... iene senevasebengeae tii 124 
taboo.........00. Gavcceuanvaunepuarersscedepspneteses .Lii 138 
Henry’s acoustic researches.... .......... iv 140 
TACLOPWOWYseveccacssccescscotccsashenerscucsssisstayy iv 162 
anomplies of sound v 37 
DINALY STIGHMETIC! i. cleccsscccsecee say vencyenn Wie tg 
Sling thermMOmMete’.......cscssscsssssecssseeses vi 47 
SBPELITGES(OLDITS.<:cccsecosen cosvsie>nanensvuvaccss wi 133 
WL NITCSIMAL SI cs cescdassvervosscasusuenevwsvabssa wi 135 
BUN! SLOWS siasctusantouccctecs vebench acevateaveenys vii 35 
topoOphone.......ssecseeeeee whsdutusspsseenatceees viii 13 
resolutions on the death of G.C. Schaeffer, 
i 90 
Telephone, Exhibition Of...............sses00 ii 67, 103 
COMMENES ON Neintsscssdonccsanasnacyueceseasesveees ii 111 
Telephonic study of binaural audition......ii% 69 
PelopHotescisc!dasvecscdsesacercubsnatecestae'steeys . ki 192 


Telescope for Naval Observatory.............. i 62, 63 


Wiz PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
Temperature and pressure, Diurnal changes 
OF, coxecsaowetetaunat wanna? Mebbasbawtdaadaqacsh se cses ii 67, 69 
Conditions determining.. .........+ ecucseanse v 91 
distribution over the surface of the globe, 
i 96 


Measurement of atmospheric................Wi 46 
of sea water as related to winds on the 


coast of New Hampshire........ aescaatnea ii 17 
75 
73 
the air........ Sikes chennthnnneeionchaanneecaacnne seeWh 24 
the human body......... sesso of pores fee ef 
(See also Meteorology and Thermometry.) 
Temperatures at which differences between 
mercurial and air thermometers are 
ZLEATESE ....ccccrceccncceves soccccscecrossceveeseses ix 25 
OL the Pacific OCEAN... ccccssvcsoeessceccevesousssh ii 192 
Tenth census mortality statistics.............0w 164 
PROTA OG MAVAIS..ccascesgcconsssscocdnkpesseanscecnssetses v 98 
Terrestrial magnetism, Bibliography of..x 23, 27 
Constant P in observations of............... x 102 
Terquem, cited on Feuerbach’s circle...wili 46 
TDexns Cross "TIM DETS:,ccssssanecadessencssnccssuer ene <6 
Thanhoffer, cited on the pulse............. 0000 vi %7 
Theatres, Burning oOf......... namevnaed oeaneeeeeeaenes di 95 
WHGOIGLY, sacvscsvasnedasch wadaavepseees ae “pas v 103 
of the American Indians........ auaceacsasanecee Lio 
PRL OO) OLICTYONA. scsdecascucusdsecocucdecnsaccrssescse wi 152 
practically tested by RE er ae eR vi 138 
Thermal belts of North Carolina..... ....... vi 11 


Thermometry, List of papers on: 

on thermometers. B. F. Craig. Title 
OTL cavacacuasnsavecasarcehesnpenatana esa savcamawoeners i 42 

a method of verifying with exactness the 
indications of a thermometer. B. F. 
Craig. Tetle On t....00....0000eceesreesee scevee i 43 

a@ comparison of the thermometers used to 
determine the correction for atmos- 
pheric refraction at the U. S. Naval 


Observatory. J. R. Eastman. Ab- 

BUT ECU senpssncuneasdaannescsaans Geaubeseadsaeneteustssnd i 68 
on the air thermometer of Prof. Jolly. J. 

Bi. Hilgard. Title Onis. sacceesesosessasecess i 89 
determining the temperature of the air. 

iG: Abbe: | ADSiraCis.cccteaetsoecectecneceseae vi 24 
hygrometric observations. H. A. Hazen. 

BAL DAUCEC iauvenmaneneieaneensnsnpsnuasrseensstbaNe set: vi 36 
thermometerexposure. H.A. Hazen. Ab- 

GUNACLcatonesecundatastoxssnaesesadessapeecetssnesenee vi 46 
thermometerexposure. H.A. Hazen. Ab- 

SUPACT...c000 Sibusysade son upstneesannese Deneenn «Whi 80 


the measurement of temperature at dis- 
tant points. T.C. Mendenhall. Title 
ONLY... 000 So rercestnceec nrerenrtee rater viii 18 

the condensing hygrometer and sling psy- 
chrometer. H. A. Hazen. Abstract..wiii 25 


Page, 
Thermometry, List of papers on—Cont’d. 
temperatures at which differences between 
mercurial and air thermometers are 
greatest. T. Russell. Jn full. 1 fig- 


MUTE ios avuscoesvancccdenadéuecoscogutasseonnesaaheineeal ix 25 
the gilding of thermometer bulbs. J. H. 
Kidder. Title only ....scccccooscresssooan kX 33 


effects of solar radiation upon thermome- 
ter bulbs having different metallic 
coverings. H.A.Hazen. Abstract..ix 33 
Thompson, Gilbert, communication on the 
physical-geographical divisions of the 
southeastern portion of the United 
States and their corresponding topo- 


graphical types. ADstract.......006 s+ ix _ 22 
What is topography? Abstract 
remarks On glacicLS.......ssee-seceesceee —_ 
Indian paintings, io....ccccccscssvancsss sscnen vili 16 | 


Thompson, Prof.S. P., cited on plecteinieg .v 168 
Thomson, Sir William, cited on rigidity of 


LHC) GATE ti sencctenscesvivey actesesastsopeteaeaenee ii 78 
Sumner’s method a wxvoverRy OU; 
Volt-meter Of....ccccescccdsscccesencreesvencetvane viii 26 


Thomson, William, communication on a 
new method for detecting and measur- 
ing the optical defects of the eye. 


RREPETENCE.c...00-eaccccoeseasew éavoucasonaneas aaa” i 22 
Three methods of evolution.........00.000 «vi xxvii © 
Throwing-sticks....... «ix, (18 
Thunderstorms in 1884 wil 10 

Electrical phenomena of....... sscueeneseaeaeeea ii 189 
Tidal retardation and consequent crumpling, 
viii 19 
Tides at Boston influenced by winds and 
barometric PreSSuUre,........sseccsccsossesennes 
Tillo, Col.,-cited on levellings in Asia........ 
Time, A system of standard.........c..-sseceseeeee 
determination with a meridian transit..wili 55 


w Ati 26, 40, x 104 


Todd, D. P., communication on solar paral- 
lax from the velocity of light. Refer- 

OMUAE thviuhtsxecveusnus Seep ritcccer ee woyeceseanee iii 74 
a mechanical attachment for equatorial 
mountings to facilitate sweeping in 
right ascension. Abstract and refer- 

ENCE ...s0000 chen ane sve denen envakseneseassueheaemauee .Aid 142 
the solar parallax as derived from the 
American photographs of the transit 
of Venus 1874, December 8-9. Abstract 

GN TEFETENCE. .veccvseccesonaerars ecscseesconceveel WY 168 
Todd, J. E., communication onsquaternary 
deposits of western Iowa and eastern 

Nebraska. AdStract. .ccosrccsscresscesssenek © 120 


...4 137, 202, wi 106 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-X. 


Page. 
Todd, J. E., remarks on charcoal in the 
drift...... Manqantenarenelcasaeu tena aseecece aeneanas fv 122 


Toner, J. M, communication on a method 
of describing aud locating with ease 
the approximate positions of geo- 


graphical regions. Title only........ sooeek 97 
the burning of theatresand public halls. 
PEPOPEM CILGn seessentercssuces are Srecvewecestescxall GO 
amalformed dog. Wo abstract............ 41185 
earth vibrations at Niagara Falls. Ab- 
RAM a TG ietue ten ab eecstshinsaasnancncssnawdneneeceauae iv 186 
coins and medals. Abséract......... scrcnane Wi 2 
remarks on care of pamphlets............ viii 29 
Tonto Sandstone, Age Of ............c00 ducedsaseuuee i 109 
Topaz from Stoneham, Me..... we With 5 
Topographic map defined.............. eck) Tt 
types in the southeastern States......... ix 22 
Topography and geology of the Cross Tim- 
bers of Texas......... eohaeheusel sasaurunes assess > 
ANA StTUCTULC......000 ceeeee Subsosnene Sense enatuks > ae 
COANE. serccsseiscessss Baaeakasest! Saseseanthnenaancsse x 14 
Topophone.............. avdcaves maseonidanc samedects we Whit 12 
Tornado at Rochester, Minn..........0..ses00eWiil 
Torreya in Southern States and Japan......id 42 
Townley, &., cited on transmission of sound, 
: wv 42 
PUPATIS TG LO XELLOS casi scessonsqcosaececacesasse eokeeasgWAlh, (27 
Meridian........ CeAerECEELS Reativeeescastuesves verse will 55 
of Mercury....... eeaGhinanesucqsidesvcactovessecerceve ii 199 
Mercury, May, 1878..... lid 43 
WenS) 1874, .0. ot tecccsscvecens i 63, ii 31, 33, iw 168 
MS ites arccavcesarxccelescsarcactersuossncnce vi 21 
Trap of Orange Mt., N. J........ Rebs sa seseuative -viii 24 
Treasurer’s report.....v 176, 180, vi xii, vii xxiv, 


viii xxviii, ix xxx, x xxxiv 
Tremors detected by astronomical observa- 


TIGIS ssn ccesassee peteepenaae toxin snasanscnack basses iii 120 
Triangle, Formule for the area of.........wiil 37 
Problem concerning...........0+ Biaecteecerspre Rhy 700 
Trisection Of angles...........sscecceseesseeseses sesame 90 
Trouvelot, L., Drawings of nebule by........ pt eal 
Tucker, R., Solution of a geometrical prob- 
PGNEM UD Vraesctsuastenndvucentuaxacevscsnccestesneses iil 65 
Tupman, —, letter on solar eclipse. Com- 
municated by W. Harkness. No ab- 
Sill Cbreccssecrodseccnatessne Rearenusetsegucdassossacad A 56 
winin es |W. diy DAL) Ofsic..cceasresseedeoveesecee's v 102 
Tyndall, John, cited on photophonie experi- 
MENIS...inoces reecceo Sassebalehadtatas ass pedenen iv 152 
sound anomalies.......... dechcadesaceceoaccess -v 33, 41 
heat absorption by the air..............6 -v 94, 96 
Introduction of........ snore toneenn thc ret eer i 65 
letter on fog signals. Communicated by 
ereLenTy. TINO GOSE CCL. .2.-.ccccscesesacseesse i 91 


Uinta Mountains, Permian rocks of.........44 106 


Uniforniitarianianisss.i.sscsaveteactetecccccccecWiil 6 
United States, Centre of population of....... s£) 35 
Geographic centre Of............se000 acacecseee i 22 
Wrara.:.. <b. madendertera Gace pereesaer eccane w= Oe 
Uranometria Argentina....... iii 122 
Uranus, Satellites Of ......ssscssse-cocscsseseeeessel (30) 
Utah, Glacial epoch in................ bade sapitexcivshes i 84 
Permian formation of........ week Add 68, 105 
Ute languages...cccicisescccesses Rendesavesarees senses 28 
Vacant offices, Filling of.. .....41 84, 141 53, -v 112, 
vi 41, vii 36 
Valentin, cited on mineralogy....... “ceetneatas boa i 
Valleys; Classification: Of:....cc.n.cstesesccnsanseseee i 49 
Values at different times...... ra Seaesave Ai 87 
Relative, of gold, greenbacks, and silver, 
fi 52 


Van Sant, ——, communication on a method 
of lighting gas-jets by electricity. Wo 


COBEN DCbwccocecversveceaicdescess ee cveasvaceusen lla O03 
Variations of latitude 10 
Vauquelin, cited on mineralogy......... ..... -4i 78 
Velocity of earth tremors.......... elascoteces ee viii 28 

Carthquake WAVEeS......cc0secseeseceee ix 41, x 17, 28 
Venom of serpents........ Wesaduasucwoadsconararecnecs vi 38 
Ventilation of the House of Representatives, 

v 99 
Venus, Transit of, 1874.........1 63, 1131, 33, iw 168 

ASSZicchcesouns arouser) vacccesens ae sAcenNaldtenes sem apenas wi 21 

Verification of weather predictions........ vii 122, 

viii 8, x 83, 94 
Werteprss,|Cepnalic:sccaicc.ccsccsssuresoscccsnsecsnecers i 26 
Virginia, Fossil plants from..............s0eee00 ii (26) 


Apparatus for testing............cssecsseeeceeees iii 53 
Vital principle........... adaencen eeaurda seer 4 27, v 50, 102 
statistics of the tenth U.S. census ...... viii 4 
Vocabulary of an individual..............000 ii 28, (16) 
WOIt-MICHOI: ie sncsonseeccosvececccess ScebeEcco ee sactcce vill 26 
Volcanic dust in the Great Basin.......... vii 18 
LOGICS faves oe tensnnacscnnctuteceseUeectunsesvecpsteace vii 78 
problem, The............00. inesesecabasedasansencened vi 87 
BHM SLi cocvccasccostcasé socees sevens ctavecestectebeneos vii 33 
Voleano, Latest, in northern California.....4x 46 
Volcanoes of New MeXiCO........cesecsceseseeas -vii 76 


Von Cronstedt, cited on mineralogy...........4 78 
Von Jherling, Dr. H., cited on the Chito- ; 


THVCLEG.b cceue stpsatenvacsceosatnecatanwunrcuboctestrent ii 193 
Vortex motion............ a haaasuenedssccucaceseeesaeh fii 143 
Wiuleany Search fore. -ccet scccassecacuentsecetonceriacs li 85 
Wagner, cited on the sun’s diameter.........1 (4) 


Waite, Chief Justice M. R., letter announcing 
the death of Joseph Henry...............44 196 


174 PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
Walcott, C. D., communication on the Cam- 
brian system in the United States and 
Canada. Abstract. 1 figure... vi 98 
the geologic age of the lowest formation 
of Emmons’ Taconic system. Refer- 


ENCE. 00 dadeveweead atone duaddddeddsetcsccsdadaacenses eG tb 
Discovery of Permian fossils by......... iii 68, 105 
Wallerius, cited on mineralogy...... aber vecasteee i 78 


Walling, H. F., communication on topo- 
graphical indications of a fault near 
Harper’s Ferry. Abstract...... watatees vi 30 

Ward, Lester F., communication on the nat- 
ural system of plants. Title only..di 186, 187 

the origin of the chemical elements. 


Title only ....0+ Redcaees Peperecee pene SeArencererc. iii 33 
animal population of the giobe. Abstract, 
iv 27 


field and closet notes on the flora of 

Washington and vicinity. Abstract.iv 64 
the organic compounds in their relations 

to life. Title Only ...1.0ccececcssseansesssonasesW OL 
some physical and economie features 

of the Upper Missourisystem. Refer- 


GNGE. seccascccencsnese eeuswomaKens ihexeccaenaeiassha vii 20 
the flora of the Laramie group. Refer- 
ONCE .ucrcnee ais huantiasauesie st cescespen saaakaet dns viii 17 
the frequency of coincidences. Abstract, 
Kas 


the geographical distribution of fossil 
plants. Reference... 
remarks on vital force 
Dismal Swamp.......... 


deflection Of riverS...........ccccesceeseeees ree 

Indian observation of nature............. vii 74 
eare of pamphlets....... Acbecobrocerecee sess Will = 29 

Warren, G. K., cited on abnormal phenom- 
BH AOL/SOWH AL caccrccatcastesscisnareangivs seanes ii (48) 

communication on the geological history 
of Lake Winnipeg. Abstract........00 ii 27 

Warner, A. J.. communication on the silver 
question. Abstract.......0 easeesa/sverusen iii 112 
Wasatch Mountains fault......ccceeesseers aiteseas ii 103 
Growth Of ..........000 ScavaduedsensseeneeTsAe ne beneh ii 195 
Washington a scientific centre....i xi, viii xlvi, 
x 47 
Flora of....... ide eens Minvks dteucteans opeuusncnescevarane iv 64 
Watershed of the Reiponrasi region......Ai 67, 82 
Waterspouts in North Carolina... ..... cecceccesh 104 


Watson, J. C., communication on the discov- 
ery of new planets having especial ref- 
erence to the asteroids. Title only....4 53 

Watson, Sereno, cited on the Great Basin 


ON risesecmeaueiass-vovassesevscncamersnccresneke iv 99 

the classification of plants............4W 108, 110 
Wave lengths of light......cscscssrecsessecseree sence wv 142 
Waves, Barth quakes scavsncvcsesssesevecssctescsocrcere > a by 


Page. 
Waves, molecules and at@ms.........ccceseeseeeees i 66 
Weather forecasts......ccsscsssseesescceses ‘v 122, vidi 8 


Webb, Capt., cited on phenomena of sound, 
ii (49), (50) 
Weiss, Prof., cited on mineralogy............4 78, 79 
Welling, J. C., communication on the life 
and character of Joseph Henry. In 
fll sasaavaveessadtsoueen acus lat iscnaestesenie otouanepem ii 203 
anomalies of sound signals. Jn full.....w 39 
the atomic philosophy, physical and 


metaphysical. Presidential address. 
Tv full cvercsess Aroorrrtrecort: etoues vii xxix, 81 
eulogy on Gen. A. A. Humphreys. Ab- 
SUPACE cvccassun scdvev veces evauvasesdecudcuves tanner vii 4 
remarks On vocabularies. ..........ssscee coos fi 28. 
Grifting DUOVS..,.ccccevss,sseveesancsssnadeeenen wii 15 
Indian observation of nature............. vil 75 
Wells, D. A., cited on medium of exchange, 
hii 101 
Wenham, cited on microscope apertures..iii 19 
Werner, cited on Mineralogy..........c00 cree i78, 79 
Wernich, cited on contamination of air by 
SOWALO iccacsecaasahev des kaandonawuerati eva ndecane iv 38 
Whatiis'a glacier ?t:.2i.c22 Saesseswerncueutensemeat wii 37 
Wheatstone’s microphone, Modification of, 
iv 183 
Whewell, Dr. W., cited on attraction..........W 161 
Greek philosophy.............0000+ see Whi XXXxVili 
White, C. A., cited on the loess of Iowa.....iw 121 


communication on the evolutional history 
of the North American Unionidee. 


Title only...... sodscechsdeadseaasseddtvnaseuceenete ii 181 
asymmetry in the form of the human 
cranium, (Z2tle Onlys..ccacovsscetoners ae ii 190 


the fresh-water shell-heaps of the in- 
terior rivers of North America. Title 


the subject of the Permian formation in 
North America. Abstract...........0+ .-did 104 
artesian wells on the Great Plains. Ref- 
CV CUCE a cascacesaencennsessnpawe osececcuncawupausepenes v 101 
remarks on the relations of plants to 
LCOLOLY.....ecseeeeeee dvsesee)ischeust one usesaneash iv 119 
loess of the Mississippi valley........... «iv 122 
VETOED. ....00..eccee0 enaaie sabe horanedyarsl annie debsecansWp 09) 
theory of permanence of oceans......... vi 93 
drainage system of Iowa........4 oo -decuassewenn oO) 
White, Prof. I. C., Discovery of Permian fos- 
sils by........ anacdtecasconeeeee doveocoeveusnastuna ey LOG 
Whitfield, R. P., Observations on Limnea 
Diyas sch esectuck bunetes wacutdaleeten ea ants 
Whitney, Prof, Je Di; cited | on geology of 
Great Basin.......... edaauedeaenohe doceususssstoneaena 
Whitney, Prof. W. D., cited on™individual 
vocabularies....... ined chuaucaneeecasadadaeyeents ii (19) 
Wiebe, H. F., cited on thermometry......:..4x 26 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I-xX. 


Page. 

Wild, Prof., cited on thermometry............ ix 33 
Williams, G. H., communication on the 
methods of modern petrography. Ab- 

BUNCE erspecdesvsscesn=-salaceub> sbraseanesve Stes vii 36 
Willis, Bailey, communication on the topog- 
raphy and structure in the Bays 


Mountains, Tennessee. Reference....K 7 
development of a perspective map from 
acontour map. Title only..........0.0000 Part!) 
Mount Rainier and its glaciers. Ab- 
BUNGE ssusccescess Reatenaeanedtate cadacencancventrestex x 10 
remarks on geology of Cascade Mount- 
HET Gee esr ee Bee eCCRRE ET Serer esnenstracne eeeatee ix 8 


Winchell, Alexander, communication on the 
progressive dispersion of mankind 


over the surface of the earth. Title 
ONLY... 2.008 pasmeenasahan cas shakes fackussaceatdsecesten Ail 32 
Wind and hygrometry....... AAT, vi 36 
TFUERW OVI UEACLION ..5cnsccccseboctascscuscesceneaasne iii 31 
retardation of storm centres..............+. v 108 
as related to barometric gradient............ i 106 
velocity ANd PLreSSULe.....seccceccesesecersees epee Ay 
Winds and barometric pressure-in relation 
to tides....... auuansayacnnasccserecdeeeaaeun Be eercss 4 53 
as related to ocean temperatures on the 
coast of New Hampshire........... 17 
observed in balloon ascensions 35 
ONGMOUNERIN SIOPCS;.<ccsccsccscssencecaceesscesses 38 
Wind-wrought errors in barometric observa- 
BONA eremcts sess cenesnaetence ance ases Seda scwavestsnacave v 91 
VEG VAM Gay EN OONY, Of: cccscssscveseccusverseccseteoces x 9 
Winlock, W. C., communication on comets 
II and III, 1884. Title only............ viii 16 
physical observations of Wolf’s comet 
(1884, III). Abstract. .........s.seeseeees vili 37 
Winter of 1882~’83, Prognostication for......w 122 
Woeikoff, Alexander, communication on the 
meteorology of Russia. Reference......4 75 


the results of a recent determination of 
the elevation of the Caspian and Aral 
S089. Abstract a iccccciecessses cases Saesasonstes ii 34 

meteorological observations in Peru, and 
some meteorological conditions of that 


country. Title only....... benttegetescascasait At 35 
Wood, Dr. H.C., Researches on inoculation 

of diphtheria by.............. iaveen ess Petraes iv 38 
Woodbury process of photo-printing........ i 42, 57 
Wooden pavements, Failure Of.............ee08 Ai 26 


Woodward, J. J., communication on the al- 

leged hermaphrodite described by 

Drs. Accly, Blackman, and Jackson. 
Abstract and reference.........+0+ Sct ae a 24 

he desirability of reproducing photo- 

graphs of scientific objects, and espe- 

cially of magnified microscopical 

preparations, in a permanent form by 


175. 


Page. 
Woodward, J. J., communication on—Cont’d. 
some photo-mechanical method. <Ab- 
SETACE ....0ecce0 Bieaaephnssiduanans'a seagas aaneaaea senate i 41 
the use of monochromatic sunlight as 
an aid to high-power definition. Ab- 


BUNACE GNA TEFERENCE ss asccvucecesescccssosevencees i 47 
the Woodbury photo-relief process. Ab- 
SETACE ....0ccene nededudonvepamsedaksbasiacqccactes velyeV i 57 
spectra and spectroscopes. Vo abstract, 

i 89 
micrometrie writing on glass. Title 


OMA snscces sssccadacscosscsee peeved caapessevesas Reexeehe i 93 
the similarity between the red blood- 
corpuscles of man and those of certain 
other mammals, especially the dog; 
considered in connection with the di- 
agnosis of blood stains in criminal 
eases. Abstract and reference............ ii 20 
the markings on Nayicula rhomboides. 
TRGLE OVD) sc actanctchaccanaceees aacanushaterenecesces ii 69 
the rulings on glass by Mr. Rogers, of 
Cambridge: Abstract ..5.s.scesetessvsesbencae ii 120 
the modern microscope, Nobert’s lines, 
and the attempts of others to con- 
struct them. Title OnLy.....ssc.s0 sesesees di 25 
diffraction phenomena in the field of 
the microscope. Abstract and refer- 


CNL Onisncsasiee aetnstnastaeiewanssiedonets Serta ii 60 
the microscopical structure of wool. 

Datla iON ire cea ccsdncttsades svcgivscotaveverenecesee fi 62 
the Papyrus Ebers. Abstract......... wii 64 


the use of photography in connection 
with the micrometer measurement of 
blood corpuscles. Title only.... .......dl 79 
asimple device for the illumination of 
balsam-mounted objects for examina- 
tion with certain immersion objectives 
whose “balsam angle” is 90° or up- 
wards. Jn full.) 1 fig“urre..ccccccacssecevese ii 126 
the apertometer of Prof. E. Abbe, of Jena, 
Germany. Abstract... .ccscccsecsssconcsones iii 18 
a standard for micrometry. Abstract, 
iii 22 
the oil-immersion objectives of Zeiss, 
and on convenient methods of obtain- 
ing oblique illumination for these and 
similar objectives. Abstract............d41 25 
& new apertometer for microscopic cb- 
jectives. Dttle- only icoccsssdscesccvcce kil 37 
some apparatus recently brought into 
use by the Medical Department of the 
Army for the examination of the eye. 
ALD BER EC Eosncccsscencdcancosncevssusccenevanteey econ iii 53 
Riddell’s binocular microscope—an his- 
torical notice. Abstract and refer- 
ONCE. cocccrcececcccreccssccrerecccssereccccsssscccecsshW 30 


176 


Page. 
Woodward, J. J., communication on—Cont’d. 
a biographical sketch of the late Dr. 


Otis. TN fUll.cecccrcccrsscresseversnnnsseeserees iv 171 
modern philosophical conceptions of 
life. Presidential address. In full......v 49 
Death Of... .cccesccesss aieede dade ctu seeneate eabuavaves vil 72 
remarks on malformed dog........ Maes: 4185 
diagnosis of blood-stains.......-......s00000 ii 41 
a new meteorological instrument........ di 64 
POIGONEA ATTOW Suc c2-c-scoesccctcscasee sseeed 180, 182 
Resolutions on the death of..............00+ vii 75 
Woodward, R.S., cited on infinite attraction, 


wili 59 
communication on the special treatment 
of certain forms of observation-equa- 
BIOMB CADENA Bb aeetde osha. ts sere cease conateeee vi 156 
a concrete problem in hydrostatics pro- 
posed by Mr. G. K. Gilbert. Title only, 
vii 101 
some practical features of a field time 
determination with a meridian transit. 
ADSER Met esicdexavescdbcectanasscadecakesseveaty viii 55 
the changes of terrestrial level surfaces 
due to variations in distribution of 
superficial matter. Reference.......... ix 15 
the position and shape of the geoid as 
dependent on local masses. Reference, 
ix 53, 54 
the free cooling of a homogeneous sphere 
initially heated to a uniform tempera- 


ture. Reference....... Santee Bp verereciocinece x 90 

the conditioned cooling of a homogene- 
ous spheres | -Repenence.cisssessccdeccocnasees x 103 
remarks on deflection of plumb-line....vii 92 
GrassMann’s ZEOMELLY........0...scceevees vili 53 
Infinite attraction ......s000- cseccccscccccesses viii 63 
problem in probabilities......... Ssdve raster 89 
Wolf’s comet (1884 III). .1....c-seeceseeeeee viii 37 
MW GOTATA: srscpelne acocoderecanaccesecsaeatdassdeciedsneurate v 62 
Words in an individual vocabulary......ii 28, (16) 
Written language and speech............ssee0 iii 139 

Wyandottes, Social and political organiza- 
WIOWOLisrerebasceess paveuuspevese’s teacutensntsiiaties lil 137 
pWards) StanGard)ccccoscdscsucneesssccessses Lupecteeye ii 136 


Yarnall, Mordecai, communication on the 
general star catalogue prepared from 
the observations at the Naval Obsery- 


atory since 1845. Reference.......ssee.000+ i 74 

MD GALH VOLT eis ictse clap cncsenctecacceseswenchesesswaghds fii 28 

Yeast ferment as an insecticide.............. vii 11 

Yellowstone expedition of 1870...........ssscee00 ee 

WRN Gy ea Na dasc<takacorsvenanves coustuesncnrsurevteroiee vii 20 
Young, C. A., cited on observations at Sher- 

TANS WW YO wcovveusecccensiunishecvuseeess 4k 71, 73 


zodiacal light............. ee aupsenasewusaurents i (21) 


PHILOSOPHICAL SOCIETY OF WASHINGTON. 


Page. 
Young, C. A., communication on the expe- 
dition to Pekin for observing the late 
transit of Venus. Abstract............. fi 33 
Young, Dr. T., cited on superficial repul- 
siOn....... apaveausteleveatadeausa eacesvad soveescceneW 155 
theories of heat and light........ wee 134 
Young-Helmholtz theory of color....... itediv Soe 


Ziwet, Alexander, communication on Grass- 
mann’s system of geometry. Reference. 


wili 53 
remarks on problem in probabilites.......x 89 
Zodiacal. light..i<cscsc.csvchoecvavane cevesned deceenee ssessht (19) 
Zoological work of S. F. Baird....... aves tuohaeeen x 62 

Zoology, List of papers on (See also Bi- 

ology). 

on the characteristics and zoological rela- 
tions of man. T.Gill. Abstract........ i 24 

on the number of the cephalie vertebre. 
T. Hilgard. Reference........ phalbeaeen ee i 26 


on additions to the fish fauna of Massachu- 

setts, due to the researches of Prof. S. 

F. Baird, U. S. Fish Commissioner. T. 

Gill... Reference: ic..cccscsese oconcenastabessres nner 
on the tapir of the Andes and its allied 

forms. T.. Gilli: :2itleonlyak-cterccsasere 169 
on a tunny new to the American coast. T. 

Gill. Title only...cccitWarseecene wuyeeee Pons Wl v¢ 
on the decrease of fish on the southern 

coast of New England. S. F. Baird. 

Refer ence......+ seeetenreeae alowetohScdavarceceneeeme A 52 
on the homologies of the shoulder girdle 

of fishes. . T. Gill; Reference....:s.-.0s i 64 
on the Scombrocottus salmoneus of Peters. 

T. Gill... Title ont. devessssteccedscctaceteeye i 68 
on the homologies of the arm in fishes, 

and the development of the humerus 

in ganoids. T. Gill. Title only.........4 73 
on the habits of the fur-bearing seals of the 

islands of St. Paul and St. George, 


Behring Sea. H. W. Elliott. Refer- 

ONCE. sodsascuceasessessstuncanarddesheensuitsteeueeeennae i gl 
on the primates and their relations to 

man... T. Gill. . Ditle onlyxnsdiesectaneeee i 96 


on the structure and homologies of the 
limbs, especially in Aves. E. Coues. 
Ditle: ONMAY. Sec tenotoce sevedseccesentachuae ee NEA ced i 96 
on the structure and shape of Palzothe- 
rium. T. Gill. Abstract......... ee ae 
on the “Prodromus methodi mammal- 
ium” of Storr. T. Gill. Jn full...ii 15, (3) 
on the similarity between the red blood- 
corpuscles of man and those of certain 
other mammals, especially the dog; 
considered in connection with the 
diagnosis of blood-stains in criminal 


INDEX TO VOLUMES I[- x. 


Page. 


Zoology, List of papers— Cont'd. 
cases. J.J. Woodward. Abstract and 
MOT CLOTNE Ciestidarshactetesseasarsaserescckeares acs ii 
on the geographical distribution of mam- 
mals. T.N. Gill. Abstract............0 ii 
explanatory note on the diagnosis of 
‘blood stains. J.G. Richardson. Read 
by J. J. Woodward. Reference....,.....4 
outlines of a natural arrangement of the 
Falconide. R. Ridgway. Communi- 
cated by T. Gill. Reference.............05 ii 
the microscopical structure of wool. 
Woodward and John Leconte. Title 
the markings on Navicula rhomboides. 
J.J.Woodward. Title only..........0006 ii 
shower of the Rocky-Mountain grasshop- 
pers. C. G. Boerner. Communicated 
by J. Henry. AdStract...-..- ceceeseee vere dh 
the relations and sequences cof be fants 
Centrarchoides. T. N. Gill. Title 
ONY ceesgeskseus ccosstves PAN Bt aS aie li 
the morphology of the antlers of the Cer- 
vide. T.Gill. Abstract and reference, 
li 
some phases of the evolutional history of 
the North American Unionidee. C. A. 
URIETC ee AW ELEKOTL sweverisscisavontacs cocsesseves: li 
a new species of Chimeera found in Amer- 
ican waters. T. Gill. Abstract.........ii 
{exhibition of malformed dog.] 
MONOGEs WO AORENGCL...... seccconeseces’ asenee ili 
the results of recent investigations into 
the natural history of the Chitonide. 
Distt OS Ute AOSULGCL .cdoncts.20-caccanss00-0 ii 
a fish found on the Florida coast. 
Abbey. Letter, read by C. ae No 
PEDO D EC ractionge sceriicadiciavacesncesecsccant set ere ii 
the family of Ceratiids. T. N. Gill. Title 
MITEDMIE  cuupnctoeads <Uotasctaturdtaniacssatsea-csestsascs ii 
notes on the museums and zoological 
gardens of northern Europe. W. H. 
Dall. 
the artificial propagation of the cod. S. F. 
IIR yA USER ACT sc ic.cesceerncvacssesenesosesss ili 
the embryology of Lingula and the sys- 
tematic relations of the Brachiopods. 
W. K. Brooks. Title only............. ... iif 
the muscles of the oyster. W. H. Dall. 
ROBY CGE oredaleulscen reused ecocusocvnsa iets seveeee ofl 


20 


41 


41 


62 


69 


87 


118 


185 


202 


202 


Title only.....sss00 agedet ddsetesaees iii 19, 21 


29 


33 


36 


177 


Page. 


Zoology, List of papers on—Cont’d. 


pupation of the Nymphalide. C.Y. Riley. 
PL UREM IS anennecnsdscavdayscansveocaveyeoesace eases iil 
the issuance of silkworm moths from their 
cocoons, and some striking departures 
from normal habits in insects. C.V. 
Riley... Ditle One. s.cetvccsssecsceses.sassseus iii 
some recent observations on mollusks. 
W.-H. Dall -ADStr Obits crcsccscestecnecees iii 
some remarkable instances of ingestion 
among fishes. T.N. Gill. Abstract..iii 
animal population of the globe. L. F. 
Ward. Absiritetci ci) tecencaseccencsncuses iv 
the swordfish and its allies. G. B. Goode. 
RESON ENCE avait iuetdesca sine Wisccatcteee renee iv 
on some peculiar features of mollusks 
found at pink depths. W. H. Dall. 
Abstract... vostuasaseaceueswussnecterssancesuwmi 
on some peeailap Ravages of the Terads 
navalis. A.B. Johnson. Title only..v 
on the classification of the insectivorous 
mammals. T.Gill. In full.............. Vv 
the prevention of malarial diseases, illus- 
trating, inter alia, the conservative 
function of ague. A. F.A. King. Ab- 


SEN DCCs svthnes eccrentecoestene-cuvey ksaroreessebenee vi 
recent experiments on serpent yenom. 
R. Fletcher. Reference............,0.-000e vi 
analogues in zoo-geography. T. N. Gill. 
DUCLEIO TUN ccay accent aieetone oe xesatteeniceees vi 
ichthyological results of the voyage of the 
Albatross. T.N.Gill. Title only...... vi 
recent advances in our knowledge of the 
limpets. W.H. Dall. Abstract......wii 
recent advances in economic entomology. 
C.Vie Baileys Abstracts. ch accncrsee 
certain appendages of the mollusca. W. 
Ba Dally Reperence-c'.::..ccscesese cee vii 


two remarkable forms of mollusks. W. 
H. Dall. Abstract and reference......witi 
the distribution of fishes in the oceanic 
abysses and middle strata. G. B. 
Goode and T. H. Bean. Title only...ix 


’ our city shade-trees, their foes and their 


future. C.V. Riley. Reference.........X 
the economic phase of the English spar- 
row question. C.H. Merriam. Refer- 
OMCE. ccarccscecis sucudepaansudnsabowevestecsacanaautors x 


Zornow, Prof. A. R., cited on Malfatti’s bene 


lem.. ainsandedaneGecadseeuesceencexeey veld 


41 


44 
75 
116 
27 


162 


we 
bo 


a 


16 


118 


He an bal ‘Aaa Heitynegit ie B06 fe EE 
: ¢ . saith wee 4 SY ieard te tae , 


-_ 
~ 


¥ ita By jest 
reas <5 <LunNatieh s PRA Peis. AL en uae 
iba ede Rian ea i: a a eae ad, 

1 ’ a Cie 


PMR asi hi. tr ey te) byl aay ty bho A 
ot Aare Ty a Set Nees tee oa , Pi vine ea pena 


aS *, . <v s 
ud ght Stee ties op ey ‘ 7 ae Oe ed 
2 ye ¢ 47 ‘ 3 AWK Hy r Mth tay eat 
4 bose vid ' ‘ = 
\ ” , ro 
: ¢ F “4 pe 
° : ; ‘, \ ¥ 


§ De 4 u » 
hig . ‘ * 
vf 
1439 eh @ : 
rl ‘ 
v : bi ee 
rae 4 ul 
F oe, Am TER A , f , 
/ : ‘ 
F ma 1 ’ os 
F ‘ 
A is ie * . , ‘ 
4 bh ¢ tae 6 ark al ‘ 
iN a ” 
iY 4 Pi § a uk 


2 vz rereeperee 94 Ae $ ‘ 
, Pidey eae Ie ‘ f x j > 7 
re ¥ i » ' ‘ A ‘ores 

i is a 4 , 

4 ‘ i ele pa 4 
; oe { Ne ) 

p ‘ : ais 

y ay : seat bat ‘ ‘a3 

\ ( P f 

i Cs Apna va ’ 


: 4 es ss has FD ‘ Lh thee : i 4 
f Ay Te < he ab eh t 7 t 
: : ’ re te y t ‘ 
) * 
Y , . pete) Ate aS Ar eth Neri 
. hd ‘ * Naty ed ies 
i 
‘ y , ar 
P =a 
: 
al a 
¥ ’ 
v < 3 
ve ? ; ° x 
: f Se ee . “+ f 
ine a ‘ 
Wee I i \ 
; ; ‘ 
4 s ’ ‘ 


a+ 
tar BO Rate 


— aa ees” ‘eaer 
DARARARA AN RAP aif : | 
ny waa > TT ee 
an nanRannnan nan a aaa saad es aa Psst AAA aye TITRAANY 
p Pig! vw Naan ARAN AYANAIA RannArnn i we AANA aAAnnd: t . rconas 
AnAAAA OAR ARRAN AannnnnaNnnaaanAs ananannanes NAR Ate 2 nah a AAA anaanraann 
A ~ SS NAAT i AAAAA 


AAAAR Aap AANA ‘na Snndat 
ga AAA AMA. Meanie nany MM SAAAAMAAAARA ‘onnconnattt tana 


P\AAAl 
Raa A; A : AnARBRA | ae ae 
mtd Mw yy eee Ay ee nDAANAA Aaa 29727 a RARAN 
Namne ga Mea anna iv" AA naan’ AASAASn aA annAn’ annann ann 
Nene os : moran Se v, AP he! , Mannan’ ee AAAA ann AAOnOARE 
NR PRAR SS ARSAR ARS * oe bagg VA" Bannan Roane NN nacenhan nani 

gprckeen ces ens ase Age aRaAnnA 

wt Aner. aannatn 


: IAT 
A Au AIR 
ak AAA 


ys eri ACE 2 ; saacaanaannnnl ° aga AAAAARA AMAA 
AeA Ay N | MAMAR Aa | anne 
AANA ATS As Anne Annnan J 


A anya iasenenlnnnnnaeaninan 


only ‘ A A w - anyatatttty AA Na h Annan? 

ae yA : “RRAR. -nanasanaan 3 

Palace nnaae an RRAANAA ma PAAAAAAAN. 
val ee Aan